summaryrefslogtreecommitdiff
path: root/docs/htmldocs
diff options
context:
space:
mode:
Diffstat (limited to 'docs/htmldocs')
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/Samba-Developers-Guide.html10559
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/bugreport.html411
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/diagnosis.html835
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/findsmb.1.html307
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/groupmapping.html412
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/install.html1039
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/integrate-ms-networks.html1221
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/introduction.html424
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/lmhosts.5.html215
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/msdfs.html359
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/net.8.html545
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/nmbd.8.html821
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/nmblookup.1.html467
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/optional.html924
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/pam.html861
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/pdbedit.8.html680
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/printing.html3604
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/rpcclient.1.html871
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/samba-bdc.html592
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/samba-pdc.html3070
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/samba.7.html427
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/smb.conf.5.html19827
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/smbcacls.1.html460
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/smbclient.1.html1747
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/smbcontrol.1.html444
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/smbd.8.html807
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/smbmnt.8.html197
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/smbmount.8.html482
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/smbpasswd.5.html342
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/smbpasswd.8.html663
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/smbsh.1.html551
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/smbspool.8.html232
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/smbstatus.1.html257
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/smbtar.1.html375
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/smbumount.8.html145
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/speed.html504
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/swat.8.html486
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/testparm.1.html331
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/testprns.1.html265
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/type.html398
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/vfstest.1.html502
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/wbinfo.1.html408
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/winbind.html1897
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/winbindd.8.html999
44 files changed, 9196 insertions, 51767 deletions
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/Samba-Developers-Guide.html b/docs/htmldocs/Samba-Developers-Guide.html
index b90d99bf66..86de03d627 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/Samba-Developers-Guide.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/Samba-Developers-Guide.html
@@ -1,1091 +1,193 @@
-<!DOCTYPE HTML PUBLIC "-//W3C//DTD HTML 4.01 Transitional//EN">
-<HTML
-><HEAD
-><TITLE
->SAMBA Developers Guide</TITLE
-><META
-NAME="GENERATOR"
-CONTENT="Modular DocBook HTML Stylesheet Version 1.77"></HEAD
-><BODY
-CLASS="BOOK"
-BGCOLOR="#FFFFFF"
-TEXT="#000000"
-LINK="#0000FF"
-VLINK="#840084"
-ALINK="#0000FF"
-><DIV
-CLASS="BOOK"
-><A
-NAME="SAMBA-DEVELOPERS-GUIDE"
-></A
-><DIV
-CLASS="TITLEPAGE"
-><H1
-CLASS="TITLE"
-><A
-NAME="SAMBA-DEVELOPERS-GUIDE"
-></A
->SAMBA Developers Guide</H1
-><H3
-CLASS="AUTHOR"
-><A
-NAME="AEN4"
-></A
->SAMBA Team</H3
-><HR></DIV
-><HR><H1
-><A
-NAME="AEN8"
-></A
->Abstract</H1
-><P
-><SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->Last Update</I
-></SPAN
-> : Mon Sep 30 15:23:53 CDT 2002</P
-><P
->This book is a collection of documents that might be useful for
+<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>SAMBA Developers Guide</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><meta name="description" content="
+Last Update : Fri Jun 6 00:45:54 CEST 2003
+
+This book is a collection of documents that might be useful for
people developing samba or those interested in doing so.
It's nothing more than a collection of documents written by samba developers about
the internals of various parts of samba and the SMB protocol. It's still incomplete.
The most recent version of this document
-can be found at <A
-HREF="http://devel.samba.org/"
-TARGET="_top"
->http://devel.samba.org/</A
->.
-Please send updates to <A
-HREF="mailto:jelmer@samba.org"
-TARGET="_top"
->jelmer@samba.org</A
->.</P
-><P
->This documentation is distributed under the GNU General Public License (GPL)
+can be found at http://devel.samba.org/.
+Please send updates to Jelmer Vernooij.
+
+This documentation is distributed under the GNU General Public License (GPL)
version 2. A copy of the license is included with the Samba source
-distribution. A copy can be found on-line at <A
-HREF="http://www.fsf.org/licenses/gpl.txt"
-TARGET="_top"
->http://www.fsf.org/licenses/gpl.txt</A
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="TOC"
-><DL
-><DT
-><B
->Table of Contents</B
-></DT
-><DT
->1. <A
-HREF="#NETBIOS"
->Definition of NetBIOS Protocol and Name Resolution Modes</A
-></DT
-><DD
-><DL
-><DT
->1.1. <A
-HREF="#AEN24"
->NETBIOS</A
-></DT
-><DT
->1.2. <A
-HREF="#AEN35"
->BROADCAST NetBIOS</A
-></DT
-><DT
->1.3. <A
-HREF="#AEN39"
->NBNS NetBIOS</A
-></DT
-></DL
-></DD
-><DT
->2. <A
-HREF="#ARCHITECTURE"
->Samba Architecture</A
-></DT
-><DD
-><DL
-><DT
->2.1. <A
-HREF="#AEN54"
->Introduction</A
-></DT
-><DT
->2.2. <A
-HREF="#AEN65"
->Multithreading and Samba</A
-></DT
-><DT
->2.3. <A
-HREF="#AEN70"
->Threading smbd</A
-></DT
-><DT
->2.4. <A
-HREF="#AEN86"
->Threading nmbd</A
-></DT
-><DT
->2.5. <A
-HREF="#AEN92"
->nbmd Design</A
-></DT
-></DL
-></DD
-><DT
->3. <A
-HREF="#DEBUG"
->The samba DEBUG system</A
-></DT
-><DD
-><DL
-><DT
->3.1. <A
-HREF="#AEN103"
->New Output Syntax</A
-></DT
-><DT
->3.2. <A
-HREF="#AEN128"
->The DEBUG() Macro</A
-></DT
-><DT
->3.3. <A
-HREF="#AEN151"
->The DEBUGADD() Macro</A
-></DT
-><DT
->3.4. <A
-HREF="#AEN159"
->The DEBUGLVL() Macro</A
-></DT
-><DT
->3.5. <A
-HREF="#AEN179"
->New Functions</A
-></DT
-><DD
-><DL
-><DT
->3.5.1. <A
-HREF="#AEN181"
->dbgtext()</A
-></DT
-><DT
->3.5.2. <A
-HREF="#AEN184"
->dbghdr()</A
-></DT
-><DT
->3.5.3. <A
-HREF="#AEN188"
->format_debug_text()</A
-></DT
-></DL
-></DD
-></DL
-></DD
-><DT
->4. <A
-HREF="#CODINGSUGGESTIONS"
->Coding Suggestions</A
-></DT
-><DT
->5. <A
-HREF="#INTERNALS"
->Samba Internals</A
-></DT
-><DD
-><DL
-><DT
->5.1. <A
-HREF="#AEN284"
->Character Handling</A
-></DT
-><DT
->5.2. <A
-HREF="#AEN288"
->The new functions</A
-></DT
-><DT
->5.3. <A
-HREF="#AEN317"
->Macros in byteorder.h</A
-></DT
-><DD
-><DL
-><DT
->5.3.1. <A
-HREF="#AEN320"
->CVAL(buf,pos)</A
-></DT
-><DT
->5.3.2. <A
-HREF="#AEN323"
->PVAL(buf,pos)</A
-></DT
-><DT
->5.3.3. <A
-HREF="#AEN326"
->SCVAL(buf,pos,val)</A
-></DT
-><DT
->5.3.4. <A
-HREF="#AEN329"
->SVAL(buf,pos)</A
-></DT
-><DT
->5.3.5. <A
-HREF="#AEN332"
->IVAL(buf,pos)</A
-></DT
-><DT
->5.3.6. <A
-HREF="#AEN335"
->SVALS(buf,pos)</A
-></DT
-><DT
->5.3.7. <A
-HREF="#AEN338"
->IVALS(buf,pos)</A
-></DT
-><DT
->5.3.8. <A
-HREF="#AEN341"
->SSVAL(buf,pos,val)</A
-></DT
-><DT
->5.3.9. <A
-HREF="#AEN344"
->SIVAL(buf,pos,val)</A
-></DT
-><DT
->5.3.10. <A
-HREF="#AEN347"
->SSVALS(buf,pos,val)</A
-></DT
-><DT
->5.3.11. <A
-HREF="#AEN350"
->SIVALS(buf,pos,val)</A
-></DT
-><DT
->5.3.12. <A
-HREF="#AEN353"
->RSVAL(buf,pos)</A
-></DT
-><DT
->5.3.13. <A
-HREF="#AEN356"
->RIVAL(buf,pos)</A
-></DT
-><DT
->5.3.14. <A
-HREF="#AEN359"
->RSSVAL(buf,pos,val)</A
-></DT
-><DT
->5.3.15. <A
-HREF="#AEN362"
->RSIVAL(buf,pos,val)</A
-></DT
-></DL
-></DD
-><DT
->5.4. <A
-HREF="#AEN365"
->LAN Manager Samba API</A
-></DT
-><DD
-><DL
-><DT
->5.4.1. <A
-HREF="#AEN371"
->Parameters</A
-></DT
-><DT
->5.4.2. <A
-HREF="#AEN406"
->Return value</A
-></DT
-></DL
-></DD
-><DT
->5.5. <A
-HREF="#AEN420"
->Code character table</A
-></DT
-></DL
-></DD
-><DT
->6. <A
-HREF="#PARSING"
->The smb.conf file</A
-></DT
-><DD
-><DL
-><DT
->6.1. <A
-HREF="#AEN451"
->Lexical Analysis</A
-></DT
-><DD
-><DL
-><DT
->6.1.1. <A
-HREF="#AEN472"
->Handling of Whitespace</A
-></DT
-><DT
->6.1.2. <A
-HREF="#AEN484"
->Handling of Line Continuation</A
-></DT
-><DT
->6.1.3. <A
-HREF="#AEN495"
->Line Continuation Quirks</A
-></DT
-></DL
-></DD
-><DT
->6.2. <A
-HREF="#AEN515"
->Syntax</A
-></DT
-><DD
-><DL
-><DT
->6.2.1. <A
-HREF="#AEN530"
->About params.c</A
-></DT
-></DL
-></DD
-></DL
-></DD
-><DT
->7. <A
-HREF="#UNIX-SMB"
->NetBIOS in a Unix World</A
-></DT
-><DD
-><DL
-><DT
->7.1. <A
-HREF="#AEN540"
->Introduction</A
-></DT
-><DT
->7.2. <A
-HREF="#AEN544"
->Usernames</A
-></DT
-><DT
->7.3. <A
-HREF="#AEN552"
->File Ownership</A
-></DT
-><DT
->7.4. <A
-HREF="#AEN557"
->Passwords</A
-></DT
-><DT
->7.5. <A
-HREF="#AEN563"
->Locking</A
-></DT
-><DT
->7.6. <A
-HREF="#AEN571"
->Deny Modes</A
-></DT
-><DT
->7.7. <A
-HREF="#AEN575"
->Trapdoor UIDs</A
-></DT
-><DT
->7.8. <A
-HREF="#AEN579"
->Port numbers</A
-></DT
-><DT
->7.9. <A
-HREF="#AEN584"
->Protocol Complexity</A
-></DT
-></DL
-></DD
-><DT
->8. <A
-HREF="#TRACING"
->Tracing samba system calls</A
-></DT
-><DT
->9. <A
-HREF="#NTDOMAIN"
->NT Domain RPC's</A
-></DT
-><DD
-><DL
-><DT
->9.1. <A
-HREF="#AEN652"
->Introduction</A
-></DT
-><DD
-><DL
-><DT
->9.1.1. <A
-HREF="#AEN688"
->Sources</A
-></DT
-><DT
->9.1.2. <A
-HREF="#AEN695"
->Credits</A
-></DT
-></DL
-></DD
-><DT
->9.2. <A
-HREF="#AEN702"
->Notes and Structures</A
-></DT
-><DD
-><DL
-><DT
->9.2.1. <A
-HREF="#AEN704"
->Notes</A
-></DT
-><DT
->9.2.2. <A
-HREF="#AEN717"
->Enumerations</A
-></DT
-><DT
->9.2.3. <A
-HREF="#AEN775"
->Structures</A
-></DT
-></DL
-></DD
-><DT
->9.3. <A
-HREF="#AEN1571"
->MSRPC over Transact Named Pipe</A
-></DT
-><DD
-><DL
-><DT
->9.3.1. <A
-HREF="#AEN1574"
->MSRPC Pipes</A
-></DT
-><DT
->9.3.2. <A
-HREF="#AEN1588"
->Header</A
-></DT
-><DT
->9.3.3. <A
-HREF="#AEN1842"
->Tail</A
-></DT
-><DT
->9.3.4. <A
-HREF="#AEN1854"
->RPC Bind / Bind Ack</A
-></DT
-><DT
->9.3.5. <A
-HREF="#AEN1898"
->NTLSA Transact Named Pipe</A
-></DT
-><DT
->9.3.6. <A
-HREF="#AEN1939"
->LSA Open Policy</A
-></DT
-><DT
->9.3.7. <A
-HREF="#AEN1973"
->LSA Query Info Policy</A
-></DT
-><DT
->9.3.8. <A
-HREF="#AEN2001"
->LSA Enumerate Trusted Domains</A
-></DT
-><DT
->9.3.9. <A
-HREF="#AEN2025"
->LSA Open Secret</A
-></DT
-><DT
->9.3.10. <A
-HREF="#AEN2054"
->LSA Close</A
-></DT
-><DT
->9.3.11. <A
-HREF="#AEN2071"
->LSA Lookup SIDS</A
-></DT
-><DT
->9.3.12. <A
-HREF="#AEN2130"
->LSA Lookup Names</A
-></DT
-></DL
-></DD
-><DT
->9.4. <A
-HREF="#AEN2193"
->NETLOGON rpc Transact Named Pipe</A
-></DT
-><DD
-><DL
-><DT
->9.4.1. <A
-HREF="#AEN2232"
->LSA Request Challenge</A
-></DT
-><DT
->9.4.2. <A
-HREF="#AEN2267"
->LSA Authenticate 2</A
-></DT
-><DT
->9.4.3. <A
-HREF="#AEN2306"
->LSA Server Password Set</A
-></DT
-><DT
->9.4.4. <A
-HREF="#AEN2335"
->LSA SAM Logon</A
-></DT
-><DT
->9.4.5. <A
-HREF="#AEN2359"
->LSA SAM Logoff</A
-></DT
-></DL
-></DD
-><DT
->9.5. <A
-HREF="#AEN2382"
->\\MAILSLOT\NET\NTLOGON</A
-></DT
-><DD
-><DL
-><DT
->9.5.1. <A
-HREF="#AEN2386"
->Query for PDC</A
-></DT
-><DT
->9.5.2. <A
-HREF="#AEN2460"
->SAM Logon</A
-></DT
-></DL
-></DD
-><DT
->9.6. <A
-HREF="#AEN2550"
->SRVSVC Transact Named Pipe</A
-></DT
-><DD
-><DL
-><DT
->9.6.1. <A
-HREF="#AEN2562"
->Net Share Enum</A
-></DT
-><DT
->9.6.2. <A
-HREF="#AEN2623"
->Net Server Get Info</A
-></DT
-></DL
-></DD
-><DT
->9.7. <A
-HREF="#AEN2654"
->Cryptographic side of NT Domain Authentication</A
-></DT
-><DD
-><DL
-><DT
->9.7.1. <A
-HREF="#AEN2656"
->Definitions</A
-></DT
-><DT
->9.7.2. <A
-HREF="#AEN2699"
->Protocol</A
-></DT
-><DT
->9.7.3. <A
-HREF="#AEN2709"
->Comments</A
-></DT
-></DL
-></DD
-><DT
->9.8. <A
-HREF="#AEN2716"
->SIDs and RIDs</A
-></DT
-><DD
-><DL
-><DT
->9.8.1. <A
-HREF="#AEN2724"
->Well-known SIDs</A
-></DT
-><DT
->9.8.2. <A
-HREF="#AEN2812"
->Well-known RIDS</A
-></DT
-></DL
-></DD
-></DL
-></DD
-><DT
->10. <A
-HREF="#PRINTING"
->Samba Printing Internals</A
-></DT
-><DD
-><DL
-><DT
->10.1. <A
-HREF="#AEN2896"
->Abstract</A
-></DT
-><DT
->10.2. <A
-HREF="#AEN2899"
->Printing Interface to Various Back ends</A
-></DT
-><DT
->10.3. <A
-HREF="#AEN2925"
->Print Queue TDB's</A
-></DT
-><DT
->10.4. <A
-HREF="#AEN2959"
->ChangeID &#38; Client Caching of Printer Information</A
-></DT
-><DT
->10.5. <A
-HREF="#AEN2962"
->Windows NT/2K Printer Change Notify</A
-></DT
-></DL
-></DD
-><DT
->11. <A
-HREF="#WINS"
->Samba WINS Internals</A
-></DT
-><DD
-><DL
-><DT
->11.1. <A
-HREF="#AEN3033"
->WINS Failover</A
-></DT
-></DL
-></DD
-><DT
->12. <A
-HREF="#SAM"
->The Upcoming SAM System</A
-></DT
-><DD
-><DL
-><DT
->12.1. <A
-HREF="#AEN3054"
->Security in the 'new SAM'</A
-></DT
-><DT
->12.2. <A
-HREF="#AEN3071"
->Standalone from UNIX</A
-></DT
-><DT
->12.3. <A
-HREF="#AEN3075"
->Handles and Races in the new SAM</A
-></DT
-><DT
->12.4. <A
-HREF="#AEN3086"
->Layers</A
-></DT
-><DD
-><DL
-><DT
->12.4.1. <A
-HREF="#AEN3088"
->Application</A
-></DT
-><DT
->12.4.2. <A
-HREF="#AEN3091"
->SAM Interface</A
-></DT
-><DT
->12.4.3. <A
-HREF="#AEN3095"
->SAM Modules</A
-></DT
-></DL
-></DD
-><DT
->12.5. <A
-HREF="#AEN3098"
->SAM Modules</A
-></DT
-><DD
-><DL
-><DT
->12.5.1. <A
-HREF="#AEN3100"
->Special Module: sam_passdb</A
-></DT
-><DT
->12.5.2. <A
-HREF="#AEN3103"
->sam_ads</A
-></DT
-></DL
-></DD
-><DT
->12.6. <A
-HREF="#AEN3107"
->Memory Management</A
-></DT
-><DT
->12.7. <A
-HREF="#AEN3121"
->Testing</A
-></DT
-></DL
-></DD
-><DT
->13. <A
-HREF="#PWENCRYPT"
->LanMan and NT Password Encryption</A
-></DT
-><DD
-><DL
-><DT
->13.1. <A
-HREF="#AEN3147"
->Introduction</A
-></DT
-><DT
->13.2. <A
-HREF="#AEN3151"
->How does it work?</A
-></DT
-><DT
->13.3. <A
-HREF="#AEN3162"
-><A
-NAME="SMBPASSWDFILEFORMAT"
-></A
->The smbpasswd file</A
-></DT
-></DL
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="CHAPTER"
-><HR><H1
-><A
-NAME="NETBIOS"
-></A
->Chapter 1. Definition of NetBIOS Protocol and Name Resolution Modes</H1
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><H2
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN24"
-></A
->1.1. NETBIOS</H2
-><P
->NetBIOS runs over the following tranports: TCP/IP; NetBEUI and IPX/SPX.
+distribution. A copy can be found on-line at http://www.fsf.org/licenses/gpl.txt
+"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="book" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h1 class="title"><a name="Samba-Developers-Guide"></a>SAMBA Developers Guide</h1></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="surname">SAMBA Team</span></h3></div></div><div><div class="legalnotice"><p><b>Attributions. </b>
+ </p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term"><a href="#netbios" title="Chapter 1. Definition of NetBIOS Protocol and Name Resolution Modes">Definition of NetBIOS Protocol and Name Resolution Modes</a></span></dt><dd><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Luke Leighton</p></li></ul></div></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="#architecture" title="Chapter 2. Samba Architecture">Samba Architecture</a></span></dt><dd><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Dan Shearer</p></li></ul></div></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="#debug" title="Chapter 3. The samba DEBUG system">The samba DEBUG system</a></span></dt><dd><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Chris Hertel</p></li></ul></div></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="#CodingSuggestions" title="Chapter 4. Coding Suggestions">Coding Suggestions</a></span></dt><dd><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Steve French</p></li><li><p>Simo Sorce</p></li><li><p>Andrew Bartlett</p></li><li><p>Tim Potter</p></li><li><p>Martin Pool</p></li></ul></div></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="#internals" title="Chapter 5. Samba Internals">Samba Internals</a></span></dt><dd><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>David Chappell &lt;<a href="David.Chappell@mail.trincoll.edu" target="_top">David.Chappell@mail.trincoll.edu</a>&gt;</p></li></ul></div></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="#parsing" title="Chapter 6. The smb.conf file">The smb.conf file</a></span></dt><dd><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Chris Hertel</p></li></ul></div></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="#unix-smb" title="Chapter 7. NetBIOS in a Unix World">NetBIOS in a Unix World</a></span></dt><dd><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Andrew Tridgell</p></li></ul></div></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="#tracing" title="Chapter 8. Tracing samba system calls">Tracing samba system calls</a></span></dt><dd><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Andrew Tridgell</p></li></ul></div></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="#ntdomain" title="Chapter 9. NT Domain RPC's">NT Domain RPC's</a></span></dt><dd><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Luke Leighton &lt;<a href="lkcl@switchboard.net" target="_top">lkcl@switchboard.net</a>&gt;</p></li><li><p>Paul Ashton &lt;<a href="paul@argo.demon.co.uk" target="_top">paul@argo.demon.co.uk</a>&gt;</p></li><li><p>Duncan Stansfield &lt;<a href="duncans@sco.com" target="_top">duncans@sco.com</a>&gt;</p></li></ul></div></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="#printing" title="Chapter 10. Samba Printing Internals">Samba Printing Internals</a></span></dt><dd><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Gerald Carter</p></li></ul></div></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="#wins" title="Chapter 11. Samba WINS Internals">Samba WINS Internals</a></span></dt><dd><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Gerald Carter</p></li></ul></div></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="#sam" title="Chapter 12. The Upcoming SAM System">The Upcoming SAM System</a></span></dt><dd><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Andrew Bartlett</p></li></ul></div></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="#pwencrypt" title="Chapter 13. LanMan and NT Password Encryption">LanMan and NT Password Encryption</a></span></dt><dd><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Jeremy Allison &lt;<a href="samba@samba.org" target="_top">samba@samba.org</a>&gt;</p></li></ul></div></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="#modules" title="Chapter 14. Modules">Modules</a></span></dt><dd><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Jelmer Vernooij &lt;<a href="jelmer@samba.org" target="_top">jelmer@samba.org</a>&gt;</p></li></ul></div></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="#rpc-plugin" title="Chapter 15. RPC Pluggable Modules">RPC Pluggable Modules</a></span></dt><dd><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Anthony Liguori &lt;<a href="aliguor@us.ibm.com" target="_top">aliguor@us.ibm.com</a>&gt;</p></li><li><p>Jelmer Vernooij &lt;<a href="jelmer@samba.org" target="_top">jelmer@samba.org</a>&gt;</p></li></ul></div></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="#vfs" title="Chapter 16. VFS Modules">VFS Modules</a></span></dt><dd><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Alexander Bokovoy &lt;<a href="ab@samba.org" target="_top">ab@samba.org</a>&gt;</p></li><li><p>Stefan Metzmacher &lt;<a href="metze@metzemix.de" target="_top">metze@metzemix.de</a>&gt;</p></li></ul></div></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="#Packaging" title="Chapter 17. Notes to packagers">Notes to packagers</a></span></dt><dd><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Jelmer Vernooij</p></li></ul></div></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="#contributing" title="Chapter 18. Contributing code">Contributing code</a></span></dt><dd><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Jelmer Vernooij &lt;<a href="jelmer@samba.org" target="_top">jelmer@samba.org</a>&gt;</p></li></ul></div></dd></dl></div><p>
+
+ </p></div></div><div><div class="abstract"><p class="title"><b>Abstract</b></p><p>
+<span class="emphasis"><em>Last Update</em></span> : Fri Jun 6 00:45:54 CEST 2003
+</p><p>
+This book is a collection of documents that might be useful for
+people developing samba or those interested in doing so.
+It's nothing more than a collection of documents written by samba developers about
+the internals of various parts of samba and the SMB protocol. It's still incomplete.
+The most recent version of this document
+can be found at <a href="http://devel.samba.org/" target="_top">http://devel.samba.org/</a>.
+Please send updates to <a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org" target="_top">Jelmer Vernooij</a>.
+</p><p>
+This documentation is distributed under the GNU General Public License (GPL)
+version 2. A copy of the license is included with the Samba source
+distribution. A copy can be found on-line at <a href="http://www.fsf.org/licenses/gpl.txt" target="_top">http://www.fsf.org/licenses/gpl.txt</a>
+</p></div></div></div><div></div><hr></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt>1. <a href="#netbios">Definition of NetBIOS Protocol and Name Resolution Modes</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2797526">NETBIOS</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2866011">BROADCAST NetBIOS</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2866042">NBNS NetBIOS</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>2. <a href="#architecture">Samba Architecture</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2797150">Introduction</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2797202">Multithreading and Samba</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2797240">Threading smbd</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2797314">Threading nmbd</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2797382">nbmd Design</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>3. <a href="#debug">The samba DEBUG system</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2796808">New Output Syntax</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2796946">The DEBUG() Macro</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2867248">The DEBUGADD() Macro</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2867293">The DEBUGLVL() Macro</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2867398">New Functions</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2867405">dbgtext()</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2867425">dbghdr()</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2867448">format_debug_text()</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>4. <a href="#CodingSuggestions">Coding Suggestions</a></dt><dt>5. <a href="#internals">Samba Internals</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2866821">Character Handling</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2866847">The new functions</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2868099">Macros in byteorder.h</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2869024">CVAL(buf,pos)</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2869037">PVAL(buf,pos)</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2869051">SCVAL(buf,pos,val)</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2869064">SVAL(buf,pos)</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2869080">IVAL(buf,pos)</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2869094">SVALS(buf,pos)</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2869109">IVALS(buf,pos)</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2869123">SSVAL(buf,pos,val)</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2869138">SIVAL(buf,pos,val)</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2869152">SSVALS(buf,pos,val)</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2869166">SIVALS(buf,pos,val)</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2869181">RSVAL(buf,pos)</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2869195">RIVAL(buf,pos)</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2869210">RSSVAL(buf,pos,val)</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2869225">RSIVAL(buf,pos,val)</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2869240">LAN Manager Samba API</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2869276">Parameters</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2869427">Return value</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2869512">Code character table</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>6. <a href="#parsing">The smb.conf file</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2868851">Lexical Analysis</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2868944">Handling of Whitespace</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2869000">Handling of Line Continuation</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2870660">Line Continuation Quirks</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2870758">Syntax</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2870829">About params.c</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>7. <a href="#unix-smb">NetBIOS in a Unix World</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2870276">Introduction</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2870301">Usernames</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2870529">File Ownership</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2870566">Passwords</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2870604">Locking</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2871543">Deny Modes</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2871573">Trapdoor UIDs</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2871598">Port numbers</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2871644">Protocol Complexity</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>8. <a href="#tracing">Tracing samba system calls</a></dt><dt>9. <a href="#ntdomain">NT Domain RPC's</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2871220">Introduction</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2872245">Sources</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2872278">Credits</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2872317">Notes and Structures</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2872324">Notes</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2873087">Enumerations</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2873300">Structures</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2876250">MSRPC over Transact Named Pipe</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2876262">MSRPC Pipes</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2876365">Header</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2877236">Tail</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2877281">RPC Bind / Bind Ack</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2877461">NTLSA Transact Named Pipe</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2877626">LSA Open Policy</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2877752">LSA Query Info Policy</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2877858">LSA Enumerate Trusted Domains</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2877950">LSA Open Secret</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2878060">LSA Close</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2878126">LSA Lookup SIDS</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2878335">LSA Lookup Names</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2878561">NETLOGON rpc Transact Named Pipe</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2878722">LSA Request Challenge</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2878856">LSA Authenticate 2</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2879004">LSA Server Password Set</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2879119">LSA SAM Logon</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2879232">LSA SAM Logoff</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2879324">\\MAILSLOT\NET\NTLOGON</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2879336">Query for PDC</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2879604">SAM Logon</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2879929">SRVSVC Transact Named Pipe</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2879974">Net Share Enum</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2880194">Net Server Get Info</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2880310">Cryptographic side of NT Domain Authentication</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2880318">Definitions</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2880480">Protocol</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2880577">Comments</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2880626">SIDs and RIDs</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2880666">Well-known SIDs</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2880981">Well-known RIDS</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>10. <a href="#printing">Samba Printing Internals</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2889663">Abstract</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2889679">
+Printing Interface to Various Back ends
+</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2889934">
+Print Queue TDB's
+</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2890143">
+ChangeID and Client Caching of Printer Information
+</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2890156">
+Windows NT/2K Printer Change Notify
+</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>11. <a href="#wins">Samba WINS Internals</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2889624">WINS Failover</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>12. <a href="#sam">The Upcoming SAM System</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2889427">Security in the 'new SAM'</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2890951">Standalone from UNIX</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2890985">Handles and Races in the new SAM</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2891054">Layers</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2891061">Application</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2891077">SAM Interface</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2891105">SAM Modules</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2891126">SAM Modules</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2891134">Special Module: sam_passdb</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2891152">sam_ads</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2891191">Memory Management</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2891281">Testing</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>13. <a href="#pwencrypt">LanMan and NT Password Encryption</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2891920">Introduction</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2891945">How does it work?</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2890832">The smbpasswd file</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>14. <a href="#modules">Modules</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2891872">Advantages</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2892773">Loading modules</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2892806">Static modules</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2893746">Shared modules</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2893775">Writing modules</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2893837">Static/Shared selection in configure.in</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>15. <a href="#rpc-plugin">RPC Pluggable Modules</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2892540">About</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2892559">General Overview</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>16. <a href="#vfs">VFS Modules</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2894852">The Samba (Posix) VFS layer</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2894859">The general interface</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2894974">Possible VFS operation layers</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2895046">The Interaction between the Samba VFS subsystem and the modules</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2895054">Initialization and registration</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2895246">How the Modules handle per connection data</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2895490">Upgrading to the New VFS Interface</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2895497">Upgrading from 2.2.* and 3.0aplha modules</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2896037">Some Notes</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2896044">Implement TRANSPARENT functions</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2896069">Implement OPAQUE functions</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>17. <a href="#Packaging">Notes to packagers</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2894645">Versioning</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2894678">Modules</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>18. <a href="#contributing">Contributing code</a></dt></dl></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="netbios"></a>Chapter 1. Definition of NetBIOS Protocol and Name Resolution Modes</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Luke</span> <span class="surname">Leighton</span></h3></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">12 June 1997</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2797526">NETBIOS</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2866011">BROADCAST NetBIOS</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2866042">NBNS NetBIOS</a></dt></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2797526"></a>NETBIOS</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+NetBIOS runs over the following tranports: TCP/IP; NetBEUI and IPX/SPX.
Samba only uses NetBIOS over TCP/IP. For details on the TCP/IP NetBIOS
Session Service NetBIOS Datagram Service, and NetBIOS Names, see
-rfc1001.txt and rfc1002.txt.</P
-><P
->
+rfc1001.txt and rfc1002.txt.
+</p><p>
NetBEUI is a raw NetBIOS frame protocol implementation that allows NetBIOS
datagrams to be sent out over the 'wire' embedded within LLC frames.
NetBEUI is not required when using NetBIOS over TCP/IP protocols and it
-is preferable NOT to install NetBEUI if it can be avoided.</P
-><P
->
+is preferable NOT to install NetBEUI if it can be avoided.
+</p><p>
IPX/SPX is also not required when using NetBIOS over TCP/IP, and it is
preferable NOT to install the IPX/SPX transport unless you are using Novell
servers. At the very least, it is recommended that you do not install
-'NetBIOS over IPX/SPX'.</P
-><P
->[When installing Windows 95, you will find that NetBEUI and IPX/SPX are
+'NetBIOS over IPX/SPX'.
+</p><p>
+[When installing Windows 95, you will find that NetBEUI and IPX/SPX are
installed as the default protocols. This is because they are the simplest
-to manage: no Windows 95 user-configuration is required].</P
-><P
->
+to manage: no Windows 95 user-configuration is required].
+</p><p>
NetBIOS applications (such as samba) offer their services (for example,
SMB file and print sharing) on a NetBIOS name. They must claim this name
on the network before doing so. The NetBIOS session service will then
accept connections on the application's behalf (on the NetBIOS name
claimed by the application). A NetBIOS session between the application
-and the client can then commence.</P
-><P
->
+and the client can then commence.
+</p><p>
NetBIOS names consist of 15 characters plus a 'type' character. This is
similar, in concept, to an IP address and a TCP port number, respectively.
A NetBIOS-aware application on a host will offer different services under
different NetBIOS name types, just as a host will offer different TCP/IP
-services on different port numbers.</P
-><P
->
+services on different port numbers.
+</p><p>
NetBIOS names must be claimed on a network, and must be defended. The use
of NetBIOS names is most suitable on a single subnet; a Local Area Network
-or a Wide Area Network.</P
-><P
->
+or a Wide Area Network.
+</p><p>
NetBIOS names are either UNIQUE or GROUP. Only one application can claim a
-UNIQUE NetBIOS name on a network.</P
-><P
->There are two kinds of NetBIOS Name resolution: Broadcast and Point-to-Point.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><HR><H2
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN35"
-></A
->1.2. BROADCAST NetBIOS</H2
-><P
->
+UNIQUE NetBIOS name on a network.
+</p><p>
+There are two kinds of NetBIOS Name resolution: Broadcast and Point-to-Point.
+</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2866011"></a>BROADCAST NetBIOS</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>
Clients can claim names, and therefore offer services on successfully claimed
names, on their broadcast-isolated subnet. One way to get NetBIOS services
(such as browsing: see ftp.microsoft.com/drg/developr/CIFS/browdiff.txt; and
SMB file/print sharing: see cifs4.txt) working on a LAN or WAN is to make
-your routers forward all broadcast packets from TCP/IP ports 137, 138 and 139.</P
-><P
->
+your routers forward all broadcast packets from TCP/IP ports 137, 138 and 139.
+</p><p>
This, however, is not recommended. If you have a large LAN or WAN, you will
find that some of your hosts spend 95 percent of their time dealing with
broadcast traffic. [If you have IPX/SPX on your LAN or WAN, you will find
that this is already happening: a packet analyzer will show, roughly
-every twelve minutes, great swathes of broadcast traffic!].</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><HR><H2
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN39"
-></A
->1.3. NBNS NetBIOS</H2
-><P
->rfc1001.txt describes, amongst other things, the implementation and use
+every twelve minutes, great swathes of broadcast traffic!].
+</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2866042"></a>NBNS NetBIOS</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+rfc1001.txt describes, amongst other things, the implementation and use
of, a 'NetBIOS Name Service'. NT/AS offers 'Windows Internet Name Service'
which is fully rfc1001/2 compliant, but has had to take specific action
with certain NetBIOS names in order to make it useful. (for example, it
-deals with the registration of &#60;1c&#62; &#60;1d&#62; &#60;1e&#62; names all in different ways.
+deals with the registration of &lt;1c&gt; &lt;1d&gt; &lt;1e&gt; names all in different ways.
I recommend the reading of the Microsoft WINS Server Help files for full
-details).</P
-><P
->
+details).
+</p><p>
The use of a WINS server cuts down on broadcast network traffic for
NetBIOS name resolution. It has the effect of pulling all the broadcast
isolated subnets together into a single NetBIOS scope, across your LAN
-or WAN, while avoiding the use of TCP/IP broadcast packets.</P
-><P
->When you have a WINS server on your LAN, WINS clients will be able to
+or WAN, while avoiding the use of TCP/IP broadcast packets.
+</p><p>
+When you have a WINS server on your LAN, WINS clients will be able to
contact the WINS server to resolve NetBIOS names. Note that only those
WINS clients that have registered with the same WINS server will be
visible. The WINS server _can_ have static NetBIOS entries added to its
database (usually for security reasons you might want to consider putting
your domain controllers or other important servers as static entries,
but you should not rely on this as your sole means of security), but for
-the most part, NetBIOS names are registered dynamically.</P
-><P
->This provides some confusion for lots of people, and is worth mentioning
+the most part, NetBIOS names are registered dynamically.
+</p><p>
+This provides some confusion for lots of people, and is worth mentioning
here: a Browse Server is NOT a WINS Server, even if these services are
implemented in the same application. A Browse Server _needs_ a WINS server
-because a Browse Server is a WINS client, which is _not_ the same thing].</P
-><P
->Clients can claim names, and therefore offer services on successfully claimed
+because a Browse Server is a WINS client, which is _not_ the same thing].
+</p><p>
+Clients can claim names, and therefore offer services on successfully claimed
names, on their broadcast-isolated subnet. One way to get NetBIOS services
(such as browsing: see ftp.microsoft.com/drg/developr/CIFS/browdiff.txt; and
SMB file/print sharing: see cifs6.txt) working on a LAN or WAN is to make
your routers forward all broadcast packets from TCP/IP ports 137, 138 and 139.
You will find, however, if you do this on a large LAN or a WAN, that your
network is completely swamped by NetBIOS and browsing packets, which is why
-WINS was developed to minimise the necessity of broadcast traffic.</P
-><P
->
+WINS was developed to minimise the necessity of broadcast traffic.
+</p><p>
WINS Clients therefore claim names from the WINS server. If the WINS
server allows them to register a name, the client's NetBIOS session service
can then offer services on this name. Other WINS clients will then
-contact the WINS server to resolve a NetBIOS name.</P
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="CHAPTER"
-><HR><H1
-><A
-NAME="ARCHITECTURE"
-></A
->Chapter 2. Samba Architecture</H1
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><H2
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN54"
-></A
->2.1. Introduction</H2
-><P
->This document gives a general overview of how Samba works
+contact the WINS server to resolve a NetBIOS name.
+</p></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="architecture"></a>Chapter 2. Samba Architecture</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Dan</span> <span class="surname">Shearer</span></h3></div></div><div><p class="pubdate"> November 1997</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2797150">Introduction</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2797202">Multithreading and Samba</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2797240">Threading smbd</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2797314">Threading nmbd</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2797382">nbmd Design</a></dt></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2797150"></a>Introduction</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+This document gives a general overview of how Samba works
internally. The Samba Team has tried to come up with a model which is
the best possible compromise between elegance, portability, security
and the constraints imposed by the very messy SMB and CIFS
-protocol. </P
-><P
->It also tries to answer some of the frequently asked questions such as:</P
-><P
-></P
-><OL
-TYPE="1"
-><LI
-><P
-> Is Samba secure when running on Unix? The xyz platform?
- What about the root priveliges issue?</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->Pros and cons of multithreading in various parts of Samba</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->Why not have a separate process for name resolution, WINS, and browsing?</P
-></LI
-></OL
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><HR><H2
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN65"
-></A
->2.2. Multithreading and Samba</H2
-><P
->People sometimes tout threads as a uniformly good thing. They are very
+protocol.
+</p><p>
+It also tries to answer some of the frequently asked questions such as:
+</p><div class="orderedlist"><ol type="1"><li><p>
+ Is Samba secure when running on Unix? The xyz platform?
+ What about the root priveliges issue?
+</p></li><li><p>Pros and cons of multithreading in various parts of Samba</p></li><li><p>Why not have a separate process for name resolution, WINS, and browsing?</p></li></ol></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2797202"></a>Multithreading and Samba</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+People sometimes tout threads as a uniformly good thing. They are very
nice in their place but are quite inappropriate for smbd. nmbd is
-another matter, and multi-threading it would be very nice. </P
-><P
->The short version is that smbd is not multithreaded, and alternative
+another matter, and multi-threading it would be very nice.
+</p><p>
+The short version is that smbd is not multithreaded, and alternative
servers that take this approach under Unix (such as Syntax, at the
time of writing) suffer tremendous performance penalties and are less
robust. nmbd is not threaded either, but this is because it is not
possible to do it while keeping code consistent and portable across 35
-or more platforms. (This drawback also applies to threading smbd.)</P
-><P
->The longer versions is that there are very good reasons for not making
+or more platforms. (This drawback also applies to threading smbd.)
+</p><p>
+The longer versions is that there are very good reasons for not making
smbd multi-threaded. Multi-threading would actually make Samba much
slower, less scalable, less portable and much less robust. The fact
that we use a separate process for each connection is one of Samba's
-biggest advantages.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><HR><H2
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN70"
-></A
->2.3. Threading smbd</H2
-><P
->A few problems that would arise from a threaded smbd are:</P
-><P
-></P
-><OL
-TYPE="1"
-><LI
-><P
-> It's not only to create threads instead of processes, but you
+biggest advantages.
+</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2797240"></a>Threading smbd</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+A few problems that would arise from a threaded smbd are:
+</p><div class="orderedlist"><ol type="1"><li><p>
+ It's not only to create threads instead of processes, but you
must care about all variables if they have to be thread specific
- (currently they would be global).</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-> if one thread dies (eg. a seg fault) then all threads die. We can
- immediately throw robustness out the window.</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-> many of the system calls we make are blocking. Non-blocking
+ (currently they would be global).
+</p></li><li><p>
+ if one thread dies (eg. a seg fault) then all threads die. We can
+ immediately throw robustness out the window.
+</p></li><li><p>
+ many of the system calls we make are blocking. Non-blocking
equivalents of many calls are either not available or are awkward (and
slow) to use. So while we block in one thread all clients are
waiting. Imagine if one share is a slow NFS filesystem and the others
- are fast, we will end up slowing all clients to the speed of NFS.</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-> you can't run as a different uid in different threads. This means
+ are fast, we will end up slowing all clients to the speed of NFS.
+</p></li><li><p>
+ you can't run as a different uid in different threads. This means
we would have to switch uid/gid on _every_ SMB packet. It would be
- horrendously slow.</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-> the per process file descriptor limit would mean that we could only
- support a limited number of clients.</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-> we couldn't use the system locking calls as the locking context of
- fcntl() is a process, not a thread.</P
-></LI
-></OL
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><HR><H2
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN86"
-></A
->2.4. Threading nmbd</H2
-><P
->This would be ideal, but gets sunk by portability requirements.</P
-><P
->Andrew tried to write a test threads library for nmbd that used only
+ horrendously slow.
+</p></li><li><p>
+ the per process file descriptor limit would mean that we could only
+ support a limited number of clients.
+</p></li><li><p>
+ we couldn't use the system locking calls as the locking context of
+ fcntl() is a process, not a thread.
+</p></li></ol></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2797314"></a>Threading nmbd</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+This would be ideal, but gets sunk by portability requirements.
+</p><p>
+Andrew tried to write a test threads library for nmbd that used only
ansi-C constructs (using setjmp and longjmp). Unfortunately some OSes
defeat this by restricting longjmp to calling addresses that are
shallower than the current address on the stack (apparently AIX does
@@ -1095,31 +197,22 @@ and without threads, and as the real aim of threads is to make the
code clearer we would not have gained anything. (it is a myth that
threads make things faster. threading is like recursion, it can make
things clear but the same thing can always be done faster by some
-other method)</P
-><P
->Chris tried to spec out a general design that would abstract threading
+other method)
+</p><p>
+Chris tried to spec out a general design that would abstract threading
vs separate processes (vs other methods?) and make them accessible
through some general API. This doesn't work because of the data
sharing requirements of the protocol (packets in the future depending
on packets now, etc.) At least, the code would work but would be very
-clumsy, and besides the fork() type model would never work on Unix. (Is there an OS that it would work on, for nmbd?)</P
-><P
->A fork() is cheap, but not nearly cheap enough to do on every UDP
+clumsy, and besides the fork() type model would never work on Unix. (Is there an OS that it would work on, for nmbd?)
+</p><p>
+A fork() is cheap, but not nearly cheap enough to do on every UDP
packet that arrives. Having a pool of processes is possible but is
nasty to program cleanly due to the enormous amount of shared data (in
complex structures) between the processes. We can't rely on each
-platform having a shared memory system.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><HR><H2
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN92"
-></A
->2.5. nbmd Design</H2
-><P
->Originally Andrew used recursion to simulate a multi-threaded
+platform having a shared memory system.
+</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2797382"></a>nbmd Design</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+Originally Andrew used recursion to simulate a multi-threaded
environment, which use the stack enormously and made for really
confusing debugging sessions. Luke Leighton rewrote it to use a
queuing system that keeps state information on each packet. The
@@ -1131,37 +224,18 @@ and a pointer to a user-defined memory block. This suddenly
made things much simpler: large numbers of functions could be
made static, and modularised. This is the same principle as used
in NT's kernel, and achieves the same effect as threads, but in
-a single process.</P
-><P
->Then Jeremy rewrote nmbd. The packet data in nmbd isn't what's on the
+a single process.
+</p><p>
+Then Jeremy rewrote nmbd. The packet data in nmbd isn't what's on the
wire. It's a nice format that is very amenable to processing but still
-keeps the idea of a distinct packet. See "struct packet_struct" in
+keeps the idea of a distinct packet. See &quot;struct packet_struct&quot; in
nameserv.h. It has all the detail but none of the on-the-wire
mess. This makes it ideal for using in disk or memory-based databases
-for browsing and WINS support. </P
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="CHAPTER"
-><HR><H1
-><A
-NAME="DEBUG"
-></A
->Chapter 3. The samba DEBUG system</H1
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><H2
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN103"
-></A
->3.1. New Output Syntax</H2
-><P
-> The syntax of a debugging log file is represented as:</P
-><P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
-> &gt;debugfile&lt; :== { &gt;debugmsg&lt; }
+for browsing and WINS support.
+</p></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="debug"></a>Chapter 3. The samba DEBUG system</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Chris</span> <span class="surname">Hertel</span></h3></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">July 1998</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2796808">New Output Syntax</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2796946">The DEBUG() Macro</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2867248">The DEBUGADD() Macro</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2867293">The DEBUGLVL() Macro</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2867398">New Functions</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2867405">dbgtext()</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2867425">dbghdr()</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2867448">format_debug_text()</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2796808"></a>New Output Syntax</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+ The syntax of a debugging log file is represented as:
+</p><pre class="programlisting">
+ &gt;debugfile&lt; :== { &gt;debugmsg&lt; }
&gt;debugmsg&lt; :== &gt;debughdr&lt; '\n' &gt;debugtext&lt;
@@ -1169,323 +243,178 @@ CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
&gt;debugtext&lt; :== { &gt;debugline&lt; }
- &gt;debugline&lt; :== TEXT '\n'</PRE
-></P
-><P
->TEXT is a string of characters excluding the newline character.</P
-><P
->LEVEL is the DEBUG level of the message (an integer in the range
- 0..10).</P
-><P
->TIME is a timestamp.</P
-><P
->FILE is the name of the file from which the debug message was
-generated.</P
-><P
->FUNCTION is the function from which the debug message was generated.</P
-><P
->LINE is the line number of the debug statement that generated the
-message.</P
-><P
->Basically, what that all means is:</P
-><P
-></P
-><OL
-TYPE="1"
-><LI
-><P
->A debugging log file is made up of debug messages.</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->Each debug message is made up of a header and text. The header is
-separated from the text by a newline.</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->The header begins with the timestamp and debug level of the
+ &gt;debugline&lt; :== TEXT '\n'
+</pre><p>
+TEXT is a string of characters excluding the newline character.
+</p><p>
+LEVEL is the DEBUG level of the message (an integer in the range
+ 0..10).
+</p><p>
+TIME is a timestamp.
+</p><p>
+FILE is the name of the file from which the debug message was
+generated.
+</p><p>
+FUNCTION is the function from which the debug message was generated.
+</p><p>
+LINE is the line number of the debug statement that generated the
+message.
+</p><p>Basically, what that all means is:</p><div class="orderedlist"><ol type="1"><li><p>
+A debugging log file is made up of debug messages.
+</p></li><li><p>
+Each debug message is made up of a header and text. The header is
+separated from the text by a newline.
+</p></li><li><p>
+The header begins with the timestamp and debug level of the
message enclosed in brackets. The filename, function, and line
number at which the message was generated follow. The filename is
terminated by a colon, and the function name is terminated by the
parenthesis which contain the line number. Depending upon the
compiler, the function name may be missing (it is generated by the
-__FUNCTION__ macro, which is not universally implemented, dangit).</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->The message text is made up of zero or more lines, each terminated
-by a newline.</P
-></LI
-></OL
-><P
->Here's some example output:</P
-><P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
-> [1998/08/03 12:55:25, 1] nmbd.c:(659)
+__FUNCTION__ macro, which is not universally implemented, dangit).
+</p></li><li><p>
+The message text is made up of zero or more lines, each terminated
+by a newline.
+</p></li></ol></div><p>Here's some example output:</p><pre class="programlisting">
+ [1998/08/03 12:55:25, 1] nmbd.c:(659)
Netbios nameserver version 1.9.19-prealpha started.
Copyright Andrew Tridgell 1994-1997
[1998/08/03 12:55:25, 3] loadparm.c:(763)
- Initializing global parameters</PRE
-></P
-><P
->Note that in the above example the function names are not listed on
+ Initializing global parameters
+</pre><p>
+Note that in the above example the function names are not listed on
the header line. That's because the example above was generated on an
-SGI Indy, and the SGI compiler doesn't support the __FUNCTION__ macro.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><HR><H2
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN128"
-></A
->3.2. The DEBUG() Macro</H2
-><P
->Use of the DEBUG() macro is unchanged. DEBUG() takes two parameters.
+SGI Indy, and the SGI compiler doesn't support the __FUNCTION__ macro.
+</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2796946"></a>The DEBUG() Macro</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+Use of the DEBUG() macro is unchanged. DEBUG() takes two parameters.
The first is the message level, the second is the body of a function
-call to the Debug1() function.</P
-><P
->That's confusing.</P
-><P
->Here's an example which may help a bit. If you would write</P
-><P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
->printf( "This is a %s message.\n", "debug" );</PRE
-></P
-><P
->to send the output to stdout, then you would write</P
-><P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
->DEBUG( 0, ( "This is a %s message.\n", "debug" ) );</PRE
-></P
-><P
->to send the output to the debug file. All of the normal printf()
-formatting escapes work.</P
-><P
->Note that in the above example the DEBUG message level is set to 0.
+call to the Debug1() function.
+</p><p>That's confusing.</p><p>Here's an example which may help a bit. If you would write</p><pre class="programlisting">
+printf( &quot;This is a %s message.\n&quot;, &quot;debug&quot; );
+</pre><p>
+to send the output to stdout, then you would write
+</p><pre class="programlisting">
+DEBUG( 0, ( &quot;This is a %s message.\n&quot;, &quot;debug&quot; ) );
+</pre><p>
+to send the output to the debug file. All of the normal printf()
+formatting escapes work.
+</p><p>
+Note that in the above example the DEBUG message level is set to 0.
Messages at level 0 always print. Basically, if the message level is
less than or equal to the global value DEBUGLEVEL, then the DEBUG
-statement is processed.</P
-><P
->The output of the above example would be something like:</P
-><P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
-> [1998/07/30 16:00:51, 0] file.c:function(128)
- This is a debug message.</PRE
-></P
-><P
->Each call to DEBUG() creates a new header *unless* the output produced
+statement is processed.
+</p><p>
+The output of the above example would be something like:
+</p><pre class="programlisting">
+ [1998/07/30 16:00:51, 0] file.c:function(128)
+ This is a debug message.
+</pre><p>
+Each call to DEBUG() creates a new header *unless* the output produced
by the previous call to DEBUG() did not end with a '\n'. Output to the
debug file is passed through a formatting buffer which is flushed
every time a newline is encountered. If the buffer is not empty when
-DEBUG() is called, the new input is simply appended.</P
-><P
->...but that's really just a Kludge. It was put in place because
+DEBUG() is called, the new input is simply appended.
+</p><p>
+...but that's really just a Kludge. It was put in place because
DEBUG() has been used to write partial lines. Here's a simple (dumb)
-example of the kind of thing I'm talking about:</P
-><P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
-> DEBUG( 0, ("The test returned " ) );
+example of the kind of thing I'm talking about:
+</p><pre class="programlisting">
+ DEBUG( 0, (&quot;The test returned &quot; ) );
if( test() )
- DEBUG(0, ("True") );
+ DEBUG(0, (&quot;True&quot;) );
else
- DEBUG(0, ("False") );
- DEBUG(0, (".\n") );</PRE
-></P
-><P
->Without the format buffer, the output (assuming test() returned true)
-would look like this:</P
-><P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
-> [1998/07/30 16:00:51, 0] file.c:function(256)
+ DEBUG(0, (&quot;False&quot;) );
+ DEBUG(0, (&quot;.\n&quot;) );
+</pre><p>
+Without the format buffer, the output (assuming test() returned true)
+would look like this:
+</p><pre class="programlisting">
+ [1998/07/30 16:00:51, 0] file.c:function(256)
The test returned
[1998/07/30 16:00:51, 0] file.c:function(258)
True
[1998/07/30 16:00:51, 0] file.c:function(261)
- .</PRE
-></P
-><P
->Which isn't much use. The format buffer kludge fixes this problem.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><HR><H2
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN151"
-></A
->3.3. The DEBUGADD() Macro</H2
-><P
->In addition to the kludgey solution to the broken line problem
+ .
+</pre><p>Which isn't much use. The format buffer kludge fixes this problem.
+</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2867248"></a>The DEBUGADD() Macro</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+In addition to the kludgey solution to the broken line problem
described above, there is a clean solution. The DEBUGADD() macro never
generates a header. It will append new text to the current debug
message even if the format buffer is empty. The syntax of the
-DEBUGADD() macro is the same as that of the DEBUG() macro.</P
-><P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
-> DEBUG( 0, ("This is the first line.\n" ) );
- DEBUGADD( 0, ("This is the second line.\nThis is the third line.\n" ) );</PRE
-></P
-><P
->Produces</P
-><P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
-> [1998/07/30 16:00:51, 0] file.c:function(512)
+DEBUGADD() macro is the same as that of the DEBUG() macro.
+</p><pre class="programlisting">
+ DEBUG( 0, (&quot;This is the first line.\n&quot; ) );
+ DEBUGADD( 0, (&quot;This is the second line.\nThis is the third line.\n&quot; ) );
+</pre><p>Produces</p><pre class="programlisting">
+ [1998/07/30 16:00:51, 0] file.c:function(512)
This is the first line.
This is the second line.
- This is the third line.</PRE
-></P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><HR><H2
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN159"
-></A
->3.4. The DEBUGLVL() Macro</H2
-><P
->One of the problems with the DEBUG() macro was that DEBUG() lines
+ This is the third line.
+</pre></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2867293"></a>The DEBUGLVL() Macro</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+One of the problems with the DEBUG() macro was that DEBUG() lines
tended to get a bit long. Consider this example from
-nmbd_sendannounce.c:</P
-><P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
-> DEBUG(3,("send_local_master_announcement: type %x for name %s on subnet %s for workgroup %s\n",
- type, global_myname, subrec-&#62;subnet_name, work-&#62;work_group));</PRE
-></P
-><P
->One solution to this is to break it down using DEBUG() and DEBUGADD(),
-as follows:</P
-><P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
-> DEBUG( 3, ( "send_local_master_announcement: " ) );
- DEBUGADD( 3, ( "type %x for name %s ", type, global_myname ) );
- DEBUGADD( 3, ( "on subnet %s ", subrec-&#62;subnet_name ) );
- DEBUGADD( 3, ( "for workgroup %s\n", work-&#62;work_group ) );</PRE
-></P
-><P
->A similar, but arguably nicer approach is to use the DEBUGLVL() macro.
+nmbd_sendannounce.c:
+</p><pre class="programlisting">
+ DEBUG(3,(&quot;send_local_master_announcement: type %x for name %s on subnet %s for workgroup %s\n&quot;,
+ type, global_myname, subrec-&gt;subnet_name, work-&gt;work_group));
+</pre><p>
+One solution to this is to break it down using DEBUG() and DEBUGADD(),
+as follows:
+</p><pre class="programlisting">
+ DEBUG( 3, ( &quot;send_local_master_announcement: &quot; ) );
+ DEBUGADD( 3, ( &quot;type %x for name %s &quot;, type, global_myname ) );
+ DEBUGADD( 3, ( &quot;on subnet %s &quot;, subrec-&gt;subnet_name ) );
+ DEBUGADD( 3, ( &quot;for workgroup %s\n&quot;, work-&gt;work_group ) );
+</pre><p>
+A similar, but arguably nicer approach is to use the DEBUGLVL() macro.
This macro returns True if the message level is less than or equal to
-the global DEBUGLEVEL value, so:</P
-><P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
-> if( DEBUGLVL( 3 ) )
+the global DEBUGLEVEL value, so:
+</p><pre class="programlisting">
+ if( DEBUGLVL( 3 ) )
{
- dbgtext( "send_local_master_announcement: " );
- dbgtext( "type %x for name %s ", type, global_myname );
- dbgtext( "on subnet %s ", subrec-&#62;subnet_name );
- dbgtext( "for workgroup %s\n", work-&#62;work_group );
- }</PRE
-></P
-><P
->(The dbgtext() function is explained below.)</P
-><P
->There are a few advantages to this scheme:</P
-><P
-></P
-><OL
-TYPE="1"
-><LI
-><P
->The test is performed only once.</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->You can allocate variables off of the stack that will only be used
-within the DEBUGLVL() block.</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->Processing that is only relevant to debug output can be contained
-within the DEBUGLVL() block.</P
-></LI
-></OL
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><HR><H2
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN179"
-></A
->3.5. New Functions</H2
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><H3
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN181"
-></A
->3.5.1. dbgtext()</H3
-><P
->This function prints debug message text to the debug file (and
+ dbgtext( &quot;send_local_master_announcement: &quot; );
+ dbgtext( &quot;type %x for name %s &quot;, type, global_myname );
+ dbgtext( &quot;on subnet %s &quot;, subrec-&gt;subnet_name );
+ dbgtext( &quot;for workgroup %s\n&quot;, work-&gt;work_group );
+ }
+</pre><p>(The dbgtext() function is explained below.)</p><p>There are a few advantages to this scheme:</p><div class="orderedlist"><ol type="1"><li><p>
+The test is performed only once.
+</p></li><li><p>
+You can allocate variables off of the stack that will only be used
+within the DEBUGLVL() block.
+</p></li><li><p>
+Processing that is only relevant to debug output can be contained
+within the DEBUGLVL() block.
+</p></li></ol></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2867398"></a>New Functions</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2867405"></a>dbgtext()</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+This function prints debug message text to the debug file (and
possibly to syslog) via the format buffer. The function uses a
variable argument list just like printf() or Debug1(). The
input is printed into a buffer using the vslprintf() function,
and then passed to format_debug_text().
If you use DEBUGLVL() you will probably print the body of the
-message using dbgtext(). </P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><HR><H3
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN184"
-></A
->3.5.2. dbghdr()</H3
-><P
->This is the function that writes a debug message header.
+message using dbgtext().
+</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2867425"></a>dbghdr()</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+This is the function that writes a debug message header.
Headers are not processed via the format buffer. Also note that
if the format buffer is not empty, a call to dbghdr() will not
-produce any output. See the comments in dbghdr() for more info.</P
-><P
->It is not likely that this function will be called directly. It
-is used by DEBUG() and DEBUGADD().</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><HR><H3
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN188"
-></A
->3.5.3. format_debug_text()</H3
-><P
->This is a static function in debug.c. It stores the output text
+produce any output. See the comments in dbghdr() for more info.
+</p><p>
+It is not likely that this function will be called directly. It
+is used by DEBUG() and DEBUGADD().
+</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2867448"></a>format_debug_text()</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+This is a static function in debug.c. It stores the output text
for the body of the message in a buffer until it encounters a
newline. When the newline character is found, the buffer is
written to the debug file via the Debug1() function, and the
buffer is reset. This allows us to add the indentation at the
beginning of each line of the message body, and also ensures
that the output is written a line at a time (which cleans up
-syslog output).</P
-></DIV
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="CHAPTER"
-><HR><H1
-><A
-NAME="CODINGSUGGESTIONS"
-></A
->Chapter 4. Coding Suggestions</H1
-><P
->So you want to add code to Samba ...</P
-><P
->One of the daunting tasks facing a programmer attempting to write code for
+syslog output).
+</p></div></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="CodingSuggestions"></a>Chapter 4. Coding Suggestions</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Steve</span> <span class="surname">French</span></h3></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Simo</span> <span class="surname">Sorce</span></h3></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Andrew</span> <span class="surname">Bartlett</span></h3></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Tim</span> <span class="surname">Potter</span></h3></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Martin</span> <span class="surname">Pool</span></h3></div></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+So you want to add code to Samba ...
+</p><p>
+One of the daunting tasks facing a programmer attempting to write code for
Samba is understanding the various coding conventions used by those most
active in the project. These conventions were mostly unwritten and helped
improve either the portability, stability or consistency of the code. This
@@ -1493,305 +422,181 @@ document will attempt to document a few of the more important coding
practices used at this time on the Samba project. The coding practices are
expected to change slightly over time, and even to grow as more is learned
about obscure portability considerations. Two existing documents
-<TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->samba/source/internals.doc</TT
-> and
-<TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->samba/source/architecture.doc</TT
-> provide
-additional information.</P
-><P
->The loosely related question of coding style is very personal and this
+<tt class="filename">samba/source/internals.doc</tt> and
+<tt class="filename">samba/source/architecture.doc</tt> provide
+additional information.
+</p><p>
+The loosely related question of coding style is very personal and this
document does not attempt to address that subject, except to say that I
have observed that eight character tabs seem to be preferred in Samba
source. If you are interested in the topic of coding style, two oft-quoted
-documents are:</P
-><P
-><A
-HREF="http://lxr.linux.no/source/Documentation/CodingStyle"
-TARGET="_top"
->http://lxr.linux.no/source/Documentation/CodingStyle</A
-></P
-><P
-><A
-HREF="http://www.fsf.org/prep/standards_toc.html"
-TARGET="_top"
->http://www.fsf.org/prep/standards_toc.html</A
-></P
-><P
->But note that coding style in Samba varies due to the many different
-programmers who have contributed.</P
-><P
->Following are some considerations you should use when adding new code to
-Samba. First and foremost remember that:</P
-><P
->Portability is a primary consideration in adding function, as is network
+documents are:
+</p><p>
+<a href="http://lxr.linux.no/source/Documentation/CodingStyle" target="_top">http://lxr.linux.no/source/Documentation/CodingStyle</a>
+</p><p>
+<a href="http://www.fsf.org/prep/standards_toc.html" target="_top">http://www.fsf.org/prep/standards_toc.html</a>
+</p><p>
+But note that coding style in Samba varies due to the many different
+programmers who have contributed.
+</p><p>
+Following are some considerations you should use when adding new code to
+Samba. First and foremost remember that:
+</p><p>
+Portability is a primary consideration in adding function, as is network
compatability with de facto, existing, real world CIFS/SMB implementations.
There are lots of platforms that Samba builds on so use caution when adding
a call to a library function that is not invoked in existing Samba code.
Also note that there are many quite different SMB/CIFS clients that Samba
tries to support, not all of which follow the SNIA CIFS Technical Reference
(or the earlier Microsoft reference documents or the X/Open book on the SMB
-Standard) perfectly.</P
-><P
->Here are some other suggestions:</P
-><P
-></P
-><OL
-TYPE="1"
-><LI
-><P
-> use d_printf instead of printf for display text
- reason: enable auto-substitution of translated language text </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-> use SAFE_FREE instead of free
- reason: reduce traps due to null pointers</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-> don't use bzero use memset, or ZERO_STRUCT and ZERO_STRUCTP macros
- reason: not POSIX</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-> don't use strcpy and strlen (use safe_* equivalents)
- reason: to avoid traps due to buffer overruns</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-> don't use getopt_long, use popt functions instead
- reason: portability</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-> explicitly add const qualifiers on parm passing in functions where parm
- is input only (somewhat controversial but const can be #defined away)</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-> when passing a va_list as an arg, or assigning one to another
+Standard) perfectly.
+</p><p>
+Here are some other suggestions:
+</p><div class="orderedlist"><ol type="1"><li><p>
+ use d_printf instead of printf for display text
+ reason: enable auto-substitution of translated language text
+</p></li><li><p>
+ use SAFE_FREE instead of free
+ reason: reduce traps due to null pointers
+</p></li><li><p>
+ don't use bzero use memset, or ZERO_STRUCT and ZERO_STRUCTP macros
+ reason: not POSIX
+</p></li><li><p>
+ don't use strcpy and strlen (use safe_* equivalents)
+ reason: to avoid traps due to buffer overruns
+</p></li><li><p>
+ don't use getopt_long, use popt functions instead
+ reason: portability
+</p></li><li><p>
+ explicitly add const qualifiers on parm passing in functions where parm
+ is input only (somewhat controversial but const can be #defined away)
+</p></li><li><p>
+ when passing a va_list as an arg, or assigning one to another
please use the VA_COPY() macro
reason: on some platforms, va_list is a struct that must be
- initialized in each function...can SEGV if you don't.</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-> discourage use of threads
- reason: portability (also see architecture.doc)</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-> don't explicitly include new header files in C files - new h files
+ initialized in each function...can SEGV if you don't.
+</p></li><li><p>
+ discourage use of threads
+ reason: portability (also see architecture.doc)
+</p></li><li><p>
+ don't explicitly include new header files in C files - new h files
should be included by adding them once to includes.h
- reason: consistency</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-> don't explicitly extern functions (they are autogenerated by
- "make proto" into proto.h)
- reason: consistency</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-> use endian safe macros when unpacking SMBs (see byteorder.h and
+ reason: consistency
+</p></li><li><p>
+ don't explicitly extern functions (they are autogenerated by
+ &quot;make proto&quot; into proto.h)
+ reason: consistency
+</p></li><li><p>
+ use endian safe macros when unpacking SMBs (see byteorder.h and
internals.doc)
- reason: not everyone uses Intel</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-> Note Unicode implications of charset handling (see internals.doc). See
+ reason: not everyone uses Intel
+</p></li><li><p>
+ Note Unicode implications of charset handling (see internals.doc). See
pull_* and push_* and convert_string functions.
- reason: Internationalization</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-> Don't assume English only
- reason: See above</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-> Try to avoid using in/out parameters (functions that return data which
+ reason: Internationalization
+</p></li><li><p>
+ Don't assume English only
+ reason: See above
+</p></li><li><p>
+ Try to avoid using in/out parameters (functions that return data which
overwrites input parameters)
- reason: Can cause stability problems</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-> Ensure copyright notices are correct, don't append Tridge's name to code
+ reason: Can cause stability problems
+</p></li><li><p>
+ Ensure copyright notices are correct, don't append Tridge's name to code
that he didn't write. If you did not write the code, make sure that it
- can coexist with the rest of the Samba GPLed code.</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-> Consider usage of DATA_BLOBs for length specified byte-data.
- reason: stability</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-> Take advantage of tdbs for database like function
- reason: consistency</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-> Don't access the SAM_ACCOUNT structure directly, they should be accessed
+ can coexist with the rest of the Samba GPLed code.
+</p></li><li><p>
+ Consider usage of DATA_BLOBs for length specified byte-data.
+ reason: stability
+</p></li><li><p>
+ Take advantage of tdbs for database like function
+ reason: consistency
+</p></li><li><p>
+ Don't access the SAM_ACCOUNT structure directly, they should be accessed
via pdb_get...() and pdb_set...() functions.
- reason: stability, consistency</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-> Don't check a password directly against the passdb, always use the
+ reason: stability, consistency
+</p></li><li><p>
+ Don't check a password directly against the passdb, always use the
check_password() interface.
- reason: long term pluggability</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-> Try to use asprintf rather than pstrings and fstrings where possible</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-> Use normal C comments / * instead of C++ comments // like
+ reason: long term pluggability
+</p></li><li><p>
+ Try to use asprintf rather than pstrings and fstrings where possible
+</p></li><li><p>
+ Use normal C comments / * instead of C++ comments // like
this. Although the C++ comment format is part of the C99
- standard, some older vendor C compilers do not accept it.</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-> Try to write documentation for API functions and structures
+ standard, some older vendor C compilers do not accept it.
+</p></li><li><p>
+ Try to write documentation for API functions and structures
explaining the point of the code, the way it should be used, and
any special conditions or results. Mark these with a double-star
comment start / ** so that they can be picked up by Doxygen, as in
- this file.</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-> Keep the scope narrow. This means making functions/variables
+ this file.
+</p></li><li><p>
+ Keep the scope narrow. This means making functions/variables
static whenever possible. We don't want our namespace
polluted. Each module should have a minimal number of externally
- visible functions or variables.</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-> Use function pointers to keep knowledge about particular pieces of
+ visible functions or variables.
+</p></li><li><p>
+ Use function pointers to keep knowledge about particular pieces of
code isolated in one place. We don't want a particular piece of
functionality to be spread out across lots of places - that makes
for fragile, hand to maintain code. Instead, design an interface
and use tables containing function pointers to implement specific
functionality. This is particularly important for command
- interpreters. </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-> Think carefully about what it will be like for someone else to add
+ interpreters.
+</p></li><li><p>
+ Think carefully about what it will be like for someone else to add
to and maintain your code. If it would be hard for someone else to
- maintain then do it another way. </P
-></LI
-></OL
-><P
->The suggestions above are simply that, suggestions, but the information may
+ maintain then do it another way.
+</p></li></ol></div><p>
+The suggestions above are simply that, suggestions, but the information may
help in reducing the routine rework done on new code. The preceeding list
is expected to change routinely as new support routines and macros are
-added.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="CHAPTER"
-><HR><H1
-><A
-NAME="INTERNALS"
-></A
->Chapter 5. Samba Internals</H1
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><H2
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN284"
-></A
->5.1. Character Handling</H2
-><P
->This section describes character set handling in Samba, as implemented in
-Samba 3.0 and above</P
-><P
->In the past Samba had very ad-hoc character set handling. Scattered
+added.
+</p></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="internals"></a>Chapter 5. Samba Internals</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">David</span> <span class="surname">Chappell</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><div class="address"><p><tt class="email">&lt;<a href="mailto:David.Chappell@mail.trincoll.edu">David.Chappell@mail.trincoll.edu</a>&gt;</tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">8 May 1996</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2866821">Character Handling</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2866847">The new functions</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2868099">Macros in byteorder.h</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2869024">CVAL(buf,pos)</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2869037">PVAL(buf,pos)</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2869051">SCVAL(buf,pos,val)</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2869064">SVAL(buf,pos)</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2869080">IVAL(buf,pos)</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2869094">SVALS(buf,pos)</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2869109">IVALS(buf,pos)</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2869123">SSVAL(buf,pos,val)</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2869138">SIVAL(buf,pos,val)</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2869152">SSVALS(buf,pos,val)</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2869166">SIVALS(buf,pos,val)</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2869181">RSVAL(buf,pos)</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2869195">RIVAL(buf,pos)</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2869210">RSSVAL(buf,pos,val)</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2869225">RSIVAL(buf,pos,val)</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2869240">LAN Manager Samba API</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2869276">Parameters</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2869427">Return value</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2869512">Code character table</a></dt></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2866821"></a>Character Handling</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+This section describes character set handling in Samba, as implemented in
+Samba 3.0 and above
+</p><p>
+In the past Samba had very ad-hoc character set handling. Scattered
throughout the code were numerous calls which converted particular
strings to/from DOS codepages. The problem is that there was no way of
telling if a particular char* is in dos codepage or unix
codepage. This led to a nightmare of code that tried to cope with
-particular cases without handlingt the general case.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><HR><H2
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN288"
-></A
->5.2. The new functions</H2
-><P
->The new system works like this:</P
-><P
-></P
-><OL
-TYPE="1"
-><LI
-><P
-> all char* strings inside Samba are "unix" strings. These are
- multi-byte strings that are in the charset defined by the "unix
- charset" option in smb.conf. </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-> there is no single fixed character set for unix strings, but any
+particular cases without handlingt the general case.
+</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2866847"></a>The new functions</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+The new system works like this:
+</p><div class="orderedlist"><ol type="1"><li><p>
+ all char* strings inside Samba are &quot;unix&quot; strings. These are
+ multi-byte strings that are in the charset defined by the &quot;unix
+ charset&quot; option in smb.conf.
+</p></li><li><p>
+ there is no single fixed character set for unix strings, but any
character set that is used does need the following properties:
- </P
-><P
-></P
-><OL
-TYPE="a"
-><LI
-><P
-> must not contain NULLs except for termination
- </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-> must be 7-bit compatible with C strings, so that a constant
+ </p><div class="orderedlist"><ol type="a"><li><p>
+ must not contain NULLs except for termination
+ </p></li><li><p>
+ must be 7-bit compatible with C strings, so that a constant
string or character in C will be byte-for-byte identical to the
equivalent string in the chosen character set.
- </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-> when you uppercase or lowercase a string it does not become
+ </p></li><li><p>
+ when you uppercase or lowercase a string it does not become
longer than the original string
- </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-> must be able to correctly hold all characters that your client
+ </p></li><li><p>
+ must be able to correctly hold all characters that your client
will throw at it
- </P
-></LI
-></OL
-><P
-> For example, UTF-8 is fine, and most multi-byte asian character sets
+ </p></li></ol></div><p>
+ For example, UTF-8 is fine, and most multi-byte asian character sets
are fine, but UCS2 could not be used for unix strings as they
contain nulls.
- </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-> when you need to put a string into a buffer that will be sent on the
+ </p></li><li><p>
+ when you need to put a string into a buffer that will be sent on the
wire, or you need a string in a character set format that is
compatible with the clients character set then you need to use a
pull_ or push_ function. The pull_ functions pull a string from a
wire buffer into a (multi-byte) unix string. The push_ functions
- push a string out to a wire buffer. </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-> the two main pull_ and push_ functions you need to understand are
+ push a string out to a wire buffer.
+</p></li><li><p>
+ the two main pull_ and push_ functions you need to understand are
pull_string and push_string. These functions take a base pointer
that should point at the start of the SMB packet that the string is
in. The functions will check the flags field in this packet to
@@ -1801,953 +606,426 @@ TYPE="a"
STR_ASCII flags. For use in smbd/ and libsmb/ there are wrapper
functions clistr_ and srvstr_ that call the pull_/push_ functions
with the appropriate first argument.
- </P
-><P
-> You may also call the pull_ascii/pull_ucs2 or push_ascii/push_ucs2
+ </p><p>
+ You may also call the pull_ascii/pull_ucs2 or push_ascii/push_ucs2
functions if you know that a particular string is ascii or
unicode. There are also a number of other convenience functions in
charcnv.c that call the pull_/push_ functions with particularly
common arguments, such as pull_ascii_pstring()
- </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-> The biggest thing to remember is that internal (unix) strings in Samba
+ </p></li><li><p>
+ The biggest thing to remember is that internal (unix) strings in Samba
may now contain multi-byte characters. This means you cannot assume
that characters are always 1 byte long. Often this means that you will
have to convert strings to ucs2 and back again in order to do some
(seemingly) simple task. For examples of how to do this see functions
like strchr_m(). I know this is very slow, and we will eventually
- speed it up but right now we want this stuff correct not fast.</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-> all lp_ functions now return unix strings. The magic "DOS" flag on
- parameters is gone.</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-> all vfs functions take unix strings. Don't convert when passing to them</P
-></LI
-></OL
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><HR><H2
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN317"
-></A
->5.3. Macros in byteorder.h</H2
-><P
->This section describes the macros defined in byteorder.h. These macros
-are used extensively in the Samba code.</P
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><HR><H3
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN320"
-></A
->5.3.1. CVAL(buf,pos)</H3
-><P
->returns the byte at offset pos within buffer buf as an unsigned character.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><HR><H3
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN323"
-></A
->5.3.2. PVAL(buf,pos)</H3
-><P
->returns the value of CVAL(buf,pos) cast to type unsigned integer.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><HR><H3
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN326"
-></A
->5.3.3. SCVAL(buf,pos,val)</H3
-><P
->sets the byte at offset pos within buffer buf to value val.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><HR><H3
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN329"
-></A
->5.3.4. SVAL(buf,pos)</H3
-><P
-> returns the value of the unsigned short (16 bit) little-endian integer at
+ speed it up but right now we want this stuff correct not fast.
+</p></li><li><p>
+ all lp_ functions now return unix strings. The magic &quot;DOS&quot; flag on
+ parameters is gone.
+</p></li><li><p>
+ all vfs functions take unix strings. Don't convert when passing to them
+</p></li></ol></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2868099"></a>Macros in byteorder.h</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+This section describes the macros defined in byteorder.h. These macros
+are used extensively in the Samba code.
+</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2869024"></a>CVAL(buf,pos)</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+returns the byte at offset pos within buffer buf as an unsigned character.
+</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2869037"></a>PVAL(buf,pos)</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>returns the value of CVAL(buf,pos) cast to type unsigned integer.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2869051"></a>SCVAL(buf,pos,val)</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>sets the byte at offset pos within buffer buf to value val.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2869064"></a>SVAL(buf,pos)</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+ returns the value of the unsigned short (16 bit) little-endian integer at
offset pos within buffer buf. An integer of this type is sometimes
- refered to as "USHORT".</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><HR><H3
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN332"
-></A
->5.3.5. IVAL(buf,pos)</H3
-><P
->returns the value of the unsigned 32 bit little-endian integer at offset
-pos within buffer buf.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><HR><H3
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN335"
-></A
->5.3.6. SVALS(buf,pos)</H3
-><P
->returns the value of the signed short (16 bit) little-endian integer at
-offset pos within buffer buf.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><HR><H3
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN338"
-></A
->5.3.7. IVALS(buf,pos)</H3
-><P
->returns the value of the signed 32 bit little-endian integer at offset pos
-within buffer buf.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><HR><H3
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN341"
-></A
->5.3.8. SSVAL(buf,pos,val)</H3
-><P
->sets the unsigned short (16 bit) little-endian integer at offset pos within
-buffer buf to value val.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><HR><H3
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN344"
-></A
->5.3.9. SIVAL(buf,pos,val)</H3
-><P
->sets the unsigned 32 bit little-endian integer at offset pos within buffer
-buf to the value val.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><HR><H3
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN347"
-></A
->5.3.10. SSVALS(buf,pos,val)</H3
-><P
->sets the short (16 bit) signed little-endian integer at offset pos within
-buffer buf to the value val.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><HR><H3
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN350"
-></A
->5.3.11. SIVALS(buf,pos,val)</H3
-><P
->sets the signed 32 bit little-endian integer at offset pos withing buffer
-buf to the value val.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><HR><H3
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN353"
-></A
->5.3.12. RSVAL(buf,pos)</H3
-><P
->returns the value of the unsigned short (16 bit) big-endian integer at
-offset pos within buffer buf.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><HR><H3
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN356"
-></A
->5.3.13. RIVAL(buf,pos)</H3
-><P
->returns the value of the unsigned 32 bit big-endian integer at offset
-pos within buffer buf.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><HR><H3
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN359"
-></A
->5.3.14. RSSVAL(buf,pos,val)</H3
-><P
->sets the value of the unsigned short (16 bit) big-endian integer at
+ refered to as &quot;USHORT&quot;.
+</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2869080"></a>IVAL(buf,pos)</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>returns the value of the unsigned 32 bit little-endian integer at offset
+pos within buffer buf.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2869094"></a>SVALS(buf,pos)</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>returns the value of the signed short (16 bit) little-endian integer at
+offset pos within buffer buf.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2869109"></a>IVALS(buf,pos)</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>returns the value of the signed 32 bit little-endian integer at offset pos
+within buffer buf.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2869123"></a>SSVAL(buf,pos,val)</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>sets the unsigned short (16 bit) little-endian integer at offset pos within
+buffer buf to value val.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2869138"></a>SIVAL(buf,pos,val)</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>sets the unsigned 32 bit little-endian integer at offset pos within buffer
+buf to the value val.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2869152"></a>SSVALS(buf,pos,val)</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>sets the short (16 bit) signed little-endian integer at offset pos within
+buffer buf to the value val.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2869166"></a>SIVALS(buf,pos,val)</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>sets the signed 32 bit little-endian integer at offset pos withing buffer
+buf to the value val.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2869181"></a>RSVAL(buf,pos)</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>returns the value of the unsigned short (16 bit) big-endian integer at
+offset pos within buffer buf.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2869195"></a>RIVAL(buf,pos)</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>returns the value of the unsigned 32 bit big-endian integer at offset
+pos within buffer buf.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2869210"></a>RSSVAL(buf,pos,val)</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>sets the value of the unsigned short (16 bit) big-endian integer at
offset pos within buffer buf to value val.
-refered to as "USHORT".</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><HR><H3
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN362"
-></A
->5.3.15. RSIVAL(buf,pos,val)</H3
-><P
->sets the value of the unsigned 32 bit big-endian integer at offset
-pos within buffer buf to value val.</P
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><HR><H2
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN365"
-></A
->5.4. LAN Manager Samba API</H2
-><P
->This section describes the functions need to make a LAN Manager RPC call.
+refered to as &quot;USHORT&quot;.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2869225"></a>RSIVAL(buf,pos,val)</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>sets the value of the unsigned 32 bit big-endian integer at offset
+pos within buffer buf to value val.</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2869240"></a>LAN Manager Samba API</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+This section describes the functions need to make a LAN Manager RPC call.
This information had been obtained by examining the Samba code and the LAN
Manager 2.0 API documentation. It should not be considered entirely
-reliable.</P
-><P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
->call_api(int prcnt, int drcnt, int mprcnt, int mdrcnt,
- char *param, char *data, char **rparam, char **rdata);</PRE
-></P
-><P
->This function is defined in client.c. It uses an SMB transaction to call a
-remote api.</P
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><HR><H3
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN371"
-></A
->5.4.1. Parameters</H3
-><P
->The parameters are as follows:</P
-><P
-></P
-><OL
-TYPE="1"
-><LI
-><P
-> prcnt: the number of bytes of parameters begin sent.</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-> drcnt: the number of bytes of data begin sent.</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-> mprcnt: the maximum number of bytes of parameters which should be returned</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-> mdrcnt: the maximum number of bytes of data which should be returned</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-> param: a pointer to the parameters to be sent.</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-> data: a pointer to the data to be sent.</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-> rparam: a pointer to a pointer which will be set to point to the returned
- paramters. The caller of call_api() must deallocate this memory.</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-> rdata: a pointer to a pointer which will be set to point to the returned
- data. The caller of call_api() must deallocate this memory.</P
-></LI
-></OL
-><P
->These are the parameters which you ought to send, in the order of their
-appearance in the parameter block:</P
-><P
-></P
-><OL
-TYPE="1"
-><LI
-><P
->An unsigned 16 bit integer API number. You should set this value with
-SSVAL(). I do not know where these numbers are described.</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->An ASCIIZ string describing the parameters to the API function as defined
+reliable.
+</p><p>
+</p><pre class="programlisting">
+call_api(int prcnt, int drcnt, int mprcnt, int mdrcnt,
+ char *param, char *data, char **rparam, char **rdata);
+</pre><p>
+</p><p>
+This function is defined in client.c. It uses an SMB transaction to call a
+remote api.
+</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2869276"></a>Parameters</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>The parameters are as follows:</p><div class="orderedlist"><ol type="1"><li><p>
+ prcnt: the number of bytes of parameters begin sent.
+</p></li><li><p>
+ drcnt: the number of bytes of data begin sent.
+</p></li><li><p>
+ mprcnt: the maximum number of bytes of parameters which should be returned
+</p></li><li><p>
+ mdrcnt: the maximum number of bytes of data which should be returned
+</p></li><li><p>
+ param: a pointer to the parameters to be sent.
+</p></li><li><p>
+ data: a pointer to the data to be sent.
+</p></li><li><p>
+ rparam: a pointer to a pointer which will be set to point to the returned
+ paramters. The caller of call_api() must deallocate this memory.
+</p></li><li><p>
+ rdata: a pointer to a pointer which will be set to point to the returned
+ data. The caller of call_api() must deallocate this memory.
+</p></li></ol></div><p>
+These are the parameters which you ought to send, in the order of their
+appearance in the parameter block:
+</p><div class="orderedlist"><ol type="1"><li><p>
+An unsigned 16 bit integer API number. You should set this value with
+SSVAL(). I do not know where these numbers are described.
+</p></li><li><p>
+An ASCIIZ string describing the parameters to the API function as defined
in the LAN Manager documentation. The first parameter, which is the server
name, is ommited. This string is based uppon the API function as described
-in the manual, not the data which is actually passed.</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->An ASCIIZ string describing the data structure which ought to be returned.</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->Any parameters which appear in the function call, as defined in the LAN
-Manager API documentation, after the "Server" and up to and including the
-"uLevel" parameters.</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->An unsigned 16 bit integer which gives the size in bytes of the buffer we
+in the manual, not the data which is actually passed.
+</p></li><li><p>
+An ASCIIZ string describing the data structure which ought to be returned.
+</p></li><li><p>
+Any parameters which appear in the function call, as defined in the LAN
+Manager API documentation, after the &quot;Server&quot; and up to and including the
+&quot;uLevel&quot; parameters.
+</p></li><li><p>
+An unsigned 16 bit integer which gives the size in bytes of the buffer we
will use to receive the returned array of data structures. Presumably this
-should be the same as mdrcnt. This value should be set with SSVAL().</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->An ASCIIZ string describing substructures which should be returned. If no
-substructures apply, this string is of zero length.</P
-></LI
-></OL
-><P
->The code in client.c always calls call_api() with no data. It is unclear
-when a non-zero length data buffer would be sent.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><HR><H3
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN406"
-></A
->5.4.2. Return value</H3
-><P
->The returned parameters (pointed to by rparam), in their order of appearance
-are:</P
-><P
-></P
-><OL
-TYPE="1"
-><LI
-><P
->An unsigned 16 bit integer which contains the API function's return code.
-This value should be read with SVAL().</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->An adjustment which tells the amount by which pointers in the returned
+should be the same as mdrcnt. This value should be set with SSVAL().
+</p></li><li><p>
+An ASCIIZ string describing substructures which should be returned. If no
+substructures apply, this string is of zero length.
+</p></li></ol></div><p>
+The code in client.c always calls call_api() with no data. It is unclear
+when a non-zero length data buffer would be sent.
+</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2869427"></a>Return value</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+The returned parameters (pointed to by rparam), in their order of appearance
+are:</p><div class="orderedlist"><ol type="1"><li><p>
+An unsigned 16 bit integer which contains the API function's return code.
+This value should be read with SVAL().
+</p></li><li><p>
+An adjustment which tells the amount by which pointers in the returned
data should be adjusted. This value should be read with SVAL(). Basically,
the address of the start of the returned data buffer should have the returned
pointer value added to it and then have this value subtracted from it in
-order to obtain the currect offset into the returned data buffer.</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->A count of the number of elements in the array of structures returned.
-It is also possible that this may sometimes be the number of bytes returned.</P
-></LI
-></OL
-><P
->When call_api() returns, rparam points to the returned parameters. The
+order to obtain the currect offset into the returned data buffer.
+</p></li><li><p>
+A count of the number of elements in the array of structures returned.
+It is also possible that this may sometimes be the number of bytes returned.
+</p></li></ol></div><p>
+When call_api() returns, rparam points to the returned parameters. The
first if these is the result code. It will be zero if the API call
-suceeded. This value by be read with "SVAL(rparam,0)".</P
-><P
->The second parameter may be read as "SVAL(rparam,2)". It is a 16 bit offset
+suceeded. This value by be read with &quot;SVAL(rparam,0)&quot;.
+</p><p>
+The second parameter may be read as &quot;SVAL(rparam,2)&quot;. It is a 16 bit offset
which indicates what the base address of the returned data buffer was when
it was built on the server. It should be used to correct pointer before
-use.</P
-><P
->The returned data buffer contains the array of returned data structures.
+use.
+</p><p>
+The returned data buffer contains the array of returned data structures.
Note that all pointers must be adjusted before use. The function
-fix_char_ptr() in client.c can be used for this purpose.</P
-><P
->The third parameter (which may be read as "SVAL(rparam,4)") has something to
+fix_char_ptr() in client.c can be used for this purpose.
+</p><p>
+The third parameter (which may be read as &quot;SVAL(rparam,4)&quot;) has something to
do with indicating the amount of data returned or possibly the amount of
-data which can be returned if enough buffer space is allowed.</P
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><HR><H2
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN420"
-></A
->5.5. Code character table</H2
-><P
->Certain data structures are described by means of ASCIIz strings containing
-code characters. These are the code characters:</P
-><P
-></P
-><OL
-TYPE="1"
-><LI
-><P
->W a type byte little-endian unsigned integer</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->N a count of substructures which follow</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->D a four byte little-endian unsigned integer</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->B a byte (with optional count expressed as trailing ASCII digits)</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->z a four byte offset to a NULL terminated string</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->l a four byte offset to non-string user data</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->b an offset to data (with count expressed as trailing ASCII digits)</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->r pointer to returned data buffer???</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->L length in bytes of returned data buffer???</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->h number of bytes of information available???</P
-></LI
-></OL
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="CHAPTER"
-><HR><H1
-><A
-NAME="PARSING"
-></A
->Chapter 6. The smb.conf file</H1
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><H2
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN451"
-></A
->6.1. Lexical Analysis</H2
-><P
->Basically, the file is processed on a line by line basis. There are
+data which can be returned if enough buffer space is allowed.
+</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2869512"></a>Code character table</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+Certain data structures are described by means of ASCIIz strings containing
+code characters. These are the code characters:
+</p><div class="orderedlist"><ol type="1"><li><p>
+W a type byte little-endian unsigned integer
+</p></li><li><p>
+N a count of substructures which follow
+</p></li><li><p>
+D a four byte little-endian unsigned integer
+</p></li><li><p>
+B a byte (with optional count expressed as trailing ASCII digits)
+</p></li><li><p>
+z a four byte offset to a NULL terminated string
+</p></li><li><p>
+l a four byte offset to non-string user data
+</p></li><li><p>
+b an offset to data (with count expressed as trailing ASCII digits)
+</p></li><li><p>
+r pointer to returned data buffer???
+</p></li><li><p>
+L length in bytes of returned data buffer???
+</p></li><li><p>
+h number of bytes of information available???
+</p></li></ol></div></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="parsing"></a>Chapter 6. The smb.conf file</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Chris</span> <span class="surname">Hertel</span></h3></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">November 1997</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2868851">Lexical Analysis</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2868944">Handling of Whitespace</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2869000">Handling of Line Continuation</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2870660">Line Continuation Quirks</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2870758">Syntax</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2870829">About params.c</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2868851"></a>Lexical Analysis</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+Basically, the file is processed on a line by line basis. There are
four types of lines that are recognized by the lexical analyzer
-(params.c):</P
-><P
-></P
-><OL
-TYPE="1"
-><LI
-><P
->Blank lines - Lines containing only whitespace.</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->Comment lines - Lines beginning with either a semi-colon or a
-pound sign (';' or '#').</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->Section header lines - Lines beginning with an open square bracket ('[').</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->Parameter lines - Lines beginning with any other character.
-(The default line type.)</P
-></LI
-></OL
-><P
->The first two are handled exclusively by the lexical analyzer, which
-ignores them. The latter two line types are scanned for</P
-><P
-></P
-><OL
-TYPE="1"
-><LI
-><P
-> - Section names</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-> - Parameter names</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-> - Parameter values</P
-></LI
-></OL
-><P
->These are the only tokens passed to the parameter loader
+(params.c):
+</p><div class="orderedlist"><ol type="1"><li><p>
+Blank lines - Lines containing only whitespace.
+</p></li><li><p>
+Comment lines - Lines beginning with either a semi-colon or a
+pound sign (';' or '#').
+</p></li><li><p>
+Section header lines - Lines beginning with an open square bracket ('[').
+</p></li><li><p>
+Parameter lines - Lines beginning with any other character.
+(The default line type.)
+</p></li></ol></div><p>
+The first two are handled exclusively by the lexical analyzer, which
+ignores them. The latter two line types are scanned for
+</p><div class="orderedlist"><ol type="1"><li><p>
+ - Section names
+</p></li><li><p>
+ - Parameter names
+</p></li><li><p>
+ - Parameter values
+</p></li></ol></div><p>
+These are the only tokens passed to the parameter loader
(loadparm.c). Parameter names and values are divided from one
-another by an equal sign: '='.</P
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><HR><H3
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN472"
-></A
->6.1.1. Handling of Whitespace</H3
-><P
->Whitespace is defined as all characters recognized by the isspace()
+another by an equal sign: '='.
+</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2868944"></a>Handling of Whitespace</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+Whitespace is defined as all characters recognized by the isspace()
function (see ctype(3C)) except for the newline character ('\n')
-The newline is excluded because it identifies the end of the line.</P
-><P
-></P
-><OL
-TYPE="1"
-><LI
-><P
->The lexical analyzer scans past white space at the beginning of a line.</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->Section and parameter names may contain internal white space. All
-whitespace within a name is compressed to a single space character. </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->Internal whitespace within a parameter value is kept verbatim with
+The newline is excluded because it identifies the end of the line.
+</p><div class="orderedlist"><ol type="1"><li><p>
+The lexical analyzer scans past white space at the beginning of a line.
+</p></li><li><p>
+Section and parameter names may contain internal white space. All
+whitespace within a name is compressed to a single space character.
+</p></li><li><p>
+Internal whitespace within a parameter value is kept verbatim with
the exception of carriage return characters ('\r'), all of which
-are removed.</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->Leading and trailing whitespace is removed from names and values.</P
-></LI
-></OL
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><HR><H3
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN484"
-></A
->6.1.2. Handling of Line Continuation</H3
-><P
->Long section header and parameter lines may be extended across
+are removed.
+</p></li><li><p>
+Leading and trailing whitespace is removed from names and values.
+</p></li></ol></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2869000"></a>Handling of Line Continuation</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+Long section header and parameter lines may be extended across
multiple lines by use of the backslash character ('\\'). Line
-continuation is ignored for blank and comment lines.</P
-><P
->If the last (non-whitespace) character within a section header or on
+continuation is ignored for blank and comment lines.
+</p><p>
+If the last (non-whitespace) character within a section header or on
a parameter line is a backslash, then the next line will be
(logically) concatonated with the current line by the lexical
-analyzer. For example:</P
-><P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
-> param name = parameter value string \
- with line continuation.</PRE
-></P
-><P
->Would be read as</P
-><P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
-> param name = parameter value string with line continuation.</PRE
-></P
-><P
->Note that there are five spaces following the word 'string',
+analyzer. For example:
+</p><pre class="programlisting">
+ param name = parameter value string \
+ with line continuation.
+</pre><p>Would be read as</p><pre class="programlisting">
+ param name = parameter value string with line continuation.
+</pre><p>
+Note that there are five spaces following the word 'string',
representing the one space between 'string' and '\\' in the top
line, plus the four preceeding the word 'with' in the second line.
-(Yes, I'm counting the indentation.)</P
-><P
->Line continuation characters are ignored on blank lines and at the end
+(Yes, I'm counting the indentation.)
+</p><p>
+Line continuation characters are ignored on blank lines and at the end
of comments. They are *only* recognized within section and parameter
-lines.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><HR><H3
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN495"
-></A
->6.1.3. Line Continuation Quirks</H3
-><P
->Note the following example:</P
-><P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
-> param name = parameter value string \
+lines.
+</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2870660"></a>Line Continuation Quirks</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>Note the following example:</p><pre class="programlisting">
+ param name = parameter value string \
\
- with line continuation.</PRE
-></P
-><P
->The middle line is *not* parsed as a blank line because it is first
-concatonated with the top line. The result is</P
-><P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
->param name = parameter value string with line continuation.</PRE
-></P
-><P
->The same is true for comment lines.</P
-><P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
-> param name = parameter value string \
+ with line continuation.
+</pre><p>
+The middle line is *not* parsed as a blank line because it is first
+concatonated with the top line. The result is
+</p><pre class="programlisting">
+param name = parameter value string with line continuation.
+</pre><p>The same is true for comment lines.</p><pre class="programlisting">
+ param name = parameter value string \
; comment \
- with a comment.</PRE
-></P
-><P
->This becomes:</P
-><P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
->param name = parameter value string ; comment with a comment.</PRE
-></P
-><P
->On a section header line, the closing bracket (']') is considered a
-terminating character, and the rest of the line is ignored. The lines</P
-><P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
-> [ section name ] garbage \
- param name = value</PRE
-></P
-><P
->are read as</P
-><P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
-> [section name]
- param name = value</PRE
-></P
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><HR><H2
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN515"
-></A
->6.2. Syntax</H2
-><P
->The syntax of the smb.conf file is as follows:</P
-><P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
-> &lt;file&gt; :== { &lt;section&gt; } EOF
+ with a comment.
+</pre><p>This becomes:</p><pre class="programlisting">
+param name = parameter value string ; comment with a comment.
+</pre><p>
+On a section header line, the closing bracket (']') is considered a
+terminating character, and the rest of the line is ignored. The lines
+</p><pre class="programlisting">
+ [ section name ] garbage \
+ param name = value
+</pre><p>are read as</p><pre class="programlisting">
+ [section name]
+ param name = value
+</pre></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2870758"></a>Syntax</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>The syntax of the smb.conf file is as follows:</p><pre class="programlisting">
+ &lt;file&gt; :== { &lt;section&gt; } EOF
&lt;section&gt; :== &lt;section header&gt; { &lt;parameter line&gt; }
&lt;section header&gt; :== '[' NAME ']'
- &lt;parameter line&gt; :== NAME '=' VALUE NL</PRE
-></P
-><P
->Basically, this means that</P
-><P
-></P
-><OL
-TYPE="1"
-><LI
-><P
-> a file is made up of zero or more sections, and is terminated by
- an EOF (we knew that).</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-> A section is made up of a section header followed by zero or more
- parameter lines.</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-> A section header is identified by an opening bracket and
+ &lt;parameter line&gt; :== NAME '=' VALUE NL
+</pre><p>Basically, this means that</p><div class="orderedlist"><ol type="1"><li><p>
+ a file is made up of zero or more sections, and is terminated by
+ an EOF (we knew that).
+</p></li><li><p>
+ A section is made up of a section header followed by zero or more
+ parameter lines.
+</p></li><li><p>
+ A section header is identified by an opening bracket and
terminated by the closing bracket. The enclosed NAME identifies
- the section.</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-> A parameter line is divided into a NAME and a VALUE. The *first*
+ the section.
+</p></li><li><p>
+ A parameter line is divided into a NAME and a VALUE. The *first*
equal sign on the line separates the NAME from the VALUE. The
- VALUE is terminated by a newline character (NL = '\n').</P
-></LI
-></OL
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><HR><H3
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN530"
-></A
->6.2.1. About params.c</H3
-><P
->The parsing of the config file is a bit unusual if you are used to
+ VALUE is terminated by a newline character (NL = '\n').
+</p></li></ol></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2870829"></a>About params.c</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+The parsing of the config file is a bit unusual if you are used to
lex, yacc, bison, etc. Both lexical analysis (scanning) and parsing
are performed by params.c. Values are loaded via callbacks to
-loadparm.c.</P
-></DIV
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="CHAPTER"
-><HR><H1
-><A
-NAME="UNIX-SMB"
-></A
->Chapter 7. NetBIOS in a Unix World</H1
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><H2
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN540"
-></A
->7.1. Introduction</H2
-><P
->This is a short document that describes some of the issues that
+loadparm.c.
+</p></div></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="unix-smb"></a>Chapter 7. NetBIOS in a Unix World</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Andrew</span> <span class="surname">Tridgell</span></h3></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">April 1995</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2870276">Introduction</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2870301">Usernames</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2870529">File Ownership</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2870566">Passwords</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2870604">Locking</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2871543">Deny Modes</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2871573">Trapdoor UIDs</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2871598">Port numbers</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2871644">Protocol Complexity</a></dt></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2870276"></a>Introduction</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+This is a short document that describes some of the issues that
confront a SMB implementation on unix, and how Samba copes with
-them. They may help people who are looking at unix&#60;-&#62;PC
-interoperability.</P
-><P
->It was written to help out a person who was writing a paper on unix to
-PC connectivity.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><HR><H2
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN544"
-></A
->7.2. Usernames</H2
-><P
->The SMB protocol has only a loose username concept. Early SMB
+them. They may help people who are looking at unix&lt;-&gt;PC
+interoperability.
+</p><p>
+It was written to help out a person who was writing a paper on unix to
+PC connectivity.
+</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2870301"></a>Usernames</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+The SMB protocol has only a loose username concept. Early SMB
protocols (such as CORE and COREPLUS) have no username concept at
all. Even in later protocols clients often attempt operations
(particularly printer operations) without first validating a username
-on the server.</P
-><P
->Unix security is based around username/password pairs. A unix box
+on the server.
+</p><p>
+Unix security is based around username/password pairs. A unix box
should not allow clients to do any substantive operation without some
-sort of validation. </P
-><P
->The problem mostly manifests itself when the unix server is in "share
-level" security mode. This is the default mode as the alternative
-"user level" security mode usually forces a client to connect to the
+sort of validation.
+</p><p>
+The problem mostly manifests itself when the unix server is in &quot;share
+level&quot; security mode. This is the default mode as the alternative
+&quot;user level&quot; security mode usually forces a client to connect to the
server as the same user for each connected share, which is
-inconvenient in many sites.</P
-><P
->In "share level" security the client normally gives a username in the
-"session setup" protocol, but does not supply an accompanying
-password. The client then connects to resources using the "tree
-connect" protocol, and supplies a password. The problem is that the
+inconvenient in many sites.
+</p><p>
+In &quot;share level&quot; security the client normally gives a username in the
+&quot;session setup&quot; protocol, but does not supply an accompanying
+password. The client then connects to resources using the &quot;tree
+connect&quot; protocol, and supplies a password. The problem is that the
user on the PC types the username and the password in different
contexts, unaware that they need to go together to give access to the
server. The username is normally the one the user typed in when they
-"logged onto" the PC (this assumes Windows for Workgroups). The
-password is the one they chose when connecting to the disk or printer.</P
-><P
->The user often chooses a totally different username for their login as
+&quot;logged onto&quot; the PC (this assumes Windows for Workgroups). The
+password is the one they chose when connecting to the disk or printer.
+</p><p>
+The user often chooses a totally different username for their login as
for the drive connection. Often they also want to access different
drives as different usernames. The unix server needs some way of
-divining the correct username to combine with each password.</P
-><P
->Samba tries to avoid this problem using several methods. These succeed
+divining the correct username to combine with each password.
+</p><p>
+Samba tries to avoid this problem using several methods. These succeed
in the vast majority of cases. The methods include username maps, the
service%user syntax, the saving of session setup usernames for later
validation and the derivation of the username from the service name
-(either directly or via the user= option).</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><HR><H2
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN552"
-></A
->7.3. File Ownership</H2
-><P
->The commonly used SMB protocols have no way of saying "you can't do
-that because you don't own the file". They have, in fact, no concept
-of file ownership at all.</P
-><P
->This brings up all sorts of interesting problems. For example, when
+(either directly or via the user= option).
+</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2870529"></a>File Ownership</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+The commonly used SMB protocols have no way of saying &quot;you can't do
+that because you don't own the file&quot;. They have, in fact, no concept
+of file ownership at all.
+</p><p>
+This brings up all sorts of interesting problems. For example, when
you copy a file to a unix drive, and the file is world writeable but
owned by another user the file will transfer correctly but will
receive the wrong date. This is because the utime() call under unix
only succeeds for the owner of the file, or root, even if the file is
world writeable. For security reasons Samba does all file operations
as the validated user, not root, so the utime() fails. This can stuff
-up shared development diectories as programs like "make" will not get
-file time comparisons right.</P
-><P
->There are several possible solutions to this problem, including
+up shared development diectories as programs like &quot;make&quot; will not get
+file time comparisons right.
+</p><p>
+There are several possible solutions to this problem, including
username mapping, and forcing a specific username for particular
-shares.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><HR><H2
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN557"
-></A
->7.4. Passwords</H2
-><P
->Many SMB clients uppercase passwords before sending them. I have no
+shares.
+</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2870566"></a>Passwords</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+Many SMB clients uppercase passwords before sending them. I have no
idea why they do this. Interestingly WfWg uppercases the password only
if the server is running a protocol greater than COREPLUS, so
-obviously it isn't just the data entry routines that are to blame.</P
-><P
->Unix passwords are case sensitive. So if users use mixed case
-passwords they are in trouble.</P
-><P
->Samba can try to cope with this by either using the "password level"
+obviously it isn't just the data entry routines that are to blame.
+</p><p>
+Unix passwords are case sensitive. So if users use mixed case
+passwords they are in trouble.
+</p><p>
+Samba can try to cope with this by either using the &quot;password level&quot;
option which causes Samba to try the offered password with up to the
-specified number of case changes, or by using the "password server"
+specified number of case changes, or by using the &quot;password server&quot;
option which allows Samba to do its validation via another machine
-(typically a WinNT server).</P
-><P
->Samba supports the password encryption method used by SMB
+(typically a WinNT server).
+</p><p>
+Samba supports the password encryption method used by SMB
clients. Note that the use of password encryption in Microsoft
-networking leads to password hashes that are "plain text equivalent".
+networking leads to password hashes that are &quot;plain text equivalent&quot;.
This means that it is *VERY* important to ensure that the Samba
smbpasswd file containing these password hashes is only readable
by the root user. See the documentation ENCRYPTION.txt for more
-details.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><HR><H2
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN563"
-></A
->7.5. Locking</H2
-><P
->Since samba 2.2, samba supports other types of locking as well. This
-section is outdated.</P
-><P
->The locking calls available under a DOS/Windows environment are much
+details.
+</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2870604"></a>Locking</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+Since samba 2.2, samba supports other types of locking as well. This
+section is outdated.
+</p><p>
+The locking calls available under a DOS/Windows environment are much
richer than those available in unix. This means a unix server (like
Samba) choosing to use the standard fcntl() based unix locking calls
-to implement SMB locking has to improvise a bit.</P
-><P
->One major problem is that dos locks can be in a 32 bit (unsigned)
+to implement SMB locking has to improvise a bit.
+</p><p>
+One major problem is that dos locks can be in a 32 bit (unsigned)
range. Unix locking calls are 32 bits, but are signed, giving only a 31
bit range. Unfortunately OLE2 clients use the top bit to select a
-locking range used for OLE semaphores.</P
-><P
->To work around this problem Samba compresses the 32 bit range into 31
+locking range used for OLE semaphores.
+</p><p>
+To work around this problem Samba compresses the 32 bit range into 31
bits by appropriate bit shifting. This seems to work but is not
ideal. In a future version a separate SMB lockd may be added to cope
-with the problem.</P
-><P
->It also doesn't help that many unix lockd daemons are very buggy and
+with the problem.
+</p><p>
+It also doesn't help that many unix lockd daemons are very buggy and
crash at the slightest provocation. They normally go mostly unused in
a unix environment because few unix programs use byte range
locking. The stress of huge numbers of lock requests from dos/windows
-clients can kill the daemon on some systems.</P
-><P
->The second major problem is the "opportunistic locking" requested by
+clients can kill the daemon on some systems.
+</p><p>
+The second major problem is the &quot;opportunistic locking&quot; requested by
some clients. If a client requests opportunistic locking then it is
asking the server to notify it if anyone else tries to do something on
the same file, at which time the client will say if it is willing to
give up its lock. Unix has no simple way of implementing
-opportunistic locking, and currently Samba has no support for it.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><HR><H2
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN571"
-></A
->7.6. Deny Modes</H2
-><P
->When a SMB client opens a file it asks for a particular "deny mode" to
+opportunistic locking, and currently Samba has no support for it.
+</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2871543"></a>Deny Modes</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+When a SMB client opens a file it asks for a particular &quot;deny mode&quot; to
be placed on the file. These modes (DENY_NONE, DENY_READ, DENY_WRITE,
DENY_ALL, DENY_FCB and DENY_DOS) specify what actions should be
allowed by anyone else who tries to use the file at the same time. If
DENY_READ is placed on the file, for example, then any attempt to open
-the file for reading should fail.</P
-><P
->Unix has no equivalent notion. To implement this Samba uses either lock
+the file for reading should fail.
+</p><p>
+Unix has no equivalent notion. To implement this Samba uses either lock
files based on the files inode and placed in a separate lock
directory or a shared memory implementation. The lock file method
is clumsy and consumes processing and file resources,
the shared memory implementation is vastly prefered and is turned on
-by default for those systems that support it.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><HR><H2
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN575"
-></A
->7.7. Trapdoor UIDs</H2
-><P
->A SMB session can run with several uids on the one socket. This
+by default for those systems that support it.
+</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2871573"></a>Trapdoor UIDs</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+A SMB session can run with several uids on the one socket. This
happens when a user connects to two shares with different
usernames. To cope with this the unix server needs to switch uids
within the one process. On some unixes (such as SCO) this is not
possible. This means that on those unixes the client is restricted to
-a single uid.</P
-><P
->Note that you can also get the "trapdoor uid" message for other
-reasons. Please see the FAQ for details.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><HR><H2
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN579"
-></A
->7.8. Port numbers</H2
-><P
->There is a convention that clients on sockets use high "unprivilaged"
-port numbers (&#62;1000) and connect to servers on low "privilaged" port
+a single uid.
+</p><p>
+Note that you can also get the &quot;trapdoor uid&quot; message for other
+reasons. Please see the FAQ for details.
+</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2871598"></a>Port numbers</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+There is a convention that clients on sockets use high &quot;unprivilaged&quot;
+port numbers (&gt;1000) and connect to servers on low &quot;privilaged&quot; port
numbers. This is enforced in Unix as non-root users can't open a
-socket for listening on port numbers less than 1000.</P
-><P
->Most PC based SMB clients (such as WfWg and WinNT) don't follow this
+socket for listening on port numbers less than 1000.
+</p><p>
+Most PC based SMB clients (such as WfWg and WinNT) don't follow this
convention completely. The main culprit is the netbios nameserving on
udp port 137. Name query requests come from a source port of 137. This
is a problem when you combine it with the common firewalling technique
of not allowing incoming packets on low port numbers. This means that
these clients can't query a netbios nameserver on the other side of a
-low port based firewall.</P
-><P
->The problem is more severe with netbios node status queries. I've
+low port based firewall.
+</p><p>
+The problem is more severe with netbios node status queries. I've
found that WfWg, Win95 and WinNT3.5 all respond to netbios node status
queries on port 137 no matter what the source port was in the
request. This works between machines that are both using port 137, but
@@ -2755,421 +1033,179 @@ it means it's not possible for a unix user to do a node status request
to any of these OSes unless they are running as root. The answer comes
back, but it goes to port 137 which the unix user can't listen
on. Interestingly WinNT3.1 got this right - it sends node status
-responses back to the source port in the request.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><HR><H2
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN584"
-></A
->7.9. Protocol Complexity</H2
-><P
->There are many "protocol levels" in the SMB protocol. It seems that
+responses back to the source port in the request.
+</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2871644"></a>Protocol Complexity</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+There are many &quot;protocol levels&quot; in the SMB protocol. It seems that
each time new functionality was added to a Microsoft operating system,
they added the equivalent functions in a new protocol level of the SMB
-protocol to "externalise" the new capabilities.</P
-><P
->This means the protocol is very "rich", offering many ways of doing
+protocol to &quot;externalise&quot; the new capabilities.
+</p><p>
+This means the protocol is very &quot;rich&quot;, offering many ways of doing
each file operation. This means SMB servers need to be complex and
large. It also means it is very difficult to make them bug free. It is
not just Samba that suffers from this problem, other servers such as
WinNT don't support every variation of every call and it has almost
certainly been a headache for MS developers to support the myriad of
-SMB calls that are available.</P
-><P
->There are about 65 "top level" operations in the SMB protocol (things
+SMB calls that are available.
+</p><p>
+There are about 65 &quot;top level&quot; operations in the SMB protocol (things
like SMBread and SMBwrite). Some of these include hundreds of
sub-functions (SMBtrans has at least 120 sub-functions, like
DosPrintQAdd and NetSessionEnum). All of them take several options
that can change the way they work. Many take dozens of possible
-"information levels" that change the structures that need to be
-returned. Samba supports all but 2 of the "top level" functions. It
+&quot;information levels&quot; that change the structures that need to be
+returned. Samba supports all but 2 of the &quot;top level&quot; functions. It
supports only 8 (so far) of the SMBtrans sub-functions. Even NT
-doesn't support them all.</P
-><P
->Samba currently supports up to the "NT LM 0.12" protocol, which is the
+doesn't support them all.
+</p><p>
+Samba currently supports up to the &quot;NT LM 0.12&quot; protocol, which is the
one preferred by Win95 and WinNT3.5. Luckily this protocol level has a
-"capabilities" field which specifies which super-duper new-fangled
+&quot;capabilities&quot; field which specifies which super-duper new-fangled
options the server suports. This helps to make the implementation of
-this protocol level much easier.</P
-><P
->There is also a problem with the SMB specications. SMB is a X/Open
+this protocol level much easier.
+</p><p>
+There is also a problem with the SMB specications. SMB is a X/Open
spec, but the X/Open book is far from ideal, and fails to cover many
important issues, leaving much to the imagination. Microsoft recently
renamed the SMB protocol CIFS (Common Internet File System) and have
published new specifications. These are far superior to the old
X/Open documents but there are still undocumented calls and features.
This specification is actively being worked on by a CIFS developers
-mailing list hosted by Microsft.</P
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="CHAPTER"
-><HR><H1
-><A
-NAME="TRACING"
-></A
->Chapter 8. Tracing samba system calls</H1
-><P
->This file describes how to do a system call trace on Samba to work out
+mailing list hosted by Microsft.
+</p></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="tracing"></a>Chapter 8. Tracing samba system calls</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Andrew</span> <span class="surname">Tridgell</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span></div></div></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+This file describes how to do a system call trace on Samba to work out
what its doing wrong. This is not for the faint of heart, but if you
-are reading this then you are probably desperate.</P
-><P
->Actually its not as bad as the the above makes it sound, just don't
-expect the output to be very pretty :-)</P
-><P
->Ok, down to business. One of the big advantages of unix systems is
+are reading this then you are probably desperate.
+</p><p>
+Actually its not as bad as the the above makes it sound, just don't
+expect the output to be very pretty :-)
+</p><p>
+Ok, down to business. One of the big advantages of unix systems is
that they nearly all come with a system trace utility that allows you
to monitor all system calls that a program is making. This is
extremely using for debugging and also helps when trying to work out
why something is slower than you expect. You can use system tracing
-without any special compilation options. </P
-><P
->The system trace utility is called different things on different
+without any special compilation options.
+</p><p>
+The system trace utility is called different things on different
systems. On Linux systems its called strace. Under SunOS 4 its called
trace. Under SVR4 style systems (including solaris) its called
-truss. Under many BSD systems its called ktrace. </P
-><P
->The first thing you should do is read the man page for your native
+truss. Under many BSD systems its called ktrace.
+</p><p>
+The first thing you should do is read the man page for your native
system call tracer. In the discussion below I'll assume its called
strace as strace is the only portable system tracer (its available for
free for many unix types) and its also got some of the nicest
-features.</P
-><P
->Next, try using strace on some simple commands. For example, <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->strace
-ls</B
-> or <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->strace echo hello</B
->.</P
-><P
->
+features.
+</p><p>
+Next, try using strace on some simple commands. For example, <b class="command">strace
+ls</b> or <b class="command">strace echo hello</b>.
+</p><p>
You'll notice that it produces a LOT of output. It is showing you the
arguments to every system call that the program makes and the
result. Very little happens in a program without a system call so you
get lots of output. You'll also find that it produces a lot of
-"preamble" stuff showing the loading of shared libraries etc. Ignore
-this (unless its going wrong!)</P
-><P
->For example, the only line that really matters in the <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->strace echo
-hello</B
-> output is:</P
-><P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
->write(1, "hello\n", 6) = 6</PRE
-></P
-><P
->all the rest is just setting up to run the program.</P
-><P
->Ok, now you're familiar with strace. To use it on Samba you need to
+&quot;preamble&quot; stuff showing the loading of shared libraries etc. Ignore
+this (unless its going wrong!)
+</p><p>
+For example, the only line that really matters in the <b class="command">strace echo
+hello</b> output is:
+</p><pre class="programlisting">
+write(1, &quot;hello\n&quot;, 6) = 6
+</pre><p>all the rest is just setting up to run the program.</p><p>
+Ok, now you're familiar with strace. To use it on Samba you need to
strace the running smbd daemon. The way I tend ot use it is to first
login from my Windows PC to the Samba server, then use smbstatus to
find which process ID that client is attached to, then as root I do
-<B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->strace -p PID</B
-> to attach to that process. I normally redirect the
+<b class="command">strace -p PID</b> to attach to that process. I normally redirect the
stderr output from this command to a file for later perusal. For
-example, if I'm using a csh style shell:</P
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->strace -f -p 3872 &#62;&#38; strace.out</B
-></P
-><P
->or with a sh style shell:</P
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->strace -f -p 3872 &#62; strace.out 2&#62;&#38;1</B
-></P
-><P
->Note the "-f" option. This is only available on some systems, and
+example, if I'm using a csh style shell:
+</p><p><b class="command">strace -f -p 3872 &gt;&amp; strace.out</b></p><p>or with a sh style shell:</p><p><b class="command">strace -f -p 3872 &gt; strace.out 2&gt;&amp;1</b></p><p>
+Note the &quot;-f&quot; option. This is only available on some systems, and
allows you to trace not just the current process, but any children it
forks. This is great for finding printing problems caused by the
-"print command" being wrong.</P
-><P
->Once you are attached you then can do whatever it is on the client
+&quot;print command&quot; being wrong.
+</p><p>
+Once you are attached you then can do whatever it is on the client
that is causing problems and you will capture all the system calls
-that smbd makes. </P
-><P
->So how do you interpret the results? Generally I search through the
+that smbd makes.
+</p><p>
+So how do you interpret the results? Generally I search through the
output for strings that I know will appear when the problem
happens. For example, if I am having touble with permissions on a file
I would search for that files name in the strace output and look at
the surrounding lines. Another trick is to match up file descriptor
-numbers and "follow" what happens to an open file until it is closed.</P
-><P
->Beyond this you will have to use your initiative. To give you an idea
+numbers and &quot;follow&quot; what happens to an open file until it is closed.
+</p><p>
+Beyond this you will have to use your initiative. To give you an idea
of what you are looking for here is a piece of strace output that
-shows that <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/dev/null</TT
-> is not world writeable, which
-causes printing to fail with Samba:</P
-><P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
->[pid 28268] open("/dev/null", O_RDWR) = -1 EACCES (Permission denied)
-[pid 28268] open("/dev/null", O_WRONLY) = -1 EACCES (Permission denied)</PRE
-></P
-><P
->The process is trying to first open <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/dev/null</TT
-> read-write
-then read-only. Both fail. This means <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/dev/null</TT
-> has
-incorrect permissions.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="CHAPTER"
-><HR><H1
-><A
-NAME="NTDOMAIN"
-></A
->Chapter 9. NT Domain RPC's</H1
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><H2
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN652"
-></A
->9.1. Introduction</H2
-><P
->This document contains information to provide an NT workstation with login
-services, without the need for an NT server. It is the sgml version of <A
-HREF="http://mailhost.cb1.com/~lkcl/cifsntdomain.txt"
-TARGET="_top"
->http://mailhost.cb1.com/~lkcl/cifsntdomain.txt</A
->, controlled by Luke.</P
-><P
->It should be possible to select a domain instead of a workgroup (in the NT
+shows that <tt class="filename">/dev/null</tt> is not world writeable, which
+causes printing to fail with Samba:
+</p><pre class="programlisting">
+[pid 28268] open(&quot;/dev/null&quot;, O_RDWR) = -1 EACCES (Permission denied)
+[pid 28268] open(&quot;/dev/null&quot;, O_WRONLY) = -1 EACCES (Permission denied)
+</pre><p>
+The process is trying to first open <tt class="filename">/dev/null</tt> read-write
+then read-only. Both fail. This means <tt class="filename">/dev/null</tt> has
+incorrect permissions.
+</p></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="ntdomain"></a>Chapter 9. NT Domain RPC's</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Luke</span> <span class="surname">Leighton</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><div class="address"><p><tt class="email">&lt;<a href="mailto:lkcl@switchboard.net">lkcl@switchboard.net</a>&gt;</tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Paul</span> <span class="surname">Ashton</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><div class="address"><p><tt class="email">&lt;<a href="mailto:paul@argo.demon.co.uk">paul@argo.demon.co.uk</a>&gt;</tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Duncan</span> <span class="surname">Stansfield</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><div class="address"><p><tt class="email">&lt;<a href="mailto:duncans@sco.com">duncans@sco.com</a>&gt;</tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">01 November 97(version 0.0.24)</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2871220">Introduction</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2872245">Sources</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2872278">Credits</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2872317">Notes and Structures</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2872324">Notes</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2873087">Enumerations</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2873300">Structures</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2876250">MSRPC over Transact Named Pipe</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2876262">MSRPC Pipes</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2876365">Header</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2877236">Tail</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2877281">RPC Bind / Bind Ack</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2877461">NTLSA Transact Named Pipe</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2877626">LSA Open Policy</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2877752">LSA Query Info Policy</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2877858">LSA Enumerate Trusted Domains</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2877950">LSA Open Secret</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2878060">LSA Close</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2878126">LSA Lookup SIDS</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2878335">LSA Lookup Names</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2878561">NETLOGON rpc Transact Named Pipe</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2878722">LSA Request Challenge</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2878856">LSA Authenticate 2</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2879004">LSA Server Password Set</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2879119">LSA SAM Logon</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2879232">LSA SAM Logoff</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2879324">\\MAILSLOT\NET\NTLOGON</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2879336">Query for PDC</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2879604">SAM Logon</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2879929">SRVSVC Transact Named Pipe</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2879974">Net Share Enum</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2880194">Net Server Get Info</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2880310">Cryptographic side of NT Domain Authentication</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2880318">Definitions</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2880480">Protocol</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2880577">Comments</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2880626">SIDs and RIDs</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2880666">Well-known SIDs</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2880981">Well-known RIDS</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2871220"></a>Introduction</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+This document contains information to provide an NT workstation with login
+services, without the need for an NT server. It is the sgml version of <a href="http://mailhost.cb1.com/~lkcl/cifsntdomain.txt" target="_top">http://mailhost.cb1.com/~lkcl/cifsntdomain.txt</a>, controlled by Luke.
+</p><p>
+It should be possible to select a domain instead of a workgroup (in the NT
workstation's TCP/IP settings) and after the obligatory reboot, type in a
username, password, select a domain and successfully log in. I would
appreciate any feedback on your experiences with this process, and any
-comments, corrections and additions to this document.</P
-><P
->The packets described here can be easily derived from (and are probably
+comments, corrections and additions to this document.
+</p><p>
+The packets described here can be easily derived from (and are probably
better understood using) Netmon.exe. You will need to use the version
of Netmon that matches your system, in order to correctly decode the
NETLOGON, lsarpc and srvsvc Transact pipes. This document is derived from
NT Service Pack 1 and its corresponding version of Netmon. It is intended
that an annotated packet trace be produced, which will likely be more
-instructive than this document.</P
-><P
->Also needed, to fully implement NT Domain Login Services, is the
+instructive than this document.
+</p><p>
+Also needed, to fully implement NT Domain Login Services, is the
document describing the cryptographic part of the NT authentication.
This document is available from comp.protocols.smb; from the ntsecurity.net
-digest and from the samba digest, amongst other sources.</P
-><P
->A copy is available from:</P
-><P
-><A
-HREF="http://ntbugtraq.rc.on.ca/SCRIPTS/WA.EXE?A2=ind9708;L=ntbugtraq;O=A;P=2935"
-TARGET="_top"
->http://ntbugtraq.rc.on.ca/SCRIPTS/WA.EXE?A2=ind9708;L=ntbugtraq;O=A;P=2935</A
-></P
-><P
-><A
-HREF="http://mailhost.cb1.com/~lkcl/crypt.html"
-TARGET="_top"
->http://mailhost.cb1.com/~lkcl/crypt.html</A
-></P
-><P
->A c-code implementation, provided by <A
-HREF="mailto:linus@incolumitas.se"
-TARGET="_top"
->Linus Nordberg</A
->
-of this protocol is available from:</P
-><P
-><A
-HREF="http://samba.org/cgi-bin/mfs/01/digest/1997/97aug/0391.html"
-TARGET="_top"
->http://samba.org/cgi-bin/mfs/01/digest/1997/97aug/0391.html</A
-></P
-><P
-><A
-HREF="http://mailhost.cb1.com/~lkcl/crypt.txt"
-TARGET="_top"
->http://mailhost.cb1.com/~lkcl/crypt.txt</A
-></P
-><P
->Also used to provide debugging information is the Check Build version of
+digest and from the samba digest, amongst other sources.
+</p><p>
+A copy is available from:
+</p><p><a href="http://ntbugtraq.rc.on.ca/SCRIPTS/WA.EXE?A2=ind9708;L=ntbugtraq;O=A;P=2935" target="_top">http://ntbugtraq.rc.on.ca/SCRIPTS/WA.EXE?A2=ind9708;L=ntbugtraq;O=A;P=2935</a></p><p><a href="http://mailhost.cb1.com/~lkcl/crypt.html" target="_top">http://mailhost.cb1.com/~lkcl/crypt.html</a></p><p>
+A c-code implementation, provided by <a href="mailto:linus@incolumitas.se" target="_top">Linus Nordberg</a>
+of this protocol is available from:
+</p><p><a href="http://samba.org/cgi-bin/mfs/01/digest/1997/97aug/0391.html" target="_top">http://samba.org/cgi-bin/mfs/01/digest/1997/97aug/0391.html</a></p><p><a href="http://mailhost.cb1.com/~lkcl/crypt.txt" target="_top">http://mailhost.cb1.com/~lkcl/crypt.txt</a></p><p>
+Also used to provide debugging information is the Check Build version of
NT workstation, and enabling full debugging in NETLOGON. This is
-achieved by setting the following REG_SZ registry key to 0x1ffffff:</P
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->HKLM\SYSTEM\CurrentControlSet\Services\Netlogon\Parameters</TT
-></P
-><P
-><SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->Incorrect direct editing of the registry can cause your
+achieved by setting the following REG_SZ registry key to 0x1ffffff:
+</p><p><tt class="filename">HKLM\SYSTEM\CurrentControlSet\Services\Netlogon\Parameters</tt></p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Incorrect direct editing of the registry can cause your
machine to fail. Then again, so can incorrect implementation of this
-protocol. See "Liability:" above.</I
-></SPAN
-></P
-><P
->Bear in mind that each packet over-the-wire will have its origin in an
+protocol. See &quot;Liability:&quot; above.</em></span></p><p>
+Bear in mind that each packet over-the-wire will have its origin in an
API call. Therefore, there are likely to be structures, enumerations
-and defines that are usefully documented elsewhere.</P
-><P
->This document is by no means complete or authoritative. Missing sections
-include, but are not limited to:</P
-><P
-></P
-><OL
-TYPE="1"
-><LI
-><P
->Mappings of RIDs to usernames (and vice-versa).</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->What a User ID is and what a Group ID is.</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->The exact meaning/definition of various magic constants or enumerations.</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->The reply error code and use of that error code when a
+and defines that are usefully documented elsewhere.
+</p><p>
+This document is by no means complete or authoritative. Missing sections
+include, but are not limited to:
+</p><div class="orderedlist"><ol type="1"><li><p>Mappings of RIDs to usernames (and vice-versa).</p></li><li><p>What a User ID is and what a Group ID is.</p></li><li><p>The exact meaning/definition of various magic constants or enumerations.</p></li><li><p>The reply error code and use of that error code when a
workstation becomes a member of a domain (to be described later).
Failure to return this error code will make the workstation report
-that it is already a member of the domain.</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->the cryptographic side of the NetrServerPasswordSet command,
+that it is already a member of the domain.</p></li><li><p>the cryptographic side of the NetrServerPasswordSet command,
which would allow the workstation to change its password. This password is
used to generate the long-term session key. [It is possible to reject this
-command, and keep the default workstation password].</P
-></LI
-></OL
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><HR><H3
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN688"
-></A
->9.1.1. Sources</H3
-><P
-></P
-><TABLE
-BORDER="0"
-><TBODY
-><TR
-><TD
->cket Traces from Netmonitor (Service Pack 1 and above)</TD
-></TR
-><TR
-><TD
->ul Ashton and Luke Leighton's other "NT Domain" doc.</TD
-></TR
-><TR
-><TD
->FS documentation - cifs6.txt</TD
-></TR
-><TR
-><TD
->FS documentation - cifsrap2.txt</TD
-></TR
-></TBODY
-></TABLE
-><P
-></P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><HR><H3
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN695"
-></A
->9.1.2. Credits</H3
-><P
-></P
-><TABLE
-BORDER="0"
-><TBODY
-><TR
-><TD
->Paul Ashton: loads of work with Net Monitor; understanding the NT authentication system; reference implementation of the NT domain support on which this document is originally based.</TD
-></TR
-><TR
-><TD
->Duncan Stansfield: low-level analysis of MSRPC Pipes.</TD
-></TR
-><TR
-><TD
->Linus Nordberg: producing c-code from Paul's crypto spec.</TD
-></TR
-><TR
-><TD
->Windows Sourcer development team</TD
-></TR
-></TBODY
-></TABLE
-><P
-></P
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><HR><H2
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN702"
-></A
->9.2. Notes and Structures</H2
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><H3
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN704"
-></A
->9.2.1. Notes</H3
-><P
-></P
-><OL
-TYPE="1"
-><LI
-><P
->In the SMB Transact pipes, some "Structures", described here, appear to be
+command, and keep the default workstation password].</p></li></ol></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2872245"></a>Sources</h3></div></div><div></div></div><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td>cket Traces from Netmonitor (Service Pack 1 and above)</td></tr><tr><td>ul Ashton and Luke Leighton's other &quot;NT Domain&quot; doc.</td></tr><tr><td>FS documentation - cifs6.txt</td></tr><tr><td>FS documentation - cifsrap2.txt</td></tr></table></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2872278"></a>Credits</h3></div></div><div></div></div><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td>Paul Ashton: loads of work with Net Monitor; understanding the NT authentication system; reference implementation of the NT domain support on which this document is originally based.</td></tr><tr><td>Duncan Stansfield: low-level analysis of MSRPC Pipes.</td></tr><tr><td>Linus Nordberg: producing c-code from Paul's crypto spec.</td></tr><tr><td>Windows Sourcer development team</td></tr></table></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2872317"></a>Notes and Structures</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2872324"></a>Notes</h3></div></div><div></div></div><div class="orderedlist"><ol type="1"><li><p>
+In the SMB Transact pipes, some &quot;Structures&quot;, described here, appear to be
4-byte aligned with the SMB header, at their start. Exactly which
-"Structures" need aligning is not precisely known or documented.</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->In the UDP NTLOGON Mailslots, some "Structures", described here, appear to be
-2-byte aligned with the start of the mailslot, at their start.</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->Domain SID is of the format S-revision-version-auth1-auth2...authN.
-e.g S-1-5-123-456-789-123-456. the 5 could be a sub-revision.</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->any undocumented buffer pointers must be non-zero if the string buffer it
+&quot;Structures&quot; need aligning is not precisely known or documented.
+</p></li><li><p>
+In the UDP NTLOGON Mailslots, some &quot;Structures&quot;, described here, appear to be
+2-byte aligned with the start of the mailslot, at their start.
+</p></li><li><p>
+Domain SID is of the format S-revision-version-auth1-auth2...authN.
+e.g S-1-5-123-456-789-123-456. the 5 could be a sub-revision.
+</p></li><li><p>
+any undocumented buffer pointers must be non-zero if the string buffer it
refers to contains characters. exactly what value they should be is unknown.
0x0000 0002 seems to do the trick to indicate that the buffer exists. a
NULL buffer pointer indicates that the string buffer is of zero length.
@@ -3178,3707 +1214,90 @@ refers to is NOT put into (or taken out of) the SMB data stream. This is
empirically derived from, for example, the LSA SAM Logon response packet,
where if the buffer pointer is NULL, the user information is not inserted
into the data stream. Exactly what happens with an array of buffer pointers
-is not known, although an educated guess can be made.</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->an array of structures (a container) appears to have a count and a pointer.
+is not known, although an educated guess can be made.
+</p></li><li><p>
+an array of structures (a container) appears to have a count and a pointer.
if the count is zero, the pointer is also zero. no further data is put
into or taken out of the SMB data stream. if the count is non-zero, then
the pointer is also non-zero. immediately following the pointer is the
count again, followed by an array of container sub-structures. the count
-appears a third time after the last sub-structure.</P
-></LI
-></OL
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><HR><H3
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN717"
-></A
->9.2.2. Enumerations</H3
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><H4
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><A
-NAME="AEN719"
-></A
->9.2.2.1. MSRPC Header type</H4
-><P
->command number in the msrpc packet header</P
-><P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
->MSRPC_Request:</DT
-><DD
-><P
->0x00</P
-></DD
-><DT
->MSRPC_Response:</DT
-><DD
-><P
->0x02</P
-></DD
-><DT
->MSRPC_Bind:</DT
-><DD
-><P
->0x0B</P
-></DD
-><DT
->MSRPC_BindAck:</DT
-><DD
-><P
->0x0C</P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><HR><H4
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><A
-NAME="AEN739"
-></A
->9.2.2.2. MSRPC Packet info</H4
-><P
->The meaning of these flags is undocumented</P
-><P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
->FirstFrag:</DT
-><DD
-><P
->0x01 </P
-></DD
-><DT
->LastFrag:</DT
-><DD
-><P
->0x02 </P
-></DD
-><DT
->NotaFrag:</DT
-><DD
-><P
->0x04 </P
-></DD
-><DT
->RecRespond:</DT
-><DD
-><P
->0x08 </P
-></DD
-><DT
->NoMultiplex:</DT
-><DD
-><P
->0x10 </P
-></DD
-><DT
->NotForIdemp:</DT
-><DD
-><P
->0x20 </P
-></DD
-><DT
->NotforBcast:</DT
-><DD
-><P
->0x40 </P
-></DD
-><DT
->NoUuid:</DT
-><DD
-><P
->0x80 </P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><HR><H3
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN775"
-></A
->9.2.3. Structures</H3
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><H4
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><A
-NAME="AEN777"
-></A
->9.2.3.1. VOID *</H4
-><P
->sizeof VOID* is 32 bits.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><HR><H4
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><A
-NAME="AEN780"
-></A
->9.2.3.2. char</H4
-><P
->sizeof char is 8 bits.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><HR><H4
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><A
-NAME="AEN783"
-></A
->9.2.3.3. UTIME</H4
-><P
->UTIME is 32 bits, indicating time in seconds since 01jan1970. documented in cifs6.txt (section 3.5 page, page 30).</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><HR><H4
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><A
-NAME="AEN786"
-></A
->9.2.3.4. NTTIME</H4
-><P
->NTTIME is 64 bits. documented in cifs6.txt (section 3.5 page, page 30).</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><HR><H4
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><A
-NAME="AEN789"
-></A
->9.2.3.5. DOM_SID (domain SID structure)</H4
-><P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
->UINT32</DT
-><DD
-><P
->num of sub-authorities in domain SID</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT8</DT
-><DD
-><P
->SID revision number</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT8</DT
-><DD
-><P
->num of sub-authorities in domain SID</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT8[6]</DT
-><DD
-><P
->6 bytes for domain SID - Identifier Authority.</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT16[n_subauths]</DT
-><DD
-><P
->domain SID sub-authorities</P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-><P
-><SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->Note: the domain SID is documented elsewhere.</I
-></SPAN
-></P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><HR><H4
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><A
-NAME="AEN814"
-></A
->9.2.3.6. STR (string)</H4
-><P
->STR (string) is a char[] : a null-terminated string of ascii characters.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><HR><H4
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><A
-NAME="AEN817"
-></A
->9.2.3.7. UNIHDR (unicode string header)</H4
-><P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
->UINT16</DT
-><DD
-><P
->length of unicode string</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT16</DT
-><DD
-><P
->max length of unicode string</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT32</DT
-><DD
-><P
->4 - undocumented.</P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><HR><H4
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><A
-NAME="AEN832"
-></A
->9.2.3.8. UNIHDR2 (unicode string header plus buffer pointer)</H4
-><P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
->UNIHDR</DT
-><DD
-><P
->unicode string header</P
-></DD
-><DT
->VOID*</DT
-><DD
-><P
->undocumented buffer pointer</P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><HR><H4
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><A
-NAME="AEN843"
-></A
->9.2.3.9. UNISTR (unicode string)</H4
-><P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
->UINT16[]</DT
-><DD
-><P
->null-terminated string of unicode characters.</P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><HR><H4
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><A
-NAME="AEN850"
-></A
->9.2.3.10. NAME (length-indicated unicode string)</H4
-><P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
->UINT32</DT
-><DD
-><P
->length of unicode string</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT16[]</DT
-><DD
-><P
->null-terminated string of unicode characters.</P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><HR><H4
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><A
-NAME="AEN861"
-></A
->9.2.3.11. UNISTR2 (aligned unicode string)</H4
-><P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
->UINT8[]</DT
-><DD
-><P
->padding to get unicode string 4-byte aligned with the start of the SMB header.</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT32</DT
-><DD
-><P
->max length of unicode string</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT32</DT
-><DD
-><P
->0 - undocumented</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT32</DT
-><DD
-><P
->length of unicode string</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT16[]</DT
-><DD
-><P
->string of uncode characters</P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><HR><H4
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><A
-NAME="AEN884"
-></A
->9.2.3.12. OBJ_ATTR (object attributes)</H4
-><P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
->UINT32</DT
-><DD
-><P
->0x18 - length (in bytes) including the length field.</P
-></DD
-><DT
->VOID*</DT
-><DD
-><P
->0 - root directory (pointer)</P
-></DD
-><DT
->VOID*</DT
-><DD
-><P
->0 - object name (pointer)</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT32</DT
-><DD
-><P
->0 - attributes (undocumented)</P
-></DD
-><DT
->VOID*</DT
-><DD
-><P
->0 - security descriptior (pointer)</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT32</DT
-><DD
-><P
->0 - security quality of service</P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><HR><H4
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><A
-NAME="AEN911"
-></A
->9.2.3.13. POL_HND (LSA policy handle)</H4
-><P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
->char[20]</DT
-><DD
-><P
->policy handle</P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><HR><H4
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><A
-NAME="AEN918"
-></A
->9.2.3.14. DOM_SID2 (domain SID structure, SIDS stored in unicode)</H4
-><P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
->UINT32</DT
-><DD
-><P
->5 - SID type</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT32</DT
-><DD
-><P
->0 - undocumented</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UNIHDR2</DT
-><DD
-><P
->domain SID unicode string header</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UNISTR</DT
-><DD
-><P
->domain SID unicode string</P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-><P
-><SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->Note: there is a conflict between the unicode string header and the unicode string itself as to which to use to indicate string length. this will need to be resolved.</I
-></SPAN
-></P
-><P
-><SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->Note: the SID type indicates, for example, an alias; a well-known group etc. this is documented somewhere.</I
-></SPAN
-></P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><HR><H4
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><A
-NAME="AEN941"
-></A
->9.2.3.15. DOM_RID (domain RID structure)</H4
-><P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
->UINT32</DT
-><DD
-><P
->5 - well-known SID. 1 - user SID (see ShowACLs)</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT32</DT
-><DD
-><P
->5 - undocumented</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT32</DT
-><DD
-><P
->domain RID </P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT32</DT
-><DD
-><P
->0 - domain index out of above reference domains</P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><HR><H4
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><A
-NAME="AEN960"
-></A
->9.2.3.16. LOG_INFO (server, account, client structure)</H4
-><P
-><SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->Note: logon server name starts with two '\' characters and is upper case.</I
-></SPAN
-></P
-><P
-><SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->Note: account name is the logon client name from the LSA Request Challenge, with a $ on the end of it, in upper case.</I
-></SPAN
-></P
-><P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
->VOID*</DT
-><DD
-><P
->undocumented buffer pointer</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UNISTR2</DT
-><DD
-><P
->logon server unicode string</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UNISTR2</DT
-><DD
-><P
->account name unicode string</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT16</DT
-><DD
-><P
->sec_chan - security channel type</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UNISTR2</DT
-><DD
-><P
->logon client machine unicode string</P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><HR><H4
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><A
-NAME="AEN987"
-></A
->9.2.3.17. CLNT_SRV (server, client names structure)</H4
-><P
-><SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->Note: logon server name starts with two '\' characters and is upper case.</I
-></SPAN
-></P
-><P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
->VOID*</DT
-><DD
-><P
->undocumented buffer pointer</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UNISTR2</DT
-><DD
-><P
->logon server unicode string</P
-></DD
-><DT
->VOID*</DT
-><DD
-><P
->undocumented buffer pointer</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UNISTR2</DT
-><DD
-><P
->logon client machine unicode string</P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><HR><H4
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><A
-NAME="AEN1008"
-></A
->9.2.3.18. CREDS (credentials + time stamp)</H4
-><P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
->char[8]</DT
-><DD
-><P
->credentials</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UTIME</DT
-><DD
-><P
->time stamp</P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><HR><H4
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><A
-NAME="AEN1019"
-></A
->9.2.3.19. CLNT_INFO2 (server, client structure, client credentials)</H4
-><P
-><SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->Note: whenever this structure appears in a request, you must take a copy of the client-calculated credentials received, because they will beused in subsequent credential checks. the presumed intention is to
- maintain an authenticated request/response trail.</I
-></SPAN
-></P
-><P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
->CLNT_SRV</DT
-><DD
-><P
->client and server names</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT8[]</DT
-><DD
-><P
->???? padding, for 4-byte alignment with SMB header.</P
-></DD
-><DT
->VOID*</DT
-><DD
-><P
->pointer to client credentials.</P
-></DD
-><DT
->CREDS</DT
-><DD
-><P
->client-calculated credentials + client time</P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><HR><H4
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><A
-NAME="AEN1040"
-></A
->9.2.3.20. CLNT_INFO (server, account, client structure, client credentials)</H4
-><P
-><SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->Note: whenever this structure appears in a request, you must take a copy of the client-calculated credentials received, because they will be used in subsequent credential checks. the presumed intention is to maintain an authenticated request/response trail.</I
-></SPAN
-></P
-><P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
->LOG_INFO</DT
-><DD
-><P
->logon account info</P
-></DD
-><DT
->CREDS</DT
-><DD
-><P
->client-calculated credentials + client time</P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><HR><H4
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><A
-NAME="AEN1053"
-></A
->9.2.3.21. ID_INFO_1 (id info structure, auth level 1)</H4
-><P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
->VOID*</DT
-><DD
-><P
->ptr_id_info_1</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UNIHDR</DT
-><DD
-><P
->domain name unicode header</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT32</DT
-><DD
-><P
->param control</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT64</DT
-><DD
-><P
->logon ID</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UNIHDR</DT
-><DD
-><P
->user name unicode header</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UNIHDR</DT
-><DD
-><P
->workgroup name unicode header</P
-></DD
-><DT
->char[16]</DT
-><DD
-><P
->arc4 LM OWF Password</P
-></DD
-><DT
->char[16]</DT
-><DD
-><P
->arc4 NT OWF Password</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UNISTR2</DT
-><DD
-><P
->domain name unicode string</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UNISTR2</DT
-><DD
-><P
->user name unicode string</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UNISTR2</DT
-><DD
-><P
->workstation name unicode string</P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><HR><H4
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><A
-NAME="AEN1100"
-></A
->9.2.3.22. SAM_INFO (sam logon/logoff id info structure)</H4
-><P
-><SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->Note: presumably, the return credentials is supposedly for the server to verify that the credential chain hasn't been compromised.</I
-></SPAN
-></P
-><P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
->CLNT_INFO2</DT
-><DD
-><P
->client identification/authentication info</P
-></DD
-><DT
->VOID*</DT
-><DD
-><P
->pointer to return credentials.</P
-></DD
-><DT
->CRED</DT
-><DD
-><P
->return credentials - ignored.</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT16</DT
-><DD
-><P
->logon level</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT16</DT
-><DD
-><P
->switch value</P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-><P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
-> switch (switch_value)
+appears a third time after the last sub-structure.
+</p></li></ol></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2873087"></a>Enumerations</h3></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2873094"></a>MSRPC Header type</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p>command number in the msrpc packet header</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">MSRPC_Request:</span></dt><dd><p>0x00</p></dd><dt><span class="term">MSRPC_Response:</span></dt><dd><p>0x02</p></dd><dt><span class="term">MSRPC_Bind:</span></dt><dd><p>0x0B</p></dd><dt><span class="term">MSRPC_BindAck:</span></dt><dd><p>0x0C</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2873169"></a>MSRPC Packet info</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p>The meaning of these flags is undocumented</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">FirstFrag:</span></dt><dd><p>0x01 </p></dd><dt><span class="term">LastFrag:</span></dt><dd><p>0x02 </p></dd><dt><span class="term">NotaFrag:</span></dt><dd><p>0x04 </p></dd><dt><span class="term">RecRespond:</span></dt><dd><p>0x08 </p></dd><dt><span class="term">NoMultiplex:</span></dt><dd><p>0x10 </p></dd><dt><span class="term">NotForIdemp:</span></dt><dd><p>0x20 </p></dd><dt><span class="term">NotforBcast:</span></dt><dd><p>0x40 </p></dd><dt><span class="term">NoUuid:</span></dt><dd><p>0x80 </p></dd></dl></div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2873300"></a>Structures</h3></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2873307"></a>VOID *</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p>sizeof VOID* is 32 bits.</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2873319"></a>char</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p>sizeof char is 8 bits.</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2873330"></a>UTIME</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p>UTIME is 32 bits, indicating time in seconds since 01jan1970. documented in cifs6.txt (section 3.5 page, page 30).</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2873343"></a>NTTIME</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p>NTTIME is 64 bits. documented in cifs6.txt (section 3.5 page, page 30).</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2873355"></a>DOM_SID (domain SID structure)</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>num of sub-authorities in domain SID</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT8</span></dt><dd><p>SID revision number</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT8</span></dt><dd><p>num of sub-authorities in domain SID</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT8[6]</span></dt><dd><p>6 bytes for domain SID - Identifier Authority.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT16[n_subauths]</span></dt><dd><p>domain SID sub-authorities</p></dd></dl></div><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note: the domain SID is documented elsewhere.</em></span>
+</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2873449"></a>STR (string)</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p>STR (string) is a char[] : a null-terminated string of ascii characters.</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2873462"></a>UNIHDR (unicode string header) </h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">UINT16</span></dt><dd><p>length of unicode string</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT16</span></dt><dd><p>max length of unicode string</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>4 - undocumented.</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2873519"></a>UNIHDR2 (unicode string header plus buffer pointer)</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">UNIHDR</span></dt><dd><p>unicode string header</p></dd><dt><span class="term">VOID*</span></dt><dd><p>undocumented buffer pointer</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2873561"></a>UNISTR (unicode string)</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">UINT16[]</span></dt><dd><p>null-terminated string of unicode characters.</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2873589"></a>NAME (length-indicated unicode string)</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>length of unicode string</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT16[]</span></dt><dd><p>null-terminated string of unicode characters.</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2873631"></a>UNISTR2 (aligned unicode string)</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">UINT8[]</span></dt><dd><p>padding to get unicode string 4-byte aligned with the start of the SMB header.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>max length of unicode string</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>0 - undocumented</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>length of unicode string</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT16[]</span></dt><dd><p>string of uncode characters</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2873717"></a>OBJ_ATTR (object attributes)</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>0x18 - length (in bytes) including the length field.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">VOID*</span></dt><dd><p>0 - root directory (pointer)</p></dd><dt><span class="term">VOID*</span></dt><dd><p>0 - object name (pointer)</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>0 - attributes (undocumented)</p></dd><dt><span class="term">VOID*</span></dt><dd><p>0 - security descriptior (pointer)</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>0 - security quality of service</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2873810"></a>POL_HND (LSA policy handle)</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">char[20]</span></dt><dd><p>policy handle</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2873837"></a>DOM_SID2 (domain SID structure, SIDS stored in unicode)</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>5 - SID type</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>0 - undocumented</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNIHDR2</span></dt><dd><p>domain SID unicode string header</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNISTR</span></dt><dd><p>domain SID unicode string</p></dd></dl></div><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note: there is a conflict between the unicode string header and the unicode string itself as to which to use to indicate string length. this will need to be resolved.</em></span></p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note: the SID type indicates, for example, an alias; a well-known group etc. this is documented somewhere.</em></span></p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2873924"></a>DOM_RID (domain RID structure)</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>5 - well-known SID. 1 - user SID (see ShowACLs)</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>5 - undocumented</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>domain RID </p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>0 - domain index out of above reference domains</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2873993"></a>LOG_INFO (server, account, client structure)</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note: logon server name starts with two '\' characters and is upper case.</em></span></p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note: account name is the logon client name from the LSA Request Challenge, with a $ on the end of it, in upper case.</em></span></p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">VOID*</span></dt><dd><p>undocumented buffer pointer</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNISTR2</span></dt><dd><p>logon server unicode string</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNISTR2</span></dt><dd><p>account name unicode string</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT16</span></dt><dd><p>sec_chan - security channel type</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNISTR2</span></dt><dd><p>logon client machine unicode string</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2874093"></a>CLNT_SRV (server, client names structure)</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note: logon server name starts with two '\' characters and is upper case.</em></span></p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">VOID*</span></dt><dd><p>undocumented buffer pointer</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNISTR2</span></dt><dd><p>logon server unicode string</p></dd><dt><span class="term">VOID*</span></dt><dd><p>undocumented buffer pointer</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNISTR2</span></dt><dd><p>logon client machine unicode string</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2874170"></a>CREDS (credentials + time stamp)</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">char[8]</span></dt><dd><p>credentials</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UTIME</span></dt><dd><p>time stamp</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2874210"></a>CLNT_INFO2 (server, client structure, client credentials)</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note: whenever this structure appears in a request, you must take a copy of the client-calculated credentials received, because they will beused in subsequent credential checks. the presumed intention is to
+ maintain an authenticated request/response trail.</em></span></p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">CLNT_SRV</span></dt><dd><p>client and server names</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT8[]</span></dt><dd><p>???? padding, for 4-byte alignment with SMB header.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">VOID*</span></dt><dd><p>pointer to client credentials.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">CREDS</span></dt><dd><p>client-calculated credentials + client time</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2874294"></a>CLNT_INFO (server, account, client structure, client credentials)</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note: whenever this structure appears in a request, you must take a copy of the client-calculated credentials received, because they will be used in subsequent credential checks. the presumed intention is to maintain an authenticated request/response trail.</em></span></p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">LOG_INFO</span></dt><dd><p>logon account info</p></dd><dt><span class="term">CREDS</span></dt><dd><p>client-calculated credentials + client time</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2874346"></a>ID_INFO_1 (id info structure, auth level 1)</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">VOID*</span></dt><dd><p>ptr_id_info_1</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNIHDR</span></dt><dd><p>domain name unicode header</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>param control</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT64</span></dt><dd><p>logon ID</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNIHDR</span></dt><dd><p>user name unicode header</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNIHDR</span></dt><dd><p>workgroup name unicode header</p></dd><dt><span class="term">char[16]</span></dt><dd><p>arc4 LM OWF Password</p></dd><dt><span class="term">char[16]</span></dt><dd><p>arc4 NT OWF Password</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNISTR2</span></dt><dd><p>domain name unicode string</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNISTR2</span></dt><dd><p>user name unicode string</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNISTR2</span></dt><dd><p>workstation name unicode string</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2874516"></a>SAM_INFO (sam logon/logoff id info structure)</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note: presumably, the return credentials is supposedly for the server to verify that the credential chain hasn't been compromised.</em></span></p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">CLNT_INFO2</span></dt><dd><p>client identification/authentication info</p></dd><dt><span class="term">VOID*</span></dt><dd><p>pointer to return credentials.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">CRED</span></dt><dd><p>return credentials - ignored.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT16</span></dt><dd><p>logon level</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT16</span></dt><dd><p>switch value</p></dd></dl></div><pre class="programlisting">
+ switch (switch_value)
case 1:
{
ID_INFO_1 id_info_1;
- }</PRE
-></P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><HR><H4
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><A
-NAME="AEN1127"
-></A
->9.2.3.23. GID (group id info)</H4
-><P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
->UINT32</DT
-><DD
-><P
->group id</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT32</DT
-><DD
-><P
->user attributes (only used by NT 3.1 and 3.51)</P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><HR><H4
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><A
-NAME="AEN1138"
-></A
->9.2.3.24. DOM_REF (domain reference info)</H4
-><P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
->VOID*</DT
-><DD
-><P
->undocumented buffer pointer.</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT32</DT
-><DD
-><P
->num referenced domains?</P
-></DD
-><DT
->VOID*</DT
-><DD
-><P
->undocumented domain name buffer pointer.</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT32</DT
-><DD
-><P
->32 - max number of entries</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT32</DT
-><DD
-><P
->4 - num referenced domains?</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UNIHDR2</DT
-><DD
-><P
->domain name unicode string header</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UNIHDR2[num_ref_doms-1]</DT
-><DD
-><P
->referenced domain unicode string headers</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UNISTR</DT
-><DD
-><P
->domain name unicode string</P
-></DD
-><DT
->DOM_SID[num_ref_doms]</DT
-><DD
-><P
->referenced domain SIDs</P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><HR><H4
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><A
-NAME="AEN1177"
-></A
->9.2.3.25. DOM_INFO (domain info, levels 3 and 5 are the same))</H4
-><P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
->UINT8[]</DT
-><DD
-><P
->??? padding to get 4-byte alignment with start of SMB header</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT16</DT
-><DD
-><P
->domain name string length * 2</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT16</DT
-><DD
-><P
->domain name string length * 2</P
-></DD
-><DT
->VOID*</DT
-><DD
-><P
->undocumented domain name string buffer pointer</P
-></DD
-><DT
->VOID*</DT
-><DD
-><P
->undocumented domain SID string buffer pointer</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UNISTR2</DT
-><DD
-><P
->domain name (unicode string)</P
-></DD
-><DT
->DOM_SID</DT
-><DD
-><P
->domain SID</P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><HR><H4
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><A
-NAME="AEN1208"
-></A
->9.2.3.26. USER_INFO (user logon info)</H4
-><P
-><SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->Note: it would be nice to know what the 16 byte user session key is for.</I
-></SPAN
-></P
-><P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
->NTTIME</DT
-><DD
-><P
->logon time</P
-></DD
-><DT
->NTTIME</DT
-><DD
-><P
->logoff time</P
-></DD
-><DT
->NTTIME</DT
-><DD
-><P
->kickoff time</P
-></DD
-><DT
->NTTIME</DT
-><DD
-><P
->password last set time</P
-></DD
-><DT
->NTTIME</DT
-><DD
-><P
->password can change time</P
-></DD
-><DT
->NTTIME</DT
-><DD
-><P
->password must change time</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UNIHDR</DT
-><DD
-><P
->username unicode string header</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UNIHDR</DT
-><DD
-><P
->user's full name unicode string header</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UNIHDR</DT
-><DD
-><P
->logon script unicode string header</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UNIHDR</DT
-><DD
-><P
->profile path unicode string header</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UNIHDR</DT
-><DD
-><P
->home directory unicode string header</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UNIHDR</DT
-><DD
-><P
->home directory drive unicode string header</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT16</DT
-><DD
-><P
->logon count</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT16</DT
-><DD
-><P
->bad password count</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT32</DT
-><DD
-><P
->User ID</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT32</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Group ID</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT32</DT
-><DD
-><P
->num groups</P
-></DD
-><DT
->VOID*</DT
-><DD
-><P
->undocumented buffer pointer to groups.</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT32</DT
-><DD
-><P
->user flags</P
-></DD
-><DT
->char[16]</DT
-><DD
-><P
->user session key</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UNIHDR</DT
-><DD
-><P
->logon server unicode string header</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UNIHDR</DT
-><DD
-><P
->logon domain unicode string header</P
-></DD
-><DT
->VOID*</DT
-><DD
-><P
->undocumented logon domain id pointer</P
-></DD
-><DT
->char[40]</DT
-><DD
-><P
->40 undocumented padding bytes. future expansion?</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT32</DT
-><DD
-><P
->0 - num_other_sids?</P
-></DD
-><DT
->VOID*</DT
-><DD
-><P
->NULL - undocumented pointer to other domain SIDs.</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UNISTR2</DT
-><DD
-><P
->username unicode string</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UNISTR2</DT
-><DD
-><P
->user's full name unicode string</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UNISTR2</DT
-><DD
-><P
->logon script unicode string</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UNISTR2</DT
-><DD
-><P
->profile path unicode string</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UNISTR2</DT
-><DD
-><P
->home directory unicode string</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UNISTR2</DT
-><DD
-><P
->home directory drive unicode string</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT32</DT
-><DD
-><P
->num groups</P
-></DD
-><DT
->GID[num_groups]</DT
-><DD
-><P
->group info</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UNISTR2</DT
-><DD
-><P
->logon server unicode string</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UNISTR2</DT
-><DD
-><P
->logon domain unicode string</P
-></DD
-><DT
->DOM_SID</DT
-><DD
-><P
->domain SID</P
-></DD
-><DT
->DOM_SID[num_sids]</DT
-><DD
-><P
->other domain SIDs?</P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><HR><H4
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><A
-NAME="AEN1365"
-></A
->9.2.3.27. SH_INFO_1_PTR (pointers to level 1 share info strings)</H4
-><P
-><SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->Note: see cifsrap2.txt section5, page 10.</I
-></SPAN
-></P
-><P
-></P
-><TABLE
-BORDER="0"
-><TBODY
-><TR
-><TD
->0 for shi1_type indicates a Disk.</TD
-></TR
-><TR
-><TD
->1 for shi1_type indicates a Print Queue.</TD
-></TR
-><TR
-><TD
->2 for shi1_type indicates a Device.</TD
-></TR
-><TR
-><TD
->3 for shi1_type indicates an IPC pipe.</TD
-></TR
-><TR
-><TD
->0x8000 0000 (top bit set in shi1_type) indicates a hidden share.</TD
-></TR
-></TBODY
-></TABLE
-><P
-></P
-><P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
->VOID*</DT
-><DD
-><P
->shi1_netname - pointer to net name</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT32</DT
-><DD
-><P
->shi1_type - type of share. 0 - undocumented.</P
-></DD
-><DT
->VOID*</DT
-><DD
-><P
->shi1_remark - pointer to comment.</P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><HR><H4
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><A
-NAME="AEN1388"
-></A
->9.2.3.28. SH_INFO_1_STR (level 1 share info strings)</H4
-><P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
->UNISTR2</DT
-><DD
-><P
->shi1_netname - unicode string of net name</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UNISTR2</DT
-><DD
-><P
->shi1_remark - unicode string of comment.</P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><HR><H4
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><A
-NAME="AEN1399"
-></A
->9.2.3.29. SHARE_INFO_1_CTR</H4
-><P
->share container with 0 entries:</P
-><P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
->UINT32</DT
-><DD
-><P
->0 - EntriesRead</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT32</DT
-><DD
-><P
->0 - Buffer</P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-><P
->share container with &#62; 0 entries:</P
-><P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
->UINT32</DT
-><DD
-><P
->EntriesRead</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT32</DT
-><DD
-><P
->non-zero - Buffer</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT32</DT
-><DD
-><P
->EntriesRead</P
-></DD
-><DT
->SH_INFO_1_PTR[EntriesRead]</DT
-><DD
-><P
->share entry pointers</P
-></DD
-><DT
->SH_INFO_1_STR[EntriesRead]</DT
-><DD
-><P
->share entry strings</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT8[]</DT
-><DD
-><P
->padding to get unicode string 4-byte aligned with start of the SMB header.</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT32</DT
-><DD
-><P
->EntriesRead</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT32</DT
-><DD
-><P
->0 - padding</P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><HR><H4
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><A
-NAME="AEN1445"
-></A
->9.2.3.30. SERVER_INFO_101</H4
-><P
-><SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->Note: see cifs6.txt section 6.4 - the fields described therein will be of assistance here. for example, the type listed below is the same as fServerType, which is described in 6.4.1. </I
-></SPAN
-></P
-><P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
->SV_TYPE_WORKSTATION</DT
-><DD
-><P
->0x00000001 All workstations</P
-></DD
-><DT
->SV_TYPE_SERVER</DT
-><DD
-><P
->0x00000002 All servers</P
-></DD
-><DT
->SV_TYPE_SQLSERVER</DT
-><DD
-><P
->0x00000004 Any server running with SQL server</P
-></DD
-><DT
->SV_TYPE_DOMAIN_CTRL</DT
-><DD
-><P
->0x00000008 Primary domain controller</P
-></DD
-><DT
->SV_TYPE_DOMAIN_BAKCTRL</DT
-><DD
-><P
->0x00000010 Backup domain controller</P
-></DD
-><DT
->SV_TYPE_TIME_SOURCE</DT
-><DD
-><P
->0x00000020 Server running the timesource service</P
-></DD
-><DT
->SV_TYPE_AFP</DT
-><DD
-><P
->0x00000040 Apple File Protocol servers</P
-></DD
-><DT
->SV_TYPE_NOVELL</DT
-><DD
-><P
->0x00000080 Novell servers</P
-></DD
-><DT
->SV_TYPE_DOMAIN_MEMBER</DT
-><DD
-><P
->0x00000100 Domain Member</P
-></DD
-><DT
->SV_TYPE_PRINTQ_SERVER</DT
-><DD
-><P
->0x00000200 Server sharing print queue</P
-></DD
-><DT
->SV_TYPE_DIALIN_SERVER</DT
-><DD
-><P
->0x00000400 Server running dialin service.</P
-></DD
-><DT
->SV_TYPE_XENIX_SERVER</DT
-><DD
-><P
->0x00000800 Xenix server</P
-></DD
-><DT
->SV_TYPE_NT</DT
-><DD
-><P
->0x00001000 NT server</P
-></DD
-><DT
->SV_TYPE_WFW</DT
-><DD
-><P
->0x00002000 Server running Windows for </P
-></DD
-><DT
->SV_TYPE_SERVER_NT</DT
-><DD
-><P
->0x00008000 Windows NT non DC server</P
-></DD
-><DT
->SV_TYPE_POTENTIAL_BROWSER</DT
-><DD
-><P
->0x00010000 Server that can run the browser service</P
-></DD
-><DT
->SV_TYPE_BACKUP_BROWSER</DT
-><DD
-><P
->0x00020000 Backup browser server</P
-></DD
-><DT
->SV_TYPE_MASTER_BROWSER</DT
-><DD
-><P
->0x00040000 Master browser server</P
-></DD
-><DT
->SV_TYPE_DOMAIN_MASTER</DT
-><DD
-><P
->0x00080000 Domain Master Browser server</P
-></DD
-><DT
->SV_TYPE_LOCAL_LIST_ONLY</DT
-><DD
-><P
->0x40000000 Enumerate only entries marked "local"</P
-></DD
-><DT
->SV_TYPE_DOMAIN_ENUM</DT
-><DD
-><P
->0x80000000 Enumerate Domains. The pszServer and pszDomain parameters must be NULL.</P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-><P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
->UINT32</DT
-><DD
-><P
->500 - platform_id</P
-></DD
-><DT
->VOID*</DT
-><DD
-><P
->pointer to name</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT32</DT
-><DD
-><P
->5 - major version</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT32</DT
-><DD
-><P
->4 - minor version</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT32</DT
-><DD
-><P
->type (SV_TYPE_... bit field)</P
-></DD
-><DT
->VOID*</DT
-><DD
-><P
->pointer to comment</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UNISTR2</DT
-><DD
-><P
->sv101_name - unicode string of server name</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UNISTR2</DT
-><DD
-><P
->sv_101_comment - unicode string of server comment.</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT8[]</DT
-><DD
-><P
->padding to get unicode string 4-byte aligned with start of the SMB header.</P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-></DIV
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><HR><H2
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN1571"
-></A
->9.3. MSRPC over Transact Named Pipe</H2
-><P
->For details on the SMB Transact Named Pipe, see cifs6.txt</P
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><HR><H3
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN1574"
-></A
->9.3.1. MSRPC Pipes</H3
-><P
->The MSRPC is conducted over an SMB Transact Pipe with a name of
-<TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->\PIPE\</TT
->. You must first obtain a 16 bit file handle, by
-sending a SMBopenX with the pipe name <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->\PIPE\srvsvc</TT
-> for
+ }
+</pre></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2874620"></a>GID (group id info)</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>group id</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>user attributes (only used by NT 3.1 and 3.51)</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2874658"></a>DOM_REF (domain reference info)</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">VOID*</span></dt><dd><p>undocumented buffer pointer.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>num referenced domains?</p></dd><dt><span class="term">VOID*</span></dt><dd><p>undocumented domain name buffer pointer.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>32 - max number of entries</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>4 - num referenced domains?</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNIHDR2</span></dt><dd><p>domain name unicode string header</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNIHDR2[num_ref_doms-1]</span></dt><dd><p>referenced domain unicode string headers</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNISTR</span></dt><dd><p>domain name unicode string</p></dd><dt><span class="term">DOM_SID[num_ref_doms]</span></dt><dd><p>referenced domain SIDs</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2874802"></a>DOM_INFO (domain info, levels 3 and 5 are the same))</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">UINT8[]</span></dt><dd><p>??? padding to get 4-byte alignment with start of SMB header</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT16</span></dt><dd><p>domain name string length * 2</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT16</span></dt><dd><p>domain name string length * 2</p></dd><dt><span class="term">VOID*</span></dt><dd><p>undocumented domain name string buffer pointer</p></dd><dt><span class="term">VOID*</span></dt><dd><p>undocumented domain SID string buffer pointer</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNISTR2</span></dt><dd><p>domain name (unicode string)</p></dd><dt><span class="term">DOM_SID</span></dt><dd><p>domain SID</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2874915"></a>USER_INFO (user logon info)</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note: it would be nice to know what the 16 byte user session key is for.</em></span></p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">NTTIME</span></dt><dd><p>logon time</p></dd><dt><span class="term">NTTIME</span></dt><dd><p>logoff time</p></dd><dt><span class="term">NTTIME</span></dt><dd><p>kickoff time</p></dd><dt><span class="term">NTTIME</span></dt><dd><p>password last set time</p></dd><dt><span class="term">NTTIME</span></dt><dd><p>password can change time</p></dd><dt><span class="term">NTTIME</span></dt><dd><p>password must change time</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNIHDR</span></dt><dd><p>username unicode string header</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNIHDR</span></dt><dd><p>user's full name unicode string header</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNIHDR</span></dt><dd><p>logon script unicode string header</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNIHDR</span></dt><dd><p>profile path unicode string header</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNIHDR</span></dt><dd><p>home directory unicode string header</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNIHDR</span></dt><dd><p>home directory drive unicode string header</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT16</span></dt><dd><p>logon count</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT16</span></dt><dd><p>bad password count</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>User ID</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>Group ID</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>num groups</p></dd><dt><span class="term">VOID*</span></dt><dd><p>undocumented buffer pointer to groups.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>user flags</p></dd><dt><span class="term">char[16]</span></dt><dd><p>user session key</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNIHDR</span></dt><dd><p>logon server unicode string header</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNIHDR</span></dt><dd><p>logon domain unicode string header</p></dd><dt><span class="term">VOID*</span></dt><dd><p>undocumented logon domain id pointer</p></dd><dt><span class="term">char[40]</span></dt><dd><p>40 undocumented padding bytes. future expansion?</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>0 - num_other_sids?</p></dd><dt><span class="term">VOID*</span></dt><dd><p>NULL - undocumented pointer to other domain SIDs.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNISTR2</span></dt><dd><p>username unicode string</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNISTR2</span></dt><dd><p>user's full name unicode string</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNISTR2</span></dt><dd><p>logon script unicode string</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNISTR2</span></dt><dd><p>profile path unicode string</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNISTR2</span></dt><dd><p>home directory unicode string</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNISTR2</span></dt><dd><p>home directory drive unicode string</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>num groups</p></dd><dt><span class="term">GID[num_groups]</span></dt><dd><p>group info</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNISTR2</span></dt><dd><p>logon server unicode string</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNISTR2</span></dt><dd><p>logon domain unicode string</p></dd><dt><span class="term">DOM_SID</span></dt><dd><p>domain SID</p></dd><dt><span class="term">DOM_SID[num_sids]</span></dt><dd><p>other domain SIDs?</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2875478"></a>SH_INFO_1_PTR (pointers to level 1 share info strings)</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note: see cifsrap2.txt section5, page 10.</em></span></p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td>0 for shi1_type indicates a Disk.</td></tr><tr><td>1 for shi1_type indicates a Print Queue.</td></tr><tr><td>2 for shi1_type indicates a Device.</td></tr><tr><td>3 for shi1_type indicates an IPC pipe.</td></tr><tr><td>0x8000 0000 (top bit set in shi1_type) indicates a hidden share.</td></tr></table><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">VOID*</span></dt><dd><p>shi1_netname - pointer to net name</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>shi1_type - type of share. 0 - undocumented.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">VOID*</span></dt><dd><p>shi1_remark - pointer to comment.</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2875573"></a>SH_INFO_1_STR (level 1 share info strings)</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">UNISTR2</span></dt><dd><p>shi1_netname - unicode string of net name</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNISTR2</span></dt><dd><p>shi1_remark - unicode string of comment.</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2875615"></a>SHARE_INFO_1_CTR</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p>share container with 0 entries:</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>0 - EntriesRead</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>0 - Buffer</p></dd></dl></div><p>share container with &gt; 0 entries:</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>EntriesRead</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>non-zero - Buffer</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>EntriesRead</p></dd><dt><span class="term">SH_INFO_1_PTR[EntriesRead]</span></dt><dd><p>share entry pointers</p></dd><dt><span class="term">SH_INFO_1_STR[EntriesRead]</span></dt><dd><p>share entry strings</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT8[]</span></dt><dd><p>padding to get unicode string 4-byte aligned with start of the SMB header.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>EntriesRead</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>0 - padding</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2875784"></a>SERVER_INFO_101</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note: see cifs6.txt section 6.4 - the fields described therein will be of assistance here. for example, the type listed below is the same as fServerType, which is described in 6.4.1. </em></span></p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">SV_TYPE_WORKSTATION</span></dt><dd><p>0x00000001 All workstations</p></dd><dt><span class="term">SV_TYPE_SERVER</span></dt><dd><p>0x00000002 All servers</p></dd><dt><span class="term">SV_TYPE_SQLSERVER</span></dt><dd><p>0x00000004 Any server running with SQL server</p></dd><dt><span class="term">SV_TYPE_DOMAIN_CTRL</span></dt><dd><p>0x00000008 Primary domain controller</p></dd><dt><span class="term">SV_TYPE_DOMAIN_BAKCTRL</span></dt><dd><p>0x00000010 Backup domain controller</p></dd><dt><span class="term">SV_TYPE_TIME_SOURCE</span></dt><dd><p>0x00000020 Server running the timesource service</p></dd><dt><span class="term">SV_TYPE_AFP</span></dt><dd><p>0x00000040 Apple File Protocol servers</p></dd><dt><span class="term">SV_TYPE_NOVELL</span></dt><dd><p>0x00000080 Novell servers</p></dd><dt><span class="term">SV_TYPE_DOMAIN_MEMBER</span></dt><dd><p>0x00000100 Domain Member</p></dd><dt><span class="term">SV_TYPE_PRINTQ_SERVER</span></dt><dd><p>0x00000200 Server sharing print queue</p></dd><dt><span class="term">SV_TYPE_DIALIN_SERVER</span></dt><dd><p>0x00000400 Server running dialin service.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">SV_TYPE_XENIX_SERVER</span></dt><dd><p>0x00000800 Xenix server</p></dd><dt><span class="term">SV_TYPE_NT</span></dt><dd><p>0x00001000 NT server</p></dd><dt><span class="term">SV_TYPE_WFW</span></dt><dd><p>0x00002000 Server running Windows for </p></dd><dt><span class="term">SV_TYPE_SERVER_NT</span></dt><dd><p>0x00008000 Windows NT non DC server</p></dd><dt><span class="term">SV_TYPE_POTENTIAL_BROWSER</span></dt><dd><p>0x00010000 Server that can run the browser service</p></dd><dt><span class="term">SV_TYPE_BACKUP_BROWSER</span></dt><dd><p>0x00020000 Backup browser server</p></dd><dt><span class="term">SV_TYPE_MASTER_BROWSER</span></dt><dd><p>0x00040000 Master browser server</p></dd><dt><span class="term">SV_TYPE_DOMAIN_MASTER</span></dt><dd><p>0x00080000 Domain Master Browser server</p></dd><dt><span class="term">SV_TYPE_LOCAL_LIST_ONLY</span></dt><dd><p>0x40000000 Enumerate only entries marked &quot;local&quot;</p></dd><dt><span class="term">SV_TYPE_DOMAIN_ENUM</span></dt><dd><p>0x80000000 Enumerate Domains. The pszServer and pszDomain parameters must be NULL.</p></dd></dl></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>500 - platform_id</p></dd><dt><span class="term">VOID*</span></dt><dd><p>pointer to name</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>5 - major version</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>4 - minor version</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>type (SV_TYPE_... bit field)</p></dd><dt><span class="term">VOID*</span></dt><dd><p>pointer to comment</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNISTR2</span></dt><dd><p>sv101_name - unicode string of server name</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNISTR2</span></dt><dd><p>sv_101_comment - unicode string of server comment.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT8[]</span></dt><dd><p>padding to get unicode string 4-byte aligned with start of the SMB header.</p></dd></dl></div></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2876250"></a>MSRPC over Transact Named Pipe</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>For details on the SMB Transact Named Pipe, see cifs6.txt</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2876262"></a>MSRPC Pipes</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+The MSRPC is conducted over an SMB Transact Pipe with a name of
+<tt class="filename">\PIPE\</tt>. You must first obtain a 16 bit file handle, by
+sending a SMBopenX with the pipe name <tt class="filename">\PIPE\srvsvc</tt> for
example. You can then perform an SMB Trans,
-and must carry out an SMBclose on the file handle once you are finished.</P
-><P
->Trans Requests must be sent with two setup UINT16s, no UINT16 params (none
+and must carry out an SMBclose on the file handle once you are finished.
+</p><p>
+Trans Requests must be sent with two setup UINT16s, no UINT16 params (none
known about), and UINT8 data parameters sufficient to contain the MSRPC
header, and MSRPC data. The first UINT16 setup parameter must be either
0x0026 to indicate an RPC, or 0x0001 to indicate Set Named Pipe Handle
state. The second UINT16 parameter must be the file handle for the pipe,
-obtained above.</P
-><P
->The Data section for an API Command of 0x0026 (RPC pipe) in the Trans
+obtained above.
+</p><p>
+The Data section for an API Command of 0x0026 (RPC pipe) in the Trans
Request is the RPC Header, followed by the RPC Data. The Data section for
an API Command of 0x0001 (Set Named Pipe Handle state) is two bytes. The
-only value seen for these two bytes is 0x00 0x43.</P
-><P
->MSRPC Responses are sent as response data inside standard SMB Trans
-responses, with the MSRPC Header, MSRPC Data and MSRPC tail.</P
-><P
->It is suspected that the Trans Requests will need to be at least 2-byte
+only value seen for these two bytes is 0x00 0x43.
+</p><p>
+MSRPC Responses are sent as response data inside standard SMB Trans
+responses, with the MSRPC Header, MSRPC Data and MSRPC tail.
+</p><p>
+It is suspected that the Trans Requests will need to be at least 2-byte
aligned (probably 4-byte). This is standard practice for SMBs. It is also
independent of the observed 4-byte alignments with the start of the MSRPC
header, including the 4-byte alignment between the MSRPC header and the
-MSRPC data.</P
-><P
->First, an SMBtconX connection is made to the IPC$ share. The connection
+MSRPC data.
+</p><p>
+First, an SMBtconX connection is made to the IPC$ share. The connection
must be made using encrypted passwords, not clear-text. Then, an SMBopenX
is made on the pipe. Then, a Set Named Pipe Handle State must be sent,
after which the pipe is ready to accept API commands. Lastly, and SMBclose
-is sent.</P
-><P
->To be resolved:</P
-><P
->lkcl/01nov97 there appear to be two additional bytes after the null-terminated \PIPE\ name for the RPC pipe. Values seen so far are
-listed below:</P
-><P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
-> initial SMBopenX request: RPC API command 0x26 params:
- "\\PIPE\\lsarpc" 0x65 0x63; 0x72 0x70; 0x44 0x65;
- "\\PIPE\\srvsvc" 0x73 0x76; 0x4E 0x00; 0x5C 0x43;</PRE
-></P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><HR><H3
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN1588"
-></A
->9.3.2. Header</H3
-><P
->[section to be rewritten, following receipt of work by Duncan Stansfield]</P
-><P
->Interesting note: if you set packed data representation to 0x0100 0000
-then all 4-byte and 2-byte word ordering is turned around!</P
-><P
->The start of each of the NTLSA and NETLOGON named pipes begins with:</P
-><P
-><B
->offset: </B
->00</P
-><P
-><B
->Variable type: </B
->UINT8</P
-><P
-><B
->Variable data: </B
->5 - RPC major version</P
-><P
-><B
->offset: </B
->01</P
-><P
-><B
->Variable type: </B
->UINT8</P
-><P
-><B
->Variable data: </B
->0 - RPC minor version</P
-><P
-><B
->offset: </B
->02</P
-><P
-><B
->Variable type: </B
->UINT8</P
-><P
-><B
->Variable data: </B
->2 - RPC response packet</P
-><P
-><B
->offset: </B
->03</P
-><P
-><B
->Variable type: </B
->UINT8</P
-><P
-><B
->Variable data: </B
->3 - (FirstFrag bit-wise or with LastFrag)</P
-><P
-><B
->offset: </B
->04</P
-><P
-><B
->Variable type: </B
->UINT32</P
-><P
-><B
->Variable data: </B
->0x1000 0000 - packed data representation</P
-><P
-><B
->offset: </B
->08</P
-><P
-><B
->Variable type: </B
->UINT16</P
-><P
-><B
->Variable data: </B
->fragment length - data size (bytes) inc header and tail.</P
-><P
-><B
->offset: </B
->0A</P
-><P
-><B
->Variable type: </B
->UINT16</P
-><P
-><B
->Variable data: </B
->0 - authentication length </P
-><P
-><B
->offset: </B
->0C</P
-><P
-><B
->Variable type: </B
->UINT32</P
-><P
-><B
->Variable data: </B
->call identifier. matches 12th UINT32 of incoming RPC data.</P
-><P
-><B
->offset: </B
->10</P
-><P
-><B
->Variable type: </B
->UINT32</P
-><P
-><B
->Variable data: </B
->allocation hint - data size (bytes) minus header and tail.</P
-><P
-><B
->offset: </B
->14</P
-><P
-><B
->Variable type: </B
->UINT16</P
-><P
-><B
->Variable data: </B
->0 - presentation context identifier</P
-><P
-><B
->offset: </B
->16</P
-><P
-><B
->Variable type: </B
->UINT8</P
-><P
-><B
->Variable data: </B
->0 - cancel count</P
-><P
-><B
->offset: </B
->17</P
-><P
-><B
->Variable type: </B
->UINT8</P
-><P
-><B
->Variable data: </B
->in replies: 0 - reserved; in requests: opnum - see #defines.</P
-><P
-><B
->offset: </B
->18</P
-><P
-><B
->Variable type: </B
->......</P
-><P
-><B
->Variable data: </B
->start of data (goes on for allocation_hint bytes)</P
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><HR><H4
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><A
-NAME="AEN1649"
-></A
->9.3.2.1. RPC_Packet for request, response, bind and bind acknowledgement</H4
-><P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
->UINT8 versionmaj</DT
-><DD
-><P
->reply same as request (0x05)</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT8 versionmin</DT
-><DD
-><P
->reply same as request (0x00)</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT8 type</DT
-><DD
-><P
->one of the MSRPC_Type enums</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT8 flags</DT
-><DD
-><P
->reply same as request (0x00 for Bind, 0x03 for Request)</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT32 representation</DT
-><DD
-><P
->reply same as request (0x00000010)</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT16 fraglength</DT
-><DD
-><P
->the length of the data section of the SMB trans packet</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT16 authlength</DT
-><DD
-><P
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT32 callid</DT
-><DD
-><P
->call identifier. (e.g. 0x00149594)</P
-></DD
-><DT
->* stub USE TvPacket</DT
-><DD
-><P
->the remainder of the packet depending on the "type"</P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><HR><H4
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><A
-NAME="AEN1688"
-></A
->9.3.2.2. Interface identification</H4
-><P
->the interfaces are numbered. as yet I haven't seen more than one interface used on the same pipe name srvsvc</P
-><P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
->abstract (0x4B324FC8, 0x01D31670, 0x475A7812, 0x88E16EBF, 0x00000003)
-transfer (0x8A885D04, 0x11C91CEB, 0x0008E89F, 0x6048102B, 0x00000002)</PRE
-></P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><HR><H4
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><A
-NAME="AEN1693"
-></A
->9.3.2.3. RPC_Iface RW</H4
-><P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
->UINT8 byte[16]</DT
-><DD
-><P
->16 bytes of number</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT32 version</DT
-><DD
-><P
->the interface number</P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><HR><H4
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><A
-NAME="AEN1704"
-></A
->9.3.2.4. RPC_ReqBind RW</H4
-><P
->the remainder of the packet after the header if "type" was Bind in the response header, "type" should be BindAck</P
-><P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
->UINT16 maxtsize</DT
-><DD
-><P
->maximum transmission fragment size (0x1630)</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT16 maxrsize</DT
-><DD
-><P
->max receive fragment size (0x1630)</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT32 assocgid</DT
-><DD
-><P
->associated group id (0x0)</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT32 numelements</DT
-><DD
-><P
->the number of elements (0x1)</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT16 contextid</DT
-><DD
-><P
->presentation context identifier (0x0)</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT8 numsyntaxes</DT
-><DD
-><P
->the number of syntaxes (has always been 1?)(0x1)</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT8[]</DT
-><DD
-><P
->4-byte alignment padding, against SMB header</P
-></DD
-><DT
->* abstractint USE RPC_Iface</DT
-><DD
-><P
->num and vers. of interface client is using</P
-></DD
-><DT
->* transferint USE RPC_Iface</DT
-><DD
-><P
->num and vers. of interface to use for replies</P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><HR><H4
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><A
-NAME="AEN1744"
-></A
->9.3.2.5. RPC_Address RW</H4
-><P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
->UINT16 length</DT
-><DD
-><P
->length of the string including null terminator</P
-></DD
-><DT
->* port USE string</DT
-><DD
-><P
->the string above in single byte, null terminated form</P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><HR><H4
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><A
-NAME="AEN1755"
-></A
->9.3.2.6. RPC_ResBind RW</H4
-><P
->the response to place after the header in the reply packet</P
-><P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
->UINT16 maxtsize</DT
-><DD
-><P
->same as request</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT16 maxrsize</DT
-><DD
-><P
->same as request</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT32 assocgid</DT
-><DD
-><P
->zero</P
-></DD
-><DT
->* secondaddr USE RPC_Address</DT
-><DD
-><P
->the address string, as described earlier</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT8[]</DT
-><DD
-><P
->4-byte alignment padding, against SMB header</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT8 numresults</DT
-><DD
-><P
->the number of results (0x01)</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT8[]</DT
-><DD
-><P
->4-byte alignment padding, against SMB header</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT16 result</DT
-><DD
-><P
->result (0x00 = accept)</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT16 reason</DT
-><DD
-><P
->reason (0x00 = no reason specified)</P
-></DD
-><DT
->* transfersyntax USE RPC_Iface</DT
-><DD
-><P
->the transfer syntax from the request</P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><HR><H4
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><A
-NAME="AEN1799"
-></A
->9.3.2.7. RPC_ReqNorm RW</H4
-><P
->the remainder of the packet after the header for every other other request</P
-><P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
->UINT32 allochint</DT
-><DD
-><P
->the size of the stub data in bytes</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT16 prescontext</DT
-><DD
-><P
->presentation context identifier (0x0)</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT16 opnum</DT
-><DD
-><P
->operation number (0x15)</P
-></DD
-><DT
->* stub USE TvPacket</DT
-><DD
-><P
->a packet dependent on the pipe name (probably the interface) and the op number)</P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><HR><H4
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><A
-NAME="AEN1819"
-></A
->9.3.2.8. RPC_ResNorm RW</H4
-><P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
->UINT32 allochint</DT
-><DD
-><P
-># size of the stub data in bytes</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT16 prescontext</DT
-><DD
-><P
-># presentation context identifier (same as request)</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT8 cancelcount</DT
-><DD
-><P
-># cancel count? (0x0)</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT8 reserved</DT
-><DD
-><P
-># 0 - one byte padding</P
-></DD
-><DT
->* stub USE TvPacket</DT
-><DD
-><P
-># the remainder of the reply</P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><HR><H3
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN1842"
-></A
->9.3.3. Tail</H3
-><P
->The end of each of the NTLSA and NETLOGON named pipes ends with:</P
-><P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
->......</DT
-><DD
-><P
->end of data</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT32</DT
-><DD
-><P
->return code</P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><HR><H3
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN1854"
-></A
->9.3.4. RPC Bind / Bind Ack</H3
-><P
->RPC Binds are the process of associating an RPC pipe (e.g \PIPE\lsarpc)
-with a "transfer syntax" (see RPC_Iface structure). The purpose for doing
-this is unknown.</P
-><P
-><SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->Note: The RPC_ResBind SMB Transact request is sent with two uint16 setup parameters. The first is 0x0026; the second is the file handle
- returned by the SMBopenX Transact response.</I
-></SPAN
-></P
-><P
-><SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->Note: The RPC_ResBind members maxtsize, maxrsize and assocgid are the same in the response as the same members in the RPC_ReqBind. The
+is sent.
+</p><p>
+To be resolved:
+</p><p>
+lkcl/01nov97 there appear to be two additional bytes after the null-terminated \PIPE\ name for the RPC pipe. Values seen so far are
+listed below:</p><pre class="programlisting">
+ initial SMBopenX request: RPC API command 0x26 params:
+ &quot;\\PIPE\\lsarpc&quot; 0x65 0x63; 0x72 0x70; 0x44 0x65;
+ &quot;\\PIPE\\srvsvc&quot; 0x73 0x76; 0x4E 0x00; 0x5C 0x43;
+</pre></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2876365"></a>Header</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>[section to be rewritten, following receipt of work by Duncan Stansfield]</p><p>Interesting note: if you set packed data representation to 0x0100 0000
+then all 4-byte and 2-byte word ordering is turned around!</p><p>The start of each of the NTLSA and NETLOGON named pipes begins with:</p><div class="segmentedlist"><p><b>offset: </b>00</p><p><b>Variable type: </b>UINT8</p><p><b>Variable data: </b>5 - RPC major version</p><p><b>offset: </b>01</p><p><b>Variable type: </b>UINT8</p><p><b>Variable data: </b>0 - RPC minor version</p><p><b>offset: </b>02</p><p><b>Variable type: </b>UINT8</p><p><b>Variable data: </b>2 - RPC response packet</p><p><b>offset: </b>03</p><p><b>Variable type: </b>UINT8</p><p><b>Variable data: </b>3 - (FirstFrag bit-wise or with LastFrag)</p><p><b>offset: </b>04</p><p><b>Variable type: </b>UINT32</p><p><b>Variable data: </b>0x1000 0000 - packed data representation</p><p><b>offset: </b>08</p><p><b>Variable type: </b>UINT16</p><p><b>Variable data: </b>fragment length - data size (bytes) inc header and tail.</p><p><b>offset: </b>0A</p><p><b>Variable type: </b>UINT16</p><p><b>Variable data: </b>0 - authentication length </p><p><b>offset: </b>0C</p><p><b>Variable type: </b>UINT32</p><p><b>Variable data: </b>call identifier. matches 12th UINT32 of incoming RPC data.</p><p><b>offset: </b>10</p><p><b>Variable type: </b>UINT32</p><p><b>Variable data: </b>allocation hint - data size (bytes) minus header and tail.</p><p><b>offset: </b>14</p><p><b>Variable type: </b>UINT16</p><p><b>Variable data: </b>0 - presentation context identifier</p><p><b>offset: </b>16</p><p><b>Variable type: </b>UINT8</p><p><b>Variable data: </b>0 - cancel count</p><p><b>offset: </b>17</p><p><b>Variable type: </b>UINT8</p><p><b>Variable data: </b>in replies: 0 - reserved; in requests: opnum - see #defines.</p><p><b>offset: </b>18</p><p><b>Variable type: </b>......</p><p><b>Variable data: </b>start of data (goes on for allocation_hint bytes)</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2876554"></a>RPC_Packet for request, response, bind and bind acknowledgement</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">UINT8 versionmaj</span></dt><dd><p>reply same as request (0x05)</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT8 versionmin</span></dt><dd><p>reply same as request (0x00)</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT8 type</span></dt><dd><p>one of the MSRPC_Type enums</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT8 flags</span></dt><dd><p>reply same as request (0x00 for Bind, 0x03 for Request)</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32 representation</span></dt><dd><p>reply same as request (0x00000010)</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT16 fraglength</span></dt><dd><p>the length of the data section of the SMB trans packet</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT16 authlength</span></dt><dd><p></p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32 callid</span></dt><dd><p>call identifier. (e.g. 0x00149594)</p></dd><dt><span class="term">* stub USE TvPacket</span></dt><dd><p>the remainder of the packet depending on the &quot;type&quot;</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2876688"></a>Interface identification</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p>the interfaces are numbered. as yet I haven't seen more than one interface used on the same pipe name srvsvc</p><pre class="programlisting">
+abstract (0x4B324FC8, 0x01D31670, 0x475A7812, 0x88E16EBF, 0x00000003)
+transfer (0x8A885D04, 0x11C91CEB, 0x0008E89F, 0x6048102B, 0x00000002)
+</pre></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2876714"></a>RPC_Iface RW</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">UINT8 byte[16]</span></dt><dd><p>16 bytes of number</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32 version</span></dt><dd><p>the interface number</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2876753"></a>RPC_ReqBind RW</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p>the remainder of the packet after the header if &quot;type&quot; was Bind in the response header, &quot;type&quot; should be BindAck</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">UINT16 maxtsize</span></dt><dd><p>maximum transmission fragment size (0x1630)</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT16 maxrsize</span></dt><dd><p>max receive fragment size (0x1630)</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32 assocgid</span></dt><dd><p>associated group id (0x0)</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32 numelements</span></dt><dd><p>the number of elements (0x1)</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT16 contextid</span></dt><dd><p>presentation context identifier (0x0)</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT8 numsyntaxes</span></dt><dd><p>the number of syntaxes (has always been 1?)(0x1)</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT8[]</span></dt><dd><p>4-byte alignment padding, against SMB header</p></dd><dt><span class="term">* abstractint USE RPC_Iface</span></dt><dd><p>num and vers. of interface client is using</p></dd><dt><span class="term">* transferint USE RPC_Iface</span></dt><dd><p>num and vers. of interface to use for replies</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2876893"></a>RPC_Address RW</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">UINT16 length</span></dt><dd><p>length of the string including null terminator</p></dd><dt><span class="term">* port USE string</span></dt><dd><p>the string above in single byte, null terminated form</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2876933"></a>RPC_ResBind RW</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p>the response to place after the header in the reply packet</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">UINT16 maxtsize</span></dt><dd><p>same as request</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT16 maxrsize</span></dt><dd><p>same as request</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32 assocgid</span></dt><dd><p>zero</p></dd><dt><span class="term">* secondaddr USE RPC_Address</span></dt><dd><p>the address string, as described earlier</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT8[]</span></dt><dd><p>4-byte alignment padding, against SMB header</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT8 numresults</span></dt><dd><p>the number of results (0x01)</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT8[]</span></dt><dd><p>4-byte alignment padding, against SMB header</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT16 result</span></dt><dd><p>result (0x00 = accept)</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT16 reason</span></dt><dd><p>reason (0x00 = no reason specified)</p></dd><dt><span class="term">* transfersyntax USE RPC_Iface</span></dt><dd><p>the transfer syntax from the request</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2877084"></a>RPC_ReqNorm RW</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p>the remainder of the packet after the header for every other other request</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">UINT32 allochint</span></dt><dd><p>the size of the stub data in bytes</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT16 prescontext</span></dt><dd><p>presentation context identifier (0x0)</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT16 opnum</span></dt><dd><p>operation number (0x15)</p></dd><dt><span class="term">* stub USE TvPacket</span></dt><dd><p>a packet dependent on the pipe name (probably the interface) and the op number)</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2877156"></a>RPC_ResNorm RW</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">UINT32 allochint</span></dt><dd><p># size of the stub data in bytes</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT16 prescontext</span></dt><dd><p># presentation context identifier (same as request)</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT8 cancelcount</span></dt><dd><p># cancel count? (0x0)</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT8 reserved</span></dt><dd><p># 0 - one byte padding</p></dd><dt><span class="term">* stub USE TvPacket</span></dt><dd><p># the remainder of the reply</p></dd></dl></div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2877236"></a>Tail</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>The end of each of the NTLSA and NETLOGON named pipes ends with:</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">......</span></dt><dd><p>end of data</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>return code</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2877281"></a>RPC Bind / Bind Ack</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+RPC Binds are the process of associating an RPC pipe (e.g \PIPE\lsarpc)
+with a &quot;transfer syntax&quot; (see RPC_Iface structure). The purpose for doing
+this is unknown.
+</p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note: The RPC_ResBind SMB Transact request is sent with two uint16 setup parameters. The first is 0x0026; the second is the file handle
+ returned by the SMBopenX Transact response.</em></span></p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note: The RPC_ResBind members maxtsize, maxrsize and assocgid are the same in the response as the same members in the RPC_ReqBind. The
RPC_ResBind member transfersyntax is the same in the response as
- the</I
-></SPAN
-></P
-><P
-><SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->Note: The RPC_ResBind response member secondaddr contains the name of what is presumed to be the service behind the RPC pipe. The
- mapping identified so far is:</I
-></SPAN
-></P
-><P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
->initial SMBopenX request:</DT
-><DD
-><P
->RPC_ResBind response:</P
-></DD
-><DT
->"\\PIPE\\srvsvc"</DT
-><DD
-><P
->"\\PIPE\\ntsvcs"</P
-></DD
-><DT
->"\\PIPE\\samr"</DT
-><DD
-><P
->"\\PIPE\\lsass"</P
-></DD
-><DT
->"\\PIPE\\lsarpc"</DT
-><DD
-><P
->"\\PIPE\\lsass"</P
-></DD
-><DT
->"\\PIPE\\wkssvc"</DT
-><DD
-><P
->"\\PIPE\\wksvcs"</P
-></DD
-><DT
->"\\PIPE\\NETLOGON"</DT
-><DD
-><P
->"\\PIPE\\NETLOGON"</P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-><P
-><SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->Note: The RPC_Packet fraglength member in both the Bind Request and Bind Acknowledgment must contain the length of the entire RPC data, including the RPC_Packet header.</I
-></SPAN
-></P
-><P
->Request:</P
-><P
-></P
-><TABLE
-BORDER="0"
-><TBODY
-><TR
-><TD
->RPC_Packet</TD
-></TR
-><TR
-><TD
->RPC_ReqBind</TD
-></TR
-></TBODY
-></TABLE
-><P
-></P
-><P
->Response:</P
-><P
-></P
-><TABLE
-BORDER="0"
-><TBODY
-><TR
-><TD
->RPC_Packet</TD
-></TR
-><TR
-><TD
->RPC_ResBind</TD
-></TR
-></TBODY
-></TABLE
-><P
-></P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><HR><H3
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN1898"
-></A
->9.3.5. NTLSA Transact Named Pipe</H3
-><P
->The sequence of actions taken on this pipe are:</P
-><P
-></P
-><TABLE
-BORDER="0"
-><TBODY
-><TR
-><TD
->Establish a connection to the IPC$ share (SMBtconX). use encrypted passwords.</TD
-></TR
-><TR
-><TD
->Open an RPC Pipe with the name "\\PIPE\\lsarpc". Store the file handle.</TD
-></TR
-><TR
-><TD
->Using the file handle, send a Set Named Pipe Handle state to 0x4300.</TD
-></TR
-><TR
-><TD
->Send an LSA Open Policy request. Store the Policy Handle.</TD
-></TR
-><TR
-><TD
->Using the Policy Handle, send LSA Query Info Policy requests, etc.</TD
-></TR
-><TR
-><TD
->Using the Policy Handle, send an LSA Close.</TD
-></TR
-><TR
-><TD
->Close the IPC$ share.</TD
-></TR
-></TBODY
-></TABLE
-><P
-></P
-><P
->Defines for this pipe, identifying the query are:</P
-><P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
->LSA Open Policy:</DT
-><DD
-><P
->0x2c</P
-></DD
-><DT
->LSA Query Info Policy:</DT
-><DD
-><P
->0x07</P
-></DD
-><DT
->LSA Enumerate Trusted Domains:</DT
-><DD
-><P
->0x0d</P
-></DD
-><DT
->LSA Open Secret:</DT
-><DD
-><P
->0xff</P
-></DD
-><DT
->LSA Lookup SIDs:</DT
-><DD
-><P
->0xfe</P
-></DD
-><DT
->LSA Lookup Names:</DT
-><DD
-><P
->0xfd</P
-></DD
-><DT
->LSA Close:</DT
-><DD
-><P
->0x00</P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><HR><H3
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN1939"
-></A
->9.3.6. LSA Open Policy</H3
-><P
-><SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->Note: The policy handle can be anything you like.</I
-></SPAN
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><HR><H4
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><A
-NAME="AEN1943"
-></A
->9.3.6.1. Request</H4
-><P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
->VOID*</DT
-><DD
-><P
->buffer pointer</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UNISTR2</DT
-><DD
-><P
->server name - unicode string starting with two '\'s</P
-></DD
-><DT
->OBJ_ATTR</DT
-><DD
-><P
->object attributes</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT32</DT
-><DD
-><P
->1 - desired access</P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><HR><H4
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><A
-NAME="AEN1962"
-></A
->9.3.6.2. Response</H4
-><P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
->POL_HND</DT
-><DD
-><P
->LSA policy handle</P
-></DD
-><DT
->return</DT
-><DD
-><P
->0 - indicates success</P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><HR><H3
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN1973"
-></A
->9.3.7. LSA Query Info Policy</H3
-><P
-><SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->Note: The info class in response must be the same as that in the request.</I
-></SPAN
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><HR><H4
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><A
-NAME="AEN1977"
-></A
->9.3.7.1. Request</H4
-><P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
->POL_HND</DT
-><DD
-><P
->LSA policy handle</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT16</DT
-><DD
-><P
->info class (also a policy handle?)</P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><HR><H4
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><A
-NAME="AEN1988"
-></A
->9.3.7.2. Response</H4
-><P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
->VOID*</DT
-><DD
-><P
->undocumented buffer pointer</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT16</DT
-><DD
-><P
->info class (same as info class in request).</P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-><P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
->switch (info class)
+ the</em></span></p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note: The RPC_ResBind response member secondaddr contains the name of what is presumed to be the service behind the RPC pipe. The
+ mapping identified so far is:</em></span></p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">initial SMBopenX request:</span></dt><dd><p>RPC_ResBind response:</p></dd><dt><span class="term">&quot;\\PIPE\\srvsvc&quot;</span></dt><dd><p>&quot;\\PIPE\\ntsvcs&quot;</p></dd><dt><span class="term">&quot;\\PIPE\\samr&quot;</span></dt><dd><p>&quot;\\PIPE\\lsass&quot;</p></dd><dt><span class="term">&quot;\\PIPE\\lsarpc&quot;</span></dt><dd><p>&quot;\\PIPE\\lsass&quot;</p></dd><dt><span class="term">&quot;\\PIPE\\wkssvc&quot;</span></dt><dd><p>&quot;\\PIPE\\wksvcs&quot;</p></dd><dt><span class="term">&quot;\\PIPE\\NETLOGON&quot;</span></dt><dd><p>&quot;\\PIPE\\NETLOGON&quot;</p></dd></dl></div><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note: The RPC_Packet fraglength member in both the Bind Request and Bind Acknowledgment must contain the length of the entire RPC data, including the RPC_Packet header.</em></span></p><p>Request:</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td>RPC_Packet</td></tr><tr><td>RPC_ReqBind</td></tr></table><p>Response:</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td>RPC_Packet</td></tr><tr><td>RPC_ResBind</td></tr></table></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2877461"></a>NTLSA Transact Named Pipe</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>The sequence of actions taken on this pipe are:</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td>Establish a connection to the IPC$ share (SMBtconX). use encrypted passwords.</td></tr><tr><td>Open an RPC Pipe with the name &quot;\\PIPE\\lsarpc&quot;. Store the file handle.</td></tr><tr><td>Using the file handle, send a Set Named Pipe Handle state to 0x4300.</td></tr><tr><td>Send an LSA Open Policy request. Store the Policy Handle.</td></tr><tr><td>Using the Policy Handle, send LSA Query Info Policy requests, etc.</td></tr><tr><td>Using the Policy Handle, send an LSA Close.</td></tr><tr><td>Close the IPC$ share.</td></tr></table><p>Defines for this pipe, identifying the query are:</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">LSA Open Policy:</span></dt><dd><p>0x2c</p></dd><dt><span class="term">LSA Query Info Policy:</span></dt><dd><p>0x07</p></dd><dt><span class="term">LSA Enumerate Trusted Domains:</span></dt><dd><p>0x0d</p></dd><dt><span class="term">LSA Open Secret:</span></dt><dd><p>0xff</p></dd><dt><span class="term">LSA Lookup SIDs:</span></dt><dd><p>0xfe</p></dd><dt><span class="term">LSA Lookup Names:</span></dt><dd><p>0xfd</p></dd><dt><span class="term">LSA Close:</span></dt><dd><p>0x00</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2877626"></a>LSA Open Policy</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note: The policy handle can be anything you like.</em></span></p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2877640"></a>Request</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">VOID*</span></dt><dd><p>buffer pointer</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNISTR2</span></dt><dd><p>server name - unicode string starting with two '\'s</p></dd><dt><span class="term">OBJ_ATTR</span></dt><dd><p>object attributes</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>1 - desired access</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2877710"></a>Response</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">POL_HND</span></dt><dd><p>LSA policy handle</p></dd><dt><span class="term">return</span></dt><dd><p>0 - indicates success</p></dd></dl></div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2877752"></a>LSA Query Info Policy</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note: The info class in response must be the same as that in the request.</em></span></p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2877766"></a>Request</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">POL_HND</span></dt><dd><p>LSA policy handle</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT16</span></dt><dd><p>info class (also a policy handle?)</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2877805"></a>Response</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">VOID*</span></dt><dd><p>undocumented buffer pointer</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT16</span></dt><dd><p>info class (same as info class in request).</p></dd></dl></div><pre class="programlisting">
+switch (info class)
case 3:
case 5:
{
DOM_INFO domain info, levels 3 and 5 (are the same).
}
-return 0 - indicates success</PRE
-></P
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><HR><H3
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN2001"
-></A
->9.3.8. LSA Enumerate Trusted Domains</H3
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><H4
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><A
-NAME="AEN2003"
-></A
->9.3.8.1. Request</H4
-><P
->no extra data</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><HR><H4
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><A
-NAME="AEN2006"
-></A
->9.3.8.2. Response</H4
-><P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
->UINT32</DT
-><DD
-><P
->0 - enumeration context</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT32</DT
-><DD
-><P
->0 - entries read</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT32</DT
-><DD
-><P
->0 - trust information</P
-></DD
-><DT
->return</DT
-><DD
-><P
->0x8000 001a - "no trusted domains" success code</P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><HR><H3
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN2025"
-></A
->9.3.9. LSA Open Secret</H3
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><H4
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><A
-NAME="AEN2027"
-></A
->9.3.9.1. Request</H4
-><P
->no extra data</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><HR><H4
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><A
-NAME="AEN2030"
-></A
->9.3.9.2. Response</H4
-><P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
->UINT32</DT
-><DD
-><P
->0 - undocumented</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT32</DT
-><DD
-><P
->0 - undocumented</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT32</DT
-><DD
-><P
->0 - undocumented</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT32</DT
-><DD
-><P
->0 - undocumented</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT32</DT
-><DD
-><P
->0 - undocumented</P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-><P
->return 0x0C00 0034 - "no such secret" success code</P
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><HR><H3
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN2054"
-></A
->9.3.10. LSA Close</H3
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><H4
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><A
-NAME="AEN2056"
-></A
->9.3.10.1. Request</H4
-><P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
->POL_HND</DT
-><DD
-><P
->policy handle to be closed</P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><HR><H4
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><A
-NAME="AEN2063"
-></A
->9.3.10.2. Response</H4
-><P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
->POL_HND</DT
-><DD
-><P
->0s - closed policy handle (all zeros)</P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-><P
->return 0 - indicates success</P
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><HR><H3
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN2071"
-></A
->9.3.11. LSA Lookup SIDS</H3
-><P
-><SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->Note: num_entries in response must be same as num_entries in request.</I
-></SPAN
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><HR><H4
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><A
-NAME="AEN2075"
-></A
->9.3.11.1. Request</H4
-><P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
->POL_HND</DT
-><DD
-><P
->LSA policy handle</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT32</DT
-><DD
-><P
->num_entries</P
-></DD
-><DT
->VOID*</DT
-><DD
-><P
->undocumented domain SID buffer pointer</P
-></DD
-><DT
->VOID*</DT
-><DD
-><P
->undocumented domain name buffer pointer</P
-></DD
-><DT
->VOID*[num_entries] undocumented domain SID pointers to be looked up.</DT
-><DD
-><P
->DOM_SID[num_entries] domain SIDs to be looked up.</P
-></DD
-><DT
->char[16]</DT
-><DD
-><P
->completely undocumented 16 bytes.</P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><HR><H4
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><A
-NAME="AEN2102"
-></A
->9.3.11.2. Response</H4
-><P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
->DOM_REF</DT
-><DD
-><P
->domain reference response</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT32</DT
-><DD
-><P
->num_entries (listed above)</P
-></DD
-><DT
->VOID*</DT
-><DD
-><P
->undocumented buffer pointer</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT32</DT
-><DD
-><P
->num_entries (listed above)</P
-></DD
-><DT
->DOM_SID2[num_entries]</DT
-><DD
-><P
->domain SIDs (from Request, listed above).</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT32</DT
-><DD
-><P
->num_entries (listed above)</P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-><P
->return 0 - indicates success</P
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><HR><H3
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN2130"
-></A
->9.3.12. LSA Lookup Names</H3
-><P
-><SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->Note: num_entries in response must be same as num_entries in request.</I
-></SPAN
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><HR><H4
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><A
-NAME="AEN2134"
-></A
->9.3.12.1. Request</H4
-><P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
->POL_HND</DT
-><DD
-><P
->LSA policy handle</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT32</DT
-><DD
-><P
->num_entries</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT32</DT
-><DD
-><P
->num_entries</P
-></DD
-><DT
->VOID*</DT
-><DD
-><P
->undocumented domain SID buffer pointer</P
-></DD
-><DT
->VOID*</DT
-><DD
-><P
->undocumented domain name buffer pointer</P
-></DD
-><DT
->NAME[num_entries]</DT
-><DD
-><P
->names to be looked up.</P
-></DD
-><DT
->char[]</DT
-><DD
-><P
->undocumented bytes - falsely translated SID structure?</P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><HR><H4
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><A
-NAME="AEN2165"
-></A
->9.3.12.2. Response</H4
-><P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
->DOM_REF</DT
-><DD
-><P
->domain reference response</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT32</DT
-><DD
-><P
->num_entries (listed above)</P
-></DD
-><DT
->VOID*</DT
-><DD
-><P
->undocumented buffer pointer</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT32</DT
-><DD
-><P
->num_entries (listed above)</P
-></DD
-><DT
->DOM_RID[num_entries]</DT
-><DD
-><P
->domain SIDs (from Request, listed above).</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT32</DT
-><DD
-><P
->num_entries (listed above)</P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-><P
->return 0 - indicates success</P
-></DIV
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><HR><H2
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN2193"
-></A
->9.4. NETLOGON rpc Transact Named Pipe</H2
-><P
->The sequence of actions taken on this pipe are:</P
-><P
-></P
-><TABLE
-BORDER="0"
-><TBODY
-><TR
-><TD
->tablish a connection to the IPC$ share (SMBtconX). use encrypted passwords.</TD
-></TR
-><TR
-><TD
->en an RPC Pipe with the name "\\PIPE\\NETLOGON". Store the file handle.</TD
-></TR
-><TR
-><TD
->ing the file handle, send a Set Named Pipe Handle state to 0x4300.</TD
-></TR
-><TR
-><TD
->eate Client Challenge. Send LSA Request Challenge. Store Server Challenge.</TD
-></TR
-><TR
-><TD
->lculate Session Key. Send an LSA Auth 2 Challenge. Store Auth2 Challenge.</TD
-></TR
-><TR
-><TD
->lc/Verify Client Creds. Send LSA Srv PW Set. Calc/Verify Server Creds.</TD
-></TR
-><TR
-><TD
->lc/Verify Client Creds. Send LSA SAM Logon . Calc/Verify Server Creds.</TD
-></TR
-><TR
-><TD
->lc/Verify Client Creds. Send LSA SAM Logoff. Calc/Verify Server Creds.</TD
-></TR
-><TR
-><TD
->ose the IPC$ share.</TD
-></TR
-></TBODY
-></TABLE
-><P
-></P
-><P
->Defines for this pipe, identifying the query are</P
-><P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
->LSA Request Challenge:</DT
-><DD
-><P
->0x04</P
-></DD
-><DT
->LSA Server Password Set:</DT
-><DD
-><P
->0x06</P
-></DD
-><DT
->LSA SAM Logon:</DT
-><DD
-><P
->0x02</P
-></DD
-><DT
->LSA SAM Logoff:</DT
-><DD
-><P
->0x03</P
-></DD
-><DT
->LSA Auth 2:</DT
-><DD
-><P
->0x0f</P
-></DD
-><DT
->LSA Logon Control:</DT
-><DD
-><P
->0x0e</P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><HR><H3
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN2232"
-></A
->9.4.1. LSA Request Challenge</H3
-><P
-><SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->Note: logon server name starts with two '\' characters and is upper case.</I
-></SPAN
-></P
-><P
-><SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->Note: logon client is the machine, not the user.</I
-></SPAN
-></P
-><P
-><SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->Note: the initial LanManager password hash, against which the challenge is issued, is the machine name itself (lower case). there will becalls issued (LSA Server Password Set) which will change this, later. refusing these calls allows you to always deal with the same password (i.e the LM# of the machine name in lower case).</I
-></SPAN
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><HR><H4
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><A
-NAME="AEN2240"
-></A
->9.4.1.1. Request</H4
-><P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
->VOID*</DT
-><DD
-><P
->undocumented buffer pointer</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UNISTR2</DT
-><DD
-><P
->logon server unicode string</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UNISTR2</DT
-><DD
-><P
->logon client unicode string</P
-></DD
-><DT
->char[8]</DT
-><DD
-><P
->client challenge</P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><HR><H4
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><A
-NAME="AEN2259"
-></A
->9.4.1.2. Response</H4
-><P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
->char[8]</DT
-><DD
-><P
->server challenge</P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-><P
->return 0 - indicates success</P
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><HR><H3
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN2267"
-></A
->9.4.2. LSA Authenticate 2</H3
-><P
-><SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->Note: in between request and response, calculate the client credentials, and check them against the client-calculated credentials (this process uses the previously received client credentials).</I
-></SPAN
-></P
-><P
-><SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->Note: neg_flags in the response is the same as that in the request.</I
-></SPAN
-></P
-><P
-><SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->Note: you must take a copy of the client-calculated credentials received here, because they will be used in subsequent authentication packets.</I
-></SPAN
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><HR><H4
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><A
-NAME="AEN2275"
-></A
->9.4.2.1. Request</H4
-><P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
->LOG_INFO</DT
-><DD
-><P
->client identification info</P
-></DD
-><DT
->char[8]</DT
-><DD
-><P
->client-calculated credentials</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT8[]</DT
-><DD
-><P
->padding to 4-byte align with start of SMB header.</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT32</DT
-><DD
-><P
->neg_flags - negotiated flags (usual value is 0x0000 01ff)</P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><HR><H4
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><A
-NAME="AEN2294"
-></A
->9.4.2.2. Response</H4
-><P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
->char[8]</DT
-><DD
-><P
->server credentials.</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT32</DT
-><DD
-><P
->neg_flags - same as neg_flags in request.</P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-><P
->return 0 - indicates success. failure value unknown.</P
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><HR><H3
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN2306"
-></A
->9.4.3. LSA Server Password Set</H3
-><P
-><SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->Note: the new password is suspected to be a DES encryption using the old password to generate the key.</I
-></SPAN
-></P
-><P
-><SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->Note: in between request and response, calculate the client credentials, and check them against the client-calculated credentials (this process uses the previously received client credentials).</I
-></SPAN
-></P
-><P
-><SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->Note: the server credentials are constructed from the client-calculated credentials and the client time + 1 second.</I
-></SPAN
-></P
-><P
-><SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->Note: you must take a copy of the client-calculated credentials received here, because they will be used in subsequent authentication packets.</I
-></SPAN
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><HR><H4
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><A
-NAME="AEN2316"
-></A
->9.4.3.1. Request</H4
-><P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
->CLNT_INFO</DT
-><DD
-><P
->client identification/authentication info</P
-></DD
-><DT
->char[]</DT
-><DD
-><P
->new password - undocumented.</P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><HR><H4
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><A
-NAME="AEN2327"
-></A
->9.4.3.2. Response</H4
-><P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
->CREDS</DT
-><DD
-><P
->server credentials. server time stamp appears to be ignored.</P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-><P
->return 0 - indicates success; 0xC000 006a indicates failure</P
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><HR><H3
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN2335"
-></A
->9.4.4. LSA SAM Logon</H3
-><P
-><SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->Note: valid_user is True iff the username and password hash are valid for
- the requested domain.</I
-></SPAN
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><HR><H4
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><A
-NAME="AEN2339"
-></A
->9.4.4.1. Request</H4
-><P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
->SAM_INFO</DT
-><DD
-><P
->sam_id structure</P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><HR><H4
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><A
-NAME="AEN2346"
-></A
->9.4.4.2. Response</H4
-><P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
->VOID*</DT
-><DD
-><P
->undocumented buffer pointer</P
-></DD
-><DT
->CREDS</DT
-><DD
-><P
->server credentials. server time stamp appears to be ignored.</P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-><P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
->if (valid_user)
+return 0 - indicates success
+</pre></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2877858"></a>LSA Enumerate Trusted Domains</h3></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2877866"></a>Request</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p>no extra data</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2877878"></a>Response</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>0 - enumeration context</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>0 - entries read</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>0 - trust information</p></dd><dt><span class="term">return</span></dt><dd><p>0x8000 001a - &quot;no trusted domains&quot; success code</p></dd></dl></div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2877950"></a>LSA Open Secret</h3></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2877957"></a>Request</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p>no extra data</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2877969"></a>Response</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>0 - undocumented</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>0 - undocumented</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>0 - undocumented</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>0 - undocumented</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>0 - undocumented</p></dd></dl></div><p>return 0x0C00 0034 - &quot;no such secret&quot; success code</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2878060"></a>LSA Close</h3></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2878067"></a>Request</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">POL_HND</span></dt><dd><p>policy handle to be closed</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2878094"></a>Response</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">POL_HND</span></dt><dd><p>0s - closed policy handle (all zeros)</p></dd></dl></div><p>return 0 - indicates success</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2878126"></a>LSA Lookup SIDS</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note: num_entries in response must be same as num_entries in request.</em></span></p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2878139"></a>Request</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">POL_HND</span></dt><dd><p>LSA policy handle</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>num_entries</p></dd><dt><span class="term">VOID*</span></dt><dd><p>undocumented domain SID buffer pointer</p></dd><dt><span class="term">VOID*</span></dt><dd><p>undocumented domain name buffer pointer</p></dd><dt><span class="term">VOID*[num_entries] undocumented domain SID pointers to be looked up.
+</span></dt><dd><p>DOM_SID[num_entries] domain SIDs to be looked up.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">char[16]</span></dt><dd><p>completely undocumented 16 bytes.</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2878239"></a>Response</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">DOM_REF</span></dt><dd><p>domain reference response</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>num_entries (listed above)</p></dd><dt><span class="term">VOID*</span></dt><dd><p>undocumented buffer pointer</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>num_entries (listed above)</p></dd><dt><span class="term">DOM_SID2[num_entries]</span></dt><dd><p>domain SIDs (from Request, listed above).</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>num_entries (listed above)</p></dd></dl></div><p>return 0 - indicates success</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2878335"></a>LSA Lookup Names</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note: num_entries in response must be same as num_entries in request.</em></span></p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2878349"></a>Request</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">POL_HND</span></dt><dd><p>LSA policy handle</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>num_entries</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>num_entries</p></dd><dt><span class="term">VOID*</span></dt><dd><p>undocumented domain SID buffer pointer</p></dd><dt><span class="term">VOID*</span></dt><dd><p>undocumented domain name buffer pointer</p></dd><dt><span class="term">NAME[num_entries]</span></dt><dd><p>names to be looked up.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">char[]</span></dt><dd><p>undocumented bytes - falsely translated SID structure?</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2878463"></a>Response</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">DOM_REF</span></dt><dd><p>domain reference response</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>num_entries (listed above)</p></dd><dt><span class="term">VOID*</span></dt><dd><p>undocumented buffer pointer</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>num_entries (listed above)</p></dd><dt><span class="term">DOM_RID[num_entries]</span></dt><dd><p>domain SIDs (from Request, listed above).</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>num_entries (listed above)</p></dd></dl></div><p>return 0 - indicates success</p></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2878561"></a>NETLOGON rpc Transact Named Pipe</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>The sequence of actions taken on this pipe are:</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td>tablish a connection to the IPC$ share (SMBtconX). use encrypted passwords.</td></tr><tr><td>en an RPC Pipe with the name &quot;\\PIPE\\NETLOGON&quot;. Store the file handle.</td></tr><tr><td>ing the file handle, send a Set Named Pipe Handle state to 0x4300.</td></tr><tr><td>eate Client Challenge. Send LSA Request Challenge. Store Server Challenge.</td></tr><tr><td>lculate Session Key. Send an LSA Auth 2 Challenge. Store Auth2 Challenge.</td></tr><tr><td>lc/Verify Client Creds. Send LSA Srv PW Set. Calc/Verify Server Creds.</td></tr><tr><td>lc/Verify Client Creds. Send LSA SAM Logon . Calc/Verify Server Creds.</td></tr><tr><td>lc/Verify Client Creds. Send LSA SAM Logoff. Calc/Verify Server Creds.</td></tr><tr><td>ose the IPC$ share.</td></tr></table><p>Defines for this pipe, identifying the query are</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">LSA Request Challenge:</span></dt><dd><p>0x04</p></dd><dt><span class="term">LSA Server Password Set:</span></dt><dd><p>0x06</p></dd><dt><span class="term">LSA SAM Logon:</span></dt><dd><p>0x02</p></dd><dt><span class="term">LSA SAM Logoff:</span></dt><dd><p>0x03</p></dd><dt><span class="term">LSA Auth 2:</span></dt><dd><p>0x0f</p></dd><dt><span class="term">LSA Logon Control:</span></dt><dd><p>0x0e</p></dd></dl></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2878722"></a>LSA Request Challenge</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note: logon server name starts with two '\' characters and is upper case.</em></span></p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note: logon client is the machine, not the user.</em></span></p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note: the initial LanManager password hash, against which the challenge is issued, is the machine name itself (lower case). there will becalls issued (LSA Server Password Set) which will change this, later. refusing these calls allows you to always deal with the same password (i.e the LM# of the machine name in lower case).</em></span></p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2878754"></a>Request</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">VOID*</span></dt><dd><p>undocumented buffer pointer</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNISTR2</span></dt><dd><p>logon server unicode string</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNISTR2</span></dt><dd><p>logon client unicode string</p></dd><dt><span class="term">char[8]</span></dt><dd><p>client challenge</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2878824"></a>Response</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">char[8]</span></dt><dd><p>server challenge</p></dd></dl></div><p>return 0 - indicates success</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2878856"></a>LSA Authenticate 2</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note: in between request and response, calculate the client credentials, and check them against the client-calculated credentials (this process uses the previously received client credentials).</em></span></p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note: neg_flags in the response is the same as that in the request.</em></span></p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note: you must take a copy of the client-calculated credentials received here, because they will be used in subsequent authentication packets.</em></span></p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2878887"></a>Request</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">LOG_INFO</span></dt><dd><p>client identification info</p></dd><dt><span class="term">char[8]</span></dt><dd><p>client-calculated credentials</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT8[]</span></dt><dd><p>padding to 4-byte align with start of SMB header.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>neg_flags - negotiated flags (usual value is 0x0000 01ff)</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2878956"></a>Response</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">char[8]</span></dt><dd><p>server credentials.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>neg_flags - same as neg_flags in request.</p></dd></dl></div><p>return 0 - indicates success. failure value unknown.</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2879004"></a>LSA Server Password Set</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note: the new password is suspected to be a DES encryption using the old password to generate the key.</em></span></p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note: in between request and response, calculate the client credentials, and check them against the client-calculated credentials (this process uses the previously received client credentials).</em></span></p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note: the server credentials are constructed from the client-calculated credentials and the client time + 1 second.</em></span></p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note: you must take a copy of the client-calculated credentials received here, because they will be used in subsequent authentication packets.</em></span></p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2879043"></a>Request</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">CLNT_INFO</span></dt><dd><p>client identification/authentication info</p></dd><dt><span class="term">char[]</span></dt><dd><p>new password - undocumented.</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2879085"></a>Response</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">CREDS</span></dt><dd><p>server credentials. server time stamp appears to be ignored.</p></dd></dl></div><p>return 0 - indicates success; 0xC000 006a indicates failure</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2879119"></a>LSA SAM Logon</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p><span class="emphasis"><em>
+Note: valid_user is True iff the username and password hash are valid for
+ the requested domain.
+</em></span></p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2879133"></a>Request</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">SAM_INFO</span></dt><dd><p>sam_id structure</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2879161"></a>Response</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">VOID*</span></dt><dd><p>undocumented buffer pointer</p></dd><dt><span class="term">CREDS</span></dt><dd><p>server credentials. server time stamp appears to be ignored.</p></dd></dl></div><pre class="programlisting">
+if (valid_user)
{
UINT16 3 - switch value indicating USER_INFO structure.
VOID* non-zero - pointer to USER_INFO structure
@@ -6896,1325 +1315,117 @@ else
UINT32 1 - Authoritative response; 0 - Non-Auth?
return 0xC000 0064 - NT_STATUS_NO_SUCH_USER.
-}</PRE
-></P
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><HR><H3
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN2359"
-></A
->9.4.5. LSA SAM Logoff</H3
-><P
-><SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->Note: presumably, the SAM_INFO structure is validated, and a (currently
- undocumented) error code returned if the Logoff is invalid.</I
-></SPAN
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><HR><H4
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><A
-NAME="AEN2363"
-></A
->9.4.5.1. Request</H4
-><P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
->SAM_INFO</DT
-><DD
-><P
->sam_id structure</P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><HR><H4
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><A
-NAME="AEN2370"
-></A
->9.4.5.2. Response</H4
-><P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
->VOID*</DT
-><DD
-><P
->undocumented buffer pointer</P
-></DD
-><DT
->CREDS</DT
-><DD
-><P
->server credentials. server time stamp appears to be ignored.</P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-><P
->return 0 - indicates success. undocumented failure indication.</P
-></DIV
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><HR><H2
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN2382"
-></A
->9.5. \\MAILSLOT\NET\NTLOGON</H2
-><P
-><SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->Note: mailslots will contain a response mailslot, to which the response
- should be sent. the target NetBIOS name is REQUEST_NAME&#60;20&#62;, where
- REQUEST_NAME is the name of the machine that sent the request.</I
-></SPAN
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><HR><H3
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN2386"
-></A
->9.5.1. Query for PDC</H3
-><P
-><SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->Note: NTversion, LMNTtoken, LM20token in response are the same as those given in the request.</I
-></SPAN
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><HR><H4
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><A
-NAME="AEN2390"
-></A
->9.5.1.1. Request</H4
-><P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
->UINT16</DT
-><DD
-><P
->0x0007 - Query for PDC</P
-></DD
-><DT
->STR</DT
-><DD
-><P
->machine name</P
-></DD
-><DT
->STR</DT
-><DD
-><P
->response mailslot</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT8[]</DT
-><DD
-><P
->padding to 2-byte align with start of mailslot.</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UNISTR</DT
-><DD
-><P
->machine name</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT32</DT
-><DD
-><P
->NTversion</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT16</DT
-><DD
-><P
->LMNTtoken</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT16</DT
-><DD
-><P
->LM20token</P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><HR><H4
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><A
-NAME="AEN2425"
-></A
->9.5.1.2. Response</H4
-><P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
->UINT16</DT
-><DD
-><P
->0x000A - Respose to Query for PDC</P
-></DD
-><DT
->STR</DT
-><DD
-><P
->machine name (in uppercase)</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT8[]</DT
-><DD
-><P
->padding to 2-byte align with start of mailslot.</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UNISTR</DT
-><DD
-><P
->machine name</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UNISTR</DT
-><DD
-><P
->domain name</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT32</DT
-><DD
-><P
->NTversion (same as received in request)</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT16</DT
-><DD
-><P
->LMNTtoken (same as received in request)</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT16</DT
-><DD
-><P
->LM20token (same as received in request)</P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><HR><H3
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN2460"
-></A
->9.5.2. SAM Logon</H3
-><P
-><SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->Note: machine name in response is preceded by two '\' characters.</I
-></SPAN
-></P
-><P
-><SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->Note: NTversion, LMNTtoken, LM20token in response are the same as those given in the request.</I
-></SPAN
-></P
-><P
-><SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->Note: user name in the response is presumably the same as that in the request.</I
-></SPAN
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><HR><H4
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><A
-NAME="AEN2468"
-></A
->9.5.2.1. Request</H4
-><P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
->UINT16</DT
-><DD
-><P
->0x0012 - SAM Logon</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT16</DT
-><DD
-><P
->request count</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UNISTR</DT
-><DD
-><P
->machine name</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UNISTR</DT
-><DD
-><P
->user name</P
-></DD
-><DT
->STR</DT
-><DD
-><P
->response mailslot</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT32</DT
-><DD
-><P
->alloweable account</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT32</DT
-><DD
-><P
->domain SID size</P
-></DD
-><DT
->char[sid_size]</DT
-><DD
-><P
->domain SID, of sid_size bytes.</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT8[]</DT
-><DD
-><P
->???? padding to 4? 2? -byte align with start of mailslot.</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT32</DT
-><DD
-><P
->NTversion</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT16</DT
-><DD
-><P
->LMNTtoken</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT16</DT
-><DD
-><P
->LM20token</P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><HR><H4
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><A
-NAME="AEN2519"
-></A
->9.5.2.2. Response</H4
-><P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
->UINT16</DT
-><DD
-><P
->0x0013 - Response to SAM Logon</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UNISTR</DT
-><DD
-><P
->machine name</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UNISTR</DT
-><DD
-><P
->user name - workstation trust account</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UNISTR</DT
-><DD
-><P
->domain name </P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT32</DT
-><DD
-><P
->NTversion</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT16</DT
-><DD
-><P
->LMNTtoken</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT16</DT
-><DD
-><P
->LM20token</P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-></DIV
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><HR><H2
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN2550"
-></A
->9.6. SRVSVC Transact Named Pipe</H2
-><P
->Defines for this pipe, identifying the query are:</P
-><P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
->Net Share Enum</DT
-><DD
-><P
->0x0f</P
-></DD
-><DT
->Net Server Get Info</DT
-><DD
-><P
->0x15</P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><HR><H3
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN2562"
-></A
->9.6.1. Net Share Enum</H3
-><P
-><SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->Note: share level and switch value in the response are presumably the same as those in the request.</I
-></SPAN
-></P
-><P
-><SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->Note: cifsrap2.txt (section 5) may be of limited assistance here.</I
-></SPAN
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><HR><H4
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><A
-NAME="AEN2568"
-></A
->9.6.1.1. Request</H4
-><P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
->VOID*</DT
-><DD
-><P
->pointer (to server name?)</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UNISTR2</DT
-><DD
-><P
->server name</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT8[]</DT
-><DD
-><P
->padding to get unicode string 4-byte aligned with the start of the SMB header.</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT32</DT
-><DD
-><P
->share level</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT32</DT
-><DD
-><P
->switch value</P
-></DD
-><DT
->VOID*</DT
-><DD
-><P
->pointer to SHARE_INFO_1_CTR</P
-></DD
-><DT
->SHARE_INFO_1_CTR</DT
-><DD
-><P
->share info with 0 entries</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT32</DT
-><DD
-><P
->preferred maximum length (0xffff ffff)</P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><HR><H4
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><A
-NAME="AEN2603"
-></A
->9.6.1.2. Response</H4
-><P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
->UINT32</DT
-><DD
-><P
->share level</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT32</DT
-><DD
-><P
->switch value</P
-></DD
-><DT
->VOID*</DT
-><DD
-><P
->pointer to SHARE_INFO_1_CTR</P
-></DD
-><DT
->SHARE_INFO_1_CTR</DT
-><DD
-><P
->share info (only added if share info ptr is non-zero)</P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-><P
->return 0 - indicates success</P
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><HR><H3
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN2623"
-></A
->9.6.2. Net Server Get Info</H3
-><P
-><SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->Note: level is the same value as in the request.</I
-></SPAN
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><HR><H4
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><A
-NAME="AEN2627"
-></A
->9.6.2.1. Request</H4
-><P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
->UNISTR2</DT
-><DD
-><P
->server name</P
-></DD
-><DT
->UINT32</DT
-><DD
-><P
->switch level</P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><HR><H4
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><A
-NAME="AEN2638"
-></A
->9.6.2.2. Response</H4
-><P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
->UINT32</DT
-><DD
-><P
->switch level</P
-></DD
-><DT
->VOID*</DT
-><DD
-><P
->pointer to SERVER_INFO_101</P
-></DD
-><DT
->SERVER_INFO_101</DT
-><DD
-><P
->server info (only added if server info ptr is non-zero)</P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-><P
->return 0 - indicates success</P
-></DIV
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><HR><H2
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN2654"
-></A
->9.7. Cryptographic side of NT Domain Authentication</H2
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><H3
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN2656"
-></A
->9.7.1. Definitions</H3
-><P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
->Add(A1,A2)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Intel byte ordered addition of corresponding 4 byte words in arrays A1 and A2</P
-></DD
-><DT
->E(K,D)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->DES ECB encryption of 8 byte data D using 7 byte key K</P
-></DD
-><DT
->lmowf()</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Lan man hash</P
-></DD
-><DT
->ntowf()</DT
-><DD
-><P
->NT hash</P
-></DD
-><DT
->PW</DT
-><DD
-><P
->md4(machine_password) == md4(lsadump $machine.acc) ==
-pwdump(machine$) (initially) == md4(lmowf(unicode(machine)))</P
-></DD
-><DT
->ARC4(K,Lk,D,Ld)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->ARC4 encryption of data D of length Ld with key K of length Lk</P
-></DD
-><DT
->v[m..n(,l)]</DT
-><DD
-><P
->subset of v from bytes m to n, optionally padded with zeroes to length l</P
-></DD
-><DT
->Cred(K,D)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->E(K[7..7,7],E(K[0..6],D)) computes a credential</P
-></DD
-><DT
->Time()</DT
-><DD
-><P
->4 byte current time</P
-></DD
-><DT
->Cc,Cs</DT
-><DD
-><P
->8 byte client and server challenges Rc,Rs: 8 byte client and server credentials</P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><HR><H3
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN2699"
-></A
->9.7.2. Protocol</H3
-><P
->C-&#62;S ReqChal,Cc S-&#62;C Cs</P
-><P
->C &#38; S compute session key Ks = E(PW[9..15],E(PW[0..6],Add(Cc,Cs)))</P
-><P
->C: Rc = Cred(Ks,Cc) C-&#62;S Authenticate,Rc S: Rs = Cred(Ks,Cs),
-assert(Rc == Cred(Ks,Cc)) S-&#62;C Rs C: assert(Rs == Cred(Ks,Cs))</P
-><P
->On joining the domain the client will optionally attempt to change its
+}
+</pre></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2879232"></a>LSA SAM Logoff</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p><span class="emphasis"><em>
+Note: presumably, the SAM_INFO structure is validated, and a (currently
+ undocumented) error code returned if the Logoff is invalid.
+</em></span></p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2879247"></a>Request</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">SAM_INFO</span></dt><dd><p>sam_id structure</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2879274"></a>Response</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">VOID*</span></dt><dd><p>undocumented buffer pointer</p></dd><dt><span class="term">CREDS</span></dt><dd><p>server credentials. server time stamp appears to be ignored.</p></dd></dl></div><p>return 0 - indicates success. undocumented failure indication.</p></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2879324"></a>\\MAILSLOT\NET\NTLOGON</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p><span class="emphasis"><em>
+Note: mailslots will contain a response mailslot, to which the response
+ should be sent. the target NetBIOS name is REQUEST_NAME&lt;20&gt;, where
+ REQUEST_NAME is the name of the machine that sent the request.
+</em></span></p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2879336"></a>Query for PDC</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note: NTversion, LMNTtoken, LM20token in response are the same as those given in the request.</em></span></p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2879356"></a>Request</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">UINT16</span></dt><dd><p>0x0007 - Query for PDC</p></dd><dt><span class="term">STR</span></dt><dd><p>machine name</p></dd><dt><span class="term">STR</span></dt><dd><p>response mailslot</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT8[]</span></dt><dd><p>padding to 2-byte align with start of mailslot.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNISTR</span></dt><dd><p>machine name</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>NTversion</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT16</span></dt><dd><p>LMNTtoken</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT16</span></dt><dd><p>LM20token</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2879483"></a>Response</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">UINT16</span></dt><dd><p>0x000A - Respose to Query for PDC</p></dd><dt><span class="term">STR</span></dt><dd><p>machine name (in uppercase)</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT8[]</span></dt><dd><p>padding to 2-byte align with start of mailslot.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNISTR</span></dt><dd><p>machine name</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNISTR</span></dt><dd><p>domain name</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>NTversion (same as received in request)</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT16</span></dt><dd><p>LMNTtoken (same as received in request)</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT16</span></dt><dd><p>LM20token (same as received in request)</p></dd></dl></div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2879604"></a>SAM Logon</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note: machine name in response is preceded by two '\' characters.</em></span></p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note: NTversion, LMNTtoken, LM20token in response are the same as those given in the request.</em></span></p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note: user name in the response is presumably the same as that in the request.</em></span></p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2879632"></a>Request</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">UINT16</span></dt><dd><p>0x0012 - SAM Logon</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT16</span></dt><dd><p>request count</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNISTR</span></dt><dd><p>machine name</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNISTR</span></dt><dd><p>user name</p></dd><dt><span class="term">STR</span></dt><dd><p>response mailslot</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>alloweable account</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>domain SID size</p></dd><dt><span class="term">char[sid_size]</span></dt><dd><p>domain SID, of sid_size bytes.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT8[]</span></dt><dd><p>???? padding to 4? 2? -byte align with start of mailslot.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>NTversion</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT16</span></dt><dd><p>LMNTtoken</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT16</span></dt><dd><p>LM20token</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2879815"></a>Response</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">UINT16</span></dt><dd><p>0x0013 - Response to SAM Logon</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNISTR</span></dt><dd><p>machine name</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNISTR</span></dt><dd><p>user name - workstation trust account</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNISTR</span></dt><dd><p>domain name </p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>NTversion</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT16</span></dt><dd><p>LMNTtoken</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT16</span></dt><dd><p>LM20token</p></dd></dl></div></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2879929"></a>SRVSVC Transact Named Pipe</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>Defines for this pipe, identifying the query are:</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">Net Share Enum</span></dt><dd><p>0x0f</p></dd><dt><span class="term">Net Server Get Info</span></dt><dd><p>0x15</p></dd></dl></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2879974"></a>Net Share Enum</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note: share level and switch value in the response are presumably the same as those in the request.</em></span></p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note: cifsrap2.txt (section 5) may be of limited assistance here.</em></span></p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2879995"></a>Request</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">VOID*</span></dt><dd><p>pointer (to server name?)</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNISTR2</span></dt><dd><p>server name</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT8[]</span></dt><dd><p>padding to get unicode string 4-byte aligned with the start of the SMB header.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>share level</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>switch value</p></dd><dt><span class="term">VOID*</span></dt><dd><p>pointer to SHARE_INFO_1_CTR</p></dd><dt><span class="term">SHARE_INFO_1_CTR</span></dt><dd><p>share info with 0 entries</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>preferred maximum length (0xffff ffff)</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2880120"></a>Response</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>share level</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>switch value</p></dd><dt><span class="term">VOID*</span></dt><dd><p>pointer to SHARE_INFO_1_CTR</p></dd><dt><span class="term">SHARE_INFO_1_CTR</span></dt><dd><p>share info (only added if share info ptr is non-zero)</p></dd></dl></div><p>return 0 - indicates success</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2880194"></a>Net Server Get Info</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note: level is the same value as in the request.</em></span></p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2880207"></a>Request</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">UNISTR2</span></dt><dd><p>server name</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>switch level</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2880248"></a>Response</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>switch level</p></dd><dt><span class="term">VOID*</span></dt><dd><p>pointer to SERVER_INFO_101</p></dd><dt><span class="term">SERVER_INFO_101</span></dt><dd><p>server info (only added if server info ptr is non-zero)</p></dd></dl></div><p>return 0 - indicates success</p></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2880310"></a>Cryptographic side of NT Domain Authentication</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2880318"></a>Definitions</h3></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">Add(A1,A2)</span></dt><dd><p>Intel byte ordered addition of corresponding 4 byte words in arrays A1 and A2</p></dd><dt><span class="term">E(K,D)</span></dt><dd><p>DES ECB encryption of 8 byte data D using 7 byte key K</p></dd><dt><span class="term">lmowf()</span></dt><dd><p>Lan man hash</p></dd><dt><span class="term">ntowf()</span></dt><dd><p>NT hash</p></dd><dt><span class="term">PW</span></dt><dd><p>md4(machine_password) == md4(lsadump $machine.acc) ==
+pwdump(machine$) (initially) == md4(lmowf(unicode(machine)))
+</p></dd><dt><span class="term">ARC4(K,Lk,D,Ld)</span></dt><dd><p>ARC4 encryption of data D of length Ld with key K of length Lk</p></dd><dt><span class="term">v[m..n(,l)]</span></dt><dd><p>subset of v from bytes m to n, optionally padded with zeroes to length l</p></dd><dt><span class="term">Cred(K,D)</span></dt><dd><p>E(K[7..7,7],E(K[0..6],D)) computes a credential</p></dd><dt><span class="term">Time()</span></dt><dd><p>4 byte current time</p></dd><dt><span class="term">Cc,Cs</span></dt><dd><p>8 byte client and server challenges Rc,Rs: 8 byte client and server credentials</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2880480"></a>Protocol</h3></div></div><div></div></div><pre class="programlisting">
+C-&gt;S ReqChal,Cc
+S-&gt;C Cs
+</pre><pre class="programlisting">
+C &amp; S compute session key Ks = E(PW[9..15],E(PW[0..6],Add(Cc,Cs)))
+</pre><pre class="programlisting">
+C: Rc = Cred(Ks,Cc)
+C-&gt;S Authenticate,Rc
+S: Rs = Cred(Ks,Cs), assert(Rc == Cred(Ks,Cc))
+S-&gt;C Rs
+C: assert(Rs == Cred(Ks,Cs))
+</pre><p>
+On joining the domain the client will optionally attempt to change its
password and the domain controller may refuse to update it depending
-on registry settings. This will also occur weekly afterwards.</P
-><P
->C: Tc = Time(), Rc' = Cred(Ks,Rc+Tc) C-&#62;S ServerPasswordSet,Rc',Tc,
-arc4(Ks[0..7,16],lmowf(randompassword()) C: Rc = Cred(Ks,Rc+Tc+1) S:
-assert(Rc' == Cred(Ks,Rc+Tc)), Ts = Time() S: Rs' = Cred(Ks,Rs+Tc+1)
-S-&#62;C Rs',Ts C: assert(Rs' == Cred(Ks,Rs+Tc+1)) S: Rs = Rs'</P
-><P
->User: U with password P wishes to login to the domain (incidental data
-such as workstation and domain omitted)</P
-><P
->C: Tc = Time(), Rc' = Cred(Ks,Rc+Tc) C-&#62;S NetLogonSamLogon,Rc',Tc,U,
-arc4(Ks[0..7,16],16,ntowf(P),16), arc4(Ks[0..7,16],16,lmowf(P),16) S:
-assert(Rc' == Cred(Ks,Rc+Tc)) assert(passwords match those in SAM) S:
-Ts = Time()</P
-><P
->S-&#62;C Cred(Ks,Cred(Ks,Rc+Tc+1)),userinfo(logon script,UID,SIDs,etc) C:
-assert(Rs == Cred(Ks,Cred(Rc+Tc+1)) C: Rc = Cred(Ks,Rc+Tc+1)</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><HR><H3
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN2709"
-></A
->9.7.3. Comments</H3
-><P
->On first joining the domain the session key could be computed by
+on registry settings. This will also occur weekly afterwards.
+</p><pre class="programlisting">
+C: Tc = Time(), Rc' = Cred(Ks,Rc+Tc)
+C-&gt;S ServerPasswordSet,Rc',Tc,arc4(Ks[0..7,16],lmowf(randompassword())
+C: Rc = Cred(Ks,Rc+Tc+1)
+S: assert(Rc' == Cred(Ks,Rc+Tc)), Ts = Time()
+S: Rs' = Cred(Ks,Rs+Tc+1)
+S-&gt;C Rs',Ts
+C: assert(Rs' == Cred(Ks,Rs+Tc+1))
+S: Rs = Rs'
+</pre><p>
+User: U with password P wishes to login to the domain (incidental data
+such as workstation and domain omitted)
+</p><pre class="programlisting">
+C: Tc = Time(), Rc' = Cred(Ks,Rc+Tc)
+C-&gt;S NetLogonSamLogon,Rc',Tc,U,arc4(Ks[0..7,16],16,ntowf(P),16), arc4(Ks[0..7,16],16,lmowf(P),16)
+S: assert(Rc' == Cred(Ks,Rc+Tc)) assert(passwords match those in SAM)
+S: Ts = Time()
+</pre><pre class="programlisting">
+S-&gt;C Cred(Ks,Cred(Ks,Rc+Tc+1)),userinfo(logon script,UID,SIDs,etc)
+C: assert(Rs == Cred(Ks,Cred(Rc+Tc+1))
+C: Rc = Cred(Ks,Rc+Tc+1)
+</pre></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2880577"></a>Comments</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+On first joining the domain the session key could be computed by
anyone listening in on the network as the machine password has a well
known value. Until the machine is rebooted it will use this session
key to encrypt NT and LM one way functions of passwords which are
password equivalents. Any user who logs in before the machine has been
rebooted a second time will have their password equivalent exposed. Of
-course the new machine password is exposed at this time anyway.</P
-><P
->None of the returned user info such as logon script, profile path and
-SIDs *appear* to be protected by anything other than the TCP checksum.</P
-><P
->The server time stamps appear to be ignored.</P
-><P
->The client sends a ReturnAuthenticator in the SamLogon request which I
+course the new machine password is exposed at this time anyway.
+</p><p>
+None of the returned user info such as logon script, profile path and
+SIDs *appear* to be protected by anything other than the TCP checksum.
+</p><p>
+The server time stamps appear to be ignored.
+</p><p>
+The client sends a ReturnAuthenticator in the SamLogon request which I
can't find a use for. However its time is used as the timestamp
-returned by the server.</P
-><P
->The password OWFs should NOT be sent over the network reversibly
+returned by the server.
+</p><p>
+The password OWFs should NOT be sent over the network reversibly
encrypted. They should be sent using ARC4(Ks,md4(owf)) with the server
-computing the same function using the owf values in the SAM.</P
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><HR><H2
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN2716"
-></A
->9.8. SIDs and RIDs</H2
-><P
->SIDs and RIDs are well documented elsewhere.</P
-><P
->A SID is an NT Security ID (see DOM_SID structure). They are of the form:</P
-><P
-></P
-><TABLE
-BORDER="0"
-><TBODY
-><TR
-><TD
->revision-NN-SubAuth1-SubAuth2-SubAuth3... </TD
-></TR
-><TR
-><TD
->revision-0xNNNNNNNNNNNN-SubAuth1-SubAuth2-SubAuth3...</TD
-></TR
-></TBODY
-></TABLE
-><P
-></P
-><P
->currently, the SID revision is 1.
-The Sub-Authorities are known as Relative IDs (RIDs).</P
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><HR><H3
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN2724"
-></A
->9.8.1. Well-known SIDs</H3
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><H4
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><A
-NAME="AEN2726"
-></A
->9.8.1.1. Universal well-known SIDs</H4
-><P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
->Null SID</DT
-><DD
-><P
->S-1-0-0</P
-></DD
-><DT
->World</DT
-><DD
-><P
->S-1-1-0</P
-></DD
-><DT
->Local</DT
-><DD
-><P
->S-1-2-0</P
-></DD
-><DT
->Creator Owner ID</DT
-><DD
-><P
->S-1-3-0</P
-></DD
-><DT
->Creator Group ID</DT
-><DD
-><P
->S-1-3-1</P
-></DD
-><DT
->Creator Owner Server ID</DT
-><DD
-><P
->S-1-3-2</P
-></DD
-><DT
->Creator Group Server ID</DT
-><DD
-><P
->S-1-3-3</P
-></DD
-><DT
->(Non-unique IDs)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->S-1-4</P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><HR><H4
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><A
-NAME="AEN2761"
-></A
->9.8.1.2. NT well-known SIDs</H4
-><P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
->NT Authority</DT
-><DD
-><P
->S-1-5</P
-></DD
-><DT
->Dialup</DT
-><DD
-><P
->S-1-5-1</P
-></DD
-><DT
->Network</DT
-><DD
-><P
->S-1-5-2</P
-></DD
-><DT
->Batch</DT
-><DD
-><P
->S-1-5-3</P
-></DD
-><DT
->Interactive</DT
-><DD
-><P
->S-1-5-4</P
-></DD
-><DT
->Service</DT
-><DD
-><P
->S-1-5-6</P
-></DD
-><DT
->AnonymousLogon(aka null logon session)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->S-1-5-7</P
-></DD
-><DT
->Proxy</DT
-><DD
-><P
->S-1-5-8</P
-></DD
-><DT
->ServerLogon(aka domain controller account)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->S-1-5-8</P
-></DD
-><DT
->(Logon IDs)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->S-1-5-5-X-Y</P
-></DD
-><DT
->(NT non-unique IDs)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->S-1-5-0x15-...</P
-></DD
-><DT
->(Built-in domain)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->s-1-5-0x20</P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><HR><H3
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN2812"
-></A
->9.8.2. Well-known RIDS</H3
-><P
->A RID is a sub-authority value, as part of either a SID, or in the case
+computing the same function using the owf values in the SAM.
+</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2880626"></a>SIDs and RIDs</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+SIDs and RIDs are well documented elsewhere.
+</p><p>
+A SID is an NT Security ID (see DOM_SID structure). They are of the form:
+</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td>revision-NN-SubAuth1-SubAuth2-SubAuth3... </td></tr><tr><td>revision-0xNNNNNNNNNNNN-SubAuth1-SubAuth2-SubAuth3...</td></tr></table><p>
+currently, the SID revision is 1.
+The Sub-Authorities are known as Relative IDs (RIDs).
+</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2880666"></a>Well-known SIDs</h3></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2880673"></a>Universal well-known SIDs</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">Null SID</span></dt><dd><p>S-1-0-0</p></dd><dt><span class="term">World</span></dt><dd><p>S-1-1-0</p></dd><dt><span class="term">Local</span></dt><dd><p>S-1-2-0</p></dd><dt><span class="term">Creator Owner ID</span></dt><dd><p>S-1-3-0</p></dd><dt><span class="term">Creator Group ID</span></dt><dd><p>S-1-3-1</p></dd><dt><span class="term">Creator Owner Server ID</span></dt><dd><p>S-1-3-2</p></dd><dt><span class="term">Creator Group Server ID</span></dt><dd><p>S-1-3-3</p></dd><dt><span class="term">(Non-unique IDs)</span></dt><dd><p>S-1-4</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2880800"></a>NT well-known SIDs</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">NT Authority</span></dt><dd><p>S-1-5</p></dd><dt><span class="term">Dialup</span></dt><dd><p>S-1-5-1</p></dd><dt><span class="term">Network</span></dt><dd><p>S-1-5-2</p></dd><dt><span class="term">Batch</span></dt><dd><p>S-1-5-3</p></dd><dt><span class="term">Interactive</span></dt><dd><p>S-1-5-4</p></dd><dt><span class="term">Service</span></dt><dd><p>S-1-5-6</p></dd><dt><span class="term">AnonymousLogon(aka null logon session)</span></dt><dd><p>S-1-5-7</p></dd><dt><span class="term">Proxy</span></dt><dd><p>S-1-5-8</p></dd><dt><span class="term">ServerLogon(aka domain controller account)</span></dt><dd><p>S-1-5-8</p></dd><dt><span class="term">(Logon IDs)</span></dt><dd><p>S-1-5-5-X-Y</p></dd><dt><span class="term">(NT non-unique IDs)</span></dt><dd><p>S-1-5-0x15-...</p></dd><dt><span class="term">(Built-in domain)</span></dt><dd><p>s-1-5-0x20</p></dd></dl></div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2880981"></a>Well-known RIDS</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+A RID is a sub-authority value, as part of either a SID, or in the case
of Group RIDs, part of the DOM_GID structure, in the USER_INFO_1
-structure, in the LSA SAM Logon response.</P
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><HR><H4
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><A
-NAME="AEN2815"
-></A
->9.8.2.1. Well-known RID users</H4
-><P
-><B
->Groupname: </B
->DOMAIN_USER_RID_ADMIN</P
-><P
-><B
->????: </B
->0x0000</P
-><P
-><B
->RID: </B
->01F4</P
-><P
-><B
->Groupname: </B
->DOMAIN_USER_RID_GUEST</P
-><P
-><B
->????: </B
->0x0000</P
-><P
-><B
->RID: </B
->01F5</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><HR><H4
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><A
-NAME="AEN2829"
-></A
->9.8.2.2. Well-known RID groups</H4
-><P
-><B
->Groupname: </B
-> DOMAIN_GROUP_RID_ADMINS</P
-><P
-><B
->????: </B
->0x0000</P
-><P
-><B
->RID: </B
->0200</P
-><P
-><B
->Groupname: </B
-> DOMAIN_GROUP_RID_USERS</P
-><P
-><B
->????: </B
->0x0000</P
-><P
-><B
->RID: </B
->0201</P
-><P
-><B
->Groupname: </B
-> DOMAIN_GROUP_RID_GUESTS</P
-><P
-><B
->????: </B
->0x0000</P
-><P
-><B
->RID: </B
->0202</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><HR><H4
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><A
-NAME="AEN2847"
-></A
->9.8.2.3. Well-known RID aliases</H4
-><P
-><B
->Groupname: </B
-> DOMAIN_ALIAS_RID_ADMINS</P
-><P
-><B
->????: </B
->0x0000</P
-><P
-><B
->RID: </B
->0220</P
-><P
-><B
->Groupname: </B
-> DOMAIN_ALIAS_RID_USERS</P
-><P
-><B
->????: </B
->0x0000</P
-><P
-><B
->RID: </B
->0221</P
-><P
-><B
->Groupname: </B
-> DOMAIN_ALIAS_RID_GUESTS</P
-><P
-><B
->????: </B
->0x0000</P
-><P
-><B
->RID: </B
->0222</P
-><P
-><B
->Groupname: </B
-> DOMAIN_ALIAS_RID_POWER_USERS</P
-><P
-><B
->????: </B
->0x0000</P
-><P
-><B
->RID: </B
->0223</P
-><P
-><B
->Groupname: </B
-> DOMAIN_ALIAS_RID_ACCOUNT_OPS</P
-><P
-><B
->????: </B
->0x0000</P
-><P
-><B
->RID: </B
->0224</P
-><P
-><B
->Groupname: </B
-> DOMAIN_ALIAS_RID_SYSTEM_OPS</P
-><P
-><B
->????: </B
->0x0000</P
-><P
-><B
->RID: </B
->0225</P
-><P
-><B
->Groupname: </B
-> DOMAIN_ALIAS_RID_PRINT_OPS</P
-><P
-><B
->????: </B
->0x0000</P
-><P
-><B
->RID: </B
->0226</P
-><P
-><B
->Groupname: </B
-> DOMAIN_ALIAS_RID_BACKUP_OPS</P
-><P
-><B
->????: </B
->0x0000</P
-><P
-><B
->RID: </B
->0227</P
-><P
-><B
->Groupname: </B
-> DOMAIN_ALIAS_RID_REPLICATOR</P
-><P
-><B
->????: </B
->0x0000</P
-><P
-><B
->RID: </B
->0228</P
-></DIV
-></DIV
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="CHAPTER"
-><HR><H1
-><A
-NAME="PRINTING"
-></A
->Chapter 10. Samba Printing Internals</H1
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><H2
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN2896"
-></A
->10.1. Abstract</H2
-><P
->The purpose of this document is to provide some insight into
+structure, in the LSA SAM Logon response.
+</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2880995"></a>Well-known RID users</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="segmentedlist"><p><b>Groupname: </b>DOMAIN_USER_RID_ADMIN</p><p><b>????: </b>0x0000</p><p><b>RID: </b>01F4</p><p><b>Groupname: </b>DOMAIN_USER_RID_GUEST</p><p><b>????: </b>0x0000</p><p><b>RID: </b>01F5</p></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2881044"></a>Well-known RID groups</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="segmentedlist"><p><b>Groupname: </b> DOMAIN_GROUP_RID_ADMINS</p><p><b>????: </b>0x0000</p><p><b>RID: </b>0200</p><p><b>Groupname: </b> DOMAIN_GROUP_RID_USERS</p><p><b>????: </b>0x0000</p><p><b>RID: </b>0201</p><p><b>Groupname: </b> DOMAIN_GROUP_RID_GUESTS</p><p><b>????: </b>0x0000</p><p><b>RID: </b>0202</p></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2881103"></a>Well-known RID aliases</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="segmentedlist"><p><b>Groupname: </b> DOMAIN_ALIAS_RID_ADMINS</p><p><b>????: </b>0x0000</p><p><b>RID: </b>0220</p><p><b>Groupname: </b> DOMAIN_ALIAS_RID_USERS</p><p><b>????: </b>0x0000</p><p><b>RID: </b>0221</p><p><b>Groupname: </b> DOMAIN_ALIAS_RID_GUESTS</p><p><b>????: </b>0x0000</p><p><b>RID: </b>0222</p><p><b>Groupname: </b> DOMAIN_ALIAS_RID_POWER_USERS</p><p><b>????: </b>0x0000</p><p><b>RID: </b>0223</p><p><b>Groupname: </b> DOMAIN_ALIAS_RID_ACCOUNT_OPS</p><p><b>????: </b>0x0000</p><p><b>RID: </b>0224</p><p><b>Groupname: </b> DOMAIN_ALIAS_RID_SYSTEM_OPS</p><p><b>????: </b>0x0000</p><p><b>RID: </b>0225</p><p><b>Groupname: </b> DOMAIN_ALIAS_RID_PRINT_OPS</p><p><b>????: </b>0x0000</p><p><b>RID: </b>0226</p><p><b>Groupname: </b> DOMAIN_ALIAS_RID_BACKUP_OPS</p><p><b>????: </b>0x0000</p><p><b>RID: </b>0227</p><p><b>Groupname: </b> DOMAIN_ALIAS_RID_REPLICATOR</p><p><b>????: </b>0x0000</p><p><b>RID: </b>0228</p></div></div></div></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="printing"></a>Chapter 10. Samba Printing Internals</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Gerald</span> <span class="surname">Carter</span></h3></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">October 2002</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2889663">Abstract</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2889679">
+Printing Interface to Various Back ends
+</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2889934">
+Print Queue TDB's
+</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2890143">
+ChangeID and Client Caching of Printer Information
+</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2890156">
+Windows NT/2K Printer Change Notify
+</a></dt></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2889663"></a>Abstract</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+The purpose of this document is to provide some insight into
Samba's printing functionality and also to describe the semantics
-of certain features of Windows client printing.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><HR><H2
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN2899"
-></A
->10.2. Printing Interface to Various Back ends</H2
-><P
->Samba uses a table of function pointers to seven functions. The
-function prototypes are defined in the <TT
-CLASS="VARNAME"
->printif</TT
-> structure declared
-in <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->printing.h</TT
->.</P
-><P
-></P
-><UL
-><LI
-><P
->retrieve the contents of a print queue</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->pause the print queue</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->resume a paused print queue</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->delete a job from the queue</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->pause a job in the print queue</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->result a paused print job in the queue</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->submit a job to the print queue</P
-></LI
-></UL
-><P
->Currently there are only two printing back end implementations
-defined.</P
-><P
-></P
-><UL
-><LI
-><P
->a generic set of functions for working with standard UNIX
- printing subsystems</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->a set of CUPS specific functions (this is only enabled if
- the CUPS libraries were located at compile time).</P
-></LI
-></UL
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><HR><H2
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN2925"
-></A
->10.3. Print Queue TDB's</H2
-><P
->Samba provides periodic caching of the output from the "lpq command"
+of certain features of Windows client printing.
+</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2889679"></a>
+Printing Interface to Various Back ends
+</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+Samba uses a table of function pointers to seven functions. The
+function prototypes are defined in the <tt class="varname">printif</tt> structure declared
+in <tt class="filename">printing.h</tt>.
+</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>retrieve the contents of a print queue</p></li><li><p>pause the print queue</p></li><li><p>resume a paused print queue</p></li><li><p>delete a job from the queue</p></li><li><p>pause a job in the print queue</p></li><li><p>result a paused print job in the queue</p></li><li><p>submit a job to the print queue</p></li></ul></div><p>
+Currently there are only two printing back end implementations
+defined.
+</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>a generic set of functions for working with standard UNIX
+ printing subsystems</p></li><li><p>a set of CUPS specific functions (this is only enabled if
+ the CUPS libraries were located at compile time).</p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2889934"></a>
+Print Queue TDB's
+</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+Samba provides periodic caching of the output from the &quot;lpq command&quot;
for performance reasons. This cache time is configurable in seconds.
Obviously the longer the cache time the less often smbd will be
required to exec a copy of lpq. However, the accuracy of the print
-queue contents displayed to clients will be diminished as well.</P
-><P
->The list of currently opened print queue TDB's can be found
+queue contents displayed to clients will be diminished as well.
+</p><p>
+The list of currently opened print queue TDB's can be found
be examining the list of tdb_print_db structures ( see print_db_head
in printing.c ). A queue TDB is opened using the wrapper function
printing.c:get_print_db_byname(). The function ensures that smbd
@@ -8222,17 +1433,15 @@ does not open more than MAX_PRINT_DBS_OPEN in an effort to prevent
a large print server from exhausting all available file descriptors.
If the number of open queue TDB's exceeds the MAX_PRINT_DBS_OPEN
limit, smbd falls back to a most recently used algorithm for maintaining
-a list of open TDB's.</P
-><P
->There are two ways in which a a print job can be entered into
+a list of open TDB's.
+</p><p>
+There are two ways in which a a print job can be entered into
a print queue's TDB. The first is to submit the job from a Windows
client which will insert the job information directly into the TDB.
The second method is to have the print job picked up by executing the
-"lpq command".</P
-><P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
->/* included from printing.h */
+&quot;lpq command&quot;.
+</p><pre class="programlisting">
+/* included from printing.h */
struct printjob {
pid_t pid; /* which process launched the job */
int sysjob; /* the system (lp) job number */
@@ -8248,63 +1457,28 @@ struct printjob {
fstring user; /* the user who started the job */
fstring queuename; /* service number of printer for this job */
NT_DEVICEMODE *nt_devmode;
-};</PRE
-></P
-><P
->The current manifestation of the printjob structure contains a field
-for the UNIX job id returned from the "lpq command" and a Windows job
+};
+</pre><p>
+The current manifestation of the printjob structure contains a field
+for the UNIX job id returned from the &quot;lpq command&quot; and a Windows job
ID (32-bit bounded by PRINT_MAX_JOBID). When a print job is returned
-by the "lpq command" that does not match an existing job in the queue's
+by the &quot;lpq command&quot; that does not match an existing job in the queue's
TDB, a 32-bit job ID above the &lt;*vance doesn't know what word is missing here*&gt; is generating by adding UNIX_JOB_START to
-the id reported by lpq.</P
-><P
->In order to match a 32-bit Windows jobid onto a 16-bit lanman print job
+the id reported by lpq.
+</p><p>
+In order to match a 32-bit Windows jobid onto a 16-bit lanman print job
id, smbd uses an in memory TDB to match the former to a number appropriate
-for old lanman clients.</P
-><P
->When updating a print queue, smbd will perform the following
-steps ( refer to <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->print.c:print_queue_update()</TT
-> ):</P
-><P
-></P
-><OL
-TYPE="1"
-><LI
-><P
->Check to see if another smbd is currently in
+for old lanman clients.
+</p><p>
+When updating a print queue, smbd will perform the following
+steps ( refer to <tt class="filename">print.c:print_queue_update()</tt> ):
+</p><div class="orderedlist"><ol type="1"><li><p>Check to see if another smbd is currently in
the process of updating the queue contents by checking the pid
- stored in <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->LOCK/<TT
-CLASS="REPLACEABLE"
-><I
->printer_name</I
-></TT
-></TT
->.
- If so, then do not update the TDB.</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->Lock the mutex entry in the TDB and store our own pid.
- Check that this succeeded, else fail.</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->Store the updated time stamp for the new cache
- listing</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->Retrieve the queue listing via "lpq command"</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
-> foreach job in the queue
+ stored in <tt class="constant">LOCK/<i class="replaceable"><tt>printer_name</tt></i></tt>.
+ If so, then do not update the TDB.</p></li><li><p>Lock the mutex entry in the TDB and store our own pid.
+ Check that this succeeded, else fail.</p></li><li><p>Store the updated time stamp for the new cache
+ listing</p></li><li><p>Retrieve the queue listing via &quot;lpq command&quot;</p></li><li><pre class="programlisting">
+ foreach job in the queue
{
if the job is a UNIX job, create a new entry;
if the job has a Windows based jobid, then
@@ -8315,119 +1489,51 @@ CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
else
update the job status only
}
- }</PRE
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->Delete any jobs in the TDB that are not
- in the in the lpq listing</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->Store the print queue status in the TDB</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->update the cache time stamp again</P
-></LI
-></OL
-><P
->Note that it is the contents of this TDB that is returned to Windows
-clients and not the actual listing from the "lpq command".</P
-><P
->The NT_DEVICEMODE stored as part of the printjob structure is used to
+ }</pre></li><li><p>Delete any jobs in the TDB that are not
+ in the in the lpq listing</p></li><li><p>Store the print queue status in the TDB</p></li><li><p>update the cache time stamp again</p></li></ol></div><p>
+Note that it is the contents of this TDB that is returned to Windows
+clients and not the actual listing from the &quot;lpq command&quot;.
+</p><p>
+The NT_DEVICEMODE stored as part of the printjob structure is used to
store a pointer to a non-default DeviceMode associated with the print
job. The pointer will be non-null when the client included a Device
Mode in the OpenPrinterEx() call and subsequently submitted a job for
printing on that same handle. If the client did not include a Device
Mode in the OpenPrinterEx() request, the nt_devmode field is NULL
-and the job has the printer's device mode associated with it by default.</P
-><P
->Only non-default Device Mode are stored with print jobs in the print
+and the job has the printer's device mode associated with it by default.
+</p><p>
+Only non-default Device Mode are stored with print jobs in the print
queue TDB. Otherwise, the Device Mode is obtained from the printer
-object when the client issues a GetJob(level == 2) request.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><HR><H2
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN2959"
-></A
->10.4. ChangeID &#38; Client Caching of Printer Information</H2
-><P
->[To be filled in later]</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><HR><H2
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN2962"
-></A
->10.5. Windows NT/2K Printer Change Notify</H2
-><P
->When working with Windows NT+ clients, it is possible for a
+object when the client issues a GetJob(level == 2) request.
+</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2890143"></a>
+ChangeID and Client Caching of Printer Information
+</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+[To be filled in later]
+</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2890156"></a>
+Windows NT/2K Printer Change Notify
+</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+When working with Windows NT+ clients, it is possible for a
print server to use RPC to send asynchronous change notification
events to clients for certain printer and print job attributes.
This can be useful when the client needs to know that a new
job has been added to the queue for a given printer or that the
driver for a printer has been changed. Note that this is done
entirely orthogonal to cache updates based on a new ChangeID for
-a printer object.</P
-><P
->The basic set of RPC's used to implement change notification are</P
-><P
-></P
-><UL
-><LI
-><P
->RemoteFindFirstPrinterChangeNotifyEx ( RFFPCN )</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->RemoteFindNextPrinterChangeNotifyEx ( RFNPCN )</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->FindClosePrinterChangeNotify( FCPCN )</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->ReplyOpenPrinter</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->ReplyClosePrinter</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->RouteRefreshPrinterChangeNotify ( RRPCN )</P
-></LI
-></UL
-><P
->One additional RPC is available to a server, but is never used by the
-Windows spooler service:</P
-><P
-></P
-><UL
-><LI
-><P
->RouteReplyPrinter()</P
-></LI
-></UL
-><P
->The opnum for all of these RPC's are defined in include/rpc_spoolss.h</P
-><P
->Windows NT print servers use a bizarre method of sending print
+a printer object.
+</p><p>
+The basic set of RPC's used to implement change notification are
+</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>RemoteFindFirstPrinterChangeNotifyEx ( RFFPCN )</p></li><li><p>RemoteFindNextPrinterChangeNotifyEx ( RFNPCN )</p></li><li><p>FindClosePrinterChangeNotify( FCPCN )</p></li><li><p>ReplyOpenPrinter</p></li><li><p>ReplyClosePrinter</p></li><li><p>RouteRefreshPrinterChangeNotify ( RRPCN )</p></li></ul></div><p>
+One additional RPC is available to a server, but is never used by the
+Windows spooler service:
+</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>RouteReplyPrinter()</p></li></ul></div><p>
+The opnum for all of these RPC's are defined in include/rpc_spoolss.h
+</p><p>
+Windows NT print servers use a bizarre method of sending print
notification event to clients. The process of registering a new change
notification handle is as follows. The 'C' is for client and the
-'S' is for server. All error conditions have been eliminated.</P
-><P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
->C: Obtain handle to printer or to the printer
+'S' is for server. All error conditions have been eliminated.
+</p><pre class="programlisting">
+C: Obtain handle to printer or to the printer
server via the standard OpenPrinterEx() call.
S: Respond with a valid handle to object
@@ -8457,453 +1563,229 @@ C: If the change notification handle is ever released by the
or a piece of data was wrong.
S: The server closes the internal change notification handle
(POLICY_HND) and does not send any further change notification
- events to the client for that printer or job.</PRE
-></P
-><P
->The current list of notification events supported by Samba can be
-found by examining the internal tables in srv_spoolss_nt.c</P
-><P
-></P
-><UL
-><LI
-><P
->printer_notify_table[]</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->job_notify_table[]</P
-></LI
-></UL
-><P
->When an event occurs that could be monitored, smbd sends a message
+ events to the client for that printer or job.
+</pre><p>
+The current list of notification events supported by Samba can be
+found by examining the internal tables in srv_spoolss_nt.c
+</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>printer_notify_table[]</p></li><li><p>job_notify_table[]</p></li></ul></div><p>
+When an event occurs that could be monitored, smbd sends a message
to itself about the change. The list of events to be transmitted
are queued by the smbd process sending the message to prevent an
overload of TDB usage and the internal message is sent during smbd's
idle loop (refer to printing/notify.c and the functions
-send_spoolss_notify2_msg() and print_notify_send_messages() ).</P
-><P
->The decision of whether or not the change is to be sent to connected
+send_spoolss_notify2_msg() and print_notify_send_messages() ).
+</p><p>
+The decision of whether or not the change is to be sent to connected
clients is made by the routine which actually sends the notification.
-( refer to srv_spoolss_nt.c:recieve_notify2_message() ).</P
-><P
->Because it possible to receive a listing of multiple changes for
+( refer to srv_spoolss_nt.c:recieve_notify2_message() ).
+</p><p>
+Because it possible to receive a listing of multiple changes for
multiple printers, the notification events must be split into
categories by the printer name. This makes it possible to group
multiple change events to be sent in a single RPC according to the
-printer handle obtained via a ReplyOpenPrinter().</P
-><P
->The actual change notification is performed using the RRPCN request
-RPC. This packet contains</P
-><P
-></P
-><UL
-><LI
-><P
->the printer handle registered with the
-client's spooler on which the change occurred</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->The change_low value which was sent as part
-of the last RFNPCN request from the client</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->The SPOOL_NOTIFY_INFO container with the event
-information</P
-></LI
-></UL
-><P
->A <TT
-CLASS="VARNAME"
->SPOOL_NOTIFY_INFO</TT
-> contains:</P
-><P
-></P
-><UL
-><LI
-><P
->the version and flags field are predefined
-and should not be changed</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->The count field is the number of entries
-in the SPOOL_NOTIFY_INFO_DATA array</P
-></LI
-></UL
-><P
->The <TT
-CLASS="VARNAME"
->SPOOL_NOTIFY_INFO_DATA</TT
-> entries contain:</P
-><P
-></P
-><UL
-><LI
-><P
->The type defines whether or not this event
-is for a printer or a print job</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->The field is the flag identifying the event</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->the notify_data union contains the new valuie of the
-attribute</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->The enc_type defines the size of the structure for marshalling
-and unmarshalling</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->(a) the id must be 0 for a printer event on a printer handle.
+printer handle obtained via a ReplyOpenPrinter().
+</p><p>
+The actual change notification is performed using the RRPCN request
+RPC. This packet contains
+</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>the printer handle registered with the
+client's spooler on which the change occurred</p></li><li><p>The change_low value which was sent as part
+of the last RFNPCN request from the client</p></li><li><p>The SPOOL_NOTIFY_INFO container with the event
+information</p></li></ul></div><p>
+A <tt class="varname">SPOOL_NOTIFY_INFO</tt> contains:
+</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>the version and flags field are predefined
+and should not be changed</p></li><li><p>The count field is the number of entries
+in the SPOOL_NOTIFY_INFO_DATA array</p></li></ul></div><p>
+The <tt class="varname">SPOOL_NOTIFY_INFO_DATA</tt> entries contain:
+</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>The type defines whether or not this event
+is for a printer or a print job</p></li><li><p>The field is the flag identifying the event</p></li><li><p>the notify_data union contains the new valuie of the
+attribute</p></li><li><p>The enc_type defines the size of the structure for marshalling
+and unmarshalling</p></li><li><p>(a) the id must be 0 for a printer event on a printer handle.
(b) the id must be the job id for an event on a printer job
(c) the id must be the matching number of the printer index used
in the response packet to the RFNPCN when using a print server
handle for notification. Samba currently uses the snum of
the printer for this which can break if the list of services
-has been modified since the notification handle was registered.</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->The size is either (a) the string length in UNICODE for strings,
+has been modified since the notification handle was registered.</p></li><li><p>The size is either (a) the string length in UNICODE for strings,
(b) the size in bytes of the security descriptor, or (c) 0 for
-data values.</P
-></LI
-></UL
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="CHAPTER"
-><HR><H1
-><A
-NAME="WINS"
-></A
->Chapter 11. Samba WINS Internals</H1
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><H2
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN3033"
-></A
->11.1. WINS Failover</H2
-><P
->The current Samba codebase possesses the capability to use groups of WINS
+data values.</p></li></ul></div></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="wins"></a>Chapter 11. Samba WINS Internals</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Gerald</span> <span class="surname">Carter</span></h3></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">October 2002</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2889624">WINS Failover</a></dt></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2889624"></a>WINS Failover</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+The current Samba codebase possesses the capability to use groups of WINS
servers that share a common namespace for NetBIOS name registration and
-resolution. The formal parameter syntax is</P
-><P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
-> WINS_SERVER_PARAM = SERVER [ SEPARATOR SERVER_LIST ]
+resolution. The formal parameter syntax is
+</p><pre class="programlisting">
+ WINS_SERVER_PARAM = SERVER [ SEPARATOR SERVER_LIST ]
WINS_SERVER_PARAM = &quot;wins server&quot;
SERVER = ADDR[:TAG]
ADDR = ip_addr | fqdn
TAG = string
SEPARATOR = comma | \s+
- SERVER_LIST = SERVER [ SEPARATOR SERVER_LIST ]</PRE
-></P
-><P
->A simple example of a valid wins server setting is</P
-><P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
->[global]
- wins server = 192.168.1.2 192.168.1.3</PRE
-></P
-><P
->In the event that no TAG is defined in for a SERVER in the list, smbd assigns a default
+ SERVER_LIST = SERVER [ SEPARATOR SERVER_LIST ]
+</pre><p>
+A simple example of a valid wins server setting is
+</p><pre class="programlisting">
+[global]
+ wins server = 192.168.1.2 192.168.1.3
+</pre><p>
+In the event that no TAG is defined in for a SERVER in the list, smbd assigns a default
TAG of &quot;*&quot;. A TAG is used to group servers of a shared NetBIOS namespace together. Upon
startup, nmbd will attempt to register the netbios name value with one server in each
-tagged group.</P
-><P
->An example using tags to group WINS servers together is show here. Note that the use of
-interface names in the tags is only by convention and is not a technical requirement.</P
-><P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
->[global]
- wins server = 192.168.1.2:eth0 192.168.1.3:eth0 192.168.2.2:eth1</PRE
-></P
-><P
->Using this configuration, nmbd would attempt to register the server's NetBIOS name
+tagged group.
+</p><p>
+An example using tags to group WINS servers together is show here. Note that the use of
+interface names in the tags is only by convention and is not a technical requirement.
+</p><pre class="programlisting">
+[global]
+ wins server = 192.168.1.2:eth0 192.168.1.3:eth0 192.168.2.2:eth1
+</pre><p>
+Using this configuration, nmbd would attempt to register the server's NetBIOS name
with one WINS server in each group. Because the &quot;eth0&quot; group has two servers, the
second server would only be used when a registration (or resolution) request to
-the first server in that group timed out.</P
-><P
->NetBIOS name resolution follows a similar pattern as name registration. When resolving
+the first server in that group timed out.
+</p><p>
+NetBIOS name resolution follows a similar pattern as name registration. When resolving
a NetBIOS name via WINS, smbd and other Samba programs will attempt to query a single WINS
server in a tagged group until either a positive response is obtained at least once or
until a server from every tagged group has responded negatively to the name query request.
If a timeout occurs when querying a specific WINS server, that server is marked as down to
prevent further timeouts and the next server in the WINS group is contacted. Once marked as
dead, Samba will not attempt to contact that server for name registration/resolution queries
-for a period of 10 minutes.</P
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="CHAPTER"
-><HR><H1
-><A
-NAME="SAM"
-></A
->Chapter 12. The Upcoming SAM System</H1
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><H2
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN3054"
-></A
->12.1. Security in the 'new SAM'</H2
-><P
->One of the biggest problems with passdb is it's implementation of
+for a period of 10 minutes.
+</p></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="sam"></a>Chapter 12. The Upcoming SAM System</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Andrew</span> <span class="surname">Bartlett</span></h3></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">1 October 2002</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2889427">Security in the 'new SAM'</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2890951">Standalone from UNIX</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2890985">Handles and Races in the new SAM</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2891054">Layers</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2891061">Application</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2891077">SAM Interface</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2891105">SAM Modules</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2891126">SAM Modules</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2891134">Special Module: sam_passdb</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2891152">sam_ads</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2891191">Memory Management</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2891281">Testing</a></dt></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2889427"></a>Security in the 'new SAM'</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>One of the biggest problems with passdb is it's implementation of
'security'. Access control is on a 'are you root at the moment' basis,
and it has no concept of NT ACLs. Things like ldapsam had to add
-'magic' 'are you root' checks.</P
-><P
->We took this very seriously when we started work, and the new structure
+'magic' 'are you root' checks.</p><p>We took this very seriously when we started work, and the new structure
is designed with this in mind, from the ground up. Each call to the SAM
has a NT_TOKEN and (if relevant) an 'access desired'. This is either
provided as a parameter, or implicitly supplied by the object being
-accessed.</P
-><P
->For example, when you call </P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
->&#60;
+accessed.</p><p>
+For example, when you call
+</p><pre class="programlisting">
NTSTATUS sam_get_account_by_name(const SAM_CONTEXT *context, const
NT_USER_TOKEN *access_token, uint32 access_desired, const char *domain,
-const char *name, SAM_ACCOUNT_HANDLE **account)</PRE
-><P
->The context can be NULL (and is used to allow import/export by setting
-up 2 contexts, and allowing calls on both simultaneously)</P
-><P
->The access token *must* be specified. Normally the user's token out of
-current_user, this can also be a global 'system' context.</P
-><P
->The access desired is as per the ACL, for passing to the seaccess stuff.</P
-><P
->The domain/username are standard. Even if we only have one domain,
+const char *name, SAM_ACCOUNT_HANDLE **account)
+</pre><p>
+The context can be NULL (and is used to allow import/export by setting
+up 2 contexts, and allowing calls on both simultaneously)
+</p><p>
+The access token *must* be specified. Normally the user's token out of
+current_user, this can also be a global 'system' context.
+</p><p>
+The access desired is as per the ACL, for passing to the seaccess stuff.
+</p><p>
+The domain/username are standard. Even if we only have one domain,
keeping this ensures that we don't get 'unqualified' usernames (same
-problem as we had with unqualified SIDs).</P
-><P
->We return a 'handle'. This is opaque to the rest of Samba, but is
-operated on by get/set routines, all of which return NTSTATUS.</P
-><P
->The access checking is done by the SAM module. The reason it is not
+problem as we had with unqualified SIDs).
+</p><p>
+We return a 'handle'. This is opaque to the rest of Samba, but is
+operated on by get/set routines, all of which return NTSTATUS.
+</p><p>
+The access checking is done by the SAM module. The reason it is not
done 'above' the interface is to ensure a 'choke point'. I put a lot of
effort into the auth subsystem to ensure we never 'accidentally' forgot
to check for null passwords, missed a restriction etc. I intend the SAM
-to be written with the same caution.</P
-><P
->The reason the access checking is not handled by the interface itself is
+to be written with the same caution.
+</p><p>
+The reason the access checking is not handled by the interface itself is
due to the different implementations it make take on. For example, on
ADS, you cannot set a password over a non-SSL connection. Other
backends may have similar requirements - we need to leave this policy up
to the modules. They will naturally have access to 'helper' procedures
-and good examples to avoid mishaps.</P
-><P
->(Furthermore, some backends my actually chose to push the whole ACL
+and good examples to avoid mishaps.
+</p><p>
+(Furthermore, some backends my actually chose to push the whole ACL
issue to the remote server, and - assuming ldap for this example - bind
-as the user directly)</P
-><P
->Each returned handle has an internal 'access permitted', which allows
+as the user directly)
+</p><p>
+Each returned handle has an internal 'access permitted', which allows
the 'get' and 'set' routines to return 'ACCESS_DENIED' for things that
were not able to be retrieved from the backend. This removes the need
to specify the NT_TOKEN on every operation, and allows for 'object not
-present' to be easily distinguished from 'access denied'.</P
-><P
->When you 'set' an object (calling sam_update_account) the internal
+present' to be easily distinguished from 'access denied'.
+</p><p>
+When you 'set' an object (calling sam_update_account) the internal
details are again used. Each change that has been made to the object
has been flagged, so as to avoid race conditions (on unmodified
components) and to avoid violating any extra ACL requirements on the
-actual data store (like the LDAP server).</P
-><P
->Finally, we have generic get_sec_desc() and set_sec_desc() routines to
-allow external ACL manipulation. These do lookups based on SID.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><HR><H2
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN3071"
-></A
->12.2. Standalone from UNIX</H2
-><P
->One of the primary tenants of the 'new SAM' is that it would not attempt
+actual data store (like the LDAP server).
+</p><p>
+Finally, we have generic get_sec_desc() and set_sec_desc() routines to
+allow external ACL manipulation. These do lookups based on SID.
+</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2890951"></a>Standalone from UNIX</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+One of the primary tenants of the 'new SAM' is that it would not attempt
to deal with 'what unix id for that'. This would be left to the 'SMS'
(Sid Mapping System') or SID farm, and probably administered via
winbind. We have had constructive discussion on how 'basic' unix
accounts like 'root' would be handled, and we think this can work.
-Accounts not preexisting in unix would be served up via winbind.</P
-><P
->This is an *optional* part, and my preferred end-game. We have a fare
-way to go before things like winbind up to it however.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><HR><H2
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN3075"
-></A
->12.3. Handles and Races in the new SAM</H2
-><P
->One of the things that the 'new SAM' work has tried to face is both
+Accounts not preexisting in unix would be served up via winbind.
+</p><p>
+This is an *optional* part, and my preferred end-game. We have a fare
+way to go before things like winbind up to it however.
+</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2890985"></a>Handles and Races in the new SAM</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+One of the things that the 'new SAM' work has tried to face is both
compatibility with existing code, and a closer alignment to the SAMR
interface. I consider SAMR to be a 'primary customer' to the this work,
because if we get alignment with that wrong, things get more, rather
than less complex. Also, most other parts of Samba are much more
-flexible with what they can allow.</P
-><P
->In any case, that was a decision taken as to how the general design
-would progress. BTW, my understanding of SAMR may be completely flawed.</P
-><P
->One of the most race-prone areas of the new code is the conflicting
-update problem. We have taken two approaches: </P
-><P
-></P
-><UL
-><LI
-><P
->'Not conflicting' conflicts. Due to the way usrmgr operates, it will
+flexible with what they can allow.
+</p><p>
+In any case, that was a decision taken as to how the general design
+would progress. BTW, my understanding of SAMR may be completely flawed.
+</p><p>
+One of the most race-prone areas of the new code is the conflicting
+update problem. We have taken two approaches:
+</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>'Not conflicting' conflicts. Due to the way usrmgr operates, it will
open a user, display all the properties and *save* them all, even if you
-don't change any.</P
-><P
->For this, see what I've done in rpc_server/srv_samr_util.c. I intend
+don't change any.
+</p><p>
+For this, see what I've done in rpc_server/srv_samr_util.c. I intend
to take this one step further, and operate on the 'handle' that the
values were read from. This should mean that we only update things that
-have *really* changed.</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->'conflicting' updates: Currently we don't deal with this (in passdb
+have *really* changed.
+</p></li><li><p>
+'conflicting' updates: Currently we don't deal with this (in passdb
or the new sam stuff), but the design is sufficiently flexible to 'deny'
-a second update. I don't foresee locking records however.</P
-></LI
-></UL
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><HR><H2
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN3086"
-></A
->12.4. Layers</H2
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><H3
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN3088"
-></A
->12.4.1. Application</H3
-><P
->This is where smbd, samtest and whatever end-user replacement we have
+a second update. I don't foresee locking records however.
+</p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2891054"></a>Layers</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2891061"></a>Application</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+This is where smbd, samtest and whatever end-user replacement we have
for pdbedit sits. They use only the SAM interface, and do not get
-'special knowledge' of what is below them.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><HR><H3
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN3091"
-></A
->12.4.2. SAM Interface</H3
-><P
->This level 'owns' the various handle structures, the get/set routines on
+'special knowledge' of what is below them.
+</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2891077"></a>SAM Interface</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+This level 'owns' the various handle structures, the get/set routines on
those structures and provides the public interface. The application
layer may initialize a 'context' to be passed to all interface routines,
else a default, self-initialising context will be supplied. This layser
finds the appropriate backend module for the task, and tries very hard
not to need to much 'knowledge'. It should just provide the required
-abstraction to the modules below, and arrange for their initial loading.</P
-><P
->We could possibly add ACL checking at this layer, to avoid discrepancies
-in implementation modules.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><HR><H3
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN3095"
-></A
->12.4.3. SAM Modules</H3
-><P
->These do not communicate with the application directly, only by setting
+abstraction to the modules below, and arrange for their initial loading.
+</p><p>
+We could possibly add ACL checking at this layer, to avoid discrepancies
+in implementation modules.
+</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2891105"></a>SAM Modules</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+These do not communicate with the application directly, only by setting
values in the handles, and receiving requests from the interface. These
modules are responsible for translating values from the handle's
.private into (say) an LDAP modification list. The module is expected
to 'know' things like it's own domain SID, domain name, and any other
state attached to the SAM. Simpler modules may call back to some helper
-routine.</P
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><HR><H2
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN3098"
-></A
->12.5. SAM Modules</H2
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><H3
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN3100"
-></A
->12.5.1. Special Module: sam_passdb</H3
-><P
->In order for there to be a smooth transition, kai is writing a module
+routine.
+</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2891126"></a>SAM Modules</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2891134"></a>Special Module: sam_passdb</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+In order for there to be a smooth transition, kai is writing a module
that reads existing passdb backends, and translates them into SAM
replies. (Also pulling data from the account policy DB etc). We also
intend to write a module that does the reverse - gives the SAM a passdb
-interface.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><HR><H3
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN3103"
-></A
->12.5.2. sam_ads</H3
-><P
->This is the first of the SAM modules to be committed to the tree -
+interface.
+</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2891152"></a>sam_ads</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+This is the first of the SAM modules to be committed to the tree -
mainly because I needed to coordinate work with metze (who authored most
of it). This module aims to use Samba's libads code to provide an
Active Directory LDAP client, suitable for use on a mixed-mode DC.
While it is currently being tested against Win2k servers (with a
password in the smb.conf file) it is expected to eventually use a
(possibly modified) OpenLDAP server. We hope that this will assist in
-the construction of an Samba AD DC.</P
-><P
->We also intend to construct a Samba 2.2/3.0 compatible ldap module,
-again using libads code.</P
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><HR><H2
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN3107"
-></A
->12.6. Memory Management</H2
-><P
->
+the construction of an Samba AD DC.
+</p><p>
+We also intend to construct a Samba 2.2/3.0 compatible ldap module,
+again using libads code.
+</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2891191"></a>Memory Management</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>
The 'new SAM' development effort also concerned itself with getting a
sane implementation of memory management. It was decided that we would
be (as much as possible) talloc based, using an 'internal talloc
@@ -8911,132 +1793,63 @@ context' on many objects. That is, the creation of an object would
initiate it's own internal talloc context, and this would be used for
all operations on that object. Much of this is already implemented in
passdb. Also, like passdb, it will be possible to specify that some
-object actually be created on a specified context. </P
-><P
->Memory management is important here because the APIs in the 'new SAM' do
+object actually be created on a specified context.
+</p><p>
+Memory management is important here because the APIs in the 'new SAM' do
not use 'pdb_init()' or an equivalent. They always allocate new
objects. Enumeration's are slightly different, and occur on a supplied
context that 'owns' the entire list, rather than per-element. (the
enumeration functions return an array of all elements - not full handles
just basic (and public) info) Likewise for things that fill in a char
-**.</P
-><P
->For example:</P
-><P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
->NTSTATUS sam_lookup_sid(const SAM_CONTEXT *context, const NT_USER_TOKEN
+**.
+</p><p>For example:</p><pre class="programlisting">
+NTSTATUS sam_lookup_sid(const SAM_CONTEXT *context, const NT_USER_TOKEN
*access_token, TALLOC_CTX *mem_ctx, const DOM_SID *sid, char **name,
-uint32 *type)</PRE
-></P
-><P
->Takes a context to allocate the 'name' on, while:</P
-><P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
->NTSTATUS sam_get_account_by_sid(const SAM_CONTEXT *context, const
+uint32 *type)
+</pre><p>Takes a context to allocate the 'name' on, while:</p><pre class="programlisting">
+NTSTATUS sam_get_account_by_sid(const SAM_CONTEXT *context, const
NT_USER_TOKEN *access_token, uint32 access_desired, const DOM_SID
-*accountsid, SAM_ACCOUNT_HANDLE **account)</PRE
-></P
-><P
->Allocates a handle and stores the allocation context on that handle.</P
-><P
->I think that the following:</P
-><P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
->NTSTATUS sam_enum_accounts(const SAM_CONTEXT *context, const
+*accountsid, SAM_ACCOUNT_HANDLE **account)
+</pre><p>Allocates a handle and stores the allocation context on that handle.</p><p>I think that the following:</p><pre class="programlisting">
+NTSTATUS sam_enum_accounts(const SAM_CONTEXT *context, const
NT_USER_TOKEN *access_token, const DOM_SID *domainsid, uint16 acct_ctrl,
-int32 *account_count, SAM_ACCOUNT_ENUM **accounts)</PRE
-></P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><HR><H2
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN3121"
-></A
->12.7. Testing</H2
-><P
->Testing is vital in any piece of software, and Samba is certainly no
+int32 *account_count, SAM_ACCOUNT_ENUM **accounts)
+</pre></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2891281"></a>Testing</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+Testing is vital in any piece of software, and Samba is certainly no
exception. In designing this new subsystem, we have taken care to ensure
-it is easily tested, independent of outside protocols.</P
-><P
->To this end, Jelmer has constructed 'samtest'. </P
-><P
->This utility (see torture/samtest.c) is structured like rpcclient, but
+it is easily tested, independent of outside protocols.
+</p><p>
+To this end, Jelmer has constructed 'samtest'.
+</p><p>
+This utility (see torture/samtest.c) is structured like rpcclient, but
instead operates on the SAM subsystem. It creates a 'custom' SAM
context, that may be distinct from the default values used by the rest
-of the system, and can load a separate configuration file. </P
-><P
->A small number of commands are currently implemented, but these have
+of the system, and can load a separate configuration file.
+</p><p>
+A small number of commands are currently implemented, but these have
already proved vital in testing. I expect SAM module authors will find
-it particularly valuable.</P
-><P
->Example useage:</P
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="PROMPT"
->$</TT
-> <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->bin/samtest</B
-></P
-><P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
->&#62; context ads:ldap://192.168.1.96</PRE
->
+it particularly valuable.
+</p><p>Example useage:</p><p><tt class="prompt">$</tt> <b class="command">bin/samtest</b></p><pre class="programlisting">
+&gt; context ads:ldap://192.168.1.96
+</pre><p>
(this loads a new context, using the new ADS module. The parameter is
-the 'location' of the ldap server)</P
-><P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
->&#62; lookup_name DOMAIN abartlet</PRE
->
-(returns a sid).</P
-><P
->Because the 'new SAM' is NT ACL based, there will be a command to
-specify an arbitrary NT ACL, but for now it uses 'system' by default.</P
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="CHAPTER"
-><HR><H1
-><A
-NAME="PWENCRYPT"
-></A
->Chapter 13. LanMan and NT Password Encryption</H1
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><H2
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN3147"
-></A
->13.1. Introduction</H2
-><P
->With the development of LanManager and Windows NT
+the 'location' of the ldap server)
+</p><pre class="programlisting">
+&gt; lookup_name DOMAIN abartlet
+</pre><p>
+(returns a sid).
+</p><p>
+Because the 'new SAM' is NT ACL based, there will be a command to
+specify an arbitrary NT ACL, but for now it uses 'system' by default.
+</p></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="pwencrypt"></a>Chapter 13. LanMan and NT Password Encryption</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jeremy</span> <span class="surname">Allison</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><br>
+ <tt class="email">&lt;<a href="mailto:samba@samba.org">samba@samba.org</a>&gt;</tt><br>
+ </p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">19 Apr 1999</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2891920">Introduction</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2891945">How does it work?</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2890832">The smbpasswd file</a></dt></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2891920"></a>Introduction</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>With the development of LanManager and Windows NT
compatible password encryption for Samba, it is now able
to validate user connections in exactly the same way as
- a LanManager or Windows NT server.</P
-><P
->This document describes how the SMB password encryption
+ a LanManager or Windows NT server.</p><p>This document describes how the SMB password encryption
algorithm works and what issues there are in choosing whether
you want to use it. You should read it carefully, especially
- the part about security and the "PROS and CONS" section.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><HR><H2
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN3151"
-></A
->13.2. How does it work?</H2
-><P
->LanManager encryption is somewhat similar to UNIX
+ the part about security and the &quot;PROS and CONS&quot; section.</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2891945"></a>How does it work?</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>LanManager encryption is somewhat similar to UNIX
password encryption. The server uses a file containing a
hashed value of a user's password. This is created by taking
the user's plaintext password, capitalising it, and either
@@ -9044,265 +1857,791 @@ NAME="AEN3151"
This 14 byte value is used as two 56 bit DES keys to encrypt
a 'magic' eight byte value, forming a 16 byte value which is
stored by the server and client. Let this value be known as
- the "hashed password".</P
-><P
->Windows NT encryption is a higher quality mechanism,
+ the &quot;hashed password&quot;.</p><p>Windows NT encryption is a higher quality mechanism,
consisting of doing an MD4 hash on a Unicode version of the user's
password. This also produces a 16 byte hash value that is
- non-reversible.</P
-><P
->When a client (LanManager, Windows for WorkGroups, Windows
+ non-reversible.</p><p>When a client (LanManager, Windows for WorkGroups, Windows
95 or Windows NT) wishes to mount a Samba drive (or use a Samba
resource), it first requests a connection and negotiates the
protocol that the client and server will use. In the reply to this
request the Samba server generates and appends an 8 byte, random
value - this is stored in the Samba server after the reply is sent
- and is known as the "challenge". The challenge is different for
- every client connection.</P
-><P
->The client then uses the hashed password (16 byte values
+ and is known as the &quot;challenge&quot;. The challenge is different for
+ every client connection.</p><p>The client then uses the hashed password (16 byte values
described above), appended with 5 null bytes, as three 56 bit
DES keys, each of which is used to encrypt the challenge 8 byte
- value, forming a 24 byte value known as the "response".</P
-><P
->In the SMB call SMBsessionsetupX (when user level security
+ value, forming a 24 byte value known as the &quot;response&quot;.</p><p>In the SMB call SMBsessionsetupX (when user level security
is selected) or the call SMBtconX (when share level security is
selected), the 24 byte response is returned by the client to the
Samba server. For Windows NT protocol levels the above calculation
is done on both hashes of the user's password and both responses are
- returned in the SMB call, giving two 24 byte values.</P
-><P
->The Samba server then reproduces the above calculation, using
+ returned in the SMB call, giving two 24 byte values.</p><p>The Samba server then reproduces the above calculation, using
its own stored value of the 16 byte hashed password (read from the
- <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->smbpasswd</TT
-> file - described later) and the challenge
+ <tt class="filename">smbpasswd</tt> file - described later) and the challenge
value that it kept from the negotiate protocol reply. It then checks
to see if the 24 byte value it calculates matches the 24 byte value
- returned to it from the client.</P
-><P
->If these values match exactly, then the client knew the
+ returned to it from the client.</p><p>If these values match exactly, then the client knew the
correct password (or the 16 byte hashed value - see security note
below) and is thus allowed access. If not, then the client did not
- know the correct password and is denied access.</P
-><P
->Note that the Samba server never knows or stores the cleartext
+ know the correct password and is denied access.</p><p>Note that the Samba server never knows or stores the cleartext
of the user's password - just the 16 byte hashed values derived from
it. Also note that the cleartext password or 16 byte hashed values
- are never transmitted over the network - thus increasing security.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><HR><H2
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN3162"
-></A
->13.3. <A
-NAME="SMBPASSWDFILEFORMAT"
-></A
->The smbpasswd file</H2
-><P
->In order for Samba to participate in the above protocol
+ are never transmitted over the network - thus increasing security.</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2890832"></a>The smbpasswd file</h2></div></div><div></div></div><a name="SMBPASSWDFILEFORMAT"></a><p>In order for Samba to participate in the above protocol
it must be able to look up the 16 byte hashed values given a user name.
Unfortunately, as the UNIX password value is also a one way hash
function (ie. it is impossible to retrieve the cleartext of the user's
password given the UNIX hash of it), a separate password file
containing this 16 byte value must be kept. To minimise problems with
- these two password files, getting out of sync, the UNIX <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
-> /etc/passwd</TT
-> and the <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->smbpasswd</TT
-> file,
- a utility, <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->mksmbpasswd.sh</B
->, is provided to generate
- a smbpasswd file from a UNIX <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/passwd</TT
-> file.
- </P
-><P
->To generate the smbpasswd file from your <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/passwd
- </TT
-> file use the following command :</P
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="PROMPT"
->$ </TT
-><TT
-CLASS="USERINPUT"
-><B
->cat /etc/passwd | mksmbpasswd.sh
- &gt; /usr/local/samba/private/smbpasswd</B
-></TT
-></P
-><P
->If you are running on a system that uses NIS, use</P
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="PROMPT"
->$ </TT
-><TT
-CLASS="USERINPUT"
-><B
->ypcat passwd | mksmbpasswd.sh
- &gt; /usr/local/samba/private/smbpasswd</B
-></TT
-></P
-><P
->The <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->mksmbpasswd.sh</B
-> program is found in
+ these two password files, getting out of sync, the UNIX <tt class="filename">
+ /etc/passwd</tt> and the <tt class="filename">smbpasswd</tt> file,
+ a utility, <b class="command">mksmbpasswd.sh</b>, is provided to generate
+ a smbpasswd file from a UNIX <tt class="filename">/etc/passwd</tt> file.
+ </p><p>To generate the smbpasswd file from your <tt class="filename">/etc/passwd
+ </tt> file use the following command:</p><p><tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>cat /etc/passwd | mksmbpasswd.sh
+ &gt; /usr/local/samba/private/smbpasswd</tt></b></p><p>If you are running on a system that uses NIS, use</p><p><tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>ypcat passwd | mksmbpasswd.sh
+ &gt; /usr/local/samba/private/smbpasswd</tt></b></p><p>The <b class="command">mksmbpasswd.sh</b> program is found in
the Samba source directory. By default, the smbpasswd file is
- stored in :</P
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/usr/local/samba/private/smbpasswd</TT
-></P
-><P
->The owner of the <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/usr/local/samba/private/</TT
->
+ stored in :</p><p><tt class="filename">/usr/local/samba/private/smbpasswd</tt></p><p>The owner of the <tt class="filename">/usr/local/samba/private/</tt>
directory should be set to root, and the permissions on it should
- be set to 0500 (<B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->chmod 500 /usr/local/samba/private</B
->).
- </P
-><P
->Likewise, the smbpasswd file inside the private directory should
+ be set to 0500 (<b class="command">chmod 500 /usr/local/samba/private</b>).
+ </p><p>Likewise, the smbpasswd file inside the private directory should
be owned by root and the permissions on is should be set to 0600
- (<B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->chmod 600 smbpasswd</B
->).</P
-><P
->The format of the smbpasswd file is (The line has been
+ (<b class="command">chmod 600 smbpasswd</b>).</p><p>The format of the smbpasswd file is (The line has been
wrapped here. It should appear as one entry per line in
- your smbpasswd file.)</P
-><P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
->username:uid:XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX:XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX:
+ your smbpasswd file.)</p><pre class="programlisting">
+username:uid:XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX:XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX:
[Account type]:LCT-&lt;last-change-time&gt;:Long name
- </PRE
-></P
-><P
->Although only the <TT
-CLASS="REPLACEABLE"
-><I
->username</I
-></TT
->,
- <TT
-CLASS="REPLACEABLE"
-><I
->uid</I
-></TT
->, <TT
-CLASS="REPLACEABLE"
-><I
-> XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX</I
-></TT
->,
- [<TT
-CLASS="REPLACEABLE"
-><I
->Account type</I
-></TT
->] and <TT
-CLASS="REPLACEABLE"
-><I
-> last-change-time</I
-></TT
-> sections are significant
- and are looked at in the Samba code.</P
-><P
->It is <SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->VITALLY</I
-></SPAN
-> important that there by 32
+ </pre><p>Although only the <i class="replaceable"><tt>username</tt></i>,
+ <i class="replaceable"><tt>uid</tt></i>, <i class="replaceable"><tt>
+ XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX</tt></i>,
+ [<i class="replaceable"><tt>Account type</tt></i>] and <i class="replaceable"><tt>
+ last-change-time</tt></i> sections are significant
+ and are looked at in the Samba code.</p><p>It is <span class="emphasis"><em>VITALLY</em></span> important that there by 32
'X' characters between the two ':' characters in the XXX sections -
the smbpasswd and Samba code will fail to validate any entries that
do not have 32 characters between ':' characters. The first XXX
section is for the Lanman password hash, the second is for the
- Windows NT version.</P
-><P
->When the password file is created all users have password entries
+ Windows NT version.</p><p>When the password file is created all users have password entries
consisting of 32 'X' characters. By default this disallows any access
as this user. When a user has a password set, the 'X' characters change
to 32 ascii hexadecimal digits (0-9, A-F). These are an ascii
- representation of the 16 byte hashed value of a user's password.</P
-><P
->To set a user to have no password (not recommended), edit the file
+ representation of the 16 byte hashed value of a user's password.</p><p>To set a user to have no password (not recommended), edit the file
using vi, and replace the first 11 characters with the ascii text
- <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->"NO PASSWORD"</TT
-> (minus the quotes).</P
-><P
->For example, to clear the password for user bob, his smbpasswd file
- entry would look like :</P
-><P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
-> bob:100:NO PASSWORDXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX:XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX:[U ]:LCT-00000000:Bob's full name:/bobhome:/bobshell
- </PRE
-></P
-><P
->If you are allowing users to use the smbpasswd command to set
+ <tt class="constant">&quot;NO PASSWORD&quot;</tt> (minus the quotes).</p><p>For example, to clear the password for user bob, his smbpasswd file
+ entry would look like :</p><pre class="programlisting">
+bob:100:NO PASSWORDXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX:XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX:
+ [U ]:LCT-00000000:Bob's full name:/bobhome:/bobshell
+ </pre><p>If you are allowing users to use the smbpasswd command to set
their own passwords, you may want to give users NO PASSWORD initially
so they do not have to enter a previous password when changing to their
new password (not recommended). In order for you to allow this the
- <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbpasswd</B
-> program must be able to connect to the
- <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbd</B
-> daemon as that user with no password. Enable this
- by adding the line :</P
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->null passwords = yes</B
-></P
-><P
->to the [global] section of the smb.conf file (this is why
+ <b class="command">smbpasswd</b> program must be able to connect to the
+ <b class="command">smbd</b> daemon as that user with no password. Enable this
+ by adding the line :</p><p><b class="command">null passwords = yes</b></p><p>to the [global] section of the smb.conf file (this is why
the above scenario is not recommended). Preferably, allocate your
users a default password to begin with, so you do not have
- to enable this on your server.</P
-><P
-><SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->Note : </I
-></SPAN
->This file should be protected very
+ to enable this on your server.</p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note : </em></span>This file should be protected very
carefully. Anyone with access to this file can (with enough knowledge of
the protocols) gain access to your SMB server. The file is thus more
- sensitive than a normal unix <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/passwd</TT
-> file.</P
-></DIV
-></DIV
-></DIV
-></BODY
-></HTML
-> \ No newline at end of file
+ sensitive than a normal unix <tt class="filename">/etc/passwd</tt> file.</p></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="modules"></a>Chapter 14. Modules</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email">&lt;<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</a>&gt;</tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate"> 19 March 2003 </p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2891872">Advantages</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2892773">Loading modules</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2892806">Static modules</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2893746">Shared modules</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2893775">Writing modules</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2893837">Static/Shared selection in configure.in</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2891872"></a>Advantages</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+The new modules system has the following advantages:
+</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td>Transparent loading of static and shared modules (no need
+for a subsystem to know about modules)</td></tr><tr><td>Simple selection between shared and static modules at configure time</td></tr><tr><td>&quot;preload modules&quot; option for increasing performance for stable modules</td></tr><tr><td>No nasty #define stuff anymore</td></tr><tr><td>All backends are available as plugin now (including pdb_ldap and pdb_tdb)</td></tr></table></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2892773"></a>Loading modules</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+Some subsystems in samba use different backends. These backends can be
+either statically linked in to samba or available as a plugin. A subsystem
+should have a function that allows a module to register itself. For example,
+the passdb subsystem has:
+</p><pre class="programlisting">
+NTSTATUS smb_register_passdb(int version, const char *name, pdb_init_function init);
+</pre><p>
+This function will be called by the initialisation function of the module to
+register itself.
+</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2892806"></a>Static modules</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+The modules system compiles a list of initialisation functions for the
+static modules of each subsystem. This is a define. For example,
+it is here currently (from <tt class="filename">include/config.h</tt>):
+</p><pre class="programlisting">
+/* Static init functions */
+#define static_init_pdb { pdb_mysql_init(); pdb_ldap_init(); pdb_smbpasswd_init(); pdb_tdbsam_init(); pdb_guest_init();}
+</pre><p>
+These functions should be called before the subsystem is used. That
+should be done when the subsystem is initialised or first used.
+</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2893746"></a>Shared modules</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+If a subsystem needs a certain backend, it should check if it has
+already been registered. If the backend hasn't been registered already,
+the subsystem should call smb_probe_module(char *subsystem, char *backend).
+This function tries to load the correct module from a certain path
+($LIBDIR/subsystem/backend.so). If the first character in 'backend'
+is a slash, smb_probe_module() tries to load the module from the
+absolute path specified in 'backend'.
+</p><p>After smb_probe_module() has been executed, the subsystem
+should check again if the module has been registered.
+</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2893775"></a>Writing modules</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+Each module has an initialisation function. For modules that are
+included with samba this name is '<i class="replaceable"><tt>subsystem</tt></i>_<i class="replaceable"><tt>backend</tt></i>_init'. For external modules (that will never be built-in, but only available as a module) this name is always 'init_module'. (In the case of modules included with samba, the configure system will add a #define subsystem_backend_init() init_module()).
+The prototype for these functions is:
+</p><pre class="programlisting">
+NTSTATUS init_module(void);
+</pre><p>This function should call one or more
+registration functions. The function should return NT_STATUS_OK on success and
+NT_STATUS_UNSUCCESSFUL or a more useful nt error code on failure.</p><p>For example, pdb_ldap_init() contains: </p><pre class="programlisting">
+NTSTATUS pdb_ldap_init(void)
+{
+smb_register_passdb(PASSDB_INTERFACE_VERSION, &quot;ldapsam&quot;, pdb_init_ldapsam);
+smb_register_passdb(PASSDB_INTERFACE_VERSION, &quot;ldapsam_nua&quot;, pdb_init_ldapsam_nua);
+ return NT_STATUS_OK;
+}
+</pre><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2893837"></a>Static/Shared selection in configure.in</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+Some macros in configure.in generate the various defines and substs that
+are necessary for the system to work correct. All modules that should
+be built by default have to be added to the variable 'default_modules'.
+For example, if ldap is found, pdb_ldap is added to this variable.
+</p><p>
+On the bottom of configure.in, SMB_MODULE() should be called
+for each module and SMB_SUBSYSTEM() for each subsystem.
+</p><p>Syntax:</p><pre class="programlisting">
+SMB_MODULE(<i class="replaceable"><tt>subsystem</tt></i>_<i class="replaceable"><tt>backend</tt></i>, <i class="replaceable"><tt>object files</tt></i>, <i class="replaceable"><tt>plugin name</tt></i>, <i class="replaceable"><tt>subsystem name</tt></i>, <i class="replaceable"><tt>static_action</tt></i>, <i class="replaceable"><tt>shared_action</tt></i>)
+SMB_SUBSYSTEM(<i class="replaceable"><tt>subsystem</tt></i>)
+</pre><p>Also, make sure to add the correct directives to
+<tt class="filename">Makefile.in</tt>. <i class="replaceable"><tt>@SUBSYSTEM_STATIC@</tt></i>
+will be replaced with a list of objects files of the modules that need to
+be linked in statically. <i class="replaceable"><tt>@SUBSYSTEM_MODULES@</tt></i> will
+be replaced with the names of the plugins to build.
+</p><p>You must make sure all .c files that contain defines that can
+be changed by ./configure are rebuilded in the 'modules_clean' make target.
+Practically, this means all c files that contain <b class="command">static_init_subsystem;</b> calls need to be rebuilded.
+</p></div></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="rpc-plugin"></a>Chapter 15. RPC Pluggable Modules</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Anthony</span> <span class="surname">Liguori</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">IBM<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email">&lt;<a href="mailto:aliguor@us.ibm.com">aliguor@us.ibm.com</a>&gt;</tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email">&lt;<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</a>&gt;</tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">January 2003</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2892540">About</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2892559">General Overview</a></dt></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2892540"></a>About</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+This document describes how to make use the new RPC Pluggable Modules features
+of Samba 3.0. This architecture was added to increase the maintainability of
+Samba allowing RPC Pipes to be worked on separately from the main CVS branch.
+The RPM architecture will also allow third-party vendors to add functionality
+to Samba through plug-ins.
+</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2892559"></a>General Overview</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+When an RPC call is sent to smbd, smbd tries to load a shared library by the
+name <tt class="filename">librpc_&lt;pipename&gt;.so</tt> to handle the call if
+it doesn't know how to handle the call internally. For instance, LSA calls
+are handled by <tt class="filename">librpc_lsass.so</tt>..
+These shared libraries should be located in the <tt class="filename">&lt;sambaroot&gt;/lib/rpc</tt>. smbd then attempts to call the init_module function within
+the shared library. Check the chapter on modules for more information.
+</p><p>
+In the init_module function, the library should call
+rpc_pipe_register_commands(). This function takes the following arguments:
+</p><pre class="programlisting">
+NTSTATUS rpc_pipe_register_commands(int version, const char *clnt, const char *srv,
+ const struct api_struct *cmds, int size);
+</pre><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">version</span></dt><dd><p>Version number of the RPC interface. Use the define <span class="emphasis"><em>SMB_RPC_INTERFACE_VERSION</em></span> for this
+argument.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">clnt</span></dt><dd><p>the Client name of the named pipe</p></dd><dt><span class="term">srv</span></dt><dd><p>the Server name of the named pipe</p></dd><dt><span class="term">cmds</span></dt><dd><p>a list of api_structs that map RPC ordinal numbers to function calls</p></dd><dt><span class="term">size</span></dt><dd><p>the number of api_structs contained in cmds</p></dd></dl></div><p>
+See rpc_server/srv_reg.c and rpc_server/srv_reg_nt.c for a small example of
+how to use this library.
+</p></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="vfs"></a>Chapter 16. VFS Modules</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Alexander</span> <span class="surname">Bokovoy</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><div class="address"><p><tt class="email">&lt;<a href="mailto:ab@samba.org">ab@samba.org</a>&gt;</tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Stefan</span> <span class="surname">Metzmacher</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><div class="address"><p><tt class="email">&lt;<a href="mailto:metze@metzemix.de">metze@metzemix.de</a>&gt;</tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate"> 27 May 2003 </p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2894852">The Samba (Posix) VFS layer</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2894859">The general interface</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2894974">Possible VFS operation layers</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2895046">The Interaction between the Samba VFS subsystem and the modules</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2895054">Initialization and registration</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2895246">How the Modules handle per connection data</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2895490">Upgrading to the New VFS Interface</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2895497">Upgrading from 2.2.* and 3.0aplha modules</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2896037">Some Notes</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2896044">Implement TRANSPARENT functions</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2896069">Implement OPAQUE functions</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2894852"></a>The Samba (Posix) VFS layer</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2894859"></a>The general interface</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+Each VFS operation has a vfs_op_type, a function pointer and a handle pointer in the
+struct vfs_ops and tree macros to make it easier to call the operations.
+(Take a look at <tt class="filename">include/vfs.h</tt> and <tt class="filename">include/vfs_macros.h</tt>.)
+</p><pre class="programlisting">
+typedef enum _vfs_op_type {
+ SMB_VFS_OP_NOOP = -1,
+
+ ...
+
+ /* File operations */
+
+ SMB_VFS_OP_OPEN,
+ SMB_VFS_OP_CLOSE,
+ SMB_VFS_OP_READ,
+ SMB_VFS_OP_WRITE,
+ SMB_VFS_OP_LSEEK,
+ SMB_VFS_OP_SENDFILE,
+
+ ...
+
+ SMB_VFS_OP_LAST
+} vfs_op_type;
+</pre><p>This struct contains the function and handle pointers for all operations.</p><pre class="programlisting">
+struct vfs_ops {
+ struct vfs_fn_pointers {
+ ...
+
+ /* File operations */
+
+ int (*open)(struct vfs_handle_struct *handle,
+ struct connection_struct *conn,
+ const char *fname, int flags, mode_t mode);
+ int (*close)(struct vfs_handle_struct *handle,
+ struct files_struct *fsp, int fd);
+ ssize_t (*read)(struct vfs_handle_struct *handle,
+ struct files_struct *fsp, int fd, void *data, size_t n);
+ ssize_t (*write)(struct vfs_handle_struct *handle,
+ struct files_struct *fsp, int fd,
+ const void *data, size_t n);
+ SMB_OFF_T (*lseek)(struct vfs_handle_struct *handle,
+ struct files_struct *fsp, int fd,
+ SMB_OFF_T offset, int whence);
+ ssize_t (*sendfile)(struct vfs_handle_struct *handle,
+ int tofd, files_struct *fsp, int fromfd,
+ const DATA_BLOB *header, SMB_OFF_T offset, size_t count);
+
+ ...
+ } ops;
+
+ struct vfs_handles_pointers {
+ ...
+
+ /* File operations */
+
+ struct vfs_handle_struct *open;
+ struct vfs_handle_struct *close;
+ struct vfs_handle_struct *read;
+ struct vfs_handle_struct *write;
+ struct vfs_handle_struct *lseek;
+ struct vfs_handle_struct *sendfile;
+
+ ...
+ } handles;
+};
+</pre><p>
+This macros SHOULD be used to call any vfs operation.
+DO NOT ACCESS conn-&gt;vfs.ops.* directly !!!
+</p><pre class="programlisting">
+...
+
+/* File operations */
+#define SMB_VFS_OPEN(conn, fname, flags, mode) \
+ ((conn)-&gt;vfs.ops.open((conn)-&gt;vfs.handles.open,\
+ (conn), (fname), (flags), (mode)))
+#define SMB_VFS_CLOSE(fsp, fd) \
+ ((fsp)-&gt;conn-&gt;vfs.ops.close(\
+ (fsp)-&gt;conn-&gt;vfs.handles.close, (fsp), (fd)))
+#define SMB_VFS_READ(fsp, fd, data, n) \
+ ((fsp)-&gt;conn-&gt;vfs.ops.read(\
+ (fsp)-&gt;conn-&gt;vfs.handles.read,\
+ (fsp), (fd), (data), (n)))
+#define SMB_VFS_WRITE(fsp, fd, data, n) \
+ ((fsp)-&gt;conn-&gt;vfs.ops.write(\
+ (fsp)-&gt;conn-&gt;vfs.handles.write,\
+ (fsp), (fd), (data), (n)))
+#define SMB_VFS_LSEEK(fsp, fd, offset, whence) \
+ ((fsp)-&gt;conn-&gt;vfs.ops.lseek(\
+ (fsp)-&gt;conn-&gt;vfs.handles.lseek,\
+ (fsp), (fd), (offset), (whence)))
+#define SMB_VFS_SENDFILE(tofd, fsp, fromfd, header, offset, count) \
+ ((fsp)-&gt;conn-&gt;vfs.ops.sendfile(\
+ (fsp)-&gt;conn-&gt;vfs.handles.sendfile,\
+ (tofd), (fsp), (fromfd), (header), (offset), (count)))
+
+...
+</pre></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2894974"></a>Possible VFS operation layers</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+These values are used by the VFS subsystem when building the conn-&gt;vfs
+and conn-&gt;vfs_opaque structs for a connection with multiple VFS modules.
+Internally, Samba differentiates only opaque and transparent layers at this process.
+Other types are used for providing better diagnosing facilities.
+</p><p>
+Most modules will provide transparent layers. Opaque layer is for modules
+which implement actual file system calls (like DB-based VFS). For example,
+default POSIX VFS which is built in into Samba is an opaque VFS module.
+</p><p>
+Other layer types (logger, splitter, scanner) were designed to provide different
+degree of transparency and for diagnosing VFS module behaviour.
+</p><p>
+Each module can implement several layers at the same time provided that only
+one layer is used per each operation.
+</p><pre class="programlisting">
+typedef enum _vfs_op_layer {
+ SMB_VFS_LAYER_NOOP = -1, /* - For using in VFS module to indicate end of array */
+ /* of operations description */
+ SMB_VFS_LAYER_OPAQUE = 0, /* - Final level, does not call anything beyond itself */
+ SMB_VFS_LAYER_TRANSPARENT, /* - Normal operation, calls underlying layer after */
+ /* possibly changing passed data */
+ SMB_VFS_LAYER_LOGGER, /* - Logs data, calls underlying layer, logging may not */
+ /* use Samba VFS */
+ SMB_VFS_LAYER_SPLITTER, /* - Splits operation, calls underlying layer _and_ own facility, */
+ /* then combines result */
+ SMB_VFS_LAYER_SCANNER /* - Checks data and possibly initiates additional */
+ /* file activity like logging to files _inside_ samba VFS */
+} vfs_op_layer;
+</pre></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2895046"></a>The Interaction between the Samba VFS subsystem and the modules</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2895054"></a>Initialization and registration</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+As each Samba module a VFS module should have a
+</p><pre class="programlisting">NTSTATUS vfs_example_init(void);</pre><p> function if it's staticly linked to samba or
+</p><pre class="programlisting">NTSTATUS init_module(void);</pre><p> function if it's a shared module.
+</p><p>
+This should be the only non static function inside the module.
+Global variables should also be static!
+</p><p>
+The module should register its functions via the
+</p><pre class="programlisting">
+NTSTATUS smb_register_vfs(int version, const char *name, vfs_op_tuple *vfs_op_tuples);
+</pre><p> function.
+</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">version</span></dt><dd><p>should be filled with SMB_VFS_INTERFACE_VERSION</p></dd><dt><span class="term">name</span></dt><dd><p>this is the name witch can be listed in the
+<b class="command">vfs objects</b> parameter to use this module.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">vfs_op_tuples</span></dt><dd><p>
+this is an array of vfs_op_tuple's.
+(vfs_op_tuples is descripted in details below.)
+</p></dd></dl></div><p>
+For each operation the module wants to provide it has a entry in the
+vfs_op_tuple array.
+</p><pre class="programlisting">
+typedef struct _vfs_op_tuple {
+ void* op;
+ vfs_op_type type;
+ vfs_op_layer layer;
+} vfs_op_tuple;
+</pre><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">op</span></dt><dd><p>the function pointer to the specified function.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">type</span></dt><dd><p>the vfs_op_type of the function to specified witch operation the function provides.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">layer</span></dt><dd><p>the vfs_op_layer in whitch the function operates.</p></dd></dl></div><p>A simple example:</p><pre class="programlisting">
+static vfs_op_tuple example_op_tuples[] = {
+ {SMB_VFS_OP(example_connect), SMB_VFS_OP_CONNECT, SMB_VFS_LAYER_TRANSPARENT},
+ {SMB_VFS_OP(example_disconnect), SMB_VFS_OP_DISCONNECT, SMB_VFS_LAYER_TRANSPARENT},
+
+ {SMB_VFS_OP(example_rename), SMB_VFS_OP_RENAME, SMB_VFS_LAYER_OPAQUE},
+
+ /* This indicates the end of the array */
+ {SMB_VFS_OP(NULL), SMB_VFS_OP_NOOP, SMB_VFS_LAYER_NOOP}
+};
+
+NTSTATUS init_module(void)
+{
+ return smb_register_vfs(SMB_VFS_INTERFACE_VERSION, &quot;example&quot;, example_op_tuples);
+}
+</pre></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2895246"></a>How the Modules handle per connection data</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>Each VFS function has as first parameter a pointer to the modules vfs_handle_struct.
+</p><pre class="programlisting">
+typedef struct vfs_handle_struct {
+ struct vfs_handle_struct *next, *prev;
+ const char *param;
+ struct vfs_ops vfs_next;
+ struct connection_struct *conn;
+ void *data;
+ void (*free_data)(void **data);
+} vfs_handle_struct;
+</pre><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">param</span></dt><dd><p>this is the module parameter specified in the <b class="command">vfs objects</b> parameter.</p><p>e.g. for 'vfs objects = example:test' param would be &quot;test&quot;.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">vfs_next</span></dt><dd><p>This vfs_ops struct contains the information for calling the next module operations.
+Use the vfs_next_* macros to call a next module operations and
+don't access handle-&gt;vfs_next.ops.* directly!</p></dd><dt><span class="term">conn</span></dt><dd><p>This is a pointer back to the connection_struct to witch the handle belongs.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">data</span></dt><dd><p>This is a pointer for holding module private data.
+You can alloc data with connection life time on the handle-&gt;conn-&gt;mem_ctx TALLOC_CTX.
+But you can also manage the memory allocation yourself.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">free_data</span></dt><dd><p>This is a function pointer to a function that free's the module private data.
+If you talloc your private data on the TALLOC_CTX handle-&gt;conn-&gt;mem_ctx,
+you can set this function pointer to NULL.</p></dd></dl></div><p>Some useful MACROS for handle private data.
+</p><pre class="programlisting">
+#define SMB_VFS_HANDLE_GET_DATA(handle, datap, type, ret) { \
+ if (!(handle)||((datap=(type *)(handle)-&gt;data)==NULL)) { \
+ DEBUG(0,(&quot;%s() failed to get vfs_handle-&gt;data!\n&quot;,FUNCTION_MACRO)); \
+ ret; \
+ } \
+}
+
+#define SMB_VFS_HANDLE_SET_DATA(handle, datap, free_fn, type, ret) { \
+ if (!(handle)) { \
+ DEBUG(0,(&quot;%s() failed to set handle-&gt;data!\n&quot;,FUNCTION_MACRO)); \
+ ret; \
+ } else { \
+ if ((handle)-&gt;free_data) { \
+ (handle)-&gt;free_data(&amp;(handle)-&gt;data); \
+ } \
+ (handle)-&gt;data = (void *)datap; \
+ (handle)-&gt;free_data = free_fn; \
+ } \
+}
+
+#define SMB_VFS_HANDLE_FREE_DATA(handle) { \
+ if ((handle) &amp;&amp; (handle)-&gt;free_data) { \
+ (handle)-&gt;free_data(&amp;(handle)-&gt;data); \
+ } \
+}
+</pre><p>How SMB_VFS_LAYER_TRANSPARENT functions can call the SMB_VFS_LAYER_OPAQUE functions.</p><p>The easiest way to do this is to use the SMB_VFS_OPAQUE_* macros.
+</p><pre class="programlisting">
+...
+/* File operations */
+#define SMB_VFS_OPAQUE_OPEN(conn, fname, flags, mode) \
+ ((conn)-&gt;vfs_opaque.ops.open(\
+ (conn)-&gt;vfs_opaque.handles.open,\
+ (conn), (fname), (flags), (mode)))
+#define SMB_VFS_OPAQUE_CLOSE(fsp, fd) \
+ ((fsp)-&gt;conn-&gt;vfs_opaque.ops.close(\
+ (fsp)-&gt;conn-&gt;vfs_opaque.handles.close,\
+ (fsp), (fd)))
+#define SMB_VFS_OPAQUE_READ(fsp, fd, data, n) \
+ ((fsp)-&gt;conn-&gt;vfs_opaque.ops.read(\
+ (fsp)-&gt;conn-&gt;vfs_opaque.handles.read,\
+ (fsp), (fd), (data), (n)))
+#define SMB_VFS_OPAQUE_WRITE(fsp, fd, data, n) \
+ ((fsp)-&gt;conn-&gt;vfs_opaque.ops.write(\
+ (fsp)-&gt;conn-&gt;vfs_opaque.handles.write,\
+ (fsp), (fd), (data), (n)))
+#define SMB_VFS_OPAQUE_LSEEK(fsp, fd, offset, whence) \
+ ((fsp)-&gt;conn-&gt;vfs_opaque.ops.lseek(\
+ (fsp)-&gt;conn-&gt;vfs_opaque.handles.lseek,\
+ (fsp), (fd), (offset), (whence)))
+#define SMB_VFS_OPAQUE_SENDFILE(tofd, fsp, fromfd, header, offset, count) \
+ ((fsp)-&gt;conn-&gt;vfs_opaque.ops.sendfile(\
+ (fsp)-&gt;conn-&gt;vfs_opaque.handles.sendfile,\
+ (tofd), (fsp), (fromfd), (header), (offset), (count)))
+...
+</pre><p>How SMB_VFS_LAYER_TRANSPARENT functions can call the next modules functions.</p><p>The easiest way to do this is to use the SMB_VFS_NEXT_* macros.
+</p><pre class="programlisting">
+...
+/* File operations */
+#define SMB_VFS_NEXT_OPEN(handle, conn, fname, flags, mode) \
+ ((handle)-&gt;vfs_next.ops.open(\
+ (handle)-&gt;vfs_next.handles.open,\
+ (conn), (fname), (flags), (mode)))
+#define SMB_VFS_NEXT_CLOSE(handle, fsp, fd) \
+ ((handle)-&gt;vfs_next.ops.close(\
+ (handle)-&gt;vfs_next.handles.close,\
+ (fsp), (fd)))
+#define SMB_VFS_NEXT_READ(handle, fsp, fd, data, n) \
+ ((handle)-&gt;vfs_next.ops.read(\
+ (handle)-&gt;vfs_next.handles.read,\
+ (fsp), (fd), (data), (n)))
+#define SMB_VFS_NEXT_WRITE(handle, fsp, fd, data, n) \
+ ((handle)-&gt;vfs_next.ops.write(\
+ (handle)-&gt;vfs_next.handles.write,\
+ (fsp), (fd), (data), (n)))
+#define SMB_VFS_NEXT_LSEEK(handle, fsp, fd, offset, whence) \
+ ((handle)-&gt;vfs_next.ops.lseek(\
+ (handle)-&gt;vfs_next.handles.lseek,\
+ (fsp), (fd), (offset), (whence)))
+#define SMB_VFS_NEXT_SENDFILE(handle, tofd, fsp, fromfd, header, offset, count) \
+ ((handle)-&gt;vfs_next.ops.sendfile(\
+ (handle)-&gt;vfs_next.handles.sendfile,\
+ (tofd), (fsp), (fromfd), (header), (offset), (count)))
+...
+</pre></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2895490"></a>Upgrading to the New VFS Interface</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2895497"></a>Upgrading from 2.2.* and 3.0aplha modules</h3></div></div><div></div></div><div class="orderedlist"><ol type="1"><li><p>
+Add &quot;vfs_handle_struct *handle, &quot; as first parameter to all vfs operation functions.
+e.g. example_connect(connection_struct *conn, const char *service, const char *user);
+-&gt; example_connect(vfs_handle_struct *handle, connection_struct *conn, const char *service, const char *user);
+</p></li><li><p>
+Replace &quot;default_vfs_ops.&quot; with &quot;smb_vfs_next_&quot;.
+e.g. default_vfs_ops.connect(conn, service, user);
+-&gt; smb_vfs_next_connect(conn, service, user);
+</p></li><li><p>
+Uppercase all &quot;vfs_next_*&quot; functions.
+e.g. smb_vfs_next_connect(conn, service, user);
+-&gt; SMB_VFS_NEXT_CONNECT(conn, service, user);
+</p></li><li><p>
+Add &quot;handle, &quot; as first parameter to all VFS_NEXT_*() calls.
+e.g. SMB_VFS_NEXT_CONNECT(conn, service, user);
+-&gt; SMB_VFS_NEXT_CONNECT(handle, conn, service, user);
+</p></li><li><p>
+(Only for 2.2.* modules)
+Convert the old struct vfs_ops example_ops to
+a vfs_op_tuple example_op_tuples[] array.
+e.g.
+</p><pre class="programlisting">
+struct vfs_ops example_ops = {
+ /* Disk operations */
+ example_connect, /* connect */
+ example_disconnect, /* disconnect */
+ NULL, /* disk free *
+ /* Directory operations */
+ NULL, /* opendir */
+ NULL, /* readdir */
+ NULL, /* mkdir */
+ NULL, /* rmdir */
+ NULL, /* closedir */
+ /* File operations */
+ NULL, /* open */
+ NULL, /* close */
+ NULL, /* read */
+ NULL, /* write */
+ NULL, /* lseek */
+ NULL, /* sendfile */
+ NULL, /* rename */
+ NULL, /* fsync */
+ example_stat, /* stat */
+ example_fstat, /* fstat */
+ example_lstat, /* lstat */
+ NULL, /* unlink */
+ NULL, /* chmod */
+ NULL, /* fchmod */
+ NULL, /* chown */
+ NULL, /* fchown */
+ NULL, /* chdir */
+ NULL, /* getwd */
+ NULL, /* utime */
+ NULL, /* ftruncate */
+ NULL, /* lock */
+ NULL, /* symlink */
+ NULL, /* readlink */
+ NULL, /* link */
+ NULL, /* mknod */
+ NULL, /* realpath */
+ NULL, /* fget_nt_acl */
+ NULL, /* get_nt_acl */
+ NULL, /* fset_nt_acl */
+ NULL, /* set_nt_acl */
+
+ NULL, /* chmod_acl */
+ NULL, /* fchmod_acl */
+
+ NULL, /* sys_acl_get_entry */
+ NULL, /* sys_acl_get_tag_type */
+ NULL, /* sys_acl_get_permset */
+ NULL, /* sys_acl_get_qualifier */
+ NULL, /* sys_acl_get_file */
+ NULL, /* sys_acl_get_fd */
+ NULL, /* sys_acl_clear_perms */
+ NULL, /* sys_acl_add_perm */
+ NULL, /* sys_acl_to_text */
+ NULL, /* sys_acl_init */
+ NULL, /* sys_acl_create_entry */
+ NULL, /* sys_acl_set_tag_type */
+ NULL, /* sys_acl_set_qualifier */
+ NULL, /* sys_acl_set_permset */
+ NULL, /* sys_acl_valid */
+ NULL, /* sys_acl_set_file */
+ NULL, /* sys_acl_set_fd */
+ NULL, /* sys_acl_delete_def_file */
+ NULL, /* sys_acl_get_perm */
+ NULL, /* sys_acl_free_text */
+ NULL, /* sys_acl_free_acl */
+ NULL /* sys_acl_free_qualifier */
+};
+</pre><p>
+-&gt;
+</p><pre class="programlisting">
+static vfs_op_tuple example_op_tuples[] = {
+ {SMB_VFS_OP(example_connect), SMB_VFS_OP_CONNECT, SMB_VFS_LAYER_TRANSPARENT},
+ {SMB_VFS_OP(example_disconnect), SMB_VFS_OP_DISCONNECT, SMB_VFS_LAYER_TRANSPARENT},
+
+ {SMB_VFS_OP(example_fstat), SMB_VFS_OP_FSTAT, SMB_VFS_LAYER_TRANSPARENT},
+ {SMB_VFS_OP(example_stat), SMB_VFS_OP_STAT, SMB_VFS_LAYER_TRANSPARENT},
+ {SMB_VFS_OP(example_lstat), SMB_VFS_OP_LSTAT, SMB_VFS_LAYER_TRANSPARENT},
+
+ {SMB_VFS_OP(NULL), SMB_VFS_OP_NOOP, SMB_VFS_LAYER_NOOP}
+};
+</pre><p>
+</p></li><li><p>
+Move the example_op_tuples[] array to the end of the file.
+</p></li><li><p>
+Add the init_module() function at the end of the file.
+e.g.
+</p><pre class="programlisting">
+NTSTATUS init_module(void)
+{
+ return smb_register_vfs(SMB_VFS_INTERFACE_VERSION,&quot;example&quot;,example_op_tuples);
+}
+</pre><p>
+</p></li><li><p>
+Check if your vfs_init() function does more then just prepare the vfs_ops structs or
+remember the struct smb_vfs_handle_struct.
+</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td>If NOT you can remove the vfs_init() function.</td></tr><tr><td>If YES decide if you want to move the code to the example_connect() operation or to the init_module(). And then remove vfs_init().
+ e.g. a debug class registration should go into init_module() and the allocation of private data should go to example_connect().</td></tr></table><p>
+</p></li><li><p>
+(Only for 3.0alpha* modules)
+Check if your vfs_done() function contains needed code.
+</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td>If NOT you can remove the vfs_done() function.</td></tr><tr><td>If YES decide if you can move the code to the example_disconnect() operation. Otherwise register a SMB_EXIT_EVENT with smb_register_exit_event(); (Described in the <a href="#modules" title="Chapter 14. Modules">modules section</a>) And then remove vfs_done(). e.g. the freeing of private data should go to example_disconnect().
+</td></tr></table><p>
+</p></li><li><p>
+Check if you have any global variables left.
+Decide if it wouldn't be better to have this data on a connection basis.
+</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td>If NOT leave them as they are. (e.g. this could be the variable for the private debug class.)</td></tr><tr><td>If YES pack all this data into a struct. You can use handle-&gt;data to point to such a struct on a per connection basis.</td></tr></table><p>
+
+ e.g. if you have such a struct:
+</p><pre class="programlisting">
+struct example_privates {
+ char *some_string;
+ int db_connection;
+};
+</pre><p>
+first way of doing it:
+</p><pre class="programlisting">
+static int example_connect(vfs_handle_struct *handle,
+ connection_struct *conn, const char *service,
+ const char* user)
+{
+ struct example_privates *data = NULL;
+
+ /* alloc our private data */
+ data = (struct example_privates *)talloc_zero(conn-&gt;mem_ctx, sizeof(struct example_privates));
+ if (!data) {
+ DEBUG(0,(&quot;talloc_zero() failed\n&quot;));
+ return -1;
+ }
+
+ /* init out private data */
+ data-&gt;some_string = talloc_strdup(conn-&gt;mem_ctx,&quot;test&quot;);
+ if (!data-&gt;some_string) {
+ DEBUG(0,(&quot;talloc_strdup() failed\n&quot;));
+ return -1;
+ }
+
+ data-&gt;db_connection = open_db_conn();
+
+ /* and now store the private data pointer in handle-&gt;data
+ * we don't need to specify a free_function here because
+ * we use the connection TALLOC context.
+ * (return -1 if something failed.)
+ */
+ VFS_HANDLE_SET_DATA(handle, data, NULL, struct example_privates, return -1);
+
+ return SMB_VFS_NEXT_CONNECT(handle,conn,service,user);
+}
+
+static int example_close(vfs_handle_struct *handle, files_struct *fsp, int fd)
+{
+ struct example_privates *data = NULL;
+
+ /* get the pointer to our private data
+ * return -1 if something failed
+ */
+ SMB_VFS_HANDLE_GET_DATA(handle, data, struct example_privates, return -1);
+
+ /* do something here...*/
+ DEBUG(0,(&quot;some_string: %s\n&quot;,data-&gt;some_string));
+
+ return SMB_VFS_NEXT_CLOSE(handle, fsp, fd);
+}
+</pre><p>
+second way of doing it:
+</p><pre class="programlisting">
+static void free_example_privates(void **datap)
+{
+ struct example_privates *data = (struct example_privates *)*datap;
+
+ SAFE_FREE(data-&gt;some_string);
+ SAFE_FREE(data);
+
+ datap = NULL;
+
+ return;
+}
+
+static int example_connect(vfs_handle_struct *handle,
+ connection_struct *conn, const char *service,
+ const char* user)
+{
+ struct example_privates *data = NULL;
+
+ /* alloc our private data */
+ data = (struct example_privates *)malloc(sizeof(struct example_privates));
+ if (!data) {
+ DEBUG(0,(&quot;malloc() failed\n&quot;));
+ return -1;
+ }
+
+ /* init out private data */
+ data-&gt;some_string = strdup(conn-&gt;mem_ctx,&quot;test&quot;);
+ if (!data-&gt;some_string) {
+ DEBUG(0,(&quot;strdup() failed\n&quot;));
+ return -1;
+ }
+
+ data-&gt;db_connection = open_db_conn();
+
+ /* and now store the private data pointer in handle-&gt;data
+ * we need to specify a free_function because we used malloc() and strdup().
+ * (return -1 if something failed.)
+ */
+ SMB_VFS_HANDLE_SET_DATA(handle, data, NULL, struct example_privates, return -1);
+
+ return SMB_VFS_NEXT_CONNECT(handle,conn,service,user);
+}
+
+static int example_close(vfs_handle_struct *handle, files_struct *fsp, int fd)
+{
+ struct example_privates *data = NULL;
+
+ /* get the pointer to our private data
+ * return -1 if something failed
+ */
+ SMB_VFS_HANDLE_GET_DATA(handle, data, struct example_privates, return -1);
+
+ /* do something here...*/
+ DEBUG(0,(&quot;some_string: %s\n&quot;,data-&gt;some_string));
+
+ return VFS_NEXT_CLOSE(handle, fsp, fd);
+}
+</pre><p>
+</p></li><li><p>
+To make it easy to build 3rd party modules it would be usefull to provide
+configure.in, (configure), install.sh and Makefile.in with the module.
+(Take a look at the example in <tt class="filename">examples/VFS</tt>.)
+</p><p>
+The configure script accepts <tt class="option">--with-samba-source</tt> to specify
+the path to the samba source tree.
+It also accept <tt class="option">--enable-developer</tt> which lets the compiler
+give you more warnings.
+</p><p>
+The idea is that you can extend this
+<tt class="filename">configure.in</tt> and <tt class="filename">Makefile.in</tt> scripts
+for your module.
+</p></li><li><p>
+Compiling &amp; Testing...
+</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><b class="userinput"><tt>./configure <tt class="option">--enable-developer</tt></tt></b> ...</td></tr><tr><td><b class="userinput"><tt>make</tt></b></td></tr><tr><td>Try to fix all compiler warnings</td></tr><tr><td><b class="userinput"><tt>make</tt></b></td></tr><tr><td>Testing, Testing, Testing ...</td></tr></table><p>
+</p></li></ol></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2896037"></a>Some Notes</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2896044"></a>Implement TRANSPARENT functions</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+Avoid writing functions like this:
+
+</p><pre class="programlisting">
+static int example_close(vfs_handle_struct *handle, files_struct *fsp, int fd)
+{
+ return SMB_VFS_NEXT_CLOSE(handle, fsp, fd);
+}
+</pre><p>
+
+Overload only the functions you really need to!
+</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2896069"></a>Implement OPAQUE functions</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+If you want to just implement a better version of a
+default samba opaque function
+(e.g. like a disk_free() function for a special filesystem)
+it's ok to just overload that specific function.
+</p><p>
+If you want to implement a database filesystem or
+something different from a posix filesystem.
+Make sure that you overload every vfs operation!!!
+</p><p>
+Functions your FS does not support should be overloaded by something like this:
+e.g. for a readonly filesystem.
+</p><pre class="programlisting">
+static int example_rename(vfs_handle_struct *handle, connection_struct *conn,
+ char *oldname, char *newname)
+{
+ DEBUG(10,(&quot;function rename() not allowed on vfs 'example'\n&quot;));
+ errno = ENOSYS;
+ return -1;
+}
+</pre></div></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="Packaging"></a>Chapter 17. Notes to packagers</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3></div></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2894645">Versioning</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2894678">Modules</a></dt></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2894645"></a>Versioning</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>Please, please update the version number in
+<tt class="filename">source/include/version.h</tt> to include the versioning of your package. This makes it easier to distinguish standard samba builds
+from custom-build samba builds (distributions often patch packages). For
+example, a good version would be: </p><pre class="programlisting">
+Version 2.999+3.0.alpha21-5 for Debian
+</pre></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2894678"></a>Modules</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>Samba now has support for building parts of samba as plugins. This
+makes it possible to, for example, put ldap or mysql support in a seperate
+package, thus making it possible to have a normal samba package not
+depending on ldap or mysql. To build as much parts of samba
+as a plugin, run: </p><pre class="programlisting">
+./configure --with-shared-modules=rpc,vfs,auth,pdb,charset
+</pre></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="contributing"></a>Chapter 18. Contributing code</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="othername">R.</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">The Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email">&lt;<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</a>&gt;</tt></p></div></div></div></div></div><div></div></div><p>Here are a few tips and notes that might be useful if you are
+ interested in modifying samba source code and getting it into
+ samba's main branch.</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">Retrieving the source</span></dt><dd><p>In order to contribute code to samba, make sure you have the
+ latest source. Retrieving the samba source code from CVS is
+ documented in the appendix of the Samba HOWTO Collection.
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term">Discuss large modifications with team members</span></dt><dd><p>Please discuss large modifications you are going to make
+ with members of the samba team. Some parts of the samba code
+ have one or more 'owners' - samba developers who wrote most
+ of the code and maintain it.
+ </p><p>This way you can avoid spending your time and effort on
+ something that is not going to make it into the main samba branch
+ because someone else was working on the same thing or because your
+ implementation is not the correct one.
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term">Patch format</span></dt><dd><p>Patches to the samba tree should be in unified diff format,
+ e.g. files generated by <b class="userinput"><tt>diff -u</tt></b>.
+ </p><p>If you are modifying a copy of samba you retrieved from CVS,
+ you can easily generate a diff file of these changes by running
+ <b class="userinput"><tt>cvs diff -u</tt></b>.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">Points of attention when modifying samba source code</span></dt><dd><p>
+ </p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td>Don't simply copy code from other places and modify it until it
+ works. Code needs to be clean and logical. Duplicate
+ code is to be avoided.</td></tr><tr><td>Test your patch. It might take a while before one of us looks
+ at your patch so it will take longer before your patch when your patch
+ needs to go thru the review cycle again.</td></tr><tr><td>Don't put seperate patches in one large diff file. This makes
+ it harder to read, understand and test the patch. You might
+ also risk not getting a good patch committed because you mixed it
+ with one that had issues. </td></tr><tr><td>Make sure your patch complies to the samba coding style as
+ suggested in the coding-suggestions chapter. </td></tr></table><p>
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term">Sending in bugfixes</span></dt><dd><p>Bugfixes to bugs in samba should be submitted to samba's
+ <a href="https://bugzilla.samba.org/" target="_top">bugzilla system</a>,
+ along with a description of the bug.
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term">Sending in feature patches</span></dt><dd><p>Send feature patches along with a description of what the
+ patch is supposed to do to the
+ <a href="mailto:samba-technical@samba.org" target="_top">Samba-technical mailinglist</a> and possibly to a samba team member who is (one of the) 'owners'
+ of the code you made modifications to. We are all busy people
+ so everybody tends to 'let one of the others handle it'. If nobody
+ responded to your patch for a week, try to send it again until you
+ get a response from one of us.
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term">Feedback on your patch</span></dt><dd><p>One of the team members will look at your patch and either
+ commit your patch or give comments why he won't apply it. In the
+ latter case you can fix your patch and re-send it until
+ your patch is approved.</p></dd></dl></div></div></div></body></html>
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/bugreport.html b/docs/htmldocs/bugreport.html
index fcc4b7e91a..01b88729ed 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/bugreport.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/bugreport.html
@@ -1,352 +1,119 @@
-<!DOCTYPE HTML PUBLIC "-//W3C//DTD HTML 4.01 Transitional//EN">
-<HTML
-><HEAD
-><TITLE
->Reporting Bugs</TITLE
-><META
-NAME="GENERATOR"
-CONTENT="Modular DocBook HTML Stylesheet Version 1.76b+
-"><LINK
-REL="HOME"
-TITLE="SAMBA Project Documentation"
-HREF="samba-howto-collection.html"><LINK
-REL="UP"
-TITLE="Appendixes"
-HREF="appendixes.html"><LINK
-REL="PREVIOUS"
-TITLE="Samba and other CIFS clients"
-HREF="other-clients.html"><LINK
-REL="NEXT"
-TITLE="Diagnosing your samba server"
-HREF="diagnosis.html"></HEAD
-><BODY
-CLASS="CHAPTER"
-BGCOLOR="#FFFFFF"
-TEXT="#000000"
-LINK="#0000FF"
-VLINK="#840084"
-ALINK="#0000FF"
-><DIV
-CLASS="NAVHEADER"
-><TABLE
-SUMMARY="Header navigation table"
-WIDTH="100%"
-BORDER="0"
-CELLPADDING="0"
-CELLSPACING="0"
-><TR
-><TH
-COLSPAN="3"
-ALIGN="center"
->SAMBA Project Documentation</TH
-></TR
-><TR
-><TD
-WIDTH="10%"
-ALIGN="left"
-VALIGN="bottom"
-><A
-HREF="other-clients.html"
-ACCESSKEY="P"
->Prev</A
-></TD
-><TD
-WIDTH="80%"
-ALIGN="center"
-VALIGN="bottom"
-></TD
-><TD
-WIDTH="10%"
-ALIGN="right"
-VALIGN="bottom"
-><A
-HREF="diagnosis.html"
-ACCESSKEY="N"
->Next</A
-></TD
-></TR
-></TABLE
-><HR
-ALIGN="LEFT"
-WIDTH="100%"></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="CHAPTER"
-><H1
-><A
-NAME="BUGREPORT">Chapter 25. Reporting Bugs</H1
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><H1
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN3309">25.1. Introduction</H1
-><P
->The email address for bug reports for stable releases is <A
-HREF="samba@samba.org"
-TARGET="_top"
->samba@samba.org</A
->.
-Bug reports for alpha releases should go to <A
-HREF="mailto:samba-technical@samba.org"
-TARGET="_top"
->samba-technical@samba.org</A
->.</P
-><P
->Please take the time to read this file before you submit a bug
+<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 35. Reporting Bugs</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="troubleshooting.html" title="Part V. Troubleshooting"><link rel="previous" href="problems.html" title="Chapter 34. Analysing and solving samba problems"><link rel="next" href="Appendixes.html" title="Part VI. Appendixes"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 35. Reporting Bugs</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="problems.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part V. Troubleshooting</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="Appendixes.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="bugreport"></a>Chapter 35. Reporting Bugs</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="othername">R.</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">The Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email">&lt;<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</a>&gt;</tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="surname">Someone; Tridge or Karl Auer perhaps?</span></h3></div></div><div><p class="pubdate"> 27 June 1997 </p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="bugreport.html#id3011690">Introduction</a></dt><dt><a href="bugreport.html#id3011912">General info</a></dt><dt><a href="bugreport.html#id3011949">Debug levels</a></dt><dt><a href="bugreport.html#id3012091">Internal errors</a></dt><dt><a href="bugreport.html#id3012199">Attaching to a running process</a></dt><dt><a href="bugreport.html#id3012246">Patches</a></dt></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id3011690"></a>Introduction</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>Please report bugs using
+ <a href="https://bugzilla.samba.org/" target="_top">bugzilla</a>.</p><p>
+Please take the time to read this file before you submit a bug
report. Also, please see if it has changed between releases, as we
-may be changing the bug reporting mechanism at some time.</P
-><P
->Please also do as much as you can yourself to help track down the
+may be changing the bug reporting mechanism at some time.
+</p><p>
+Please also do as much as you can yourself to help track down the
bug. Samba is maintained by a dedicated group of people who volunteer
their time, skills and efforts. We receive far more mail about it than
we can possibly answer, so you have a much higher chance of an answer
-and a fix if you send us a "developer friendly" bug report that lets
-us fix it fast. </P
-><P
->Do not assume that if you post the bug to the comp.protocols.smb
+and a fix if you send us a &quot;developer friendly&quot; bug report that lets
+us fix it fast.
+</p><p>
+Do not assume that if you post the bug to the comp.protocols.smb
newsgroup or the mailing list that we will read it. If you suspect that your
problem is not a bug but a configuration problem then it is better to send
it to the Samba mailing list, as there are (at last count) 5000 other users on
-that list that may be able to help you.</P
-><P
->You may also like to look though the recent mailing list archives,
+that list that may be able to help you.
+</p><p>
+You may also like to look though the recent mailing list archives,
which are conveniently accessible on the Samba web pages
-at <A
-HREF="http://samba.org/samba/"
-TARGET="_top"
->http://samba.org/samba/</A
->.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><H1
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN3319">25.2. General info</H1
-><P
->Before submitting a bug report check your config for silly
+at <a href="http://samba.org/samba/" target="_top">http://samba.org/samba/</a>.
+</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id3011912"></a>General info</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+Before submitting a bug report check your config for silly
errors. Look in your log files for obvious messages that tell you that
you've misconfigured something and run testparm to test your config
-file for correct syntax.</P
-><P
->Have you run through the <A
-HREF="Diagnosis.html"
-TARGET="_top"
->diagnosis</A
->?
-This is very important.</P
-><P
->If you include part of a log file with your bug report then be sure to
+file for correct syntax.
+</p><p>
+Have you run through the <a href="diagnosis.html" title="Chapter 33. The samba checklist">diagnosis</a>?
+This is very important.
+</p><p>
+If you include part of a log file with your bug report then be sure to
annotate it with exactly what you were doing on the client at the
-time, and exactly what the results were.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><H1
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN3325">25.3. Debug levels</H1
-><P
->If the bug has anything to do with Samba behaving incorrectly as a
+time, and exactly what the results were.
+</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id3011949"></a>Debug levels</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+If the bug has anything to do with Samba behaving incorrectly as a
server (like refusing to open a file) then the log files will probably
be very useful. Depending on the problem a log level of between 3 and
10 showing the problem may be appropriate. A higher level givesmore
-detail, but may use too much disk space.</P
-><P
->To set the debug level use <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->log level =</B
-> in your
-<TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->smb.conf</TT
->. You may also find it useful to set the log
+detail, but may use too much disk space.
+</p><p>
+To set the debug level use the <i class="parameter"><tt>log level</tt></i> in your
+<tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>. You may also find it useful to set the log
level higher for just one machine and keep separate logs for each machine.
-To do this use:</P
-><P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
->log level = 10
+To do this use:
+</p><pre class="programlisting">
+log level = 10
log file = /usr/local/samba/lib/log.%m
-include = /usr/local/samba/lib/smb.conf.%m</PRE
-></P
-><P
->then create a file
-<TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/usr/local/samba/lib/smb.conf.machine</TT
-> where
-"machine" is the name of the client you wish to debug. In that file
-put any smb.conf commands you want, for example
-<B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->log level=</B
-> may be useful. This also allows you to
+include = /usr/local/samba/lib/smb.conf.%m
+</pre><p>
+then create a file
+<tt class="filename">/usr/local/samba/lib/smb.conf.<i class="replaceable"><tt>machine</tt></i></tt> where
+<i class="replaceable"><tt>machine</tt></i> is the name of the client you wish to debug. In that file
+put any <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> commands you want, for example
+<i class="parameter"><tt>log level</tt></i> may be useful. This also allows you to
experiment with different security systems, protocol levels etc on just
-one machine.</P
-><P
->The <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->smb.conf</TT
-> entry <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->log level =</B
->
-is synonymous with the entry <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->debuglevel =</B
-> that has been
-used in older versions of Samba and is being retained for backwards
-compatibility of smb.conf files.</P
-><P
->As the <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->log level =</B
-> value is increased you will record
+one machine.
+</p><p>
+The <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> entry <i class="parameter"><tt>log level</tt></i>
+is synonymous with the parameter <i class="parameter"><tt>debuglevel</tt></i> that has
+been used in older versions of Samba and is being retained for backwards
+compatibility of <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> files.
+</p><p>
+As the <i class="parameter"><tt>log level</tt></i> value is increased you will record
a significantly increasing level of debugging information. For most
-debugging operations you may not need a setting higher than 3. Nearly
-all bugs can be tracked at a setting of 10, but be prepared for a VERY
-large volume of log data.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><H1
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN3342">25.4. Internal errors</H1
-><P
->If you get a "INTERNAL ERROR" message in your log files it means that
-Samba got an unexpected signal while running. It is probably a
+debugging operations you may not need a setting higher than
+<tt class="constant">3</tt>. Nearly
+all bugs can be tracked at a setting of <tt class="constant">10</tt>, but be
+prepared for a VERY large volume of log data.
+</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id3012091"></a>Internal errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+If you get a <span class="errorname">INTERNAL ERROR</span> message in your log files
+it means that Samba got an unexpected signal while running. It is probably a
segmentation fault and almost certainly means a bug in Samba (unless
-you have faulty hardware or system software)</P
-><P
->If the message came from smbd then it will probably be accompanied by
+you have faulty hardware or system software).
+</p><p>
+If the message came from smbd then it will probably be accompanied by
a message which details the last SMB message received by smbd. This
info is often very useful in tracking down the problem so please
-include it in your bug report.</P
-><P
->You should also detail how to reproduce the problem, if
-possible. Please make this reasonably detailed.</P
-><P
->You may also find that a core file appeared in a "corefiles"
+include it in your bug report.
+</p><p>
+You should also detail how to reproduce the problem, if
+possible. Please make this reasonably detailed.
+</p><p>
+You may also find that a core file appeared in a <tt class="filename">corefiles</tt>
subdirectory of the directory where you keep your samba log
files. This file is the most useful tool for tracking down the bug. To
-use it you do this:</P
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->gdb smbd core</B
-></P
-><P
->adding appropriate paths to smbd and core so gdb can find them. If you
-don't have gdb then try "dbx". Then within the debugger use the
-command "where" to give a stack trace of where the problem
-occurred. Include this in your mail.</P
-><P
->If you known any assembly language then do a "disass" of the routine
+use it you do this:
+</p><pre class="screen">
+ <tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>gdb smbd core</tt></b>
+</pre><p>
+adding appropriate paths to smbd and core so gdb can find them. If you
+don't have gdb then try <b class="userinput"><tt>dbx</tt></b>. Then within the debugger
+use the command <b class="command">where</b> to give a stack trace of where the
+problem occurred. Include this in your report.
+</p><p>
+If you know any assembly language then do a
+<b class="command">disass</b> of the routine
where the problem occurred (if its in a library routine then
disassemble the routine that called it) and try to work out exactly
where the problem is by looking at the surrounding code. Even if you
don't know assembly then incuding this info in the bug report can be
-useful. </P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><H1
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN3352">25.5. Attaching to a running process</H1
-><P
->Unfortunately some unixes (in particular some recent linux kernels)
+useful.
+</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id3012199"></a>Attaching to a running process</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+Unfortunately some unixes (in particular some recent linux kernels)
refuse to dump a core file if the task has changed uid (which smbd
does often). To debug with this sort of system you could try to attach
-to the running process using "gdb smbd PID" where you get PID from
-smbstatus. Then use "c" to continue and try to cause the core dump
+to the running process using
+<b class="userinput"><tt>gdb smbd <i class="replaceable"><tt>PID</tt></i></tt></b> where you get
+<i class="replaceable"><tt>PID</tt></i> from <span class="application">smbstatus</span>.
+Then use <b class="command">c</b> to continue and try to cause the core dump
using the client. The debugger should catch the fault and tell you
-where it occurred.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><H1
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN3355">25.6. Patches</H1
-><P
->The best sort of bug report is one that includes a fix! If you send us
-patches please use <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->diff -u</B
-> format if your version of
-diff supports it, otherwise use <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->diff -c4</B
->. Make sure
-your do the diff against a clean version of the source and let me know
-exactly what version you used. </P
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="NAVFOOTER"
-><HR
-ALIGN="LEFT"
-WIDTH="100%"><TABLE
-SUMMARY="Footer navigation table"
-WIDTH="100%"
-BORDER="0"
-CELLPADDING="0"
-CELLSPACING="0"
-><TR
-><TD
-WIDTH="33%"
-ALIGN="left"
-VALIGN="top"
-><A
-HREF="other-clients.html"
-ACCESSKEY="P"
->Prev</A
-></TD
-><TD
-WIDTH="34%"
-ALIGN="center"
-VALIGN="top"
-><A
-HREF="samba-howto-collection.html"
-ACCESSKEY="H"
->Home</A
-></TD
-><TD
-WIDTH="33%"
-ALIGN="right"
-VALIGN="top"
-><A
-HREF="diagnosis.html"
-ACCESSKEY="N"
->Next</A
-></TD
-></TR
-><TR
-><TD
-WIDTH="33%"
-ALIGN="left"
-VALIGN="top"
->Samba and other CIFS clients</TD
-><TD
-WIDTH="34%"
-ALIGN="center"
-VALIGN="top"
-><A
-HREF="appendixes.html"
-ACCESSKEY="U"
->Up</A
-></TD
-><TD
-WIDTH="33%"
-ALIGN="right"
-VALIGN="top"
->Diagnosing your samba server</TD
-></TR
-></TABLE
-></DIV
-></BODY
-></HTML
-> \ No newline at end of file
+where it occurred.
+</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id3012246"></a>Patches</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+The best sort of bug report is one that includes a fix! If you send us
+patches please use <b class="userinput"><tt>diff -u</tt></b> format if your version of
+diff supports it, otherwise use <b class="userinput"><tt>diff -c4</tt></b>. Make sure
+you do the diff against a clean version of the source and let me know
+exactly what version you used.
+</p></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="problems.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="troubleshooting.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="Appendixes.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 34. Analysing and solving samba problems </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="index.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Part VI. Appendixes</td></tr></table></div></body></html>
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/diagnosis.html b/docs/htmldocs/diagnosis.html
index a7b2e59436..af242b6006 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/diagnosis.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/diagnosis.html
@@ -1,627 +1,302 @@
-<!DOCTYPE HTML PUBLIC "-//W3C//DTD HTML 4.01 Transitional//EN">
-<HTML
-><HEAD
-><TITLE
->Diagnosing your samba server</TITLE
-><META
-NAME="GENERATOR"
-CONTENT="Modular DocBook HTML Stylesheet Version 1.76b+
-"><LINK
-REL="HOME"
-TITLE="SAMBA Project Documentation"
-HREF="samba-howto-collection.html"><LINK
-REL="UP"
-TITLE="Appendixes"
-HREF="appendixes.html"><LINK
-REL="PREVIOUS"
-TITLE="Reporting Bugs"
-HREF="bugreport.html"></HEAD
-><BODY
-CLASS="CHAPTER"
-BGCOLOR="#FFFFFF"
-TEXT="#000000"
-LINK="#0000FF"
-VLINK="#840084"
-ALINK="#0000FF"
-><DIV
-CLASS="NAVHEADER"
-><TABLE
-SUMMARY="Header navigation table"
-WIDTH="100%"
-BORDER="0"
-CELLPADDING="0"
-CELLSPACING="0"
-><TR
-><TH
-COLSPAN="3"
-ALIGN="center"
->SAMBA Project Documentation</TH
-></TR
-><TR
-><TD
-WIDTH="10%"
-ALIGN="left"
-VALIGN="bottom"
-><A
-HREF="bugreport.html"
-ACCESSKEY="P"
->Prev</A
-></TD
-><TD
-WIDTH="80%"
-ALIGN="center"
-VALIGN="bottom"
-></TD
-><TD
-WIDTH="10%"
-ALIGN="right"
-VALIGN="bottom"
->&nbsp;</TD
-></TR
-></TABLE
-><HR
-ALIGN="LEFT"
-WIDTH="100%"></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="CHAPTER"
-><H1
-><A
-NAME="DIAGNOSIS">Chapter 26. Diagnosing your samba server</H1
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><H1
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN3378">26.1. Introduction</H1
-><P
->This file contains a list of tests you can perform to validate your
+<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 33. The samba checklist</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="troubleshooting.html" title="Part V. Troubleshooting"><link rel="previous" href="troubleshooting.html" title="Part V. Troubleshooting"><link rel="next" href="problems.html" title="Chapter 34. Analysing and solving samba problems"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 33. The samba checklist</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="troubleshooting.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part V. Troubleshooting</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="problems.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="diagnosis"></a>Chapter 33. The samba checklist</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Andrew</span> <span class="surname">Tridgell</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email">&lt;<a href="mailto:tridge@samba.org">tridge@samba.org</a>&gt;</tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="othername">R.</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">The Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email">&lt;<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</a>&gt;</tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">Wed Jan 15</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="diagnosis.html#id3005492">Introduction</a></dt><dt><a href="diagnosis.html#id3007352">Assumptions</a></dt><dt><a href="diagnosis.html#id3007529">The tests</a></dt><dt><a href="diagnosis.html#id3008704">Still having troubles?</a></dt></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id3005492"></a>Introduction</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+This file contains a list of tests you can perform to validate your
Samba server. It also tells you what the likely cause of the problem
is if it fails any one of these steps. If it passes all these tests
-then it is probably working fine.</P
-><P
->You should do ALL the tests, in the order shown. We have tried to
+then it is probably working fine.
+</p><p>
+You should do ALL the tests, in the order shown. We have tried to
carefully choose them so later tests only use capabilities verified in
-the earlier tests.</P
-><P
->If you send one of the samba mailing lists an email saying "it doesn't work"
+the earlier tests. However, do not stop at the first error as there
+have been some instances when continuing with the tests has helped
+to solve a problem.
+</p><p>
+If you send one of the samba mailing lists an email saying &quot;it doesn't work&quot;
and you have not followed this test procedure then you should not be surprised
-your email is ignored.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><H1
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN3383">26.2. Assumptions</H1
-><P
->In all of the tests it is assumed you have a Samba server called
-BIGSERVER and a PC called ACLIENT both in workgroup TESTGROUP.</P
-><P
->The procedure is similar for other types of clients.</P
-><P
->It is also assumed you know the name of an available share in your
-smb.conf. I will assume this share is called "tmp". You can add a
-"tmp" share like by adding the following to smb.conf:</P
-><P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
->&#13;[tmp]
+if your email is ignored.
+</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id3007352"></a>Assumptions</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+In all of the tests it is assumed you have a Samba server called
+BIGSERVER and a PC called ACLIENT both in workgroup TESTGROUP.
+</p><p>
+The procedure is similar for other types of clients.
+</p><p>
+It is also assumed you know the name of an available share in your
+<tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>. I will assume this share is called <i class="replaceable"><tt>tmp</tt></i>.
+You can add a <i class="replaceable"><tt>tmp</tt></i> share like this by adding the
+following to <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>:
+</p><pre class="programlisting">
+
+[tmp]
comment = temporary files
path = /tmp
- read only = yes&#13;</PRE
-></P
-><P
->THESE TESTS ASSUME VERSION 3.0.0 OR LATER OF THE SAMBA SUITE. SOME
-COMMANDS SHOWN DID NOT EXIST IN EARLIER VERSIONS</P
-><P
->Please pay attention to the error messages you receive. If any error message
-reports that your server is being unfriendly you should first check that you
-IP name resolution is correctly set up. eg: Make sure your /etc/resolv.conf
-file points to name servers that really do exist.</P
-><P
->Also, if you do not have DNS server access for name resolution please check
-that the settings for your smb.conf file results in "dns proxy = no". The
-best way to check this is with "testparm smb.conf"</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><H1
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN3393">26.3. Tests</H1
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><H2
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN3395">26.3.1. Test 1</H2
-><P
->In the directory in which you store your smb.conf file, run the command
-"testparm smb.conf". If it reports any errors then your smb.conf
-configuration file is faulty.</P
-><P
->Note: Your smb.conf file may be located in: <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/samba</TT
->
- Or in: <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/usr/local/samba/lib</TT
-></P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><H2
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN3401">26.3.2. Test 2</H2
-><P
->Run the command "ping BIGSERVER" from the PC and "ping ACLIENT" from
+ read only = yes
+
+</pre><p>
+</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p>
+These tests assume version 3.0 or later of the samba suite.
+Some commands shown did not exist in earlier versions.
+</p></div><p>
+Please pay attention to the error messages you receive. If any error message
+reports that your server is being unfriendly you should first check that your
+IP name resolution is correctly set up. eg: Make sure your <tt class="filename">/etc/resolv.conf</tt>
+file points to name servers that really do exist.
+</p><p>
+Also, if you do not have DNS server access for name resolution please check
+that the settings for your <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file results in <b class="command">dns proxy = no</b>. The
+best way to check this is with <b class="userinput"><tt>testparm smb.conf</tt></b>.
+</p><p>
+It is helpful to monitor the log files during testing by using the
+<b class="command">tail -F <i class="replaceable"><tt>log_file_name</tt></i></b> in a separate
+terminal console (use ctrl-alt-F1 through F6 or multiple terminals in X).
+Relevant log files can be found (for default installations) in
+<tt class="filename">/usr/local/samba/var</tt>. Also, connection logs from
+machines can be found here or possibly in <tt class="filename">/var/log/samba</tt>
+depending on how or if you specified logging in your <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file.
+</p><p>
+If you make changes to your <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file while going through these test,
+don't forget to restart <span class="application">smbd</span> and <span class="application">nmbd</span>.
+</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id3007529"></a>The tests</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="procedure"><p class="title"><b>Procedure 33.1. Diagnosing your samba server</b></p><ol type="1"><li><p>
+In the directory in which you store your <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file, run the command
+<b class="userinput"><tt>testparm smb.conf</tt></b>. If it reports any errors then your <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>
+configuration file is faulty.
+</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p>
+Your <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file may be located in: <tt class="filename">/etc/samba</tt>
+Or in: <tt class="filename">/usr/local/samba/lib</tt>
+</p></div></li><li><p>
+Run the command <b class="userinput"><tt>ping BIGSERVER</tt></b> from the PC and
+<b class="userinput"><tt>ping ACLIENT</tt></b> from
the unix box. If you don't get a valid response then your TCP/IP
-software is not correctly installed. </P
-><P
->Note that you will need to start a "dos prompt" window on the PC to
-run ping.</P
-><P
->If you get a message saying "host not found" or similar then your DNS
-software or /etc/hosts file is not correctly setup. It is possible to
+software is not correctly installed.
+</p><p>
+Note that you will need to start a &quot;dos prompt&quot; window on the PC to
+run ping.
+</p><p>
+If you get a message saying <span class="errorname">host not found</span> or similar then your DNS
+software or <tt class="filename">/etc/hosts</tt> file is not correctly setup.
+It is possible to
run samba without DNS entries for the server and client, but I assume
-you do have correct entries for the remainder of these tests. </P
-><P
->Another reason why ping might fail is if your host is running firewall
+you do have correct entries for the remainder of these tests.
+</p><p>
+Another reason why ping might fail is if your host is running firewall
software. You will need to relax the rules to let in the workstation
in question, perhaps by allowing access from another subnet (on Linux
-this is done via the ipfwadm program.)</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><H2
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN3407">26.3.3. Test 3</H2
-><P
->Run the command "smbclient -L BIGSERVER" on the unix box. You
-should get a list of available shares back. </P
-><P
->If you get a error message containing the string "Bad password" then
-you probably have either an incorrect "hosts allow", "hosts deny" or
-"valid users" line in your smb.conf, or your guest account is not
-valid. Check what your guest account is using "testparm" and
-temporarily remove any "hosts allow", "hosts deny", "valid users" or
-"invalid users" lines.</P
-><P
->If you get a "connection refused" response then the smbd server may
+this is done via the <span class="application">ipfwadm</span> program.)
+</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p>
+Modern Linux distributions install ipchains/iptables by default.
+This is a common problem that is often overlooked.
+</p></div></li><li><p>
+Run the command <b class="userinput"><tt>smbclient -L BIGSERVER</tt></b> on the unix box. You
+should get a list of available shares back.
+</p><p>
+If you get a error message containing the string &quot;Bad password&quot; then
+you probably have either an incorrect <b class="command">hosts allow</b>,
+<b class="command">hosts deny</b> or <b class="command">valid users</b> line in your
+<tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>, or your guest account is not
+valid. Check what your guest account is using <span class="application">testparm</span> and
+temporarily remove any <b class="command">hosts allow</b>, <b class="command">hosts deny</b>, <b class="command">valid users</b> or <b class="command">invalid users</b> lines.
+</p><p>
+If you get a <span class="errorname">connection refused</span> response then the smbd server may
not be running. If you installed it in inetd.conf then you probably edited
that file incorrectly. If you installed it as a daemon then check that
it is running, and check that the netbios-ssn port is in a LISTEN
-state using "netstat -a".</P
-><P
->If you get a "session request failed" then the server refused the
-connection. If it says "Your server software is being unfriendly" then
-its probably because you have invalid command line parameters to smbd,
-or a similar fatal problem with the initial startup of smbd. Also
-check your config file (smb.conf) for syntax errors with "testparm"
+state using <b class="userinput"><tt>netstat -a</tt></b>.
+</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p>
+Some Unix / Linux systems use <b class="command">xinetd</b> in place of
+<b class="command">inetd</b>. Check your system documentation for the location
+of the control file/s for your particular system implementation of
+this network super daemon.
+</p></div><p>
+If you get a <span class="errorname">session request failed</span> then the server refused the
+connection. If it says &quot;Your server software is being unfriendly&quot; then
+its probably because you have invalid command line parameters to <span class="application">smbd</span>,
+or a similar fatal problem with the initial startup of <span class="application">smbd</span>. Also
+check your config file (<tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>) for syntax errors with <span class="application">testparm</span>
and that the various directories where samba keeps its log and lock
-files exist.</P
-><P
->There are a number of reasons for which smbd may refuse or decline
+files exist.
+</p><p>
+There are a number of reasons for which smbd may refuse or decline
a session request. The most common of these involve one or more of
-the following smb.conf file entries:</P
-><P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
-> hosts deny = ALL
+the following <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file entries:
+</p><pre class="programlisting">
+ hosts deny = ALL
hosts allow = xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx/yy
- bind interfaces only = Yes</PRE
-></P
-><P
->In the above, no allowance has been made for any session requests that
+ bind interfaces only = Yes
+</pre><p>
+In the above, no allowance has been made for any session requests that
will automatically translate to the loopback adaptor address 127.0.0.1.
-To solve this problem change these lines to:</P
-><P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
-> hosts deny = ALL
- hosts allow = xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx/yy 127.</PRE
-></P
-><P
->Do NOT use the "bind interfaces only" parameter where you may wish to
-use the samba password change facility, or where smbclient may need to
-access local service for name resolution or for local resource
-connections. (Note: the "bind interfaces only" parameter deficiency
+To solve this problem change these lines to:
+</p><pre class="programlisting">
+ hosts deny = ALL
+ hosts allow = xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx/yy 127.
+</pre><p>
+Do <span class="emphasis"><em>not</em></span> use the <b class="command">bind interfaces only</b> parameter where you
+may wish to
+use the samba password change facility, or where <span class="application">smbclient</span> may need to
+access a local service for name resolution or for local resource
+connections. (Note: the <b class="command">bind interfaces only</b> parameter deficiency
where it will not allow connections to the loopback address will be
-fixed soon).</P
-><P
->Another common cause of these two errors is having something already running
-on port 139, such as Samba (ie: smbd is running from inetd already) or
-something like Digital's Pathworks. Check your inetd.conf file before trying
-to start smbd as a daemon, it can avoid a lot of frustration!</P
-><P
->And yet another possible cause for failure of TEST 3 is when the subnet mask
+fixed soon).
+</p><p>
+Another common cause of these two errors is having something already running
+on port <tt class="constant">139</tt>, such as Samba
+(ie: <span class="application">smbd</span> is running from <span class="application">inetd</span> already) or
+something like Digital's Pathworks. Check your <tt class="filename">inetd.conf</tt> file before trying
+to start <span class="application">smbd</span> as a daemon, it can avoid a lot of frustration!
+</p><p>
+And yet another possible cause for failure of this test is when the subnet mask
and / or broadcast address settings are incorrect. Please check that the
network interface IP Address / Broadcast Address / Subnet Mask settings are
-correct and that Samba has correctly noted these in the log.nmb file.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><H2
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN3422">26.3.4. Test 4</H2
-><P
->Run the command "nmblookup -B BIGSERVER __SAMBA__". You should get the
-IP address of your Samba server back.</P
-><P
->If you don't then nmbd is incorrectly installed. Check your inetd.conf
+correct and that Samba has correctly noted these in the <tt class="filename">log.nmb</tt> file.
+</p></li><li><p>
+Run the command <b class="userinput"><tt>nmblookup -B BIGSERVER __SAMBA__</tt></b>. You should get the
+IP address of your Samba server back.
+</p><p>
+If you don't then nmbd is incorrectly installed. Check your <tt class="filename">inetd.conf</tt>
if you run it from there, or that the daemon is running and listening
-to udp port 137.</P
-><P
->One common problem is that many inetd implementations can't take many
+to udp port 137.
+</p><p>
+One common problem is that many inetd implementations can't take many
parameters on the command line. If this is the case then create a
one-line script that contains the right parameters and run that from
-inetd.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><H2
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN3427">26.3.5. Test 5</H2
-><P
->run the command <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->nmblookup -B ACLIENT '*'</B
-></P
-><P
->You should get the PCs IP address back. If you don't then the client
+inetd.
+</p></li><li><p>run the command <b class="userinput"><tt>nmblookup -B ACLIENT '*'</tt></b></p><p>
+You should get the PCs IP address back. If you don't then the client
software on the PC isn't installed correctly, or isn't started, or you
-got the name of the PC wrong. </P
-><P
->If ACLIENT doesn't resolve via DNS then use the IP address of the
-client in the above test.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><H2
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN3433">26.3.6. Test 6</H2
-><P
->Run the command <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->nmblookup -d 2 '*'</B
-></P
-><P
->This time we are trying the same as the previous test but are trying
+got the name of the PC wrong.
+</p><p>
+If ACLIENT doesn't resolve via DNS then use the IP address of the
+client in the above test.
+</p></li><li><p>
+Run the command <b class="userinput"><tt>nmblookup -d 2 '*'</tt></b>
+</p><p>
+This time we are trying the same as the previous test but are trying
it via a broadcast to the default broadcast address. A number of
Netbios/TCPIP hosts on the network should respond, although Samba may
not catch all of the responses in the short time it listens. You
-should see "got a positive name query response" messages from several
-hosts.</P
-><P
->If this doesn't give a similar result to the previous test then
+should see <span class="errorname">got a positive name query response</span>
+messages from several hosts.
+</p><p>
+If this doesn't give a similar result to the previous test then
nmblookup isn't correctly getting your broadcast address through its
-automatic mechanism. In this case you should experiment use the
-"interfaces" option in smb.conf to manually configure your IP
-address, broadcast and netmask. </P
-><P
->If your PC and server aren't on the same subnet then you will need to
-use the -B option to set the broadcast address to the that of the PCs
-subnet.</P
-><P
->This test will probably fail if your subnet mask and broadcast address are
-not correct. (Refer to TEST 3 notes above).</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><H2
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN3441">26.3.7. Test 7</H2
-><P
->Run the command <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbclient //BIGSERVER/TMP</B
->. You should
+automatic mechanism. In this case you should experiment with the
+<b class="command">interfaces</b> option in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> to manually configure your IP
+address, broadcast and netmask.
+</p><p>
+If your PC and server aren't on the same subnet then you will need to
+use the <i class="parameter"><tt>-B</tt></i> option to set the broadcast address to that of the PCs
+subnet.
+</p><p>
+This test will probably fail if your subnet mask and broadcast address are
+not correct. (Refer to TEST 3 notes above).
+</p></li><li><p>
+Run the command <b class="userinput"><tt>smbclient //BIGSERVER/TMP</tt></b>. You should
then be prompted for a password. You should use the password of the account
you are logged into the unix box with. If you want to test with
-another account then add the -U &gt;accountname&lt; option to the end of
+another account then add the <i class="parameter"><tt>-U <i class="replaceable"><tt>accountname</tt></i></tt></i> option to the end of
the command line. eg:
-<B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbclient //bigserver/tmp -Ujohndoe</B
-></P
-><P
->Note: It is possible to specify the password along with the username
+<b class="userinput"><tt>smbclient //bigserver/tmp -Ujohndoe</tt></b>
+</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p>
+It is possible to specify the password along with the username
as follows:
-<B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbclient //bigserver/tmp -Ujohndoe%secret</B
-></P
-><P
->Once you enter the password you should get the "smb&#62;" prompt. If you
-don't then look at the error message. If it says "invalid network
-name" then the service "tmp" is not correctly setup in your smb.conf.</P
-><P
->If it says "bad password" then the likely causes are:</P
-><P
-></P
-><OL
-TYPE="1"
-><LI
-><P
-> you have shadow passords (or some other password system) but didn't
- compile in support for them in smbd
- </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-> your "valid users" configuration is incorrect
- </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-> you have a mixed case password and you haven't enabled the "password
- level" option at a high enough level
- </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-> the "path =" line in smb.conf is incorrect. Check it with testparm
- </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-> you enabled password encryption but didn't create the SMB encrypted
- password file
- </P
-></LI
-></OL
-><P
->Once connected you should be able to use the commands
-<B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->dir</B
-> <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->get</B
-> <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->put</B
-> etc.
-Type <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->help &gt;command&lt;</B
-> for instructions. You should
+<b class="userinput"><tt>smbclient //bigserver/tmp -Ujohndoe%secret</tt></b>
+</p></div><p>
+Once you enter the password you should get the <tt class="prompt">smb&gt;</tt> prompt. If you
+don't then look at the error message. If it says <span class="errorname">invalid network
+name</span> then the service <span class="emphasis"><em>&quot;tmp&quot;</em></span> is not correctly setup in your <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>.
+</p><p>
+If it says <span class="errorname">bad password</span> then the likely causes are:
+</p><div class="orderedlist"><ol type="1"><li><p>
+ you have shadow passords (or some other password system) but didn't
+ compile in support for them in <span class="application">smbd</span>
+ </p></li><li><p>
+ your <b class="command">valid users</b> configuration is incorrect
+ </p></li><li><p>
+ you have a mixed case password and you haven't enabled the <b class="command">password
+ level</b> option at a high enough level
+ </p></li><li><p>
+ the <b class="command">path =</b> line in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> is incorrect. Check it with <span class="application">testparm</span>
+ </p></li><li><p>
+ you enabled password encryption but didn't map unix to samba users
+ </p></li></ol></div><p>
+Once connected you should be able to use the commands
+<b class="command">dir</b> <b class="command">get</b> <b class="command">put</b> etc.
+Type <b class="command">help <i class="replaceable"><tt>command</tt></i></b> for instructions. You should
especially check that the amount of free disk space shown is correct
-when you type <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->dir</B
->.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><H2
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN3467">26.3.8. Test 8</H2
-><P
->On the PC type the command <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->net view \\BIGSERVER</B
->. You will
-need to do this from within a "dos prompt" window. You should get back a
-list of available shares on the server.</P
-><P
->If you get a "network name not found" or similar error then netbios
+when you type <b class="command">dir</b>.
+</p></li><li><p>
+On the PC, type the command <b class="userinput"><tt>net view \\BIGSERVER</tt></b>. You will
+need to do this from within a &quot;dos prompt&quot; window. You should get back a
+list of available shares on the server.
+</p><p>
+If you get a <span class="errorname">network name not found</span> or similar error then netbios
name resolution is not working. This is usually caused by a problem in
nmbd. To overcome it you could do one of the following (you only need
-to choose one of them):</P
-><P
-></P
-><OL
-TYPE="1"
-><LI
-><P
-> fixup the nmbd installation</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-> add the IP address of BIGSERVER to the "wins server" box in the
- advanced tcp/ip setup on the PC.</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-> enable windows name resolution via DNS in the advanced section of
- the tcp/ip setup</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-> add BIGSERVER to your lmhosts file on the PC.</P
-></LI
-></OL
-><P
->If you get a "invalid network name" or "bad password error" then the
-same fixes apply as they did for the "smbclient -L" test above. In
-particular, make sure your "hosts allow" line is correct (see the man
-pages)</P
-><P
->Also, do not overlook that fact that when the workstation requests the
+to choose one of them):
+</p><div class="orderedlist"><ol type="1"><li><p>
+ fixup the <span class="application">nmbd</span> installation
+</p></li><li><p>
+ add the IP address of BIGSERVER to the <b class="command">wins server</b> box in the
+ advanced tcp/ip setup on the PC.
+</p></li><li><p>
+ enable windows name resolution via DNS in the advanced section of
+ the tcp/ip setup
+</p></li><li><p>
+ add BIGSERVER to your lmhosts file on the PC.
+</p></li></ol></div><p>
+If you get a <span class="errorname">invalid network name</span> or <span class="errorname">bad password error</span> then the
+same fixes apply as they did for the <b class="userinput"><tt>smbclient -L</tt></b> test above. In
+particular, make sure your <b class="command">hosts allow</b> line is correct (see the man
+pages)
+</p><p>
+Also, do not overlook that fact that when the workstation requests the
connection to the samba server it will attempt to connect using the
name with which you logged onto your Windows machine. You need to make
sure that an account exists on your Samba server with that exact same
-name and password.</P
-><P
->If you get "specified computer is not receiving requests" or similar
+name and password.
+</p><p>
+If you get <span class="errorname">specified computer is not receiving requests</span> or similar
it probably means that the host is not contactable via tcp services.
Check to see if the host is running tcp wrappers, and if so add an entry in
-the hosts.allow file for your client (or subnet, etc.)</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><H2
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN3484">26.3.9. Test 9</H2
-><P
->Run the command <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->net use x: \\BIGSERVER\TMP</B
->. You should
-be prompted for a password then you should get a "command completed
-successfully" message. If not then your PC software is incorrectly
-installed or your smb.conf is incorrect. make sure your "hosts allow"
-and other config lines in smb.conf are correct.</P
-><P
->It's also possible that the server can't work out what user name to
-connect you as. To see if this is the problem add the line "user =
-USERNAME" to the [tmp] section of smb.conf where "USERNAME" is the
+the <tt class="filename">hosts.allow</tt> file for your client (or subnet, etc.)
+</p></li><li><p>
+Run the command <b class="userinput"><tt>net use x: \\BIGSERVER\TMP</tt></b>. You should
+be prompted for a password then you should get a <tt class="computeroutput">command completed
+successfully</tt> message. If not then your PC software is incorrectly
+installed or your smb.conf is incorrect. make sure your <b class="command">hosts allow</b>
+and other config lines in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> are correct.
+</p><p>
+It's also possible that the server can't work out what user name to
+connect you as. To see if this is the problem add the line <i class="parameter"><tt>user =
+<i class="replaceable"><tt>username</tt></i></tt></i> to the <i class="parameter"><tt>[tmp]</tt></i> section of
+<tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> where <i class="replaceable"><tt>username</tt></i> is the
username corresponding to the password you typed. If you find this
-fixes things you may need the username mapping option. </P
-><P
->It might also be the case that your client only sends encrypted passwords
-and you have <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->encrypt passwords = no</B
-> in <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->smb.conf</TT
->.
-Turn it back on to fix.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><H2
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN3492">26.3.10. Test 10</H2
-><P
->Run the command <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->nmblookup -M TESTGROUP</B
-> where
-TESTGROUP is the name of the workgroup that your Samba server and
+fixes things you may need the username mapping option.
+</p><p>
+It might also be the case that your client only sends encrypted passwords
+and you have <i class="parameter"><tt>encrypt passwords = no</tt></i> in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>
+Turn it back on to fix.
+</p></li><li><p>
+Run the command <b class="userinput"><tt>nmblookup -M <i class="replaceable"><tt>testgroup</tt></i></tt></b> where
+<i class="replaceable"><tt>testgroup</tt></i> is the name of the workgroup that your Samba server and
Windows PCs belong to. You should get back the IP address of the
-master browser for that workgroup.</P
-><P
->If you don't then the election process has failed. Wait a minute to
+master browser for that workgroup.
+</p><p>
+If you don't then the election process has failed. Wait a minute to
see if it is just being slow then try again. If it still fails after
-that then look at the browsing options you have set in smb.conf. Make
-sure you have <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->preferred master = yes</B
-> to ensure that
-an election is held at startup.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><H2
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN3498">26.3.11. Test 11</H2
-><P
->From file manager try to browse the server. Your samba server should
+that then look at the browsing options you have set in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>. Make
+sure you have <i class="parameter"><tt>preferred master = yes</tt></i> to ensure that
+an election is held at startup.
+</p></li><li><p>
+&gt;From file manager try to browse the server. Your samba server should
appear in the browse list of your local workgroup (or the one you
specified in smb.conf). You should be able to double click on the name
-of the server and get a list of shares. If you get a "invalid
-password" error when you do then you are probably running WinNT and it
+of the server and get a list of shares. If you get a &quot;invalid
+password&quot; error when you do then you are probably running WinNT and it
is refusing to browse a server that has no encrypted password
capability and is in user level security mode. In this case either set
-<B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->security = server</B
-> AND
-<B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->password server = Windows_NT_Machine</B
-> in your
-smb.conf file, or enable encrypted passwords AFTER compiling in support
-for encrypted passwords (refer to the Makefile).</P
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><H1
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN3503">26.4. Still having troubles?</H1
-><P
->Try the mailing list or newsgroup, or use the ethereal utility to
-sniff the problem. The official samba mailing list can be reached at
-<A
-HREF="mailto:samba@samba.org"
-TARGET="_top"
->samba@samba.org</A
->. To find
-out more about samba and how to subscribe to the mailing list check
-out the samba web page at
-<A
-HREF="http://samba.org/samba"
-TARGET="_top"
->http://samba.org/samba</A
-></P
-><P
->Also look at the other docs in the Samba package!</P
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="NAVFOOTER"
-><HR
-ALIGN="LEFT"
-WIDTH="100%"><TABLE
-SUMMARY="Footer navigation table"
-WIDTH="100%"
-BORDER="0"
-CELLPADDING="0"
-CELLSPACING="0"
-><TR
-><TD
-WIDTH="33%"
-ALIGN="left"
-VALIGN="top"
-><A
-HREF="bugreport.html"
-ACCESSKEY="P"
->Prev</A
-></TD
-><TD
-WIDTH="34%"
-ALIGN="center"
-VALIGN="top"
-><A
-HREF="samba-howto-collection.html"
-ACCESSKEY="H"
->Home</A
-></TD
-><TD
-WIDTH="33%"
-ALIGN="right"
-VALIGN="top"
->&nbsp;</TD
-></TR
-><TR
-><TD
-WIDTH="33%"
-ALIGN="left"
-VALIGN="top"
->Reporting Bugs</TD
-><TD
-WIDTH="34%"
-ALIGN="center"
-VALIGN="top"
-><A
-HREF="appendixes.html"
-ACCESSKEY="U"
->Up</A
-></TD
-><TD
-WIDTH="33%"
-ALIGN="right"
-VALIGN="top"
->&nbsp;</TD
-></TR
-></TABLE
-></DIV
-></BODY
-></HTML
-> \ No newline at end of file
+<i class="parameter"><tt>security = server</tt></i> AND
+<i class="parameter"><tt>password server = Windows_NT_Machine</tt></i> in your
+<tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file, or make sure <i class="parameter"><tt>encrypted passwords</tt></i> is
+set to &quot;yes&quot;.
+</p></li></ol></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id3008704"></a>Still having troubles?</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>Read the chapter on
+<a href="problems.html" title="Chapter 34. Analysing and solving samba problems">Analysing and Solving Problems</a>.
+</p></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="troubleshooting.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="troubleshooting.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="problems.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Part V. Troubleshooting </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="index.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 34. Analysing and solving samba problems</td></tr></table></div></body></html>
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/findsmb.1.html b/docs/htmldocs/findsmb.1.html
index af7100ed6f..a6013a13ec 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/findsmb.1.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/findsmb.1.html
@@ -1,214 +1,41 @@
-<!DOCTYPE HTML PUBLIC "-//W3C//DTD HTML 4.01//EN">
-<HTML
-><HEAD
-><TITLE
->findsmb</TITLE
-><META
-NAME="GENERATOR"
-CONTENT="Modular DocBook HTML Stylesheet Version 1.76b+
-"></HEAD
-><BODY
-CLASS="REFENTRY"
-BGCOLOR="#FFFFFF"
-TEXT="#000000"
-LINK="#0000FF"
-VLINK="#840084"
-ALINK="#0000FF"
-><H1
-><A
-NAME="FINDSMB">findsmb</H1
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFNAMEDIV"
-><A
-NAME="AEN5"
-></A
-><H2
->Name</H2
->findsmb&nbsp;--&nbsp;list info about machines that respond to SMB
- name queries on a subnet</DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSYNOPSISDIV"
-><A
-NAME="AEN8"><H2
->Synopsis</H2
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->findsmb</B
-> [subnet broadcast address]</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN12"
-></A
-><H2
->DESCRIPTION</H2
-><P
->This perl script is part of the <A
-HREF="samba.7.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-> Samba</A
-> suite.</P
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->findsmb</B
-> is a perl script that
+<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>findsmb</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="findsmb.1"></a><div class="titlepage"><div></div><div></div></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>findsmb &#8212; list info about machines that respond to SMB
+ name queries on a subnet</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><tt class="command">findsmb</tt> [subnet broadcast address]</p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This perl script is part of the <a href="Samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">Samba</span>(7)</span></a>
+ suite.</p><p><b class="command">findsmb</b> is a perl script that
prints out several pieces of information about machines
on a subnet that respond to SMB name query requests.
- It uses <A
-HREF="nmblookup.1.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
-> nmblookup(1)</B
-></A
-> and <A
-HREF="smbclient.1.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-> <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbclient(1)</B
-></A
-> to obtain this information.
- </P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN22"
-></A
-><H2
->OPTIONS</H2
-><P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
->-r</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Controls whether <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->findsmb</B
-> takes
+ It uses <a href="nmblookup.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">nmblookup</span>(1)</span></a>
+ and <a href="smbclient.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbclient</span>(1)</span></a>
+ to obtain this information.
+ </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">-r</span></dt><dd><p>Controls whether <b class="command">findsmb</b> takes
bugs in Windows95 into account when trying to find a Netbios name
registered of the remote machine. This option is disabled by default
because it is specific to Windows 95 and Windows 95 machines only.
- If set, <A
-HREF="nmblookup.1.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->nmblookup</B
-></A
->
- will be called with <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->-B</TT
-> option.</P
-></DD
-><DT
->subnet broadcast address</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Without this option, <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->findsmb
- </B
-> will probe the subnet of the machine where
- <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->findsmb</B
-> is run. This value is passed
- to <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->nmblookup</B
-> as part of the
- <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->-B</TT
-> option.</P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN41"
-></A
-><H2
->EXAMPLES</H2
-><P
->The output of <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->findsmb</B
-> lists the following
+ If set, <a href="nmblookup.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">nmblookup</span>(1)</span></a>
+ will be called with <tt class="constant">-B</tt> option.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">subnet broadcast address</span></dt><dd><p>Without this option, <b class="command">findsmb
+ </b> will probe the subnet of the machine where
+ <a href="findsmb.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">findsmb</span>(1)</span></a>
+ is run. This value is passed to
+ <a href="nmblookup.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">nmblookup</span>(1)</span></a>
+ as part of the <tt class="constant">-B</tt> option.</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>EXAMPLES</h2><p>The output of <b class="command">findsmb</b> lists the following
information for all machines that respond to the initial
- <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->nmblookup</B
-> for any name: IP address, NetBIOS name,
- Workgroup name, operating system, and SMB server version.</P
-><P
->There will be a '+' in front of the workgroup name for
+ <b class="command">nmblookup</b> for any name: IP address, NetBIOS name,
+ Workgroup name, operating system, and SMB server version.</p><p>There will be a '+' in front of the workgroup name for
machines that are local master browsers for that workgroup. There
will be an '*' in front of the workgroup name for
machines that are the domain master browser for that workgroup.
Machines that are running Windows, Windows 95 or Windows 98 will
not show any information about the operating system or server
- version.</P
-><P
->The command with <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->-r</TT
-> option
- must be run on a system without <A
-HREF="nmbd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->nmbd</B
-></A
-> running.
- If <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->nmbd</B
-> is running on the system, you will
+ version.</p><p>The command with <tt class="constant">-r</tt> option
+ must be run on a system without <a href="nmbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">nmbd</span>(8)</span></a> running.
+
+ If <b class="command">nmbd</b> is running on the system, you will
only get the IP address and the DNS name of the machine. To
get proper responses from Windows 95 and Windows 98 machines,
- the command must be run as root and with <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->-r</TT
->
- option on a machine without <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->nmbd</B
-> running.</P
-><P
->For example, running <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->findsmb</B
-> without
- <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->-r</TT
-> option set would yield output similar
- to the following</P
-><TABLE
-BORDER="0"
-BGCOLOR="#E0E0E0"
-WIDTH="100%"
-><TR
-><TD
-><PRE
-CLASS="SCREEN"
-><TT
-CLASS="COMPUTEROUTPUT"
->IP ADDR NETBIOS NAME WORKGROUP/OS/VERSION
+ the command must be run as root and with <tt class="constant">-r</tt>
+ option on a machine without <b class="command">nmbd</b> running.</p><p>For example, running <b class="command">findsmb</b>
+ without <tt class="constant">-r</tt> option set would yield output similar
+ to the following</p><pre class="screen">
+IP ADDR NETBIOS NAME WORKGROUP/OS/VERSION
---------------------------------------------------------------------
192.168.35.10 MINESET-TEST1 [DMVENGR]
192.168.35.55 LINUXBOX *[MYGROUP] [Unix] [Samba 2.0.6]
@@ -220,81 +47,15 @@ CLASS="COMPUTEROUTPUT"
192.168.35.88 SCNT2 +[MVENGR] [Windows NT 4.0] [NT LAN Manager 4.0]
192.168.35.93 FROGSTAR-PC [MVENGR] [Windows 5.0] [Windows 2000 LAN Manager]
192.168.35.97 HERBNT1 *[HERB-NT] [Windows NT 4.0] [NT LAN Manager 4.0]
- </TT
-></PRE
-></TD
-></TR
-></TABLE
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN59"
-></A
-><H2
->VERSION</H2
-><P
->This man page is correct for version 3.0 of
- the Samba suite.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN62"
-></A
-><H2
->SEE ALSO</H2
-><P
-><A
-HREF="nmbd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->nmbd(8)</B
-></A
->,
- <A
-HREF="smbclient.1.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbclient(1)
- </B
-></A
->, and <A
-HREF="nmblookup.1.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-> <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->nmblookup(1)</B
-></A
->
- </P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN71"
-></A
-><H2
->AUTHOR</H2
-><P
->The original Samba software and related utilities
+</pre></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3.0 of
+ the Samba suite.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>SEE ALSO</h2><p><a href="nmbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">nmbd</span>(8)</span></a>,
+ <a href="smbclient.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbclient</span>(1)</span></a>, and <a href="nmblookup.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">nmblookup</span>(1)</span></a>
+ </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
- to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</P
-><P
->The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer.
+ to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</p><p>The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer.
The man page sources were converted to YODL format (another
- excellent piece of Open Source software, available at
- <A
-HREF="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/"
-TARGET="_top"
-> ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/</A
->) and updated for the Samba 2.0
- release by Jeremy Allison. The conversion to DocBook for
- Samba 2.2 was done by Gerald Carter</P
-></DIV
-></BODY
-></HTML
-> \ No newline at end of file
+ excellent piece of Open Source software, available at <a href="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/" target="_top">ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/</a>)
+ and updated for the Samba 2.0 release by Jeremy Allison. The conversion to DocBook for
+ Samba 2.2 was done by Gerald Carter. The conversion to DocBook
+ XML 4.2 for Samba 3.0 was done by Alexander Bokovoy.</p></div></div></body></html>
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/groupmapping.html b/docs/htmldocs/groupmapping.html
index 84cf521fc9..8508edf2a5 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/groupmapping.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/groupmapping.html
@@ -1,235 +1,177 @@
-<!DOCTYPE HTML PUBLIC "-//W3C//DTD HTML 4.01 Transitional//EN">
-<HTML
-><HEAD
-><TITLE
->Group mapping HOWTO</TITLE
-><META
-NAME="GENERATOR"
-CONTENT="Modular DocBook HTML Stylesheet Version 1.76b+
-"><LINK
-REL="HOME"
-TITLE="SAMBA Project Documentation"
-HREF="samba-howto-collection.html"><LINK
-REL="UP"
-TITLE="Optional configuration"
-HREF="optional.html"><LINK
-REL="PREVIOUS"
-TITLE="HOWTO Access Samba source code via CVS"
-HREF="cvs-access.html"><LINK
-REL="NEXT"
-TITLE="Samba performance issues"
-HREF="speed.html"></HEAD
-><BODY
-CLASS="CHAPTER"
-BGCOLOR="#FFFFFF"
-TEXT="#000000"
-LINK="#0000FF"
-VLINK="#840084"
-ALINK="#0000FF"
-><DIV
-CLASS="NAVHEADER"
-><TABLE
-SUMMARY="Header navigation table"
-WIDTH="100%"
-BORDER="0"
-CELLPADDING="0"
-CELLSPACING="0"
-><TR
-><TH
-COLSPAN="3"
-ALIGN="center"
->SAMBA Project Documentation</TH
-></TR
-><TR
-><TD
-WIDTH="10%"
-ALIGN="left"
-VALIGN="bottom"
-><A
-HREF="cvs-access.html"
-ACCESSKEY="P"
->Prev</A
-></TD
-><TD
-WIDTH="80%"
-ALIGN="center"
-VALIGN="bottom"
-></TD
-><TD
-WIDTH="10%"
-ALIGN="right"
-VALIGN="bottom"
-><A
-HREF="speed.html"
-ACCESSKEY="N"
->Next</A
-></TD
-></TR
-></TABLE
-><HR
-ALIGN="LEFT"
-WIDTH="100%"></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="CHAPTER"
-><H1
-><A
-NAME="GROUPMAPPING">Chapter 21. Group mapping HOWTO</H1
-><P
->
-Starting with Samba 3.0 alpha 2, a new group mapping function is available. The
-current method (likely to change) to manage the groups is a new command called
-<B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbgroupedit</B
->.</P
-><P
->The first immediate reason to use the group mapping on a PDC, is that
-the <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->domain admin group</B
-> of <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->smb.conf</TT
-> is
-now gone. This parameter was used to give the listed users local admin rights
-on their workstations. It was some magic stuff that simply worked but didn't
-scale very well for complex setups.</P
-><P
->Let me explain how it works on NT/W2K, to have this magic fade away.
-When installing NT/W2K on a computer, the installer program creates some users
-and groups. Notably the 'Administrators' group, and gives to that group some
-privileges like the ability to change the date and time or to kill any process
-(or close too) running on the local machine. The 'Administrator' user is a
-member of the 'Administrators' group, and thus 'inherit' the 'Administrators'
-group privileges. If a 'joe' user is created and become a member of the
-'Administrator' group, 'joe' has exactly the same rights as 'Administrator'.</P
-><P
->When a NT/W2K machine is joined to a domain, during that phase, the "Domain
-Administrators' group of the PDC is added to the 'Administrators' group of the
-workstation. Every members of the 'Domain Administrators' group 'inherit' the
-rights of the 'Administrators' group when logging on the workstation.</P
-><P
->You are now wondering how to make some of your samba PDC users members of the
-'Domain Administrators' ? That's really easy.</P
-><P
-></P
-><OL
-TYPE="1"
-><LI
-><P
->create a unix group (usually in <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/group</TT
->), let's call it domadm</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->add to this group the users that must be Administrators. For example if you want joe,john and mary, your entry in <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/group</TT
-> will look like:</P
-><P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
->domadm:x:502:joe,john,mary</PRE
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->Map this domadm group to the <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->domain admins</B
-> group by running the command:</P
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbgroupedit -c "Domain Admins" -u domadm</B
-></P
-></LI
-></OL
-><P
->You're set, joe, john and mary are domain administrators !</P
-><P
->Like the Domain Admins group, you can map any arbitrary Unix group to any NT
-group. You can also make any Unix group a domain group. For example, on a domain
-member machine (an NT/W2K or a samba server running winbind), you would like to
-give access to a certain directory to some users who are member of a group on
-your samba PDC. Flag that group as a domain group by running:</P
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbgroupedit -a unixgroup -td</B
-></P
-><P
->You can list the various groups in the mapping database like this</P
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbgroupedit -v</B
-></P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="NAVFOOTER"
-><HR
-ALIGN="LEFT"
-WIDTH="100%"><TABLE
-SUMMARY="Footer navigation table"
-WIDTH="100%"
-BORDER="0"
-CELLPADDING="0"
-CELLSPACING="0"
-><TR
-><TD
-WIDTH="33%"
-ALIGN="left"
-VALIGN="top"
-><A
-HREF="cvs-access.html"
-ACCESSKEY="P"
->Prev</A
-></TD
-><TD
-WIDTH="34%"
-ALIGN="center"
-VALIGN="top"
-><A
-HREF="samba-howto-collection.html"
-ACCESSKEY="H"
->Home</A
-></TD
-><TD
-WIDTH="33%"
-ALIGN="right"
-VALIGN="top"
-><A
-HREF="speed.html"
-ACCESSKEY="N"
->Next</A
-></TD
-></TR
-><TR
-><TD
-WIDTH="33%"
-ALIGN="left"
-VALIGN="top"
->HOWTO Access Samba source code via CVS</TD
-><TD
-WIDTH="34%"
-ALIGN="center"
-VALIGN="top"
-><A
-HREF="optional.html"
-ACCESSKEY="U"
->Up</A
-></TD
-><TD
-WIDTH="33%"
-ALIGN="right"
-VALIGN="top"
->Samba performance issues</TD
-></TR
-></TABLE
-></DIV
-></BODY
-></HTML
-> \ No newline at end of file
+<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 12. Mapping MS Windows and Unix Groups</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="optional.html" title="Part III. Advanced Configuration"><link rel="previous" href="passdb.html" title="Chapter 11. Account Information Databases"><link rel="next" href="AccessControls.html" title="Chapter 13. File, Directory and Share Access Controls"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 12. Mapping MS Windows and Unix Groups</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="passdb.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part III. Advanced Configuration</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="AccessControls.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="groupmapping"></a>Chapter 12. Mapping MS Windows and Unix Groups</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jean François</span> <span class="surname">Micouleau</span></h3></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Gerald</span> <span class="othername">(Jerry)</span> <span class="surname">Carter</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email">&lt;<a href="mailto:jerry@samba.org">jerry@samba.org</a>&gt;</tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email">&lt;<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>&gt;</tt></p></div></div></div></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="groupmapping.html#id2921059">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="groupmapping.html#id2921161">Discussion</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="groupmapping.html#id2921352">Example Configuration</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="groupmapping.html#id2921416">Configuration Scripts</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="groupmapping.html#id2921430">Sample smb.conf add group script</a></dt><dt><a href="groupmapping.html#id2921498">Script to configure Group Mapping</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="groupmapping.html#id2921590">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="groupmapping.html#id2921606">Adding Groups Fails</a></dt><dt><a href="groupmapping.html#id2921666">Adding MS Windows Groups to MS Windows Groups Fails</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><p>
+ Starting with Samba-3, new group mapping functionality is available to create associations
+ between Windows group SIDs and UNIX groups. The <i class="parameter"><tt>groupmap</tt></i> subcommand
+ included with the <span class="application">net</span> tool can be used to manage these associations.
+ </p><div class="warning" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Warning</h3><p>
+ The first immediate reason to use the group mapping on a Samba PDC, is that
+ the <i class="parameter"><tt>domain admin group</tt></i> has been removed and should no longer
+ be specified in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>. This parameter was used to give the listed users membership
+ in the <tt class="constant">Domain Admins</tt> Windows group which gave local admin rights on their workstations
+ (in default configurations).
+ </p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2921059"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+ Samba allows the administrator to create MS Windows NT4 / 200x group accounts and to
+ arbitrarily associate them with Unix/Linux group accounts.
+ </p><p>
+ Group accounts can be managed using the MS Windows NT4 or MS Windows 200x MMC tools
+ so long as appropriate interface scripts have been provided to <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>
+ </p><p>
+ Administrators should be aware that where <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> group interface scripts make
+ direct calls to the Unix/Linux system tools (eg: the shadow utilities, <b class="command">groupadd</b>,
+ <b class="command">groupdel</b>, <b class="command">groupmod</b>) then the resulting Unix/Linux group names will be subject
+ to any limits imposed by these tools. If the tool does NOT allow upper case characters
+ or space characters, then the creation of an MS Windows NT4 / 200x style group of
+ <i class="parameter"><tt>Engineering Managers</tt></i> will attempt to create an identically named
+ Unix/Linux group, an attempt that will of course fail!
+ </p><p>
+ There are several possible work-arounds for the operating system tools limitation. One
+ method is to use a script that generates a name for the Unix/Linux system group that
+ fits the operating system limits, and that then just passes the Unix/Linux group id (GID)
+ back to the calling samba interface. This will provide a dynamic work-around solution.
+ </p><p>
+ Another work-around is to manually create a Unix/Linux group, then manually create the
+ MS Windows NT4 / 200x group on the Samba server and then use the <b class="command">net groupmap</b>
+ tool to connect the two to each other.
+ </p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2921161"></a>Discussion</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+ When installing <span class="application">MS Windows NT4 / 200x</span> on a computer, the installation
+ program creates default users and groups. Notably the <tt class="constant">Administrators</tt> group,
+ and gives to that group privileges necessary privilidges to perform essential system tasks.
+ eg: Ability to change the date and time or to kill any process (or close too) running on the
+ local machine.
+ </p><p>
+ The 'Administrator' user is a member of the 'Administrators' group, and thus inherits
+ 'Administrators' group privileges. If a 'joe' user is created to be a member of the
+ 'Administrator' group, 'joe' has exactly the same rights as 'Administrator'.
+ </p><p>
+ When an MS Windows NT4 / W200x is made a domain member, the &quot;Domain Adminis&quot; group of the
+ PDC is added to the local 'Administrators' group of the workstation. Every member of the
+ 'Domain Administrators' group inherits the rights of the local 'Administrators' group when
+ logging on the workstation.
+ </p><p>
+ The following steps describe how to make samba PDC users members of the 'Domain Admins' group?
+ </p><div class="orderedlist"><ol type="1"><li><p>
+ create a unix group (usually in <tt class="filename">/etc/group</tt>), let's call it domadm
+ </p></li><li><p>add to this group the users that must be Administrators. For example
+ if you want joe,john and mary, your entry in <tt class="filename">/etc/group</tt> will
+ look like:
+ </p><pre class="programlisting">
+ domadm:x:502:joe,john,mary
+ </pre><p>
+ </p></li><li><p>
+ Map this domadm group to the &quot;Domain Admins&quot; group by running the command:
+ </p><p>
+ </p><pre class="screen">
+ <tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>net groupmap add ntgroup=&quot;Domain Admins&quot; unixgroup=domadm</tt></b>
+ </pre><p>
+ </p><p>
+ The quotes around &quot;Domain Admins&quot; are necessary due to the space in the group name.
+ Also make sure to leave no whitespace surrounding the equal character (=).
+ </p></li></ol></div><p>
+ Now joe, john and mary are domain administrators!
+ </p><p>
+ It is possible to map any arbitrary UNIX group to any Windows NT4 / 200x group as well as
+ making any UNIX group a Windows domain group. For example, if you wanted to include a
+ UNIX group (e.g. acct) in a ACL on a local file or printer on a domain member machine,
+ you would flag that group as a domain group by running the following on the Samba PDC:
+ </p><p>
+ </p><pre class="screen">
+ <tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>net groupmap add rid=1000 ntgroup=&quot;Accounting&quot; unixgroup=acct</tt></b>
+ </pre><p>
+ </p><p>
+ Be aware that the RID parmeter is a unsigned 32 bit integer that should
+ normally start at 1000. However, this rid must not overlap with any RID assigned
+ to a user. Verifying this is done differently depending on on the passdb backend
+ you are using. Future versions of the tools may perform the verification automatically,
+ but for now the burden is on you.
+ </p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2921352"></a>Example Configuration</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+ You can list the various groups in the mapping database by executing
+ <b class="command">net groupmap list</b>. Here is an example:
+ </p><p>
+ </p><pre class="screen">
+ <tt class="prompt">root# </tt> <b class="userinput"><tt>net groupmap list</tt></b>
+ System Administrators (S-1-5-21-2547222302-1596225915-2414751004-1002) -&gt; sysadmin
+ Domain Admins (S-1-5-21-2547222302-1596225915-2414751004-512) -&gt; domadmin
+ Domain Users (S-1-5-21-2547222302-1596225915-2414751004-513) -&gt; domuser
+ Domain Guests (S-1-5-21-2547222302-1596225915-2414751004-514) -&gt; domguest
+ </pre><p>
+ </p><p>
+ For complete details on <b class="command">net groupmap</b>, refer to the net(8) man page.
+ </p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2921416"></a>Configuration Scripts</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+ Everyone needs tools. Some of us like to create our own, others prefer to use canned tools
+ (ie: prepared by someone else for general use).
+ </p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2921430"></a>Sample <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> add group script</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+ A script to great complying group names for use by the samba group interfaces:
+ </p><p>
+</p><div class="example"><a name="id2921453"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 12.1. smbgrpadd.sh</b></p><pre class="programlisting">
+
+#!/bin/bash
+
+# Add the group using normal system groupadd tool.
+groupadd smbtmpgrp00
+
+thegid=`cat /etc/group | grep smbtmpgrp00 | cut -d &quot;:&quot; -f3`
+
+# Now change the name to what we want for the MS Windows networking end
+cat /etc/group | sed s/smbtmpgrp00/$1/g &gt; /etc/group
+
+# Now return the GID as would normally happen.
+echo $thegid
+exit 0
+</pre></div><p>
+</p><p>
+ The <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> entry for the above script would look like:
+ </p><pre class="programlisting">
+ add group script = /path_to_tool/smbgrpadd.sh %g
+ </pre><p>
+ </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2921498"></a>Script to configure Group Mapping</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+ In our example we have created a Unix/Linux group called <i class="parameter"><tt>ntadmin</tt></i>.
+ Our script will create the additional groups <i class="parameter"><tt>Engineers, Marketoids, Gnomes</tt></i>:
+ </p><p>
+</p><pre class="programlisting">
+#!/bin/bash
+
+net groupmap modify ntgroup=&quot;Domain Admins&quot; unixgroup=ntadmin
+net groupmap modify ntgroup=&quot;Domain Users&quot; unixgroup=users
+net groupmap modify ntgroup=&quot;Domain Guests&quot; unixgroup=nobody
+net groupmap modify ntgroup=&quot;Administrators&quot; unixgroup=root
+net groupmap modify ntgroup=&quot;Users&quot; unixgroup=users
+net groupmap modify ntgroup=&quot;Guests&quot; unixgroup=nobody
+net groupmap modify ntgroup=&quot;System Operators&quot; unixgroup=sys
+net groupmap modify ntgroup=&quot;Account Operators&quot; unixgroup=root
+net groupmap modify ntgroup=&quot;Backup Operators&quot; unixgroup=bin
+net groupmap modify ntgroup=&quot;Print Operators&quot; unixgroup=lp
+net groupmap modify ntgroup=&quot;Replicators&quot; unixgroup=daemon
+net groupmap modify ntgroup=&quot;Power Users&quot; unixgroup=sys
+
+#groupadd Engineers
+#groupadd Marketoids
+#groupadd Gnomes
+
+#net groupmap add ntgroup=&quot;Engineers&quot; unixgroup=Engineers type=d
+#net groupmap add ntgroup=&quot;Marketoids&quot; unixgroup=Marketoids type=d
+#net groupmap add ntgroup=&quot;Gnomes&quot; unixgroup=Gnomes type=d
+</pre><p>
+</p><p>
+ Of course it is expected that the admininstrator will modify this to suit local needs.
+ For information regarding the use of the <b class="command">net groupmap</b> tool please
+ refer to the man page.
+ </p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2921590"></a>Common Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+At this time there are many little surprises for the unwary administrator. In a real sense
+it is imperative that every step of automated control scripts must be carefully tested
+manually before putting them into active service.
+</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2921606"></a>Adding Groups Fails</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+ This is a common problem when the <b class="command">groupadd</b> is called directly
+ by the samba interface script for the <i class="parameter"><tt>add group script</tt></i> in
+ the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file.
+ </p><p>
+ The most common cause of failure is an attempt to add an MS Windows group acocunt
+ that has either an upper case character and/or a space character in it.
+ </p><p>
+ There are three possible work-arounds. Firstly, use only group names that comply
+ with the limitations of the Unix/Linux <b class="command">groupadd</b> system tool.
+ The second involves use of the script mentioned earlier in this chapter, and the
+ third option is to manually create a Unix/Linux group account that can substitute
+ for the MS Windows group name, then use the procedure listed above to map that group
+ to the MS Windows group.
+ </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2921666"></a>Adding MS Windows Groups to MS Windows Groups Fails</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+ Samba-3 does NOT support nested groups from the MS Windows control environment.
+ </p></div></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="passdb.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="optional.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="AccessControls.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 11. Account Information Databases </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="index.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 13. File, Directory and Share Access Controls</td></tr></table></div></body></html>
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/install.html b/docs/htmldocs/install.html
index 0ba79dbe26..973b6083a8 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/install.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/install.html
@@ -1,896 +1,155 @@
-<!DOCTYPE HTML PUBLIC "-//W3C//DTD HTML 4.01 Transitional//EN">
-<HTML
-><HEAD
-><TITLE
->How to Install and Test SAMBA</TITLE
-><META
-NAME="GENERATOR"
-CONTENT="Modular DocBook HTML Stylesheet Version 1.76b+
-"><LINK
-REL="HOME"
-TITLE="SAMBA Project Documentation"
-HREF="samba-howto-collection.html"><LINK
-REL="UP"
-TITLE="General installation"
-HREF="introduction.html"><LINK
-REL="PREVIOUS"
-TITLE="General installation"
-HREF="introduction.html"><LINK
-REL="NEXT"
-TITLE="Improved browsing in samba"
-HREF="improved-browsing.html"></HEAD
-><BODY
-CLASS="CHAPTER"
-BGCOLOR="#FFFFFF"
-TEXT="#000000"
-LINK="#0000FF"
-VLINK="#840084"
-ALINK="#0000FF"
-><DIV
-CLASS="NAVHEADER"
-><TABLE
-SUMMARY="Header navigation table"
-WIDTH="100%"
-BORDER="0"
-CELLPADDING="0"
-CELLSPACING="0"
-><TR
-><TH
-COLSPAN="3"
-ALIGN="center"
->SAMBA Project Documentation</TH
-></TR
-><TR
-><TD
-WIDTH="10%"
-ALIGN="left"
-VALIGN="bottom"
-><A
-HREF="introduction.html"
-ACCESSKEY="P"
->Prev</A
-></TD
-><TD
-WIDTH="80%"
-ALIGN="center"
-VALIGN="bottom"
-></TD
-><TD
-WIDTH="10%"
-ALIGN="right"
-VALIGN="bottom"
-><A
-HREF="improved-browsing.html"
-ACCESSKEY="N"
->Next</A
-></TD
-></TR
-></TABLE
-><HR
-ALIGN="LEFT"
-WIDTH="100%"></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="CHAPTER"
-><H1
-><A
-NAME="INSTALL">Chapter 1. How to Install and Test SAMBA</H1
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><H1
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN26">1.1. Read the man pages</H1
-><P
->The man pages distributed with SAMBA contain
- lots of useful info that will help to get you started.
- If you don't know how to read man pages then try
- something like:</P
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="PROMPT"
->$ </TT
-><TT
-CLASS="USERINPUT"
-><B
->man smbd.8</B
-></TT
->
- or
- <TT
-CLASS="PROMPT"
->$ </TT
-><TT
-CLASS="USERINPUT"
-><B
->nroff -man smbd.8 | more
- </B
-></TT
-> on older unixes.</P
-><P
->Other sources of information are pointed to
- by the Samba web site,<A
-HREF="http://www.samba.org/"
-TARGET="_top"
-> http://www.samba.org</A
-></P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><H1
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN36">1.2. Building the Binaries</H1
-><P
->To do this, first run the program <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->./configure
- </B
-> in the source directory. This should automatically
- configure Samba for your operating system. If you have unusual
- needs then you may wish to run</P
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="PROMPT"
->root# </TT
-><TT
-CLASS="USERINPUT"
-><B
->./configure --help
- </B
-></TT
-></P
-><P
->first to see what special options you can enable.
- Then executing</P
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="PROMPT"
->root# </TT
-><TT
-CLASS="USERINPUT"
-><B
->make</B
-></TT
-></P
-><P
->will create the binaries. Once it's successfully
- compiled you can use </P
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="PROMPT"
->root# </TT
-><TT
-CLASS="USERINPUT"
-><B
->make install</B
-></TT
-></P
-><P
->to install the binaries and manual pages. You can
- separately install the binaries and/or man pages using</P
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="PROMPT"
->root# </TT
-><TT
-CLASS="USERINPUT"
-><B
->make installbin
- </B
-></TT
-></P
-><P
->and</P
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="PROMPT"
->root# </TT
-><TT
-CLASS="USERINPUT"
-><B
->make installman
- </B
-></TT
-></P
-><P
->Note that if you are upgrading for a previous version
- of Samba you might like to know that the old versions of
- the binaries will be renamed with a ".old" extension. You
- can go back to the previous version with</P
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="PROMPT"
->root# </TT
-><TT
-CLASS="USERINPUT"
-><B
->make revert
- </B
-></TT
-></P
-><P
->if you find this version a disaster!</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><H1
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN64">1.3. The all important step</H1
-><P
->At this stage you must fetch yourself a
- coffee or other drink you find stimulating. Getting the rest
- of the install right can sometimes be tricky, so you will
- probably need it.</P
-><P
->If you have installed samba before then you can skip
- this step.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><H1
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN68">1.4. Create the smb configuration file.</H1
-><P
->There are sample configuration files in the examples
- subdirectory in the distribution. I suggest you read them
- carefully so you can see how the options go together in
- practice. See the man page for all the options.</P
-><P
->The simplest useful configuration file would be
- something like this:</P
-><P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
-> [global]
- workgroup = MYGROUP
+<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 2. How to Install and Test SAMBA</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="introduction.html" title="Part I. General Installation"><link rel="previous" href="IntroSMB.html" title="Chapter 1. Introduction to Samba"><link rel="next" href="FastStart.html" title="Chapter 3. FastStart for the Impatient"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 2. How to Install and Test SAMBA</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="IntroSMB.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part I. General Installation</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="FastStart.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="install"></a>Chapter 2. How to Install and Test SAMBA</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Andrew</span> <span class="surname">Tridgell</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email">&lt;<a href="mailto:tridge@samba.org">tridge@samba.org</a>&gt;</tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="othername">R.</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">The Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email">&lt;<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</a>&gt;</tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email">&lt;<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>&gt;</tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Karl</span> <span class="surname">Auer</span></h3></div></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="install.html#id2886809">Obtaining and installing samba</a></dt><dt><a href="install.html#id2886850">Configuring samba (smb.conf)</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="install.html#id2886887">Example Configuration</a></dt><dt><a href="install.html#id2887037">SWAT</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="install.html#id2887081">Try listing the shares available on your
+ server</a></dt><dt><a href="install.html#id2887132">Try connecting with the unix client</a></dt><dt><a href="install.html#id2887232">Try connecting from a DOS, WfWg, Win9x, WinNT,
+ Win2k, OS/2, etc... client</a></dt><dt><a href="install.html#id2887296">What If Things Don't Work?</a></dt><dt><a href="install.html#id2887329">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="install.html#id2887342">Why are so many smbd processes eating memory?</a></dt><dt><a href="install.html#id2887558">I'm getting &quot;open_oplock_ipc: Failed to get local UDP socket for address 100007f. Error was Cannot assign requested&quot; in the logs</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2886809"></a>Obtaining and installing samba</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+ Binary packages of samba are included in almost any Linux or
+ Unix distribution. There are also some packages available at
+ <a href="http://samba.org/" target="_top">the samba homepage</a>.
+ </p><p>If you need to compile samba from source, check the
+ <a href="compiling.html" title="Chapter 36. How to compile SAMBA">appropriate appendix chapter</a>.</p><p>If you have already installed samba, or if your operating system
+ was pre-installed with samba, then you may not need to bother with this
+ chapter. On the other hand, you may want to read this chapter anyhow
+ for information about updating samba.</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2886850"></a>Configuring samba (smb.conf)</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+ Samba's configuration is stored in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file,
+ that usually resides in <tt class="filename">/etc/samba/smb.conf</tt>
+ or <tt class="filename">/usr/local/samba/lib/smb.conf</tt>. You can either
+ edit this file yourself or do it using one of the many graphical
+ tools that are available, such as the web-based interface swat, that
+ is included with samba.
+ </p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2886887"></a>Example Configuration</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+ There are sample configuration files in the examples subdirectory in the
+ distribution. I suggest you read them carefully so you can see how the options
+ go together in practice. See the man page for all the options.
+ </p><p>
+ The simplest useful configuration file would be something like this:
+ </p><p>
+ </p><pre class="programlisting">
+ [global]
+ workgroup = MYGROUP
- [homes]
- guest ok = no
- read only = no
- </PRE
-></P
-><P
->which would allow connections by anyone with an
- account on the server, using either their login name or
- "homes" as the service name. (Note that I also set the
- workgroup that Samba is part of. See BROWSING.txt for details)</P
-><P
->Note that <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->make install</B
-> will not install
- a <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->smb.conf</TT
-> file. You need to create it
- yourself. </P
-><P
->Make sure you put the smb.conf file in the same place
- you specified in the<TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->Makefile</TT
-> (the default is to
- look for it in <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/usr/local/samba/lib/</TT
->).</P
-><P
->For more information about security settings for the
- [homes] share please refer to the document UNIX_SECURITY.txt.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><H1
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN82">1.5. Test your config file with
- <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->testparm</B
-></H1
-><P
->It's important that you test the validity of your
- <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->smb.conf</TT
-> file using the testparm program.
- If testparm runs OK then it will list the loaded services. If
- not it will give an error message.</P
-><P
->Make sure it runs OK and that the services look
- reasonable before proceeding. </P
-><P
->Always run testparm again when you change
- <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->smb.conf</TT
->!</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><H1
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN90">1.6. Starting the smbd and nmbd</H1
-><P
->You must choose to start smbd and nmbd either
- as daemons or from <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->inetd</B
->. Don't try
- to do both! Either you can put them in <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
-> inetd.conf</TT
-> and have them started on demand
- by <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->inetd</B
->, or you can start them as
- daemons either from the command line or in <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
-> /etc/rc.local</TT
->. See the man pages for details
- on the command line options. Take particular care to read
- the bit about what user you need to be in order to start
- Samba. In many cases you must be root.</P
-><P
->The main advantage of starting <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbd</B
->
- and <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->nmbd</B
-> using the recommended daemon method
- is that they will respond slightly more quickly to an initial connection
- request.</P
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><H2
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN100">1.6.1. Starting from inetd.conf</H2
-><P
->NOTE; The following will be different if
- you use NIS or NIS+ to distributed services maps.</P
-><P
->Look at your <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/services</TT
->.
- What is defined at port 139/tcp. If nothing is defined
- then add a line like this:</P
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="USERINPUT"
-><B
->netbios-ssn 139/tcp</B
-></TT
-></P
-><P
->similarly for 137/udp you should have an entry like:</P
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="USERINPUT"
-><B
->netbios-ns 137/udp</B
-></TT
-></P
-><P
->Next edit your <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/inetd.conf</TT
->
- and add two lines something like this:</P
-><P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
-> netbios-ssn stream tcp nowait root /usr/local/samba/bin/smbd smbd
- netbios-ns dgram udp wait root /usr/local/samba/bin/nmbd nmbd
- </PRE
-></P
-><P
->The exact syntax of <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/inetd.conf</TT
->
- varies between unixes. Look at the other entries in inetd.conf
- for a guide.</P
-><P
->NOTE: Some unixes already have entries like netbios_ns
- (note the underscore) in <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/services</TT
->.
- You must either edit <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/services</TT
-> or
- <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/inetd.conf</TT
-> to make them consistent.</P
-><P
->NOTE: On many systems you may need to use the
- "interfaces" option in smb.conf to specify the IP address
- and netmask of your interfaces. Run <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->ifconfig</B
->
- as root if you don't know what the broadcast is for your
- net. <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->nmbd</B
-> tries to determine it at run
- time, but fails on some unixes. See the section on "testing nmbd"
- for a method of finding if you need to do this.</P
-><P
->!!!WARNING!!! Many unixes only accept around 5
- parameters on the command line in <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->inetd.conf</TT
->.
- This means you shouldn't use spaces between the options and
- arguments, or you should use a script, and start the script
- from <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->inetd</B
->.</P
-><P
->Restart <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->inetd</B
->, perhaps just send
- it a HUP. If you have installed an earlier version of <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
-> nmbd</B
-> then you may need to kill nmbd as well.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><H2
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN129">1.6.2. Alternative: starting it as a daemon</H2
-><P
->To start the server as a daemon you should create
- a script something like this one, perhaps calling
- it <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->startsmb</TT
->.</P
-><P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
-> #!/bin/sh
- /usr/local/samba/bin/smbd -D
- /usr/local/samba/bin/nmbd -D
- </PRE
-></P
-><P
->then make it executable with <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->chmod
- +x startsmb</B
-></P
-><P
->You can then run <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->startsmb</B
-> by
- hand or execute it from <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/rc.local</TT
->
- </P
-><P
->To kill it send a kill signal to the processes
- <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->nmbd</B
-> and <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbd</B
->.</P
-><P
->NOTE: If you use the SVR4 style init system then
- you may like to look at the <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->examples/svr4-startup</TT
->
- script to make Samba fit into that system.</P
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><H1
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN145">1.7. Try listing the shares available on your
- server</H1
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="PROMPT"
->$ </TT
-><TT
-CLASS="USERINPUT"
-><B
->smbclient -L
- <TT
-CLASS="REPLACEABLE"
-><I
->yourhostname</I
-></TT
-></B
-></TT
-></P
-><P
->You should get back a list of shares available on
+ [homes]
+ guest ok = no
+ read only = no
+ </pre><p>
+ </p><p>
+ This will allow connections by anyone with an account on the server, using either
+ their login name or &quot;<i class="parameter"><tt>homes</tt></i>&quot; as the service name.
+ (Note that the workgroup that Samba must also be set.)
+ </p><p>
+ Make sure you put the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file in the same place
+ you specified in the<tt class="filename">Makefile</tt> (the default is to
+ look for it in <tt class="filename">/usr/local/samba/lib/</tt>).
+ </p><p>
+ For more information about security settings for the
+ <i class="parameter"><tt>[homes]</tt></i> share please refer to the chapter
+ <a href="securing-samba.html" title="Chapter 15. Securing Samba">Securing Samba</a>.
+ </p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2886982"></a>Test your config file with <b class="command">testparm</b></h4></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+ It's important that you test the validity of your <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>
+ file using the <span class="application">testparm</span> program. If testparm runs OK
+ then it will list the loaded services. If not it will give an error message.
+ </p><p>
+ Make sure it runs OK and that the services look reasonable before proceeding.
+ </p><p>
+ Always run testparm again when you change <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>!
+ </p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2887037"></a>SWAT</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+ SWAT is a web-based interface that helps you configure samba.
+ SWAT might not be available in the samba package on your platform,
+ but in a separate package. Please read the swat manpage
+ on compiling, installing and configuring swat from source.
+ </p><p>
+ To launch SWAT just run your favorite web browser and
+ point it at <a href="http://localhost:901/" target="_top">http://localhost:901/</a>. Replace
+ <i class="replaceable"><tt>localhost</tt></i>
+ with the name of the computer you are running samba on if you
+ are running samba on a different computer than your browser.
+ </p><p>
+ Note that you can attach to SWAT from any IP connected
+ machine but connecting from a remote machine leaves your
+ connection open to password sniffing as passwords will be sent
+ in the clear over the wire.
+ </p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2887081"></a>Try listing the shares available on your
+ server</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p><tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>smbclient -L
+ <i class="replaceable"><tt>yourhostname</tt></i></tt></b></p><p>You should get back a list of shares available on
your server. If you don't then something is incorrectly setup.
Note that this method can also be used to see what shares
- are available on other LanManager clients (such as WfWg).</P
-><P
->If you choose user level security then you may find
+ are available on other LanManager clients (such as WfWg).</p><p>If you choose user level security then you may find
that Samba requests a password before it will list the shares.
- See the <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbclient</B
-> man page for details. (you
+ See the <b class="command">smbclient</b> man page for details. (you
can force it to list the shares without a password by
adding the option -U% to the command line. This will not work
- with non-Samba servers)</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><H1
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN154">1.8. Try connecting with the unix client</H1
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="PROMPT"
->$ </TT
-><TT
-CLASS="USERINPUT"
-><B
->smbclient <TT
-CLASS="REPLACEABLE"
-><I
-> //yourhostname/aservice</I
-></TT
-></B
-></TT
-></P
-><P
->Typically the <TT
-CLASS="REPLACEABLE"
-><I
->yourhostname</I
-></TT
->
- would be the name of the host where you installed <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
-> smbd</B
->. The <TT
-CLASS="REPLACEABLE"
-><I
->aservice</I
-></TT
-> is
- any service you have defined in the <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->smb.conf</TT
->
- file. Try your user name if you just have a [homes] section
- in <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->smb.conf</TT
->.</P
-><P
->For example if your unix host is bambi and your login
- name is fred you would type:</P
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="PROMPT"
->$ </TT
-><TT
-CLASS="USERINPUT"
-><B
->smbclient //bambi/fred
- </B
-></TT
-></P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><H1
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN170">1.9. Try connecting from a DOS, WfWg, Win9x, WinNT,
- Win2k, OS/2, etc... client</H1
-><P
->Try mounting disks. eg:</P
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="PROMPT"
->C:\WINDOWS\&#62; </TT
-><TT
-CLASS="USERINPUT"
-><B
->net use d: \\servername\service
- </B
-></TT
-></P
-><P
->Try printing. eg:</P
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="PROMPT"
->C:\WINDOWS\&#62; </TT
-><TT
-CLASS="USERINPUT"
-><B
->net use lpt1:
- \\servername\spoolservice</B
-></TT
-></P
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="PROMPT"
->C:\WINDOWS\&#62; </TT
-><TT
-CLASS="USERINPUT"
-><B
->print filename
- </B
-></TT
-></P
-><P
->Celebrate, or send me a bug report!</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><H1
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN184">1.10. What If Things Don't Work?</H1
-><P
->If nothing works and you start to think "who wrote
- this pile of trash" then I suggest you do step 2 again (and
- again) till you calm down.</P
-><P
->Then you might read the file DIAGNOSIS.txt and the
- FAQ. If you are still stuck then try the mailing list or
- newsgroup (look in the README for details). Samba has been
- successfully installed at thousands of sites worldwide, so maybe
- someone else has hit your problem and has overcome it. You could
- also use the WWW site to scan back issues of the samba-digest.</P
-><P
->When you fix the problem PLEASE send me some updates to the
- documentation (or source code) so that the next person will find it
- easier. </P
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><H2
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN189">1.10.1. Diagnosing Problems</H2
-><P
->If you have installation problems then go to the
- <A
-HREF="Diagnosis.html"
-TARGET="_top"
->Diagnosis</A
-> chapter to try to find the
- problem.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><H2
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN193">1.10.2. Scope IDs</H2
-><P
->By default Samba uses a blank scope ID. This means
- all your windows boxes must also have a blank scope ID.
- If you really want to use a non-blank scope ID then you will
- need to use the 'netbios scope' smb.conf option.
- All your PCs will need to have the same setting for
- this to work. I do not recommend scope IDs.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><H2
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN196">1.10.3. Choosing the Protocol Level</H2
-><P
->The SMB protocol has many dialects. Currently
- Samba supports 5, called CORE, COREPLUS, LANMAN1,
- LANMAN2 and NT1.</P
-><P
->You can choose what maximum protocol to support
- in the <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->smb.conf</TT
-> file. The default is
- NT1 and that is the best for the vast majority of sites.</P
-><P
->In older versions of Samba you may have found it
- necessary to use COREPLUS. The limitations that led to
- this have mostly been fixed. It is now less likely that you
- will want to use less than LANMAN1. The only remaining advantage
- of COREPLUS is that for some obscure reason WfWg preserves
- the case of passwords in this protocol, whereas under LANMAN1,
- LANMAN2 or NT1 it uppercases all passwords before sending them,
- forcing you to use the "password level=" option in some cases.</P
-><P
->The main advantage of LANMAN2 and NT1 is support for
- long filenames with some clients (eg: smbclient, Windows NT
- or Win95). </P
-><P
->See the smb.conf(5) manual page for more details.</P
-><P
->Note: To support print queue reporting you may find
- that you have to use TCP/IP as the default protocol under
- WfWg. For some reason if you leave Netbeui as the default
- it may break the print queue reporting on some systems.
- It is presumably a WfWg bug.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><H2
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN205">1.10.4. Printing from UNIX to a Client PC</H2
-><P
->To use a printer that is available via a smb-based
- server from a unix host with LPR you will need to compile the
- smbclient program. You then need to install the script
- "smbprint". Read the instruction in smbprint for more details.
- </P
-><P
->There is also a SYSV style script that does much
- the same thing called smbprint.sysv. It contains instructions.</P
-><P
->See the CUPS manual for information about setting up
- printing from a unix host with CUPS to a smb-based server. </P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><H2
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN210">1.10.5. Locking</H2
-><P
->One area which sometimes causes trouble is locking.</P
-><P
->There are two types of locking which need to be
- performed by a SMB server. The first is "record locking"
- which allows a client to lock a range of bytes in a open file.
- The second is the "deny modes" that are specified when a file
- is open.</P
-><P
->Record locking semantics under Unix is very
- different from record locking under Windows. Versions
- of Samba before 2.2 have tried to use the native
- fcntl() unix system call to implement proper record
- locking between different Samba clients. This can not
- be fully correct due to several reasons. The simplest
- is the fact that a Windows client is allowed to lock a
- byte range up to 2^32 or 2^64, depending on the client
- OS. The unix locking only supports byte ranges up to
- 2^31. So it is not possible to correctly satisfy a
- lock request above 2^31. There are many more
- differences, too many to be listed here.</P
-><P
->Samba 2.2 and above implements record locking
- completely independent of the underlying unix
- system. If a byte range lock that the client requests
- happens to fall into the range 0-2^31, Samba hands
- this request down to the Unix system. All other locks
- can not be seen by unix anyway.</P
-><P
->Strictly a SMB server should check for locks before
- every read and write call on a file. Unfortunately with the
- way fcntl() works this can be slow and may overstress the
- rpc.lockd. It is also almost always unnecessary as clients
- are supposed to independently make locking calls before reads
- and writes anyway if locking is important to them. By default
- Samba only makes locking calls when explicitly asked
- to by a client, but if you set "strict locking = yes" then it will
- make lock checking calls on every read and write. </P
-><P
->You can also disable by range locking completely
- using "locking = no". This is useful for those shares that
- don't support locking or don't need it (such as cdroms). In
- this case Samba fakes the return codes of locking calls to
- tell clients that everything is OK.</P
-><P
->The second class of locking is the "deny modes". These
- are set by an application when it opens a file to determine
- what types of access should be allowed simultaneously with
- its open. A client may ask for DENY_NONE, DENY_READ, DENY_WRITE
- or DENY_ALL. There are also special compatibility modes called
- DENY_FCB and DENY_DOS.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><H2
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN219">1.10.6. Mapping Usernames</H2
-><P
->If you have different usernames on the PCs and
- the unix server then take a look at the "username map" option.
- See the smb.conf man page for details.</P
-></DIV
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="NAVFOOTER"
-><HR
-ALIGN="LEFT"
-WIDTH="100%"><TABLE
-SUMMARY="Footer navigation table"
-WIDTH="100%"
-BORDER="0"
-CELLPADDING="0"
-CELLSPACING="0"
-><TR
-><TD
-WIDTH="33%"
-ALIGN="left"
-VALIGN="top"
-><A
-HREF="introduction.html"
-ACCESSKEY="P"
->Prev</A
-></TD
-><TD
-WIDTH="34%"
-ALIGN="center"
-VALIGN="top"
-><A
-HREF="samba-howto-collection.html"
-ACCESSKEY="H"
->Home</A
-></TD
-><TD
-WIDTH="33%"
-ALIGN="right"
-VALIGN="top"
-><A
-HREF="improved-browsing.html"
-ACCESSKEY="N"
->Next</A
-></TD
-></TR
-><TR
-><TD
-WIDTH="33%"
-ALIGN="left"
-VALIGN="top"
->General installation</TD
-><TD
-WIDTH="34%"
-ALIGN="center"
-VALIGN="top"
-><A
-HREF="introduction.html"
-ACCESSKEY="U"
->Up</A
-></TD
-><TD
-WIDTH="33%"
-ALIGN="right"
-VALIGN="top"
->Improved browsing in samba</TD
-></TR
-></TABLE
-></DIV
-></BODY
-></HTML
-> \ No newline at end of file
+ with non-Samba servers)</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2887132"></a>Try connecting with the unix client</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p><tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>smbclient <i class="replaceable"><tt>
+ //yourhostname/aservice</tt></i></tt></b></p><p>Typically the <i class="replaceable"><tt>yourhostname</tt></i>
+ would be the name of the host where you installed <span class="application">smbd</span>.
+ The <i class="replaceable"><tt>aservice</tt></i> is
+ any service you have defined in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>
+ file. Try your user name if you just have a <i class="parameter"><tt>[homes]</tt></i>
+ section
+ in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>.</p><p>For example if your unix host is <i class="replaceable"><tt>bambi</tt></i>
+ and your login name is <i class="replaceable"><tt>fred</tt></i> you would type:</p><p><tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>smbclient //<i class="replaceable"><tt>bambi</tt></i>/<i class="replaceable"><tt>fred</tt></i>
+ </tt></b></p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2887232"></a>Try connecting from a DOS, WfWg, Win9x, WinNT,
+ Win2k, OS/2, etc... client</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>Try mounting disks. eg:</p><p><tt class="prompt">C:\WINDOWS\&gt; </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>net use d: \\servername\service
+ </tt></b></p><p>Try printing. eg:</p><p><tt class="prompt">C:\WINDOWS\&gt; </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>net use lpt1:
+ \\servername\spoolservice</tt></b></p><p><tt class="prompt">C:\WINDOWS\&gt; </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>print filename
+ </tt></b></p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2887296"></a>What If Things Don't Work?</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>Then you might read the file chapter
+ <a href="diagnosis.html" title="Chapter 33. The samba checklist">Diagnosis</a> and the
+ FAQ. If you are still stuck then try to follow
+ the <a href="problems.html" title="Chapter 34. Analysing and solving samba problems">Analysing and Solving Problems chapter</a>
+ Samba has been successfully installed at thousands of sites worldwide,
+ so maybe someone else has hit your problem and has overcome it. </p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2887329"></a>Common Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+The following questions and issues get raised on the samba mailing list over and over again.
+</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2887342"></a>Why are so many smbd processes eating memory?</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+&#8220;<span class="quote">
+Site that is running Samba on an AIX box. They are sharing out about 2 terabytes using samba.
+Samba was installed using smitty and the binaries. We seem to be experiencing a memory problem
+with this box. When I do a <b class="command">svmon -Pu</b> the monitoring program shows that <span class="application">smbd</span> has several
+processes of smbd running:
+</span>&#8221;
+</p><p>
+ &#8220;<span class="quote">
+Is samba suppose to start this many different smbd processes? Or does it run as one smbd process? Also
+is it normal for it to be taking up this much memory?
+</span>&#8221;
+</p><p>
+</p><pre class="screen">
+Inuse * 4096 = amount of memory being used by this process
+
+ Pid Command Inuse Pin Pgsp Virtual 64-bit Mthrd
+ 20950 smbd 33098 1906 181 5017 N N
+ 22262 smbd 9104 1906 5410
+ 21060 smbd 9048 1906 181 5479 N N
+ 25972 smbd 8678 1906 181 5109 N N
+ 24524 smbd 8674 1906 181 5105 N N
+ 19262 smbd 8582 1906 181 5013 N N
+ 20722 smbd 8572 1906 181 5003 N N
+ 21454 smbd 8572 1906 181 5003 N N
+ 28946 smbd 8567 1906 181 4996 N N
+ 24076 smbd 8566 1906 181 4996 N N
+ 20138 smbd 8566 1906 181 4996 N N
+ 17608 smbd 8565 1906 181 4996 N N
+ 21820 smbd 8565 1906 181 4996 N N
+ 26940 smbd 8565 1906 181 4996 N N
+ 19884 smbd 8565 1906 181 4996 N N
+ 9912 smbd 8565 1906 181 4996 N N
+ 25800 smbd 8564 1906 181 4995 N N
+ 20452 smbd 8564 1906 181 4995 N N
+ 18592 smbd 8562 1906 181 4993 N N
+ 28216 smbd 8521 1906 181 4954 N N
+ 19110 smbd 8404 1906 181 4862 N N
+
+ Total memory used: 841,592,832 bytes
+</pre><p>
+</p><p>
+Samba consists on three core programs:
+<span class="application">nmbd</span>, <span class="application">smbd</span>, <span class="application">winbindd</span>. <span class="application">nmbd</span> is the name server message daemon,
+<span class="application">smbd</span> is the server message daemon, <span class="application">winbindd</span> is the daemon that
+handles communication with Domain Controllers.
+</p><p>
+If your system is NOT running as a WINS server, then there will be one (1) single instance of
+ <span class="application">nmbd</span> running on your system. If it is running as a WINS server then there will be
+two (2) instances - one to handle the WINS requests.
+</p><p>
+<span class="application">smbd</span> handles ALL connection requests and then spawns a new process for each client
+connection made. That is why you are seeing so many of them, one (1) per client connection.
+</p><p>
+<span class="application">winbindd</span> will run as one or two daemons, depending on whether or not it is being
+run in &quot;split mode&quot; (in which case there will be two instances).
+</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2887558"></a>I'm getting &quot;open_oplock_ipc: Failed to get local UDP socket for address 100007f. Error was Cannot assign requested&quot; in the logs</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>Your loopback device isn't working correctly. Make sure it's running. </p></div></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="IntroSMB.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="introduction.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="FastStart.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 1. Introduction to Samba </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="index.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 3. FastStart for the Impatient</td></tr></table></div></body></html>
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/integrate-ms-networks.html b/docs/htmldocs/integrate-ms-networks.html
index ad6aa9e225..f3038ce5a4 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/integrate-ms-networks.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/integrate-ms-networks.html
@@ -1,221 +1,62 @@
-<!DOCTYPE HTML PUBLIC "-//W3C//DTD HTML 4.01 Transitional//EN">
-<HTML
-><HEAD
-><TITLE
->Integrating MS Windows networks with Samba</TITLE
-><META
-NAME="GENERATOR"
-CONTENT="Modular DocBook HTML Stylesheet Version 1.76b+
-"><LINK
-REL="HOME"
-TITLE="SAMBA Project Documentation"
-HREF="samba-howto-collection.html"><LINK
-REL="UP"
-TITLE="Optional configuration"
-HREF="optional.html"><LINK
-REL="PREVIOUS"
-TITLE="Optional configuration"
-HREF="optional.html"><LINK
-REL="NEXT"
-TITLE="UNIX Permission Bits and Windows NT Access Control Lists"
-HREF="unix-permissions.html"></HEAD
-><BODY
-CLASS="CHAPTER"
-BGCOLOR="#FFFFFF"
-TEXT="#000000"
-LINK="#0000FF"
-VLINK="#840084"
-ALINK="#0000FF"
-><DIV
-CLASS="NAVHEADER"
-><TABLE
-SUMMARY="Header navigation table"
-WIDTH="100%"
-BORDER="0"
-CELLPADDING="0"
-CELLSPACING="0"
-><TR
-><TH
-COLSPAN="3"
-ALIGN="center"
->SAMBA Project Documentation</TH
-></TR
-><TR
-><TD
-WIDTH="10%"
-ALIGN="left"
-VALIGN="bottom"
-><A
-HREF="optional.html"
-ACCESSKEY="P"
->Prev</A
-></TD
-><TD
-WIDTH="80%"
-ALIGN="center"
-VALIGN="bottom"
-></TD
-><TD
-WIDTH="10%"
-ALIGN="right"
-VALIGN="bottom"
-><A
-HREF="unix-permissions.html"
-ACCESSKEY="N"
->Next</A
-></TD
-></TR
-></TABLE
-><HR
-ALIGN="LEFT"
-WIDTH="100%"></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="CHAPTER"
-><H1
-><A
-NAME="INTEGRATE-MS-NETWORKS">Chapter 10. Integrating MS Windows networks with Samba</H1
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><H1
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN1374">10.1. Agenda</H1
-><P
->To identify the key functional mechanisms of MS Windows networking
-to enable the deployment of Samba as a means of extending and/or
-replacing MS Windows NT/2000 technology.</P
-><P
->We will examine:</P
-><P
-></P
-><OL
-TYPE="1"
-><LI
-><P
->Name resolution in a pure Unix/Linux TCP/IP
- environment
- </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->Name resolution as used within MS Windows
- networking
- </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->How browsing functions and how to deploy stable
- and dependable browsing using Samba
- </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->MS Windows security options and how to
- configure Samba for seemless integration
- </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->Configuration of Samba as:</P
-><P
-></P
-><OL
-TYPE="a"
-><LI
-><P
->A stand-alone server</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->An MS Windows NT 3.x/4.0 security domain member
- </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->An alternative to an MS Windows NT 3.x/4.0 Domain Controller
- </P
-></LI
-></OL
-></LI
-></OL
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><H1
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN1396">10.2. Name Resolution in a pure Unix/Linux world</H1
-><P
->The key configuration files covered in this section are:</P
-><P
-></P
-><UL
-><LI
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/hosts</TT
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/resolv.conf</TT
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/host.conf</TT
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/nsswitch.conf</TT
-></P
-></LI
-></UL
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><H2
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN1412">10.2.1. <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/hosts</TT
-></H2
-><P
->Contains a static list of IP Addresses and names.
-eg:</P
-><P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
-> 127.0.0.1 localhost localhost.localdomain
- 192.168.1.1 bigbox.caldera.com bigbox alias4box</PRE
-></P
-><P
->The purpose of <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/hosts</TT
-> is to provide a
+<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 26. Integrating MS Windows networks with Samba</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="optional.html" title="Part III. Advanced Configuration"><link rel="previous" href="pam.html" title="Chapter 25. PAM based Distributed Authentication"><link rel="next" href="unicode.html" title="Chapter 27. Unicode/Charsets"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 26. Integrating MS Windows networks with Samba</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="pam.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part III. Advanced Configuration</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="unicode.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="integrate-ms-networks"></a>Chapter 26. Integrating MS Windows networks with Samba</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email">&lt;<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>&gt;</tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate"> (Jan 01 2001) </p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2999128">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2999152">Background Information</a></dt><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2999197">Name Resolution in a pure Unix/Linux world</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2999254">/etc/hosts</a></dt><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2999378">/etc/resolv.conf</a></dt><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2999422">/etc/host.conf</a></dt><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2999464">/etc/nsswitch.conf</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2999552">Name resolution as used within MS Windows networking</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2999700">The NetBIOS Name Cache</a></dt><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2999745">The LMHOSTS file</a></dt><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2999989">HOSTS file</a></dt><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id3000021">DNS Lookup</a></dt><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id3000046">WINS Lookup</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id3000117">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id3000133">My Boomerang Won't Come Back</a></dt><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id3000164">Very Slow Network Connections</a></dt><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id3000216">Samba server name change problem</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><p>
+This section deals with NetBIOS over TCP/IP name to IP address resolution. If
+your MS Windows clients are NOT configured to use NetBIOS over TCP/IP then this
+section does not apply to your installation. If your installation involves use of
+NetBIOS over TCP/IP then this section may help you to resolve networking problems.
+</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p>
+ NetBIOS over TCP/IP has nothing to do with NetBEUI. NetBEUI is NetBIOS
+ over Logical Link Control (LLC). On modern networks it is highly advised
+ to NOT run NetBEUI at all. Note also that there is NO such thing as
+ NetBEUI over TCP/IP - the existence of such a protocol is a complete
+ and utter mis-apprehension.
+</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2999128"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+Many MS Windows network administrators have never been exposed to basic TCP/IP
+networking as it is implemented in a Unix/Linux operating system. Likewise, many Unix and
+Linux adminsitrators have not been exposed to the intricacies of MS Windows TCP/IP based
+networking (and may have no desire to be either).
+</p><p>
+This chapter gives a short introduction to the basics of how a name can be resolved to
+it's IP address for each operating system environment.
+</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2999152"></a>Background Information</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+Since the introduction of MS Windows 2000 it is possible to run MS Windows networking
+without the use of NetBIOS over TCP/IP. NetBIOS over TCP/IP uses UDP port 137 for NetBIOS
+name resolution and uses TCP port 139 for NetBIOS session services. When NetBIOS over
+TCP/IP is disabled on MS Windows 2000 and later clients then only TCP port 445 will be
+used and UDP port 137 and TCP port 139 will not.
+</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p>
+When using Windows 2000 or later clients, if NetBIOS over TCP/IP is NOT disabled, then
+the client will use UDP port 137 (NetBIOS Name Service, also known as the Windows Internet
+Name Service or WINS), TCP port 139 AND TCP port 445 (for actual file and print traffic).
+</p></div><p>
+When NetBIOS over TCP/IP is disabled the use of DNS is essential. Most installations that
+disable NetBIOS over TCP/IP today use MS Active Directory Service (ADS). ADS requires
+Dynamic DNS with Service Resource Records (SRV RR) and with Incremental Zone Transfers (IXFR).
+Use of DHCP with ADS is recommended as a further means of maintaining central control
+over client workstation network configuration.
+</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2999197"></a>Name Resolution in a pure Unix/Linux world</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+The key configuration files covered in this section are:
+</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><tt class="filename">/etc/hosts</tt></p></li><li><p><tt class="filename">/etc/resolv.conf</tt></p></li><li><p><tt class="filename">/etc/host.conf</tt></p></li><li><p><tt class="filename">/etc/nsswitch.conf</tt></p></li></ul></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2999254"></a><tt class="filename">/etc/hosts</tt></h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+Contains a static list of IP Addresses and names.
+eg:
+</p><pre class="screen">
+ 127.0.0.1 localhost localhost.localdomain
+ 192.168.1.1 bigbox.caldera.com bigbox alias4box
+</pre><p>
+The purpose of <tt class="filename">/etc/hosts</tt> is to provide a
name resolution mechanism so that uses do not need to remember
-IP addresses.</P
-><P
->Network packets that are sent over the physical network transport
+IP addresses.
+</p><p>
+Network packets that are sent over the physical network transport
layer communicate not via IP addresses but rather using the Media
Access Control address, or MAC address. IP Addresses are currently
32 bits in length and are typically presented as four (4) decimal
-numbers that are separated by a dot (or period). eg: 168.192.1.1</P
-><P
->MAC Addresses use 48 bits (or 6 bytes) and are typically represented
+numbers that are separated by a dot (or period). eg: 168.192.1.1.
+</p><p>
+MAC Addresses use 48 bits (or 6 bytes) and are typically represented
as two digit hexadecimal numbers separated by colons. eg:
-40:8e:0a:12:34:56</P
-><P
->Every network interfrace must have an MAC address. Associated with
+40:8e:0a:12:34:56
+</p><p>
+Every network interface must have an MAC address. Associated with
a MAC address there may be one or more IP addresses. There is NO
relationship between an IP address and a MAC address, all such assignments
are arbitary or discretionary in nature. At the most basic level all
@@ -224,18 +65,15 @@ addresses must be globally unique, and generally remains fixed for
any particular interface, the assignment of an IP address makes sense
from a network management perspective. More than one IP address can
be assigned per MAC address. One address must be the primary IP address,
-this is the address that will be returned in the ARP reply.</P
-><P
->When a user or a process wants to communicate with another machine
-the protocol implementation ensures that the "machine name" or "host
-name" is resolved to an IP address in a manner that is controlled
+this is the address that will be returned in the ARP reply.
+</p><p>
+When a user or a process wants to communicate with another machine
+the protocol implementation ensures that the &quot;machine name&quot; or &quot;host
+name&quot; is resolved to an IP address in a manner that is controlled
by the TCP/IP configuration control files. The file
-<TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/hosts</TT
-> is one such file.</P
-><P
->When the IP address of the destination interface has been
+<tt class="filename">/etc/hosts</tt> is one such file.
+</p><p>
+When the IP address of the destination interface has been
determined a protocol called ARP/RARP is used to identify
the MAC address of the target interface. ARP stands for Address
Resolution Protocol, and is a broadcast oriented method that
@@ -245,98 +83,41 @@ address. Network interfaces are programmed to respond to two
MAC addresses only; their own unique address and the address
ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff. The reply packet from an ARP request will
contain the MAC address and the primary IP address for each
-interface.</P
-><P
->The <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/hosts</TT
-> file is foundational to all
+interface.
+</p><p>
+The <tt class="filename">/etc/hosts</tt> file is foundational to all
Unix/Linux TCP/IP installations and as a minumum will contain
the localhost and local network interface IP addresses and the
primary names by which they are known within the local machine.
This file helps to prime the pump so that a basic level of name
resolution can exist before any other method of name resolution
-becomes available.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><H2
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN1428">10.2.2. <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/resolv.conf</TT
-></H2
-><P
->This file tells the name resolution libraries:</P
-><P
-></P
-><UL
-><LI
-><P
->The name of the domain to which the machine
+becomes available.
+</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2999378"></a><tt class="filename">/etc/resolv.conf</tt></h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+This file tells the name resolution libraries:
+</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>The name of the domain to which the machine
belongs
- </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->The name(s) of any domains that should be
+ </p></li><li><p>The name(s) of any domains that should be
automatically searched when trying to resolve unqualified
host names to their IP address
- </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->The name or IP address of available Domain
+ </p></li><li><p>The name or IP address of available Domain
Name Servers that may be asked to perform name to address
translation lookups
- </P
-></LI
-></UL
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><H2
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN1439">10.2.3. <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/host.conf</TT
-></H2
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/host.conf</TT
-> is the primary means by
+ </p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2999422"></a><tt class="filename">/etc/host.conf</tt></h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+<tt class="filename">/etc/host.conf</tt> is the primary means by
which the setting in /etc/resolv.conf may be affected. It is a
critical configuration file. This file controls the order by
-which name resolution may procede. The typical structure is:</P
-><P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
-> order hosts,bind
- multi on</PRE
-></P
-><P
->then both addresses should be returned. Please refer to the
-man page for host.conf for further details.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><H2
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN1447">10.2.4. <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/nsswitch.conf</TT
-></H2
-><P
->This file controls the actual name resolution targets. The
-file typically has resolver object specifications as follows:</P
-><P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
-> # /etc/nsswitch.conf
+which name resolution may procede. The typical structure is:
+</p><pre class="screen">
+ order hosts,bind
+ multi on
+</pre><p>
+then both addresses should be returned. Please refer to the
+man page for host.conf for further details.
+</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2999464"></a><tt class="filename">/etc/nsswitch.conf</tt></h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+This file controls the actual name resolution targets. The
+file typically has resolver object specifications as follows:
+</p><pre class="screen">
+ # /etc/nsswitch.conf
#
# Name Service Switch configuration file.
#
@@ -355,99 +136,75 @@ CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
ethers: nis files
protocols: nis files
rpc: nis files
- services: nis files</PRE
-></P
-><P
->Of course, each of these mechanisms requires that the appropriate
-facilities and/or services are correctly configured.</P
-><P
->It should be noted that unless a network request/message must be
+ services: nis files
+</pre><p>
+Of course, each of these mechanisms requires that the appropriate
+facilities and/or services are correctly configured.
+</p><p>
+It should be noted that unless a network request/message must be
sent, TCP/IP networks are silent. All TCP/IP communications assumes a
-principal of speaking only when necessary.</P
-><P
->Starting with version 2.2.0 samba has Linux support for extensions to
+principal of speaking only when necessary.
+</p><p>
+Starting with version 2.2.0 samba has Linux support for extensions to
the name service switch infrastructure so that linux clients will
be able to obtain resolution of MS Windows NetBIOS names to IP
Addresses. To gain this functionality Samba needs to be compiled
-with appropriate arguments to the make command (ie: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->make
-nsswitch/libnss_wins.so</B
->). The resulting library should
-then be installed in the <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/lib</TT
-> directory and
-the "wins" parameter needs to be added to the "hosts:" line in
-the <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/nsswitch.conf</TT
-> file. At this point it
+with appropriate arguments to the make command (ie: <b class="userinput"><tt>make
+nsswitch/libnss_wins.so</tt></b>). The resulting library should
+then be installed in the <tt class="filename">/lib</tt> directory and
+the &quot;wins&quot; parameter needs to be added to the &quot;hosts:&quot; line in
+the <tt class="filename">/etc/nsswitch.conf</tt> file. At this point it
will be possible to ping any MS Windows machine by it's NetBIOS
machine name, so long as that machine is within the workgroup to
-which both the samba machine and the MS Windows machine belong.</P
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><H1
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN1459">10.3. Name resolution as used within MS Windows networking</H1
-><P
->MS Windows networking is predicated about the name each machine
+which both the samba machine and the MS Windows machine belong.
+</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2999552"></a>Name resolution as used within MS Windows networking</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+MS Windows networking is predicated about the name each machine
is given. This name is known variously (and inconsistently) as
-the "computer name", "machine name", "networking name", "netbios name",
-"SMB name". All terms mean the same thing with the exception of
-"netbios name" which can apply also to the name of the workgroup or the
-domain name. The terms "workgroup" and "domain" are really just a
+the &quot;computer name&quot;, &quot;machine name&quot;, &quot;networking name&quot;, &quot;netbios name&quot;,
+&quot;SMB name&quot;. All terms mean the same thing with the exception of
+&quot;netbios name&quot; which can apply also to the name of the workgroup or the
+domain name. The terms &quot;workgroup&quot; and &quot;domain&quot; are really just a
simply name with which the machine is associated. All NetBIOS names
are exactly 16 characters in length. The 16th character is reserved.
It is used to store a one byte value that indicates service level
information for the NetBIOS name that is registered. A NetBIOS machine
name is therefore registered for each service type that is provided by
-the client/server.</P
-><P
->The following are typical NetBIOS name/service type registrations:</P
-><P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
-> Unique NetBIOS Names:
- MACHINENAME&#60;00&#62; = Server Service is running on MACHINENAME
- MACHINENAME&#60;03&#62; = Generic Machine Name (NetBIOS name)
- MACHINENAME&#60;20&#62; = LanMan Server service is running on MACHINENAME
- WORKGROUP&#60;1b&#62; = Domain Master Browser
+the client/server.
+</p><p>
+The following are typical NetBIOS name/service type registrations:
+</p><pre class="screen">
+ Unique NetBIOS Names:
+ MACHINENAME&lt;00&gt; = Server Service is running on MACHINENAME
+ MACHINENAME&lt;03&gt; = Generic Machine Name (NetBIOS name)
+ MACHINENAME&lt;20&gt; = LanMan Server service is running on MACHINENAME
+ WORKGROUP&lt;1b&gt; = Domain Master Browser
Group Names:
- WORKGROUP&#60;03&#62; = Generic Name registered by all members of WORKGROUP
- WORKGROUP&#60;1c&#62; = Domain Controllers / Netlogon Servers
- WORKGROUP&#60;1d&#62; = Local Master Browsers
- WORKGROUP&#60;1e&#62; = Internet Name Resolvers</PRE
-></P
-><P
->It should be noted that all NetBIOS machines register their own
+ WORKGROUP&lt;03&gt; = Generic Name registered by all members of WORKGROUP
+ WORKGROUP&lt;1c&gt; = Domain Controllers / Netlogon Servers
+ WORKGROUP&lt;1d&gt; = Local Master Browsers
+ WORKGROUP&lt;1e&gt; = Internet Name Resolvers
+</pre><p>
+It should be noted that all NetBIOS machines register their own
names as per the above. This is in vast contrast to TCP/IP
installations where traditionally the system administrator will
determine in the /etc/hosts or in the DNS database what names
-are associated with each IP address.</P
-><P
->One further point of clarification should be noted, the <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/hosts</TT
->
+are associated with each IP address.
+</p><p>
+One further point of clarification should be noted, the <tt class="filename">/etc/hosts</tt>
file and the DNS records do not provide the NetBIOS name type information
that MS Windows clients depend on to locate the type of service that may
be needed. An example of this is what happens when an MS Windows client
-wants to locate a domain logon server. It find this service and the IP
+wants to locate a domain logon server. It finds this service and the IP
address of a server that provides it by performing a lookup (via a
NetBIOS broadcast) for enumeration of all machines that have
-registered the name type *&#60;1c&#62;. A logon request is then sent to each
+registered the name type *&lt;1c&gt;. A logon request is then sent to each
IP address that is returned in the enumerated list of IP addresses. Which
-ever machine first replies then ends up providing the logon services.</P
-><P
->The name "workgroup" or "domain" really can be confusing since these
+ever machine first replies then ends up providing the logon services.
+</p><p>
+The name &quot;workgroup&quot; or &quot;domain&quot; really can be confusing since these
have the added significance of indicating what is the security
-architecture of the MS Windows network. The term "workgroup" indicates
+architecture of the MS Windows network. The term &quot;workgroup&quot; indicates
that the primary nature of the network environment is that of a
peer-to-peer design. In a WORKGROUP all machines are responsible for
their own security, and generally such security is limited to use of
@@ -455,9 +212,9 @@ just a password (known as SHARE MODE security). In most situations
with peer-to-peer networking the users who control their own machines
will simply opt to have no security at all. It is possible to have
USER MODE security in a WORKGROUP environment, thus requiring use
-of a user name and a matching password.</P
-><P
->MS Windows networking is thus predetermined to use machine names
+of a user name and a matching password.
+</p><p>
+MS Windows networking is thus predetermined to use machine names
for all local and remote machine message passing. The protocol used is
called Server Message Block (SMB) and this is implemented using
the NetBIOS protocol (Network Basic Input Output System). NetBIOS can
@@ -466,60 +223,39 @@ the resulting protocol is called NetBEUI (Network Basic Extended User
Interface). NetBIOS can also be run over IPX (Internetworking Packet
Exchange) protocol as used by Novell NetWare, and it can be run
over TCP/IP protocols - in which case the resulting protocol is called
-NBT or NetBT, the NetBIOS over TCP/IP.</P
-><P
->MS Windows machines use a complex array of name resolution mechanisms.
+NBT or NetBT, the NetBIOS over TCP/IP.
+</p><p>
+MS Windows machines use a complex array of name resolution mechanisms.
Since we are primarily concerned with TCP/IP this demonstration is
-limited to this area.</P
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><H2
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN1471">10.3.1. The NetBIOS Name Cache</H2
-><P
->All MS Windows machines employ an in memory buffer in which is
+limited to this area.
+</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2999700"></a>The NetBIOS Name Cache</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+All MS Windows machines employ an in memory buffer in which is
stored the NetBIOS names and IP addresses for all external
machines that that machine has communicated with over the
past 10-15 minutes. It is more efficient to obtain an IP address
for a machine from the local cache than it is to go through all the
-configured name resolution mechanisms.</P
-><P
->If a machine whose name is in the local name cache has been shut
+configured name resolution mechanisms.
+</p><p>
+If a machine whose name is in the local name cache has been shut
down before the name had been expired and flushed from the cache, then
an attempt to exchange a message with that machine will be subject
to time-out delays. i.e.: Its name is in the cache, so a name resolution
lookup will succeed, but the machine can not respond. This can be
-frustrating for users - but it is a characteristic of the protocol.</P
-><P
->The MS Windows utility that allows examination of the NetBIOS
-name cache is called "nbtstat". The Samba equivalent of this
-is called "nmblookup".</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><H2
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN1476">10.3.2. The LMHOSTS file</H2
-><P
->This file is usually located in MS Windows NT 4.0 or
-2000 in <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->C:\WINNT\SYSTEM32\DRIVERS\ETC</TT
-> and contains
+frustrating for users - but it is a characteristic of the protocol.
+</p><p>
+The MS Windows utility that allows examination of the NetBIOS
+name cache is called &quot;nbtstat&quot;. The Samba equivalent of this
+is called <b class="command">nmblookup</b>.
+</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2999745"></a>The LMHOSTS file</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+This file is usually located in MS Windows NT 4.0 or
+2000 in <tt class="filename">C:\WINNT\SYSTEM32\DRIVERS\ETC</tt> and contains
the IP Address and the machine name in matched pairs. The
-<TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->LMHOSTS</TT
-> file performs NetBIOS name
-to IP address mapping oriented.</P
-><P
->It typically looks like:</P
-><P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
-> # Copyright (c) 1998 Microsoft Corp.
+<tt class="filename">LMHOSTS</tt> file performs NetBIOS name
+to IP address mapping.
+</p><p>
+It typically looks like:
+</p><pre class="screen">
+ # Copyright (c) 1998 Microsoft Corp.
#
# This is a sample LMHOSTS file used by the Microsoft Wins Client (NetBIOS
# over TCP/IP) stack for Windows98
@@ -528,7 +264,7 @@ CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
# (NetBIOS) names. Each entry should be kept on an individual line.
# The IP address should be placed in the first column followed by the
# corresponding computername. The address and the comptername
- # should be separated by at least one space or tab. The "#" character
+ # should be separated by at least one space or tab. The &quot;#&quot; character
# is generally used to denote the start of a comment (see the exceptions
# below).
#
@@ -542,28 +278,28 @@ CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
# #END_ALTERNATE
# \0xnn (non-printing character support)
#
- # Following any entry in the file with the characters "#PRE" will cause
+ # Following any entry in the file with the characters &quot;#PRE&quot; will cause
# the entry to be preloaded into the name cache. By default, entries are
# not preloaded, but are parsed only after dynamic name resolution fails.
#
- # Following an entry with the "#DOM:&lt;domain&gt;" tag will associate the
+ # Following an entry with the &quot;#DOM:&lt;domain&gt;&quot; tag will associate the
# entry with the domain specified by &lt;domain&gt;. This affects how the
# browser and logon services behave in TCP/IP environments. To preload
# the host name associated with #DOM entry, it is necessary to also add a
# #PRE to the line. The &lt;domain&gt; is always preloaded although it will not
# be shown when the name cache is viewed.
#
- # Specifying "#INCLUDE &lt;filename&gt;" will force the RFC NetBIOS (NBT)
+ # Specifying &quot;#INCLUDE &lt;filename&gt;&quot; will force the RFC NetBIOS (NBT)
# software to seek the specified &lt;filename&gt; and parse it as if it were
# local. &lt;filename&gt; is generally a UNC-based name, allowing a
# centralized lmhosts file to be maintained on a server.
# It is ALWAYS necessary to provide a mapping for the IP address of the
# server prior to the #INCLUDE. This mapping must use the #PRE directive.
- # In addtion the share "public" in the example below must be in the
- # LanManServer list of "NullSessionShares" in order for client machines to
+ # In addtion the share &quot;public&quot; in the example below must be in the
+ # LanManServer list of &quot;NullSessionShares&quot; in order for client machines to
# be able to read the lmhosts file successfully. This key is under
# \machine\system\currentcontrolset\services\lanmanserver\parameters\nullsessionshares
- # in the registry. Simply add "public" to the list found there.
+ # in the registry. Simply add &quot;public&quot; to the list found there.
#
# The #BEGIN_ and #END_ALTERNATE keywords allow multiple #INCLUDE
# statements to be grouped together. Any single successful include
@@ -576,7 +312,7 @@ CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
# The following example illustrates all of these extensions:
#
# 102.54.94.97 rhino #PRE #DOM:networking #net group's DC
- # 102.54.94.102 "appname \0x14" #special app server
+ # 102.54.94.102 &quot;appname \0x14&quot; #special app server
# 102.54.94.123 popular #PRE #source server
# 102.54.94.117 localsrv #PRE #needed for the include
#
@@ -585,564 +321,107 @@ CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
# #INCLUDE \\rhino\public\lmhosts
# #END_ALTERNATE
#
- # In the above example, the "appname" server contains a special
- # character in its name, the "popular" and "localsrv" server names are
- # preloaded, and the "rhino" server name is specified so it can be used
- # to later #INCLUDE a centrally maintained lmhosts file if the "localsrv"
+ # In the above example, the &quot;appname&quot; server contains a special
+ # character in its name, the &quot;popular&quot; and &quot;localsrv&quot; server names are
+ # preloaded, and the &quot;rhino&quot; server name is specified so it can be used
+ # to later #INCLUDE a centrally maintained lmhosts file if the &quot;localsrv&quot;
# system is unavailable.
#
# Note that the whole file is parsed including comments on each lookup,
# so keeping the number of comments to a minimum will improve performance.
# Therefore it is not advisable to simply add lmhosts file entries onto the
- # end of this file.</PRE
-></P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><H2
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN1484">10.3.3. HOSTS file</H2
-><P
->This file is usually located in MS Windows NT 4.0 or 2000 in
-<TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->C:\WINNT\SYSTEM32\DRIVERS\ETC</TT
-> and contains
+ # end of this file.
+</pre></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2999989"></a>HOSTS file</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+This file is usually located in MS Windows NT 4.0 or 2000 in
+<tt class="filename">C:\WINNT\SYSTEM32\DRIVERS\ETC</tt> and contains
the IP Address and the IP hostname in matched pairs. It can be
used by the name resolution infrastructure in MS Windows, depending
on how the TCP/IP environment is configured. This file is in
-every way the equivalent of the Unix/Linux <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/hosts</TT
-> file.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><H2
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN1489">10.3.4. DNS Lookup</H2
-><P
->This capability is configured in the TCP/IP setup area in the network
+every way the equivalent of the Unix/Linux <tt class="filename">/etc/hosts</tt> file.
+</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id3000021"></a>DNS Lookup</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+This capability is configured in the TCP/IP setup area in the network
configuration facility. If enabled an elaborate name resolution sequence
-is followed the precise nature of which isdependant on what the NetBIOS
+is followed the precise nature of which is dependant on what the NetBIOS
Node Type parameter is configured to. A Node Type of 0 means use
NetBIOS broadcast (over UDP broadcast) is first used if the name
that is the subject of a name lookup is not found in the NetBIOS name
cache. If that fails then DNS, HOSTS and LMHOSTS are checked. If set to
Node Type 8, then a NetBIOS Unicast (over UDP Unicast) is sent to the
WINS Server to obtain a lookup before DNS, HOSTS, LMHOSTS, or broadcast
-lookup is used.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><H2
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN1492">10.3.5. WINS Lookup</H2
-><P
->A WINS (Windows Internet Name Server) service is the equivaent of the
+lookup is used.
+</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id3000046"></a>WINS Lookup</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+A WINS (Windows Internet Name Server) service is the equivaent of the
rfc1001/1002 specified NBNS (NetBIOS Name Server). A WINS server stores
the names and IP addresses that are registered by a Windows client
-if the TCP/IP setup has been given at least one WINS Server IP Address.</P
-><P
->To configure Samba to be a WINS server the following parameter needs
-to be added to the <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->smb.conf</TT
-> file:</P
-><P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
-> wins support = Yes</PRE
-></P
-><P
->To configure Samba to use a WINS server the following parameters are
-needed in the smb.conf file:</P
-><P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
-> wins support = No
- wins server = xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx</PRE
-></P
-><P
->where <TT
-CLASS="REPLACEABLE"
-><I
->xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx</I
-></TT
-> is the IP address
-of the WINS server.</P
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><H1
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN1504">10.4. How browsing functions and how to deploy stable and
-dependable browsing using Samba</H1
-><P
->As stated above, MS Windows machines register their NetBIOS names
-(i.e.: the machine name for each service type in operation) on start
-up. Also, as stated above, the exact method by which this name registration
-takes place is determined by whether or not the MS Windows client/server
-has been given a WINS server address, whether or not LMHOSTS lookup
-is enabled, or if DNS for NetBIOS name resolution is enabled, etc.</P
-><P
->In the case where there is no WINS server all name registrations as
-well as name lookups are done by UDP broadcast. This isolates name
-resolution to the local subnet, unless LMHOSTS is used to list all
-names and IP addresses. In such situations Samba provides a means by
-which the samba server name may be forcibly injected into the browse
-list of a remote MS Windows network (using the "remote announce" parameter).</P
-><P
->Where a WINS server is used, the MS Windows client will use UDP
-unicast to register with the WINS server. Such packets can be routed
-and thus WINS allows name resolution to function across routed networks.</P
-><P
->During the startup process an election will take place to create a
-local master browser if one does not already exist. On each NetBIOS network
-one machine will be elected to function as the domain master browser. This
-domain browsing has nothing to do with MS security domain control.
-Instead, the domain master browser serves the role of contacting each local
-master browser (found by asking WINS or from LMHOSTS) and exchanging browse
-list contents. This way every master browser will eventually obtain a complete
-list of all machines that are on the network. Every 11-15 minutes an election
-is held to determine which machine will be the master browser. By the nature of
-the election criteria used, the machine with the highest uptime, or the
-most senior protocol version, or other criteria, will win the election
-as domain master browser.</P
-><P
->Clients wishing to browse the network make use of this list, but also depend
-on the availability of correct name resolution to the respective IP
-address/addresses. </P
-><P
->Any configuration that breaks name resolution and/or browsing intrinsics
-will annoy users because they will have to put up with protracted
-inability to use the network services.</P
-><P
->Samba supports a feature that allows forced synchonisation
-of browse lists across routed networks using the "remote
-browse sync" parameter in the smb.conf file. This causes Samba
-to contact the local master browser on a remote network and
-to request browse list synchronisation. This effectively bridges
-two networks that are separated by routers. The two remote
-networks may use either broadcast based name resolution or WINS
-based name resolution, but it should be noted that the "remote
-browse sync" parameter provides browse list synchronisation - and
-that is distinct from name to address resolution, in other
-words, for cross subnet browsing to function correctly it is
-essential that a name to address resolution mechanism be provided.
-This mechanism could be via DNS, <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/hosts</TT
->,
-and so on.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><H1
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN1514">10.5. MS Windows security options and how to configure
-Samba for seemless integration</H1
-><P
->MS Windows clients may use encrypted passwords as part of a
-challenege/response authentication model (a.k.a. NTLMv1) or
-alone, or clear text strings for simple password based
-authentication. It should be realized that with the SMB
-protocol the password is passed over the network either
-in plain text or encrypted, but not both in the same
-authentication requets.</P
-><P
->When encrypted passwords are used a password that has been
-entered by the user is encrypted in two ways:</P
-><P
-></P
-><UL
-><LI
-><P
->An MD4 hash of the UNICODE of the password
- string. This is known as the NT hash.
- </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->The password is converted to upper case,
- and then padded or trucated to 14 bytes. This string is
- then appended with 5 bytes of NULL characters and split to
- form two 56 bit DES keys to encrypt a "magic" 8 byte value.
- The resulting 16 bytes for the LanMan hash.
- </P
-></LI
-></UL
-><P
->You should refer to the <A
-HREF="ENCRYPTION.html"
-TARGET="_top"
->Password Encryption</A
-> chapter in this HOWTO collection
-for more details on the inner workings</P
-><P
->MS Windows 95 pre-service pack 1, MS Windows NT versions 3.x
-and version 4.0 pre-service pack 3 will use either mode of
-password authentication. All versions of MS Windows that follow
-these versions no longer support plain text passwords by default.</P
-><P
->MS Windows clients have a habit of dropping network mappings that
-have been idle for 10 minutes or longer. When the user attempts to
-use the mapped drive connection that has been dropped, the client
-re-establishes the connection using
-a cached copy of the password.</P
-><P
->When Microsoft changed the default password mode, they dropped support for
-caching of the plain text password. This means that when the registry
-parameter is changed to re-enable use of plain text passwords it appears to
-work, but when a dropped mapping attempts to revalidate it will fail if
-the remote authentication server does not support encrypted passwords.
-This means that it is definitely not a good idea to re-enable plain text
-password support in such clients.</P
-><P
->The following parameters can be used to work around the
-issue of Windows 9x client upper casing usernames and
-password before transmitting them to the SMB server
-when using clear text authentication.</P
-><P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
-> <A
-HREF="smb.conf.5.html#PASSWORDLEVEL"
-TARGET="_top"
->passsword level</A
-> = <TT
-CLASS="REPLACEABLE"
-><I
->integer</I
-></TT
->
- <A
-HREF="smb.conf.5.html#USERNAMELEVEL"
-TARGET="_top"
->username level</A
-> = <TT
-CLASS="REPLACEABLE"
-><I
->integer</I
-></TT
-></PRE
-></P
-><P
->By default Samba will lower case the username before attempting
-to lookup the user in the database of local system accounts.
-Because UNIX usernames conventionally only contain lower case
-character, the <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->username level</I
-></TT
-> parameter
-is rarely even needed.</P
-><P
->However, password on UNIX systems often make use of mixed case
-characters. This means that in order for a user on a Windows 9x
-client to connect to a Samba server using clear text authentication,
-the <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->password level</I
-></TT
-> must be set to the maximum
-number of upper case letter which <SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->could</I
-></SPAN
-> appear
-is a password. Note that is the server OS uses the traditional
-DES version of crypt(), then a <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->password level</I
-></TT
->
-of 8 will result in case insensitive passwords as seen from Windows
-users. This will also result in longer login times as Samba
-hash to compute the permutations of the password string and
-try them one by one until a match is located (or all combinations fail).</P
-><P
->The best option to adopt is to enable support for encrypted passwords
-where ever Samba is used. There are three configuration possibilities
-for support of encrypted passwords:</P
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><H2
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN1542">10.5.1. Use MS Windows NT as an authentication server</H2
-><P
->This method involves the additions of the following parameters
-in the smb.conf file:</P
-><P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
-> encrypt passwords = Yes
- security = server
- password server = "NetBIOS_name_of_PDC"</PRE
-></P
-><P
->There are two ways of identifying whether or not a username and
-password pair was valid or not. One uses the reply information provided
-as part of the authentication messaging process, the other uses
-just and error code.</P
-><P
->The down-side of this mode of configuration is the fact that
-for security reasons Samba will send the password server a bogus
-username and a bogus password and if the remote server fails to
-reject the username and password pair then an alternative mode
-of identification of validation is used. Where a site uses password
-lock out after a certain number of failed authentication attempts
-this will result in user lockouts.</P
-><P
->Use of this mode of authentication does require there to be
-a standard Unix account for the user, this account can be blocked
-to prevent logons by other than MS Windows clients.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><H2
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN1550">10.5.2. Make Samba a member of an MS Windows NT security domain</H2
-><P
->This method involves additon of the following paramters in the smb.conf file:</P
-><P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
-> encrypt passwords = Yes
- security = domain
- workgroup = "name of NT domain"
- password server = *</PRE
-></P
-><P
->The use of the "*" argument to "password server" will cause samba
-to locate the domain controller in a way analogous to the way
-this is done within MS Windows NT.</P
-><P
->In order for this method to work the Samba server needs to join the
-MS Windows NT security domain. This is done as follows:</P
-><P
-></P
-><UL
-><LI
-><P
->On the MS Windows NT domain controller using
- the Server Manager add a machine account for the Samba server.
- </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->Next, on the Linux system execute:
- <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbpasswd -r PDC_NAME -j DOMAIN_NAME</B
->
- </P
-></LI
-></UL
-><P
->Use of this mode of authentication does require there to be
-a standard Unix account for the user in order to assign
-a uid once the account has been authenticated by the remote
-Windows DC. This account can be blocked to prevent logons by
-other than MS Windows clients by things such as setting an invalid
-shell in the <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/passwd</TT
-> entry.</P
-><P
->An alternative to assigning UIDs to Windows users on a
-Samba member server is presented in the <A
-HREF="winbind.html"
-TARGET="_top"
->Winbind Overview</A
-> chapter in
-this HOWTO collection.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><H2
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN1567">10.5.3. Configure Samba as an authentication server</H2
-><P
->This mode of authentication demands that there be on the
-Unix/Linux system both a Unix style account as well as an
-smbpasswd entry for the user. The Unix system account can be
-locked if required as only the encrypted password will be
-used for SMB client authentication.</P
-><P
->This method involves addition of the following parameters to
-the smb.conf file:</P
-><P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
->## please refer to the Samba PDC HOWTO chapter later in
-## this collection for more details
-[global]
- encrypt passwords = Yes
- security = user
- domain logons = Yes
- ; an OS level of 33 or more is recommended
- os level = 33
+if the TCP/IP setup has been given at least one WINS Server IP Address.
+</p><p>
+To configure Samba to be a WINS server the following parameter needs
+to be added to the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file:
+</p><pre class="screen">
+ wins support = Yes
+</pre><p>
+To configure Samba to use a WINS server the following parameters are
+needed in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file:
+</p><pre class="screen">
+ wins support = No
+ wins server = xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx
+</pre><p>
+where <i class="replaceable"><tt>xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx</tt></i> is the IP address
+of the WINS server.
+</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id3000117"></a>Common Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+TCP/IP network configuration problems find every network administrator sooner or later.
+The cause can be anything from keybaord mishaps, forgetfulness, simple mistakes, and
+carelessness. Of course, noone is every deliberately careless!
+</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id3000133"></a>My Boomerang Won't Come Back</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+ Well, the real complaint said, &quot;I can ping my samba server from Windows, but I can
+ not ping my Windows machine from the samba server.&quot;
+ </p><p>
+ The Windows machine was at IP Address 192.168.1.2 with netmask 255.255.255.0, the
+ Samba server (Linux) was at IP Address 192.168.1.130 with netmast 255.255.255.128.
+ The machines were on a local network with no external connections.
+ </p><p>
+ Due to inconsistent netmasks, the Windows machine was on network 192.168.1.0/24, while
+ the Samba server was on network 192.168.1.128/25 - logically a different network.
+ </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id3000164"></a>Very Slow Network Connections</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+ A common causes of slow network response includes:
+ </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Client is configured to use DNS and DNS server is down</p></li><li><p>Client is configured to use remote DNS server, but remote connection is down</p></li><li><p>Client is configured to use a WINS server, but there is no WINS server</p></li><li><p>Client is NOT configured to use a WINS server, but there is a WINS server</p></li><li><p>Firewall is filtering our DNS or WINS traffic</p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id3000216"></a>Samba server name change problem</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+ The name of the samba server was changed, samba was restarted, samba server can not be
+ pinged by new name from MS Windows NT4 Workstation, but it does still respond to ping using
+ the old name. Why?
+ </p><p>
+ From this description three (3) things are rather obvious:
+ </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>WINS is NOT in use, only broadcast based name resolution is used</p></li><li><p>The samba server was renamed and restarted within the last 10-15 minutes</p></li><li><p>The old samba server name is still in the NetBIOS name cache on the MS Windows NT4 Workstation</p></li></ul></div><p>
+ To find what names are present in the NetBIOS name cache on the MS Windows NT4 machine,
+ open a cmd shell, then:
+ </p><p>
+ </p><pre class="screen">
+ C:\temp\&gt;nbtstat -n
-[NETLOGON]
- path = /somewhare/in/file/system
- read only = yes</PRE
-></P
-><P
->in order for this method to work a Unix system account needs
-to be created for each user, as well as for each MS Windows NT/2000
-machine. The following structure is required.</P
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><H3
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><A
-NAME="AEN1574">10.5.3.1. Users</H3
-><P
->A user account that may provide a home directory should be
-created. The following Linux system commands are typical of
-the procedure for creating an account.</P
-><P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
-> # useradd -s /bin/bash -d /home/"userid" -m "userid"
- # passwd "userid"
- Enter Password: &lt;pw&gt;
-
- # smbpasswd -a "userid"
- Enter Password: &lt;pw&gt;</PRE
-></P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><H3
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><A
-NAME="AEN1579">10.5.3.2. MS Windows NT Machine Accounts</H3
-><P
->These are required only when Samba is used as a domain
-controller. Refer to the Samba-PDC-HOWTO for more details.</P
-><P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
-> # useradd -s /bin/false -d /dev/null "machine_name"\$
- # passwd -l "machine_name"\$
- # smbpasswd -a -m "machine_name"</PRE
-></P
-></DIV
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><H1
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN1584">10.6. Conclusions</H1
-><P
->Samba provides a flexible means to operate as...</P
-><P
-></P
-><UL
-><LI
-><P
->A Stand-alone server - No special action is needed
- other than to create user accounts. Stand-alone servers do NOT
- provide network logon services, meaning that machines that use this
- server do NOT perform a domain logon but instead make use only of
- the MS Windows logon which is local to the MS Windows
- workstation/server.
- </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->An MS Windows NT 3.x/4.0 security domain member.
- </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->An alternative to an MS Windows NT 3.x/4.0
- Domain Controller.
- </P
-></LI
-></UL
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="NAVFOOTER"
-><HR
-ALIGN="LEFT"
-WIDTH="100%"><TABLE
-SUMMARY="Footer navigation table"
-WIDTH="100%"
-BORDER="0"
-CELLPADDING="0"
-CELLSPACING="0"
-><TR
-><TD
-WIDTH="33%"
-ALIGN="left"
-VALIGN="top"
-><A
-HREF="optional.html"
-ACCESSKEY="P"
->Prev</A
-></TD
-><TD
-WIDTH="34%"
-ALIGN="center"
-VALIGN="top"
-><A
-HREF="samba-howto-collection.html"
-ACCESSKEY="H"
->Home</A
-></TD
-><TD
-WIDTH="33%"
-ALIGN="right"
-VALIGN="top"
-><A
-HREF="unix-permissions.html"
-ACCESSKEY="N"
->Next</A
-></TD
-></TR
-><TR
-><TD
-WIDTH="33%"
-ALIGN="left"
-VALIGN="top"
->Optional configuration</TD
-><TD
-WIDTH="34%"
-ALIGN="center"
-VALIGN="top"
-><A
-HREF="optional.html"
-ACCESSKEY="U"
->Up</A
-></TD
-><TD
-WIDTH="33%"
-ALIGN="right"
-VALIGN="top"
->UNIX Permission Bits and Windows NT Access Control Lists</TD
-></TR
-></TABLE
-></DIV
-></BODY
-></HTML
-> \ No newline at end of file
+ NetBIOS Local Name Table
+
+ Name Type Status
+ ------------------------------------------------
+ SLACK &lt;03&gt; UNIQUE Registered
+ ADMININSTRATOR &lt;03&gt; UNIQUE Registered
+ SLACK &lt;00&gt; UNIQUE Registered
+ SARDON &lt;00&gt; GROUP Registered
+ SLACK &lt;20&gt; UNIQUE Registered
+ SLACK &lt;1F&gt; UNIQUE Registered
+
+
+ C:\Temp\&gt;nbtstat -c
+
+ NetBIOS Remote Cache Name Table
+
+ Name Type Host Address Life [sec]
+ --------------------------------------------------------------
+ FRODO &lt;20&gt; UNIQUE 192.168.1.1 240
+
+ C:\Temp\&gt;
+ </pre><p>
+ </p><p>
+ In the above example, FRODO is the Samba server and SLACK is the MS Windows NT4 Workstation.
+ The first listing shows the contents of the Local Name Table (ie: Identity information on
+ the MS Windows workstation), the second shows the NetBIOS name in the NetBIOS name cache.
+ The name cache contains the remote machines known to this workstation.
+ </p></div></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="pam.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="optional.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="unicode.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 25. PAM based Distributed Authentication </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="index.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 27. Unicode/Charsets</td></tr></table></div></body></html>
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/introduction.html b/docs/htmldocs/introduction.html
index 762d56ba6a..b4e1765f2d 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/introduction.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/introduction.html
@@ -1,421 +1,5 @@
-<!DOCTYPE HTML PUBLIC "-//W3C//DTD HTML 4.01 Transitional//EN">
-<HTML
-><HEAD
-><TITLE
->General installation</TITLE
-><META
-NAME="GENERATOR"
-CONTENT="Modular DocBook HTML Stylesheet Version 1.76b+
-"><LINK
-REL="HOME"
-TITLE="SAMBA Project Documentation"
-HREF="samba-howto-collection.html"><LINK
-REL="PREVIOUS"
-TITLE="SAMBA Project Documentation"
-HREF="samba-howto-collection.html"><LINK
-REL="NEXT"
-TITLE="How to Install and Test SAMBA"
-HREF="install.html"></HEAD
-><BODY
-CLASS="PART"
-BGCOLOR="#FFFFFF"
-TEXT="#000000"
-LINK="#0000FF"
-VLINK="#840084"
-ALINK="#0000FF"
-><DIV
-CLASS="NAVHEADER"
-><TABLE
-SUMMARY="Header navigation table"
-WIDTH="100%"
-BORDER="0"
-CELLPADDING="0"
-CELLSPACING="0"
-><TR
-><TH
-COLSPAN="3"
-ALIGN="center"
->SAMBA Project Documentation</TH
-></TR
-><TR
-><TD
-WIDTH="10%"
-ALIGN="left"
-VALIGN="bottom"
-><A
-HREF="samba-howto-collection.html"
-ACCESSKEY="P"
->Prev</A
-></TD
-><TD
-WIDTH="80%"
-ALIGN="center"
-VALIGN="bottom"
-></TD
-><TD
-WIDTH="10%"
-ALIGN="right"
-VALIGN="bottom"
-><A
-HREF="install.html"
-ACCESSKEY="N"
->Next</A
-></TD
-></TR
-></TABLE
-><HR
-ALIGN="LEFT"
-WIDTH="100%"></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="PART"
-><A
-NAME="INTRODUCTION"><DIV
-CLASS="TITLEPAGE"
-><H1
-CLASS="TITLE"
->I. General installation</H1
-><DIV
-CLASS="PARTINTRO"
-><A
-NAME="AEN21"><H1
->Introduction</H1
-><P
->This part contains general info on how to install samba
+<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Part I. General Installation</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="previous" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="next" href="IntroSMB.html" title="Chapter 1. Introduction to Samba"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Part I. General Installation</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="index.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center"> </th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="IntroSMB.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="part" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h1 class="title"><a name="introduction"></a>General Installation</h1></div></div><div></div></div><div class="partintro" lang="en"><div><div><div><h1 class="title"><a name="id2884272"></a>Preparing Samba for Configuration</h1></div></div><div></div></div><p>This section of the Samba-HOWTO-Collection contains general info on how to install samba
and how to configure the parts of samba you will most likely need.
-PLEASE read this.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="TOC"
-><DL
-><DT
-><B
->Table of Contents</B
-></DT
-><DT
->1. <A
-HREF="install.html"
->How to Install and Test SAMBA</A
-></DT
-><DD
-><DL
-><DT
->1.1. <A
-HREF="install.html#AEN26"
->Read the man pages</A
-></DT
-><DT
->1.2. <A
-HREF="install.html#AEN36"
->Building the Binaries</A
-></DT
-><DT
->1.3. <A
-HREF="install.html#AEN64"
->The all important step</A
-></DT
-><DT
->1.4. <A
-HREF="install.html#AEN68"
->Create the smb configuration file.</A
-></DT
-><DT
->1.5. <A
-HREF="install.html#AEN82"
->Test your config file with
- <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->testparm</B
-></A
-></DT
-><DT
->1.6. <A
-HREF="install.html#AEN90"
->Starting the smbd and nmbd</A
-></DT
-><DD
-><DL
-><DT
->1.6.1. <A
-HREF="install.html#AEN100"
->Starting from inetd.conf</A
-></DT
-><DT
->1.6.2. <A
-HREF="install.html#AEN129"
->Alternative: starting it as a daemon</A
-></DT
-></DL
-></DD
-><DT
->1.7. <A
-HREF="install.html#AEN145"
->Try listing the shares available on your
- server</A
-></DT
-><DT
->1.8. <A
-HREF="install.html#AEN154"
->Try connecting with the unix client</A
-></DT
-><DT
->1.9. <A
-HREF="install.html#AEN170"
->Try connecting from a DOS, WfWg, Win9x, WinNT,
- Win2k, OS/2, etc... client</A
-></DT
-><DT
->1.10. <A
-HREF="install.html#AEN184"
->What If Things Don't Work?</A
-></DT
-><DD
-><DL
-><DT
->1.10.1. <A
-HREF="install.html#AEN189"
->Diagnosing Problems</A
-></DT
-><DT
->1.10.2. <A
-HREF="install.html#AEN193"
->Scope IDs</A
-></DT
-><DT
->1.10.3. <A
-HREF="install.html#AEN196"
->Choosing the Protocol Level</A
-></DT
-><DT
->1.10.4. <A
-HREF="install.html#AEN205"
->Printing from UNIX to a Client PC</A
-></DT
-><DT
->1.10.5. <A
-HREF="install.html#AEN210"
->Locking</A
-></DT
-><DT
->1.10.6. <A
-HREF="install.html#AEN219"
->Mapping Usernames</A
-></DT
-></DL
-></DD
-></DL
-></DD
-><DT
->2. <A
-HREF="improved-browsing.html"
->Improved browsing in samba</A
-></DT
-><DD
-><DL
-><DT
->2.1. <A
-HREF="improved-browsing.html#AEN229"
->Overview of browsing</A
-></DT
-><DT
->2.2. <A
-HREF="improved-browsing.html#AEN233"
->Browsing support in samba</A
-></DT
-><DT
->2.3. <A
-HREF="improved-browsing.html#AEN242"
->Problem resolution</A
-></DT
-><DT
->2.4. <A
-HREF="improved-browsing.html#AEN249"
->Browsing across subnets</A
-></DT
-><DD
-><DL
-><DT
->2.4.1. <A
-HREF="improved-browsing.html#AEN254"
->How does cross subnet browsing work ?</A
-></DT
-></DL
-></DD
-><DT
->2.5. <A
-HREF="improved-browsing.html#AEN289"
->Setting up a WINS server</A
-></DT
-><DT
->2.6. <A
-HREF="improved-browsing.html#AEN308"
->Setting up Browsing in a WORKGROUP</A
-></DT
-><DT
->2.7. <A
-HREF="improved-browsing.html#AEN326"
->Setting up Browsing in a DOMAIN</A
-></DT
-><DT
->2.8. <A
-HREF="improved-browsing.html#AEN336"
->Forcing samba to be the master</A
-></DT
-><DT
->2.9. <A
-HREF="improved-browsing.html#AEN345"
->Making samba the domain master</A
-></DT
-><DT
->2.10. <A
-HREF="improved-browsing.html#AEN363"
->Note about broadcast addresses</A
-></DT
-><DT
->2.11. <A
-HREF="improved-browsing.html#AEN366"
->Multiple interfaces</A
-></DT
-></DL
-></DD
-><DT
->3. <A
-HREF="browsing-quick.html"
->Quick Cross Subnet Browsing / Cross Workgroup Browsing guide</A
-></DT
-><DD
-><DL
-><DT
->3.1. <A
-HREF="browsing-quick.html#AEN377"
->Discussion</A
-></DT
-><DT
->3.2. <A
-HREF="browsing-quick.html#AEN385"
->Use of the "Remote Announce" parameter</A
-></DT
-><DT
->3.3. <A
-HREF="browsing-quick.html#AEN399"
->Use of the "Remote Browse Sync" parameter</A
-></DT
-><DT
->3.4. <A
-HREF="browsing-quick.html#AEN404"
->Use of WINS</A
-></DT
-><DT
->3.5. <A
-HREF="browsing-quick.html#AEN415"
->Do NOT use more than one (1) protocol on MS Windows machines</A
-></DT
-><DT
->3.6. <A
-HREF="browsing-quick.html#AEN421"
->Name Resolution Order</A
-></DT
-></DL
-></DD
-><DT
->4. <A
-HREF="pwencrypt.html"
->LanMan and NT Password Encryption in Samba</A
-></DT
-><DD
-><DL
-><DT
->4.1. <A
-HREF="pwencrypt.html#AEN457"
->Introduction</A
-></DT
-><DT
->4.2. <A
-HREF="pwencrypt.html#AEN462"
->Important Notes About Security</A
-></DT
-><DD
-><DL
-><DT
->4.2.1. <A
-HREF="pwencrypt.html#AEN481"
->Advantages of SMB Encryption</A
-></DT
-><DT
->4.2.2. <A
-HREF="pwencrypt.html#AEN488"
->Advantages of non-encrypted passwords</A
-></DT
-></DL
-></DD
-><DT
->4.3. <A
-HREF="pwencrypt.html#AEN497"
->The smbpasswd Command</A
-></DT
-></DL
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="NAVFOOTER"
-><HR
-ALIGN="LEFT"
-WIDTH="100%"><TABLE
-SUMMARY="Footer navigation table"
-WIDTH="100%"
-BORDER="0"
-CELLPADDING="0"
-CELLSPACING="0"
-><TR
-><TD
-WIDTH="33%"
-ALIGN="left"
-VALIGN="top"
-><A
-HREF="samba-howto-collection.html"
-ACCESSKEY="P"
->Prev</A
-></TD
-><TD
-WIDTH="34%"
-ALIGN="center"
-VALIGN="top"
-><A
-HREF="samba-howto-collection.html"
-ACCESSKEY="H"
->Home</A
-></TD
-><TD
-WIDTH="33%"
-ALIGN="right"
-VALIGN="top"
-><A
-HREF="install.html"
-ACCESSKEY="N"
->Next</A
-></TD
-></TR
-><TR
-><TD
-WIDTH="33%"
-ALIGN="left"
-VALIGN="top"
->SAMBA Project Documentation</TD
-><TD
-WIDTH="34%"
-ALIGN="center"
-VALIGN="top"
->&nbsp;</TD
-><TD
-WIDTH="33%"
-ALIGN="right"
-VALIGN="top"
->How to Install and Test SAMBA</TD
-></TR
-></TABLE
-></DIV
-></BODY
-></HTML
-> \ No newline at end of file
+PLEASE read this.</p><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt>1. <a href="IntroSMB.html">Introduction to Samba</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="IntroSMB.html#id2885554">Background</a></dt><dt><a href="IntroSMB.html#id2885765">Terminology</a></dt><dt><a href="IntroSMB.html#id2885920">Related Projects</a></dt><dt><a href="IntroSMB.html#id2885988">SMB Methodology</a></dt><dt><a href="IntroSMB.html#id2886076">Epilogue</a></dt><dt><a href="IntroSMB.html#id2886150">Miscellaneous</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>2. <a href="install.html">How to Install and Test SAMBA</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="install.html#id2886809">Obtaining and installing samba</a></dt><dt><a href="install.html#id2886850">Configuring samba (smb.conf)</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="install.html#id2886887">Example Configuration</a></dt><dt><a href="install.html#id2887037">SWAT</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="install.html#id2887081">Try listing the shares available on your
+ server</a></dt><dt><a href="install.html#id2887132">Try connecting with the unix client</a></dt><dt><a href="install.html#id2887232">Try connecting from a DOS, WfWg, Win9x, WinNT,
+ Win2k, OS/2, etc... client</a></dt><dt><a href="install.html#id2887296">What If Things Don't Work?</a></dt><dt><a href="install.html#id2887329">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="install.html#id2887342">Why are so many smbd processes eating memory?</a></dt><dt><a href="install.html#id2887558">I'm getting &quot;open_oplock_ipc: Failed to get local UDP socket for address 100007f. Error was Cannot assign requested&quot; in the logs</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>3. <a href="FastStart.html">FastStart for the Impatient</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="FastStart.html#id2886685">Note</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="index.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="index.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="IntroSMB.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">SAMBA Project Documentation </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="index.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 1. Introduction to Samba</td></tr></table></div></body></html>
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/lmhosts.5.html b/docs/htmldocs/lmhosts.5.html
index 4d7f11e64b..b96ddf8ddb 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/lmhosts.5.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/lmhosts.5.html
@@ -1,210 +1,37 @@
-<!DOCTYPE HTML PUBLIC "-//W3C//DTD HTML 4.01 Transitional//EN">
-<HTML
-><HEAD
-><TITLE
->lmhosts</TITLE
-><META
-NAME="GENERATOR"
-CONTENT="Modular DocBook HTML Stylesheet Version 1.77"></HEAD
-><BODY
-CLASS="REFENTRY"
-BGCOLOR="#FFFFFF"
-TEXT="#000000"
-LINK="#0000FF"
-VLINK="#840084"
-ALINK="#0000FF"
-><H1
-><A
-NAME="LMHOSTS"
-></A
->lmhosts</H1
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFNAMEDIV"
-><A
-NAME="AEN5"
-></A
-><H2
->Name</H2
->lmhosts&nbsp;--&nbsp;The Samba NetBIOS hosts file</DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSYNOPSISDIV"
-><A
-NAME="AEN8"
-></A
-><H2
->Synopsis</H2
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->lmhosts</TT
-> is the <A
-HREF="samba.7.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-> Samba</A
-> NetBIOS name to IP address mapping file.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN12"
-></A
-><H2
->DESCRIPTION</H2
-><P
->This file is part of the <A
-HREF="samba.7.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-> Samba</A
-> suite.</P
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->lmhosts</TT
-> is the <SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->Samba
- </I
-></SPAN
-> NetBIOS name to IP address mapping file. It
- is very similar to the <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/hosts</TT
-> file
+<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>lmhosts</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="lmhosts.5"></a><div class="titlepage"><div></div><div></div></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>lmhosts &#8212; The Samba NetBIOS hosts file</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><p><tt class="filename">lmhosts</tt> is the <a href="Samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">Samba</span>(7)</span></a> NetBIOS name to IP address mapping file.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This file is part of the <a href="Samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">Samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p><tt class="filename">lmhosts</tt> is the <span class="emphasis"><em>Samba
+ </em></span> NetBIOS name to IP address mapping file. It
+ is very similar to the <tt class="filename">/etc/hosts</tt> file
format, except that the hostname component must correspond
- to the NetBIOS naming format.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN20"
-></A
-><H2
->FILE FORMAT</H2
-><P
->It is an ASCII file containing one line for NetBIOS name.
+ to the NetBIOS naming format.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>FILE FORMAT</h2><p>It is an ASCII file containing one line for NetBIOS name.
The two fields on each line are separated from each other by
white space. Any entry beginning with '#' is ignored. Each line
- in the lmhosts file contains the following information :</P
-><P
-></P
-><UL
-><LI
-><P
->IP Address - in dotted decimal format.</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->NetBIOS Name - This name format is a
+ in the lmhosts file contains the following information:</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>IP Address - in dotted decimal format.</p></li><li><p>NetBIOS Name - This name format is a
maximum fifteen character host name, with an optional
trailing '#' character followed by the NetBIOS name type
- as two hexadecimal digits.</P
-><P
->If the trailing '#' is omitted then the given IP
+ as two hexadecimal digits.</p><p>If the trailing '#' is omitted then the given IP
address will be returned for all names that match the given
- name, whatever the NetBIOS name type in the lookup.</P
-></LI
-></UL
-><P
->An example follows :</P
-><P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
->#
+ name, whatever the NetBIOS name type in the lookup.</p></li></ul></div><p>An example follows:</p><pre class="programlisting">
+#
# Sample Samba lmhosts file.
#
192.9.200.1 TESTPC
192.9.200.20 NTSERVER#20
192.9.200.21 SAMBASERVER
- </PRE
-></P
-><P
->Contains three IP to NetBIOS name mappings. The first
- and third will be returned for any queries for the names "TESTPC"
- and "SAMBASERVER" respectively, whatever the type component of
- the NetBIOS name requested.</P
-><P
->The second mapping will be returned only when the "0x20" name
- type for a name "NTSERVER" is queried. Any other name type will not
- be resolved.</P
-><P
->The default location of the <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->lmhosts</TT
-> file
- is in the same directory as the <A
-HREF="smb.conf.5.html"
-TARGET="_top"
->
- smb.conf(5)&#62;</A
-> file.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN37"
-></A
-><H2
->VERSION</H2
-><P
->This man page is correct for version 2.2 of
- the Samba suite.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN40"
-></A
-><H2
->SEE ALSO</H2
-><P
-><A
-HREF="smbclient.1.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbclient(1)
- </B
-></A
->, <A
-HREF="smb.conf.5.html#NAMERESOLVEORDER"
-TARGET="_top"
-> smb.conf(5)</A
->, and <A
-HREF="smbpasswd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
-> smbpasswd(8)</B
-></A
->
- </P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN48"
-></A
-><H2
->AUTHOR</H2
-><P
->The original Samba software and related utilities
+ </pre><p>Contains three IP to NetBIOS name mappings. The first
+ and third will be returned for any queries for the names &quot;TESTPC&quot;
+ and &quot;SAMBASERVER&quot; respectively, whatever the type component of
+ the NetBIOS name requested.</p><p>The second mapping will be returned only when the &quot;0x20&quot; name
+ type for a name &quot;NTSERVER&quot; is queried. Any other name type will not
+ be resolved.</p><p>The default location of the <tt class="filename">lmhosts</tt> file
+ is in the same directory as the <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> file.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3.0 of the Samba suite.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>SEE ALSO</h2><p><a href="smbclient.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbclient</span>(1)</span></a>, <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a>, and <a href="smbpasswd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbpasswd</span>(8)</span></a>
+ </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
- to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</P
-><P
->The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer.
+ to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</p><p>The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer.
The man page sources were converted to YODL format (another
excellent piece of Open Source software, available at
- <A
-HREF="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/"
-TARGET="_top"
-> ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/</A
->) and updated for the Samba 2.0
+ <a href="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/" target="_top">
+ ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/</a>) and updated for the Samba 2.0
release by Jeremy Allison. The conversion to DocBook for
- Samba 2.2 was done by Gerald Carter</P
-></DIV
-></BODY
-></HTML
-> \ No newline at end of file
+ Samba 2.2 was done by Gerald Carter. The conversion to DocBook
+ XML 4.2 was done by Alexander Bokovoy.</p></div></div></body></html>
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/msdfs.html b/docs/htmldocs/msdfs.html
index f6fe1c7e1d..f8f2a3ea52 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/msdfs.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/msdfs.html
@@ -1,321 +1,62 @@
-<!DOCTYPE HTML PUBLIC "-//W3C//DTD HTML 4.01 Transitional//EN">
-<HTML
-><HEAD
-><TITLE
->Hosting a Microsoft Distributed File System tree on Samba</TITLE
-><META
-NAME="GENERATOR"
-CONTENT="Modular DocBook HTML Stylesheet Version 1.76b+
-"><LINK
-REL="HOME"
-TITLE="SAMBA Project Documentation"
-HREF="samba-howto-collection.html"><LINK
-REL="UP"
-TITLE="Optional configuration"
-HREF="optional.html"><LINK
-REL="PREVIOUS"
-TITLE="Configuring PAM for distributed but centrally
-managed authentication"
-HREF="pam.html"><LINK
-REL="NEXT"
-TITLE="Printing Support"
-HREF="printing.html"></HEAD
-><BODY
-CLASS="CHAPTER"
-BGCOLOR="#FFFFFF"
-TEXT="#000000"
-LINK="#0000FF"
-VLINK="#840084"
-ALINK="#0000FF"
-><DIV
-CLASS="NAVHEADER"
-><TABLE
-SUMMARY="Header navigation table"
-WIDTH="100%"
-BORDER="0"
-CELLPADDING="0"
-CELLSPACING="0"
-><TR
-><TH
-COLSPAN="3"
-ALIGN="center"
->SAMBA Project Documentation</TH
-></TR
-><TR
-><TD
-WIDTH="10%"
-ALIGN="left"
-VALIGN="bottom"
-><A
-HREF="pam.html"
-ACCESSKEY="P"
->Prev</A
-></TD
-><TD
-WIDTH="80%"
-ALIGN="center"
-VALIGN="bottom"
-></TD
-><TD
-WIDTH="10%"
-ALIGN="right"
-VALIGN="bottom"
-><A
-HREF="printing.html"
-ACCESSKEY="N"
->Next</A
-></TD
-></TR
-></TABLE
-><HR
-ALIGN="LEFT"
-WIDTH="100%"></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="CHAPTER"
-><H1
-><A
-NAME="MSDFS">Chapter 13. Hosting a Microsoft Distributed File System tree on Samba</H1
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><H1
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN1859">13.1. Instructions</H1
-><P
->The Distributed File System (or Dfs) provides a means of
- separating the logical view of files and directories that users
- see from the actual physical locations of these resources on the
- network. It allows for higher availability, smoother storage expansion,
- load balancing etc. For more information about Dfs, refer to <A
-HREF="http://www.microsoft.com/NTServer/nts/downloads/winfeatures/NTSDistrFile/AdminGuide.asp"
-TARGET="_top"
-> Microsoft documentation</A
->. </P
-><P
->This document explains how to host a Dfs tree on a Unix
- machine (for Dfs-aware clients to browse) using Samba.</P
-><P
->To enable SMB-based DFS for Samba, configure it with the
- <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->--with-msdfs</I
-></TT
-> option. Once built, a
- Samba server can be made a Dfs server by setting the global
- boolean <A
-HREF="smb.conf.5.html#HOSTMSDFS"
-TARGET="_top"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
-> host msdfs</I
-></TT
-></A
-> parameter in the <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->smb.conf
- </TT
-> file. You designate a share as a Dfs root using the share
- level boolean <A
-HREF="smb.conf.5.html#MSDFSROOT"
-TARGET="_top"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
-> msdfs root</I
-></TT
-></A
-> parameter. A Dfs root directory on
- Samba hosts Dfs links in the form of symbolic links that point
- to other servers. For example, a symbolic link
- <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->junction-&gt;msdfs:storage1\share1</TT
-> in
- the share directory acts as the Dfs junction. When Dfs-aware
- clients attempt to access the junction link, they are redirected
- to the storage location (in this case, \\storage1\share1).</P
-><P
->Dfs trees on Samba work with all Dfs-aware clients ranging
- from Windows 95 to 2000.</P
-><P
->Here's an example of setting up a Dfs tree on a Samba
- server.</P
-><P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
-># The smb.conf file:
+<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 17. Hosting a Microsoft Distributed File System tree on Samba</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="optional.html" title="Part III. Advanced Configuration"><link rel="previous" href="InterdomainTrusts.html" title="Chapter 16. Interdomain Trust Relationships"><link rel="next" href="printing.html" title="Chapter 18. Classical Printing Support"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 17. Hosting a Microsoft Distributed File System tree on Samba</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="InterdomainTrusts.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part III. Advanced Configuration</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="printing.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="msdfs"></a>Chapter 17. Hosting a Microsoft Distributed File System tree on Samba</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Shirish</span> <span class="surname">Kalele</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team &amp; Veritas Software<br></span><div class="address"><p><br>
+ <tt class="email">&lt;<a href="mailto:samba@samba.org">samba@samba.org</a>&gt;</tt><br>
+ </p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">12 Jul 2000</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="msdfs.html#id2932887">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="msdfs.html#id2934539">Common Errors</a></dt></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2932887"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+ The Distributed File System (or DFS) provides a means of separating the logical
+ view of files and directories that users see from the actual physical locations
+ of these resources on the network. It allows for higher availability, smoother
+ storage expansion, load balancing etc.
+ </p><p>
+ For information about DFS, refer to
+ <a href="http://www.microsoft.com/NTServer/nts/downloads/winfeatures/NTSDistrFile/AdminGuide.asp" target="_top">
+ Microsoft documentation at http://www.microsoft.com/NTServer/nts/downloads/winfeatures/NTSDistrFile/AdminGuide.asp</a>.
+ </p><p>
+ This document explains how to host a DFS tree on a Unix machine (for DFS-aware
+ clients to browse) using Samba.
+ </p><p>
+ To enable SMB-based DFS for Samba, configure it with the <i class="parameter"><tt>--with-msdfs</tt></i>
+ option. Once built, a Samba server can be made a DFS server by setting the global
+ boolean <a href="smb.conf.5.html#HOSTMSDFS" target="_top"><i class="parameter"><tt> host msdfs</tt></i></a>
+ parameter in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf </tt> file. You designate a share as a DFS
+ root using the share level boolean <a href="smb.conf.5.html#MSDFSROOT" target="_top"><i class="parameter"><tt>
+ msdfs root</tt></i></a> parameter. A DFS root directory on Samba hosts DFS
+ links in the form of symbolic links that point to other servers. For example, a symbolic link
+ <tt class="filename">junction-&gt;msdfs:storage1\share1</tt> in the share directory acts
+ as the DFS junction. When DFS-aware clients attempt to access the junction link,
+ they are redirected to the storage location (in this case, \\storage1\share1).
+ </p><p>
+ DFS trees on Samba work with all DFS-aware clients ranging from Windows 95 to 200x.
+ </p><p>
+ Here's an example of setting up a DFS tree on a Samba server.
+ </p><pre class="programlisting">
+# The smb.conf file:
[global]
- netbios name = SAMBA
+ netbios name = SMOKEY
host msdfs = yes
[dfs]
path = /export/dfsroot
msdfs root = yes
- </PRE
-></P
-><P
->In the /export/dfsroot directory we set up our dfs links to
- other servers on the network.</P
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="PROMPT"
->root# </TT
-><TT
-CLASS="USERINPUT"
-><B
->cd /export/dfsroot</B
-></TT
-></P
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="PROMPT"
->root# </TT
-><TT
-CLASS="USERINPUT"
-><B
->chown root /export/dfsroot</B
-></TT
-></P
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="PROMPT"
->root# </TT
-><TT
-CLASS="USERINPUT"
-><B
->chmod 755 /export/dfsroot</B
-></TT
-></P
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="PROMPT"
->root# </TT
-><TT
-CLASS="USERINPUT"
-><B
->ln -s msdfs:storageA\\shareA linka</B
-></TT
-></P
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="PROMPT"
->root# </TT
-><TT
-CLASS="USERINPUT"
-><B
->ln -s msdfs:serverB\\share,serverC\\share linkb</B
-></TT
-></P
-><P
->You should set up the permissions and ownership of
- the directory acting as the Dfs root such that only designated
+ </pre><p>In the /export/dfsroot directory we set up our dfs links to
+ other servers on the network.</p><pre class="screen">
+ <tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>cd /export/dfsroot</tt></b>
+ <tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>chown root /export/dfsroot</tt></b>
+ <tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>chmod 755 /export/dfsroot</tt></b>
+ <tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>ln -s msdfs:storageA\\shareA linka</tt></b>
+ <tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>ln -s msdfs:serverB\\share,serverC\\share linkb</tt></b>
+ </pre><p>You should set up the permissions and ownership of
+ the directory acting as the DFS root such that only designated
users can create, delete or modify the msdfs links. Also note
that symlink names should be all lowercase. This limitation exists
to have Samba avoid trying all the case combinations to get at
the link name. Finally set up the symbolic links to point to the
- network shares you want, and start Samba.</P
-><P
->Users on Dfs-aware clients can now browse the Dfs tree
+ network shares you want, and start Samba.</p><p>Users on DFS-aware clients can now browse the DFS tree
on the Samba server at \\samba\dfs. Accessing
links linka or linkb (which appear as directories to the client)
- takes users directly to the appropriate shares on the network.</P
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><H2
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN1894">13.1.1. Notes</H2
-><P
-></P
-><UL
-><LI
-><P
->Windows clients need to be rebooted
- if a previously mounted non-dfs share is made a dfs
- root or vice versa. A better way is to introduce a
- new share and make it the dfs root.</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->Currently there's a restriction that msdfs
- symlink names should all be lowercase.</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->For security purposes, the directory
- acting as the root of the Dfs tree should have ownership
- and permissions set so that only designated users can
- modify the symbolic links in the directory.</P
-></LI
-></UL
-></DIV
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="NAVFOOTER"
-><HR
-ALIGN="LEFT"
-WIDTH="100%"><TABLE
-SUMMARY="Footer navigation table"
-WIDTH="100%"
-BORDER="0"
-CELLPADDING="0"
-CELLSPACING="0"
-><TR
-><TD
-WIDTH="33%"
-ALIGN="left"
-VALIGN="top"
-><A
-HREF="pam.html"
-ACCESSKEY="P"
->Prev</A
-></TD
-><TD
-WIDTH="34%"
-ALIGN="center"
-VALIGN="top"
-><A
-HREF="samba-howto-collection.html"
-ACCESSKEY="H"
->Home</A
-></TD
-><TD
-WIDTH="33%"
-ALIGN="right"
-VALIGN="top"
-><A
-HREF="printing.html"
-ACCESSKEY="N"
->Next</A
-></TD
-></TR
-><TR
-><TD
-WIDTH="33%"
-ALIGN="left"
-VALIGN="top"
->Configuring PAM for distributed but centrally
-managed authentication</TD
-><TD
-WIDTH="34%"
-ALIGN="center"
-VALIGN="top"
-><A
-HREF="optional.html"
-ACCESSKEY="U"
->Up</A
-></TD
-><TD
-WIDTH="33%"
-ALIGN="right"
-VALIGN="top"
->Printing Support</TD
-></TR
-></TABLE
-></DIV
-></BODY
-></HTML
-> \ No newline at end of file
+ takes users directly to the appropriate shares on the network.</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2934539"></a>Common Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Windows clients need to be rebooted
+ if a previously mounted non-dfs share is made a dfs
+ root or vice versa. A better way is to introduce a
+ new share and make it the dfs root.</p></li><li><p>Currently there's a restriction that msdfs
+ symlink names should all be lowercase.</p></li><li><p>For security purposes, the directory
+ acting as the root of the DFS tree should have ownership
+ and permissions set so that only designated users can
+ modify the symbolic links in the directory.</p></li></ul></div></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="InterdomainTrusts.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="optional.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="printing.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 16. Interdomain Trust Relationships </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="index.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 18. Classical Printing Support</td></tr></table></div></body></html>
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/net.8.html b/docs/htmldocs/net.8.html
index b7ed1357c3..13e4be81be 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/net.8.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/net.8.html
@@ -1,403 +1,146 @@
-<!DOCTYPE HTML PUBLIC "-//W3C//DTD HTML 4.01 Transitional//EN">
-<HTML
-><HEAD
-><TITLE
->net</TITLE
-><META
-NAME="GENERATOR"
-CONTENT="Modular DocBook HTML Stylesheet Version 1.77"></HEAD
-><BODY
-CLASS="REFENTRY"
-BGCOLOR="#FFFFFF"
-TEXT="#000000"
-LINK="#0000FF"
-VLINK="#840084"
-ALINK="#0000FF"
-><H1
-><A
-NAME="NET"
-></A
->net</H1
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFNAMEDIV"
-><A
-NAME="AEN5"
-></A
-><H2
->Name</H2
->net&nbsp;--&nbsp;Tool for administration of Samba and remote
- CIFS servers.</DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSYNOPSISDIV"
-><A
-NAME="AEN8"
-></A
-><H2
->Synopsis</H2
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->net</B
-> {&lt;ads|rap|rpc&gt;} [-h] [-w workgroup] [-W myworkgroup] [-U user] [-I ip-address] [-p port] [-n myname] [-s conffile] [-S server] [-C comment] [-M maxusers] [-F flags] [-j jobid] [-l] [-r] [-f] [-t timeout] [-P] [-D debuglevel]</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN31"
-></A
-><H2
->DESCRIPTION</H2
-><P
->This tool is part of the <A
-HREF="samba.7.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-> Samba</A
-> suite.</P
-><P
->The samba net utility is meant to work just like the net utility
- available for windows and DOS.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN36"
-></A
-><H2
->OPTIONS</H2
-><P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
->-h</DT
-><DD
-><P
-> Display summary of all available options.
-
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-w target-workgroup</DT
-><DD
-><P
-> Sets target workgroup or domain. You have to specify either this option or the IP address or the name of a server.
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-W workgroup</DT
-><DD
-><P
-> Sets client workgroup or domain
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-U user</DT
-><DD
-><P
-> User name to use
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-I ip-address</DT
-><DD
-><P
-> IP address of target server to use. You have to specify either this option or a target workgroup or a target server.
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-p port</DT
-><DD
-><P
-> Port on the target server to connect to.
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-n myname</DT
-><DD
-><P
-> Sets name of the client.
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-s conffile</DT
-><DD
-><P
-> Specify alternative configuration file that should be loaded.
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-S server</DT
-><DD
-><P
-> Name of target server. You should specify either this option or a target workgroup or a target IP address.
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-C comment</DT
-><DD
-><P
-> FIXME
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-M maxusers</DT
-><DD
-><P
-> FIXME
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-F flags</DT
-><DD
-><P
-> FIXME
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-j jobid</DT
-><DD
-><P
-> FIXME
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-l</DT
-><DD
-><P
-> FIXME
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-r</DT
-><DD
-><P
-> FIXME
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-f</DT
-><DD
-><P
-> FIXME
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-t timeout</DT
-><DD
-><P
-> FIXME
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-P</DT
-><DD
-><P
-> Make queries to the external server using the machine account of the local server.
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-D debuglevel</DT
-><DD
-><P
->set the debuglevel. Debug level 0 is the lowest
- and 100 being the highest. This should be set to 100 if you are
- planning on submitting a bug report to the Samba team (see
- <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->BUGS.txt</TT
->).
- </P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN116"
-></A
-><H2
->TIME</H2
-><P
->The <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->NET TIME</B
-> command allows you to view the time on a remote server
- or synchronise the time on the local server with the time on the remote server.</P
-><P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
-></DT
-><DD
-><P
-> Without any options, the <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->NET TIME</B
-> command
- displays the time on the remote server.
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
->SYSTEM</DT
-><DD
-><P
-> Displays the time on the remote server in a format ready for /bin/date
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
->SET</DT
-><DD
-><P
-> Tries to set the date and time of the local server to that on
- the remote server using /bin/date.
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
->ZONE</DT
-><DD
-><P
-> Displays the timezone in hours from GMT on the remote computer.
- </P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN138"
-></A
-><H2
->RPC</H2
-><P
->The <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->NET RPC</B
-> command allows you to do various
- NT4 operations.</P
-><P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
->JOIN -U username[%password] [options]</DT
-><DD
-><P
-> Join a domain with specified username and password. Password
- will be prompted if none is specified.</P
-></DD
-><DT
->JOIN [options except -U]</DT
-><DD
-><P
-> to join a domain created in server manager
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
->USER [misc. options] [targets]</DT
-><DD
-><P
-> List users
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
->USER DELETE &lt;name&gt; [misc options]</DT
-><DD
-><P
-> delete specified user
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
->USER INFO &lt;name&gt; [misc options]</DT
-><DD
-><P
-> list the domain groups of the specified user
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
->USER ADD &lt;name&gt; [password] [-F user flags] [misc. options</DT
-><DD
-><P
-> Add specified user
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
->GROUP [misc options] [targets]</DT
-><DD
-><P
-> List user groups
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
->GROUP DELETE &lt;name&gt; [misc. options] [targets]</DT
-><DD
-><P
-> Delete specified group
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
->GROUP ADD &lt;name&gt; [-C comment]</DT
-><DD
-><P
-> Create specified group
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
->SHARE [misc. options] [targets]</DT
-><DD
-><P
-> enumerates all exported resources (network shares) on target server
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
->SHARE ADD &lt;name=serverpath&gt; [misc. options] [targets]</DT
-><DD
-><P
-> Adds a share from a server (makes the export active)
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
->SHARE DELETE &lt;sharenam</DT
-><DD
-><P
-></P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN191"
-></A
-><H2
->VERSION</H2
-><P
->This man page is incomplete for version 3.0 of the Samba
- suite.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN194"
-></A
-><H2
->AUTHOR</H2
-><P
->The original Samba software and related utilities
+<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>net</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="net.8"></a><div class="titlepage"><div></div><div></div></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>net &#8212; Tool for administration of Samba and remote
+ CIFS servers.
+ </p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><tt class="command">net</tt> {&lt;ads|rap|rpc&gt;} [-h] [-w workgroup] [-W myworkgroup] [-U user] [-I ip-address] [-p port] [-n myname] [-s conffile] [-S server] [-l] [-P] [-D debuglevel]</p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This tool is part of the <a href="Samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">Samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p>The samba net utility is meant to work just like the net utility
+ available for windows and DOS. The first argument should be used
+ to specify the protocol to use when executing a certain command.
+ ADS is used for ActiveDirectory, RAP is using for old (Win9x/NT3)
+ clients and RPC can be used for NT4 and Windows 2000. If this
+ argument is omitted, net will try to determine it automatically.
+ Not all commands are available on all protocols.
+ </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">-h|--help</span></dt><dd><p>Print a summary of command line options.
+</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-w target-workgroup</span></dt><dd><p>
+ Sets target workgroup or domain. You have to specify
+ either this option or the IP address or the name of a server.
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-W workgroup</span></dt><dd><p>
+ Sets client workgroup or domain
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-U user</span></dt><dd><p>
+ User name to use
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-I ip-address</span></dt><dd><p>
+ IP address of target server to use. You have to
+ specify either this option or a target workgroup or
+ a target server.
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-p port</span></dt><dd><p>
+ Port on the target server to connect to (usually 139 or 445).
+ Defaults to trying 445 first, then 139.
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-n &lt;primary NetBIOS name&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>This option allows you to override
+the NetBIOS name that Samba uses for itself. This is identical
+to setting the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#netbiosname" target="_top"><i class="parameter"><tt>NetBIOS
+name</tt></i></a> parameter in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> file. However, a command
+line setting will take precedence over settings in
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a>.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-s &lt;configuration file&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>The file specified contains the
+configuration details required by the server. The
+information in this file includes server-specific
+information such as what printcap file to use, as well
+as descriptions of all the services that the server is
+to provide. See <a href="smb.conf.5.html" target="_top"><tt class="filename">
+smb.conf(5)</tt></a> for more information.
+The default configuration file name is determined at
+compile time.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-S server</span></dt><dd><p>
+ Name of target server. You should specify either
+ this option or a target workgroup or a target IP address.
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-l</span></dt><dd><p>
+ When listing data, give more information on each item.
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-P</span></dt><dd><p>
+ Make queries to the external server using the machine account of the local server.
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-d|--debug=debuglevel</span></dt><dd><p><i class="replaceable"><tt>debuglevel</tt></i> is an integer
+from 0 to 10. The default value if this parameter is
+not specified is zero.</p><p>The higher this value, the more detail will be
+logged to the log files about the activities of the
+server. At level 0, only critical errors and serious
+warnings will be logged. Level 1 is a reasonable level for
+day to day running - it generates a small amount of
+information about operations carried out.</p><p>Levels above 1 will generate considerable
+amounts of log data, and should only be used when
+investigating a problem. Levels above 3 are designed for
+use only by developers and generate HUGE amounts of log
+data, most of which is extremely cryptic.</p><p>Note that specifying this parameter here will
+override the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#loglevel" target="_top">log
+level</a> parameter in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html" target="_top">
+<tt class="filename">smb.conf(5)</tt></a> file.</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>COMMANDS</h2><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><h3>TIME</h3><p>The <b class="command">NET TIME</b> command allows you to view the time on a remote server
+ or synchronise the time on the local server with the time on the remote server.</p><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><h4>TIME</h4><p>Without any options, the <b class="command">NET TIME</b> command
+displays the time on the remote server.
+</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><h4>TIME SYSTEM</h4><p> Displays the time on the remote server in a format ready for <b class="command">/bin/date</b></p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><h4>TIME SET</h4><p>Tries to set the date and time of the local server to that on
+the remote server using <b class="command">/bin/date</b>. </p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><h4>TIME ZONE</h4><p>Displays the timezone in hours from GMT on the remote computer.</p></div></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><h3>[RPC|ADS] JOIN [TYPE] [-U username[%password]] [options]</h3><p>
+Join a domain. If the account already exists on the server, and
+[TYPE] is MEMBER, the machine will attempt to join automatically.
+(Assuming that the machine has been created in server manager)
+Otherwise, a password will be prompted for, and a new account may
+be created.</p><p>
+[TYPE] may be PDC, BDC or MEMBER to specify the type of server
+joining the domain.
+</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><h3>[RPC] OLDJOIN [options]</h3><p>Join a domain. Use the OLDJOIN option to join the domain
+using the old style of domain joining - you need to create a trust
+account in server manager first.</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><h3>[RPC|ADS] USER</h3><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><h4>[RPC|ADS] USER DELETE <i class="replaceable"><tt>target</tt></i></h4><p>Delete specified user</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><h4>[RPC|ADS] USER LIST</h4><p>List all users</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><h4>[RPC|ADS] USER INFO <i class="replaceable"><tt>target</tt></i></h4><p>List the domain groups of a the specified user.</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><h4>[RPC|ADS] USER ADD <i class="replaceable"><tt>name</tt></i> [password] [-F user flags] [-C comment]</h4><p>Add specified user.</p></div></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><h3>[RPC|ADS] GROUP</h3><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><h4>[RPC|ADS] GROUP [misc options] [targets]</h4><p>List user groups.</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><h4>[RPC|ADS] GROUP DELETE <i class="replaceable"><tt>name</tt></i> [misc. options]</h4><p>Delete specified group.</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><h4>[RPC|ADS] GROUP ADD <i class="replaceable"><tt>name</tt></i> [-C comment]</h4><p>Create specified group.</p></div></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><h3>[RAP|RPC] SHARE</h3><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><h4>[RAP|RPC] SHARE [misc. options] [targets]</h4><p>Enumerates all exported resources (network shares) on target server.</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><h4>[RAP|RPC] SHARE ADD <i class="replaceable"><tt>name=serverpath</tt></i> [-C comment] [-M maxusers] [targets]</h4><p>Adds a share from a server (makes the export active). Maxusers
+specifies the number of users that can be connected to the
+share simultaneously.</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><h4>SHARE DELETE <i class="replaceable"><tt>sharenam</tt></i></h4><p>Delete specified share.</p></div></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><h3>[RPC|RAP] FILE</h3><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><h4>[RPC|RAP] FILE</h4><p>List all open files on remote server.</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><h4>[RPC|RAP] FILE CLOSE <i class="replaceable"><tt>fileid</tt></i></h4><p>Close file with specified <i class="replaceable"><tt>fileid</tt></i> on
+remote server.</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><h4>[RPC|RAP] FILE INFO <i class="replaceable"><tt>fileid</tt></i></h4><p>
+Print information on specified <i class="replaceable"><tt>fileid</tt></i>.
+Currently listed are: file-id, username, locks, path, permissions.
+</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><h4>[RAP|RPC] FILE USER</h4><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p>Currently NOT implemented.</p></div></div></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><h3>SESSION</h3><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><h4>RAP SESSION</h4><p>Without any other options, SESSION enumerates all active SMB/CIFS
+sessions on the target server.</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><h4>RAP SESSION DELETE|CLOSE <i class="replaceable"><tt>CLIENT_NAME</tt></i></h4><p>Close the specified sessions.</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><h4>RAP SESSION INFO <i class="replaceable"><tt>CLIENT_NAME</tt></i></h4><p>Give a list with all the open files in specified session.</p></div></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><h3>RAP SERVER <i class="replaceable"><tt>DOMAIN</tt></i></h3><p>List all servers in specified domain or workgroup. Defaults
+to local domain.</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><h3>RAP DOMAIN</h3><p>Lists all domains and workgroups visible on the
+current network.</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><h3>RAP PRINTQ</h3><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><h4>RAP PRINTQ LIST <i class="replaceable"><tt>QUEUE_NAME</tt></i></h4><p>Lists the specified print queue and print jobs on the server.
+If the <i class="replaceable"><tt>QUEUE_NAME</tt></i> is omitted, all
+queues are listed.</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><h4>RAP PRINTQ DELETE <i class="replaceable"><tt>JOBID</tt></i></h4><p>Delete job with specified id.</p></div></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><h3>RAP VALIDATE <i class="replaceable"><tt>user</tt></i> [<i class="replaceable"><tt>password</tt></i>]</h3><p>
+Validate whether the specified user can log in to the
+remote server. If the password is not specified on the commandline, it
+will be prompted.
+</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p>Currently NOT implemented.</p></div></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><h3>RAP GROUPMEMBER</h3><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><h4>RAP GROUPMEMBER LIST <i class="replaceable"><tt>GROUP</tt></i></h4><p>List all members of the specified group.</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><h4>RAP GROUPMEMBER DELETE <i class="replaceable"><tt>GROUP</tt></i> <i class="replaceable"><tt>USER</tt></i></h4><p>Delete member from group.</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><h4>RAP GROUPMEMBER ADD <i class="replaceable"><tt>GROUP</tt></i> <i class="replaceable"><tt>USER</tt></i></h4><p>Add member to group.</p></div></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><h3>RAP ADMIN <i class="replaceable"><tt>command</tt></i></h3><p>Execute the specified <i class="replaceable"><tt>command</tt></i> on
+the remote server. Only works with OS/2 servers.
+</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p>Currently NOT implemented.</p></div></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><h3>RAP SERVICE</h3><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><h4>RAP SERVICE START <i class="replaceable"><tt>NAME</tt></i> [arguments...]</h4><p>Start the specified service on the remote server. Not implemented yet.</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p>Currently NOT implemented.</p></div></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><h4>RAP SERVICE STOP</h4><p>Stop the specified service on the remote server.</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p>Currently NOT implemented.</p></div></div></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><h3>RAP PASSWORD <i class="replaceable"><tt>USER</tt></i> <i class="replaceable"><tt>OLDPASS</tt></i> <i class="replaceable"><tt>NEWPASS</tt></i></h3><p>
+Change password of <i class="replaceable"><tt>USER</tt></i> from <i class="replaceable"><tt>OLDPASS</tt></i> to <i class="replaceable"><tt>NEWPASS</tt></i>.
+</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><h3>LOOKUP</h3><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><h4>LOOKUP HOST <i class="replaceable"><tt>HOSTNAME</tt></i> [<i class="replaceable"><tt>TYPE</tt></i>]</h4><p>
+Lookup the IP address of the given host with the specified type (netbios suffix).
+The type defaults to 0x20 (workstation).
+</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><h4>LOOKUP LDAP [<i class="replaceable"><tt>DOMAIN</tt></i></h4><p>Give IP address of LDAP server of specified <i class="replaceable"><tt>DOMAIN</tt></i>. Defaults to local domain.</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><h4>LOOKUP KDC [<i class="replaceable"><tt>REALM</tt></i>]</h4><p>Give IP address of KDC for the specified <i class="replaceable"><tt>REALM</tt></i>.
+Defaults to local realm.</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><h4>LOOKUP DC [<i class="replaceable"><tt>DOMAIN</tt></i>]</h4><p>Give IP's of Domain Controllers for specified <i class="replaceable"><tt>
+DOMAIN</tt></i>. Defaults to local domain.</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><h4>LOOKUP MASTER <i class="replaceable"><tt>DOMAIN</tt></i></h4><p>Give IP of master browser for specified <i class="replaceable"><tt>DOMAIN</tt></i>
+or workgroup. Defaults to local domain.</p></div></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><h3>CACHE</h3><p>Samba uses a general caching interface called 'gencache'. It
+can be controlled using 'NET CACHE'.</p><p>All the timeout parameters support the suffixes:
+
+</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td>s - Seconds</td></tr><tr><td>m - Minutes</td></tr><tr><td>h - Hours</td></tr><tr><td>d - Days</td></tr><tr><td>w - Weeks</td></tr></table><p>
+
+</p><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><h4>CACHE ADD <i class="replaceable"><tt>key</tt></i> <i class="replaceable"><tt>data</tt></i> <i class="replaceable"><tt>time-out</tt></i></h4><p>Add specified key+data to the cache with the given timeout.</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><h4>CACHE DEL <i class="replaceable"><tt>key</tt></i></h4><p>Delete key from the cache.</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><h4>CACHE SET <i class="replaceable"><tt>key</tt></i> <i class="replaceable"><tt>data</tt></i> <i class="replaceable"><tt>time-out</tt></i></h4><p>Update data of existing cache entry.</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><h4>CACHE SEARCH <i class="replaceable"><tt>PATTERN</tt></i></h4><p>Search for the specified pattern in the cache data.</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><h4>CACHE LIST</h4><p>
+List all current items in the cache.
+</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><h4>CACHE FLUSH</h4><p>Remove all the current items from the cache.</p></div></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><h3>GETLOCALSID [DOMAIN]</h3><p>Print the SID of the specified domain, or if the parameter is
+omitted, the SID of the domain the local server is in.</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><h3>SETLOCALSID S-1-5-21-x-y-z</h3><p>Sets domain sid for the local server to the specified SID.</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><h3>GROUPMAP</h3><p>Manage the mappings between Windows group SIDs and UNIX groups.
+Parameters take the for &quot;parameter=value&quot;. Common options include:</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>unixgroup - Name of the UNIX group</p></li><li><p>ntgroup - Name of the Windows NT group (must be
+ resolvable to a SID</p></li><li><p>rid - Unsigned 32-bit integer</p></li><li><p>sid - Full SID in the form of &quot;S-1-...&quot;</p></li><li><p>type - Type of the group; either 'domain', 'local',
+ or 'builtin'</p></li><li><p>comment - Freeform text description of the group</p></li></ul></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><h4>GROUPMAP ADD</h4><p>Add a new group mapping entry</p><p>net groupmap add {rid=int|sid=string} unixgroup=string [type={domain|local|builtin}] [ntgroup=string] [comment=string]</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><h4>GROUPMAP DELETE</h4><p>Delete a group mapping entry</p><p>net groupmap delete {ntgroup=string|sid=SID}</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><h4>GROUPMAP MODIFY</h4><p>Update en existing group entry</p><p>net groupmap modify {ntgroup=string|sid=SID} [unixgroup=string] [comment=string] [type={domain|local}</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><h4>GROUPMAP LIST</h4><p>List existing group mapping entries</p><p>net groupmap list [verbose] [ntgroup=string] [sid=SID]</p></div></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><h3>MAXRID</h3><p>Prints out the highest RID currently in use on the local
+server (by the active 'passdb backend').
+</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><h3>RPC INFO</h3><p>Print information about the domain of the remote server,
+such as domain name, domain sid and number of users and groups.
+</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><h3>[RPC|ADS] TESTJOIN</h3><p>Check whether participation in a domain is still valid.</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><h3>[RPC|ADS] CHANGETRUSTPW</h3><p>Force change of domain trust password.</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><h3>RPC TRUSTDOM</h3><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><h4>RPC TRUSTDOM ADD <i class="replaceable"><tt>DOMAIN</tt></i></h4><p>Add a interdomain trust account for
+<i class="replaceable"><tt>DOMAIN</tt></i> to the remote server.
+</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><h4>RPC TRUSTDOM DEL <i class="replaceable"><tt>DOMAIM</tt></i></h4><p>Remove interdomain trust account for
+<i class="replaceable"><tt>DOMAIN</tt></i> from the remote server.
+</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p>Currently NOT implemented.</p></div></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><h4>RPC TRUSTDOM ESTABLISH <i class="replaceable"><tt>DOMAIN</tt></i></h4><p>
+Establish a trust relationship to a trusting domain.
+Interdomain account must already be created on the remote PDC.
+</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><h4>RPC TRUSTDOM REVOKE <i class="replaceable"><tt>DOMAIN</tt></i></h4><p>Abandon relationship to trusted domain</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><h4>RPC TRUSTDOM LIST</h4><p>List all current interdomain trust relationships.</p></div></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><h3>RPC ABORTSHUTDOWN</h3><p>Abort the shutdown of a remote server.</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><h3>SHUTDOWN [-t timeout] [-r] [-f] [-C message]</h3><p>Shut down the remote server.</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">-r</span></dt><dd><p>
+Reboot after shutdown.
+</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-f</span></dt><dd><p>
+Force shutting down all applications.
+</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-t timeout</span></dt><dd><p>
+Timeout before system will be shut down. An interactive
+user of the system can use this time to cancel the shutdown.
+</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-C message</span></dt><dd><p>Display the specified message on the screen to
+announce the shutdown.</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><h3>SAMDUMP</h3><p>Print out sam database of remote server. You need
+to run this on either a BDC. </p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><h3>VAMPIRE</h3><p>Export users, aliases and groups from remote server to
+local server. Can only be run an a BDC.
+</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><h3>GETSID</h3><p>Fetch domain SID and store it in the local <tt class="filename">secrets.tdb</tt>. </p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><h3>ADS LEAVE</h3><p>Make the remote host leave the domain it is part of. </p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><h3>ADS STATUS</h3><p>Print out status of machine account of the local machine in ADS.
+Prints out quite some debug info. Aimed at developers, regular
+users should use <b class="command">NET ADS TESTJOIN</b>.</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><h3>ADS PRINTER</h3><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><h4>ADS PRINTER INFO [<i class="replaceable"><tt>PRINTER</tt></i>] [<i class="replaceable"><tt>SERVER</tt></i>]</h4><p>
+Lookup info for <i class="replaceable"><tt>PRINTER</tt></i> on <i class="replaceable"><tt>SERVER</tt></i>. The printer name defaults to &quot;*&quot;, the
+server name defaults to the local host.</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><h4>ADS PRINTER PUBLISH <i class="replaceable"><tt>PRINTER</tt></i></h4><p>Publish specified printer using ADS.</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><h4>ADS PRINTER REMOVE <i class="replaceable"><tt>PRINTER</tt></i></h4><p>Remove specified printer from ADS directory.</p></div></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><h3>ADS SEARCH <i class="replaceable"><tt>EXPRESSION</tt></i> <i class="replaceable"><tt>ATTRIBUTES...</tt></i></h3><p>Perform a raw LDAP search on a ADS server and dump the results. The
+expression is a standard LDAP search expression, and the
+attributes are a list of LDAP fields to show in the results.</p><p>Example: <b class="userinput"><tt>net ads search '(objectCategory=group)' sAMAccountName</tt></b>
+</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><h3>ADS DN <i class="replaceable"><tt>DN</tt></i> <i class="replaceable"><tt>(attributes)</tt></i></h3><p>
+Perform a raw LDAP search on a ADS server and dump the results. The
+DN standard LDAP DN, and the attributes are a list of LDAP fields
+to show in the result.
+</p><p>Example: <b class="userinput"><tt>net ads dn 'CN=administrator,CN=Users,DC=my,DC=domain' SAMAccountName</tt></b></p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><h3>WORKGROUP</h3><p>Print out workgroup name for specified kerberos realm.</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><h3>HELP [COMMAND]</h3><p>Gives usage information for the specified command.</p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is complete for version 3.0 of the Samba
+ suite.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
- to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</P
-><P
->The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer.
- The current set of manpages and documentation is maintained
- by the Samba Team in the same fashion as the Samba source code.</P
-></DIV
-></BODY
-></HTML
-> \ No newline at end of file
+ to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</p><p>The net manpage was written by Jelmer Vernooij.</p></div></div></body></html>
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/nmbd.8.html b/docs/htmldocs/nmbd.8.html
index 1183a14522..c282bde89d 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/nmbd.8.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/nmbd.8.html
@@ -1,754 +1,153 @@
-<!DOCTYPE HTML PUBLIC "-//W3C//DTD HTML 4.01//EN">
-<HTML
-><HEAD
-><TITLE
->nmbd</TITLE
-><META
-NAME="GENERATOR"
-CONTENT="Modular DocBook HTML Stylesheet Version 1.76b+
-"></HEAD
-><BODY
-CLASS="REFENTRY"
-BGCOLOR="#FFFFFF"
-TEXT="#000000"
-LINK="#0000FF"
-VLINK="#840084"
-ALINK="#0000FF"
-><H1
-><A
-NAME="NMBD">nmbd</H1
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFNAMEDIV"
-><A
-NAME="AEN5"
-></A
-><H2
->Name</H2
->nmbd&nbsp;--&nbsp;NetBIOS name server to provide NetBIOS
- over IP naming services to clients</DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSYNOPSISDIV"
-><A
-NAME="AEN8"><H2
->Synopsis</H2
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->nmbd</B
-> [-D] [-F] [-S] [-a] [-i] [-o] [-h] [-V] [-d &#60;debug level&#62;] [-H &#60;lmhosts file&#62;] [-l &#60;log directory&#62;] [-n &#60;primary netbios name&#62;] [-p &#60;port number&#62;] [-s &#60;configuration file&#62;]</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN25"
-></A
-><H2
->DESCRIPTION</H2
-><P
->This program is part of the Samba suite.</P
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->nmbd</B
-> is a server that understands
+<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>nmbd</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="nmbd.8"></a><div class="titlepage"><div></div><div></div></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>nmbd &#8212; NetBIOS name server to provide NetBIOS
+ over IP naming services to clients</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><tt class="command">nmbd</tt> [-D] [-F] [-S] [-a] [-i] [-o] [-h] [-V] [-d &lt;debug level&gt;] [-H &lt;lmhosts file&gt;] [-l &lt;log directory&gt;] [-n &lt;primary netbios name&gt;] [-p &lt;port number&gt;] [-s &lt;configuration file&gt;]</p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This program is part of the <a href="Samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">Samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p><b class="command">nmbd</b> is a server that understands
and can reply to NetBIOS over IP name service requests, like
those produced by SMB/CIFS clients such as Windows 95/98/ME,
Windows NT, Windows 2000, Windows XP and LanManager clients. It also
participates in the browsing protocols which make up the
- Windows "Network Neighborhood" view.</P
-><P
->SMB/CIFS clients, when they start up, may wish to
+ Windows &quot;Network Neighborhood&quot; view.</p><p>SMB/CIFS clients, when they start up, may wish to
locate an SMB/CIFS server. That is, they wish to know what
- IP number a specified host is using.</P
-><P
->Amongst other services, <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->nmbd</B
-> will
+ IP number a specified host is using.</p><p>Amongst other services, <b class="command">nmbd</b> will
listen for such requests, and if its own NetBIOS name is
specified it will respond with the IP number of the host it
- is running on. Its "own NetBIOS name" is by
+ is running on. Its &quot;own NetBIOS name&quot; is by
default the primary DNS name of the host it is running on,
- but this can be overridden with the <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->-n</I
->
- option (see OPTIONS below). Thus <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->nmbd</B
-> will
+ but this can be overridden with the <span class="emphasis"><em>-n</em></span>
+ option (see OPTIONS below). Thus <b class="command">nmbd</b> will
reply to broadcast queries for its own name(s). Additional
- names for <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->nmbd</B
-> to respond on can be set
- via parameters in the <A
-HREF="smb.conf.5.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-><TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
-> smb.conf(5)</TT
-></A
-> configuration file.</P
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->nmbd</B
-> can also be used as a WINS
+ names for <b class="command">nmbd</b> to respond on can be set
+ via parameters in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> configuration file.</p><p><b class="command">nmbd</b> can also be used as a WINS
(Windows Internet Name Server) server. What this basically means
is that it will act as a WINS database server, creating a
database from name registration requests that it receives and
- replying to queries from clients for these names.</P
-><P
->In addition, <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->nmbd</B
-> can act as a WINS
+ replying to queries from clients for these names.</p><p>In addition, <b class="command">nmbd</b> can act as a WINS
proxy, relaying broadcast queries from clients that do
not understand how to talk the WINS protocol to a WINS
- server.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN42"
-></A
-><H2
->OPTIONS</H2
-><P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
->-D</DT
-><DD
-><P
->If specified, this parameter causes
- <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->nmbd</B
-> to operate as a daemon. That is,
+ server.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">-D</span></dt><dd><p>If specified, this parameter causes
+ <b class="command">nmbd</b> to operate as a daemon. That is,
it detaches itself and runs in the background, fielding
- requests on the appropriate port. By default, <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->nmbd</B
->
+ requests on the appropriate port. By default, <b class="command">nmbd</b>
will operate as a daemon if launched from a command shell.
- nmbd can also be operated from the <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->inetd</B
->
+ nmbd can also be operated from the <b class="command">inetd</b>
meta-daemon, although this is not recommended.
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-F</DT
-><DD
-><P
->If specified, this parameter causes
- the main <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->nmbd</B
-> process to not daemonize,
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-F</span></dt><dd><p>If specified, this parameter causes
+ the main <b class="command">nmbd</b> process to not daemonize,
i.e. double-fork and disassociate with the terminal.
Child processes are still created as normal to service
each connection request, but the main process does not
exit. This operation mode is suitable for running
- <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->nmbd</B
-> under process supervisors such
- as <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->supervise</B
-> and <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->svscan</B
->
- from Daniel J. Bernstein's <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->daemontools</B
->
+ <b class="command">nmbd</b> under process supervisors such
+ as <b class="command">supervise</b> and <b class="command">svscan</b>
+ from Daniel J. Bernstein's <b class="command">daemontools</b>
package, or the AIX process monitor.
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-S</DT
-><DD
-><P
->If specified, this parameter causes
- <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->nmbd</B
-> to log to standard output rather
- than a file.</P
-></DD
-><DT
->-a</DT
-><DD
-><P
->If this parameter is specified, each new
- connection will append log messages to the log file.
- This is the default.</P
-></DD
-><DT
->-i</DT
-><DD
-><P
->If this parameter is specified it causes the
- server to run "interactively", not as a daemon, even if the
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-S</span></dt><dd><p>If specified, this parameter causes
+ <b class="command">nmbd</b> to log to standard output rather
+ than a file.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-i</span></dt><dd><p>If this parameter is specified it causes the
+ server to run &quot;interactively&quot;, not as a daemon, even if the
server is executed on the command line of a shell. Setting this
parameter negates the implicit daemon mode when run from the
- command line. <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->nmbd</B
-> also logs to standard
- output, as if the <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->-S</B
-> parameter had been
- given. </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-o</DT
-><DD
-><P
->If this parameter is specified, the
- log files will be overwritten when opened. By default,
- <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbd</B
-> will append entries to the log
- files.</P
-></DD
-><DT
->-h</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Prints the help information (usage)
- for <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->nmbd</B
->.</P
-></DD
-><DT
->-H &#60;filename&#62;</DT
-><DD
-><P
->NetBIOS lmhosts file. The lmhosts
+ command line. <b class="command">nmbd</b> also logs to standard
+ output, as if the <tt class="constant">-S</tt> parameter had been
+ given. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-h|--help</span></dt><dd><p>Print a summary of command line options.
+</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-H &lt;filename&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>NetBIOS lmhosts file. The lmhosts
file is a list of NetBIOS names to IP addresses that
is loaded by the nmbd server and used via the name
- resolution mechanism <A
-HREF="smb.conf.5.html#nameresolveorder"
-TARGET="_top"
-> name resolve order</A
-> described in <A
-HREF="smb.conf.5.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-> <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->smb.conf(5)</TT
-></A
->
- to resolve any NetBIOS name queries needed by the server. Note
- that the contents of this file are <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->NOT</I
->
- used by <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->nmbd</B
-> to answer any name queries.
+ resolution mechanism <a href="smb.conf.5.html#nameresolveorder" target="_top"><i class="parameter"><tt>name resolve
+ order</tt></i></a> described in <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> to resolve any
+ NetBIOS name queries needed by the server. Note
+ that the contents of this file are <span class="emphasis"><em>NOT</em></span>
+ used by <b class="command">nmbd</b> to answer any name queries.
Adding a line to this file affects name NetBIOS resolution
- from this host <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->ONLY</I
->.</P
-><P
->The default path to this file is compiled into
+ from this host <span class="emphasis"><em>ONLY</em></span>.</p><p>The default path to this file is compiled into
Samba as part of the build process. Common defaults
- are <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/usr/local/samba/lib/lmhosts</TT
->,
- <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/usr/samba/lib/lmhosts</TT
-> or
- <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/lmhosts</TT
->. See the
- <A
-HREF="lmhosts.5.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-><TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->lmhosts(5)</TT
-></A
->
- man page for details on the contents of this file.</P
-></DD
-><DT
->-V</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Prints the version number for
- <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->nmbd</B
->.</P
-></DD
-><DT
->-d &#60;debug level&#62;</DT
-><DD
-><P
->debuglevel is an integer
- from 0 to 10. The default value if this parameter is
- not specified is zero.</P
-><P
->The higher this value, the more detail will
- be logged to the log files about the activities of the
- server. At level 0, only critical errors and serious
- warnings will be logged. Level 1 is a reasonable level for
- day to day running - it generates a small amount of
- information about operations carried out.</P
-><P
->Levels above 1 will generate considerable amounts
- of log data, and should only be used when investigating
- a problem. Levels above 3 are designed for use only by developers
- and generate HUGE amounts of log data, most of which is extremely
- cryptic.</P
-><P
->Note that specifying this parameter here will override
- the <A
-HREF="smb.conf.5.html#loglevel"
-TARGET="_top"
->log level</A
->
- parameter in the <A
-HREF="smb.conf.5.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-><TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
-> smb.conf(5)</TT
-></A
-> file.</P
-></DD
-><DT
->-l &#60;log directory&#62;</DT
-><DD
-><P
->The -l parameter specifies a directory
- into which the "log.nmbd" log file will be created
- for operational data from the running <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->nmbd</B
->
- server. The default log directory is compiled into Samba
- as part of the build process. Common defaults are <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
-> /usr/local/samba/var/log.nmb</TT
->, <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
-> /usr/samba/var/log.nmb</TT
-> or
- <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/var/log/log.nmb</TT
->. <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->Beware:</I
->
- If the directory specified does not exist, <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->nmbd</B
->
- will log to the default debug log location defined at compile time.
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-n &#60;primary NetBIOS name&#62;</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This option allows you to override
- the NetBIOS name that Samba uses for itself. This is identical
- to setting the <A
-HREF="smb.conf.5.html#netbiosname"
-TARGET="_top"
-> NetBIOS name</A
-> parameter in the <A
-HREF="smb.conf.5.html"
-TARGET="_top"
->
- <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->smb.conf</TT
-></A
-> file. However, a command
- line setting will take precedence over settings in
- <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->smb.conf</TT
->.</P
-></DD
-><DT
->-p &#60;UDP port number&#62;</DT
-><DD
-><P
->UDP port number is a positive integer value.
+ are <tt class="filename">/usr/local/samba/lib/lmhosts</tt>,
+ <tt class="filename">/usr/samba/lib/lmhosts</tt> or
+ <tt class="filename">/etc/samba/lmhosts</tt>. See the <a href="lmhosts.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">lmhosts</span>(5)</span></a> man page for details on the contents of this file.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-V</span></dt><dd><p>Prints the version number for
+<b class="command">smbd</b>.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-s &lt;configuration file&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>The file specified contains the
+configuration details required by the server. The
+information in this file includes server-specific
+information such as what printcap file to use, as well
+as descriptions of all the services that the server is
+to provide. See <a href="smb.conf.5.html" target="_top"><tt class="filename">
+smb.conf(5)</tt></a> for more information.
+The default configuration file name is determined at
+compile time.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-d|--debug=debuglevel</span></dt><dd><p><i class="replaceable"><tt>debuglevel</tt></i> is an integer
+from 0 to 10. The default value if this parameter is
+not specified is zero.</p><p>The higher this value, the more detail will be
+logged to the log files about the activities of the
+server. At level 0, only critical errors and serious
+warnings will be logged. Level 1 is a reasonable level for
+day to day running - it generates a small amount of
+information about operations carried out.</p><p>Levels above 1 will generate considerable
+amounts of log data, and should only be used when
+investigating a problem. Levels above 3 are designed for
+use only by developers and generate HUGE amounts of log
+data, most of which is extremely cryptic.</p><p>Note that specifying this parameter here will
+override the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#loglevel" target="_top">log
+level</a> parameter in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html" target="_top">
+<tt class="filename">smb.conf(5)</tt></a> file.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-l|--logfile=logbasename</span></dt><dd><p>File name for log/debug files. The extension
+<tt class="constant">&quot;.client&quot;</tt> will be appended. The log file is
+never removed by the client.
+</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-p &lt;UDP port number&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>UDP port number is a positive integer value.
This option changes the default UDP port number (normally 137)
- that <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->nmbd</B
-> responds to name queries on. Don't
+ that <b class="command">nmbd</b> responds to name queries on. Don't
use this option unless you are an expert, in which case you
- won't need help!</P
-></DD
-><DT
->-s &#60;configuration file&#62;</DT
-><DD
-><P
->The default configuration file name
- is set at build time, typically as <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
-> /usr/local/samba/lib/smb.conf</TT
->, but
- this may be changed when Samba is autoconfigured.</P
-><P
->The file specified contains the configuration details
- required by the server. See <A
-HREF="smb.conf.5.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-> <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->smb.conf(5)</TT
-></A
-> for more information.
- </P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN148"
-></A
-><H2
->FILES</H2
-><P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
-><TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/inetd.conf</TT
-></DT
-><DD
-><P
->If the server is to be run by the
- <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->inetd</B
-> meta-daemon, this file
+ won't need help!</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>FILES</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term"><tt class="filename">/etc/inetd.conf</tt></span></dt><dd><p>If the server is to be run by the
+ <b class="command">inetd</b> meta-daemon, this file
must contain suitable startup information for the
- meta-daemon. See the <A
-HREF="UNIX_INSTALL.html"
-TARGET="_top"
->UNIX_INSTALL.html</A
-> document
+ meta-daemon. See the <a href="install.html" target="_top">install</a> document
for details.
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
-><TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/rc</TT
-></DT
-><DD
-><P
->or whatever initialization script your
- system uses).</P
-><P
->If running the server as a daemon at startup,
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term"><tt class="filename">/etc/rc</tt></span></dt><dd><p>or whatever initialization script your
+ system uses).</p><p>If running the server as a daemon at startup,
this file will need to contain an appropriate startup
- sequence for the server. See the <A
-HREF="UNIX_INSTALL.html"
-TARGET="_top"
->UNIX_INSTALL.html</A
-> document
- for details.</P
-></DD
-><DT
-><TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/services</TT
-></DT
-><DD
-><P
->If running the server via the
- meta-daemon <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->inetd</B
->, this file
+ sequence for the server. See the <a href="install.html" target="_top">&quot;How to Install and Test SAMBA&quot;</a> document
+ for details.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><tt class="filename">/etc/services</tt></span></dt><dd><p>If running the server via the
+ meta-daemon <b class="command">inetd</b>, this file
must contain a mapping of service name (e.g., netbios-ssn)
to service port (e.g., 139) and protocol type (e.g., tcp).
- See the <A
-HREF="UNIX_INSTALL.html"
-TARGET="_top"
->UNIX_INSTALL.html</A
->
- document for details.</P
-></DD
-><DT
-><TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/usr/local/samba/lib/smb.conf</TT
-></DT
-><DD
-><P
->This is the default location of the
- <A
-HREF="smb.conf.5.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-><TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->smb.conf</TT
-></A
->
- server configuration file. Other common places that systems
- install this file are <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/usr/samba/lib/smb.conf</TT
->
- and <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/smb.conf</TT
->.</P
-><P
->When run as a WINS server (see the
- <A
-HREF="smb.conf.5.html#WINSSUPPORT"
-TARGET="_top"
->wins support</A
->
- parameter in the <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->smb.conf(5)</TT
-> man page),
- <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->nmbd</B
->
- will store the WINS database in the file <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->wins.dat</TT
->
- in the <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->var/locks</TT
-> directory configured under
- wherever Samba was configured to install itself.</P
-><P
->If <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->nmbd</B
-> is acting as a <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
-> browse master</I
-> (see the <A
-HREF="smb.conf.5.html#LOCALMASTER"
-TARGET="_top"
->local master</A
->
- parameter in the <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->smb.conf(5)</TT
-> man page,
- <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->nmbd</B
->
- will store the browsing database in the file <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->browse.dat
- </TT
-> in the <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->var/locks</TT
-> directory
+ See the <a href="install.html" target="_top">&quot;How to Install and Test SAMBA&quot;</a>
+ document for details.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><tt class="filename">/usr/local/samba/lib/smb.conf</tt></span></dt><dd><p>This is the default location of
+ the <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> server
+ configuration file. Other common places that systems
+ install this file are <tt class="filename">/usr/samba/lib/smb.conf</tt>
+ and <tt class="filename">/etc/samba/smb.conf</tt>.</p><p>When run as a WINS server (see the
+ <a href="smb.conf.5.html#WINSSUPPORT" target="_top"><tt class="constant">wins support</tt></a>
+ parameter in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> man page),
+ <b class="command">nmbd</b>
+ will store the WINS database in the file <tt class="filename">wins.dat</tt>
+ in the <tt class="filename">var/locks</tt> directory configured under
+ wherever Samba was configured to install itself.</p><p>If <b class="command">nmbd</b> is acting as a <span class="emphasis"><em>
+ browse master</em></span> (see the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#LOCALMASTER" target="_top"><tt class="constant">local master</tt></a>
+ parameter in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> man page, <b class="command">nmbd</b>
+ will store the browsing database in the file <tt class="filename">browse.dat
+ </tt> in the <tt class="filename">var/locks</tt> directory
configured under wherever Samba was configured to install itself.
- </P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN195"
-></A
-><H2
->SIGNALS</H2
-><P
->To shut down an <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->nmbd</B
-> process it is recommended
- that SIGKILL (-9) <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->NOT</I
-> be used, except as a last
+ </p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>SIGNALS</h2><p>To shut down an <b class="command">nmbd</b> process it is recommended
+ that SIGKILL (-9) <span class="emphasis"><em>NOT</em></span> be used, except as a last
resort, as this may leave the name database in an inconsistent state.
- The correct way to terminate <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->nmbd</B
-> is to send it
- a SIGTERM (-15) signal and wait for it to die on its own.</P
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->nmbd</B
-> will accept SIGHUP, which will cause
- it to dump out its namelists into the file <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->namelist.debug
- </TT
-> in the <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/usr/local/samba/var/locks</TT
->
- directory (or the <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->var/locks</TT
-> directory configured
+ The correct way to terminate <b class="command">nmbd</b> is to send it
+ a SIGTERM (-15) signal and wait for it to die on its own.</p><p><b class="command">nmbd</b> will accept SIGHUP, which will cause
+ it to dump out its namelists into the file <tt class="filename">namelist.debug
+ </tt> in the <tt class="filename">/usr/local/samba/var/locks</tt>
+ directory (or the <tt class="filename">var/locks</tt> directory configured
under wherever Samba was configured to install itself). This will also
- cause <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->nmbd</B
-> to dump out its server database in
- the <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->log.nmb</TT
-> file.</P
-><P
->The debug log level of nmbd may be raised or lowered using
- <A
-HREF="smbcontrol.1.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbcontrol(1)</B
->
- </A
-> (SIGUSR[1|2] signals are no longer used in Samba 2.2). This is
- to allow transient problems to be diagnosed, whilst still running
- at a normally low log level.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN211"
-></A
-><H2
->VERSION</H2
-><P
->This man page is correct for version 3.0 of
- the Samba suite.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN214"
-></A
-><H2
->SEE ALSO</H2
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->inetd(8)</B
->, <A
-HREF="smbd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbd(8)</B
-></A
->,
- <A
-HREF="smb.conf.5.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-><TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->smb.conf(5)</TT
->
- </A
->, <A
-HREF="smbclient.1.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbclient(1)
- </B
-></A
->, <A
-HREF="testparm.1.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
-> testparm(1)</B
-></A
->, <A
-HREF="testprns.1.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-> <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->testprns(1)</B
-></A
->, and the Internet RFC's
- <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->rfc1001.txt</TT
->, <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->rfc1002.txt</TT
->.
+ cause <b class="command">nmbd</b> to dump out its server database in
+ the <tt class="filename">log.nmb</tt> file.</p><p>The debug log level of nmbd may be raised or lowered
+ using <a href="smbcontrol.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbcontrol</span>(1)</span></a> (SIGUSR[1|2] signals
+ are no longer used since Samba 2.2). This is to allow
+ transient problems to be diagnosed, whilst still running
+ at a normally low log level.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3.0 of
+ the Samba suite.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>SEE ALSO</h2><p>
+ <a href="inetd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">inetd</span>(8)</span></a>, <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a>, <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a>, <a href="smbclient.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbclient</span>(1)</span></a>, <a href="testparm.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">testparm</span>(1)</span></a>, <a href="testprns.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">testprns</span>(1)</span></a>, and the Internet
+ RFC's <tt class="filename">rfc1001.txt</tt>, <tt class="filename">rfc1002.txt</tt>.
In addition the CIFS (formerly SMB) specification is available
- as a link from the Web page <A
-HREF="http://samba.org/cifs/"
-TARGET="_top"
->
- http://samba.org/cifs/</A
->.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN231"
-></A
-><H2
->AUTHOR</H2
-><P
->The original Samba software and related utilities
+ as a link from the Web page <a href="http://samba.org/cifs/" target="_top">
+ http://samba.org/cifs/</a>.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
- to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</P
-><P
->The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer.
+ to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</p><p>The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer.
The man page sources were converted to YODL format (another
- excellent piece of Open Source software, available at
- <A
-HREF="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/"
-TARGET="_top"
-> ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/</A
->) and updated for the Samba 2.0
+ excellent piece of Open Source software, available at <a href="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/" target="_top">
+ ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/</a>) and updated for the Samba 2.0
release by Jeremy Allison. The conversion to DocBook for
- Samba 2.2 was done by Gerald Carter</P
-></DIV
-></BODY
-></HTML
-> \ No newline at end of file
+ Samba 2.2 was done by Gerald Carter. The conversion to DocBook
+ XML 4.2 for Samba 3.0 was done by Alexander Bokovoy.</p></div></div></body></html>
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/nmblookup.1.html b/docs/htmldocs/nmblookup.1.html
index 2ce322990f..46c17ce706 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/nmblookup.1.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/nmblookup.1.html
@@ -1,412 +1,107 @@
-<!DOCTYPE HTML PUBLIC "-//W3C//DTD HTML 4.01 Transitional//EN">
-<HTML
-><HEAD
-><TITLE
->nmblookup</TITLE
-><META
-NAME="GENERATOR"
-CONTENT="Modular DocBook HTML Stylesheet Version 1.77"></HEAD
-><BODY
-CLASS="REFENTRY"
-BGCOLOR="#FFFFFF"
-TEXT="#000000"
-LINK="#0000FF"
-VLINK="#840084"
-ALINK="#0000FF"
-><H1
-><A
-NAME="NMBLOOKUP"
-></A
->nmblookup</H1
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFNAMEDIV"
-><A
-NAME="AEN5"
-></A
-><H2
->Name</H2
->nmblookup&nbsp;--&nbsp;NetBIOS over TCP/IP client used to lookup NetBIOS
- names</DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSYNOPSISDIV"
-><A
-NAME="AEN8"
-></A
-><H2
->Synopsis</H2
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->nmblookup</B
-> [-M] [-R] [-S] [-r] [-A] [-h] [-B &lt;broadcast address&gt;] [-U &lt;unicast address&gt;] [-d &lt;debug level&gt;] [-s &lt;smb config file&gt;] [-i &lt;NetBIOS scope&gt;] [-T] [-f] {name}</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN25"
-></A
-><H2
->DESCRIPTION</H2
-><P
->This tool is part of the <A
-HREF="samba.7.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-> Samba</A
-> suite.</P
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->nmblookup</B
-> is used to query NetBIOS names
+<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>nmblookup</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="nmblookup"></a><div class="titlepage"><div></div><div></div></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>nmblookup &#8212; NetBIOS over TCP/IP client used to lookup NetBIOS
+ names</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><tt class="command">nmblookup</tt> [-M] [-R] [-S] [-r] [-A] [-h] [-B &lt;broadcast address&gt;] [-U &lt;unicast address&gt;] [-d &lt;debug level&gt;] [-s &lt;smb config file&gt;] [-i &lt;NetBIOS scope&gt;] [-T] [-f] {name}</p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This tool is part of the <a href="Samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">Samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p><b class="command">nmblookup</b> is used to query NetBIOS names
and map them to IP addresses in a network using NetBIOS over TCP/IP
queries. The options allow the name queries to be directed at a
particular IP broadcast area or to a particular machine. All queries
- are done over UDP.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN31"
-></A
-><H2
->OPTIONS</H2
-><P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
->-M</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Searches for a master browser by looking
- up the NetBIOS name <TT
-CLASS="REPLACEABLE"
-><I
->name</I
-></TT
-> with a
- type of <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->0x1d</TT
->. If <TT
-CLASS="REPLACEABLE"
-><I
-> name</I
-></TT
-> is "-" then it does a lookup on the special name
- <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->__MSBROWSE__</TT
->.</P
-></DD
-><DT
->-R</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Set the recursion desired bit in the packet
+ are done over UDP.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">-M</span></dt><dd><p>Searches for a master browser by looking
+ up the NetBIOS name <i class="replaceable"><tt>name</tt></i> with a
+ type of <tt class="constant">0x1d</tt>. If <i class="replaceable"><tt>
+ name</tt></i> is &quot;-&quot; then it does a lookup on the special name
+ <tt class="constant">__MSBROWSE__</tt>. Please note that in order to
+ use the name &quot;-&quot;, you need to make sure &quot;-&quot; isn't parsed as an
+ argument, e.g. use :
+ <b class="userinput"><tt>nmblookup -M -- -</tt></b>.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-R</span></dt><dd><p>Set the recursion desired bit in the packet
to do a recursive lookup. This is used when sending a name
query to a machine running a WINS server and the user wishes
to query the names in the WINS server. If this bit is unset
the normal (broadcast responding) NetBIOS processing code
- on a machine is used instead. See rfc1001, rfc1002 for details.
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-S</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Once the name query has returned an IP
+ on a machine is used instead. See RFC1001, RFC1002 for details.
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-S</span></dt><dd><p>Once the name query has returned an IP
address then do a node status query as well. A node status
query returns the NetBIOS names registered by a host.
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-r</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Try and bind to UDP port 137 to send and receive UDP
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-r</span></dt><dd><p>Try and bind to UDP port 137 to send and receive UDP
datagrams. The reason for this option is a bug in Windows 95
where it ignores the source port of the requesting packet
and only replies to UDP port 137. Unfortunately, on most UNIX
systems root privilege is needed to bind to this port, and
- in addition, if the <A
-HREF="nmbd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
->nmbd(8)</A
->
- daemon is running on this machine it also binds to this port.
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-A</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Interpret <TT
-CLASS="REPLACEABLE"
-><I
->name</I
-></TT
-> as
- an IP Address and do a node status query on this address.</P
-></DD
-><DT
->-h</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Print a help (usage) message.</P
-></DD
-><DT
->-B &lt;broadcast address&gt;</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Send the query to the given broadcast address. Without
+ in addition, if the <a href="nmbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">nmbd</span>(8)</span></a> daemon is running on this machine it also binds to this port.
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-A</span></dt><dd><p>Interpret <i class="replaceable"><tt>name</tt></i> as
+ an IP Address and do a node status query on this address.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-n &lt;primary NetBIOS name&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>This option allows you to override
+the NetBIOS name that Samba uses for itself. This is identical
+to setting the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#netbiosname" target="_top"><i class="parameter"><tt>NetBIOS
+name</tt></i></a> parameter in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> file. However, a command
+line setting will take precedence over settings in
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a>.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-i &lt;scope&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>This specifies a NetBIOS scope that
+<b class="command">nmblookup</b> will use to communicate with when
+generating NetBIOS names. For details on the use of NetBIOS
+scopes, see rfc1001.txt and rfc1002.txt. NetBIOS scopes are
+<span class="emphasis"><em>very</em></span> rarely used, only set this parameter
+if you are the system administrator in charge of all the
+NetBIOS systems you communicate with.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-W|--workgroup=domain</span></dt><dd><p>Set the SMB domain of the username. This
+overrides the default domain which is the domain defined in
+smb.conf. If the domain specified is the same as the servers
+NetBIOS name, it causes the client to log on using the servers local
+SAM (as opposed to the Domain SAM). </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-O socket options</span></dt><dd><p>TCP socket options to set on the client
+socket. See the socket options parameter in
+the <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> manual page for the list of valid
+options. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-h|--help</span></dt><dd><p>Print a summary of command line options.
+</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-B &lt;broadcast address&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>Send the query to the given broadcast address. Without
this option the default behavior of nmblookup is to send the
query to the broadcast address of the network interfaces as
- either auto-detected or defined in the <A
-HREF="smb.conf.5.html#INTERFACES"
-TARGET="_top"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->interfaces</I
-></TT
->
- </A
-> parameter of the <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->smb.conf (5)</TT
-> file.
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-U &lt;unicast address&gt;</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Do a unicast query to the specified address or
- host <TT
-CLASS="REPLACEABLE"
-><I
->unicast address</I
-></TT
->. This option
- (along with the <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->-R</I
-></TT
-> option) is needed to
- query a WINS server.</P
-></DD
-><DT
->-d &lt;debuglevel&gt;</DT
-><DD
-><P
->debuglevel is an integer from 0 to 10.</P
-><P
->The default value if this parameter is not specified
- is zero.</P
-><P
->The higher this value, the more detail will be logged
- about the activities of <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->nmblookup</B
->. At level
- 0, only critical errors and serious warnings will be logged.</P
-><P
->Levels above 1 will generate considerable amounts of
- log data, and should only be used when investigating a problem.
- Levels above 3 are designed for use only by developers and
- generate HUGE amounts of data, most of which is extremely cryptic.</P
-><P
->Note that specifying this parameter here will override
- the <A
-HREF="smb.conf.5.html#LOGLEVEL"
-TARGET="_top"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
-> log level</I
-></TT
-></A
-> parameter in the <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
-> smb.conf(5)</TT
-> file.</P
-></DD
-><DT
->-s &lt;smb.conf&gt;</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This parameter specifies the pathname to
- the Samba configuration file, <A
-HREF="smb.conf.5.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-> smb.conf(5)</A
->. This file controls all aspects of
- the Samba setup on the machine.</P
-></DD
-><DT
->-i &lt;scope&gt;</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This specifies a NetBIOS scope that
- <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->nmblookup</B
-> will use to communicate with when
- generating NetBIOS names. For details on the use of NetBIOS
- scopes, see rfc1001.txt and rfc1002.txt. NetBIOS scopes are
- <SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->very</I
-></SPAN
-> rarely used, only set this parameter
- if you are the system administrator in charge of all the
- NetBIOS systems you communicate with.</P
-></DD
-><DT
->-T</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This causes any IP addresses found in the
+ either auto-detected or defined in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#INTERFACES" target="_top"><i class="parameter"><tt>interfaces</tt></i>
+ </a> parameter of the <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> file.
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-U &lt;unicast address&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>Do a unicast query to the specified address or
+ host <i class="replaceable"><tt>unicast address</tt></i>. This option
+ (along with the <i class="parameter"><tt>-R</tt></i> option) is needed to
+ query a WINS server.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-V</span></dt><dd><p>Prints the version number for
+<b class="command">smbd</b>.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-s &lt;configuration file&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>The file specified contains the
+configuration details required by the server. The
+information in this file includes server-specific
+information such as what printcap file to use, as well
+as descriptions of all the services that the server is
+to provide. See <a href="smb.conf.5.html" target="_top"><tt class="filename">
+smb.conf(5)</tt></a> for more information.
+The default configuration file name is determined at
+compile time.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-d|--debug=debuglevel</span></dt><dd><p><i class="replaceable"><tt>debuglevel</tt></i> is an integer
+from 0 to 10. The default value if this parameter is
+not specified is zero.</p><p>The higher this value, the more detail will be
+logged to the log files about the activities of the
+server. At level 0, only critical errors and serious
+warnings will be logged. Level 1 is a reasonable level for
+day to day running - it generates a small amount of
+information about operations carried out.</p><p>Levels above 1 will generate considerable
+amounts of log data, and should only be used when
+investigating a problem. Levels above 3 are designed for
+use only by developers and generate HUGE amounts of log
+data, most of which is extremely cryptic.</p><p>Note that specifying this parameter here will
+override the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#loglevel" target="_top">log
+level</a> parameter in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html" target="_top">
+<tt class="filename">smb.conf(5)</tt></a> file.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-l|--logfile=logbasename</span></dt><dd><p>File name for log/debug files. The extension
+<tt class="constant">&quot;.client&quot;</tt> will be appended. The log file is
+never removed by the client.
+</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-T</span></dt><dd><p>This causes any IP addresses found in the
lookup to be looked up via a reverse DNS lookup into a
- DNS name, and printed out before each</P
-><P
-><SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->IP address .... NetBIOS name</I
-></SPAN
-></P
-><P
-> pair that is the normal output.</P
-></DD
-><DT
->-f</DT
-><DD
-><P
-> Show which flags apply to the name that has been looked up. Possible
+ DNS name, and printed out before each</p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>IP address .... NetBIOS name</em></span></p><p> pair that is the normal output.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-f</span></dt><dd><p>
+ Show which flags apply to the name that has been looked up. Possible
answers are zero or more of: Response, Authoritative,
Truncated, Recursion_Desired, Recursion_Available, Broadcast.
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
->name</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This is the NetBIOS name being queried. Depending
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term">name</span></dt><dd><p>This is the NetBIOS name being queried. Depending
upon the previous options this may be a NetBIOS name or IP address.
If a NetBIOS name then the different name types may be specified
by appending '#&lt;type&gt;' to the name. This name may also be
'*', which will return all registered names within a broadcast
- area.</P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN115"
-></A
-><H2
->EXAMPLES</H2
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->nmblookup</B
-> can be used to query
- a WINS server (in the same way <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->nslookup</B
-> is
- used to query DNS servers). To query a WINS server,
- <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->nmblookup</B
-> must be called like this:</P
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->nmblookup -U server -R 'name'</B
-></P
-><P
->For example, running :</P
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->nmblookup -U samba.org -R 'IRIX#1B'</B
-></P
-><P
->would query the WINS server samba.org for the domain
- master browser (1B name type) for the IRIX workgroup.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN127"
-></A
-><H2
->VERSION</H2
-><P
->This man page is correct for version 3.0 of
- the Samba suite.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN130"
-></A
-><H2
->SEE ALSO</H2
-><P
-><A
-HREF="nmbd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->nmbd(8)</B
-></A
->,
- <A
-HREF="samba.7.html"
-TARGET="_top"
->samba(7)</A
->, and <A
-HREF="smb.conf.5.html"
-TARGET="_top"
->smb.conf(5)</A
->
- </P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN137"
-></A
-><H2
->AUTHOR</H2
-><P
->The original Samba software and related utilities
+ area.</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>EXAMPLES</h2><p><b class="command">nmblookup</b> can be used to query
+ a WINS server (in the same way <b class="command">nslookup</b> is
+ used to query DNS servers). To query a WINS server, <b class="command">nmblookup</b>
+ must be called like this:</p><p><b class="command">nmblookup -U server -R 'name'</b></p><p>For example, running :</p><p><b class="command">nmblookup -U samba.org -R 'IRIX#1B'</b></p><p>would query the WINS server samba.org for the domain
+ master browser (1B name type) for the IRIX workgroup.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3.0 of
+ the Samba suite.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>SEE ALSO</h2><p><a href="nmbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">nmbd</span>(8)</span></a>, <a href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a>, and <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a>.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
- to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</P
-><P
->The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer.
+ to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</p><p>The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer.
The man page sources were converted to YODL format (another
- excellent piece of Open Source software, available at
- <A
-HREF="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/"
-TARGET="_top"
-> ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/</A
->) and updated for the Samba 2.0
+ excellent piece of Open Source software, available at <a href="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/" target="_top">
+ ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/</a>) and updated for the Samba 2.0
release by Jeremy Allison. The conversion to DocBook for
- Samba 2.2 was done by Gerald Carter</P
-></DIV
-></BODY
-></HTML
-> \ No newline at end of file
+ Samba 2.2 was done by Gerald Carter. The conversion to DocBook
+ XML 4.2 for Samba 3.0 was done by Alexander Bokovoy.</p></div></div></body></html>
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/optional.html b/docs/htmldocs/optional.html
index b15515ddab..22761de9c9 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/optional.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/optional.html
@@ -1,898 +1,26 @@
-<!DOCTYPE HTML PUBLIC "-//W3C//DTD HTML 4.01 Transitional//EN">
-<HTML
-><HEAD
-><TITLE
->Optional configuration</TITLE
-><META
-NAME="GENERATOR"
-CONTENT="Modular DocBook HTML Stylesheet Version 1.76b+
-"><LINK
-REL="HOME"
-TITLE="SAMBA Project Documentation"
-HREF="samba-howto-collection.html"><LINK
-REL="PREVIOUS"
-TITLE="Samba as a NT4 domain member"
-HREF="domain-security.html"><LINK
-REL="NEXT"
-TITLE="Integrating MS Windows networks with Samba"
-HREF="integrate-ms-networks.html"></HEAD
-><BODY
-CLASS="PART"
-BGCOLOR="#FFFFFF"
-TEXT="#000000"
-LINK="#0000FF"
-VLINK="#840084"
-ALINK="#0000FF"
-><DIV
-CLASS="NAVHEADER"
-><TABLE
-SUMMARY="Header navigation table"
-WIDTH="100%"
-BORDER="0"
-CELLPADDING="0"
-CELLSPACING="0"
-><TR
-><TH
-COLSPAN="3"
-ALIGN="center"
->SAMBA Project Documentation</TH
-></TR
-><TR
-><TD
-WIDTH="10%"
-ALIGN="left"
-VALIGN="bottom"
-><A
-HREF="domain-security.html"
-ACCESSKEY="P"
->Prev</A
-></TD
-><TD
-WIDTH="80%"
-ALIGN="center"
-VALIGN="bottom"
-></TD
-><TD
-WIDTH="10%"
-ALIGN="right"
-VALIGN="bottom"
-><A
-HREF="integrate-ms-networks.html"
-ACCESSKEY="N"
->Next</A
-></TD
-></TR
-></TABLE
-><HR
-ALIGN="LEFT"
-WIDTH="100%"></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="PART"
-><A
-NAME="OPTIONAL"><DIV
-CLASS="TITLEPAGE"
-><H1
-CLASS="TITLE"
->III. Optional configuration</H1
-><DIV
-CLASS="PARTINTRO"
-><A
-NAME="AEN1360"><H1
->Introduction</H1
-><P
->Samba has several features that you might want or might not want to use. The chapters in this
-part each cover one specific feature.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="TOC"
-><DL
-><DT
-><B
->Table of Contents</B
-></DT
-><DT
->10. <A
-HREF="integrate-ms-networks.html"
->Integrating MS Windows networks with Samba</A
-></DT
-><DD
-><DL
-><DT
->10.1. <A
-HREF="integrate-ms-networks.html#AEN1374"
->Agenda</A
-></DT
-><DT
->10.2. <A
-HREF="integrate-ms-networks.html#AEN1396"
->Name Resolution in a pure Unix/Linux world</A
-></DT
-><DD
-><DL
-><DT
->10.2.1. <A
-HREF="integrate-ms-networks.html#AEN1412"
-><TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/hosts</TT
-></A
-></DT
-><DT
->10.2.2. <A
-HREF="integrate-ms-networks.html#AEN1428"
-><TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/resolv.conf</TT
-></A
-></DT
-><DT
->10.2.3. <A
-HREF="integrate-ms-networks.html#AEN1439"
-><TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/host.conf</TT
-></A
-></DT
-><DT
->10.2.4. <A
-HREF="integrate-ms-networks.html#AEN1447"
-><TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/nsswitch.conf</TT
-></A
-></DT
-></DL
-></DD
-><DT
->10.3. <A
-HREF="integrate-ms-networks.html#AEN1459"
->Name resolution as used within MS Windows networking</A
-></DT
-><DD
-><DL
-><DT
->10.3.1. <A
-HREF="integrate-ms-networks.html#AEN1471"
->The NetBIOS Name Cache</A
-></DT
-><DT
->10.3.2. <A
-HREF="integrate-ms-networks.html#AEN1476"
->The LMHOSTS file</A
-></DT
-><DT
->10.3.3. <A
-HREF="integrate-ms-networks.html#AEN1484"
->HOSTS file</A
-></DT
-><DT
->10.3.4. <A
-HREF="integrate-ms-networks.html#AEN1489"
->DNS Lookup</A
-></DT
-><DT
->10.3.5. <A
-HREF="integrate-ms-networks.html#AEN1492"
->WINS Lookup</A
-></DT
-></DL
-></DD
-><DT
->10.4. <A
-HREF="integrate-ms-networks.html#AEN1504"
->How browsing functions and how to deploy stable and
-dependable browsing using Samba</A
-></DT
-><DT
->10.5. <A
-HREF="integrate-ms-networks.html#AEN1514"
->MS Windows security options and how to configure
-Samba for seemless integration</A
-></DT
-><DD
-><DL
-><DT
->10.5.1. <A
-HREF="integrate-ms-networks.html#AEN1542"
->Use MS Windows NT as an authentication server</A
-></DT
-><DT
->10.5.2. <A
-HREF="integrate-ms-networks.html#AEN1550"
->Make Samba a member of an MS Windows NT security domain</A
-></DT
-><DT
->10.5.3. <A
-HREF="integrate-ms-networks.html#AEN1567"
->Configure Samba as an authentication server</A
-></DT
-></DL
-></DD
-><DT
->10.6. <A
-HREF="integrate-ms-networks.html#AEN1584"
->Conclusions</A
-></DT
-></DL
-></DD
-><DT
->11. <A
-HREF="unix-permissions.html"
->UNIX Permission Bits and Windows NT Access Control Lists</A
-></DT
-><DD
-><DL
-><DT
->11.1. <A
-HREF="unix-permissions.html#AEN1605"
->Viewing and changing UNIX permissions using the NT
- security dialogs</A
-></DT
-><DT
->11.2. <A
-HREF="unix-permissions.html#AEN1614"
->How to view file security on a Samba share</A
-></DT
-><DT
->11.3. <A
-HREF="unix-permissions.html#AEN1625"
->Viewing file ownership</A
-></DT
-><DT
->11.4. <A
-HREF="unix-permissions.html#AEN1645"
->Viewing file or directory permissions</A
-></DT
-><DD
-><DL
-><DT
->11.4.1. <A
-HREF="unix-permissions.html#AEN1660"
->File Permissions</A
-></DT
-><DT
->11.4.2. <A
-HREF="unix-permissions.html#AEN1674"
->Directory Permissions</A
-></DT
-></DL
-></DD
-><DT
->11.5. <A
-HREF="unix-permissions.html#AEN1681"
->Modifying file or directory permissions</A
-></DT
-><DT
->11.6. <A
-HREF="unix-permissions.html#AEN1703"
->Interaction with the standard Samba create mask
- parameters</A
-></DT
-><DT
->11.7. <A
-HREF="unix-permissions.html#AEN1767"
->Interaction with the standard Samba file attribute
- mapping</A
-></DT
-></DL
-></DD
-><DT
->12. <A
-HREF="pam.html"
->Configuring PAM for distributed but centrally
-managed authentication</A
-></DT
-><DD
-><DL
-><DT
->12.1. <A
-HREF="pam.html#AEN1788"
->Samba and PAM</A
-></DT
-><DT
->12.2. <A
-HREF="pam.html#AEN1832"
->Distributed Authentication</A
-></DT
-><DT
->12.3. <A
-HREF="pam.html#AEN1839"
->PAM Configuration in smb.conf</A
-></DT
-></DL
-></DD
-><DT
->13. <A
-HREF="msdfs.html"
->Hosting a Microsoft Distributed File System tree on Samba</A
-></DT
-><DD
-><DL
-><DT
->13.1. <A
-HREF="msdfs.html#AEN1859"
->Instructions</A
-></DT
-><DD
-><DL
-><DT
->13.1.1. <A
-HREF="msdfs.html#AEN1894"
->Notes</A
-></DT
-></DL
-></DD
-></DL
-></DD
-><DT
->14. <A
-HREF="printing.html"
->Printing Support</A
-></DT
-><DD
-><DL
-><DT
->14.1. <A
-HREF="printing.html#AEN1920"
->Introduction</A
-></DT
-><DT
->14.2. <A
-HREF="printing.html#AEN1942"
->Configuration</A
-></DT
-><DD
-><DL
-><DT
->14.2.1. <A
-HREF="printing.html#AEN1950"
->Creating [print$]</A
-></DT
-><DT
->14.2.2. <A
-HREF="printing.html#AEN1985"
->Setting Drivers for Existing Printers</A
-></DT
-><DT
->14.2.3. <A
-HREF="printing.html#AEN2001"
->Support a large number of printers</A
-></DT
-><DT
->14.2.4. <A
-HREF="printing.html#AEN2012"
->Adding New Printers via the Windows NT APW</A
-></DT
-><DT
->14.2.5. <A
-HREF="printing.html#AEN2042"
->Samba and Printer Ports</A
-></DT
-></DL
-></DD
-><DT
->14.3. <A
-HREF="printing.html#AEN2050"
->The Imprints Toolset</A
-></DT
-><DD
-><DL
-><DT
->14.3.1. <A
-HREF="printing.html#AEN2054"
->What is Imprints?</A
-></DT
-><DT
->14.3.2. <A
-HREF="printing.html#AEN2064"
->Creating Printer Driver Packages</A
-></DT
-><DT
->14.3.3. <A
-HREF="printing.html#AEN2067"
->The Imprints server</A
-></DT
-><DT
->14.3.4. <A
-HREF="printing.html#AEN2071"
->The Installation Client</A
-></DT
-></DL
-></DD
-><DT
->14.4. <A
-HREF="printing.html#AEN2093"
->Diagnosis</A
-></DT
-><DD
-><DL
-><DT
->14.4.1. <A
-HREF="printing.html#AEN2095"
->Introduction</A
-></DT
-><DT
->14.4.2. <A
-HREF="printing.html#AEN2111"
->Debugging printer problems</A
-></DT
-><DT
->14.4.3. <A
-HREF="printing.html#AEN2120"
->What printers do I have?</A
-></DT
-><DT
->14.4.4. <A
-HREF="printing.html#AEN2128"
->Setting up printcap and print servers</A
-></DT
-><DT
->14.4.5. <A
-HREF="printing.html#AEN2156"
->Job sent, no output</A
-></DT
-><DT
->14.4.6. <A
-HREF="printing.html#AEN2167"
->Job sent, strange output</A
-></DT
-><DT
->14.4.7. <A
-HREF="printing.html#AEN2179"
->Raw PostScript printed</A
-></DT
-><DT
->14.4.8. <A
-HREF="printing.html#AEN2182"
->Advanced Printing</A
-></DT
-><DT
->14.4.9. <A
-HREF="printing.html#AEN2185"
->Real debugging</A
-></DT
-></DL
-></DD
-></DL
-></DD
-><DT
->15. <A
-HREF="winbind.html"
->Unified Logons between Windows NT and UNIX using Winbind</A
-></DT
-><DD
-><DL
-><DT
->15.1. <A
-HREF="winbind.html#AEN2225"
->Abstract</A
-></DT
-><DT
->15.2. <A
-HREF="winbind.html#AEN2229"
->Introduction</A
-></DT
-><DT
->15.3. <A
-HREF="winbind.html#AEN2242"
->What Winbind Provides</A
-></DT
-><DD
-><DL
-><DT
->15.3.1. <A
-HREF="winbind.html#AEN2249"
->Target Uses</A
-></DT
-></DL
-></DD
-><DT
->15.4. <A
-HREF="winbind.html#AEN2253"
->How Winbind Works</A
-></DT
-><DD
-><DL
-><DT
->15.4.1. <A
-HREF="winbind.html#AEN2258"
->Microsoft Remote Procedure Calls</A
-></DT
-><DT
->15.4.2. <A
-HREF="winbind.html#AEN2262"
->Name Service Switch</A
-></DT
-><DT
->15.4.3. <A
-HREF="winbind.html#AEN2278"
->Pluggable Authentication Modules</A
-></DT
-><DT
->15.4.4. <A
-HREF="winbind.html#AEN2286"
->User and Group ID Allocation</A
-></DT
-><DT
->15.4.5. <A
-HREF="winbind.html#AEN2290"
->Result Caching</A
-></DT
-></DL
-></DD
-><DT
->15.5. <A
-HREF="winbind.html#AEN2293"
->Installation and Configuration</A
-></DT
-><DD
-><DL
-><DT
->15.5.1. <A
-HREF="winbind.html#AEN2300"
->Introduction</A
-></DT
-><DT
->15.5.2. <A
-HREF="winbind.html#AEN2313"
->Requirements</A
-></DT
-><DT
->15.5.3. <A
-HREF="winbind.html#AEN2327"
->Testing Things Out</A
-></DT
-></DL
-></DD
-><DT
->15.6. <A
-HREF="winbind.html#AEN2542"
->Limitations</A
-></DT
-><DT
->15.7. <A
-HREF="winbind.html#AEN2552"
->Conclusion</A
-></DT
-></DL
-></DD
-><DT
->16. <A
-HREF="pdb-mysql.html"
->Passdb MySQL plugin</A
-></DT
-><DD
-><DL
-><DT
->16.1. <A
-HREF="pdb-mysql.html#AEN2566"
->Building</A
-></DT
-><DT
->16.2. <A
-HREF="pdb-mysql.html#AEN2572"
->Configuring</A
-></DT
-><DT
->16.3. <A
-HREF="pdb-mysql.html#AEN2589"
->Using plaintext passwords or encrypted password</A
-></DT
-><DT
->16.4. <A
-HREF="pdb-mysql.html#AEN2594"
->Getting non-column data from the table</A
-></DT
-></DL
-></DD
-><DT
->17. <A
-HREF="pdb-xml.html"
->Passdb XML plugin</A
-></DT
-><DD
-><DL
-><DT
->17.1. <A
-HREF="pdb-xml.html#AEN2613"
->Building</A
-></DT
-><DT
->17.2. <A
-HREF="pdb-xml.html#AEN2619"
->Usage</A
-></DT
-></DL
-></DD
-><DT
->18. <A
-HREF="vfs.html"
->Stackable VFS modules</A
-></DT
-><DD
-><DL
-><DT
->18.1. <A
-HREF="vfs.html#AEN2640"
->Introduction and configuration</A
-></DT
-><DT
->18.2. <A
-HREF="vfs.html#AEN2649"
->Included modules</A
-></DT
-><DD
-><DL
-><DT
->18.2.1. <A
-HREF="vfs.html#AEN2651"
->audit</A
-></DT
-><DT
->18.2.2. <A
-HREF="vfs.html#AEN2659"
->recycle</A
-></DT
-><DT
->18.2.3. <A
-HREF="vfs.html#AEN2696"
->netatalk</A
-></DT
-></DL
-></DD
-><DT
->18.3. <A
-HREF="vfs.html#AEN2703"
->VFS modules available elsewhere</A
-></DT
-><DD
-><DL
-><DT
->18.3.1. <A
-HREF="vfs.html#AEN2707"
->DatabaseFS</A
-></DT
-><DT
->18.3.2. <A
-HREF="vfs.html#AEN2715"
->vscan</A
-></DT
-></DL
-></DD
-></DL
-></DD
-><DT
->19. <A
-HREF="samba-ldap-howto.html"
->Storing Samba's User/Machine Account information in an LDAP Directory</A
-></DT
-><DD
-><DL
-><DT
->19.1. <A
-HREF="samba-ldap-howto.html#AEN2737"
->Purpose</A
-></DT
-><DT
->19.2. <A
-HREF="samba-ldap-howto.html#AEN2757"
->Introduction</A
-></DT
-><DT
->19.3. <A
-HREF="samba-ldap-howto.html#AEN2786"
->Supported LDAP Servers</A
-></DT
-><DT
->19.4. <A
-HREF="samba-ldap-howto.html#AEN2791"
->Schema and Relationship to the RFC 2307 posixAccount</A
-></DT
-><DT
->19.5. <A
-HREF="samba-ldap-howto.html#AEN2803"
->Configuring Samba with LDAP</A
-></DT
-><DD
-><DL
-><DT
->19.5.1. <A
-HREF="samba-ldap-howto.html#AEN2805"
->OpenLDAP configuration</A
-></DT
-><DT
->19.5.2. <A
-HREF="samba-ldap-howto.html#AEN2822"
->Configuring Samba</A
-></DT
-></DL
-></DD
-><DT
->19.6. <A
-HREF="samba-ldap-howto.html#AEN2850"
->Accounts and Groups management</A
-></DT
-><DT
->19.7. <A
-HREF="samba-ldap-howto.html#AEN2855"
->Security and sambaAccount</A
-></DT
-><DT
->19.8. <A
-HREF="samba-ldap-howto.html#AEN2875"
->LDAP specials attributes for sambaAccounts</A
-></DT
-><DT
->19.9. <A
-HREF="samba-ldap-howto.html#AEN2945"
->Example LDIF Entries for a sambaAccount</A
-></DT
-><DT
->19.10. <A
-HREF="samba-ldap-howto.html#AEN2953"
->Comments</A
-></DT
-></DL
-></DD
-><DT
->20. <A
-HREF="cvs-access.html"
->HOWTO Access Samba source code via CVS</A
-></DT
-><DD
-><DL
-><DT
->20.1. <A
-HREF="cvs-access.html#AEN2964"
->Introduction</A
-></DT
-><DT
->20.2. <A
-HREF="cvs-access.html#AEN2969"
->CVS Access to samba.org</A
-></DT
-><DD
-><DL
-><DT
->20.2.1. <A
-HREF="cvs-access.html#AEN2972"
->Access via CVSweb</A
-></DT
-><DT
->20.2.2. <A
-HREF="cvs-access.html#AEN2977"
->Access via cvs</A
-></DT
-></DL
-></DD
-></DL
-></DD
-><DT
->21. <A
-HREF="groupmapping.html"
->Group mapping HOWTO</A
-></DT
-><DT
->22. <A
-HREF="speed.html"
->Samba performance issues</A
-></DT
-><DD
-><DL
-><DT
->22.1. <A
-HREF="speed.html#AEN3055"
->Comparisons</A
-></DT
-><DT
->22.2. <A
-HREF="speed.html#AEN3061"
->Socket options</A
-></DT
-><DT
->22.3. <A
-HREF="speed.html#AEN3068"
->Read size</A
-></DT
-><DT
->22.4. <A
-HREF="speed.html#AEN3073"
->Max xmit</A
-></DT
-><DT
->22.5. <A
-HREF="speed.html#AEN3078"
->Log level</A
-></DT
-><DT
->22.6. <A
-HREF="speed.html#AEN3081"
->Read raw</A
-></DT
-><DT
->22.7. <A
-HREF="speed.html#AEN3086"
->Write raw</A
-></DT
-><DT
->22.8. <A
-HREF="speed.html#AEN3090"
->Slow Clients</A
-></DT
-><DT
->22.9. <A
-HREF="speed.html#AEN3094"
->Slow Logins</A
-></DT
-><DT
->22.10. <A
-HREF="speed.html#AEN3097"
->Client tuning</A
-></DT
-></DL
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="NAVFOOTER"
-><HR
-ALIGN="LEFT"
-WIDTH="100%"><TABLE
-SUMMARY="Footer navigation table"
-WIDTH="100%"
-BORDER="0"
-CELLPADDING="0"
-CELLSPACING="0"
-><TR
-><TD
-WIDTH="33%"
-ALIGN="left"
-VALIGN="top"
-><A
-HREF="domain-security.html"
-ACCESSKEY="P"
->Prev</A
-></TD
-><TD
-WIDTH="34%"
-ALIGN="center"
-VALIGN="top"
-><A
-HREF="samba-howto-collection.html"
-ACCESSKEY="H"
->Home</A
-></TD
-><TD
-WIDTH="33%"
-ALIGN="right"
-VALIGN="top"
-><A
-HREF="integrate-ms-networks.html"
-ACCESSKEY="N"
->Next</A
-></TD
-></TR
-><TR
-><TD
-WIDTH="33%"
-ALIGN="left"
-VALIGN="top"
->Samba as a NT4 domain member</TD
-><TD
-WIDTH="34%"
-ALIGN="center"
-VALIGN="top"
->&nbsp;</TD
-><TD
-WIDTH="33%"
-ALIGN="right"
-VALIGN="top"
->Integrating MS Windows networks with Samba</TD
-></TR
-></TABLE
-></DIV
-></BODY
-></HTML
-> \ No newline at end of file
+<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Part III. Advanced Configuration</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="previous" href="ClientConfig.html" title="Chapter 9. MS Windows Network Configuration Guide"><link rel="next" href="NetworkBrowsing.html" title="Chapter 10. Samba / MS Windows Network Browsing Guide"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Part III. Advanced Configuration</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="ClientConfig.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center"> </th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="NetworkBrowsing.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="part" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h1 class="title"><a name="optional"></a>Advanced Configuration</h1></div></div><div></div></div><div class="partintro" lang="en"><div><div><div><h1 class="title"><a name="id2901497"></a>Valuable Nuts and Bolts Information</h1></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+Samba has several features that you might want or might not want to use. The chapters in this part each cover specific Samba features.
+</p><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt>10. <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html">Samba / MS Windows Network Browsing Guide</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2903318">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2903397">What is Browsing?</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2903501">Discussion</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2903517">NetBIOS over TCP/IP</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2903680">TCP/IP - without NetBIOS</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2903811">DNS and Active Directory</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2903948">How Browsing Functions</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2904073">Setting up WORKGROUP Browsing</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2904295">Setting up DOMAIN Browsing</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#browse-force-master">Forcing samba to be the master</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2904565">Making samba the domain master</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2904720">Note about broadcast addresses</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2904738">Multiple interfaces</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2904767">Use of the Remote Announce parameter</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2904872">Use of the Remote Browse Sync parameter</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2904933">WINS - The Windows Internetworking Name Server</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2905084">Setting up a WINS server</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2905282">WINS Replication</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2905308">Static WINS Entries</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2905338">Helpful Hints</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2905352">Windows Networking Protocols</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2905425">Name Resolution Order</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2905546">Technical Overview of browsing</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2905593">Browsing support in samba</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2905700">Problem resolution</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2905779">Browsing across subnets</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2906423">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2906439">How can one flush the Samba NetBIOS name cache without restarting samba?</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2906467">My client reports &quot;This server is not configured to list shared resources&quot;</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>11. <a href="passdb.html">Account Information Databases</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2909924">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2910250">Technical Information</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2910313">Important Notes About Security</a></dt><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2910568">Mapping User Identifiers between MS Windows and Unix</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2910622">Account Management Tools</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2910654">The smbpasswd Command</a></dt><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2910920">The pdbedit Command</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2911072">Password Backends</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2911108">Plain Text</a></dt><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2911147">smbpasswd - Encrypted Password Database</a></dt><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2911255">tdbsam</a></dt><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2911282">ldapsam</a></dt><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2912800">MySQL</a></dt><dt><a href="passdb.html#XMLpassdb">XML</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2913602">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2913610">Users can not logon - Users not in Samba SAM</a></dt><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2913625">Users are being added to the wrong backend database</a></dt><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2913685">auth methods does not work</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>12. <a href="groupmapping.html">Mapping MS Windows and Unix Groups</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="groupmapping.html#id2921059">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="groupmapping.html#id2921161">Discussion</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="groupmapping.html#id2921352">Example Configuration</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="groupmapping.html#id2921416">Configuration Scripts</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="groupmapping.html#id2921430">Sample smb.conf add group script</a></dt><dt><a href="groupmapping.html#id2921498">Script to configure Group Mapping</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="groupmapping.html#id2921590">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="groupmapping.html#id2921606">Adding Groups Fails</a></dt><dt><a href="groupmapping.html#id2921666">Adding MS Windows Groups to MS Windows Groups Fails</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>13. <a href="AccessControls.html">File, Directory and Share Access Controls</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2919880">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2919917">File System Access Controls</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2919936">MS Windows NTFS Comparison with Unix File Systems</a></dt><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2920193">Managing Directories</a></dt><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2920288">File and Directory Access Control</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2920503">Share Definition Access Controls</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2921683">User and Group Based Controls</a></dt><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2921954">File and Directory Permissions Based Controls</a></dt><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2922199">Miscellaneous Controls</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2922415">Access Controls on Shares</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2922487">Share Permissions Management</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2922786">MS Windows Access Control Lists and Unix Interoperability</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2922794">Managing UNIX permissions Using NT Security Dialogs</a></dt><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2922832">Viewing File Security on a Samba Share</a></dt><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2922911">Viewing file ownership</a></dt><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2923033">Viewing File or Directory Permissions</a></dt><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2923261">Modifying file or directory permissions</a></dt><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2923413">Interaction with the standard Samba create mask
+ parameters</a></dt><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2923742">Interaction with the standard Samba file attribute
+ mapping</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2923818">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2923832">Users can not write to a public share</a></dt><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2924212">I have set force user and samba still makes root the owner of all the files
+ I touch!</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>14. <a href="locking.html">File and Record Locking</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="locking.html#id2927824">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="locking.html#id2927880">Discussion</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="locking.html#id2928010">Opportunistic Locking Overview</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="locking.html#id2928657">Samba Opportunistic Locking Control</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="locking.html#id2928766">Example Configuration</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="locking.html#id2929027">MS Windows Opportunistic Locking and Caching Controls</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="locking.html#id2929257">Workstation Service Entries</a></dt><dt><a href="locking.html#id2929284">Server Service Entries</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="locking.html#id2929364">Persistent Data Corruption</a></dt><dt><a href="locking.html#id2929393">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="locking.html#id2929468">locking.tdb error messages</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="locking.html#id2929498">Additional Reading</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>15. <a href="securing-samba.html">Securing Samba</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2931551">Introduction</a></dt><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2931584">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2931658">Technical Discussion of Protective Measures and Issues</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2931678">Using host based protection</a></dt><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2931748">User based protection</a></dt><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2931799">Using interface protection</a></dt><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2931852">Using a firewall</a></dt><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2931908">Using a IPC$ share deny</a></dt><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2931970">NTLMv2 Security</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2932010">Upgrading Samba</a></dt><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2932035">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2932053">Smbclient works on localhost, but the network is dead</a></dt><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2932078">Why can users access home directories of other users?</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>16. <a href="InterdomainTrusts.html">Interdomain Trust Relationships</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="InterdomainTrusts.html#id2932984">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="InterdomainTrusts.html#id2933012">Trust Relationship Background</a></dt><dt><a href="InterdomainTrusts.html#id2933096">Native MS Windows NT4 Trusts Configuration</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="InterdomainTrusts.html#id2933109">NT4 as the Trusting Domain (ie. creating the trusted account)</a></dt><dt><a href="InterdomainTrusts.html#id2933194">NT4 as the Trusted Domain (ie. creating trusted account's password)</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="InterdomainTrusts.html#id2933230">Configuring Samba NT-style Domain Trusts</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="InterdomainTrusts.html#id2933258">Samba-3 as the Trusting Domain</a></dt><dt><a href="InterdomainTrusts.html#id2933398">Samba-3 as the Trusted Domain</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="InterdomainTrusts.html#id2933530">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="InterdomainTrusts.html#id2933545">Tell me about Trust Relationships using Samba</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>17. <a href="msdfs.html">Hosting a Microsoft Distributed File System tree on Samba</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="msdfs.html#id2932887">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="msdfs.html#id2934539">Common Errors</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>18. <a href="printing.html">Classical Printing Support</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="printing.html#id2934100">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2934168">Technical Introduction</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="printing.html#id2934206">What happens if you send a Job from a Client</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2934276">Printing Related Configuration Parameters</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2934356">Parameters Recommended for Use</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2935524">Parameters for Backwards Compatibility</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2935632">Parameters no longer in use</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="printing.html#id2935725">A simple Configuration to Print with Samba-3</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="printing.html#id2935795">Verification of &quot;Settings in Use&quot; with testparm</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2935884">A little Experiment to warn you</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="printing.html#id2936190">Extended Sample Configuration to Print with Samba-3</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2936293">Detailed Explanation of the Example's Settings</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="printing.html#id2936306">The [global] Section</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2936689">The [printers] Section</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2937018">Any [my_printer_name] Section</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2937239">Print Commands</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2937289">Default Print Commands for various Unix Print Subsystems</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2937815">Setting up your own Print Commands</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="printing.html#id2938094">Innovations in Samba Printing since 2.2</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="printing.html#id2938259">Client Drivers on Samba Server for Point'n'Print</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2938411">The [printer$] Section is removed from Samba-3</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2938524">Creating the [print$] Share</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2938595">Parameters in the [print$] Section</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2938826">Subdirectory Structure in [print$]</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="printing.html#id2938986">Installing Drivers into [print$]</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="printing.html#id2939081">Setting Drivers for existing Printers with a Client GUI</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2939264">Setting Drivers for existing Printers with
+rpcclient</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="printing.html#id2940985">&quot;The Proof of the Pudding lies in the Eating&quot; (Client Driver Insta
+Procedure)</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="printing.html#id2941006">The first Client Driver Installation</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2941204">IMPORTANT! Setting Device Modes on new Printers</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2941493">Further Client Driver Install Procedures</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2941588">Always make first Client Connection as root or &quot;printer admin&quot;</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="printing.html#id2941730">Other Gotchas</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="printing.html#id2941763">Setting Default Print Options for the Client Drivers</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2942200">Supporting large Numbers of Printers</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2942503">Adding new Printers with the Windows NT APW</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2942746">Weird Error Message Cannot connect under a
+different Name</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2942844">Be careful when assembling Driver Files</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2943191">Samba and Printer Ports</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2943261">Avoiding the most common Misconfigurations of the Client Driver</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="printing.html#id2943283">The Imprints Toolset</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="printing.html#id2943329">What is Imprints?</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2943370">Creating Printer Driver Packages</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2943389">The Imprints Server</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2943413">The Installation Client</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="printing.html#id2943566">Add Network Printers at Logon without User Interaction</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2943895">The addprinter command</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2943940">Migration of &quot;Classical&quot; printing to Samba-3</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2944110">Publishing Printer Information in Active Directory or LDAP</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2944124">Common Errors and Problems</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="printing.html#id2944137">I give my root password but I don't get access</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2944170">My printjobs get spooled into the spooling directory, but then get lost</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>19. <a href="CUPS-printing.html">CUPS Printing Support in Samba 3.0</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2953147">Introduction</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2953154">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2953364">Overview</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2953418">Basic Configuration of CUPS support</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2953497">Linking of smbd with libcups.so</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2953643">Simple smb.conf Settings for CUPS</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2953725">More complex smb.conf Settings for
+CUPS</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2953842">Advanced Configuration</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2953863">Central spooling vs. &quot;Peer-to-Peer&quot; printing</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2953890">CUPS/Samba as a &quot;spooling-only&quot; Print Server; &quot;raw&quot; printing
+with Vendor Drivers on Windows Clients</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2953927">Driver Installation Methods on Windows Clients</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2953985">Explicitly enable &quot;raw&quot; printing for
+application/octet-stream!</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2954145">Three familiar Methods for driver upload plus a new one</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2954239">Using CUPS/Samba in an advanced Way -- intelligent printing
+with PostScript Driver Download</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2954314">GDI on Windows -- PostScript on Unix</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2954359">Windows Drivers, GDI and EMF</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2954459">Unix Printfile Conversion and GUI Basics</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2954529">PostScript and Ghostscript</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2954627">Ghostscript -- the Software RIP for non-PostScript Printers</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2954723">PostScript Printer Description (PPD) Specification</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2954792">CUPS can use all Windows-formatted Vendor PPDs</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2954881">CUPS also uses PPDs for non-PostScript Printers</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2954904">The CUPS Filtering Architecture</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2955044">MIME types and CUPS Filters</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2955231">MIME type Conversion Rules</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2955348">Filter Requirements</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2955518">Prefilters</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2955604">pstops</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2955706">pstoraster</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2955862">imagetops and imagetoraster</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2955918">rasterto [printerspecific]</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2956002">CUPS Backends</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2956341">cupsomatic/Foomatic -- how do they fit into the Picture?</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2956453">The Complete Picture</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2956469">mime.convs</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2956522">&quot;Raw&quot; printing</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2956576">&quot;application/octet-stream&quot; printing</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2956798">PostScript Printer Descriptions (PPDs) for non-PS Printers</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2957026">Difference between cupsomatic/foomatic-rip and
+native CUPS printing</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2957182">Examples for filtering Chains</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2957413">Sources of CUPS drivers / PPDs</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2957541">Printing with Interface Scripts</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2957617">Network printing (purely Windows)</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2957632">From Windows Clients to an NT Print Server</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2957672">Driver Execution on the Client</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2957732">Driver Execution on the Server</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2957793">Network Printing (Windows clients -- UNIX/Samba Print
+Servers)</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2957814">From Windows Clients to a CUPS/Samba Print Server</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2957980">Samba receiving Jobfiles and passing them to CUPS</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2958056">Network PostScript RIP: CUPS Filters on Server -- clients use
+PostScript Driver with CUPS-PPDs</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2958111">PPDs for non-PS Printers on UNIX</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2958152">PPDs for non-PS Printers on Windows</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2958218">Windows Terminal Servers (WTS) as CUPS Clients</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2958235">Printer Drivers running in &quot;Kernel Mode&quot; cause many
+Problems</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2958269">Workarounds impose Heavy Limitations</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2958291">CUPS: a &quot;Magical Stone&quot;?</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2958317">PostScript Drivers with no major problems -- even in Kernel
+Mode</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2958351"> Setting up CUPS for driver Download</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2958370">cupsaddsmb: the unknown Utility</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2958462">Prepare your smb.conf for
+cupsaddsmb</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2958508">CUPS Package of &quot;PostScript Driver for WinNT/2k/XP&quot;</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2958706">Recognize the different Driver Files</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2958764">Acquiring the Adobe Driver Files</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2958797">ESP Print Pro Package of &quot;PostScript Driver for
+WinNT/2k/XP&quot;</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2958846">Caveats to be considered</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2959068">What are the Benefits of using the &quot;CUPS PostScript Driver for
+Windows NT/2k/XP&quot; as compared to the Adobe Driver?</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2959250">Run &quot;cupsaddsmb&quot; (quiet Mode)</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2959351">Run &quot;cupsaddsmb&quot; with verbose Output</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2959577">Understanding cupsaddsmb</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2959672">How to recognize if cupsaddsm completed successfully</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2959759">cupsaddsmb with a Samba PDC</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2959794">cupsaddsmb Flowchart</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2959847">Installing the PostScript Driver on a Client</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2959960">Avoiding critical PostScript Driver Settings on the
+Client</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2960094">Installing PostScript Driver Files manually (using
+rpcclient)</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2960209">A Check of the rpcclient man Page</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2960322">Understanding the rpcclient man Page</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2960412">Producing an Example by querying a Windows Box</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2960518">What is required for adddriver and setdriver to succeed</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2960680">Manual Commandline Driver Installation in 15 little Steps</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2961331">Troubleshooting revisited</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2961433">The printing *.tdb Files</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2961536">Trivial DataBase Files</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2961606">Binary Format</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2961668">Losing *.tdb Files</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2961726">Using tdbbackup</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2961794">CUPS Print Drivers from Linuxprinting.org</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2961901">foomatic-rip and Foomatic explained</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2962572">foomatic-rip and Foomatic-PPD Download and Installation</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2963032">Page Accounting with CUPS</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2963064">Setting up Quotas</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2963096">Correct and incorrect Accounting</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2963137">Adobe and CUPS PostScript Drivers for Windows Clients</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2963208">The page_log File Syntax</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2963309">Possible Shortcomings</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2963381">Future Developments</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2963429">Other Accounting Tools</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2963444">Additional Material</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2963637">Auto-Deletion or Preservation of CUPS Spool Files</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2963683">CUPS Configuration Settings explained</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2963766">Pre-conditions</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2963827">Manual Configuration</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2963844">When not to use Samba to print to
+CUPS</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2963861">In Case of Trouble.....</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2963897">Where to find Documentation</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2963910">How to ask for Help</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2963922">Where to find Help</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2963936">Appendix</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2963943">Printing from CUPS to Windows attached
+Printers</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2964172">More CUPS filtering Chains</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2964478">Trouble Shooting Guidelines to fix typical Samba printing
+Problems</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2965597">An Overview of the CUPS Printing Processes</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>20. <a href="VFS.html">Stackable VFS modules</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="VFS.html#id2977722">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="VFS.html#id2977740">Discussion</a></dt><dt><a href="VFS.html#id2977794">Included modules</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="VFS.html#id2977801">audit</a></dt><dt><a href="VFS.html#id2977840">extd_audit</a></dt><dt><a href="VFS.html#id2977964">fake_perms</a></dt><dt><a href="VFS.html#id2977983">recycle</a></dt><dt><a href="VFS.html#id2978121">netatalk</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="VFS.html#id2978166">VFS modules available elsewhere</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="VFS.html#id2978188">DatabaseFS</a></dt><dt><a href="VFS.html#id2978243">vscan</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="VFS.html#id2978273">Common Errors</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>21. <a href="winbind.html">Integrated Logon Support using Winbind</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2979118">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2979146">Introduction</a></dt><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2979218">What Winbind Provides</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2979278">Target Uses</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2979309">How Winbind Works</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2979337">Microsoft Remote Procedure Calls</a></dt><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2979371">Microsoft Active Directory Services</a></dt><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2979394">Name Service Switch</a></dt><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2979530">Pluggable Authentication Modules</a></dt><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2979602">User and Group ID Allocation</a></dt><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2979637">Result Caching</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2979664">Installation and Configuration</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2979692">Introduction</a></dt><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2979768">Requirements</a></dt><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2979861">Testing Things Out</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2981479">Conclusion</a></dt><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2981498">Common Errors</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>22. <a href="AdvancedNetworkManagement.html">Advanced Network Manangement</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="AdvancedNetworkManagement.html#id2983992">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="AdvancedNetworkManagement.html#id2984181">Remote Server Administration</a></dt><dt><a href="AdvancedNetworkManagement.html#id2984280">Remote Desktop Management</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="AdvancedNetworkManagement.html#id2984297">Remote Management from NoMachines.Com</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="AdvancedNetworkManagement.html#id2984509">Network Logon Script Magic</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="AdvancedNetworkManagement.html#id2984705">Adding printers without user intervention</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="AdvancedNetworkManagement.html#id2984738">Common Errors</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>23. <a href="PolicyMgmt.html">System and Account Policies</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2983801">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2983856">Creating and Managing System Policies</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2985639">Windows 9x/Me Policies</a></dt><dt><a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2985734">Windows NT4 Style Policy Files</a></dt><dt><a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2985867">MS Windows 200x / XP Professional Policies</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2986119">Managing Account/User Policies</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2986220">Samba Editreg Toolset</a></dt><dt><a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2986240">Windows NT4/200x</a></dt><dt><a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2986261">Samba PDC</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2986305">System Startup and Logon Processing Overview</a></dt><dt><a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2986452">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2986466">Policy Does Not Work</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>24. <a href="ProfileMgmt.html">Desktop Profile Management</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2987673">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2987707">Roaming Profiles</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2987748">Samba Configuration for Profile Handling</a></dt><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2988153">Windows Client Profile Configuration Information</a></dt><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2989324">Sharing Profiles between W9x/Me and NT4/200x/XP workstations</a></dt><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2989389">Profile Migration from Windows NT4/200x Server to Samba</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2989654">Mandatory profiles</a></dt><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2989712">Creating/Managing Group Profiles</a></dt><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2989758">Default Profile for Windows Users</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2989778">MS Windows 9x/Me</a></dt><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2989926">MS Windows NT4 Workstation</a></dt><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2990480">MS Windows 200x/XP</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2990984">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2990997">How does one set up roaming profiles for just one (or a few) user/s or group/s?</a></dt><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2991060">Can NOT use Roaming Profiles</a></dt><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2991282">Changing the default profile</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>25. <a href="pam.html">PAM based Distributed Authentication</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="pam.html#id2995226">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="pam.html#id2995494">Technical Discussion</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="pam.html#id2995512">PAM Configuration Syntax</a></dt><dt><a href="pam.html#id2996183">Example System Configurations</a></dt><dt><a href="pam.html#id2996484">smb.conf PAM Configuration</a></dt><dt><a href="pam.html#id2996541">Remote CIFS Authentication using winbindd.so</a></dt><dt><a href="pam.html#id2996625">Password Synchronization using pam_smbpass.so</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="pam.html#id2996992">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="pam.html#id2997005">pam_winbind problem</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>26. <a href="integrate-ms-networks.html">Integrating MS Windows networks with Samba</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2999128">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2999152">Background Information</a></dt><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2999197">Name Resolution in a pure Unix/Linux world</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2999254">/etc/hosts</a></dt><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2999378">/etc/resolv.conf</a></dt><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2999422">/etc/host.conf</a></dt><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2999464">/etc/nsswitch.conf</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2999552">Name resolution as used within MS Windows networking</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2999700">The NetBIOS Name Cache</a></dt><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2999745">The LMHOSTS file</a></dt><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2999989">HOSTS file</a></dt><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id3000021">DNS Lookup</a></dt><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id3000046">WINS Lookup</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id3000117">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id3000133">My Boomerang Won't Come Back</a></dt><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id3000164">Very Slow Network Connections</a></dt><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id3000216">Samba server name change problem</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>27. <a href="unicode.html">Unicode/Charsets</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="unicode.html#id3001334">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="unicode.html#id3001536">What are charsets and unicode?</a></dt><dt><a href="unicode.html#id3001606">Samba and charsets</a></dt><dt><a href="unicode.html#id3001706">Conversion from old names</a></dt><dt><a href="unicode.html#id3001751">Japanese charsets</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>28. <a href="Backup.html">Samba Backup Techniques</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="Backup.html#id3000954">Note</a></dt><dt><a href="Backup.html#id3000979">Features and Benefits</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>29. <a href="SambaHA.html">High Availability Options</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="SambaHA.html#id3002521">Note</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="ClientConfig.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="index.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="NetworkBrowsing.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 9. MS Windows Network Configuration Guide </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="index.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 10. Samba / MS Windows Network Browsing Guide</td></tr></table></div></body></html>
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/pam.html b/docs/htmldocs/pam.html
index ba2bf6c922..6fa5727720 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/pam.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/pam.html
@@ -1,158 +1,290 @@
-<!DOCTYPE HTML PUBLIC "-//W3C//DTD HTML 4.01 Transitional//EN">
-<HTML
-><HEAD
-><TITLE
->Configuring PAM for distributed but centrally
-managed authentication</TITLE
-><META
-NAME="GENERATOR"
-CONTENT="Modular DocBook HTML Stylesheet Version 1.76b+
-"><LINK
-REL="HOME"
-TITLE="SAMBA Project Documentation"
-HREF="samba-howto-collection.html"><LINK
-REL="UP"
-TITLE="Optional configuration"
-HREF="optional.html"><LINK
-REL="PREVIOUS"
-TITLE="UNIX Permission Bits and Windows NT Access Control Lists"
-HREF="unix-permissions.html"><LINK
-REL="NEXT"
-TITLE="Hosting a Microsoft Distributed File System tree on Samba"
-HREF="msdfs.html"></HEAD
-><BODY
-CLASS="CHAPTER"
-BGCOLOR="#FFFFFF"
-TEXT="#000000"
-LINK="#0000FF"
-VLINK="#840084"
-ALINK="#0000FF"
-><DIV
-CLASS="NAVHEADER"
-><TABLE
-SUMMARY="Header navigation table"
-WIDTH="100%"
-BORDER="0"
-CELLPADDING="0"
-CELLSPACING="0"
-><TR
-><TH
-COLSPAN="3"
-ALIGN="center"
->SAMBA Project Documentation</TH
-></TR
-><TR
-><TD
-WIDTH="10%"
-ALIGN="left"
-VALIGN="bottom"
-><A
-HREF="unix-permissions.html"
-ACCESSKEY="P"
->Prev</A
-></TD
-><TD
-WIDTH="80%"
-ALIGN="center"
-VALIGN="bottom"
-></TD
-><TD
-WIDTH="10%"
-ALIGN="right"
-VALIGN="bottom"
-><A
-HREF="msdfs.html"
-ACCESSKEY="N"
->Next</A
-></TD
-></TR
-></TABLE
-><HR
-ALIGN="LEFT"
-WIDTH="100%"></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="CHAPTER"
-><H1
-><A
-NAME="PAM">Chapter 12. Configuring PAM for distributed but centrally
-managed authentication</H1
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><H1
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN1788">12.1. Samba and PAM</H1
-><P
->A number of Unix systems (eg: Sun Solaris), as well as the
-xxxxBSD family and Linux, now utilize the Pluggable Authentication
-Modules (PAM) facility to provide all authentication,
-authorization and resource control services. Prior to the
-introduction of PAM, a decision to use an alternative to
-the system password database (<TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/passwd</TT
->)
-would require the provision of alternatives for all programs that provide
-security services. Such a choice would involve provision of
-alternatives to such programs as: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->login</B
->,
-<B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->passwd</B
->, <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->chown</B
->, etc.</P
-><P
->PAM provides a mechanism that disconnects these security programs
-from the underlying authentication/authorization infrastructure.
-PAM is configured either through one file <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/pam.conf</TT
-> (Solaris),
-or by editing individual files that are located in <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/pam.d</TT
->.</P
-><P
->The following is an example <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/pam.d/login</TT
-> configuration file.
+<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 25. PAM based Distributed Authentication</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="optional.html" title="Part III. Advanced Configuration"><link rel="previous" href="ProfileMgmt.html" title="Chapter 24. Desktop Profile Management"><link rel="next" href="integrate-ms-networks.html" title="Chapter 26. Integrating MS Windows networks with Samba"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 25. PAM based Distributed Authentication</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="ProfileMgmt.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part III. Advanced Configuration</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="integrate-ms-networks.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="pam"></a>Chapter 25. PAM based Distributed Authentication</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email">&lt;<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>&gt;</tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Stephen</span> <span class="surname">Langasek</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><div class="address"><p><tt class="email">&lt;<a href="mailto:vorlon@netexpress.net">vorlon@netexpress.net</a>&gt;</tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">May 31, 2003</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="pam.html#id2995226">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="pam.html#id2995494">Technical Discussion</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="pam.html#id2995512">PAM Configuration Syntax</a></dt><dt><a href="pam.html#id2996183">Example System Configurations</a></dt><dt><a href="pam.html#id2996484">smb.conf PAM Configuration</a></dt><dt><a href="pam.html#id2996541">Remote CIFS Authentication using winbindd.so</a></dt><dt><a href="pam.html#id2996625">Password Synchronization using pam_smbpass.so</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="pam.html#id2996992">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="pam.html#id2997005">pam_winbind problem</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><p>
+This chapter you should help you to deploy winbind based authentication on any PAM enabled
+Unix/Linux system. Winbind can be used to enable user level application access authentication
+from any MS Windows NT Domain, MS Windows 200x Active Directory based domain, or any Samba
+based domain environment. It will also help you to configure PAM based local host access
+controls that are appropriate to your Samba configuration.
+</p><p>
+In addition to knowing how to configure winbind into PAM, you will learn generic PAM managment
+possibilities and in particular how to deploy tools like pam_smbpass.so to your adavantage.
+</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p>
+The use of Winbind require more than PAM configuration alone. Please refer to <a href="winbind.html" title="Chapter 21. Integrated Logon Support using Winbind">the Winbind chapter</a>.
+</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2995226"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+A number of Unix systems (eg: Sun Solaris), as well as the xxxxBSD family and Linux,
+now utilize the Pluggable Authentication Modules (PAM) facility to provide all authentication,
+authorization and resource control services. Prior to the introduction of PAM, a decision
+to use an alternative to the system password database (<tt class="filename">/etc/passwd</tt>)
+would require the provision of alternatives for all programs that provide security services.
+Such a choice would involve provision of alternatives to such programs as: <b class="command">login</b>,
+<b class="command">passwd</b>, <b class="command">chown</b>, etc.
+</p><p>
+PAM provides a mechanism that disconnects these security programs from the underlying
+authentication/authorization infrastructure. PAM is configured either through one file
+<tt class="filename">/etc/pam.conf</tt> (Solaris), or by editing individual files that are
+located in <tt class="filename">/etc/pam.d</tt>.
+</p><p>
+On PAM enabled Unix/Linux systems it is an easy matter to configure the system to use any
+authentication backend, so long as the appropriate dynamically loadable library modules
+are available for it. The backend may be local to the system, or may be centralised on a
+remote server.
+</p><p>
+PAM support modules are available for:
+</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term"><tt class="filename">/etc/passwd</tt></span></dt><dd><p>-</p><p>
+ There are several PAM modules that interact with this standard Unix user
+ database. The most common are called: pam_unix.so, pam_unix2.so, pam_pwdb.so
+ and pam_userdb.so.
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term">Kerberos</span></dt><dd><p>-</p><p>
+ The pam_krb5.so module allows the use of any Kerberos compliant server.
+ This tool is used to access MIT Kerberos, Heimdal Kerberos, and potentially
+ Microsoft Active Directory (if enabled).
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term">LDAP</span></dt><dd><p>-</p><p>
+ The pam_ldap.so module allows the use of any LDAP v2 or v3 compatible backend
+ server. Commonly used LDAP backend servers include: OpenLDAP v2.0 and v2.1,
+ Sun ONE iDentity server, Novell eDirectory server, Microsoft Active Directory.
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term">NetWare Bindery</span></dt><dd><p>-</p><p>
+ The pam_ncp_auth.so module allows authentication off any bindery enabled
+ NetWare Core Protocol based server.
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term">SMB Password</span></dt><dd><p>-</p><p>
+ This module, called pam_smbpass.so, will allow user authentication off
+ the passdb backend that is configured in the Samba <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file.
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term">SMB Server</span></dt><dd><p>-</p><p>
+ The pam_smb_auth.so module is the original MS Windows networking authentication
+ tool. This module has been somewhat outdated by the Winbind module.
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term">Winbind</span></dt><dd><p>-</p><p>
+ The pam_winbind.so module allows Samba to obtain authentication from any
+ MS Windows Domain Controller. It can just as easily be used to authenticate
+ users for access to any PAM enabled application.
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term">RADIUS</span></dt><dd><p>-</p><p>
+ There is a PAM RADIUS (Remote Access Dial-In User Service) authentication
+ module. In most cases the administrator will need to locate the source code
+ for this tool and compile and install it themselves. RADIUS protocols are
+ used by many routers and terminal servers.
+ </p></dd></dl></div><p>
+Of the above, Samba provides the pam_smbpasswd.so and the pam_winbind.so modules alone.
+</p><p>
+Once configured, these permit a remarkable level of flexibility in the location and use
+of distributed samba domain controllers that can provide wide are network bandwidth
+efficient authentication services for PAM capable systems. In effect, this allows the
+deployment of centrally managed and maintained distributed authentication from a single
+user account database.
+</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2995494"></a>Technical Discussion</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+PAM is designed to provide the system administrator with a great deal of flexibility in
+configuration of the privilege granting applications of their system. The local
+configuration of system security controlled by PAM is contained in one of two places:
+either the single system file, /etc/pam.conf; or the /etc/pam.d/ directory.
+</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2995512"></a>PAM Configuration Syntax</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+In this section we discuss the correct syntax of and generic options respected by entries to these files.
+PAM specific tokens in the configuration file are case insensitive. The module paths, however, are case
+sensitive since they indicate a file's name and reflect the case dependence of typical file-systems.
+The case-sensitivity of the arguments to any given module is defined for each module in turn.
+</p><p>
+In addition to the lines described below, there are two special characters provided for the convenience
+of the system administrator: comments are preceded by a `#' and extend to the next end-of-line; also,
+module specification lines may be extended with a `\' escaped newline.
+</p><p>
+If the PAM authentication module (loadable link library file) is located in the
+default location then it is not necessary to specify the path. In the case of
+Linux, the default location is <tt class="filename">/lib/security</tt>. If the module
+is located outside the default then the path must be specified as:
+</p><p>
+</p><pre class="screen">
+auth required /other_path/pam_strange_module.so
+</pre><p>
+</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2995568"></a>Anatomy of <tt class="filename">/etc/pam.d</tt> Entries</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+The remaining information in this subsection was taken from the documentation of the Linux-PAM
+project. For more information on PAM, see
+<a href="http://ftp.kernel.org/pub/linux/libs/pam/" target="_top">
+http://ftp.kernel.org/pub/linux/libs/pam</a> The Official Linux-PAM home page.
+</p><p>
+A general configuration line of the /etc/pam.conf file has the following form:
+</p><p>
+</p><pre class="screen">
+service-name module-type control-flag module-path args
+</pre><p>
+</p><p>
+Below, we explain the meaning of each of these tokens. The second (and more recently adopted)
+way of configuring Linux-PAM is via the contents of the <tt class="filename">/etc/pam.d/</tt> directory.
+Once we have explained the meaning of the above tokens, we will describe this method.
+</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">service-name</span></dt><dd><p>-</p><p>
+ The name of the service associated with this entry. Frequently the service name is the conventional
+ name of the given application. For example, `ftpd', `rlogind' and `su', etc. .
+ </p><p>
+ There is a special service-name, reserved for defining a default authentication mechanism. It has
+ the name `OTHER' and may be specified in either lower or upper case characters. Note, when there
+ is a module specified for a named service, the `OTHER' entries are ignored.
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term">module-type</span></dt><dd><p>-</p><p>
+ One of (currently) four types of module. The four types are as follows:
+ </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>
+ <span class="emphasis"><em>auth:</em></span> this module type provides two aspects of authenticating the user.
+ Firstly, it establishes that the user is who they claim to be, by instructing the application
+ to prompt the user for a password or other means of identification. Secondly, the module can
+ grant group membership (independently of the <tt class="filename">/etc/groups</tt> file discussed
+ above) or other privileges through its credential granting properties.
+ </p></li><li><p>
+ <span class="emphasis"><em>account:</em></span> this module performs non-authentication based account management.
+ It is typically used to restrict/permit access to a service based on the time of day, currently
+ available system resources (maximum number of users) or perhaps the location of the applicant
+ user `root' login only on the console.
+ </p></li><li><p>
+ <span class="emphasis"><em>session:</em></span> primarily, this module is associated with doing things that need
+ to be done for the user before/after they can be given service. Such things include the loggin
+ of information concerning the opening/closing of some data exchange with a user, mountin
+ directories, etc.
+ </p></li><li><p>
+ <span class="emphasis"><em>password:</em></span> this last module type is required for updating the authentication
+ token associated with the user. Typically, there is one module for each `challenge/response'
+ based authentication (auth) module-type.
+ </p></li></ul></div></dd><dt><span class="term">control-flag</span></dt><dd><p>-</p><p>
+ The control-flag is used to indicate how the PAM library will react to the success or failure of the
+ module it is associated with. Since modules can be stacked (modules of the same type execute in series,
+ one after another), the control-flags determine the relative importance of each module. The application
+ is not made aware of the individual success or failure of modules listed in the
+ <tt class="filename">/etc/pam.conf</tt> file. Instead, it receives a summary success or fail response from
+ the Linux-PAM library. The order of execution of these modules is that of the entries in the
+ <tt class="filename">/etc/pam.conf</tt> file; earlier entries are executed before later ones.
+ As of Linux-PAM v0.60, this control-flag can be defined with one of two syntaxes.
+ </p><p>
+ The simpler (and historical) syntax for the control-flag is a single keyword defined to indicate the
+ severity of concern associated with the success or failure of a specific module. There are four such
+ <span class="emphasis"><em>keywords: required, requisite, sufficient and optional</em></span>.
+ </p><p>
+ The Linux-PAM library interprets these keywords in the following manner:
+ </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>
+ <span class="emphasis"><em>required:</em></span> this indicates that the success of the module is required for the
+ module-type facility to succeed. Failure of this module will not be apparent to the user until all
+ of the remaining modules (of the same module-type) have been executed.
+ </p></li><li><p>
+ <span class="emphasis"><em>requisite:</em></span> like required, however, in the case that such a module returns a
+ failure, control is directly returned to the application. The return value is that associated with
+ the first required or requisite module to fail. Note, this flag can be used to protect against the
+ possibility of a user getting the opportunity to enter a password over an unsafe medium. It is
+ conceivable that such behavior might inform an attacker of valid accounts on a system. This
+ possibility should be weighed against the not insignificant concerns of exposing a sensitive
+ password in a hostile environment.
+ </p></li><li><p>
+ <span class="emphasis"><em>sufficient:</em></span> the success of this module is deemed `sufficient' to satisfy
+ the Linux-PAM library that this module-type has succeeded in its purpose. In the event that no
+ previous required module has failed, no more `stacked' modules of this type are invoked. (Note,
+ in this case subsequent required modules are not invoked.). A failure of this module is not deemed
+ as fatal to satisfying the application that this module-type has succeeded.
+ </p></li><li><p>
+ <span class="emphasis"><em>optional:</em></span> as its name suggests, this control-flag marks the module as not
+ being critical to the success or failure of the user's application for service. In general,
+ Linux-PAM ignores such a module when determining if the module stack will succeed or fail.
+ However, in the absence of any definite successes or failures of previous or subsequent stacked
+ modules this module will determine the nature of the response to the application. One example of
+ this latter case, is when the other modules return something like PAM_IGNORE.
+ </p></li></ul></div><p>
+ The more elaborate (newer) syntax is much more specific and gives the administrator a great deal of control
+ over how the user is authenticated. This form of the control flag is delimeted with square brackets and
+ consists of a series of value=action tokens:
+ </p><pre class="screen">
+ [value1=action1 value2=action2 ...]
+ </pre><p>
+ Here, valueI is one of the following return values: success; open_err; symbol_err; service_err;
+ system_err; buf_err; perm_denied; auth_err; cred_insufficient; authinfo_unavail; user_unknown; maxtries;
+ new_authtok_reqd; acct_expired; session_err; cred_unavail; cred_expired; cred_err; no_module_data; conv_err;
+ authtok_err; authtok_recover_err; authtok_lock_busy; authtok_disable_aging; try_again; ignore; abort;
+ authtok_expired; module_unknown; bad_item; and default. The last of these (default) can be used to set
+ the action for those return values that are not explicitly defined.
+ </p><p>
+ The actionI can be a positive integer or one of the following tokens: ignore; ok; done; bad; die; and reset.
+ A positive integer, J, when specified as the action, can be used to indicate that the next J modules of the
+ current module-type will be skipped. In this way, the administrator can develop a moderately sophisticated
+ stack of modules with a number of different paths of execution. Which path is taken can be determined by the
+ reactions of individual modules.
+ </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>
+ <span class="emphasis"><em>ignore:</em></span> when used with a stack of modules, the module's return status will not
+ contribute to the return code the application obtains.
+ </p></li><li><p>
+ <span class="emphasis"><em>bad:</em></span> this action indicates that the return code should be thought of as indicative
+ of the module failing. If this module is the first in the stack to fail, its status value will be used
+ for that of the whole stack.
+ </p></li><li><p>
+ <span class="emphasis"><em>die:</em></span> equivalent to bad with the side effect of terminating the module stack and
+ PAM immediately returning to the application.
+ </p></li><li><p>
+ <span class="emphasis"><em>ok:</em></span> this tells PAM that the administrator thinks this return code should
+ contribute directly to the return code of the full stack of modules. In other words, if the former
+ state of the stack would lead to a return of PAM_SUCCESS, the module's return code will override
+ this value. Note, if the former state of the stack holds some value that is indicative of a modules
+ failure, this 'ok' value will not be used to override that value.
+ </p></li><li><p>
+ <span class="emphasis"><em>done:</em></span> equivalent to ok with the side effect of terminating the module stack and
+ PAM immediately returning to the application.
+ </p></li><li><p>
+ <span class="emphasis"><em>reset:</em></span> clear all memory of the state of the module stack and start again with
+ the next stacked module.
+ </p></li></ul></div><p>
+ Each of the four keywords: required; requisite; sufficient; and optional, have an equivalent expression in
+ terms of the [...] syntax. They are as follows:
+ </p><p>
+ </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>
+ required is equivalent to [success=ok new_authtok_reqd=ok ignore=ignore default=bad]
+ </p></li><li><p>
+ requisite is equivalent to [success=ok new_authtok_reqd=ok ignore=ignore default=die]
+ </p></li><li><p>
+ sufficient is equivalent to [success=done new_authtok_reqd=done default=ignore]
+ </p></li><li><p>
+ optional is equivalent to [success=ok new_authtok_reqd=ok default=ignore]
+ </p></li></ul></div><p>
+ </p><p>
+ Just to get a feel for the power of this new syntax, here is a taste of what you can do with it. With Linux-PAM-0.63,
+ the notion of client plug-in agents was introduced. This is something that makes it possible for PAM to support
+ machine-machine authentication using the transport protocol inherent to the client/server application. With the
+ <span class="emphasis"><em>[ ... value=action ... ]</em></span> control syntax, it is possible for an application to be configured
+ to support binary prompts with compliant clients, but to gracefully fall over into an alternative authentication
+ mode for older, legacy, applications.
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term">module-path</span></dt><dd><p>-</p><p>
+ The path-name of the dynamically loadable object file; the pluggable module itself. If the first character of the
+ module path is `/', it is assumed to be a complete path. If this is not the case, the given module path is appended
+ to the default module path: <tt class="filename">/lib/security</tt> (but see the notes above).
+ </p><p>
+ The args are a list of tokens that are passed to the module when it is invoked. Much like arguments to a typical
+ Linux shell command. Generally, valid arguments are optional and are specific to any given module. Invalid arguments
+ are ignored by a module, however, when encountering an invalid argument, the module is required to write an error
+ to syslog(3). For a list of generic options see the next section.
+ </p><p>
+ Note, if you wish to include spaces in an argument, you should surround that argument with square brackets. For example:
+ </p><pre class="screen">
+squid auth required pam_mysql.so user=passwd_query passwd=mada \
+ db=eminence [query=select user_name from internet_service where \
+ user_name='%u' and password=PASSWORD('%p') and \
+ service='web_proxy']
+</pre><p>
+ Note, when using this convention, you can include `[' characters inside the string, and if you wish to include a `]'
+ character inside the string that will survive the argument parsing, you should use `\['. In other words:
+ </p><pre class="screen">
+[..[..\]..] --&gt; ..[..]..
+</pre><p>
+ Any line in (one of) the configuration file(s), that is not formatted correctly, will generally tend (erring on the
+ side of caution) to make the authentication process fail. A corresponding error is written to the system log files
+ with a call to syslog(3).
+ </p></dd></dl></div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2996183"></a>Example System Configurations</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+The following is an example <tt class="filename">/etc/pam.d/login</tt> configuration file.
This example had all options been uncommented is probably not usable
as it stacks many conditions before allowing successful completion
of the login process. Essentially all conditions can be disabled
-by commenting them out except the calls to <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->pam_pwdb.so</TT
->.</P
-><P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
->#%PAM-1.0
+by commenting them out except the calls to <tt class="filename">pam_pwdb.so</tt>.
+</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2996213"></a>PAM: original login config</h4></div></div><div></div></div><pre class="screen">
+#%PAM-1.0
# The PAM configuration file for the `login' service
#
-auth required pam_securetty.so
-auth required pam_nologin.so
-# auth required pam_dialup.so
-# auth optional pam_mail.so
-auth required pam_pwdb.so shadow md5
-# account requisite pam_time.so
-account required pam_pwdb.so
-session required pam_pwdb.so
-# session optional pam_lastlog.so
-# password required pam_cracklib.so retry=3
-password required pam_pwdb.so shadow md5</PRE
-></P
-><P
->PAM allows use of replacable modules. Those available on a
-sample system include:</P
-><P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
->$ /bin/ls /lib/security
+auth required pam_securetty.so
+auth required pam_nologin.so
+# auth required pam_dialup.so
+# auth optional pam_mail.so
+auth required pam_pwdb.so shadow md5
+# account requisite pam_time.so
+account required pam_pwdb.so
+session required pam_pwdb.so
+# session optional pam_lastlog.so
+# password required pam_cracklib.so retry=3
+password required pam_pwdb.so shadow md5
+</pre></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2996239"></a>PAM: login using pam_smbpass</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+PAM allows use of replacable modules. Those available on a sample system include:
+</p><p><tt class="prompt">$</tt><b class="userinput"><tt>/bin/ls /lib/security</tt></b>
+</p><pre class="screen">
pam_access.so pam_ftp.so pam_limits.so
pam_ncp_auth.so pam_rhosts_auth.so pam_stress.so
pam_cracklib.so pam_group.so pam_listfile.so
@@ -164,262 +296,227 @@ pam_pwdb.so pam_shells.so pam_unix.so
pam_env.so pam_ldap.so pam_motd.so
pam_radius.so pam_smbpass.so pam_unix_acct.so
pam_wheel.so pam_unix_auth.so pam_unix_passwd.so
-pam_userdb.so pam_warn.so pam_unix_session.so</PRE
-></P
-><P
->The following example for the login program replaces the use of
-the <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->pam_pwdb.so</TT
-> module which uses the system
-password database (<TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/passwd</TT
->,
-<TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/shadow</TT
->, <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/group</TT
->) with
-the module <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->pam_smbpass.so</TT
-> which uses the Samba
+pam_userdb.so pam_warn.so pam_unix_session.so
+</pre><p>
+The following example for the login program replaces the use of
+the <tt class="filename">pam_pwdb.so</tt> module which uses the system
+password database (<tt class="filename">/etc/passwd</tt>,
+<tt class="filename">/etc/shadow</tt>, <tt class="filename">/etc/group</tt>) with
+the module <tt class="filename">pam_smbpass.so</tt> which uses the Samba
database which contains the Microsoft MD4 encrypted password
hashes. This database is stored in either
-<TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/usr/local/samba/private/smbpasswd</TT
->,
-<TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/samba/smbpasswd</TT
->, or in
-<TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/samba.d/smbpasswd</TT
->, depending on the
+<tt class="filename">/usr/local/samba/private/smbpasswd</tt>,
+<tt class="filename">/etc/samba/smbpasswd</tt>, or in
+<tt class="filename">/etc/samba.d/smbpasswd</tt>, depending on the
Samba implementation for your Unix/Linux system. The
-<TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->pam_smbpass.so</TT
-> module is provided by
+<tt class="filename">pam_smbpass.so</tt> module is provided by
Samba version 2.2.1 or later. It can be compiled by specifying the
-<B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->--with-pam_smbpass</B
-> options when running Samba's
-<TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->configure</TT
-> script. For more information
-on the <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->pam_smbpass</TT
-> module, see the documentation
-in the <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->source/pam_smbpass</TT
-> directory of the Samba
-source distribution.</P
-><P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
->#%PAM-1.0
+<tt class="option">--with-pam_smbpass</tt> options when running Samba's
+<b class="command">configure</b> script. For more information
+on the <tt class="filename">pam_smbpass</tt> module, see the documentation
+in the <tt class="filename">source/pam_smbpass</tt> directory of the Samba
+source distribution.
+</p><pre class="screen">
+#%PAM-1.0
# The PAM configuration file for the `login' service
#
-auth required pam_smbpass.so nodelay
-account required pam_smbpass.so nodelay
-session required pam_smbpass.so nodelay
-password required pam_smbpass.so nodelay</PRE
-></P
-><P
->The following is the PAM configuration file for a particular
-Linux system. The default condition uses <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->pam_pwdb.so</TT
->.</P
-><P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
->#%PAM-1.0
+auth required pam_smbpass.so nodelay
+account required pam_smbpass.so nodelay
+session required pam_smbpass.so nodelay
+password required pam_smbpass.so nodelay
+</pre><p>
+The following is the PAM configuration file for a particular
+Linux system. The default condition uses <tt class="filename">pam_pwdb.so</tt>.
+</p><pre class="screen">
+#%PAM-1.0
# The PAM configuration file for the `samba' service
#
-auth required /lib/security/pam_pwdb.so nullok nodelay shadow audit
-account required /lib/security/pam_pwdb.so audit nodelay
-session required /lib/security/pam_pwdb.so nodelay
-password required /lib/security/pam_pwdb.so shadow md5</PRE
-></P
-><P
->In the following example the decision has been made to use the
+auth required pam_pwdb.so nullok nodelay shadow audit
+account required pam_pwdb.so audit nodelay
+session required pam_pwdb.so nodelay
+password required pam_pwdb.so shadow md5
+</pre><p>
+In the following example the decision has been made to use the
smbpasswd database even for basic samba authentication. Such a
decision could also be made for the passwd program and would
thus allow the smbpasswd passwords to be changed using the passwd
-program.</P
-><P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
->#%PAM-1.0
+program.
+</p><pre class="screen">
+#%PAM-1.0
# The PAM configuration file for the `samba' service
#
-auth required /lib/security/pam_smbpass.so nodelay
-account required /lib/security/pam_pwdb.so audit nodelay
-session required /lib/security/pam_pwdb.so nodelay
-password required /lib/security/pam_smbpass.so nodelay smbconf=/etc/samba.d/smb.conf</PRE
-></P
-><P
->Note: PAM allows stacking of authentication mechanisms. It is
+auth required pam_smbpass.so nodelay
+account required pam_pwdb.so audit nodelay
+session required pam_pwdb.so nodelay
+password required pam_smbpass.so nodelay smbconf=/etc/samba.d/smb.conf
+</pre><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p>PAM allows stacking of authentication mechanisms. It is
also possible to pass information obtained within one PAM module through
to the next module in the PAM stack. Please refer to the documentation for
your particular system implementation for details regarding the specific
capabilities of PAM in this environment. Some Linux implmentations also
-provide the <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->pam_stack.so</TT
-> module that allows all
+provide the <tt class="filename">pam_stack.so</tt> module that allows all
authentication to be configured in a single central file. The
-<TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->pam_stack.so</TT
-> method has some very devoted followers
+<tt class="filename">pam_stack.so</tt> method has some very devoted followers
on the basis that it allows for easier administration. As with all issues in
life though, every decision makes trade-offs, so you may want examine the
-PAM documentation for further helpful information.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><H1
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN1832">12.2. Distributed Authentication</H1
-><P
->The astute administrator will realize from this that the
-combination of <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->pam_smbpass.so</TT
->,
-<B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->winbindd</B
->, and <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->rsync</B
-> (see
-<A
-HREF="http://rsync.samba.org/"
-TARGET="_top"
->http://rsync.samba.org/</A
->)
-will allow the establishment of a centrally managed, distributed
-user/password database that can also be used by all
-PAM (eg: Linux) aware programs and applications. This arrangement
-can have particularly potent advantages compared with the
-use of Microsoft Active Directory Service (ADS) in so far as
-reduction of wide area network authentication traffic.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><H1
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN1839">12.3. PAM Configuration in smb.conf</H1
-><P
->There is an option in smb.conf called <A
-HREF="smb.conf.5.html#OBEYPAMRESTRICTIONS"
-TARGET="_top"
->obey pam restrictions</A
->.
-The following is from the on-line help for this option in SWAT;</P
-><P
->When Samba 2.2 is configure to enable PAM support (i.e.
-<TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->--with-pam</TT
->), this parameter will
+PAM documentation for further helpful information.
+</p></div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2996484"></a>smb.conf PAM Configuration</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+There is an option in smb.conf called <a href="smb.conf.5.html#OBEYPAMRESTRICTIONS" target="_top">obey pam restrictions</a>.
+The following is from the on-line help for this option in SWAT;
+</p><p>
+When Samba-3 is configured to enable PAM support (i.e.
+<tt class="option">--with-pam</tt>), this parameter will
control whether or not Samba should obey PAM's account
and session management directives. The default behavior
is to use PAM for clear text authentication only and to
ignore any account or session management. Note that Samba always
ignores PAM for authentication in the case of
-<A
-HREF="smb.conf.5.html#ENCRYPTPASSWORDS"
-TARGET="_top"
->encrypt passwords = yes</A
->.
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html#ENCRYPTPASSWORDS" target="_top">encrypt passwords = yes</a>.
The reason is that PAM modules cannot support the challenge/response
authentication mechanism needed in the presence of SMB
-password encryption. </P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->obey pam restrictions = no</B
-></P
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="NAVFOOTER"
-><HR
-ALIGN="LEFT"
-WIDTH="100%"><TABLE
-SUMMARY="Footer navigation table"
-WIDTH="100%"
-BORDER="0"
-CELLPADDING="0"
-CELLSPACING="0"
-><TR
-><TD
-WIDTH="33%"
-ALIGN="left"
-VALIGN="top"
-><A
-HREF="unix-permissions.html"
-ACCESSKEY="P"
->Prev</A
-></TD
-><TD
-WIDTH="34%"
-ALIGN="center"
-VALIGN="top"
-><A
-HREF="samba-howto-collection.html"
-ACCESSKEY="H"
->Home</A
-></TD
-><TD
-WIDTH="33%"
-ALIGN="right"
-VALIGN="top"
-><A
-HREF="msdfs.html"
-ACCESSKEY="N"
->Next</A
-></TD
-></TR
-><TR
-><TD
-WIDTH="33%"
-ALIGN="left"
-VALIGN="top"
->UNIX Permission Bits and Windows NT Access Control Lists</TD
-><TD
-WIDTH="34%"
-ALIGN="center"
-VALIGN="top"
-><A
-HREF="optional.html"
-ACCESSKEY="U"
->Up</A
-></TD
-><TD
-WIDTH="33%"
-ALIGN="right"
-VALIGN="top"
->Hosting a Microsoft Distributed File System tree on Samba</TD
-></TR
-></TABLE
-></DIV
-></BODY
-></HTML
-> \ No newline at end of file
+password encryption.
+</p><p>Default: <i class="parameter"><tt>obey pam restrictions = no</tt></i></p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2996541"></a>Remote CIFS Authentication using winbindd.so</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+All operating systems depend on the provision of users credentials accecptable to the platform.
+Unix requires the provision of a user identifier (UID) as well as a group identifier (GID).
+These are both simple integer type numbers that are obtained from a password backend such
+as <tt class="filename">/etc/passwd</tt>.
+</p><p>
+Users and groups on a Windows NT server are assigned a relative id (rid) which is unique for
+the domain when the user or group is created. To convert the Windows NT user or group into
+a unix user or group, a mapping between rids and unix user and group ids is required. This
+is one of the jobs that winbind performs.
+</p><p>
+As winbind users and groups are resolved from a server, user and group ids are allocated
+from a specified range. This is done on a first come, first served basis, although all
+existing users and groups will be mapped as soon as a client performs a user or group
+enumeration command. The allocated unix ids are stored in a database file under the Samba
+lock directory and will be remembered.
+</p><p>
+The astute administrator will realize from this that the combination of <tt class="filename">pam_smbpass.so</tt>,
+<b class="command">winbindd</b>, and a distributed passdb backend, such as ldap, will allow the establishment of a
+centrally managed, distributed user/password database that can also be used by all PAM (eg: Linux) aware
+programs and applications. This arrangement can have particularly potent advantages compared with the use of
+Microsoft Active Directory Service (ADS) in so far as reduction of wide area network authentication traffic.
+</p><div class="warning" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Warning</h3><p>
+The rid to unix id database is the only location where the user and group mappings are
+stored by winbindd. If this file is deleted or corrupted, there is no way for winbindd
+to determine which user and group ids correspond to Windows NT user and group rids.
+</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2996625"></a>Password Synchronization using pam_smbpass.so</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+pam_smbpass is a PAM module which can be used on conforming systems to
+keep the smbpasswd (Samba password) database in sync with the unix
+password file. PAM (Pluggable Authentication Modules) is an API supported
+under some Unices, such as Solaris, HPUX and Linux, that provides a
+generic interface to authentication mechanisms.
+</p><p>
+This module authenticates a local smbpasswd user database. If you require
+support for authenticating against a remote SMB server, or if you're
+concerned about the presence of suid root binaries on your system, it is
+recommended that you use pam_winbind instead.
+</p><p>
+Options recognized by this module are as follows:
+</p><div class="table"><a name="id2996658"></a><p class="title"><b>Table 25.1. Options recognized by pam_smbpass</b></p><table summary="Options recognized by pam_smbpass" border="1"><colgroup><col><col></colgroup><tbody><tr><td align="left">debug</td><td align="left">log more debugging info</td></tr><tr><td align="left">audit</td><td align="left">like debug, but also logs unknown usernames</td></tr><tr><td align="left">use_first_pass</td><td align="left">don't prompt the user for passwords; take them from PAM_ items instead</td></tr><tr><td align="left">try_first_pass</td><td align="left">try to get the password from a previous PAM module, fall back to prompting the user</td></tr><tr><td align="left">use_authtok</td><td align="left">like try_first_pass, but *fail* if the new PAM_AUTHTOK has not been previously set. (intended for stacking password modules only)</td></tr><tr><td align="left">not_set_pass</td><td align="left">don't make passwords used by this module available to other modules.</td></tr><tr><td align="left">nodelay</td><td align="left">don't insert ~1 second delays on authentication failure.</td></tr><tr><td align="left">nullok</td><td align="left">null passwords are allowed.</td></tr><tr><td align="left">nonull</td><td align="left">null passwords are not allowed. Used to override the Samba configuration.</td></tr><tr><td align="left">migrate</td><td align="left">only meaningful in an &quot;auth&quot; context; used to update smbpasswd file with a password used for successful authentication.</td></tr><tr><td align="left">smbconf=<i class="replaceable"><tt>file</tt></i></td><td align="left">specify an alternate path to the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file.</td></tr></tbody></table></div><p>
+</p><p>
+Thanks go to the following people:
+</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><a href="mailto:morgan@transmeta.com" target="_top">Andrew Morgan</a>, for providing the Linux-PAM
+ framework, without which none of this would have happened</td></tr><tr><td><a href="gafton@redhat.com" target="_top">Christian Gafton</a> and Andrew Morgan again, for the
+ pam_pwdb module upon which pam_smbpass was originally based</td></tr><tr><td><a href="lkcl@switchboard.net" target="_top">Luke Leighton</a> for being receptive to the idea,
+ and for the occasional good-natured complaint about the project's status
+ that keep me working on it :)</td></tr></table><p>.
+</p><p>
+The following are examples of the use of pam_smbpass.so in the format of Linux
+<tt class="filename">/etc/pam.d/</tt> files structure. Those wishing to implement this
+tool on other platforms will need to adapt this appropriately.
+</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2996858"></a>Password Synchronisation Configuration</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+A sample PAM configuration that shows the use of pam_smbpass to make
+sure private/smbpasswd is kept in sync when /etc/passwd (/etc/shadow)
+is changed. Useful when an expired password might be changed by an
+application (such as ssh).
+</p><pre class="screen">
+#%PAM-1.0
+# password-sync
+#
+auth requisite pam_nologin.so
+auth required pam_unix.so
+account required pam_unix.so
+password requisite pam_cracklib.so retry=3
+password requisite pam_unix.so shadow md5 use_authtok try_first_pass
+password required pam_smbpass.so nullok use_authtok try_first_pass
+session required pam_unix.so
+</pre></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2996891"></a>Password Migration Configuration</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+A sample PAM configuration that shows the use of pam_smbpass to migrate
+from plaintext to encrypted passwords for Samba. Unlike other methods,
+this can be used for users who have never connected to Samba shares:
+password migration takes place when users ftp in, login using ssh, pop
+their mail, etc.
+</p><pre class="screen">
+#%PAM-1.0
+# password-migration
+#
+auth requisite pam_nologin.so
+# pam_smbpass is called IF pam_unix succeeds.
+auth requisite pam_unix.so
+auth optional pam_smbpass.so migrate
+account required pam_unix.so
+password requisite pam_cracklib.so retry=3
+password requisite pam_unix.so shadow md5 use_authtok try_first_pass
+password optional pam_smbpass.so nullok use_authtok try_first_pass
+session required pam_unix.so
+</pre></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2996926"></a>Mature Password Configuration</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+A sample PAM configuration for a 'mature' smbpasswd installation.
+private/smbpasswd is fully populated, and we consider it an error if
+the smbpasswd doesn't exist or doesn't match the Unix password.
+</p><pre class="screen">
+#%PAM-1.0
+# password-mature
+#
+auth requisite pam_nologin.so
+auth required pam_unix.so
+account required pam_unix.so
+password requisite pam_cracklib.so retry=3
+password requisite pam_unix.so shadow md5 use_authtok try_first_pass
+password required pam_smbpass.so use_authtok use_first_pass
+session required pam_unix.so
+</pre></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2996958"></a>Kerberos Password Integration Configuration</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+A sample PAM configuration that shows pam_smbpass used together with
+pam_krb5. This could be useful on a Samba PDC that is also a member of
+a Kerberos realm.
+</p><pre class="screen">
+#%PAM-1.0
+# kdc-pdc
+#
+auth requisite pam_nologin.so
+auth requisite pam_krb5.so
+auth optional pam_smbpass.so migrate
+account required pam_krb5.so
+password requisite pam_cracklib.so retry=3
+password optional pam_smbpass.so nullok use_authtok try_first_pass
+password required pam_krb5.so use_authtok try_first_pass
+session required pam_krb5.so
+</pre></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2996992"></a>Common Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+PAM can be a very fickle and sensitive to configuration glitches. Here we look at a few cases from
+the Samba mailing list.
+</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2997005"></a>pam_winbind problem</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+ I have the following PAM configuration:
+ </p><p>
+</p><pre class="screen">
+auth required /lib/security/pam_securetty.so
+auth sufficient /lib/security/pam_winbind.so
+auth sufficient /lib/security/pam_unix.so use_first_pass nullok
+auth required /lib/security/pam_stack.so service=system-auth
+auth required /lib/security/pam_nologin.so
+account required /lib/security/pam_stack.so service=system-auth
+account required /lib/security/pam_winbind.so
+password required /lib/security/pam_stack.so service=system-auth
+</pre><p>
+</p><p>
+ When I open a new console with [ctrl][alt][F1], then I cant log in with my user &quot;pitie&quot;.
+ I've tried with user &quot;scienceu+pitie&quot; also.
+ </p><p>
+ Answer: The problem may lie with your inclusion of <i class="parameter"><tt>pam_stack.so
+ service=system-auth</tt></i>. That file often contains a lot of stuff that may
+ duplicate what you're already doing. Try commenting out the pam_stack lines
+ for auth and account and see if things work. If they do, look at
+ <tt class="filename">/etc/pam.d/system-auth</tt> and copy only what you need from it into your
+ <tt class="filename">/etc/pam.d/login</tt> file. Alternatively, if you want all services to use
+ winbind, you can put the winbind-specific stuff in <tt class="filename">/etc/pam.d/system-auth</tt>.
+ </p></div></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="ProfileMgmt.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="optional.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="integrate-ms-networks.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 24. Desktop Profile Management </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="index.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 26. Integrating MS Windows networks with Samba</td></tr></table></div></body></html>
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/pdbedit.8.html b/docs/htmldocs/pdbedit.8.html
index 7b85e2bb80..d77f8fcec2 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/pdbedit.8.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/pdbedit.8.html
@@ -1,606 +1,136 @@
-<!DOCTYPE HTML PUBLIC "-//W3C//DTD HTML 4.01//EN">
-<HTML
-><HEAD
-><TITLE
->pdbedit</TITLE
-><META
-NAME="GENERATOR"
-CONTENT="Modular DocBook HTML Stylesheet Version 1.76b+
-"></HEAD
-><BODY
-CLASS="REFENTRY"
-BGCOLOR="#FFFFFF"
-TEXT="#000000"
-LINK="#0000FF"
-VLINK="#840084"
-ALINK="#0000FF"
-><H1
-><A
-NAME="PDBEDIT">pdbedit</H1
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFNAMEDIV"
-><A
-NAME="AEN5"
-></A
-><H2
->Name</H2
->pdbedit&nbsp;--&nbsp;manage the SAM database</DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSYNOPSISDIV"
-><A
-NAME="AEN8"><H2
->Synopsis</H2
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->pdbedit</B
-> [-l] [-v] [-w] [-u username] [-f fullname] [-h homedir] [-D drive] [-S script] [-p profile] [-a] [-m] [-x] [-i passdb-backend] [-e passdb-backend] [-g] [-b passdb-backend] [-d debuglevel] [-s configfile] [-P account-policy] [-V value]</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN31"
-></A
-><H2
->DESCRIPTION</H2
-><P
->This tool is part of the <A
-HREF="samba.7.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-> Samba</A
-> suite.</P
-><P
->The pdbedit program is used to manage the users accounts
- stored in the sam database and can only be run by root.</P
-><P
->The pdbedit tool uses the passdb modular interface and is
+<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>pdbedit</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="pdbedit.8"></a><div class="titlepage"><div></div><div></div></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>pdbedit &#8212; manage the SAM database</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><tt class="command">pdbedit</tt> [-L] [-v] [-w] [-u username] [-f fullname] [-h homedir] [-D drive] [-S script] [-p profile] [-a] [-m] [-x] [-i passdb-backend] [-e passdb-backend] [-b passdb-backend] [-g] [-d debuglevel] [-s configfile] [-P account-policy] [-C value]</p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This tool is part of the <a href="Samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">Samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p>The pdbedit program is used to manage the users accounts
+ stored in the sam database and can only be run by root.</p><p>The pdbedit tool uses the passdb modular interface and is
independent from the kind of users database used (currently there
are smbpasswd, ldap, nis+ and tdb based and more can be added
- without changing the tool).</P
-><P
->There are five main ways to use pdbedit: adding a user account,
+ without changing the tool).</p><p>There are five main ways to use pdbedit: adding a user account,
removing a user account, modifing a user account, listing user
- accounts, importing users accounts.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN38"
-></A
-><H2
->OPTIONS</H2
-><P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
->-l</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This option lists all the user accounts
+ accounts, importing users accounts.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">-L</span></dt><dd><p>This option lists all the user accounts
present in the users database.
This option prints a list of user/uid pairs separated by
- the ':' character.</P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->pdbedit -l</B
-></P
-><P
-><TABLE
-BORDER="0"
-BGCOLOR="#E0E0E0"
-WIDTH="90%"
-><TR
-><TD
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
-> sorce:500:Simo Sorce
- samba:45:Test User
- </PRE
-></TD
-></TR
-></TABLE
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
->-v</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This option enables the verbose listing format.
+ the ':' character.</p><p>Example: <b class="command">pdbedit -L</b></p><pre class="screen">
+sorce:500:Simo Sorce
+samba:45:Test User
+</pre></dd><dt><span class="term">-v</span></dt><dd><p>This option enables the verbose listing format.
It causes pdbedit to list the users in the database, printing
- out the account fields in a descriptive format.</P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->pdbedit -l -v</B
-></P
-><P
-><TABLE
-BORDER="0"
-BGCOLOR="#E0E0E0"
-WIDTH="90%"
-><TR
-><TD
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
-> ---------------
- username: sorce
- user ID/Group: 500/500
- user RID/GRID: 2000/2001
- Full Name: Simo Sorce
- Home Directory: \\BERSERKER\sorce
- HomeDir Drive: H:
- Logon Script: \\BERSERKER\netlogon\sorce.bat
- Profile Path: \\BERSERKER\profile
- ---------------
- username: samba
- user ID/Group: 45/45
- user RID/GRID: 1090/1091
- Full Name: Test User
- Home Directory: \\BERSERKER\samba
- HomeDir Drive:
- Logon Script:
- Profile Path: \\BERSERKER\profile
- </PRE
-></TD
-></TR
-></TABLE
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
->-w</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This option sets the "smbpasswd" listing format.
+ out the account fields in a descriptive format.</p><p>Example: <b class="command">pdbedit -l -v</b></p><pre class="screen">
+---------------
+username: sorce
+user ID/Group: 500/500
+user RID/GRID: 2000/2001
+Full Name: Simo Sorce
+Home Directory: \\BERSERKER\sorce
+HomeDir Drive: H:
+Logon Script: \\BERSERKER\netlogon\sorce.bat
+Profile Path: \\BERSERKER\profile
+---------------
+username: samba
+user ID/Group: 45/45
+user RID/GRID: 1090/1091
+Full Name: Test User
+Home Directory: \\BERSERKER\samba
+HomeDir Drive:
+Logon Script:
+Profile Path: \\BERSERKER\profile
+</pre></dd><dt><span class="term">-w</span></dt><dd><p>This option sets the &quot;smbpasswd&quot; listing format.
It will make pdbedit list the users in the database, printing
out the account fields in a format compatible with the
- <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->smbpasswd</TT
-> file format. (see the <A
-HREF="smbpasswd.5.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-><TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->smbpasswd(5)</TT
-></A
-> for details)</P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->pdbedit -l -w</B
-></P
-><P
-><TABLE
-BORDER="0"
-BGCOLOR="#E0E0E0"
-WIDTH="90%"
-><TR
-><TD
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
-> sorce:500:508818B733CE64BEAAD3B435B51404EE:D2A2418EFC466A8A0F6B1DBB5C3DB80C:[UX ]:LCT-00000000:
- samba:45:0F2B255F7B67A7A9AAD3B435B51404EE:BC281CE3F53B6A5146629CD4751D3490:[UX ]:LCT-3BFA1E8D:
- </PRE
-></TD
-></TR
-></TABLE
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
->-u username</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This option specifies the username to be
+ <tt class="filename">smbpasswd</tt> file format. (see the
+ <a href="smbpasswd.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbpasswd</span>(5)</span></a> for details)</p><p>Example: <b class="command">pdbedit -L -w</b></p><pre class="screen">
+sorce:500:508818B733CE64BEAAD3B435B51404EE:D2A2418EFC466A8A0F6B1DBB5C3DB80C:[UX ]:LCT-00000000:
+samba:45:0F2B255F7B67A7A9AAD3B435B51404EE:BC281CE3F53B6A5146629CD4751D3490:[UX ]:LCT-3BFA1E8D:
+</pre></dd><dt><span class="term">-u username</span></dt><dd><p>This option specifies the username to be
used for the operation requested (listing, adding, removing).
- It is <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->required</I
-> in add, remove and modify
- operations and <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->optional</I
-> in list
- operations.</P
-></DD
-><DT
->-f fullname</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This option can be used while adding or
+ It is <span class="emphasis"><em>required</em></span> in add, remove and modify
+ operations and <span class="emphasis"><em>optional</em></span> in list
+ operations.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-f fullname</span></dt><dd><p>This option can be used while adding or
modifing a user account. It will specify the user's full
- name. </P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->-f "Simo Sorce"</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
->-h homedir</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This option can be used while adding or
+ name. </p><p>Example: <b class="command">-f &quot;Simo Sorce&quot;</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term">-h homedir</span></dt><dd><p>This option can be used while adding or
modifing a user account. It will specify the user's home
- directory network path.</P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->-h "\\\\BERSERKER\\sorce"</B
->
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-D drive</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This option can be used while adding or
+ directory network path.</p><p>Example: <b class="command">-h &quot;\\\\BERSERKER\\sorce&quot;</b>
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-D drive</span></dt><dd><p>This option can be used while adding or
modifing a user account. It will specify the windows drive
- letter to be used to map the home directory.</P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->-d "H:"</B
->
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-S script</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This option can be used while adding or
+ letter to be used to map the home directory.</p><p>Example: <b class="command">-d &quot;H:&quot;</b>
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-S script</span></dt><dd><p>This option can be used while adding or
modifing a user account. It will specify the user's logon
- script path.</P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->-s "\\\\BERSERKER\\netlogon\\sorce.bat"</B
->
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-p profile</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This option can be used while adding or
+ script path.</p><p>Example: <b class="command">-s &quot;\\\\BERSERKER\\netlogon\\sorce.bat&quot;</b>
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-p profile</span></dt><dd><p>This option can be used while adding or
modifing a user account. It will specify the user's profile
- directory.</P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->-p "\\\\BERSERKER\\netlogon"</B
->
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-a</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This option is used to add a user into the
+ directory.</p><p>Example: <b class="command">-p &quot;\\\\BERSERKER\\netlogon&quot;</b>
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-G SID|rid</span></dt><dd><p>
+ This option can be used while adding or modifying a user account. It
+ will specify the users' new primary group SID (Security Identifier) or
+ rid. </p><p>Example: <b class="command">-G S-1-5-21-2447931902-1787058256-3961074038-1201</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term">-U SID|rid</span></dt><dd><p>
+ This option can be used while adding or modifying a user account. It
+ will specify the users' new SID (Security Identifier) or
+ rid. </p><p>Example: <b class="command">-U S-1-5-21-2447931902-1787058256-3961074038-5004</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term">-c account-control</span></dt><dd><p>This option can be used while adding or modifying a user
+ account. It will specify the users' account control property. Possible
+ flags that can be set are: N, D, H, L, X.
+ </p><p>Example: <b class="command">-c &quot;[X ]&quot;</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term">-a</span></dt><dd><p>This option is used to add a user into the
database. This command needs a user name specified with
the -u switch. When adding a new user, pdbedit will also
- ask for the password to be used.</P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->pdbedit -a -u sorce</B
->
- <TABLE
-BORDER="0"
-BGCOLOR="#E0E0E0"
-WIDTH="90%"
-><TR
-><TD
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
->new password:
- retype new password</PRE
-></TD
-></TR
-></TABLE
->
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-m</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This option may only be used in conjunction
- with the <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->-a</I
-></TT
-> option. It will make
+ ask for the password to be used.</p><p>Example: <b class="command">pdbedit -a -u sorce</b>
+</p><pre class="programlisting">new password:
+retype new password
+</pre><p>
+</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-r</span></dt><dd><p>This option is used to modify an existing user
+ in the database. This command needs a user name specified with the -u
+ switch. Other options can be specified to modify the properties of
+ the specified user. This flag is kept for backwards compatibility, but
+ it is no longer necessary to specify it.
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-m</span></dt><dd><p>This option may only be used in conjunction
+ with the <i class="parameter"><tt>-a</tt></i> option. It will make
pdbedit to add a machine trust account instead of a user
- account (-u username will provide the machine name).</P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->pdbedit -a -m -u w2k-wks</B
->
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-x</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This option causes pdbedit to delete an account
+ account (-u username will provide the machine name).</p><p>Example: <b class="command">pdbedit -a -m -u w2k-wks</b>
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-x</span></dt><dd><p>This option causes pdbedit to delete an account
from the database. It needs a username specified with the
- -u switch.</P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->pdbedit -x -u bob</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
->-i passdb-backend</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Use a different passdb backend to retrieve users
+ -u switch.</p><p>Example: <b class="command">pdbedit -x -u bob</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term">-i passdb-backend</span></dt><dd><p>Use a different passdb backend to retrieve users
than the one specified in smb.conf. Can be used to import data into
- your local user database.</P
-><P
->This option will ease migration from one passdb backend to
- another.</P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->pdbedit -i smbpasswd:/etc/smbpasswd.old
- </B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
->-e passdb-backend</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Exports all currently available users to the
- specified password database backend.</P
-><P
->This option will ease migration from one passdb backend to
- another and will ease backing up.</P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->pdbedit -e smbpasswd:/root/samba-users.backup</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
->-g</DT
-><DD
-><P
->If you specify <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->-g</I
-></TT
->,
- then <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->-i in-backend -e out-backend</I
-></TT
->
- applies to the group mapping instead of the user database.
- </P
-><P
->This option will ease migration from one passdb backend to
- another and will ease backing up.</P
-></DD
-><DT
->-b passdb-backend</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Use a different default passdb backend. </P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->pdbedit -b xml:/root/pdb-backup.xml -l</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
->-P account-policy</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Display an account policy</P
-><P
->Valid policies are: minimum password age, reset count minutes, disconnect time,
+ your local user database.</p><p>This option will ease migration from one passdb backend to
+ another.</p><p>Example: <b class="command">pdbedit -i smbpasswd:/etc/smbpasswd.old
+ </b></p></dd><dt><span class="term">-e passdb-backend</span></dt><dd><p>Exports all currently available users to the
+ specified password database backend.</p><p>This option will ease migration from one passdb backend to
+ another and will ease backing up.</p><p>Example: <b class="command">pdbedit -e smbpasswd:/root/samba-users.backup</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term">-g</span></dt><dd><p>If you specify <i class="parameter"><tt>-g</tt></i>,
+ then <i class="parameter"><tt>-i in-backend -e out-backend</tt></i>
+ applies to the group mapping instead of the user database.</p><p>This option will ease migration from one passdb backend to
+ another and will ease backing up.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-b passdb-backend</span></dt><dd><p>Use a different default passdb backend. </p><p>Example: <b class="command">pdbedit -b xml:/root/pdb-backup.xml -l</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term">-P account-policy</span></dt><dd><p>Display an account policy</p><p>Valid policies are: minimum password age, reset count minutes, disconnect time,
user must logon to change password, password history, lockout duration, min password length,
- maximum password age and bad lockout attempt.</P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->pdbedit -P "bad lockout attempt"</B
-></P
-><P
-><TABLE
-BORDER="0"
-BGCOLOR="#E0E0E0"
-WIDTH="90%"
-><TR
-><TD
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
-> account policy value for bad lockout attempt is 0
- </PRE
-></TD
-></TR
-></TABLE
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
->-V account-policy-value</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Sets an account policy to a specified value.
+ maximum password age and bad lockout attempt.</p><p>Example: <b class="command">pdbedit -P &quot;bad lockout attempt&quot;</b></p><pre class="programlisting">
+account policy value for bad lockout attempt is 0
+</pre></dd><dt><span class="term">-C account-policy-value</span></dt><dd><p>Sets an account policy to a specified value.
This option may only be used in conjunction
- with the <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->-P</I
-></TT
-> option.
- </P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->pdbedit -P "bad lockout attempt" -V 3</B
-></P
-><P
-><TABLE
-BORDER="0"
-BGCOLOR="#E0E0E0"
-WIDTH="90%"
-><TR
-><TD
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
-> account policy value for bad lockout attempt was 0
- account policy value for bad lockout attempt is now 3
- </PRE
-></TD
-></TR
-></TABLE
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
->-d|--debug=debuglevel</DT
-><DD
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="REPLACEABLE"
-><I
->debuglevel</I
-></TT
-> is an integer
+ with the <i class="parameter"><tt>-P</tt></i> option.
+ </p><p>Example: <b class="command">pdbedit -P &quot;bad lockout attempt&quot; -C 3</b></p><pre class="programlisting">
+account policy value for bad lockout attempt was 0
+account policy value for bad lockout attempt is now 3
+</pre></dd><dt><span class="term">-h|--help</span></dt><dd><p>Print a summary of command line options.
+</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-V</span></dt><dd><p>Prints the version number for
+<b class="command">smbd</b>.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-s &lt;configuration file&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>The file specified contains the
+configuration details required by the server. The
+information in this file includes server-specific
+information such as what printcap file to use, as well
+as descriptions of all the services that the server is
+to provide. See <a href="smb.conf.5.html" target="_top"><tt class="filename">
+smb.conf(5)</tt></a> for more information.
+The default configuration file name is determined at
+compile time.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-d|--debug=debuglevel</span></dt><dd><p><i class="replaceable"><tt>debuglevel</tt></i> is an integer
from 0 to 10. The default value if this parameter is
-not specified is zero.</P
-><P
->The higher this value, the more detail will be
+not specified is zero.</p><p>The higher this value, the more detail will be
logged to the log files about the activities of the
server. At level 0, only critical errors and serious
warnings will be logged. Level 1 is a reasonable level for
day to day running - it generates a small amount of
-information about operations carried out.</P
-><P
->Levels above 1 will generate considerable
+information about operations carried out.</p><p>Levels above 1 will generate considerable
amounts of log data, and should only be used when
investigating a problem. Levels above 3 are designed for
use only by developers and generate HUGE amounts of log
-data, most of which is extremely cryptic.</P
-><P
->Note that specifying this parameter here will
-override the <A
-HREF="smb.conf.5.html#loglevel"
-TARGET="_top"
->log
-level</A
-> parameter in the <A
-HREF="smb.conf.5.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-><TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->smb.conf(5)</TT
-></A
-> file.</P
-></DD
-><DT
->-h|--help</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Print a summary of command line options.</P
-></DD
-><DT
->-s &#60;configuration file&#62;</DT
-><DD
-><P
->The file specified contains the
-configuration details required by the server. The
-information in this file includes server-specific
-information such as what printcap file to use, as well
-as descriptions of all the services that the server is
-to provide. See <A
-HREF="smb.conf.5.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-><TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->smb.conf(5)</TT
-></A
-> for more information.
-The default configuration file name is determined at
-compile time.</P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN190"
-></A
-><H2
->NOTES</H2
-><P
->This command may be used only by root.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN193"
-></A
-><H2
->VERSION</H2
-><P
->This man page is correct for version 2.2 of
- the Samba suite.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN196"
-></A
-><H2
->SEE ALSO</H2
-><P
-><A
-HREF="smbpasswd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
->smbpasswd(8)</A
->,
- <A
-HREF="samba.7.html"
-TARGET="_top"
->samba(7)</A
->
- </P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN201"
-></A
-><H2
->AUTHOR</H2
-><P
->The original Samba software and related utilities
+data, most of which is extremely cryptic.</p><p>Note that specifying this parameter here will
+override the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#loglevel" target="_top">log
+level</a> parameter in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html" target="_top">
+<tt class="filename">smb.conf(5)</tt></a> file.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-l|--logfile=logbasename</span></dt><dd><p>File name for log/debug files. The extension
+<tt class="constant">&quot;.client&quot;</tt> will be appended. The log file is
+never removed by the client.
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>NOTES</h2><p>This command may be used only by root.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3.0 of
+ the Samba suite.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>SEE ALSO</h2><p><a href="smbpasswd.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbpasswd</span>(5)</span></a>, <a href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a></p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
- to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</P
-><P
->The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer.
- The man page sources were converted to YODL format (another
- excellent piece of Open Source software, available at
- <A
-HREF="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/"
-TARGET="_top"
-> ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/</A
->) and updated for the Samba 2.0
- release by Jeremy Allison. The conversion to DocBook for
- Samba 2.2 was done by Gerald Carter</P
-></DIV
-></BODY
-></HTML
-> \ No newline at end of file
+ to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</p></div></div></body></html>
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/printing.html b/docs/htmldocs/printing.html
index 46ebbcdf84..62856e7ecf 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/printing.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/printing.html
@@ -1,1386 +1,2240 @@
-<!DOCTYPE HTML PUBLIC "-//W3C//DTD HTML 4.01 Transitional//EN">
-<HTML
-><HEAD
-><TITLE
->Printing Support</TITLE
-><META
-NAME="GENERATOR"
-CONTENT="Modular DocBook HTML Stylesheet Version 1.76b+
-"><LINK
-REL="HOME"
-TITLE="SAMBA Project Documentation"
-HREF="samba-howto-collection.html"><LINK
-REL="UP"
-TITLE="Optional configuration"
-HREF="optional.html"><LINK
-REL="PREVIOUS"
-TITLE="Hosting a Microsoft Distributed File System tree on Samba"
-HREF="msdfs.html"><LINK
-REL="NEXT"
-TITLE="Unified Logons between Windows NT and UNIX using Winbind"
-HREF="winbind.html"></HEAD
-><BODY
-CLASS="CHAPTER"
-BGCOLOR="#FFFFFF"
-TEXT="#000000"
-LINK="#0000FF"
-VLINK="#840084"
-ALINK="#0000FF"
-><DIV
-CLASS="NAVHEADER"
-><TABLE
-SUMMARY="Header navigation table"
-WIDTH="100%"
-BORDER="0"
-CELLPADDING="0"
-CELLSPACING="0"
-><TR
-><TH
-COLSPAN="3"
-ALIGN="center"
->SAMBA Project Documentation</TH
-></TR
-><TR
-><TD
-WIDTH="10%"
-ALIGN="left"
-VALIGN="bottom"
-><A
-HREF="msdfs.html"
-ACCESSKEY="P"
->Prev</A
-></TD
-><TD
-WIDTH="80%"
-ALIGN="center"
-VALIGN="bottom"
-></TD
-><TD
-WIDTH="10%"
-ALIGN="right"
-VALIGN="bottom"
-><A
-HREF="winbind.html"
-ACCESSKEY="N"
->Next</A
-></TD
-></TR
-></TABLE
-><HR
-ALIGN="LEFT"
-WIDTH="100%"></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="CHAPTER"
-><H1
-><A
-NAME="PRINTING">Chapter 14. Printing Support</H1
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><H1
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN1920">14.1. Introduction</H1
-><P
->Beginning with the 2.2.0 release, Samba supports
-the native Windows NT printing mechanisms implemented via
-MS-RPC (i.e. the SPOOLSS named pipe). Previous versions of
-Samba only supported LanMan printing calls.</P
-><P
->The additional functionality provided by the new
-SPOOLSS support includes:</P
-><P
-></P
-><UL
-><LI
-><P
->Support for downloading printer driver
- files to Windows 95/98/NT/2000 clients upon demand.
- </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->Uploading of printer drivers via the
- Windows NT Add Printer Wizard (APW) or the
- Imprints tool set (refer to <A
-HREF="http://imprints.sourceforge.net"
-TARGET="_top"
->http://imprints.sourceforge.net</A
->).
- </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->Support for the native MS-RPC printing
- calls such as StartDocPrinter, EnumJobs(), etc... (See
- the MSDN documentation at <A
-HREF="http://msdn.microsoft.com/"
-TARGET="_top"
->http://msdn.microsoft.com/</A
->
- for more information on the Win32 printing API)
- </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->Support for NT Access Control Lists (ACL)
- on printer objects</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->Improved support for printer queue manipulation
- through the use of an internal databases for spooled job
- information</P
-></LI
-></UL
-><P
->There has been some initial confusion about what all this means
-and whether or not it is a requirement for printer drivers to be
-installed on a Samba host in order to support printing from Windows
-clients. As a side note, Samba does not use these drivers in any way to process
-spooled files. They are utilized entirely by the clients.</P
-><P
->The following MS KB article, may be of some help if you are dealing with
-Windows 2000 clients: <SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->How to Add Printers with No User
-Interaction in Windows 2000</I
-></SPAN
-></P
-><P
-><A
-HREF="http://support.microsoft.com/support/kb/articles/Q189/1/05.ASP"
-TARGET="_top"
->http://support.microsoft.com/support/kb/articles/Q189/1/05.ASP</A
-></P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><H1
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN1942">14.2. Configuration</H1
-><DIV
-CLASS="WARNING"
-><P
-></P
-><TABLE
-CLASS="WARNING"
-WIDTH="100%"
-BORDER="0"
-><TR
-><TD
-WIDTH="25"
-ALIGN="CENTER"
-VALIGN="TOP"
-><IMG
-SRC="../images/warning.gif"
-HSPACE="5"
-ALT="Warning"></TD
-><TH
-ALIGN="LEFT"
-VALIGN="CENTER"
-><B
->[print$] vs. [printer$]</B
-></TH
-></TR
-><TR
-><TD
->&nbsp;</TD
-><TD
-ALIGN="LEFT"
-VALIGN="TOP"
-><P
->Previous versions of Samba recommended using a share named [printer$].
-This name was taken from the printer$ service created by Windows 9x
-clients when a printer was shared. Windows 9x printer servers always have
-a printer$ service which provides read-only access via no
-password in order to support printer driver downloads.</P
-><P
->However, the initial implementation allowed for a
-parameter named <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->printer driver location</I
-></TT
->
-to be used on a per share basis to specify the location of
-the driver files associated with that printer. Another
-parameter named <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->printer driver</I
-></TT
-> provided
-a means of defining the printer driver name to be sent to
-the client.</P
-></TD
-></TR
-></TABLE
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><H2
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN1950">14.2.1. Creating [print$]</H2
-><P
->In order to support the uploading of printer driver
-files, you must first configure a file share named [print$].
-The name of this share is hard coded in Samba's internals so
-the name is very important (print$ is the service used by
-Windows NT print servers to provide support for printer driver
-download).</P
-><P
->You should modify the server's smb.conf file to add the global
-parameters and to create the
-following file share (of course, some of the parameter values,
-such as 'path' are arbitrary and should be replaced with
-appropriate values for your site):</P
-><P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
->[global]
- ; members of the ntadmin group should be able
- ; to add drivers and set printer properties
- ; root is implicitly a 'printer admin'
- printer admin = @ntadmin
+<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 18. Classical Printing Support</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="optional.html" title="Part III. Advanced Configuration"><link rel="previous" href="msdfs.html" title="Chapter 17. Hosting a Microsoft Distributed File System tree on Samba"><link rel="next" href="CUPS-printing.html" title="Chapter 19. CUPS Printing Support in Samba 3.0"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 18. Classical Printing Support</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="msdfs.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part III. Advanced Configuration</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="CUPS-printing.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="printing"></a>Chapter 18. Classical Printing Support</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Kurt</span> <span class="surname">Pfeifle</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname"> Danka Deutschland GmbH <br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email">&lt;<a href="mailto:kpfeifle@danka.de">kpfeifle@danka.de</a>&gt;</tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">May 32, 2003</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="printing.html#id2934100">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2934168">Technical Introduction</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="printing.html#id2934206">What happens if you send a Job from a Client</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2934276">Printing Related Configuration Parameters</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2934356">Parameters Recommended for Use</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2935524">Parameters for Backwards Compatibility</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2935632">Parameters no longer in use</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="printing.html#id2935725">A simple Configuration to Print with Samba-3</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="printing.html#id2935795">Verification of &quot;Settings in Use&quot; with testparm</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2935884">A little Experiment to warn you</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="printing.html#id2936190">Extended Sample Configuration to Print with Samba-3</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2936293">Detailed Explanation of the Example's Settings</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="printing.html#id2936306">The [global] Section</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2936689">The [printers] Section</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2937018">Any [my_printer_name] Section</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2937239">Print Commands</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2937289">Default Print Commands for various Unix Print Subsystems</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2937815">Setting up your own Print Commands</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="printing.html#id2938094">Innovations in Samba Printing since 2.2</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="printing.html#id2938259">Client Drivers on Samba Server for Point'n'Print</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2938411">The [printer$] Section is removed from Samba-3</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2938524">Creating the [print$] Share</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2938595">Parameters in the [print$] Section</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2938826">Subdirectory Structure in [print$]</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="printing.html#id2938986">Installing Drivers into [print$]</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="printing.html#id2939081">Setting Drivers for existing Printers with a Client GUI</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2939264">Setting Drivers for existing Printers with
+rpcclient</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="printing.html#id2940985">&quot;The Proof of the Pudding lies in the Eating&quot; (Client Driver Insta
+Procedure)</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="printing.html#id2941006">The first Client Driver Installation</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2941204">IMPORTANT! Setting Device Modes on new Printers</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2941493">Further Client Driver Install Procedures</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2941588">Always make first Client Connection as root or &quot;printer admin&quot;</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="printing.html#id2941730">Other Gotchas</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="printing.html#id2941763">Setting Default Print Options for the Client Drivers</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2942200">Supporting large Numbers of Printers</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2942503">Adding new Printers with the Windows NT APW</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2942746">Weird Error Message Cannot connect under a
+different Name</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2942844">Be careful when assembling Driver Files</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2943191">Samba and Printer Ports</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2943261">Avoiding the most common Misconfigurations of the Client Driver</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="printing.html#id2943283">The Imprints Toolset</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="printing.html#id2943329">What is Imprints?</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2943370">Creating Printer Driver Packages</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2943389">The Imprints Server</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2943413">The Installation Client</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="printing.html#id2943566">Add Network Printers at Logon without User Interaction</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2943895">The addprinter command</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2943940">Migration of &quot;Classical&quot; printing to Samba-3</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2944110">Publishing Printer Information in Active Directory or LDAP</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2944124">Common Errors and Problems</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="printing.html#id2944137">I give my root password but I don't get access</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2944170">My printjobs get spooled into the spooling directory, but then get lost</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2934100"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+Printing is often a mission-critical service for the users. Samba can
+provide this service reliably and seamlessly for a client network
+consisting of Windows workstations.
+</p><p>
+A Samba-3.0 print service may be run on a Standalone or a Domain
+member server, side by side with file serving functions, or on a
+dedicated print server. It can be made as tight or as loosely secured
+as needs dictate. Configurations may be simple or complex. Available
+authentication schemes are essentially the same as described for file
+services in previous chapters. Overall, Samba's printing support is
+now able to replace an NT or Windows 2000 print server full-square,
+with additional benefits in many cases. Clients may download and
+install drivers and printers through their familiar &quot;Point'n'Print&quot;
+mechanism. Printer installations executed by &quot;Logon Scripts&quot; are no
+problem. Administrators can upload and manage drivers to be used by
+clients through the familiar &quot;Add Printer Wizard&quot;. As an additional
+benefit, driver and printer management may be run from the commandline
+or through scripts, making it more efficient in case of large numbers
+of printers. If a central accounting of print jobs (tracking every
+single page and supplying the raw data for all sorts of statistical
+reports) is required, this is best supported by CUPS as the print
+subsystem underneath the Samba hood.
+</p><p>
+This chapter deals with the foundations of Samba printing, as they
+implemented by the more traditional UNIX (BSD- and System V-style)
+printing systems. Many things apply to CUPS, the newer Common UNIX
+Printing System, too; so if you use CUPS, you might be tempted to jump
+to the next chapter -- but you will certainly miss a few things if you
+do so. Better read this chapter too.
+</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p>
+Most of the given examples have been verified on Windows XP
+Professional clients. Where this document describes the responses to
+commands given, bear in mind that Windows 2000 clients are very
+similar, but may differ in details. Windows NT is somewhat different
+again.
+</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2934168"></a>Technical Introduction</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+Samba's printing support always relies on the installed print
+subsystem of the Unix OS it runs on. Samba is a &quot;middleman&quot;. It takes
+printfiles from Windows (or other SMB) clients and passes them to the
+real printing system for further processing. Therefore it needs to
+&quot;talk&quot; to two sides: to the Windows print clients and to the Unix
+printing system. Hence we must differentiate between the various
+client OS types each of which behave differently, as well as the
+various UNIX print subsystems, which themselves have different
+features and are accessed differently. This part of the Samba HOWTO
+Collection deals with the &quot;traditional&quot; way of Unix printing first;
+the next chapter covers in great detail the more modern
+<span class="emphasis"><em>Common UNIX Printing System</em></span>
+(CUPS).
-[print$]
- path = /usr/local/samba/printers
- guest ok = yes
- browseable = yes
- read only = yes
- ; since this share is configured as read only, then we need
- ; a 'write list'. Check the file system permissions to make
- ; sure this account can copy files to the share. If this
- ; is setup to a non-root account, then it should also exist
- ; as a 'printer admin'
- write list = @ntadmin,root</PRE
-></P
-><P
->The <A
-HREF="smb.conf.5.html#WRITELIST"
-TARGET="_top"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->write list</I
-></TT
-></A
-> is used to allow administrative
-level user accounts to have write access in order to update files
-on the share. See the <A
-HREF="smb.conf.5.html"
-TARGET="_top"
->smb.conf(5)
-man page</A
-> for more information on configuring file shares.</P
-><P
->The requirement for <A
-HREF="smb.conf.5.html#GUESTOK"
-TARGET="_top"
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->guest
-ok = yes</B
-></A
-> depends upon how your
-site is configured. If users will be guaranteed to have
-an account on the Samba host, then this is a non-issue.</P
-><DIV
-CLASS="NOTE"
-><P
-></P
-><TABLE
-CLASS="NOTE"
-WIDTH="100%"
-BORDER="0"
-><TR
-><TD
-WIDTH="25"
-ALIGN="CENTER"
-VALIGN="TOP"
-><IMG
-SRC="../images/note.gif"
-HSPACE="5"
-ALT="Note"></TD
-><TH
-ALIGN="LEFT"
-VALIGN="CENTER"
-><B
->Author's Note</B
-></TH
-></TR
-><TR
-><TD
->&nbsp;</TD
-><TD
-ALIGN="LEFT"
-VALIGN="TOP"
-><P
->The non-issue is that if all your Windows NT users are guaranteed to be
-authenticated by the Samba server (such as a domain member server and the NT
-user has already been validated by the Domain Controller in
-order to logon to the Windows NT console), then guest access
-is not necessary. Of course, in a workgroup environment where
-you just want to be able to print without worrying about
-silly accounts and security, then configure the share for
-guest access. You'll probably want to add <A
-HREF="smb.conf.5.html#MAPTOGUEST"
-TARGET="_top"
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->map to guest = Bad User</B
-></A
-> in the [global] section as well. Make sure
-you understand what this parameter does before using it
-though. --jerry</P
-></TD
-></TR
-></TABLE
-></DIV
-><P
->In order for a Windows NT print server to support
-the downloading of driver files by multiple client architectures,
-it must create subdirectories within the [print$] service
-which correspond to each of the supported client architectures.
-Samba follows this model as well.</P
-><P
->Next create the directory tree below the [print$] share
-for each architecture you wish to support.</P
-><P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
->[print$]-----
- |-W32X86 ; "Windows NT x86"
- |-WIN40 ; "Windows 95/98"
- |-W32ALPHA ; "Windows NT Alpha_AXP"
- |-W32MIPS ; "Windows NT R4000"
- |-W32PPC ; "Windows NT PowerPC"</PRE
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="WARNING"
-><P
-></P
-><TABLE
-CLASS="WARNING"
-WIDTH="100%"
-BORDER="0"
-><TR
-><TD
-WIDTH="25"
-ALIGN="CENTER"
-VALIGN="TOP"
-><IMG
-SRC="../images/warning.gif"
-HSPACE="5"
-ALT="Warning"></TD
-><TH
-ALIGN="LEFT"
-VALIGN="CENTER"
-><B
->ATTENTION! REQUIRED PERMISSIONS</B
-></TH
-></TR
-><TR
-><TD
->&nbsp;</TD
-><TD
-ALIGN="LEFT"
-VALIGN="TOP"
-><P
->In order to currently add a new driver to you Samba host,
-one of two conditions must hold true:</P
-><P
-></P
-><UL
-><LI
-><P
->The account used to connect to the Samba host
- must have a uid of 0 (i.e. a root account)</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->The account used to connect to the Samba host
- must be a member of the <A
-HREF="smb.conf.5.html#PRINTERADMIN"
-TARGET="_top"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->printer
- admin</I
-></TT
-></A
-> list.</P
-></LI
-></UL
-><P
->Of course, the connected account must still possess access
-to add files to the subdirectories beneath [print$]. Remember
-that all file shares are set to 'read only' by default.</P
-></TD
-></TR
-></TABLE
-></DIV
-><P
->Once you have created the required [print$] service and
-associated subdirectories, simply log onto the Samba server using
-a root (or <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->printer admin</I
-></TT
->) account
-from a Windows NT 4.0/2k client. Open "Network Neighbourhood" or
-"My Network Places" and browse for the Samba host. Once you have located
-the server, navigate to the "Printers..." folder.
-You should see an initial listing of printers
-that matches the printer shares defined on your Samba host.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><H2
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN1985">14.2.2. Setting Drivers for Existing Printers</H2
-><P
->The initial listing of printers in the Samba host's
-Printers folder will have no real printer driver assigned
-to them. This defaults to a NULL string to allow the use
-of the local Add Printer Wizard on NT/2000 clients.
-Attempting to view the printer properties for a printer
-which has this default driver assigned will result in
-the error message:</P
-><P
-><SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->Device settings cannot be displayed. The driver
-for the specified printer is not installed, only spooler
-properties will be displayed. Do you want to install the
-driver now?</I
-></SPAN
-></P
-><P
->Click "No" in the error dialog and you will be presented with
-the printer properties window. The way to assign a driver to a
-printer is to either</P
-><P
-></P
-><UL
-><LI
-><P
->Use the "New Driver..." button to install
- a new printer driver, or</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->Select a driver from the popup list of
- installed drivers. Initially this list will be empty.</P
-></LI
-></UL
-><P
->If you wish to install printer drivers for client
-operating systems other than "Windows NT x86", you will need
-to use the "Sharing" tab of the printer properties dialog.</P
-><P
->Assuming you have connected with a root account, you
-will also be able modify other printer properties such as
-ACLs and device settings using this dialog box.</P
-><P
->A few closing comments for this section, it is possible
-on a Windows NT print server to have printers
-listed in the Printers folder which are not shared. Samba does
-not make this distinction. By definition, the only printers of
-which Samba is aware are those which are specified as shares in
-<TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->smb.conf</TT
->.</P
-><P
->Another interesting side note is that Windows NT clients do
-not use the SMB printer share, but rather can print directly
-to any printer on another Windows NT host using MS-RPC. This
-of course assumes that the printing client has the necessary
-privileges on the remote host serving the printer. The default
-permissions assigned by Windows NT to a printer gives the "Print"
-permissions to the "Everyone" well-known group.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><H2
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN2001">14.2.3. Support a large number of printers</H2
-><P
->One issue that has arisen during the development
-phase of Samba 2.2 is the need to support driver downloads for
-100's of printers. Using the Windows NT APW is somewhat
-awkward to say the list. If more than one printer are using the
-same driver, the <A
-HREF="rpcclient.1.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->rpcclient's
-setdriver command</B
-></A
-> can be used to set the driver
-associated with an installed driver. The following is example
-of how this could be accomplished:</P
-><P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
->
-<TT
-CLASS="PROMPT"
->$ </TT
->rpcclient pogo -U root%secret -c "enumdrivers"
-Domain=[NARNIA] OS=[Unix] Server=[Samba 2.2.0-alpha3]
+</p><div class="important" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Important</h3><p>CUPS users, be warned: don't just jump on to the next
+chapter. You might miss important information contained only
+here!</p></div><p>
+</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2934206"></a>What happens if you send a Job from a Client</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+To successfully print a job from a Windows client via a Samba
+print server to a UNIX printer, there are 6 (potentially 7)
+stages:
+</p><div class="orderedlist"><ol type="1"><li><p>Windows opens a connection to the printershare</p></li><li><p>Samba must authenticate the user</p></li><li><p>Windows sends a copy of the printfile over the network
+into Samba's spooling area</p></li><li><p>Windows closes the connection again</p></li><li><p>Samba invokes the print command to hand the file over
+to the UNIX print subsystem's spooling area</p></li><li><p>The Unix print subsystem processes the print
+job</p></li><li><p>The printfile may need to be explicitely deleted
+from the Samba spooling area.</p></li></ol></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2934276"></a>Printing Related Configuration Parameters</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+There are a number of configuration parameters in
+ controlling Samba's printing
+behaviour. Please also refer to the man page for smb.conf to
+acquire an overview about these. As with other parameters, there are
+Global Level (tagged with a &quot;<span class="emphasis"><em>G</em></span>&quot; in the listings) and
+Service Level (&quot;<span class="emphasis"><em>S</em></span>&quot;) parameters.
+</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">Service Level Parameters</span></dt><dd><p>These <span class="emphasis"><em>may</em></span> go into the
+<i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i> section of
+. In this case they define the default
+behaviour of all individual or service level shares (provided those
+don't have a different setting defined for the same parameter, thus
+overriding the global default).</p></dd><dt><span class="term">Global Parameters</span></dt><dd><p>These <span class="emphasis"><em>may not</em></span> go into individual
+shares. If they go in by error, the &quot;testparm&quot; utility can discover
+this (if you run it) and tell you so.</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2934356"></a>Parameters Recommended for Use</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>The following <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> parameters directly
+related to printing are used in Samba-3. See also the
+<tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> man page for detailed explanations:
+</p><p><b>List of printing related parameters in Samba-3. </b>
+</p><div class="itemizedlist"><p class="title"><b>Global level parameters:</b></p><ul type="disc"><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>addprinter command (G)</tt></i></p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>deleteprinter command (G)</tt></i></p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>disable spoolss (G)</tt></i></p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>enumports command (G)</tt></i></p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>load printers (G)</tt></i></p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>lpq cache time (G)</tt></i></p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>os2 driver map (G)</tt></i></p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>printcap name (G), printcap (G)</tt></i></p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>show add printer wizard (G)</tt></i></p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>total print jobs (G)</tt></i></p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>use client driver (G)</tt></i></p></li></ul></div><p>
+
+</p><div class="itemizedlist"><p class="title"><b>Service level parameters:</b></p><ul type="disc"><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>hosts allow (S)</tt></i></p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>hosts deny (S)</tt></i></p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>lppause command (S)</tt></i></p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>lpq command (S)</tt></i></p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>lpresume command (S)</tt></i></p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>lprm command (S)</tt></i></p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>max print jobs (S)</tt></i></p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>min print space (S)</tt></i></p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>print command (S)</tt></i></p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>printable (S), print ok (S)</tt></i></p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>printer name (S), printer (S)</tt></i></p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin (S)</tt></i></p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>printing = [cups|bsd|lprng...] (S)</tt></i></p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>queuepause command (S)</tt></i></p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>queueresume command (S)</tt></i></p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>total print jobs (S)</tt></i></p></li></ul></div><p>
+</p><p>
+Samba's printing support implements the Microsoft Remote Procedure
+Calls (MS-RPC) methods for printing. These are used by Windows NT (and
+later) print servers. The old &quot;LanMan&quot; protocol is still supported as
+a fallback resort, and for older clients to use. More details will
+follow further beneath.
+</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2935524"></a>Parameters for Backwards Compatibility</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+Two new parameters that were added in Samba 2.2.2, are still present
+in Samba-3.0. Both of these options are described in the
+<tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> man page and are disabled by
+default. <span class="emphasis"><em>Use them with caution!</em></span>
+</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term"><i class="parameter"><tt>disable spoolss(G)</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p> This is
+provided for better support of Samba 2.0.x backwards capability. It
+will disable Samba's support for MS-RPC printing and yield identical
+printing behaviour to Samba 2.0.x.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><i class="parameter"><tt>use client driver (G)</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p> was provided
+for using local printer drivers on Windows NT/2000 clients. It does
+not apply to Windows 95/98/ME clients.</p></dd></dl></div><p><b>Parameters &quot;for backward compatibility only&quot;, use with caution. </b>
+</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>disable spoolss (G)</tt></i></p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>use client driver (S)</tt></i></p></li></ul></div><p>
+</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2935632"></a>Parameters no longer in use</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+Samba users upgrading from 2.2.x to 3.0 need to be aware that some
+previously available settings are no longer supported (as was
+announced some time ago). Here is a list of them:
+</p><p><b>&quot;old&quot; parameters, removed in Samba-3. </b>
+The following <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> parameters have been
+deprecated already in Samba 2.2 and are now completely removed from
+Samba-3. You cannot use them in new 3.0 installations:
+
+</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>printer driver file (G)</tt></i></p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>total print jobs (G)</tt></i></p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>postscript (S)</tt></i></p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>printer driver (S)</tt></i></p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>printer driver location (S)</tt></i></p></li></ul></div><p>
+</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2935725"></a>A simple Configuration to Print with Samba-3</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+Here is a very simple example configuration for print related settings
+in the file. If you compare it with your
+own system's , you probably find some
+additional parameters included there (as pre-configured by your OS
+vendor). Further below is a discussion and explanation of the
+parameters. Note, that this example doesn't use many parameters.
+However, in many environments these are enough to provide a valid
+ which enables all clients to print.
+</p><pre class="programlisting">
+ [global]
+ printing = bsd
+ load printers = yes
+
+ [printers]
+ path = /var/spool/samba
+ printable = yes
+ public = yes
+ writable = no
+</pre><p>
+This is only an example configuration. Many settings, if not
+explicitly set to a specific value, are used and set by Samba
+implicitly to its own default, because these have been compiled in.
+To see all settings, let root use the <b class="command">testparm</b>
+utility. <b class="command">testparm</b> also gives warnings if you have
+mis-configured certain things. Its complete output is easily 340 lines
+and more. You may want to pipe it through a pager program.
+</p><p>
+The syntax for the configuration file is easy to grasp. You should
+know that is not very picky about its
+syntax. It has been explained elsewhere in this document. A short
+reminder: It even tolerates some spelling errors (like &quot;browsable&quot;
+instead of &quot;browseable&quot;). Most spelling is case-insensitive. Also, you
+can use &quot;Yes|No&quot; or &quot;True|False&quot; for boolean settings. Lists of names
+may be separated by commas, spaces or tabs.
+</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2935795"></a>Verification of &quot;Settings in Use&quot; with <b class="command">testparm</b></h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+To see all (or at least most) printing related settings in Samba,
+including the implicitly used ones, try the command outlined below
+(hit &quot;ENTER&quot; twice!). It greps for all occurrences of &quot;lp&quot;, &quot;print&quot;,
+&quot;spool&quot;, &quot;driver&quot;, &quot;ports&quot; and &quot;[&quot; in testparm's output and gives you
+a nice overview about the running smbd's print configuration. (Note
+that this command does not show individually created printer shares,
+or the spooling paths in each case). Here is the output of my Samba
+setup, with exactly the same settings in
+as shown above:
+</p><pre class="screen">
+<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>testparm -v | egrep &quot;(lp|print|spool|driver|ports|\[)&quot;</tt></b>
+ Load smb config files from /etc/samba/smb.conf.simpleprinting
+ Processing section &quot;[homes]&quot;
+ Processing section &quot;[printers]&quot;
+
+ [global]
+ smb ports = 445 139
+ lpq cache time = 10
+ total print jobs = 0
+ load printers = Yes
+ printcap name = /etc/printcap
+ disable spoolss = No
+ enumports command =
+ addprinter command =
+ deleteprinter command =
+ show add printer wizard = Yes
+ os2 driver map =
+ printer admin =
+ min print space = 0
+ max print jobs = 1000
+ printable = No
+ printing = bsd
+ print command = lpr -r -P'%p' %s
+ lpq command = lpq -P'%p'
+ lprm command = lprm -P'%p' %j
+ lppause command =
+ lpresume command =
+ printer name =
+ use client driver = No
+
+ [homes]
+
+ [printers]
+ path = /var/spool/samba
+ printable = Yes
+
+</pre><p>
+You can easily verify which settings were implicitly added by Samba's
+default behaviour. <span class="emphasis"><em>Don't forget about this point: it may
+be important in your future dealings with Samba.</em></span>
+</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> testparm in Samba-3.0 behaves differently from 2.2.x: used
+without the &quot;-v&quot; switch it only shows you the settings actually
+written into ! To see the complete
+configuration used, add the &quot;-v&quot; parameter to testparm.</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2935884"></a>A little Experiment to warn you</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+Should you need to troubleshoot at any stage, please always come back
+to this point first and verify if &quot;testparm&quot; shows the parameters you
+expect! To give you an example from personal experience as a warning,
+try to just &quot;comment out&quot; the <i class="parameter"><tt>load printers</tt></i>&quot;
+parameter. If your 2.2.x system behaves like mine, you'll see this:
+</p><pre class="screen">
+<tt class="prompt">root# </tt>grep &quot;load printers&quot; /etc/samba/smb.conf
+ # load printers = Yes
+ # This setting is commented ooouuuuut!!
+
+<tt class="prompt">root# </tt>testparm -v /etc/samba/smb.conf | egrep &quot;(load printers)&quot;
+ load printers = Yes
+
+</pre><p>
+Despite my imagination that the commenting out of this setting should
+prevent Samba from publishing my printers, it still did! Oh Boy -- it
+cost me quite some time to find out the reason. But I am not fooled
+any more... at least not by this ;-)
+</p><pre class="screen">
+<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>grep -A1 &quot;load printers&quot; /etc/samba/smb.conf</tt></b>
+ load printers = No
+ # This setting is what I mean!!
+ # load printers = Yes
+ # This setting is commented ooouuuuut!!
+
+<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>testparm -v smb.conf.simpleprinting | egrep &quot;(load printers)&quot;</tt></b>
+ load printers = No
+
+</pre><p>
+Only when setting the parameter explicitly to
+&quot;<i class="parameter"><tt>load printers = No</tt></i>&quot;
+would Samba recognize my intentions. So my strong advice is:
+</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Never rely on &quot;commented out&quot; parameters!</p></li><li><p>Always set it up explicitly as you intend it to
+behave.</p></li><li><p>Use <b class="command">testparm</b> to uncover hidden
+settings which might not reflect your intentions.</p></li></ul></div><p>
+You can have a working Samba print configuration with this
+minimal :
+</p><pre class="screen">
+<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>cat /etc/samba/smb.conf-minimal</tt></b>
+ [printers]
+
+</pre><p>
+This example should show you that you can use testparm to test any
+filename for fitness as a Samba configuration. Actually, we want to
+encourage you <span class="emphasis"><em>not</em></span> to change your
+ on a working system (unless you know
+exactly what you are doing)! Don't rely on an assumption that changes
+will only take effect after you re-start smbd! This is not the
+case. Samba re-reads its every 60
+seconds and on each new client connection. You might have to face
+changes for your production clients that you didn't intend to apply at
+this time! You will now note a few more interesting things. Let's now
+ask <b class="command">testparm</b> what the Samba print configuration
+would be, if you used this minimalistic file as your real
+:
+</p><pre class="screen">
+<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt> testparm -v /etc/samba/smb.conf-minimal | egrep &quot;(print|lpq|spool|driver|ports|[)&quot;</tt></b>
+ Processing section &quot;[printers]&quot;
+ WARNING: [printers] service MUST be printable!
+ No path in service printers - using /tmp
+
+ lpq cache time = 10
+ total print jobs = 0
+ load printers = Yes
+ printcap name = /etc/printcap
+ disable spoolss = No
+ enumports command =
+ addprinter command =
+ deleteprinter command =
+ show add printer wizard = Yes
+ os2 driver map =
+ printer admin =
+ min print space = 0
+ max print jobs = 1000
+ printable = No
+ printing = bsd
+ print command = lpr -r -P%p %s
+ lpq command = lpq -P%p
+ printer name =
+ use client driver = No
+ [printers]
+ printable = Yes
+
+</pre><p>
+testparm issued 2 warnings:
+</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>because we didn't specify the
+<i class="parameter"><tt>[printers]</tt></i> section as printable,
+and</p></li><li><p>because we didn't tell it which spool directory to
+use.</p></li></ul></div><p>
+However, this was not fatal, and Samba-3.0 will default to values that
+will work here. But, please!, don't rely on this and don't use this
+example! This was only meant to make you careful to design and specify
+your setup to be what you really want it to be. The outcome on your
+system may vary for some parameters, since you may have a Samba built
+with a different compile-time configuration.
+<span class="emphasis"><em>Warning:</em></span> don't put a comment sign <span class="emphasis"><em>at
+the end</em></span> of a valid line. It
+will cause the parameter to be ignored (just as if you had put the
+comment sign at the front). At first I regarded this as a bug in my
+Samba version(s). But the man page states: &#8220;<span class="quote">Internal whitespace
+in a parameter value is retained verbatim.</span>&#8221; This means that a
+line consisting of, for example,
+</p><pre class="screen">
+printing =lprng #This defines LPRng as the printing system&quot;
+</pre><p>
+will regard the whole of the string after the &quot;=&quot;
+sign as the value you want to define. And this is an invalid value
+that will be ignored, and a default value used instead.]
+</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2936190"></a>Extended Sample Configuration to Print with Samba-3</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+Here we show a more verbose example configuration for print related
+settings in an . Below is a discussion
+and explanation of the various parameters. We chose to use BSD-style
+printing here, because we guess it is still the most commonly used
+system on legacy Linux installations (new installs now predominantly
+have CUPS, which is discussed entirely in the next chapter of this
+document). Note, that this example explicitly names many parameters
+which don't need to be stated because they are set by default. You
+might be able to do with a leaner .</p><div class="tip" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Tip</h3><p>
+if you read access it with the Samba Web Administration Tool (SWAT),
+and then write it to disk again, it will be optimized in a way such
+that it doesn't contain any superfluous parameters and comments. SWAT
+organizes the file for best performance. Remember that each smbd
+re-reads the Samba configuration once a minute, and that each
+connection spawns an smbd process of its own, so it is not a bad idea
+to optimize the in environments with
+hundreds or thousands of clients.</p></div><pre class="programlisting">
+ [global]
+ printing = bsd
+ load printers = yes
+ show add printer wizard = yes
+ printcap name = /etc/printcap
+ printer admin = @ntadmin, root
+ total print jobs = 100
+ lpq cache time = 20
+ use client driver = no
+
+ [printers]
+ comment = All Printers
+ printable = yes
+ path = /var/spool/samba
+ browseable = no
+ guest ok = yes
+ public = yes
+ read only = yes
+ writable = no
+
+ [my_printer_name]
+ comment = Printer with Restricted Access
+ path = /var/spool/samba_my_printer
+ printer admin = kurt
+ browseable = yes
+ printable = yes
+ writeable = no
+ hosts allow = 0.0.0.0
+ hosts deny = turbo_xp, 10.160.50.23, 10.160.51.60
+ guest ok = no
+</pre><p>
+This <span class="emphasis"><em>also</em></span> is only an example configuration. You
+may not find all the settings in your own
+ (as pre-configured by your OS
+vendor). Many configuration parameters, if not explicitly set to a
+specific value, are used and set by Samba implicitly to its own
+default, because these have been compiled in. To see all settings, let
+root use the <b class="command">testparm</b>
+utility. <b class="command">testparm</b> also gives warnings if you have
+mis-configured certain things..
+</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2936293"></a>Detailed Explanation of the Example's Settings</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+Following is a discussion of the settings from above shown example.
+</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2936306"></a>The [global] Section</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+The <i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i> section is one of 4 special
+sections (along with [<i class="parameter"><tt>[homes]</tt></i>,
+<i class="parameter"><tt>[printers]</tt></i> and
+<i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i>...) It contains all parameters which
+apply to the server as a whole. It is the place for parameters which
+have only a &quot;global&quot; meaning (G). It may also contain service level
+parameters (S) which then define default settings for all other
+sections and shares. This way you can simplify the configuration and
+avoid setting the same value repeatedly. (Within each individual
+section or share you may however override these globally set &quot;share
+level&quot; settings and specify other values).
+</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term"><i class="parameter"><tt>printing = bsd</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p> this causes Samba to use default print commands
+applicable for the BSD (a.k.a. RFC 1179 style or LPR/LPD) printing
+system. In general, the &quot;printing&quot; parameter informs Samba about the
+print subsystem it should expect. Samba supports CUPS, LPD, LPRNG,
+SYSV, HPUX, AIX, QNX and PLP. Each of these systems defaults to a
+different <i class="parameter"><tt>print command</tt></i> (and other queue control
+commands).</p><div class="caution" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Caution</h3><p>The <i class="parameter"><tt>printing</tt></i> parameter is
+normally a service level parameter. Since it is included here in the
+<i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i> section, it will take effect for all
+printer shares that are not defined differently. Samba-3.0 no longer
+supports the SOFTQ printing system.</p></div></dd><dt><span class="term"><i class="parameter"><tt>load printers = yes</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p> this tells Samba to create automatically all
+available printer shares. &quot;Available&quot; printer shares are discovered by
+scanning the printcap file. All created printer shares are also loaded
+for browsing. If you use this parameter, you do not need to specify
+separate shares for each printer. Each automatically created printer
+share will clone the configuration options found in the
+<i class="parameter"><tt>[printers]</tt></i> section. (A <i class="parameter"><tt>load printers
+= no</tt></i> setting will allow you to specify each UNIX printer
+you want to share separately, leaving out some you don't want to be
+publicly visible and available). </p></dd><dt><span class="term"><i class="parameter"><tt>show add printer wizard =
+yes</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p> this setting is normally
+enabled by default (even if the parameter is not written into the
+). It makes the <span class="guiicon">Add Printer Wizard</span> icon
+show up in the <span class="guiicon">Printers</span> folder of the Samba host's
+share listing (as shown in <span class="guiicon">Network Neighbourhood</span> or
+by the <b class="command">net view</b> command). To disable it, you need to
+explicitly set it to <tt class="constant">no</tt> (commenting it out
+will not suffice!). The Add Printer Wizard lets you upload printer
+drivers to the <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> share and associate it
+with a printer (if the respective queue exists there before the
+action), or exchange a printer's driver against any other previously
+uploaded driver. </p></dd><dt><span class="term"><i class="parameter"><tt>total print jobs = 100</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p> this setting sets the upper limit to 100 print jobs
+being active on the Samba server at any one time. Should a client
+submit a job which exceeds this number, a &#8220;<span class="quote">no more space
+available on server</span>&#8221; type of error message will be returned by
+Samba to the client. A setting of &quot;0&quot; (the default) means there is
+<span class="emphasis"><em>no</em></span> limit at all!
+</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><i class="parameter"><tt>printcap name = /etc/printcap</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p> this tells Samba where to look for a list of
+available printer names. (If you use CUPS, make sure that a printcap
+file is written: this is controlled by the &quot;Printcap&quot; directive of
+<tt class="filename">cupsd.conf</tt>).
+</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin = @ntadmin</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p> members of the ntadmin group should be able to add
+drivers and set printer properties (&quot;ntadmin&quot; is only an example name,
+it needs to be a valid UNIX group name); root is implicitly always a
+<i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin</tt></i>. The &quot;@&quot; sign precedes group names in
+. A printer admin can do anything to
+printers via the remote administration interfaces offered by MS-RPC
+(see below). Note that the <i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin</tt></i>
+parameter is normally a share level parameter, so you may associate
+different groups to different printer shares in larger installations,
+if you use the <i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin</tt></i> parameter on the
+share levels).
+</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><i class="parameter"><tt>lpq cache time = 20</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p> this controls the cache time for the results of the
+lpq command. It prevents the lpq command being called too often and
+reduces load on a heavily used print server.
+</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><i class="parameter"><tt>use client driver = no</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p> if set to <tt class="constant">yes</tt>, this setting only
+takes effect for Win NT/2k/XP clients (and not for Win 95/98/ME). Its
+default value is <tt class="constant">No</tt> (or <tt class="constant">False</tt>).
+It must <span class="emphasis"><em>not</em></span> be enabled on print shares
+(with a <tt class="constant">yes</tt> or <tt class="constant">true</tt> setting) which
+have valid drivers installed on the Samba server! For more detailed
+explanations see the man page of <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>.
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2936689"></a>The [printers] Section</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+This is the second special section. If a section with this name
+appears in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>, users are able to
+connect to any printer specified in the Samba host's printcap file,
+because Samba on startup then creates a printer share for every
+printername it finds in the printcap file. You could regard this
+section as a general convenience shortcut to share all printers with
+minimal configuration. It is also a container for settings which
+should apply as default to all printers. (For more details see the
+<tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> man page.) Settings inside this
+container must be share level parameters (S).
+</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term"><i class="parameter"><tt>comment = All printers</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p> the <i class="parameter"><tt>comment</tt></i> is shown next to
+the share if a client queries the server, either via <span class="guiicon">Network
+Neighbourhood</span> or with the <b class="command">net view</b> command to list
+available shares.
+</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><i class="parameter"><tt>printable = yes</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p> please note well, that the
+<i class="parameter"><tt>[printers]</tt></i> service <span class="emphasis"><em>must</em></span> be
+declared as printable. If you specify otherwise, smbd will refuse to
+load at startup. This parameter allows
+connected clients to open, write to and submit spool files into the
+directory specified with the <i class="parameter"><tt>path</tt></i> parameter for
+this service. It is used by Samba to differentiate printer shares from
+file shares. </p></dd><dt><span class="term"><i class="parameter"><tt>path = /var/spool/samba</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p>this must point to a directory used by Samba to spool
+incoming print files. <span class="emphasis"><em>It must not be the same as the spool
+directory specified in the configuration of your UNIX print
+subsystem!</em></span> The path would typically point to a directory
+which is world writeable, with the &quot;sticky&quot; bit set to it.
+</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><i class="parameter"><tt>browseable = no</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p> this is always set to <tt class="constant">no</tt> if
+<i class="parameter"><tt>printable = yes</tt></i>. It makes the
+<i class="parameter"><tt>[printer]</tt></i> share itself invisible in the
+list of available shares in a <b class="command">net view</b> command or
+in the Explorer browse list. (Note that you will of course see the
+individual printers).
+</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><i class="parameter"><tt>guest ok = yes</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p>
+if set to <tt class="constant">yes</tt>, then no password is required to
+connect to the printers service. Access will be granted with the
+privileges of the <i class="parameter"><tt>guest account</tt></i>. On many systems the
+guest account will map to a user named &quot;nobody&quot;. This user is in the UNIX
+passwd file with an empty password, but with no valid UNIX login.
+(Note: on some systems the guest account might not have the
+privilege to be able to print. Test this by logging in as your
+guest user using <b class="command">su - guest</b> and run a system print
+command like
+</p><p><b class="userinput"><tt>lpr -P printername /etc/motd</tt></b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><i class="parameter"><tt>public = yes</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p> this is a synonym for <i class="parameter"><tt>guest ok =
+yes</tt></i>. Since we have <i class="parameter"><tt>guest ok = yes</tt></i>,
+it really doesn't need to be here! (This leads to the interesting
+question: &#8220;<span class="quote">What, if I by accident have to contradictory settings
+for the same share?</span>&#8221; The answer is: the last one encountered by
+Sambe wins. The &quot;winner&quot; is shown by testparm. Testparm doesn't
+complain about different settings of the same parameter for the same
+share! You can test this by setting up multiple lines for the &quot;guest
+account&quot; parameter with different usernames, and then run testparm to
+see which one is actually used by Samba.)
+</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><i class="parameter"><tt>read only = yes</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p>this normally (for other types of shares) prevents
+users creating or modifying files in the service's directory. However,
+in a &quot;printable&quot; service, it is <span class="emphasis"><em>always</em></span> allowed to
+write to the directory (if user privileges allow the connection), but
+only via print spooling operations. &quot;Normal&quot; write operations are not
+allowed. </p></dd><dt><span class="term"><i class="parameter"><tt>writeable = no</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p>
+synonym for <i class="parameter"><tt>read only = yes</tt></i>
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2937018"></a>Any [my_printer_name] Section</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+If a section appears in the , which is
+tagged as <i class="parameter"><tt>printable = yes</tt></i>, Samba presents it as
+a printer share to its clients. Note, that Win95/98/ME clients may
+have problems with connecting or loading printer drivers if the share
+name has more than 8 characters! Also be very careful if you give a
+printer the same name as an existing user or file share name: upon a
+client's connection request to a certain sharename, Samba always tries
+to find file shares with that name first; if it finds one, it will
+connect to this and will never ultimately connect to a printer with
+the same name!
+</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term"><i class="parameter"><tt>comment = Printer with Restricted Access</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p> the comment says it all.
+</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><i class="parameter"><tt>path = /var/spool/samba_my_printer</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p> here we set the spooling area for this printer to
+another directory than the default. It is not a requirement to set it
+differently, but the option is available.
+</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin = kurt</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p> the printer admin definition is different for this
+explicitly defined printer share from the general
+<i class="parameter"><tt>[printers]</tt></i> share. It is not a requirement; we
+did it to show that it is possible if you want it.
+</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><i class="parameter"><tt>browseable = yes</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p> we also made this printer browseable (so that the
+clients may conveniently find it when browsing the <span class="guiicon">Network
+Neighbourhood</span>).
+</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><i class="parameter"><tt>printable = yes</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p>see explanation in last subsection.
+</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><i class="parameter"><tt>writeable = no</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p>see explanation in last subsection.
+</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><i class="parameter"><tt>hosts allow = 10.160.50.,10.160.51.</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p>here we exercise a certain degree of access control
+by using the <i class="parameter"><tt>hosts allow</tt></i> and <i class="parameter"><tt>hosts deny</tt></i> parameters. Note, that
+this is not by any means a safe bet. It is not a way to secure your
+printers. This line accepts all clients from a certain subnet in a
+first evaluation of access control
+</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><i class="parameter"><tt>hosts deny = turbo_xp,10.160.50.23,10.160.51.60
+</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p>all listed hosts are not allowed here (even if they
+belong to the &quot;allowed subnets&quot;). As you can see, you could name IP
+addresses as well as NetBIOS hostnames
+here.
+</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><i class="parameter"><tt>guest ok = no</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p>this printer is not open for the guest account!
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2937239"></a>Print Commands</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+In each section defining a printer (or in the
+<i class="parameter"><tt>[printers]</tt></i> section), a <i class="parameter"><tt>print
+command</tt></i> parameter may be defined. It sets a command to
+process the files which have been placed into the Samba print spool
+directory for that printer. (That spool directory was, if you
+remember, set up with the <i class="parameter"><tt>path</tt></i>
+parameter). Typically, this command will submit the spool file to the
+Samba host's print subsystem, using the suitable system print
+command. But there is no requirement that this needs to be the
+case. For debugging purposes or some other reason you may want to do
+something completely different than &quot;print&quot; the file. An example is a
+command that just copies the print file to a temporary location for
+further investigation when you need to debug printing. If you craft
+your own print commands (or even develop print command shell scripts),
+make sure you pay attention to the need to remove the files from the
+Samba spool directory. Otherwise your hard disk may soon suffer from
+shortage of free space.
+</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2937289"></a>Default Print Commands for various Unix Print Subsystems</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+You learned earlier on, that Samba in most cases uses its built-in
+settings for many parameters if it can not find an explicitly stated
+one in its configuration file. The same is true for the
+<i class="parameter"><tt>print command</tt></i>. The default print command varies
+depending on the <i class="parameter"><tt>printing =...</tt></i> parameter
+setting. In the commands listed below, you will notice some parameters
+of the form <span class="emphasis"><em>%X</em></span> where <span class="emphasis"><em>X</em></span> is
+<span class="emphasis"><em>p, s, J</em></span> etc. These letters stand for
+&quot;printername&quot;, &quot;spoolfile&quot; and &quot;job ID&quot; respectively. They are
+explained in more detail further below. Here is an overview (excluding
+the special case of CUPS, which is discussed in the next chapter):
+</p><div class="informaltable"><table border="1"><colgroup><col><col></colgroup><thead><tr><th align="left">If this setting is active...</th><th align="left">...this is used in lieu of an explicit command:</th></tr></thead><tbody><tr><td align="left"><i class="parameter"><tt>printing = bsd|aix|lprng|plp</tt></i></td><td align="left">print command is <b class="command">lpr -r -P%p %s</b></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><i class="parameter"><tt>printing = sysv|hpux</tt></i></td><td align="left">print command is <b class="command">lp -c -P%p %s; rm %s</b></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><i class="parameter"><tt>printing = qnx</tt></i></td><td align="left">print command is <b class="command">lp -r -P%p -s %s</b></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><i class="parameter"><tt>printing = bsd|aix|lprng|plp</tt></i></td><td align="left">lpq command is <b class="command">lpq -P%p</b></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><i class="parameter"><tt>printing = sysv|hpux</tt></i></td><td align="left">lpq command is <b class="command">lpstat -o%p</b></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><i class="parameter"><tt>printing = qnx</tt></i></td><td align="left">lpq command is <b class="command">lpq -P%p</b></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><i class="parameter"><tt>printing = bsd|aix|lprng|plp</tt></i></td><td align="left">lprm command is <b class="command">lprm -P%p %j</b></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><i class="parameter"><tt>printing = sysv|hpux</tt></i></td><td align="left">lprm command is <b class="command">cancel %p-%j</b></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><i class="parameter"><tt>printing = qnx</tt></i></td><td align="left">lprm command is <b class="command">cancel %p-%j</b></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><i class="parameter"><tt>printing = bsd|aix|lprng|plp</tt></i></td><td align="left">lppause command is <b class="command">lp -i %p-%j -H hold</b></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><i class="parameter"><tt>printing = sysv|hpux</tt></i></td><td align="left">lppause command (...is empty)</td></tr><tr><td align="left"><i class="parameter"><tt>printing = qnx</tt></i></td><td align="left">lppause command (...is empty)</td></tr><tr><td align="left"><i class="parameter"><tt>printing = bsd|aix|lprng|plp</tt></i></td><td align="left">lpresume command is <b class="command">lp -i %p-%j -H resume</b></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><i class="parameter"><tt>printing = sysv|hpux</tt></i></td><td align="left">lpresume command (...is empty)</td></tr><tr><td align="left"><i class="parameter"><tt>printing = qnx</tt></i></td><td align="left">lpresume command (...is empty)</td></tr></tbody></table></div><p>
+We excluded the special CUPS case here, because it is discussed in the
+next chapter. Just a short summary. For <i class="parameter"><tt>printing =
+CUPS</tt></i>: If SAMBA is compiled against libcups, it uses the
+CUPS API to submit jobs, etc. (It is a good idea also to set
+<i class="parameter"><tt>printcap = cups</tt></i> in case your
+<tt class="filename">cupsd.conf</tt> is set to write its autogenerated
+printcap file to an unusual place). Otherwise Samba maps to the System
+V printing commands with the -oraw option for printing, i.e. it uses
+<b class="command">lp -c -d%p -oraw; rm %s</b> With <i class="parameter"><tt>printing =
+cups</tt></i> , and if SAMBA is compiled against libcups, any
+manually set print command will be ignored!
+</p><p>
+Having listed the above mappings here, you should note that there used
+to be a <span class="emphasis"><em>bug</em></span> in recent 2.2.x versions which
+prevented the mapping from taking effect. It lead to the
+&quot;bsd|aix|lprng|plp&quot; settings taking effect for all other systems, for
+the most important commands (the <b class="command">print</b> command, the
+<b class="command">lpq</b> command and the <b class="command">lprm</b>
+command). The <b class="command">lppause</b> command and the
+<b class="command">lpresume</b> command remained empty. Of course, these
+commands worked on bsd|aix|lprng|plp but they didn't work on
+sysv|hpux|qnx systems. To work around this bug, you need to
+explicitly set the commands. Use <b class="command">testparm -v</b> to
+check which command takes effect. Then check that this command is
+adequate and actually works for your installed print subsystem. It is
+always a good idea to explicitly set up your configuration files the
+way you want them to work and not rely on any built-in defaults.
+</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2937815"></a>Setting up your own Print Commands</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+After a print job has finished spooling to a service, the
+<i class="parameter"><tt>print command</tt></i> will be used by Samba via a
+<span class="emphasis"><em>system()</em></span> call to process the spool file. Usually
+the command specified will submit the spool file to the host's
+printing subsystem. But there is no requirement at all that this must
+be the case. The print subsystem will probably not remove the spool
+file on its own. So whatever command you specify on your own you
+should ensure that the spool file is deleted after it has been
+processed.
+</p><p>
+There is no difficulty with using your own customized print commands
+with the traditional printing systems. However, if you don't wish to
+&quot;roll your own&quot;, you should be well informed about the default
+built-in commands that Samba uses for each printing subsystem (see the
+table above). In all the commands listed in the last paragraphs you
+see parameters of the form <span class="emphasis"><em>%X</em></span> These are
+<span class="emphasis"><em>macros</em></span>, or shortcuts, used as place holders for
+the names of real objects. At the time of running a command with such
+a placeholder, Samba will insert the appropriate value
+automatically. Print commands can handle all Samba macro
+substitutions. In regard to printing, the following ones do have
+special relevance:
+</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>%s, %f</tt></i> - the path to the spool
+file name</p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>%p</tt></i> - the appropriate printer
+name</p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>%J</tt></i> - the job name as
+transmitted by the client.</p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>%c</tt></i> - the number of printed
+pages of the spooled job (if known).</p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>%z</tt></i> - the size of the spooled
+print job (in bytes)</p></li></ul></div><p>
+The print command MUST contain at least one occurrence of
+<i class="parameter"><tt>%s</tt></i> or <i class="parameter"><tt>%f</tt></i>. -- The
+<i class="parameter"><tt>%p</tt></i> is optional. If no printer name is supplied,
+the <i class="parameter"><tt>%p</tt></i> will be silently removed from the print
+command. In this case the job is sent to the default printer.
+</p><p>
+If specified in the <i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i> section, the print
+command given will be used for any printable service that does not
+have its own print command specified. If there is neither a specified
+print command for a printable service nor a global print command,
+spool files will be created but not processed! And (most importantly):
+print files will not be removed, so they will start filling your Samba
+hard disk.
+</p><p>
+Note that printing may fail on some UNIXes from the &quot;nobody&quot;
+account. If this happens, create an alternative guest account and
+supply it with the privilege to print. Set up this guest account in
+the <i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i> section with the <i class="parameter"><tt>guest
+account</tt></i> parameter.
+</p><p>
+You can form quite complex print commands. You need to realize that
+print commands are just passed to a UNIX shell. The shell is able to
+expand the included environment variables as usual. (The syntax to
+include a UNIX environment variable <i class="parameter"><tt>$variable</tt></i>
+in or in the Samba print command is
+<i class="parameter"><tt>%$variable</tt></i>.) To give you a working
+<i class="parameter"><tt>print command</tt></i> example, the following will log a
+print job to <tt class="filename">/tmp/print.log</tt>, print the file, then
+remove it. Note that ';' is the usual separator for commands in shell
+scripts:
+</p><pre class="programlisting">
+
+ print command = echo Printing %s &gt;&gt; /tmp/print.log; lpr -P %p %s; rm %s
+
+</pre><p>
+You may have to vary your own command considerably from this example
+depending on how you normally print files on your system. The default
+for the <i class="parameter"><tt>print command</tt></i> parameter varies depending on the setting of
+the <i class="parameter"><tt>printing</tt></i> parameter. Another example is:
+</p><pre class="programlisting">
+ print command = /usr/local/samba/bin/myprintscript %p %s
+</pre></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2938094"></a>Innovations in Samba Printing since 2.2</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+Before version 2.2.0, Samba's print server support for Windows clients
+was limited to the level of <span class="emphasis"><em>LanMan</em></span> printing
+calls. This is the same protocol level as Windows 9x PCs offer when
+they share printers. Beginning with the 2.2.0 release, Samba started
+to support the native Windows NT printing mechanisms. These are
+implemented via <span class="emphasis"><em>MS-RPC</em></span> (RPC = <span class="emphasis"><em>Remote
+Procedure Calls</em></span> ). MS-RPCs use the
+<span class="emphasis"><em>SPOOLSS</em></span> named pipe for all printing.
+</p><p>
+The additional functionality provided by the new SPOOLSS support includes:
+</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Support for downloading printer driver files to Windows
+95/98/NT/2000 clients upon demand (<span class="emphasis"><em>Point'n'Print</em></span>);
+</p></li><li><p>Uploading of printer drivers via the Windows NT
+<span class="emphasis"><em>Add Printer Wizard</em></span> (APW) or the
+<span class="emphasis"><em>Imprints</em></span> tool set (refer to <a href="http://imprints.sourceforge.net/" target="_top">http://imprints.sourceforge.net</a>);
+</p></li><li><p>Support for the native MS-RPC printing calls such as
+StartDocPrinter, EnumJobs(), etc... (See the MSDN documentation
+at <a href="http://msdn.microsoft.com/" target="_top">http://msdn.microsoft.com/</a>
+for more information on the Win32 printing API);</p></li><li><p>Support for NT <span class="emphasis"><em>Access Control
+Lists</em></span> (ACL) on printer objects;</p></li><li><p>Improved support for printer queue manipulation
+through the use of internal databases for spooled job information
+(implemented by various <tt class="filename">*.tdb</tt>
+files).</p></li></ul></div><p>
+One other benefit of an update is this: Samba-3 is able to publish
+all its printers in Active Directory (or LDAP)!
+</p><p>
+One slight difference is here: it is possible on a Windows NT print
+server to have printers listed in the Printers folder which are
+<span class="emphasis"><em>not</em></span> shared. Samba does not make this
+distinction. By definition, the only printers of which Samba is aware
+are those which are specified as shares in
+. The reason is that Windows NT/2k/XPprof
+clients do not normally need to use the standard SMB printer share;
+rather they can print directly to any printer on another Windows NT
+host using MS-RPC. This of course assumes that the printing client has
+the necessary privileges on the remote host serving the printer. The
+default permissions assigned by Windows NT to a printer gives the
+&quot;Print&quot; permissions to the well-known <span class="emphasis"><em>Everyone</em></span>
+group. (The older clients of type Win9x can only print to &quot;shared&quot;
+printers).
+</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2938259"></a>Client Drivers on Samba Server for <span class="emphasis"><em>Point'n'Print</em></span></h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+There is still confusion about what all this means: <span class="emphasis"><em>Is it or
+is it not a requirement for printer drivers to be installed on a Samba
+host in order to support printing from Windows clients?</em></span> The
+answer to this is: No, it is not a
+<span class="emphasis"><em>requirement</em></span>. Windows NT/2000 clients can, of
+course, also run their APW to install drivers
+<span class="emphasis"><em>locally</em></span> (which then connect to a Samba served
+print queue). This is the same method as used by Windows 9x
+clients. (However, a <span class="emphasis"><em>bug</em></span> existed in Samba 2.2.0
+which made Windows NT/2000 clients require that the Samba server
+possess a valid driver for the printer. This was fixed in Samba
+2.2.1).
+</p><p>
+But it is a new <span class="emphasis"><em>option</em></span> to install the printer
+drivers into the <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> share of the Samba
+server, and a big convenience too. Then <span class="emphasis"><em>all</em></span>
+clients (including 95/98/ME) get the driver installed when they first
+connect to this printer share. The <span class="emphasis"><em>uploading</em></span> or
+<span class="emphasis"><em>depositing</em></span> of the driver into this
+<i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> share, and the following binding of
+this driver to an existing Samba printer share can be achieved by
+different means:
+</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>running the <span class="emphasis"><em>APW</em></span> on an
+NT/2k/XPprof client (this doesn't work from 95/98/ME
+clients);</p></li><li><p>using the <span class="emphasis"><em>Imprints</em></span>
+toolset;</p></li><li><p>using the <span class="emphasis"><em>smbclient</em></span> and
+<span class="emphasis"><em>rpcclient</em></span> commandline tools;</p></li><li><p>using <span class="emphasis"><em>cupsaddsmb</em></span>(only works for
+the CUPS printing system, not for LPR/LPD, LPRng
+etc.).</p></li></ul></div><p>
+Please take additional note of the following fact: <span class="emphasis"><em>Samba
+does not use these uploaded drivers in any way to process spooled
+files</em></span>. Drivers are utilized entirely by the clients, who
+download and install them via the &quot;Point 'n'Print&quot; mechanism supported
+by Samba. The clients use these drivers to generate print files in the
+format the printer (or the Unix print system) requires. Print files
+received by Samba are handed over to the Unix printing system, which
+is responsible for all further processing, if needed.
+</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2938411"></a>The [printer$] Section is removed from Samba-3</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p><b>
+<i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> vs. <i class="parameter"><tt>[printer$]</tt></i>
+. </b>
+Versions of Samba prior to 2.2 made it possible to use a share
+named <span class="emphasis"><em>[printer$]</em></span>. This name was taken from the
+same named service created by Windows 9x clients when a printer was
+shared by them. Windows 9x printer servers always have a
+<i class="parameter"><tt>[printer$]</tt></i> service which provides read-only
+access (with no password required) in order to support printer driver
+downloads. However, Samba's initial implementation allowed for a
+parameter named <i class="parameter"><tt>printer driver location</tt></i> to be
+used on a per share basis. This specified the location of the driver
+files associated with that printer. Another parameter named
+<i class="parameter"><tt>printer driver</tt></i> provided a means of defining the
+printer driver name to be sent to the client. These parameters,
+including the <i class="parameter"><tt>printer driver file</tt></i> parameter,
+are now removed and can not be used in installations of Samba-3.0.
+Now the share name <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> is used for the
+location of downloadable printer drivers. It is taken from the
+<i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> service created by Windows NT PCs when
+a printer is shared by them. Windows NT print servers always have a
+<i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> service which provides read-write
+access (in the context of its ACLs) in order to support printer driver
+down- and uploads. Don't fear -- this does not mean Windows 9x
+clients are thrown aside now. They can use Samba's
+<i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> share support just fine.
+</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2938524"></a>Creating the [print$] Share</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+In order to support the up- and downloading of printer driver files,
+you must first configure a file share named
+<i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i>. The &quot;public&quot; name of this share is
+hard coded in Samba's internals (because it is hardcoded in the MS
+Windows clients too). It cannot be renamed since Windows clients are
+programmed to search for a service of exactly this name if they want
+to retrieve printer driver files.
+</p><p>
+You should modify the server's file to
+add the global parameters and create the
+<i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> file share (of course, some of the
+parameter values, such as 'path' are arbitrary and should be replaced
+with appropriate values for your site):
+</p><pre class="screen">
+ [global]
+ ; members of the ntadmin group should be able to add drivers and set
+ ; printer properties. root is implicitly always a 'printer admin'.
+ printer admin = @ntadmin
+ [....]
+
+ [printers]
+ [....]
+
+ [print$]
+ comment = Printer Driver Download Area
+ path = /etc/samba/drivers
+ browseable = yes
+ guest ok = yes
+ read only = yes
+ write list = @ntadmin, root
+</pre><p>
+Of course, you also need to ensure that the directory named by the
+<i class="parameter"><tt>path</tt></i> parameter exists on the Unix file system.
+</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2938595"></a>Parameters in the [print$] Section</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+<i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> is a special section in
+. It contains settings relevant to
+potential printer driver download and local installation by clients.
+</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term"><i class="parameter"><tt>comment = Printer Driver
+Download Area</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p> the comment appears next to the share name if it is
+listed in a share list (usually Windows clients won't see it often but
+it will also appear up in a <b class="command">smbclient -L sambaserver
+</b> output). </p></dd><dt><span class="term"><i class="parameter"><tt>path = /etc/samba/printers</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p> this is the path to the location of the Windows
+driver file deposit from the UNIX point of
+view.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><i class="parameter"><tt>browseable = no</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p> this makes the <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> share
+&quot;invisible&quot; in Network Neighbourhood to clients. However, you can
+still &quot;mount&quot; it from any client using the <b class="command">net use
+g:\\sambaserver\print$</b> command in a &quot;DOS box&quot; or the
+&quot;Connect network drive&quot; menu from Windows
+Explorer.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><i class="parameter"><tt>guest ok = yes</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p>this gives read only access to this share for all
+guest users. Access may be used to download and install printer
+drivers on clients. The requirement for <i class="parameter"><tt>guest ok =
+yes</tt></i> depends upon how your site is configured. If users
+will be guaranteed to have an account on the Samba host, then this is
+a non-issue.</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p>
+The non-issue is this: if all your Windows NT users are guaranteed to
+be authenticated by the Samba server (for example if Samba
+authenticates via an NT domain server and the NT user has already been
+validated by the Domain Controller in order to logon to the Windows NT
+session), then guest access is not necessary. Of course, in a
+workgroup environment where you just want to be able to print without
+worrying about silly accounts and security, then configure the share
+for guest access. You'll probably want to add <i class="parameter"><tt>map to guest
+= Bad User</tt></i> in the <i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i> section
+as well. Make sure you understand what this parameter does before
+using it.
+</p></div></dd><dt><span class="term"><i class="parameter"><tt>read only = yes</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p>as we don't want everybody to upload driver files (or
+even change driver settings) we tagged this share as not
+writeable.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><i class="parameter"><tt>write list = @ntadmin,root</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p>since the <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> was made
+read only by the previous setting, we need to create a &quot;write list&quot;
+also. UNIX groups (denoted with a leading &quot;@&quot; character) and users
+listed here are allowed write access (as an exception to the general
+public's &quot;read-only&quot; access), which they need to update files on the
+share. Normally you will want to only name administrative level user
+accounts in this setting. Check the file system permissions to make
+sure these accounts can copy files to the share. If this is a non-root
+account, then the account should also be mentioned in the global
+<i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin </tt></i> parameter. See the
+ man page for more information on
+configuring file shares. </p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2938826"></a>Subdirectory Structure in [print$]</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+In order for a Windows NT print server to support the downloading of
+driver files by multiple client architectures, you must create several
+subdirectories within the <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> service
+(i.e. the Unix directory named by the <i class="parameter"><tt>path</tt></i>
+parameter). These correspond to each of the supported client
+architectures. Samba follows this model as well. Just like the name of
+the <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> share itself, the subdirectories
+*must* be exactly the names listed below (you may leave out the
+subdirectories of architectures you don't want to support).
+</p><p>
+Therefore, create a directory tree below the
+<i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> share for each architecture you wish
+to support.
+</p><pre class="programlisting">
+[print$]--+--
+ |--W32X86 # serves drivers to &quot;Windows NT x86&quot;
+ |--WIN40 # serves drivers to &quot;Windows 95/98&quot;
+ |--W32ALPHA # serves drivers to &quot;Windows NT Alpha_AXP&quot;
+ |--W32MIPS # serves drivers to &quot;Windows NT R4000&quot;
+ |--W32PPC # serves drivers to &quot;Windows NT PowerPC&quot;
+</pre><div class="important" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Required permissions</h3><p>
+In order to add a new driver to your Samba host, one of two conditions
+must hold true:
+</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>The account used to connect to the Samba host must
+have a UID of 0 (i.e. a root account)</p></li><li><p>The account used to connect to the Samba host must be
+named in the <span class="emphasis"><em>printer admin</em></span>list.</p></li></ul></div><p>
+Of course, the connected account must still possess access to add
+files to the subdirectories beneath
+<i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i>. Remember that all file shares are set
+to 'read only' by default.
+</p></div><p>
+Once you have created the required <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i>
+service and associated subdirectories, go to a Windows NT 4.0/2k/XP
+client workstation. Open <span class="guiicon">Network Neighbourhood</span> or
+<span class="guiicon">My Network Places</span> and browse for the Samba host.
+Once you have located the server, navigate to its <span class="guiicon">Printers and
+Faxes</span> folder. You should see an initial listing of printers
+that matches the printer shares defined on your Samba host.
+</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2938986"></a>Installing Drivers into [print$]</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+You have successfully created the <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i>
+share in ? And Samba has re-read its
+configuration? Good. But you are not yet ready to take off. The
+<span class="emphasis"><em>driver files</em></span> need to be present in this share,
+too! So far it is still an empty share. Unfortunatly, it is not enough
+to just copy the driver files over. They need to be <span class="emphasis"><em>set
+up</em></span> too. And that is a bit tricky, to say the least. We
+will now discuss two alternative ways to install the drivers into
+<i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i>:
+</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>using the Samba commandline utility
+<b class="command">rpcclient</b> with its various subcommands (here:
+<b class="command">adddriver</b> and <b class="command">setdriver</b>) from
+any UNIX workstation;</p></li><li><p>running a GUI (<span class="emphasis"><em>Printer
+Properties</em></span> and <span class="emphasis"><em>Add Printer Wizard</em></span>)
+from any Windows NT/2k/XP client workstation.</p></li></ul></div><p>
+The latter option is probably the easier one (even if the only
+entrance to this realm seems a little bit weird at first).
+</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2939081"></a>Setting Drivers for existing Printers with a Client GUI</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+The initial listing of printers in the Samba host's
+<span class="guiicon">Printers</span> folder accessed from a client's Explorer
+will have no real printer driver assigned to them. By default, in
+Samba-3 (as in 2.2.1 and later) this driver name is set to a NULL
+string. This must be changed now. The local <span class="emphasis"><em>Add Printer
+Wizard</em></span>, run from NT/2000/XP clients, will help us in this
+task.
+</p><p>
+However, the job to set a valid driver for the printer is not a
+straightforward one: You must attempt to view the printer properties
+for the printer to which you want the driver assigned. Open the
+Windows Explorer, open Network Neighbourhood, browse to the Samba
+host, open Samba's <span class="guiicon">Printers</span> folder, right-click the printer icon and
+select <span class="guimenu">Properties...</span>. You are now trying to view printer and driver
+properties for a queue which has this default <tt class="constant">NULL</tt> driver
+assigned. This will result in an error message (this is normal here):
+</p><p><span class="errorname"> Device settings cannot be displayed. The driver
+for the specified printer is not installed, only spooler properties
+will be displayed. Do you want to install the driver
+now?</span></p><p>
+<span class="emphasis"><em>Important:</em></span>Don't click <span class="guibutton">Yes</span>! Instead,
+<span class="emphasis"><em>click <span class="guibutton">No</span></em></span> in the error dialog.
+Only now you will be presented with the printer properties window. From here,
+the way to assign a driver to a printer is open to us. You have now the choice
+either:
+</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>select a driver from the popup list of installed
+drivers. <span class="emphasis"><em>Initially this list will be empty.</em></span>
+Or</p></li><li><p>use the <span class="guibutton">New Driver...</span> button to
+install a new printer driver (which will in fact start up the
+APW).</p></li></ul></div><p>
+Once the APW is started, the procedure is exactly the same as the one
+you are familiar with in Wiindows (we assume here that you are
+familiar with the printer driver installations procedure on Windows
+NT). Make sure your connection is in fact setup as a user with
+<i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin</tt></i> privileges (if in doubt, use
+<b class="command">smbstatus</b> to check for this). If you wish to
+install printer drivers for client operating systems other than
+<span class="application">Windows NT x86</span>, you will need to use the
+<span class="guilabel">Sharing</span> tab of the printer properties dialog.
+</p><p>
+Assuming you have connected with an administrative (or root) account
+(as named by the <i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin</tt></i> parameter),
+you will also be able to modify other printer properties such as ACLs
+and default device settings using this dialog. For the default device
+settings, please consider the advice given further below.
+</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2939264"></a>Setting Drivers for existing Printers with
+<b class="command">rpcclient</b></h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+The second way to install printer drivers into
+<i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> and set them up in a valid way can be
+done from the UNIX command line. This involves four distinct steps:
+</p><div class="orderedlist"><ol type="1"><li><p>gathering the info about the required driver files
+and collecting the files together;</p></li><li><p>deposit the driver files into the
+<i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> share's correct subdirectories
+(possibly by using <b class="command">smbclient</b>);</p></li><li><p>running the <b class="command">rpcclient</b>
+commandline utility once with the <b class="command">addriver</b>
+subcommand,</p></li><li><p>running <b class="command">rpcclient</b> a second
+time with the <b class="command">setdriver</b>
+subcommand.</p></li></ol></div><p>
+We will provide detailed hints for each of these steps in the next few
+paragraphs.
+</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2939373"></a>Identifying the Driver Files</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+To find out about the driver files, you have two options: you could
+investigate the driver CD which comes with your printer. Study the
+<tt class="filename">*.inf</tt> file on the CD, if it is contained. This
+may not be the possible, since the *.inf file might be
+missing. Unfortunately, many vendors have now started to use their own
+installation programs. These installations packages are often some
+sort of Windows platform archive format, plus, the files may get
+re-named during the installation process. This makes it extremely
+difficult to identify the driver files you need.
+</p><p>
+Then you only have the second option: install the driver first on a
+Windows client *locally* and investigate which file names and paths it
+uses after they are installed. (Note, that you need to repeat this
+procedure for every client platform you want to support. We are going
+to show it here for the <span class="application">W32X86</span> platform only, a
+name used by Microsoft for all WinNT/2k/XP clients...)
+</p><p>
+A good method to recognize the driver files this is to print the test
+page from the driver's <span class="guilabel">Properties</span> Dialog
+(<span class="guilabel">General</span> tab). Then look at the list of driver
+files named on the printout. You'll need to recognize what Windows
+(and Samba) are calling the <span class="guilabel">Driver File</span> , the
+<span class="guilabel">Data File</span>, the <span class="guilabel">Config File</span>,
+the <span class="guilabel">Help File</span> and (optionally) the
+<span class="guilabel">Dependent Driver Files</span> (this may vary slightly
+for Windows NT). You need to remember all names (or better take a
+note) for the next steps.
+</p><p>
+Another method to quickly test the driver filenames and related paths
+is provided by the <b class="command">rpcclient</b> utility. Run it with
+<b class="command">enumdrivers</b> or with the
+<b class="command">getdriver</b> subcommand, each in the
+<span class="emphasis"><em>3</em></span> level. In the following example,
+<span class="emphasis"><em>TURBO_XP</em></span> is the name of the Windows PC (in this
+case it was a Windows XP Professional laptop, BTW). I had installed
+the driver locally to TURBO_XP while <span class="emphasis"><em>kde-bitshop</em></span> is
+the name of the Linux host from which I am working. We could run an
+<span class="emphasis"><em>interactive</em></span> <b class="command">rpcclient</b> session;
+then we'd get an <span class="emphasis"><em>rpcclient /&gt;</em></span> prompt and would
+type the subcommands at this prompt. This is left as a good exercise
+to the reader. For now we use <b class="command">rpcclient</b> with the
+<tt class="option">-c</tt> parameter to execute a single subcommand
+line and exit again. This is the method you would use if you want to
+create scripts to automate the procedure for a large number of
+printers and drivers. Note the different quotes used to overcome the
+different spaces in between words:
+</p><pre class="screen">
+<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>rpcclient -U'Danka%xxxx' -c 'getdriver &quot;Heidelberg Digimaster 9110 (PS)&quot; 3' TURBO_XP</tt></b>
+ cmd = getdriver &quot;Heidelberg Digimaster 9110 (PS)&quot; 3
+
+ [Windows NT x86]
+ Printer Driver Info 3:
+ Version: [2]
+ Driver Name: [Heidelberg Digimaster 9110 (PS)]
+ Architecture: [Windows NT x86]
+ Driver Path: [C:\WINNT\System32\spool\DRIVERS\W32X86\2\HDNIS01_de.DLL]
+ Datafile: [C:\WINNT\System32\spool\DRIVERS\W32X86\2\Hddm91c1_de.ppd]
+ Configfile: [C:\WINNT\System32\spool\DRIVERS\W32X86\2\HDNIS01U_de.DLL]
+ Helpfile: [C:\WINNT\System32\spool\DRIVERS\W32X86\2\HDNIS01U_de.HLP]
+
+ Dependentfiles: [C:\WINNT\System32\spool\DRIVERS\W32X86\2\Hddm91c1_de.DLL]
+ Dependentfiles: [C:\WINNT\System32\spool\DRIVERS\W32X86\2\Hddm91c1_de.INI]
+ Dependentfiles: [C:\WINNT\System32\spool\DRIVERS\W32X86\2\Hddm91c1KMMin.DLL]
+ Dependentfiles: [C:\WINNT\System32\spool\DRIVERS\W32X86\2\Hddm91c1_de.dat]
+ Dependentfiles: [C:\WINNT\System32\spool\DRIVERS\W32X86\2\Hddm91c1_de.cat]
+ Dependentfiles: [C:\WINNT\System32\spool\DRIVERS\W32X86\2\Hddm91c1_de.def]
+ Dependentfiles: [C:\WINNT\System32\spool\DRIVERS\W32X86\2\Hddm91c1_de.hre]
+ Dependentfiles: [C:\WINNT\System32\spool\DRIVERS\W32X86\2\Hddm91c1_de.vnd]
+ Dependentfiles: [C:\WINNT\System32\spool\DRIVERS\W32X86\2\Hddm91c1_de.hlp]
+ Dependentfiles: [C:\WINNT\System32\spool\DRIVERS\W32X86\2\Hddm91c1_de_reg.HLP]
+ Dependentfiles: [C:\WINNT\System32\spool\DRIVERS\W32X86\2\HDNIS01Aux.dll]
+ Dependentfiles: [C:\WINNT\System32\spool\DRIVERS\W32X86\2\HDNIS01_de.NTF]
+
+ Monitorname: []
+ Defaultdatatype: []
+
+</pre><p>
+You may notice, that this driver has quite a big number of
+<span class="guilabel">Dependentfiles</span> (I know worse cases however). Also,
+strangely, the <span class="guilabel">Driver File</span> is here tagged as
+<span class="guilabel">Driver Path</span>.... oh, well. Here we don't have yet
+support for the so-called <span class="application">WIN40</span> architecture
+installed. This name is used by Microsoft for the Win95/98/ME platforms.
+If we want to support these, we need to install the Win95/98/ME driver
+files in addition to those for <span class="application">W32X86</span>
+(i.e. the WinNT72000/XP clients) onto a Windows PC. This PC
+can also host the Win9x drivers, even if itself runs on Windows NT,
+2000 or XP.
+</p><p>
+Since the <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> share is usually accessible
+through the <span class="guiicon">Network Neighbourhood</span>, you can also use the UNC notation
+from Windows Explorer to poke at it. The Win9x driver files will end
+up in subdirectory &quot;0&quot; of the &quot;WIN40&quot; directory. The full path to
+access them will be
+<tt class="filename">\\WINDOWSHOST\print$\WIN40\0\</tt>.
+</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> more recent drivers on Windows 2000 and Wndows XP are
+installed into the &quot;3&quot; subdirectory instead of the &quot;2&quot;. The version 2
+of drivers, as used in Windows NT, were running in Kernel Mode.
+Windows 2000 changed this. While it still can use the Kernel Mode
+drivers (if this is enabled by the Admin), its native mode for printer
+drivers is User Mode execution. This requires drivers designed for
+this. These type of drivers install into the &quot;3&quot; subdirectory.
+</p></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2939701"></a>Collecting the Driver Files from a Windows Host's
+[print$] Share</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+Now we need to collect all the driver files we identified. in our
+previous step. Where do we get them from? Well, why not retrieve them
+from the very PC and the same <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> share
+which we investigated in our last step to identify the files? We can
+use <b class="command">smbclient</b> to do this. We will use the paths and
+names which were leaked to us by <b class="command">getdriver</b>. The
+listing is edited to include linebreaks for readability:
+</p><pre class="screen">
+<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>smbclient //TURBO_XP/print\$ -U'Danka%xxxx' \
+ -c 'cd W32X86/2;mget HD*_de.* \
+ hd*ppd Hd*_de.* Hddm*dll HDN*Aux.DLL'</tt></b>
+ added interface ip=10.160.51.60 bcast=10.160.51.255 nmask=255.255.252.0
+ Got a positive name query response from 10.160.50.8 ( 10.160.50.8 )
+ Domain=[DEVELOPMENT] OS=[Windows 5.1] Server=[Windows 2000 LAN Manager]
+ <tt class="prompt">Get file Hddm91c1_de.ABD? </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>n</tt></b>
+ <tt class="prompt">Get file Hddm91c1_de.def? </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>y</tt></b>
+ getting file \W32X86\2\Hddm91c1_de.def of size 428 as Hddm91c1_de.def (22.0 kb/s) (average 22.0 kb/s)
+ <tt class="prompt">Get file Hddm91c1_de.DLL? </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>y</tt></b>
+ getting file \W32X86\2\Hddm91c1_de.DLL of size 876544 as Hddm91c1_de.DLL (737.3 kb/s) (average 737.3 kb/s)
+ [...]
+
+</pre><p>
+After this command is complete, the files are in our current local
+directory. You probably have noticed that this time we passed several
+commands to the <tt class="option">-c</tt> parameter, separated by semi-colons. This
+effects that all commands are executed in sequence on the remote
+Windows server before smbclient exits again.
+</p><p>
+Don't forget to repeat the procedure for the <span class="application">WIN40</span>
+architecture should you need to support Win95/98/XP clients. Remember, the
+files for these architectures are in the WIN40/0/ subdir. Once we are
+complete, we can run <b class="command">smbclient ... put</b> to store
+the collected files on the Samba server's
+<i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> share.
+</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2939854"></a>Depositing the Driver Files into [print$]</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+So, now we are going to put the driver files into the
+<i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> share. Remember, the UNIX path to this
+share has been defined previously in your
+. You also have created subdirectories
+for the different Windows client types you want to support. Supposing
+your <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> share maps to the UNIX path
+<tt class="filename">/etc/samba/drivers/</tt>, your driver files should now
+go here:
+</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>for all Windows NT, 2000 and XP clients into
+<tt class="filename">/etc/samba/drivers/W32X86/</tt> <span class="emphasis"><em>but
+*not*(yet) into the &quot;2&quot; subdir</em></span>!</p></li><li><p>for all Windows 95, 98 and ME clients into
+<tt class="filename">/etc/samba/drivers/WIN40/</tt> -- <span class="emphasis"><em>but *not*
+(yet) into the &quot;0&quot; subdir</em></span>!</p></li></ul></div><p>
+We again use smbclient to transfer the driver files across the
+network. We specify the same files and paths as were leaked to us by
+running <b class="command">getdriver</b> against the original
+<span class="emphasis"><em>Windows</em></span> install. However, now we are going to
+store the files into a <span class="emphasis"><em>Samba/UNIX</em></span> print server's
+<i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> share...
+</p><pre class="screen">
+<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>smbclient //SAMBA-CUPS/print\$ -U'root%xxxx' -c 'cd W32X86; put HDNIS01_de.DLL; \
+ put Hddm91c1_de.ppd; put HDNIS01U_de.DLL; \
+ put HDNIS01U_de.HLP; put Hddm91c1_de.DLL; \
+ put Hddm91c1_de.INI; put Hddm91c1KMMin.DLL; \
+ put Hddm91c1_de.dat; put Hddm91c1_de.dat; \
+ put Hddm91c1_de.def; put Hddm91c1_de.hre; \
+ put Hddm91c1_de.vnd; put Hddm91c1_de.hlp; \
+ put Hddm91c1_de_reg.HLP; put HDNIS01Aux.dll; \
+ put HDNIS01_de.NTF'</tt></b>
+ added interface ip=10.160.51.60 bcast=10.160.51.255 nmask=255.255.252.0
+ Got a positive name query response from 10.160.51.162 ( 10.160.51.162 )
+ Domain=[CUPS-PRINT] OS=[Unix] Server=[Samba 2.2.7a]
+ putting file HDNIS01_de.DLL as \W32X86\HDNIS01_de.DLL (4465.5 kb/s) (average 4465.5 kb/s)
+ putting file Hddm91c1_de.ppd as \W32X86\Hddm91c1_de.ppd (12876.8 kb/s) (average 4638.9 kb/s)
+ putting file HDNIS01U_de.DLL as \W32X86\HDNIS01U_de.DLL (20249.8 kb/s) (average 5828.3 kb/s)
+ putting file HDNIS01U_de.HLP as \W32X86\HDNIS01U_de.HLP (9652.8 kb/s) (average 5899.8 kb/s)
+ putting file Hddm91c1_de.DLL as \W32X86\Hddm91c1_de.DLL (23777.7 kb/s) (average 10400.6 kb/s)
+ putting file Hddm91c1_de.INI as \W32X86\Hddm91c1_de.INI (98.6 kb/s) (average 10329.0 kb/s)
+ putting file Hddm91c1KMMin.DLL as \W32X86\Hddm91c1KMMin.DLL (22931.5 kb/s) (average 10501.7 kb/s)
+ putting file Hddm91c1_de.dat as \W32X86\Hddm91c1_de.dat (2462.8 kb/s) (average 10393.0 kb/s)
+ putting file Hddm91c1_de.dat as \W32X86\Hddm91c1_de.dat (4925.3 kb/s) (average 10356.3 kb/s)
+ putting file Hddm91c1_de.def as \W32X86\Hddm91c1_de.def (417.9 kb/s) (average 10290.1 kb/s)
+ putting file Hddm91c1_de.hre as \W32X86\Hddm91c1_de.hre (22571.3 kb/s) (average 11338.5 kb/s)
+ putting file Hddm91c1_de.vnd as \W32X86\Hddm91c1_de.vnd (3384.6 kb/s) (average 10754.3 kb/s)
+ putting file Hddm91c1_de.hlp as \W32X86\Hddm91c1_de.hlp (18406.8 kb/s) (average 10839.8 kb/s)
+ putting file Hddm91c1_de_reg.HLP as \W32X86\Hddm91c1_de_reg.HLP (20278.3 kb/s) (average 11386.3 kb/s)
+ putting file HDNIS01Aux.dll as \W32X86\HDNIS01Aux.dll (14994.6 kb/s) (average 11405.2 kb/s)
+ putting file HDNIS01_de.NTF as \W32X86\HDNIS01_de.NTF (23390.2 kb/s) (average 13170.8 kb/s)
+
+</pre><p>
+Phewww -- that was a lot of typing! Most drivers are a lot smaller --
+many only having 3 generic PostScript driver files plus 1 PPD. Note,
+that while we did retrieve the files from the &quot;2&quot; subdirectory of the
+&quot;W32X86&quot; directory from the Windows box, we <span class="emphasis"><em>don't</em></span>
+put them (for now) in this same subdirectory of the Samba box! This
+re-location will automatically be done by the
+<b class="command">adddriver</b> command which we will run shortly (and
+don't forget to also put the files for the Win95/98/ME architecture
+into the <tt class="filename">WIN40/</tt> subdirectory should you need
+them).
+</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2940090"></a>Check if the Driver Files are there (with smbclient)</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+For now we verify that our files are there. This can be done with
+<b class="command">smbclient</b> too (but of course you can log in via SSH
+also and do this through a standard UNIX shell access too):
+</p><pre class="screen">
+<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>smbclient //SAMBA-CUPS/print\$ -U 'root%xxxx' -c 'cd W32X86; pwd; dir; cd 2; pwd; dir'</tt></b>
+ added interface ip=10.160.51.60 bcast=10.160.51.255 nmask=255.255.252.0
+ Got a positive name query response from 10.160.51.162 ( 10.160.51.162 )
+ Domain=[CUPS-PRINT] OS=[Unix] Server=[Samba 2.2.7a]
+
+ Current directory is \\SAMBA-CUPS\print$\W32X86\
+ . D 0 Sun May 4 03:56:35 2003
+ .. D 0 Thu Apr 10 23:47:40 2003
+ 2 D 0 Sun May 4 03:56:18 2003
+ HDNIS01Aux.dll A 15356 Sun May 4 03:58:59 2003
+ Hddm91c1KMMin.DLL A 46966 Sun May 4 03:58:59 2003
+ HDNIS01_de.DLL A 434400 Sun May 4 03:58:59 2003
+ HDNIS01_de.NTF A 790404 Sun May 4 03:56:35 2003
+ Hddm91c1_de.DLL A 876544 Sun May 4 03:58:59 2003
+ Hddm91c1_de.INI A 101 Sun May 4 03:58:59 2003
+ Hddm91c1_de.dat A 5044 Sun May 4 03:58:59 2003
+ Hddm91c1_de.def A 428 Sun May 4 03:58:59 2003
+ Hddm91c1_de.hlp A 37699 Sun May 4 03:58:59 2003
+ Hddm91c1_de.hre A 323584 Sun May 4 03:58:59 2003
+ Hddm91c1_de.ppd A 26373 Sun May 4 03:58:59 2003
+ Hddm91c1_de.vnd A 45056 Sun May 4 03:58:59 2003
+ HDNIS01U_de.DLL A 165888 Sun May 4 03:58:59 2003
+ HDNIS01U_de.HLP A 19770 Sun May 4 03:58:59 2003
+ Hddm91c1_de_reg.HLP A 228417 Sun May 4 03:58:59 2003
+ 40976 blocks of size 262144. 709 blocks available
+
+ Current directory is \\SAMBA-CUPS\print$\W32X86\2\
+ . D 0 Sun May 4 03:56:18 2003
+ .. D 0 Sun May 4 03:56:35 2003
+ ADOBEPS5.DLL A 434400 Sat May 3 23:18:45 2003
+ laserjet4.ppd A 9639 Thu Apr 24 01:05:32 2003
+ ADOBEPSU.DLL A 109568 Sat May 3 23:18:45 2003
+ ADOBEPSU.HLP A 18082 Sat May 3 23:18:45 2003
+ PDFcreator2.PPD A 15746 Sun Apr 20 22:24:07 2003
+ 40976 blocks of size 262144. 709 blocks available
+
+</pre><p>
+Notice that there are already driver files present in the
+<tt class="filename">2</tt> subdir (probably from a previous
+installation). Once the files for the new driver are there too, you
+are still a few steps away from being able to use them on the
+clients. The only thing you could do *now* is to retrieve them from a
+client just like you retrieve ordinary files from a file share, by
+opening print$ in Windows Explorer. But that wouldn't install them per
+Point'n'Print. The reason is: Samba doesn't know yet that these files
+are something special, namely <span class="emphasis"><em>printer driver
+files</em></span> and it doesn't know yet to which print queue(s) these
+driver files belong.
+</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2940250"></a>Running <b class="command">rpcclient</b> with
+<b class="command">adddriver</b></h4></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+So, next you must tell Samba about the special category of the files
+you just uploaded into the <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> share. This
+is done by the <b class="command">adddriver</b> command. It will
+prompt Samba to register the driver files into its internal TDB
+database files. The following command and its output has been edited,
+again, for readability:
+</p><pre class="screen">
+<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>rpcclient -Uroot%xxxx -c 'adddriver &quot;Windows NT x86&quot; &quot;dm9110:HDNIS01_de.DLL: \
+ Hddm91c1_de.ppd:HDNIS01U_de.DLL:HDNIS01U_de.HLP: \
+ NULL:RAW:Hddm91c1_de.DLL,Hddm91c1_de.INI, \
+ Hddm91c1_de.dat,Hddm91c1_de.def,Hddm91c1_de.hre, \
+ Hddm91c1_de.vnd,Hddm91c1_de.hlp,Hddm91c1KMMin.DLL, \
+ HDNIS01Aux.dll,HDNIS01_de.NTF, \
+ Hddm91c1_de_reg.HLP' SAMBA-CUPS</tt></b>
+
+ cmd = adddriver &quot;Windows NT x86&quot; &quot;dm9110:HDNIS01_de.DLL:Hddm91c1_de.ppd:HDNIS01U_de.DLL: \
+ HDNIS01U_de.HLP:NULL:RAW:Hddm91c1_de.DLL,Hddm91c1_de.INI, \
+ Hddm91c1_de.dat,Hddm91c1_de.def,Hddm91c1_de.hre, \
+ Hddm91c1_de.vnd,Hddm91c1_de.hlp,Hddm91c1KMMin.DLL, \
+ HDNIS01Aux.dll,HDNIS01_de.NTF,Hddm91c1_de_reg.HLP&quot;
+
+ Printer Driver dm9110 successfully installed.
+
+</pre><p>
+After this step the driver should be recognized by Samba on the print
+server. You need to be very carefull when typing the command. Don't
+exchange the order of the fields. Some changes would lead to a
+<tt class="computeroutput">NT_STATUS_UNSUCCESSFUL</tt> error
+message. These become obvious. Other changes might install the driver
+files successfully, but render the driver unworkable. So take care!
+Hints about the syntax of the adddriver command are in the man
+page. The CUPS printing chapter of this HOWTO collection provides a
+more detailed description, if you should need it.
+</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2940351"></a>Check how Driver Files have been moved after
+<b class="command">adddriver</b> finished</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+One indication for Samba's recognition of the files as driver files is
+the <tt class="computeroutput">successfully installed</tt> message.
+Another one is the fact, that our files have been moved by the
+<b class="command">adddriver</b> command into the <tt class="filename">2</tt>
+subdirectory. You can check this again with
+<b class="command">smbclient</b>:
+</p><pre class="screen">
+<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>smbclient //SAMBA-CUPS/print\$ -Uroot%xxxx -c 'cd W32X86;dir;pwd;cd 2;dir;pwd'</tt></b>
+ added interface ip=10.160.51.162 bcast=10.160.51.255 nmask=255.255.252.0
+ Domain=[CUPS-PRINT] OS=[Unix] Server=[Samba 2.2.7a]
+
+ Current directory is \\SAMBA-CUPS\print$\W32X86\
+ . D 0 Sun May 4 04:32:48 2003
+ .. D 0 Thu Apr 10 23:47:40 2003
+ 2 D 0 Sun May 4 04:32:48 2003
+ 40976 blocks of size 262144. 731 blocks available
+
+ Current directory is \\SAMBA-CUPS\print$\W32X86\2\
+ . D 0 Sun May 4 04:32:48 2003
+ .. D 0 Sun May 4 04:32:48 2003
+ DigiMaster.PPD A 148336 Thu Apr 24 01:07:00 2003
+ ADOBEPS5.DLL A 434400 Sat May 3 23:18:45 2003
+ laserjet4.ppd A 9639 Thu Apr 24 01:05:32 2003
+ ADOBEPSU.DLL A 109568 Sat May 3 23:18:45 2003
+ ADOBEPSU.HLP A 18082 Sat May 3 23:18:45 2003
+ PDFcreator2.PPD A 15746 Sun Apr 20 22:24:07 2003
+ HDNIS01Aux.dll A 15356 Sun May 4 04:32:18 2003
+ Hddm91c1KMMin.DLL A 46966 Sun May 4 04:32:18 2003
+ HDNIS01_de.DLL A 434400 Sun May 4 04:32:18 2003
+ HDNIS01_de.NTF A 790404 Sun May 4 04:32:18 2003
+ Hddm91c1_de.DLL A 876544 Sun May 4 04:32:18 2003
+ Hddm91c1_de.INI A 101 Sun May 4 04:32:18 2003
+ Hddm91c1_de.dat A 5044 Sun May 4 04:32:18 2003
+ Hddm91c1_de.def A 428 Sun May 4 04:32:18 2003
+ Hddm91c1_de.hlp A 37699 Sun May 4 04:32:18 2003
+ Hddm91c1_de.hre A 323584 Sun May 4 04:32:18 2003
+ Hddm91c1_de.ppd A 26373 Sun May 4 04:32:18 2003
+ Hddm91c1_de.vnd A 45056 Sun May 4 04:32:18 2003
+ HDNIS01U_de.DLL A 165888 Sun May 4 04:32:18 2003
+ HDNIS01U_de.HLP A 19770 Sun May 4 04:32:18 2003
+ Hddm91c1_de_reg.HLP A 228417 Sun May 4 04:32:18 2003
+ 40976 blocks of size 262144. 731 blocks available
+
+</pre><p>
+Another verification is that the timestamp of the printing TDB files
+is now updated (and possibly their filesize has increased).
+</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2940519"></a>Check if the Driver is recognized by Samba</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+Now the driver should be registered with Samba. We can easily verify
+this, and will do so in a moment. However, this driver is
+<span class="emphasis"><em>not yet</em></span> associated with a particular
+<span class="emphasis"><em>printer</em></span>. We may check the driver status of the
+files by at least three methods:
+</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>from any Windows client browse Network Neighbourhood,
+finde the Samba host and open the Samba <span class="guiicon">Printers and
+Faxes</span> folder. Select any printer icon, right-click and
+select the printer <span class="guimenuitem">Properties</span>. Click on the
+<span class="guilabel">Advanced</span> tab. Here is a field indicating the
+driver for that printer. A drop down menu allows you to change that
+driver (be carefull to not do this unwittingly.). You can use this
+list to view all drivers know to Samba. Your new one should be amongst
+them. (Each type of client will only see his own architecture's
+list. If you don't have every driver installed for each platform, the
+list will differ if you look at it from Windows95/98/ME or
+WindowsNT/2000/XP.)</p></li><li><p>from a Windows 2000 or XP client (not WinNT) browse
+<span class="guiicon">Network Neighbourhood</span>, search for the Samba
+server and open the server's <span class="guiicon">Printers</span> folder,
+right-click the white background (with no printer highlighted). Select
+<span class="guimenuitem">Server Properties</span>. On the
+<span class="guilabel">Drivers</span> tab you will see the new driver listed
+now. This view enables you to also inspect the list of files belonging
+to that driver<span class="emphasis"><em> (this doesn't work on Windows NT, but only on
+Windows 2000 and Windows XP. WinNT doesn't provide the &quot;Drivers&quot;
+tab).</em></span>. An alternative, much quicker method for Windows
+2000/XP to start this dialog is by typing into a DOS box (you must of
+course adapt the name to your Samba server instead of <i class="replaceable"><tt>SAMBA-CUPS</tt></i>):
+</p><p><b class="userinput"><tt> rundll32 printui.dll,PrintUIEntry /s /t2 /n\\<i class="replaceable"><tt>SAMBA-CUPS</tt></i></tt></b></p></li><li><p>from a UNIX prompt run this command (or a variant
+thereof), where <i class="replaceable"><tt>SAMBA-CUPS</tt></i> is the name of the Samba
+host and &quot;xxxx&quot; represents the actual Samba password assigned to root:
+</p><p><b class="userinput"><tt>rpcclient -U'root%xxxx' -c 'enumdrivers' <i class="replaceable"><tt>SAMBA-CUPS</tt></i></tt></b></p><p>
+You will see a listing of all drivers Samba knows about. Your new one
+should be amongst them. But it is only listed under the <i class="parameter"><tt>[Windows NT
+x86]</tt></i> heading, not under <i class="parameter"><tt>[Windows 4.0]</tt></i>,
+since we didn't install that part. Or did *you*? -- You will see a listing of
+all drivers Samba knows about. Your new one should be amongst them. In our
+example it is named <span class="emphasis"><em>dm9110</em></span>. Note that the 3rd column
+shows the other installed drivers twice, for each supported architecture one
+time. Our new driver only shows up for
+<span class="application">Windows NT 4.0 or 2000</span>. To
+have it present for <span class="application">Windows 95, 98 and ME</span> you'll
+have to repeat the whole procedure with the WIN40 architecture and subdirectory.
+</p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2940723"></a>A sidenote: you are not bound to specific driver names</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+You can name the driver as you like. If you repeat the
+<b class="command">adddriver</b> step, with the same files as before, but
+with a different driver name, it will work the same:
+</p><pre class="screen">
+<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>rpcclient -Uroot%xxxx \
+ -c 'adddriver &quot;Windows NT x86&quot; \
+ &quot;myphantasydrivername:HDNIS01_de.DLL: \
+ Hddm91c1_de.ppd:HDNIS01U_de.DLL:HDNIS01U_de.HLP: \
+ NULL:RAW:Hddm91c1_de.DLL,Hddm91c1_de.INI, \
+ Hddm91c1_de.dat,Hddm91c1_de.def,Hddm91c1_de.hre, \
+ Hddm91c1_de.vnd,Hddm91c1_de.hlp,Hddm91c1KMMin.DLL, \
+ HDNIS01Aux.dll,HDNIS01_de.NTF,Hddm91c1_de_reg.HLP' SAMBA-CUPS
+ </tt></b>
+
+ cmd = adddriver &quot;Windows NT x86&quot;
+ &quot;myphantasydrivername:HDNIS01_de.DLL:Hddm91c1_de.ppd:HDNIS01U_de.DLL:\
+ HDNIS01U_de.HLP:NULL:RAW:Hddm91c1_de.DLL,Hddm91c1_de.INI, \
+ Hddm91c1_de.dat,Hddm91c1_de.def,Hddm91c1_de.hre, \
+ Hddm91c1_de.vnd,Hddm91c1_de.hlp,Hddm91c1KMMin.DLL, \
+ HDNIS01Aux.dll,HDNIS01_de.NTF,Hddm91c1_de_reg.HLP&quot;
+
+ Printer Driver myphantasydrivername successfully installed.
+
+</pre><p>
+You will also be able to bind that driver to any print queue (however,
+you are responsible yourself that you associate drivers to queues
+which make sense to the target printer). Note, that you can't run the
+<b class="command">rpcclient</b> <b class="command">adddriver</b> command
+repeatedly. Each run &quot;consumes&quot; the files you had put into the
+<i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> share by moving them into the
+respective subdirectories. So you <span class="emphasis"><em>must</em></span> precede an
+<b class="command">smbclient ... put</b> command before each
+<b class="command">rpcclient ... addriver</b>&quot; command.
+</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2940834"></a>La Grande Finale: Running <b class="command">rpcclient</b> with
+<b class="command">setdriver</b></h4></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+Samba still needs to know <span class="emphasis"><em>which</em></span> printer's driver
+this is. It needs to create a mapping of the driver to a printer, and
+store this info in its &quot;memory&quot;, the TDB files. The <b class="command">rpcclient
+setdriver</b> command achieves exactly this:
+</p><pre class="screen">
+<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>rpcclient -U'root%xxxx' -c 'setdriver dm9110 myphantasydrivername' <i class="replaceable"><tt>SAMBA-CUPS</tt></i></tt></b>
+ cmd = setdriver dm9110 myphantasydrivername
+ Successfully set dm9110 to driver myphantasydrivername.
+</pre><p>
+Ahhhhh -- no, I didn't want to do that. Repeat, this time with the
+name I intended:
+</p><pre class="screen">
+<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>rpcclient -U'root%xxxx' -c 'setdriver dm9110 dm9110' <i class="replaceable"><tt>SAMBA-CUPS</tt></i></tt></b>
+ cmd = setdriver dm9110 dm9110
+ Succesfully set dm9110 to driver dm9110.
+</pre><p>
+The syntax of the command is <b class="userinput"><tt>rpcclient
+-U'root%<i class="replaceable"><tt>sambapassword</tt></i>' -c 'setdriver
+&quot;<i class="replaceable"><tt>printername</tt></i>&quot;
+&quot;<i class="replaceable"><tt>drivername</tt></i>'
+<i class="replaceable"><tt>SAMBA-Hostname</tt></i></tt></b> . --
+Now we have done *most* of the work. But not yet all....
+</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p>
+the <b class="command">setdriver</b> command will only succeed if the printer is
+known to
+Samba already. A bug in 2.2.x prevented Samba from recognizing freshly
+installed printers. You had to restart Samba, or at least send a HUP
+signal to all running smbd processes to work around this:
+<b class="userinput"><tt>kill -HUP `pidof smbd`</tt></b>. </p></div></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2940985"></a>&quot;The Proof of the Pudding lies in the Eating&quot; (Client Driver Insta
+Procedure)</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+A famous philosopher said once: &#8220;<span class="quote">The Proof of the Pudding lies
+in the Eating</span>&#8221;. The proof for our setup lies in the printing.
+So let's install the printer driver onto the client PCs. This is not
+as straightforward as it may seem. Read on.
+</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2941006"></a>The first Client Driver Installation</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+Especially important is the installation onto the first client PC (for
+each architectural platform separately). Once this is done correctly,
+all further clients are easy to setup and shouldn't need further
+attention. What follows is a description for the recommended first
+procedure. You work now from a client workstation. First you should
+guarantee that your connection is not unwittingly mapped to
+<i class="parameter"><tt>bad user</tt></i> &quot;nobody&quot;. In a DOS box type:
+</p><p><b class="userinput"><tt>net use \\<i class="replaceable"><tt>SAMBA-SERVER</tt></i>\print$ /user:root</tt></b></p><p>
+Replace root, if needed, by another valid
+<i class="replaceable"><tt>printer admin</tt></i> user as given in the definition.
+Should you already be connected as a different user, you'll get an error
+message. There is no easy way to get rid of that connection, because
+Windows doesn't seem to know a concept of &quot;logging off&quot; from a share
+connection (don't confuse this with logging off from the local
+workstation; that is a different matter). You can try to close
+<span class="emphasis"><em>all</em></span> Windows file explorer and Internet Explorer
+windows. As a last resort, you may have to reboot. Make sure there is
+no automatic re-connection set up. It may be easier to go to a
+different workstation and try from there. After you have made sure you
+are connected as a printer admin user (you can check this with the
+<b class="command">smbstatus</b> command on Samba) do this from the
+Windows workstation:
+</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Open <span class="guiicon">Network
+Neighbourhood</span></p></li><li><p>Browse to Samba server</p></li><li><p>Open its <span class="guiicon">Printers and
+Faxes</span> folder</p></li><li><p>Highlight and right-click the printer</p></li><li><p>Select <span class="guimenuitem">Connect...</span> (for WinNT4/2K
+it is possibly <span class="guimenuitem">Install...</span>)</p></li></ul></div><p>
+A new printer (named <i class="replaceable"><tt>printername</tt></i> on
+samba-server) should now have appeared in your
+<span class="emphasis"><em>local</em></span> Printer folder (check <span class="guimenu">Start</span> --
+<span class="guimenuitem">Settings</span> -- <span class="guimenuitem">Control Panel</span>
+-- <span class="guiicon">Printers and Faxes</span>).
+</p><p>
+Most likely you are now tempted to try and print a test page. After
+all, you now can open the printer properties and on the &quot;General&quot; tab,
+there is a button offering to do just that. But chances are that you
+get an error message saying <span class="errorname">Unable to print Test
+Page</span>. The reason might be that there is not yet a
+valid Device Mode set for the driver, or that the &quot;Printer Driver
+Data&quot; set is still incomplete.
+</p><p>
+You must now make sure that a valid &quot;Device Mode&quot; is set for the
+driver. Don't fear -- we will explain now what that means.
+</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2941204"></a>IMPORTANT! Setting Device Modes on new Printers</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+In order for a printer to be truly usable by a Windows NT/2K/XP
+client, it must possess:
+</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>a valid <span class="emphasis"><em>Device Mode</em></span> generated by
+the driver for the printer (defining things like paper size,
+orientation and duplex settings), and</p></li><li><p>a complete set of
+<span class="emphasis"><em>Printer Driver Data</em></span> generated by the
+driver.</p></li></ul></div><p>
+If either one of these is incomplete, the clients can produce less
+than optimal output at best. In the worst cases, unreadable garbage or
+nothing at all comes from the printer or they produce a harvest of
+error messages when attempting to print. Samba stores the named values
+and all printing related info in its internal TDB database files
+<tt class="filename">(ntprinters.tdb</tt>,
+<tt class="filename">ntdrivers.tdb</tt>, <tt class="filename">printing.tdb</tt>
+and <tt class="filename">ntforms.tdb</tt>).
+</p><p>
+What do these two words stand for? Basically, the Device Mode and the
+set of Printer Driver Data is a collection of settings for all print
+queue properties, initialized in a sensible way. Device Modes and
+Printer Driver Data should initially be set on the print server (that is
+here: the Samba host) to healthy values so that the clients can start
+to use them immediately. How do we set these initial healthy values?
+This can be achieved by accessing the drivers remotely from an NT (or
+2k/XP) client, as is discussed in the next paragraphs.
+</p><p>
+Be aware, that a valid Device Mode can only be initiated by a
+<i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin</tt></i>, or root (the reason should be
+obvious). Device Modes can only correctly be set by executing the
+printer driver program itself. Since Samba can not execute this Win32
+platform driver code, it sets this field initially to NULL (which is
+not a valid setting for clients to use). Fortunately, most drivers
+generate themselves the Printer Driver Data that is needed, when they
+are uploaded to the <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> share with the
+help of the APW or rpcclient.
+</p><p>
+The generation and setting of a first valid Device Mode however
+requires some &quot;tickling&quot; from a client, to set it on the Samba
+server. The easiest means of doing so is to simply change the page
+orientation on the server's printer. This &quot;executes&quot; enough of the
+printer driver program on the client for the desired effect to happen,
+and feeds back the new Device Mode to our Samba server. You can use the
+native Windows NT/2K/XP printer properties page from a Window client
+for this:
+</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Browse the <span class="guiicon">Network Neighbourhood</span></p></li><li><p>Find the Samba server</p></li><li><p>Open the Samba server's <span class="guiicon">Printers and
+ Faxes</span> folder</p></li><li><p>Highlight the shared printer in question</p></li><li><p>Right-click the printer (you may already be here, if you
+followed the last section's description)</p></li><li><p>At the bottom of the context menu select
+<span class="guimenu">Properties....</span> (if the menu still offers the
+<span class="guimenuitem">Connect...</span> entry
+further above, you need to click that one first to achieve the driver
+installation as shown in the last section)</p></li><li><p>Go to the <span class="guilabel">Advanced</span> tab; click on
+<span class="guibutton">Printing Defaults...</span></p></li><li><p>Change the &quot;Portrait&quot; page setting to &quot;Landscape&quot; (and
+back)</p></li><li><p>(Oh, and make sure to <span class="emphasis"><em>apply</em></span>
+changes between swapping the page orientation to cause the change to
+actually take effect...).</p></li><li><p>While you're at it, you may optionally also want to
+set the desired printing defaults here, which then apply to all future
+client driver installations on the remaining from now
+on.</p></li></ul></div><p>
+This procedure has executed the printer driver program on the client
+platform and fed back the correct Device Mode to Samba, which now
+stored it in its TDB files. Once the driver is installed on the
+client, you can follow the analogous steps by accessing the
+<span class="emphasis"><em>local</em></span> <span class="guiicon">Printers</span> folder too if you are
+a Samba printer admin user. From now on printing should work as expected.
+</p><p>
+Samba also includes a service level parameter name <i class="parameter"><tt>default
+devmode</tt></i> for generating a default Device Mode for a
+printer. Some drivers will function well with Samba's default set of
+properties. Others may crash the client's spooler service. So use this
+parameter with caution. It is always better to have the client
+generate a valid device mode for the printer and store it on the
+server for you.
+</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2941493"></a>Further Client Driver Install Procedures</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+Every further driver may be done by any user, along the lines
+described above: Browse network, open printers folder on Samba server,
+right-click printer and choose <span class="guimenuitem">Connect...</span>. Once
+this completes (should be not more than a few seconds, but could also take
+a minute, depending on network conditions), you should find the new printer in
+your client workstation local <span class="guiicon">Printers and
+Faxes</span> folder.
+</p><p>
+You can also open your local <span class="guiicon">Printers and Faxes</span> folder by
+using this command on Windows 2000 and Windows XP Professional workstations:
+</p><p><b class="userinput"><tt>rundll32 shell32.dll,SHHelpShortcuts_RunDLL PrintersFolder
+</tt></b></p><p>
+or this command on Windows NT 4.0 workstations:
+</p><p><b class="userinput"><tt>
+rundll32 shell32.dll,Control_RunDLL MAIN.CPL @2
+</tt></b></p><p>
+You can enter the commands either inside a <span class="guilabel">DOS box</span> window
+or in the <span class="guimenuitem">Run command...</span> field from the
+<span class="guimenu">Start</span> menu.
+</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2941588"></a>Always make first Client Connection as root or &quot;printer admin&quot;</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+After you installed the driver on the Samba server (in its
+<i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> share, you should always make sure
+that your first client installation completes correctly. Make it a habit for
+yourself to build that the very first connection from a client as
+<i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin</tt></i>. This is to make sure that:
+</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> a first valid <span class="emphasis"><em>Device Mode</em></span> is
+really initialized (see above for more explanation details), and
+that</p></li><li><p> the default print settings of your printer for all
+further client installations are as you want them</p></li></ul></div><p>
+Do this by changing the orientation to landscape, click
+<span class="emphasis"><em>Apply</em></span>, and then change it back again. Then modify
+the other settings (for example, you don't want the default media size
+set to <span class="emphasis"><em>Letter</em></span>, when you are all using
+<span class="emphasis"><em>A4</em></span>, right? You may want to set the printer for
+<span class="emphasis"><em>duplex</em></span> as the default; etc.).
+</p><p>
+To connect as root to a Samba printer, try this command from a Windows
+2K/XP DOS box command prompt:
+</p><p><b class="userinput"><tt>runas /netonly /user:root &quot;rundll32 printui.dll,PrintUIEntry /p /t3 /n \\<i class="replaceable"><tt>SAMBA-SERVER</tt></i>\<i class="replaceable"><tt>printername</tt></i>&quot;</tt></b>
+</p><p>
+You will be prompted for root's Samba-password; type it, wait a few
+seconds, click on <span class="guibutton">Printing Defaults...</span> and
+proceed to set the job options as should be used as defaults by all
+clients. Alternatively, instead of root you can name one other member
+of the <i class="parameter"><tt>printer admins</tt></i> from the setting.
+</p><p>
+Now all the other users downloading and installing the driver
+the same way (called <span class="emphasis"><em>Point'n'Print</em></span>) will
+have the same defaults set for them. If you miss this step you'll
+get a lot of helpdesk calls from your users. But maybe you like to
+talk to people.... ;-)
+</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2941730"></a>Other Gotchas</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+Your driver is installed. It is ready for
+<span class="emphasis"><em>Point'n'Print</em></span> installation by the clients
+now. You <span class="emphasis"><em>may</em></span> have tried to download and use it
+onto your first client machine now. But wait... let's make you
+acquainted first with a few tips and tricks you may find useful. For
+example, suppose you didn't manage to &quot;set the defaults&quot; on the
+printer, as advised in the preceeding paragraphs? And your users
+complain about various issues (such as &#8220;<span class="quote">We need to set the paper
+size for each job from Letter to A4 and it won't store it!</span>&#8221;)
+</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2941763"></a>Setting Default Print Options for the Client Drivers</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+The last sentence might be viewed with mixed feelings by some users and
+admins. They have struggled for hours and hours and couldn't arrive at
+a point were their settings seemed to be saved. It is not their
+fault. The confusing thing is this: in the multi-tabbed dialog that pops
+up when you right-click the printer name and select
+<span class="guimenuitem">Properties...</span>, you can arrive at two identically
+looking dialogs, each claiming that they help you to set printer options,
+in three different ways. Here is the definite answer to the &quot;Samba
+Default Driver Setting FAQ&quot;:
+</p><p><b>&#8220;<span class="quote">I can't set and save default print options
+for all users on Win2K/XP! Why not?</span>&#8221; </b>
+How are you doing it? I bet the wrong way.... (it is not very
+easy to find out, though). There are 3 different ways to bring you to
+a dialog that <span class="emphasis"><em>seems</em></span> to set everything. All three
+dialogs <span class="emphasis"><em>look</em></span> the same. Only one of them
+<span class="emphasis"><em>does</em></span> what you intend.
+<span class="emphasis"><em>Important:</em></span> you need to be Administrator or Print
+Administrator to do this for all users. Here is how I reproduce it in
+on XP Professional:
+
+</p><div class="orderedlist"><ol type="A"><li><p>The first &quot;wrong&quot; way:
+
+</p><div class="orderedlist"><ol type="1"><li><p>Open the <span class="guiicon">Printers</span>
+folder.</p></li><li><p>Right-click on the printer
+(<span class="emphasis"><em>remoteprinter on cupshost</em></span>) and
+select in context menu <span class="guimenu">Printing
+Preferences...</span></p></li><li><p>Look at this dialog closely and remember what it looks
+like.</p></li></ol></div><p>
+</p></li><li><p>The second &quot;wrong&quot; way:
+
+</p><div class="orderedlist"><ol type="1"><li><p>Open the <span class="guimenu">Printers</span>
+folder.</p></li><li><p>Right-click on the printer (<span class="emphasis"><em>remoteprinter on
+cupshost</em></span>) and select in the context menu
+<span class="guimenuitem">Properties</span></p></li><li><p>Click on the <span class="guilabel">General</span>
+tab</p></li><li><p>Click on the button <span class="guibutton">Printing
+Preferences...</span></p></li><li><p>A new dialog opens. Keep this dialog open and go back
+to the parent dialog.</p></li></ol></div><p>
+</p></li><li><p>The third, the &quot;correct&quot; way: (should you do
+this from the beginning, just carry out steps 1. and 2. from second
+&quot;way&quot; above)
+
+</p><div class="orderedlist"><ol type="1"><li><p>Click on the <span class="guilabel">Advanced</span>
+tab. (Hmmm... if everything is &quot;Grayed Out&quot;, then you are not logged
+in as a user with enough privileges).</p></li><li><p>Click on the <span class="guibutton">Printing
+Defaults...</span> button.</p></li><li><p>On any of the two new tabs, click on the
+<span class="guilabel">Advanced...</span> button.</p></li><li><p>A new dialog opens. Compare this one to the other,
+identical looking one from &quot;B.5&quot; or A.3&quot;.</p></li></ol></div><p>
+</p></li></ol></div><p>
+
+Do you see any difference in the two settings dialogs? I don't
+either. However, only the last one, which you arrived at with steps
+C.1.-6. will permanently save any settings which will then become the
+defaults for new users. If you want all clients to have the same
+defaults, you need to conduct these steps as administrator
+(<i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin</tt></i> in )
+<span class="emphasis"><em>before</em></span> a client downloads the driver (the clients
+can later set their own <span class="emphasis"><em>per-user defaults</em></span> by
+following the procedures<span class="emphasis"><em>A.</em></span>
+or<span class="emphasis"><em>B.</em></span> above...). (This is new: Windows 2000 and
+Windows XP allow <span class="emphasis"><em>per-user</em></span> default settings and
+the ones the administrator gives them, before they set up their own).
+The &quot;parents&quot; of the identically looking dialogs have a slight
+difference in their window names: one is called
+<tt class="computeroutput">Default Print Values for Printer Foo on Server
+Bar&quot;</tt> (which is the one you need) and the other is
+called &quot;<tt class="computeroutput">Print Settings for Printer Foo on Server
+Bar</tt>&quot;. The last one is the one you arrive at when you
+right-click on the printer and select <span class="guimenuitem">Print
+Settings...</span>. This is the one what you were
+taught to use back in the days of Windows NT! So it is only natural to
+try the same way with Win2k or WinXP. You wouldn't dream
+that there is now a different &quot;clicking path&quot; to arrive at an
+identically looking, but functionally different dialog to set defaults
+for all users!
+</p><div class="tip" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Tip</h3><p>Try (on Win2000 and WinXP) to run this command (as a user
+with the right privileges):
+</p><p><b class="userinput"><tt>
+rundll32 printui.dll,PrintUIEntry /p /t3 /n\\<i class="replaceable"><tt>SAMBA-SERVER</tt></i>\<i class="replaceable"><tt>printersharename</tt></i>
+</tt></b></p><p>
+to see the tab with the <span class="guilabel">Printing Defaults...</span>
+button (the one you need). Also run this command:
+</p><p><b class="userinput"><tt>
+rundll32 printui.dll,PrintUIEntry /p /t0 /n\\<i class="replaceable"><tt>SAMBA-SERVER</tt></i>\<i class="replaceable"><tt>printersharename</tt></i>
+</tt></b></p><p>
+to see the tab with the <span class="guilabel">Printing Preferences...</span>
+button (the one which doesn't set system-wide defaults). You can
+start the commands from inside a DOS box&quot; or from the <span class="guimenu">Start</span>
+-- <span class="guimenuitem">Run...</span> menu.
+</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2942200"></a>Supporting large Numbers of Printers</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+One issue that has arisen during the recent development phase of Samba
+is the need to support driver downloads for 100's of printers. Using
+Windows NT APW here is somewhat awkward (to say the least). If you
+don't want to acquire RSS pains from such the printer installation
+clicking orgy alone, you need to think about a non-interactive script.
+</p><p>
+If more than one printer is using the same driver, the
+<b class="command">rpcclient setdriver</b> command can be used to set the
+driver associated with an installed queue. If the driver is uploaded
+to <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> once and registered with the
+printing TDBs, it can be used by multiple print queues. In this case
+you just need to repeat the <b class="command">setprinter</b> subcommand
+of <b class="command">rpcclient</b> for every queue (without the need to
+conduct the <b class="command">adddriver</b> again and again). The
+following is an example of how this could be accomplished:
+</p><pre class="screen">
+<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>rpcclient <i class="replaceable"><tt>SAMBA-CUPS</tt></i> -U root%<i class="replaceable"><tt>secret</tt></i> -c 'enumdrivers'</tt></b>
+ cmd = enumdrivers
+
+ [Windows NT x86]
+ Printer Driver Info 1:
+ Driver Name: [infotec IS 2075 PCL 6]
-[Windows NT x86]
-Printer Driver Info 1:
- Driver Name: [HP LaserJet 4000 Series PS]
+ Printer Driver Info 1:
+ Driver Name: [DANKA InfoStream]
-Printer Driver Info 1:
- Driver Name: [HP LaserJet 2100 Series PS]
+ Printer Driver Info 1:
+ Driver Name: [Heidelberg Digimaster 9110 (PS)]
-Printer Driver Info 1:
- Driver Name: [HP LaserJet 4Si/4SiMX PS]
-
-<TT
-CLASS="PROMPT"
->$ </TT
->rpcclient pogo -U root%secret -c "enumprinters"
-Domain=[NARNIA] OS=[Unix] Server=[Samba 2.2.0-alpha3]
- flags:[0x800000]
- name:[\\POGO\hp-print]
- description:[POGO\\POGO\hp-print,NO DRIVER AVAILABLE FOR THIS PRINTER,]
- comment:[]
-
-<TT
-CLASS="PROMPT"
->$ </TT
->rpcclient pogo -U root%secret \
-<TT
-CLASS="PROMPT"
->&gt; </TT
-> -c "setdriver hp-print \"HP LaserJet 4000 Series PS\""
-Domain=[NARNIA] OS=[Unix] Server=[Samba 2.2.0-alpha3]
-Successfully set hp-print to driver HP LaserJet 4000 Series PS.</PRE
-></P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><H2
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN2012">14.2.4. Adding New Printers via the Windows NT APW</H2
-><P
->By default, Samba offers all printer shares defined in <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->smb.conf</TT
->
-in the "Printers..." folder. Also existing in this folder is the Windows NT
-Add Printer Wizard icon. The APW will be show only if</P
-><P
-></P
-><UL
-><LI
-><P
->The connected user is able to successfully
- execute an OpenPrinterEx(\\server) with administrative
- privileges (i.e. root or <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->printer admin</I
-></TT
->).
- </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="smb.conf.5.html#SHOWADDPRINTERWIZARD"
-TARGET="_top"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->show
- add printer wizard = yes</I
-></TT
-></A
-> (the default).
- </P
-></LI
-></UL
-><P
->In order to be able to use the APW to successfully add a printer to a Samba
-server, the <A
-HREF="smb.conf.5.html#ADDPRINTERCOMMAND"
-TARGET="_top"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->add
-printer command</I
-></TT
-></A
-> must have a defined value. The program
-hook must successfully add the printer to the system (i.e.
-<TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/printcap</TT
-> or appropriate files) and
-<TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->smb.conf</TT
-> if necessary.</P
-><P
->When using the APW from a client, if the named printer share does
-not exist, <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbd</B
-> will execute the <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->add printer
-command</I
-></TT
-> and reparse to the <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->smb.conf</TT
->
-to attempt to locate the new printer share. If the share is still not defined,
-an error of "Access Denied" is returned to the client. Note that the
-<TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->add printer program</I
-></TT
-> is executed under the context
-of the connected user, not necessarily a root account.</P
-><P
->There is a complementary <A
-HREF="smb.conf.5.html#DELETEPRINTERCOMMAND"
-TARGET="_top"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->delete
-printer command</I
-></TT
-></A
-> for removing entries from the "Printers..."
-folder.</P
-><P
->The following is an example <A
-HREF="smb.conf.5.html#ADDPRINTERCOMMAN"
-TARGET="_top"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->add printer command</I
-></TT
-></A
-> script. It adds the appropriate entries to <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/printcap.local</TT
-> (change that to what you need) and returns a line of 'Done' which is needed for the whole process to work.</P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
->#!/bin/sh
+ Printer Driver Info 1:
+ Driver Name: [dm9110]
+
+ Printer Driver Info 1:
+ Driver Name: [myphantasydrivername]
+
+ [....]
+</pre><p>
+
+</p><pre class="screen">
+<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>rpcclient <i class="replaceable"><tt>SAMBA-CUPS</tt></i> -U root%<i class="replaceable"><tt>secret</tt></i> -c 'enumprinters'</tt></b>
+ cmd = enumprinters
+ flags:[0x800000]
+ name:[\\SAMBA-CUPS\dm9110]
+ description:[\\SAMBA-CUPS\dm9110,,110ppm HiVolume DANKA Stuttgart]
+ comment:[110 ppm HiVolume DANKA Stuttgart]
+ [....]
+</pre><p>
+
+</p><pre class="screen">
+<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>rpcclient <i class="replaceable"><tt>SAMBA-CUPS</tt></i> -U root%<i class="replaceable"><tt>secret</tt></i> -c 'setdriver <i class="replaceable"><tt>dm9110</tt></i> &quot;<i class="replaceable"><tt>Heidelberg Digimaster 9110 (PS)</tt></i>&quot;'</tt></b>
+ cmd = setdriver dm9110 Heidelberg Digimaster 9110 (PPD)
+ Successfully set dm9110 to driver Heidelberg Digimaster 9110 (PS).
+</pre><p>
+
+</p><pre class="screen">
+<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>rpcclient <i class="replaceable"><tt>SAMBA-CUPS</tt></i> -U root%<i class="replaceable"><tt>secret</tt></i> -c 'enumprinters'</tt></b>
+ cmd = enumprinters
+ flags:[0x800000]
+ name:[\\SAMBA-CUPS\dm9110]
+ description:[\\SAMBA-CUPS\dm9110,Heidelberg Digimaster 9110 (PS),110ppm HiVolume DANKA Stuttgart]
+ comment:[110ppm HiVolume DANKA Stuttgart]
+ [....]
+</pre><p>
+
+</p><pre class="screen">
+<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>rpcclient <i class="replaceable"><tt>SAMBA-CUPS</tt></i> -U root%<i class="replaceable"><tt>secret</tt></i> -c 'setdriver <i class="replaceable"><tt>dm9110</tt></i> <i class="replaceable"><tt>myphantasydrivername</tt></i>'</tt></b>
+ cmd = setdriver dm9110 myphantasydrivername
+ Successfully set dm9110 to myphantasydrivername.
+</pre><p>
+
+</p><pre class="screen">
+<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>rpcclient <i class="replaceable"><tt>SAMBA-CUPS</tt></i> -U root%<i class="replaceable"><tt>secret</tt></i> -c 'enumprinters'</tt></b>
+ cmd = enumprinters
+ flags:[0x800000]
+ name:[\\SAMBA-CUPS\dm9110]
+ description:[\\SAMBA-CUPS\dm9110,myphantasydrivername,110ppm HiVolume DANKA Stuttgart]
+ comment:[110ppm HiVolume DANKA Stuttgart]
+ [....]
+</pre><p>
+It may be not easy to recognize: but the first call to
+<b class="command">enumprinters</b> showed the &quot;dm9110&quot; printer with an
+empty string where the driver should have been listed (between the 2
+commas in the &quot;description&quot; field). After the
+<b class="command">setdriver</b> command succeeded, all is well. (The
+CUPS Printing chapter has more info about the installation of printer
+drivers with the help of <b class="command">rpccclient</b>).
+</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2942503"></a>Adding new Printers with the Windows NT APW</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+By default, Samba exhibits all printer shares defined in
+<tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> in the
+<span class="guiicon">Printers...</span> folder. Also located in this folder
+is the Windows NT Add Printer Wizard icon. The APW will be shown only
+if:
+</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>...the connected user is able to successfully execute
+an <b class="command">OpenPrinterEx(\\server)</b> with administrative
+privileges (i.e. root or <i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin</tt></i>).
+</p><div class="tip" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Tip</h3><p> Try this from a Windows 2K/XP DOS box command prompt:
+</p><p><b class="userinput"><tt>
+runas /netonly /user:root rundll32 printui.dll,PrintUIEntry /p /t0 /n \\<i class="replaceable"><tt>SAMBA-SERVER</tt></i>\<i class="replaceable"><tt>printersharename</tt></i>
+</tt></b></p><p>
+and click on <span class="guibutton">Printing Preferences...</span>
+</p></div></li><li><p>... contains the setting
+<i class="parameter"><tt>show add printer wizard = yes</tt></i> (the
+default).</p></li></ul></div><p>
+The APW can do various things:
+</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>upload a new driver to the Samba
+<i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> share;</p></li><li><p>associate an uploaded driver with an existing (but
+still &quot;driverless&quot;) print queue;</p></li><li><p>exchange the currently used driver for an existing
+print queue with one that has been uploaded before;</p></li><li><p>add an entirely new printer to the Samba host (only in
+conjunction with a working <i class="parameter"><tt>add printer command</tt></i>;
+a corresponding <i class="parameter"><tt>delete printer command</tt></i> for
+removing entries from the <span class="guiicon">Printers...</span> folder
+may be provided too)</p></li></ul></div><p>
+The last one (add a new printer) requires more effort than the
+previous ones. In order to use the APW to successfully add a printer
+to a Samba server, the <i class="parameter"><tt>add printer command</tt></i> must
+have a defined value. The program hook must successfully add the
+printer to the Unix print system (i.e. to
+<tt class="filename">/etc/printcap</tt>,
+<tt class="filename">/etc/cups/printers.conf</tt> or other appropriate
+files) and to if necessary.
+</p><p>
+When using the APW from a client, if the named printer share does not
+exist, smbd will execute the <i class="parameter"><tt>add printer
+command</tt></i> and reparse to the
+to attempt to locate the new printer share. If the share is still not
+defined, an error of <span class="errorname">Access Denied</span> is
+returned to the client. Note that the <i class="parameter"><tt>add printer
+command</tt></i> is executed under the context of the connected
+user, not necessarily a root account. A <i class="parameter"><tt>map to guest = bad
+user</tt></i> may have connected you unwittingly under the wrong
+privilege; you should check it by using the
+<b class="command">smbstatus</b> command.
+</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2942746"></a>Weird Error Message <span class="errorname">Cannot connect under a
+different Name</span></h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+Once you are connected with the wrong credentials, there is no means
+to reverse the situation other than to close all Explorer windows, and
+perhaps reboot.
+</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>The <b class="command">net use \\SAMBA-SERVER\sharename
+/user:root</b> gives you an error message: <tt class="computeroutput">Multiple
+connections to a server or a shared resource by the same user
+utilizing the several user names are not allowed. Disconnect all
+previous connections to the server, resp. the shared resource, and try
+again.</tt></p></li><li><p>Every attempt to &quot;connect a network drive&quot; to
+<tt class="filename">\\SAMBASERVER\\print$</tt> to z: is countered by the
+pertinacious message. <tt class="computeroutput">This network folder is currently
+connected under different credentials (username and password).
+Disconnect first any existing connection to this network share in
+order to connect again under a different username and
+password</tt>.</p></li></ul></div><p>
+So you close all connections. You try again. You get the same
+message. You check from the Samba side, using
+<b class="command">smbstatus</b>. Yes, there are some more
+connections. You kill them all. The client still gives you the same
+error message. You watch the smbd.log file on a very high debug level
+and try re-connect. Same error message, but not a single line in the
+log. You start to wonder if there was a connection attempt at all. You
+run ethereal and tcpdump while you try to connect. Result: not a
+single byte goes on the wire. Windows still gives the error
+message. You close all Explorer Windows and start it again. You try to
+connect - and this times it works! Windows seems to cache connection
+info somewhere and doesn't keep it up to date (if you are unlucky you
+might need to reboot to get rid of the error message).
+</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2942844"></a>Be careful when assembling Driver Files</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+You need to be very careful when you take notes about the files and
+belonging to a particular driver. Don't confuse the files for driver
+version &quot;0&quot; (for Win95/98/ME, going into
+<tt class="filename">[print$]/WIN/0/</tt>), driver version &quot;2&quot; (Kernel Mode
+driver for WinNT, going into <tt class="filename">[print$]/W32X86/2/</tt>
+<span class="emphasis"><em>may</em></span> be used on Win2K/XP too), and driver version
+&quot;3&quot; (non-Kernel Mode driver going into
+<tt class="filename">[print$]/W32X86/3/</tt> <span class="emphasis"><em>can not</em></span>
+be used on WinNT). Very often these different driver versions contain
+files carrying the same name; but still the files are very different!
+Also, if you look at them from the Windows Explorer (they reside in
+<tt class="filename">%WINDOWS%\system32\spool\drivers\W32X86\</tt>) you
+will probably see names in capital letters, while an &quot;enumdrivers&quot;
+command from Samba would show mixed or lower case letters. So it is
+easy to confuse them. If you install them manually using
+<b class="command">rpcclient</b> and subcommands, you may even succeed
+without an error message. Only later, when you try install on a
+client, you will encounter error messages like <tt class="computeroutput">This
+server has no appropriate driver for the printer</tt>.
+</p><p>
+Here is an example. You are invited to look very closely at the
+various files, compare their names and their spelling, and discover
+the differences in the composition of the version-2 and -3 sets
+Note: the version-0 set contained 40 (!)
+<i class="parameter"><tt>Dependentfiles</tt></i>, so I left it out for space
+reasons:
+</p><pre class="screen">
+<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>rpcclient -U 'Administrator%<i class="replaceable"><tt>secret</tt></i>' -c 'enumdrivers 3' 10.160.50.8 </tt></b>
+
+ Printer Driver Info 3:
+ Version: [3]
+ Driver Name: [Canon iR8500 PS3]
+ Architecture: [Windows NT x86]
+ Driver Path: [\\10.160.50.8\print$\W32X86\3\cns3g.dll]
+ Datafile: [\\10.160.50.8\print$\W32X86\3\iR8500sg.xpd]
+ Configfile: [\\10.160.50.8\print$\W32X86\3\cns3gui.dll]
+ Helpfile: [\\10.160.50.8\print$\W32X86\3\cns3g.hlp]
+
+ Dependentfiles: [\\10.160.50.8\print$\W32X86\3\aucplmNT.dll]
+ Dependentfiles: [\\10.160.50.8\print$\W32X86\3\ucs32p.dll]
+ Dependentfiles: [\\10.160.50.8\print$\W32X86\3\tnl32.dll]
+ Dependentfiles: [\\10.160.50.8\print$\W32X86\3\aussdrv.dll]
+ Dependentfiles: [\\10.160.50.8\print$\W32X86\3\cnspdc.dll]
+ Dependentfiles: [\\10.160.50.8\print$\W32X86\3\aussapi.dat]
+ Dependentfiles: [\\10.160.50.8\print$\W32X86\3\cns3407.dll]
+ Dependentfiles: [\\10.160.50.8\print$\W32X86\3\CnS3G.cnt]
+ Dependentfiles: [\\10.160.50.8\print$\W32X86\3\NBAPI.DLL]
+ Dependentfiles: [\\10.160.50.8\print$\W32X86\3\NBIPC.DLL]
+ Dependentfiles: [\\10.160.50.8\print$\W32X86\3\cpcview.exe]
+ Dependentfiles: [\\10.160.50.8\print$\W32X86\3\cpcdspl.exe]
+ Dependentfiles: [\\10.160.50.8\print$\W32X86\3\cpcedit.dll]
+ Dependentfiles: [\\10.160.50.8\print$\W32X86\3\cpcqm.exe]
+ Dependentfiles: [\\10.160.50.8\print$\W32X86\3\cpcspl.dll]
+ Dependentfiles: [\\10.160.50.8\print$\W32X86\3\cfine32.dll]
+ Dependentfiles: [\\10.160.50.8\print$\W32X86\3\cpcr407.dll]
+ Dependentfiles: [\\10.160.50.8\print$\W32X86\3\Cpcqm407.hlp]
+ Dependentfiles: [\\10.160.50.8\print$\W32X86\3\cpcqm407.cnt]
+ Dependentfiles: [\\10.160.50.8\print$\W32X86\3\cns3ggr.dll]
+
+ Monitorname: []
+ Defaultdatatype: []
+
+ Printer Driver Info 3:
+ Version: [2]
+ Driver Name: [Canon iR5000-6000 PS3]
+ Architecture: [Windows NT x86]
+ Driver Path: [\\10.160.50.8\print$\W32X86\2\cns3g.dll]
+ Datafile: [\\10.160.50.8\print$\W32X86\2\IR5000sg.xpd]
+ Configfile: [\\10.160.50.8\print$\W32X86\2\cns3gui.dll]
+ Helpfile: [\\10.160.50.8\print$\W32X86\2\cns3g.hlp]
+
+ Dependentfiles: [\\10.160.50.8\print$\W32X86\2\AUCPLMNT.DLL]
+ Dependentfiles: [\\10.160.50.8\print$\W32X86\2\aussdrv.dll]
+ Dependentfiles: [\\10.160.50.8\print$\W32X86\2\cnspdc.dll]
+ Dependentfiles: [\\10.160.50.8\print$\W32X86\2\aussapi.dat]
+ Dependentfiles: [\\10.160.50.8\print$\W32X86\2\cns3407.dll]
+ Dependentfiles: [\\10.160.50.8\print$\W32X86\2\CnS3G.cnt]
+ Dependentfiles: [\\10.160.50.8\print$\W32X86\2\NBAPI.DLL]
+ Dependentfiles: [\\10.160.50.8\print$\W32X86\2\NBIPC.DLL]
+ Dependentfiles: [\\10.160.50.8\print$\W32X86\2\cns3gum.dll]
+
+ Monitorname: [CPCA Language Monitor2]
+ Defaultdatatype: []
+
+</pre><p>
+If we write the &quot;version 2&quot; files and the &quot;version 3&quot; files
+into different text files and compare the result, we see this
+picture:
+</p><pre class="screen">
+<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>sdiff 2-files 3-files</tt></b>
-# Script to insert a new printer entry into printcap.local
-#
-# $1, printer name, used as the descriptive name
-# $2, share name, used as the printer name for Linux
-# $3, port name
-# $4, driver name
-# $5, location, used for the device file of the printer
-# $6, win9x location
-#
-# Make sure we use the location that RedHat uses for local printer defs
-PRINTCAP=/etc/printcap.local
-DATE=`date +%Y%m%d-%H%M%S`
-LP=lp
-RESTART="service lpd restart"
+ cns3g.dll cns3g.dll
+ iR8500sg.xpd iR8500sg.xpd
+ cns3gui.dll cns3gui.dll
+ cns3g.hlp cns3g.hlp
+ AUCPLMNT.DLL | aucplmNT.dll
+ &gt; ucs32p.dll
+ &gt; tnl32.dll
+ aussdrv.dll aussdrv.dll
+ cnspdc.dll cnspdc.dll
+ aussapi.dat aussapi.dat
+ cns3407.dll cns3407.dll
+ CnS3G.cnt CnS3G.cnt
+ NBAPI.DLL NBAPI.DLL
+ NBIPC.DLL NBIPC.DLL
+ cns3gum.dll | cpcview.exe
+ &gt; cpcdspl.exe
+ &gt; cpcqm.exe
+ &gt; cpcspl.dll
+ &gt; cfine32.dll
+ &gt; cpcr407.dll
+ &gt; Cpcqm407.hlp
+ &gt; cpcqm407.cnt
+ &gt; cns3ggr.dll
-# Keep a copy
-cp $PRINTCAP $PRINTCAP.$DATE
-# Add the printer to $PRINTCAP
-echo "" &#62;&#62; $PRINTCAP
-echo "$2|$1:\\" &#62;&#62; $PRINTCAP
-echo " :sd=/var/spool/lpd/$2:\\" &#62;&#62; $PRINTCAP
-echo " :mx=0:ml=0:sh:\\" &#62;&#62; $PRINTCAP
-echo " :lp=/usr/local/samba/var/print/$5.prn:" &#62;&#62; $PRINTCAP
+</pre><p>
+Don't be fooled though! Driver files for each version with identical
+names may be different in their content, as you can see from this size
+comparison:
+</p><pre class="screen">
+<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>for i in cns3g.hlp cns3gui.dll cns3g.dll; do \
+ smbclient //10.160.50.8/print\$ -U 'Administrator%xxxx' \
+ -c &quot;cd W32X86/3; dir $i; cd .. ; cd 2; dir $i&quot;; \
+ done</tt></b>
-touch "/usr/local/samba/var/print/$5.prn" &#62;&#62; /tmp/printadd.$$ 2&#62;&#38;1
-chown $LP "/usr/local/samba/var/print/$5.prn" &#62;&#62; /tmp/printadd.$$ 2&#62;&#38;1
+ CNS3G.HLP A 122981 Thu May 30 02:31:00 2002
+ CNS3G.HLP A 99948 Thu May 30 02:31:00 2002
-mkdir /var/spool/lpd/$2
-chmod 700 /var/spool/lpd/$2
-chown $LP /var/spool/lpd/$2
-#echo $1 &#62;&#62; "/usr/local/samba/var/print/$5.prn"
-#echo $2 &#62;&#62; "/usr/local/samba/var/print/$5.prn"
-#echo $3 &#62;&#62; "/usr/local/samba/var/print/$5.prn"
-#echo $4 &#62;&#62; "/usr/local/samba/var/print/$5.prn"
-#echo $5 &#62;&#62; "/usr/local/samba/var/print/$5.prn"
-#echo $6 &#62;&#62; "/usr/local/samba/var/print/$5.prn"
-$RESTART &#62;&#62; "/usr/local/samba/var/print/$5.prn"
-# Not sure if this is needed
-touch /usr/local/samba/lib/smb.conf
-#
-# You need to return a value, but I am not sure what it means.
-#
-echo "Done"
-exit 0</PRE
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><H2
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN2042">14.2.5. Samba and Printer Ports</H2
-><P
->Windows NT/2000 print servers associate a port with each printer. These normally
-take the form of LPT1:, COM1:, FILE:, etc... Samba must also support the
-concept of ports associated with a printer. By default, only one printer port,
-named "Samba Printer Port", exists on a system. Samba does not really a port in
-order to print, rather it is a requirement of Windows clients. </P
-><P
->Note that Samba does not support the concept of "Printer Pooling" internally
-either. This is when a logical printer is assigned to multiple ports as
-a form of load balancing or fail over.</P
-><P
->If you require that multiple ports be defined for some reason,
-<TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->smb.conf</TT
-> possesses a <A
-HREF="smb.conf.5.html#ENUMPORTSCOMMAND"
-TARGET="_top"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->enumports
-command</I
-></TT
-></A
-> which can be used to define an external program
-that generates a listing of ports on a system.</P
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><H1
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN2050">14.3. The Imprints Toolset</H1
-><P
->The Imprints tool set provides a UNIX equivalent of the
- Windows NT Add Printer Wizard. For complete information, please
- refer to the Imprints web site at <A
-HREF="http://imprints.sourceforge.net/"
-TARGET="_top"
-> http://imprints.sourceforge.net/</A
-> as well as the documentation
- included with the imprints source distribution. This section will
- only provide a brief introduction to the features of Imprints.</P
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><H2
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN2054">14.3.1. What is Imprints?</H2
-><P
->Imprints is a collection of tools for supporting the goals
- of</P
-><P
-></P
-><UL
-><LI
-><P
->Providing a central repository information
- regarding Windows NT and 95/98 printer driver packages</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->Providing the tools necessary for creating
- the Imprints printer driver packages.</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->Providing an installation client which
- will obtain and install printer drivers on remote Samba
- and Windows NT 4 print servers.</P
-></LI
-></UL
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><H2
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN2064">14.3.2. Creating Printer Driver Packages</H2
-><P
->The process of creating printer driver packages is beyond
- the scope of this document (refer to Imprints.txt also included
- with the Samba distribution for more information). In short,
- an Imprints driver package is a gzipped tarball containing the
- driver files, related INF files, and a control file needed by the
- installation client.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><H2
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN2067">14.3.3. The Imprints server</H2
-><P
->The Imprints server is really a database server that
- may be queried via standard HTTP mechanisms. Each printer
- entry in the database has an associated URL for the actual
- downloading of the package. Each package is digitally signed
- via GnuPG which can be used to verify that package downloaded
- is actually the one referred in the Imprints database. It is
- <SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->not</I
-></SPAN
-> recommended that this security check
- be disabled.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><H2
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN2071">14.3.4. The Installation Client</H2
-><P
->More information regarding the Imprints installation client
- is available in the <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->Imprints-Client-HOWTO.ps</TT
->
- file included with the imprints source package.</P
-><P
->The Imprints installation client comes in two forms.</P
-><P
-></P
-><UL
-><LI
-><P
->a set of command line Perl scripts</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->a GTK+ based graphical interface to
- the command line perl scripts</P
-></LI
-></UL
-><P
->The installation client (in both forms) provides a means
- of querying the Imprints database server for a matching
- list of known printer model names as well as a means to
- download and install the drivers on remote Samba and Windows
- NT print servers.</P
-><P
->The basic installation process is in four steps and
- perl code is wrapped around <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbclient</B
->
- and <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->rpcclient</B
->.</P
-><P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
->
-foreach (supported architecture for a given driver)
-{
- 1. rpcclient: Get the appropriate upload directory
- on the remote server
- 2. smbclient: Upload the driver files
- 3. rpcclient: Issues an AddPrinterDriver() MS-RPC
-}
-
-4. rpcclient: Issue an AddPrinterEx() MS-RPC to actually
- create the printer</PRE
-></P
-><P
->One of the problems encountered when implementing
- the Imprints tool set was the name space issues between
- various supported client architectures. For example, Windows
- NT includes a driver named "Apple LaserWriter II NTX v51.8"
- and Windows 95 calls its version of this driver "Apple
- LaserWriter II NTX"</P
-><P
->The problem is how to know what client drivers have
- been uploaded for a printer. As astute reader will remember
- that the Windows NT Printer Properties dialog only includes
- space for one printer driver name. A quick look in the
- Windows NT 4.0 system registry at</P
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->HKLM\System\CurrentControlSet\Control\Print\Environment
- </TT
-></P
-><P
->will reveal that Windows NT always uses the NT driver
- name. This is ok as Windows NT always requires that at least
- the Windows NT version of the printer driver is present.
- However, Samba does not have the requirement internally.
- Therefore, how can you use the NT driver name if is has not
- already been installed?</P
-><P
->The way of sidestepping this limitation is to require
- that all Imprints printer driver packages include both the Intel
- Windows NT and 95/98 printer drivers and that NT driver is
- installed first.</P
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><H1
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN2093">14.4. Diagnosis</H1
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><H2
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN2095">14.4.1. Introduction</H2
-><P
->This is a short description of how to debug printing problems with
-Samba. This describes how to debug problems with printing from a SMB
-client to a Samba server, not the other way around. For the reverse
-see the examples/printing directory.</P
-><P
->Ok, so you want to print to a Samba server from your PC. The first
-thing you need to understand is that Samba does not actually do any
-printing itself, it just acts as a middleman between your PC client
-and your Unix printing subsystem. Samba receives the file from the PC
-then passes the file to a external "print command". What print command
-you use is up to you.</P
-><P
->The whole things is controlled using options in smb.conf. The most
-relevant options (which you should look up in the smb.conf man page)
-are:</P
-><P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
-> [global]
- print command - send a file to a spooler
- lpq command - get spool queue status
- lprm command - remove a job
- [printers]
- path = /var/spool/lpd/samba</PRE
-></P
-><P
->The following are nice to know about:</P
-><P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
-> queuepause command - stop a printer or print queue
- queueresume command - start a printer or print queue</PRE
-></P
-><P
->Example:</P
-><P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
-> print command = /usr/bin/lpr -r -P%p %s
- lpq command = /usr/bin/lpq -P%p %s
- lprm command = /usr/bin/lprm -P%p %j
- queuepause command = /usr/sbin/lpc -P%p stop
- queuepause command = /usr/sbin/lpc -P%p start</PRE
-></P
-><P
->Samba should set reasonable defaults for these depending on your
-system type, but it isn't clairvoyant. It is not uncommon that you
-have to tweak these for local conditions. The commands should
-always have fully specified pathnames, as the smdb may not have
-the correct PATH values.</P
-><P
->When you send a job to Samba to be printed, it will make a temporary
-copy of it in the directory specified in the [printers] section.
-and it should be periodically cleaned out. The lpr -r option
-requests that the temporary copy be removed after printing; If
-printing fails then you might find leftover files in this directory,
-and it should be periodically cleaned out. Samba used the lpq
-command to determine the "job number" assigned to your print job
-by the spooler.</P
-><P
->The %&gt;letter&lt; are "macros" that get dynamically replaced with appropriate
-values when they are used. The %s gets replaced with the name of the spool
-file that Samba creates and the %p gets replaced with the name of the
-printer. The %j gets replaced with the "job number" which comes from
-the lpq output.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><H2
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN2111">14.4.2. Debugging printer problems</H2
-><P
->One way to debug printing problems is to start by replacing these
-command with shell scripts that record the arguments and the contents
-of the print file. A simple example of this kind of things might
-be:</P
-><P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
-> print command = /tmp/saveprint %p %s
+ CNS3GUI.DLL A 1805824 Thu May 30 02:31:00 2002
+ CNS3GUI.DLL A 1785344 Thu May 30 02:31:00 2002
- #!/bin/saveprint
- # we make sure that we are the right user
- /usr/bin/id -p &#62;/tmp/tmp.print
- # we run the command and save the error messages
- # replace the command with the one appropriate for your system
- /usr/bin/lpr -r -P$1 $2 2&#62;&#62;&#38;/tmp/tmp.print</PRE
-></P
-><P
->Then you print a file and try removing it. You may find that the
-print queue needs to be stopped in order to see the queue status
-and remove the job:</P
-><P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
->&#13;h4: {42} % echo hi &#62;/tmp/hi
-h4: {43} % smbclient //localhost/lw4
-added interface ip=10.0.0.4 bcast=10.0.0.255 nmask=255.255.255.0
-Password:
-Domain=[ASTART] OS=[Unix] Server=[Samba 2.0.7]
-smb: \&#62; print /tmp/hi
-putting file /tmp/hi as hi-17534 (0.0 kb/s) (average 0.0 kb/s)
-smb: \&#62; queue
-1049 3 hi-17534
-smb: \&#62; cancel 1049
-Error cancelling job 1049 : code 0
-smb: \&#62; cancel 1049
-Job 1049 cancelled
-smb: \&#62; queue
-smb: \&#62; exit</PRE
-></P
-><P
->The 'code 0' indicates that the job was removed. The comment
-by the smbclient is a bit misleading on this.
-You can observe the command output and then and look at the
-/tmp/tmp.print file to see what the results are. You can quickly
-find out if the problem is with your printing system. Often people
-have problems with their /etc/printcap file or permissions on
-various print queues.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><H2
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN2120">14.4.3. What printers do I have?</H2
-><P
->You can use the 'testprns' program to check to see if the printer
-name you are using is recognized by Samba. For example, you can
-use:</P
-><P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
-> testprns printer /etc/printcap</PRE
-></P
-><P
->Samba can get its printcap information from a file or from a program.
-You can try the following to see the format of the extracted
-information:</P
-><P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
-> testprns -a printer /etc/printcap
+ CNS3G.DLL A 1145088 Thu May 30 02:31:00 2002
+ CNS3G.DLL A 15872 Thu May 30 02:31:00 2002
- testprns -a printer '|/bin/cat printcap'</PRE
-></P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><H2
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN2128">14.4.4. Setting up printcap and print servers</H2
-><P
->You may need to set up some printcaps for your Samba system to use.
-It is strongly recommended that you use the facilities provided by
-the print spooler to set up queues and printcap information.</P
-><P
->Samba requires either a printcap or program to deliver printcap
-information. This printcap information has the format:</P
-><P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
-> name|alias1|alias2...:option=value:...</PRE
-></P
-><P
->For almost all printing systems, the printer 'name' must be composed
-only of alphanumeric or underscore '_' characters. Some systems also
-allow hyphens ('-') as well. An alias is an alternative name for the
-printer, and an alias with a space in it is used as a 'comment'
-about the printer. The printcap format optionally uses a \ at the end of lines
-to extend the printcap to multiple lines.</P
-><P
->Here are some examples of printcap files:</P
-><P
-><P
-></P
-><OL
-TYPE="1"
-><LI
-><P
->pr just printer name</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->pr|alias printer name and alias</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->pr|My Printer printer name, alias used as comment</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->pr:sh:\ Same as pr:sh:cm= testing
- :cm= \
- testing</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->pr:sh Same as pr:sh:cm= testing
- :cm= testing</P
-></LI
-></OL
-></P
-><P
->Samba reads the printcap information when first started. If you make
-changes in the printcap information, then you must do the following:</P
-><P
-></P
-><OL
-TYPE="1"
-><LI
-><P
->make sure that the print spooler is aware of these changes.
-The LPRng system uses the 'lpc reread' command to do this.</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->make sure that the spool queues, etc., exist and have the
-correct permissions. The LPRng system uses the 'checkpc -f'
-command to do this.</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->You now should send a SIGHUP signal to the smbd server to have
-it reread the printcap information.</P
-></LI
-></OL
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><H2
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN2156">14.4.5. Job sent, no output</H2
-><P
->This is the most frustrating part of printing. You may have sent the
-job, verified that the job was forwarded, set up a wrapper around
-the command to send the file, but there was no output from the printer.</P
-><P
->First, check to make sure that the job REALLY is getting to the
-right print queue. If you are using a BSD or LPRng print spooler,
-you can temporarily stop the printing of jobs. Jobs can still be
-submitted, but they will not be printed. Use:</P
-><P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
-> lpc -Pprinter stop</PRE
-></P
-><P
->Now submit a print job and then use 'lpq -Pprinter' to see if the
-job is in the print queue. If it is not in the print queue then
-you will have to find out why it is not being accepted for printing.</P
-><P
->Next, you may want to check to see what the format of the job really
-was. With the assistance of the system administrator you can view
-the submitted jobs files. You may be surprised to find that these
-are not in what you would expect to call a printable format.
-You can use the UNIX 'file' utitily to determine what the job
-format actually is:</P
-><P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
-> cd /var/spool/lpd/printer # spool directory of print jobs
- ls # find job files
- file dfA001myhost</PRE
-></P
-><P
->You should make sure that your printer supports this format OR that
-your system administrator has installed a 'print filter' that will
-convert the file to a format appropriate for your printer.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><H2
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN2167">14.4.6. Job sent, strange output</H2
-><P
->Once you have the job printing, you can then start worrying about
-making it print nicely.</P
-><P
->The most common problem is extra pages of output: banner pages
-OR blank pages at the end.</P
-><P
->If you are getting banner pages, check and make sure that the
-printcap option or printer option is configured for no banners.
-If you have a printcap, this is the :sh (suppress header or banner
-page) option. You should have the following in your printer.</P
-><P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
-> printer: ... :sh</PRE
-></P
-><P
->If you have this option and are still getting banner pages, there
-is a strong chance that your printer is generating them for you
-automatically. You should make sure that banner printing is disabled
-for the printer. This usually requires using the printer setup software
-or procedures supplied by the printer manufacturer.</P
-><P
->If you get an extra page of output, this could be due to problems
-with your job format, or if you are generating PostScript jobs,
-incorrect setting on your printer driver on the MicroSoft client.
-For example, under Win95 there is a option:</P
-><P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
-> Printers|Printer Name|(Right Click)Properties|Postscript|Advanced|</PRE
-></P
-><P
->that allows you to choose if a Ctrl-D is appended to all jobs.
-This is a very bad thing to do, as most spooling systems will
-automatically add a ^D to the end of the job if it is detected as
-PostScript. The multiple ^D may cause an additional page of output.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><H2
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN2179">14.4.7. Raw PostScript printed</H2
-><P
->This is a problem that is usually caused by either the print spooling
-system putting information at the start of the print job that makes
-the printer think the job is a text file, or your printer simply
-does not support PostScript. You may need to enable 'Automatic
-Format Detection' on your printer.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><H2
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN2182">14.4.8. Advanced Printing</H2
-><P
->Note that you can do some pretty magic things by using your
-imagination with the "print command" option and some shell scripts.
-Doing print accounting is easy by passing the %U option to a print
-command shell script. You could even make the print command detect
-the type of output and its size and send it to an appropriate
-printer.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><H2
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN2185">14.4.9. Real debugging</H2
-><P
->If the above debug tips don't help, then maybe you need to bring in
-the bug guns, system tracing. See Tracing.txt in this directory.</P
-></DIV
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="NAVFOOTER"
-><HR
-ALIGN="LEFT"
-WIDTH="100%"><TABLE
-SUMMARY="Footer navigation table"
-WIDTH="100%"
-BORDER="0"
-CELLPADDING="0"
-CELLSPACING="0"
-><TR
-><TD
-WIDTH="33%"
-ALIGN="left"
-VALIGN="top"
-><A
-HREF="msdfs.html"
-ACCESSKEY="P"
->Prev</A
-></TD
-><TD
-WIDTH="34%"
-ALIGN="center"
-VALIGN="top"
-><A
-HREF="samba-howto-collection.html"
-ACCESSKEY="H"
->Home</A
-></TD
-><TD
-WIDTH="33%"
-ALIGN="right"
-VALIGN="top"
-><A
-HREF="winbind.html"
-ACCESSKEY="N"
->Next</A
-></TD
-></TR
-><TR
-><TD
-WIDTH="33%"
-ALIGN="left"
-VALIGN="top"
->Hosting a Microsoft Distributed File System tree on Samba</TD
-><TD
-WIDTH="34%"
-ALIGN="center"
-VALIGN="top"
-><A
-HREF="optional.html"
-ACCESSKEY="U"
->Up</A
-></TD
-><TD
-WIDTH="33%"
-ALIGN="right"
-VALIGN="top"
->Unified Logons between Windows NT and UNIX using Winbind</TD
-></TR
-></TABLE
-></DIV
-></BODY
-></HTML
-> \ No newline at end of file
+</pre><p>
+In my example were even more differences than shown here. Conclusion:
+you must be very careful to select the correct driver files for each
+driver version. Don't rely on the names alone. Don't interchange files
+belonging to different driver versions.
+</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2943191"></a>Samba and Printer Ports</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+Windows NT/2000 print servers associate a port with each
+printer. These normally take the form of <tt class="filename">LPT1:</tt>,
+<tt class="filename">COM1:</tt>, <tt class="filename">FILE:</tt>, etc. Samba
+must also support the concept of ports associated with a printer. By
+default, only one printer port, named &quot;Samba Printer Port&quot;, exists on
+a system. Samba does not really need such a &quot;port&quot; in order to print;
+it rather is a requirement of Windows clients. They insist on being
+told about an available port when they request this info, otherwise
+they throw an error message at you. So Samba fakes the port
+information to keep the Windows clients happy.
+</p><p>
+Note that Samba does not support the concept of &quot;Printer Pooling&quot;
+internally either. Printer Pooling assigns a logical printer to
+multiple ports as a form of load balancing or fail over.
+</p><p>
+If you require that multiple ports be defined for some reason or
+another (&#8220;<span class="quote">My users and my Boss should not know that they are
+working with Samba</span>&#8221;), possesses a
+<i class="parameter"><tt>enumports command</tt></i> which can be used to define
+an external program that generates a listing of ports on a system.
+</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2943261"></a>Avoiding the most common Misconfigurations of the Client Driver</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+So - printing works, but there are still problems. Most jobs print
+well, some don't print at all. Some jobs have problems with fonts,
+which don't look good at all. Some jobs print fast, and some are
+dead-slow. We can't cover it all; but we want to encourage you to read
+the little paragraph about &quot;Avoiding the wrong PostScript Driver
+Settings&quot; in the CUPS Printing part of this document.
+</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2943283"></a>The Imprints Toolset</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+The Imprints tool set provides a UNIX equivalent of the
+Windows NT Add Printer Wizard. For complete information, please
+refer to the Imprints web site
+at<a href="http://imprints.sourceforge.net/" target="_top">http://imprints.sourceforge.net/</a>
+as well as the documentation included with the imprints source
+distribution. This section will only provide a brief introduction
+to the features of Imprints.
+</p><p><b>Attention! Maintainer required. </b>
+Unfortunately, the Imprints toolset is no longer maintained. As of
+December, 2000, the project is in need of a new maintainer. The most
+important skill to have is decent perl coding and an interest in
+MS-RPC based printing using Samba. If you wish to volunteer, please
+coordinate your efforts on the samba-technical mailing list. The
+toolset is still in usable form; but only for a series of older
+printer models, where there are prepared packages to use. Packages for
+more up to date print devices are needed if Imprints should have a
+future.</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2943329"></a>What is Imprints?</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+Imprints is a collection of tools for supporting these goals:
+</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Providing a central repository information regarding
+Windows NT and 95/98 printer driver packages</p></li><li><p>Providing the tools necessary for creating the
+Imprints printer driver packages.</p></li><li><p>Providing an installation client which will obtain
+printer drivers from a central internet (or intranet) Imprints Server
+repository and install them on remote Samba and Windows NT4 print
+servers.</p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2943370"></a>Creating Printer Driver Packages</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+The process of creating printer driver packages is beyond the scope of
+this document (refer to Imprints.txt also included with the Samba
+distribution for more information). In short, an Imprints driver
+package is a gzipped tarball containing the driver files, related INF
+files, and a control file needed by the installation client.
+</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2943389"></a>The Imprints Server</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+The Imprints server is really a database server that may be queried
+via standard HTTP mechanisms. Each printer entry in the database has
+an associated URL for the actual downloading of the package. Each
+package is digitally signed via GnuPG which can be used to verify that
+package downloaded is actually the one referred in the Imprints
+database. It is strongly recommended that this security check
+<span class="emphasis"><em>not</em></span> be disabled.
+</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2943413"></a>The Installation Client</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+More information regarding the Imprints installation client is
+available in the <tt class="filename">Imprints-Client-HOWTO.ps</tt> file
+included with the imprints source package.
+</p><p>
+The Imprints installation client comes in two forms.
+</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>a set of command line Perl scripts</p></li><li><p>a GTK+ based graphical interface to the command line Perl
+scripts</p></li></ul></div><p>
+The installation client (in both forms) provides a means of querying
+the Imprints database server for a matching list of known printer
+model names as well as a means to download and install the drivers on
+remote Samba and Windows NT print servers.
+</p><p>
+The basic installation process is in four steps and perl code is
+wrapped around smbclient and rpcclient
+</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>
+ foreach (supported architecture for a given driver)
+ </p><div class="orderedlist"><ol type="1"><li><p>rpcclient: Get the appropriate upload directory on the remote server</p></li><li><p>smbclient: Upload the driver files</p></li><li><p>rpcclient: Issues an AddPrinterDriver() MS-RPC</p></li></ol></div><p>
+ </p></li><li><p>rpcclient: Issue an AddPrinterEx() MS-RPC to actually create the printer</p></li></ul></div><p>
+One of the problems encountered when implementing the Imprints tool
+set was the name space issues between various supported client
+architectures. For example, Windows NT includes a driver named &quot;Apple
+LaserWriter II NTX v51.8&quot; and Windows 95 calls its version of this
+driver &quot;Apple LaserWriter II NTX&quot;
+</p><p>
+The problem is how to know what client drivers have been uploaded for
+a printer. An astute reader will remember that the Windows NT Printer
+Properties dialog only includes space for one printer driver name. A
+quick look in the Windows NT 4.0 system registry at
+</p><p><tt class="filename">
+ HKLM\System\CurrentControlSet\Control\Print\Environment
+</tt></p><p>
+will reveal that Windows NT always uses the NT driver name. This is
+ok as Windows NT always requires that at least the Windows NT version
+of the printer driver is present. However, Samba does not have the
+requirement internally. Therefore, how can you use the NT driver name
+if is has not already been installed?
+</p><p>
+The way of sidestepping this limitation is to require that all
+Imprints printer driver packages include both the Intel Windows NT and
+95/98 printer drivers and that NT driver is installed first.
+</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2943566"></a>Add Network Printers at Logon without User Interaction</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+The following MS Knowledge Base article may be of some help if you
+need to handle Windows 2000 clients: <span class="emphasis"><em>How to Add Printers
+with No User Interaction in Windows 2000.</em></span> ( <a href="http://support.microsoft.com/default.aspx?scid=kb;en-us;189105" target="_top">http://support.microsoft.com/default.aspx?scid=kb;en-us;189105</a>
+). It also applies to Windows XP Professional clients.
+</p><p>
+The ideas sketched out below are inspired by this article. It
+describes a commandline method which can be applied to install
+network and local printers and their drivers. This is most useful
+if integrated in Logon Scripts. You can see what options are
+available by typing in a command prompt (&quot;DOS box&quot;) this:
+</p><p><b class="userinput"><tt>rundll32 printui.dll,PrintUIEntry /?</tt></b></p><p>
+A window pops up which shows you all of the commandline switches
+available. An extensive list of examples is also provided. This is
+only for Win 2k/XP. It doesn't work on WinNT. WinNT has probably some
+other tools in the respective Resource Kit. Here is a suggestion about
+what a client logon script might contain, with a short explanation of
+what the lines actually do (it works if 2k/XP Windows clients access
+printers via Samba, but works for Windows-based print servers too):
+</p><pre class="screen">
+<b class="userinput"><tt>rundll32 printui.dll,PrintUIEntry /dn /n &quot;\\sambacupsserver\infotec2105-IPDS&quot; /q</tt></b>
+<b class="userinput"><tt>rundll32 printui.dll,PrintUIEntry /in /n &quot;\\sambacupsserver\infotec2105-PS&quot;</tt></b>
+<b class="userinput"><tt>rundll32 printui.dll,PrintUIEntry /y /n &quot;\\sambacupsserver\infotec2105-PS&quot;</tt></b>
+</pre><p>
+Here is a list of the used commandline parameters:
+</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">/dn</span></dt><dd><p>deletes a network printer</p></dd><dt><span class="term">/q</span></dt><dd><p>quiet modus</p></dd><dt><span class="term">/n</span></dt><dd><p>names a printer</p></dd><dt><span class="term">/in</span></dt><dd><p>adds a network printer connection</p></dd><dt><span class="term">/y</span></dt><dd><p>sets printer as default printer</p></dd></dl></div><p>
+I have tested this with a Samba 2.2.7a and a Samba-3alpha24
+installation and Windows XP Professional clients. Note that this
+specific command set works with network print queues (installing
+local print queues requires different parameters, but this is of no
+interest here).
+</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Line 1 deletes a possibly existing previous network
+printer <span class="emphasis"><em>infotec2105-IPDS</em></span> (which had used native
+Windows drivers with LPRng that were removed from the server which was
+converted to CUPS). The <b class="command">/q</b> at the end eliminates
+&quot;Confirm&quot; or error dialog boxes popping up. They should not be
+presented to the user logging on.</p></li><li><p>Line 2 adds the new printer
+<span class="emphasis"><em>infotec2105-PS</em></span> (which actually is same physical
+device but is now run by the new CUPS printing system and associated
+with the CUPS/Adobe PS drivers). The printer and its driver
+<span class="emphasis"><em>must</em></span> have been added to Samba prior to the user
+logging in (e.g. by a procedure as discussed earlier in this chapter,
+or by running <b class="command">cupsaddsmb</b>). The driver is now
+auto-downloaded to the client PC where the user is about to log
+in.</p></li><li><p>Line 3 sets the default printer to this new network
+printer (there might be several other printers installed with this
+same method and some may be local as well -- so we deside for a
+default printer). The default printer selection may of course be
+different for different users.</p></li></ul></div><p>
+Note that the second line only works if the printer
+<span class="emphasis"><em>infotec2105-PS</em></span> has an already working printqueue
+on &quot;sambacupsserver&quot;, and if the printer drivers have sucessfully been
+uploaded (via <b class="command">APW</b> ,
+<b class="command">smbclient/rpcclient</b> or
+<b class="command">cupsaddsmb</b>) into the
+<i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> driver repository of Samba. Also, some
+Samba versions prior to version 3.0 required a re-start of smbd after
+the printer install and the driver upload, otherwise the script (or
+any other client driver download) would fail.
+</p><p>
+Since there no easy way to test for the existence of an installed
+network printer from the logon script, the suggestion is: don't bother
+checking and just allow the deinstallation/reinstallation to occur
+every time a user logs in; it's really quick anyway (1 to 2 seconds).
+</p><p>
+The additional benefits for this are:
+</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>It puts in place any printer default setup changes
+automatically at every user logon.</p></li><li><p>It allows for &quot;roaming&quot; users' login into the domain from
+different workstations.</p></li></ul></div><p>
+Since network printers are installed per user this much simplifies the
+process of keeping the installation up-to-date. The extra few seconds
+at logon time will not really be noticeable. Printers can be centrally
+added, changed, and deleted at will on the server with no user
+intervention required on the clients (you just need to keep the logon
+scripts up to date).
+</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2943895"></a>The <b class="command">addprinter</b> command</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+The <b class="command">addprinter</b> command can be configured to be a
+shell script or program executed by Samba. It is triggered by running
+the APW from a client against the Samba print server. The APW asks the
+user to fill in several fields (such as printer name, driver to be
+used, comment, port monitor, etc.). These parameters are passed on to
+Samba by the APW. If the addprinter command is designed in a way that
+it can create a new printer (through writing correct printcap entries
+on legacy systems, or execute the <b class="command">lpadmin</b> command
+on more modern systems) and create the associated share in
+, then the APW will in effect really
+create a new printer on Samba and the UNIX print subsystem!
+</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2943940"></a>Migration of &quot;Classical&quot; printing to Samba-3</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+The basic &quot;NT-style&quot; printer driver management has not changed
+considerably in 3.0 over the 2.2.x releases (apart from many small
+improvements). Here migration should be quite easy, especially if you
+followed previous advice to stop using deprecated parameters in your
+setup. For migrations from an existing 2.0.x setup, or if you
+continued &quot;Win9x-style&quot; printing in your Samba 2.2 installations, it
+is more of an effort. Please read the appropriate release notes and
+the HOWTO Collection for 2.2. You can follow several paths. Here are
+possible scenarios for migration:
+</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>You need to study and apply the new Windows NT printer
+and driver support. Previously used parameters &quot;<i class="parameter"><tt>printer
+driver file</tt></i>&quot;, &quot; <i class="parameter"><tt>printer driver</tt></i>&quot; and
+&quot;<i class="parameter"><tt>printer driver location</tt></i>&quot; are no longer
+supported.</p></li><li><p>If you want to take advantage of WinNT printer driver
+support you also need to migrate theWin9x/ME drivers to the new
+setup.</p></li><li><p>An existing <tt class="filename">printers.def</tt> file
+(the one specified in the now removed parameter <i class="parameter"><tt>printer
+driver file = ...</tt></i>) will work no longer with Samba-3.0. In
+3.0, smbd attempts to locate a Win9x/ME driver files for the printer
+in <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> and additional settings in the TDB
+and only there; if it fails it will <span class="emphasis"><em>not</em></span> (as 2.2.x
+used to do) drop down to using a <tt class="filename">printers.def</tt>
+(and all associated parameters). The make_printerdef tool is removed
+and there is no backwards compatibility for this.</p></li><li><p>You need to install a Windows 9x driver into the
+<i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> share for a printer on your Samba
+host. The driver files will be stored in the &quot;WIN40/0&quot; subdirectory of
+<i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i>, and some other settings and info go
+into the printing-related TDBs.</p></li><li><p>If you want to migrate an existing
+<tt class="filename">printers.def</tt> file into the new setup, the current
+only solution is to use the Windows NT APW to install the NT drivers
+and the 9x drivers. This can be scripted using smbclient and
+rpcclient. See the Imprints installation client at:
+</p><p>
+<a href="http://imprints.sourceforge.net/" target="_top"><span class="emphasis"><em>http://imprints.sourceforge.net/</em></span></a>
+</p><p>
+for an example. See also the discussion of rpcclient usage in the
+&quot;CUPS Printing&quot; section.</p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2944110"></a>Publishing Printer Information in Active Directory or LDAP</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+We will publish an update to this section shortly.
+</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2944124"></a>Common Errors and Problems</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+Here are a few typical errors and problems people have
+encountered. You can avoid them. Read on.
+</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2944137"></a>I give my root password but I don't get access</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+Don't confuse the root password which is valid for the Unix system
+(and in most cases stored in the form of a one-way hash in a file
+named <tt class="filename">/etc/shadow</tt>) with the password used to
+authenticate against Samba!. Samba doesn't know the UNIX password; for
+root to access Samba resources via Samba-type access, a Samba account
+for root must be created first. This is often done with the
+<b class="command">smbpasswd</b> command.
+</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2944170"></a>My printjobs get spooled into the spooling directory, but then get lost</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+Don't use the existing Unix print system spool directory for the Samba
+spool directory. It may seem convenient and a saving of space, but it
+only leads to problems. The two <span class="emphasis"><em>must</em></span> be separate.
+</p></div></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="msdfs.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="optional.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="CUPS-printing.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 17. Hosting a Microsoft Distributed File System tree on Samba </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="index.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 19. CUPS Printing Support in Samba 3.0</td></tr></table></div></body></html>
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/rpcclient.1.html b/docs/htmldocs/rpcclient.1.html
index e695663c8a..47c4d914a5 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/rpcclient.1.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/rpcclient.1.html
@@ -1,781 +1,198 @@
-<!DOCTYPE HTML PUBLIC "-//W3C//DTD HTML 4.01 Transitional//EN">
-<HTML
-><HEAD
-><TITLE
->rpcclient</TITLE
-><META
-NAME="GENERATOR"
-CONTENT="Modular DocBook HTML Stylesheet Version 1.77"></HEAD
-><BODY
-CLASS="REFENTRY"
-BGCOLOR="#FFFFFF"
-TEXT="#000000"
-LINK="#0000FF"
-VLINK="#840084"
-ALINK="#0000FF"
-><H1
-><A
-NAME="RPCCLIENT"
-></A
->rpcclient</H1
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFNAMEDIV"
-><A
-NAME="AEN5"
-></A
-><H2
->Name</H2
->rpcclient&nbsp;--&nbsp;tool for executing client side
- MS-RPC functions</DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSYNOPSISDIV"
-><A
-NAME="AEN8"
-></A
-><H2
->Synopsis</H2
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->rpcclient</B
-> [-A authfile] [-c &lt;command string&gt;] [-d debuglevel] [-h] [-l logfile] [-N] [-s &lt;smb config file&gt;] [-U username[%password]] [-W workgroup] [-N] [-I destinationIP] {server}</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN23"
-></A
-><H2
->DESCRIPTION</H2
-><P
->This tool is part of the <A
-HREF="samba.7.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-> Samba</A
-> suite.</P
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->rpcclient</B
-> is a utility initially developed
+<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>rpcclient</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="rpcclient.1"></a><div class="titlepage"><div></div><div></div></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>rpcclient &#8212; tool for executing client side
+ MS-RPC functions</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><tt class="command">rpcclient</tt> [-A authfile] [-c &lt;command string&gt;] [-d debuglevel] [-h] [-l logfile] [-N] [-s &lt;smb config file&gt;] [-U username[%password]] [-W workgroup] [-N] [-I destinationIP] {server}</p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This tool is part of the <a href="Samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">Samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p><b class="command">rpcclient</b> is a utility initially developed
to test MS-RPC functionality in Samba itself. It has undergone
several stages of development and stability. Many system administrators
have now written scripts around it to manage Windows NT clients from
- their UNIX workstation. </P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN29"
-></A
-><H2
->OPTIONS</H2
-><P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
->server</DT
-><DD
-><P
->NetBIOS name of Server to which to connect.
+ their UNIX workstation. </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">server</span></dt><dd><p>NetBIOS name of Server to which to connect.
The server can be any SMB/CIFS server. The name is
- resolved using the <A
-HREF="smb.conf.5.html#NAMERESOLVEORDER"
-TARGET="_top"
-> <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->name resolve order</I
-></TT
-></A
-> line from
- <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->smb.conf(5)</TT
->.</P
-></DD
-><DT
->-A|--authfile=filename</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This option allows
- you to specify a file from which to read the username and
- password used in the connection. The format of the file is
- </P
-><P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
-> username = &lt;value&gt;
- password = &lt;value&gt;
- domain = &lt;value&gt;
- </PRE
-></P
-><P
->Make certain that the permissions on the file restrict
- access from unwanted users. </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-c|--command='command string'</DT
-><DD
-><P
->execute semicolon separated commands (listed
- below)) </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-d|--debug=debuglevel</DT
-><DD
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="REPLACEABLE"
-><I
->debuglevel</I
-></TT
-> is an integer
+ resolved using the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#NAMERESOLVEORDER" target="_top">
+ <i class="parameter"><tt>name resolve order</tt></i></a> line from <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a>.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-c|--command='command string'</span></dt><dd><p>execute semicolon separated commands (listed
+ below)) </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-I IP-address</span></dt><dd><p><i class="replaceable"><tt>IP address</tt></i> is the address of the server to connect to.
+ It should be specified in standard &quot;a.b.c.d&quot; notation. </p><p>Normally the client would attempt to locate a named
+ SMB/CIFS server by looking it up via the NetBIOS name resolution
+ mechanism described above in the <i class="parameter"><tt>name resolve order</tt></i>
+ parameter above. Using this parameter will force the client
+ to assume that the server is on the machine with the specified IP
+ address and the NetBIOS name component of the resource being
+ connected to will be ignored. </p><p>There is no default for this parameter. If not supplied,
+ it will be determined automatically by the client as described
+ above. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-V</span></dt><dd><p>Prints the version number for
+<b class="command">smbd</b>.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-s &lt;configuration file&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>The file specified contains the
+configuration details required by the server. The
+information in this file includes server-specific
+information such as what printcap file to use, as well
+as descriptions of all the services that the server is
+to provide. See <a href="smb.conf.5.html" target="_top"><tt class="filename">
+smb.conf(5)</tt></a> for more information.
+The default configuration file name is determined at
+compile time.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-d|--debug=debuglevel</span></dt><dd><p><i class="replaceable"><tt>debuglevel</tt></i> is an integer
from 0 to 10. The default value if this parameter is
-not specified is zero.</P
-><P
->The higher this value, the more detail will be
+not specified is zero.</p><p>The higher this value, the more detail will be
logged to the log files about the activities of the
server. At level 0, only critical errors and serious
warnings will be logged. Level 1 is a reasonable level for
day to day running - it generates a small amount of
-information about operations carried out.</P
-><P
->Levels above 1 will generate considerable
+information about operations carried out.</p><p>Levels above 1 will generate considerable
amounts of log data, and should only be used when
investigating a problem. Levels above 3 are designed for
use only by developers and generate HUGE amounts of log
-data, most of which is extremely cryptic.</P
-><P
->Note that specifying this parameter here will
-override the <A
-HREF="smb.conf.5.html#loglevel"
-TARGET="_top"
->log
-level</A
-> parameter in the <A
-HREF="smb.conf.5.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-><TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->smb.conf(5)</TT
-></A
-> file.</P
-></DD
-><DT
->-h|--help</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Print a summary of command line options.</P
-></DD
-><DT
->-I IP-address</DT
-><DD
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="REPLACEABLE"
-><I
->IP address</I
-></TT
-> is the address of the server to connect to.
- It should be specified in standard "a.b.c.d" notation. </P
-><P
->Normally the client would attempt to locate a named
- SMB/CIFS server by looking it up via the NetBIOS name resolution
- mechanism described above in the <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->name resolve order</I
-></TT
->
- parameter above. Using this parameter will force the client
- to assume that the server is on the machine with the specified IP
- address and the NetBIOS name component of the resource being
- connected to will be ignored. </P
-><P
->There is no default for this parameter. If not supplied,
- it will be determined automatically by the client as described
- above. </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-l|--logfile=logbasename</DT
-><DD
-><P
->File name for log/debug files. The extension
- <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->'.client'</TT
-> will be appended. The log file is
- never removed by the client.
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-N|--nopass</DT
-><DD
-><P
->instruct <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->rpcclient</B
-> not to ask
- for a password. By default, <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->rpcclient</B
-> will
- prompt for a password. See also the <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->-U</I
-></TT
->
- option.</P
-></DD
-><DT
->-s|--conf=smb.conf</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Specifies the location of the all-important
- <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->smb.conf</TT
-> file. </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-U|--user=username[%password]</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Sets the SMB username or username and password. </P
-><P
->If %password is not specified, the user will be prompted. The
- client will first check the <TT
-CLASS="ENVAR"
->USER</TT
-> environment variable, then the
- <TT
-CLASS="ENVAR"
->LOGNAME</TT
-> variable and if either exists, the
- string is uppercased. If these environmental variables are not
- found, the username <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->GUEST</TT
-> is used. </P
-><P
->A third option is to use a credentials file which
- contains the plaintext of the username and password. This
- option is mainly provided for scripts where the admin does not
- wish to pass the credentials on the command line or via environment
- variables. If this method is used, make certain that the permissions
- on the file restrict access from unwanted users. See the
- <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->-A</I
-></TT
-> for more details. </P
-><P
->Be cautious about including passwords in scripts. Also, on
- many systems the command line of a running process may be seen
- via the <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->ps</B
-> command. To be safe always allow
- <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->rpcclient</B
-> to prompt for a password and type
- it in directly. </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-W|--workgroup=domain</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Set the SMB domain of the username. This
- overrides the default domain which is the domain defined in
- smb.conf. If the domain specified is the same as the server's NetBIOS name,
- it causes the client to log on using the server's local SAM (as
- opposed to the Domain SAM). </P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN107"
-></A
-><H2
->COMMANDS</H2
-><P
-><SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->LSARPC</I
-></SPAN
-></P
-><P
-></P
-><UL
-><LI
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->lsaquery</B
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->lookupsids</B
-> - Resolve a list
+data, most of which is extremely cryptic.</p><p>Note that specifying this parameter here will
+override the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#loglevel" target="_top">log
+level</a> parameter in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html" target="_top">
+<tt class="filename">smb.conf(5)</tt></a> file.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-l|--logfile=logbasename</span></dt><dd><p>File name for log/debug files. The extension
+<tt class="constant">&quot;.client&quot;</tt> will be appended. The log file is
+never removed by the client.
+</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-N</span></dt><dd><p>If specified, this parameter suppresses the normal
+password prompt from the client to the user. This is useful when
+accessing a service that does not require a password. </p><p>Unless a password is specified on the command line or
+this parameter is specified, the client will request a
+password.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-k</span></dt><dd><p>
+Try to authenticate with kerberos. Only useful in
+an Active Directory environment.
+</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-A|--authfile=filename</span></dt><dd><p>This option allows
+you to specify a file from which to read the username and
+password used in the connection. The format of the file is
+</p><pre class="programlisting">
+username = &lt;value&gt;
+password = &lt;value&gt;
+domain = &lt;value&gt;
+</pre><p>Make certain that the permissions on the file restrict
+access from unwanted users. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-U|--user=username[%password]</span></dt><dd><p>Sets the SMB username or username and password. </p><p>If %password is not specified, the user will be prompted. The
+client will first check the <tt class="envar">USER</tt> environment variable, then the
+<tt class="envar">LOGNAME</tt> variable and if either exists, the
+string is uppercased. If these environmental variables are not
+found, the username <tt class="constant">GUEST</tt> is used. </p><p>A third option is to use a credentials file which
+contains the plaintext of the username and password. This
+option is mainly provided for scripts where the admin does not
+wish to pass the credentials on the command line or via environment
+variables. If this method is used, make certain that the permissions
+on the file restrict access from unwanted users. See the
+<i class="parameter"><tt>-A</tt></i> for more details. </p><p>Be cautious about including passwords in scripts. Also, on
+many systems the command line of a running process may be seen
+via the <b class="command">ps</b> command. To be safe always allow
+<b class="command">rpcclient</b> to prompt for a password and type
+it in directly. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-n &lt;primary NetBIOS name&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>This option allows you to override
+the NetBIOS name that Samba uses for itself. This is identical
+to setting the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#netbiosname" target="_top"><i class="parameter"><tt>NetBIOS
+name</tt></i></a> parameter in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> file. However, a command
+line setting will take precedence over settings in
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a>.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-i &lt;scope&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>This specifies a NetBIOS scope that
+<b class="command">nmblookup</b> will use to communicate with when
+generating NetBIOS names. For details on the use of NetBIOS
+scopes, see rfc1001.txt and rfc1002.txt. NetBIOS scopes are
+<span class="emphasis"><em>very</em></span> rarely used, only set this parameter
+if you are the system administrator in charge of all the
+NetBIOS systems you communicate with.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-W|--workgroup=domain</span></dt><dd><p>Set the SMB domain of the username. This
+overrides the default domain which is the domain defined in
+smb.conf. If the domain specified is the same as the servers
+NetBIOS name, it causes the client to log on using the servers local
+SAM (as opposed to the Domain SAM). </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-O socket options</span></dt><dd><p>TCP socket options to set on the client
+socket. See the socket options parameter in
+the <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> manual page for the list of valid
+options. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-h|--help</span></dt><dd><p>Print a summary of command line options.
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>COMMANDS</h2><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><h3>LSARPC</h3><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">lsaquery</span></dt><dd><p>Query info policy</p></dd><dt><span class="term">lookupsids</span></dt><dd><p>Resolve a list
of SIDs to usernames.
- </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->lookupnames</B
-> - Resolve a list
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term">lookupnames</span></dt><dd><p>Resolve a list
of usernames to SIDs.
- </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->enumtrusts</B
-></P
-></LI
-></UL
-><P
-> </P
-><P
-><SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->SAMR</I
-></SPAN
-></P
-><P
-></P
-><UL
-><LI
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->queryuser</B
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->querygroup</B
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->queryusergroups</B
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->querygroupmem</B
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->queryaliasmem</B
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->querydispinfo</B
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->querydominfo</B
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->enumdomgroups</B
-></P
-></LI
-></UL
-><P
-> </P
-><P
-><SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->SPOOLSS</I
-></SPAN
-></P
-><P
-></P
-><UL
-><LI
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->adddriver &lt;arch&gt; &lt;config&gt;</B
->
- - Execute an AddPrinterDriver() RPC to install the printer driver
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term">enumtrusts</span></dt><dd><p>Enumerate trusted domains</p></dd><dt><span class="term">enumprivs</span></dt><dd><p>Enumerate privileges</p></dd><dt><span class="term">getdispname</span></dt><dd><p>Get the privilege name</p></dd><dt><span class="term">lsaenumsid</span></dt><dd><p>Enumerate the LSA SIDS</p></dd><dt><span class="term">lsaenumprivsaccount</span></dt><dd><p>Enumerate the privileges of an SID</p></dd><dt><span class="term">lsaenumacctrights</span></dt><dd><p>Enumerate the rights of an SID</p></dd><dt><span class="term">lsaenumacctwithright</span></dt><dd><p>Enumerate accounts with a right</p></dd><dt><span class="term">lsaaddacctrights</span></dt><dd><p>Add rights to an account</p></dd><dt><span class="term">lsaremoveacctrights</span></dt><dd><p>Remove rights from an account</p></dd><dt><span class="term">lsalookupprivvalue</span></dt><dd><p>Get a privilege value given its name</p></dd><dt><span class="term">lsaquerysecobj</span></dt><dd><p>Query LSA security object</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><h3>LSARPC-DS</h3><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">dsroledominfo</span></dt><dd><p>Get Primary Domain Information</p></dd></dl></div><p> </p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>DFS</em></span></p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">dfsexist</span></dt><dd><p>Query DFS support</p></dd><dt><span class="term">dfsadd</span></dt><dd><p>Add a DFS share</p></dd><dt><span class="term">dfsremove</span></dt><dd><p>Remove a DFS share</p></dd><dt><span class="term">dfsgetinfo</span></dt><dd><p>Query DFS share info</p></dd><dt><span class="term">dfsenum</span></dt><dd><p>Enumerate dfs shares</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><h3>REG</h3><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">shutdown</span></dt><dd><p>Remote Shutdown</p></dd><dt><span class="term">abortshutdown</span></dt><dd><p>Abort Shutdown</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><h3>SRVSVC</h3><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">srvinfo</span></dt><dd><p>Server query info</p></dd><dt><span class="term">netshareenum</span></dt><dd><p>Enumerate shares</p></dd><dt><span class="term">netfileenum</span></dt><dd><p>Enumerate open files</p></dd><dt><span class="term">netremotetod</span></dt><dd><p>Fetch remote time of day</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><h3>SAMR</h3><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">queryuser</span></dt><dd><p>Query user info</p></dd><dt><span class="term">querygroup</span></dt><dd><p>Query group info</p></dd><dt><span class="term">queryusergroups</span></dt><dd><p>Query user groups</p></dd><dt><span class="term">querygroupmem</span></dt><dd><p>Query group membership</p></dd><dt><span class="term">queryaliasmem</span></dt><dd><p>Query alias membership</p></dd><dt><span class="term">querydispinfo</span></dt><dd><p>Query display info</p></dd><dt><span class="term">querydominfo</span></dt><dd><p>Query domain info</p></dd><dt><span class="term">enumdomusers</span></dt><dd><p>Enumerate domain users</p></dd><dt><span class="term">enumdomgroups</span></dt><dd><p>Enumerate domain groups</p></dd><dt><span class="term">enumalsgroups</span></dt><dd><p>Enumerate alias groups</p></dd><dt><span class="term">createdomuser</span></dt><dd><p>Create domain user</p></dd><dt><span class="term">samlookupnames</span></dt><dd><p>Look up names</p></dd><dt><span class="term">samlookuprids</span></dt><dd><p>Look up names</p></dd><dt><span class="term">deletedomuser</span></dt><dd><p>Delete domain user</p></dd><dt><span class="term">samquerysecobj</span></dt><dd><p>Query SAMR security object</p></dd><dt><span class="term">getdompwinfo</span></dt><dd><p>Retrieve domain password info</p></dd><dt><span class="term">lookupdomain</span></dt><dd><p>Look up domain</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><h3>SPOOLSS</h3><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">adddriver &lt;arch&gt; &lt;config&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>
+ Execute an AddPrinterDriver() RPC to install the printer driver
information on the server. Note that the driver files should
already exist in the directory returned by
- <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->getdriverdir</B
->. Possible values for
- <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->arch</I
-></TT
-> are the same as those for
- the <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->getdriverdir</B
-> command.
- The <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->config</I
-></TT
-> parameter is defined as
- follows: </P
-><P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
-> Long Printer Name:\
- Driver File Name:\
- Data File Name:\
- Config File Name:\
- Help File Name:\
- Language Monitor Name:\
- Default Data Type:\
- Comma Separated list of Files
- </PRE
-></P
-><P
->Any empty fields should be enter as the string "NULL". </P
-><P
->Samba does not need to support the concept of Print Monitors
+ <b class="command">getdriverdir</b>. Possible values for
+ <i class="parameter"><tt>arch</tt></i> are the same as those for
+ the <b class="command">getdriverdir</b> command.
+ The <i class="parameter"><tt>config</tt></i> parameter is defined as
+ follows: </p><pre class="programlisting">
+Long Printer Name:\
+Driver File Name:\
+Data File Name:\
+Config File Name:\
+Help File Name:\
+Language Monitor Name:\
+Default Data Type:\
+Comma Separated list of Files
+</pre><p>Any empty fields should be enter as the string &quot;NULL&quot;. </p><p>Samba does not need to support the concept of Print Monitors
since these only apply to local printers whose driver can make
use of a bi-directional link for communication. This field should
- be "NULL". On a remote NT print server, the Print Monitor for a
+ be &quot;NULL&quot;. On a remote NT print server, the Print Monitor for a
driver must already be installed prior to adding the driver or
- else the RPC will fail. </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->addprinter &lt;printername&gt;
- &lt;sharename&gt; &lt;drivername&gt; &lt;port&gt;</B
->
- - Add a printer on the remote server. This printer
+ else the RPC will fail. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">addprinter &lt;printername&gt;
+ &lt;sharename&gt; &lt;drivername&gt; &lt;port&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>
+ Add a printer on the remote server. This printer
will be automatically shared. Be aware that the printer driver
- must already be installed on the server (see <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->adddriver</B
->)
- and the <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->port</I
-></TT
->must be a valid port name (see
- <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->enumports</B
->.</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->deldriver</B
-> - Delete the
+ must already be installed on the server (see <b class="command">adddriver</b>)
+ and the <i class="parameter"><tt>port</tt></i>must be a valid port name (see
+ <b class="command">enumports</b>.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">deldriver</span></dt><dd><p>Delete the
specified printer driver for all architectures. This
does not delete the actual driver files from the server,
only the entry from the server's list of drivers.
- </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->enumdata</B
-> - Enumerate all
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term">enumdata</span></dt><dd><p>Enumerate all
printer setting data stored on the server. On Windows NT clients,
these values are stored in the registry, while Samba servers
store them in the printers TDB. This command corresponds
to the MS Platform SDK GetPrinterData() function (* This
- command is currently unimplemented).</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->enumjobs &lt;printer&gt;</B
->
- - List the jobs and status of a given printer.
+ command is currently unimplemented).</p></dd><dt><span class="term">enumdataex</span></dt><dd><p>Enumerate printer data for a key</p></dd><dt><span class="term">enumjobs &lt;printer&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>List the jobs and status of a given printer.
This command corresponds to the MS Platform SDK EnumJobs()
- function (* This command is currently unimplemented).</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->enumports [level]</B
->
- - Executes an EnumPorts() call using the specified
+ function</p></dd><dt><span class="term">enumkey</span></dt><dd><p>Enumerate
+ printer keys</p></dd><dt><span class="term">enumports [level]</span></dt><dd><p>
+ Executes an EnumPorts() call using the specified
info level. Currently only info levels 1 and 2 are supported.
- </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->enumdrivers [level]</B
->
- - Execute an EnumPrinterDrivers() call. This lists the various installed
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term">enumdrivers [level]</span></dt><dd><p>
+ Execute an EnumPrinterDrivers() call. This lists the various installed
printer drivers for all architectures. Refer to the MS Platform SDK
documentation for more details of the various flags and calling
- options. Currently supported info levels are 1, 2, and 3.</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->enumprinters [level]</B
->
- - Execute an EnumPrinters() call. This lists the various installed
+ options. Currently supported info levels are 1, 2, and 3.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">enumprinters [level]</span></dt><dd><p>Execute an EnumPrinters() call. This lists the various installed
and share printers. Refer to the MS Platform SDK documentation for
more details of the various flags and calling options. Currently
- supported info levels are 0, 1, and 2.</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->getdata &lt;printername&gt;</B
->
- - Retrieve the data for a given printer setting. See
- the <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->enumdata</B
-> command for more information.
+ supported info levels are 1, 2 and 5.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">getdata &lt;printername&gt; &lt;valuename;&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>Retrieve the data for a given printer setting. See
+ the <b class="command">enumdata</b> command for more information.
This command corresponds to the GetPrinterData() MS Platform
- SDK function (* This command is currently unimplemented). </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->getdriver &lt;printername&gt;</B
->
- - Retrieve the printer driver information (such as driver file,
+ SDK function. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">getdataex</span></dt><dd><p>Get
+ printer driver data with
+ keyname</p></dd><dt><span class="term">getdriver &lt;printername&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>
+ Retrieve the printer driver information (such as driver file,
config file, dependent files, etc...) for
the given printer. This command corresponds to the GetPrinterDriver()
MS Platform SDK function. Currently info level 1, 2, and 3 are supported.
- </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->getdriverdir &lt;arch&gt;</B
->
- - Execute a GetPrinterDriverDirectory()
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term">getdriverdir &lt;arch&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>
+ Execute a GetPrinterDriverDirectory()
RPC to retrieve the SMB share name and subdirectory for
storing printer driver files for a given architecture. Possible
- values for <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->arch</I
-></TT
-> are "Windows 4.0"
- (for Windows 95/98), "Windows NT x86", "Windows NT PowerPC", "Windows
- Alpha_AXP", and "Windows NT R4000". </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->getprinter &lt;printername&gt;</B
->
- - Retrieve the current printer information. This command
+ values for <i class="parameter"><tt>arch</tt></i> are &quot;Windows 4.0&quot;
+ (for Windows 95/98), &quot;Windows NT x86&quot;, &quot;Windows NT PowerPC&quot;, &quot;Windows
+ Alpha_AXP&quot;, and &quot;Windows NT R4000&quot;. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">getprinter &lt;printername&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>Retrieve the current printer information. This command
corresponds to the GetPrinter() MS Platform SDK function.
- </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->openprinter &lt;printername&gt;</B
->
- - Execute an OpenPrinterEx() and ClosePrinter() RPC
- against a given printer. </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->setdriver &lt;printername&gt;
- &lt;drivername&gt;</B
->
- - Execute a SetPrinter() command to update the printer driver
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term">getprintprocdir</span></dt><dd><p>Get
+ print processor
+ directory</p></dd><dt><span class="term">openprinter &lt;printername&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>Execute an OpenPrinterEx() and ClosePrinter() RPC
+ against a given printer. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">setdriver &lt;printername&gt;
+ &lt;drivername&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>Execute a SetPrinter() command to update the printer driver
associated with an installed printer. The printer driver must
- already be correctly installed on the print server. </P
-><P
->See also the <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->enumprinters</B
-> and
- <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->enumdrivers</B
-> commands for obtaining a list of
- of installed printers and drivers.</P
-></LI
-></UL
-><P
-><SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->GENERAL OPTIONS</I
-></SPAN
-></P
-><P
-></P
-><UL
-><LI
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->debuglevel</B
-> - Set the current
- debug level used to log information.</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->help (?)</B
-> - Print a listing of all
+ already be correctly installed on the print server. </p><p>See also the <b class="command">enumprinters</b> and
+ <b class="command">enumdrivers</b> commands for obtaining a list of
+ of installed printers and drivers.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">addform</span></dt><dd><p>Add form</p></dd><dt><span class="term">setform</span></dt><dd><p>Set form</p></dd><dt><span class="term">getform</span></dt><dd><p>Get form</p></dd><dt><span class="term">deleteform</span></dt><dd><p>Delete form</p></dd><dt><span class="term">enumforms</span></dt><dd><p>Enumerate form</p></dd><dt><span class="term">setprinter</span></dt><dd><p>Set printer comment</p></dd><dt><span class="term">setprinterdata</span></dt><dd><p>Set REG_SZ printer data</p></dd><dt><span class="term">rffpcnex</span></dt><dd><p>Rffpcnex test</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><h3>NETLOGON</h3><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">logonctrl2</span></dt><dd><p>Logon Control 2</p></dd><dt><span class="term">logonctrl</span></dt><dd><p>Logon Control</p></dd><dt><span class="term">samsync</span></dt><dd><p>Sam Synchronisation</p></dd><dt><span class="term">samdeltas</span></dt><dd><p>Query Sam Deltas</p></dd><dt><span class="term">samlogon</span></dt><dd><p>Sam Logon</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><h3>GENERAL COMMANDS</h3><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">debuglevel</span></dt><dd><p>Set the current
+ debug level used to log information.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">help (?)</span></dt><dd><p>Print a listing of all
known commands or extended help on a particular command.
- </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->quit (exit)</B
-> - Exit <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->rpcclient
- </B
->.</P
-></LI
-></UL
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN227"
-></A
-><H2
->BUGS</H2
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->rpcclient</B
-> is designed as a developer testing tool
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term">quit (exit)</span></dt><dd><p>Exit <b class="command">rpcclient
+ </b>.</p></dd></dl></div></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>BUGS</h2><p><b class="command">rpcclient</b> is designed as a developer testing tool
and may not be robust in certain areas (such as command line parsing).
It has been known to generate a core dump upon failures when invalid
- parameters where passed to the interpreter. </P
-><P
->From Luke Leighton's original rpcclient man page:</P
-><P
-><SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->"WARNING!</I
-></SPAN
-> The MSRPC over SMB code has
+ parameters where passed to the interpreter. </p><p>From Luke Leighton's original rpcclient man page:</p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>WARNING!</em></span> The MSRPC over SMB code has
been developed from examining Network traces. No documentation is
available from the original creators (Microsoft) on how MSRPC over
SMB works, or how the individual MSRPC services work. Microsoft's
implementation of these services has been demonstrated (and reported)
- to be... a bit flaky in places. </P
-><P
->The development of Samba's implementation is also a bit rough,
- and as more of the services are understood, it can even result in
- versions of <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbd(8)</B
-> and <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->rpcclient(1)</B
->
- that are incompatible for some commands or services. Additionally,
+ to be... a bit flaky in places. </p><p>The development of Samba's implementation is also a bit rough,
+ and as more of the services are understood, it can even result in
+ versions of <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> and <a href="rpcclient.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">rpcclient</span>(1)</span></a> that are incompatible for some commands or services. Additionally,
the developers are sending reports to Microsoft, and problems found
or reported to Microsoft are fixed in Service Packs, which may
- result in incompatibilities." </P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN237"
-></A
-><H2
->VERSION</H2
-><P
->This man page is correct for version 3.0 of the Samba
- suite.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN240"
-></A
-><H2
->AUTHOR</H2
-><P
->The original Samba software and related utilities
+ result in incompatibilities.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3.0 of the Samba
+ suite.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
- to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</P
-><P
->The original rpcclient man page was written by Matthew
+ to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</p><p>The original rpcclient man page was written by Matthew
Geddes, Luke Kenneth Casson Leighton, and rewritten by Gerald Carter.
The conversion to DocBook for Samba 2.2 was done by Gerald
- Carter.</P
-></DIV
-></BODY
-></HTML
-> \ No newline at end of file
+ Carter. The conversion to DocBook XML 4.2 for Samba 3.0 was
+ done by Alexander Bokovoy.</p></div></div></body></html>
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/samba-bdc.html b/docs/htmldocs/samba-bdc.html
index ef06a89416..95d1cc4e5f 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/samba-bdc.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/samba-bdc.html
@@ -1,348 +1,246 @@
-<!DOCTYPE HTML PUBLIC "-//W3C//DTD HTML 4.01 Transitional//EN">
-<HTML
-><HEAD
-><TITLE
->How to Act as a Backup Domain Controller in a Purely Samba Controlled Domain</TITLE
-><META
-NAME="GENERATOR"
-CONTENT="Modular DocBook HTML Stylesheet Version 1.76b+
-"><LINK
-REL="HOME"
-TITLE="SAMBA Project Documentation"
-HREF="samba-howto-collection.html"><LINK
-REL="UP"
-TITLE="Type of installation"
-HREF="type.html"><LINK
-REL="PREVIOUS"
-TITLE="How to Configure Samba as a NT4 Primary Domain Controller"
-HREF="samba-pdc.html"><LINK
-REL="NEXT"
-TITLE="Samba as a ADS domain member"
-HREF="ads.html"></HEAD
-><BODY
-CLASS="CHAPTER"
-BGCOLOR="#FFFFFF"
-TEXT="#000000"
-LINK="#0000FF"
-VLINK="#840084"
-ALINK="#0000FF"
-><DIV
-CLASS="NAVHEADER"
-><TABLE
-SUMMARY="Header navigation table"
-WIDTH="100%"
-BORDER="0"
-CELLPADDING="0"
-CELLSPACING="0"
-><TR
-><TH
-COLSPAN="3"
-ALIGN="center"
->SAMBA Project Documentation</TH
-></TR
-><TR
-><TD
-WIDTH="10%"
-ALIGN="left"
-VALIGN="bottom"
-><A
-HREF="samba-pdc.html"
-ACCESSKEY="P"
->Prev</A
-></TD
-><TD
-WIDTH="80%"
-ALIGN="center"
-VALIGN="bottom"
-></TD
-><TD
-WIDTH="10%"
-ALIGN="right"
-VALIGN="bottom"
-><A
-HREF="ads.html"
-ACCESSKEY="N"
->Next</A
-></TD
-></TR
-></TABLE
-><HR
-ALIGN="LEFT"
-WIDTH="100%"></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="CHAPTER"
-><H1
-><A
-NAME="SAMBA-BDC">Chapter 7. How to Act as a Backup Domain Controller in a Purely Samba Controlled Domain</H1
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><H1
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN1127">7.1. Prerequisite Reading</H1
-><P
->Before you continue reading in this chapter, please make sure
-that you are comfortable with configuring a Samba PDC
-as described in the <A
-HREF="Samba-PDC-HOWTO.html"
-TARGET="_top"
->Samba-PDC-HOWTO</A
->.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><H1
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN1131">7.2. Background</H1
-><P
->What is a Domain Controller? It is a machine that is able to answer
-logon requests from workstations in a Windows NT Domain. Whenever a
-user logs into a Windows NT Workstation, the workstation connects to a
-Domain Controller and asks him whether the username and password the
-user typed in is correct. The Domain Controller replies with a lot of
-information about the user, for example the place where the users
-profile is stored, the users full name of the user. All this
-information is stored in the NT user database, the so-called SAM.</P
-><P
->There are two kinds of Domain Controller in a NT 4 compatible Domain:
-A Primary Domain Controller (PDC) and one or more Backup Domain
-Controllers (BDC). The PDC contains the master copy of the
-SAM. Whenever the SAM has to change, for example when a user changes
-his password, this change has to be done on the PDC. A Backup Domain
-Controller is a machine that maintains a read-only copy of the
-SAM. This way it is able to reply to logon requests and authenticate
-users in case the PDC is not available. During this time no changes to
-the SAM are possible. Whenever changes to the SAM are done on the PDC,
-all BDC receive the changes from the PDC.</P
-><P
->Since version 2.2 Samba officially supports domain logons for all
-current Windows Clients, including Windows 2000 and XP. This text
-assumes the domain to be named SAMBA. To be able to act as a PDC, some
-parameters in the [global]-section of the smb.conf have to be set:</P
-><P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
->workgroup = SAMBA
-domain master = yes
-domain logons = yes</PRE
-></P
-><P
->Several other things like a [homes] and a [netlogon] share also may be
-set along with settings for the profile path, the users home drive and
-others. This will not be covered in this document.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><H1
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN1139">7.3. What qualifies a Domain Controller on the network?</H1
-><P
->Every machine that is a Domain Controller for the domain SAMBA has to
-register the NetBIOS group name SAMBA#1c with the WINS server and/or
-by broadcast on the local network. The PDC also registers the unique
-NetBIOS name SAMBA#1b with the WINS server. The name type #1b is
-normally reserved for the domain master browser, a role that has
-nothing to do with anything related to authentication, but the
-Microsoft Domain implementation requires the domain master browser to
-be on the same machine as the PDC.</P
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><H2
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN1142">7.3.1. How does a Workstation find its domain controller?</H2
-><P
->A NT workstation in the domain SAMBA that wants a local user to be
-authenticated has to find the domain controller for SAMBA. It does
-this by doing a NetBIOS name query for the group name SAMBA#1c. It
-assumes that each of the machines it gets back from the queries is a
-domain controller and can answer logon requests. To not open security
-holes both the workstation and the selected (TODO: How is the DC
-chosen) domain controller authenticate each other. After that the
-workstation sends the user's credentials (his name and password) to
-the domain controller, asking for approval.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><H2
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN1145">7.3.2. When is the PDC needed?</H2
-><P
->Whenever a user wants to change his password, this has to be done on
-the PDC. To find the PDC, the workstation does a NetBIOS name query
-for SAMBA#1b, assuming this machine maintains the master copy of the
-SAM. The workstation contacts the PDC, both mutually authenticate and
-the password change is done.</P
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><H1
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN1148">7.4. Can Samba be a Backup Domain Controller?</H1
-><P
->With version 2.2, no. The native NT SAM replication protocols have
-not yet been fully implemented. The Samba Team is working on
-understanding and implementing the protocols, but this work has not
-been finished for version 2.2.</P
-><P
->Can I get the benefits of a BDC with Samba? Yes. The main reason for
-implementing a BDC is availability. If the PDC is a Samba machine,
-a second Samba machine can be set up to
-service logon requests whenever the PDC is down.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><H1
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN1152">7.5. How do I set up a Samba BDC?</H1
-><P
->Several things have to be done:</P
-><P
-></P
-><UL
-><LI
-><P
->The domain SID has to be the same on the PDC and the BDC. This used to
-be stored in the file private/MACHINE.SID. This file is not created
-anymore since Samba 2.2.5 or even earlier. Nowadays the domain SID is
-stored in the file private/secrets.tdb. Simply copying the secrets.tdb
-from the PDC to the BDC does not work, as the BDC would
-generate a new SID for itself and override the domain SID with this
-new BDC SID.</P
-><P
->To retrieve the domain SID from the PDC or an existing BDC and store it in the
-secrets.tdb, execute 'net rpc getsid' on the BDC.</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->The Unix user database has to be synchronized from the PDC to the
-BDC. This means that both the /etc/passwd and /etc/group have to be
-replicated from the PDC to the BDC. This can be done manually
-whenever changes are made, or the PDC is set up as a NIS master
-server and the BDC as a NIS slave server. To set up the BDC as a
-mere NIS client would not be enough, as the BDC would not be able to
-access its user database in case of a PDC failure.</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->The Samba password database in the file private/smbpasswd has to be
-replicated from the PDC to the BDC. This is a bit tricky, see the
-next section.</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->Any netlogon share has to be replicated from the PDC to the
-BDC. This can be done manually whenever login scripts are changed,
-or it can be done automatically together with the smbpasswd
-synchronization.</P
-></LI
-></UL
-><P
->Finally, the BDC has to be found by the workstations. This can be done
-by setting</P
-><P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
->workgroup = samba
-domain master = no
-domain logons = yes</PRE
-></P
-><P
->in the [global]-section of the smb.conf of the BDC. This makes the BDC
-only register the name SAMBA#1c with the WINS server. This is no
-problem as the name SAMBA#1c is a NetBIOS group name that is meant to
+<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 6. Backup Domain Control</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="type.html" title="Part II. Server Configuration Basics"><link rel="previous" href="samba-pdc.html" title="Chapter 5. Domain Control"><link rel="next" href="domain-member.html" title="Chapter 7. Domain Membership"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 6. Backup Domain Control</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="samba-pdc.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part II. Server Configuration Basics</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="domain-member.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="samba-bdc"></a>Chapter 6. Backup Domain Control</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email">&lt;<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>&gt;</tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Volker</span> <span class="surname">Lendecke</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email">&lt;<a href="mailto:Volker.Lendecke@SerNet.DE">Volker.Lendecke@SerNet.DE</a>&gt;</tt></p></div></div></div></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2895956">Features And Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2896128">Essential Background Information</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2896156">MS Windows NT4 Style Domain Control</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2896368">Active Directory Domain Control</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2896390">What qualifies a Domain Controller on the network?</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2896416">How does a Workstation find its domain controller?</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2896462">Backup Domain Controller Configuration</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2896532">Example Configuration</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2896591">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2896605">Machine Accounts keep expiring, what can I do?</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2896630">Can Samba be a Backup Domain Controller to an NT4 PDC?</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2896663">How do I replicate the smbpasswd file?</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2896692">Can I do this all with LDAP?</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><p>
+Before you continue reading in this section, please make sure that you are comfortable
+with configuring a Samba Domain Controller as described in the
+<a href="Samba-PDC-HOWTO.html" target="_top">Domain Control Chapter</a>.
+</p><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2895956"></a>Features And Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+This is one of the most difficult chapters to summarise. It matters not what we say here
+for someone will still draw conclusions and / or approach the Samba-Team with expectations
+that are either not yet capable of being delivered, or that can be achieved for more
+effectively using a totally different approach. Since this HOWTO is already so large and
+extensive, we have taken the decision to provide sufficient (but not comprehensive)
+information regarding Backup Domain Control. In the event that you should have a persistent
+concern that is not addressed in this HOWTO document then please email
+<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org" target="_top">John H Terpstra</a> clearly setting out your requirements
+and / or question and we will do our best to provide a solution.
+</p><p>
+Samba-3 is capable of acting as a Backup Domain Controller to another Samba Primary Domain
+Controller. A Samba-3 PDC can operate with an LDAP Account backend. The Samba-3 BDC can
+operate with a slave LDAP server for the Account backend. This effectively gives samba a high
+degree of scalability. This is a very sweet (nice) solution for large organisations.
+</p><p>
+While it is possible to run a Samba-3 BDC with non-LDAP backend, the administrator will
+need to figure out precisely what is the best way to replicate (copy / distribute) the
+user and machine Accounts backend.
+</p><p>
+The use of a non-LDAP backend SAM database is particularly problematic because Domain member
+servers and workstations periodically change the machine trust account password. The new
+password is then stored only locally. This means that in the absence of a centrally stored
+accounts database (such as that provided with an LDAP based solution) if Samba-3 is running
+as a BDC, the PDC instance of the Domain member trust account password will not reach the
+PDC (master) copy of the SAM. If the PDC SAM is then replicated to BDCs this results in
+overwriting of the SAM that contains the updated (changed) trust account password with resulting
+breakage of the domain trust.
+</p><p>
+Considering the number of comments and questions raised concerning how to configure a BDC
+lets consider each possible option and look at the pro's and con's for each theoretical solution:
+</p><div class="itemizedlist"><p class="title"><b>Backup Domain Backend Account Distribution Options</b></p><ul type="disc"><li><p>
+ Solution: Passwd Backend is LDAP based, BDCs use a slave LDAP server
+ </p><p>
+ Arguments For: This is a neat and manageable solution. The LDAP based SAM (ldapsam)
+ is constantly kept up to date.
+ </p><p>
+ Arguments Against: Complexity
+ </p></li><li><p>
+ Passdb Backend is tdbsam based, BDCs use cron based &quot;net rcp vampire&quot; to
+ suck down the Accounts database from the PDC
+ </p><p>
+ Arguments For: It would be a nice solution
+ </p><p>
+ Arguments Against: It does not work because Samba-3 does not support the required
+ protocols. This may become a later feature but is not available today.
+ </p></li><li><p>
+ Make use of rsync to replicate (pull down) copies of the essential account files
+ </p><p>
+ Arguments For: It is a simple solution, easy to set up as a scheduled job
+ </p><p>
+ Arguments Against: This will over-write the locally changed machine trust account
+ passwords. This is a broken and flawed solution. Do NOT do this.
+ </p></li><li><p>
+ Operate with an entirely local accounts database (not recommended)
+ </p><p>
+ Arguments For: Simple, easy to maintain
+ </p><p>
+ Arguments Against: All machine trust accounts and user accounts will be locally
+ maintained. Domain users will NOT be able to roam from office to office. This is
+ a broken and flawed solution. Do NOT do this.
+ </p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2896128"></a>Essential Background Information</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+A Domain Controller is a machine that is able to answer logon requests from network
+workstations. Microsoft LanManager and IBM LanServer were two early products that
+provided this capability. The technology has become known as the LanMan Netlogon service.
+</p><p>
+When MS Windows NT3.10 was first released it supported an new style of Domain Control
+and with it a new form of the network logon service that has extended functionality.
+This service became known as the NT NetLogon Service. The nature of this service has
+changed with the evolution of MS Windows NT and today provides a very complex array of
+services that are implemented over a complex spectrum of technologies.
+</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2896156"></a>MS Windows NT4 Style Domain Control</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+Whenever a user logs into a Windows NT4 / 200x / XP Profresional Workstation,
+the workstation connects to a Domain Controller (authentication server) to validate
+the username and password that the user entered are valid. If the information entered
+does not validate against the account information that has been stored in the Domain
+Control database (the SAM, or Security Accounts Manager database) then a set of error
+codes is returned to the workstation that has made the authentication request.
+</p><p>
+When the username / password pair has been validated, the Domain Controller
+(authentication server) will respond with full enumeration of the account information
+that has been stored regarding that user in the User and Machine Accounts database
+for that Domain. This information contains a complete network access profile for
+the user but excludes any information that is particular to the user's desktop profile,
+or for that matter it excludes all desktop profiles for groups that the user may
+belong to. It does include password time limits, password uniqueness controls,
+network access time limits, account validity information, machine names from which the
+user may access the network, and much more. All this information was stored in the SAM
+in all versions of MS Windows NT (3.10, 3.50, 3.51, 4.0).
+</p><p>
+The account information (user and machine) on Domain Controllers is stored in two files,
+one containing the Security information and the other the SAM. These are stored in files
+by the same name in the <tt class="filename">C:\WinNT\System32\config</tt> directory. These
+are the files that are involved in replication of the SAM database where Backup Domain
+Controllers are present on the network.
+</p><p>
+There are two situations in which it is desirable to install Backup Domain Controllers:
+</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>
+ On the local network that the Primary Domain Controller is on if there are many
+ workstations and/or where the PDC is generally very busy. In this case the BDCs
+ will pick up network logon requests and help to add robustness to network services.
+ </p></li><li><p>
+ At each remote site, to reduce wide area network traffic and to add stability to
+ remote network operations. The design of the network, the strategic placement of
+ Backup Domain Controllers, together with an implementation that localises as much
+ of network to client interchange as possible will help to minimise wide area network
+ bandwidth needs (and thus costs).
+ </p></li></ul></div><p>
+The PDC contains the master copy of the SAM. In the event that an administrator makes a
+change to the user account database while physically present on the local network that
+has the PDC, the change will likely be made directly to the PDC instance of the master
+copy of the SAM. In the event that this update may be performed in a branch office the
+change will likely be stored in a delta file on the local BDC. The BDC will then send
+a trigger to the PDC to commence the process of SAM synchronisation. The PDC will then
+request the delta from the BDC and apply it to the master SAM. THe PDC will then contact
+all the BDCs in the Domain and trigger them to obtain the update and then apply that to
+their own copy of the SAM.
+</p><p>
+Thus the BDC is said to hold a <span class="emphasis"><em>read-only</em></span> of the SAM from which
+it is able to process network logon requests and to authenticate users. The BDC can
+continue to provide this service, particularly while, for example, the wide area
+network link to the PDC is down. Thus a BDC plays a very important role in both
+maintenance of Domain security as well as in network integrity.
+</p><p>
+In the event that the PDC should need to be taken out of service, or if it dies, then
+one of the BDCs can be promoted to a PDC. If this happens while the original PDC is on
+line then it is automatically demoted to a BDC. This is an important aspect of Domain
+Controller management. The tool that is used to affect a promotion or a demotion is the
+Server Manager for Domains.
+</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2896305"></a>Example PDC Configuration</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+Since version 2.2 Samba officially supports domain logons for all current Windows Clients,
+including Windows NT4, 2003 and XP Professional. For samba to be enabled as a PDC some
+parameters in the <i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i>-section of the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> have to be set:
+</p><pre class="programlisting">
+ workgroup = SAMBA
+ domain master = yes
+ domain logons = yes
+</pre><p>
+Several other things like a <i class="parameter"><tt>[homes]</tt></i> and a <i class="parameter"><tt>[netlogon]</tt></i> share also need to be set along with
+settings for the profile path, the users home drive, etc.. This will not be covered in this
+chapter, for more information please refer to the chapter on Domain Control.
+</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2896368"></a>Active Directory Domain Control</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+As of the release of MS Windows 2000 and Active Directory, this information is now stored
+in a directory that can be replicated and for which partial or full administrative control
+can be delegated. Samba-3 is NOT able to be a Domain Controller within an Active Directory
+tree, and it can not be an Active Directory server. This means that Samba-3 also can NOT
+act as a Backup Domain Contoller to an Active Directory Domain Controller.
+</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2896390"></a>What qualifies a Domain Controller on the network?</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+Every machine that is a Domain Controller for the domain SAMBA has to register the NetBIOS
+group name SAMBA&lt;#1c&gt; with the WINS server and/or by broadcast on the local network.
+The PDC also registers the unique NetBIOS name SAMBA&lt;#1b&gt; with the WINS server.
+The name type &lt;#1b&gt; name is normally reserved for the Domain Master Browser, a role
+that has nothing to do with anything related to authentication, but the Microsoft Domain
+implementation requires the domain master browser to be on the same machine as the PDC.
+</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2896416"></a>How does a Workstation find its domain controller?</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+An MS Windows NT4 / 200x / XP Professional workstation in the domain SAMBA that wants a
+local user to be authenticated has to find the domain controller for SAMBA. It does this
+by doing a NetBIOS name query for the group name SAMBA&lt;#1c&gt;. It assumes that each
+of the machines it gets back from the queries is a domain controller and can answer logon
+requests. To not open security holes both the workstation and the selected domain controller
+authenticate each other. After that the workstation sends the user's credentials (name and
+password) to the local Domain Controller, for valdation.
+</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2896462"></a>Backup Domain Controller Configuration</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+Several things have to be done:
+</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>
+ The domain SID has to be the same on the PDC and the BDC. This used to
+ be stored in the file private/MACHINE.SID. This file is not created
+ anymore since Samba 2.2.5 or even earlier. Nowadays the domain SID is
+ stored in the file private/secrets.tdb. Simply copying the secrets.tdb
+ from the PDC to the BDC does not work, as the BDC would
+ generate a new SID for itself and override the domain SID with this
+ new BDC SID.</p><p>
+ To retrieve the domain SID from the PDC or an existing BDC and store it in the
+ secrets.tdb, execute 'net rpc getsid' on the BDC.
+ </p></li><li><p>
+ The Unix user database has to be synchronized from the PDC to the
+ BDC. This means that both the /etc/passwd and /etc/group have to be
+ replicated from the PDC to the BDC. This can be done manually
+ whenever changes are made, or the PDC is set up as a NIS master
+ server and the BDC as a NIS slave server. To set up the BDC as a
+ mere NIS client would not be enough, as the BDC would not be able to
+ access its user database in case of a PDC failure.
+ </p></li><li><p>
+ The Samba password database in the file private/smbpasswd has to be
+ replicated from the PDC to the BDC. This is a bit tricky, see the
+ next section.
+ </p></li><li><p>
+ Any netlogon share has to be replicated from the PDC to the
+ BDC. This can be done manually whenever login scripts are changed,
+ or it can be done automatically together with the smbpasswd
+ synchronization.
+ </p></li></ul></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2896532"></a>Example Configuration</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+Finally, the BDC has to be found by the workstations. This can be done by setting:
+</p><pre class="programlisting">
+ workgroup = SAMBA
+ domain master = no
+ domain logons = yes
+</pre><p>
+in the <i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i>-section of the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> of the BDC. This makes the BDC
+only register the name SAMBA&lt;#1c&gt; with the WINS server. This is no
+problem as the name SAMBA&lt;#1c&gt; is a NetBIOS group name that is meant to
be registered by more than one machine. The parameter 'domain master =
-no' forces the BDC not to register SAMBA#1b which as a unique NetBIOS
-name is reserved for the Primary Domain Controller.</P
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><H2
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN1169">7.5.1. How do I replicate the smbpasswd file?</H2
-><P
->Replication of the smbpasswd file is sensitive. It has to be done
-whenever changes to the SAM are made. Every user's password change is
-done in the smbpasswd file and has to be replicated to the BDC. So
-replicating the smbpasswd file very often is necessary.</P
-><P
->As the smbpasswd file contains plain text password equivalents, it
-must not be sent unencrypted over the wire. The best way to set up
-smbpasswd replication from the PDC to the BDC is to use the utility
-rsync. rsync can use ssh as a transport. ssh itself can be set up to
-accept *only* rsync transfer without requiring the user to type a
-password.</P
-></DIV
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="NAVFOOTER"
-><HR
-ALIGN="LEFT"
-WIDTH="100%"><TABLE
-SUMMARY="Footer navigation table"
-WIDTH="100%"
-BORDER="0"
-CELLPADDING="0"
-CELLSPACING="0"
-><TR
-><TD
-WIDTH="33%"
-ALIGN="left"
-VALIGN="top"
-><A
-HREF="samba-pdc.html"
-ACCESSKEY="P"
->Prev</A
-></TD
-><TD
-WIDTH="34%"
-ALIGN="center"
-VALIGN="top"
-><A
-HREF="samba-howto-collection.html"
-ACCESSKEY="H"
->Home</A
-></TD
-><TD
-WIDTH="33%"
-ALIGN="right"
-VALIGN="top"
-><A
-HREF="ads.html"
-ACCESSKEY="N"
->Next</A
-></TD
-></TR
-><TR
-><TD
-WIDTH="33%"
-ALIGN="left"
-VALIGN="top"
->How to Configure Samba as a NT4 Primary Domain Controller</TD
-><TD
-WIDTH="34%"
-ALIGN="center"
-VALIGN="top"
-><A
-HREF="type.html"
-ACCESSKEY="U"
->Up</A
-></TD
-><TD
-WIDTH="33%"
-ALIGN="right"
-VALIGN="top"
->Samba as a ADS domain member</TD
-></TR
-></TABLE
-></DIV
-></BODY
-></HTML
-> \ No newline at end of file
+no' forces the BDC not to register SAMBA&lt;#1b&gt; which as a unique NetBIOS
+name is reserved for the Primary Domain Controller.
+</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2896591"></a>Common Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+As this is a rather new area for Samba there are not many examples that we may refer to. Keep
+watching for updates to this section.
+</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2896605"></a>Machine Accounts keep expiring, what can I do?</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+This problem will occur when occur when the passdb (SAM) files are copied from a central
+server but the local Backup Domain Controllers. Local machine trust account password updates
+are not copied back to the central server. The newer machine account password is then over
+written when the SAM is copied from the PDC. The result is that the Domain member machine
+on start up will find that it's passwords does not match the one now in the database and
+since the startup security check will now fail, this machine will not allow logon attempts
+to procede and the account expiry error will be reported.
+</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2896630"></a>Can Samba be a Backup Domain Controller to an NT4 PDC?</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+With version 2.2, no. The native NT4 SAM replication protocols have not yet been fully
+implemented. The Samba Team is working on understanding and implementing the protocols,
+but this work has not been finished for version 2.2.
+</p><p>
+With version 3.0, the work on both the replication protocols and a suitable storage
+mechanism has progressed, and some form of NT4 BDC support is expected soon.
+</p><p>
+Can I get the benefits of a BDC with Samba? Yes. The main reason for implementing a
+BDC is availability. If the PDC is a Samba machine, a second Samba machine can be set up to
+service logon requests whenever the PDC is down.
+</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2896663"></a>How do I replicate the smbpasswd file?</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+Replication of the smbpasswd file is sensitive. It has to be done whenever changes
+to the SAM are made. Every user's password change is done in the smbpasswd file and
+has to be replicated to the BDC. So replicating the smbpasswd file very often is necessary.
+</p><p>
+As the smbpasswd file contains plain text password equivalents, it must not be
+sent unencrypted over the wire. The best way to set up smbpasswd replication from
+the PDC to the BDC is to use the utility rsync. rsync can use ssh as a transport.
+Ssh itself can be set up to accept *only* rsync transfer without requiring the user
+to type a password.
+</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2896692"></a>Can I do this all with LDAP?</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+The simple answer is YES. Samba's pdb_ldap code supports binding to a replica
+LDAP server, and will also follow referrals and rebind to the master if it ever
+needs to make a modification to the database. (Normally BDCs are read only, so
+this will not occur often).
+</p></div></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="samba-pdc.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="type.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="domain-member.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 5. Domain Control </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="index.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 7. Domain Membership</td></tr></table></div></body></html>
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/samba-pdc.html b/docs/htmldocs/samba-pdc.html
index 93bbc727d4..65c39d9399 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/samba-pdc.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/samba-pdc.html
@@ -1,2606 +1,550 @@
-<!DOCTYPE HTML PUBLIC "-//W3C//DTD HTML 4.01 Transitional//EN">
-<HTML
-><HEAD
-><TITLE
->How to Configure Samba as a NT4 Primary Domain Controller</TITLE
-><META
-NAME="GENERATOR"
-CONTENT="Modular DocBook HTML Stylesheet Version 1.76b+
-"><LINK
-REL="HOME"
-TITLE="SAMBA Project Documentation"
-HREF="samba-howto-collection.html"><LINK
-REL="UP"
-TITLE="Type of installation"
-HREF="type.html"><LINK
-REL="PREVIOUS"
-TITLE="User and Share security level (for servers not in a domain)"
-HREF="securitylevels.html"><LINK
-REL="NEXT"
-TITLE="How to Act as a Backup Domain Controller in a Purely Samba Controlled Domain"
-HREF="samba-bdc.html"></HEAD
-><BODY
-CLASS="CHAPTER"
-BGCOLOR="#FFFFFF"
-TEXT="#000000"
-LINK="#0000FF"
-VLINK="#840084"
-ALINK="#0000FF"
-><DIV
-CLASS="NAVHEADER"
-><TABLE
-SUMMARY="Header navigation table"
-WIDTH="100%"
-BORDER="0"
-CELLPADDING="0"
-CELLSPACING="0"
-><TR
-><TH
-COLSPAN="3"
-ALIGN="center"
->SAMBA Project Documentation</TH
-></TR
-><TR
-><TD
-WIDTH="10%"
-ALIGN="left"
-VALIGN="bottom"
-><A
-HREF="securitylevels.html"
-ACCESSKEY="P"
->Prev</A
-></TD
-><TD
-WIDTH="80%"
-ALIGN="center"
-VALIGN="bottom"
-></TD
-><TD
-WIDTH="10%"
-ALIGN="right"
-VALIGN="bottom"
-><A
-HREF="samba-bdc.html"
-ACCESSKEY="N"
->Next</A
-></TD
-></TR
-></TABLE
-><HR
-ALIGN="LEFT"
-WIDTH="100%"></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="CHAPTER"
-><H1
-><A
-NAME="SAMBA-PDC">Chapter 6. How to Configure Samba as a NT4 Primary Domain Controller</H1
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><H1
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN575">6.1. Prerequisite Reading</H1
-><P
->Before you continue reading in this chapter, please make sure
-that you are comfortable with configuring basic files services
-in smb.conf and how to enable and administer password
-encryption in Samba. Theses two topics are covered in the
-<A
-HREF="smb.conf.5.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-><TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->smb.conf(5)</TT
-></A
->
-manpage and the <A
-HREF="ENCRYPTION.html"
-TARGET="_top"
->Encryption chapter</A
->
-of this HOWTO Collection.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><H1
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN581">6.2. Background</H1
-><DIV
-CLASS="NOTE"
-><P
-></P
-><TABLE
-CLASS="NOTE"
-WIDTH="100%"
-BORDER="0"
-><TR
-><TD
-WIDTH="25"
-ALIGN="CENTER"
-VALIGN="TOP"
-><IMG
-SRC="../images/note.gif"
-HSPACE="5"
-ALT="Note"></TD
-><TD
-ALIGN="LEFT"
-VALIGN="TOP"
-><P
-><SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->Author's Note:</I
-></SPAN
-> This document is a combination
-of David Bannon's "Samba 2.2 PDC HOWTO" and "Samba NT Domain FAQ".
-Both documents are superseded by this one.</P
-></TD
-></TR
-></TABLE
-></DIV
-><P
->Versions of Samba prior to release 2.2 had marginal capabilities to act
-as a Windows NT 4.0 Primary Domain Controller
-
-(PDC). With Samba 2.2.0, we are proud to announce official support for
-Windows NT 4.0-style domain logons from Windows NT 4.0 and Windows
-2000 clients. This article outlines the steps
-necessary for configuring Samba as a PDC. It is necessary to have a
-working Samba server prior to implementing the PDC functionality. If
-you have not followed the steps outlined in <A
-HREF="UNIX_INSTALL.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-> UNIX_INSTALL.html</A
->, please make sure
-that your server is configured correctly before proceeding. Another
-good resource in the <A
-HREF="smb.conf.5.html"
-TARGET="_top"
->smb.conf(5) man
-page</A
->. The following functionality should work in 2.2:</P
-><P
-></P
-><UL
-><LI
-><P
-> domain logons for Windows NT 4.0/2000 clients.
- </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-> placing a Windows 9x client in user level security
- </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-> retrieving a list of users and groups from a Samba PDC to
- Windows 9x/NT/2000 clients
- </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-> roving (roaming) user profiles
- </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-> Windows NT 4.0-style system policies
- </P
-></LI
-></UL
-><P
->The following pieces of functionality are not included in the 2.2 release:</P
-><P
-></P
-><UL
-><LI
-><P
-> Windows NT 4 domain trusts
- </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-> SAM replication with Windows NT 4.0 Domain Controllers
+<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 5. Domain Control</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="type.html" title="Part II. Server Configuration Basics"><link rel="previous" href="ServerType.html" title="Chapter 4. Server Types and Security Modes"><link rel="next" href="samba-bdc.html" title="Chapter 6. Backup Domain Control"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 5. Domain Control</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="ServerType.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part II. Server Configuration Basics</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="samba-bdc.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="samba-pdc"></a>Chapter 5. Domain Control</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email">&lt;<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>&gt;</tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Gerald</span> <span class="othername">(Jerry)</span> <span class="surname">Carter</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email">&lt;<a href="mailto:jerry@samba.org">jerry@samba.org</a>&gt;</tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">David</span> <span class="surname">Bannon</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email">&lt;<a href="mailto:dbannon@samba.org">dbannon@samba.org</a>&gt;</tt></p></div></div></div></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2891927">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2892230">Basics of Domain Control</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2892246">Domain Controller Types</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2892458">Preparing for Domain Control</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2892778">Domain Control - Example Configuration</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2893076">Samba ADS Domain Control</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2893098">Domain and Network Logon Configuration</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2893113">Domain Network Logon Service</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2893441">Security Mode and Master Browsers</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2893548">Common Problems and Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2893555">I cannot include a '$' in a machine name</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2893594">I get told &quot;You already have a connection to the Domain....&quot;
+or &quot;Cannot join domain, the credentials supplied conflict with an
+existing set..&quot; when creating a machine trust account.</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2893643">The system can not log you on (C000019B)....</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2893714">The machine trust account for this computer either does not
+exist or is not accessible.</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2893771">When I attempt to login to a Samba Domain from a NT4/W2K workstation,
+I get a message about my account being disabled.</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2893798">Until a few minutes after Samba has started, clients get the error &quot;Domain Controller Unavailable&quot;</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><p><b><span class="emphasis"><em>The Essence of Learning:</em></span> </b>
+There are many who approach MS Windows networking with incredible misconceptions.
+That's OK, because it gives the rest of us plenty of opportunity to be of assistance.
+Those who really want help would be well advised to become familiar with information
+that is already available.
+</p><p>
+The reader is advised NOT to tackle this section without having first understood
+and mastered some basics. MS Windows networking is not particularly forgiving of
+misconfiguration. Users of MS Windows networking are likely to complain bitterly
+of persistent niggles that may be caused by broken network or system configuration.
+To a great many people however, MS Windows networking starts with a domain controller
+that in some magical way is expected to solve all ills.
+</p><p>
+From the Samba mailing list one can readilly identify many common networking issues.
+If you are not clear on the following subjects, then it will do much good to read the
+sections of this HOWTO that deal with it. These are the most common causes of MS Windows
+networking problems:
+</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td>Basic TCP/IP configuration</td></tr><tr><td>NetBIOS name resolution</td></tr><tr><td>Authentication configuration</td></tr><tr><td>User and Group configuration</td></tr><tr><td>Basic File and Directory Permission Control in Unix/Linux</td></tr><tr><td>Understanding of how MS Windows clients interoperate in a network
+ environment</td></tr></table><p>
+Do not be put off; on the surface of it MS Windows networking seems so simple that any fool
+can do it. In fact, it is not a good idea to set up an MS Windows network with
+inadequate training and preparation. But let's get our first indelible principle out of the
+way: <span class="emphasis"><em>It is perfectly OK to make mistakes!</em></span> In the right place and at
+the right time, mistakes are the essence of learning. It is <span class="emphasis"><em>very much</em></span>
+not ok to make mistakes that cause loss of productivity and impose an avoidable financial
+burden on an organisation.
+</p><p>
+Where is the right place to make mistakes? Only out of harm's way! If you are going to
+make mistakes, then please do this on a test network, away from users and in such a way as
+to not inflict pain on others. Do your learning on a test network.
+</p><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2891927"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+<span class="emphasis"><em>What is the key benefit of Microsoft Domain security?</em></span>
+</p><p>
+In a word, <span class="emphasis"><em>Single Sign On</em></span>, or SSO for short. To many, this is the holy
+grail of MS Windows NT and beyond networking. SSO allows users in a well designed network
+to log onto any workstation that is a member of the domain that their user account is in
+(or in a domain that has an appropriate trust relationship with the domain they are visiting)
+and they will be able to log onto the network and access resources (shares, files, and printers)
+as if they are sitting at their home (personal) workstation. This is a feature of the Domain
+security protocols.
+</p><p>
+The benefits of Domain security are fully available to those sites that deploy a Samba PDC.
+</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p>
+Network clients of an MS Windows Domain security environment must be Domain members to be
+able to gain access to the advanced features provided. Domain membership involves more than just
+setting the workgroup name to the Domain name. It requires the creation of a Domain trust account
+for the workstation (called a machine account). Please refer to the chapter on
+<a href="domain-member.html" title="Chapter 7. Domain Membership">Domain Membership</a> for more information.
+</p></div><p>
+The following functionalities are new to the Samba-3 release:
+</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>
+ Windows NT4 domain trusts
+ </p></li><li><p>
+ Adding users via the User Manager for Domains. This can be done on any MS Windows
+ client using the Nexus toolkit that is available from Microsoft's web site.
+ At some later date Samba-3 may get support for the use of the Microsoft Management
+ Console for user management.
+ </p></li><li><p>
+ Introduces replaceable and multiple user account (authentication)
+ back ends. In the case where the back end is placed in an LDAP database,
+ Samba-3 confers the benefits of a back end that can be distributed, replicated,
+ and is highly scalable.
+ </p></li><li><p>
+ Implements full Unicode support. This simplifies cross locale internationalisation
+ support. It also opens up the use of protocols that Samba-2.2.x had but could not use due
+ to the need to fully support Unicode.
+ </p></li></ul></div><p>
+The following functionalities are NOT provided by Samba-3:
+</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>
+ SAM replication with Windows NT4 Domain Controllers
(i.e. a Samba PDC and a Windows NT BDC or vice versa)
- </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-> Adding users via the User Manager for Domains
- </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-> Acting as a Windows 2000 Domain Controller (i.e. Kerberos and
- Active Directory)
- </P
-></LI
-></UL
-><P
->Please note that Windows 9x clients are not true members of a domain
-for reasons outlined in this article. Therefore the protocol for
-support Windows 9x-style domain logons is completely different
-from NT4 domain logons and has been officially supported for some
-time.</P
-><P
->Implementing a Samba PDC can basically be divided into 2 broad
-steps.</P
-><P
-></P
-><OL
-TYPE="1"
-><LI
-><P
-> Configuring the Samba PDC
- </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-> Creating machine trust accounts and joining clients
- to the domain
- </P
-></LI
-></OL
-><P
->There are other minor details such as user profiles, system
-policies, etc... However, these are not necessarily specific
-to a Samba PDC as much as they are related to Windows NT networking
-concepts. They will be mentioned only briefly here.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><H1
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN620">6.3. Configuring the Samba Domain Controller</H1
-><P
->The first step in creating a working Samba PDC is to
-understand the parameters necessary in smb.conf. I will not
-attempt to re-explain the parameters here as they are more that
-adequately covered in <A
-HREF="smb.conf.5.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-> the smb.conf
-man page</A
->. For convenience, the parameters have been
-linked with the actual smb.conf description.</P
-><P
->Here is an example <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->smb.conf</TT
-> for acting as a PDC:</P
-><P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
->[global]
- ; Basic server settings
- <A
-HREF="smb.conf.5.html#NETBIOSNAME"
-TARGET="_top"
->netbios name</A
-> = <TT
-CLASS="REPLACEABLE"
-><I
->POGO</I
-></TT
->
- <A
-HREF="smb.conf.5.html#WORKGROUP"
-TARGET="_top"
->workgroup</A
-> = <TT
-CLASS="REPLACEABLE"
-><I
->NARNIA</I
-></TT
->
+ </p></li><li><p>
+ Acting as a Windows 2000 Domain Controller (i.e. Kerberos and
+ Active Directory) - In point of fact, Samba-3 DOES have some
+ Active Directory Domain Control ability that is at this time
+ purely experimental <span class="emphasis"><em>AND</em></span> that is certain
+ to change as it becomes a fully supported feature some time
+ during the Samba-3 (or later) life cycle.
+ </p></li></ul></div><p>
+Windows 9x / Me / XP Home clients are not true members of a domain for reasons outlined
+in this chapter. The protocol for support of Windows 9x / Me style network (domain) logons
+is completely different from NT4 / Win2k type domain logons and has been officially supported
+for some time. These clients use the old LanMan Network Logon facilities that are supported
+in Samba since approximately the Samba-1.9.15 series.
+</p><p>
+Samba-3 has an implementation of group mapping between Windows NT groups
+and Unix groups (this is really quite complicated to explain in a short space). This is
+discussed more fully in the <a href="groupmapping.html" title="Chapter 12. Mapping MS Windows and Unix Groups">Group Mapping</a> chapter.
+</p><p>
+Samba-3, like an MS Windows NT4 PDC or a Windows 200x Active Directory, needs to store
+user and machine trust account information in a suitable backend data store. With Samba-3
+there can be multiple back-ends for this including:
+</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>
+ <span class="emphasis"><em>smbpasswd</em></span> - the plain ascii file stored used by
+ earlier versions of Samba. This file configuration option requires
+ a Unix/Linux system account for EVERY entry (ie: both for user and for
+ machine accounts). This file will be located in the <span class="emphasis"><em>private</em></span>
+ directory (default is /usr/local/samba/lib/private or on linux /etc/samba).
+ </p></li><li><p>
+ <span class="emphasis"><em>tdbsam</em></span> - a binary database backend that will be
+ stored in the <span class="emphasis"><em>private</em></span> directory in a file called
+ <span class="emphasis"><em>passdb.tdb</em></span>. The key benefit of this binary format
+ file is that it can store binary objects that can not be accomodated
+ in the traditional plain text smbpasswd file. These permit the extended
+ account controls that MS Windows NT4 and later also have.
+ </p></li><li><p>
+ <span class="emphasis"><em>ldapsam</em></span> - An LDAP based back-end. Permits the
+ LDAP server to be specified. eg: ldap://localhost or ldap://frodo.murphy.com.
+ Like the tdbsam, ldapsam permits the storing of extended account attributes
+ for control of things like: Permitted access times, password activation and
+ expiry, permitted points of access (workstation names), per user profile
+ location, and much more.
+ </p></li><li><p>
+ <span class="emphasis"><em>ldapsam_compat</em></span> - An LDAP back-end that maintains backwards
+ compatibility with the behaviour of samba-2.2.x. You should use this in the process
+ of migrating from samba-2.2.x to samba-3 if you do not want to rebuild your LDAP
+ database.
+ </p></li></ul></div><p>
+Read the chapter about <a href="passdb.html" title="Chapter 11. Account Information Databases">Account Information Database</a> for details
+regarding the choices available and how to configure them.
+</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p>
+The new tdbsam and ldapsam account backends store substantially more information than
+smbpasswd is capable of. The new backend database includes capacity to specify
+per user settings for many parameters, over-riding global settings given in the
+<tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file. eg: logon drive, logon home, logon path, etc.
+Thus, with samba-3 it is possible to have a default system configuration for profiles,
+and on a per user basis to over-ride this for those users who should not be subject
+to the default configuration.
+</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2892230"></a>Basics of Domain Control</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+Over the years, public perceptions of what Domain Control really is has taken on an
+almost mystical nature. Before we branch into a brief overview of Domain Control,
+there are three basic types of domain controllers:
+</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2892246"></a>Domain Controller Types</h3></div></div><div></div></div><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Primary Domain Controller</p></li><li><p>Backup Domain Controller</p></li><li><p>ADS Domain Controller</p></li></ul></div><p>
+The <span class="emphasis"><em>Primary Domain Controller</em></span> or PDC plays an important role in the MS
+Windows NT4 and Windows 200x Domain Control architecture, but not in the manner that so many
+expect. There is folk lore that dictates that because of it's role in the MS Windows
+network, the PDC should be the most powerful and most capable machine in the network.
+As strange as it may seem to say this here, good over all network performance dictates that
+the entire infrastructure needs to be balanced. It is advisable to invest more in the Backup
+Domain Controllers and Stand-Alone (or Domain Member) servers than in the PDC.
+</p><p>
+In the case of MS Windows NT4 style domains, it is the PDC seeds the Domain Control database,
+a part of the Windows registry called the SAM (Security Account Manager). It plays a key
+part in NT4 type domain user authentication and in synchronisation of the domain authentication
+database with Backup Domain Controllers.
+</p><p>
+With MS Windows 200x Server based Active Directory domains, one domain controller seeds a potential
+hierachy of domain controllers, each with their own area of delegated control. The master domain
+controller has the ability to override any down-stream controller, but a down-line controller has
+control only over it's down-line. With Samba-3 this functionality can be implemented using an
+LDAP based user and machine account back end.
+</p><p>
+New to Samba-3 is the ability to use a back-end database that holds the same type of data as
+the NT4 style SAM (Security Account Manager) database (one of the registry files).
+The Samba-3 SAM can be specified via the smb.conf file parameter
+<i class="parameter"><tt>passwd backend</tt></i> and valid options include
+<span class="emphasis"><em>smbpasswd, tdbsam, ldapsam, nisplussam, xmlsam, mysqlsam, guest</em></span>.
+</p><p>
+The <span class="emphasis"><em>Backup Domain Controller</em></span> or BDC plays a key role in servicing network
+authentication requests. The BDC is biased to answer logon requests in preference to the PDC.
+On a network segment that has a BDC and a PDC the BDC will be most likely to service network
+logon requests. The PDC will answer network logon requests when the BDC is too busy (high load).
+A BDC can be promoted to a PDC. If the PDC is on line at the time that a BDC is promoted to
+PDC, the previous PDC is automatically demoted to a BDC. With Samba-3 this is NOT an automatic
+operation; the PDB and BDC must be manually configured and changes need to be made likewise.
+</p><p>
+With MS Windows NT4, it is an install time decision what type of machine the server will be.
+It is possible to change the promote a BDC to a PDC and vica versa only, but the only way
+to convert a domain controller to a domain member server or a stand-alone server is to
+reinstall it. The install time choices offered are:
+</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Primary Domain Controller</em></span> - The one that seeds the domain SAM</p></li><li><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Backup Domain Controller</em></span> - One that obtains a copy of the domain SAM</p></li><li><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Domain Member Server</em></span> - One that has NO copy of the domain SAM, rather it obtains authentication from a Domain Controller for all access controls.</p></li><li><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Stand-Alone Server</em></span> - One that plays NO part is SAM synchronisation, has it's own authentication database and plays no role in Domain security.</p></li></ul></div><p>
+With MS Windows 2000 the configuration of domain control is done after the server has been
+installed. Samba-3 is capable of acting fully as a native member of a Windows 200x server
+Active Directory domain.
+</p><p>
+New to Samba-3 is the ability to function fully as an MS Windows NT4 style Domain Controller,
+excluding the SAM replication components. However, please be aware that Samba-3 support the
+MS Windows 200x domain control protocols also.
+</p><p>
+At this time any appearance that Samba-3 is capable of acting as an
+<span class="emphasis"><em>ADS Domain Controller</em></span> is limited and experimental in nature.
+This functionality should not be used until the Samba-Team offers formal support for it.
+At such a time, the documentation will be revised to duly reflect all configuration and
+management requirements.
+</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2892458"></a>Preparing for Domain Control</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+There are two ways that MS Windows machines may interact with each other, with other servers,
+and with Domain Controllers: Either as <span class="emphasis"><em>Stand-Alone</em></span> systems, more commonly
+called <span class="emphasis"><em>Workgroup</em></span> members, or as full participants in a security system,
+more commonly called <span class="emphasis"><em>Domain</em></span> members.
+</p><p>
+It should be noted that <span class="emphasis"><em>Workgroup</em></span> membership involve no special configuration
+other than the machine being configured so that the network configuration has a commonly used name
+for it's workgroup entry. It is not uncommon for the name WORKGROUP to be used for this. With this
+mode of configuration there are NO machine trust accounts and any concept of membership as such
+is limited to the fact that all machines appear in the network neighbourhood to be logically
+grouped together. Again, just to be clear: <span class="emphasis"><em>workgroup mode does not involve any security machine
+accounts</em></span>.
+</p><p>
+Domain member machines have a machine account in the Domain accounts database. A special procedure
+must be followed on each machine to affect Domain membership. This procedure, which can be done
+only by the local machine Administrator account, will create the Domain machine account (if
+if does not exist), and then initializes that account. When the client first logs onto the
+Domain it triggers a machine password change.
+</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p>
+When running a Domain all MS Windows NT / 200x / XP Professional clients should be configured
+as full Domain Members - IF A SECURE NETWORK IS WANTED. If the machine is NOT made a member of the
+Domain, then it will operate like a workgroup (stand-alone) machine. Please refer the
+<a href="domain-member.html" title="Chapter 7. Domain Membership">Domain Membership</a> chapter for information regarding
+ HOW to make your MS Windows clients Domain members.
+</p></div><p>
+The following are necessary for configuring Samba-3 as an MS Windows NT4 style PDC for MS Windows
+NT4 / 200x / XP clients.
+</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td>Configuration of basic TCP/IP and MS Windows Networking</td></tr><tr><td>Correct designation of the Server Role (<i class="parameter"><tt>security = user</tt></i>)</td></tr><tr><td>Consistent configuration of Name Resolution (See chapter on <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html" title="Chapter 10. Samba / MS Windows Network Browsing Guide">Browsing</a> and on
+ <a href="integrate-ms-networks.html" title="Chapter 26. Integrating MS Windows networks with Samba">MS Windows network Integration</a>)</td></tr><tr><td>Domain logons for Windows NT4 / 200x / XP Professional clients</td></tr><tr><td>Configuration of Roaming Profiles or explicit configuration to force local profile usage</td></tr><tr><td>Configuration of Network/System Policies</td></tr><tr><td>Adding and managing domain user accounts</td></tr><tr><td>Configuring MS Windows client machines to become domain members</td></tr></table><p>
+The following provisions are required to serve MS Windows 9x / Me Clients:
+</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td>Configuration of basic TCP/IP and MS Windows Networking</td></tr><tr><td>Correct designation of the Server Role (<i class="parameter"><tt>security = user</tt></i>)</td></tr><tr><td>Network Logon Configuration (Since Windows 9x / XP Home are not technically domain
+ members, they do not really particpate in the security aspects of Domain logons as such)</td></tr><tr><td>Roaming Profile Configuration</td></tr><tr><td>Configuration of System Policy handling</td></tr><tr><td>Installation of the Network driver &quot;Client for MS Windows Networks&quot; and configuration
+ to log onto the domain</td></tr><tr><td>Placing Windows 9x / Me clients in user level security - if it is desired to allow
+ all client share access to be controlled according to domain user / group identities.</td></tr><tr><td>Adding and managing domain user accounts</td></tr></table><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p>
+Roaming Profiles and System/Network policies are advanced network administration topics
+that are covered in the <a href="ProfileMgmt.html" title="Chapter 24. Desktop Profile Management">Profile Management</a> and
+<a href="PolicyMgmt.html" title="Chapter 23. System and Account Policies">Policy Management</a> chapters of this document. However, these are not necessarily specific
+to a Samba PDC as much as they are related to Windows NT networking concepts.
+</p></div><p>
+A Domain Controller is an SMB/CIFS server that:
+</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>
+ Registers and advertises itself as a Domain Controller (through NetBIOS broadcasts
+ as well as by way of name registrations either by Mailslot Broadcasts over UDP broadcast,
+ to a WINS server over UDP unicast, or via DNS and Active Directory)
+ </p></li><li><p>
+ Provides the NETLOGON service (actually a collection of services that runs over
+ a number of protocols. These include the LanMan Logon service, the Netlogon service,
+ the Local Security Account service, and variations of them)
+ </p></li><li><p>
+ Provides a share called NETLOGON
+ </p></li></ul></div><p>
+For Samba to provide these is rather easy to configure. Each Samba Domain Controller must provide
+the NETLOGON service which Samba calls the <span class="emphasis"><em>domain logons</em></span> functionality
+(after the name of the parameter in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file). Additionally, one (1) server in a Samba-3
+Domain must advertise itself as the domain master browser. This causes the Primary Domain Controller
+to claim domain specific NetBIOS name that identifies it as a domain master browser for its given
+domain/workgroup. Local master browsers in the same domain/workgroup on broadcast-isolated subnets
+then ask for a complete copy of the browse list for the whole wide area network. Browser clients
+will then contact their local master browser, and will receive the domain-wide browse list,
+instead of just the list for their broadcast-isolated subnet.
+</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2892778"></a>Domain Control - Example Configuration</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+The first step in creating a working Samba PDC is to understand the parameters necessary
+in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>. Here we attempt to explain the parameters that are covered in
+the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> man page.
+</p><p>
+Here is an example <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> for acting as a PDC:
+</p><pre class="programlisting">
+ [global]
+ ; Basic server settings
+ <a href="smb.conf.5.html#NETBIOSNAME" target="_top">netbios name</a> = <i class="replaceable"><tt>POGO</tt></i>
+ <a href="smb.conf.5.html#WORKGROUP" target="_top">workgroup</a> = <i class="replaceable"><tt>NARNIA</tt></i>
+
+ ; User and Machine Account Backends
+ ; Choices are: tdbsam, smbpasswd, ldapsam, mysqlsam, xmlsam, guest
+ <a href="smb.conf.5.html#PASSDBBACKEND" target="_top">passdb backend</a> = ldapsam, guest
+
+ ; we should act as the domain and local master browser
+ <a href="smb.conf.5.html#OSLEVEL" target="_top">os level</a> = 64
+ <a href="smb.conf.5.html#PERFERREDMASTER" target="_top">preferred master</a> = yes
+ <a href="smb.conf.5.html#DOMAINMASTER" target="_top">domain master</a> = yes
+ <a href="smb.conf.5.html#LOCALMASTER" target="_top">local master</a> = yes
+
+ ; security settings (must user security = user)
+ <a href="smb.conf.5.html#SECURITYEQUALSUSER" target="_top">security</a> = user
+
+ ; encrypted passwords are a requirement for a PDC (default = Yes)
+ <a href="smb.conf.5.html#ENCRYPTPASSWORDS" target="_top">encrypt passwords</a> = yes
+
+ ; support domain logons
+ <a href="smb.conf.5.html#DOMAINLOGONS" target="_top">domain logons</a> = yes
+
+ ; where to store user profiles?
+ <a href="smb.conf.5.html#LOGONPATH" target="_top">logon path</a> = \\%N\profiles\%u
+
+ ; where is a user's home directory and where should it be mounted at?
+ <a href="smb.conf.5.html#LOGONDRIVE" target="_top">logon drive</a> = H:
+ <a href="smb.conf.5.html#LOGONHOME" target="_top">logon home</a> = \\homeserver\%u\winprofile
+
+ ; specify a generic logon script for all users
+ ; this is a relative **DOS** path to the [netlogon] share
+ <a href="smb.conf.5.html#LOGONSCRIPT" target="_top">logon script</a> = logon.cmd
- ; we should act as the domain and local master browser
- <A
-HREF="smb.conf.5.html#OSLEVEL"
-TARGET="_top"
->os level</A
-> = 64
- <A
-HREF="smb.conf.5.html#PERFERREDMASTER"
-TARGET="_top"
->preferred master</A
-> = yes
- <A
-HREF="smb.conf.5.html#DOMAINMASTER"
-TARGET="_top"
->domain master</A
-> = yes
- <A
-HREF="smb.conf.5.html#LOCALMASTER"
-TARGET="_top"
->local master</A
-> = yes
-
- ; security settings (must user security = user)
- <A
-HREF="smb.conf.5.html#SECURITYEQUALSUSER"
-TARGET="_top"
->security</A
-> = user
-
- ; encrypted passwords are a requirement for a PDC
- <A
-HREF="smb.conf.5.html#ENCRYPTPASSWORDS"
-TARGET="_top"
->encrypt passwords</A
-> = yes
-
- ; support domain logons
- <A
-HREF="smb.conf.5.html#DOMAINLOGONS"
-TARGET="_top"
->domain logons</A
-> = yes
-
- ; where to store user profiles?
- <A
-HREF="smb.conf.5.html#LOGONPATH"
-TARGET="_top"
->logon path</A
-> = \\%N\profiles\%u
-
- ; where is a user's home directory and where should it
- ; be mounted at?
- <A
-HREF="smb.conf.5.html#LOGONDRIVE"
-TARGET="_top"
->logon drive</A
-> = H:
- <A
-HREF="smb.conf.5.html#LOGONHOME"
-TARGET="_top"
->logon home</A
-> = \\homeserver\%u
-
- ; specify a generic logon script for all users
- ; this is a relative **DOS** path to the [netlogon] share
- <A
-HREF="smb.conf.5.html#LOGONSCRIPT"
-TARGET="_top"
->logon script</A
-> = logon.cmd
+ ; necessary share for domain controller
+ [netlogon]
+ <a href="smb.conf.5.html#PATH" target="_top">path</a> = /usr/local/samba/lib/netlogon
+ <a href="smb.conf.5.html#READONLY" target="_top">read only</a> = yes
+ <a href="smb.conf.5.html#WRITELIST" target="_top">write list</a> = <i class="replaceable"><tt>ntadmin</tt></i>
+
+ ; share for storing user profiles
+ [profiles]
+ <a href="smb.conf.5.html#PATH" target="_top">path</a> = /export/smb/ntprofile
+ <a href="smb.conf.5.html#READONLY" target="_top">read only</a> = no
+ <a href="smb.conf.5.html#CREATEMASK" target="_top">create mask</a> = 0600
+ <a href="smb.conf.5.html#DIRECTORYMASK" target="_top">directory mask</a> = 0700
+</pre><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p>
+The above parameters make for a full set of parameters that may define the server's mode
+of operation. The following parameters are the essentials alone:
-; necessary share for domain controller
-[netlogon]
- <A
-HREF="smb.conf.5.html#PATH"
-TARGET="_top"
->path</A
-> = /usr/local/samba/lib/netlogon
- <A
-HREF="smb.conf.5.html#READONLY"
-TARGET="_top"
->read only</A
-> = yes
- <A
-HREF="smb.conf.5.html#WRITELIST"
-TARGET="_top"
->write list</A
-> = <TT
-CLASS="REPLACEABLE"
-><I
->ntadmin</I
-></TT
->
-
-; share for storing user profiles
-[profiles]
- <A
-HREF="smb.conf.5.html#PATH"
-TARGET="_top"
->path</A
-> = /export/smb/ntprofile
- <A
-HREF="smb.conf.5.html#READONLY"
-TARGET="_top"
->read only</A
-> = no
- <A
-HREF="smb.conf.5.html#CREATEMASK"
-TARGET="_top"
->create mask</A
-> = 0600
- <A
-HREF="smb.conf.5.html#DIRECTORYMASK"
-TARGET="_top"
->directory mask</A
-> = 0700</PRE
-></P
-><P
->There are a couple of points to emphasize in the above configuration.</P
-><P
-></P
-><UL
-><LI
-><P
-> Encrypted passwords must be enabled. For more details on how
- to do this, refer to <A
-HREF="ENCRYPTION.html"
-TARGET="_top"
->ENCRYPTION.html</A
->.
- </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-> The server must support domain logons and a
- <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->[netlogon]</TT
-> share
- </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-> The server must be the domain master browser in order for Windows
+</p><pre class="programlisting">
+ workgroup = NARNIA
+ domain logons = Yes
+ domain master = Yes
+ security = User
+</pre><p>
+
+The additional parameters shown in the longer listing above just makes for a
+more complete environment.
+</p></div><p>
+There are a couple of points to emphasize in the above configuration.
+</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>
+ Encrypted passwords must be enabled. For more details on how
+ to do this, refer to <a href="passdb.html" title="Chapter 11. Account Information Databases">Account Information Database chapter</a>.
+ </p></li><li><p>
+ The server must support domain logons and have a
+ <i class="parameter"><tt>[netlogon]</tt></i> share
+ </p></li><li><p>
+ The server must be the domain master browser in order for Windows
client to locate the server as a DC. Please refer to the various
Network Browsing documentation included with this distribution for
details.
- </P
-></LI
-></UL
-><P
->As Samba 2.2 does not offer a complete implementation of group mapping
-between Windows NT groups and Unix groups (this is really quite
-complicated to explain in a short space), you should refer to the
-<A
-HREF="smb.conf.5.html#DOMAINADMINGROUP"
-TARGET="_top"
->domain admin
-group</A
-> smb.conf parameter for information of creating "Domain
-Admins" style accounts.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><H1
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN663">6.4. Creating Machine Trust Accounts and Joining Clients to the
-Domain</H1
-><P
->A machine trust account is a Samba account that is used to
-authenticate a client machine (rather than a user) to the Samba
-server. In Windows terminology, this is known as a "Computer
-Account."</P
-><P
->The password of a machine trust account acts as the shared secret for
-secure communication with the Domain Controller. This is a security
-feature to prevent an unauthorized machine with the same NetBIOS name
-from joining the domain and gaining access to domain user/group
-accounts. Windows NT and 2000 clients use machine trust accounts, but
-Windows 9x clients do not. Hence, a Windows 9x client is never a true
-member of a domain because it does not possess a machine trust
-account, and thus has no shared secret with the domain controller.</P
-><P
->A Windows PDC stores each machine trust account in the Windows
-Registry. A Samba PDC, however, stores each machine trust account
-in two parts, as follows:
+ </p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2893076"></a>Samba ADS Domain Control</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+Samba-3 is not and can not act as an Active Directory Server. It can not truly function as
+an Active Directory Primary Domain Controller. The protocols for some of the functionality
+the Active Directory Domain Controllers is have been partially implemented on an experimental
+only basis. Please do NOT expect Samba-3 to support these protocols - nor should you depend
+on any such functionality either now or in the future. The Samba-Team may well remove such
+experiemental features or may change their behaviour.
+</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2893098"></a>Domain and Network Logon Configuration</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+The subject of Network or Domain Logons is discussed here because it rightly forms
+an integral part of the essential functionality that is provided by a Domain Controller.
+</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2893113"></a>Domain Network Logon Service</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+All Domain Controllers must run the netlogon service (<span class="emphasis"><em>domain logons</em></span>
+in Samba). One Domain Controller must be configured with <i class="parameter"><tt>domain master = Yes</tt></i>
+(the Primary Domain Controller); on ALL Backup Domain Controllers <i class="parameter"><tt>domain master = No</tt></i>
+must be set.
+</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2893146"></a>Example Configuration</h4></div></div><div></div></div><pre class="programlisting">
+ [globals]
+ domain logons = Yes
+ domain master = (Yes on PDC, No on BDCs)
-<P
-></P
-><UL
-><LI
-><P
->A Samba account, stored in the same location as user
- LanMan and NT password hashes (currently
- <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->smbpasswd</TT
->). The Samba account
- possesses and uses only the NT password hash.</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->A corresponding Unix account, typically stored in
- <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/passwd</TT
->. (Future releases will alleviate the need to
- create <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/passwd</TT
-> entries.) </P
-></LI
-></UL
-></P
-><P
->There are two ways to create machine trust accounts:</P
-><P
-></P
-><UL
-><LI
-><P
-> Manual creation. Both the Samba and corresponding
- Unix account are created by hand.</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-> "On-the-fly" creation. The Samba machine trust
- account is automatically created by Samba at the time the client
- is joined to the domain. (For security, this is the
- recommended method.) The corresponding Unix account may be
- created automatically or manually. </P
-></LI
-></UL
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><H2
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN682">6.4.1. Manual Creation of Machine Trust Accounts</H2
-><P
->The first step in manually creating a machine trust account is to
-manually create the corresponding Unix account in
-<TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/passwd</TT
->. This can be done using
-<B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->vipw</B
-> or other 'add user' command that is normally
-used to create new Unix accounts. The following is an example for a
-Linux based Samba server:</P
-><P
-> <TT
-CLASS="PROMPT"
->root# </TT
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->/usr/sbin/useradd -g 100 -d /dev/null -c <TT
-CLASS="REPLACEABLE"
-><I
->"machine
-nickname"</I
-></TT
-> -s /bin/false <TT
-CLASS="REPLACEABLE"
-><I
->machine_name</I
-></TT
->$ </B
-></P
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="PROMPT"
->root# </TT
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->passwd -l <TT
-CLASS="REPLACEABLE"
-><I
->machine_name</I
-></TT
->$</B
-></P
-><P
->On *BSD systems, this can be done using the 'chpass' utility:</P
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="PROMPT"
->root# </TT
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->chpass -a "<TT
-CLASS="REPLACEABLE"
-><I
->machine_name</I
-></TT
->$:*:101:100::0:0:Workstation <TT
-CLASS="REPLACEABLE"
-><I
->machine_name</I
-></TT
->:/dev/null:/sbin/nologin"</B
-></P
-><P
->The <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/passwd</TT
-> entry will list the machine name
-with a "$" appended, won't have a password, will have a null shell and no
-home directory. For example a machine named 'doppy' would have an
-<TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/passwd</TT
-> entry like this:</P
-><P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
->doppy$:x:505:501:<TT
-CLASS="REPLACEABLE"
-><I
->machine_nickname</I
-></TT
->:/dev/null:/bin/false</PRE
-></P
-><P
->Above, <TT
-CLASS="REPLACEABLE"
-><I
->machine_nickname</I
-></TT
-> can be any
-descriptive name for the client, i.e., BasementComputer.
-<TT
-CLASS="REPLACEABLE"
-><I
->machine_name</I
-></TT
-> absolutely must be the NetBIOS
-name of the client to be joined to the domain. The "$" must be
-appended to the NetBIOS name of the client or Samba will not recognize
-this as a machine trust account.</P
-><P
->Now that the corresponding Unix account has been created, the next step is to create
-the Samba account for the client containing the well-known initial
-machine trust account password. This can be done using the <A
-HREF="smbpasswd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbpasswd(8)</B
-></A
-> command
-as shown here:</P
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="PROMPT"
->root# </TT
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbpasswd -a -m <TT
-CLASS="REPLACEABLE"
-><I
->machine_name</I
-></TT
-></B
-></P
-><P
->where <TT
-CLASS="REPLACEABLE"
-><I
->machine_name</I
-></TT
-> is the machine's NetBIOS
-name. The RID of the new machine account is generated from the UID of
-the corresponding Unix account.</P
-><DIV
-CLASS="WARNING"
-><P
-></P
-><TABLE
-CLASS="WARNING"
-WIDTH="100%"
-BORDER="0"
-><TR
-><TD
-WIDTH="25"
-ALIGN="CENTER"
-VALIGN="TOP"
-><IMG
-SRC="../images/warning.gif"
-HSPACE="5"
-ALT="Warning"></TD
-><TH
-ALIGN="LEFT"
-VALIGN="CENTER"
-><B
->Join the client to the domain immediately</B
-></TH
-></TR
-><TR
-><TD
->&nbsp;</TD
-><TD
-ALIGN="LEFT"
-VALIGN="TOP"
-><P
-> Manually creating a machine trust account using this method is the
- equivalent of creating a machine trust account on a Windows NT PDC using
- the "Server Manager". From the time at which the account is created
- to the time which the client joins the domain and changes the password,
- your domain is vulnerable to an intruder joining your domain using a
- a machine with the same NetBIOS name. A PDC inherently trusts
- members of the domain and will serve out a large degree of user
- information to such clients. You have been warned!
- </P
-></TD
-></TR
-></TABLE
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><H2
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN723">6.4.2. "On-the-Fly" Creation of Machine Trust Accounts</H2
-><P
->The second (and recommended) way of creating machine trust accounts is
-simply to allow the Samba server to create them as needed when the client
-is joined to the domain. </P
-><P
->Since each Samba machine trust account requires a corresponding
-Unix account, a method for automatically creating the
-Unix account is usually supplied; this requires configuration of the
-<A
-HREF="smb.conf.5.html#ADDUSERSCRIPT"
-TARGET="_top"
->add user script</A
->
-option in <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->smb.conf</TT
->. This
-method is not required, however; corresponding Unix accounts may also
-be created manually.</P
-><P
->Below is an example for a RedHat 6.2 Linux system.</P
-><P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
->[global]
- # &#60;...remainder of parameters...&#62;
- add user script = /usr/sbin/useradd -d /dev/null -g 100 -s /bin/false -M %u </PRE
-></P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><H2
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN732">6.4.3. Joining the Client to the Domain</H2
-><P
->The procedure for joining a client to the domain varies with the
-version of Windows.</P
-><P
-></P
-><UL
-><LI
-><P
-><SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->Windows 2000</I
-></SPAN
-></P
-><P
-> When the user elects to join the client to a domain, Windows prompts for
- an account and password that is privileged to join the domain. A
- Samba administrative account (i.e., a Samba account that has root
- privileges on the Samba server) must be entered here; the
- operation will fail if an ordinary user account is given.
- The password for this account should be
- set to a different password than the associated
- <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/passwd</TT
-> entry, for security
- reasons. </P
-><P
->The session key of the Samba administrative account acts as an
- encryption key for setting the password of the machine trust
- account. The machine trust account will be created on-the-fly, or
- updated if it already exists.</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->Windows NT</I
-></SPAN
-></P
-><P
-> If the machine trust account was created manually, on the
- Identification Changes menu enter the domain name, but do not
- check the box "Create a Computer Account in the Domain." In this case,
- the existing machine trust account is used to join the machine to
- the domain.</P
-><P
-> If the machine trust account is to be created
- on-the-fly, on the Identification Changes menu enter the domain
- name, and check the box "Create a Computer Account in the Domain." In
- this case, joining the domain proceeds as above for Windows 2000
- (i.e., you must supply a Samba administrative account when
- prompted).</P
-></LI
-></UL
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><H1
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN747">6.5. Common Problems and Errors</H1
-><P
-></P
-><P
-></P
-><UL
-><LI
-><P
-> <SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->I cannot include a '$' in a machine name.</I
-></SPAN
->
- </P
-><P
-> A 'machine name' in (typically) <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/passwd</TT
->
- of the machine name with a '$' appended. FreeBSD (and other BSD
- systems?) won't create a user with a '$' in their name.
- </P
-><P
-> The problem is only in the program used to make the entry, once
- made, it works perfectly. So create a user without the '$' and
- use <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->vipw</B
-> to edit the entry, adding the '$'. Or create
- the whole entry with vipw if you like, make sure you use a
- unique User ID !
- </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-> <SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->I get told "You already have a connection to the Domain...."
- or "Cannot join domain, the credentials supplied conflict with an
- existing set.." when creating a machine trust account.</I
-></SPAN
->
- </P
-><P
-> This happens if you try to create a machine trust account from the
- machine itself and already have a connection (e.g. mapped drive)
- to a share (or IPC$) on the Samba PDC. The following command
- will remove all network drive connections:
- </P
-><P
-> <TT
-CLASS="PROMPT"
->C:\WINNT\&#62;</TT
-> <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->net use * /d</B
->
- </P
-><P
-> Further, if the machine is a already a 'member of a workgroup' that
- is the same name as the domain you are joining (bad idea) you will
- get this message. Change the workgroup name to something else, it
- does not matter what, reboot, and try again.
- </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-> <SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->The system can not log you on (C000019B)....</I
-></SPAN
->
- </P
-><P
->I joined the domain successfully but after upgrading
- to a newer version of the Samba code I get the message, "The system
- can not log you on (C000019B), Please try a gain or consult your
- system administrator" when attempting to logon.
- </P
-><P
-> This occurs when the domain SID stored in
- <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->private/WORKGROUP.SID</TT
-> is
- changed. For example, you remove the file and <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbd</B
-> automatically
- creates a new one. Or you are swapping back and forth between
- versions 2.0.7, TNG and the HEAD branch code (not recommended). The
- only way to correct the problem is to restore the original domain
- SID or remove the domain client from the domain and rejoin.
- </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-> <SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->The machine trust account for this computer either does not
- exist or is not accessible.</I
-></SPAN
->
- </P
-><P
-> When I try to join the domain I get the message "The machine account
- for this computer either does not exist or is not accessible". What's
- wrong?
- </P
-><P
-> This problem is caused by the PDC not having a suitable machine trust account.
- If you are using the <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->add user script</I
-></TT
-> method to create
- accounts then this would indicate that it has not worked. Ensure the domain
- admin user system is working.
- </P
-><P
-> Alternatively if you are creating account entries manually then they
- have not been created correctly. Make sure that you have the entry
- correct for the machine trust account in smbpasswd file on the Samba PDC.
- If you added the account using an editor rather than using the smbpasswd
- utility, make sure that the account name is the machine NetBIOS name
- with a '$' appended to it ( i.e. computer_name$ ). There must be an entry
- in both /etc/passwd and the smbpasswd file. Some people have reported
- that inconsistent subnet masks between the Samba server and the NT
- client have caused this problem. Make sure that these are consistent
- for both client and server.
- </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-> <SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->When I attempt to login to a Samba Domain from a NT4/W2K workstation,
- I get a message about my account being disabled.</I
-></SPAN
->
- </P
-><P
-> This problem is caused by a PAM related bug in Samba 2.2.0. This bug is
- fixed in 2.2.1. Other symptoms could be unaccessible shares on
- NT/W2K member servers in the domain or the following error in your smbd.log:
- passdb/pampass.c:pam_account(268) PAM: UNKNOWN ERROR for User: %user%
- </P
-><P
-> At first be ensure to enable the useraccounts with <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbpasswd -e
- %user%</B
->, this is normally done, when you create an account.
- </P
-><P
-> In order to work around this problem in 2.2.0, configure the
- <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->account</I
-></TT
-> control flag in
- <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/pam.d/samba</TT
-> file as follows:
- </P
-><P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
-> account required pam_permit.so
- </PRE
-></P
-><P
-> If you want to remain backward compatibility to samba 2.0.x use
- <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->pam_permit.so</TT
->, it's also possible to use
- <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->pam_pwdb.so</TT
->. There are some bugs if you try to
- use <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->pam_unix.so</TT
->, if you need this, be ensure to use
- the most recent version of this file.
- </P
-></LI
-></UL
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><H1
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN795">6.6. System Policies and Profiles</H1
-><P
->Much of the information necessary to implement System Policies and
-Roving User Profiles in a Samba domain is the same as that for
-implementing these same items in a Windows NT 4.0 domain.
-You should read the white paper <A
-HREF="http://www.microsoft.com/ntserver/management/deployment/planguide/prof_policies.asp"
-TARGET="_top"
->Implementing
-Profiles and Policies in Windows NT 4.0</A
-> available from Microsoft.</P
-><P
->Here are some additional details:</P
-><P
-></P
-><UL
-><LI
-><P
-> <SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->What about Windows NT Policy Editor?</I
-></SPAN
->
- </P
-><P
-> To create or edit <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->ntconfig.pol</TT
-> you must use
- the NT Server Policy Editor, <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->poledit.exe</B
-> which
- is included with NT Server but <SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->not NT Workstation</I
-></SPAN
->.
- There is a Policy Editor on a NTws
- but it is not suitable for creating <SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->Domain Policies</I
-></SPAN
->.
- Further, although the Windows 95
- Policy Editor can be installed on an NT Workstation/Server, it will not
- work with NT policies because the registry key that are set by the policy templates.
- However, the files from the NT Server will run happily enough on an NTws.
- You need <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->poledit.exe, common.adm</TT
-> and <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->winnt.adm</TT
->. It is convenient
- to put the two *.adm files in <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->c:\winnt\inf</TT
-> which is where
- the binary will look for them unless told otherwise. Note also that that
- directory is 'hidden'.
- </P
-><P
-> The Windows NT policy editor is also included with the Service Pack 3 (and
- later) for Windows NT 4.0. Extract the files using <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->servicepackname /x</B
->,
- i.e. that's <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->Nt4sp6ai.exe /x</B
-> for service pack 6a. The policy editor,
- <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->poledit.exe</B
-> and the associated template files (*.adm) should
- be extracted as well. It is also possible to downloaded the policy template
- files for Office97 and get a copy of the policy editor. Another possible
- location is with the Zero Administration Kit available for download from Microsoft.
- </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-> <SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->Can Win95 do Policies?</I
-></SPAN
->
- </P
-><P
-> Install the group policy handler for Win9x to pick up group
- policies. Look on the Win98 CD in <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->\tools\reskit\netadmin\poledit</TT
->.
- Install group policies on a Win9x client by double-clicking
- <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->grouppol.inf</TT
->. Log off and on again a couple of
- times and see if Win98 picks up group policies. Unfortunately this needs
- to be done on every Win9x machine that uses group policies....
- </P
-><P
-> If group policies don't work one reports suggests getting the updated
- (read: working) grouppol.dll for Windows 9x. The group list is grabbed
- from /etc/group.
- </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-> <SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->How do I get 'User Manager' and 'Server Manager'</I
-></SPAN
->
- </P
-><P
-> Since I don't need to buy an NT Server CD now, how do I get
- the 'User Manager for Domains', the 'Server Manager'?
- </P
-><P
-> Microsoft distributes a version of these tools called nexus for
- installation on Windows 95 systems. The tools set includes
- </P
-><P
-></P
-><UL
-><LI
-><P
->Server Manager</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->User Manager for Domains</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->Event Viewer</P
-></LI
-></UL
-><P
-> Click here to download the archived file <A
-HREF="ftp://ftp.microsoft.com/Softlib/MSLFILES/NEXUS.EXE"
-TARGET="_top"
->ftp://ftp.microsoft.com/Softlib/MSLFILES/NEXUS.EXE</A
->
- </P
-><P
-> The Windows NT 4.0 version of the 'User Manager for
- Domains' and 'Server Manager' are available from Microsoft via ftp
- from <A
-HREF="ftp://ftp.microsoft.com/Softlib/MSLFILES/SRVTOOLS.EXE"
-TARGET="_top"
->ftp://ftp.microsoft.com/Softlib/MSLFILES/SRVTOOLS.EXE</A
->
- </P
-></LI
-></UL
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><H1
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN839">6.7. What other help can I get?</H1
-><P
->There are many sources of information available in the form
-of mailing lists, RFC's and documentation. The docs that come
-with the samba distribution contain very good explanations of
-general SMB topics such as browsing.</P
-><P
-></P
-><UL
-><LI
-><P
-> <SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->What are some diagnostics tools I can use to debug the domain logon
- process and where can I find them?</I
-></SPAN
->
- </P
-><P
-> One of the best diagnostic tools for debugging problems is Samba itself.
- You can use the -d option for both smbd and nmbd to specify what
- 'debug level' at which to run. See the man pages on smbd, nmbd and
- smb.conf for more information on debugging options. The debug
- level can range from 1 (the default) to 10 (100 for debugging passwords).
- </P
-><P
-> Another helpful method of debugging is to compile samba using the
- <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->gcc -g </B
-> flag. This will include debug
- information in the binaries and allow you to attach gdb to the
- running smbd / nmbd process. In order to attach gdb to an smbd
- process for an NT workstation, first get the workstation to make the
- connection. Pressing ctrl-alt-delete and going down to the domain box
- is sufficient (at least, on the first time you join the domain) to
- generate a 'LsaEnumTrustedDomains'. Thereafter, the workstation
- maintains an open connection, and therefore there will be an smbd
- process running (assuming that you haven't set a really short smbd
- idle timeout) So, in between pressing ctrl alt delete, and actually
- typing in your password, you can gdb attach and continue.
- </P
-><P
-> Some useful samba commands worth investigating:
- </P
-><P
-></P
-><UL
-><LI
-><P
->testparam | more</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->smbclient -L //{netbios name of server}</P
-></LI
-></UL
-><P
-> An SMB enabled version of tcpdump is available from
- <A
-HREF="http://www.tcpdump.org/"
-TARGET="_top"
->http://www.tcpdup.org/</A
->.
- Ethereal, another good packet sniffer for Unix and Win32
- hosts, can be downloaded from <A
-HREF="http://www.ethereal.com/"
-TARGET="_top"
->http://www.ethereal.com</A
->.
- </P
-><P
-> For tracing things on the Microsoft Windows NT, Network Monitor
- (aka. netmon) is available on the Microsoft Developer Network CD's,
- the Windows NT Server install CD and the SMS CD's. The version of
- netmon that ships with SMS allows for dumping packets between any two
- computers (i.e. placing the network interface in promiscuous mode).
- The version on the NT Server install CD will only allow monitoring
- of network traffic directed to the local NT box and broadcasts on the
- local subnet. Be aware that Ethereal can read and write netmon
- formatted files.
- </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-> <SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->How do I install 'Network Monitor' on an NT Workstation
- or a Windows 9x box?</I
-></SPAN
->
- </P
-><P
-> Installing netmon on an NT workstation requires a couple
- of steps. The following are for installing Netmon V4.00.349, which comes
- with Microsoft Windows NT Server 4.0, on Microsoft Windows NT
- Workstation 4.0. The process should be similar for other version of
- Windows NT / Netmon. You will need both the Microsoft Windows
- NT Server 4.0 Install CD and the Workstation 4.0 Install CD.
- </P
-><P
-> Initially you will need to install 'Network Monitor Tools and Agent'
- on the NT Server. To do this
- </P
-><P
-></P
-><UL
-><LI
-><P
->Goto Start - Settings - Control Panel -
- Network - Services - Add </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->Select the 'Network Monitor Tools and Agent' and
- click on 'OK'.</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->Click 'OK' on the Network Control Panel.
- </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->Insert the Windows NT Server 4.0 install CD
- when prompted.</P
-></LI
-></UL
-><P
-> At this point the Netmon files should exist in
- <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->%SYSTEMROOT%\System32\netmon\*.*</TT
->.
- Two subdirectories exist as well, <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->parsers\</TT
->
- which contains the necessary DLL's for parsing the netmon packet
- dump, and <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->captures\</TT
->.
- </P
-><P
-> In order to install the Netmon tools on an NT Workstation, you will
- first need to install the 'Network Monitor Agent' from the Workstation
- install CD.
- </P
-><P
-></P
-><UL
-><LI
-><P
->Goto Start - Settings - Control Panel -
- Network - Services - Add</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->Select the 'Network Monitor Agent' and click
- on 'OK'.</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->Click 'OK' on the Network Control Panel.
- </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->Insert the Windows NT Workstation 4.0 install
- CD when prompted.</P
-></LI
-></UL
-><P
-> Now copy the files from the NT Server in %SYSTEMROOT%\System32\netmon\*.*
- to %SYSTEMROOT%\System32\netmon\*.* on the Workstation and set
- permissions as you deem appropriate for your site. You will need
- administrative rights on the NT box to run netmon.
- </P
-><P
-> To install Netmon on a Windows 9x box install the network monitor agent
- from the Windows 9x CD (\admin\nettools\netmon). There is a readme
- file located with the netmon driver files on the CD if you need
- information on how to do this. Copy the files from a working
- Netmon installation.
- </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-> The following is a list if helpful URLs and other links:
- </P
-><P
-></P
-><UL
-><LI
-><P
->Home of Samba site <A
-HREF="http://samba.org"
-TARGET="_top"
-> http://samba.org</A
->. We have a mirror near you !</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-> The <SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->Development</I
-></SPAN
-> document
- on the Samba mirrors might mention your problem. If so,
- it might mean that the developers are working on it.</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->See how Scott Merrill simulates a BDC behavior at
- <A
-HREF="http://www.skippy.net/linux/smb-howto.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-> http://www.skippy.net/linux/smb-howto.html</A
->. </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->Although 2.0.7 has almost had its day as a PDC, David Bannon will
- keep the 2.0.7 PDC pages at <A
-HREF="http://bioserve.latrobe.edu.au/samba"
-TARGET="_top"
-> http://bioserve.latrobe.edu.au/samba</A
-> going for a while yet.</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->Misc links to CIFS information
- <A
-HREF="http://samba.org/cifs/"
-TARGET="_top"
->http://samba.org/cifs/</A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->NT Domains for Unix <A
-HREF="http://mailhost.cb1.com/~lkcl/ntdom/"
-TARGET="_top"
-> http://mailhost.cb1.com/~lkcl/ntdom/</A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->FTP site for older SMB specs:
- <A
-HREF="ftp://ftp.microsoft.com/developr/drg/CIFS/"
-TARGET="_top"
-> ftp://ftp.microsoft.com/developr/drg/CIFS/</A
-></P
-></LI
-></UL
-></LI
-></UL
-><P
-></P
-><UL
-><LI
-><P
-> <SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->How do I get help from the mailing lists?</I
-></SPAN
->
- </P
-><P
-> There are a number of Samba related mailing lists. Go to <A
-HREF="http://samba.org"
-TARGET="_top"
->http://samba.org</A
->, click on your nearest mirror
- and then click on <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->Support</B
-> and then click on <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
-> Samba related mailing lists</B
->.
- </P
-><P
-> For questions relating to Samba TNG go to
- <A
-HREF="http://www.samba-tng.org/"
-TARGET="_top"
->http://www.samba-tng.org/</A
->
- It has been requested that you don't post questions about Samba-TNG to the
- main stream Samba lists.</P
-><P
-> If you post a message to one of the lists please observe the following guide lines :
- </P
-><P
-></P
-><UL
-><LI
-><P
-> Always remember that the developers are volunteers, they are
- not paid and they never guarantee to produce a particular feature at
- a particular time. Any time lines are 'best guess' and nothing more.
- </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-> Always mention what version of samba you are using and what
- operating system its running under. You should probably list the
- relevant sections of your smb.conf file, at least the options
- in [global] that affect PDC support.</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->In addition to the version, if you obtained Samba via
- CVS mention the date when you last checked it out.</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-> Try and make your question clear and brief, lots of long,
- convoluted questions get deleted before they are completely read !
- Don't post html encoded messages (if you can select colour or font
- size its html).</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-> If you run one of those nifty 'I'm on holidays' things when
- you are away, make sure its configured to not answer mailing lists.
- </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-> Don't cross post. Work out which is the best list to post to
- and see what happens, i.e. don't post to both samba-ntdom and samba-technical.
- Many people active on the lists subscribe to more
- than one list and get annoyed to see the same message two or more times.
- Often someone will see a message and thinking it would be better dealt
- with on another, will forward it on for you.</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->You might include <SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->partial</I
-></SPAN
->
- log files written at a debug level set to as much as 20.
- Please don't send the entire log but enough to give the context of the
- error messages.</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->(Possibly) If you have a complete netmon trace ( from the opening of
- the pipe to the error ) you can send the *.CAP file as well.</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->Please think carefully before attaching a document to an email.
- Consider pasting the relevant parts into the body of the message. The samba
- mailing lists go to a huge number of people, do they all need a copy of your
- smb.conf in their attach directory?</P
-></LI
-></UL
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-> <SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->How do I get off the mailing lists?</I
-></SPAN
->
- </P
-><P
->To have your name removed from a samba mailing list, go to the
- same place you went to to get on it. Go to <A
-HREF="http://lists.samba.org/"
-TARGET="_top"
->http://lists.samba.org</A
->,
- click on your nearest mirror and then click on <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->Support</B
-> and
- then click on <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
-> Samba related mailing lists</B
->. Or perhaps see
- <A
-HREF="http://lists.samba.org/mailman/roster/samba-ntdom"
-TARGET="_top"
->here</A
->
- </P
-><P
-> Please don't post messages to the list asking to be removed, you will just
- be referred to the above address (unless that process failed in some way...)
- </P
-></LI
-></UL
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><H1
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN953">6.8. Domain Control for Windows 9x/ME</H1
-><DIV
-CLASS="NOTE"
-><P
-></P
-><TABLE
-CLASS="NOTE"
-WIDTH="100%"
-BORDER="0"
-><TR
-><TD
-WIDTH="25"
-ALIGN="CENTER"
-VALIGN="TOP"
-><IMG
-SRC="../images/note.gif"
-HSPACE="5"
-ALT="Note"></TD
-><TD
-ALIGN="LEFT"
-VALIGN="TOP"
-><P
->The following section contains much of the original
-DOMAIN.txt file previously included with Samba. Much of
-the material is based on what went into the book <SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->Special
-Edition, Using Samba</I
-></SPAN
->, by Richard Sharpe.</P
-></TD
-></TR
-></TABLE
-></DIV
-><P
->A domain and a workgroup are exactly the same thing in terms of network
+ [netlogon]
+ comment = Network Logon Service
+ path = /var/lib/samba/netlogon
+ guest ok = Yes
+ browseable = No
+</pre></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2893167"></a>The Special Case of MS Windows XP Home Edition</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p>
+MS Windows XP Home Edition does not have the ability to join any type of Domain
+security facility. Unlike, MS Windows 9x / Me, MS Windows XP Home Edition also completely
+lacks the ability to log onto a network.
+</p></div><p>
+To be completely clear: If you want MS Windows XP Home Edition to integrate with your
+MS Windows NT4 or Active Directory Domain security understand - IT CAN NOT BE DONE.
+Your only choice is to buy the upgrade pack from MS Windows XP Home Edition to
+MS Windows XP Professional.
+</p><p>
+Now that this has been said, please do NOT ask the mailing list, or email any of the
+Samba-Team members with your questions asking how to make this work. It can't be done.
+</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2893201"></a>The Special Case of Windows 9x / Me</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+A domain and a workgroup are exactly the same thing in terms of network
browsing. The difference is that a distributable authentication
database is associated with a domain, for secure login access to a
network. Also, different access rights can be granted to users if they
-successfully authenticate against a domain logon server (NT server and
-other systems based on NT server support this, as does at least Samba TNG now).</P
-><P
->The SMB client logging on to a domain has an expectation that every other
+successfully authenticate against a domain logon server. Samba-3 does this
+now in the same way that MS Windows NT/2K.
+</p><p>
+The SMB client logging on to a domain has an expectation that every other
server in the domain should accept the same authentication information.
-Network browsing functionality of domains and workgroups is
-identical and is explained in BROWSING.txt. It should be noted, that browsing
-is totally orthogonal to logon support.</P
-><P
->Issues related to the single-logon network model are discussed in this
+Network browsing functionality of domains and workgroups is identical and
+is explained in this documentation under the browsing discussions.
+It should be noted, that browsing is totally orthogonal to logon support.
+</p><p>
+Issues related to the single-logon network model are discussed in this
section. Samba supports domain logons, network logon scripts, and user
profiles for MS Windows for workgroups and MS Windows 9X/ME clients
-which will be the focus of this section.</P
-><P
->When an SMB client in a domain wishes to logon it broadcast requests for a
+which are the focus of this section.
+</p><p>
+When an SMB client in a domain wishes to logon, it broadcasts requests for a
logon server. The first one to reply gets the job, and validates its
password using whatever mechanism the Samba administrator has installed.
It is possible (but very stupid) to create a domain where the user
database is not shared between servers, i.e. they are effectively workgroup
servers advertising themselves as participating in a domain. This
demonstrates how authentication is quite different from but closely
-involved with domains.</P
-><P
->Using these features you can make your clients verify their logon via
+involved with domains.
+</p><p>
+Using these features you can make your clients verify their logon via
the Samba server; make clients run a batch file when they logon to
-the network and download their preferences, desktop and start menu.</P
-><P
->Before launching into the configuration instructions, it is
-worthwhile lookingat how a Windows 9x/ME client performs a logon:</P
-><P
-></P
-><OL
-TYPE="1"
-><LI
-><P
-> The client broadcasts (to the IP broadcast address of the subnet it is in)
- a NetLogon request. This is sent to the NetBIOS name DOMAIN&#60;1c&#62; at the
+the network and download their preferences, desktop and start menu.
+</p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>
+MS Windows XP Home edition is NOT able to join a domain and does not permit
+the use of domain logons.
+</em></span></p><p>
+Before launching into the configuration instructions, it is
+worthwhile to look at how a Windows 9x/ME client performs a logon:
+</p><div class="orderedlist"><ol type="1"><li><p>
+ The client broadcasts (to the IP broadcast address of the subnet it is in)
+ a NetLogon request. This is sent to the NetBIOS name DOMAIN&lt;#1c&gt; at the
NetBIOS layer. The client chooses the first response it receives, which
contains the NetBIOS name of the logon server to use in the format of
- \\SERVER.
- </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-> The client then connects to that server, logs on (does an SMBsessetupX) and
+ <tt class="filename">\\SERVER</tt>.
+ </p></li><li><p>
+ The client then connects to that server, logs on (does an SMBsessetupX) and
then connects to the IPC$ share (using an SMBtconX).
- </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-> The client then does a NetWkstaUserLogon request, which retrieves the name
+ </p></li><li><p>
+ The client then does a NetWkstaUserLogon request, which retrieves the name
of the user's logon script.
- </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-> The client then connects to the NetLogon share and searches for this
+ </p></li><li><p>
+ The client then connects to the NetLogon share and searches for said script
and if it is found and can be read, is retrieved and executed by the client.
After this, the client disconnects from the NetLogon share.
- </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-> The client then sends a NetUserGetInfo request to the server, to retrieve
+ </p></li><li><p>
+ The client then sends a NetUserGetInfo request to the server, to retrieve
the user's home share, which is used to search for profiles. Since the
- response to the NetUserGetInfo request does not contain much more
+ response to the NetUserGetInfo request does not contain much more than
the user's home share, profiles for Win9X clients MUST reside in the user
home directory.
- </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-> The client then connects to the user's home share and searches for the
+ </p></li><li><p>
+ The client then connects to the user's home share and searches for the
user's profile. As it turns out, you can specify the user's home share as
- a sharename and path. For example, \\server\fred\.profile.
+ a sharename and path. For example, <tt class="filename">\\server\fred\.winprofile</tt>.
If the profiles are found, they are implemented.
- </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-> The client then disconnects from the user's home share, and reconnects to
- the NetLogon share and looks for CONFIG.POL, the policies file. If this is
+ </p></li><li><p>
+ The client then disconnects from the user's home share, and reconnects to
+ the NetLogon share and looks for <tt class="filename">CONFIG.POL</tt>, the policies file. If this is
found, it is read and implemented.
- </P
-></LI
-></OL
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><H2
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN979">6.8.1. Configuration Instructions: Network Logons</H2
-><P
->The main difference between a PDC and a Windows 9x logon
-server configuration is that</P
-><P
-></P
-><UL
-><LI
-><P
->Password encryption is not required for a Windows 9x logon server.</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->Windows 9x/ME clients do not possess machine trust accounts.</P
-></LI
-></UL
-><P
->Therefore, a Samba PDC will also act as a Windows 9x logon
-server.</P
-><DIV
-CLASS="WARNING"
-><P
-></P
-><TABLE
-CLASS="WARNING"
-WIDTH="100%"
-BORDER="0"
-><TR
-><TD
-WIDTH="25"
-ALIGN="CENTER"
-VALIGN="TOP"
-><IMG
-SRC="../images/warning.gif"
-HSPACE="5"
-ALT="Warning"></TD
-><TH
-ALIGN="LEFT"
-VALIGN="CENTER"
-><B
->security mode and master browsers</B
-></TH
-></TR
-><TR
-><TD
->&nbsp;</TD
-><TD
-ALIGN="LEFT"
-VALIGN="TOP"
-><P
->There are a few comments to make in order to tie up some
+ </p></li></ol></div><p>
+The main difference between a PDC and a Windows 9x logon server configuration is that
+</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>
+ Password encryption is not required for a Windows 9x logon server. But note
+ that beginning with MS Windows 98 the default setting is that plain-text
+ password support has been disabled. It can be re-enabled with the registry
+ changes that are documented in the chapter on Policies.
+ </p></li><li><p>
+ Windows 9x/ME clients do not require and do not use machine trust accounts.
+ </p></li></ul></div><p>
+A Samba PDC will act as a Windows 9x logon server; after all, it does provide the
+network logon services that MS Windows 9x / Me expect to find.
+</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2893441"></a>Security Mode and Master Browsers</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+There are a few comments to make in order to tie up some
loose ends. There has been much debate over the issue of whether
or not it is ok to configure Samba as a Domain Controller in security
-modes other than <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->USER</TT
->. The only security mode
-which will not work due to technical reasons is <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->SHARE</TT
->
-mode security. <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->DOMAIN</TT
-> and <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->SERVER</TT
->
-mode security is really just a variation on SMB user level security.</P
-><P
->Actually, this issue is also closely tied to the debate on whether
+modes other than <tt class="constant">USER</tt>. The only security mode
+which will not work due to technical reasons is <tt class="constant">SHARE</tt>
+mode security. <tt class="constant">DOMAIN</tt> and <tt class="constant">SERVER</tt>
+mode security are really just a variation on SMB user level security.
+</p><p>
+Actually, this issue is also closely tied to the debate on whether
or not Samba must be the domain master browser for its workgroup
when operating as a DC. While it may technically be possible
to configure a server as such (after all, browsing and domain logons
-are two distinctly different functions), it is not a good idea to
-so. You should remember that the DC must register the DOMAIN#1b NetBIOS
+are two distinctly different functions), it is not a good idea to do
+so. You should remember that the DC must register the DOMAIN&lt;#1b&gt; NetBIOS
name. This is the name used by Windows clients to locate the DC.
Windows clients do not distinguish between the DC and the DMB.
-For this reason, it is very wise to configure the Samba DC as the DMB.</P
-><P
->Now back to the issue of configuring a Samba DC to use a mode other
-than "security = user". If a Samba host is configured to use
+For this reason, it is very wise to configure the Samba DC as the DMB.
+</p><p>
+Now back to the issue of configuring a Samba DC to use a mode other
+than <i class="parameter"><tt>security = user</tt></i>. If a Samba host is configured to use
another SMB server or DC in order to validate user connection
requests, then it is a fact that some other machine on the network
-(the "password server") knows more about user than the Samba host.
+(the <i class="parameter"><tt>password server</tt></i>) knows more about the user than the Samba host.
99% of the time, this other host is a domain controller. Now
-in order to operate in domain mode security, the "workgroup" parameter
+in order to operate in domain mode security, the <i class="parameter"><tt>workgroup</tt></i> parameter
must be set to the name of the Windows NT domain (which already
-has a domain controller, right?)</P
-><P
->Therefore configuring a Samba box as a DC for a domain that
-already by definition has a PDC is asking for trouble.
-Therefore, you should always configure the Samba DC to be the DMB
-for its domain.</P
-></TD
-></TR
-></TABLE
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><H2
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN998">6.8.2. Configuration Instructions: Setting up Roaming User Profiles</H2
-><DIV
-CLASS="WARNING"
-><P
-></P
-><TABLE
-CLASS="WARNING"
-WIDTH="100%"
-BORDER="0"
-><TR
-><TD
-WIDTH="25"
-ALIGN="CENTER"
-VALIGN="TOP"
-><IMG
-SRC="../images/warning.gif"
-HSPACE="5"
-ALT="Warning"></TD
-><TD
-ALIGN="LEFT"
-VALIGN="TOP"
-><P
-><SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->NOTE!</I
-></SPAN
-> Roaming profiles support is different
-for Win9X and WinNT.</P
-></TD
-></TR
-></TABLE
-></DIV
-><P
->Before discussing how to configure roaming profiles, it is useful to see how
-Win9X and WinNT clients implement these features.</P
-><P
->Win9X clients send a NetUserGetInfo request to the server to get the user's
-profiles location. However, the response does not have room for a separate
-profiles location field, only the user's home share. This means that Win9X
-profiles are restricted to being in the user's home directory.</P
-><P
->WinNT clients send a NetSAMLogon RPC request, which contains many fields,
-including a separate field for the location of the user's profiles.
-This means that support for profiles is different for Win9X and WinNT.</P
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><H3
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><A
-NAME="AEN1006">6.8.2.1. Windows NT Configuration</H3
-><P
->To support WinNT clients, in the [global] section of smb.conf set the
-following (for example):</P
-><P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
->logon path = \\profileserver\profileshare\profilepath\%U\moreprofilepath</PRE
-></P
-><P
->The default for this option is \\%N\%U\profile, namely
-\\sambaserver\username\profile. The \\N%\%U service is created
-automatically by the [homes] service.
-If you are using a samba server for the profiles, you _must_ make the
-share specified in the logon path browseable. </P
-><DIV
-CLASS="NOTE"
-><P
-></P
-><TABLE
-CLASS="NOTE"
-WIDTH="100%"
-BORDER="0"
-><TR
-><TD
-WIDTH="25"
-ALIGN="CENTER"
-VALIGN="TOP"
-><IMG
-SRC="../images/note.gif"
-HSPACE="5"
-ALT="Note"></TD
-><TD
-ALIGN="LEFT"
-VALIGN="TOP"
-><P
->[lkcl 26aug96 - we have discovered a problem where Windows clients can
-maintain a connection to the [homes] share in between logins. The
-[homes] share must NOT therefore be used in a profile path.]</P
-></TD
-></TR
-></TABLE
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><H3
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><A
-NAME="AEN1014">6.8.2.2. Windows 9X Configuration</H3
-><P
->To support Win9X clients, you must use the "logon home" parameter. Samba has
-now been fixed so that "net use/home" now works as well, and it, too, relies
-on the "logon home" parameter.</P
-><P
->By using the logon home parameter, you are restricted to putting Win9X
-profiles in the user's home directory. But wait! There is a trick you
-can use. If you set the following in the [global] section of your
-smb.conf file:</P
-><P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
->logon home = \\%L\%U\.profiles</PRE
-></P
-><P
->then your Win9X clients will dutifully put their clients in a subdirectory
-of your home directory called .profiles (thus making them hidden).</P
-><P
->Not only that, but 'net use/home' will also work, because of a feature in
-Win9X. It removes any directory stuff off the end of the home directory area
-and only uses the server and share portion. That is, it looks like you
-specified \\%L\%U for "logon home".</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><H3
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><A
-NAME="AEN1022">6.8.2.3. Win9X and WinNT Configuration</H3
-><P
->You can support profiles for both Win9X and WinNT clients by setting both the
-"logon home" and "logon path" parameters. For example:</P
-><P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
->logon home = \\%L\%U\.profiles
-logon path = \\%L\profiles\%U</PRE
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="NOTE"
-><P
-></P
-><TABLE
-CLASS="NOTE"
-WIDTH="100%"
-BORDER="0"
-><TR
-><TD
-WIDTH="25"
-ALIGN="CENTER"
-VALIGN="TOP"
-><IMG
-SRC="../images/note.gif"
-HSPACE="5"
-ALT="Note"></TD
-><TD
-ALIGN="LEFT"
-VALIGN="TOP"
-><P
->I have not checked what 'net use /home' does on NT when "logon home" is
-set as above.</P
-></TD
-></TR
-></TABLE
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><H3
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><A
-NAME="AEN1029">6.8.2.4. Windows 9X Profile Setup</H3
-><P
->When a user first logs in on Windows 9X, the file user.DAT is created,
-as are folders "Start Menu", "Desktop", "Programs" and "Nethood".
-These directories and their contents will be merged with the local
-versions stored in c:\windows\profiles\username on subsequent logins,
-taking the most recent from each. You will need to use the [global]
-options "preserve case = yes", "short preserve case = yes" and
-"case sensitive = no" in order to maintain capital letters in shortcuts
-in any of the profile folders.</P
-><P
->The user.DAT file contains all the user's preferences. If you wish to
-enforce a set of preferences, rename their user.DAT file to user.MAN,
-and deny them write access to this file.</P
-><P
-></P
-><OL
-TYPE="1"
-><LI
-><P
-> On the Windows 95 machine, go to Control Panel | Passwords and
- select the User Profiles tab. Select the required level of
- roaming preferences. Press OK, but do _not_ allow the computer
- to reboot.
- </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-> On the Windows 95 machine, go to Control Panel | Network |
- Client for Microsoft Networks | Preferences. Select 'Log on to
- NT Domain'. Then, ensure that the Primary Logon is 'Client for
- Microsoft Networks'. Press OK, and this time allow the computer
- to reboot.
- </P
-></LI
-></OL
-><P
->Under Windows 95, Profiles are downloaded from the Primary Logon.
-If you have the Primary Logon as 'Client for Novell Networks', then
-the profiles and logon script will be downloaded from your Novell
-Server. If you have the Primary Logon as 'Windows Logon', then the
-profiles will be loaded from the local machine - a bit against the
-concept of roaming profiles, if you ask me.</P
-><P
->You will now find that the Microsoft Networks Login box contains
-[user, password, domain] instead of just [user, password]. Type in
-the samba server's domain name (or any other domain known to exist,
-but bear in mind that the user will be authenticated against this
-domain and profiles downloaded from it, if that domain logon server
-supports it), user name and user's password.</P
-><P
->Once the user has been successfully validated, the Windows 95 machine
-will inform you that 'The user has not logged on before' and asks you
-if you wish to save the user's preferences? Select 'yes'.</P
-><P
->Once the Windows 95 client comes up with the desktop, you should be able
-to examine the contents of the directory specified in the "logon path"
-on the samba server and verify that the "Desktop", "Start Menu",
-"Programs" and "Nethood" folders have been created.</P
-><P
->These folders will be cached locally on the client, and updated when
-the user logs off (if you haven't made them read-only by then :-).
-You will find that if the user creates further folders or short-cuts,
-that the client will merge the profile contents downloaded with the
-contents of the profile directory already on the local client, taking
-the newest folders and short-cuts from each set.</P
-><P
->If you have made the folders / files read-only on the samba server,
-then you will get errors from the w95 machine on logon and logout, as
-it attempts to merge the local and the remote profile. Basically, if
-you have any errors reported by the w95 machine, check the Unix file
-permissions and ownership rights on the profile directory contents,
-on the samba server.</P
-><P
->If you have problems creating user profiles, you can reset the user's
-local desktop cache, as shown below. When this user then next logs in,
-they will be told that they are logging in "for the first time".</P
-><P
-></P
-><OL
-TYPE="1"
-><LI
-><P
-> instead of logging in under the [user, password, domain] dialog,
- press escape.
- </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-> run the regedit.exe program, and look in:
- </P
-><P
-> HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE\Windows\CurrentVersion\ProfileList
- </P
-><P
-> you will find an entry, for each user, of ProfilePath. Note the
- contents of this key (likely to be c:\windows\profiles\username),
- then delete the key ProfilePath for the required user.
- </P
-><P
-> [Exit the registry editor].
- </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-> <SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->WARNING</I
-></SPAN
-> - before deleting the contents of the
- directory listed in
- the ProfilePath (this is likely to be c:\windows\profiles\username),
- ask them if they have any important files stored on their desktop
- or in their start menu. delete the contents of the directory
- ProfilePath (making a backup if any of the files are needed).
- </P
-><P
-> This will have the effect of removing the local (read-only hidden
- system file) user.DAT in their profile directory, as well as the
- local "desktop", "nethood", "start menu" and "programs" folders.
- </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-> search for the user's .PWL password-caching file in the c:\windows
- directory, and delete it.
- </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-> log off the windows 95 client.
- </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-> check the contents of the profile path (see "logon path" described
- above), and delete the user.DAT or user.MAN file for the user,
- making a backup if required.
- </P
-></LI
-></OL
-><P
->If all else fails, increase samba's debug log levels to between 3 and 10,
-and / or run a packet trace program such as tcpdump or netmon.exe, and
-look for any error reports.</P
-><P
->If you have access to an NT server, then first set up roaming profiles
-and / or netlogons on the NT server. Make a packet trace, or examine
-the example packet traces provided with NT server, and see what the
-differences are with the equivalent samba trace.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><H3
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><A
-NAME="AEN1065">6.8.2.5. Windows NT Workstation 4.0</H3
-><P
->When a user first logs in to a Windows NT Workstation, the profile
-NTuser.DAT is created. The profile location can be now specified
-through the "logon path" parameter. </P
-><DIV
-CLASS="NOTE"
-><P
-></P
-><TABLE
-CLASS="NOTE"
-WIDTH="100%"
-BORDER="0"
-><TR
-><TD
-WIDTH="25"
-ALIGN="CENTER"
-VALIGN="TOP"
-><IMG
-SRC="../images/note.gif"
-HSPACE="5"
-ALT="Note"></TD
-><TD
-ALIGN="LEFT"
-VALIGN="TOP"
-><P
->[lkcl 10aug97 - i tried setting the path to
-\\samba-server\homes\profile, and discovered that this fails because
-a background process maintains the connection to the [homes] share
-which does _not_ close down in between user logins. you have to
-have \\samba-server\%L\profile, where user is the username created
-from the [homes] share].</P
-></TD
-></TR
-></TABLE
-></DIV
-><P
->There is a parameter that is now available for use with NT Profiles:
-"logon drive". This should be set to "h:" or any other drive, and
-should be used in conjunction with the new "logon home" parameter.</P
-><P
->The entry for the NT 4.0 profile is a _directory_ not a file. The NT
-help on profiles mentions that a directory is also created with a .PDS
-extension. The user, while logging in, must have write permission to
-create the full profile path (and the folder with the .PDS extension)
-[lkcl 10aug97 - i found that the creation of the .PDS directory failed,
-and had to create these manually for each user, with a shell script.
-also, i presume, but have not tested, that the full profile path must
-be browseable just as it is for w95, due to the manner in which they
-attempt to create the full profile path: test existence of each path
-component; create path component].</P
-><P
->In the profile directory, NT creates more folders than 95. It creates
-"Application Data" and others, as well as "Desktop", "Nethood",
-"Start Menu" and "Programs". The profile itself is stored in a file
-NTuser.DAT. Nothing appears to be stored in the .PDS directory, and
-its purpose is currently unknown.</P
-><P
->You can use the System Control Panel to copy a local profile onto
-a samba server (see NT Help on profiles: it is also capable of firing
-up the correct location in the System Control Panel for you). The
-NT Help file also mentions that renaming NTuser.DAT to NTuser.MAN
-turns a profile into a mandatory one.</P
-><DIV
-CLASS="NOTE"
-><P
-></P
-><TABLE
-CLASS="NOTE"
-WIDTH="100%"
-BORDER="0"
-><TR
-><TD
-WIDTH="25"
-ALIGN="CENTER"
-VALIGN="TOP"
-><IMG
-SRC="../images/note.gif"
-HSPACE="5"
-ALT="Note"></TD
-><TD
-ALIGN="LEFT"
-VALIGN="TOP"
-><P
->[lkcl 10aug97 - i notice that NT Workstation tells me that it is
-downloading a profile from a slow link. whether this is actually the
-case, or whether there is some configuration issue, as yet unknown,
-that makes NT Workstation _think_ that the link is a slow one is a
-matter to be resolved].</P
-><P
->[lkcl 20aug97 - after samba digest correspondence, one user found, and
-another confirmed, that profiles cannot be loaded from a samba server
-unless "security = user" and "encrypt passwords = yes" (see the file
-ENCRYPTION.txt) or "security = server" and "password server = ip.address.
-of.yourNTserver" are used. Either of these options will allow the NT
-workstation to access the samba server using LAN manager encrypted
-passwords, without the user intervention normally required by NT
-workstation for clear-text passwords].</P
-><P
->[lkcl 25aug97 - more comments received about NT profiles: the case of
-the profile _matters_. the file _must_ be called NTuser.DAT or, for
-a mandatory profile, NTuser.MAN].</P
-></TD
-></TR
-></TABLE
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><H3
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><A
-NAME="AEN1078">6.8.2.6. Windows NT Server</H3
-><P
->There is nothing to stop you specifying any path that you like for the
-location of users' profiles. Therefore, you could specify that the
-profile be stored on a samba server, or any other SMB server, as long as
-that SMB server supports encrypted passwords.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><H3
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><A
-NAME="AEN1081">6.8.2.7. Sharing Profiles between W95 and NT Workstation 4.0</H3
-><DIV
-CLASS="WARNING"
-><P
-></P
-><TABLE
-CLASS="WARNING"
-WIDTH="100%"
-BORDER="0"
-><TR
-><TD
-WIDTH="25"
-ALIGN="CENTER"
-VALIGN="TOP"
-><IMG
-SRC="../images/warning.gif"
-HSPACE="5"
-ALT="Warning"></TD
-><TH
-ALIGN="LEFT"
-VALIGN="CENTER"
-><B
->Potentially outdated or incorrect material follows</B
-></TH
-></TR
-><TR
-><TD
->&nbsp;</TD
-><TD
-ALIGN="LEFT"
-VALIGN="TOP"
-><P
->I think this is all bogus, but have not deleted it. (Richard Sharpe)</P
-></TD
-></TR
-></TABLE
-></DIV
-><P
->The default logon path is \\%N\%U. NT Workstation will attempt to create
-a directory "\\samba-server\username.PDS" if you specify the logon path
-as "\\samba-server\username" with the NT User Manager. Therefore, you
-will need to specify (for example) "\\samba-server\username\profile".
-NT 4.0 will attempt to create "\\samba-server\username\profile.PDS", which
-is more likely to succeed.</P
-><P
->If you then want to share the same Start Menu / Desktop with W95, you will
-need to specify "logon path = \\samba-server\username\profile" [lkcl 10aug97
-this has its drawbacks: i created a shortcut to telnet.exe, which attempts
-to run from the c:\winnt\system32 directory. this directory is obviously
-unlikely to exist on a Win95-only host].</P
-><P
->&#13;If you have this set up correctly, you will find separate user.DAT and
-NTuser.DAT files in the same profile directory.</P
-><DIV
-CLASS="NOTE"
-><P
-></P
-><TABLE
-CLASS="NOTE"
-WIDTH="100%"
-BORDER="0"
-><TR
-><TD
-WIDTH="25"
-ALIGN="CENTER"
-VALIGN="TOP"
-><IMG
-SRC="../images/note.gif"
-HSPACE="5"
-ALT="Note"></TD
-><TD
-ALIGN="LEFT"
-VALIGN="TOP"
-><P
->[lkcl 25aug97 - there are some issues to resolve with downloading of
-NT profiles, probably to do with time/date stamps. i have found that
-NTuser.DAT is never updated on the workstation after the first time that
-it is copied to the local workstation profile directory. this is in
-contrast to w95, where it _does_ transfer / update profiles correctly].</P
-></TD
-></TR
-></TABLE
-></DIV
-></DIV
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><H1
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN1091">6.9. DOMAIN_CONTROL.txt : Windows NT Domain Control &#38; Samba</H1
-><DIV
-CLASS="WARNING"
-><P
-></P
-><TABLE
-CLASS="WARNING"
-WIDTH="100%"
-BORDER="0"
-><TR
-><TD
-WIDTH="25"
-ALIGN="CENTER"
-VALIGN="TOP"
-><IMG
-SRC="../images/warning.gif"
-HSPACE="5"
-ALT="Warning"></TD
-><TH
-ALIGN="LEFT"
-VALIGN="CENTER"
-><B
->Possibly Outdated Material</B
-></TH
-></TR
-><TR
-><TD
->&nbsp;</TD
-><TD
-ALIGN="LEFT"
-VALIGN="TOP"
-><P
-> This appendix was originally authored by John H Terpstra of
- the Samba Team and is included here for posterity.
- </P
-></TD
-></TR
-></TABLE
-></DIV
-><P
-><SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->NOTE :</I
-></SPAN
->
-The term "Domain Controller" and those related to it refer to one specific
-method of authentication that can underly an SMB domain. Domain Controllers
-prior to Windows NT Server 3.1 were sold by various companies and based on
-private extensions to the LAN Manager 2.1 protocol. Windows NT introduced
-Microsoft-specific ways of distributing the user authentication database.
-See DOMAIN.txt for examples of how Samba can participate in or create
-SMB domains based on shared authentication database schemes other than the
-Windows NT SAM.</P
-><P
->Windows NT Server can be installed as either a plain file and print server
-(WORKGROUP workstation or server) or as a server that participates in Domain
-Control (DOMAIN member, Primary Domain controller or Backup Domain controller).
-The same is true for OS/2 Warp Server, Digital Pathworks and other similar
-products, all of which can participate in Domain Control along with Windows NT.</P
-><P
->To many people these terms can be confusing, so let's try to clear the air.</P
-><P
->Every Windows NT system (workstation or server) has a registry database.
-The registry contains entries that describe the initialization information
-for all services (the equivalent of Unix Daemons) that run within the Windows
-NT environment. The registry also contains entries that tell application
-software where to find dynamically loadable libraries that they depend upon.
-In fact, the registry contains entries that describes everything that anything
-may need to know to interact with the rest of the system.</P
-><P
->The registry files can be located on any Windows NT machine by opening a
-command prompt and typing:</P
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="PROMPT"
->C:\WINNT\&#62;</TT
-> dir %SystemRoot%\System32\config</P
-><P
->The environment variable %SystemRoot% value can be obtained by typing:</P
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="PROMPT"
->C:\WINNT&#62;</TT
->echo %SystemRoot%</P
-><P
->The active parts of the registry that you may want to be familiar with are
-the files called: default, system, software, sam and security.</P
-><P
->In a domain environment, Microsoft Windows NT domain controllers participate
-in replication of the SAM and SECURITY files so that all controllers within
-the domain have an exactly identical copy of each.</P
-><P
->The Microsoft Windows NT system is structured within a security model that
-says that all applications and services must authenticate themselves before
-they can obtain permission from the security manager to do what they set out
-to do.</P
-><P
->The Windows NT User database also resides within the registry. This part of
-the registry contains the user's security identifier, home directory, group
-memberships, desktop profile, and so on.</P
-><P
->Every Windows NT system (workstation as well as server) will have its own
-registry. Windows NT Servers that participate in Domain Security control
-have a database that they share in common - thus they do NOT own an
-independent full registry database of their own, as do Workstations and
-plain Servers.</P
-><P
->The User database is called the SAM (Security Access Manager) database and
-is used for all user authentication as well as for authentication of inter-
-process authentication (i.e. to ensure that the service action a user has
-requested is permitted within the limits of that user's privileges).</P
-><P
->The Samba team have produced a utility that can dump the Windows NT SAM into
-smbpasswd format: see ENCRYPTION.txt for information on smbpasswd and
-/pub/samba/pwdump on your nearest Samba mirror for the utility. This
-facility is useful but cannot be easily used to implement SAM replication
-to Samba systems.</P
-><P
->Windows for Workgroups, Windows 95, and Windows NT Workstations and Servers
-can participate in a Domain security system that is controlled by Windows NT
-servers that have been correctly configured. Almost every domain will have
-ONE Primary Domain Controller (PDC). It is desirable that each domain will
-have at least one Backup Domain Controller (BDC).</P
-><P
->The PDC and BDCs then participate in replication of the SAM database so that
-each Domain Controlling participant will have an up to date SAM component
-within its registry.</P
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="NAVFOOTER"
-><HR
-ALIGN="LEFT"
-WIDTH="100%"><TABLE
-SUMMARY="Footer navigation table"
-WIDTH="100%"
-BORDER="0"
-CELLPADDING="0"
-CELLSPACING="0"
-><TR
-><TD
-WIDTH="33%"
-ALIGN="left"
-VALIGN="top"
-><A
-HREF="securitylevels.html"
-ACCESSKEY="P"
->Prev</A
-></TD
-><TD
-WIDTH="34%"
-ALIGN="center"
-VALIGN="top"
-><A
-HREF="samba-howto-collection.html"
-ACCESSKEY="H"
->Home</A
-></TD
-><TD
-WIDTH="33%"
-ALIGN="right"
-VALIGN="top"
-><A
-HREF="samba-bdc.html"
-ACCESSKEY="N"
->Next</A
-></TD
-></TR
-><TR
-><TD
-WIDTH="33%"
-ALIGN="left"
-VALIGN="top"
->User and Share security level (for servers not in a domain)</TD
-><TD
-WIDTH="34%"
-ALIGN="center"
-VALIGN="top"
-><A
-HREF="type.html"
-ACCESSKEY="U"
->Up</A
-></TD
-><TD
-WIDTH="33%"
-ALIGN="right"
-VALIGN="top"
->How to Act as a Backup Domain Controller in a Purely Samba Controlled Domain</TD
-></TR
-></TABLE
-></DIV
-></BODY
-></HTML
-> \ No newline at end of file
+has a domain controller). If the domain does NOT already have a Domain Controller
+then you do not yet have a Domain!
+</p><p>
+Configuring a Samba box as a DC for a domain that already by definition has a
+PDC is asking for trouble. Therefore, you should always configure the Samba DC
+to be the DMB for its domain and set <i class="parameter"><tt>security = user</tt></i>.
+This is the only officially supported mode of operation.
+</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2893548"></a>Common Problems and Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2893555"></a>I cannot include a '$' in a machine name</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+A 'machine account', (typically) stored in <tt class="filename">/etc/passwd</tt>,
+takes the form of the machine name with a '$' appended. FreeBSD (and other BSD
+systems?) won't create a user with a '$' in their name.
+</p><p>
+The problem is only in the program used to make the entry. Once made, it works perfectly.
+Create a user without the '$'. Then use <b class="command">vipw</b> to edit the entry, adding
+the '$'. Or create the whole entry with vipw if you like; make sure you use a unique User ID!
+</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2893594"></a>I get told &quot;You already have a connection to the Domain....&quot;
+or &quot;Cannot join domain, the credentials supplied conflict with an
+existing set..&quot; when creating a machine trust account.</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+This happens if you try to create a machine trust account from the
+machine itself and already have a connection (e.g. mapped drive)
+to a share (or IPC$) on the Samba PDC. The following command
+will remove all network drive connections:
+</p><pre class="screen">
+ <tt class="prompt">C:\WINNT\&gt;</tt> <b class="userinput"><tt>net use * /d</tt></b>
+</pre><p>
+Further, if the machine is already a 'member of a workgroup' that
+is the same name as the domain you are joining (bad idea) you will
+get this message. Change the workgroup name to something else, it
+does not matter what, reboot, and try again.
+</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2893643"></a>The system can not log you on (C000019B)....</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>I joined the domain successfully but after upgrading
+to a newer version of the Samba code I get the message, <span class="errorname">The system
+can not log you on (C000019B), Please try again or consult your
+system administrator</span> when attempting to logon.
+</p><p>
+This occurs when the domain SID stored in the secrets.tdb database
+is changed. The most common cause of a change in domain SID is when
+the domain name and/or the server name (NetBIOS name) is changed.
+The only way to correct the problem is to restore the original domain
+SID or remove the domain client from the domain and rejoin. The domain
+SID may be reset using either the net or rpcclient utilities.
+</p><p>
+The reset or change the domain SID you can use the net command as follows:
+
+</p><pre class="screen">
+<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>net getlocalsid 'OLDNAME'</tt></b>
+<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>net setlocalsid 'SID'</tt></b>
+</pre><p>
+</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2893714"></a>The machine trust account for this computer either does not
+exist or is not accessible.</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+When I try to join the domain I get the message <span class="errorname">The machine account
+for this computer either does not exist or is not accessible</span>. What's
+wrong?
+</p><p>
+This problem is caused by the PDC not having a suitable machine trust account.
+If you are using the <i class="parameter"><tt>add machine script</tt></i> method to create
+accounts then this would indicate that it has not worked. Ensure the domain
+admin user system is working.
+</p><p>
+Alternatively if you are creating account entries manually then they
+have not been created correctly. Make sure that you have the entry
+correct for the machine trust account in smbpasswd file on the Samba PDC.
+If you added the account using an editor rather than using the smbpasswd
+utility, make sure that the account name is the machine NetBIOS name
+with a '$' appended to it ( i.e. computer_name$ ). There must be an entry
+in both /etc/passwd and the smbpasswd file.
+</p><p>
+Some people have also reported
+that inconsistent subnet masks between the Samba server and the NT
+client can cause this problem. Make sure that these are consistent
+for both client and server.
+</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2893771"></a>When I attempt to login to a Samba Domain from a NT4/W2K workstation,
+I get a message about my account being disabled.</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+Enable the user accounts with <b class="userinput"><tt>smbpasswd -e <i class="replaceable"><tt>username</tt></i>
+</tt></b>, this is normally done as an account is created.
+</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2893798"></a>Until a few minutes after Samba has started, clients get the error &quot;Domain Controller Unavailable&quot;</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+ A domain controller has to announce on the network who it is. This usually takes a while.
+ </p></div></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="ServerType.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="type.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="samba-bdc.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 4. Server Types and Security Modes </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="index.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 6. Backup Domain Control</td></tr></table></div></body></html>
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/samba.7.html b/docs/htmldocs/samba.7.html
index 0851e99bd5..1e7add51c6 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/samba.7.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/samba.7.html
@@ -1,384 +1,113 @@
-<!DOCTYPE HTML PUBLIC "-//W3C//DTD HTML 4.01 Transitional//EN">
-<HTML
-><HEAD
-><TITLE
->samba</TITLE
-><META
-NAME="GENERATOR"
-CONTENT="Modular DocBook HTML Stylesheet Version 1.77"></HEAD
-><BODY
-CLASS="REFENTRY"
-BGCOLOR="#FFFFFF"
-TEXT="#000000"
-LINK="#0000FF"
-VLINK="#840084"
-ALINK="#0000FF"
-><H1
-><A
-NAME="SAMBA"
-></A
->samba</H1
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFNAMEDIV"
-><A
-NAME="AEN5"
-></A
-><H2
->Name</H2
->SAMBA&nbsp;--&nbsp;A Windows SMB/CIFS fileserver for UNIX</DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSYNOPSISDIV"
-><A
-NAME="AEN8"
-></A
-><H2
->Synopsis</H2
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->Samba</B
-> </P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN11"
-></A
-><H2
->DESCRIPTION</H2
-><P
->The Samba software suite is a collection of programs
+<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>samba</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="samba.7"></a><div class="titlepage"><div></div><div></div></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>Samba &#8212; A Windows SMB/CIFS fileserver for UNIX</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><tt class="command">Samba</tt> </p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>The Samba software suite is a collection of programs
that implements the Server Message Block (commonly abbreviated
as SMB) protocol for UNIX systems. This protocol is sometimes
also referred to as the Common Internet File System (CIFS). For a
- more thorough description, see <A
-HREF="http://www.ubiqx.org/cifs/"
-TARGET="_top"
-> http://www.ubiqx.org/cifs/</A
->. Samba also implements the NetBIOS
- protocol in nmbd.</P
-><P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbd</B
-></DT
-><DD
-><P
->The <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbd </B
->
- daemon provides the file and print services to
+ more thorough description, see <a href="http://www.ubiqx.org/cifs/" target="_top">
+ http://www.ubiqx.org/cifs/</a>. Samba also implements the NetBIOS
+ protocol in nmbd.</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term"><a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a></span></dt><dd><p>The <b class="command">smbd</b> daemon provides the file and print services to
SMB clients, such as Windows 95/98, Windows NT, Windows
for Workgroups or LanManager. The configuration file
- for this daemon is described in <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->smb.conf</TT
->
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->nmbd</B
-></DT
-><DD
-><P
->The <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->nmbd</B
->
+ for this daemon is described in <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a>
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="nmbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">nmbd</span>(8)</span></a></span></dt><dd><p>The <b class="command">nmbd</b>
daemon provides NetBIOS nameservice and browsing
support. The configuration file for this daemon
- is described in <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->smb.conf</TT
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbclient</B
-></DT
-><DD
-><P
->The <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbclient</B
->
+ is described in <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="smbclient.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbclient</span>(1)</span></a></span></dt><dd><p>The <b class="command">smbclient</b>
program implements a simple ftp-like client. This
is useful for accessing SMB shares on other compatible
servers (such as Windows NT), and can also be used
to allow a UNIX box to print to a printer attached to
- any SMB server (such as a PC running Windows NT).</P
-></DD
-><DT
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->testparm</B
-></DT
-><DD
-><P
->The <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->testparm</B
->
- utility is a simple syntax checker for Samba's
- <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->smb.conf</TT
->configuration file.</P
-></DD
-><DT
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->testprns</B
-></DT
-><DD
-><P
->The <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->testprns</B
->
+ any SMB server (such as a PC running Windows NT).</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="testparm.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">testparm</span>(1)</span></a></span></dt><dd><p>The <b class="command">testparm</b>
+ utility is a simple syntax checker for Samba's <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> configuration file.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="testprns.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">testprns</span>(1)</span></a></span></dt><dd><p>The <b class="command">testprns</b>
utility supports testing printer names defined
- in your <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->printcap</TT
-> file used
- by Samba.</P
-></DD
-><DT
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbstatus</B
-></DT
-><DD
-><P
->The <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbstatus</B
->
+ in your <tt class="filename">printcap</tt> file used
+ by Samba.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="smbstatus.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbstatus</span>(1)</span></a></span></dt><dd><p>The <b class="command">smbstatus</b>
tool provides access to information about the
- current connections to <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbd</B
->.</P
-></DD
-><DT
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->nmblookup</B
-></DT
-><DD
-><P
->The <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->nmblookup</B
->
+ current connections to <b class="command">smbd</b>.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="nmblookup.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">nmblookup</span>(1)</span></a></span></dt><dd><p>The <b class="command">nmblookup</b>
tools allows NetBIOS name queries to be made
- from a UNIX host.</P
-></DD
-><DT
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->make_smbcodepage</B
-></DT
-><DD
-><P
->The <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->make_smbcodepage</B
->
- utility provides a means of creating SMB code page
- definition files for your <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbd</B
-> server.</P
-></DD
-><DT
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbpasswd</B
-></DT
-><DD
-><P
->The <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbpasswd</B
->
+ from a UNIX host.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="smbgroupedit.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbgroupedit</span>(8)</span></a></span></dt><dd><p>The <b class="command">smbgroupedit</b>
+ tool allows for mapping unix groups to NT Builtin,
+ Domain, or Local groups. Also it allows setting
+ priviledges for that group, such as saAddUser, etc.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="smbpasswd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbpasswd</span>(8)</span></a></span></dt><dd><p>The <b class="command">smbpasswd</b>
command is a tool for changing LanMan and Windows NT
- password hashes on Samba and Windows NT servers.</P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN76"
-></A
-><H2
->COMPONENTS</H2
-><P
->The Samba suite is made up of several components. Each
+ password hashes on Samba and Windows NT servers.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="smbcacls.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbcacls</span>(1)</span></a></span></dt><dd><p>The <b class="command">smbcacls</b> command is
+ a tool to set ACL's on remote CIFS servers. </p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="smbsh.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbsh</span>(1)</span></a></span></dt><dd><p>The <b class="command">smbsh</b> command is
+ a program that allows you to run a unix shell with
+ with an overloaded VFS.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="smbtree.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbtree</span>(1)</span></a></span></dt><dd><p>The <b class="command">smbtree</b> command
+ is a text-based network neighborhood tool.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="smbtar.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbtar</span>(1)</span></a></span></dt><dd><p>The <b class="command">smbtar</b> can make
+ backups of data on CIFS/SMB servers.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="smbspool.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbspool</span>(8)</span></a></span></dt><dd><p><b class="command">smbspool</b> is a
+ helper utility for printing on printers connected
+ to CIFS servers. </p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="smbcontrol.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbcontrol</span>(1)</span></a></span></dt><dd><p><b class="command">smbcontrol</b> is a utility
+ that can change the behaviour of running samba daemons.
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="rpcclient.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">rpcclient</span>(1)</span></a></span></dt><dd><p><b class="command">rpcclient</b> is a utility
+ that can be used to execute RPC commands on remote
+ CIFS servers.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="pdbedit.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">pdbedit</span>(8)</span></a></span></dt><dd><p>The <b class="command">pdbedit</b> command
+ can be used to maintain the local user database on
+ a samba server.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="findsmb.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">findsmb</span>(1)</span></a></span></dt><dd><p>The <b class="command">findsmb</b> command
+ can be used to find SMB servers on the local network.
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="net.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">net</span>(8)</span></a></span></dt><dd><p>The <b class="command">net</b> command
+ is supposed to work similar to the DOS/Windows
+ NET.EXE command.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="swat.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">swat</span>(8)</span></a></span></dt><dd><p><b class="command">swat</b> is a web-based
+ interface to configuring <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>.
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="winbindd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">winbindd</span>(8)</span></a></span></dt><dd><p><b class="command">winbindd</b> is a daemon
+ that is used for integrating authentication and
+ the user database into unix.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="wbinfo.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">wbinfo</span>(1)</span></a></span></dt><dd><p><b class="command">wbinfo</b> is a utility
+ that retrieves and stores information related to winbind.
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="editreg.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">editreg</span>(1)</span></a></span></dt><dd><p><b class="command">editreg</b> is a command-line
+ utility that can edit windows registry files.
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="profiles.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">profiles</span>(1)</span></a></span></dt><dd><p><b class="command">profiles</b> is a command-line
+ utility that can be used to replace all occurences of
+ a certain SID with another SID.
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="vfstest.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">vfstest</span>(1)</span></a></span></dt><dd><p><b class="command">vfstest</b> is a utility
+ that can be used to test vfs modules.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="ntlm_auth.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">ntlm_auth</span>(1)</span></a></span></dt><dd><p><b class="command">ntlm_auth</b> is a helper-utility
+ for external programs wanting to do NTLM-authentication.
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="smbmount.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbmount</span>(8)</span></a>, <a href="smbumount.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbumount</span>(8)</span></a>, <a href="smbmount.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbmount</span>(8)</span></a></span></dt><dd><p><b class="command">smbmount</b>,<b class="command">smbmnt</b> and <b class="command">smbmnt</b> are commands that can be used to
+ mount CIFS/SMB shares on Linux.
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="smbcquotas.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbcquotas</span>(1)</span></a></span></dt><dd><p><b class="command">smbcquotas</b> is a tool that
+ can set remote QUOTA's on server with NTFS 5. </p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>COMPONENTS</h2><p>The Samba suite is made up of several components. Each
component is described in a separate manual page. It is strongly
recommended that you read the documentation that comes with Samba
and the manual pages of those components that you use. If the
manual pages and documents aren't clear enough then please visit
- <A
-HREF="http://devel.samba.org/"
-TARGET="_top"
->http://devel.samba.org</A
->
- for information on how to file a bug report or submit a patch.</P
-><P
->If you require help, visit the Samba webpage at
- <A
-HREF="http://samba.org/"
-TARGET="_top"
->http://www.samba.org/</A
-> and
+ <a href="http://devel.samba.org/" target="_top">http://devel.samba.org</a>
+ for information on how to file a bug report or submit a patch.</p><p>If you require help, visit the Samba webpage at
+ <a href="http://samba.org/" target="_top">http://www.samba.org/</a> and
explore the many option available to you.
- </P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN82"
-></A
-><H2
->AVAILABILITY</H2
-><P
->The Samba software suite is licensed under the
+ </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>AVAILABILITY</h2><p>The Samba software suite is licensed under the
GNU Public License(GPL). A copy of that license should
have come with the package in the file COPYING. You are
encouraged to distribute copies of the Samba suite, but
- please obey the terms of this license.</P
-><P
->The latest version of the Samba suite can be
+ please obey the terms of this license.</p><p>The latest version of the Samba suite can be
obtained via anonymous ftp from samba.org in the
directory pub/samba/. It is also available on several
- mirror sites worldwide.</P
-><P
->You may also find useful information about Samba
- on the newsgroup <A
-HREF="news:comp.protocols.smb"
-TARGET="_top"
-> comp.protocol.smb</A
-> and the Samba mailing
+ mirror sites worldwide.</p><p>You may also find useful information about Samba
+ on the newsgroup <a href="news:comp.protocols.smb" target="_top">
+ comp.protocol.smb</a> and the Samba mailing
list. Details on how to join the mailing list are given in
- the README file that comes with Samba.</P
-><P
->If you have access to a WWW viewer (such as Netscape
- or Mosaic) then you will also find lots of useful information,
+ the README file that comes with Samba.</p><p>If you have access to a WWW viewer (such as Mozilla
+ or Konqueror) then you will also find lots of useful information,
including back issues of the Samba mailing list, at
- <A
-HREF="http://lists.samba.org/"
-TARGET="_top"
->http://lists.samba.org</A
->.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN90"
-></A
-><H2
->VERSION</H2
-><P
->This man page is correct for version 2.2 of the
- Samba suite. </P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN93"
-></A
-><H2
->CONTRIBUTIONS</H2
-><P
->If you wish to contribute to the Samba project,
+ <a href="http://lists.samba.org/" target="_top">http://lists.samba.org</a>.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3.0 of the
+ Samba suite. </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>CONTRIBUTIONS</h2><p>If you wish to contribute to the Samba project,
then I suggest you join the Samba mailing list at
- <A
-HREF="http://lists.samba.org/"
-TARGET="_top"
->http://lists.samba.org</A
->.
- </P
-><P
->If you have patches to submit, visit
- <A
-HREF="http://devel.samba.org/"
-TARGET="_top"
->http://devel.samba.org/</A
->
- for information on how to do it properly. We prefer patches in
- <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->diff -u</B
-> format.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN100"
-></A
-><H2
->CONTRIBUTORS</H2
-><P
->Contributors to the project are now too numerous
+ <a href="http://lists.samba.org/" target="_top">http://lists.samba.org</a>.
+ </p><p>If you have patches to submit, visit
+ <a href="http://devel.samba.org/" target="_top">http://devel.samba.org/</a>
+ for information on how to do it properly. We prefer patches
+ in <b class="command">diff -u</b> format.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>CONTRIBUTORS</h2><p>Contributors to the project are now too numerous
to mention here but all deserve the thanks of all Samba
- users. To see a full list, look at <A
-HREF="ftp://samba.org/pub/samba/alpha/change-log"
-TARGET="_top"
-> ftp://samba.org/pub/samba/alpha/change-log</A
->
- for the pre-CVS changes and at <A
-HREF="ftp://samba.org/pub/samba/alpha/cvs.log"
-TARGET="_top"
-> ftp://samba.org/pub/samba/alpha/cvs.log</A
->
+ users. To see a full list, look at the
+ <tt class="filename">change-log</tt> in the source package
+ for the pre-CVS changes and at <a href="http://cvs.samba.org/" target="_top">
+ http://cvs.samba.org/</a>
for the contributors to Samba post-CVS. CVS is the Open Source
source code control system used by the Samba Team to develop
- Samba. The project would have been unmanageable without it.</P
-><P
->In addition, several commercial organizations now help
- fund the Samba Team with money and equipment. For details see
- the Samba Web pages at <A
-HREF="http://samba.org/samba/samba-thanks.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-> http://samba.org/samba/samba-thanks.html</A
->.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN107"
-></A
-><H2
->AUTHOR</H2
-><P
->The original Samba software and related utilities
+ Samba. The project would have been unmanageable without it.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
- to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</P
-><P
->The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer.
+ to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</p><p>The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer.
The man page sources were converted to YODL format (another
- excellent piece of Open Source software, available at
- <A
-HREF="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/"
-TARGET="_top"
-> ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/</A
->) and updated for the Samba 2.0
+ excellent piece of Open Source software, available at <a href="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/" target="_top">
+ ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/</a>) and updated for the Samba 2.0
release by Jeremy Allison. The conversion to DocBook for
- Samba 2.2 was done by Gerald Carter</P
-></DIV
-></BODY
-></HTML
-> \ No newline at end of file
+ Samba 2.2 was done by Gerald Carter. The conversion to DocBook XML
+ 4.2 for Samba 3.0 was done by Alexander Bokovoy.</p></div></div></body></html>
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/smb.conf.5.html b/docs/htmldocs/smb.conf.5.html
index 4f02951a9c..c154347a86 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/smb.conf.5.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/smb.conf.5.html
@@ -1,19776 +1,269 @@
-<!DOCTYPE HTML PUBLIC "-//W3C//DTD HTML 4.01//EN">
-<HTML
-><HEAD
-><TITLE
->smb.conf</TITLE
-><META
-NAME="GENERATOR"
-CONTENT="Modular DocBook HTML Stylesheet Version 1.76b+
-"></HEAD
-><BODY
-CLASS="REFENTRY"
-BGCOLOR="#FFFFFF"
-TEXT="#000000"
-LINK="#0000FF"
-VLINK="#840084"
-ALINK="#0000FF"
-><H1
-><A
-NAME="SMB.CONF">smb.conf</H1
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFNAMEDIV"
-><A
-NAME="AEN5"
-></A
-><H2
->Name</H2
->smb.conf&nbsp;--&nbsp;The configuration file for the Samba suite</DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN8"
-></A
-><H2
->SYNOPSIS</H2
-><P
->The <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->smb.conf</TT
-> file is a configuration
- file for the Samba suite. <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->smb.conf</TT
-> contains
- runtime configuration information for the Samba programs. The
- <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->smb.conf</TT
-> file is designed to be configured and
- administered by the <A
-HREF="swat.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->swat(8)</B
->
- </A
-> program. The complete description of the file format and
- possible parameters held within are here for reference purposes.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN16"
-></A
-><H2
->FILE FORMAT</H2
-><P
->The file consists of sections and parameters. A section
+<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>smb.conf</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="smb.conf.5"></a><div class="titlepage"><div></div><div></div></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>smb.conf &#8212; The configuration file for the Samba suite</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>SYNOPSIS</h2><p>The <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file is a configuration
+ file for the Samba suite. <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> contains
+ runtime configuration information for the Samba programs. The <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file
+ is designed to be configured and administered by the <a href="swat.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">swat</span>(8)</span></a> program. The complete
+ description of the file format and possible parameters held within
+ are here for reference purposes.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="FILEFORMATSECT"></a><h2>FILE FORMAT</h2><p>The file consists of sections and parameters. A section
begins with the name of the section in square brackets and continues
until the next section begins. Sections contain parameters of the
- form</P
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="REPLACEABLE"
-><I
->name</I
-></TT
-> = <TT
-CLASS="REPLACEABLE"
-><I
->value
- </I
-></TT
-></P
-><P
->The file is line-based - that is, each newline-terminated
- line represents either a comment, a section name or a parameter.</P
-><P
->Section and parameter names are not case sensitive.</P
-><P
->Only the first equals sign in a parameter is significant.
+ form</p><p><i class="replaceable"><tt>name</tt></i> = <i class="replaceable"><tt>value
+ </tt></i></p><p>The file is line-based - that is, each newline-terminated
+ line represents either a comment, a section name or a parameter.</p><p>Section and parameter names are not case sensitive.</p><p>Only the first equals sign in a parameter is significant.
Whitespace before or after the first equals sign is discarded.
Leading, trailing and internal whitespace in section and parameter
names is irrelevant. Leading and trailing whitespace in a parameter
value is discarded. Internal whitespace within a parameter value
- is retained verbatim.</P
-><P
->Any line beginning with a semicolon (';') or a hash ('#')
- character is ignored, as are lines containing only whitespace.</P
-><P
->Any line ending in a '\' is continued
- on the next line in the customary UNIX fashion.</P
-><P
->The values following the equals sign in parameters are all
+ is retained verbatim.</p><p>Any line beginning with a semicolon (';') or a hash ('#')
+ character is ignored, as are lines containing only whitespace.</p><p>Any line ending in a '\' is continued
+ on the next line in the customary UNIX fashion.</p><p>The values following the equals sign in parameters are all
either a string (no quotes needed) or a boolean, which may be given
as yes/no, 0/1 or true/false. Case is not significant in boolean
values, but is preserved in string values. Some items such as
- create modes are numeric.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN28"
-></A
-><H2
->SECTION DESCRIPTIONS</H2
-><P
->Each section in the configuration file (except for the
+ create modes are numeric.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>SECTION DESCRIPTIONS</h2><p>Each section in the configuration file (except for the
[global] section) describes a shared resource (known
- as a "share"). The section name is the name of the
+ as a &quot;share&quot;). The section name is the name of the
shared resource and the parameters within the section define
- the shares attributes.</P
-><P
->There are three special sections, [global],
+ the shares attributes.</p><p>There are three special sections, [global],
[homes] and [printers], which are
- described under <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->special sections</I
->. The
- following notes apply to ordinary section descriptions.</P
-><P
->A share consists of a directory to which access is being
+ described under <span class="emphasis"><em>special sections</em></span>. The
+ following notes apply to ordinary section descriptions.</p><p>A share consists of a directory to which access is being
given plus a description of the access rights which are granted
to the user of the service. Some housekeeping options are
- also specifiable.</P
-><P
->Sections are either file share services (used by the
+ also specifiable.</p><p>Sections are either file share services (used by the
client as an extension of their native file systems) or
printable services (used by the client to access print services
- on the host running the server).</P
-><P
->Sections may be designated <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->guest</I
-> services,
+ on the host running the server).</p><p>Sections may be designated <span class="emphasis"><em>guest</em></span> services,
in which case no password is required to access them. A specified
- UNIX <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->guest account</I
-> is used to define access
- privileges in this case.</P
-><P
->Sections other than guest services will require a password
+ UNIX <span class="emphasis"><em>guest account</em></span> is used to define access
+ privileges in this case.</p><p>Sections other than guest services will require a password
to access them. The client provides the username. As older clients
only provide passwords and not usernames, you may specify a list
- of usernames to check against the password using the "user ="
+ of usernames to check against the password using the &quot;user =&quot;
option in the share definition. For modern clients such as
- Windows 95/98/ME/NT/2000, this should not be necessary.</P
-><P
->Note that the access rights granted by the server are
+ Windows 95/98/ME/NT/2000, this should not be necessary.</p><p>Note that the access rights granted by the server are
masked by the access rights granted to the specified or guest
UNIX user by the host system. The server does not grant more
- access than the host system grants.</P
-><P
->The following sample section defines a file space share.
- The user has write access to the path <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/home/bar</TT
->.
- The share is accessed via the share name "foo":</P
-><TABLE
-BORDER="0"
-BGCOLOR="#E0E0E0"
-WIDTH="100%"
-><TR
-><TD
-><PRE
-CLASS="SCREEN"
-> <TT
-CLASS="COMPUTEROUTPUT"
-> [foo]
- path = /home/bar
- read only = no
- </TT
->
- </PRE
-></TD
-></TR
-></TABLE
-><P
->The following sample section defines a printable share.
+ access than the host system grants.</p><p>The following sample section defines a file space share.
+ The user has write access to the path <tt class="filename">/home/bar</tt>.
+ The share is accessed via the share name &quot;foo&quot;:</p><pre class="screen">
+<tt class="computeroutput">
+[foo]
+ path = /home/bar
+ read only = no
+</tt>
+</pre><p>The following sample section defines a printable share.
The share is readonly, but printable. That is, the only write
access permitted is via calls to open, write to and close a
- spool file. The <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->guest ok</I
-> parameter means
+ spool file. The <span class="emphasis"><em>guest ok</em></span> parameter means
access will be permitted as the default guest user (specified
- elsewhere):</P
-><TABLE
-BORDER="0"
-BGCOLOR="#E0E0E0"
-WIDTH="100%"
-><TR
-><TD
-><PRE
-CLASS="SCREEN"
-> <TT
-CLASS="COMPUTEROUTPUT"
-> [aprinter]
- path = /usr/spool/public
- read only = yes
- printable = yes
- guest ok = yes
- </TT
->
- </PRE
-></TD
-></TR
-></TABLE
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN48"
-></A
-><H2
->SPECIAL SECTIONS</H2
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN50"
-></A
-><H3
->The [global] section</H3
-><P
->parameters in this section apply to the server
+ elsewhere):</p><pre class="screen">
+<tt class="computeroutput">
+[aprinter]
+ path = /usr/spool/public
+ read only = yes
+ printable = yes
+ guest ok = yes
+</tt>
+</pre></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>SPECIAL SECTIONS</h2><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><h3>The [global] section</h3><p>parameters in this section apply to the server
as a whole, or are defaults for sections which do not
specifically define certain items. See the notes
- under PARAMETERS for more information.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN53"
-></A
-><H3
->The [homes] section</H3
-><P
->If a section called homes is included in the
+ under PARAMETERS for more information.</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="HOMESECT"></a><h3>The [homes] section</h3><p>If a section called homes is included in the
configuration file, services connecting clients to their
- home directories can be created on the fly by the server.</P
-><P
->When the connection request is made, the existing
+ home directories can be created on the fly by the server.</p><p>When the connection request is made, the existing
sections are scanned. If a match is found, it is used. If no
match is found, the requested section name is treated as a
user name and looked up in the local password file. If the
name exists and the correct password has been given, a share is
- created by cloning the [homes] section.</P
-><P
->Some modifications are then made to the newly
- created share:</P
-><P
-></P
-><UL
-><LI
-><P
->The share name is changed from homes to
- the located username.</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->If no path was given, the path is set to
- the user's home directory.</P
-></LI
-></UL
-><P
->If you decide to use a <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->path =</I
-> line
+ created by cloning the [homes] section.</p><p>Some modifications are then made to the newly
+ created share:</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>The share name is changed from homes to
+ the located username.</p></li><li><p>If no path was given, the path is set to
+ the user's home directory.</p></li></ul></div><p>If you decide to use a <span class="emphasis"><em>path =</em></span> line
in your [homes] section then you may find it useful
- to use the %S macro. For example :</P
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="USERINPUT"
-><B
->path = /data/pchome/%S</B
-></TT
-></P
-><P
->would be useful if you have different home directories
- for your PCs than for UNIX access.</P
-><P
->This is a fast and simple way to give a large number
+ to use the %S macro. For example :</p><p><b class="userinput"><tt>path = /data/pchome/%S</tt></b></p><p>would be useful if you have different home directories
+ for your PCs than for UNIX access.</p><p>This is a fast and simple way to give a large number
of clients access to their home directories with a minimum
- of fuss.</P
-><P
->A similar process occurs if the requested section
- name is "homes", except that the share name is not
+ of fuss.</p><p>A similar process occurs if the requested section
+ name is &quot;homes&quot;, except that the share name is not
changed to that of the requesting user. This method of using
the [homes] section works well if different users share
- a client PC.</P
-><P
->The [homes] section can specify all the parameters
+ a client PC.</p><p>The [homes] section can specify all the parameters
a normal service section can specify, though some make more sense
than others. The following is a typical and suitable [homes]
- section:</P
-><TABLE
-BORDER="0"
-BGCOLOR="#E0E0E0"
-WIDTH="100%"
-><TR
-><TD
-><PRE
-CLASS="SCREEN"
-> <TT
-CLASS="COMPUTEROUTPUT"
-> [homes]
- read only = no
- </TT
->
- </PRE
-></TD
-></TR
-></TABLE
-><P
->An important point is that if guest access is specified
+ section:</p><pre class="screen">
+<tt class="computeroutput">
+[homes]
+ read only = no
+</tt>
+</pre><p>An important point is that if guest access is specified
in the [homes] section, all home directories will be
- visible to all clients <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->without a password</I
->.
+ visible to all clients <span class="emphasis"><em>without a password</em></span>.
In the very unlikely event that this is actually desirable, it
- would be wise to also specify <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->read only
- access</I
->.</P
-><P
->Note that the <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->browseable</I
-> flag for
+ would be wise to also specify <span class="emphasis"><em>read only
+ access</em></span>.</p><p>Note that the <span class="emphasis"><em>browseable</em></span> flag for
auto home directories will be inherited from the global browseable
flag, not the [homes] browseable flag. This is useful as
- it means setting <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->browseable = no</I
-> in
+ it means setting <span class="emphasis"><em>browseable = no</em></span> in
the [homes] section will hide the [homes] share but make
- any auto home directories visible.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN79"
-></A
-><H3
->The [printers] section</H3
-><P
->This section works like [homes],
- but for printers.</P
-><P
->If a [printers] section occurs in the
+ any auto home directories visible.</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="PRINTERSSECT"></a><h3>The [printers] section</h3><p>This section works like [homes],
+ but for printers.</p><p>If a [printers] section occurs in the
configuration file, users are able to connect to any printer
- specified in the local host's printcap file.</P
-><P
->When a connection request is made, the existing sections
+ specified in the local host's printcap file.</p><p>When a connection request is made, the existing sections
are scanned. If a match is found, it is used. If no match is found,
but a [homes] section exists, it is used as described
above. Otherwise, the requested section name is treated as a
printer name and the appropriate printcap file is scanned to see
if the requested section name is a valid printer share name. If
a match is found, a new printer share is created by cloning
- the [printers] section.</P
-><P
->A few modifications are then made to the newly created
- share:</P
-><P
-></P
-><UL
-><LI
-><P
->The share name is set to the located printer
- name</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->If no printer name was given, the printer name
- is set to the located printer name</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->If the share does not permit guest access and
+ the [printers] section.</p><p>A few modifications are then made to the newly created
+ share:</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>The share name is set to the located printer
+ name</p></li><li><p>If no printer name was given, the printer name
+ is set to the located printer name</p></li><li><p>If the share does not permit guest access and
no username was given, the username is set to the located
- printer name.</P
-></LI
-></UL
-><P
->Note that the [printers] service MUST be
+ printer name.</p></li></ul></div><p>Note that the [printers] service MUST be
printable - if you specify otherwise, the server will refuse
- to load the configuration file.</P
-><P
->Typically the path specified would be that of a
+ to load the configuration file.</p><p>Typically the path specified would be that of a
world-writeable spool directory with the sticky bit set on
it. A typical [printers] entry would look like
- this:</P
-><TABLE
-BORDER="0"
-BGCOLOR="#E0E0E0"
-WIDTH="100%"
-><TR
-><TD
-><PRE
-CLASS="SCREEN"
-><TT
-CLASS="COMPUTEROUTPUT"
-> [printers]
- path = /usr/spool/public
- guest ok = yes
- printable = yes
- </TT
-></PRE
-></TD
-></TR
-></TABLE
-><P
->All aliases given for a printer in the printcap file
+ this:</p><pre class="screen"><tt class="computeroutput">
+[printers]
+ path = /usr/spool/public
+ guest ok = yes
+ printable = yes
+</tt></pre><p>All aliases given for a printer in the printcap file
are legitimate printer names as far as the server is concerned.
If your printing subsystem doesn't work like that, you will have
to set up a pseudo-printcap. This is a file consisting of one or
- more lines like this:</P
-><TABLE
-BORDER="0"
-BGCOLOR="#E0E0E0"
-WIDTH="100%"
-><TR
-><TD
-><PRE
-CLASS="SCREEN"
-> <TT
-CLASS="COMPUTEROUTPUT"
-> alias|alias|alias|alias...
- </TT
->
- </PRE
-></TD
-></TR
-></TABLE
-><P
->Each alias should be an acceptable printer name for
+ more lines like this:</p><pre class="screen">
+<tt class="computeroutput">
+alias|alias|alias|alias...
+</tt>
+</pre><p>Each alias should be an acceptable printer name for
your printing subsystem. In the [global] section, specify
the new file as your printcap. The server will then only recognize
names found in your pseudo-printcap, which of course can contain
whatever aliases you like. The same technique could be used
- simply to limit access to a subset of your local printers.</P
-><P
->An alias, by the way, is defined as any component of the
+ simply to limit access to a subset of your local printers.</p><p>An alias, by the way, is defined as any component of the
first entry of a printcap record. Records are separated by newlines,
components (if there are more than one) are separated by vertical
- bar symbols ('|').</P
-><P
->NOTE: On SYSV systems which use lpstat to determine what
+ bar symbols ('|').</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p>On SYSV systems which use lpstat to determine what
printers are defined on the system you may be able to use
- "printcap name = lpstat" to automatically obtain a list
- of printers. See the "printcap name" option
- for more details.</P
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN102"
-></A
-><H2
->PARAMETERS</H2
-><P
->parameters define the specific attributes of sections.</P
-><P
->Some parameters are specific to the [global] section
- (e.g., <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->security</I
->). Some parameters are usable
- in all sections (e.g., <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->create mode</I
->). All others
+ &quot;printcap name = lpstat&quot; to automatically obtain a list
+ of printers. See the &quot;printcap name&quot; option
+ for more details.</p></div></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>PARAMETERS</h2><p>parameters define the specific attributes of sections.</p><p>Some parameters are specific to the [global] section
+ (e.g., <span class="emphasis"><em>security</em></span>). Some parameters are usable
+ in all sections (e.g., <span class="emphasis"><em>create mode</em></span>). All others
are permissible only in normal sections. For the purposes of the
following descriptions the [homes] and [printers]
- sections will be considered normal. The letter <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->G</I
->
+ sections will be considered normal. The letter <span class="emphasis"><em>G</em></span>
in parentheses indicates that a parameter is specific to the
- [global] section. The letter <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->S</I
->
+ [global] section. The letter <span class="emphasis"><em>S</em></span>
indicates that a parameter can be specified in a service specific
- section. Note that all <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->S</I
-> parameters can also be specified in
+ section. Note that all <span class="emphasis"><em>S</em></span> parameters can also be specified in
the [global] section - in which case they will define
- the default behavior for all services.</P
-><P
->parameters are arranged here in alphabetical order - this may
+ the default behavior for all services.</p><p>parameters are arranged here in alphabetical order - this may
not create best bedfellows, but at least you can find them! Where
there are synonyms, the preferred synonym is described, others refer
- to the preferred synonym.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN112"
-></A
-><H2
->VARIABLE SUBSTITUTIONS</H2
-><P
->Many of the strings that are settable in the config file
- can take substitutions. For example the option "path =
- /tmp/%u" would be interpreted as "path =
- /tmp/john" if the user connected with the username john.</P
-><P
->These substitutions are mostly noted in the descriptions below,
+ to the preferred synonym.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>VARIABLE SUBSTITUTIONS</h2><p>Many of the strings that are settable in the config file
+ can take substitutions. For example the option &quot;path =
+ /tmp/%u&quot; would be interpreted as &quot;path =
+ /tmp/john&quot; if the user connected with the username john.</p><p>These substitutions are mostly noted in the descriptions below,
but there are some general substitutions which apply whenever they
- might be relevant. These are:</P
-><P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
->%U</DT
-><DD
-><P
->session user name (the user name that the client
- wanted, not necessarily the same as the one they got).</P
-></DD
-><DT
->%G</DT
-><DD
-><P
->primary group name of %U.</P
-></DD
-><DT
->%h</DT
-><DD
-><P
->the Internet hostname that Samba is running
- on.</P
-></DD
-><DT
->%m</DT
-><DD
-><P
->the NetBIOS name of the client machine
- (very useful).</P
-></DD
-><DT
->%L</DT
-><DD
-><P
->the NetBIOS name of the server. This allows you
+ might be relevant. These are:</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">%U</span></dt><dd><p>session user name (the user name that the client
+ wanted, not necessarily the same as the one they got).</p></dd><dt><span class="term">%G</span></dt><dd><p>primary group name of %U.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">%h</span></dt><dd><p>the Internet hostname that Samba is running
+ on.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">%m</span></dt><dd><p>the NetBIOS name of the client machine
+ (very useful).</p></dd><dt><span class="term">%L</span></dt><dd><p>the NetBIOS name of the server. This allows you
to change your config based on what the client calls you. Your
- server can have a "dual personality".</P
-><P
->Note that this parameter is not available when Samba listens
- on port 445, as clients no longer send this information </P
-></DD
-><DT
->%M</DT
-><DD
-><P
->the Internet name of the client machine.
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
->%R</DT
-><DD
-><P
->the selected protocol level after
+ server can have a &quot;dual personality&quot;.</p><p>Note that this parameter is not available when Samba listens
+ on port 445, as clients no longer send this information </p></dd><dt><span class="term">%M</span></dt><dd><p>the Internet name of the client machine.
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term">%R</span></dt><dd><p>the selected protocol level after
protocol negotiation. It can be one of CORE, COREPLUS,
- LANMAN1, LANMAN2 or NT1.</P
-></DD
-><DT
->%d</DT
-><DD
-><P
->The process id of the current server
- process.</P
-></DD
-><DT
->%a</DT
-><DD
-><P
->the architecture of the remote
+ LANMAN1, LANMAN2 or NT1.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">%d</span></dt><dd><p>The process id of the current server
+ process.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">%a</span></dt><dd><p>the architecture of the remote
machine. Only some are recognized, and those may not be
100% reliable. It currently recognizes Samba, WfWg, Win95,
WinNT and Win2k. Anything else will be known as
- "UNKNOWN". If it gets it wrong then sending a level
- 3 log to <A
-HREF="mailto:samba@samba.org"
-TARGET="_top"
->samba@samba.org
- </A
-> should allow it to be fixed.</P
-></DD
-><DT
->%I</DT
-><DD
-><P
->The IP address of the client machine.</P
-></DD
-><DT
->%T</DT
-><DD
-><P
->the current date and time.</P
-></DD
-><DT
->%D</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Name of the domain or workgroup of the current user.</P
-></DD
-><DT
->%$(<TT
-CLASS="REPLACEABLE"
-><I
->envvar</I
-></TT
->)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->The value of the environment variable
- <TT
-CLASS="REPLACEABLE"
-><I
->envar</I
-></TT
->.</P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-><P
->The following substitutes apply only to some configuration options(only those
- that are used when a connection has been established):</P
-><P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
->%S</DT
-><DD
-><P
->the name of the current service, if any.</P
-></DD
-><DT
->%P</DT
-><DD
-><P
->the root directory of the current service,
- if any.</P
-></DD
-><DT
->%u</DT
-><DD
-><P
->user name of the current service, if any.</P
-></DD
-><DT
->%g</DT
-><DD
-><P
->primary group name of %u.</P
-></DD
-><DT
->%H</DT
-><DD
-><P
->the home directory of the user given
- by %u.</P
-></DD
-><DT
->%N</DT
-><DD
-><P
->the name of your NIS home directory server.
+ &quot;UNKNOWN&quot;. If it gets it wrong then sending a level
+ 3 log to <a href="mailto:samba@samba.org" target="_top">samba@samba.org
+ </a> should allow it to be fixed.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">%I</span></dt><dd><p>The IP address of the client machine.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">%T</span></dt><dd><p>the current date and time.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">%D</span></dt><dd><p>Name of the domain or workgroup of the current user.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">%$(<i class="replaceable"><tt>envvar</tt></i>)</span></dt><dd><p>The value of the environment variable
+ <i class="replaceable"><tt>envar</tt></i>.</p></dd></dl></div><p>The following substitutes apply only to some configuration options(only those
+ that are used when a connection has been established):</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">%S</span></dt><dd><p>the name of the current service, if any.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">%P</span></dt><dd><p>the root directory of the current service,
+ if any.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">%u</span></dt><dd><p>user name of the current service, if any.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">%g</span></dt><dd><p>primary group name of %u.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">%H</span></dt><dd><p>the home directory of the user given
+ by %u.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">%N</span></dt><dd><p>the name of your NIS home directory server.
This is obtained from your NIS auto.map entry. If you have
- not compiled Samba with the <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->--with-automount</I
->
- option then this value will be the same as %L.</P
-></DD
-><DT
->%p</DT
-><DD
-><P
->the path of the service's home directory,
+ not compiled Samba with the <span class="emphasis"><em>--with-automount</em></span>
+ option then this value will be the same as %L.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">%p</span></dt><dd><p>the path of the service's home directory,
obtained from your NIS auto.map entry. The NIS auto.map entry
- is split up as "%N:%p".</P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-><P
->There are some quite creative things that can be done
- with these substitutions and other smb.conf options.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN205"
-></A
-><H2
->NAME MANGLING</H2
-><P
->Samba supports "name mangling" so that DOS and
+ is split up as &quot;%N:%p&quot;.</p></dd></dl></div><p>There are some quite creative things that can be done
+ with these substitutions and other smb.conf options.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="NAMEMANGLINGSECT"></a><h2>NAME MANGLING</h2><p>Samba supports &quot;name mangling&quot; so that DOS and
Windows clients can use files that don't conform to the 8.3 format.
- It can also be set to adjust the case of 8.3 format filenames.</P
-><P
->There are several options that control the way mangling is
+ It can also be set to adjust the case of 8.3 format filenames.</p><p>There are several options that control the way mangling is
performed, and they are grouped here rather than listed separately.
- For the defaults look at the output of the testparm program. </P
-><P
->All of these options can be set separately for each service
- (or globally, of course). </P
-><P
->The options are: </P
-><P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
->mangle case = yes/no</DT
-><DD
-><P
-> controls if names that have characters that
- aren't of the "default" case are mangled. For example,
- if this is yes then a name like "Mail" would be mangled.
- Default <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->no</I
->.</P
-></DD
-><DT
->case sensitive = yes/no</DT
-><DD
-><P
->controls whether filenames are case sensitive. If
+ For the defaults look at the output of the testparm program. </p><p>All of these options can be set separately for each service
+ (or globally, of course). </p><p>The options are: </p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">mangle case = yes/no</span></dt><dd><p> controls if names that have characters that
+ aren't of the &quot;default&quot; case are mangled. For example,
+ if this is yes then a name like &quot;Mail&quot; would be mangled.
+ Default <span class="emphasis"><em>no</em></span>.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">case sensitive = yes/no</span></dt><dd><p>controls whether filenames are case sensitive. If
they aren't then Samba must do a filename search and match on passed
- names. Default <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->no</I
->.</P
-></DD
-><DT
->default case = upper/lower</DT
-><DD
-><P
->controls what the default case is for new
- filenames. Default <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->lower</I
->.</P
-></DD
-><DT
->preserve case = yes/no</DT
-><DD
-><P
->controls if new files are created with the
+ names. Default <span class="emphasis"><em>no</em></span>.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">default case = upper/lower</span></dt><dd><p>controls what the default case is for new
+ filenames. Default <span class="emphasis"><em>lower</em></span>.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">preserve case = yes/no</span></dt><dd><p>controls if new files are created with the
case that the client passes, or if they are forced to be the
- "default" case. Default <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->yes</I
->.
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
->short preserve case = yes/no</DT
-><DD
-><P
->controls if new files which conform to 8.3 syntax,
+ &quot;default&quot; case. Default <span class="emphasis"><em>yes</em></span>.
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term">short preserve case = yes/no</span></dt><dd><p>controls if new files which conform to 8.3 syntax,
that is all in upper case and of suitable length, are created
- upper case, or if they are forced to be the "default"
- case. This option can be use with "preserve case = yes"
+ upper case, or if they are forced to be the &quot;default&quot;
+ case. This option can be use with &quot;preserve case = yes&quot;
to permit long filenames to retain their case, while short names
- are lowercased. Default <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->yes</I
->.</P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-><P
->By default, Samba 3.0 has the same semantics as a Windows
- NT server, in that it is case insensitive but case preserving.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN238"
-></A
-><H2
->NOTE ABOUT USERNAME/PASSWORD VALIDATION</H2
-><P
->There are a number of ways in which a user can connect
+ are lowercased. Default <span class="emphasis"><em>yes</em></span>.</p></dd></dl></div><p>By default, Samba 3.0 has the same semantics as a Windows
+ NT server, in that it is case insensitive but case preserving.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="VALIDATIONSECT"></a><h2>NOTE ABOUT USERNAME/PASSWORD VALIDATION</h2><p>There are a number of ways in which a user can connect
to a service. The server uses the following steps in determining
if it will allow a connection to a specified service. If all the
steps fail, then the connection request is rejected. However, if one of the
- steps succeeds, then the following steps are not checked.</P
-><P
->If the service is marked "guest only = yes" and the
- server is running with share-level security ("security = share")
- then steps 1 to 5 are skipped.</P
-><P
-></P
-><OL
-TYPE="1"
-><LI
-><P
->If the client has passed a username/password
+ steps succeeds, then the following steps are not checked.</p><p>If the service is marked &quot;guest only = yes&quot; and the
+ server is running with share-level security (&quot;security = share&quot;)
+ then steps 1 to 5 are skipped.</p><div class="orderedlist"><ol type="1"><li><p>If the client has passed a username/password
pair and that username/password pair is validated by the UNIX
system's password programs then the connection is made as that
username. Note that this includes the
- \\server\service%<TT
-CLASS="REPLACEABLE"
-><I
->username</I
-></TT
-> method of passing
- a username.</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->If the client has previously registered a username
+ \\server\service%<i class="replaceable"><tt>username</tt></i> method of passing
+ a username.</p></li><li><p>If the client has previously registered a username
with the system and now supplies a correct password for that
- username then the connection is allowed.</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->The client's NetBIOS name and any previously
+ username then the connection is allowed.</p></li><li><p>The client's NetBIOS name and any previously
used user names are checked against the supplied password, if
they match then the connection is allowed as the corresponding
- user.</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->If the client has previously validated a
+ user.</p></li><li><p>If the client has previously validated a
username/password pair with the server and the client has passed
- the validation token then that username is used. </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->If a "user = " field is given in the
- <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->smb.conf</TT
-> file for the service and the client
+ the validation token then that username is used. </p></li><li><p>If a &quot;user = &quot; field is given in the
+ <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file for the service and the client
has supplied a password, and that password matches (according to
the UNIX system's password checking) with one of the usernames
- from the "user =" field then the connection is made as
- the username in the "user =" line. If one
- of the username in the "user =" list begins with a
+ from the &quot;user =&quot; field then the connection is made as
+ the username in the &quot;user =&quot; line. If one
+ of the username in the &quot;user =&quot; list begins with a
'@' then that name expands to a list of names in
- the group of the same name.</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->If the service is a guest service then a
- connection is made as the username given in the "guest
- account =" for the service, irrespective of the
- supplied password.</P
-></LI
-></OL
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN257"
-></A
-><H2
->COMPLETE LIST OF GLOBAL PARAMETERS</H2
-><P
->Here is a list of all global parameters. See the section of
- each parameter for details. Note that some are synonyms.</P
-><P
-></P
-><UL
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#ABORTSHUTDOWNSCRIPT"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->abort shutdown script</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#ADDGROUPSCRIPT"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->add group script</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#ADDPRINTERCOMMAND"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->addprinter command</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#ADDSHARECOMMAND"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->add share command</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#ADDUSERSCRIPT"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->add user script</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#ADDUSERTOGROUPSCRIPT"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->add user to group script</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#ADDMACHINESCRIPT"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->add machine script</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#DELETEGROUPSCRIPT"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->delete group script</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#ADSSERVER"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->ads server</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#ALGORITHMICRIDBASE"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->algorithmic rid base</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#ALLOWTRUSTEDDOMAINS"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->allow trusted domains</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#ANNOUNCEAS"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->announce as</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#ANNOUNCEVERSION"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->announce version</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#AUTHMETHODS"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->auth methods</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#AUTOSERVICES"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->auto services</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#BINDINTERFACESONLY"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->bind interfaces only</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#BROWSELIST"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->browse list</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#CHANGENOTIFYTIMEOUT"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->change notify timeout</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#CHANGESHARECOMMAND"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->change share command</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#CONFIGFILE"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->config file</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#DEADTIME"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->deadtime</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#DEBUGHIRESTIMESTAMP"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->debug hires timestamp</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#DEBUGPID"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->debug pid</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#DEBUGTIMESTAMP"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->debug timestamp</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#DEBUGUID"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->debug uid</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#DEBUGLEVEL"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->debuglevel</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#DEFAULT"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->default</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#DEFAULTSERVICE"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->default service</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#DELETEPRINTERCOMMAND"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->deleteprinter command</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#DELETESHARECOMMAND"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->delete share command</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#DELETEUSERSCRIPT"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->delete user script</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#DELETEUSERFROMGROUPSCRIPT"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->delete user from group script</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#DFREECOMMAND"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->dfree command</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#DISABLENETBIOS"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->disable netbios</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#DISABLESPOOLSS"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->disable spoolss</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#DISPLAYCHARSET"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->display charset</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#DNSPROXY"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->dns proxy</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#DOMAINLOGONS"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->domain logons</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#DOMAINMASTER"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->domain master</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#DOSCHARSET"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->dos charset</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#ENCRYPTPASSWORDS"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->encrypt passwords</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#ENHANCEDBROWSING"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->enhanced browsing</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#ENUMPORTSCOMMAND"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->enumports command</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#GETWDCACHE"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->getwd cache</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#HIDELOCALUSERS"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->hide local users</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#HIDEUNREADABLE"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->hide unreadable</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#HIDEUNWRITEABLEFILES"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->hide unwriteable files</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#HIDESPECIALFILES"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->hide special files</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#HOMEDIRMAP"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->homedir map</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#HOSTMSDFS"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->host msdfs</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#HOSTNAMELOOKUPS"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->hostname lookups</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#HOSTSEQUIV"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->hosts equiv</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#INTERFACES"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->interfaces</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#KEEPALIVE"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->keepalive</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#KERNELOPLOCKS"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->kernel oplocks</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#LANMANAUTH"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->lanman auth</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#LARGEREADWRITE"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->large readwrite</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#LDAPADMINDN"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->ldap admin dn</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#LDAPDELETEDN"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->ldap delete dn</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#LDAPDELONLYSAMATTR"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->ldap del only sam attr</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#LDAPFILTER"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->ldap filter</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#LDAPPORT"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->ldap port</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#LDAPSERVER"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->ldap server</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#LDAPSSL"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->ldap ssl</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#LDAPSUFFIX"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->ldap suffix</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#LDAPUSERSUFFIX"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->ldap user suffix</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#LDAPMACHINESUFFIX"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->ldap machine suffix</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#LDAPPASSWDSYNC"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->ldap passwd sync</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#LDAPTRUSTIDS"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->ldap trust ids</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#LMANNOUNCE"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->lm announce</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#LMINTERVAL"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->lm interval</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#LOADPRINTERS"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->load printers</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#LOCALMASTER"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->local master</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#LOCKDIR"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->lock dir</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#LOCKDIRECTORY"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->lock directory</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#LOCKSPINCOUNT"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->lock spin count</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#LOCKSPINTIME"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->lock spin time</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#PIDDIRECTORY"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->pid directory</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#LOGFILE"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->log file</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#LOGLEVEL"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->log level</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#LOGONDRIVE"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->logon drive</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#LOGONHOME"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->logon home</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#LOGONPATH"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->logon path</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#LOGONSCRIPT"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->logon script</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#LPQCACHETIME"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->lpq cache time</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#MACHINEPASSWORDTIMEOUT"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->machine password timeout</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#MANGLEDSTACK"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->mangled stack</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#MAPTOGUEST"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->map to guest</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#MAXDISKSIZE"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->max disk size</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#MAXLOGSIZE"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->max log size</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#MAXMUX"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->max mux</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#MAXOPENFILES"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->max open files</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#MAXPROTOCOL"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->max protocol</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#MAXSMBDPROCESSES"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->max smbd processes</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#MAXTTL"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->max ttl</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#MAXWINSTTL"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->max wins ttl</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#MAXXMIT"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->max xmit</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#MESSAGECOMMAND"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->message command</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#MINPASSWDLENGTH"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->min passwd length</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#MINPASSWORDLENGTH"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->min password length</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#MINPROTOCOL"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->min protocol</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#MINWINSTTL"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->min wins ttl</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#NAMECACHETIMEOUT"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->name cache timeout</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#NAMERESOLVEORDER"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->name resolve order</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#NETBIOSALIASES"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->netbios aliases</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#NETBIOSNAME"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->netbios name</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#NETBIOSSCOPE"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->netbios scope</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#NISHOMEDIR"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->nis homedir</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#NTLMAUTH"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->ntlm auth</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#NONUNIXACCOUNTRANGE"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->non unix account range</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#NTPIPESUPPORT"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->nt pipe support</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#NTSTATUSSUPPORT"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->nt status support</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#NULLPASSWORDS"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->null passwords</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#OBEYPAMRESTRICTIONS"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->obey pam restrictions</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#OPLOCKBREAKWAITTIME"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->oplock break wait time</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#OSLEVEL"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->os level</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#OS2DRIVERMAP"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->os2 driver map</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#PAMPASSWORDCHANGE"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->pam password change</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#PANICACTION"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->panic action</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#PARANOIDSERVERSECURITY"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->paranoid server security</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#PASSDBBACKEND"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->passdb backend</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#PASSWDCHAT"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->passwd chat</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#PASSWDCHATDEBUG"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->passwd chat debug</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#PASSWDPROGRAM"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->passwd program</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#PASSWORDLEVEL"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->password level</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#PASSWORDSERVER"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->password server</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#PREFEREDMASTER"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->prefered master</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#PREFERREDMASTER"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->preferred master</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#PRELOAD"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->preload</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#PRINTCAP"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->printcap</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#PRINTCAPNAME"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->printcap name</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#PRINTERDRIVERFILE"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->printer driver file</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#PRIVATEDIR"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->private dir</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#PROTOCOL"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->protocol</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#READBMPX"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->read bmpx</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#READRAW"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->read raw</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#READSIZE"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->read size</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#REALM"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->realm</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#REMOTEANNOUNCE"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->remote announce</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#REMOTEBROWSESYNC"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->remote browse sync</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#RESTRICTANONYMOUS"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->restrict anonymous</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#ROOT"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->root</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#ROOTDIR"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->root dir</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#ROOTDIRECTORY"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->root directory</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#SECURITY"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->security</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#SERVERSTRING"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->server string</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#SHOWADDPRINTERWIZARD"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->show add printer wizard</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#SHUTDOWNSCRIPT"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->shutdown script</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#SMBPASSWDFILE"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->smb passwd file</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#SMBPORTS"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->smb ports</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#SOCKETADDRESS"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->socket address</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#SOCKETOPTIONS"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->socket options</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#SOURCEENVIRONMENT"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->source environment</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#SPNEGO"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->use spnego</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#STATCACHE"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->stat cache</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#STATCACHESIZE"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->stat cache size</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#STRIPDOT"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->strip dot</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#SYSLOG"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->syslog</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#SYSLOGONLY"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->syslog only</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#TEMPLATEHOMEDIR"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->template homedir</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#TEMPLATESHELL"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->template shell</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#TIMEOFFSET"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->time offset</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#TIMESERVER"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->time server</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#TIMESTAMPLOGS"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->timestamp logs</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#TOTALPRINTJOBS"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->total print jobs</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#UNICODE"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->unicode</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#UNIXCHARSET"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->unix charset</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#UNIXEXTENSIONS"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->unix extensions</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#UNIXPASSWORDSYNC"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->unix password sync</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#UPDATEENCRYPTED"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->update encrypted</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#USEMMAP"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->use mmap</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#USERHOSTS"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->use rhosts</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#USESENDFILE"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->use sendfile</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#USERNAMELEVEL"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->username level</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#USERNAMEMAP"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->username map</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#UTMP"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->utmp</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#UTMPDIRECTORY"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->utmp directory</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#WTMPDIRECTORY"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->wtmp directory</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#WINBINDCACHETIME"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->winbind cache time</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#WINBINDENUMUSERS"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->winbind enum users</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#WINBINDENUMGROUPS"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->winbind enum groups</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#WINBINDGID"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->winbind gid</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#WINBINDSEPARATOR"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->winbind separator</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#WINBINDUID"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->winbind uid</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#WINBINDUSEDEFAULTDOMAIN"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->winbind use default domain</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#WINSHOOK"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->wins hook</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#WINSPARTNERS"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->wins partners</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#WINSPROXY"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->wins proxy</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#WINSSERVER"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->wins server</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#WINSSUPPORT"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->wins support</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#WORKGROUP"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->workgroup</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#WRITERAW"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->write raw</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-></UL
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN1029"
-></A
-><H2
->COMPLETE LIST OF SERVICE PARAMETERS</H2
-><P
->Here is a list of all service parameters. See the section on
- each parameter for details. Note that some are synonyms.</P
-><P
-></P
-><UL
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#ADMINUSERS"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->admin users</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#ALLOWHOSTS"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->allow hosts</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#AVAILABLE"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->available</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#BLOCKINGLOCKS"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->blocking locks</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#BLOCKSIZE"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->block size</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#BROWSABLE"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->browsable</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#BROWSEABLE"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->browseable</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#CASESENSITIVE"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->case sensitive</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#CASESIGNAMES"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->casesignames</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#COMMENT"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->comment</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#COPY"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->copy</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#CREATEMASK"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->create mask</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#CREATEMODE"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->create mode</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#CSCPOLICY"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->csc policy</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#DEFAULTCASE"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->default case</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#DEFAULTDEVMODE"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->default devmode</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#DELETEREADONLY"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->delete readonly</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#DELETEVETOFILES"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->delete veto files</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#DENYHOSTS"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->deny hosts</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#DIRECTORY"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->directory</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#DIRECTORYMASK"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->directory mask</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#DIRECTORYMODE"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->directory mode</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#DIRECTORYSECURITYMASK"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->directory security mask</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#DONTDESCEND"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->dont descend</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#DOSFILEMODE"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->dos filemode</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#DOSFILETIMERESOLUTION"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->dos filetime resolution</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#DOSFILETIMES"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->dos filetimes</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#EXEC"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->exec</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#FAKEDIRECTORYCREATETIMES"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->fake directory create times</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#FAKEOPLOCKS"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->fake oplocks</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#FOLLOWSYMLINKS"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->follow symlinks</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#FORCECREATEMODE"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->force create mode</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#FORCEDIRECTORYMODE"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->force directory mode</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#FORCEDIRECTORYSECURITYMODE"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->force directory security mode</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#FORCEGROUP"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->force group</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#FORCESECURITYMODE"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->force security mode</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#FORCEUSER"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->force user</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#FSTYPE"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->fstype</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#GROUP"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->group</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#GUESTACCOUNT"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->guest account</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#GUESTOK"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->guest ok</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#GUESTONLY"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->guest only</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#HIDEDOTFILES"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->hide dot files</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#HIDEFILES"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->hide files</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#HOSTSALLOW"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->hosts allow</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#HOSTSDENY"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->hosts deny</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#INCLUDE"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->include</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#INHERITACLS"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->inherit acls</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#INHERITPERMISSIONS"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->inherit permissions</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#INVALIDUSERS"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->invalid users</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#LEVEL2OPLOCKS"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->level2 oplocks</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#LOCKING"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->locking</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#LPPAUSECOMMAND"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->lppause command</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#LPQCOMMAND"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->lpq command</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#LPRESUMECOMMAND"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->lpresume command</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#LPRMCOMMAND"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->lprm command</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#MAGICOUTPUT"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->magic output</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#MAGICSCRIPT"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->magic script</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#MANGLECASE"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->mangle case</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#MANGLEDMAP"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->mangled map</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#MANGLEDNAMES"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->mangled names</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#MANGLINGCHAR"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->mangling char</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#MANGLINGMETHOD"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->mangling method</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#MAPARCHIVE"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->map archive</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#MAPHIDDEN"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->map hidden</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#MAPSYSTEM"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->map system</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#MAXCONNECTIONS"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->max connections</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#MAXPRINTJOBS"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->max print jobs</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#MINPRINTSPACE"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->min print space</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#MSDFSPROXY"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->msdfs proxy</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#MSDFSROOT"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->msdfs root</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#NTACLSUPPORT"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->nt acl support</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#ONLYGUEST"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->only guest</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#ONLYUSER"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->only user</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#OPLOCKCONTENTIONLIMIT"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->oplock contention limit</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#OPLOCKS"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->oplocks</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#PATH"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->path</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#POSIXLOCKING"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->posix locking</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#POSTEXEC"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->postexec</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#POSTSCRIPT"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->postscript</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#PREEXEC"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->preexec</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#PREEXECCLOSE"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->preexec close</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#PRESERVECASE"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->preserve case</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#PRINTCOMMAND"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->print command</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#PRINTOK"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->print ok</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#PRINTABLE"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->printable</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#PRINTER"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->printer</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#PRINTERADMIN"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->printer admin</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#PRINTERDRIVER"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->printer driver</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#PRINTERDRIVERLOCATION"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->printer driver location</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#PRINTERNAME"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->printer name</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#PRINTING"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->printing</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#PUBLIC"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->public</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#QUEUEPAUSECOMMAND"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->queuepause command</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#QUEUERESUMECOMMAND"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->queueresume command</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#READLIST"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->read list</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#READONLY"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->read only</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#ROOTPOSTEXEC"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->root postexec</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#ROOTPREEXEC"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->root preexec</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#ROOTPREEXECCLOSE"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->root preexec close</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#SECURITYMASK"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->security mask</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#SETDIRECTORY"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->set directory</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#SHAREMODES"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->share modes</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#SHORTPRESERVECASE"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->short preserve case</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#STRICTALLOCATE"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->strict allocate</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#STRICTLOCKING"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->strict locking</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#STRICTSYNC"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->strict sync</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#SYNCALWAYS"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->sync always</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#USECLIENTDRIVER"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->use client driver</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#USER"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->user</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#USERNAME"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->username</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#USERS"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->users</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#VALIDUSERS"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->valid users</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#VETOFILES"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->veto files</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#VETOOPLOCKFILES"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->veto oplock files</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#VFSPATH"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->vfs path</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#VFSOBJECT"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->vfs object</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#VFSOPTIONS"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->vfs options</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#VOLUME"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->volume</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#WIDELINKS"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->wide links</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#WRITABLE"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->writable</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#WRITECACHESIZE"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->write cache size</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#WRITELIST"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->write list</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#WRITEOK"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->write ok</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="#WRITEABLE"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->writeable</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-></UL
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN1533"
-></A
-><H2
->EXPLANATION OF EACH PARAMETER</H2
-><P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="ABORTSHUTDOWNSCRIPT"
-></A
->abort shutdown script (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->This parameter only exists in the HEAD cvs branch</I
->
- This a full path name to a script called by
- <A
-HREF="smbd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbd(8)</B
-></A
-> that
- should stop a shutdown procedure issued by the <A
-HREF="#SHUTDOWNSCRIPT"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->shutdown script</I
-></TT
-></A
->.</P
-><P
->This command will be run as user.</P
-><P
->Default: <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->None</I
->.</P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->abort shutdown script = /sbin/shutdown -c</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="ADDPRINTERCOMMAND"
-></A
->addprinter command (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->With the introduction of MS-RPC based printing
- support for Windows NT/2000 clients in Samba 2.2, The MS Add
- Printer Wizard (APW) icon is now also available in the
- "Printers..." folder displayed a share listing. The APW
- allows for printers to be add remotely to a Samba or Windows
- NT/2000 print server.</P
-><P
->For a Samba host this means that the printer must be
- physically added to the underlying printing system. The <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->add
- printer command</I
-></TT
-> defines a script to be run which
- will perform the necessary operations for adding the printer
- to the print system and to add the appropriate service definition
- to the <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->smb.conf</TT
-> file in order that it can be
- shared by <A
-HREF="smbd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbd(8)</B
->
- </A
->.</P
-><P
->The <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->addprinter command</I
-></TT
-> is
- automatically invoked with the following parameter (in
- order:</P
-><P
-></P
-><UL
-><LI
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->printer name</I
-></TT
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->share name</I
-></TT
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->port name</I
-></TT
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->driver name</I
-></TT
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->location</I
-></TT
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->Windows 9x driver location</I
-></TT
->
- </P
-></LI
-></UL
-><P
->All parameters are filled in from the PRINTER_INFO_2 structure sent
- by the Windows NT/2000 client with one exception. The "Windows 9x
- driver location" parameter is included for backwards compatibility
- only. The remaining fields in the structure are generated from answers
- to the APW questions.</P
-><P
->Once the <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->addprinter command</I
-></TT
-> has
- been executed, <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbd</B
-> will reparse the <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
-> smb.conf</TT
-> to determine if the share defined by the APW
- exists. If the sharename is still invalid, then <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbd
- </B
-> will return an ACCESS_DENIED error to the client.</P
-><P
->See also <A
-HREF="#DELETEPRINTERCOMMAND"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
-> deleteprinter command</I
-></TT
-></A
->, <A
-HREF="#PRINTING"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->printing</I
-></TT
-></A
->,
- <A
-HREF="#SHOWADDPRINTERWIZARD"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->show add
- printer wizard</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-><P
->Default: <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->none</I
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->addprinter command = /usr/bin/addprinter
- </B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="ADDSHARECOMMAND"
-></A
->add share command (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Samba 2.2.0 introduced the ability to dynamically
- add and delete shares via the Windows NT 4.0 Server Manager. The
- <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->add share command</I
-></TT
-> is used to define an
- external program or script which will add a new service definition
- to <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->smb.conf</TT
->. In order to successfully
- execute the <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->add share command</I
-></TT
->, <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbd</B
->
- requires that the administrator be connected using a root account (i.e.
- uid == 0).
- </P
-><P
-> When executed, <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbd</B
-> will automatically invoke the
- <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->add share command</I
-></TT
-> with four parameters.
- </P
-><P
-></P
-><UL
-><LI
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->configFile</I
-></TT
-> - the location
- of the global <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->smb.conf</TT
-> file.
- </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->shareName</I
-></TT
-> - the name of the new
- share.
- </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->pathName</I
-></TT
-> - path to an **existing**
- directory on disk.
- </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->comment</I
-></TT
-> - comment string to associate
- with the new share.
- </P
-></LI
-></UL
-><P
-> This parameter is only used for add file shares. To add printer shares,
- see the <A
-HREF="#ADDPRINTERCOMMAND"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->addprinter
- command</I
-></TT
-></A
->.
- </P
-><P
-> See also <A
-HREF="#CHANGESHARECOMMAND"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->change share
- command</I
-></TT
-></A
->, <A
-HREF="#DELETESHARECOMMAND"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->delete share
- command</I
-></TT
-></A
->.
- </P
-><P
->Default: <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->none</I
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->add share command = /usr/local/bin/addshare</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="ADDMACHINESCRIPT"
-></A
->add machine script (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This is the full pathname to a script that will
- be run by <A
-HREF="smbd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
->smbd(8)</A
-> when a machine is added
- to it's domain using the administrator username and password method. </P
-><P
->This option is only required when using sam back-ends tied to the
- Unix uid method of RID calculation such as smbpasswd. This option is only
- available in Samba 3.0.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->add machine script = &#60;empty string&#62;
- </B
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->add machine script = /usr/sbin/adduser -n -g machines -c Machine -d /dev/null -s /bin/false %u
- </B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="ADSSERVER"
-></A
->ads server (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->If this option is specified, samba does
- not try to figure out what ads server to use itself, but
- uses the specified ads server. Either one DNS name or IP
- address can be used.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->ads server = </B
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->ads server = 192.168.1.2</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="ADDUSERSCRIPT"
-></A
->add user script (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This is the full pathname to a script that will
- be run <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->AS ROOT</I
-> by <A
-HREF="smbd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
->smbd(8)
- </A
-> under special circumstances described below.</P
-><P
->Normally, a Samba server requires that UNIX users are
- created for all users accessing files on this server. For sites
- that use Windows NT account databases as their primary user database
- creating these users and keeping the user list in sync with the
- Windows NT PDC is an onerous task. This option allows <A
-HREF="smbd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
->smbd</A
-> to create the required UNIX users
- <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->ON DEMAND</I
-> when a user accesses the Samba server.</P
-><P
->In order to use this option, <A
-HREF="smbd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
->smbd</A
->
- must <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->NOT</I
-> be set to <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->security = share</I
-></TT
->
- and <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->add user script</I
-></TT
->
- must be set to a full pathname for a script that will create a UNIX
- user given one argument of <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->%u</I
-></TT
->, which expands into
- the UNIX user name to create.</P
-><P
->When the Windows user attempts to access the Samba server,
- at login (session setup in the SMB protocol) time, <A
-HREF="smbd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-> smbd</A
-> contacts the <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->password server</I
-></TT
-> and
- attempts to authenticate the given user with the given password. If the
- authentication succeeds then <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbd</B
->
- attempts to find a UNIX user in the UNIX password database to map the
- Windows user into. If this lookup fails, and <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->add user script
- </I
-></TT
-> is set then <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbd</B
-> will
- call the specified script <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->AS ROOT</I
->, expanding
- any <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->%u</I
-></TT
-> argument to be the user name to create.</P
-><P
->If this script successfully creates the user then <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbd
- </B
-> will continue on as though the UNIX user
- already existed. In this way, UNIX users are dynamically created to
- match existing Windows NT accounts.</P
-><P
->See also <A
-HREF="#SECURITY"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
-> security</I
-></TT
-></A
->, <A
-HREF="#PASSWORDSERVER"
-> <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->password server</I
-></TT
-></A
->,
- <A
-HREF="#DELETEUSERSCRIPT"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->delete user
- script</I
-></TT
-></A
->.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->add user script = &#60;empty string&#62;
- </B
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->add user script = /usr/local/samba/bin/add_user
- %u</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="ADDGROUPSCRIPT"
-></A
->add group script (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This is the full pathname to a script that will
- be run <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->AS ROOT</I
-> by <A
-HREF="smbd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
->smbd(8)</A
-> when a new group is
- requested. It will expand any
- <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->%g</I
-></TT
-> to the group name passed.
- This script is only useful for installations using the
- Windows NT domain administration tools. The script is
- free to create a group with an arbitrary name to
- circumvent unix group name restrictions. In that case
- the script must print the numeric gid of the created
- group on stdout.
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="ADMINUSERS"
-></A
->admin users (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This is a list of users who will be granted
- administrative privileges on the share. This means that they
- will do all file operations as the super-user (root).</P
-><P
->You should use this option very carefully, as any user in
- this list will be able to do anything they like on the share,
- irrespective of file permissions.</P
-><P
->Default: <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->no admin users</I
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->admin users = jason</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="ADDUSERTOGROUPSCRIPT"
-></A
->add user to group script (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Full path to the script that will be called when
- a user is added to a group using the Windows NT domain administration
- tools. It will be run by <A
-HREF="smbd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
->smbd(8)</A
->
- <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->AS ROOT</I
->. Any <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->%g</I
-></TT
-> will be
- replaced with the group name and any <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->%u</I
-></TT
-> will
- be replaced with the user name.
- </P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->add user to group script = </B
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->add user to group script = /usr/sbin/adduser %u %g</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="ALLOWHOSTS"
-></A
->allow hosts (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Synonym for <A
-HREF="#HOSTSALLOW"
-> <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->hosts allow</I
-></TT
-></A
->.</P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="ALGORITHMICRIDBASE"
-></A
->algorithmic rid base (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This determines how Samba will use its
- algorithmic mapping from uids/gid to the RIDs needed to construct
- NT Security Identifiers.</P
-><P
->Setting this option to a larger value could be useful to sites
- transitioning from WinNT and Win2k, as existing user and
- group rids would otherwise clash with sytem users etc.
- </P
-><P
->All UIDs and GIDs must be able to be resolved into SIDs for
- the correct operation of ACLs on the server. As such the algorithmic
- mapping can't be 'turned off', but pushing it 'out of the way' should
- resolve the issues. Users and groups can then be assigned 'low' RIDs
- in arbitary-rid supporting backends. </P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->algorithmic rid base = 1000</B
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->algorithmic rid base = 100000</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="ALLOWTRUSTEDDOMAINS"
-></A
->allow trusted domains (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This option only takes effect when the <A
-HREF="#SECURITY"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->security</I
-></TT
-></A
-> option is set to
- <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->server</TT
-> or <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->domain</TT
->.
- If it is set to no, then attempts to connect to a resource from
- a domain or workgroup other than the one which <A
-HREF="smbd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
->smbd</A
-> is running
- in will fail, even if that domain is trusted by the remote server
- doing the authentication.</P
-><P
->This is useful if you only want your Samba server to
- serve resources to users in the domain it is a member of. As
- an example, suppose that there are two domains DOMA and DOMB. DOMB
- is trusted by DOMA, which contains the Samba server. Under normal
- circumstances, a user with an account in DOMB can then access the
- resources of a UNIX account with the same account name on the
- Samba server even if they do not have an account in DOMA. This
- can make implementing a security boundary difficult.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->allow trusted domains = yes</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="ANNOUNCEAS"
-></A
->announce as (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This specifies what type of server
- <A
-HREF="nmbd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->nmbd</B
-></A
->
- will announce itself as, to a network neighborhood browse
- list. By default this is set to Windows NT. The valid options
- are : "NT Server" (which can also be written as "NT"),
- "NT Workstation", "Win95" or "WfW" meaning Windows NT Server,
- Windows NT Workstation, Windows 95 and Windows for Workgroups
- respectively. Do not change this parameter unless you have a
- specific need to stop Samba appearing as an NT server as this
- may prevent Samba servers from participating as browser servers
- correctly.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->announce as = NT Server</B
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->announce as = Win95</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="ANNOUNCEVERSION"
-></A
->announce version (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This specifies the major and minor version numbers
- that nmbd will use when announcing itself as a server. The default
- is 4.9. Do not change this parameter unless you have a specific
- need to set a Samba server to be a downlevel server.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->announce version = 4.9</B
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->announce version = 2.0</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="AUTOSERVICES"
-></A
->auto services (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This is a synonym for the <A
-HREF="#PRELOAD"
-> <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->preload</I
-></TT
-></A
->.</P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="AUTHMETHODS"
-></A
->auth methods (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This option allows the administrator to chose what
- authentication methods <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbd</B
-> will use when authenticating
- a user. This option defaults to sensible values based on <A
-HREF="#SECURITY"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
-> security</I
-></TT
-></A
->.
-
- Each entry in the list attempts to authenticate the user in turn, until
- the user authenticates. In practice only one method will ever actually
- be able to complete the authentication.
- </P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->auth methods = &#60;empty string&#62;</B
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->auth methods = guest sam ntdomain</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="AVAILABLE"
-></A
->available (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This parameter lets you "turn off" a service. If
- <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->available = no</I
-></TT
->, then <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->ALL</I
->
- attempts to connect to the service will fail. Such failures are
- logged.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->available = yes</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="BINDINTERFACESONLY"
-></A
->bind interfaces only (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This global parameter allows the Samba admin
- to limit what interfaces on a machine will serve SMB requests. It
- affects file service <A
-HREF="smbd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
->smbd(8)</A
-> and
- name service <A
-HREF="nmbd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
->nmbd(8)</A
-> in slightly
- different ways.</P
-><P
->For name service it causes <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->nmbd</B
-> to bind
- to ports 137 and 138 on the interfaces listed in the <A
-HREF="#INTERFACES"
->interfaces</A
-> parameter. <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->nmbd
- </B
-> also binds to the "all addresses" interface (0.0.0.0)
- on ports 137 and 138 for the purposes of reading broadcast messages.
- If this option is not set then <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->nmbd</B
-> will service
- name requests on all of these sockets. If <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->bind interfaces
- only</I
-></TT
-> is set then <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->nmbd</B
-> will check the
- source address of any packets coming in on the broadcast sockets
- and discard any that don't match the broadcast addresses of the
- interfaces in the <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->interfaces</I
-></TT
-> parameter list.
- As unicast packets are received on the other sockets it allows
- <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->nmbd</B
-> to refuse to serve names to machines that
- send packets that arrive through any interfaces not listed in the
- <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->interfaces</I
-></TT
-> list. IP Source address spoofing
- does defeat this simple check, however, so it must not be used
- seriously as a security feature for <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->nmbd</B
->.</P
-><P
->For file service it causes <A
-HREF="smbd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
->smbd(8)</A
->
- to bind only to the interface list given in the <A
-HREF="#INTERFACES"
-> interfaces</A
-> parameter. This restricts the networks that
- <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbd</B
-> will serve to packets coming in those
- interfaces. Note that you should not use this parameter for machines
- that are serving PPP or other intermittent or non-broadcast network
- interfaces as it will not cope with non-permanent interfaces.</P
-><P
->If <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->bind interfaces only</I
-></TT
-> is set then
- unless the network address <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->127.0.0.1</I
-> is added
- to the <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->interfaces</I
-></TT
-> parameter list <A
-HREF="smbpasswd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbpasswd(8)</B
-></A
->
- and <A
-HREF="swat.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->swat(8)</B
-></A
-> may
- not work as expected due to the reasons covered below.</P
-><P
->To change a users SMB password, the <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbpasswd</B
->
- by default connects to the <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->localhost - 127.0.0.1</I
->
- address as an SMB client to issue the password change request. If
- <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->bind interfaces only</I
-></TT
-> is set then unless the
- network address <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->127.0.0.1</I
-> is added to the
- <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->interfaces</I
-></TT
-> parameter list then <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
-> smbpasswd</B
-> will fail to connect in it's default mode.
- <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbpasswd</B
-> can be forced to use the primary IP interface
- of the local host by using its <A
-HREF="smbpasswd.8.html#minusr"
-TARGET="_top"
-> <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->-r <TT
-CLASS="REPLACEABLE"
-><I
->remote machine</I
-></TT
-></I
-></TT
->
- </A
-> parameter, with <TT
-CLASS="REPLACEABLE"
-><I
->remote machine</I
-></TT
-> set
- to the IP name of the primary interface of the local host.</P
-><P
->The <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->swat</B
-> status page tries to connect with
- <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbd</B
-> and <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->nmbd</B
-> at the address
- <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->127.0.0.1</I
-> to determine if they are running.
- Not adding <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->127.0.0.1</I
-> will cause <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
-> smbd</B
-> and <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->nmbd</B
-> to always show
- "not running" even if they really are. This can prevent <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
-> swat</B
-> from starting/stopping/restarting <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbd</B
->
- and <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->nmbd</B
->.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->bind interfaces only = no</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="BLOCKINGLOCKS"
-></A
->blocking locks (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This parameter controls the behavior of <A
-HREF="smbd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
->smbd(8)</A
-> when given a request by a client
- to obtain a byte range lock on a region of an open file, and the
- request has a time limit associated with it.</P
-><P
->If this parameter is set and the lock range requested
- cannot be immediately satisfied, samba will internally
- queue the lock request, and periodically attempt to obtain
- the lock until the timeout period expires.</P
-><P
->If this parameter is set to <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->no</TT
->, then
- samba will behave as previous versions of Samba would and
- will fail the lock request immediately if the lock range
- cannot be obtained.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->blocking locks = yes</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="BLOCKSIZE"
-></A
->block size (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This parameter controls the behavior of
- <A
-HREF="smbd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
->smbd(8)</A
-> when reporting disk free
- sizes. By default, this reports a disk block size of 1024 bytes.
- </P
-><P
->Changing this parameter may have some effect on the
- efficiency of client writes, this is not yet confirmed. This
- parameter was added to allow advanced administrators to change
- it (usually to a higher value) and test the effect it has on
- client write performance without re-compiling the code. As this
- is an experimental option it may be removed in a future release.
- </P
-><P
->Changing this option does not change the disk free reporting
- size, just the block size unit reported to the client.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->block size = 1024</B
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->block size = 65536</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="BROWSABLE"
-></A
->browsable (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->See the <A
-HREF="#BROWSEABLE"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
-> browseable</I
-></TT
-></A
->.</P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="BROWSELIST"
-></A
->browse list (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This controls whether <A
-HREF="smbd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-> <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbd(8)</B
-></A
-> will serve a browse list to
- a client doing a <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->NetServerEnum</B
-> call. Normally
- set to <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->yes</TT
->. You should never need to change
- this.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->browse list = yes</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="BROWSEABLE"
-></A
->browseable (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This controls whether this share is seen in
- the list of available shares in a net view and in the browse list.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->browseable = yes</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="CASESENSITIVE"
-></A
->case sensitive (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->See the discussion in the section <A
-HREF="#AEN205"
->NAME MANGLING</A
->.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->case sensitive = no</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="CASESIGNAMES"
-></A
->casesignames (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Synonym for <A
-HREF="#CASESENSITIVE"
->case
- sensitive</A
->.</P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="CHANGENOTIFYTIMEOUT"
-></A
->change notify timeout (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This SMB allows a client to tell a server to
- "watch" a particular directory for any changes and only reply to
- the SMB request when a change has occurred. Such constant scanning of
- a directory is expensive under UNIX, hence an <A
-HREF="smbd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-> <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbd(8)</B
-></A
-> daemon only performs such a scan
- on each requested directory once every <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->change notify
- timeout</I
-></TT
-> seconds.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->change notify timeout = 60</B
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->change notify timeout = 300</B
-></P
-><P
->Would change the scan time to every 5 minutes.</P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="CHANGESHARECOMMAND"
-></A
->change share command (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Samba 2.2.0 introduced the ability to dynamically
- add and delete shares via the Windows NT 4.0 Server Manager. The
- <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->change share command</I
-></TT
-> is used to define an
- external program or script which will modify an existing service definition
- in <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->smb.conf</TT
->. In order to successfully
- execute the <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->change share command</I
-></TT
->, <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbd</B
->
- requires that the administrator be connected using a root account (i.e.
- uid == 0).
- </P
-><P
-> When executed, <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbd</B
-> will automatically invoke the
- <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->change share command</I
-></TT
-> with four parameters.
- </P
-><P
-></P
-><UL
-><LI
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->configFile</I
-></TT
-> - the location
- of the global <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->smb.conf</TT
-> file.
- </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->shareName</I
-></TT
-> - the name of the new
- share.
- </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->pathName</I
-></TT
-> - path to an **existing**
- directory on disk.
- </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->comment</I
-></TT
-> - comment string to associate
- with the new share.
- </P
-></LI
-></UL
-><P
-> This parameter is only used modify existing file shares definitions. To modify
- printer shares, use the "Printers..." folder as seen when browsing the Samba host.
- </P
-><P
-> See also <A
-HREF="#ADDSHARECOMMAND"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->add share
- command</I
-></TT
-></A
->, <A
-HREF="#DELETESHARECOMMAND"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->delete
- share command</I
-></TT
-></A
->.
- </P
-><P
->Default: <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->none</I
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->change share command = /usr/local/bin/addshare</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="COMMENT"
-></A
->comment (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This is a text field that is seen next to a share
- when a client does a queries the server, either via the network
- neighborhood or via <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->net view</B
-> to list what shares
- are available.</P
-><P
->If you want to set the string that is displayed next to the
- machine name then see the <A
-HREF="#SERVERSTRING"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
-> server string</I
-></TT
-></A
-> parameter.</P
-><P
->Default: <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->No comment string</I
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->comment = Fred's Files</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="CONFIGFILE"
-></A
->config file (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This allows you to override the config file
- to use, instead of the default (usually <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->smb.conf</TT
->).
- There is a chicken and egg problem here as this option is set
- in the config file!</P
-><P
->For this reason, if the name of the config file has changed
- when the parameters are loaded then it will reload them from
- the new config file.</P
-><P
->This option takes the usual substitutions, which can
- be very useful.</P
-><P
->If the config file doesn't exist then it won't be loaded
- (allowing you to special case the config files of just a few
- clients).</P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->config file = /usr/local/samba/lib/smb.conf.%m
- </B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="COPY"
-></A
->copy (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This parameter allows you to "clone" service
- entries. The specified service is simply duplicated under the
- current service's name. Any parameters specified in the current
- section will override those in the section being copied.</P
-><P
->This feature lets you set up a 'template' service and
- create similar services easily. Note that the service being
- copied must occur earlier in the configuration file than the
- service doing the copying.</P
-><P
->Default: <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->no value</I
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->copy = otherservice</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="CREATEMASK"
-></A
->create mask (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->A synonym for this parameter is
- <A
-HREF="#CREATEMODE"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->create mode</I
-></TT
->
- </A
->.</P
-><P
->When a file is created, the necessary permissions are
- calculated according to the mapping from DOS modes to UNIX
- permissions, and the resulting UNIX mode is then bit-wise 'AND'ed
- with this parameter. This parameter may be thought of as a bit-wise
- MASK for the UNIX modes of a file. Any bit <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->not</I
->
- set here will be removed from the modes set on a file when it is
- created.</P
-><P
->The default value of this parameter removes the
- 'group' and 'other' write and execute bits from the UNIX modes.</P
-><P
->Following this Samba will bit-wise 'OR' the UNIX mode created
- from this parameter with the value of the <A
-HREF="#FORCECREATEMODE"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->force create mode</I
-></TT
-></A
->
- parameter which is set to 000 by default.</P
-><P
->This parameter does not affect directory modes. See the
- parameter <A
-HREF="#DIRECTORYMODE"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->directory mode
- </I
-></TT
-></A
-> for details.</P
-><P
->See also the <A
-HREF="#FORCECREATEMODE"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->force
- create mode</I
-></TT
-></A
-> parameter for forcing particular mode
- bits to be set on created files. See also the <A
-HREF="#DIRECTORYMODE"
-> <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->directory mode</I
-></TT
-></A
-> parameter for masking
- mode bits on created directories. See also the <A
-HREF="#INHERITPERMISSIONS"
-> <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->inherit permissions</I
-></TT
-></A
-> parameter.</P
-><P
->Note that this parameter does not apply to permissions
- set by Windows NT/2000 ACL editors. If the administrator wishes to enforce
- a mask on access control lists also, they need to set the <A
-HREF="#SECURITYMASK"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->security mask</I
-></TT
-></A
->.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->create mask = 0744</B
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->create mask = 0775</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="CREATEMODE"
-></A
->create mode (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This is a synonym for <A
-HREF="#CREATEMASK"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
-> create mask</I
-></TT
-></A
->.</P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="CSCPOLICY"
-></A
->csc policy (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This stands for <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->client-side caching
- policy</I
->, and specifies how clients capable of offline
- caching will cache the files in the share. The valid values
- are: manual, documents, programs, disable.</P
-><P
->These values correspond to those used on Windows
- servers.</P
-><P
->For example, shares containing roaming profiles can have
- offline caching disabled using <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->csc policy = disable
- </B
->.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->csc policy = manual</B
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->csc policy = programs</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="DEADTIME"
-></A
->deadtime (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->The value of the parameter (a decimal integer)
- represents the number of minutes of inactivity before a connection
- is considered dead, and it is disconnected. The deadtime only takes
- effect if the number of open files is zero.</P
-><P
->This is useful to stop a server's resources being
- exhausted by a large number of inactive connections.</P
-><P
->Most clients have an auto-reconnect feature when a
- connection is broken so in most cases this parameter should be
- transparent to users.</P
-><P
->Using this parameter with a timeout of a few minutes
- is recommended for most systems.</P
-><P
->A deadtime of zero indicates that no auto-disconnection
- should be performed.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->deadtime = 0</B
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->deadtime = 15</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="DEBUGHIRESTIMESTAMP"
-></A
->debug hires timestamp (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Sometimes the timestamps in the log messages
- are needed with a resolution of higher that seconds, this
- boolean parameter adds microsecond resolution to the timestamp
- message header when turned on.</P
-><P
->Note that the parameter <A
-HREF="#DEBUGTIMESTAMP"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
-> debug timestamp</I
-></TT
-></A
-> must be on for this to have an
- effect.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->debug hires timestamp = no</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="DEBUGPID"
-></A
->debug pid (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->When using only one log file for more then one
- forked <A
-HREF="smbd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
->smbd</A
->-process there may be hard to follow which process
- outputs which message. This boolean parameter is adds the process-id
- to the timestamp message headers in the logfile when turned on.</P
-><P
->Note that the parameter <A
-HREF="#DEBUGTIMESTAMP"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
-> debug timestamp</I
-></TT
-></A
-> must be on for this to have an
- effect.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->debug pid = no</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="DEBUGTIMESTAMP"
-></A
->debug timestamp (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Samba debug log messages are timestamped
- by default. If you are running at a high <A
-HREF="#DEBUGLEVEL"
-> <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->debug level</I
-></TT
-></A
-> these timestamps
- can be distracting. This boolean parameter allows timestamping
- to be turned off.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->debug timestamp = yes</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="DEBUGUID"
-></A
->debug uid (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Samba is sometimes run as root and sometime
- run as the connected user, this boolean parameter inserts the
- current euid, egid, uid and gid to the timestamp message headers
- in the log file if turned on.</P
-><P
->Note that the parameter <A
-HREF="#DEBUGTIMESTAMP"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
-> debug timestamp</I
-></TT
-></A
-> must be on for this to have an
- effect.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->debug uid = no</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="DEBUGLEVEL"
-></A
->debuglevel (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Synonym for <A
-HREF="#LOGLEVEL"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
-> log level</I
-></TT
-></A
->.</P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="DEFAULT"
-></A
->default (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->A synonym for <A
-HREF="#DEFAULTSERVICE"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
-> default service</I
-></TT
-></A
->.</P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="DEFAULTCASE"
-></A
->default case (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->See the section on <A
-HREF="#AEN205"
-> NAME MANGLING</A
->. Also note the <A
-HREF="#SHORTPRESERVECASE"
-> <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->short preserve case</I
-></TT
-></A
-> parameter.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->default case = lower</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="DEFAULTDEVMODE"
-></A
->default devmode (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This parameter is only applicable to <A
-HREF="#PRINTOK"
->printable</A
-> services. When smbd is serving
- Printer Drivers to Windows NT/2k/XP clients, each printer on the Samba
- server has a Device Mode which defines things such as paper size and
- orientation and duplex settings. The device mode can only correctly be
- generated by the printer driver itself (which can only be executed on a
- Win32 platform). Because smbd is unable to execute the driver code
- to generate the device mode, the default behavior is to set this field
- to NULL.
- </P
-><P
->Most problems with serving printer drivers to Windows NT/2k/XP clients
- can be traced to a problem with the generated device mode. Certain drivers
- will do things such as crashing the client's Explorer.exe with a NULL devmode.
- However, other printer drivers can cause the client's spooler service
- (spoolsv.exe) to die if the devmode was not created by the driver itself
- (i.e. smbd generates a default devmode).
- </P
-><P
->This parameter should be used with care and tested with the printer
- driver in question. It is better to leave the device mode to NULL
- and let the Windows client set the correct values. Because drivers do not
- do this all the time, setting <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->default devmode = yes</B
->
- will instruct smbd to generate a default one.
- </P
-><P
->For more information on Windows NT/2k printing and Device Modes,
- see the <A
-HREF="http://msdn.microsoft.com/"
-TARGET="_top"
->MSDN documentation</A
->.
- </P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->default devmode = no</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="DEFAULTSERVICE"
-></A
->default service (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This parameter specifies the name of a service
- which will be connected to if the service actually requested cannot
- be found. Note that the square brackets are <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->NOT</I
->
- given in the parameter value (see example below).</P
-><P
->There is no default value for this parameter. If this
- parameter is not given, attempting to connect to a nonexistent
- service results in an error.</P
-><P
->Typically the default service would be a <A
-HREF="#GUESTOK"
-> <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->guest ok</I
-></TT
-></A
->, <A
-HREF="#READONLY"
-> <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->read-only</I
-></TT
-></A
-> service.</P
-><P
->Also note that the apparent service name will be changed
- to equal that of the requested service, this is very useful as it
- allows you to use macros like <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->%S</I
-></TT
-> to make
- a wildcard service.</P
-><P
->Note also that any "_" characters in the name of the service
- used in the default service will get mapped to a "/". This allows for
- interesting things.</P
-><P
->Example:</P
-><P
-><TABLE
-BORDER="0"
-BGCOLOR="#E0E0E0"
-WIDTH="90%"
-><TR
-><TD
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
->[global]
- default service = pub
-
-[pub]
- path = /%S
- </PRE
-></TD
-></TR
-></TABLE
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="DELETEGROUPSCRIPT"
-></A
->delete group script (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This is the full pathname to a script that will
- be run <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->AS ROOT</I
-> by <A
-HREF="smbd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
->smbd(8)</A
-> when a group is requested to be deleted. It will expand any <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->%g</I
-></TT
-> to the group name passed. This script is only useful for installations using the Windows NT domain administration tools.
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="DELETEPRINTERCOMMAND"
-></A
->deleteprinter command (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->With the introduction of MS-RPC based printer
- support for Windows NT/2000 clients in Samba 2.2, it is now
- possible to delete printer at run time by issuing the
- DeletePrinter() RPC call.</P
-><P
->For a Samba host this means that the printer must be
- physically deleted from underlying printing system. The <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
-> deleteprinter command</I
-></TT
-> defines a script to be run which
- will perform the necessary operations for removing the printer
- from the print system and from <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->smb.conf</TT
->.
- </P
-><P
->The <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->deleteprinter command</I
-></TT
-> is
- automatically called with only one parameter: <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
-> "printer name"</I
-></TT
->.</P
-><P
->Once the <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->deleteprinter command</I
-></TT
-> has
- been executed, <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbd</B
-> will reparse the <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
-> smb.conf</TT
-> to associated printer no longer exists.
- If the sharename is still valid, then <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbd
- </B
-> will return an ACCESS_DENIED error to the client.</P
-><P
->See also <A
-HREF="#ADDPRINTERCOMMAND"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
-> addprinter command</I
-></TT
-></A
->, <A
-HREF="#PRINTING"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->printing</I
-></TT
-></A
->,
- <A
-HREF="#SHOWADDPRINTERWIZARD"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->show add
- printer wizard</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-><P
->Default: <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->none</I
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->deleteprinter command = /usr/bin/removeprinter
- </B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="DELETEREADONLY"
-></A
->delete readonly (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This parameter allows readonly files to be deleted.
- This is not normal DOS semantics, but is allowed by UNIX.</P
-><P
->This option may be useful for running applications such
- as rcs, where UNIX file ownership prevents changing file
- permissions, and DOS semantics prevent deletion of a read only file.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->delete readonly = no</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="DELETESHARECOMMAND"
-></A
->delete share command (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Samba 2.2.0 introduced the ability to dynamically
- add and delete shares via the Windows NT 4.0 Server Manager. The
- <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->delete share command</I
-></TT
-> is used to define an
- external program or script which will remove an existing service
- definition from <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->smb.conf</TT
->. In order to successfully
- execute the <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->delete share command</I
-></TT
->, <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbd</B
->
- requires that the administrator be connected using a root account (i.e.
- uid == 0).
- </P
-><P
-> When executed, <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbd</B
-> will automatically invoke the
- <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->delete share command</I
-></TT
-> with two parameters.
- </P
-><P
-></P
-><UL
-><LI
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->configFile</I
-></TT
-> - the location
- of the global <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->smb.conf</TT
-> file.
- </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->shareName</I
-></TT
-> - the name of
- the existing service.
- </P
-></LI
-></UL
-><P
-> This parameter is only used to remove file shares. To delete printer shares,
- see the <A
-HREF="#DELETEPRINTERCOMMAND"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->deleteprinter
- command</I
-></TT
-></A
->.
- </P
-><P
-> See also <A
-HREF="#ADDSHARECOMMAND"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->add share
- command</I
-></TT
-></A
->, <A
-HREF="#CHANGESHARECOMMAND"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->change
- share command</I
-></TT
-></A
->.
- </P
-><P
->Default: <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->none</I
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->delete share command = /usr/local/bin/delshare</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="DELETEUSERSCRIPT"
-></A
->delete user script (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This is the full pathname to a script that will
- be run by <A
-HREF="smbd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbd(8)</B
-></A
->
- when managing user's with remote RPC (NT) tools.
- </P
-><P
->This script is called when a remote client removes a user
- from the server, normally using 'User Manager for Domains' or
- <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->rpcclient</B
->.
- </P
-><P
->This script should delete the given UNIX username.
- </P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->delete user script = &#60;empty string&#62;
- </B
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->delete user script = /usr/local/samba/bin/del_user
- %u</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="DELETEUSERFROMGROUPSCRIPT"
-></A
->delete user from group script (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Full path to the script that will be called when
- a user is removed from a group using the Windows NT domain administration
- tools. It will be run by <A
-HREF="smbd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
->smbd(8)</A
->
- <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->AS ROOT</I
->. Any <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->%g</I
-></TT
-> will be
- replaced with the group name and any <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->%u</I
-></TT
-> will
- be replaced with the user name.
- </P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->delete user from group script = </B
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->delete user from group script = /usr/sbin/deluser %u %g</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="DELETEVETOFILES"
-></A
->delete veto files (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This option is used when Samba is attempting to
- delete a directory that contains one or more vetoed directories
- (see the <A
-HREF="#VETOFILES"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->veto files</I
-></TT
-></A
->
- option). If this option is set to <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->no</TT
-> (the default) then if a vetoed
- directory contains any non-vetoed files or directories then the
- directory delete will fail. This is usually what you want.</P
-><P
->If this option is set to <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->yes</TT
->, then Samba
- will attempt to recursively delete any files and directories within
- the vetoed directory. This can be useful for integration with file
- serving systems such as NetAtalk which create meta-files within
- directories you might normally veto DOS/Windows users from seeing
- (e.g. <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->.AppleDouble</TT
->)</P
-><P
->Setting <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->delete veto files = yes</B
-> allows these
- directories to be transparently deleted when the parent directory
- is deleted (so long as the user has permissions to do so).</P
-><P
->See also the <A
-HREF="#VETOFILES"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->veto
- files</I
-></TT
-></A
-> parameter.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->delete veto files = no</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="DENYHOSTS"
-></A
->deny hosts (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Synonym for <A
-HREF="#HOSTSDENY"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->hosts
- deny</I
-></TT
-></A
->.</P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="DFREECOMMAND"
-></A
->dfree command (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->The <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->dfree command</I
-></TT
-> setting should
- only be used on systems where a problem occurs with the internal
- disk space calculations. This has been known to happen with Ultrix,
- but may occur with other operating systems. The symptom that was
- seen was an error of "Abort Retry Ignore" at the end of each
- directory listing.</P
-><P
->This setting allows the replacement of the internal routines to
- calculate the total disk space and amount available with an external
- routine. The example below gives a possible script that might fulfill
- this function.</P
-><P
->The external program will be passed a single parameter indicating
- a directory in the filesystem being queried. This will typically consist
- of the string <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->./</TT
->. The script should return two
- integers in ASCII. The first should be the total disk space in blocks,
- and the second should be the number of available blocks. An optional
- third return value can give the block size in bytes. The default
- blocksize is 1024 bytes.</P
-><P
->Note: Your script should <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->NOT</I
-> be setuid or
- setgid and should be owned by (and writeable only by) root!</P
-><P
->Default: <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->By default internal routines for
- determining the disk capacity and remaining space will be used.
- </I
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->dfree command = /usr/local/samba/bin/dfree
- </B
-></P
-><P
->Where the script dfree (which must be made executable) could be:</P
-><P
-><TABLE
-BORDER="0"
-BGCOLOR="#E0E0E0"
-WIDTH="90%"
-><TR
-><TD
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
->
- #!/bin/sh
- df $1 | tail -1 | awk '{print $2" "$4}'
- </PRE
-></TD
-></TR
-></TABLE
-></P
-><P
->or perhaps (on Sys V based systems):</P
-><P
-><TABLE
-BORDER="0"
-BGCOLOR="#E0E0E0"
-WIDTH="90%"
-><TR
-><TD
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
->
- #!/bin/sh
- /usr/bin/df -k $1 | tail -1 | awk '{print $3" "$5}'
- </PRE
-></TD
-></TR
-></TABLE
-></P
-><P
->Note that you may have to replace the command names
- with full path names on some systems.</P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="DIRECTORY"
-></A
->directory (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Synonym for <A
-HREF="#PATH"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->path
- </I
-></TT
-></A
->.</P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="DIRECTORYMASK"
-></A
->directory mask (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This parameter is the octal modes which are
- used when converting DOS modes to UNIX modes when creating UNIX
- directories.</P
-><P
->When a directory is created, the necessary permissions are
- calculated according to the mapping from DOS modes to UNIX permissions,
- and the resulting UNIX mode is then bit-wise 'AND'ed with this
- parameter. This parameter may be thought of as a bit-wise MASK for
- the UNIX modes of a directory. Any bit <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->not</I
-> set
- here will be removed from the modes set on a directory when it is
- created.</P
-><P
->The default value of this parameter removes the 'group'
- and 'other' write bits from the UNIX mode, allowing only the
- user who owns the directory to modify it.</P
-><P
->Following this Samba will bit-wise 'OR' the UNIX mode
- created from this parameter with the value of the <A
-HREF="#FORCEDIRECTORYMODE"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->force directory mode
- </I
-></TT
-></A
-> parameter. This parameter is set to 000 by
- default (i.e. no extra mode bits are added).</P
-><P
->Note that this parameter does not apply to permissions
- set by Windows NT/2000 ACL editors. If the administrator wishes to enforce
- a mask on access control lists also, they need to set the <A
-HREF="#DIRECTORYSECURITYMASK"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->directory security mask</I
-></TT
-></A
->.</P
-><P
->See the <A
-HREF="#FORCEDIRECTORYMODE"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->force
- directory mode</I
-></TT
-></A
-> parameter to cause particular mode
- bits to always be set on created directories.</P
-><P
->See also the <A
-HREF="#CREATEMODE"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->create mode
- </I
-></TT
-></A
-> parameter for masking mode bits on created files,
- and the <A
-HREF="#DIRECTORYSECURITYMASK"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->directory
- security mask</I
-></TT
-></A
-> parameter.</P
-><P
->Also refer to the <A
-HREF="#INHERITPERMISSIONS"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
-> inherit permissions</I
-></TT
-></A
-> parameter.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->directory mask = 0755</B
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->directory mask = 0775</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="DIRECTORYMODE"
-></A
->directory mode (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Synonym for <A
-HREF="#DIRECTORYMASK"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
-> directory mask</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="DIRECTORYSECURITYMASK"
-></A
->directory security mask (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This parameter controls what UNIX permission bits
- can be modified when a Windows NT client is manipulating the UNIX
- permission on a directory using the native NT security dialog
- box.</P
-><P
->This parameter is applied as a mask (AND'ed with) to
- the changed permission bits, thus preventing any bits not in
- this mask from being modified. Essentially, zero bits in this
- mask may be treated as a set of bits the user is not allowed
- to change.</P
-><P
->If not set explicitly this parameter is set to 0777
- meaning a user is allowed to modify all the user/group/world
- permissions on a directory.</P
-><P
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->Note</I
-> that users who can access the
- Samba server through other means can easily bypass this restriction,
- so it is primarily useful for standalone "appliance" systems.
- Administrators of most normal systems will probably want to leave
- it as the default of <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->0777</TT
->.</P
-><P
->See also the <A
-HREF="#FORCEDIRECTORYSECURITYMODE"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
-> force directory security mode</I
-></TT
-></A
->, <A
-HREF="#SECURITYMASK"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->security mask</I
-></TT
-></A
->,
- <A
-HREF="#FORCESECURITYMODE"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->force security mode
- </I
-></TT
-></A
-> parameters.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->directory security mask = 0777</B
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->directory security mask = 0700</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="DISABLENETBIOS"
-></A
->disable netbios (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Enabling this parameter will disable netbios support
- in Samba. Netbios is the only available form of browsing in
- all windows versions except for 2000 and XP. </P
-><P
->Note that clients that only support netbios won't be able to
- see your samba server when netbios support is disabled.
- </P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->disable netbios = no</B
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->disable netbios = yes</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="DISABLESPOOLSS"
-></A
->disable spoolss (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Enabling this parameter will disable Samba's support
- for the SPOOLSS set of MS-RPC's and will yield identical behavior
- as Samba 2.0.x. Windows NT/2000 clients will downgrade to using
- Lanman style printing commands. Windows 9x/ME will be uneffected by
- the parameter. However, this will also disable the ability to upload
- printer drivers to a Samba server via the Windows NT Add Printer
- Wizard or by using the NT printer properties dialog window. It will
- also disable the capability of Windows NT/2000 clients to download
- print drivers from the Samba host upon demand.
- <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->Be very careful about enabling this parameter.</I
->
- </P
-><P
->See also <A
-HREF="#USECLIENTDRIVER"
->use client driver</A
->
- </P
-><P
->Default : <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->disable spoolss = no</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="DISPLAYCHARSET"
-></A
->display charset (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Specifies the charset that samba will use
- to print messages to stdout and stderr and SWAT will use.
- Should generally be the same as the <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->unix charset</B
->.
- </P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->display charset = ASCII</B
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->display charset = UTF8</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="DNSPROXY"
-></A
->dns proxy (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Specifies that <A
-HREF="nmbd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
->nmbd(8)</A
->
- when acting as a WINS server and finding that a NetBIOS name has not
- been registered, should treat the NetBIOS name word-for-word as a DNS
- name and do a lookup with the DNS server for that name on behalf of
- the name-querying client.</P
-><P
->Note that the maximum length for a NetBIOS name is 15
- characters, so the DNS name (or DNS alias) can likewise only be
- 15 characters, maximum.</P
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->nmbd</B
-> spawns a second copy of itself to do the
- DNS name lookup requests, as doing a name lookup is a blocking
- action.</P
-><P
->See also the parameter <A
-HREF="#WINSSUPPORT"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
-> wins support</I
-></TT
-></A
->.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->dns proxy = yes</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="DOMAINLOGONS"
-></A
->domain logons (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->If set to <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->yes</TT
->, the Samba server will serve
- Windows 95/98 Domain logons for the <A
-HREF="#WORKGROUP"
-> <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->workgroup</I
-></TT
-></A
-> it is in. Samba 2.2
- has limited capability to act as a domain controller for Windows
- NT 4 Domains. For more details on setting up this feature see
- the Samba-PDC-HOWTO included in the <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->htmldocs/</TT
->
- directory shipped with the source code.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->domain logons = no</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="DOMAINMASTER"
-></A
->domain master (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Tell <A
-HREF="nmbd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
-> nmbd(8)</B
-></A
-> to enable WAN-wide browse list
- collation. Setting this option causes <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->nmbd</B
-> to
- claim a special domain specific NetBIOS name that identifies
- it as a domain master browser for its given <A
-HREF="#WORKGROUP"
-> <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->workgroup</I
-></TT
-></A
->. Local master browsers
- in the same <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->workgroup</I
-></TT
-> on broadcast-isolated
- subnets will give this <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->nmbd</B
-> their local browse lists,
- and then ask <A
-HREF="smbd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbd(8)</B
-></A
->
- for a complete copy of the browse list for the whole wide area
- network. Browser clients will then contact their local master browser,
- and will receive the domain-wide browse list, instead of just the list
- for their broadcast-isolated subnet.</P
-><P
->Note that Windows NT Primary Domain Controllers expect to be
- able to claim this <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->workgroup</I
-></TT
-> specific special
- NetBIOS name that identifies them as domain master browsers for
- that <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->workgroup</I
-></TT
-> by default (i.e. there is no
- way to prevent a Windows NT PDC from attempting to do this). This
- means that if this parameter is set and <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->nmbd</B
-> claims
- the special name for a <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->workgroup</I
-></TT
-> before a Windows
- NT PDC is able to do so then cross subnet browsing will behave
- strangely and may fail.</P
-><P
->If <A
-HREF="#DOMAINLOGONS"
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->domain logons = yes</B
->
- </A
->, then the default behavior is to enable the <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->domain
- master</I
-></TT
-> parameter. If <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->domain logons</I
-></TT
-> is
- not enabled (the default setting), then neither will <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->domain
- master</I
-></TT
-> be enabled by default.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->domain master = auto</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="DONTDESCEND"
-></A
->dont descend (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->There are certain directories on some systems
- (e.g., the <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/proc</TT
-> tree under Linux) that are either not
- of interest to clients or are infinitely deep (recursive). This
- parameter allows you to specify a comma-delimited list of directories
- that the server should always show as empty.</P
-><P
->Note that Samba can be very fussy about the exact format
- of the "dont descend" entries. For example you may need <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
-> ./proc</TT
-> instead of just <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/proc</TT
->.
- Experimentation is the best policy :-) </P
-><P
->Default: <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->none (i.e., all directories are OK
- to descend)</I
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->dont descend = /proc,/dev</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="DOSCHARSET"
-></A
->dos charset (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->DOS SMB clients assume the server has
- the same charset as they do. This option specifies which
- charset Samba should talk to DOS clients.
- </P
-><P
->The default depends on which charsets you have instaled.
- Samba tries to use charset 850 but falls back to ASCII in
- case it is not available. Run <A
-HREF="testparm.1.html"
-TARGET="_top"
->testparm(1)
- </A
-> to check the default on your system.
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="DOSFILEMODE"
-></A
->dos filemode (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
-> The default behavior in Samba is to provide
- UNIX-like behavior where only the owner of a file/directory is
- able to change the permissions on it. However, this behavior
- is often confusing to DOS/Windows users. Enabling this parameter
- allows a user who has write access to the file (by whatever
- means) to modify the permissions on it. Note that a user
- belonging to the group owning the file will not be allowed to
- change permissions if the group is only granted read access.
- Ownership of the file/directory is not changed, only the permissions
- are modified.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->dos filemode = no</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="DOSFILETIMERESOLUTION"
-></A
->dos filetime resolution (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Under the DOS and Windows FAT filesystem, the finest
- granularity on time resolution is two seconds. Setting this parameter
- for a share causes Samba to round the reported time down to the
- nearest two second boundary when a query call that requires one second
- resolution is made to <A
-HREF="smbd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbd(8)</B
->
- </A
->.</P
-><P
->This option is mainly used as a compatibility option for Visual
- C++ when used against Samba shares. If oplocks are enabled on a
- share, Visual C++ uses two different time reading calls to check if a
- file has changed since it was last read. One of these calls uses a
- one-second granularity, the other uses a two second granularity. As
- the two second call rounds any odd second down, then if the file has a
- timestamp of an odd number of seconds then the two timestamps will not
- match and Visual C++ will keep reporting the file has changed. Setting
- this option causes the two timestamps to match, and Visual C++ is
- happy.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->dos filetime resolution = no</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="DOSFILETIMES"
-></A
->dos filetimes (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Under DOS and Windows, if a user can write to a
- file they can change the timestamp on it. Under POSIX semantics,
- only the owner of the file or root may change the timestamp. By
- default, Samba runs with POSIX semantics and refuses to change the
- timestamp on a file if the user <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbd</B
-> is acting
- on behalf of is not the file owner. Setting this option to <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
-> yes</TT
-> allows DOS semantics and <A
-HREF="smbd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
->smbd</A
-> will change the file
- timestamp as DOS requires.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->dos filetimes = no</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="ENCRYPTPASSWORDS"
-></A
->encrypt passwords (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This boolean controls whether encrypted passwords
- will be negotiated with the client. Note that Windows NT 4.0 SP3 and
- above and also Windows 98 will by default expect encrypted passwords
- unless a registry entry is changed. To use encrypted passwords in
- Samba see the file ENCRYPTION.txt in the Samba documentation
- directory <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->docs/</TT
-> shipped with the source code.</P
-><P
->In order for encrypted passwords to work correctly
- <A
-HREF="smbd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbd(8)</B
-></A
-> must either
- have access to a local <A
-HREF="smbpasswd.5.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-><TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->smbpasswd(5)
- </TT
-></A
-> file (see the <A
-HREF="smbpasswd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
-> smbpasswd(8)</B
-></A
-> program for information on how to set up
- and maintain this file), or set the <A
-HREF="#SECURITY"
->security = [server|domain|ads]</A
-> parameter which
- causes <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbd</B
-> to authenticate against another
- server.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->encrypt passwords = yes</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="ENHANCEDBROWSING"
-></A
->enhanced browsing (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This option enables a couple of enhancements to
- cross-subnet browse propagation that have been added in Samba
- but which are not standard in Microsoft implementations.
- </P
-><P
->The first enhancement to browse propagation consists of a regular
- wildcard query to a Samba WINS server for all Domain Master Browsers,
- followed by a browse synchronization with each of the returned
- DMBs. The second enhancement consists of a regular randomised browse
- synchronization with all currently known DMBs.</P
-><P
->You may wish to disable this option if you have a problem with empty
- workgroups not disappearing from browse lists. Due to the restrictions
- of the browse protocols these enhancements can cause a empty workgroup
- to stay around forever which can be annoying.</P
-><P
->In general you should leave this option enabled as it makes
- cross-subnet browse propagation much more reliable.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->enhanced browsing = yes</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="ENUMPORTSCOMMAND"
-></A
->enumports command (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->The concept of a "port" is fairly foreign
- to UNIX hosts. Under Windows NT/2000 print servers, a port
- is associated with a port monitor and generally takes the form of
- a local port (i.e. LPT1:, COM1:, FILE:) or a remote port
- (i.e. LPD Port Monitor, etc...). By default, Samba has only one
- port defined--<TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->"Samba Printer Port"</TT
->. Under
- Windows NT/2000, all printers must have a valid port name.
- If you wish to have a list of ports displayed (<B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbd
- </B
-> does not use a port name for anything) other than
- the default <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->"Samba Printer Port"</TT
->, you
- can define <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->enumports command</I
-></TT
-> to point to
- a program which should generate a list of ports, one per line,
- to standard output. This listing will then be used in response
- to the level 1 and 2 EnumPorts() RPC.</P
-><P
->Default: <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->no enumports command</I
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->enumports command = /usr/bin/listports
- </B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="EXEC"
-></A
->exec (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This is a synonym for <A
-HREF="#PREEXEC"
-> <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->preexec</I
-></TT
-></A
->.</P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="FAKEDIRECTORYCREATETIMES"
-></A
->fake directory create times (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->NTFS and Windows VFAT file systems keep a create
- time for all files and directories. This is not the same as the
- ctime - status change time - that Unix keeps, so Samba by default
- reports the earliest of the various times Unix does keep. Setting
- this parameter for a share causes Samba to always report midnight
- 1-1-1980 as the create time for directories.</P
-><P
->This option is mainly used as a compatibility option for
- Visual C++ when used against Samba shares. Visual C++ generated
- makefiles have the object directory as a dependency for each object
- file, and a make rule to create the directory. Also, when NMAKE
- compares timestamps it uses the creation time when examining a
- directory. Thus the object directory will be created if it does not
- exist, but once it does exist it will always have an earlier
- timestamp than the object files it contains.</P
-><P
->However, Unix time semantics mean that the create time
- reported by Samba will be updated whenever a file is created or
- or deleted in the directory. NMAKE finds all object files in
- the object directory. The timestamp of the last one built is then
- compared to the timestamp of the object directory. If the
- directory's timestamp if newer, then all object files
- will be rebuilt. Enabling this option
- ensures directories always predate their contents and an NMAKE build
- will proceed as expected.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->fake directory create times = no</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="FAKEOPLOCKS"
-></A
->fake oplocks (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Oplocks are the way that SMB clients get permission
- from a server to locally cache file operations. If a server grants
- an oplock (opportunistic lock) then the client is free to assume
- that it is the only one accessing the file and it will aggressively
- cache file data. With some oplock types the client may even cache
- file open/close operations. This can give enormous performance benefits.
- </P
-><P
->When you set <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->fake oplocks = yes</B
->, <A
-HREF="smbd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbd(8)</B
-></A
-> will
- always grant oplock requests no matter how many clients are using
- the file.</P
-><P
->It is generally much better to use the real <A
-HREF="#OPLOCKS"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->oplocks</I
-></TT
-></A
-> support rather
- than this parameter.</P
-><P
->If you enable this option on all read-only shares or
- shares that you know will only be accessed from one client at a
- time such as physically read-only media like CDROMs, you will see
- a big performance improvement on many operations. If you enable
- this option on shares where multiple clients may be accessing the
- files read-write at the same time you can get data corruption. Use
- this option carefully!</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->fake oplocks = no</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="FOLLOWSYMLINKS"
-></A
->follow symlinks (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This parameter allows the Samba administrator
- to stop <A
-HREF="smbd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbd(8)</B
-></A
->
- from following symbolic links in a particular share. Setting this
- parameter to <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->no</TT
-> prevents any file or directory
- that is a symbolic link from being followed (the user will get an
- error). This option is very useful to stop users from adding a
- symbolic link to <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/passwd</TT
-> in their home
- directory for instance. However it will slow filename lookups
- down slightly.</P
-><P
->This option is enabled (i.e. <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbd</B
-> will
- follow symbolic links) by default.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->follow symlinks = yes</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="FORCECREATEMODE"
-></A
->force create mode (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This parameter specifies a set of UNIX mode bit
- permissions that will <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->always</I
-> be set on a
- file created by Samba. This is done by bitwise 'OR'ing these bits onto
- the mode bits of a file that is being created or having its
- permissions changed. The default for this parameter is (in octal)
- 000. The modes in this parameter are bitwise 'OR'ed onto the file
- mode after the mask set in the <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->create mask</I
-></TT
->
- parameter is applied.</P
-><P
->See also the parameter <A
-HREF="#CREATEMASK"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->create
- mask</I
-></TT
-></A
-> for details on masking mode bits on files.</P
-><P
->See also the <A
-HREF="#INHERITPERMISSIONS"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->inherit
- permissions</I
-></TT
-></A
-> parameter.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->force create mode = 000</B
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->force create mode = 0755</B
-></P
-><P
->would force all created files to have read and execute
- permissions set for 'group' and 'other' as well as the
- read/write/execute bits set for the 'user'.</P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="FORCEDIRECTORYMODE"
-></A
->force directory mode (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This parameter specifies a set of UNIX mode bit
- permissions that will <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->always</I
-> be set on a directory
- created by Samba. This is done by bitwise 'OR'ing these bits onto the
- mode bits of a directory that is being created. The default for this
- parameter is (in octal) 0000 which will not add any extra permission
- bits to a created directory. This operation is done after the mode
- mask in the parameter <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->directory mask</I
-></TT
-> is
- applied.</P
-><P
->See also the parameter <A
-HREF="#DIRECTORYMASK"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
-> directory mask</I
-></TT
-></A
-> for details on masking mode bits
- on created directories.</P
-><P
->See also the <A
-HREF="#INHERITPERMISSIONS"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
-> inherit permissions</I
-></TT
-></A
-> parameter.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->force directory mode = 000</B
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->force directory mode = 0755</B
-></P
-><P
->would force all created directories to have read and execute
- permissions set for 'group' and 'other' as well as the
- read/write/execute bits set for the 'user'.</P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="FORCEDIRECTORYSECURITYMODE"
-></A
->force directory security mode (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This parameter controls what UNIX permission bits
- can be modified when a Windows NT client is manipulating the UNIX
- permission on a directory using the native NT security dialog box.</P
-><P
->This parameter is applied as a mask (OR'ed with) to the
- changed permission bits, thus forcing any bits in this mask that
- the user may have modified to be on. Essentially, one bits in this
- mask may be treated as a set of bits that, when modifying security
- on a directory, the user has always set to be 'on'.</P
-><P
->If not set explicitly this parameter is 000, which
- allows a user to modify all the user/group/world permissions on a
- directory without restrictions.</P
-><P
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->Note</I
-> that users who can access the
- Samba server through other means can easily bypass this restriction,
- so it is primarily useful for standalone "appliance" systems.
- Administrators of most normal systems will probably want to leave
- it set as 0000.</P
-><P
->See also the <A
-HREF="#DIRECTORYSECURITYMASK"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
-> directory security mask</I
-></TT
-></A
->, <A
-HREF="#SECURITYMASK"
-> <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->security mask</I
-></TT
-></A
->,
- <A
-HREF="#FORCESECURITYMODE"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->force security mode
- </I
-></TT
-></A
-> parameters.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->force directory security mode = 0</B
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->force directory security mode = 700</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="FORCEGROUP"
-></A
->force group (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This specifies a UNIX group name that will be
- assigned as the default primary group for all users connecting
- to this service. This is useful for sharing files by ensuring
- that all access to files on service will use the named group for
- their permissions checking. Thus, by assigning permissions for this
- group to the files and directories within this service the Samba
- administrator can restrict or allow sharing of these files.</P
-><P
->In Samba 2.0.5 and above this parameter has extended
- functionality in the following way. If the group name listed here
- has a '+' character prepended to it then the current user accessing
- the share only has the primary group default assigned to this group
- if they are already assigned as a member of that group. This allows
- an administrator to decide that only users who are already in a
- particular group will create files with group ownership set to that
- group. This gives a finer granularity of ownership assignment. For
- example, the setting <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->force group = +sys</TT
-> means
- that only users who are already in group sys will have their default
- primary group assigned to sys when accessing this Samba share. All
- other users will retain their ordinary primary group.</P
-><P
->If the <A
-HREF="#FORCEUSER"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->force user
- </I
-></TT
-></A
-> parameter is also set the group specified in
- <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->force group</I
-></TT
-> will override the primary group
- set in <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->force user</I
-></TT
->.</P
-><P
->See also <A
-HREF="#FORCEUSER"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->force
- user</I
-></TT
-></A
->.</P
-><P
->Default: <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->no forced group</I
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->force group = agroup</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="FORCESECURITYMODE"
-></A
->force security mode (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This parameter controls what UNIX permission
- bits can be modified when a Windows NT client is manipulating
- the UNIX permission on a file using the native NT security dialog
- box.</P
-><P
->This parameter is applied as a mask (OR'ed with) to the
- changed permission bits, thus forcing any bits in this mask that
- the user may have modified to be on. Essentially, one bits in this
- mask may be treated as a set of bits that, when modifying security
- on a file, the user has always set to be 'on'.</P
-><P
->If not set explicitly this parameter is set to 0,
- and allows a user to modify all the user/group/world permissions on a file,
- with no restrictions.</P
-><P
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->Note</I
-> that users who can access
- the Samba server through other means can easily bypass this restriction,
- so it is primarily useful for standalone "appliance" systems.
- Administrators of most normal systems will probably want to leave
- this set to 0000.</P
-><P
->See also the <A
-HREF="#FORCEDIRECTORYSECURITYMODE"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
-> force directory security mode</I
-></TT
-></A
->,
- <A
-HREF="#DIRECTORYSECURITYMASK"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->directory security
- mask</I
-></TT
-></A
->, <A
-HREF="#SECURITYMASK"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
-> security mask</I
-></TT
-></A
-> parameters.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->force security mode = 0</B
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->force security mode = 700</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="FORCEUSER"
-></A
->force user (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This specifies a UNIX user name that will be
- assigned as the default user for all users connecting to this service.
- This is useful for sharing files. You should also use it carefully
- as using it incorrectly can cause security problems.</P
-><P
->This user name only gets used once a connection is established.
- Thus clients still need to connect as a valid user and supply a
- valid password. Once connected, all file operations will be performed
- as the "forced user", no matter what username the client connected
- as. This can be very useful.</P
-><P
->In Samba 2.0.5 and above this parameter also causes the
- primary group of the forced user to be used as the primary group
- for all file activity. Prior to 2.0.5 the primary group was left
- as the primary group of the connecting user (this was a bug).</P
-><P
->See also <A
-HREF="#FORCEGROUP"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->force group
- </I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-><P
->Default: <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->no forced user</I
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->force user = auser</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="FSTYPE"
-></A
->fstype (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This parameter allows the administrator to
- configure the string that specifies the type of filesystem a share
- is using that is reported by <A
-HREF="smbd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbd(8)
- </B
-></A
-> when a client queries the filesystem type
- for a share. The default type is <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->NTFS</TT
-> for
- compatibility with Windows NT but this can be changed to other
- strings such as <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->Samba</TT
-> or <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->FAT
- </TT
-> if required.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->fstype = NTFS</B
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->fstype = Samba</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="GETWDCACHE"
-></A
->getwd cache (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This is a tuning option. When this is enabled a
- caching algorithm will be used to reduce the time taken for getwd()
- calls. This can have a significant impact on performance, especially
- when the <A
-HREF="#WIDELINKS"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->wide links</I
-></TT
->
- </A
->parameter is set to <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->no</TT
->.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->getwd cache = yes</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="GROUP"
-></A
->group (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Synonym for <A
-HREF="#FORCEGROUP"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->force
- group</I
-></TT
-></A
->.</P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="GUESTACCOUNT"
-></A
->guest account (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This is a username which will be used for access
- to services which are specified as <A
-HREF="#GUESTOK"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
-> guest ok</I
-></TT
-></A
-> (see below). Whatever privileges this
- user has will be available to any client connecting to the guest service.
- Typically this user will exist in the password file, but will not
- have a valid login. The user account "ftp" is often a good choice
- for this parameter. If a username is specified in a given service,
- the specified username overrides this one.</P
-><P
->One some systems the default guest account "nobody" may not
- be able to print. Use another account in this case. You should test
- this by trying to log in as your guest user (perhaps by using the
- <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->su -</B
-> command) and trying to print using the
- system print command such as <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->lpr(1)</B
-> or <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
-> lp(1)</B
->.</P
-><P
->This parameter does not accept % macros, because
- many parts of the system require this value to be
- constant for correct operation.</P
-><P
->Default: <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->specified at compile time, usually
- "nobody"</I
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->guest account = ftp</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="GUESTOK"
-></A
->guest ok (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->If this parameter is <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->yes</TT
-> for
- a service, then no password is required to connect to the service.
- Privileges will be those of the <A
-HREF="#GUESTACCOUNT"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
-> guest account</I
-></TT
-></A
->.</P
-><P
->See the section below on <A
-HREF="#SECURITY"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
-> security</I
-></TT
-></A
-> for more information about this option.
- </P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->guest ok = no</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="GUESTONLY"
-></A
->guest only (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->If this parameter is <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->yes</TT
-> for
- a service, then only guest connections to the service are permitted.
- This parameter will have no effect if <A
-HREF="#GUESTOK"
-> <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->guest ok</I
-></TT
-></A
-> is not set for the service.</P
-><P
->See the section below on <A
-HREF="#SECURITY"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
-> security</I
-></TT
-></A
-> for more information about this option.
- </P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->guest only = no</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="HIDEDOTFILES"
-></A
->hide dot files (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This is a boolean parameter that controls whether
- files starting with a dot appear as hidden files.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->hide dot files = yes</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="HIDEFILES"
-></A
->hide files(S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This is a list of files or directories that are not
- visible but are accessible. The DOS 'hidden' attribute is applied
- to any files or directories that match.</P
-><P
->Each entry in the list must be separated by a '/',
- which allows spaces to be included in the entry. '*'
- and '?' can be used to specify multiple files or directories
- as in DOS wildcards.</P
-><P
->Each entry must be a Unix path, not a DOS path and must
- not include the Unix directory separator '/'.</P
-><P
->Note that the case sensitivity option is applicable
- in hiding files.</P
-><P
->Setting this parameter will affect the performance of Samba,
- as it will be forced to check all files and directories for a match
- as they are scanned.</P
-><P
->See also <A
-HREF="#HIDEDOTFILES"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->hide
- dot files</I
-></TT
-></A
->, <A
-HREF="#VETOFILES"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
-> veto files</I
-></TT
-></A
-> and <A
-HREF="#CASESENSITIVE"
-> <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->case sensitive</I
-></TT
-></A
->.</P
-><P
->Default: <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->no file are hidden</I
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->hide files =
- /.*/DesktopFolderDB/TrashFor%m/resource.frk/</B
-></P
-><P
->The above example is based on files that the Macintosh
- SMB client (DAVE) available from <A
-HREF="http://www.thursby.com"
-TARGET="_top"
->
- Thursby</A
-> creates for internal use, and also still hides
- all files beginning with a dot.</P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="HIDELOCALUSERS"
-></A
->hide local users(G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This parameter toggles the hiding of local UNIX
- users (root, wheel, floppy, etc) from remote clients.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->hide local users = no</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="HIDEUNREADABLE"
-></A
->hide unreadable (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This parameter prevents clients from seeing the
- existance of files that cannot be read. Defaults to off.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->hide unreadable = no</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="HIDEUNWRITEABLEFILES"
-></A
->hide unwriteable files (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This parameter prevents clients from seeing
- the existance of files that cannot be written to. Defaults to off.
- Note that unwriteable directories are shown as usual.
- </P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->hide unwriteable = no</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="HIDESPECIALFILES"
-></A
->hide special files (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This parameter prevents clients from seeing
- special files such as sockets, devices and fifo's in directory
- listings.
- </P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->hide special files = no</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="HOMEDIRMAP"
-></A
->homedir map (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->If<A
-HREF="#NISHOMEDIR"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->nis homedir
- </I
-></TT
-></A
-> is <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->yes</TT
->, and <A
-HREF="smbd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbd(8)</B
-></A
-> is also acting
- as a Win95/98 <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->logon server</I
-></TT
-> then this parameter
- specifies the NIS (or YP) map from which the server for the user's
- home directory should be extracted. At present, only the Sun
- auto.home map format is understood. The form of the map is:</P
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->username server:/some/file/system</B
-></P
-><P
->and the program will extract the servername from before
- the first ':'. There should probably be a better parsing system
- that copes with different map formats and also Amd (another
- automounter) maps.</P
-><P
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->NOTE :</I
->A working NIS client is required on
- the system for this option to work.</P
-><P
->See also <A
-HREF="#NISHOMEDIR"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->nis homedir</I
-></TT
->
- </A
->, <A
-HREF="#DOMAINLOGONS"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->domain logons</I
-></TT
->
- </A
->.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->homedir map = &#60;empty string&#62;</B
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->homedir map = amd.homedir</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="HOSTMSDFS"
-></A
->host msdfs (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This boolean parameter is only available
- if Samba has been configured and compiled with the <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
-> --with-msdfs</B
-> option. If set to <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->yes</TT
->,
- Samba will act as a Dfs server, and allow Dfs-aware clients
- to browse Dfs trees hosted on the server.</P
-><P
->See also the <A
-HREF="#MSDFSROOT"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
-> msdfs root</I
-></TT
-></A
-> share level parameter. For
- more information on setting up a Dfs tree on Samba,
- refer to <A
-HREF="msdfs_setup.html"
-TARGET="_top"
->msdfs_setup.html</A
->.
- </P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->host msdfs = no</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="HOSTNAMELOOKUPS"
-></A
->hostname lookups (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Specifies whether samba should use (expensive)
- hostname lookups or use the ip addresses instead. An example place
- where hostname lookups are currently used is when checking
- the <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->hosts deny</B
-> and <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->hosts allow</B
->.
- </P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->hostname lookups = yes</B
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->hostname lookups = no</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="HOSTSALLOW"
-></A
->hosts allow (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->A synonym for this parameter is <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->allow
- hosts</I
-></TT
->.</P
-><P
->This parameter is a comma, space, or tab delimited
- set of hosts which are permitted to access a service.</P
-><P
->If specified in the [global] section then it will
- apply to all services, regardless of whether the individual
- service has a different setting.</P
-><P
->You can specify the hosts by name or IP number. For
- example, you could restrict access to only the hosts on a
- Class C subnet with something like <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->allow hosts = 150.203.5.
- </B
->. The full syntax of the list is described in the man
- page <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->hosts_access(5)</TT
->. Note that this man
- page may not be present on your system, so a brief description will
- be given here also.</P
-><P
->Note that the localhost address 127.0.0.1 will always
- be allowed access unless specifically denied by a <A
-HREF="#HOSTSDENY"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->hosts deny</I
-></TT
-></A
-> option.</P
-><P
->You can also specify hosts by network/netmask pairs and
- by netgroup names if your system supports netgroups. The
- <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->EXCEPT</I
-> keyword can also be used to limit a
- wildcard list. The following examples may provide some help:</P
-><P
->Example 1: allow all IPs in 150.203.*.*; except one</P
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->hosts allow = 150.203. EXCEPT 150.203.6.66</B
-></P
-><P
->Example 2: allow hosts that match the given network/netmask</P
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->hosts allow = 150.203.15.0/255.255.255.0</B
-></P
-><P
->Example 3: allow a couple of hosts</P
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->hosts allow = lapland, arvidsjaur</B
-></P
-><P
->Example 4: allow only hosts in NIS netgroup "foonet", but
- deny access from one particular host</P
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->hosts allow = @foonet</B
-></P
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->hosts deny = pirate</B
-></P
-><P
->Note that access still requires suitable user-level passwords.</P
-><P
->See <A
-HREF="testparm.1.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->testparm(1)</B
->
- </A
-> for a way of testing your host access to see if it does
- what you expect.</P
-><P
->Default: <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->none (i.e., all hosts permitted access)
- </I
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->allow hosts = 150.203.5. myhost.mynet.edu.au
- </B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="HOSTSDENY"
-></A
->hosts deny (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->The opposite of <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->hosts allow</I
-></TT
->
- - hosts listed here are <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->NOT</I
-> permitted access to
- services unless the specific services have their own lists to override
- this one. Where the lists conflict, the <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->allow</I
-></TT
->
- list takes precedence.</P
-><P
->Default: <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->none (i.e., no hosts specifically excluded)
- </I
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->hosts deny = 150.203.4. badhost.mynet.edu.au
- </B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="HOSTSEQUIV"
-></A
->hosts equiv (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->If this global parameter is a non-null string,
- it specifies the name of a file to read for the names of hosts
- and users who will be allowed access without specifying a password.
- </P
-><P
->This is not be confused with <A
-HREF="#HOSTSALLOW"
-> <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->hosts allow</I
-></TT
-></A
-> which is about hosts
- access to services and is more useful for guest services. <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
-> hosts equiv</I
-></TT
-> may be useful for NT clients which will
- not supply passwords to Samba.</P
-><P
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->NOTE :</I
-> The use of <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->hosts equiv
- </I
-></TT
-> can be a major security hole. This is because you are
- trusting the PC to supply the correct username. It is very easy to
- get a PC to supply a false username. I recommend that the
- <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->hosts equiv</I
-></TT
-> option be only used if you really
- know what you are doing, or perhaps on a home network where you trust
- your spouse and kids. And only if you <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->really</I
-> trust
- them :-).</P
-><P
->Default: <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->no host equivalences</I
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->hosts equiv = /etc/hosts.equiv</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="INCLUDE"
-></A
->include (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This allows you to include one config file
- inside another. The file is included literally, as though typed
- in place.</P
-><P
->It takes the standard substitutions, except <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->%u
- </I
-></TT
->, <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->%P</I
-></TT
-> and <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->%S</I
-></TT
->.
- </P
-><P
->Default: <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->no file included</I
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->include = /usr/local/samba/lib/admin_smb.conf
- </B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="INHERITACLS"
-></A
->inherit acls (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This parameter can be used to ensure
- that if default acls exist on parent directories,
- they are always honored when creating a subdirectory.
- The default behavior is to use the mode specified
- when creating the directory. Enabling this option
- sets the mode to 0777, thus guaranteeing that
- default directory acls are propagated.
- </P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->inherit acls = no</B
->
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="INHERITPERMISSIONS"
-></A
->inherit permissions (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->The permissions on new files and directories
- are normally governed by <A
-HREF="#CREATEMASK"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
-> create mask</I
-></TT
-></A
->, <A
-HREF="#DIRECTORYMASK"
-> <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->directory mask</I
-></TT
-></A
->, <A
-HREF="#FORCECREATEMODE"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->force create mode</I
-></TT
->
- </A
-> and <A
-HREF="#FORCEDIRECTORYMODE"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->force
- directory mode</I
-></TT
-></A
-> but the boolean inherit
- permissions parameter overrides this.</P
-><P
->New directories inherit the mode of the parent directory,
- including bits such as setgid.</P
-><P
->New files inherit their read/write bits from the parent
- directory. Their execute bits continue to be determined by
- <A
-HREF="#MAPARCHIVE"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->map archive</I
-></TT
->
- </A
->, <A
-HREF="#MAPHIDDEN"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->map hidden</I
-></TT
->
- </A
-> and <A
-HREF="#MAPSYSTEM"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->map system</I
-></TT
->
- </A
-> as usual.</P
-><P
->Note that the setuid bit is <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->never</I
-> set via
- inheritance (the code explicitly prohibits this).</P
-><P
->This can be particularly useful on large systems with
- many users, perhaps several thousand, to allow a single [homes]
- share to be used flexibly by each user.</P
-><P
->See also <A
-HREF="#CREATEMASK"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->create mask
- </I
-></TT
-></A
->, <A
-HREF="#DIRECTORYMASK"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
-> directory mask</I
-></TT
-></A
->, <A
-HREF="#FORCECREATEMODE"
-> <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->force create mode</I
-></TT
-></A
-> and <A
-HREF="#FORCEDIRECTORYMODE"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->force directory mode</I
-></TT
->
- </A
->.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->inherit permissions = no</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="INTERFACES"
-></A
->interfaces (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This option allows you to override the default
- network interfaces list that Samba will use for browsing, name
- registration and other NBT traffic. By default Samba will query
- the kernel for the list of all active interfaces and use any
- interfaces except 127.0.0.1 that are broadcast capable.</P
-><P
->The option takes a list of interface strings. Each string
- can be in any of the following forms:</P
-><P
-></P
-><UL
-><LI
-><P
->a network interface name (such as eth0).
- This may include shell-like wildcards so eth* will match
- any interface starting with the substring "eth"</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->an IP address. In this case the netmask is
- determined from the list of interfaces obtained from the
- kernel</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->an IP/mask pair. </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->a broadcast/mask pair.</P
-></LI
-></UL
-><P
->The "mask" parameters can either be a bit length (such
- as 24 for a C class network) or a full netmask in dotted
- decimal form.</P
-><P
->The "IP" parameters above can either be a full dotted
- decimal IP address or a hostname which will be looked up via
- the OS's normal hostname resolution mechanisms.</P
-><P
->For example, the following line:</P
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->interfaces = eth0 192.168.2.10/24 192.168.3.10/255.255.255.0
- </B
-></P
-><P
->would configure three network interfaces corresponding
- to the eth0 device and IP addresses 192.168.2.10 and 192.168.3.10.
- The netmasks of the latter two interfaces would be set to 255.255.255.0.</P
-><P
->See also <A
-HREF="#BINDINTERFACESONLY"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->bind
- interfaces only</I
-></TT
-></A
->.</P
-><P
->Default: <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->all active interfaces except 127.0.0.1
- that are broadcast capable</I
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="INVALIDUSERS"
-></A
->invalid users (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This is a list of users that should not be allowed
- to login to this service. This is really a <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->paranoid</I
->
- check to absolutely ensure an improper setting does not breach
- your security.</P
-><P
->A name starting with a '@' is interpreted as an NIS
- netgroup first (if your system supports NIS), and then as a UNIX
- group if the name was not found in the NIS netgroup database.</P
-><P
->A name starting with '+' is interpreted only
- by looking in the UNIX group database. A name starting with
- '&#38;' is interpreted only by looking in the NIS netgroup database
- (this requires NIS to be working on your system). The characters
- '+' and '&#38;' may be used at the start of the name in either order
- so the value <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->+&#38;group</I
-></TT
-> means check the
- UNIX group database, followed by the NIS netgroup database, and
- the value <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->&#38;+group</I
-></TT
-> means check the NIS
- netgroup database, followed by the UNIX group database (the
- same as the '@' prefix).</P
-><P
->The current servicename is substituted for <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->%S</I
-></TT
->.
- This is useful in the [homes] section.</P
-><P
->See also <A
-HREF="#VALIDUSERS"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->valid users
- </I
-></TT
-></A
->.</P
-><P
->Default: <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->no invalid users</I
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->invalid users = root fred admin @wheel
- </B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="KEEPALIVE"
-></A
->keepalive (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->The value of the parameter (an integer) represents
- the number of seconds between <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->keepalive</I
-></TT
->
- packets. If this parameter is zero, no keepalive packets will be
- sent. Keepalive packets, if sent, allow the server to tell whether
- a client is still present and responding.</P
-><P
->Keepalives should, in general, not be needed if the socket
- being used has the SO_KEEPALIVE attribute set on it (see <A
-HREF="#SOCKETOPTIONS"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->socket options</I
-></TT
-></A
->).
- Basically you should only use this option if you strike difficulties.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->keepalive = 300</B
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->keepalive = 600</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="KERNELOPLOCKS"
-></A
->kernel oplocks (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->For UNIXes that support kernel based <A
-HREF="#OPLOCKS"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->oplocks</I
-></TT
-></A
->
- (currently only IRIX and the Linux 2.4 kernel), this parameter
- allows the use of them to be turned on or off.</P
-><P
->Kernel oplocks support allows Samba <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->oplocks
- </I
-></TT
-> to be broken whenever a local UNIX process or NFS operation
- accesses a file that <A
-HREF="smbd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbd(8)</B
->
- </A
-> has oplocked. This allows complete data consistency between
- SMB/CIFS, NFS and local file access (and is a <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->very</I
->
- cool feature :-).</P
-><P
->This parameter defaults to <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->on</TT
->, but is translated
- to a no-op on systems that no not have the necessary kernel support.
- You should never need to touch this parameter.</P
-><P
->See also the <A
-HREF="#OPLOCKS"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->oplocks</I
-></TT
->
- </A
-> and <A
-HREF="#LEVEL2OPLOCKS"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->level2 oplocks
- </I
-></TT
-></A
-> parameters.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->kernel oplocks = yes</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="LANMANAUTH"
-></A
->lanman auth (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This parameter determines whether or not <A
-HREF="smbd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
->smbd</A
-> will
- attempt to authenticate users using the LANMAN password hash.
- If disabled, only clients which support NT password hashes (e.g. Windows
- NT/2000 clients, smbclient, etc... but not Windows 95/98 or the MS DOS
- network client) will be able to connect to the Samba host.</P
-><P
->Default : <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->lanman auth = yes</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="LARGEREADWRITE"
-></A
->large readwrite (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This parameter determines whether or not <A
-HREF="smbd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
->smbd</A
->
- supports the new 64k streaming read and write varient SMB requests introduced
- with Windows 2000. Note that due to Windows 2000 client redirector bugs
- this requires Samba to be running on a 64-bit capable operating system such
- as IRIX, Solaris or a Linux 2.4 kernel. Can improve performance by 10% with
- Windows 2000 clients. Defaults to on. Not as tested as some other Samba
- code paths.
- </P
-><P
->Default : <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->large readwrite = yes</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="LDAPADMINDN"
-></A
->ldap admin dn (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->The <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->ldap admin dn</I
-></TT
-> defines the Distinguished
- Name (DN) name used by Samba to contact the ldap server when retreiving
- user account information. The <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->ldap
- admin dn</I
-></TT
-> is used in conjunction with the admin dn password
- stored in the <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->private/secrets.tdb</TT
-> file. See the
- <A
-HREF="smbpasswd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbpasswd(8)</B
-></A
-> man
- page for more information on how to accomplish this.
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="LDAPDELETEDN"
-></A
->&#62;ldap del only sam attr (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
-> This parameter specifies whether a delete
- operation in the ldapsam deletes the complete entry or only the attributes
- specific to Samba.
- </P
-><P
->Default : <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->ldap delete dn = no</I
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="LDAPDELONLYSAMATTR"
-></A
->&#62;ldap del only sam attr (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
-> Inverted synonym for <A
-HREF="#LDAPDELETEDN"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
-> ldap delete dn</I
-></TT
-></A
->.
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="LDAPFILTER"
-></A
->ldap filter (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This parameter specifies the RFC 2254 compliant LDAP search filter.
- The default is to match the login name with the <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->uid</TT
->
- attribute for all entries matching the <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->sambaAccount</TT
->
- objectclass. Note that this filter should only return one entry.
- </P
-><P
->Default : <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->ldap filter = (&#38;(uid=%u)(objectclass=sambaAccount))</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="LDAPPORT"
-></A
->ldap port (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This parameter is only available if Samba has been
- configure to include the <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->--with-ldapsam</B
-> option
- at compile time.
- </P
-><P
-> This option is used to control the tcp port number used to contact
- the <A
-HREF="#LDAPSERVER"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->ldap server</I
-></TT
-></A
->.
- The default is to use the stand LDAPS port 636.
- </P
-><P
->See Also: <A
-HREF="#LDAPSSL"
->ldap ssl</A
->
- </P
-><P
->Default : <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->ldap port = 636 ; if ldap ssl = on</B
-></P
-><P
->Default : <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->ldap port = 389 ; if ldap ssl = off</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="LDAPSERVER"
-></A
->ldap server (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This parameter is only available if Samba has been
- configure to include the <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->--with-ldapsam</B
-> option
- at compile time.
- </P
-><P
-> This parameter should contain the FQDN of the ldap directory
- server which should be queried to locate user account information.
- </P
-><P
->Default : <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->ldap server = localhost</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="LDAPSSL"
-></A
->ldap ssl (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This option is used to define whether or not Samba should
- use SSL when connecting to the ldap server
- This is <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->NOT</I
-> related to
- Samba's previous SSL support which was enabled by specifying the
- <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->--with-ssl</B
-> option to the <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->configure</TT
->
- script.
- </P
-><P
-> The <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->ldap ssl</I
-></TT
-> can be set to one of three values:
- </P
-><P
-></P
-><UL
-><LI
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->Off</I
-></TT
-> = Never use SSL when querying the directory.</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->Start_tls</I
-></TT
-> = Use the LDAPv3 StartTLS extended operation
- (RFC2830) for communicating with the directory server.</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->On</I
-></TT
-> =
- Use SSL on the ldaps port when contacting the
- <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->ldap server</I
-></TT
->. Only
- available when the backwards-compatiblity <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
-> --with-ldapsam</B
-> option is specified
- to configure. See <A
-HREF="#PASSDBBACKEND"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->passdb backend</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-></UL
-><P
->Default : <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->ldap ssl = start_tls</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="LDAPSUFFIX"
-></A
->ldap suffix (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Specifies where user and machine accounts are added to the tree. Can be overriden by <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->ldap user suffix</B
-> and <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->ldap machine suffix</B
->. It also used as the base dn for all ldap searches. </P
-><P
->Default : <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->none</I
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="LDAPUSERSUFFIX"
-></A
->ldap user suffix (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->It specifies where users are added to the tree.
- </P
-><P
->Default : <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->none</I
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="LDAPMACHINESUFFIX"
-></A
->ldap machine suffix (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->It specifies where machines should be
- added to the ldap tree.
- </P
-><P
->Default : <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->none</I
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="LDAPPASSWDSYNC"
-></A
->ldap passwd sync (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This option is used to define whether
- or not Samba should sync the LDAP password with the NT
- and LM hashes for normal accounts (NOT for
- workstation, server or domain trusts) on a password
- change via SAMBA.
- </P
-><P
-> The <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->ldap passwd sync</I
-></TT
-> can be set to one of three values:
- </P
-><P
-></P
-><UL
-><LI
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->Yes</I
-></TT
-> = Try to update the LDAP, NT and LM passwords and update the pwdLastSet time.</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->No</I
-></TT
-> = Update NT and LM passwords and update the pwdLastSet time.</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->Only</I
-></TT
-> = Only update the LDAP password and let the LDAP server do the rest.</P
-></LI
-></UL
-><P
->Default : <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->ldap passwd sync = no</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="LDAPTRUSTIDS"
-></A
->ldap trust ids (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Normally, Samba validates each entry
- in the LDAP server against getpwnam(). This allows
- LDAP to be used for Samba with the unix system using
- NIS (for example) and also ensures that Samba does not
- present accounts that do not otherwise exist. </P
-><P
->This option is used to disable this functionality, and
- instead to rely on the presence of the appropriate
- attributes in LDAP directly, which can result in a
- significant performance boost in some situations.
- Setting this option to yes effectivly assumes
- that the local machine is running <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->nss_ldap</B
-> against the
- same LDAP server.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->ldap trust ids = No</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="LEVEL2OPLOCKS"
-></A
->level2 oplocks (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This parameter controls whether Samba supports
- level2 (read-only) oplocks on a share.</P
-><P
->Level2, or read-only oplocks allow Windows NT clients
- that have an oplock on a file to downgrade from a read-write oplock
- to a read-only oplock once a second client opens the file (instead
- of releasing all oplocks on a second open, as in traditional,
- exclusive oplocks). This allows all openers of the file that
- support level2 oplocks to cache the file for read-ahead only (ie.
- they may not cache writes or lock requests) and increases performance
- for many accesses of files that are not commonly written (such as
- application .EXE files).</P
-><P
->Once one of the clients which have a read-only oplock
- writes to the file all clients are notified (no reply is needed
- or waited for) and told to break their oplocks to "none" and
- delete any read-ahead caches.</P
-><P
->It is recommended that this parameter be turned on
- to speed access to shared executables.</P
-><P
->For more discussions on level2 oplocks see the CIFS spec.</P
-><P
->Currently, if <A
-HREF="#KERNELOPLOCKS"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->kernel
- oplocks</I
-></TT
-></A
-> are supported then level2 oplocks are
- not granted (even if this parameter is set to <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->yes</TT
->).
- Note also, the <A
-HREF="#OPLOCKS"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->oplocks</I
-></TT
->
- </A
-> parameter must be set to <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->yes</TT
-> on this share in order for
- this parameter to have any effect.</P
-><P
->See also the <A
-HREF="#OPLOCKS"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->oplocks</I
-></TT
->
- </A
-> and <A
-HREF="#OPLOCKS"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->kernel oplocks</I
-></TT
->
- </A
-> parameters.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->level2 oplocks = yes</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="LMANNOUNCE"
-></A
->lm announce (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This parameter determines if <A
-HREF="nmbd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-> <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->nmbd(8)</B
-></A
-> will produce Lanman announce
- broadcasts that are needed by OS/2 clients in order for them to see
- the Samba server in their browse list. This parameter can have three
- values, <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->yes</TT
->, <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->no</TT
->, or
- <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->auto</TT
->. The default is <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->auto</TT
->.
- If set to <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->no</TT
-> Samba will never produce these
- broadcasts. If set to <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->yes</TT
-> Samba will produce
- Lanman announce broadcasts at a frequency set by the parameter
- <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->lm interval</I
-></TT
->. If set to <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->auto</TT
->
- Samba will not send Lanman announce broadcasts by default but will
- listen for them. If it hears such a broadcast on the wire it will
- then start sending them at a frequency set by the parameter
- <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->lm interval</I
-></TT
->.</P
-><P
->See also <A
-HREF="#LMINTERVAL"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->lm interval
- </I
-></TT
-></A
->.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->lm announce = auto</B
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->lm announce = yes</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="LMINTERVAL"
-></A
->lm interval (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->If Samba is set to produce Lanman announce
- broadcasts needed by OS/2 clients (see the <A
-HREF="#LMANNOUNCE"
-> <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->lm announce</I
-></TT
-></A
-> parameter) then this
- parameter defines the frequency in seconds with which they will be
- made. If this is set to zero then no Lanman announcements will be
- made despite the setting of the <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->lm announce</I
-></TT
->
- parameter.</P
-><P
->See also <A
-HREF="#LMANNOUNCE"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->lm
- announce</I
-></TT
-></A
->.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->lm interval = 60</B
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->lm interval = 120</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="LOADPRINTERS"
-></A
->load printers (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->A boolean variable that controls whether all
- printers in the printcap will be loaded for browsing by default.
- See the <A
-HREF="#AEN79"
->printers</A
-> section for
- more details.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->load printers = yes</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="LOCALMASTER"
-></A
->local master (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This option allows <A
-HREF="nmbd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
-> nmbd(8)</B
-></A
-> to try and become a local master browser
- on a subnet. If set to <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->no</TT
-> then <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
-> nmbd</B
-> will not attempt to become a local master browser
- on a subnet and will also lose in all browsing elections. By
- default this value is set to <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->yes</TT
->. Setting this value to <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->yes</TT
-> doesn't
- mean that Samba will <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->become</I
-> the local master
- browser on a subnet, just that <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->nmbd</B
-> will <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
-> participate</I
-> in elections for local master browser.</P
-><P
->Setting this value to <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->no</TT
-> will cause <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->nmbd</B
->
- <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->never</I
-> to become a local master browser.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->local master = yes</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="LOCKDIR"
-></A
->lock dir (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Synonym for <A
-HREF="#LOCKDIRECTORY"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
-> lock directory</I
-></TT
-></A
->.</P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="LOCKDIRECTORY"
-></A
->lock directory (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This option specifies the directory where lock
- files will be placed. The lock files are used to implement the
- <A
-HREF="#MAXCONNECTIONS"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->max connections</I
-></TT
->
- </A
-> option.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->lock directory = ${prefix}/var/locks</B
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->lock directory = /var/run/samba/locks</B
->
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="LOCKSPINCOUNT"
-></A
->lock spin count (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This parameter controls the number of times
- that smbd should attempt to gain a byte range lock on the
- behalf of a client request. Experiments have shown that
- Windows 2k servers do not reply with a failure if the lock
- could not be immediately granted, but try a few more times
- in case the lock could later be aquired. This behavior
- is used to support PC database formats such as MS Access
- and FoxPro.
- </P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->lock spin count = 2</B
->
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="LOCKSPINTIME"
-></A
->lock spin time (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->The time in microseconds that smbd should
- pause before attempting to gain a failed lock. See
- <A
-HREF="#LOCKSPINCOUNT"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->lock spin
- count</I
-></TT
-></A
-> for more details.
- </P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->lock spin time = 10</B
->
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="LOCKING"
-></A
->locking (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This controls whether or not locking will be
- performed by the server in response to lock requests from the
- client.</P
-><P
->If <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->locking = no</B
->, all lock and unlock
- requests will appear to succeed and all lock queries will report
- that the file in question is available for locking.</P
-><P
->If <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->locking = yes</B
->, real locking will be performed
- by the server.</P
-><P
->This option <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->may</I
-> be useful for read-only
- filesystems which <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->may</I
-> not need locking (such as
- CDROM drives), although setting this parameter of <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->no</TT
->
- is not really recommended even in this case.</P
-><P
->Be careful about disabling locking either globally or in a
- specific service, as lack of locking may result in data corruption.
- You should never need to set this parameter.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->locking = yes</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="LOGFILE"
-></A
->log file (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This option allows you to override the name
- of the Samba log file (also known as the debug file).</P
-><P
->This option takes the standard substitutions, allowing
- you to have separate log files for each user or machine.</P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->log file = /usr/local/samba/var/log.%m
- </B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="LOGLEVEL"
-></A
->log level (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->The value of the parameter (a astring) allows
- the debug level (logging level) to be specified in the
- <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->smb.conf</TT
-> file. This parameter has been
- extended since the 2.2.x series, now it allow to specify the debug
- level for multiple debug classes. This is to give greater
- flexibility in the configuration of the system.</P
-><P
->The default will be the log level specified on
- the command line or level zero if none was specified.</P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->log level = 3 passdb:5 auth:10 winbind:2
- </B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="LOGONDRIVE"
-></A
->logon drive (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This parameter specifies the local path to
- which the home directory will be connected (see <A
-HREF="#LOGONHOME"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->logon home</I
-></TT
-></A
->)
- and is only used by NT Workstations. </P
-><P
->Note that this option is only useful if Samba is set up as a
- logon server.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->logon drive = z:</B
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->logon drive = h:</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="LOGONHOME"
-></A
->logon home (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This parameter specifies the home directory
- location when a Win95/98 or NT Workstation logs into a Samba PDC.
- It allows you to do </P
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="PROMPT"
->C:\&#62; </TT
-><TT
-CLASS="USERINPUT"
-><B
->NET USE H: /HOME</B
-></TT
->
- </P
-><P
->from a command prompt, for example.</P
-><P
->This option takes the standard substitutions, allowing
- you to have separate logon scripts for each user or machine.</P
-><P
->This parameter can be used with Win9X workstations to ensure
- that roaming profiles are stored in a subdirectory of the user's
- home directory. This is done in the following way:</P
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->logon home = \\%N\%U\profile</B
-></P
-><P
->This tells Samba to return the above string, with
- substitutions made when a client requests the info, generally
- in a NetUserGetInfo request. Win9X clients truncate the info to
- \\server\share when a user does <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->net use /home</B
->
- but use the whole string when dealing with profiles.</P
-><P
->Note that in prior versions of Samba, the <A
-HREF="#LOGONPATH"
-> <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->logon path</I
-></TT
-></A
-> was returned rather than
- <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->logon home</I
-></TT
->. This broke <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->net use
- /home</B
-> but allowed profiles outside the home directory.
- The current implementation is correct, and can be used for
- profiles if you use the above trick.</P
-><P
->This option is only useful if Samba is set up as a logon
- server.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->logon home = "\\%N\%U"</B
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->logon home = "\\remote_smb_server\%U"</B
->
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="LOGONPATH"
-></A
->logon path (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This parameter specifies the home directory
- where roaming profiles (NTuser.dat etc files for Windows NT) are
- stored. Contrary to previous versions of these manual pages, it has
- nothing to do with Win 9X roaming profiles. To find out how to
- handle roaming profiles for Win 9X system, see the <A
-HREF="#LOGONHOME"
-> <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->logon home</I
-></TT
-></A
-> parameter.</P
-><P
->This option takes the standard substitutions, allowing you
- to have separate logon scripts for each user or machine. It also
- specifies the directory from which the "Application Data",
- (<TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->desktop</TT
->, <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->start menu</TT
->,
- <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->network neighborhood</TT
->, <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->programs</TT
->
- and other folders, and their contents, are loaded and displayed on
- your Windows NT client.</P
-><P
->The share and the path must be readable by the user for
- the preferences and directories to be loaded onto the Windows NT
- client. The share must be writeable when the user logs in for the first
- time, in order that the Windows NT client can create the NTuser.dat
- and other directories.</P
-><P
->Thereafter, the directories and any of the contents can,
- if required, be made read-only. It is not advisable that the
- NTuser.dat file be made read-only - rename it to NTuser.man to
- achieve the desired effect (a <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->MAN</I
->datory
- profile). </P
-><P
->Windows clients can sometimes maintain a connection to
- the [homes] share, even though there is no user logged in.
- Therefore, it is vital that the logon path does not include a
- reference to the homes share (i.e. setting this parameter to
- \%N\%U\profile_path will cause problems).</P
-><P
->This option takes the standard substitutions, allowing
- you to have separate logon scripts for each user or machine.</P
-><P
->Note that this option is only useful if Samba is set up
- as a logon server.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->logon path = \\%N\%U\profile</B
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->logon path = \\PROFILESERVER\PROFILE\%U</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="LOGONSCRIPT"
-></A
->logon script (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This parameter specifies the batch file (.bat) or
- NT command file (.cmd) to be downloaded and run on a machine when
- a user successfully logs in. The file must contain the DOS
- style CR/LF line endings. Using a DOS-style editor to create the
- file is recommended.</P
-><P
->The script must be a relative path to the [netlogon]
- service. If the [netlogon] service specifies a <A
-HREF="#PATH"
-> <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->path</I
-></TT
-></A
-> of <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/usr/local/samba/netlogon
- </TT
->, and <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->logon script = STARTUP.BAT</B
->, then
- the file that will be downloaded is:</P
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/usr/local/samba/netlogon/STARTUP.BAT</TT
-></P
-><P
->The contents of the batch file are entirely your choice. A
- suggested command would be to add <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->NET TIME \\SERVER /SET
- /YES</B
->, to force every machine to synchronize clocks with
- the same time server. Another use would be to add <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->NET USE
- U: \\SERVER\UTILS</B
-> for commonly used utilities, or <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
-> NET USE Q: \\SERVER\ISO9001_QA</B
-> for example.</P
-><P
->Note that it is particularly important not to allow write
- access to the [netlogon] share, or to grant users write permission
- on the batch files in a secure environment, as this would allow
- the batch files to be arbitrarily modified and security to be
- breached.</P
-><P
->This option takes the standard substitutions, allowing you
- to have separate logon scripts for each user or machine.</P
-><P
->This option is only useful if Samba is set up as a logon
- server.</P
-><P
->Default: <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->no logon script defined</I
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->logon script = scripts\%U.bat</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="LPPAUSECOMMAND"
-></A
->lppause command (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This parameter specifies the command to be
- executed on the server host in order to stop printing or spooling
- a specific print job.</P
-><P
->This command should be a program or script which takes
- a printer name and job number to pause the print job. One way
- of implementing this is by using job priorities, where jobs
- having a too low priority won't be sent to the printer.</P
-><P
->If a <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->%p</I
-></TT
-> is given then the printer name
- is put in its place. A <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->%j</I
-></TT
-> is replaced with
- the job number (an integer). On HPUX (see <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->printing=hpux
- </I
-></TT
->), if the <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->-p%p</I
-></TT
-> option is added
- to the lpq command, the job will show up with the correct status, i.e.
- if the job priority is lower than the set fence priority it will
- have the PAUSED status, whereas if the priority is equal or higher it
- will have the SPOOLED or PRINTING status.</P
-><P
->Note that it is good practice to include the absolute path
- in the lppause command as the PATH may not be available to the server.</P
-><P
->See also the <A
-HREF="#PRINTING"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->printing
- </I
-></TT
-></A
-> parameter.</P
-><P
->Default: Currently no default value is given to
- this string, unless the value of the <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->printing</I
-></TT
->
- parameter is <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->SYSV</TT
->, in which case the default is :</P
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->lp -i %p-%j -H hold</B
-></P
-><P
->or if the value of the <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->printing</I
-></TT
-> parameter
- is <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->SOFTQ</TT
->, then the default is:</P
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->qstat -s -j%j -h</B
-></P
-><P
->Example for HPUX: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->lppause command = /usr/bin/lpalt
- %p-%j -p0</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="LPQCACHETIME"
-></A
->lpq cache time (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This controls how long lpq info will be cached
- for to prevent the <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->lpq</B
-> command being called too
- often. A separate cache is kept for each variation of the <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
-> lpq</B
-> command used by the system, so if you use different
- <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->lpq</B
-> commands for different users then they won't
- share cache information.</P
-><P
->The cache files are stored in <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/tmp/lpq.xxxx</TT
->
- where xxxx is a hash of the <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->lpq</B
-> command in use.</P
-><P
->The default is 10 seconds, meaning that the cached results
- of a previous identical <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->lpq</B
-> command will be used
- if the cached data is less than 10 seconds old. A large value may
- be advisable if your <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->lpq</B
-> command is very slow.</P
-><P
->A value of 0 will disable caching completely.</P
-><P
->See also the <A
-HREF="#PRINTING"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->printing
- </I
-></TT
-></A
-> parameter.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->lpq cache time = 10</B
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->lpq cache time = 30</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="LPQCOMMAND"
-></A
->lpq command (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This parameter specifies the command to be
- executed on the server host in order to obtain <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->lpq
- </B
->-style printer status information.</P
-><P
->This command should be a program or script which
- takes a printer name as its only parameter and outputs printer
- status information.</P
-><P
->Currently nine styles of printer status information
- are supported; BSD, AIX, LPRNG, PLP, SYSV, HPUX, QNX, CUPS, and SOFTQ.
- This covers most UNIX systems. You control which type is expected
- using the <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->printing =</I
-></TT
-> option.</P
-><P
->Some clients (notably Windows for Workgroups) may not
- correctly send the connection number for the printer they are
- requesting status information about. To get around this, the
- server reports on the first printer service connected to by the
- client. This only happens if the connection number sent is invalid.</P
-><P
->If a <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->%p</I
-></TT
-> is given then the printer name
- is put in its place. Otherwise it is placed at the end of the
- command.</P
-><P
->Note that it is good practice to include the absolute path
- in the <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->lpq command</I
-></TT
-> as the <TT
-CLASS="ENVAR"
->$PATH
- </TT
-> may not be available to the server. When compiled with
- the CUPS libraries, no <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->lpq command</I
-></TT
-> is
- needed because smbd will make a library call to obtain the
- print queue listing.</P
-><P
->See also the <A
-HREF="#PRINTING"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->printing
- </I
-></TT
-></A
-> parameter.</P
-><P
->Default: <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->depends on the setting of <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
-> printing</I
-></TT
-></I
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->lpq command = /usr/bin/lpq -P%p</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="LPRESUMECOMMAND"
-></A
->lpresume command (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This parameter specifies the command to be
- executed on the server host in order to restart or continue
- printing or spooling a specific print job.</P
-><P
->This command should be a program or script which takes
- a printer name and job number to resume the print job. See
- also the <A
-HREF="#LPPAUSECOMMAND"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->lppause command
- </I
-></TT
-></A
-> parameter.</P
-><P
->If a <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->%p</I
-></TT
-> is given then the printer name
- is put in its place. A <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->%j</I
-></TT
-> is replaced with
- the job number (an integer).</P
-><P
->Note that it is good practice to include the absolute path
- in the <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->lpresume command</I
-></TT
-> as the PATH may not
- be available to the server.</P
-><P
->See also the <A
-HREF="#PRINTING"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->printing
- </I
-></TT
-></A
-> parameter.</P
-><P
->Default: Currently no default value is given
- to this string, unless the value of the <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->printing</I
-></TT
->
- parameter is <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->SYSV</TT
->, in which case the default is :</P
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->lp -i %p-%j -H resume</B
-></P
-><P
->or if the value of the <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->printing</I
-></TT
-> parameter
- is <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->SOFTQ</TT
->, then the default is:</P
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->qstat -s -j%j -r</B
-></P
-><P
->Example for HPUX: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->lpresume command = /usr/bin/lpalt
- %p-%j -p2</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="LPRMCOMMAND"
-></A
->lprm command (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This parameter specifies the command to be
- executed on the server host in order to delete a print job.</P
-><P
->This command should be a program or script which takes
- a printer name and job number, and deletes the print job.</P
-><P
->If a <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->%p</I
-></TT
-> is given then the printer name
- is put in its place. A <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->%j</I
-></TT
-> is replaced with
- the job number (an integer).</P
-><P
->Note that it is good practice to include the absolute
- path in the <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->lprm command</I
-></TT
-> as the PATH may not be
- available to the server.</P
-><P
->See also the <A
-HREF="#PRINTING"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->printing
- </I
-></TT
-></A
-> parameter.</P
-><P
->Default: <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->depends on the setting of <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->printing
- </I
-></TT
-></I
-></P
-><P
->Example 1: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->lprm command = /usr/bin/lprm -P%p %j
- </B
-></P
-><P
->Example 2: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->lprm command = /usr/bin/cancel %p-%j
- </B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="MACHINEPASSWORDTIMEOUT"
-></A
->machine password timeout (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->If a Samba server is a member of a Windows
- NT Domain (see the <A
-HREF="#SECURITYEQUALSDOMAIN"
->security = domain</A
->)
- parameter) then periodically a running <A
-HREF="smbd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-> smbd(8)</A
-> process will try and change the MACHINE ACCOUNT
- PASSWORD stored in the TDB called <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->private/secrets.tdb
- </TT
->. This parameter specifies how often this password
- will be changed, in seconds. The default is one week (expressed in
- seconds), the same as a Windows NT Domain member server.</P
-><P
->See also <A
-HREF="smbpasswd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbpasswd(8)
- </B
-></A
->, and the <A
-HREF="#SECURITYEQUALSDOMAIN"
-> security = domain</A
->) parameter.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->machine password timeout = 604800</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="MAGICOUTPUT"
-></A
->magic output (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This parameter specifies the name of a file
- which will contain output created by a magic script (see the
- <A
-HREF="#MAGICSCRIPT"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->magic script</I
-></TT
-></A
->
- parameter below).</P
-><P
->Warning: If two clients use the same <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->magic script
- </I
-></TT
-> in the same directory the output file content
- is undefined.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->magic output = &#60;magic script name&#62;.out
- </B
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->magic output = myfile.txt</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="MAGICSCRIPT"
-></A
->magic script (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This parameter specifies the name of a file which,
- if opened, will be executed by the server when the file is closed.
- This allows a UNIX script to be sent to the Samba host and
- executed on behalf of the connected user.</P
-><P
->Scripts executed in this way will be deleted upon
- completion assuming that the user has the appropriate level
- of privilege and the file permissions allow the deletion.</P
-><P
->If the script generates output, output will be sent to
- the file specified by the <A
-HREF="#MAGICOUTPUT"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
-> magic output</I
-></TT
-></A
-> parameter (see above).</P
-><P
->Note that some shells are unable to interpret scripts
- containing CR/LF instead of CR as
- the end-of-line marker. Magic scripts must be executable
- <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->as is</I
-> on the host, which for some hosts and
- some shells will require filtering at the DOS end.</P
-><P
->Magic scripts are <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->EXPERIMENTAL</I
-> and
- should <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->NOT</I
-> be relied upon.</P
-><P
->Default: <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->None. Magic scripts disabled.</I
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->magic script = user.csh</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="MANGLECASE"
-></A
->mangle case (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->See the section on <A
-HREF="#AEN205"
-> NAME MANGLING</A
-></P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->mangle case = no</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="MANGLEDMAP"
-></A
->mangled map (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This is for those who want to directly map UNIX
- file names which cannot be represented on Windows/DOS. The mangling
- of names is not always what is needed. In particular you may have
- documents with file extensions that differ between DOS and UNIX.
- For example, under UNIX it is common to use <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->.html</TT
->
- for HTML files, whereas under Windows/DOS <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->.htm</TT
->
- is more commonly used.</P
-><P
->So to map <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->html</TT
-> to <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->htm</TT
->
- you would use:</P
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->mangled map = (*.html *.htm)</B
-></P
-><P
->One very useful case is to remove the annoying <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->;1
- </TT
-> off the ends of filenames on some CDROMs (only visible
- under some UNIXes). To do this use a map of (*;1 *;).</P
-><P
->Default: <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->no mangled map</I
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->mangled map = (*;1 *;)</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="MANGLEDNAMES"
-></A
->mangled names (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This controls whether non-DOS names under UNIX
- should be mapped to DOS-compatible names ("mangled") and made visible,
- or whether non-DOS names should simply be ignored.</P
-><P
->See the section on <A
-HREF="#AEN205"
-> NAME MANGLING</A
-> for details on how to control the mangling process.</P
-><P
->If mangling is used then the mangling algorithm is as follows:</P
-><P
-></P
-><UL
-><LI
-><P
->The first (up to) five alphanumeric characters
- before the rightmost dot of the filename are preserved, forced
- to upper case, and appear as the first (up to) five characters
- of the mangled name.</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->A tilde "~" is appended to the first part of the mangled
- name, followed by a two-character unique sequence, based on the
- original root name (i.e., the original filename minus its final
- extension). The final extension is included in the hash calculation
- only if it contains any upper case characters or is longer than three
- characters.</P
-><P
->Note that the character to use may be specified using
- the <A
-HREF="#MANGLINGCHAR"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->mangling char</I
-></TT
->
- </A
-> option, if you don't like '~'.</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->The first three alphanumeric characters of the final
- extension are preserved, forced to upper case and appear as the
- extension of the mangled name. The final extension is defined as that
- part of the original filename after the rightmost dot. If there are no
- dots in the filename, the mangled name will have no extension (except
- in the case of "hidden files" - see below).</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->Files whose UNIX name begins with a dot will be
- presented as DOS hidden files. The mangled name will be created as
- for other filenames, but with the leading dot removed and "___" as
- its extension regardless of actual original extension (that's three
- underscores).</P
-></LI
-></UL
-><P
->The two-digit hash value consists of upper case
- alphanumeric characters.</P
-><P
->This algorithm can cause name collisions only if files
- in a directory share the same first five alphanumeric characters.
- The probability of such a clash is 1/1300.</P
-><P
->The name mangling (if enabled) allows a file to be
- copied between UNIX directories from Windows/DOS while retaining
- the long UNIX filename. UNIX files can be renamed to a new extension
- from Windows/DOS and will retain the same basename. Mangled names
- do not change between sessions.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->mangled names = yes</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="MANGLINGMETHOD"
-></A
->mangling method (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
-> controls the algorithm used for the generating
- the mangled names. Can take two different values, "hash" and
- "hash2". "hash" is the default and is the algorithm that has been
- used in Samba for many years. "hash2" is a newer and considered
- a better algorithm (generates less collisions) in the names.
- However, many Win32 applications store the mangled names and so
- changing to the new algorithm must not be done
- lightly as these applications may break unless reinstalled.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->mangling method = hash2</B
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->mangling method = hash</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="MANGLEPREFIX"
-></A
->mangle prefix (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
-> controls the number of prefix
- characters from the original name used when generating
- the mangled names. A larger value will give a weaker
- hash and therefore more name collisions. The minimum
- value is 1 and the maximum value is 6.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->mangle prefix = 1</B
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->mangle prefix = 4</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="MANGLEDSTACK"
-></A
->mangled stack (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This parameter controls the number of mangled names
- that should be cached in the Samba server <A
-HREF="smbd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-> smbd(8)</A
->.</P
-><P
->This stack is a list of recently mangled base names
- (extensions are only maintained if they are longer than 3 characters
- or contains upper case characters).</P
-><P
->The larger this value, the more likely it is that mangled
- names can be successfully converted to correct long UNIX names.
- However, large stack sizes will slow most directory accesses. Smaller
- stacks save memory in the server (each stack element costs 256 bytes).
- </P
-><P
->It is not possible to absolutely guarantee correct long
- filenames, so be prepared for some surprises!</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->mangled stack = 50</B
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->mangled stack = 100</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="MANGLINGCHAR"
-></A
->mangling char (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This controls what character is used as
- the <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->magic</I
-> character in <A
-HREF="#AEN205"
->name mangling</A
->. The default is a '~'
- but this may interfere with some software. Use this option to set
- it to whatever you prefer.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->mangling char = ~</B
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->mangling char = ^</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="MAPARCHIVE"
-></A
->map archive (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This controls whether the DOS archive attribute
- should be mapped to the UNIX owner execute bit. The DOS archive bit
- is set when a file has been modified since its last backup. One
- motivation for this option it to keep Samba/your PC from making
- any file it touches from becoming executable under UNIX. This can
- be quite annoying for shared source code, documents, etc...</P
-><P
->Note that this requires the <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->create mask</I
-></TT
->
- parameter to be set such that owner execute bit is not masked out
- (i.e. it must include 100). See the parameter <A
-HREF="#CREATEMASK"
-> <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->create mask</I
-></TT
-></A
-> for details.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->map archive = yes</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="MAPHIDDEN"
-></A
->map hidden (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This controls whether DOS style hidden files
- should be mapped to the UNIX world execute bit.</P
-><P
->Note that this requires the <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->create mask</I
-></TT
->
- to be set such that the world execute bit is not masked out (i.e.
- it must include 001). See the parameter <A
-HREF="#CREATEMASK"
-> <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->create mask</I
-></TT
-></A
-> for details.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->map hidden = no</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="MAPSYSTEM"
-></A
->map system (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This controls whether DOS style system files
- should be mapped to the UNIX group execute bit.</P
-><P
->Note that this requires the <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->create mask</I
-></TT
->
- to be set such that the group execute bit is not masked out (i.e.
- it must include 010). See the parameter <A
-HREF="#CREATEMASK"
-> <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->create mask</I
-></TT
-></A
-> for details.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->map system = no</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="MAPTOGUEST"
-></A
->map to guest (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This parameter is only useful in <A
-HREF="#SECURITY"
-> security</A
-> modes other than <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->security = share</I
-></TT
->
- - i.e. <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->user</TT
->, <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->server</TT
->,
- and <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->domain</TT
->.</P
-><P
->This parameter can take three different values, which tell
- <A
-HREF="smbd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
->smbd(8)</A
-> what to do with user
- login requests that don't match a valid UNIX user in some way.</P
-><P
->The three settings are :</P
-><P
-></P
-><UL
-><LI
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->Never</TT
-> - Means user login
- requests with an invalid password are rejected. This is the
- default.</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->Bad User</TT
-> - Means user
- logins with an invalid password are rejected, unless the username
- does not exist, in which case it is treated as a guest login and
- mapped into the <A
-HREF="#GUESTACCOUNT"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
-> guest account</I
-></TT
-></A
->.</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->Bad Password</TT
-> - Means user logins
- with an invalid password are treated as a guest login and mapped
- into the <A
-HREF="#GUESTACCOUNT"
->guest account</A
->. Note that
- this can cause problems as it means that any user incorrectly typing
- their password will be silently logged on as "guest" - and
- will not know the reason they cannot access files they think
- they should - there will have been no message given to them
- that they got their password wrong. Helpdesk services will
- <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->hate</I
-> you if you set the <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->map to
- guest</I
-></TT
-> parameter this way :-).</P
-></LI
-></UL
-><P
->Note that this parameter is needed to set up "Guest"
- share services when using <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->security</I
-></TT
-> modes other than
- share. This is because in these modes the name of the resource being
- requested is <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->not</I
-> sent to the server until after
- the server has successfully authenticated the client so the server
- cannot make authentication decisions at the correct time (connection
- to the share) for "Guest" shares.</P
-><P
->For people familiar with the older Samba releases, this
- parameter maps to the old compile-time setting of the <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
-> GUEST_SESSSETUP</TT
-> value in local.h.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->map to guest = Never</B
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->map to guest = Bad User</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="MAXCONNECTIONS"
-></A
->max connections (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This option allows the number of simultaneous
- connections to a service to be limited. If <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->max connections
- </I
-></TT
-> is greater than 0 then connections will be refused if
- this number of connections to the service are already open. A value
- of zero mean an unlimited number of connections may be made.</P
-><P
->Record lock files are used to implement this feature. The
- lock files will be stored in the directory specified by the <A
-HREF="#LOCKDIRECTORY"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->lock directory</I
-></TT
-></A
->
- option.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->max connections = 0</B
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->max connections = 10</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="MAXDISKSIZE"
-></A
->max disk size (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This option allows you to put an upper limit
- on the apparent size of disks. If you set this option to 100
- then all shares will appear to be not larger than 100 MB in
- size.</P
-><P
->Note that this option does not limit the amount of
- data you can put on the disk. In the above case you could still
- store much more than 100 MB on the disk, but if a client ever asks
- for the amount of free disk space or the total disk size then the
- result will be bounded by the amount specified in <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->max
- disk size</I
-></TT
->.</P
-><P
->This option is primarily useful to work around bugs
- in some pieces of software that can't handle very large disks,
- particularly disks over 1GB in size.</P
-><P
->A <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->max disk size</I
-></TT
-> of 0 means no limit.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->max disk size = 0</B
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->max disk size = 1000</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="MAXLOGSIZE"
-></A
->max log size (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This option (an integer in kilobytes) specifies
- the max size the log file should grow to. Samba periodically checks
- the size and if it is exceeded it will rename the file, adding
- a <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->.old</TT
-> extension.</P
-><P
->A size of 0 means no limit.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->max log size = 5000</B
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->max log size = 1000</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="MAXMUX"
-></A
->max mux (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This option controls the maximum number of
- outstanding simultaneous SMB operations that Samba tells the client
- it will allow. You should never need to set this parameter.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->max mux = 50</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="MAXOPENFILES"
-></A
->max open files (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This parameter limits the maximum number of
- open files that one <A
-HREF="smbd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
->smbd(8)</A
-> file
- serving process may have open for a client at any one time. The
- default for this parameter is set very high (10,000) as Samba uses
- only one bit per unopened file.</P
-><P
->The limit of the number of open files is usually set
- by the UNIX per-process file descriptor limit rather than
- this parameter so you should never need to touch this parameter.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->max open files = 10000</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="MAXPRINTJOBS"
-></A
->max print jobs (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This parameter limits the maximum number of
- jobs allowable in a Samba printer queue at any given moment.
- If this number is exceeded, <A
-HREF="smbd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
-> smbd(8)</B
-></A
-> will remote "Out of Space" to the client.
- See all <A
-HREF="#TOTALPRINTJOBS"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->total
- print jobs</I
-></TT
-></A
->.
- </P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->max print jobs = 1000</B
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->max print jobs = 5000</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="MAXPROTOCOL"
-></A
->max protocol (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->The value of the parameter (a string) is the highest
- protocol level that will be supported by the server.</P
-><P
->Possible values are :</P
-><P
-></P
-><UL
-><LI
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->CORE</TT
->: Earliest version. No
- concept of user names.</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->COREPLUS</TT
->: Slight improvements on
- CORE for efficiency.</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->LANMAN1</TT
->: First <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
-> modern</I
-> version of the protocol. Long filename
- support.</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->LANMAN2</TT
->: Updates to Lanman1 protocol.
- </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->NT1</TT
->: Current up to date version of
- the protocol. Used by Windows NT. Known as CIFS.</P
-></LI
-></UL
-><P
->Normally this option should not be set as the automatic
- negotiation phase in the SMB protocol takes care of choosing
- the appropriate protocol.</P
-><P
->See also <A
-HREF="#MINPROTOCOL"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->min
- protocol</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->max protocol = NT1</B
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->max protocol = LANMAN1</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="MAXSMBDPROCESSES"
-></A
->max smbd processes (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This parameter limits the maximum number of
- <A
-HREF="smbd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbd(8)</B
-></A
->
- processes concurrently running on a system and is intended
- as a stopgap to prevent degrading service to clients in the event
- that the server has insufficient resources to handle more than this
- number of connections. Remember that under normal operating
- conditions, each user will have an <A
-HREF="smbd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
->smbd</A
-> associated with him or her
- to handle connections to all shares from a given host.
- </P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->max smbd processes = 0</B
-> ## no limit</P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->max smbd processes = 1000</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="MAXTTL"
-></A
->max ttl (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This option tells <A
-HREF="nmbd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
->nmbd(8)</A
->
- what the default 'time to live' of NetBIOS names should be (in seconds)
- when <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->nmbd</B
-> is requesting a name using either a
- broadcast packet or from a WINS server. You should never need to
- change this parameter. The default is 3 days.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->max ttl = 259200</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="MAXWINSTTL"
-></A
->max wins ttl (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This option tells <A
-HREF="nmbd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
->nmbd(8)
- </A
-> when acting as a WINS server (<A
-HREF="#WINSSUPPORT"
-> <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->wins support = yes</I
-></TT
-></A
->) what the maximum
- 'time to live' of NetBIOS names that <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->nmbd</B
->
- will grant will be (in seconds). You should never need to change this
- parameter. The default is 6 days (518400 seconds).</P
-><P
->See also the <A
-HREF="#MINWINSTTL"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->min
- wins ttl</I
-></TT
-></A
-> parameter.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->max wins ttl = 518400</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="MAXXMIT"
-></A
->max xmit (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This option controls the maximum packet size
- that will be negotiated by Samba. The default is 65535, which
- is the maximum. In some cases you may find you get better performance
- with a smaller value. A value below 2048 is likely to cause problems.
- </P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->max xmit = 65535</B
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->max xmit = 8192</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="MESSAGECOMMAND"
-></A
->message command (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This specifies what command to run when the
- server receives a WinPopup style message.</P
-><P
->This would normally be a command that would
- deliver the message somehow. How this is to be done is
- up to your imagination.</P
-><P
->An example is:</P
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->message command = csh -c 'xedit %s;rm %s' &#38;</B
->
- </P
-><P
->This delivers the message using <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->xedit</B
->, then
- removes it afterwards. <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->NOTE THAT IT IS VERY IMPORTANT
- THAT THIS COMMAND RETURN IMMEDIATELY</I
->. That's why I
- have the '&#38;' on the end. If it doesn't return immediately then
- your PCs may freeze when sending messages (they should recover
- after 30 seconds, hopefully).</P
-><P
->All messages are delivered as the global guest user.
- The command takes the standard substitutions, although <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
-> %u</I
-></TT
-> won't work (<TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->%U</I
-></TT
-> may be better
- in this case).</P
-><P
->Apart from the standard substitutions, some additional
- ones apply. In particular:</P
-><P
-></P
-><UL
-><LI
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->%s</I
-></TT
-> = the filename containing
- the message.</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->%t</I
-></TT
-> = the destination that
- the message was sent to (probably the server name).</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->%f</I
-></TT
-> = who the message
- is from.</P
-></LI
-></UL
-><P
->You could make this command send mail, or whatever else
- takes your fancy. Please let us know of any really interesting
- ideas you have.</P
-><P
->Here's a way of sending the messages as mail to root:</P
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->message command = /bin/mail -s 'message from %f on
- %m' root &#60; %s; rm %s</B
-></P
-><P
->If you don't have a message command then the message
- won't be delivered and Samba will tell the sender there was
- an error. Unfortunately WfWg totally ignores the error code
- and carries on regardless, saying that the message was delivered.
- </P
-><P
->If you want to silently delete it then try:</P
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->message command = rm %s</B
-></P
-><P
->Default: <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->no message command</I
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->message command = csh -c 'xedit %s;
- rm %s' &#38;</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="MINPASSWDLENGTH"
-></A
->min passwd length (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Synonym for <A
-HREF="#MINPASSWORDLENGTH"
-> <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->min password length</I
-></TT
-></A
->.</P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="MINPASSWORDLENGTH"
-></A
->min password length (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This option sets the minimum length in characters
- of a plaintext password that <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbd</B
-> will accept when performing
- UNIX password changing.</P
-><P
->See also <A
-HREF="#UNIXPASSWORDSYNC"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->unix
- password sync</I
-></TT
-></A
->, <A
-HREF="#PASSWDPROGRAM"
-> <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->passwd program</I
-></TT
-></A
-> and <A
-HREF="#PASSWDCHATDEBUG"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->passwd chat debug</I
-></TT
->
- </A
->.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->min password length = 5</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="MINPRINTSPACE"
-></A
->min print space (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This sets the minimum amount of free disk
- space that must be available before a user will be able to spool
- a print job. It is specified in kilobytes. The default is 0, which
- means a user can always spool a print job.</P
-><P
->See also the <A
-HREF="#PRINTING"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->printing
- </I
-></TT
-></A
-> parameter.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->min print space = 0</B
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->min print space = 2000</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="MINPROTOCOL"
-></A
->min protocol (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->The value of the parameter (a string) is the
- lowest SMB protocol dialect than Samba will support. Please refer
- to the <A
-HREF="#MAXPROTOCOL"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->max protocol</I
-></TT
-></A
->
- parameter for a list of valid protocol names and a brief description
- of each. You may also wish to refer to the C source code in
- <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->source/smbd/negprot.c</TT
-> for a listing of known protocol
- dialects supported by clients.</P
-><P
->If you are viewing this parameter as a security measure, you should
- also refer to the <A
-HREF="#LANMANAUTH"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->lanman
- auth</I
-></TT
-></A
-> parameter. Otherwise, you should never need
- to change this parameter.</P
-><P
->Default : <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->min protocol = CORE</B
-></P
-><P
->Example : <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->min protocol = NT1</B
-> # disable DOS
- clients</P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="MINWINSTTL"
-></A
->min wins ttl (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This option tells <A
-HREF="nmbd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
->nmbd(8)</A
->
- when acting as a WINS server (<A
-HREF="#WINSSUPPORT"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
-> wins support = yes</I
-></TT
-></A
->) what the minimum 'time to live'
- of NetBIOS names that <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->nmbd</B
-> will grant will be (in
- seconds). You should never need to change this parameter. The default
- is 6 hours (21600 seconds).</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->min wins ttl = 21600</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="MSDFSPROXY"
-></A
->msdfs proxy (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This parameter indicates that the share is a
- stand-in for another CIFS share whose location is specified by
- the value of the parameter. When clients attempt to connect to
- this share, they are redirected to the proxied share using
- the SMB-Dfs protocol.</P
-><P
->Only Dfs roots can act as proxy shares. Take a look at the
- <A
-HREF="#MSDFSROOT"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->msdfs root</I
-></TT
-></A
->
- and
- <A
-HREF="#HOSTMSDFS"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->host msdfs</I
-></TT
-></A
->
- options to find out how to set up a Dfs root share.</P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->msdfs proxy = \otherserver\someshare</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="MSDFSROOT"
-></A
->msdfs root (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This boolean parameter is only available if
- Samba is configured and compiled with the <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
-> --with-msdfs</B
-> option. If set to <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->yes</TT
->,
- Samba treats the share as a Dfs root and allows clients to browse
- the distributed file system tree rooted at the share directory.
- Dfs links are specified in the share directory by symbolic
- links of the form <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->msdfs:serverA\shareA,serverB\shareB</TT
->
- and so on. For more information on setting up a Dfs tree
- on Samba, refer to <A
-HREF="msdfs_setup.html"
-TARGET="_top"
->msdfs_setup.html
- </A
->.</P
-><P
->See also <A
-HREF="#HOSTMSDFS"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->host msdfs
- </I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->msdfs root = no</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="NAMECACHETIMEOUT"
-></A
->name cache timeout (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Specifies the number of seconds it takes before
- entries in samba's hostname resolve cache time out. If
- the timeout is set to 0. the caching is disabled.
- </P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->name cache timeout = 660</B
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->name cache timeout = 0</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="NAMERESOLVEORDER"
-></A
->name resolve order (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This option is used by the programs in the Samba
- suite to determine what naming services to use and in what order
- to resolve host names to IP addresses. The option takes a space
- separated string of name resolution options.</P
-><P
->The options are :"lmhosts", "host", "wins" and "bcast". They
- cause names to be resolved as follows :</P
-><P
-></P
-><UL
-><LI
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->lmhosts</TT
-> : Lookup an IP
- address in the Samba lmhosts file. If the line in lmhosts has
- no name type attached to the NetBIOS name (see the <A
-HREF="lmhosts.5.html"
-TARGET="_top"
->lmhosts(5)</A
-> for details) then
- any name type matches for lookup.</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->host</TT
-> : Do a standard host
- name to IP address resolution, using the system <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/hosts
- </TT
->, NIS, or DNS lookups. This method of name resolution
- is operating system depended for instance on IRIX or Solaris this
- may be controlled by the <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/nsswitch.conf</TT
->
- file. Note that this method is only used if the NetBIOS name
- type being queried is the 0x20 (server) name type, otherwise
- it is ignored.</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->wins</TT
-> : Query a name with
- the IP address listed in the <A
-HREF="#WINSSERVER"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
-> wins server</I
-></TT
-></A
-> parameter. If no WINS server has
- been specified this method will be ignored.</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->bcast</TT
-> : Do a broadcast on
- each of the known local interfaces listed in the <A
-HREF="#INTERFACES"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->interfaces</I
-></TT
-></A
->
- parameter. This is the least reliable of the name resolution
- methods as it depends on the target host being on a locally
- connected subnet.</P
-></LI
-></UL
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->name resolve order = lmhosts host wins bcast
- </B
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->name resolve order = lmhosts bcast host
- </B
-></P
-><P
->This will cause the local lmhosts file to be examined
- first, followed by a broadcast attempt, followed by a normal
- system hostname lookup.</P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="NETBIOSALIASES"
-></A
->netbios aliases (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This is a list of NetBIOS names that <A
-HREF="nmbd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
->nmbd(8)</A
-> will advertise as additional
- names by which the Samba server is known. This allows one machine
- to appear in browse lists under multiple names. If a machine is
- acting as a browse server or logon server none
- of these names will be advertised as either browse server or logon
- servers, only the primary name of the machine will be advertised
- with these capabilities.</P
-><P
->See also <A
-HREF="#NETBIOSNAME"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->netbios
- name</I
-></TT
-></A
->.</P
-><P
->Default: <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->empty string (no additional names)</I
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->netbios aliases = TEST TEST1 TEST2</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="NETBIOSNAME"
-></A
->netbios name (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This sets the NetBIOS name by which a Samba
- server is known. By default it is the same as the first component
- of the host's DNS name. If a machine is a browse server or
- logon server this name (or the first component
- of the hosts DNS name) will be the name that these services are
- advertised under.</P
-><P
->See also <A
-HREF="#NETBIOSALIASES"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->netbios
- aliases</I
-></TT
-></A
->.</P
-><P
->Default: <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->machine DNS name</I
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->netbios name = MYNAME</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="NETBIOSSCOPE"
-></A
->netbios scope (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This sets the NetBIOS scope that Samba will
- operate under. This should not be set unless every machine
- on your LAN also sets this value.</P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="NISHOMEDIR"
-></A
->nis homedir (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Get the home share server from a NIS map. For
- UNIX systems that use an automounter, the user's home directory
- will often be mounted on a workstation on demand from a remote
- server. </P
-><P
->When the Samba logon server is not the actual home directory
- server, but is mounting the home directories via NFS then two
- network hops would be required to access the users home directory
- if the logon server told the client to use itself as the SMB server
- for home directories (one over SMB and one over NFS). This can
- be very slow.</P
-><P
->This option allows Samba to return the home share as
- being on a different server to the logon server and as
- long as a Samba daemon is running on the home directory server,
- it will be mounted on the Samba client directly from the directory
- server. When Samba is returning the home share to the client, it
- will consult the NIS map specified in <A
-HREF="#HOMEDIRMAP"
-> <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->homedir map</I
-></TT
-></A
-> and return the server
- listed there.</P
-><P
->Note that for this option to work there must be a working
- NIS system and the Samba server with this option must also
- be a logon server.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->nis homedir = no</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="NONUNIXACCOUNTRANGE"
-></A
->non unix account range (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->The non unix account range parameter specifies
- the range of 'user ids' that are allocated by the various 'non unix
- account' passdb backends. These backends allow
- the storage of passwords for users who don't exist in /etc/passwd.
- This is most often used for machine account creation.
- This range of ids should have no existing local or NIS users within
- it as strange conflicts can occur otherwise.</P
-><P
->NOTE: These userids never appear on the system and Samba will never
- 'become' these users. They are used only to ensure that the algorithmic
- RID mapping does not conflict with normal users.
- </P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->non unix account range = &#60;empty string&#62;
- </B
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->non unix account range = 10000-20000</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="NTACLSUPPORT"
-></A
->nt acl support (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This boolean parameter controls whether
- <A
-HREF="smbd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
->smbd(8)</A
-> will attempt to map
- UNIX permissions into Windows NT access control lists.
- This parameter was formally a global parameter in releases
- prior to 2.2.2.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->nt acl support = yes</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="NTPIPESUPPORT"
-></A
->nt pipe support (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This boolean parameter controls whether
- <A
-HREF="smbd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
->smbd(8)</A
-> will allow Windows NT
- clients to connect to the NT SMB specific <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->IPC$</TT
->
- pipes. This is a developer debugging option and can be left
- alone.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->nt pipe support = yes</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="NTSTATUSSUPPORT"
-></A
->nt status support (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This boolean parameter controls whether <A
-HREF="smbd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
->smbd(8)</A
-> will negotiate NT specific status
- support with Windows NT/2k/XP clients. This is a developer
- debugging option and should be left alone.
- If this option is set to <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->no</TT
-> then Samba offers
- exactly the same DOS error codes that versions prior to Samba 2.2.3
- reported.</P
-><P
->You should not need to ever disable this parameter.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->nt status support = yes</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="NULLPASSWORDS"
-></A
->null passwords (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Allow or disallow client access to accounts
- that have null passwords. </P
-><P
->See also <A
-HREF="smbpasswd.5.html"
-TARGET="_top"
->smbpasswd (5)</A
->.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->null passwords = no</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="OBEYPAMRESTRICTIONS"
-></A
->obey pam restrictions (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->When Samba 2.2 is configured to enable PAM support
- (i.e. --with-pam), this parameter will control whether or not Samba
- should obey PAM's account and session management directives. The
- default behavior is to use PAM for clear text authentication only
- and to ignore any account or session management. Note that Samba
- always ignores PAM for authentication in the case of <A
-HREF="#ENCRYPTPASSWORDS"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->encrypt passwords = yes</I
-></TT
->
- </A
->. The reason is that PAM modules cannot support the challenge/response
- authentication mechanism needed in the presence of SMB password encryption.
- </P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->obey pam restrictions = no</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="ONLYUSER"
-></A
->only user (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This is a boolean option that controls whether
- connections with usernames not in the <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->user</I
-></TT
->
- list will be allowed. By default this option is disabled so that a
- client can supply a username to be used by the server. Enabling
- this parameter will force the server to only use the login
- names from the <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->user</I
-></TT
-> list and is only really
- useful in <A
-HREF="#SECURITYEQUALSSHARE"
->share level</A
->
- security.</P
-><P
->Note that this also means Samba won't try to deduce
- usernames from the service name. This can be annoying for
- the [homes] section. To get around this you could use <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->user =
- %S</B
-> which means your <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->user</I
-></TT
-> list
- will be just the service name, which for home directories is the
- name of the user.</P
-><P
->See also the <A
-HREF="#USER"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->user</I
-></TT
->
- </A
-> parameter.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->only user = no</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="ONLYGUEST"
-></A
->only guest (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->A synonym for <A
-HREF="#GUESTONLY"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
-> guest only</I
-></TT
-></A
->.</P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="OPLOCKBREAKWAITTIME"
-></A
->oplock break wait time (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This is a tuning parameter added due to bugs in
- both Windows 9x and WinNT. If Samba responds to a client too
- quickly when that client issues an SMB that can cause an oplock
- break request, then the network client can fail and not respond
- to the break request. This tuning parameter (which is set in milliseconds)
- is the amount of time Samba will wait before sending an oplock break
- request to such (broken) clients.</P
-><P
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->DO NOT CHANGE THIS PARAMETER UNLESS YOU HAVE READ
- AND UNDERSTOOD THE SAMBA OPLOCK CODE</I
->.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->oplock break wait time = 0</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="OPLOCKCONTENTIONLIMIT"
-></A
->oplock contention limit (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This is a <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->very</I
-> advanced
- <A
-HREF="smbd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
->smbd(8)</A
-> tuning option to
- improve the efficiency of the granting of oplocks under multiple
- client contention for the same file.</P
-><P
->In brief it specifies a number, which causes <A
-HREF="smbd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
->smbd</A
-> not to
- grant an oplock even when requested if the approximate number of
- clients contending for an oplock on the same file goes over this
- limit. This causes <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbd</B
-> to behave in a similar
- way to Windows NT.</P
-><P
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->DO NOT CHANGE THIS PARAMETER UNLESS YOU HAVE READ
- AND UNDERSTOOD THE SAMBA OPLOCK CODE</I
->.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->oplock contention limit = 2</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="OPLOCKS"
-></A
->oplocks (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This boolean option tells <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbd</B
-> whether to
- issue oplocks (opportunistic locks) to file open requests on this
- share. The oplock code can dramatically (approx. 30% or more) improve
- the speed of access to files on Samba servers. It allows the clients
- to aggressively cache files locally and you may want to disable this
- option for unreliable network environments (it is turned on by
- default in Windows NT Servers). For more information see the file
- <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->Speed.txt</TT
-> in the Samba <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->docs/</TT
->
- directory.</P
-><P
->Oplocks may be selectively turned off on certain files with a
- share. See the <A
-HREF="#VETOOPLOCKFILES"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
-> veto oplock files</I
-></TT
-></A
-> parameter. On some systems
- oplocks are recognized by the underlying operating system. This
- allows data synchronization between all access to oplocked files,
- whether it be via Samba or NFS or a local UNIX process. See the
- <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->kernel oplocks</I
-></TT
-> parameter for details.</P
-><P
->See also the <A
-HREF="#KERNELOPLOCKS"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->kernel
- oplocks</I
-></TT
-></A
-> and <A
-HREF="#LEVEL2OPLOCKS"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
-> level2 oplocks</I
-></TT
-></A
-> parameters.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->oplocks = yes</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="NTLMAUTH"
-></A
->ntlm auth (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This parameter determines whether or not <A
-HREF="smbd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
->smbd</A
-> will
- attempt to authenticate users using the NTLM password hash.
- If disabled, only the lanman password hashes will be used.
- </P
-><P
->Please note that at least this option or <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->lanman auth</B
-> should be enabled in order to be able to log in.
- </P
-><P
->Default : <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->ntlm auth = yes</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="OSLEVEL"
-></A
->os level (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This integer value controls what level Samba
- advertises itself as for browse elections. The value of this
- parameter determines whether <A
-HREF="nmbd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
->nmbd(8)</A
->
- has a chance of becoming a local master browser for the <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
-> WORKGROUP</I
-></TT
-> in the local broadcast area.</P
-><P
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->Note :</I
->By default, Samba will win
- a local master browsing election over all Microsoft operating
- systems except a Windows NT 4.0/2000 Domain Controller. This
- means that a misconfigured Samba host can effectively isolate
- a subnet for browsing purposes. See <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->BROWSING.txt
- </TT
-> in the Samba <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->docs/</TT
-> directory
- for details.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->os level = 20</B
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->os level = 65 </B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="OS2DRIVERMAP"
-></A
->os2 driver map (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->The parameter is used to define the absolute
- path to a file containing a mapping of Windows NT printer driver
- names to OS/2 printer driver names. The format is:</P
-><P
->&#60;nt driver name&#62; = &#60;os2 driver
- name&#62;.&#60;device name&#62;</P
-><P
->For example, a valid entry using the HP LaserJet 5
- printer driver would appear as <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->HP LaserJet 5L = LASERJET.HP
- LaserJet 5L</B
->.</P
-><P
->The need for the file is due to the printer driver namespace
- problem described in the <A
-HREF="printer_driver2.html"
-TARGET="_top"
->Samba
- Printing HOWTO</A
->. For more details on OS/2 clients, please
- refer to the <A
-HREF="OS2-Client-HOWTO.html"
-TARGET="_top"
->OS2-Client-HOWTO
- </A
-> containing in the Samba documentation.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->os2 driver map = &#60;empty string&#62;
- </B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="PAMPASSWORDCHANGE"
-></A
->pam password change (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->With the addition of better PAM support in Samba 2.2,
- this parameter, it is possible to use PAM's password change control
- flag for Samba. If enabled, then PAM will be used for password
- changes when requested by an SMB client instead of the program listed in
- <A
-HREF="#PASSWDPROGRAM"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->passwd program</I
-></TT
-></A
->.
- It should be possible to enable this without changing your
- <A
-HREF="#PASSWDCHAT"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->passwd chat</I
-></TT
-></A
->
- parameter for most setups.
- </P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->pam password change = no</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="PANICACTION"
-></A
->panic action (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This is a Samba developer option that allows a
- system command to be called when either <A
-HREF="smbd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-> smbd(8)</A
-> or <A
-HREF="nmbd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
->nmbd(8)</A
->
- crashes. This is usually used to draw attention to the fact that
- a problem occurred.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->panic action = &#60;empty string&#62;</B
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->panic action = "/bin/sleep 90000"</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="PARANOIDSERVERSECURITY"
-></A
->paranoid server security (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Some version of NT 4.x allow non-guest
- users with a bad passowrd. When this option is enabled, samba will not
- use a broken NT 4.x server as password server, but instead complain
- to the logs and exit.
- </P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->paranoid server security = yes</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="PASSDBBACKEND"
-></A
->passdb backend (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This option allows the administrator to chose which backends to retrieve and store passwords with. This allows (for example) both
- smbpasswd and tdbsam to be used without a recompile.
- Multiple backends can be specified, separated by spaces. The backends will be searched in the order they are specified. New users are always added to the first backend specified.
- Experimental backends must still be selected
- (eg --with-tdbsam) at configure time.
- </P
-><P
->This parameter is in two parts, the backend's name, and a 'location'
- string that has meaning only to that particular backed. These are separated
- by a : character.</P
-><P
->Available backends can include:
- <P
-></P
-><UL
-><LI
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbpasswd</B
-> - The default smbpasswd
- backend. Takes a path to the smbpasswd file as an optional argument.</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbpasswd_nua</B
-> - The smbpasswd
- backend, but with support for 'not unix accounts'.
- Takes a path to the smbpasswd file as an optional argument.</P
-><P
->See also <A
-HREF="#NONUNIXACCOUNTRANGE"
-> <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->non unix account range</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->tdbsam</B
-> - The TDB based password storage
- backend. Takes a path to the TDB as an optional argument (defaults to passdb.tdb
- in the <A
-HREF="#PRIVATEDIR"
-> <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->private dir</I
-></TT
-></A
-> directory.</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->tdbsam_nua</B
-> - The TDB based password storage
- backend, with non unix account support. Takes a path to the TDB as an optional argument (defaults to passdb.tdb
- in the <A
-HREF="#PRIVATEDIR"
-> <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->private dir</I
-></TT
-></A
-> directory.</P
-><P
->See also <A
-HREF="#NONUNIXACCOUNTRANGE"
-> <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->non unix account range</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->ldapsam</B
-> - The LDAP based passdb
- backend. Takes an LDAP URL as an optional argument (defaults to
- <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->ldap://localhost</B
->)</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->ldapsam_nua</B
-> - The LDAP based passdb
- backend, with non unix account support. Takes an LDAP URL as an optional argument (defaults to
- <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->ldap://localhost</B
->)</P
-><P
->Note: In this module, any account without a matching POSIX account is regarded
- as 'non unix'. </P
-><P
->See also <A
-HREF="#NONUNIXACCOUNTRANGE"
-> <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->non unix account
- range</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-><P
->LDAP connections should be secured where
- possible. This may be done using either
- Start-TLS (see <A
-HREF="#LDAPSSL"
-> <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->ldap ssl</I
-></TT
-></A
->) or by
- specifying <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->ldaps://</I
-></TT
-> in
- the URL argument.
- </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->nisplussam</B
-> - The NIS+ based passdb backend. Takes name NIS domain as an optional argument. Only works with sun NIS+ servers. </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->plugin</B
-> - Allows Samba to load an
- arbitary passdb backend from the .so specified as a compulsary argument.
- </P
-><P
->Any characters after the (optional) second : are passed to the plugin
- for its own processing</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->unixsam</B
-> - (EXPERIMENTAL) Allows samba to map all (other) available unix users</P
-><P
->This backend uses the standard unix database for retrieving users. Users included
- in this pdb are NOT listed in samba user listings and users included in this pdb won't be
- able to login. The use of this backend is to always be able to display the owner of a file
- on the samba server - even when the user doesn't have a 'real' samba account in one of the
- other passdb backends.
- </P
-><P
->This backend should always be the last backend listed, since it contains all users in
- the unix passdb and might 'override' mappings if specified earlier. It's meant to only return
- accounts for users that aren't covered by the previous backends.</P
-></LI
-></UL
->
- </P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->passdb backend = smbpasswd guest</B
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->passdb backend = tdbsam:/etc/samba/private/passdb.tdb smbpasswd:/etc/samba/smbpasswd </B
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->passdb backend = ldapsam_nua:ldaps://ldap.example.com </B
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->passdb backend = plugin:/usr/local/samba/lib/my_passdb.so:my_plugin_args tdbsam:/etc/samba/private/passdb.tdb</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="PASSWDCHAT"
-></A
->passwd chat (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This string controls the <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->"chat"</I
->
- conversation that takes places between <A
-HREF="smbd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
->smbd</A
-> and the local password changing
- program to change the user's password. The string describes a
- sequence of response-receive pairs that <A
-HREF="smbd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-> smbd(8)</A
-> uses to determine what to send to the
- <A
-HREF="#PASSWDPROGRAM"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->passwd program</I
-></TT
->
- </A
-> and what to expect back. If the expected output is not
- received then the password is not changed.</P
-><P
->This chat sequence is often quite site specific, depending
- on what local methods are used for password control (such as NIS
- etc).</P
-><P
->Note that this parameter only is only used if the <A
-HREF="#UNIXPASSWORDSYNC"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->unix
- password sync</I
-></TT
-></A
-> parameter is set to <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->yes</TT
->. This
- sequence is then called <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->AS ROOT</I
-> when the SMB password
- in the smbpasswd file is being changed, without access to the old
- password cleartext. This means that root must be able to reset the user's password
- without knowing the text of the previous password. In the presence of NIS/YP,
- this means that the <A
-HREF="#PASSWDPROGRAM"
->passwd program</A
-> must be
- executed on the NIS master.
- </P
-><P
->The string can contain the macro <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->%n</I
-></TT
-> which is substituted
- for the new password. The chat sequence can also contain the standard
- macros <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->\n</TT
->, <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->\r</TT
->, <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
-> \t</TT
-> and <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->\s</TT
-> to give line-feed,
- carriage-return, tab and space. The chat sequence string can also contain
- a '*' which matches any sequence of characters.
- Double quotes can be used to collect strings with spaces
- in them into a single string.</P
-><P
->If the send string in any part of the chat sequence
- is a full stop ".", then no string is sent. Similarly,
- if the expect string is a full stop then no string is expected.</P
-><P
->If the <A
-HREF="#PAMPASSWORDCHANGE"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->pam
- password change</I
-></TT
-></A
-> parameter is set to <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->yes</TT
->, the chat pairs
- may be matched in any order, and success is determined by the PAM result,
- not any particular output. The \n macro is ignored for PAM conversions.
- </P
-><P
->See also <A
-HREF="#UNIXPASSWORDSYNC"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->unix password
- sync</I
-></TT
-></A
->, <A
-HREF="#PASSWDPROGRAM"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
-> passwd program</I
-></TT
-></A
-> ,<A
-HREF="#PASSWDCHATDEBUG"
-> <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->passwd chat debug</I
-></TT
-></A
-> and <A
-HREF="#PAMPASSWORDCHANGE"
-> <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->pam password change</I
-></TT
-></A
->.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->passwd chat = *new*password* %n\n
- *new*password* %n\n *changed*</B
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->passwd chat = "*Enter OLD password*" %o\n
- "*Enter NEW password*" %n\n "*Reenter NEW password*" %n\n "*Password
- changed*"</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="PASSWDCHATDEBUG"
-></A
->passwd chat debug (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This boolean specifies if the passwd chat script
- parameter is run in <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->debug</I
-> mode. In this mode the
- strings passed to and received from the passwd chat are printed
- in the <A
-HREF="smbd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
->smbd(8)</A
-> log with a
- <A
-HREF="#DEBUGLEVEL"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->debug level</I
-></TT
-></A
->
- of 100. This is a dangerous option as it will allow plaintext passwords
- to be seen in the <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbd</B
-> log. It is available to help
- Samba admins debug their <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->passwd chat</I
-></TT
-> scripts
- when calling the <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->passwd program</I
-></TT
-> and should
- be turned off after this has been done. This option has no effect if the
- <A
-HREF="#PAMPASSWORDCHANGE"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->pam password change</I
-></TT
-></A
->
- paramter is set. This parameter is off by default.</P
-><P
->See also <A
-HREF="#PASSWDCHAT"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->passwd chat</I
-></TT
->
- </A
->, <A
-HREF="#PAMPASSWORDCHANGE"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->pam password change</I
-></TT
->
- </A
->, <A
-HREF="#PASSWDPROGRAM"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->passwd program</I
-></TT
->
- </A
->.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->passwd chat debug = no</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="PASSWDPROGRAM"
-></A
->passwd program (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->The name of a program that can be used to set
- UNIX user passwords. Any occurrences of <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->%u</I
-></TT
->
- will be replaced with the user name. The user name is checked for
- existence before calling the password changing program.</P
-><P
->Also note that many passwd programs insist in <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->reasonable
- </I
-> passwords, such as a minimum length, or the inclusion
- of mixed case chars and digits. This can pose a problem as some clients
- (such as Windows for Workgroups) uppercase the password before sending
- it.</P
-><P
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->Note</I
-> that if the <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->unix
- password sync</I
-></TT
-> parameter is set to <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->yes
- </TT
-> then this program is called <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->AS ROOT</I
->
- before the SMB password in the <A
-HREF="smbpasswd.5.html"
-TARGET="_top"
->smbpasswd(5)
- </A
-> file is changed. If this UNIX password change fails, then
- <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbd</B
-> will fail to change the SMB password also
- (this is by design).</P
-><P
->If the <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->unix password sync</I
-></TT
-> parameter
- is set this parameter <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->MUST USE ABSOLUTE PATHS</I
->
- for <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->ALL</I
-> programs called, and must be examined
- for security implications. Note that by default <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->unix
- password sync</I
-></TT
-> is set to <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->no</TT
->.</P
-><P
->See also <A
-HREF="#UNIXPASSWORDSYNC"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->unix
- password sync</I
-></TT
-></A
->.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->passwd program = /bin/passwd</B
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->passwd program = /sbin/npasswd %u</B
->
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="PASSWORDLEVEL"
-></A
->password level (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Some client/server combinations have difficulty
- with mixed-case passwords. One offending client is Windows for
- Workgroups, which for some reason forces passwords to upper
- case when using the LANMAN1 protocol, but leaves them alone when
- using COREPLUS! Another problem child is the Windows 95/98
- family of operating systems. These clients upper case clear
- text passwords even when NT LM 0.12 selected by the protocol
- negotiation request/response.</P
-><P
->This parameter defines the maximum number of characters
- that may be upper case in passwords.</P
-><P
->For example, say the password given was "FRED". If <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
-> password level</I
-></TT
-> is set to 1, the following combinations
- would be tried if "FRED" failed:</P
-><P
->"Fred", "fred", "fRed", "frEd","freD"</P
-><P
->If <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->password level</I
-></TT
-> was set to 2,
- the following combinations would also be tried: </P
-><P
->"FRed", "FrEd", "FreD", "fREd", "fReD", "frED", ..</P
-><P
->And so on.</P
-><P
->The higher value this parameter is set to the more likely
- it is that a mixed case password will be matched against a single
- case password. However, you should be aware that use of this
- parameter reduces security and increases the time taken to
- process a new connection.</P
-><P
->A value of zero will cause only two attempts to be
- made - the password as is and the password in all-lower case.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->password level = 0</B
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->password level = 4</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="PASSWORDSERVER"
-></A
->password server (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->By specifying the name of another SMB server (such
- as a WinNT box) with this option, and using <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->security = domain
- </B
-> or <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->security = server</B
-> you can get Samba
- to do all its username/password validation via a remote server.</P
-><P
->This option sets the name of the password server to use.
- It must be a NetBIOS name, so if the machine's NetBIOS name is
- different from its Internet name then you may have to add its NetBIOS
- name to the lmhosts file which is stored in the same directory
- as the <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->smb.conf</TT
-> file.</P
-><P
->The name of the password server is looked up using the
- parameter <A
-HREF="#NAMERESOLVEORDER"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->name
- resolve order</I
-></TT
-></A
-> and so may resolved
- by any method and order described in that parameter.</P
-><P
->The password server must be a machine capable of using
- the "LM1.2X002" or the "NT LM 0.12" protocol, and it must be in
- user level security mode.</P
-><P
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->NOTE:</I
-> Using a password server
- means your UNIX box (running Samba) is only as secure as your
- password server. <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->DO NOT CHOOSE A PASSWORD SERVER THAT
- YOU DON'T COMPLETELY TRUST</I
->.</P
-><P
->Never point a Samba server at itself for password
- serving. This will cause a loop and could lock up your Samba
- server!</P
-><P
->The name of the password server takes the standard
- substitutions, but probably the only useful one is <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->%m
- </I
-></TT
->, which means the Samba server will use the incoming
- client as the password server. If you use this then you better
- trust your clients, and you had better restrict them with hosts allow!</P
-><P
->If the <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->security</I
-></TT
-> parameter is set to
- <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->domain</TT
->, then the list of machines in this
- option must be a list of Primary or Backup Domain controllers for the
- Domain or the character '*', as the Samba server is effectively
- in that domain, and will use cryptographically authenticated RPC calls
- to authenticate the user logging on. The advantage of using <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
-> security = domain</B
-> is that if you list several hosts in the
- <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->password server</I
-></TT
-> option then <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbd
- </B
-> will try each in turn till it finds one that responds. This
- is useful in case your primary server goes down.</P
-><P
->If the <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->password server</I
-></TT
-> option is set
- to the character '*', then Samba will attempt to auto-locate the
- Primary or Backup Domain controllers to authenticate against by
- doing a query for the name <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->WORKGROUP&#60;1C&#62;</TT
->
- and then contacting each server returned in the list of IP
- addresses from the name resolution source. </P
-><P
->If the list of servers contains both names and the '*'
- character, the list is treated as a list of preferred
- domain controllers, but an auto lookup of all remaining DC's
- will be added to the list as well. Samba will not attempt to optimize
- this list by locating the closest DC.</P
-><P
->If the <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->security</I
-></TT
-> parameter is
- set to <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->server</TT
->, then there are different
- restrictions that <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->security = domain</B
-> doesn't
- suffer from:</P
-><P
-></P
-><UL
-><LI
-><P
->You may list several password servers in
- the <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->password server</I
-></TT
-> parameter, however if an
- <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbd</B
-> makes a connection to a password server,
- and then the password server fails, no more users will be able
- to be authenticated from this <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbd</B
->. This is a
- restriction of the SMB/CIFS protocol when in <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->security = server
- </B
-> mode and cannot be fixed in Samba.</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->If you are using a Windows NT server as your
- password server then you will have to ensure that your users
- are able to login from the Samba server, as when in <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
-> security = server</B
-> mode the network logon will appear to
- come from there rather than from the users workstation.</P
-></LI
-></UL
-><P
->See also the <A
-HREF="#SECURITY"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->security
- </I
-></TT
-></A
-> parameter.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->password server = &#60;empty string&#62;</B
->
- </P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->password server = NT-PDC, NT-BDC1, NT-BDC2, *
- </B
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->password server = *</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="PATH"
-></A
->path (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This parameter specifies a directory to which
- the user of the service is to be given access. In the case of
- printable services, this is where print data will spool prior to
- being submitted to the host for printing.</P
-><P
->For a printable service offering guest access, the service
- should be readonly and the path should be world-writeable and
- have the sticky bit set. This is not mandatory of course, but
- you probably won't get the results you expect if you do
- otherwise.</P
-><P
->Any occurrences of <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->%u</I
-></TT
-> in the path
- will be replaced with the UNIX username that the client is using
- on this connection. Any occurrences of <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->%m</I
-></TT
->
- will be replaced by the NetBIOS name of the machine they are
- connecting from. These replacements are very useful for setting
- up pseudo home directories for users.</P
-><P
->Note that this path will be based on <A
-HREF="#ROOTDIR"
-> <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->root dir</I
-></TT
-></A
-> if one was specified.</P
-><P
->Default: <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->none</I
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->path = /home/fred</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="PIDDIRECTORY"
-></A
->pid directory (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This option specifies the directory where pid
- files will be placed. </P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->pid directory = ${prefix}/var/locks</B
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->pid directory = /var/run/</B
->
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="POSIXLOCKING"
-></A
->posix locking (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->The <A
-HREF="smbd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbd(8)</B
-></A
->
- daemon maintains an database of file locks obtained by SMB clients.
- The default behavior is to map this internal database to POSIX
- locks. This means that file locks obtained by SMB clients are
- consistent with those seen by POSIX compliant applications accessing
- the files via a non-SMB method (e.g. NFS or local file access).
- You should never need to disable this parameter.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->posix locking = yes</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="POSTEXEC"
-></A
->postexec (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This option specifies a command to be run
- whenever the service is disconnected. It takes the usual
- substitutions. The command may be run as the root on some
- systems.</P
-><P
->An interesting example may be to unmount server
- resources:</P
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->postexec = /etc/umount /cdrom</B
-></P
-><P
->See also <A
-HREF="#PREEXEC"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->preexec</I
-></TT
->
- </A
->.</P
-><P
->Default: <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->none (no command executed)</I
->
- </P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->postexec = echo \"%u disconnected from %S
- from %m (%I)\" &#62;&#62; /tmp/log</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="POSTSCRIPT"
-></A
->postscript (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This parameter forces a printer to interpret
- the print files as PostScript. This is done by adding a <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->%!
- </TT
-> to the start of print output.</P
-><P
->This is most useful when you have lots of PCs that persist
- in putting a control-D at the start of print jobs, which then
- confuses your printer.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->postscript = no</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="PREEXEC"
-></A
->preexec (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This option specifies a command to be run whenever
- the service is connected to. It takes the usual substitutions.</P
-><P
->An interesting example is to send the users a welcome
- message every time they log in. Maybe a message of the day? Here
- is an example:</P
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->preexec = csh -c 'echo \"Welcome to %S!\" |
- /usr/local/samba/bin/smbclient -M %m -I %I' &#38; </B
-></P
-><P
->Of course, this could get annoying after a while :-)</P
-><P
->See also <A
-HREF="#PREEXECCLOSE"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->preexec close
- </I
-></TT
-></A
-> and <A
-HREF="#POSTEXEC"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->postexec
- </I
-></TT
-></A
->.</P
-><P
->Default: <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->none (no command executed)</I
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->preexec = echo \"%u connected to %S from %m
- (%I)\" &#62;&#62; /tmp/log</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="PREEXECCLOSE"
-></A
->preexec close (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This boolean option controls whether a non-zero
- return code from <A
-HREF="#PREEXEC"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->preexec
- </I
-></TT
-></A
-> should close the service being connected to.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->preexec close = no</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="PREFERREDMASTER"
-></A
->preferred master (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This boolean parameter controls if <A
-HREF="nmbd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
->nmbd(8)</A
-> is a preferred master browser
- for its workgroup.</P
-><P
->If this is set to <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->yes</TT
->, on startup, <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->nmbd</B
->
- will force an election, and it will have a slight advantage in
- winning the election. It is recommended that this parameter is
- used in conjunction with <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
-><A
-HREF="#DOMAINMASTER"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
-> domain master</I
-></TT
-></A
-> = yes</B
->, so that <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
-> nmbd</B
-> can guarantee becoming a domain master.</P
-><P
->Use this option with caution, because if there are several
- hosts (whether Samba servers, Windows 95 or NT) that are preferred
- master browsers on the same subnet, they will each periodically
- and continuously attempt to become the local master browser.
- This will result in unnecessary broadcast traffic and reduced browsing
- capabilities.</P
-><P
->See also <A
-HREF="#OSLEVEL"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->os level</I
-></TT
->
- </A
->.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->preferred master = auto</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="PREFEREDMASTER"
-></A
->prefered master (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Synonym for <A
-HREF="#PREFERREDMASTER"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
-> preferred master</I
-></TT
-></A
-> for people who cannot spell :-).</P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="PRELOAD"
-></A
->preload (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This is a list of services that you want to be
- automatically added to the browse lists. This is most useful
- for homes and printers services that would otherwise not be
- visible.</P
-><P
->Note that if you just want all printers in your
- printcap file loaded then the <A
-HREF="#LOADPRINTERS"
-> <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->load printers</I
-></TT
-></A
-> option is easier.</P
-><P
->Default: <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->no preloaded services</I
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->preload = fred lp colorlp</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="PRESERVECASE"
-></A
->preserve case (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
-> This controls if new filenames are created
- with the case that the client passes, or if they are forced to
- be the <A
-HREF="#DEFAULTCASE"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->default case
- </I
-></TT
-></A
->.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->preserve case = yes</B
-></P
-><P
->See the section on <A
-HREF="#AEN205"
->NAME
- MANGLING</A
-> for a fuller discussion.</P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="PRINTCOMMAND"
-></A
->print command (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->After a print job has finished spooling to
- a service, this command will be used via a <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->system()</B
->
- call to process the spool file. Typically the command specified will
- submit the spool file to the host's printing subsystem, but there
- is no requirement that this be the case. The server will not remove
- the spool file, so whatever command you specify should remove the
- spool file when it has been processed, otherwise you will need to
- manually remove old spool files.</P
-><P
->The print command is simply a text string. It will be used
- verbatim after macro substitutions have been made:</P
-><P
->s, %p - the path to the spool
- file name</P
-><P
->%p - the appropriate printer
- name</P
-><P
->%J - the job
- name as transmitted by the client.</P
-><P
->%c - The number of printed pages
- of the spooled job (if known).</P
-><P
->%z - the size of the spooled
- print job (in bytes)</P
-><P
->The print command <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->MUST</I
-> contain at least
- one occurrence of <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->%s</I
-></TT
-> or <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->%f
- </I
-></TT
-> - the <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->%p</I
-></TT
-> is optional. At the time
- a job is submitted, if no printer name is supplied the <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->%p
- </I
-></TT
-> will be silently removed from the printer command.</P
-><P
->If specified in the [global] section, the print command given
- will be used for any printable service that does not have its own
- print command specified.</P
-><P
->If there is neither a specified print command for a
- printable service nor a global print command, spool files will
- be created but not processed and (most importantly) not removed.</P
-><P
->Note that printing may fail on some UNIXes from the
- <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->nobody</TT
-> account. If this happens then create
- an alternative guest account that can print and set the <A
-HREF="#GUESTACCOUNT"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->guest account</I
-></TT
-></A
->
- in the [global] section.</P
-><P
->You can form quite complex print commands by realizing
- that they are just passed to a shell. For example the following
- will log a print job, print the file, then remove it. Note that
- ';' is the usual separator for command in shell scripts.</P
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->print command = echo Printing %s &#62;&#62;
- /tmp/print.log; lpr -P %p %s; rm %s</B
-></P
-><P
->You may have to vary this command considerably depending
- on how you normally print files on your system. The default for
- the parameter varies depending on the setting of the <A
-HREF="#PRINTING"
-> <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->printing</I
-></TT
-></A
-> parameter.</P
-><P
->Default: For <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->printing = BSD, AIX, QNX, LPRNG
- or PLP :</B
-></P
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->print command = lpr -r -P%p %s</B
-></P
-><P
->For <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->printing = SYSV or HPUX :</B
-></P
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->print command = lp -c -d%p %s; rm %s</B
-></P
-><P
->For <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->printing = SOFTQ :</B
-></P
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->print command = lp -d%p -s %s; rm %s</B
-></P
-><P
->For printing = CUPS : If SAMBA is compiled against
- libcups, then <A
-HREF="#PRINTING"
->printcap = cups</A
->
- uses the CUPS API to
- submit jobs, etc. Otherwise it maps to the System V
- commands with the -oraw option for printing, i.e. it
- uses <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->lp -c -d%p -oraw; rm %s</B
->.
- With <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->printing = cups</B
->,
- and if SAMBA is compiled against libcups, any manually
- set print command will be ignored.</P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->print command = /usr/local/samba/bin/myprintscript
- %p %s</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="PRINTOK"
-></A
->print ok (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Synonym for <A
-HREF="#PRINTABLE"
-> <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->printable</I
-></TT
-></A
->.</P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="PRINTABLE"
-></A
->printable (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->If this parameter is <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->yes</TT
->, then
- clients may open, write to and submit spool files on the directory
- specified for the service. </P
-><P
->Note that a printable service will ALWAYS allow writing
- to the service path (user privileges permitting) via the spooling
- of print data. The <A
-HREF="#READONLY"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->read only
- </I
-></TT
-></A
-> parameter controls only non-printing access to
- the resource.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->printable = no</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="PRINTCAP"
-></A
->printcap (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Synonym for <A
-HREF="#PRINTCAPNAME"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
-> printcap name</I
-></TT
-></A
->.</P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="PRINTCAPNAME"
-></A
->printcap name (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This parameter may be used to override the
- compiled-in default printcap name used by the server (usually <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
-> /etc/printcap</TT
->). See the discussion of the <A
-HREF="#AEN79"
->[printers]</A
-> section above for reasons
- why you might want to do this.</P
-><P
->To use the CUPS printing interface set <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->printcap name = cups
- </B
->. This should be supplemented by an addtional setting
- <A
-HREF="#PRINTING"
->printing = cups</A
-> in the [global]
- section. <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->printcap name = cups</B
-> will use the
- "dummy" printcap created by CUPS, as specified in your CUPS
- configuration file.
- </P
-><P
->On System V systems that use <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->lpstat</B
-> to
- list available printers you can use <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->printcap name = lpstat
- </B
-> to automatically obtain lists of available printers. This
- is the default for systems that define SYSV at configure time in
- Samba (this includes most System V based systems). If <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
-> printcap name</I
-></TT
-> is set to <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->lpstat</B
-> on
- these systems then Samba will launch <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->lpstat -v</B
-> and
- attempt to parse the output to obtain a printer list.</P
-><P
->A minimal printcap file would look something like this:</P
-><P
-><TABLE
-BORDER="0"
-BGCOLOR="#E0E0E0"
-WIDTH="90%"
-><TR
-><TD
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
-> print1|My Printer 1
- print2|My Printer 2
- print3|My Printer 3
- print4|My Printer 4
- print5|My Printer 5
- </PRE
-></TD
-></TR
-></TABLE
-></P
-><P
->where the '|' separates aliases of a printer. The fact
- that the second alias has a space in it gives a hint to Samba
- that it's a comment.</P
-><P
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->NOTE</I
->: Under AIX the default printcap
- name is <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/qconfig</TT
->. Samba will assume the
- file is in AIX <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->qconfig</TT
-> format if the string
- <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->qconfig</TT
-> appears in the printcap filename.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->printcap name = /etc/printcap</B
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->printcap name = /etc/myprintcap</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="PRINTERADMIN"
-></A
->printer admin (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This is a list of users that can do anything to
- printers via the remote administration interfaces offered by MS-RPC
- (usually using a NT workstation). Note that the root user always
- has admin rights.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->printer admin = &#60;empty string&#62;</B
->
- </P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->printer admin = admin, @staff</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="PRINTERDRIVER"
-></A
->printer driver (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->Note :</I
->This is a deprecated
- parameter and will be removed in the next major release
- following version 2.2. Please see the instructions in
- the <A
-HREF="printer_driver2.html"
-TARGET="_top"
->Samba 2.2. Printing
- HOWTO</A
-> for more information
- on the new method of loading printer drivers onto a Samba server.
- </P
-><P
->This option allows you to control the string
- that clients receive when they ask the server for the printer driver
- associated with a printer. If you are using Windows95 or Windows NT
- then you can use this to automate the setup of printers on your
- system.</P
-><P
->You need to set this parameter to the exact string (case
- sensitive) that describes the appropriate printer driver for your
- system. If you don't know the exact string to use then you should
- first try with no <A
-HREF="#PRINTERDRIVER"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
-> printer driver</I
-></TT
-></A
-> option set and the client will
- give you a list of printer drivers. The appropriate strings are
- shown in a scroll box after you have chosen the printer manufacturer.</P
-><P
->See also <A
-HREF="#PRINTERDRIVERFILE"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->printer
- driver file</I
-></TT
-></A
->.</P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->printer driver = HP LaserJet 4L</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="PRINTERDRIVERFILE"
-></A
->printer driver file (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->Note :</I
->This is a deprecated
- parameter and will be removed in the next major release
- following version 2.2. Please see the instructions in
- the <A
-HREF="printer_driver2.html"
-TARGET="_top"
->Samba 2.2. Printing
- HOWTO</A
-> for more information
- on the new method of loading printer drivers onto a Samba server.
- </P
-><P
->This parameter tells Samba where the printer driver
- definition file, used when serving drivers to Windows 95 clients, is
- to be found. If this is not set, the default is :</P
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
-><TT
-CLASS="REPLACEABLE"
-><I
->SAMBA_INSTALL_DIRECTORY</I
-></TT
->
- /lib/printers.def</TT
-></P
-><P
->This file is created from Windows 95 <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->msprint.inf
- </TT
-> files found on the Windows 95 client system. For more
- details on setting up serving of printer drivers to Windows 95
- clients, see the outdated documentation file in the <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->docs/</TT
->
- directory, <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->PRINTER_DRIVER.txt</TT
->.</P
-><P
->See also <A
-HREF="#PRINTERDRIVERLOCATION"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
-> printer driver location</I
-></TT
-></A
->.</P
-><P
->Default: <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->None (set in compile).</I
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->printer driver file =
- /usr/local/samba/printers/drivers.def</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="PRINTERDRIVERLOCATION"
-></A
->printer driver location (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->Note :</I
->This is a deprecated
- parameter and will be removed in the next major release
- following version 2.2. Please see the instructions in
- the <A
-HREF="printer_driver2.html"
-TARGET="_top"
->Samba 2.2. Printing
- HOWTO</A
-> for more information
- on the new method of loading printer drivers onto a Samba server.
- </P
-><P
->This parameter tells clients of a particular printer
- share where to find the printer driver files for the automatic
- installation of drivers for Windows 95 machines. If Samba is set up
- to serve printer drivers to Windows 95 machines, this should be set to</P
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->\\MACHINE\PRINTER$</B
-></P
-><P
->Where MACHINE is the NetBIOS name of your Samba server,
- and PRINTER$ is a share you set up for serving printer driver
- files. For more details on setting this up see the outdated documentation
- file in the <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->docs/</TT
-> directory, <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
-> PRINTER_DRIVER.txt</TT
->.</P
-><P
->See also <A
-HREF="#PRINTERDRIVERFILE"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
-> printer driver file</I
-></TT
-></A
->.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->none</B
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->printer driver location = \\MACHINE\PRINTER$
- </B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="PRINTERNAME"
-></A
->printer name (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This parameter specifies the name of the printer
- to which print jobs spooled through a printable service will be sent.</P
-><P
->If specified in the [global] section, the printer
- name given will be used for any printable service that does
- not have its own printer name specified.</P
-><P
->Default: <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->none (but may be <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->lp</TT
->
- on many systems)</I
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->printer name = laserwriter</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="PRINTER"
-></A
->printer (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Synonym for <A
-HREF="#PRINTERNAME"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
-> printer name</I
-></TT
-></A
->.</P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="PRINTING"
-></A
->printing (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This parameters controls how printer status
- information is interpreted on your system. It also affects the
- default values for the <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->print command</I
-></TT
->,
- <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->lpq command</I
-></TT
->, <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->lppause command
- </I
-></TT
->, <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->lpresume command</I
-></TT
->, and
- <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->lprm command</I
-></TT
-> if specified in the
- [global] section.</P
-><P
->Currently nine printing styles are supported. They are
- <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->BSD</TT
->, <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->AIX</TT
->,
- <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->LPRNG</TT
->, <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->PLP</TT
->,
- <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->SYSV</TT
->, <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->HPUX</TT
->,
- <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->QNX</TT
->, <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->SOFTQ</TT
->,
- and <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->CUPS</TT
->.</P
-><P
->To see what the defaults are for the other print
- commands when using the various options use the <A
-HREF="testparm.1.html"
-TARGET="_top"
->testparm(1)</A
-> program.</P
-><P
->This option can be set on a per printer basis</P
-><P
->See also the discussion in the <A
-HREF="#AEN79"
-> [printers]</A
-> section.</P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="PRIVATEDIR"
-></A
->private dir (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This parameters defines the directory
- smbd will use for storing such files as <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->smbpasswd</TT
->
- and <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->secrets.tdb</TT
->.
- </P
-><P
->Default :<B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->private dir = ${prefix}/private</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="PROTOCOL"
-></A
->protocol (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Synonym for <A
-HREF="#MAXPROTOCOL"
-> <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->max protocol</I
-></TT
-></A
->.</P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="PUBLIC"
-></A
->public (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Synonym for <A
-HREF="#GUESTOK"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->guest
- ok</I
-></TT
-></A
->.</P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="QUEUEPAUSECOMMAND"
-></A
->queuepause command (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This parameter specifies the command to be
- executed on the server host in order to pause the printer queue.</P
-><P
->This command should be a program or script which takes
- a printer name as its only parameter and stops the printer queue,
- such that no longer jobs are submitted to the printer.</P
-><P
->This command is not supported by Windows for Workgroups,
- but can be issued from the Printers window under Windows 95
- and NT.</P
-><P
->If a <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->%p</I
-></TT
-> is given then the printer name
- is put in its place. Otherwise it is placed at the end of the command.
- </P
-><P
->Note that it is good practice to include the absolute
- path in the command as the PATH may not be available to the
- server.</P
-><P
->Default: <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->depends on the setting of <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->printing
- </I
-></TT
-></I
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->queuepause command = disable %p</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="QUEUERESUMECOMMAND"
-></A
->queueresume command (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This parameter specifies the command to be
- executed on the server host in order to resume the printer queue. It
- is the command to undo the behavior that is caused by the
- previous parameter (<A
-HREF="#QUEUEPAUSECOMMAND"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
-> queuepause command</I
-></TT
-></A
->).</P
-><P
->This command should be a program or script which takes
- a printer name as its only parameter and resumes the printer queue,
- such that queued jobs are resubmitted to the printer.</P
-><P
->This command is not supported by Windows for Workgroups,
- but can be issued from the Printers window under Windows 95
- and NT.</P
-><P
->If a <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->%p</I
-></TT
-> is given then the printer name
- is put in its place. Otherwise it is placed at the end of the
- command.</P
-><P
->Note that it is good practice to include the absolute
- path in the command as the PATH may not be available to the
- server.</P
-><P
->Default: <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->depends on the setting of <A
-HREF="#PRINTING"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->printing</I
-></TT
-></A
-></I
->
- </P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->queuepause command = enable %p
- </B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="READBMPX"
-></A
->read bmpx (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This boolean parameter controls whether <A
-HREF="smbd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
->smbd(8)</A
-> will support the "Read
- Block Multiplex" SMB. This is now rarely used and defaults to
- <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->no</TT
->. You should never need to set this
- parameter.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->read bmpx = no</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="READLIST"
-></A
->read list (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This is a list of users that are given read-only
- access to a service. If the connecting user is in this list then
- they will not be given write access, no matter what the <A
-HREF="#READONLY"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->read only</I
-></TT
-></A
->
- option is set to. The list can include group names using the
- syntax described in the <A
-HREF="#INVALIDUSERS"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
-> invalid users</I
-></TT
-></A
-> parameter.</P
-><P
->See also the <A
-HREF="#WRITELIST"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
-> write list</I
-></TT
-></A
-> parameter and the <A
-HREF="#INVALIDUSERS"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->invalid users</I
-></TT
->
- </A
-> parameter.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->read list = &#60;empty string&#62;</B
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->read list = mary, @students</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="READONLY"
-></A
->read only (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->An inverted synonym is <A
-HREF="#WRITEABLE"
-> <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->writeable</I
-></TT
-></A
->.</P
-><P
->If this parameter is <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->yes</TT
->, then users
- of a service may not create or modify files in the service's
- directory.</P
-><P
->Note that a printable service (<B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->printable = yes</B
->)
- will <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->ALWAYS</I
-> allow writing to the directory
- (user privileges permitting), but only via spooling operations.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->read only = yes</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="READRAW"
-></A
->read raw (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This parameter controls whether or not the server
- will support the raw read SMB requests when transferring data
- to clients.</P
-><P
->If enabled, raw reads allow reads of 65535 bytes in
- one packet. This typically provides a major performance benefit.
- </P
-><P
->However, some clients either negotiate the allowable
- block size incorrectly or are incapable of supporting larger block
- sizes, and for these clients you may need to disable raw reads.</P
-><P
->In general this parameter should be viewed as a system tuning
- tool and left severely alone. See also <A
-HREF="#WRITERAW"
-> <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->write raw</I
-></TT
-></A
->.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->read raw = yes</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="READSIZE"
-></A
->read size (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->The option <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->read size</I
-></TT
->
- affects the overlap of disk reads/writes with network reads/writes.
- If the amount of data being transferred in several of the SMB
- commands (currently SMBwrite, SMBwriteX and SMBreadbraw) is larger
- than this value then the server begins writing the data before it
- has received the whole packet from the network, or in the case of
- SMBreadbraw, it begins writing to the network before all the data
- has been read from disk.</P
-><P
->This overlapping works best when the speeds of disk and
- network access are similar, having very little effect when the
- speed of one is much greater than the other.</P
-><P
->The default value is 16384, but very little experimentation
- has been done yet to determine the optimal value, and it is likely
- that the best value will vary greatly between systems anyway.
- A value over 65536 is pointless and will cause you to allocate
- memory unnecessarily.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->read size = 16384</B
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->read size = 8192</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="REALM"
-></A
->realm (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
-> This option specifies the kerberos realm to use. The realm is
- used as the ADS equivalent of the NT4<B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->domain</B
->. It
- is usually set to the DNS name of the kerberos server.
- </P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->realm = </B
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->realm = mysambabox.mycompany.com</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="REMOTEANNOUNCE"
-></A
->remote announce (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This option allows you to setup <A
-HREF="nmbd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
->nmbd(8)</A
-> to periodically announce itself
- to arbitrary IP addresses with an arbitrary workgroup name.</P
-><P
->This is useful if you want your Samba server to appear
- in a remote workgroup for which the normal browse propagation
- rules don't work. The remote workgroup can be anywhere that you
- can send IP packets to.</P
-><P
->For example:</P
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->remote announce = 192.168.2.255/SERVERS
- 192.168.4.255/STAFF</B
-></P
-><P
->the above line would cause <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->nmbd</B
-> to announce itself
- to the two given IP addresses using the given workgroup names.
- If you leave out the workgroup name then the one given in
- the <A
-HREF="#WORKGROUP"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->workgroup</I
-></TT
-></A
->
- parameter is used instead.</P
-><P
->The IP addresses you choose would normally be the broadcast
- addresses of the remote networks, but can also be the IP addresses
- of known browse masters if your network config is that stable.</P
-><P
->See the documentation file <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->BROWSING.txt</TT
->
- in the <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->docs/</TT
-> directory.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->remote announce = &#60;empty string&#62;
- </B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="REMOTEBROWSESYNC"
-></A
->remote browse sync (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This option allows you to setup <A
-HREF="nmbd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
->nmbd(8)</A
-> to periodically request
- synchronization of browse lists with the master browser of a Samba
- server that is on a remote segment. This option will allow you to
- gain browse lists for multiple workgroups across routed networks. This
- is done in a manner that does not work with any non-Samba servers.</P
-><P
->This is useful if you want your Samba server and all local
- clients to appear in a remote workgroup for which the normal browse
- propagation rules don't work. The remote workgroup can be anywhere
- that you can send IP packets to.</P
-><P
->For example:</P
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->remote browse sync = 192.168.2.255 192.168.4.255
- </B
-></P
-><P
->the above line would cause <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->nmbd</B
-> to request
- the master browser on the specified subnets or addresses to
- synchronize their browse lists with the local server.</P
-><P
->The IP addresses you choose would normally be the broadcast
- addresses of the remote networks, but can also be the IP addresses
- of known browse masters if your network config is that stable. If
- a machine IP address is given Samba makes NO attempt to validate
- that the remote machine is available, is listening, nor that it
- is in fact the browse master on its segment.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->remote browse sync = &#60;empty string&#62;
- </B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="RESTRICTANONYMOUS"
-></A
->restrict anonymous (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This is a integer parameter, and
- mirrors as much as possible the functinality the
- <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->RestrictAnonymous</TT
->
- registry key does on NT/Win2k. </P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->restrict anonymous = 0</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="ROOT"
-></A
->root (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Synonym for <A
-HREF="#ROOTDIRECTORY"
-> <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->root directory"</I
-></TT
-></A
->.</P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="ROOTDIR"
-></A
->root dir (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Synonym for <A
-HREF="#ROOTDIRECTORY"
-> <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->root directory"</I
-></TT
-></A
->.</P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="ROOTDIRECTORY"
-></A
->root directory (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->The server will <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->chroot()</B
-> (i.e.
- Change its root directory) to this directory on startup. This is
- not strictly necessary for secure operation. Even without it the
- server will deny access to files not in one of the service entries.
- It may also check for, and deny access to, soft links to other
- parts of the filesystem, or attempts to use ".." in file names
- to access other directories (depending on the setting of the <A
-HREF="#WIDELINKS"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->wide links</I
-></TT
-></A
->
- parameter).</P
-><P
->Adding a <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->root directory</I
-></TT
-> entry other
- than "/" adds an extra level of security, but at a price. It
- absolutely ensures that no access is given to files not in the
- sub-tree specified in the <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->root directory</I
-></TT
->
- option, <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->including</I
-> some files needed for
- complete operation of the server. To maintain full operability
- of the server you will need to mirror some system files
- into the <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->root directory</I
-></TT
-> tree. In particular
- you will need to mirror <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/passwd</TT
-> (or a
- subset of it), and any binaries or configuration files needed for
- printing (if required). The set of files that must be mirrored is
- operating system dependent.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->root directory = /</B
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->root directory = /homes/smb</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="ROOTPOSTEXEC"
-></A
->root postexec (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This is the same as the <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->postexec</I
-></TT
->
- parameter except that the command is run as root. This
- is useful for unmounting filesystems
- (such as CDROMs) after a connection is closed.</P
-><P
->See also <A
-HREF="#POSTEXEC"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
-> postexec</I
-></TT
-></A
->.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->root postexec = &#60;empty string&#62;
- </B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="ROOTPREEXEC"
-></A
->root preexec (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This is the same as the <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->preexec</I
-></TT
->
- parameter except that the command is run as root. This
- is useful for mounting filesystems (such as CDROMs) when a
- connection is opened.</P
-><P
->See also <A
-HREF="#PREEXEC"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
-> preexec</I
-></TT
-></A
-> and <A
-HREF="#PREEXECCLOSE"
-> <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->preexec close</I
-></TT
-></A
->.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->root preexec = &#60;empty string&#62;
- </B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="ROOTPREEXECCLOSE"
-></A
->root preexec close (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This is the same as the <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->preexec close
- </I
-></TT
-> parameter except that the command is run as root.</P
-><P
->See also <A
-HREF="#PREEXEC"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
-> preexec</I
-></TT
-></A
-> and <A
-HREF="#PREEXECCLOSE"
-> <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->preexec close</I
-></TT
-></A
->.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->root preexec close = no</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="SECURITY"
-></A
->security (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This option affects how clients respond to
- Samba and is one of the most important settings in the <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
-> smb.conf</TT
-> file.</P
-><P
->The option sets the "security mode bit" in replies to
- protocol negotiations with <A
-HREF="smbd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
->smbd(8)
- </A
-> to turn share level security on or off. Clients decide
- based on this bit whether (and how) to transfer user and password
- information to the server.</P
-><P
->The default is <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->security = user</B
->, as this is
- the most common setting needed when talking to Windows 98 and
- Windows NT.</P
-><P
->The alternatives are <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->security = share</B
->,
- <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->security = server</B
-> or <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->security = domain
- </B
->.</P
-><P
->In versions of Samba prior to 2.0.0, the default was
- <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->security = share</B
-> mainly because that was
- the only option at one stage.</P
-><P
->There is a bug in WfWg that has relevance to this
- setting. When in user or server level security a WfWg client
- will totally ignore the password you type in the "connect
- drive" dialog box. This makes it very difficult (if not impossible)
- to connect to a Samba service as anyone except the user that
- you are logged into WfWg as.</P
-><P
->If your PCs use usernames that are the same as their
- usernames on the UNIX machine then you will want to use
- <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->security = user</B
->. If you mostly use usernames
- that don't exist on the UNIX box then use <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->security =
- share</B
->.</P
-><P
->You should also use <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->security = share</B
-> if you
- want to mainly setup shares without a password (guest shares). This
- is commonly used for a shared printer server. It is more difficult
- to setup guest shares with <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->security = user</B
->, see
- the <A
-HREF="#MAPTOGUEST"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->map to guest</I
-></TT
->
- </A
->parameter for details.</P
-><P
->It is possible to use <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbd</B
-> in a <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
-> hybrid mode</I
-> where it is offers both user and share
- level security under different <A
-HREF="#NETBIOSALIASES"
-> <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->NetBIOS aliases</I
-></TT
-></A
->. </P
-><P
->The different settings will now be explained.</P
-><P
-><A
-NAME="SECURITYEQUALSSHARE"
-></A
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->SECURITY = SHARE
- </I
-></P
-><P
->When clients connect to a share level security server they
- need not log onto the server with a valid username and password before
- attempting to connect to a shared resource (although modern clients
- such as Windows 95/98 and Windows NT will send a logon request with
- a username but no password when talking to a <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->security = share
- </B
-> server). Instead, the clients send authentication information
- (passwords) on a per-share basis, at the time they attempt to connect
- to that share.</P
-><P
->Note that <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbd</B
-> <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->ALWAYS</I
->
- uses a valid UNIX user to act on behalf of the client, even in
- <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->security = share</B
-> level security.</P
-><P
->As clients are not required to send a username to the server
- in share level security, <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbd</B
-> uses several
- techniques to determine the correct UNIX user to use on behalf
- of the client.</P
-><P
->A list of possible UNIX usernames to match with the given
- client password is constructed using the following methods :</P
-><P
-></P
-><UL
-><LI
-><P
->If the <A
-HREF="#GUESTONLY"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->guest
- only</I
-></TT
-></A
-> parameter is set, then all the other
- stages are missed and only the <A
-HREF="#GUESTACCOUNT"
-> <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->guest account</I
-></TT
-></A
-> username is checked.
- </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->Is a username is sent with the share connection
- request, then this username (after mapping - see <A
-HREF="#USERNAMEMAP"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->username map</I
-></TT
-></A
->),
- is added as a potential username.</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->If the client did a previous <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->logon
- </I
-> request (the SessionSetup SMB call) then the
- username sent in this SMB will be added as a potential username.
- </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->The name of the service the client requested is
- added as a potential username.</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->The NetBIOS name of the client is added to
- the list as a potential username.</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->Any users on the <A
-HREF="#USER"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
-> user</I
-></TT
-></A
-> list are added as potential usernames.
- </P
-></LI
-></UL
-><P
->If the <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->guest only</I
-></TT
-> parameter is
- not set, then this list is then tried with the supplied password.
- The first user for whom the password matches will be used as the
- UNIX user.</P
-><P
->If the <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->guest only</I
-></TT
-> parameter is
- set, or no username can be determined then if the share is marked
- as available to the <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->guest account</I
-></TT
->, then this
- guest user will be used, otherwise access is denied.</P
-><P
->Note that it can be <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->very</I
-> confusing
- in share-level security as to which UNIX username will eventually
- be used in granting access.</P
-><P
->See also the section <A
-HREF="#AEN238"
-> NOTE ABOUT USERNAME/PASSWORD VALIDATION</A
->.</P
-><P
-><A
-NAME="SECURITYEQUALSUSER"
-></A
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->SECURITY = USER
- </I
-></P
-><P
->This is the default security setting in Samba 2.2.
- With user-level security a client must first "log-on" with a
- valid username and password (which can be mapped using the <A
-HREF="#USERNAMEMAP"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->username map</I
-></TT
-></A
->
- parameter). Encrypted passwords (see the <A
-HREF="#ENCRYPTPASSWORDS"
-> <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->encrypted passwords</I
-></TT
-></A
-> parameter) can also
- be used in this security mode. Parameters such as <A
-HREF="#USER"
-> <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->user</I
-></TT
-></A
-> and <A
-HREF="#GUESTONLY"
-> <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->guest only</I
-></TT
-></A
-> if set are then applied and
- may change the UNIX user to use on this connection, but only after
- the user has been successfully authenticated.</P
-><P
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->Note</I
-> that the name of the resource being
- requested is <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->not</I
-> sent to the server until after
- the server has successfully authenticated the client. This is why
- guest shares don't work in user level security without allowing
- the server to automatically map unknown users into the <A
-HREF="#GUESTACCOUNT"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->guest account</I
-></TT
-></A
->.
- See the <A
-HREF="#MAPTOGUEST"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->map to guest</I
-></TT
->
- </A
-> parameter for details on doing this.</P
-><P
->See also the section <A
-HREF="#AEN238"
-> NOTE ABOUT USERNAME/PASSWORD VALIDATION</A
->.</P
-><P
-><A
-NAME="SECURITYEQUALSSERVER"
-></A
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->SECURITY = SERVER
- </I
-></P
-><P
->In this mode Samba will try to validate the username/password
- by passing it to another SMB server, such as an NT box. If this
- fails it will revert to <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->security = user</B
->, but note
- that if encrypted passwords have been negotiated then Samba cannot
- revert back to checking the UNIX password file, it must have a valid
- <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->smbpasswd</TT
-> file to check users against. See the
- documentation file in the <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->docs/</TT
-> directory
- <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->ENCRYPTION.txt</TT
-> for details on how to set this
- up.</P
-><P
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->Note</I
-> that from the client's point of
- view <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->security = server</B
-> is the same as <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
-> security = user</B
->. It only affects how the server deals
- with the authentication, it does not in any way affect what the
- client sees.</P
-><P
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->Note</I
-> that the name of the resource being
- requested is <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->not</I
-> sent to the server until after
- the server has successfully authenticated the client. This is why
- guest shares don't work in user level security without allowing
- the server to automatically map unknown users into the <A
-HREF="#GUESTACCOUNT"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->guest account</I
-></TT
-></A
->.
- See the <A
-HREF="#MAPTOGUEST"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->map to guest</I
-></TT
->
- </A
-> parameter for details on doing this.</P
-><P
->See also the section <A
-HREF="#AEN238"
-> NOTE ABOUT USERNAME/PASSWORD VALIDATION</A
->.</P
-><P
->See also the <A
-HREF="#PASSWORDSERVER"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->password
- server</I
-></TT
-></A
-> parameter and the <A
-HREF="#ENCRYPTPASSWORDS"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->encrypted passwords</I
-></TT
->
- </A
-> parameter.</P
-><P
-><A
-NAME="SECURITYEQUALSDOMAIN"
-></A
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->SECURITY = DOMAIN
- </I
-></P
-><P
->This mode will only work correctly if <A
-HREF="smbpasswd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
->smbpasswd(8)</A
-> has been used to add this
- machine into a Windows NT Domain. It expects the <A
-HREF="#ENCRYPTPASSWORDS"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->encrypted passwords</I
-></TT
->
- </A
-> parameter to be set to <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->yes</TT
->. In this
- mode Samba will try to validate the username/password by passing
- it to a Windows NT Primary or Backup Domain Controller, in exactly
- the same way that a Windows NT Server would do.</P
-><P
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->Note</I
-> that a valid UNIX user must still
- exist as well as the account on the Domain Controller to allow
- Samba to have a valid UNIX account to map file access to.</P
-><P
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->Note</I
-> that from the client's point
- of view <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->security = domain</B
-> is the same as <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->security = user
- </B
->. It only affects how the server deals with the authentication,
- it does not in any way affect what the client sees.</P
-><P
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->Note</I
-> that the name of the resource being
- requested is <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->not</I
-> sent to the server until after
- the server has successfully authenticated the client. This is why
- guest shares don't work in user level security without allowing
- the server to automatically map unknown users into the <A
-HREF="#GUESTACCOUNT"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->guest account</I
-></TT
-></A
->.
- See the <A
-HREF="#MAPTOGUEST"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->map to guest</I
-></TT
->
- </A
-> parameter for details on doing this.</P
-><P
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->BUG:</I
-> There is currently a bug in the
- implementation of <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->security = domain</B
-> with respect
- to multi-byte character set usernames. The communication with a
- Domain Controller must be done in UNICODE and Samba currently
- does not widen multi-byte user names to UNICODE correctly, thus
- a multi-byte username will not be recognized correctly at the
- Domain Controller. This issue will be addressed in a future release.</P
-><P
->See also the section <A
-HREF="#AEN238"
-> NOTE ABOUT USERNAME/PASSWORD VALIDATION</A
->.</P
-><P
->See also the <A
-HREF="#PASSWORDSERVER"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->password
- server</I
-></TT
-></A
-> parameter and the <A
-HREF="#ENCRYPTPASSWORDS"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->encrypted passwords</I
-></TT
->
- </A
-> parameter.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->security = USER</B
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->security = DOMAIN</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="SECURITYMASK"
-></A
->security mask (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This parameter controls what UNIX permission
- bits can be modified when a Windows NT client is manipulating
- the UNIX permission on a file using the native NT security
- dialog box.</P
-><P
->This parameter is applied as a mask (AND'ed with) to
- the changed permission bits, thus preventing any bits not in
- this mask from being modified. Essentially, zero bits in this
- mask may be treated as a set of bits the user is not allowed
- to change.</P
-><P
->If not set explicitly this parameter is 0777, allowing
- a user to modify all the user/group/world permissions on a file.
- </P
-><P
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->Note</I
-> that users who can access the
- Samba server through other means can easily bypass this
- restriction, so it is primarily useful for standalone
- "appliance" systems. Administrators of most normal systems will
- probably want to leave it set to <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->0777</TT
->.</P
-><P
->See also the <A
-HREF="#FORCEDIRECTORYSECURITYMODE"
-> <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->force directory security mode</I
-></TT
-></A
->,
- <A
-HREF="#DIRECTORYSECURITYMASK"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->directory
- security mask</I
-></TT
-></A
->, <A
-HREF="#FORCESECURITYMODE"
-> <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->force security mode</I
-></TT
-></A
-> parameters.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->security mask = 0777</B
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->security mask = 0770</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="SERVERSTRING"
-></A
->server string (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This controls what string will show up in the
- printer comment box in print manager and next to the IPC connection
- in <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->net view</B
->. It can be any string that you wish
- to show to your users.</P
-><P
->It also sets what will appear in browse lists next
- to the machine name.</P
-><P
->A <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->%v</I
-></TT
-> will be replaced with the Samba
- version number.</P
-><P
->A <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->%h</I
-></TT
-> will be replaced with the
- hostname.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->server string = Samba %v</B
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->server string = University of GNUs Samba
- Server</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="SETDIRECTORY"
-></A
->set directory (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->If <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->set directory = no</B
->, then
- users of the service may not use the setdir command to change
- directory.</P
-><P
->The <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->setdir</B
-> command is only implemented
- in the Digital Pathworks client. See the Pathworks documentation
- for details.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->set directory = no</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="SHAREMODES"
-></A
->share modes (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This enables or disables the honoring of
- the <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->share modes</I
-></TT
-> during a file open. These
- modes are used by clients to gain exclusive read or write access
- to a file.</P
-><P
->These open modes are not directly supported by UNIX, so
- they are simulated using shared memory, or lock files if your
- UNIX doesn't support shared memory (almost all do).</P
-><P
->The share modes that are enabled by this option are
- <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->DENY_DOS</TT
->, <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->DENY_ALL</TT
->,
- <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->DENY_READ</TT
->, <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->DENY_WRITE</TT
->,
- <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->DENY_NONE</TT
-> and <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->DENY_FCB</TT
->.
- </P
-><P
->This option gives full share compatibility and enabled
- by default.</P
-><P
->You should <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->NEVER</I
-> turn this parameter
- off as many Windows applications will break if you do so.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->share modes = yes</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="SHORTPRESERVECASE"
-></A
->short preserve case (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This boolean parameter controls if new files
- which conform to 8.3 syntax, that is all in upper case and of
- suitable length, are created upper case, or if they are forced
- to be the <A
-HREF="#DEFAULTCASE"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->default case
- </I
-></TT
-></A
->. This option can be use with <A
-HREF="#PRESERVECASE"
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->preserve case = yes</B
->
- </A
-> to permit long filenames to retain their case, while short
- names are lowered. </P
-><P
->See the section on <A
-HREF="#AEN205"
-> NAME MANGLING</A
->.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->short preserve case = yes</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="SHOWADDPRINTERWIZARD"
-></A
->show add printer wizard (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->With the introduction of MS-RPC based printing support
- for Windows NT/2000 client in Samba 2.2, a "Printers..." folder will
- appear on Samba hosts in the share listing. Normally this folder will
- contain an icon for the MS Add Printer Wizard (APW). However, it is
- possible to disable this feature regardless of the level of privilege
- of the connected user.</P
-><P
->Under normal circumstances, the Windows NT/2000 client will
- open a handle on the printer server with OpenPrinterEx() asking for
- Administrator privileges. If the user does not have administrative
- access on the print server (i.e is not root or a member of the
- <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->printer admin</I
-></TT
-> group), the OpenPrinterEx()
- call fails and the client makes another open call with a request for
- a lower privilege level. This should succeed, however the APW
- icon will not be displayed.</P
-><P
->Disabling the <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->show add printer wizard</I
-></TT
->
- parameter will always cause the OpenPrinterEx() on the server
- to fail. Thus the APW icon will never be displayed. <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
-> Note :</I
->This does not prevent the same user from having
- administrative privilege on an individual printer.</P
-><P
->See also <A
-HREF="#ADDPRINTERCOMMAND"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->addprinter
- command</I
-></TT
-></A
->, <A
-HREF="#DELETEPRINTERCOMMAND"
-> <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->deleteprinter command</I
-></TT
-></A
->, <A
-HREF="#PRINTERADMIN"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->printer admin</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-><P
->Default :<B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->show add printer wizard = yes</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="SHUTDOWNSCRIPT"
-></A
->shutdown script (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->This parameter only exists in the HEAD cvs branch</I
->
- This a full path name to a script called by
- <A
-HREF="smbd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbd(8)</B
-></A
-> that
- should start a shutdown procedure.</P
-><P
->This command will be run as the user connected to the
- server.</P
-><P
->%m %t %r %f parameters are expanded</P
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->%m</I
-></TT
-> will be substituted with the
- shutdown message sent to the server.</P
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->%t</I
-></TT
-> will be substituted with the
- number of seconds to wait before effectively starting the
- shutdown procedure.</P
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->%r</I
-></TT
-> will be substituted with the
- switch <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->-r</I
->. It means reboot after shutdown
- for NT.
- </P
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->%f</I
-></TT
-> will be substituted with the
- switch <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->-f</I
->. It means force the shutdown
- even if applications do not respond for NT.</P
-><P
->Default: <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->None</I
->.</P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->abort shutdown script = /usr/local/samba/sbin/shutdown %m %t %r %f</B
-></P
-><P
->Shutdown script example:
- <TABLE
-BORDER="0"
-BGCOLOR="#E0E0E0"
-WIDTH="90%"
-><TR
-><TD
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
-> #!/bin/bash
-
- $time=0
- let "time/60"
- let "time++"
-
- /sbin/shutdown $3 $4 +$time $1 &#38;
- </PRE
-></TD
-></TR
-></TABLE
->
- Shutdown does not return so we need to launch it in background.
- </P
-><P
->See also <A
-HREF="#ABORTSHUTDOWNSCRIPT"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->abort shutdown script</I
-></TT
-></A
->.</P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="SMBPASSWDFILE"
-></A
->smb passwd file (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This option sets the path to the encrypted
- smbpasswd file. By default the path to the smbpasswd file
- is compiled into Samba.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smb passwd file = ${prefix}/private/smbpasswd
- </B
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smb passwd file = /etc/samba/smbpasswd
- </B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="SMBPORTS"
-></A
->smb ports (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Specifies which ports the server should listen on
- for SMB traffic.
- </P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smb ports = 445 139</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="SOCKETADDRESS"
-></A
->socket address (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This option allows you to control what
- address Samba will listen for connections on. This is used to
- support multiple virtual interfaces on the one server, each
- with a different configuration.</P
-><P
->By default Samba will accept connections on any
- address.</P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->socket address = 192.168.2.20</B
->
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="SOCKETOPTIONS"
-></A
->socket options (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This option allows you to set socket options
- to be used when talking with the client.</P
-><P
->Socket options are controls on the networking layer
- of the operating systems which allow the connection to be
- tuned.</P
-><P
->This option will typically be used to tune your Samba
- server for optimal performance for your local network. There is
- no way that Samba can know what the optimal parameters are for
- your net, so you must experiment and choose them yourself. We
- strongly suggest you read the appropriate documentation for your
- operating system first (perhaps <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->man setsockopt</B
->
- will help).</P
-><P
->You may find that on some systems Samba will say
- "Unknown socket option" when you supply an option. This means you
- either incorrectly typed it or you need to add an include file
- to includes.h for your OS. If the latter is the case please
- send the patch to <A
-HREF="mailto:samba@samba.org"
-TARGET="_top"
-> samba@samba.org</A
->.</P
-><P
->Any of the supported socket options may be combined
- in any way you like, as long as your OS allows it.</P
-><P
->This is the list of socket options currently settable
- using this option:</P
-><P
-></P
-><UL
-><LI
-><P
->SO_KEEPALIVE</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->SO_REUSEADDR</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->SO_BROADCAST</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->TCP_NODELAY</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->IPTOS_LOWDELAY</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->IPTOS_THROUGHPUT</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->SO_SNDBUF *</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->SO_RCVBUF *</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->SO_SNDLOWAT *</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->SO_RCVLOWAT *</P
-></LI
-></UL
-><P
->Those marked with a <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->'*'</I
-> take an integer
- argument. The others can optionally take a 1 or 0 argument to enable
- or disable the option, by default they will be enabled if you
- don't specify 1 or 0.</P
-><P
->To specify an argument use the syntax SOME_OPTION = VALUE
- for example <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->SO_SNDBUF = 8192</B
->. Note that you must
- not have any spaces before or after the = sign.</P
-><P
->If you are on a local network then a sensible option
- might be</P
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->socket options = IPTOS_LOWDELAY</B
-></P
-><P
->If you have a local network then you could try:</P
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->socket options = IPTOS_LOWDELAY TCP_NODELAY</B
-></P
-><P
->If you are on a wide area network then perhaps try
- setting IPTOS_THROUGHPUT. </P
-><P
->Note that several of the options may cause your Samba
- server to fail completely. Use these options with caution!</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->socket options = TCP_NODELAY</B
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->socket options = IPTOS_LOWDELAY</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="SOURCEENVIRONMENT"
-></A
->source environment (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This parameter causes Samba to set environment
- variables as per the content of the file named.</P
-><P
->If the value of this parameter starts with a "|" character
- then Samba will treat that value as a pipe command to open and
- will set the environment variables from the output of the pipe.</P
-><P
->The contents of the file or the output of the pipe should
- be formatted as the output of the standard Unix <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->env(1)
- </B
-> command. This is of the form :</P
-><P
->Example environment entry:</P
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->SAMBA_NETBIOS_NAME = myhostname</B
-></P
-><P
->Default: <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->No default value</I
-></P
-><P
->Examples: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->source environment = |/etc/smb.conf.sh
- </B
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->source environment =
- /usr/local/smb_env_vars</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="SPNEGO"
-></A
->use spnego (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
-> This variable controls controls whether samba will try to use Simple and Protected NEGOciation (as specified by rfc2478) with WindowsXP and Windows2000sp2 clients to agree upon an authentication mechanism. As of samba 3.0alpha it must be set to "no" for these clients to join a samba domain controller. It can be set to "yes" to allow samba to participate in an AD domain controlled by a Windows2000 domain controller.</P
-><P
->Default: <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->use spnego = yes</I
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="STATCACHE"
-></A
->stat cache (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This parameter determines if <A
-HREF="smbd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
->smbd(8)</A
-> will use a cache in order to
- speed up case insensitive name mappings. You should never need
- to change this parameter.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->stat cache = yes</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="STATCACHESIZE"
-></A
->stat cache size (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This parameter determines the number of
- entries in the <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->stat cache</I
-></TT
->. You should
- never need to change this parameter.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->stat cache size = 50</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="STRICTALLOCATE"
-></A
->strict allocate (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This is a boolean that controls the handling of
- disk space allocation in the server. When this is set to <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->yes</TT
->
- the server will change from UNIX behaviour of not committing real
- disk storage blocks when a file is extended to the Windows behaviour
- of actually forcing the disk system to allocate real storage blocks
- when a file is created or extended to be a given size. In UNIX
- terminology this means that Samba will stop creating sparse files.
- This can be slow on some systems.</P
-><P
->When strict allocate is <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->no</TT
-> the server does sparse
- disk block allocation when a file is extended.</P
-><P
->Setting this to <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->yes</TT
-> can help Samba return
- out of quota messages on systems that are restricting the disk quota
- of users.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->strict allocate = no</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="STRICTLOCKING"
-></A
->strict locking (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This is a boolean that controls the handling of
- file locking in the server. When this is set to <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->yes</TT
->
- the server will check every read and write access for file locks, and
- deny access if locks exist. This can be slow on some systems.</P
-><P
->When strict locking is <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->no</TT
-> the server does file
- lock checks only when the client explicitly asks for them.</P
-><P
->Well-behaved clients always ask for lock checks when it
- is important, so in the vast majority of cases <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->strict
- locking = no</B
-> is preferable.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->strict locking = no</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="STRICTSYNC"
-></A
->strict sync (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Many Windows applications (including the Windows
- 98 explorer shell) seem to confuse flushing buffer contents to
- disk with doing a sync to disk. Under UNIX, a sync call forces
- the process to be suspended until the kernel has ensured that
- all outstanding data in kernel disk buffers has been safely stored
- onto stable storage. This is very slow and should only be done
- rarely. Setting this parameter to <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->no</TT
-> (the
- default) means that <A
-HREF="smbd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
->smbd</A
-> ignores the Windows applications requests for
- a sync call. There is only a possibility of losing data if the
- operating system itself that Samba is running on crashes, so there is
- little danger in this default setting. In addition, this fixes many
- performance problems that people have reported with the new Windows98
- explorer shell file copies.</P
-><P
->See also the <A
-HREF="#SYNCALWAYS"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->sync
- always&#62;</I
-></TT
-></A
-> parameter.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->strict sync = no</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="STRIPDOT"
-></A
->strip dot (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This is a boolean that controls whether to
- strip trailing dots off UNIX filenames. This helps with some
- CDROMs that have filenames ending in a single dot.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->strip dot = no</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="SYNCALWAYS"
-></A
->sync always (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This is a boolean parameter that controls
- whether writes will always be written to stable storage before
- the write call returns. If this is <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->no</TT
-> then the server will be
- guided by the client's request in each write call (clients can
- set a bit indicating that a particular write should be synchronous).
- If this is <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->yes</TT
-> then every write will be followed by a <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->fsync()
- </B
-> call to ensure the data is written to disk. Note that
- the <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->strict sync</I
-></TT
-> parameter must be set to
- <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->yes</TT
-> in order for this parameter to have
- any affect.</P
-><P
->See also the <A
-HREF="#STRICTSYNC"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->strict
- sync</I
-></TT
-></A
-> parameter.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->sync always = no</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="SYSLOG"
-></A
->syslog (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This parameter maps how Samba debug messages
- are logged onto the system syslog logging levels. Samba debug
- level zero maps onto syslog <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->LOG_ERR</TT
->, debug
- level one maps onto <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->LOG_WARNING</TT
->, debug level
- two maps onto <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->LOG_NOTICE</TT
->, debug level three
- maps onto LOG_INFO. All higher levels are mapped to <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
-> LOG_DEBUG</TT
->.</P
-><P
->This parameter sets the threshold for sending messages
- to syslog. Only messages with debug level less than this value
- will be sent to syslog.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->syslog = 1</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="SYSLOGONLY"
-></A
->syslog only (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->If this parameter is set then Samba debug
- messages are logged into the system syslog only, and not to
- the debug log files.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->syslog only = no</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="TEMPLATEHOMEDIR"
-></A
->template homedir (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->When filling out the user information for a Windows NT
- user, the <A
-HREF="winbindd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
->winbindd(8)</A
-> daemon
- uses this parameter to fill in the home directory for that user.
- If the string <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->%D</I
-></TT
-> is present it is substituted
- with the user's Windows NT domain name. If the string <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->%U
- </I
-></TT
-> is present it is substituted with the user's Windows
- NT user name.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->template homedir = /home/%D/%U</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="TEMPLATESHELL"
-></A
->template shell (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->When filling out the user information for a Windows NT
- user, the <A
-HREF="winbindd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
->winbindd(8)</A
-> daemon
- uses this parameter to fill in the login shell for that user.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->template shell = /bin/false</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="TIMEOFFSET"
-></A
->time offset (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This parameter is a setting in minutes to add
- to the normal GMT to local time conversion. This is useful if
- you are serving a lot of PCs that have incorrect daylight
- saving time handling.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->time offset = 0</B
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->time offset = 60</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="TIMESERVER"
-></A
->time server (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This parameter determines if <A
-HREF="nmbd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
->
- nmbd(8)</A
-> advertises itself as a time server to Windows
- clients.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->time server = no</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="TIMESTAMPLOGS"
-></A
->timestamp logs (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Synonym for <A
-HREF="#DEBUGTIMESTAMP"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
-> debug timestamp</I
-></TT
-></A
->.</P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="TOTALPRINTJOBS"
-></A
->total print jobs (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This parameter accepts an integer value which defines
- a limit on the maximum number of print jobs that will be accepted
- system wide at any given time. If a print job is submitted
- by a client which will exceed this number, then <A
-HREF="smbd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
->smbd</A
-> will return an
- error indicating that no space is available on the server. The
- default value of 0 means that no such limit exists. This parameter
- can be used to prevent a server from exceeding its capacity and is
- designed as a printing throttle. See also
- <A
-HREF="#MAXPRINTJOBS"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->max print jobs</I
-></TT
-></A
->.
- </P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->total print jobs = 0</B
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->total print jobs = 5000</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="UNICODE"
-></A
->unicode (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Specifies whether Samba should try
- to use unicode on the wire by default. Note: This does NOT
- mean that samba will assume that the unix machine uses unicode!
- </P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->unicode = yes</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="UNIXCHARSET"
-></A
->unix charset (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Specifies the charset the unix machine
- Samba runs on uses. Samba needs to know this in order to be able to
- convert text to the charsets other SMB clients use.
- </P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->unix charset = ASCII</B
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->unix charset = UTF8</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="UNIXEXTENSIONS"
-></A
->unix extensions(G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This boolean parameter controls whether Samba
- implments the CIFS UNIX extensions, as defined by HP.
- These extensions enable Samba to better serve UNIX CIFS clients
- by supporting features such as symbolic links, hard links, etc...
- These extensions require a similarly enabled client, and are of
- no current use to Windows clients.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->unix extensions = no</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="UNIXPASSWORDSYNC"
-></A
->unix password sync (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This boolean parameter controls whether Samba
- attempts to synchronize the UNIX password with the SMB password
- when the encrypted SMB password in the smbpasswd file is changed.
- If this is set to <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->yes</TT
-> the program specified in the <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->passwd
- program</I
-></TT
->parameter is called <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->AS ROOT</I
-> -
- to allow the new UNIX password to be set without access to the
- old UNIX password (as the SMB password change code has no
- access to the old password cleartext, only the new).</P
-><P
->See also <A
-HREF="#PASSWDPROGRAM"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->passwd
- program</I
-></TT
-></A
->, <A
-HREF="#PASSWDCHAT"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
-> passwd chat</I
-></TT
-></A
->.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->unix password sync = no</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="UPDATEENCRYPTED"
-></A
->update encrypted (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This boolean parameter allows a user logging
- on with a plaintext password to have their encrypted (hashed)
- password in the smbpasswd file to be updated automatically as
- they log on. This option allows a site to migrate from plaintext
- password authentication (users authenticate with plaintext
- password over the wire, and are checked against a UNIX account
- database) to encrypted password authentication (the SMB
- challenge/response authentication mechanism) without forcing
- all users to re-enter their passwords via smbpasswd at the time the
- change is made. This is a convenience option to allow the change over
- to encrypted passwords to be made over a longer period. Once all users
- have encrypted representations of their passwords in the smbpasswd
- file this parameter should be set to <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->no</TT
->.</P
-><P
->In order for this parameter to work correctly the <A
-HREF="#ENCRYPTPASSWORDS"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->encrypt passwords</I
-></TT
->
- </A
-> parameter must be set to <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->no</TT
-> when
- this parameter is set to <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->yes</TT
->.</P
-><P
->Note that even when this parameter is set a user
- authenticating to <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbd</B
-> must still enter a valid
- password in order to connect correctly, and to update their hashed
- (smbpasswd) passwords.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->update encrypted = no</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="USECLIENTDRIVER"
-></A
->use client driver (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This parameter applies only to Windows NT/2000
- clients. It has no affect on Windows 95/98/ME clients. When
- serving a printer to Windows NT/2000 clients without first installing
- a valid printer driver on the Samba host, the client will be required
- to install a local printer driver. From this point on, the client
- will treat the print as a local printer and not a network printer
- connection. This is much the same behavior that will occur
- when <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->disable spoolss = yes</B
->. </P
-><P
->The differentiating
- factor is that under normal circumstances, the NT/2000 client will
- attempt to open the network printer using MS-RPC. The problem is that
- because the client considers the printer to be local, it will attempt
- to issue the OpenPrinterEx() call requesting access rights associated
- with the logged on user. If the user possesses local administator rights
- but not root privilegde on the Samba host (often the case), the OpenPrinterEx()
- call will fail. The result is that the client will now display an "Access
- Denied; Unable to connect" message in the printer queue window (even though
- jobs may successfully be printed). </P
-><P
->If this parameter is enabled for a printer, then any attempt
- to open the printer with the PRINTER_ACCESS_ADMINISTER right is mapped
- to PRINTER_ACCESS_USE instead. Thus allowing the OpenPrinterEx()
- call to succeed. <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->This parameter MUST not be able enabled
- on a print share which has valid print driver installed on the Samba
- server.</I
-></P
-><P
->See also <A
-HREF="#DISABLESPOOLSS"
->disable spoolss</A
->
- </P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->use client driver = no</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="USEMMAP"
-></A
->use mmap (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This global parameter determines if the tdb internals of Samba can
- depend on mmap working correctly on the running system. Samba requires a coherent
- mmap/read-write system memory cache. Currently only HPUX does not have such a
- coherent cache, and so this parameter is set to <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->no</TT
-> by
- default on HPUX. On all other systems this parameter should be left alone. This
- parameter is provided to help the Samba developers track down problems with
- the tdb internal code.
- </P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->use mmap = yes</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="USERHOSTS"
-></A
->use rhosts (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->If this global parameter is <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->yes</TT
->, it specifies
- that the UNIX user's <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->.rhosts</TT
-> file in their home directory
- will be read to find the names of hosts and users who will be allowed
- access without specifying a password.</P
-><P
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->NOTE:</I
-> The use of <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->use rhosts
- </I
-></TT
-> can be a major security hole. This is because you are
- trusting the PC to supply the correct username. It is very easy to
- get a PC to supply a false username. I recommend that the <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
-> use rhosts</I
-></TT
-> option be only used if you really know what
- you are doing.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->use rhosts = no</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="USER"
-></A
->user (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Synonym for <A
-HREF="#USERNAME"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
-> username</I
-></TT
-></A
->.</P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="USERS"
-></A
->users (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Synonym for <A
-HREF="#USERNAME"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
-> username</I
-></TT
-></A
->.</P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="USERNAME"
-></A
->username (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Multiple users may be specified in a comma-delimited
- list, in which case the supplied password will be tested against
- each username in turn (left to right).</P
-><P
->The <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->username</I
-></TT
-> line is needed only when
- the PC is unable to supply its own username. This is the case
- for the COREPLUS protocol or where your users have different WfWg
- usernames to UNIX usernames. In both these cases you may also be
- better using the \\server\share%user syntax instead.</P
-><P
->The <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->username</I
-></TT
-> line is not a great
- solution in many cases as it means Samba will try to validate
- the supplied password against each of the usernames in the
- <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->username</I
-></TT
-> line in turn. This is slow and
- a bad idea for lots of users in case of duplicate passwords.
- You may get timeouts or security breaches using this parameter
- unwisely.</P
-><P
->Samba relies on the underlying UNIX security. This
- parameter does not restrict who can login, it just offers hints
- to the Samba server as to what usernames might correspond to the
- supplied password. Users can login as whoever they please and
- they will be able to do no more damage than if they started a
- telnet session. The daemon runs as the user that they log in as,
- so they cannot do anything that user cannot do.</P
-><P
->To restrict a service to a particular set of users you
- can use the <A
-HREF="#VALIDUSERS"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->valid users
- </I
-></TT
-></A
-> parameter.</P
-><P
->If any of the usernames begin with a '@' then the name
- will be looked up first in the NIS netgroups list (if Samba
- is compiled with netgroup support), followed by a lookup in
- the UNIX groups database and will expand to a list of all users
- in the group of that name.</P
-><P
->If any of the usernames begin with a '+' then the name
- will be looked up only in the UNIX groups database and will
- expand to a list of all users in the group of that name.</P
-><P
->If any of the usernames begin with a '&#38;'then the name
- will be looked up only in the NIS netgroups database (if Samba
- is compiled with netgroup support) and will expand to a list
- of all users in the netgroup group of that name.</P
-><P
->Note that searching though a groups database can take
- quite some time, and some clients may time out during the
- search.</P
-><P
->See the section <A
-HREF="#AEN238"
->NOTE ABOUT
- USERNAME/PASSWORD VALIDATION</A
-> for more information on how
- this parameter determines access to the services.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->The guest account if a guest service,
- else &#60;empty string&#62;.</B
-></P
-><P
->Examples:<B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->username = fred, mary, jack, jane,
- @users, @pcgroup</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="USERNAMELEVEL"
-></A
->username level (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This option helps Samba to try and 'guess' at
- the real UNIX username, as many DOS clients send an all-uppercase
- username. By default Samba tries all lowercase, followed by the
- username with the first letter capitalized, and fails if the
- username is not found on the UNIX machine.</P
-><P
->If this parameter is set to non-zero the behavior changes.
- This parameter is a number that specifies the number of uppercase
- combinations to try while trying to determine the UNIX user name. The
- higher the number the more combinations will be tried, but the slower
- the discovery of usernames will be. Use this parameter when you have
- strange usernames on your UNIX machine, such as <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->AstrangeUser
- </TT
->.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->username level = 0</B
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->username level = 5</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="USERNAMEMAP"
-></A
->username map (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This option allows you to specify a file containing
- a mapping of usernames from the clients to the server. This can be
- used for several purposes. The most common is to map usernames
- that users use on DOS or Windows machines to those that the UNIX
- box uses. The other is to map multiple users to a single username
- so that they can more easily share files.</P
-><P
->The map file is parsed line by line. Each line should
- contain a single UNIX username on the left then a '=' followed
- by a list of usernames on the right. The list of usernames on the
- right may contain names of the form @group in which case they
- will match any UNIX username in that group. The special client
- name '*' is a wildcard and matches any name. Each line of the
- map file may be up to 1023 characters long.</P
-><P
->The file is processed on each line by taking the
- supplied username and comparing it with each username on the right
- hand side of the '=' signs. If the supplied name matches any of
- the names on the right hand side then it is replaced with the name
- on the left. Processing then continues with the next line.</P
-><P
->If any line begins with a '#' or a ';' then it is
- ignored</P
-><P
->If any line begins with an '!' then the processing
- will stop after that line if a mapping was done by the line.
- Otherwise mapping continues with every line being processed.
- Using '!' is most useful when you have a wildcard mapping line
- later in the file.</P
-><P
->For example to map from the name <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->admin</TT
->
- or <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->administrator</TT
-> to the UNIX name <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
-> root</TT
-> you would use:</P
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->root = admin administrator</B
-></P
-><P
->Or to map anyone in the UNIX group <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->system</TT
->
- to the UNIX name <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->sys</TT
-> you would use:</P
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->sys = @system</B
-></P
-><P
->You can have as many mappings as you like in a username
- map file.</P
-><P
->If your system supports the NIS NETGROUP option then
- the netgroup database is checked before the <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/group
- </TT
-> database for matching groups.</P
-><P
->You can map Windows usernames that have spaces in them
- by using double quotes around the name. For example:</P
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->tridge = "Andrew Tridgell"</B
-></P
-><P
->would map the windows username "Andrew Tridgell" to the
- unix username "tridge".</P
-><P
->The following example would map mary and fred to the
- unix user sys, and map the rest to guest. Note the use of the
- '!' to tell Samba to stop processing if it gets a match on
- that line.</P
-><P
-><TABLE
-BORDER="0"
-BGCOLOR="#E0E0E0"
-WIDTH="90%"
-><TR
-><TD
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
-> !sys = mary fred
- guest = *
- </PRE
-></TD
-></TR
-></TABLE
-></P
-><P
->Note that the remapping is applied to all occurrences
- of usernames. Thus if you connect to \\server\fred and <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
-> fred</TT
-> is remapped to <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->mary</TT
-> then you
- will actually be connecting to \\server\mary and will need to
- supply a password suitable for <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->mary</TT
-> not
- <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->fred</TT
->. The only exception to this is the
- username passed to the <A
-HREF="#PASSWORDSERVER"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
-> password server</I
-></TT
-></A
-> (if you have one). The password
- server will receive whatever username the client supplies without
- modification.</P
-><P
->Also note that no reverse mapping is done. The main effect
- this has is with printing. Users who have been mapped may have
- trouble deleting print jobs as PrintManager under WfWg will think
- they don't own the print job.</P
-><P
->Default: <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->no username map</I
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->username map = /usr/local/samba/lib/users.map
- </B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="USESENDFILE"
-></A
->use sendfile (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->If this parameter is <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->yes</TT
->, and Samba
- was built with the --with-sendfile-support option, and the underlying operating
- system supports sendfile system call, then some SMB read calls (mainly ReadAndX
- and ReadRaw) will use the more efficient sendfile system call for files that
- are exclusively oplocked. This may make more efficient use of the system CPU's
- and cause Samba to be faster. This is off by default as it's effects are unknown
- as yet.
- </P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->use sendfile = no</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="UTMP"
-></A
->utmp (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This boolean parameter is only available if
- Samba has been configured and compiled with the option <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
-> --with-utmp</B
->. If set to <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->yes</TT
-> then Samba will attempt
- to add utmp or utmpx records (depending on the UNIX system) whenever a
- connection is made to a Samba server. Sites may use this to record the
- user connecting to a Samba share.</P
-><P
->Due to the requirements of the utmp record, we
- are required to create a unique identifier for the
- incoming user. Enabling this option creates an n^2
- algorithm to find this number. This may impede
- performance on large installations. </P
-><P
->See also the <A
-HREF="#UTMPDIRECTORY"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
-> utmp directory</I
-></TT
-></A
-> parameter.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->utmp = no</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="UTMPDIRECTORY"
-></A
->utmp directory(G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This parameter is only available if Samba has
- been configured and compiled with the option <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
-> --with-utmp</B
->. It specifies a directory pathname that is
- used to store the utmp or utmpx files (depending on the UNIX system) that
- record user connections to a Samba server. See also the <A
-HREF="#UTMP"
-> <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->utmp</I
-></TT
-></A
-> parameter. By default this is
- not set, meaning the system will use whatever utmp file the
- native system is set to use (usually
- <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/var/run/utmp</TT
-> on Linux).</P
-><P
->Default: <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->no utmp directory</I
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->utmp directory = /var/run/utmp</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="WTMPDIRECTORY"
-></A
->wtmp directory(G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This parameter is only available if Samba has
- been configured and compiled with the option <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
-> --with-utmp</B
->. It specifies a directory pathname that is
- used to store the wtmp or wtmpx files (depending on the UNIX system) that
- record user connections to a Samba server. The difference with
- the utmp directory is the fact that user info is kept after a user
- has logged out.
-
- See also the <A
-HREF="#UTMP"
-> <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->utmp</I
-></TT
-></A
-> parameter. By default this is
- not set, meaning the system will use whatever utmp file the
- native system is set to use (usually
- <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/var/run/wtmp</TT
-> on Linux).</P
-><P
->Default: <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->no wtmp directory</I
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->wtmp directory = /var/log/wtmp</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="VALIDUSERS"
-></A
->valid users (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This is a list of users that should be allowed
- to login to this service. Names starting with '@', '+' and '&#38;'
- are interpreted using the same rules as described in the
- <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->invalid users</I
-></TT
-> parameter.</P
-><P
->If this is empty (the default) then any user can login.
- If a username is in both this list and the <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->invalid
- users</I
-></TT
-> list then access is denied for that user.</P
-><P
->The current servicename is substituted for <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->%S
- </I
-></TT
->. This is useful in the [homes] section.</P
-><P
->See also <A
-HREF="#INVALIDUSERS"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->invalid users
- </I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-><P
->Default: <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->No valid users list (anyone can login)
- </I
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->valid users = greg, @pcusers</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="VETOFILES"
-></A
->veto files(S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This is a list of files and directories that
- are neither visible nor accessible. Each entry in the list must
- be separated by a '/', which allows spaces to be included
- in the entry. '*' and '?' can be used to specify multiple files
- or directories as in DOS wildcards.</P
-><P
->Each entry must be a unix path, not a DOS path and
- must <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->not</I
-> include the unix directory
- separator '/'.</P
-><P
->Note that the <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->case sensitive</I
-></TT
-> option
- is applicable in vetoing files.</P
-><P
->One feature of the veto files parameter that it
- is important to be aware of is Samba's behaviour when
- trying to delete a directory. If a directory that is
- to be deleted contains nothing but veto files this
- deletion will <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->fail</I
-> unless you also set
- the <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->delete veto files</I
-></TT
-> parameter to
- <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->yes</I
-></TT
->.</P
-><P
->Setting this parameter will affect the performance
- of Samba, as it will be forced to check all files and directories
- for a match as they are scanned.</P
-><P
->See also <A
-HREF="#HIDEFILES"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->hide files
- </I
-></TT
-></A
-> and <A
-HREF="#CASESENSITIVE"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
-> case sensitive</I
-></TT
-></A
->.</P
-><P
->Default: <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->No files or directories are vetoed.
- </I
-></P
-><P
->Examples:<TABLE
-BORDER="0"
-BGCOLOR="#E0E0E0"
-WIDTH="90%"
-><TR
-><TD
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
->; Veto any files containing the word Security,
-; any ending in .tmp, and any directory containing the
-; word root.
-veto files = /*Security*/*.tmp/*root*/
-
-; Veto the Apple specific files that a NetAtalk server
-; creates.
-veto files = /.AppleDouble/.bin/.AppleDesktop/Network Trash Folder/</PRE
-></TD
-></TR
-></TABLE
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="VETOOPLOCKFILES"
-></A
->veto oplock files (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This parameter is only valid when the <A
-HREF="#OPLOCKS"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->oplocks</I
-></TT
-></A
->
- parameter is turned on for a share. It allows the Samba administrator
- to selectively turn off the granting of oplocks on selected files that
- match a wildcarded list, similar to the wildcarded list used in the
- <A
-HREF="#VETOFILES"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->veto files</I
-></TT
-></A
->
- parameter.</P
-><P
->Default: <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->No files are vetoed for oplock
- grants</I
-></P
-><P
->You might want to do this on files that you know will
- be heavily contended for by clients. A good example of this
- is in the NetBench SMB benchmark program, which causes heavy
- client contention for files ending in <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->.SEM</TT
->.
- To cause Samba not to grant oplocks on these files you would use
- the line (either in the [global] section or in the section for
- the particular NetBench share :</P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->veto oplock files = /*.SEM/
- </B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="VFSPATH"
-></A
->vfs path (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This parameter specifies the directory
- to look in for vfs modules. The name of every <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->vfs object
- </B
-> will be prepended by this directory
- </P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->vfs path = </B
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->vfs path = /usr/lib/samba/vfs</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="VFSOBJECT"
-></A
->vfs object (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This parameter specifies a shared object files that
- are used for Samba VFS I/O operations. By default, normal
- disk I/O operations are used but these can be overloaded
- with one or more VFS objects. </P
-><P
->Default : <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->no value</I
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="VFSOPTIONS"
-></A
->vfs options (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This parameter allows parameters to be passed
- to the vfs layer at initialization time.
- See also <A
-HREF="#VFSOBJECT"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
-> vfs object</I
-></TT
-></A
->.</P
-><P
->Default : <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->no value</I
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="VOLUME"
-></A
->volume (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
-> This allows you to override the volume label
- returned for a share. Useful for CDROMs with installation programs
- that insist on a particular volume label.</P
-><P
->Default: <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->the name of the share</I
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="WIDELINKS"
-></A
->wide links (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This parameter controls whether or not links
- in the UNIX file system may be followed by the server. Links
- that point to areas within the directory tree exported by the
- server are always allowed; this parameter controls access only
- to areas that are outside the directory tree being exported.</P
-><P
->Note that setting this parameter can have a negative
- effect on your server performance due to the extra system calls
- that Samba has to do in order to perform the link checks.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->wide links = yes</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="WINBINDCACHETIME"
-></A
->winbind cache time (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This parameter specifies the number of seconds the
- <A
-HREF="winbindd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
->winbindd(8)</A
-> daemon will cache
- user and group information before querying a Windows NT server
- again.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->winbind cache type = 15</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="WINBINDENUMUSERS"
-></A
->winbind enum users (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->On large installations using
- <A
-HREF="winbindd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
->winbindd(8)</A
-> it may be
- necessary to suppress the enumeration of users through the
- <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
-> setpwent()</B
->,
- <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->getpwent()</B
-> and
- <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->endpwent()</B
-> group of system calls. If
- the <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->winbind enum users</I
-></TT
-> parameter is
- <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->no</TT
->, calls to the <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->getpwent</B
-> system call
- will not return any data. </P
-><P
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->Warning:</I
-> Turning off user
- enumeration may cause some programs to behave oddly. For
- example, the finger program relies on having access to the
- full user list when searching for matching
- usernames. </P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->winbind enum users = yes </B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="WINBINDENUMGROUPS"
-></A
->winbind enum groups (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->On large installations using
- <A
-HREF="winbindd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
->winbindd(8)</A
-> it may be
- necessary to suppress the enumeration of groups through the
- <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
-> setgrent()</B
->,
- <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->getgrent()</B
-> and
- <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->endgrent()</B
-> group of system calls. If
- the <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->winbind enum groups</I
-></TT
-> parameter is
- <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->no</TT
->, calls to the <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->getgrent()</B
-> system
- call will not return any data. </P
-><P
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->Warning:</I
-> Turning off group
- enumeration may cause some programs to behave oddly.
- </P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->winbind enum groups = yes </B
->
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="WINBINDGID"
-></A
->winbind gid (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->The winbind gid parameter specifies the range of group
- ids that are allocated by the <A
-HREF="winbindd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-> winbindd(8)</A
-> daemon. This range of group ids should have no
- existing local or NIS groups within it as strange conflicts can
- occur otherwise.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->winbind gid = &#60;empty string&#62;
- </B
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->winbind gid = 10000-20000</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="WINBINDSEPARATOR"
-></A
->winbind separator (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This parameter allows an admin to define the character
- used when listing a username of the form of <TT
-CLASS="REPLACEABLE"
-><I
->DOMAIN
- </I
-></TT
->\<TT
-CLASS="REPLACEABLE"
-><I
->user</I
-></TT
->. This parameter
- is only applicable when using the <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->pam_winbind.so</TT
->
- and <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->nss_winbind.so</TT
-> modules for UNIX services.
- </P
-><P
->Please note that setting this parameter to + causes problems
- with group membership at least on glibc systems, as the character +
- is used as a special character for NIS in /etc/group.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->winbind separator = '\'</B
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->winbind separator = +</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="WINBINDUID"
-></A
->winbind uid (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->The winbind gid parameter specifies the range of group
- ids that are allocated by the <A
-HREF="winbindd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-> winbindd(8)</A
-> daemon. This range of ids should have no
- existing local or NIS users within it as strange conflicts can
- occur otherwise.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->winbind uid = &#60;empty string&#62;
- </B
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->winbind uid = 10000-20000</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
->winbind use default domain, <A
-NAME="WINBINDUSEDEFAULTDOMAIN"
-></A
->winbind use default domain (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This parameter specifies whether the <A
-HREF="winbindd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-> winbindd(8)</A
->
- daemon should operate on users without domain component in their username.
- Users without a domain component are treated as is part of the winbindd server's
- own domain. While this does not benifit Windows users, it makes SSH, FTP and e-mail
- function in a way much closer to the way they would in a native unix system.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->winbind use default domain = &#60;no&#62;
- </B
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->winbind use default domain = yes</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="WINSHOOK"
-></A
->wins hook (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->When Samba is running as a WINS server this
- allows you to call an external program for all changes to the
- WINS database. The primary use for this option is to allow the
- dynamic update of external name resolution databases such as
- dynamic DNS.</P
-><P
->The wins hook parameter specifies the name of a script
- or executable that will be called as follows:</P
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->wins_hook operation name nametype ttl IP_list
- </B
-></P
-><P
-></P
-><UL
-><LI
-><P
->The first argument is the operation and is one
- of "add", "delete", or "refresh". In most cases the operation can
- be ignored as the rest of the parameters provide sufficient
- information. Note that "refresh" may sometimes be called when the
- name has not previously been added, in that case it should be treated
- as an add.</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->The second argument is the NetBIOS name. If the
- name is not a legal name then the wins hook is not called.
- Legal names contain only letters, digits, hyphens, underscores
- and periods.</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->The third argument is the NetBIOS name
- type as a 2 digit hexadecimal number. </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->The fourth argument is the TTL (time to live)
- for the name in seconds.</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->The fifth and subsequent arguments are the IP
- addresses currently registered for that name. If this list is
- empty then the name should be deleted.</P
-></LI
-></UL
-><P
->An example script that calls the BIND dynamic DNS update
- program <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->nsupdate</B
-> is provided in the examples
- directory of the Samba source code. </P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="WINSPROXY"
-></A
->wins proxy (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This is a boolean that controls if <A
-HREF="nmbd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
->nmbd(8)</A
-> will respond to broadcast name
- queries on behalf of other hosts. You may need to set this
- to <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->yes</TT
-> for some older clients.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->wins proxy = no</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="WINSSERVER"
-></A
->wins server (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This specifies the IP address (or DNS name: IP
- address for preference) of the WINS server that <A
-HREF="nmbd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-> nmbd(8)</A
-> should register with. If you have a WINS server on
- your network then you should set this to the WINS server's IP.</P
-><P
->You should point this at your WINS server if you have a
- multi-subnetted network.</P
-><P
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->NOTE</I
->. You need to set up Samba to point
- to a WINS server if you have multiple subnets and wish cross-subnet
- browsing to work correctly.</P
-><P
->See the documentation file <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->BROWSING.txt</TT
->
- in the docs/ directory of your Samba source distribution.</P
-><P
->Default: <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->not enabled</I
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->wins server = 192.9.200.1</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="WINSSUPPORT"
-></A
->wins support (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This boolean controls if the <A
-HREF="nmbd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
->
- nmbd(8)</A
-> process in Samba will act as a WINS server. You should
- not set this to <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->yes</TT
-> unless you have a multi-subnetted network and
- you wish a particular <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->nmbd</B
-> to be your WINS server.
- Note that you should <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->NEVER</I
-> set this to <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->yes</TT
->
- on more than one machine in your network.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->wins support = no</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="WORKGROUP"
-></A
->workgroup (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This controls what workgroup your server will
- appear to be in when queried by clients. Note that this parameter
- also controls the Domain name used with the <A
-HREF="#SECURITYEQUALSDOMAIN"
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->security = domain</B
-></A
->
- setting.</P
-><P
->Default: <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->set at compile time to WORKGROUP</I
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->workgroup = MYGROUP</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="WRITABLE"
-></A
->writable (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Synonym for <A
-HREF="#WRITEABLE"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
-> writeable</I
-></TT
-></A
-> for people who can't spell :-).</P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="WRITECACHESIZE"
-></A
->write cache size (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->If this integer parameter is set to non-zero value,
- Samba will create an in-memory cache for each oplocked file
- (it does <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->not</I
-> do this for
- non-oplocked files). All writes that the client does not request
- to be flushed directly to disk will be stored in this cache if possible.
- The cache is flushed onto disk when a write comes in whose offset
- would not fit into the cache or when the file is closed by the client.
- Reads for the file are also served from this cache if the data is stored
- within it.</P
-><P
->This cache allows Samba to batch client writes into a more
- efficient write size for RAID disks (i.e. writes may be tuned to
- be the RAID stripe size) and can improve performance on systems
- where the disk subsystem is a bottleneck but there is free
- memory for userspace programs.</P
-><P
->The integer parameter specifies the size of this cache
- (per oplocked file) in bytes.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->write cache size = 0</B
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->write cache size = 262144</B
-></P
-><P
->for a 256k cache size per file.</P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="WRITELIST"
-></A
->write list (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This is a list of users that are given read-write
- access to a service. If the connecting user is in this list then
- they will be given write access, no matter what the <A
-HREF="#READONLY"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->read only</I
-></TT
-></A
->
- option is set to. The list can include group names using the
- @group syntax.</P
-><P
->Note that if a user is in both the read list and the
- write list then they will be given write access.</P
-><P
->See also the <A
-HREF="#READLIST"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->read list
- </I
-></TT
-></A
-> option.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->write list = &#60;empty string&#62;
- </B
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->write list = admin, root, @staff
- </B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="WINSPARTNERS"
-></A
->wins partners (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->A space separated list of partners' IP addresses for
- WINS replication. WINS partners are always defined as push/pull
- partners as defining only one way WINS replication is unreliable.
- WINS replication is currently experimental and unreliable between
- samba servers.
- </P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->wins partners = </B
-></P
-><P
->Example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->wins partners = 192.168.0.1 172.16.1.2</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="WRITEOK"
-></A
->write ok (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Inverted synonym for <A
-HREF="#READONLY"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
-> read only</I
-></TT
-></A
->.</P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="WRITERAW"
-></A
->write raw (G)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This parameter controls whether or not the server
- will support raw write SMB's when transferring data from clients.
- You should never need to change this parameter.</P
-><P
->Default: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->write raw = yes</B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
-><A
-NAME="WRITEABLE"
-></A
->writeable (S)</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Inverted synonym for <A
-HREF="#READONLY"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
-> read only</I
-></TT
-></A
->.</P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN6215"
-></A
-><H2
->WARNINGS</H2
-><P
->Although the configuration file permits service names
+ the group of the same name.</p></li><li><p>If the service is a guest service then a
+ connection is made as the username given in the &quot;guest
+ account =&quot; for the service, irrespective of the
+ supplied password.</p></li></ol></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>COMPLETE LIST OF GLOBAL PARAMETERS</h2><p>Here is a list of all global parameters. See the section of
+ each parameter for details. Note that some are synonyms.</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"></ul></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>COMPLETE LIST OF SERVICE PARAMETERS</h2><p>Here is a list of all service parameters. See the section on
+ each parameter for details. Note that some are synonyms.</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"></ul></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>EXPLANATION OF EACH PARAMETER</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>WARNINGS</h2><p>Although the configuration file permits service names
to contain spaces, your client software may not. Spaces will
be ignored in comparisons anyway, so it shouldn't be a
- problem - but be aware of the possibility.</P
-><P
->On a similar note, many clients - especially DOS clients -
- limit service names to eight characters. <A
-HREF="smbd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
->smbd(8)
- </A
-> has no such limitation, but attempts to connect from such
+ problem - but be aware of the possibility.</p><p>On a similar note, many clients - especially DOS clients -
+ limit service names to eight characters. <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> has no such limitation, but attempts to connect from such
clients will fail if they truncate the service names. For this reason
you should probably keep your service names down to eight characters
- in length.</P
-><P
->Use of the [homes] and [printers] special sections make life
+ in length.</p><p>Use of the [homes] and [printers] special sections make life
for an administrator easy, but the various combinations of default
attributes can be tricky. Take extreme care when designing these
sections. In particular, ensure that the permissions on spool
- directories are correct.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN6221"
-></A
-><H2
->VERSION</H2
-><P
->This man page is correct for version 3.0 of
- the Samba suite.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN6224"
-></A
-><H2
->SEE ALSO</H2
-><P
-><A
-HREF="samba.7.html"
-TARGET="_top"
->samba(7)</A
->,
- <A
-HREF="smbpasswd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbpasswd(8)</B
-></A
->,
- <A
-HREF="swat.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->swat(8)</B
-></A
->,
- <A
-HREF="smbd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbd(8)</B
-></A
->,
- <A
-HREF="nmbd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->nmbd(8)</B
-></A
->,
- <A
-HREF="smbclient.1.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbclient(1)</B
-></A
->,
- <A
-HREF="nmblookup.1.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->nmblookup(1)</B
-></A
->,
- <A
-HREF="testparm.1.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->testparm(1)</B
-></A
->,
- <A
-HREF="testprns.1.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->testprns(1)</B
-></A
->
- </P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN6244"
-></A
-><H2
->AUTHOR</H2
-><P
->The original Samba software and related utilities
+ directories are correct.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3.0 of the Samba suite.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>SEE ALSO</h2><p>
+ <a href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a>, <a href="smbpasswd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbpasswd</span>(8)</span></a>, <a href="swat.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">swat</span>(8)</span></a>, <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a>, <a href="nmbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">nmbd</span>(8)</span></a>, <a href="smbclient.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbclient</span>(1)</span></a>, <a href="nmblookup.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">nmblookup</span>(1)</span></a>, <a href="testparm.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">testparm</span>(1)</span></a>, <a href="testprns.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">testprns</span>(1)</span></a>.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
- to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</P
-><P
->The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer.
+ to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</p><p>The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer.
The man page sources were converted to YODL format (another
- excellent piece of Open Source software, available at
- <A
-HREF="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/"
-TARGET="_top"
-> ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/</A
->) and updated for the Samba 2.0
+ excellent piece of Open Source software, available at <a href="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/" target="_top">
+ ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/</a>) and updated for the Samba 2.0
release by Jeremy Allison. The conversion to DocBook for
- Samba 2.2 was done by Gerald Carter</P
-></DIV
-></BODY
-></HTML
-> \ No newline at end of file
+ Samba 2.2 was done by Gerald Carter. The conversion to DocBook XML 4.2
+ for Samba 3.0 was done by Alexander Bokovoy.</p></div></div></body></html>
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/smbcacls.1.html b/docs/htmldocs/smbcacls.1.html
index e0425d481d..d7c5fed1b5 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/smbcacls.1.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/smbcacls.1.html
@@ -1,415 +1,95 @@
-<!DOCTYPE HTML PUBLIC "-//W3C//DTD HTML 4.01 Transitional//EN">
-<HTML
-><HEAD
-><TITLE
->smbcacls</TITLE
-><META
-NAME="GENERATOR"
-CONTENT="Modular DocBook HTML Stylesheet Version 1.77"></HEAD
-><BODY
-CLASS="REFENTRY"
-BGCOLOR="#FFFFFF"
-TEXT="#000000"
-LINK="#0000FF"
-VLINK="#840084"
-ALINK="#0000FF"
-><H1
-><A
-NAME="SMBCACLS"
-></A
->smbcacls</H1
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFNAMEDIV"
-><A
-NAME="AEN5"
-></A
-><H2
->Name</H2
->smbcacls&nbsp;--&nbsp;Set or get ACLs on an NT file or directory names</DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSYNOPSISDIV"
-><A
-NAME="AEN8"
-></A
-><H2
->Synopsis</H2
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbcacls</B
-> {//server/share} {filename} [-U username] [-A acls] [-M acls] [-D acls] [-S acls] [-C name] [-G name] [-n] [-h]</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN22"
-></A
-><H2
->DESCRIPTION</H2
-><P
->This tool is part of the <A
-HREF="samba.7.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-> Samba</A
-> suite.</P
-><P
->The <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbcacls</B
-> program manipulates NT Access Control
- Lists (ACLs) on SMB file shares. </P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN28"
-></A
-><H2
->OPTIONS</H2
-><P
->The following options are available to the <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbcacls</B
-> program.
- The format of ACLs is described in the section ACL FORMAT </P
-><P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
->-A acls</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Add the ACLs specified to the ACL list. Existing
- access control entries are unchanged. </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-M acls</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Modify the mask value (permissions) for the ACLs
+<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>smbcacls</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="smbcacls.1"></a><div class="titlepage"><div></div><div></div></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>smbcacls &#8212; Set or get ACLs on an NT file or directory names</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><tt class="command">smbcacls</tt> {//server/share} {filename} [-D acls] [-M acls] [-A acls] [-S acls] [-C name] [-G name] [-n] [-t] [-U username] [-h] [-d]</p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This tool is part of the <a href="Samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">Samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p>The <b class="command">smbcacls</b> program manipulates NT Access Control
+ Lists (ACLs) on SMB file shares. </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>OPTIONS</h2><p>The following options are available to the <b class="command">smbcacls</b> program.
+ The format of ACLs is described in the section ACL FORMAT </p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">-A acls</span></dt><dd><p>Add the ACLs specified to the ACL list. Existing
+ access control entries are unchanged. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-M acls</span></dt><dd><p>Modify the mask value (permissions) for the ACLs
specified on the command line. An error will be printed for each
ACL specified that was not already present in the ACL list
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-D acls</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Delete any ACLs specified on the command line.
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-D acls</span></dt><dd><p>Delete any ACLs specified on the command line.
An error will be printed for each ACL specified that was not
- already present in the ACL list. </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-S acls</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This command sets the ACLs on the file with
+ already present in the ACL list. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-S acls</span></dt><dd><p>This command sets the ACLs on the file with
only the ones specified on the command line. All other ACLs are
erased. Note that the ACL specified must contain at least a revision,
- type, owner and group for the call to succeed. </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-U username</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Specifies a username used to connect to the
- specified service. The username may be of the form "username" in
+ type, owner and group for the call to succeed. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-U username</span></dt><dd><p>Specifies a username used to connect to the
+ specified service. The username may be of the form &quot;username&quot; in
which case the user is prompted to enter in a password and the
- workgroup specified in the <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->smb.conf</TT
-> file is
- used, or "username%password" or "DOMAIN\username%password" and the
- password and workgroup names are used as provided. </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-C name</DT
-><DD
-><P
->The owner of a file or directory can be changed
- to the name given using the <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->-C</I
-></TT
-> option.
+ workgroup specified in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> file is
+ used, or &quot;username%password&quot; or &quot;DOMAIN\username%password&quot; and the
+ password and workgroup names are used as provided. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-C name</span></dt><dd><p>The owner of a file or directory can be changed
+ to the name given using the <i class="parameter"><tt>-C</tt></i> option.
The name can be a sid in the form S-1-x-y-z or a name resolved
- against the server specified in the first argument. </P
-><P
->This command is a shortcut for -M OWNER:name.
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-G name</DT
-><DD
-><P
->The group owner of a file or directory can
- be changed to the name given using the <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->-G</I
-></TT
->
+ against the server specified in the first argument. </p><p>This command is a shortcut for -M OWNER:name.
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-G name</span></dt><dd><p>The group owner of a file or directory can
+ be changed to the name given using the <i class="parameter"><tt>-G</tt></i>
option. The name can be a sid in the form S-1-x-y-z or a name
resolved against the server specified n the first argument.
- </P
-><P
->This command is a shortcut for -M GROUP:name.</P
-></DD
-><DT
->-n</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This option displays all ACL information in numeric
+ </p><p>This command is a shortcut for -M GROUP:name.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-n</span></dt><dd><p>This option displays all ACL information in numeric
format. The default is to convert SIDs to names and ACE types
- and masks to a readable string format. </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-h</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Print usage information on the <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbcacls
- </B
-> program.</P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN75"
-></A
-><H2
->ACL FORMAT</H2
-><P
->The format of an ACL is one or more ACL entries separated by
- either commas or newlines. An ACL entry is one of the following: </P
-><P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
->
+ and masks to a readable string format. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-t</span></dt><dd><p>
+ Don't actually do anything, only validate the correctness of
+ the arguments.
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-h|--help</span></dt><dd><p>Print a summary of command line options.
+</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-V</span></dt><dd><p>Prints the version number for
+<b class="command">smbd</b>.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-s &lt;configuration file&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>The file specified contains the
+configuration details required by the server. The
+information in this file includes server-specific
+information such as what printcap file to use, as well
+as descriptions of all the services that the server is
+to provide. See <a href="smb.conf.5.html" target="_top"><tt class="filename">
+smb.conf(5)</tt></a> for more information.
+The default configuration file name is determined at
+compile time.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-d|--debug=debuglevel</span></dt><dd><p><i class="replaceable"><tt>debuglevel</tt></i> is an integer
+from 0 to 10. The default value if this parameter is
+not specified is zero.</p><p>The higher this value, the more detail will be
+logged to the log files about the activities of the
+server. At level 0, only critical errors and serious
+warnings will be logged. Level 1 is a reasonable level for
+day to day running - it generates a small amount of
+information about operations carried out.</p><p>Levels above 1 will generate considerable
+amounts of log data, and should only be used when
+investigating a problem. Levels above 3 are designed for
+use only by developers and generate HUGE amounts of log
+data, most of which is extremely cryptic.</p><p>Note that specifying this parameter here will
+override the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#loglevel" target="_top">log
+level</a> parameter in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html" target="_top">
+<tt class="filename">smb.conf(5)</tt></a> file.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-l|--logfile=logbasename</span></dt><dd><p>File name for log/debug files. The extension
+<tt class="constant">&quot;.client&quot;</tt> will be appended. The log file is
+never removed by the client.
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>ACL FORMAT</h2><p>The format of an ACL is one or more ACL entries separated by
+ either commas or newlines. An ACL entry is one of the following: </p><pre class="programlisting">
REVISION:&lt;revision number&gt;
OWNER:&lt;sid or name&gt;
GROUP:&lt;sid or name&gt;
ACL:&lt;sid or name&gt;:&lt;type&gt;/&lt;flags&gt;/&lt;mask&gt;
- </PRE
-></P
-><P
->The revision of the ACL specifies the internal Windows
+</pre><p>The revision of the ACL specifies the internal Windows
NT ACL revision for the security descriptor.
If not specified it defaults to 1. Using values other than 1 may
- cause strange behaviour. </P
-><P
->The owner and group specify the owner and group sids for the
+ cause strange behaviour. </p><p>The owner and group specify the owner and group sids for the
object. If a SID in the format CWS-1-x-y-z is specified this is used,
otherwise the name specified is resolved using the server on which
- the file or directory resides. </P
-><P
->ACLs specify permissions granted to the SID. This SID again
- can be specified in CWS-1-x-y-z format or as a name in which case
- it is resolved against the server on which the file or directory
- resides. The type, flags and mask values determine the type of
- access granted to the SID. </P
-><P
->The type can be either 0 or 1 corresponding to ALLOWED or
- DENIED access to the SID. The flags values are generally
- zero for file ACLs and either 9 or 2 for directory ACLs. Some
- common flags are: </P
-><P
-></P
-><UL
-><LI
-><P
->#define SEC_ACE_FLAG_OBJECT_INHERIT 0x1</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->#define SEC_ACE_FLAG_CONTAINER_INHERIT 0x2</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->#define SEC_ACE_FLAG_NO_PROPAGATE_INHERIT 0x4
- </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->#define SEC_ACE_FLAG_INHERIT_ONLY 0x8</P
-></LI
-></UL
-><P
->At present flags can only be specified as decimal or
- hexadecimal values.</P
-><P
->The mask is a value which expresses the access right
+ the file or directory resides. </p><p>ACLs specify permissions granted to the SID. This SID again
+ can be specified in CWS-1-x-y-z format or as a name in which case
+ it is resolved against the server on which the file or directory
+ resides. The type, flags and mask values determine the type of
+ access granted to the SID. </p><p>The type can be either 0 or 1 corresponding to ALLOWED or
+ DENIED access to the SID. The flags values are generally
+ zero for file ACLs and either 9 or 2 for directory ACLs. Some
+ common flags are: </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><tt class="constant">#define SEC_ACE_FLAG_OBJECT_INHERIT 0x1</tt></p></li><li><p><tt class="constant">#define SEC_ACE_FLAG_CONTAINER_INHERIT 0x2</tt></p></li><li><p><tt class="constant">#define SEC_ACE_FLAG_NO_PROPAGATE_INHERIT 0x4</tt></p></li><li><p><tt class="constant">#define SEC_ACE_FLAG_INHERIT_ONLY 0x8</tt></p></li></ul></div><p>At present flags can only be specified as decimal or
+ hexadecimal values.</p><p>The mask is a value which expresses the access right
granted to the SID. It can be given as a decimal or hexadecimal value,
or by using one of the following text strings which map to the NT
- file permissions of the same name. </P
-><P
-></P
-><UL
-><LI
-><P
-><SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->R</I
-></SPAN
-> - Allow read access </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->W</I
-></SPAN
-> - Allow write access</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->X</I
-></SPAN
-> - Execute permission on the object</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->D</I
-></SPAN
-> - Delete the object</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->P</I
-></SPAN
-> - Change permissions</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->O</I
-></SPAN
-> - Take ownership</P
-></LI
-></UL
-><P
->The following combined permissions can be specified:</P
-><P
-></P
-><UL
-><LI
-><P
-><SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->READ</I
-></SPAN
-> - Equivalent to 'RX'
- permissions</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->CHANGE</I
-></SPAN
-> - Equivalent to 'RXWD' permissions
- </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->FULL</I
-></SPAN
-> - Equivalent to 'RWXDPO'
- permissions</P
-></LI
-></UL
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN125"
-></A
-><H2
->EXIT STATUS</H2
-><P
->The <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbcacls</B
-> program sets the exit status
+ file permissions of the same name. </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><span class="emphasis"><em>R</em></span> - Allow read access </p></li><li><p><span class="emphasis"><em>W</em></span> - Allow write access</p></li><li><p><span class="emphasis"><em>X</em></span> - Execute permission on the object</p></li><li><p><span class="emphasis"><em>D</em></span> - Delete the object</p></li><li><p><span class="emphasis"><em>P</em></span> - Change permissions</p></li><li><p><span class="emphasis"><em>O</em></span> - Take ownership</p></li></ul></div><p>The following combined permissions can be specified:</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><span class="emphasis"><em>READ</em></span> - Equivalent to 'RX'
+ permissions</p></li><li><p><span class="emphasis"><em>CHANGE</em></span> - Equivalent to 'RXWD' permissions
+ </p></li><li><p><span class="emphasis"><em>FULL</em></span> - Equivalent to 'RWXDPO'
+ permissions</p></li></ul></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>EXIT STATUS</h2><p>The <b class="command">smbcacls</b> program sets the exit status
depending on the success or otherwise of the operations performed.
- The exit status may be one of the following values. </P
-><P
->If the operation succeeded, smbcacls returns and exit
- status of 0. If <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbcacls</B
-> couldn't connect to the specified server,
+ The exit status may be one of the following values. </p><p>If the operation succeeded, smbcacls returns and exit
+ status of 0. If <b class="command">smbcacls</b> couldn't connect to the specified server,
or there was an error getting or setting the ACLs, an exit status
of 1 is returned. If there was an error parsing any command line
- arguments, an exit status of 2 is returned. </P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN131"
-></A
-><H2
->VERSION</H2
-><P
->This man page is correct for version 2.2 of
- the Samba suite.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN134"
-></A
-><H2
->AUTHOR</H2
-><P
->The original Samba software and related utilities
+ arguments, an exit status of 2 is returned. </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3.0 of the Samba suite.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
- to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</P
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbcacls</B
-> was written by Andrew Tridgell
- and Tim Potter.</P
-><P
->The conversion to DocBook for Samba 2.2 was done
- by Gerald Carter</P
-></DIV
-></BODY
-></HTML
-> \ No newline at end of file
+ to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</p><p><b class="command">smbcacls</b> was written by Andrew Tridgell
+ and Tim Potter.</p><p>The conversion to DocBook for Samba 2.2 was done
+ by Gerald Carter. The conversion to DocBook XML 4.2 for Samba 3.0 was done
+ by Alexander Bokovoy.</p></div></div></body></html>
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/smbclient.1.html b/docs/htmldocs/smbclient.1.html
index ca8cafd312..ecb85d6e85 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/smbclient.1.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/smbclient.1.html
@@ -1,1645 +1,424 @@
-<!DOCTYPE HTML PUBLIC "-//W3C//DTD HTML 4.01 Transitional//EN">
-<HTML
-><HEAD
-><TITLE
->smbclient</TITLE
-><META
-NAME="GENERATOR"
-CONTENT="Modular DocBook HTML Stylesheet Version 1.77"></HEAD
-><BODY
-CLASS="REFENTRY"
-BGCOLOR="#FFFFFF"
-TEXT="#000000"
-LINK="#0000FF"
-VLINK="#840084"
-ALINK="#0000FF"
-><H1
-><A
-NAME="SMBCLIENT"
-></A
->smbclient</H1
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFNAMEDIV"
-><A
-NAME="AEN5"
-></A
-><H2
->Name</H2
->smbclient&nbsp;--&nbsp;ftp-like client to access SMB/CIFS resources
- on servers</DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSYNOPSISDIV"
-><A
-NAME="AEN8"
-></A
-><H2
->Synopsis</H2
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbclient</B
-> {servicename} [password] [-b &lt;buffer size&gt;] [-d debuglevel] [-D Directory] [-U username] [-W workgroup] [-M &lt;netbios name&gt;] [-m maxprotocol] [-A authfile] [-N] [-l logfile] [-L &lt;netbios name&gt;] [-I destinationIP] [-E] [-c &lt;command string&gt;] [-i scope] [-O &lt;socket options&gt;] [-p port] [-R &lt;name resolve order&gt;] [-s &lt;smb config file&gt;] [-T&lt;c|x&gt;IXFqgbNan]</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN33"
-></A
-><H2
->DESCRIPTION</H2
-><P
->This tool is part of the <A
-HREF="samba.7.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-> Samba</A
-> suite.</P
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbclient</B
-> is a client that can
+<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>smbclient</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="smbclient.1"></a><div class="titlepage"><div></div><div></div></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>smbclient &#8212; ftp-like client to access SMB/CIFS resources
+ on servers</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><tt class="command">smbclient</tt> {servicename} [password] [-b &lt;buffer size&gt;] [-d debuglevel] [-D Directory] [-U username] [-W workgroup] [-M &lt;netbios name&gt;] [-m maxprotocol] [-A authfile] [-N] [-l logfile] [-L &lt;netbios name&gt;] [-I destinationIP] [-E] [-c &lt;command string&gt;] [-i scope] [-O &lt;socket options&gt;] [-p port] [-R &lt;name resolve order&gt;] [-s &lt;smb config file&gt;] [-T&lt;c|x&gt;IXFqgbNan] [-k]</p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This tool is part of the <a href="Samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">Samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p><b class="command">smbclient</b> is a client that can
'talk' to an SMB/CIFS server. It offers an interface
- similar to that of the ftp program (see <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->ftp(1)</B
->).
+ similar to that of the ftp program (see <a href="ftp.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">ftp</span>(1)</span></a>).
Operations include things like getting files from the server
to the local machine, putting files from the local machine to
the server, retrieving directory information from the server
- and so on. </P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN40"
-></A
-><H2
->OPTIONS</H2
-><P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
->servicename</DT
-><DD
-><P
->servicename is the name of the service
+ and so on. </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">servicename</span></dt><dd><p>servicename is the name of the service
you want to use on the server. A service name takes the form
- <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->//server/service</TT
-> where <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->server
- </I
-></TT
-> is the NetBIOS name of the SMB/CIFS server
- offering the desired service and <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->service</I
-></TT
->
+ <tt class="filename">//server/service</tt> where <i class="parameter"><tt>server
+ </tt></i> is the NetBIOS name of the SMB/CIFS server
+ offering the desired service and <i class="parameter"><tt>service</tt></i>
is the name of the service offered. Thus to connect to
- the service "printer" on the SMB/CIFS server "smbserver",
- you would use the servicename <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->//smbserver/printer
- </TT
-></P
-><P
->Note that the server name required is NOT necessarily
+ the service &quot;printer&quot; on the SMB/CIFS server &quot;smbserver&quot;,
+ you would use the servicename <tt class="filename">//smbserver/printer
+ </tt></p><p>Note that the server name required is NOT necessarily
the IP (DNS) host name of the server ! The name required is
a NetBIOS server name, which may or may not be the
same as the IP hostname of the machine running the server.
- </P
-><P
->The server name is looked up according to either
- the <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->-R</I
-></TT
-> parameter to <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbclient</B
-> or
- using the name resolve order parameter in the <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->smb.conf</TT
-> file,
+ </p><p>The server name is looked up according to either
+ the <i class="parameter"><tt>-R</tt></i> parameter to <b class="command">smbclient</b> or
+ using the name resolve order parameter in
+ the <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> file,
allowing an administrator to change the order and methods
- by which server names are looked up. </P
-></DD
-><DT
->password</DT
-><DD
-><P
->The password required to access the specified
+ by which server names are looked up. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">password</span></dt><dd><p>The password required to access the specified
service on the specified server. If this parameter is
- supplied, the <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->-N</I
-></TT
-> option (suppress
- password prompt) is assumed. </P
-><P
->There is no default password. If no password is supplied
+ supplied, the <i class="parameter"><tt>-N</tt></i> option (suppress
+ password prompt) is assumed. </p><p>There is no default password. If no password is supplied
on the command line (either by using this parameter or adding
- a password to the <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->-U</I
-></TT
-> option (see
- below)) and the <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->-N</I
-></TT
-> option is not
+ a password to the <i class="parameter"><tt>-U</tt></i> option (see
+ below)) and the <i class="parameter"><tt>-N</tt></i> option is not
specified, the client will prompt for a password, even if
the desired service does not require one. (If no password is
required, simply press ENTER to provide a null password.)
- </P
-><P
->Note: Some servers (including OS/2 and Windows for
+ </p><p>Note: Some servers (including OS/2 and Windows for
Workgroups) insist on an uppercase password. Lowercase
or mixed case passwords may be rejected by these servers.
- </P
-><P
->Be cautious about including passwords in scripts.
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-s smb.conf</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Specifies the location of the all important
- <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->smb.conf</TT
-> file. </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-O socket options</DT
-><DD
-><P
->TCP socket options to set on the client
- socket. See the socket options parameter in the <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
-> smb.conf (5)</TT
-> manpage for the list of valid
- options. </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-R &lt;name resolve order&gt;</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This option is used by the programs in the Samba
+ </p><p>Be cautious about including passwords in scripts.
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-R &lt;name resolve order&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>This option is used by the programs in the Samba
suite to determine what naming services and in what order to resolve
host names to IP addresses. The option takes a space-separated
- string of different name resolution options.</P
-><P
->The options are :"lmhosts", "host", "wins" and "bcast". They
- cause names to be resolved as follows :</P
-><P
-></P
-><UL
-><LI
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->lmhosts</TT
-> : Lookup an IP
+ string of different name resolution options.</p><p>The options are :&quot;lmhosts&quot;, &quot;host&quot;, &quot;wins&quot; and &quot;bcast&quot;. They
+ cause names to be resolved as follows:</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><tt class="constant">lmhosts</tt>: Lookup an IP
address in the Samba lmhosts file. If the line in lmhosts has
- no name type attached to the NetBIOS name (see the <A
-HREF="lmhosts.5.html"
-TARGET="_top"
->lmhosts(5)</A
-> for details) then
- any name type matches for lookup.</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->host</TT
-> : Do a standard host
- name to IP address resolution, using the system <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/hosts
- </TT
->, NIS, or DNS lookups. This method of name resolution
+ no name type attached to the NetBIOS name (see
+ the <a href="lmhosts.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">lmhosts</span>(5)</span></a> for details) then
+ any name type matches for lookup.</p></li><li><p><tt class="constant">host</tt>: Do a standard host
+ name to IP address resolution, using the system <tt class="filename">/etc/hosts
+ </tt>, NIS, or DNS lookups. This method of name resolution
is operating system dependent, for instance on IRIX or Solaris this
- may be controlled by the <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/nsswitch.conf</TT
->
+ may be controlled by the <tt class="filename">/etc/nsswitch.conf</tt>
file). Note that this method is only used if the NetBIOS name
type being queried is the 0x20 (server) name type, otherwise
- it is ignored.</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->wins</TT
-> : Query a name with
- the IP address listed in the <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->wins server</I
-></TT
->
+ it is ignored.</p></li><li><p><tt class="constant">wins</tt>: Query a name with
+ the IP address listed in the <i class="parameter"><tt>wins server</tt></i>
parameter. If no WINS server has
- been specified this method will be ignored.</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->bcast</TT
-> : Do a broadcast on
+ been specified this method will be ignored.</p></li><li><p><tt class="constant">bcast</tt>: Do a broadcast on
each of the known local interfaces listed in the
- <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->interfaces</I
-></TT
->
+ <i class="parameter"><tt>interfaces</tt></i>
parameter. This is the least reliable of the name resolution
methods as it depends on the target host being on a locally
- connected subnet.</P
-></LI
-></UL
-><P
->If this parameter is not set then the name resolve order
- defined in the <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->smb.conf</TT
-> file parameter
- (name resolve order) will be used. </P
-><P
->The default order is lmhosts, host, wins, bcast and without
- this parameter or any entry in the <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->name resolve order
- </I
-></TT
-> parameter of the <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->smb.conf</TT
-> file the name resolution
- methods will be attempted in this order. </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-M NetBIOS name</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This options allows you to send messages, using
- the "WinPopup" protocol, to another computer. Once a connection is
+ connected subnet.</p></li></ul></div><p>If this parameter is not set then the name resolve order
+ defined in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> file parameter
+ (name resolve order) will be used. </p><p>The default order is lmhosts, host, wins, bcast and without
+ this parameter or any entry in the <i class="parameter"><tt>name resolve order
+ </tt></i> parameter of the <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> file the name resolution
+ methods will be attempted in this order. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-M NetBIOS name</span></dt><dd><p>This options allows you to send messages, using
+ the &quot;WinPopup&quot; protocol, to another computer. Once a connection is
established you then type your message, pressing ^D (control-D) to
- end. </P
-><P
->If the receiving computer is running WinPopup the user will
+ end. </p><p>If the receiving computer is running WinPopup the user will
receive the message and probably a beep. If they are not running
WinPopup the message will be lost, and no error message will
- occur. </P
-><P
->The message is also automatically truncated if the message
+ occur. </p><p>The message is also automatically truncated if the message
is over 1600 bytes, as this is the limit of the protocol.
- </P
-><P
->One useful trick is to cat the message through
- <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbclient</B
->. For example: <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
-> cat mymessage.txt | smbclient -M FRED </B
-> will
- send the message in the file <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->mymessage.txt</TT
->
- to the machine FRED. </P
-><P
->You may also find the <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->-U</I
-></TT
-> and
- <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->-I</I
-></TT
-> options useful, as they allow you to
- control the FROM and TO parts of the message. </P
-><P
->See the message command parameter in the <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
-> smb.conf(5)</TT
-> for a description of how to handle incoming
- WinPopup messages in Samba. </P
-><P
-><SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->Note</I
-></SPAN
->: Copy WinPopup into the startup group
+ </p><p>One useful trick is to cat the message through
+ <b class="command">smbclient</b>. For example: <b class="command">
+ cat mymessage.txt | smbclient -M FRED </b> will
+ send the message in the file <tt class="filename">mymessage.txt</tt>
+ to the machine FRED. </p><p>You may also find the <i class="parameter"><tt>-U</tt></i> and
+ <i class="parameter"><tt>-I</tt></i> options useful, as they allow you to
+ control the FROM and TO parts of the message. </p><p>See the <i class="parameter"><tt>message command</tt></i> parameter in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> for a description of how to handle incoming
+ WinPopup messages in Samba. </p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note</em></span>: Copy WinPopup into the startup group
on your WfWg PCs if you want them to always be able to receive
- messages. </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-i scope</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This specifies a NetBIOS scope that smbclient will
- use to communicate with when generating NetBIOS names. For details
- on the use of NetBIOS scopes, see <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->rfc1001.txt</TT
->
- and <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->rfc1002.txt</TT
->.
- NetBIOS scopes are <SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->very</I
-></SPAN
-> rarely used, only set
- this parameter if you are the system administrator in charge of all
- the NetBIOS systems you communicate with. </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-N</DT
-><DD
-><P
->If specified, this parameter suppresses the normal
- password prompt from the client to the user. This is useful when
- accessing a service that does not require a password. </P
-><P
->Unless a password is specified on the command line or
- this parameter is specified, the client will request a
- password.</P
-></DD
-><DT
->-n NetBIOS name</DT
-><DD
-><P
->By default, the client will use the local
- machine's hostname (in uppercase) as its NetBIOS name. This parameter
- allows you to override the host name and use whatever NetBIOS
- name you wish. </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-d debuglevel</DT
-><DD
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="REPLACEABLE"
-><I
->debuglevel</I
-></TT
-> is an integer from 0 to 10, or
- the letter 'A'. </P
-><P
->The default value if this parameter is not specified
- is zero. </P
-><P
->The higher this value, the more detail will be logged to
- the log files about the activities of the
- client. At level 0, only critical errors and serious warnings will
- be logged. Level 1 is a reasonable level for day to day running -
- it generates a small amount of information about operations
- carried out. </P
-><P
->Levels above 1 will generate considerable amounts of log
- data, and should only be used when investigating a problem.
- Levels above 3 are designed for use only by developers and
- generate HUGE amounts of log data, most of which is extremely
- cryptic. If <TT
-CLASS="REPLACEABLE"
-><I
->debuglevel</I
-></TT
-> is set to the letter 'A', then <SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->all
- </I
-></SPAN
-> debug messages will be printed. This setting
- is for developers only (and people who <SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->really</I
-></SPAN
-> want
- to know how the code works internally). </P
-><P
->Note that specifying this parameter here will override
- the log level parameter in the <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->smb.conf (5)</TT
->
- file. </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-p port</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This number is the TCP port number that will be used
+ messages. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-p port</span></dt><dd><p>This number is the TCP port number that will be used
when making connections to the server. The standard (well-known)
TCP port number for an SMB/CIFS server is 139, which is the
- default. </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-l logfilename</DT
-><DD
-><P
->If specified, <TT
-CLASS="REPLACEABLE"
-><I
->logfilename</I
-></TT
-> specifies a base filename
+ default. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-l logfilename</span></dt><dd><p>If specified, <i class="replaceable"><tt>logfilename</tt></i> specifies a base filename
into which operational data from the running client will be
- logged. </P
-><P
->The default base name is specified at compile time.</P
-><P
->The base name is used to generate actual log file names.
- For example, if the name specified was "log", the debug file
- would be <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->log.client</TT
->.</P
-><P
->The log file generated is never removed by the client.
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-h</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Print the usage message for the client. </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-I IP-address</DT
-><DD
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="REPLACEABLE"
-><I
->IP address</I
-></TT
-> is the address of the server to connect to.
- It should be specified in standard "a.b.c.d" notation. </P
-><P
->Normally the client would attempt to locate a named
+ logged. </p><p>The default base name is specified at compile time.</p><p>The base name is used to generate actual log file names.
+ For example, if the name specified was &quot;log&quot;, the debug file
+ would be <tt class="filename">log.client</tt>.</p><p>The log file generated is never removed by the client.
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-h|--help</span></dt><dd><p>Print a summary of command line options.
+</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-I IP-address</span></dt><dd><p><i class="replaceable"><tt>IP address</tt></i> is the address of the server to connect to.
+ It should be specified in standard &quot;a.b.c.d&quot; notation. </p><p>Normally the client would attempt to locate a named
SMB/CIFS server by looking it up via the NetBIOS name resolution
- mechanism described above in the <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->name resolve order</I
-></TT
->
+ mechanism described above in the <i class="parameter"><tt>name resolve order</tt></i>
parameter above. Using this parameter will force the client
to assume that the server is on the machine with the specified IP
address and the NetBIOS name component of the resource being
- connected to will be ignored. </P
-><P
->There is no default for this parameter. If not supplied,
+ connected to will be ignored. </p><p>There is no default for this parameter. If not supplied,
it will be determined automatically by the client as described
- above. </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-E</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This parameter causes the client to write messages
+ above. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-E</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter causes the client to write messages
to the standard error stream (stderr) rather than to the standard
- output stream. </P
-><P
->By default, the client writes messages to standard output
- - typically the user's tty. </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-U username[%pass]</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Sets the SMB username or username and password.
- If %pass is not specified, The user will be prompted. The client
- will first check the <TT
-CLASS="ENVAR"
->USER</TT
-> environment variable, then the
- <TT
-CLASS="ENVAR"
->LOGNAME</TT
-> variable and if either exists, the
- string is uppercased. Anything in these variables following a '%'
- sign will be treated as the password. If these environment
- variables are not found, the username <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->GUEST</TT
->
- is used. </P
-><P
->If the password is not included in these environment
- variables (using the %pass syntax), <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbclient</B
-> will look for
- a <TT
-CLASS="ENVAR"
->PASSWD</TT
-> environment variable from which
- to read the password. </P
-><P
->A third option is to use a credentials file which
- contains the plaintext of the domain name, username and password. This
- option is mainly provided for scripts where the admin doesn't
- wish to pass the credentials on the command line or via environment
- variables. If this method is used, make certain that the permissions
- on the file restrict access from unwanted users. See the
- <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->-A</I
-></TT
-> for more details. </P
-><P
->Be cautious about including passwords in scripts or in
- the <TT
-CLASS="ENVAR"
->PASSWD</TT
-> environment variable. Also, on
- many systems the command line of a running process may be seen
- via the <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->ps</B
-> command to be safe always allow
- <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbclient</B
-> to prompt for a password and type
- it in directly. </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-A filename</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This option allows
- you to specify a file from which to read the username, domain name, and
- password used in the connection. The format of the file is
- </P
-><P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
->username = &lt;value&gt;
-password = &lt;value&gt;
-domain = &lt;value&gt;
- </PRE
-></P
-><P
->If the domain parameter is missing the current workgroup name
- is used instead. Make certain that the permissions on the file restrict
- access from unwanted users. </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-L</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This option allows you to look at what services
- are available on a server. You use it as <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbclient -L
- host</B
-> and a list should appear. The <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->-I
- </I
-></TT
-> option may be useful if your NetBIOS names don't
+ output stream. </p><p>By default, the client writes messages to standard output
+ - typically the user's tty. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-L</span></dt><dd><p>This option allows you to look at what services
+ are available on a server. You use it as <b class="command">smbclient -L
+ host</b> and a list should appear. The <i class="parameter"><tt>-I
+ </tt></i> option may be useful if your NetBIOS names don't
match your TCP/IP DNS host names or if you are trying to reach a
- host on another network. </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-t terminal code</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This option tells <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbclient</B
-> how to interpret
+ host on another network. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-t terminal code</span></dt><dd><p>This option tells <b class="command">smbclient</b> how to interpret
filenames coming from the remote server. Usually Asian language
multibyte UNIX implementations use different character sets than
- SMB/CIFS servers (<SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->EUC</I
-></SPAN
-> instead of <SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
-> SJIS</I
-></SPAN
-> for example). Setting this parameter will let
- <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbclient</B
-> convert between the UNIX filenames and
+ SMB/CIFS servers (<span class="emphasis"><em>EUC</em></span> instead of <span class="emphasis"><em>
+ SJIS</em></span> for example). Setting this parameter will let
+ <b class="command">smbclient</b> convert between the UNIX filenames and
the SMB filenames correctly. This option has not been seriously tested
- and may have some problems. </P
-><P
->The terminal codes include CWsjis, CWeuc, CWjis7, CWjis8,
+ and may have some problems. </p><p>The terminal codes include CWsjis, CWeuc, CWjis7, CWjis8,
CWjunet, CWhex, CWcap. This is not a complete list, check the Samba
- source code for the complete list. </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-b buffersize</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This option changes the transmit/send buffer
+ source code for the complete list. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-b buffersize</span></dt><dd><p>This option changes the transmit/send buffer
size when getting or putting a file from/to the server. The default
is 65520 bytes. Setting this value smaller (to 1200 bytes) has been
observed to speed up file transfers to and from a Win9x server.
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-W WORKGROUP</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Override the default workgroup (domain) specified
- in the workgroup parameter of the <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->smb.conf</TT
->
- file for this connection. This may be needed to connect to some
- servers. </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-T tar options</DT
-><DD
-><P
->smbclient may be used to create <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->tar(1)
- </B
-> compatible backups of all the files on an SMB/CIFS
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-V</span></dt><dd><p>Prints the version number for
+<b class="command">smbd</b>.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-s &lt;configuration file&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>The file specified contains the
+configuration details required by the server. The
+information in this file includes server-specific
+information such as what printcap file to use, as well
+as descriptions of all the services that the server is
+to provide. See <a href="smb.conf.5.html" target="_top"><tt class="filename">
+smb.conf(5)</tt></a> for more information.
+The default configuration file name is determined at
+compile time.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-d|--debug=debuglevel</span></dt><dd><p><i class="replaceable"><tt>debuglevel</tt></i> is an integer
+from 0 to 10. The default value if this parameter is
+not specified is zero.</p><p>The higher this value, the more detail will be
+logged to the log files about the activities of the
+server. At level 0, only critical errors and serious
+warnings will be logged. Level 1 is a reasonable level for
+day to day running - it generates a small amount of
+information about operations carried out.</p><p>Levels above 1 will generate considerable
+amounts of log data, and should only be used when
+investigating a problem. Levels above 3 are designed for
+use only by developers and generate HUGE amounts of log
+data, most of which is extremely cryptic.</p><p>Note that specifying this parameter here will
+override the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#loglevel" target="_top">log
+level</a> parameter in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html" target="_top">
+<tt class="filename">smb.conf(5)</tt></a> file.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-l|--logfile=logbasename</span></dt><dd><p>File name for log/debug files. The extension
+<tt class="constant">&quot;.client&quot;</tt> will be appended. The log file is
+never removed by the client.
+</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-N</span></dt><dd><p>If specified, this parameter suppresses the normal
+password prompt from the client to the user. This is useful when
+accessing a service that does not require a password. </p><p>Unless a password is specified on the command line or
+this parameter is specified, the client will request a
+password.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-k</span></dt><dd><p>
+Try to authenticate with kerberos. Only useful in
+an Active Directory environment.
+</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-A|--authfile=filename</span></dt><dd><p>This option allows
+you to specify a file from which to read the username and
+password used in the connection. The format of the file is
+</p><pre class="programlisting">
+username = &lt;value&gt;
+password = &lt;value&gt;
+domain = &lt;value&gt;
+</pre><p>Make certain that the permissions on the file restrict
+access from unwanted users. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-U|--user=username[%password]</span></dt><dd><p>Sets the SMB username or username and password. </p><p>If %password is not specified, the user will be prompted. The
+client will first check the <tt class="envar">USER</tt> environment variable, then the
+<tt class="envar">LOGNAME</tt> variable and if either exists, the
+string is uppercased. If these environmental variables are not
+found, the username <tt class="constant">GUEST</tt> is used. </p><p>A third option is to use a credentials file which
+contains the plaintext of the username and password. This
+option is mainly provided for scripts where the admin does not
+wish to pass the credentials on the command line or via environment
+variables. If this method is used, make certain that the permissions
+on the file restrict access from unwanted users. See the
+<i class="parameter"><tt>-A</tt></i> for more details. </p><p>Be cautious about including passwords in scripts. Also, on
+many systems the command line of a running process may be seen
+via the <b class="command">ps</b> command. To be safe always allow
+<b class="command">rpcclient</b> to prompt for a password and type
+it in directly. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-n &lt;primary NetBIOS name&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>This option allows you to override
+the NetBIOS name that Samba uses for itself. This is identical
+to setting the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#netbiosname" target="_top"><i class="parameter"><tt>NetBIOS
+name</tt></i></a> parameter in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> file. However, a command
+line setting will take precedence over settings in
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a>.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-i &lt;scope&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>This specifies a NetBIOS scope that
+<b class="command">nmblookup</b> will use to communicate with when
+generating NetBIOS names. For details on the use of NetBIOS
+scopes, see rfc1001.txt and rfc1002.txt. NetBIOS scopes are
+<span class="emphasis"><em>very</em></span> rarely used, only set this parameter
+if you are the system administrator in charge of all the
+NetBIOS systems you communicate with.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-W|--workgroup=domain</span></dt><dd><p>Set the SMB domain of the username. This
+overrides the default domain which is the domain defined in
+smb.conf. If the domain specified is the same as the servers
+NetBIOS name, it causes the client to log on using the servers local
+SAM (as opposed to the Domain SAM). </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-O socket options</span></dt><dd><p>TCP socket options to set on the client
+socket. See the socket options parameter in
+the <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> manual page for the list of valid
+options. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-T tar options</span></dt><dd><p>smbclient may be used to create <b class="command">tar(1)
+ </b> compatible backups of all the files on an SMB/CIFS
share. The secondary tar flags that can be given to this option
- are : </P
-><P
-></P
-><UL
-><LI
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->c</I
-></TT
-> - Create a tar file on UNIX.
+ are : </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>c</tt></i> - Create a tar file on UNIX.
Must be followed by the name of a tar file, tape device
- or "-" for standard output. If using standard output you must
+ or &quot;-&quot; for standard output. If using standard output you must
turn the log level to its lowest value -d0 to avoid corrupting
your tar file. This flag is mutually exclusive with the
- <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->x</I
-></TT
-> flag. </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->x</I
-></TT
-> - Extract (restore) a local
+ <i class="parameter"><tt>x</tt></i> flag. </p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>x</tt></i> - Extract (restore) a local
tar file back to a share. Unless the -D option is given, the tar
files will be restored from the top level of the share. Must be
- followed by the name of the tar file, device or "-" for standard
- input. Mutually exclusive with the <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->c</I
-></TT
-> flag.
+ followed by the name of the tar file, device or &quot;-&quot; for standard
+ input. Mutually exclusive with the <i class="parameter"><tt>c</tt></i> flag.
Restored files have their creation times (mtime) set to the
date saved in the tar file. Directories currently do not get
- their creation dates restored properly. </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->I</I
-></TT
-> - Include files and directories.
+ their creation dates restored properly. </p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>I</tt></i> - Include files and directories.
Is the default behavior when filenames are specified above. Causes
tar files to be included in an extract or create (and therefore
everything else to be excluded). See example below. Filename globbing
- works in one of two ways. See r below. </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->X</I
-></TT
-> - Exclude files and directories.
+ works in one of two ways. See r below. </p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>X</tt></i> - Exclude files and directories.
Causes tar files to be excluded from an extract or create. See
example below. Filename globbing works in one of two ways now.
- See <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->r</I
-></TT
-> below. </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->b</I
-></TT
-> - Blocksize. Must be followed
+ See <i class="parameter"><tt>r</tt></i> below. </p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>b</tt></i> - Blocksize. Must be followed
by a valid (greater than zero) blocksize. Causes tar file to be
written out in blocksize*TBLOCK (usually 512 byte) blocks.
- </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->g</I
-></TT
-> - Incremental. Only back up
+ </p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>g</tt></i> - Incremental. Only back up
files that have the archive bit set. Useful only with the
- <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->c</I
-></TT
-> flag. </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->q</I
-></TT
-> - Quiet. Keeps tar from printing
+ <i class="parameter"><tt>c</tt></i> flag. </p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>q</tt></i> - Quiet. Keeps tar from printing
diagnostics as it works. This is the same as tarmode quiet.
- </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->r</I
-></TT
-> - Regular expression include
+ </p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>r</tt></i> - Regular expression include
or exclude. Uses regular expression matching for
excluding or excluding files if compiled with HAVE_REGEX_H.
However this mode can be very slow. If not compiled with
HAVE_REGEX_H, does a limited wildcard match on '*' and '?'.
- </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->N</I
-></TT
-> - Newer than. Must be followed
+ </p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>N</tt></i> - Newer than. Must be followed
by the name of a file whose date is compared against files found
on the share during a create. Only files newer than the file
specified are backed up to the tar file. Useful only with the
- <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->c</I
-></TT
-> flag. </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->a</I
-></TT
-> - Set archive bit. Causes the
+ <i class="parameter"><tt>c</tt></i> flag. </p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>a</tt></i> - Set archive bit. Causes the
archive bit to be reset when a file is backed up. Useful with the
- <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->g</I
-></TT
-> and <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->c</I
-></TT
-> flags.
- </P
-></LI
-></UL
-><P
-><SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->Tar Long File Names</I
-></SPAN
-></P
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbclient</B
->'s tar option now supports long
+ <i class="parameter"><tt>g</tt></i> and <i class="parameter"><tt>c</tt></i> flags.
+ </p></li></ul></div><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Tar Long File Names</em></span></p><p><b class="command">smbclient</b>'s tar option now supports long
file names both on backup and restore. However, the full path
name of the file must be less than 1024 bytes. Also, when
- a tar archive is created, <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbclient</B
->'s tar option places all
+ a tar archive is created, <b class="command">smbclient</b>'s tar option places all
files in the archive with relative names, not absolute names.
- </P
-><P
-><SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->Tar Filenames</I
-></SPAN
-></P
-><P
->All file names can be given as DOS path names (with '\'
+ </p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Tar Filenames</em></span></p><p>All file names can be given as DOS path names (with '\\'
as the component separator) or as UNIX path names (with '/' as
- the component separator). </P
-><P
-><SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->Examples</I
-></SPAN
-></P
-><P
->Restore from tar file <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->backup.tar</TT
-> into myshare on mypc
- (no password on share). </P
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbclient //mypc/yshare "" -N -Tx backup.tar
- </B
-></P
-><P
->Restore everything except <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->users/docs</TT
->
- </P
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbclient //mypc/myshare "" -N -TXx backup.tar
- users/docs</B
-></P
-><P
->Create a tar file of the files beneath <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
-> users/docs</TT
->. </P
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbclient //mypc/myshare "" -N -Tc
- backup.tar users/docs </B
-></P
-><P
->Create the same tar file as above, but now use
- a DOS path name. </P
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbclient //mypc/myshare "" -N -tc backup.tar
- users\edocs </B
-></P
-><P
->Create a tar file of all the files and directories in
- the share. </P
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbclient //mypc/myshare "" -N -Tc backup.tar *
- </B
-></P
-></DD
-><DT
->-D initial directory</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Change to initial directory before starting. Probably
- only of any use with the tar -T option. </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-c command string</DT
-><DD
-><P
->command string is a semicolon-separated list of
- commands to be executed instead of prompting from stdin. <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
-> -N</I
-></TT
-> is implied by <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->-c</I
-></TT
->.</P
-><P
->This is particularly useful in scripts and for printing stdin
- to the server, e.g. <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->-c 'print -'</B
->. </P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN310"
-></A
-><H2
->OPERATIONS</H2
-><P
->Once the client is running, the user is presented with
- a prompt : </P
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="PROMPT"
->smb:\&gt; </TT
-></P
-><P
->The backslash ("\") indicates the current working directory
+ the component separator). </p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Examples</em></span></p><p>Restore from tar file <tt class="filename">backup.tar</tt> into myshare on mypc
+ (no password on share). </p><p><b class="command">smbclient //mypc/yshare &quot;&quot; -N -Tx backup.tar
+ </b></p><p>Restore everything except <tt class="filename">users/docs</tt>
+ </p><p><b class="command">smbclient //mypc/myshare &quot;&quot; -N -TXx backup.tar
+ users/docs</b></p><p>Create a tar file of the files beneath <tt class="filename">
+ users/docs</tt>. </p><p><b class="command">smbclient //mypc/myshare &quot;&quot; -N -Tc
+ backup.tar users/docs </b></p><p>Create the same tar file as above, but now use
+ a DOS path name. </p><p><b class="command">smbclient //mypc/myshare &quot;&quot; -N -tc backup.tar
+ users\edocs </b></p><p>Create a tar file of all the files and directories in
+ the share. </p><p><b class="command">smbclient //mypc/myshare &quot;&quot; -N -Tc backup.tar *
+ </b></p></dd><dt><span class="term">-D initial directory</span></dt><dd><p>Change to initial directory before starting. Probably
+ only of any use with the tar -T option. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-c command string</span></dt><dd><p>command string is a semicolon-separated list of
+ commands to be executed instead of prompting from stdin. <i class="parameter"><tt>
+ -N</tt></i> is implied by <i class="parameter"><tt>-c</tt></i>.</p><p>This is particularly useful in scripts and for printing stdin
+ to the server, e.g. <b class="command">-c 'print -'</b>. </p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>OPERATIONS</h2><p>Once the client is running, the user is presented with
+ a prompt : </p><p><tt class="prompt">smb:\&gt; </tt></p><p>The backslash (&quot;\\&quot;) indicates the current working directory
on the server, and will change if the current working directory
- is changed. </P
-><P
->The prompt indicates that the client is ready and waiting to
+ is changed. </p><p>The prompt indicates that the client is ready and waiting to
carry out a user command. Each command is a single word, optionally
followed by parameters specific to that command. Command and parameters
are space-delimited unless these notes specifically
state otherwise. All commands are case-insensitive. Parameters to
commands may or may not be case sensitive, depending on the command.
- </P
-><P
->You can specify file names which have spaces in them by quoting
- the name with double quotes, for example "a long file name". </P
-><P
->Parameters shown in square brackets (e.g., "[parameter]") are
+ </p><p>You can specify file names which have spaces in them by quoting
+ the name with double quotes, for example &quot;a long file name&quot;. </p><p>Parameters shown in square brackets (e.g., &quot;[parameter]&quot;) are
optional. If not given, the command will use suitable defaults. Parameters
- shown in angle brackets (e.g., "&lt;parameter&gt;") are required.
- </P
-><P
->Note that all commands operating on the server are actually
+ shown in angle brackets (e.g., &quot;&lt;parameter&gt;&quot;) are required.
+ </p><p>Note that all commands operating on the server are actually
performed by issuing a request to the server. Thus the behavior may
vary from server to server, depending on how the server was implemented.
- </P
-><P
->The commands available are given here in alphabetical order. </P
-><P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
->? [command]</DT
-><DD
-><P
->If <TT
-CLASS="REPLACEABLE"
-><I
->command</I
-></TT
-> is specified, the ? command will display
+ </p><p>The commands available are given here in alphabetical order. </p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">? [command]</span></dt><dd><p>If <i class="replaceable"><tt>command</tt></i> is specified, the ? command will display
a brief informative message about the specified command. If no
command is specified, a list of available commands will
- be displayed. </P
-></DD
-><DT
->! [shell command]</DT
-><DD
-><P
->If <TT
-CLASS="REPLACEABLE"
-><I
->shell command</I
-></TT
-> is specified, the !
+ be displayed. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">! [shell command]</span></dt><dd><p>If <i class="replaceable"><tt>shell command</tt></i> is specified, the !
command will execute a shell locally and run the specified shell
command. If no command is specified, a local shell will be run.
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
->altname file</DT
-><DD
-><P
->The client will request that the server return
- the "alternate" name (the 8.3 name) for a file or directory.
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
->cancel jobid0 [jobid1] ... [jobidN]</DT
-><DD
-><P
->The client will request that the server cancel
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term">altname file</span></dt><dd><p>The client will request that the server return
+ the &quot;alternate&quot; name (the 8.3 name) for a file or directory.
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term">cancel jobid0 [jobid1] ... [jobidN]</span></dt><dd><p>The client will request that the server cancel
the printjobs identified by the given numeric print job ids.
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
->chmod file mode in octal</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This command depends on the server supporting the CIFS
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term">chmod file mode in octal</span></dt><dd><p>This command depends on the server supporting the CIFS
UNIX extensions and will fail if the server does not. The client requests that the server
change the UNIX permissions to the given octal mode, in standard UNIX format.
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
->chown file uid gid</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This command depends on the server supporting the CIFS
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term">chown file uid gid</span></dt><dd><p>This command depends on the server supporting the CIFS
UNIX extensions and will fail if the server does not. The client requests that the server
change the UNIX user and group ownership to the given decimal values. Note there is
currently no way to remotely look up the UNIX uid and gid values for a given name.
This may be addressed in future versions of the CIFS UNIX extensions.
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
->cd [directory name]</DT
-><DD
-><P
->If "directory name" is specified, the current
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term">cd [directory name]</span></dt><dd><p>If &quot;directory name&quot; is specified, the current
working directory on the server will be changed to the directory
specified. This operation will fail if for any reason the specified
- directory is inaccessible. </P
-><P
->If no directory name is specified, the current working
- directory on the server will be reported. </P
-></DD
-><DT
->del &lt;mask&gt;</DT
-><DD
-><P
->The client will request that the server attempt
- to delete all files matching <TT
-CLASS="REPLACEABLE"
-><I
->mask</I
-></TT
-> from the current working
- directory on the server. </P
-></DD
-><DT
->dir &lt;mask&gt;</DT
-><DD
-><P
->A list of the files matching <TT
-CLASS="REPLACEABLE"
-><I
->mask</I
-></TT
-> in the current
+ directory is inaccessible. </p><p>If no directory name is specified, the current working
+ directory on the server will be reported. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">del &lt;mask&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>The client will request that the server attempt
+ to delete all files matching <i class="replaceable"><tt>mask</tt></i> from the current working
+ directory on the server. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">dir &lt;mask&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>A list of the files matching <i class="replaceable"><tt>mask</tt></i> in the current
working directory on the server will be retrieved from the server
- and displayed. </P
-></DD
-><DT
->exit</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Terminate the connection with the server and exit
- from the program. </P
-></DD
-><DT
->get &lt;remote file name&gt; [local file name]</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Copy the file called <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->remote file name</TT
-> from
+ and displayed. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">exit</span></dt><dd><p>Terminate the connection with the server and exit
+ from the program. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">get &lt;remote file name&gt; [local file name]</span></dt><dd><p>Copy the file called <tt class="filename">remote file name</tt> from
the server to the machine running the client. If specified, name
- the local copy <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->local file name</TT
->. Note that all transfers in
- <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbclient</B
-> are binary. See also the
- lowercase command. </P
-></DD
-><DT
->help [command]</DT
-><DD
-><P
->See the ? command above. </P
-></DD
-><DT
->lcd [directory name]</DT
-><DD
-><P
->If <TT
-CLASS="REPLACEABLE"
-><I
->directory name</I
-></TT
-> is specified, the current
+ the local copy <tt class="filename">local file name</tt>. Note that all transfers in
+ <b class="command">smbclient</b> are binary. See also the
+ lowercase command. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">help [command]</span></dt><dd><p>See the ? command above. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">lcd [directory name]</span></dt><dd><p>If <i class="replaceable"><tt>directory name</tt></i> is specified, the current
working directory on the local machine will be changed to
the directory specified. This operation will fail if for any
- reason the specified directory is inaccessible. </P
-><P
->If no directory name is specified, the name of the
+ reason the specified directory is inaccessible. </p><p>If no directory name is specified, the name of the
current working directory on the local machine will be reported.
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
->link source destination</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This command depends on the server supporting the CIFS
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term">link source destination</span></dt><dd><p>This command depends on the server supporting the CIFS
UNIX extensions and will fail if the server does not. The client requests that the server
create a hard link between the source and destination files. The source file
must not exist.
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
->lowercase</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Toggle lowercasing of filenames for the get and
- mget commands. </P
-><P
->When lowercasing is toggled ON, local filenames are converted
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term">lowercase</span></dt><dd><p>Toggle lowercasing of filenames for the get and
+ mget commands. </p><p>When lowercasing is toggled ON, local filenames are converted
to lowercase when using the get and mget commands. This is
often useful when copying (say) MSDOS files from a server, because
- lowercase filenames are the norm on UNIX systems. </P
-></DD
-><DT
->ls &lt;mask&gt;</DT
-><DD
-><P
->See the dir command above. </P
-></DD
-><DT
->mask &lt;mask&gt;</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This command allows the user to set up a mask
+ lowercase filenames are the norm on UNIX systems. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">ls &lt;mask&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>See the dir command above. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">mask &lt;mask&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>This command allows the user to set up a mask
which will be used during recursive operation of the mget and
- mput commands. </P
-><P
->The masks specified to the mget and mput commands act as
+ mput commands. </p><p>The masks specified to the mget and mput commands act as
filters for directories rather than files when recursion is
- toggled ON. </P
-><P
->The mask specified with the mask command is necessary
+ toggled ON. </p><p>The mask specified with the mask command is necessary
to filter files within those directories. For example, if the
- mask specified in an mget command is "source*" and the mask
- specified with the mask command is "*.c" and recursion is
+ mask specified in an mget command is &quot;source*&quot; and the mask
+ specified with the mask command is &quot;*.c&quot; and recursion is
toggled ON, the mget command will retrieve all files matching
- "*.c" in all directories below and including all directories
- matching "source*" in the current working directory. </P
-><P
->Note that the value for mask defaults to blank (equivalent
- to "*") and remains so until the mask command is used to change it.
+ &quot;*.c&quot; in all directories below and including all directories
+ matching &quot;source*&quot; in the current working directory. </p><p>Note that the value for mask defaults to blank (equivalent
+ to &quot;*&quot;) and remains so until the mask command is used to change it.
It retains the most recently specified value indefinitely. To
avoid unexpected results it would be wise to change the value of
- mask back to "*" after using the mget or mput commands. </P
-></DD
-><DT
->md &lt;directory name&gt;</DT
-><DD
-><P
->See the mkdir command. </P
-></DD
-><DT
->mget &lt;mask&gt;</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Copy all files matching <TT
-CLASS="REPLACEABLE"
-><I
->mask</I
-></TT
-> from the server to
- the machine running the client. </P
-><P
->Note that <TT
-CLASS="REPLACEABLE"
-><I
->mask</I
-></TT
-> is interpreted differently during recursive
+ mask back to &quot;*&quot; after using the mget or mput commands. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">md &lt;directory name&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>See the mkdir command. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">mget &lt;mask&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>Copy all files matching <i class="replaceable"><tt>mask</tt></i> from the server to
+ the machine running the client. </p><p>Note that <i class="replaceable"><tt>mask</tt></i> is interpreted differently during recursive
operation and non-recursive operation - refer to the recurse and
mask commands for more information. Note that all transfers in
- <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbclient</B
-> are binary. See also the lowercase command. </P
-></DD
-><DT
->mkdir &lt;directory name&gt;</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Create a new directory on the server (user access
- privileges permitting) with the specified name. </P
-></DD
-><DT
->mput &lt;mask&gt;</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Copy all files matching <TT
-CLASS="REPLACEABLE"
-><I
->mask</I
-></TT
-> in the current working
+ <b class="command">smbclient</b> are binary. See also the lowercase command. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">mkdir &lt;directory name&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>Create a new directory on the server (user access
+ privileges permitting) with the specified name. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">mput &lt;mask&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>Copy all files matching <i class="replaceable"><tt>mask</tt></i> in the current working
directory on the local machine to the current working directory on
- the server. </P
-><P
->Note that <TT
-CLASS="REPLACEABLE"
-><I
->mask</I
-></TT
-> is interpreted differently during recursive
+ the server. </p><p>Note that <i class="replaceable"><tt>mask</tt></i> is interpreted differently during recursive
operation and non-recursive operation - refer to the recurse and mask
- commands for more information. Note that all transfers in <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbclient</B
->
- are binary. </P
-></DD
-><DT
->print &lt;file name&gt;</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Print the specified file from the local machine
- through a printable service on the server. </P
-><P
->See also the printmode command.</P
-></DD
-><DT
->printmode &lt;graphics or text&gt;</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Set the print mode to suit either binary data
+ commands for more information. Note that all transfers in <b class="command">smbclient</b>
+ are binary. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">print &lt;file name&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>Print the specified file from the local machine
+ through a printable service on the server. </p><p>See also the printmode command.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">printmode &lt;graphics or text&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>Set the print mode to suit either binary data
(such as graphical information) or text. Subsequent print
- commands will use the currently set print mode. </P
-></DD
-><DT
->prompt</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Toggle prompting for filenames during operation
- of the mget and mput commands. </P
-><P
->When toggled ON, the user will be prompted to confirm
+ commands will use the currently set print mode. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">prompt</span></dt><dd><p>Toggle prompting for filenames during operation
+ of the mget and mput commands. </p><p>When toggled ON, the user will be prompted to confirm
the transfer of each file during these commands. When toggled
OFF, all specified files will be transferred without prompting.
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
->put &lt;local file name&gt; [remote file name]</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Copy the file called <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->local file name</TT
-> from the
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term">put &lt;local file name&gt; [remote file name]</span></dt><dd><p>Copy the file called <tt class="filename">local file name</tt> from the
machine running the client to the server. If specified,
- name the remote copy <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->remote file name</TT
->. Note that all transfers
- in <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbclient</B
-> are binary. See also the lowercase command.
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
->queue</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Displays the print queue, showing the job id,
- name, size and current status. </P
-></DD
-><DT
->quit</DT
-><DD
-><P
->See the exit command. </P
-></DD
-><DT
->rd &lt;directory name&gt;</DT
-><DD
-><P
->See the rmdir command. </P
-></DD
-><DT
->recurse</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Toggle directory recursion for the commands mget
- and mput. </P
-><P
->When toggled ON, these commands will process all directories
+ name the remote copy <tt class="filename">remote file name</tt>. Note that all transfers
+ in <b class="command">smbclient</b> are binary. See also the lowercase command.
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term">queue</span></dt><dd><p>Displays the print queue, showing the job id,
+ name, size and current status. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">quit</span></dt><dd><p>See the exit command. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">rd &lt;directory name&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>See the rmdir command. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">recurse</span></dt><dd><p>Toggle directory recursion for the commands mget
+ and mput. </p><p>When toggled ON, these commands will process all directories
in the source directory (i.e., the directory they are copying
from ) and will recurse into any that match the mask specified
to the command. Only files that match the mask specified using
the mask command will be retrieved. See also the mask command.
- </P
-><P
->When recursion is toggled OFF, only files from the current
+ </p><p>When recursion is toggled OFF, only files from the current
working directory on the source machine that match the mask specified
to the mget or mput commands will be copied, and any mask specified
- using the mask command will be ignored. </P
-></DD
-><DT
->rm &lt;mask&gt;</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Remove all files matching <TT
-CLASS="REPLACEABLE"
-><I
->mask</I
-></TT
-> from the current
- working directory on the server. </P
-></DD
-><DT
->rmdir &lt;directory name&gt;</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Remove the specified directory (user access
- privileges permitting) from the server. </P
-></DD
-><DT
->setmode &lt;filename&gt; &lt;perm=[+|\-]rsha&gt;</DT
-><DD
-><P
->A version of the DOS attrib command to set
- file permissions. For example: </P
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->setmode myfile +r </B
-></P
-><P
->would make myfile read only. </P
-></DD
-><DT
->symlink source destination</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This command depends on the server supporting the CIFS
+ using the mask command will be ignored. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">rm &lt;mask&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>Remove all files matching <i class="replaceable"><tt>mask</tt></i> from the current
+ working directory on the server. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">rmdir &lt;directory name&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>Remove the specified directory (user access
+ privileges permitting) from the server. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">setmode &lt;filename&gt; &lt;perm=[+|\-]rsha&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>A version of the DOS attrib command to set
+ file permissions. For example: </p><p><b class="command">setmode myfile +r </b></p><p>would make myfile read only. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">symlink source destination</span></dt><dd><p>This command depends on the server supporting the CIFS
UNIX extensions and will fail if the server does not. The client requests that the server
create a symbolic hard link between the source and destination files. The source file
must not exist. Note that the server will not create a link to any path that lies
outside the currently connected share. This is enforced by the Samba server.
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
->tar &lt;c|x&gt;[IXbgNa]</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Performs a tar operation - see the <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->-T
- </I
-></TT
-> command line option above. Behavior may be affected
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term">tar &lt;c|x&gt;[IXbgNa]</span></dt><dd><p>Performs a tar operation - see the <i class="parameter"><tt>-T
+ </tt></i> command line option above. Behavior may be affected
by the tarmode command (see below). Using g (incremental) and N
- (newer) will affect tarmode settings. Note that using the "-" option
+ (newer) will affect tarmode settings. Note that using the &quot;-&quot; option
with tar x may not work - use the command line option instead.
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
->blocksize &lt;blocksize&gt;</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Blocksize. Must be followed by a valid (greater
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term">blocksize &lt;blocksize&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>Blocksize. Must be followed by a valid (greater
than zero) blocksize. Causes tar file to be written out in
- <TT
-CLASS="REPLACEABLE"
-><I
->blocksize</I
-></TT
->*TBLOCK (usually 512 byte) blocks. </P
-></DD
-><DT
->tarmode &lt;full|inc|reset|noreset&gt;</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Changes tar's behavior with regard to archive
+ <i class="replaceable"><tt>blocksize</tt></i>*TBLOCK (usually 512 byte) blocks. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">tarmode &lt;full|inc|reset|noreset&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>Changes tar's behavior with regard to archive
bits. In full mode, tar will back up everything regardless of the
archive bit setting (this is the default mode). In incremental mode,
tar will only back up files with the archive bit set. In reset mode,
tar will reset the archive bit on all files it backs up (implies
- read/write share). </P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN501"
-></A
-><H2
->NOTES</H2
-><P
->Some servers are fussy about the case of supplied usernames,
+ read/write share). </p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>NOTES</h2><p>Some servers are fussy about the case of supplied usernames,
passwords, share names (AKA service names) and machine names.
If you fail to connect try giving all parameters in uppercase.
- </P
-><P
->It is often necessary to use the -n option when connecting
+ </p><p>It is often necessary to use the -n option when connecting
to some types of servers. For example OS/2 LanManager insists
on a valid NetBIOS name being used, so you need to supply a valid
- name that would be known to the server.</P
-><P
->smbclient supports long file names where the server
- supports the LANMAN2 protocol or above. </P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN506"
-></A
-><H2
->ENVIRONMENT VARIABLES</H2
-><P
->The variable <TT
-CLASS="ENVAR"
->USER</TT
-> may contain the
+ name that would be known to the server.</p><p>smbclient supports long file names where the server
+ supports the LANMAN2 protocol or above. </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>ENVIRONMENT VARIABLES</h2><p>The variable <tt class="envar">USER</tt> may contain the
username of the person using the client. This information is
used only if the protocol level is high enough to support
- session-level passwords.</P
-><P
->The variable <TT
-CLASS="ENVAR"
->PASSWD</TT
-> may contain
+ session-level passwords.</p><p>The variable <tt class="envar">PASSWD</tt> may contain
the password of the person using the client. This information is
used only if the protocol level is high enough to support
- session-level passwords. </P
-><P
->The variable <TT
-CLASS="ENVAR"
->LIBSMB_PROG</TT
-> may contain
+ session-level passwords. </p><p>The variable <tt class="envar">LIBSMB_PROG</tt> may contain
the path, executed with system(), which the client should connect
to instead of connecting to a server. This functionality is primarily
intended as a development aid, and works best when using a LMHOSTS
- file</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN514"
-></A
-><H2
->INSTALLATION</H2
-><P
->The location of the client program is a matter for
+ file</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>INSTALLATION</h2><p>The location of the client program is a matter for
individual system administrators. The following are thus
- suggestions only. </P
-><P
->It is recommended that the smbclient software be installed
- in the <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/usr/local/samba/bin/</TT
-> or <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
-> /usr/samba/bin/</TT
-> directory, this directory readable
+ suggestions only. </p><p>It is recommended that the smbclient software be installed
+ in the <tt class="filename">/usr/local/samba/bin/</tt> or <tt class="filename">
+ /usr/samba/bin/</tt> directory, this directory readable
by all, writeable only by root. The client program itself should
- be executable by all. The client should <SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->NOT</I
-></SPAN
-> be
- setuid or setgid! </P
-><P
->The client log files should be put in a directory readable
- and writeable only by the user. </P
-><P
->To test the client, you will need to know the name of a
- running SMB/CIFS server. It is possible to run <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbd(8)
- </B
-> as an ordinary user - running that server as a daemon
+ be executable by all. The client should <span class="emphasis"><em>NOT</em></span> be
+ setuid or setgid! </p><p>The client log files should be put in a directory readable
+ and writeable only by the user. </p><p>To test the client, you will need to know the name of a
+ running SMB/CIFS server. It is possible to run <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> as an ordinary user - running that server as a daemon
on a user-accessible port (typically any port number over 1024)
- would provide a suitable test server. </P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN524"
-></A
-><H2
->DIAGNOSTICS</H2
-><P
->Most diagnostics issued by the client are logged in a
+ would provide a suitable test server. </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>DIAGNOSTICS</h2><p>Most diagnostics issued by the client are logged in a
specified log file. The log file name is specified at compile time,
- but may be overridden on the command line. </P
-><P
->The number and nature of diagnostics available depends
+ but may be overridden on the command line. </p><p>The number and nature of diagnostics available depends
on the debug level used by the client. If you have problems,
- set the debug level to 3 and peruse the log files. </P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN528"
-></A
-><H2
->VERSION</H2
-><P
->This man page is correct for version 2.2 of
- the Samba suite.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN531"
-></A
-><H2
->AUTHOR</H2
-><P
->The original Samba software and related utilities
+ set the debug level to 3 and peruse the log files. </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 2.2 of the Samba suite.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
- to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</P
-><P
->The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer.
+ to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</p><p>The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer.
The man page sources were converted to YODL format (another
- excellent piece of Open Source software, available at
- <A
-HREF="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/"
-TARGET="_top"
-> ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/</A
->) and updated for the Samba 2.0
+ excellent piece of Open Source software, available at <a href="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/" target="_top">
+ ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/</a>) and updated for the Samba 2.0
release by Jeremy Allison. The conversion to DocBook for
- Samba 2.2 was done by Gerald Carter</P
-></DIV
-></BODY
-></HTML
-> \ No newline at end of file
+ Samba 2.2 was done by Gerald Carter. The conversion to DocBook XML 4.2 for Samba 3.0
+ was done by Alexander Bokovoy.</p></div></div></body></html>
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/smbcontrol.1.html b/docs/htmldocs/smbcontrol.1.html
index 12662dcc04..21344b9ade 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/smbcontrol.1.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/smbcontrol.1.html
@@ -1,385 +1,71 @@
-<!DOCTYPE HTML PUBLIC "-//W3C//DTD HTML 4.01 Transitional//EN">
-<HTML
-><HEAD
-><TITLE
->smbcontrol</TITLE
-><META
-NAME="GENERATOR"
-CONTENT="Modular DocBook HTML Stylesheet Version 1.77"></HEAD
-><BODY
-CLASS="REFENTRY"
-BGCOLOR="#FFFFFF"
-TEXT="#000000"
-LINK="#0000FF"
-VLINK="#840084"
-ALINK="#0000FF"
-><H1
-><A
-NAME="SMBCONTROL"
-></A
->smbcontrol</H1
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFNAMEDIV"
-><A
-NAME="AEN5"
-></A
-><H2
->Name</H2
->smbcontrol&nbsp;--&nbsp;send messages to smbd, nmbd or winbindd processes</DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSYNOPSISDIV"
-><A
-NAME="AEN8"
-></A
-><H2
->Synopsis</H2
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbcontrol</B
-> [-i]</P
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbcontrol</B
-> [destination] [message-type] [parameter]</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN17"
-></A
-><H2
->DESCRIPTION</H2
-><P
->This tool is part of the <A
-HREF="samba.7.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-> Samba</A
-> suite.</P
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbcontrol</B
-> is a very small program, which
- sends messages to an <A
-HREF="smbd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
->smbd(8)</A
->,
- an <A
-HREF="nmbd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
->nmbd(8)</A
->
- or a <A
-HREF="winbindd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
->winbindd(8)</A
->
- daemon running on the system.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN26"
-></A
-><H2
->OPTIONS</H2
-><P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
->-i</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Run interactively. Individual commands
+<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>smbcontrol</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="smbcontrol.1"></a><div class="titlepage"><div></div><div></div></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>smbcontrol &#8212; send messages to smbd, nmbd or winbindd processes</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><tt class="command">smbcontrol</tt> [-i] [-s]</p></div><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><tt class="command">smbcontrol</tt> [destination] [message-type] [parameter]</p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This tool is part of the <a href="Samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">Samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p><b class="command">smbcontrol</b> is a very small program, which
+ sends messages to a <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a>, a <a href="nmbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">nmbd</span>(8)</span></a>, or a <a href="winbindd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">winbindd</span>(8)</span></a> daemon running on the system.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">-h|--help</span></dt><dd><p>Print a summary of command line options.
+</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-s &lt;configuration file&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>The file specified contains the
+configuration details required by the server. The
+information in this file includes server-specific
+information such as what printcap file to use, as well
+as descriptions of all the services that the server is
+to provide. See <a href="smb.conf.5.html" target="_top"><tt class="filename">
+smb.conf(5)</tt></a> for more information.
+The default configuration file name is determined at
+compile time.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-i</span></dt><dd><p>Run interactively. Individual commands
of the form destination message-type parameters can be entered
- on STDIN. An empty command line or a "q" will quit the
- program.</P
-></DD
-><DT
->destination</DT
-><DD
-><P
->One of <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->nmbd</I
-></TT
->
- <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->smbd</I
-></TT
-> or a process ID.</P
-><P
->The <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->smbd</I
-></TT
-> destination causes the
- message to "broadcast" to all smbd daemons.</P
-><P
->The <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->nmbd</I
-></TT
-> destination causes the
+ on STDIN. An empty command line or a &quot;q&quot; will quit the
+ program.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">destination</span></dt><dd><p>One of <i class="parameter"><tt>nmbd</tt></i>, <i class="parameter"><tt>smbd</tt></i> or a process ID.</p><p>The <i class="parameter"><tt>smbd</tt></i> destination causes the
+ message to &quot;broadcast&quot; to all smbd daemons.</p><p>The <i class="parameter"><tt>nmbd</tt></i> destination causes the
message to be sent to the nmbd daemon specified in the
- <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->nmbd.pid</TT
-> file.</P
-><P
->If a single process ID is given, the message is sent
- to only that process.</P
-></DD
-><DT
->message-type</DT
-><DD
-><P
->One of: <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->close-share</TT
->,
- <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->debug</TT
->,
- <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->force-election</TT
->, <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->ping
- </TT
->, <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->profile</TT
->, <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
-> debuglevel</TT
->, <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->profilelevel</TT
->,
- or <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->printnotify</TT
->.</P
-><P
->The <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->close-share</TT
-> message-type sends a
- message to smbd which will then close the client connections to
- the named share. Note that this doesn't affect client connections
- to any other shares. This message-type takes an argument of the
- share name for which client connections will be closed, or the
- "*" character which will close all currently open shares.
- This may be useful if you made changes to the access controls on the share.
- This message can only be sent to <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->smbd</TT
->.</P
-><P
->The <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->debug</TT
-> message-type allows
- the debug level to be set to the value specified by the
- parameter. This can be sent to any of the destinations.</P
-><P
->The <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->force-election</TT
-> message-type can only be
- sent to the <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->nmbd</TT
-> destination. This message
- causes the <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->nmbd</B
-> daemon to force a new browse
- master election.</P
-><P
->The <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->ping</TT
-> message-type sends the
- number of "ping" messages specified by the parameter and waits
- for the same number of reply "pong" messages. This can be sent to
- any of the destinations.</P
-><P
->The <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->profile</TT
-> message-type sends a
- message to an smbd to change the profile settings based on the
- parameter. The parameter can be "on" to turn on profile stats
- collection, "off" to turn off profile stats collection, "count"
- to enable only collection of count stats (time stats are
- disabled), and "flush" to zero the current profile stats. This can
- be sent to any smbd or nmbd destinations.</P
-><P
->The <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->debuglevel</TT
-> message-type sends
- a "request debug level" message. The current debug level setting
- is returned by a "debuglevel" message. This can be
- sent to any of the destinations.</P
-><P
->The <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->profilelevel</TT
-> message-type sends
- a "request profile level" message. The current profile level
- setting is returned by a "profilelevel" message. This can be sent
- to any smbd or nmbd destinations.</P
-><P
->The <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->printnotify</TT
-> message-type sends a
- message to smbd which in turn sends a printer notify message to
- any Windows NT clients connected to a printer. This message-type
- takes the following arguments:
-
- <P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
->queuepause printername</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Send a queue pause change notify
- message to the printer specified.</P
-></DD
-><DT
->queueresume printername</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Send a queue resume change notify
- message for the printer specified.</P
-></DD
-><DT
->jobpause printername unixjobid</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Send a job pause change notify
- message for the printer and unix jobid
- specified.</P
-></DD
-><DT
->jobresume printername unixjobid</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Send a job resume change notify
- message for the printer and unix jobid
- specified.</P
-></DD
-><DT
->jobdelete printername unixjobid</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Send a job delete change notify
- message for the printer and unix jobid
- specified.</P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
->
-
- Note that this message only sends notification that an
- event has occured. It doesn't actually cause the
- event to happen.
-
- This message can only be sent to <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->smbd</TT
->.
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
->parameters</DT
-><DD
-><P
->any parameters required for the message-type</P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN102"
-></A
-><H2
->VERSION</H2
-><P
->This man page is correct for version 2.2 of
- the Samba suite.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN105"
-></A
-><H2
->SEE ALSO</H2
-><P
-><A
-HREF="nmbd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->nmbd(8)</B
-></A
->,
- and <A
-HREF="smbd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbd(8)</B
-></A
->.
- </P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN112"
-></A
-><H2
->AUTHOR</H2
-><P
->The original Samba software and related utilities
+ <tt class="filename">nmbd.pid</tt> file.</p><p>If a single process ID is given, the message is sent
+ to only that process.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">message-type</span></dt><dd><p>Type of message to send. See
+ the section <tt class="constant">MESSAGE-TYPES</tt> for details.
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term">parameters</span></dt><dd><p>any parameters required for the message-type</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>MESSAGE-TYPES</h2><p>Available message types are:</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">close-share</span></dt><dd><p>Order smbd to close the client
+ connections to the named share. Note that this doesn't affect client
+ connections to any other shares. This message-type takes an argument of the
+ share name for which client connections will be closed, or the
+ &quot;*&quot; character which will close all currently open shares.
+ This may be useful if you made changes to the access controls on the share.
+ This message can only be sent to <tt class="constant">smbd</tt>.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">debug</span></dt><dd><p>Set debug level to the value specified by the
+ parameter. This can be sent to any of the destinations.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">force-election</span></dt><dd><p>This message causes the <b class="command">nmbd</b> daemon to
+ force a new browse master election. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">ping</span></dt><dd><p>
+ Send specified number of &quot;ping&quot; messages and
+ wait for the same number of reply &quot;pong&quot; messages. This can be sent to
+ any of the destinations.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">profile</span></dt><dd><p>Change profile settings of a daemon, based on the
+ parameter. The parameter can be &quot;on&quot; to turn on profile stats
+ collection, &quot;off&quot; to turn off profile stats collection, &quot;count&quot;
+ to enable only collection of count stats (time stats are
+ disabled), and &quot;flush&quot; to zero the current profile stats. This can
+ be sent to any smbd or nmbd destinations.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">debuglevel</span></dt><dd><p>
+ Request debuglevel of a certain daemon and write it to stdout. This
+ can be sent to any of the destinations.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">profilelevel</span></dt><dd><p>
+ Request profilelevel of a certain daemon and write it to stdout.
+ This can be sent to any smbd or nmbd destinations.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">printnotify</span></dt><dd><p>
+ Order smbd to send a printer notify message to any Windows NT clients
+ connected to a printer. This message-type takes the following arguments:
+ </p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">queuepause printername</span></dt><dd><p>Send a queue pause change notify
+ message to the printer specified.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">queueresume printername</span></dt><dd><p>Send a queue resume change notify
+ message for the printer specified.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">jobpause printername unixjobid</span></dt><dd><p>Send a job pause change notify
+ message for the printer and unix jobid
+ specified.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">jobresume printername unixjobid</span></dt><dd><p>Send a job resume change notify
+ message for the printer and unix jobid
+ specified.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">jobdelete printername unixjobid</span></dt><dd><p>Send a job delete change notify
+ message for the printer and unix jobid
+ specified.</p></dd></dl></div><p>
+ Note that this message only sends notification that an
+ event has occured. It doesn't actually cause the
+ event to happen.
+ </p><p>This message can only be sent to <tt class="constant">smbd</tt>. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">samsync</span></dt><dd><p>Order smbd to synchronise sam database from PDC (being BDC). Can only be sent to <tt class="constant">smbd</tt>. </p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p>Not working at the moment</p></div></dd><dt><span class="term">samrepl</span></dt><dd><p>Send sam replication message, with specified serial. Can only be sent to <tt class="constant">smbd</tt>. Should not be used manually.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">dmalloc-mark</span></dt><dd><p>Set a mark for dmalloc. Can be sent to both smbd and nmbd. Only available if samba is built with dmalloc support. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">dmalloc-log-changed</span></dt><dd><p>
+ Dump the pointers that have changed since the mark set by dmalloc-mark.
+ Can be sent to both smbd and nmbd. Only available if samba is built with dmalloc support. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">shutdown</span></dt><dd><p>Shut down specified daemon. Can be sent to both smbd and nmbd.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">pool-usage</span></dt><dd><p>Print a human-readable description of all
+ talloc(pool) memory usage by the specified daemon/process. Available
+ for both smbd and nmbd.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">drvupgrade</span></dt><dd><p>Force clients of printers using specified driver
+ to update their local version of the driver. Can only be
+ sent to smbd.</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3.0 of
+ the Samba suite.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>SEE ALSO</h2><p><a href="nmbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">nmbd</span>(8)</span></a> and <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a>.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
- to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</P
-><P
->The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer.
+ to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</p><p>The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer.
The man page sources were converted to YODL format (another
- excellent piece of Open Source software, available at
- <A
-HREF="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/"
-TARGET="_top"
-> ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/</A
->) and updated for the Samba 2.0
+ excellent piece of Open Source software, available at <a href="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/" target="_top">
+ ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/</a>) and updated for the Samba 2.0
release by Jeremy Allison. The conversion to DocBook for
- Samba 2.2 was done by Gerald Carter</P
-></DIV
-></BODY
-></HTML
-> \ No newline at end of file
+ Samba 2.2 was done by Gerald Carter. The conversion to DocBook XML 4.2 for
+ Samba 3.0 was done by Alexander Bokovoy.</p></div></div></body></html>
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/smbd.8.html b/docs/htmldocs/smbd.8.html
index 65f5f95b8d..5b71bd7196 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/smbd.8.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/smbd.8.html
@@ -1,780 +1,183 @@
-<!DOCTYPE HTML PUBLIC "-//W3C//DTD HTML 4.01//EN">
-<HTML
-><HEAD
-><TITLE
->smbd</TITLE
-><META
-NAME="GENERATOR"
-CONTENT="Modular DocBook HTML Stylesheet Version 1.76b+
-"></HEAD
-><BODY
-CLASS="REFENTRY"
-BGCOLOR="#FFFFFF"
-TEXT="#000000"
-LINK="#0000FF"
-VLINK="#840084"
-ALINK="#0000FF"
-><H1
-><A
-NAME="SMBD">smbd</H1
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFNAMEDIV"
-><A
-NAME="AEN5"
-></A
-><H2
->Name</H2
->smbd&nbsp;--&nbsp;server to provide SMB/CIFS services to clients</DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSYNOPSISDIV"
-><A
-NAME="AEN8"><H2
->Synopsis</H2
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbd</B
-> [-D] [-F] [-S] [-i] [-h] [-V] [-b] [-d &#60;debug level&#62;] [-l &#60;log directory&#62;] [-p &#60;port number&#62;] [-O &#60;socket option&#62;] [-s &#60;configuration file&#62;]</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN23"
-></A
-><H2
->DESCRIPTION</H2
-><P
->This program is part of the Samba suite.</P
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbd</B
-> is the server daemon that
+<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>smbd</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="smbd.8"></a><div class="titlepage"><div></div><div></div></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>smbd &#8212; server to provide SMB/CIFS services to clients</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><tt class="command">smbd</tt> [-D] [-F] [-S] [-i] [-h] [-V] [-b] [-d &lt;debug level&gt;] [-l &lt;log directory&gt;] [-p &lt;port number&gt;] [-O &lt;socket option&gt;] [-s &lt;configuration file&gt;]</p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This program is part of the <a href="Samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">Samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p><b class="command">smbd</b> is the server daemon that
provides filesharing and printing services to Windows clients.
The server provides filespace and printer services to
clients using the SMB (or CIFS) protocol. This is compatible
with the LanManager protocol, and can service LanManager
clients. These include MSCLIENT 3.0 for DOS, Windows for
Workgroups, Windows 95/98/ME, Windows NT, Windows 2000,
- OS/2, DAVE for Macintosh, and smbfs for Linux.</P
-><P
->An extensive description of the services that the
+ OS/2, DAVE for Macintosh, and smbfs for Linux.</p><p>An extensive description of the services that the
server can provide is given in the man page for the
configuration file controlling the attributes of those
- services (see <A
-HREF="smb.conf.5.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-><TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->smb.conf(5)
- </TT
-></A
->. This man page will not describe the
+ services (see <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a>. This man page will not describe the
services, but will concentrate on the administrative aspects
- of running the server.</P
-><P
->Please note that there are significant security
- implications to running this server, and the <A
-HREF="smb.conf.5.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-><TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->smb.conf(5)</TT
-></A
->
- manpage should be regarded as mandatory reading before
- proceeding with installation.</P
-><P
->A session is created whenever a client requests one.
+ of running the server.</p><p>Please note that there are significant security
+ implications to running this server, and the <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> manual page should be regarded as mandatory reading before
+ proceeding with installation.</p><p>A session is created whenever a client requests one.
Each client gets a copy of the server for each session. This
copy then services all connections made by the client during
that session. When all connections from its client are closed,
- the copy of the server for that client terminates.</P
-><P
->The configuration file, and any files that it includes,
+ the copy of the server for that client terminates.</p><p>The configuration file, and any files that it includes,
are automatically reloaded every minute, if they change. You
can force a reload by sending a SIGHUP to the server. Reloading
the configuration file will not affect connections to any service
that is already established. Either the user will have to
- disconnect from the service, or <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbd</B
-> killed and restarted.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN37"
-></A
-><H2
->OPTIONS</H2
-><P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
->-D</DT
-><DD
-><P
->If specified, this parameter causes
+ disconnect from the service, or <b class="command">smbd</b> killed and restarted.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">-D</span></dt><dd><p>If specified, this parameter causes
the server to operate as a daemon. That is, it detaches
itself and runs in the background, fielding requests
on the appropriate port. Operating the server as a
- daemon is the recommended way of running <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbd</B
-> for
+ daemon is the recommended way of running <b class="command">smbd</b> for
servers that provide more than casual use file and
- print services. This switch is assumed if <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbd
- </B
-> is executed on the command line of a shell.
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-F</DT
-><DD
-><P
->If specified, this parameter causes
- the main <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbd</B
-> process to not daemonize,
+ print services. This switch is assumed if <b class="command">smbd
+ </b> is executed on the command line of a shell.
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-F</span></dt><dd><p>If specified, this parameter causes
+ the main <b class="command">smbd</b> process to not daemonize,
i.e. double-fork and disassociate with the terminal.
Child processes are still created as normal to service
each connection request, but the main process does not
exit. This operation mode is suitable for running
- <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbd</B
-> under process supervisors such
- as <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->supervise</B
-> and <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->svscan</B
->
- from Daniel J. Bernstein's <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->daemontools</B
->
+ <b class="command">smbd</b> under process supervisors such
+ as <b class="command">supervise</b> and <b class="command">svscan</b>
+ from Daniel J. Bernstein's <b class="command">daemontools</b>
package, or the AIX process monitor.
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-S</DT
-><DD
-><P
->If specified, this parameter causes
- <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbd</B
-> to log to standard output rather
- than a file.</P
-></DD
-><DT
->-i</DT
-><DD
-><P
->If this parameter is specified it causes the
- server to run "interactively", not as a daemon, even if the
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-S</span></dt><dd><p>If specified, this parameter causes
+ <b class="command">smbd</b> to log to standard output rather
+ than a file.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-i</span></dt><dd><p>If this parameter is specified it causes the
+ server to run &quot;interactively&quot;, not as a daemon, even if the
server is executed on the command line of a shell. Setting this
parameter negates the implicit deamon mode when run from the
- command line. <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbd</B
-> also logs to standard
- output, as if the <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->-S</B
-> parameter had been
+ command line. <b class="command">smbd</b> also logs to standard
+ output, as if the <b class="command">-S</b> parameter had been
given.
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-h</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Prints the help information (usage)
- for <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbd</B
->.</P
-></DD
-><DT
->-V</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Prints the version number for
- <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbd</B
->.</P
-></DD
-><DT
->-b</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Prints information about how
- Samba was built.</P
-></DD
-><DT
->-d &#60;debug level&#62;</DT
-><DD
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="REPLACEABLE"
-><I
->debuglevel</I
-></TT
-> is an integer
- from 0 to 10. The default value if this parameter is
- not specified is zero.</P
-><P
->The higher this value, the more detail will be
- logged to the log files about the activities of the
- server. At level 0, only critical errors and serious
- warnings will be logged. Level 1 is a reasonable level for
- day to day running - it generates a small amount of
- information about operations carried out.</P
-><P
->Levels above 1 will generate considerable
- amounts of log data, and should only be used when
- investigating a problem. Levels above 3 are designed for
- use only by developers and generate HUGE amounts of log
- data, most of which is extremely cryptic.</P
-><P
->Note that specifying this parameter here will
- override the <A
-HREF="smb.conf.5.html#loglevel"
-TARGET="_top"
->log
- level</A
-> parameter in the <A
-HREF="smb.conf.5.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-> <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->smb.conf(5)</TT
-></A
-> file.</P
-></DD
-><DT
->-l &#60;log directory&#62;</DT
-><DD
-><P
->If specified,
- <TT
-CLASS="REPLACEABLE"
-><I
->log directory</I
-></TT
->
- specifies a log directory into which the "log.smbd" log
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-V</span></dt><dd><p>Prints the version number for
+<b class="command">smbd</b>.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-s &lt;configuration file&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>The file specified contains the
+configuration details required by the server. The
+information in this file includes server-specific
+information such as what printcap file to use, as well
+as descriptions of all the services that the server is
+to provide. See <a href="smb.conf.5.html" target="_top"><tt class="filename">
+smb.conf(5)</tt></a> for more information.
+The default configuration file name is determined at
+compile time.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-d|--debug=debuglevel</span></dt><dd><p><i class="replaceable"><tt>debuglevel</tt></i> is an integer
+from 0 to 10. The default value if this parameter is
+not specified is zero.</p><p>The higher this value, the more detail will be
+logged to the log files about the activities of the
+server. At level 0, only critical errors and serious
+warnings will be logged. Level 1 is a reasonable level for
+day to day running - it generates a small amount of
+information about operations carried out.</p><p>Levels above 1 will generate considerable
+amounts of log data, and should only be used when
+investigating a problem. Levels above 3 are designed for
+use only by developers and generate HUGE amounts of log
+data, most of which is extremely cryptic.</p><p>Note that specifying this parameter here will
+override the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#loglevel" target="_top">log
+level</a> parameter in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html" target="_top">
+<tt class="filename">smb.conf(5)</tt></a> file.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-l|--logfile=logbasename</span></dt><dd><p>File name for log/debug files. The extension
+<tt class="constant">&quot;.client&quot;</tt> will be appended. The log file is
+never removed by the client.
+</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-h|--help</span></dt><dd><p>Print a summary of command line options.
+</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-b</span></dt><dd><p>Prints information about how
+ Samba was built.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-l &lt;log directory&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>If specified,
+ <i class="replaceable"><tt>log directory</tt></i>
+ specifies a log directory into which the &quot;log.smbd&quot; log
file will be created for informational and debug
messages from the running server. The log
file generated is never removed by the server although
- its size may be controlled by the <A
-HREF="smb.conf.5.html#maxlogsize"
-TARGET="_top"
->max log size</A
->
- option in the <A
-HREF="smb.conf.5.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-><TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
-> smb.conf(5)</TT
-></A
-> file. <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->Beware:</I
->
- If the directory specified does not exist, <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbd</B
->
+ its size may be controlled by the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#maxlogsize" target="_top"><i class="parameter"><tt>max log size</tt></i></a>
+ option in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> file. <span class="emphasis"><em>Beware:</em></span>
+ If the directory specified does not exist, <b class="command">smbd</b>
will log to the default debug log location defined at compile time.
- </P
-><P
->The default log directory is specified at
- compile time.</P
-></DD
-><DT
->-O &#60;socket options&#62;</DT
-><DD
-><P
->See the <A
-HREF="smb.conf.5.html#socketoptions"
-TARGET="_top"
->socket options</A
->
- parameter in the <A
-HREF="smb.conf.5.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-><TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->smb.conf(5)
- </TT
-></A
-> file for details.</P
-></DD
-><DT
->-p &#60;port number&#62;</DT
-><DD
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="REPLACEABLE"
-><I
->port number</I
-></TT
-> is a positive integer
+ </p><p>The default log directory is specified at
+ compile time.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-p &lt;port number&gt;</span></dt><dd><p><i class="replaceable"><tt>port number</tt></i> is a positive integer
value. The default value if this parameter is not
- specified is 139.</P
-><P
->This number is the port number that will be
+ specified is 139.</p><p>This number is the port number that will be
used when making connections to the server from client
software. The standard (well-known) port number for the
SMB over TCP is 139, hence the default. If you wish to
run the server as an ordinary user rather than
as root, most systems will require you to use a port
number greater than 1024 - ask your system administrator
- for help if you are in this situation.</P
-><P
->In order for the server to be useful by most
+ for help if you are in this situation.</p><p>In order for the server to be useful by most
clients, should you configure it on a port other
than 139, you will require port redirection services
on port 139, details of which are outlined in rfc1002.txt
- section 4.3.5.</P
-><P
->This parameter is not normally specified except
- in the above situation.</P
-></DD
-><DT
->-s &#60;configuration file&#62;</DT
-><DD
-><P
->The file specified contains the
- configuration details required by the server. The
- information in this file includes server-specific
- information such as what printcap file to use, as well
- as descriptions of all the services that the server is
- to provide. See <A
-HREF="smb.conf.5.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-><TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
-> smb.conf(5)</TT
-></A
-> for more information.
- The default configuration file name is determined at
- compile time.</P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN123"
-></A
-><H2
->FILES</H2
-><P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
-><TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/inetd.conf</TT
-></DT
-><DD
-><P
->If the server is to be run by the
- <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->inetd</B
-> meta-daemon, this file
+ section 4.3.5.</p><p>This parameter is not normally specified except
+ in the above situation.</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>FILES</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term"><tt class="filename">/etc/inetd.conf</tt></span></dt><dd><p>If the server is to be run by the
+ <b class="command">inetd</b> meta-daemon, this file
must contain suitable startup information for the
- meta-daemon. See the <A
-HREF="UNIX_INSTALL.html"
-TARGET="_top"
->UNIX_INSTALL.html</A
->
+ meta-daemon. See the <a href="install.html" target="_top">&quot;How to Install and Test SAMBA&quot;</a>
document for details.
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
-><TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/rc</TT
-></DT
-><DD
-><P
->or whatever initialization script your
- system uses).</P
-><P
->If running the server as a daemon at startup,
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term"><tt class="filename">/etc/rc</tt></span></dt><dd><p>or whatever initialization script your
+ system uses).</p><p>If running the server as a daemon at startup,
this file will need to contain an appropriate startup
- sequence for the server. See the <A
-HREF="UNIX_INSTALL.html"
-TARGET="_top"
->UNIX_INSTALL.html</A
->
- document for details.</P
-></DD
-><DT
-><TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/services</TT
-></DT
-><DD
-><P
->If running the server via the
- meta-daemon <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->inetd</B
->, this file
+ sequence for the server. See the <a href="install.html" target="_top">&quot;How to Install and Test SAMBA&quot;</a>
+ document for details.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><tt class="filename">/etc/services</tt></span></dt><dd><p>If running the server via the
+ meta-daemon <b class="command">inetd</b>, this file
must contain a mapping of service name (e.g., netbios-ssn)
to service port (e.g., 139) and protocol type (e.g., tcp).
- See the <A
-HREF="UNIX_INSTALL.html"
-TARGET="_top"
->UNIX_INSTALL.html</A
->
- document for details.</P
-></DD
-><DT
-><TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/usr/local/samba/lib/smb.conf</TT
-></DT
-><DD
-><P
->This is the default location of the
- <A
-HREF="smb.conf.5.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-><TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->smb.conf</TT
-></A
->
- server configuration file. Other common places that systems
- install this file are <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/usr/samba/lib/smb.conf</TT
->
- and <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/smb.conf</TT
->.</P
-><P
->This file describes all the services the server
- is to make available to clients. See <A
-HREF="smb.conf.5.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-> <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->smb.conf(5)</TT
-></A
-> for more information.</P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN159"
-></A
-><H2
->LIMITATIONS</H2
-><P
->On some systems <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbd</B
-> cannot change uid back
+ See the <a href="install.html" target="_top">&quot;How to Install and Test SAMBA&quot;</a>
+ document for details.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><tt class="filename">/usr/local/samba/lib/smb.conf</tt></span></dt><dd><p>This is the default location of the <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> server configuration file. Other common places that systems
+ install this file are <tt class="filename">/usr/samba/lib/smb.conf</tt>
+ and <tt class="filename">/etc/samba/smb.conf</tt>.</p><p>This file describes all the services the server
+ is to make available to clients. See <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> for more information.</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>LIMITATIONS</h2><p>On some systems <b class="command">smbd</b> cannot change uid back
to root after a setuid() call. Such systems are called
trapdoor uid systems. If you have such a system,
you will be unable to connect from a client (such as a PC) as
two different users at once. Attempts to connect the
second user will result in access denied or
- similar.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN163"
-></A
-><H2
->ENVIRONMENT VARIABLES</H2
-><P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
-><TT
-CLASS="ENVAR"
->PRINTER</TT
-></DT
-><DD
-><P
->If no printer name is specified to
+ similar.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>ENVIRONMENT VARIABLES</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term"><tt class="envar">PRINTER</tt></span></dt><dd><p>If no printer name is specified to
printable services, most systems will use the value of
- this variable (or <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->lp</TT
-> if this variable is
+ this variable (or <tt class="constant">lp</tt> if this variable is
not defined) as the name of the printer to use. This
- is not specific to the server, however.</P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN172"
-></A
-><H2
->PAM INTERACTION</H2
-><P
->Samba uses PAM for authentication (when presented with a plaintext
+ is not specific to the server, however.</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>PAM INTERACTION</h2><p>Samba uses PAM for authentication (when presented with a plaintext
password), for account checking (is this account disabled?) and for
session management. The degree too which samba supports PAM is restricted
- by the limitations of the SMB protocol and the
- <A
-HREF="smb.conf.5.html#OBEYPAMRESRICTIONS"
-TARGET="_top"
->obey pam restricions</A
->
- smb.conf paramater. When this is set, the following restrictions apply:
- </P
-><P
-></P
-><UL
-><LI
-><P
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->Account Validation</I
->: All accesses to a
+ by the limitations of the SMB protocol and the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#OBEYPAMRESRICTIONS" target="_top"><i class="parameter"><tt>obey
+ pam restricions</tt></i></a> <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> paramater. When this is set, the following restrictions apply:
+ </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Account Validation</em></span>: All accesses to a
samba server are checked
against PAM to see if the account is vaild, not disabled and is permitted to
login at this time. This also applies to encrypted logins.
- </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->Session Management</I
->: When not using share
+ </p></li><li><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Session Management</em></span>: When not using share
level secuirty, users must pass PAM's session checks before access
is granted. Note however, that this is bypassed in share level secuirty.
Note also that some older pam configuration files may need a line
added for session support.
- </P
-></LI
-></UL
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN183"
-></A
-><H2
->VERSION</H2
-><P
->This man page is correct for version 3.0 of
- the Samba suite.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN186"
-></A
-><H2
->DIAGNOSTICS</H2
-><P
->Most diagnostics issued by the server are logged
+ </p></li></ul></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3.0 of
+ the Samba suite.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>DIAGNOSTICS</h2><p>Most diagnostics issued by the server are logged
in a specified log file. The log file name is specified
- at compile time, but may be overridden on the command line.</P
-><P
->The number and nature of diagnostics available depends
+ at compile time, but may be overridden on the command line.</p><p>The number and nature of diagnostics available depends
on the debug level used by the server. If you have problems, set
- the debug level to 3 and peruse the log files.</P
-><P
->Most messages are reasonably self-explanatory. Unfortunately,
+ the debug level to 3 and peruse the log files.</p><p>Most messages are reasonably self-explanatory. Unfortunately,
at the time this man page was created, there are too many diagnostics
available in the source code to warrant describing each and every
diagnostic. At this stage your best bet is still to grep the
source code and inspect the conditions that gave rise to the
- diagnostics you are seeing.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN191"
-></A
-><H2
->SIGNALS</H2
-><P
->Sending the <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbd</B
-> a SIGHUP will cause it to
- reload its <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->smb.conf</TT
-> configuration
- file within a short period of time.</P
-><P
->To shut down a user's <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbd</B
-> process it is recommended
- that <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->SIGKILL (-9)</B
-> <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->NOT</I
->
+ diagnostics you are seeing.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>SIGNALS</h2><p>Sending the <b class="command">smbd</b> a SIGHUP will cause it to
+ reload its <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> configuration
+ file within a short period of time.</p><p>To shut down a user's <b class="command">smbd</b> process it is recommended
+ that <b class="command">SIGKILL (-9)</b> <span class="emphasis"><em>NOT</em></span>
be used, except as a last resort, as this may leave the shared
memory area in an inconsistent state. The safe way to terminate
- an <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbd</B
-> is to send it a SIGTERM (-15) signal and wait for
- it to die on its own.</P
-><P
->The debug log level of <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbd</B
-> may be raised
- or lowered using <A
-HREF="smbcontrol.1.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbcontrol(1)
- </B
-></A
-> program (SIGUSR[1|2] signals are no longer used in
- Samba 2.2). This is to allow transient problems to be diagnosed,
- whilst still running at a normally low log level.</P
-><P
->Note that as the signal handlers send a debug write,
- they are not re-entrant in <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbd</B
->. This you should wait until
- <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbd</B
-> is in a state of waiting for an incoming SMB before
+ an <b class="command">smbd</b> is to send it a SIGTERM (-15) signal and wait for
+ it to die on its own.</p><p>The debug log level of <b class="command">smbd</b> may be raised
+ or lowered using <a href="smbcontrol.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbcontrol</span>(1)</span></a> program (SIGUSR[1|2] signals are no longer
+ used since Samba 2.2). This is to allow transient problems to be diagnosed,
+ whilst still running at a normally low log level.</p><p>Note that as the signal handlers send a debug write,
+ they are not re-entrant in <b class="command">smbd</b>. This you should wait until
+ <b class="command">smbd</b> is in a state of waiting for an incoming SMB before
issuing them. It is possible to make the signal handlers safe
by un-blocking the signals before the select call and re-blocking
- them after, however this would affect performance.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN208"
-></A
-><H2
->SEE ALSO</H2
-><P
->hosts_access(5), <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->inetd(8)</B
->,
- <A
-HREF="nmbd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->nmbd(8)</B
-></A
->,
- <A
-HREF="smb.conf.5.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-><TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->smb.conf(5)</TT
->
- </A
->, <A
-HREF="smbclient.1.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbclient(1)
- </B
-></A
->, <A
-HREF="testparm.1.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
-> testparm(1)</B
-></A
->, <A
-HREF="testprns.1.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-> <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->testprns(1)</B
-></A
->, and the Internet RFC's
- <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->rfc1001.txt</TT
->, <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->rfc1002.txt</TT
->.
+ them after, however this would affect performance.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>SEE ALSO</h2><p><a href="hosts_access.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">hosts_access</span>(5)</span></a>, <a href="inetd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">inetd</span>(8)</span></a>, <a href="nmbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">nmbd</span>(8)</span></a>, <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a>, <a href="smbclient.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbclient</span>(1)</span></a>, <a href="testparm.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">testparm</span>(1)</span></a>, <a href="testprns.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">testprns</span>(1)</span></a>, and the
+ Internet RFC's <tt class="filename">rfc1001.txt</tt>, <tt class="filename">rfc1002.txt</tt>.
In addition the CIFS (formerly SMB) specification is available
- as a link from the Web page <A
-HREF="http://samba.org/cifs/"
-TARGET="_top"
->
- http://samba.org/cifs/</A
->.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN225"
-></A
-><H2
->AUTHOR</H2
-><P
->The original Samba software and related utilities
+ as a link from the Web page <a href="http://samba.org/cifs/" target="_top">
+ http://samba.org/cifs/</a>.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
- to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</P
-><P
->The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer.
+ to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</p><p>The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer.
The man page sources were converted to YODL format (another
- excellent piece of Open Source software, available at
- <A
-HREF="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/"
-TARGET="_top"
-> ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/</A
->) and updated for the Samba 2.0
+ excellent piece of Open Source software, available at <a href="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/" target="_top">
+ ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/</a>) and updated for the Samba 2.0
release by Jeremy Allison. The conversion to DocBook for
- Samba 2.2 was done by Gerald Carter</P
-></DIV
-></BODY
-></HTML
-> \ No newline at end of file
+ Samba 2.2 was done by Gerald Carter. The conversion to DocBook XML 4.2 for
+ Samba 3.0 was done by Alexander Bokovoy.</p></div></div></body></html>
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/smbmnt.8.html b/docs/htmldocs/smbmnt.8.html
index 06b9fb1fd3..8caedac3f5 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/smbmnt.8.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/smbmnt.8.html
@@ -1,179 +1,24 @@
-<!DOCTYPE HTML PUBLIC "-//W3C//DTD HTML 4.01 Transitional//EN">
-<HTML
-><HEAD
-><TITLE
->smbmnt</TITLE
-><META
-NAME="GENERATOR"
-CONTENT="Modular DocBook HTML Stylesheet Version 1.77"></HEAD
-><BODY
-CLASS="REFENTRY"
-BGCOLOR="#FFFFFF"
-TEXT="#000000"
-LINK="#0000FF"
-VLINK="#840084"
-ALINK="#0000FF"
-><H1
-><A
-NAME="SMBMNT"
-></A
->smbmnt</H1
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFNAMEDIV"
-><A
-NAME="AEN5"
-></A
-><H2
->Name</H2
->smbmnt&nbsp;--&nbsp;helper utility for mounting SMB filesystems</DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSYNOPSISDIV"
-><A
-NAME="AEN8"
-></A
-><H2
->Synopsis</H2
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbmnt</B
-> {mount-point} [-s &lt;share&gt;] [-r] [-u &lt;uid&gt;] [-g &lt;gid&gt;] [-f &lt;mask&gt;] [-d &lt;mask&gt;] [-o &lt;options&gt;]</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN19"
-></A
-><H2
->DESCRIPTION</H2
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbmnt</B
-> is a helper application used
+<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>smbmnt</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="smbmnt.8"></a><div class="titlepage"><div></div><div></div></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>smbmnt &#8212; helper utility for mounting SMB filesystems</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><tt class="command">smbmnt</tt> {mount-point} [-s &lt;share&gt;] [-r] [-u &lt;uid&gt;] [-g &lt;gid&gt;] [-f &lt;mask&gt;] [-d &lt;mask&gt;] [-o &lt;options&gt;] [-h]</p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p><b class="command">smbmnt</b> is a helper application used
by the smbmount program to do the actual mounting of SMB shares.
- <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbmnt</B
-> can be installed setuid root if you want
- normal users to be able to mount their SMB shares.</P
-><P
->A setuid smbmnt will only allow mounts on directories owned
- by the user, and that the user has write permission on.</P
-><P
->The <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbmnt</B
-> program is normally invoked
- by <A
-HREF="smbmount.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbmount(8)</B
->
- </A
->. It should not be invoked directly by users. </P
-><P
->smbmount searches the normal PATH for smbmnt. You must ensure
- that the smbmnt version in your path matches the smbmount used.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN30"
-></A
-><H2
->OPTIONS</H2
-><P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
->-r</DT
-><DD
-><P
->mount the filesystem read-only
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-u uid</DT
-><DD
-><P
->specify the uid that the files will
- be owned by </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-g gid</DT
-><DD
-><P
->specify the gid that the files will be
- owned by </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-f mask</DT
-><DD
-><P
->specify the octal file mask applied
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-d mask</DT
-><DD
-><P
->specify the octal directory mask
- applied </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-o options</DT
-><DD
-><P
-> list of options that are passed as-is to smbfs, if this
+ <b class="command">smbmnt</b> can be installed setuid root if you want
+ normal users to be able to mount their SMB shares.</p><p>A setuid smbmnt will only allow mounts on directories owned
+ by the user, and that the user has write permission on.</p><p>The <b class="command">smbmnt</b> program is normally invoked
+ by <a href="smbmount.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbmount</span>(8)</span></a>. It should not be invoked directly by users. </p><p>smbmount searches the normal PATH for smbmnt. You must ensure
+ that the smbmnt version in your path matches the smbmount used.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">-r</span></dt><dd><p>mount the filesystem read-only
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-u uid</span></dt><dd><p>specify the uid that the files will
+ be owned by </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-g gid</span></dt><dd><p>specify the gid that the files will be
+ owned by </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-f mask</span></dt><dd><p>specify the octal file mask applied
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-d mask</span></dt><dd><p>specify the octal directory mask
+ applied </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-o options</span></dt><dd><p>
+ list of options that are passed as-is to smbfs, if this
command is run on a 2.4 or higher Linux kernel.
- </P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN57"
-></A
-><H2
->AUTHOR</H2
-><P
->Volker Lendecke, Andrew Tridgell, Michael H. Warfield
- and others.</P
-><P
->The current maintainer of smbfs and the userspace
- tools <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbmount</B
->, <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbumount</B
->,
- and <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbmnt</B
-> is <A
-HREF="mailto:urban@teststation.com"
-TARGET="_top"
->Urban Widmark</A
->.
- The <A
-HREF="mailto:samba@samba.org"
-TARGET="_top"
->SAMBA Mailing list</A
->
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-h|--help</span></dt><dd><p>Print a summary of command line options.
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>Volker Lendecke, Andrew Tridgell, Michael H. Warfield
+ and others.</p><p>The current maintainer of smbfs and the userspace
+ tools <b class="command">smbmount</b>, <b class="command">smbumount</b>,
+ and <b class="command">smbmnt</b> is <a href="mailto:urban@teststation.com" target="_top">Urban Widmark</a>.
+ The <a href="mailto:samba@samba.org" target="_top">SAMBA Mailing list</a>
is the preferred place to ask questions regarding these programs.
- </P
-><P
->The conversion of this manpage for Samba 2.2 was performed
- by Gerald Carter</P
-></DIV
-></BODY
-></HTML
-> \ No newline at end of file
+ </p><p>The conversion of this manpage for Samba 2.2 was performed
+ by Gerald Carter. The conversion to DocBook XML 4.2 for Samba 3.0
+ was done by Alexander Bokovoy.</p></div></div></body></html>
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/smbmount.8.html b/docs/htmldocs/smbmount.8.html
index 81a3ac04b2..233dee51d7 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/smbmount.8.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/smbmount.8.html
@@ -1,321 +1,72 @@
-<!DOCTYPE HTML PUBLIC "-//W3C//DTD HTML 4.01 Transitional//EN">
-<HTML
-><HEAD
-><TITLE
->smbmount</TITLE
-><META
-NAME="GENERATOR"
-CONTENT="Modular DocBook HTML Stylesheet Version 1.77"></HEAD
-><BODY
-CLASS="REFENTRY"
-BGCOLOR="#FFFFFF"
-TEXT="#000000"
-LINK="#0000FF"
-VLINK="#840084"
-ALINK="#0000FF"
-><H1
-><A
-NAME="SMBMOUNT"
-></A
->smbmount</H1
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFNAMEDIV"
-><A
-NAME="AEN5"
-></A
-><H2
->Name</H2
->smbmount&nbsp;--&nbsp;mount an smbfs filesystem</DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSYNOPSISDIV"
-><A
-NAME="AEN8"
-></A
-><H2
->Synopsis</H2
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbmount</B
-> {service} {mount-point} [-o options]</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN14"
-></A
-><H2
->DESCRIPTION</H2
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbmount</B
-> mounts a Linux SMB filesystem. It
- is usually invoked as <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->mount.smbfs</B
-> by
- the <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->mount(8)</B
-> command when using the
- "-t smbfs" option. This command only works in Linux, and the kernel must
- support the smbfs filesystem. </P
-><P
->Options to <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbmount</B
-> are specified as a comma-separated
+<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>smbmount</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="smbmount.8"></a><div class="titlepage"><div></div><div></div></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>smbmount &#8212; mount an smbfs filesystem</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><tt class="command">smbmount</tt> {service} {mount-point} [-o options]</p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p><b class="command">smbmount</b> mounts a Linux SMB filesystem. It
+ is usually invoked as <b class="command">mount.smbfs</b> by
+ the <a href="mount.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">mount</span>(8)</span></a> command when using the
+ &quot;-t smbfs&quot; option. This command only works in Linux, and the kernel must
+ support the smbfs filesystem. </p><p>Options to <b class="command">smbmount</b> are specified as a comma-separated
list of key=value pairs. It is possible to send options other
than those listed here, assuming that smbfs supports them. If
you get mount failures, check your kernel log for errors on
- unknown options.</P
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbmount</B
-> is a daemon. After mounting it keeps running until
+ unknown options.</p><p><b class="command">smbmount</b> is a daemon. After mounting it keeps running until
the mounted smbfs is umounted. It will log things that happen
- when in daemon mode using the "machine name" smbmount, so
- typically this output will end up in <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->log.smbmount</TT
->. The
- <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbmount</B
-> process may also be called mount.smbfs.</P
-><P
-><SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->NOTE:</I
-></SPAN
-> <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbmount</B
->
- calls <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbmnt(8)</B
-> to do the actual mount. You
- must make sure that <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbmnt</B
-> is in the path so
- that it can be found. </P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN31"
-></A
-><H2
->OPTIONS</H2
-><P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
->username=&lt;arg&gt;</DT
-><DD
-><P
->specifies the username to connect as. If
- this is not given, then the environment variable <TT
-CLASS="ENVAR"
-> USER</TT
-> is used. This option can also take the
- form "user%password" or "user/workgroup" or
- "user/workgroup%password" to allow the password and workgroup
- to be specified as part of the username.</P
-></DD
-><DT
->password=&lt;arg&gt;</DT
-><DD
-><P
->specifies the SMB password. If this
+ when in daemon mode using the &quot;machine name&quot; smbmount, so
+ typically this output will end up in <tt class="filename">log.smbmount</tt>. The <b class="command">
+ smbmount</b> process may also be called mount.smbfs.</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> <b class="command">smbmount</b>
+ calls <a href="smbmnt.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbmnt</span>(8)</span></a> to do the actual mount. You
+ must make sure that <b class="command">smbmnt</b> is in the path so
+ that it can be found. </p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">username=&lt;arg&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>specifies the username to connect as. If
+ this is not given, then the environment variable <tt class="envar">
+ USER</tt> is used. This option can also take the
+ form &quot;user%password&quot; or &quot;user/workgroup&quot; or
+ &quot;user/workgroup%password&quot; to allow the password and workgroup
+ to be specified as part of the username.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">password=&lt;arg&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>specifies the SMB password. If this
option is not given then the environment variable
- <TT
-CLASS="ENVAR"
->PASSWD</TT
-> is used. If it can find
- no password <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbmount</B
-> will prompt
+ <tt class="envar">PASSWD</tt> is used. If it can find
+ no password <b class="command">smbmount</b> will prompt
for a passeword, unless the guest option is
- given. </P
-><P
-> Note that passwords which contain the argument delimiter
+ given. </p><p>
+ Note that passwords which contain the argument delimiter
character (i.e. a comma ',') will failed to be parsed correctly
on the command line. However, the same password defined
in the PASSWD environment variable or a credentials file (see
below) will be read correctly.
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
->credentials=&lt;filename&gt;</DT
-><DD
-><P
->specifies a file that contains a username
- and/or password. The format of the file is:</P
-><P
-> <PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
-> username = &lt;value&gt;
- password = &lt;value&gt;
- </PRE
->
- </P
-><P
->This is preferred over having passwords in plaintext in a
- shared file, such as <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/fstab</TT
->. Be sure to protect any
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term">credentials=&lt;filename&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>specifies a file that contains a username and/or password.
+The format of the file is:
+</p><pre class="programlisting">
+username = &lt;value&gt;
+password = &lt;value&gt;
+</pre><p>This is preferred over having passwords in plaintext in a
+ shared file, such as <tt class="filename">/etc/fstab</tt>. Be sure to protect any
credentials file properly.
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
->netbiosname=&lt;arg&gt;</DT
-><DD
-><P
->sets the source NetBIOS name. It defaults
- to the local hostname. </P
-></DD
-><DT
->uid=&lt;arg&gt;</DT
-><DD
-><P
->sets the uid that will own all files on
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term">krb</span></dt><dd><p>Use kerberos (Active Directory). </p></dd><dt><span class="term">netbiosname=&lt;arg&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>sets the source NetBIOS name. It defaults
+ to the local hostname. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">uid=&lt;arg&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>sets the uid that will own all files on
the mounted filesystem.
It may be specified as either a username or a numeric uid.
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
->gid=&lt;arg&gt;</DT
-><DD
-><P
->sets the gid that will own all files on
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term">gid=&lt;arg&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>sets the gid that will own all files on
the mounted filesystem.
It may be specified as either a groupname or a numeric
- gid. </P
-></DD
-><DT
->port=&lt;arg&gt;</DT
-><DD
-><P
->sets the remote SMB port number. The default
- is 139. </P
-></DD
-><DT
->fmask=&lt;arg&gt;</DT
-><DD
-><P
->sets the file mask. This determines the
+ gid. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">port=&lt;arg&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>sets the remote SMB port number. The default
+ is 139. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">fmask=&lt;arg&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>sets the file mask. This determines the
permissions that remote files have in the local filesystem.
- The default is based on the current umask. </P
-></DD
-><DT
->dmask=&lt;arg&gt;</DT
-><DD
-><P
->sets the directory mask. This determines the
+ This is not a umask, but the actual permissions for the files.
+ The default is based on the current umask. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">dmask=&lt;arg&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>Sets the directory mask. This determines the
permissions that remote directories have in the local filesystem.
- The default is based on the current umask. </P
-></DD
-><DT
->debug=&lt;arg&gt;</DT
-><DD
-><P
->sets the debug level. This is useful for
+ This is not a umask, but the actual permissions for the directories.
+ The default is based on the current umask. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">debug=&lt;arg&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>Sets the debug level. This is useful for
tracking down SMB connection problems. A suggested value to
start with is 4. If set too high there will be a lot of
- output, possibly hiding the useful output.</P
-></DD
-><DT
->ip=&lt;arg&gt;</DT
-><DD
-><P
->sets the destination host or IP address.
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
->workgroup=&lt;arg&gt;</DT
-><DD
-><P
->sets the workgroup on the destination </P
-></DD
-><DT
->sockopt=&lt;arg&gt;</DT
-><DD
-><P
->sets the TCP socket options. See the <A
-HREF="smb.conf.5.html#SOCKETOPTIONS"
-TARGET="_top"
-><TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->smb.conf
- </TT
-></A
-> <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->socket options</I
-></TT
-> option.
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
->scope=&lt;arg&gt;</DT
-><DD
-><P
->sets the NetBIOS scope </P
-></DD
-><DT
->guest</DT
-><DD
-><P
->don't prompt for a password </P
-></DD
-><DT
->ro</DT
-><DD
-><P
->mount read-only </P
-></DD
-><DT
->rw</DT
-><DD
-><P
->mount read-write </P
-></DD
-><DT
->iocharset=&lt;arg&gt;</DT
-><DD
-><P
-> sets the charset used by the Linux side for codepage
+ output, possibly hiding the useful output.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">ip=&lt;arg&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>Sets the destination host or IP address.
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term">workgroup=&lt;arg&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>Sets the workgroup on the destination </p></dd><dt><span class="term">sockopt=&lt;arg&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>Sets the TCP socket options. See the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#SOCKETOPTIONS" target="_top"><a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a></a> <i class="parameter"><tt>socket options</tt></i> option.
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term">scope=&lt;arg&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>Sets the NetBIOS scope </p></dd><dt><span class="term">guest</span></dt><dd><p>Don't prompt for a password </p></dd><dt><span class="term">ro</span></dt><dd><p>mount read-only </p></dd><dt><span class="term">rw</span></dt><dd><p>mount read-write </p></dd><dt><span class="term">iocharset=&lt;arg&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>
+ sets the charset used by the Linux side for codepage
to charset translations (NLS). Argument should be the
name of a charset, like iso8859-1. (Note: only kernel
2.4.0 or later)
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
->codepage=&lt;arg&gt;</DT
-><DD
-><P
-> sets the codepage the server uses. See the iocharset
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term">codepage=&lt;arg&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>
+ sets the codepage the server uses. See the iocharset
option. Example value cp850. (Note: only kernel 2.4.0
or later)
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
->ttl=&lt;arg&gt;</DT
-><DD
-><P
-> sets how long a directory listing is cached in milliseconds
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term">ttl=&lt;arg&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>
+ sets how long a directory listing is cached in milliseconds
(also affects visibility of file size and date
changes). A higher value means that changes on the
server take longer to be noticed but it can give
@@ -324,141 +75,34 @@ CLASS="PARAMETER"
like 10000ms (10 seconds) is probably more reasonable
in many cases.
(Note: only kernel 2.4.2 or later)
- </P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN125"
-></A
-><H2
->ENVIRONMENT VARIABLES</H2
-><P
->The variable <TT
-CLASS="ENVAR"
->USER</TT
-> may contain the username of the
+ </p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>ENVIRONMENT VARIABLES</h2><p>The variable <tt class="envar">USER</tt> may contain the username of the
person using the client. This information is used only if the
protocol level is high enough to support session-level
passwords. The variable can be used to set both username and
- password by using the format username%password.</P
-><P
->The variable <TT
-CLASS="ENVAR"
->PASSWD</TT
-> may contain the password of the
+ password by using the format username%password.</p><p>The variable <tt class="envar">PASSWD</tt> may contain the password of the
person using the client. This information is used only if the
protocol level is high enough to support session-level
- passwords.</P
-><P
->The variable <TT
-CLASS="ENVAR"
->PASSWD_FILE</TT
-> may contain the pathname
+ passwords.</p><p>The variable <tt class="envar">PASSWD_FILE</tt> may contain the pathname
of a file to read the password from. A single line of input is
- read and used as the password.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN133"
-></A
-><H2
->BUGS</H2
-><P
->Passwords and other options containing , can not be handled.
+ read and used as the password.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>BUGS</h2><p>Passwords and other options containing , can not be handled.
For passwords an alternative way of passing them is in a credentials
- file or in the PASSWD environment.</P
-><P
->The credentials file does not handle usernames or passwords with
- leading space.</P
-><P
->One smbfs bug is important enough to mention here, even if it
- is a bit misplaced:</P
-><P
-></P
-><UL
-><LI
-><P
->Mounts sometimes stop working. This is usually
+ file or in the PASSWD environment.</p><p>The credentials file does not handle usernames or passwords with
+ leading space.</p><p>One smbfs bug is important enough to mention here, even if it
+ is a bit misplaced:</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Mounts sometimes stop working. This is usually
caused by smbmount terminating. Since smbfs needs smbmount to
reconnect when the server disconnects, the mount will eventually go
dead. An umount/mount normally fixes this. At least 2 ways to
- trigger this bug are known.</P
-></LI
-></UL
-><P
->Note that the typical response to a bug report is suggestion
+ trigger this bug are known.</p></li></ul></div><p>Note that the typical response to a bug report is suggestion
to try the latest version first. So please try doing that first,
and always include which versions you use of relevant software
- when reporting bugs (minimum: samba, kernel, distribution)</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN142"
-></A
-><H2
->SEE ALSO</H2
-><P
->Documentation/filesystems/smbfs.txt in the linux kernel
- source tree may contain additional options and information.</P
-><P
->FreeBSD also has a smbfs, but it is not related to smbmount</P
-><P
->For Solaris, HP-UX and others you may want to look at
- <A
-HREF="smbsh.1.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbsh(1)</B
-></A
-> or at other
- solutions, such as sharity or perhaps replacing the SMB server with
- a NFS server.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN149"
-></A
-><H2
->AUTHOR</H2
-><P
->Volker Lendecke, Andrew Tridgell, Michael H. Warfield
- and others.</P
-><P
->The current maintainer of smbfs and the userspace
- tools <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbmount</B
->, <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbumount</B
->,
- and <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbmnt</B
-> is <A
-HREF="mailto:urban@teststation.com"
-TARGET="_top"
->Urban Widmark</A
->.
- The <A
-HREF="mailto:samba@samba.org"
-TARGET="_top"
->SAMBA Mailing list</A
->
+ when reporting bugs (minimum: samba, kernel, distribution)</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>SEE ALSO</h2><p>Documentation/filesystems/smbfs.txt in the linux kernel
+ source tree may contain additional options and information.</p><p>FreeBSD also has a smbfs, but it is not related to smbmount</p><p>For Solaris, HP-UX and others you may want to look at <a href="smbsh.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbsh</span>(1)</span></a> or at other solutions, such as
+ Sharity or perhaps replacing the SMB server with a NFS server.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>Volker Lendecke, Andrew Tridgell, Michael H. Warfield
+ and others.</p><p>The current maintainer of smbfs and the userspace
+ tools <b class="command">smbmount</b>, <b class="command">smbumount</b>,
+ and <b class="command">smbmnt</b> is <a href="mailto:urban@teststation.com" target="_top">Urban Widmark</a>.
+ The <a href="mailto:samba@samba.org" target="_top">SAMBA Mailing list</a>
is the preferred place to ask questions regarding these programs.
- </P
-><P
->The conversion of this manpage for Samba 2.2 was performed
- by Gerald Carter</P
-></DIV
-></BODY
-></HTML
-> \ No newline at end of file
+ </p><p>The conversion of this manpage for Samba 2.2 was performed
+ by Gerald Carter. The conversion to DocBook XML 4.2 for Samba 3.0
+ was done by Alexander Bokovoy.</p></div></div></body></html>
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/smbpasswd.5.html b/docs/htmldocs/smbpasswd.5.html
index ac3ab94691..556b637f4f 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/smbpasswd.5.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/smbpasswd.5.html
@@ -1,357 +1,89 @@
-<!DOCTYPE HTML PUBLIC "-//W3C//DTD HTML 4.01 Transitional//EN">
-<HTML
-><HEAD
-><TITLE
->smbpasswd</TITLE
-><META
-NAME="GENERATOR"
-CONTENT="Modular DocBook HTML Stylesheet Version 1.77"></HEAD
-><BODY
-CLASS="REFENTRY"
-BGCOLOR="#FFFFFF"
-TEXT="#000000"
-LINK="#0000FF"
-VLINK="#840084"
-ALINK="#0000FF"
-><H1
-><A
-NAME="SMBPASSWD"
-></A
->smbpasswd</H1
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFNAMEDIV"
-><A
-NAME="AEN5"
-></A
-><H2
->Name</H2
->smbpasswd&nbsp;--&nbsp;The Samba encrypted password file</DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSYNOPSISDIV"
-><A
-NAME="AEN8"
-></A
-><H2
->Synopsis</H2
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->smbpasswd</TT
-></P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN11"
-></A
-><H2
->DESCRIPTION</H2
-><P
->This tool is part of the <A
-HREF="samba.7.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-> Samba</A
-> suite.</P
-><P
->smbpasswd is the Samba encrypted password file. It contains
+<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>smbpasswd</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="smbpasswd.5"></a><div class="titlepage"><div></div><div></div></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>smbpasswd &#8212; The Samba encrypted password file</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><p><tt class="filename">smbpasswd</tt></p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This tool is part of the <a href="Samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">Samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p>smbpasswd is the Samba encrypted password file. It contains
the username, Unix user id and the SMB hashed passwords of the
user, as well as account flag information and the time the
password was last changed. This file format has been evolving with
- Samba and has had several different formats in the past. </P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN16"
-></A
-><H2
->FILE FORMAT</H2
-><P
->The format of the smbpasswd file used by Samba 2.2
- is very similar to the familiar Unix <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->passwd(5)</TT
->
+ Samba and has had several different formats in the past. </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>FILE FORMAT</h2><p>The format of the smbpasswd file used by Samba 2.2
+ is very similar to the familiar Unix <tt class="filename">passwd(5)</tt>
file. It is an ASCII file containing one line for each user. Each field
ithin each line is separated from the next by a colon. Any entry
beginning with '#' is ignored. The smbpasswd file contains the
- following information for each user: </P
-><P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
->name</DT
-><DD
-><P
-> This is the user name. It must be a name that
- already exists in the standard UNIX passwd file. </P
-></DD
-><DT
->uid</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This is the UNIX uid. It must match the uid
+ following information for each user: </p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">name</span></dt><dd><p> This is the user name. It must be a name that
+ already exists in the standard UNIX passwd file. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">uid</span></dt><dd><p>This is the UNIX uid. It must match the uid
field for the same user entry in the standard UNIX passwd file.
If this does not match then Samba will refuse to recognize
this smbpasswd file entry as being valid for a user.
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
->Lanman Password Hash</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This is the LANMAN hash of the user's password,
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term">Lanman Password Hash</span></dt><dd><p>This is the LANMAN hash of the user's password,
encoded as 32 hex digits. The LANMAN hash is created by DES
encrypting a well known string with the user's password as the
DES key. This is the same password used by Windows 95/98 machines.
Note that this password hash is regarded as weak as it is
vulnerable to dictionary attacks and if two users choose the
same password this entry will be identical (i.e. the password
- is not "salted" as the UNIX password is). If the user has a
- null password this field will contain the characters "NO PASSWORD"
+ is not &quot;salted&quot; as the UNIX password is). If the user has a
+ null password this field will contain the characters &quot;NO PASSWORD&quot;
as the start of the hex string. If the hex string is equal to
32 'X' characters then the user's account is marked as
- <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->disabled</TT
-> and the user will not be able to
- log onto the Samba server. </P
-><P
-><SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->WARNING !!</I
-></SPAN
-> Note that, due to
+ <tt class="constant">disabled</tt> and the user will not be able to
+ log onto the Samba server. </p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>WARNING !!</em></span> Note that, due to
the challenge-response nature of the SMB/CIFS authentication
protocol, anyone with a knowledge of this password hash will
be able to impersonate the user on the network. For this
- reason these hashes are known as <SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->plain text
- equivalents</I
-></SPAN
-> and must <SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->NOT</I
-></SPAN
-> be made
+ reason these hashes are known as <span class="emphasis"><em>plain text
+ equivalents</em></span> and must <span class="emphasis"><em>NOT</em></span> be made
available to anyone but the root user. To protect these passwords
the smbpasswd file is placed in a directory with read and
traverse access only to the root user and the smbpasswd file
itself must be set to be read/write only by root, with no
- other access. </P
-></DD
-><DT
->NT Password Hash</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This is the Windows NT hash of the user's
+ other access. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">NT Password Hash</span></dt><dd><p>This is the Windows NT hash of the user's
password, encoded as 32 hex digits. The Windows NT hash is
created by taking the user's password as represented in
16-bit, little-endian UNICODE and then applying the MD4
- (internet rfc1321) hashing algorithm to it. </P
-><P
->This password hash is considered more secure than
+ (internet rfc1321) hashing algorithm to it. </p><p>This password hash is considered more secure than
the LANMAN Password Hash as it preserves the case of the
password and uses a much higher quality hashing algorithm.
However, it is still the case that if two users choose the same
password this entry will be identical (i.e. the password is
- not "salted" as the UNIX password is). </P
-><P
-><SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->WARNING !!</I
-></SPAN
->. Note that, due to
+ not &quot;salted&quot; as the UNIX password is). </p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>WARNING !!</em></span>. Note that, due to
the challenge-response nature of the SMB/CIFS authentication
protocol, anyone with a knowledge of this password hash will
be able to impersonate the user on the network. For this
- reason these hashes are known as <SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->plain text
- equivalents</I
-></SPAN
-> and must <SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->NOT</I
-></SPAN
-> be made
+ reason these hashes are known as <span class="emphasis"><em>plain text
+ equivalents</em></span> and must <span class="emphasis"><em>NOT</em></span> be made
available to anyone but the root user. To protect these passwords
the smbpasswd file is placed in a directory with read and
traverse access only to the root user and the smbpasswd file
itself must be set to be read/write only by root, with no
- other access. </P
-></DD
-><DT
->Account Flags</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This section contains flags that describe
+ other access. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">Account Flags</span></dt><dd><p>This section contains flags that describe
the attributes of the users account. In the Samba 2.2 release
this field is bracketed by '[' and ']' characters and is always
13 characters in length (including the '[' and ']' characters).
- The contents of this field may be any of the characters.
- </P
-><P
-></P
-><UL
-><LI
-><P
-><SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->U</I
-></SPAN
-> - This means
- this is a "User" account, i.e. an ordinary user. Only User
+ The contents of this field may be any of the following characters:
+ </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><span class="emphasis"><em>U</em></span> - This means
+ this is a &quot;User&quot; account, i.e. an ordinary user. Only User
and Workstation Trust accounts are currently supported
- in the smbpasswd file. </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->N</I
-></SPAN
-> - This means the
+ in the smbpasswd file. </p></li><li><p><span class="emphasis"><em>N</em></span> - This means the
account has no password (the passwords in the fields LANMAN
Password Hash and NT Password Hash are ignored). Note that this
- will only allow users to log on with no password if the <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
-> null passwords</I
-></TT
-> parameter is set in the <A
-HREF="smb.conf.5.html#NULLPASSWORDS"
-TARGET="_top"
-><TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->smb.conf(5)
- </TT
-></A
-> config file. </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->D</I
-></SPAN
-> - This means the account
- is disabled and no SMB/CIFS logins will be allowed for
- this user. </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->W</I
-></SPAN
-> - This means this account
- is a "Workstation Trust" account. This kind of account is used
+ will only allow users to log on with no password if the <i class="parameter"><tt>
+ null passwords</tt></i> parameter is set in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#NULLPASSWORDS" target="_top"><a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a></a> config file. </p></li><li><p><span class="emphasis"><em>D</em></span> - This means the account
+ is disabled and no SMB/CIFS logins will be allowed for this user. </p></li><li><p><span class="emphasis"><em>W</em></span> - This means this account
+ is a &quot;Workstation Trust&quot; account. This kind of account is used
in the Samba PDC code stream to allow Windows NT Workstations
- and Servers to join a Domain hosted by a Samba PDC. </P
-></LI
-></UL
-><P
->Other flags may be added as the code is extended in future.
- The rest of this field space is filled in with spaces. </P
-></DD
-><DT
->Last Change Time</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This field consists of the time the account was
+ and Servers to join a Domain hosted by a Samba PDC. </p></li></ul></div><p>Other flags may be added as the code is extended in future.
+ The rest of this field space is filled in with spaces. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">Last Change Time</span></dt><dd><p>This field consists of the time the account was
last modified. It consists of the characters 'LCT-' (standing for
- "Last Change Time") followed by a numeric encoding of the UNIX time
+ &quot;Last Change Time&quot;) followed by a numeric encoding of the UNIX time
in seconds since the epoch (1970) that the last change was made.
- </P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-><P
->All other colon separated fields are ignored at this time.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN73"
-></A
-><H2
->VERSION</H2
-><P
->This man page is correct for version 3.0 of
- the Samba suite.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN76"
-></A
-><H2
->SEE ALSO</H2
-><P
-><A
-HREF="smbpasswd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbpasswd(8)</B
-></A
->,
- <A
-HREF="samba.7.html"
-TARGET="_top"
->samba(7)</A
->, and
+ </p></dd></dl></div><p>All other colon separated fields are ignored at this time.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3.0 of
+ the Samba suite.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>SEE ALSO</h2><p><a href="smbpasswd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbpasswd</span>(8)</span></a>, <a href="Samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">Samba</span>(7)</span></a>, and
the Internet RFC1321 for details on the MD4 algorithm.
- </P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN82"
-></A
-><H2
->AUTHOR</H2
-><P
->The original Samba software and related utilities
+ </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
- to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</P
-><P
->The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer.
+ to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</p><p>The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer.
The man page sources were converted to YODL format (another
- excellent piece of Open Source software, available at
- <A
-HREF="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/"
-TARGET="_top"
-> ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/</A
->) and updated for the Samba 2.0
+ excellent piece of Open Source software, available at <a href="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/" target="_top">
+ ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/</a>) and updated for the Samba 2.0
release by Jeremy Allison. The conversion to DocBook for
- Samba 2.2 was done by Gerald Carter</P
-></DIV
-></BODY
-></HTML
-> \ No newline at end of file
+ Samba 2.2 was done by Gerald Carter. The conversion to DocBook XML 4.2
+ for Samba 3.0 was done by Alexander Bokovoy.</p></div></div></body></html>
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/smbpasswd.8.html b/docs/htmldocs/smbpasswd.8.html
index da3cb9f601..7612fdd775 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/smbpasswd.8.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/smbpasswd.8.html
@@ -1,626 +1,163 @@
-<!DOCTYPE HTML PUBLIC "-//W3C//DTD HTML 4.01//EN">
-<HTML
-><HEAD
-><TITLE
->smbpasswd</TITLE
-><META
-NAME="GENERATOR"
-CONTENT="Modular DocBook HTML Stylesheet Version 1.76b+
-"></HEAD
-><BODY
-CLASS="REFENTRY"
-BGCOLOR="#FFFFFF"
-TEXT="#000000"
-LINK="#0000FF"
-VLINK="#840084"
-ALINK="#0000FF"
-><H1
-><A
-NAME="SMBPASSWD">smbpasswd</H1
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFNAMEDIV"
-><A
-NAME="AEN5"
-></A
-><H2
->Name</H2
->smbpasswd&nbsp;--&nbsp;change a user's SMB password</DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSYNOPSISDIV"
-><A
-NAME="AEN8"><H2
->Synopsis</H2
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbpasswd</B
-> [-a] [-x] [-d] [-e] [-D debuglevel] [-n] [-r &#60;remote machine&#62;] [-R &#60;name resolve order&#62;] [-m] [-U username[%password]] [-h] [-s] [-w pass] [-i] [-L] [username]</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN27"
-></A
-><H2
->DESCRIPTION</H2
-><P
->This tool is part of the <A
-HREF="samba.7.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-> Samba</A
-> suite.</P
-><P
->The smbpasswd program has several different
- functions, depending on whether it is run by the <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->root</I
->
- user or not. When run as a normal user it allows the user to change
+<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>smbpasswd</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="smbpasswd.8"></a><div class="titlepage"><div></div><div></div></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>smbpasswd &#8212; change a user's SMB password</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><tt class="command">smbpasswd</tt> [-a] [-x] [-d] [-e] [-D debuglevel] [-n] [-r &lt;remote machine&gt;] [-R &lt;name resolve order&gt;] [-m] [-U username[%password]] [-h] [-s] [-w pass] [-i] [-L] [username]</p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This tool is part of the <a href="Samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">Samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p>The smbpasswd program has several different
+ functions, depending on whether it is run by the <span class="emphasis"><em>root</em></span> user
+ or not. When run as a normal user it allows the user to change
the password used for their SMB sessions on any machines that store
- SMB passwords. </P
-><P
->By default (when run with no arguments) it will attempt to
+ SMB passwords. </p><p>By default (when run with no arguments) it will attempt to
change the current user's SMB password on the local machine. This is
- similar to the way the <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->passwd(1)</B
-> program works.
- <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbpasswd</B
-> differs from how the passwd program works
- however in that it is not <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->setuid root</I
-> but works in
- a client-server mode and communicates with a locally running
- <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbd(8)</B
->. As a consequence in order for this to
+ similar to the way the <b class="command">passwd(1)</b> program works. <b class="command">
+ smbpasswd</b> differs from how the passwd program works
+ however in that it is not <span class="emphasis"><em>setuid root</em></span> but works in
+ a client-server mode and communicates with a
+ locally running <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a>. As a consequence in order for this to
succeed the smbd daemon must be running on the local machine. On a
UNIX machine the encrypted SMB passwords are usually stored in
- the <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->smbpasswd(5)</TT
-> file. </P
-><P
->When run by an ordinary user with no options, smbpasswd
+ the <a href="smbpasswd.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbpasswd</span>(5)</span></a> file. </p><p>When run by an ordinary user with no options, smbpasswd
will prompt them for their old SMB password and then ask them
for their new password twice, to ensure that the new password
was typed correctly. No passwords will be echoed on the screen
whilst being typed. If you have a blank SMB password (specified by
- the string "NO PASSWORD" in the smbpasswd file) then just press
- the &#60;Enter&#62; key when asked for your old password. </P
-><P
->smbpasswd can also be used by a normal user to change their
+ the string &quot;NO PASSWORD&quot; in the smbpasswd file) then just press
+ the &lt;Enter&gt; key when asked for your old password. </p><p>smbpasswd can also be used by a normal user to change their
SMB password on remote machines, such as Windows NT Primary Domain
- Controllers. See the (-r) and -U options below. </P
-><P
->When run by root, smbpasswd allows new users to be added
+ Controllers. See the (<i class="parameter"><tt>-r</tt></i>) and <i class="parameter"><tt>-U</tt></i> options
+ below. </p><p>When run by root, smbpasswd allows new users to be added
and deleted in the smbpasswd file, as well as allows changes to
- the attributes of the user in this file to be made. When run by root,
- <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbpasswd</B
-> accesses the local smbpasswd file
+ the attributes of the user in this file to be made. When run by root, <b class="command">
+ smbpasswd</b> accesses the local smbpasswd file
directly, thus enabling changes to be made even if smbd is not
- running. </P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN43"
-></A
-><H2
->OPTIONS</H2
-><P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
->-a</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This option specifies that the username
+ running. </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">-a</span></dt><dd><p>This option specifies that the username
following should be added to the local smbpasswd file, with the
- new password typed (type &#60;Enter&#62; for the old password). This
+ new password typed (type &lt;Enter&gt; for the old password). This
option is ignored if the username following already exists in
the smbpasswd file and it is treated like a regular change
password command. Note that the default passdb backends require
the user to already exist in the system password file (usually
- <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/passwd</TT
->), else the request to add the
- user will fail. </P
-><P
->This option is only available when running smbpasswd
- as root. </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-x</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This option specifies that the username
+ <tt class="filename">/etc/passwd</tt>), else the request to add the
+ user will fail. </p><p>This option is only available when running smbpasswd
+ as root. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-x</span></dt><dd><p>This option specifies that the username
following should be deleted from the local smbpasswd file.
- </P
-><P
->This option is only available when running smbpasswd as
- root.</P
-></DD
-><DT
->-d</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This option specifies that the username following
- should be <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->disabled</TT
-> in the local smbpasswd
- file. This is done by writing a <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->'D'</TT
-> flag
+ </p><p>This option is only available when running smbpasswd as
+ root.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-d</span></dt><dd><p>This option specifies that the username following
+ should be <tt class="constant">disabled</tt> in the local smbpasswd
+ file. This is done by writing a <tt class="constant">'D'</tt> flag
into the account control space in the smbpasswd file. Once this
is done all attempts to authenticate via SMB using this username
- will fail. </P
-><P
->If the smbpasswd file is in the 'old' format (pre-Samba 2.0
+ will fail. </p><p>If the smbpasswd file is in the 'old' format (pre-Samba 2.0
format) there is no space in the user's password entry to write
- this information and the command will FAIL. See <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbpasswd(5)
- </B
-> for details on the 'old' and new password file formats.
- </P
-><P
->This option is only available when running smbpasswd as
- root.</P
-></DD
-><DT
->-e</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This option specifies that the username following
- should be <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->enabled</TT
-> in the local smbpasswd file,
+ this information and the command will FAIL. See <a href="smbpasswd.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbpasswd</span>(5)</span></a> for details on the 'old' and new password file formats.
+ </p><p>This option is only available when running smbpasswd as
+ root.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-e</span></dt><dd><p>This option specifies that the username following
+ should be <tt class="constant">enabled</tt> in the local smbpasswd file,
if the account was previously disabled. If the account was not
disabled this option has no effect. Once the account is enabled then
- the user will be able to authenticate via SMB once again. </P
-><P
->If the smbpasswd file is in the 'old' format, then <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
-> smbpasswd</B
-> will FAIL to enable the account.
- See <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbpasswd (5)</B
-> for
- details on the 'old' and new password file formats. </P
-><P
->This option is only available when running smbpasswd as root.
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-D debuglevel</DT
-><DD
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="REPLACEABLE"
-><I
->debuglevel</I
-></TT
-> is an integer
+ the user will be able to authenticate via SMB once again. </p><p>If the smbpasswd file is in the 'old' format, then <b class="command">
+ smbpasswd</b> will FAIL to enable the account.
+ See <a href="smbpasswd.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbpasswd</span>(5)</span></a> for
+ details on the 'old' and new password file formats. </p><p>This option is only available when running smbpasswd as root.
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-D debuglevel</span></dt><dd><p><i class="replaceable"><tt>debuglevel</tt></i> is an integer
from 0 to 10. The default value if this parameter is not specified
- is zero. </P
-><P
->The higher this value, the more detail will be logged to the
+ is zero. </p><p>The higher this value, the more detail will be logged to the
log files about the activities of smbpasswd. At level 0, only
- critical errors and serious warnings will be logged. </P
-><P
->Levels above 1 will generate considerable amounts of log
+ critical errors and serious warnings will be logged. </p><p>Levels above 1 will generate considerable amounts of log
data, and should only be used when investigating a problem. Levels
above 3 are designed for use only by developers and generate
HUGE amounts of log data, most of which is extremely cryptic.
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-n</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This option specifies that the username following
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-n</span></dt><dd><p>This option specifies that the username following
should have their password set to null (i.e. a blank password) in
- the local smbpasswd file. This is done by writing the string "NO
- PASSWORD" as the first part of the first password stored in the
- smbpasswd file. </P
-><P
->Note that to allow users to logon to a Samba server once
- the password has been set to "NO PASSWORD" in the smbpasswd
+ the local smbpasswd file. This is done by writing the string &quot;NO
+ PASSWORD&quot; as the first part of the first password stored in the
+ smbpasswd file. </p><p>Note that to allow users to logon to a Samba server once
+ the password has been set to &quot;NO PASSWORD&quot; in the smbpasswd
file the administrator must set the following parameter in the [global]
- section of the <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->smb.conf</TT
-> file : </P
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->null passwords = yes</B
-></P
-><P
->This option is only available when running smbpasswd as
- root.</P
-></DD
-><DT
->-r remote machine name</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This option allows a user to specify what machine
+ section of the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file : </p><p><b class="command">null passwords = yes</b></p><p>This option is only available when running smbpasswd as
+ root.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-r remote machine name</span></dt><dd><p>This option allows a user to specify what machine
they wish to change their password on. Without this parameter
- smbpasswd defaults to the local host. The <TT
-CLASS="REPLACEABLE"
-><I
->remote
- machine name</I
-></TT
-> is the NetBIOS name of the SMB/CIFS
+ smbpasswd defaults to the local host. The <i class="replaceable"><tt>remote
+ machine name</tt></i> is the NetBIOS name of the SMB/CIFS
server to contact to attempt the password change. This name is
resolved into an IP address using the standard name resolution
- mechanism in all programs of the Samba suite. See the <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->-R
- name resolve order</I
-></TT
-> parameter for details on changing
- this resolving mechanism. </P
-><P
->The username whose password is changed is that of the
- current UNIX logged on user. See the <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->-U username</I
-></TT
->
+ mechanism in all programs of the Samba suite. See the <i class="parameter"><tt>-R
+ name resolve order</tt></i> parameter for details on changing
+ this resolving mechanism. </p><p>The username whose password is changed is that of the
+ current UNIX logged on user. See the <i class="parameter"><tt>-U username</tt></i>
parameter for details on changing the password for a different
- username. </P
-><P
->Note that if changing a Windows NT Domain password the
+ username. </p><p>Note that if changing a Windows NT Domain password the
remote machine specified must be the Primary Domain Controller for
the domain (Backup Domain Controllers only have a read-only
copy of the user account database and will not allow the password
- change).</P
-><P
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->Note</I
-> that Windows 95/98 do not have
+ change).</p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note</em></span> that Windows 95/98 do not have
a real password database so it is not possible to change passwords
- specifying a Win95/98 machine as remote machine target. </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-R name resolve order</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This option allows the user of smbpasswd to determine
+ specifying a Win95/98 machine as remote machine target. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-R name resolve order</span></dt><dd><p>This option allows the user of smbpasswd to determine
what name resolution services to use when looking up the NetBIOS
- name of the host being connected to. </P
-><P
->The options are :"lmhosts", "host", "wins" and "bcast". They
- cause names to be resolved as follows : </P
-><P
-></P
-><UL
-><LI
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->lmhosts</TT
-> : Lookup an IP
+ name of the host being connected to. </p><p>The options are :&quot;lmhosts&quot;, &quot;host&quot;, &quot;wins&quot; and &quot;bcast&quot;. They
+ cause names to be resolved as follows: </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><tt class="constant">lmhosts</tt>: Lookup an IP
address in the Samba lmhosts file. If the line in lmhosts has
- no name type attached to the NetBIOS name (see the <A
-HREF="lmhosts.5.html"
-TARGET="_top"
->lmhosts(5)</A
-> for details) then
- any name type matches for lookup.</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->host</TT
-> : Do a standard host
- name to IP address resolution, using the system <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/hosts
- </TT
->, NIS, or DNS lookups. This method of name resolution
+ no name type attached to the NetBIOS name (see the <a href="lmhosts.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">lmhosts</span>(5)</span></a> for details) then
+ any name type matches for lookup.</p></li><li><p><tt class="constant">host</tt>: Do a standard host
+ name to IP address resolution, using the system <tt class="filename">/etc/hosts
+ </tt>, NIS, or DNS lookups. This method of name resolution
is operating system depended for instance on IRIX or Solaris this
- may be controlled by the <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/nsswitch.conf</TT
->
+ may be controlled by the <tt class="filename">/etc/nsswitch.conf</tt>
file). Note that this method is only used if the NetBIOS name
type being queried is the 0x20 (server) name type, otherwise
- it is ignored.</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->wins</TT
-> : Query a name with
- the IP address listed in the <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->wins server</I
-></TT
->
+ it is ignored.</p></li><li><p><tt class="constant">wins</tt>: Query a name with
+ the IP address listed in the <i class="parameter"><tt>wins server</tt></i>
parameter. If no WINS server has been specified this method
- will be ignored.</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->bcast</TT
-> : Do a broadcast on
+ will be ignored.</p></li><li><p><tt class="constant">bcast</tt>: Do a broadcast on
each of the known local interfaces listed in the
- <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->interfaces</I
-></TT
-> parameter. This is the least
+ <i class="parameter"><tt>interfaces</tt></i> parameter. This is the least
reliable of the name resolution methods as it depends on the
- target host being on a locally connected subnet.</P
-></LI
-></UL
-><P
->The default order is <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->lmhosts, host, wins, bcast</B
->
- and without this parameter or any entry in the
- <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->smb.conf</TT
-> file the name resolution methods will
- be attempted in this order. </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-m</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This option tells smbpasswd that the account
+ target host being on a locally connected subnet.</p></li></ul></div><p>The default order is <b class="command">lmhosts, host, wins, bcast</b>
+ and without this parameter or any entry in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> file the name resolution methods will
+ be attempted in this order. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-m</span></dt><dd><p>This option tells smbpasswd that the account
being changed is a MACHINE account. Currently this is used
- when Samba is being used as an NT Primary Domain Controller.</P
-><P
->This option is only available when running smbpasswd as root.
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-U username</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This option may only be used in conjunction
- with the <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->-r</I
-></TT
-> option. When changing
+ when Samba is being used as an NT Primary Domain Controller.</p><p>This option is only available when running smbpasswd as root.
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-U username</span></dt><dd><p>This option may only be used in conjunction
+ with the <i class="parameter"><tt>-r</tt></i> option. When changing
a password on a remote machine it allows the user to specify
the user name on that machine whose password will be changed. It
is present to allow users who have different user names on
- different systems to change these passwords. </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-h</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This option prints the help string for <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
-> smbpasswd</B
->, selecting the correct one for running as root
- or as an ordinary user. </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-s</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This option causes smbpasswd to be silent (i.e.
+ different systems to change these passwords. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-h</span></dt><dd><p>This option prints the help string for <b class="command">
+ smbpasswd</b>, selecting the correct one for running as root
+ or as an ordinary user. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-s</span></dt><dd><p>This option causes smbpasswd to be silent (i.e.
not issue prompts) and to read its old and new passwords from
- standard input, rather than from <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/dev/tty</TT
->
- (like the <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->passwd(1)</B
-> program does). This option
- is to aid people writing scripts to drive smbpasswd</P
-></DD
-><DT
->-w password</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This parameter is only available if Samba
+ standard input, rather than from <tt class="filename">/dev/tty</tt>
+ (like the <b class="command">passwd(1)</b> program does). This option
+ is to aid people writing scripts to drive smbpasswd</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-w password</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter is only available if Samba
has been configured to use the experimental
- <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->--with-ldapsam</B
-> option. The <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->-w</I
-></TT
->
+ <b class="command">--with-ldapsam</b> option. The <i class="parameter"><tt>-w</tt></i>
switch is used to specify the password to be used with the
- <A
-HREF="smb.conf.5.html#LDAPADMINDN"
-TARGET="_top"
-><TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->ldap admin
- dn</I
-></TT
-></A
->. Note that the password is stored in
- the <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->private/secrets.tdb</TT
-> and is keyed off
- of the admin's DN. This means that if the value of <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->ldap
- admin dn</I
-></TT
-> ever changes, the password will need to be
+ <a href="smb.conf.5.html#LDAPADMINDN" target="_top"><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap admin
+ dn</tt></i></a>. Note that the password is stored in
+ the <tt class="filename">secrets.tdb</tt> and is keyed off
+ of the admin's DN. This means that if the value of <i class="parameter"><tt>ldap
+ admin dn</tt></i> ever changes, the password will need to be
manually updated as well.
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-i</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This option tells smbpasswd that the account
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-i</span></dt><dd><p>This option tells smbpasswd that the account
being changed is an interdomain trust account. Currently this is used
when Samba is being used as an NT Primary Domain Controller.
- The account contains the info about another trusted domain.</P
-><P
->This option is only available when running smbpasswd as root.
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-L</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Run in local mode.</P
-></DD
-><DT
->username</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This specifies the username for all of the
- <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->root only</I
-> options to operate on. Only root
+ The account contains the info about another trusted domain.</p><p>This option is only available when running smbpasswd as root.
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-L</span></dt><dd><p>Run in local mode.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">username</span></dt><dd><p>This specifies the username for all of the
+ <span class="emphasis"><em>root only</em></span> options to operate on. Only root
can specify this parameter as only root has the permission needed
to modify attributes directly in the local smbpasswd file.
- </P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN173"
-></A
-><H2
->NOTES</H2
-><P
->Since <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbpasswd</B
-> works in client-server
+ </p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>NOTES</h2><p>Since <b class="command">smbpasswd</b> works in client-server
mode communicating with a local smbd for a non-root user then
the smbd daemon must be running for this to work. A common problem
- is to add a restriction to the hosts that may access the <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
-> smbd</B
-> running on the local machine by specifying a
- <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->allow hosts</I
-></TT
-> or <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->deny hosts</I
-></TT
->
- entry in the <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->smb.conf</TT
-> file and neglecting to
- allow "localhost" access to the smbd. </P
-><P
->In addition, the smbpasswd command is only useful if Samba
- has been set up to use encrypted passwords. See the file
- <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->ENCRYPTION.txt</TT
-> in the docs directory for details
- on how to do this. </P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN183"
-></A
-><H2
->VERSION</H2
-><P
->This man page is correct for version 3.0 of
- the Samba suite.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN186"
-></A
-><H2
->SEE ALSO</H2
-><P
-><A
-HREF="smbpasswd.5.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-><TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->smbpasswd(5)</TT
-></A
->,
- <A
-HREF="samba.7.html"
-TARGET="_top"
->samba(7)</A
->
- </P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN192"
-></A
-><H2
->AUTHOR</H2
-><P
->The original Samba software and related utilities
+ is to add a restriction to the hosts that may access the <b class="command">
+ smbd</b> running on the local machine by specifying either <i class="parameter"><tt>allow
+ hosts</tt></i> or <i class="parameter"><tt>deny hosts</tt></i> entry in
+ the <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> file and neglecting to
+ allow &quot;localhost&quot; access to the smbd. </p><p>In addition, the smbpasswd command is only useful if Samba
+ has been set up to use encrypted passwords. See the document <a href="pwencrypt.html" target="_top">
+ &quot;LanMan and NT Password Encryption in Samba&quot;</a> in the docs directory for details
+ on how to do this. </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3.0 of the Samba suite.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>SEE ALSO</h2><p><a href="smbpasswd.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbpasswd</span>(5)</span></a>, <a href="Samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">Samba</span>(7)</span></a>.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
- to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</P
-><P
->The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer.
+ to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</p><p>The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer.
The man page sources were converted to YODL format (another
- excellent piece of Open Source software, available at
- <A
-HREF="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/"
-TARGET="_top"
-> ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/</A
->) and updated for the Samba 2.0
+ excellent piece of Open Source software, available at <a href="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/" target="_top">
+ ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/</a>) and updated for the Samba 2.0
release by Jeremy Allison. The conversion to DocBook for
- Samba 2.2 was done by Gerald Carter</P
-></DIV
-></BODY
-></HTML
-> \ No newline at end of file
+ Samba 2.2 was done by Gerald Carter. The conversion to DocBook XML 4.2
+ for Samba 3.0 was done by Alexander Bokovoy.</p></div></div></body></html>
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/smbsh.1.html b/docs/htmldocs/smbsh.1.html
index bab2b45cdd..935576af6b 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/smbsh.1.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/smbsh.1.html
@@ -1,467 +1,110 @@
-<!DOCTYPE HTML PUBLIC "-//W3C//DTD HTML 4.01//EN">
-<HTML
-><HEAD
-><TITLE
->smbsh</TITLE
-><META
-NAME="GENERATOR"
-CONTENT="Modular DocBook HTML Stylesheet Version 1.76b+
-"></HEAD
-><BODY
-CLASS="REFENTRY"
-BGCOLOR="#FFFFFF"
-TEXT="#000000"
-LINK="#0000FF"
-VLINK="#840084"
-ALINK="#0000FF"
-><H1
-><A
-NAME="SMBSH">smbsh</H1
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFNAMEDIV"
-><A
-NAME="AEN5"
-></A
-><H2
->Name</H2
->smbsh&nbsp;--&nbsp;Allows access to Windows NT filesystem
- using UNIX commands</DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSYNOPSISDIV"
-><A
-NAME="AEN8"><H2
->Synopsis</H2
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbsh</B
-> [-W workgroup] [-U username] [-P prefix] [-R &#60;name resolve order&#62;] [-d &#60;debug level&#62;] [-l logfile] [-L libdir]</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN18"
-></A
-><H2
->DESCRIPTION</H2
-><P
->This tool is part of the <A
-HREF="samba.7.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-> Samba</A
-> suite.</P
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbsh</B
-> allows you to access an NT filesystem
- using UNIX commands such as <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->ls</B
->, <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
-> egrep</B
->, and <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->rcp</B
->. You must use a
- shell that is dynamically linked in order for <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbsh</B
->
- to work correctly.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN28"
-></A
-><H2
->OPTIONS</H2
-><P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
->-W WORKGROUP</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Override the default workgroup specified in the
- workgroup parameter of the <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->smb.conf</TT
-> file
+<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>smbsh</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="smbsh.1"></a><div class="titlepage"><div></div><div></div></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>smbsh &#8212; Allows access to Windows NT filesystem
+ using UNIX commands</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><tt class="command">smbsh</tt> [-W workgroup] [-U username] [-P prefix] [-R &lt;name resolve order&gt;] [-d &lt;debug level&gt;] [-l logfile] [-L libdir]</p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This tool is part of the <a href="Samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">Samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p><b class="command">smbsh</b> allows you to access an NT filesystem
+ using UNIX commands such as <b class="command">ls</b>, <b class="command">
+ egrep</b>, and <b class="command">rcp</b>. You must use a
+ shell that is dynamically linked in order for <b class="command">smbsh</b>
+ to work correctly.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">-W WORKGROUP</span></dt><dd><p>Override the default workgroup specified in the
+ workgroup parameter of the <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> file
for this session. This may be needed to connect to some
- servers. </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-U username[%pass]</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Sets the SMB username or username and password.
+ servers. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-U username[%pass]</span></dt><dd><p>Sets the SMB username or username and password.
If this option is not specified, the user will be prompted for
both the username and the password. If %pass is not specified,
the user will be prompted for the password.
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-P prefix</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This option allows
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-P prefix</span></dt><dd><p>This option allows
the user to set the directory prefix for SMB access. The
default value if this option is not specified is
- <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->smb</I
->.
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-R &#60;name resolve order&#62;</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This option is used to determine what naming
- services and in what order to resolve
- host names to IP addresses. The option takes a space-separated
- string of different name resolution options.</P
-><P
->The options are :"lmhosts", "host", "wins" and "bcast".
- They cause names to be resolved as follows :</P
-><P
-></P
-><UL
-><LI
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->lmhosts</TT
-> :
- Lookup an IP address in the Samba lmhosts file. If the
- line in lmhosts has no name type attached to the
- NetBIOS name
- (see the <A
-HREF="lmhosts.5.html"
-TARGET="_top"
->lmhosts(5)</A
->
- for details) then any name type matches for lookup.
- </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->host</TT
-> :
- Do a standard host name to IP address resolution, using
- the system <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/hosts</TT
->, NIS, or DNS
- lookups. This method of name resolution is operating
- system dependent, for instance on IRIX or Solaris this
- may be controlled by the <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/nsswitch.conf
- </TT
-> file). Note that this method is only used
- if the NetBIOS name type being queried is the 0x20
- (server) name type, otherwise it is ignored.
- </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->wins</TT
-> :
- Query a name with the IP address listed in the
- <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->wins server</I
-></TT
-> parameter. If no
- WINS server has been specified this method will be
- ignored.
- </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->bcast</TT
-> :
- Do a broadcast on each of the known local interfaces
- listed in the <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->interfaces</I
-></TT
->
- parameter. This is the least reliable of the name
- resolution methods as it depends on the target host
- being on a locally connected subnet.
- </P
-></LI
-></UL
-><P
->If this parameter is not set then the name resolve order
- defined in the <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->smb.conf</TT
-> file parameter
- (name resolve order) will be used. </P
-><P
->The default order is lmhosts, host, wins, bcast. Without
- this parameter or any entry in the <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->name resolve order
- </I
-></TT
-> parameter of the <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->smb.conf</TT
->
- file, the name resolution methods will be attempted in this
- order. </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-d &#60;debug level&#62;</DT
-><DD
-><P
->debug level is an integer from 0 to 10.</P
-><P
->The default value if this parameter is not specified
- is zero.</P
-><P
->The higher this value, the more detail will be logged
- about the activities of <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->nmblookup</B
->. At level
- 0, only critical errors and serious warnings will be logged.
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-l logfilename</DT
-><DD
-><P
->If specified causes all debug messages to be
- written to the file specified by <TT
-CLASS="REPLACEABLE"
-><I
->logfilename
- </I
-></TT
->. If not specified then all messages will be
- written to<TT
-CLASS="REPLACEABLE"
-><I
->stderr</I
-></TT
->.
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-L libdir</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This parameter specifies the location of the
- shared libraries used by <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbsh</B
->. The default
+ <span class="emphasis"><em>smb</em></span>.
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-s &lt;configuration file&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>The file specified contains the
+configuration details required by the server. The
+information in this file includes server-specific
+information such as what printcap file to use, as well
+as descriptions of all the services that the server is
+to provide. See <a href="smb.conf.5.html" target="_top"><tt class="filename">
+smb.conf(5)</tt></a> for more information.
+The default configuration file name is determined at
+compile time.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-d|--debug=debuglevel</span></dt><dd><p><i class="replaceable"><tt>debuglevel</tt></i> is an integer
+from 0 to 10. The default value if this parameter is
+not specified is zero.</p><p>The higher this value, the more detail will be
+logged to the log files about the activities of the
+server. At level 0, only critical errors and serious
+warnings will be logged. Level 1 is a reasonable level for
+day to day running - it generates a small amount of
+information about operations carried out.</p><p>Levels above 1 will generate considerable
+amounts of log data, and should only be used when
+investigating a problem. Levels above 3 are designed for
+use only by developers and generate HUGE amounts of log
+data, most of which is extremely cryptic.</p><p>Note that specifying this parameter here will
+override the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#loglevel" target="_top">log
+level</a> parameter in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html" target="_top">
+<tt class="filename">smb.conf(5)</tt></a> file.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-R &lt;name resolve order&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>This option is used to determine what naming
+services and in what order to resolve
+host names to IP addresses. The option takes a space-separated
+string of different name resolution options.</p><p>The options are: &quot;lmhosts&quot;, &quot;host&quot;, &quot;wins&quot; and &quot;bcast&quot;.
+They cause names to be resolved as follows :</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><tt class="constant">lmhosts</tt>:
+Lookup an IP address in the Samba lmhosts file. If the
+line in lmhosts has no name type attached to the
+NetBIOS name
+(see the <a href="lmhosts.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">lmhosts</span>(5)</span></a> for details)
+then any name type matches for lookup.
+</p></li><li><p><tt class="constant">host</tt>:
+Do a standard host name to IP address resolution, using
+the system <tt class="filename">/etc/hosts</tt>, NIS, or DNS
+lookups. This method of name resolution is operating
+system dependent, for instance on IRIX or Solaris this
+may be controlled by the <tt class="filename">/etc/nsswitch.conf
+</tt> file). Note that this method is only used
+if the NetBIOS name type being queried is the 0x20
+(server) name type, otherwise it is ignored.
+</p></li><li><p><tt class="constant">wins</tt>:
+Query a name with the IP address listed in the
+<i class="parameter"><tt>wins server</tt></i> parameter. If no
+WINS server has been specified this method will be
+ignored.
+</p></li><li><p><tt class="constant">bcast</tt>:
+Do a broadcast on each of the known local interfaces
+listed in the <i class="parameter"><tt>interfaces</tt></i>
+parameter. This is the least reliable of the name
+resolution methods as it depends on the target host
+being on a locally connected subnet.
+</p></li></ul></div><p>If this parameter is not set then the name resolve order
+defined in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> file parameter
+(<i class="parameter"><tt>name resolve order</tt></i>) will be used. </p><p>The default order is lmhosts, host, wins, bcast. Without
+this parameter or any entry in the <i class="parameter"><tt>name resolve order
+</tt></i> parameter of the <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> file, the name resolution methods
+will be attempted in this order. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-L libdir</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter specifies the location of the
+ shared libraries used by <b class="command">smbsh</b>. The default
value is specified at compile time.
- </P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN91"
-></A
-><H2
->EXAMPLES</H2
-><P
->To use the <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbsh</B
-> command, execute <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
-> smbsh</B
-> from the prompt and enter the username and password
+ </p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>EXAMPLES</h2><p>To use the <b class="command">smbsh</b> command, execute <b class="command">
+ smbsh</b> from the prompt and enter the username and password
that authenticates you to the machine running the Windows NT
- operating system.</P
-><P
-><TABLE
-BORDER="0"
-BGCOLOR="#E0E0E0"
-WIDTH="100%"
-><TR
-><TD
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
-> <TT
-CLASS="PROMPT"
->system% </TT
-><TT
-CLASS="USERINPUT"
-><B
->smbsh</B
-></TT
->
- <TT
-CLASS="PROMPT"
->Username: </TT
-><TT
-CLASS="USERINPUT"
-><B
->user</B
-></TT
->
- <TT
-CLASS="PROMPT"
->Password: </TT
-><TT
-CLASS="USERINPUT"
-><B
->XXXXXXX</B
-></TT
->
- </PRE
-></TD
-></TR
-></TABLE
-></P
-><P
->Any dynamically linked command you execute from
- this shell will access the <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/smb</TT
-> directory
- using the smb protocol. For example, the command <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->ls /smb
- </B
-> will show a list of workgroups. The command
- <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->ls /smb/MYGROUP </B
-> will show all the machines in
+ operating system.
+</p><pre class="programlisting">
+<tt class="prompt">system% </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>smbsh</tt></b>
+<tt class="prompt">Username: </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>user</tt></b>
+<tt class="prompt">Password: </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>XXXXXXX</tt></b>
+</pre><p>Any dynamically linked command you execute from
+ this shell will access the <tt class="filename">/smb</tt> directory
+ using the smb protocol. For example, the command <b class="command">ls /smb
+ </b> will show a list of workgroups. The command
+ <b class="command">ls /smb/MYGROUP </b> will show all the machines in
the workgroup MYGROUP. The command
- <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->ls /smb/MYGROUP/&#60;machine-name&#62;</B
-> will show the share
- names for that machine. You could then, for example, use the <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
-> cd</B
-> command to change directories, <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->vi</B
-> to
- edit files, and <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->rcp</B
-> to copy files.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN112"
-></A
-><H2
->VERSION</H2
-><P
->This man page is correct for version 3.0 of
- the Samba suite.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN115"
-></A
-><H2
->BUGS</H2
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbsh</B
-> works by intercepting the standard
- libc calls with the dynamically loaded versions in <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
-> smbwrapper.o</TT
->. Not all calls have been "wrapped", so
- some programs may not function correctly under <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbsh
- </B
->.</P
-><P
->Programs which are not dynamically linked cannot make
- use of <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbsh</B
->'s functionality. Most versions
- of UNIX have a <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->file</B
-> command that will
- describe how a program was linked.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN124"
-></A
-><H2
->SEE ALSO</H2
-><P
-><A
-HREF="smbd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbd(8)</B
-></A
->,
- <A
-HREF="smb.conf.5.html"
-TARGET="_top"
->smb.conf(5)</A
->
- </P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN130"
-></A
-><H2
->AUTHOR</H2
-><P
->The original Samba software and related utilities
+ <b class="command">ls /smb/MYGROUP/&lt;machine-name&gt;</b> will show the share
+ names for that machine. You could then, for example, use the <b class="command">
+ cd</b> command to change directories, <b class="command">vi</b> to
+ edit files, and <b class="command">rcp</b> to copy files.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3.0 of the Samba suite.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>BUGS</h2><p><b class="command">smbsh</b> works by intercepting the standard
+ libc calls with the dynamically loaded versions in <tt class="filename">
+ smbwrapper.o</tt>. Not all calls have been &quot;wrapped&quot;, so
+ some programs may not function correctly under <b class="command">smbsh
+ </b>.</p><p>Programs which are not dynamically linked cannot make
+ use of <b class="command">smbsh</b>'s functionality. Most versions
+ of UNIX have a <b class="command">file</b> command that will
+ describe how a program was linked.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>SEE ALSO</h2><p><a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a>, <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a></p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
- to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</P
-><P
->The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer.
+ to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</p><p>The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer.
The man page sources were converted to YODL format (another
- excellent piece of Open Source software, available at
- <A
-HREF="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/"
-TARGET="_top"
-> ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/</A
->) and updated for the Samba 2.0
+ excellent piece of Open Source software, available at <a href="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/" target="_top">
+ ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/</a>) and updated for the Samba 2.0
release by Jeremy Allison. The conversion to DocBook for
- Samba 2.2 was done by Gerald Carter</P
-></DIV
-></BODY
-></HTML
-> \ No newline at end of file
+ Samba 2.2 was done by Gerald Carter. The conversion to DocBook XML 4.2
+ for Samba 3.0 was done by Alexander Bokovoy.</p></div></div></body></html>
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/smbspool.8.html b/docs/htmldocs/smbspool.8.html
index 8dc2fbbd63..186f30ebcf 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/smbspool.8.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/smbspool.8.html
@@ -1,227 +1,35 @@
-<!DOCTYPE HTML PUBLIC "-//W3C//DTD HTML 4.01 Transitional//EN">
-<HTML
-><HEAD
-><TITLE
->smbspool</TITLE
-><META
-NAME="GENERATOR"
-CONTENT="Modular DocBook HTML Stylesheet Version 1.77"></HEAD
-><BODY
-CLASS="REFENTRY"
-BGCOLOR="#FFFFFF"
-TEXT="#000000"
-LINK="#0000FF"
-VLINK="#840084"
-ALINK="#0000FF"
-><H1
-><A
-NAME="SMBSPOOL"
-></A
->smbspool</H1
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFNAMEDIV"
-><A
-NAME="AEN5"
-></A
-><H2
->Name</H2
->smbspool&nbsp;--&nbsp;send a print file to an SMB printer</DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSYNOPSISDIV"
-><A
-NAME="AEN8"
-></A
-><H2
->Synopsis</H2
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbspool</B
-> [job] [user] [title] [copies] [options] [filename]</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN17"
-></A
-><H2
->DESCRIPTION</H2
-><P
->This tool is part of the <A
-HREF="samba.7.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-> Samba</A
-> suite.</P
-><P
->smbspool is a very small print spooling program that
+<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>smbspool</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="smbspool.8"></a><div class="titlepage"><div></div><div></div></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>smbspool &#8212; send a print file to an SMB printer</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><tt class="command">smbspool</tt> {job} {user} {title} {copies} {options} [filename]</p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This tool is part of the <a href="Samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">Samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p>smbspool is a very small print spooling program that
sends a print file to an SMB printer. The command-line arguments
are position-dependent for compatibility with the Common UNIX
Printing System, but you can use smbspool with any printing system
- or from a program or script.</P
-><P
-><SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->DEVICE URI</I
-></SPAN
-></P
-><P
->smbspool specifies the destination using a Uniform Resource
- Identifier ("URI") with a method of "smb". This string can take
- a number of forms:</P
-><P
-></P
-><UL
-><LI
-><P
->smb://server/printer</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->smb://workgroup/server/printer</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->smb://username:password@server/printer</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->smb://username:password@workgroup/server/printer
- </P
-></LI
-></UL
-><P
->smbspool tries to get the URI from argv[0]. If argv[0]
- contains the name of the program then it looks in the <TT
-CLASS="ENVAR"
-> DEVICE_URI</TT
-> environment variable.</P
-><P
->Programs using the <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->exec(2)</B
-> functions can
+ or from a program or script.</p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>DEVICE URI</em></span></p><p>smbspool specifies the destination using a Uniform Resource
+ Identifier (&quot;URI&quot;) with a method of &quot;smb&quot;. This string can take
+ a number of forms:</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>smb://server/printer</p></li><li><p>smb://workgroup/server/printer</p></li><li><p>smb://username:password@server/printer</p></li><li><p>smb://username:password@workgroup/server/printer</p></li></ul></div><p>smbspool tries to get the URI from argv[0]. If argv[0]
+ contains the name of the program then it looks in the <tt class="envar">
+ DEVICE_URI</tt> environment variable.</p><p>Programs using the <b class="command">exec(2)</b> functions can
pass the URI in argv[0], while shell scripts must set the
- <TT
-CLASS="ENVAR"
->DEVICE_URI</TT
-> environment variable prior to
- running smbspool.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN39"
-></A
-><H2
->OPTIONS</H2
-><P
-></P
-><UL
-><LI
-><P
->The job argument (argv[1]) contains the
+ <tt class="envar">DEVICE_URI</tt> environment variable prior to
+ running smbspool.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>The job argument (argv[1]) contains the
job ID number and is presently not used by smbspool.
- </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->The user argument (argv[2]) contains the
+ </p></li><li><p>The user argument (argv[2]) contains the
print user's name and is presently not used by smbspool.
- </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->The title argument (argv[3]) contains the
+ </p></li><li><p>The title argument (argv[3]) contains the
job title string and is passed as the remote file name
- when sending the print job.</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->The copies argument (argv[4]) contains
+ when sending the print job.</p></li><li><p>The copies argument (argv[4]) contains
the number of copies to be printed of the named file. If
no filename is provided then this argument is not used by
- smbspool.</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->The options argument (argv[5]) contains
+ smbspool.</p></li><li><p>The options argument (argv[5]) contains
the print options in a single string and is currently
- not used by smbspool.</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->The filename argument (argv[6]) contains the
+ not used by smbspool.</p></li><li><p>The filename argument (argv[6]) contains the
name of the file to print. If this argument is not specified
- then the print file is read from the standard input.</P
-></LI
-></UL
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN54"
-></A
-><H2
->VERSION</H2
-><P
->This man page is correct for version 2.2 of
- the Samba suite.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN57"
-></A
-><H2
->SEE ALSO</H2
-><P
-><A
-HREF="smbd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbd(8)</B
-></A
->,
- and <A
-HREF="samba.7.html"
-TARGET="_top"
->samba(7)</A
->.
- </P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN63"
-></A
-><H2
->AUTHOR</H2
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbspool</B
-> was written by Michael Sweet
- at Easy Software Products.</P
-><P
->The original Samba software and related utilities
+ then the print file is read from the standard input.</p></li></ul></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3.0 of the Samba suite.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>SEE ALSO</h2><p><a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> and <a href="Samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">Samba</span>(7)</span></a>.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p><b class="command">smbspool</b> was written by Michael Sweet
+ at Easy Software Products.</p><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
- to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</P
-><P
->The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer.
+ to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</p><p>The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer.
The man page sources were converted to YODL format (another
- excellent piece of Open Source software, available at
- <A
-HREF="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/"
-TARGET="_top"
-> ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/</A
->) and updated for the Samba 2.0
+ excellent piece of Open Source software, available at <a href="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/" target="_top">
+ ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/</a>) and updated for the Samba 2.0
release by Jeremy Allison. The conversion to DocBook for
- Samba 2.2 was done by Gerald Carter</P
-></DIV
-></BODY
-></HTML
-> \ No newline at end of file
+ Samba 2.2 was done by Gerald Carter. The conversion to DocBook XML 4.2
+ for Samba 3.0 was done by Alexander Bokovoy.</p></div></div></body></html>
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/smbstatus.1.html b/docs/htmldocs/smbstatus.1.html
index fb7e14fadd..c1be6234c3 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/smbstatus.1.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/smbstatus.1.html
@@ -1,223 +1,44 @@
-<!DOCTYPE HTML PUBLIC "-//W3C//DTD HTML 4.01 Transitional//EN">
-<HTML
-><HEAD
-><TITLE
->smbstatus</TITLE
-><META
-NAME="GENERATOR"
-CONTENT="Modular DocBook HTML Stylesheet Version 1.77"></HEAD
-><BODY
-CLASS="REFENTRY"
-BGCOLOR="#FFFFFF"
-TEXT="#000000"
-LINK="#0000FF"
-VLINK="#840084"
-ALINK="#0000FF"
-><H1
-><A
-NAME="SMBSTATUS"
-></A
->smbstatus</H1
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFNAMEDIV"
-><A
-NAME="AEN5"
-></A
-><H2
->Name</H2
->smbstatus&nbsp;--&nbsp;report on current Samba connections</DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSYNOPSISDIV"
-><A
-NAME="AEN8"
-></A
-><H2
->Synopsis</H2
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbstatus</B
-> [-P] [-b] [-d &lt;debug level&gt;] [-v] [-L] [-B] [-p] [-S] [-s &lt;configuration file&gt;] [-u &lt;username&gt;]</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN21"
-></A
-><H2
->DESCRIPTION</H2
-><P
->This tool is part of the <A
-HREF="samba.7.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-> Samba</A
-> suite.</P
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbstatus</B
-> is a very simple program to
- list the current Samba connections.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN27"
-></A
-><H2
->OPTIONS</H2
-><P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
->-P|--profile</DT
-><DD
-><P
->If samba has been compiled with the
+<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>smbstatus</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="smbstatus.1"></a><div class="titlepage"><div></div><div></div></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>smbstatus &#8212; report on current Samba connections</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><tt class="command">smbstatus</tt> [-P] [-b] [-d &lt;debug level&gt;] [-v] [-L] [-B] [-p] [-S] [-s &lt;configuration file&gt;] [-u &lt;username&gt;]</p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This tool is part of the <a href="Samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">Samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p><b class="command">smbstatus</b> is a very simple program to
+ list the current Samba connections.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">-P|--profile</span></dt><dd><p>If samba has been compiled with the
profiling option, print only the contents of the profiling
- shared memory area.</P
-></DD
-><DT
->-b|--brief</DT
-><DD
-><P
->gives brief output.</P
-></DD
-><DT
->-d|--debug=&lt;debuglevel&gt;</DT
-><DD
-><P
->sets debugging to specified level</P
-></DD
-><DT
->-v|--verbose</DT
-><DD
-><P
->gives verbose output.</P
-></DD
-><DT
->-L|--locks</DT
-><DD
-><P
->causes smbstatus to only list locks.</P
-></DD
-><DT
->-B|--byterange</DT
-><DD
-><P
->causes smbstatus to include byte range locks.
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-p|--processes</DT
-><DD
-><P
->print a list of <A
-HREF="smbd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-> <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbd(8)</B
-></A
-> processes and exit.
- Useful for scripting.</P
-></DD
-><DT
->-S|--shares</DT
-><DD
-><P
->causes smbstatus to only list shares.</P
-></DD
-><DT
->-s|--conf=&lt;configuration file&gt;</DT
-><DD
-><P
->The default configuration file name is
- determined at compile time. The file specified contains the
- configuration details required by the server. See <A
-HREF="smb.conf.5.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-><TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->smb.conf(5)</TT
->
- </A
-> for more information.</P
-></DD
-><DT
->-u|--user=&lt;username&gt;</DT
-><DD
-><P
->selects information relevant to
- <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->username</I
-></TT
-> only.</P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN75"
-></A
-><H2
->VERSION</H2
-><P
->This man page is correct for version 3.0 of
- the Samba suite.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN78"
-></A
-><H2
->SEE ALSO</H2
-><P
-><A
-HREF="smbd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbd(8)</B
-></A
-> and
- <A
-HREF="smb.conf.5.html"
-TARGET="_top"
->smb.conf(5)</A
->.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN84"
-></A
-><H2
->AUTHOR</H2
-><P
->The original Samba software and related utilities
+ shared memory area.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-b|--brief</span></dt><dd><p>gives brief output.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-V</span></dt><dd><p>Prints the version number for
+<b class="command">smbd</b>.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-s &lt;configuration file&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>The file specified contains the
+configuration details required by the server. The
+information in this file includes server-specific
+information such as what printcap file to use, as well
+as descriptions of all the services that the server is
+to provide. See <a href="smb.conf.5.html" target="_top"><tt class="filename">
+smb.conf(5)</tt></a> for more information.
+The default configuration file name is determined at
+compile time.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-d|--debug=debuglevel</span></dt><dd><p><i class="replaceable"><tt>debuglevel</tt></i> is an integer
+from 0 to 10. The default value if this parameter is
+not specified is zero.</p><p>The higher this value, the more detail will be
+logged to the log files about the activities of the
+server. At level 0, only critical errors and serious
+warnings will be logged. Level 1 is a reasonable level for
+day to day running - it generates a small amount of
+information about operations carried out.</p><p>Levels above 1 will generate considerable
+amounts of log data, and should only be used when
+investigating a problem. Levels above 3 are designed for
+use only by developers and generate HUGE amounts of log
+data, most of which is extremely cryptic.</p><p>Note that specifying this parameter here will
+override the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#loglevel" target="_top">log
+level</a> parameter in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html" target="_top">
+<tt class="filename">smb.conf(5)</tt></a> file.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-l|--logfile=logbasename</span></dt><dd><p>File name for log/debug files. The extension
+<tt class="constant">&quot;.client&quot;</tt> will be appended. The log file is
+never removed by the client.
+</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-v|--verbose</span></dt><dd><p>gives verbose output.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-L|--locks</span></dt><dd><p>causes smbstatus to only list locks.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-B|--byterange</span></dt><dd><p>causes smbstatus to include byte range locks.
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-p|--processes</span></dt><dd><p>print a list of <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> processes and exit.
+ Useful for scripting.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-S|--shares</span></dt><dd><p>causes smbstatus to only list shares.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-h|--help</span></dt><dd><p>Print a summary of command line options.
+</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-u|--user=&lt;username&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>selects information relevant to
+ <i class="parameter"><tt>username</tt></i> only.</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3.0 of
+ the Samba suite.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>SEE ALSO</h2><p><a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> and <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a>.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
- to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</P
-><P
->The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer.
+ to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</p><p>The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer.
The man page sources were converted to YODL format (another
- excellent piece of Open Source software, available at
- <A
-HREF="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/"
-TARGET="_top"
-> ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/</A
->) and updated for the Samba 2.0
+ excellent piece of Open Source software, available at <a href="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/" target="_top">
+ ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/</a>) and updated for the Samba 2.0
release by Jeremy Allison. The conversion to DocBook for
- Samba 2.2 was done by Gerald Carter</P
-></DIV
-></BODY
-></HTML
-> \ No newline at end of file
+ Samba 2.2 was done by Gerald Carter. The conversion to DocBook XML 4.2
+ for Samba 3.0 was done by Alexander Bokovoy.</p></div></div></body></html>
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/smbtar.1.html b/docs/htmldocs/smbtar.1.html
index d3215c6901..30058d1860 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/smbtar.1.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/smbtar.1.html
@@ -1,356 +1,39 @@
-<!DOCTYPE HTML PUBLIC "-//W3C//DTD HTML 4.01 Transitional//EN">
-<HTML
-><HEAD
-><TITLE
->smbtar</TITLE
-><META
-NAME="GENERATOR"
-CONTENT="Modular DocBook HTML Stylesheet Version 1.77"></HEAD
-><BODY
-CLASS="REFENTRY"
-BGCOLOR="#FFFFFF"
-TEXT="#000000"
-LINK="#0000FF"
-VLINK="#840084"
-ALINK="#0000FF"
-><H1
-><A
-NAME="SMBTAR"
-></A
->smbtar</H1
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFNAMEDIV"
-><A
-NAME="AEN5"
-></A
-><H2
->Name</H2
->smbtar&nbsp;--&nbsp;shell script for backing up SMB/CIFS shares
- directly to UNIX tape drives</DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSYNOPSISDIV"
-><A
-NAME="AEN8"
-></A
-><H2
->Synopsis</H2
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbtar</B
-> {-s server} [-p password] [-x services] [-X] [-d directory] [-u user] [-t tape] [-t tape] [-b blocksize] [-N filename] [-i] [-r] [-l loglevel] [-v] {filenames}</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN26"
-></A
-><H2
->DESCRIPTION</H2
-><P
->This tool is part of the <A
-HREF="samba.7.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-> Samba</A
-> suite.</P
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbtar</B
-> is a very small shell script on top
- of <A
-HREF="smbclient.1.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbclient(1)</B
-></A
->
- which dumps SMB shares directly to tape. </P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN34"
-></A
-><H2
->OPTIONS</H2
-><P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
->-s server</DT
-><DD
-><P
->The SMB/CIFS server that the share resides
- upon.</P
-></DD
-><DT
->-x service</DT
-><DD
-><P
->The share name on the server to connect to.
- The default is "backup".</P
-></DD
-><DT
->-X</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Exclude mode. Exclude filenames... from tar
- create or restore. </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-d directory</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Change to initial <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->directory
- </I
-></TT
-> before restoring / backing up files. </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-v</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Verbose mode.</P
-></DD
-><DT
->-p password</DT
-><DD
-><P
->The password to use to access a share.
- Default: none </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-u user</DT
-><DD
-><P
->The user id to connect as. Default:
- UNIX login name. </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-t tape</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Tape device. May be regular file or tape
- device. Default: <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->$TAPE</I
-></TT
-> environmental
- variable; if not set, a file called <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->tar.out
- </TT
->. </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-b blocksize</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Blocking factor. Defaults to 20. See
- <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->tar(1)</B
-> for a fuller explanation. </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-N filename</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Backup only files newer than filename. Could
+<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>smbtar</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="smbtar.1"></a><div class="titlepage"><div></div><div></div></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>smbtar &#8212; shell script for backing up SMB/CIFS shares
+ directly to UNIX tape drives</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><tt class="command">smbtar</tt> [-r] [-i] [-a] [-v] {-s server} [-p password] [-x services] [-X] [-N filename] [-b blocksize] [-d directory] [-l loglevel] [-u user] [-t tape] {filenames}</p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This tool is part of the <a href="Samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">Samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p><b class="command">smbtar</b> is a very small shell script on top
+ of <a href="smbclient.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbclient</span>(1)</span></a> which dumps SMB shares directly to tape.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">-s server</span></dt><dd><p>The SMB/CIFS server that the share resides
+ upon.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-x service</span></dt><dd><p>The share name on the server to connect to.
+ The default is &quot;backup&quot;.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-X</span></dt><dd><p>Exclude mode. Exclude filenames... from tar
+ create or restore. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-d directory</span></dt><dd><p>Change to initial <i class="parameter"><tt>directory
+ </tt></i> before restoring / backing up files. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-v</span></dt><dd><p>Verbose mode.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-p password</span></dt><dd><p>The password to use to access a share.
+ Default: none </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-u user</span></dt><dd><p>The user id to connect as. Default:
+ UNIX login name. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-a</span></dt><dd><p>Reset DOS archive bit mode to
+ indicate file has been archived. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-t tape</span></dt><dd><p>Tape device. May be regular file or tape
+ device. Default: <i class="parameter"><tt>$TAPE</tt></i> environmental
+ variable; if not set, a file called <tt class="filename">tar.out
+ </tt>. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-b blocksize</span></dt><dd><p>Blocking factor. Defaults to 20. See
+ <b class="command">tar(1)</b> for a fuller explanation. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-N filename</span></dt><dd><p>Backup only files newer than filename. Could
be used (for example) on a log file to implement incremental
- backups. </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-i</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Incremental mode; tar files are only backed
+ backups. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-i</span></dt><dd><p>Incremental mode; tar files are only backed
up if they have the archive bit set. The archive bit is reset
- after each file is read. </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-r</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Restore. Files are restored to the share
- from the tar file. </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-l log level</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Log (debug) level. Corresponds to the
- <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->-d</I
-></TT
-> flag of <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbclient(1)
- </B
->. </P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN95"
-></A
-><H2
->ENVIRONMENT VARIABLES</H2
-><P
->The <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->$TAPE</I
-></TT
-> variable specifies the
+ after each file is read. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-r</span></dt><dd><p>Restore. Files are restored to the share
+ from the tar file. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-l log level</span></dt><dd><p>Log (debug) level. Corresponds to the
+ <i class="parameter"><tt>-d</tt></i> flag of <a href="smbclient.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbclient</span>(1)</span></a>.</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>ENVIRONMENT VARIABLES</h2><p>The <i class="parameter"><tt>$TAPE</tt></i> variable specifies the
default tape device to write to. May be overridden
- with the -t option. </P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN99"
-></A
-><H2
->BUGS</H2
-><P
->The <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbtar</B
-> script has different
- options from ordinary tar and from smbclient's tar command. </P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN103"
-></A
-><H2
->CAVEATS</H2
-><P
->Sites that are more careful about security may not like
+ with the -t option. </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>BUGS</h2><p>The <b class="command">smbtar</b> script has different
+ options from ordinary tar and from smbclient's tar command. </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>CAVEATS</h2><p>Sites that are more careful about security may not like
the way the script handles PC passwords. Backup and restore work
on entire shares; should work on file lists. smbtar works best
- with GNU tar and may not work well with other versions. </P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN106"
-></A
-><H2
->DIAGNOSTICS</H2
-><P
->See the <SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->DIAGNOSTICS</I
-></SPAN
-> section for the
- <A
-HREF="smbclient.1.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbclient(1)</B
->
- </A
-> command.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN112"
-></A
-><H2
->VERSION</H2
-><P
->This man page is correct for version 3.0 of
- the Samba suite.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN115"
-></A
-><H2
->SEE ALSO</H2
-><P
-><A
-HREF="smbd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbd(8)</B
-></A
->,
- <A
-HREF="smbclient.1.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbclient(1)</B
-></A
->,
- <A
-HREF="smb.conf.5.html"
-TARGET="_top"
->smb.conf(5)</A
->,
- </P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN123"
-></A
-><H2
->AUTHOR</H2
-><P
->The original Samba software and related utilities
+ with GNU tar and may not work well with other versions. </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>DIAGNOSTICS</h2><p>See the <span class="emphasis"><em>DIAGNOSTICS</em></span> section for the <a href="smbclient.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbclient</span>(1)</span></a> command.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3.0 of
+ the Samba suite.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>SEE ALSO</h2><p><a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a>, <a href="smbclient.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbclient</span>(1)</span></a>, <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a>.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
- to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</P
-><P
-><A
-HREF="mailto:poultenr@logica.co.uk"
-TARGET="_top"
->Ricky Poulten</A
->
- wrote the tar extension and this man page. The <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbtar</B
->
- script was heavily rewritten and improved by <A
-HREF="mailto:Martin.Kraemer@mch.sni.de"
-TARGET="_top"
->Martin Kraemer</A
->. Many
+ to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</p><p><a href="mailto:poultenr@logica.co.uk" target="_top">Ricky Poulten</a>
+ wrote the tar extension and this man page. The <b class="command">smbtar</b>
+ script was heavily rewritten and improved by <a href="mailto:Martin.Kraemer@mch.sni.de" target="_top">Martin Kraemer</a>. Many
thanks to everyone who suggested extensions, improvements, bug
fixes, etc. The man page sources were converted to YODL format (another
- excellent piece of Open Source software, available at
- <A
-HREF="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/"
-TARGET="_top"
-> ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/</A
->) and updated for the Samba 2.0
+ excellent piece of Open Source software, available at <a href="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/" target="_top">
+ ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/</a>) and updated for the Samba 2.0
release by Jeremy Allison. The conversion to DocBook for
- Samba 2.2 was done by Gerald Carter.</P
-></DIV
-></BODY
-></HTML
-> \ No newline at end of file
+ Samba 2.2 was done by Gerald Carter. The conversion to DocBook XML 4.2 for
+ Samba 3.0 was done by Alexander Bokovoy.</p></div></div></body></html>
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/smbumount.8.html b/docs/htmldocs/smbumount.8.html
index 993436f0c6..f0aa0f974d 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/smbumount.8.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/smbumount.8.html
@@ -1,141 +1,16 @@
-<!DOCTYPE HTML PUBLIC "-//W3C//DTD HTML 4.01 Transitional//EN">
-<HTML
-><HEAD
-><TITLE
->smbumount</TITLE
-><META
-NAME="GENERATOR"
-CONTENT="Modular DocBook HTML Stylesheet Version 1.77"></HEAD
-><BODY
-CLASS="REFENTRY"
-BGCOLOR="#FFFFFF"
-TEXT="#000000"
-LINK="#0000FF"
-VLINK="#840084"
-ALINK="#0000FF"
-><H1
-><A
-NAME="SMBUMOUNT"
-></A
->smbumount</H1
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFNAMEDIV"
-><A
-NAME="AEN5"
-></A
-><H2
->Name</H2
->smbumount&nbsp;--&nbsp;smbfs umount for normal users</DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSYNOPSISDIV"
-><A
-NAME="AEN8"
-></A
-><H2
->Synopsis</H2
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbumount</B
-> {mount-point}</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN12"
-></A
-><H2
->DESCRIPTION</H2
-><P
->With this program, normal users can unmount smb-filesystems,
- provided that it is suid root. <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbumount</B
-> has
+<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>smbumount</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="smbumount.8"></a><div class="titlepage"><div></div><div></div></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>smbumount &#8212; smbfs umount for normal users</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><tt class="command">smbumount</tt> {mount-point}</p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>With this program, normal users can unmount smb-filesystems,
+ provided that it is suid root. <b class="command">smbumount</b> has
been written to give normal Linux users more control over their
resources. It is safe to install this program suid root, because only
the user who has mounted a filesystem is allowed to unmount it again.
For root it is not necessary to use smbumount. The normal umount
program works perfectly well, but it would certainly be problematic
- to make umount setuid root.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN16"
-></A
-><H2
->OPTIONS</H2
-><P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
->mount-point</DT
-><DD
-><P
->The directory to unmount.</P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN23"
-></A
-><H2
->SEE ALSO</H2
-><P
-><A
-HREF="smbmount.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbmount(8)</B
->
- </A
-></P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN28"
-></A
-><H2
->AUTHOR</H2
-><P
->Volker Lendecke, Andrew Tridgell, Michael H. Warfield
- and others.</P
-><P
->The current maintainer of smbfs and the userspace
- tools <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbmount</B
->, <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbumount</B
->,
- and <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbmnt</B
-> is <A
-HREF="mailto:urban@teststation.com"
-TARGET="_top"
->Urban Widmark</A
->.
- The <A
-HREF="mailto:samba@samba.org"
-TARGET="_top"
->SAMBA Mailing list</A
->
+ to make umount setuid root.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">mount-point</span></dt><dd><p>The directory to unmount.</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>SEE ALSO</h2><p><a href="smbmount.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbmount</span>(8)</span></a></p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>Volker Lendecke, Andrew Tridgell, Michael H. Warfield
+ and others.</p><p>The current maintainer of smbfs and the userspace
+ tools <b class="command">smbmount</b>, <b class="command">smbumount</b>,
+ and <b class="command">smbmnt</b> is <a href="mailto:urban@teststation.com" target="_top">Urban Widmark</a>.
+ The <a href="mailto:samba@samba.org" target="_top">SAMBA Mailing list</a>
is the preferred place to ask questions regarding these programs.
- </P
-><P
->The conversion of this manpage for Samba 2.2 was performed
- by Gerald Carter</P
-></DIV
-></BODY
-></HTML
-> \ No newline at end of file
+ </p><p>The conversion of this manpage for Samba 2.2 was performed
+ by Gerald Carter. The conversion to DocBook XML 4.2 for Samba 3.0
+ was done by Alexander Bokovoy.</p></div></div></body></html>
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/speed.html b/docs/htmldocs/speed.html
index 1a05706f92..c7ae9dda2d 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/speed.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/speed.html
@@ -1,419 +1,143 @@
-<!DOCTYPE HTML PUBLIC "-//W3C//DTD HTML 4.01 Transitional//EN">
-<HTML
-><HEAD
-><TITLE
->Samba performance issues</TITLE
-><META
-NAME="GENERATOR"
-CONTENT="Modular DocBook HTML Stylesheet Version 1.76b+
-"><LINK
-REL="HOME"
-TITLE="SAMBA Project Documentation"
-HREF="samba-howto-collection.html"><LINK
-REL="UP"
-TITLE="Optional configuration"
-HREF="optional.html"><LINK
-REL="PREVIOUS"
-TITLE="Group mapping HOWTO"
-HREF="groupmapping.html"><LINK
-REL="NEXT"
-TITLE="Appendixes"
-HREF="appendixes.html"></HEAD
-><BODY
-CLASS="CHAPTER"
-BGCOLOR="#FFFFFF"
-TEXT="#000000"
-LINK="#0000FF"
-VLINK="#840084"
-ALINK="#0000FF"
-><DIV
-CLASS="NAVHEADER"
-><TABLE
-SUMMARY="Header navigation table"
-WIDTH="100%"
-BORDER="0"
-CELLPADDING="0"
-CELLSPACING="0"
-><TR
-><TH
-COLSPAN="3"
-ALIGN="center"
->SAMBA Project Documentation</TH
-></TR
-><TR
-><TD
-WIDTH="10%"
-ALIGN="left"
-VALIGN="bottom"
-><A
-HREF="groupmapping.html"
-ACCESSKEY="P"
->Prev</A
-></TD
-><TD
-WIDTH="80%"
-ALIGN="center"
-VALIGN="bottom"
-></TD
-><TD
-WIDTH="10%"
-ALIGN="right"
-VALIGN="bottom"
-><A
-HREF="appendixes.html"
-ACCESSKEY="N"
->Next</A
-></TD
-></TR
-></TABLE
-><HR
-ALIGN="LEFT"
-WIDTH="100%"></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="CHAPTER"
-><H1
-><A
-NAME="SPEED">Chapter 22. Samba performance issues</H1
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><H1
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN3055">22.1. Comparisons</H1
-><P
->The Samba server uses TCP to talk to the client. Thus if you are
+<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 39. Samba Performance Tuning</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="Appendixes.html" title="Part VI. Appendixes"><link rel="previous" href="Other-Clients.html" title="Chapter 38. Samba and other CIFS clients"><link rel="next" href="DNSDHCP.html" title="Chapter 40. DNS and DHCP Configuration Guide"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 39. Samba Performance Tuning</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="Other-Clients.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part VI. Appendixes</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="DNSDHCP.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="speed"></a>Chapter 39. Samba Performance Tuning</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Paul</span> <span class="surname">Cochrane</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Dundee Limb Fitting Centre<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email">&lt;<a href="mailto:paulc@dth.scot.nhs.uk">paulc@dth.scot.nhs.uk</a>&gt;</tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="othername">R.</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">The Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email">&lt;<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</a>&gt;</tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email">&lt;<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>&gt;</tt></p></div></div></div></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="speed.html#id3018190">Comparisons</a></dt><dt><a href="speed.html#id3018235">Socket options</a></dt><dt><a href="speed.html#id3018310">Read size</a></dt><dt><a href="speed.html#id3018354">Max xmit</a></dt><dt><a href="speed.html#id3018407">Log level</a></dt><dt><a href="speed.html#id3018430">Read raw</a></dt><dt><a href="speed.html#id3018486">Write raw</a></dt><dt><a href="speed.html#id3018528">Slow Logins</a></dt><dt><a href="speed.html#id3018550">LDAP</a></dt><dt><a href="speed.html#id3018575">Client tuning</a></dt><dt><a href="speed.html#id3018601">Samba performance problem due changing kernel</a></dt><dt><a href="speed.html#id3018632">Corrupt tdb Files</a></dt></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id3018190"></a>Comparisons</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+The Samba server uses TCP to talk to the client. Thus if you are
trying to see if it performs well you should really compare it to
programs that use the same protocol. The most readily available
programs for file transfer that use TCP are ftp or another TCP based
-SMB server.</P
-><P
->If you want to test against something like a NT or WfWg server then
+SMB server.
+</p><p>
+If you want to test against something like a NT or WfWg server then
you will have to disable all but TCP on either the client or
server. Otherwise you may well be using a totally different protocol
-(such as Netbeui) and comparisons may not be valid.</P
-><P
->Generally you should find that Samba performs similarly to ftp at raw
+(such as Netbeui) and comparisons may not be valid.
+</p><p>
+Generally you should find that Samba performs similarly to ftp at raw
transfer speed. It should perform quite a bit faster than NFS,
-although this very much depends on your system.</P
-><P
->Several people have done comparisons between Samba and Novell, NFS or
+although this very much depends on your system.
+</p><p>
+Several people have done comparisons between Samba and Novell, NFS or
WinNT. In some cases Samba performed the best, in others the worst. I
suspect the biggest factor is not Samba vs some other system but the
hardware and drivers used on the various systems. Given similar
hardware Samba should certainly be competitive in speed with other
-systems.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><H1
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN3061">22.2. Socket options</H1
-><P
->There are a number of socket options that can greatly affect the
-performance of a TCP based server like Samba.</P
-><P
->The socket options that Samba uses are settable both on the command
-line with the -O option, or in the smb.conf file.</P
-><P
->The "socket options" section of the smb.conf manual page describes how
-to set these and gives recommendations.</P
-><P
->Getting the socket options right can make a big difference to your
+systems.
+</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id3018235"></a>Socket options</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+There are a number of socket options that can greatly affect the
+performance of a TCP based server like Samba.
+</p><p>
+The socket options that Samba uses are settable both on the command
+line with the <tt class="option">-O</tt> option, or in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file.
+</p><p>
+The <i class="parameter"><tt>socket options</tt></i> section of the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> manual page describes how
+to set these and gives recommendations.
+</p><p>
+Getting the socket options right can make a big difference to your
performance, but getting them wrong can degrade it by just as
-much. The correct settings are very dependent on your local network.</P
-><P
->The socket option TCP_NODELAY is the one that seems to make the
+much. The correct settings are very dependent on your local network.
+</p><p>
+The socket option TCP_NODELAY is the one that seems to make the
biggest single difference for most networks. Many people report that
-adding "socket options = TCP_NODELAY" doubles the read performance of
-a Samba drive. The best explanation I have seen for this is that the
-Microsoft TCP/IP stack is slow in sending tcp ACKs.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><H1
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN3068">22.3. Read size</H1
-><P
->The option "read size" affects the overlap of disk reads/writes with
-network reads/writes. If the amount of data being transferred in
-several of the SMB commands (currently SMBwrite, SMBwriteX and
+adding <i class="parameter"><tt>socket options = TCP_NODELAY</tt></i> doubles the read
+performance of a Samba drive. The best explanation I have seen for this is
+that the Microsoft TCP/IP stack is slow in sending tcp ACKs.
+</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id3018310"></a>Read size</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+The option <i class="parameter"><tt>read size</tt></i> affects the overlap of disk
+reads/writes with network reads/writes. If the amount of data being
+transferred in several of the SMB commands (currently SMBwrite, SMBwriteX and
SMBreadbraw) is larger than this value then the server begins writing
the data before it has received the whole packet from the network, or
in the case of SMBreadbraw, it begins writing to the network before
-all the data has been read from disk.</P
-><P
->This overlapping works best when the speeds of disk and network access
+all the data has been read from disk.
+</p><p>
+This overlapping works best when the speeds of disk and network access
are similar, having very little effect when the speed of one is much
-greater than the other.</P
-><P
->The default value is 16384, but very little experimentation has been
+greater than the other.
+</p><p>
+The default value is 16384, but very little experimentation has been
done yet to determine the optimal value, and it is likely that the best
value will vary greatly between systems anyway. A value over 65536 is
-pointless and will cause you to allocate memory unnecessarily.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><H1
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN3073">22.4. Max xmit</H1
-><P
->At startup the client and server negotiate a "maximum transmit" size,
+pointless and will cause you to allocate memory unnecessarily.
+</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id3018354"></a>Max xmit</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+At startup the client and server negotiate a <i class="parameter"><tt>maximum transmit</tt></i> size,
which limits the size of nearly all SMB commands. You can set the
-maximum size that Samba will negotiate using the "max xmit = " option
-in smb.conf. Note that this is the maximum size of SMB request that
+maximum size that Samba will negotiate using the <i class="parameter"><tt>max xmit = </tt></i> option
+in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>. Note that this is the maximum size of SMB requests that
Samba will accept, but not the maximum size that the *client* will accept.
The client maximum receive size is sent to Samba by the client and Samba
-honours this limit.</P
-><P
->It defaults to 65536 bytes (the maximum), but it is possible that some
+honours this limit.
+</p><p>
+It defaults to 65536 bytes (the maximum), but it is possible that some
clients may perform better with a smaller transmit unit. Trying values
-of less than 2048 is likely to cause severe problems.</P
-><P
->In most cases the default is the best option.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><H1
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN3078">22.5. Log level</H1
-><P
->If you set the log level (also known as "debug level") higher than 2
+of less than 2048 is likely to cause severe problems.
+</p><p>
+In most cases the default is the best option.
+</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id3018407"></a>Log level</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+If you set the log level (also known as <i class="parameter"><tt>debug level</tt></i>) higher than 2
then you may suffer a large drop in performance. This is because the
server flushes the log file after each operation, which can be very
-expensive. </P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><H1
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN3081">22.6. Read raw</H1
-><P
->The "read raw" operation is designed to be an optimised, low-latency
+expensive.
+</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id3018430"></a>Read raw</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+The <i class="parameter"><tt>read raw</tt></i> operation is designed to be an optimised, low-latency
file read operation. A server may choose to not support it,
-however. and Samba makes support for "read raw" optional, with it
-being enabled by default.</P
-><P
->In some cases clients don't handle "read raw" very well and actually
+however. and Samba makes support for <i class="parameter"><tt>read raw</tt></i> optional, with it
+being enabled by default.
+</p><p>
+In some cases clients don't handle <i class="parameter"><tt>read raw</tt></i> very well and actually
get lower performance using it than they get using the conventional
-read operations. </P
-><P
->So you might like to try "read raw = no" and see what happens on your
+read operations.
+</p><p>
+So you might like to try <i class="parameter"><tt>read raw = no</tt></i> and see what happens on your
network. It might lower, raise or not affect your performance. Only
-testing can really tell.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><H1
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN3086">22.7. Write raw</H1
-><P
->The "write raw" operation is designed to be an optimised, low-latency
+testing can really tell.
+</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id3018486"></a>Write raw</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+The <i class="parameter"><tt>write raw</tt></i> operation is designed to be an optimised, low-latency
file write operation. A server may choose to not support it,
-however. and Samba makes support for "write raw" optional, with it
-being enabled by default.</P
-><P
->Some machines may find "write raw" slower than normal write, in which
-case you may wish to change this option.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><H1
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN3090">22.8. Slow Clients</H1
-><P
->One person has reported that setting the protocol to COREPLUS rather
-than LANMAN2 gave a dramatic speed improvement (from 10k/s to 150k/s).</P
-><P
->I suspect that his PC's (386sx16 based) were asking for more data than
-they could chew. I suspect a similar speed could be had by setting
-"read raw = no" and "max xmit = 2048", instead of changing the
-protocol. Lowering the "read size" might also help.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><H1
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN3094">22.9. Slow Logins</H1
-><P
->Slow logins are almost always due to the password checking time. Using
-the lowest practical "password level" will improve things a lot. You
-could also enable the "UFC crypt" option in the Makefile.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><H1
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN3097">22.10. Client tuning</H1
-><P
->Often a speed problem can be traced to the client. The client (for
+however. and Samba makes support for <i class="parameter"><tt>write raw</tt></i> optional, with it
+being enabled by default.
+</p><p>
+Some machines may find <i class="parameter"><tt>write raw</tt></i> slower than normal write, in which
+case you may wish to change this option.
+</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id3018528"></a>Slow Logins</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+Slow logins are almost always due to the password checking time. Using
+the lowest practical <i class="parameter"><tt>password level</tt></i> will improve things.
+</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id3018550"></a>LDAP</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+LDAP can be vastly improved by using the
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html#LDAPTRUSTIDS" target="_top"><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap trust ids</tt></i></a> parameter.
+</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id3018575"></a>Client tuning</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+Often a speed problem can be traced to the client. The client (for
example Windows for Workgroups) can often be tuned for better TCP
-performance.</P
-><P
->See your client docs for details. In particular, I have heard rumours
-that the WfWg options TCPWINDOWSIZE and TCPSEGMENTSIZE can have a
-large impact on performance.</P
-><P
->Also note that some people have found that setting DefaultRcvWindow in
-the [MSTCP] section of the SYSTEM.INI file under WfWg to 3072 gives a
-big improvement. I don't know why.</P
-><P
->My own experience wth DefaultRcvWindow is that I get much better
-performance with a large value (16384 or larger). Other people have
-reported that anything over 3072 slows things down enourmously. One
-person even reported a speed drop of a factor of 30 when he went from
-3072 to 8192. I don't know why.</P
-><P
->It probably depends a lot on your hardware, and the type of unix box
-you have at the other end of the link.</P
-><P
->Paul Cochrane has done some testing on client side tuning and come
-to the following conclusions:</P
-><P
->Install the W2setup.exe file from www.microsoft.com. This is an
-update for the winsock stack and utilities which improve performance.</P
-><P
->Configure the win95 TCPIP registry settings to give better
-perfomance. I use a program called MTUSPEED.exe which I got off the
-net. There are various other utilities of this type freely available.
-The setting which give the best performance for me are:</P
-><P
-></P
-><OL
-TYPE="1"
-><LI
-><P
->MaxMTU Remove</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->RWIN Remove</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->MTUAutoDiscover Disable</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->MTUBlackHoleDetect Disable</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->Time To Live Enabled</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->Time To Live - HOPS 32</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->NDI Cache Size 0</P
-></LI
-></OL
-><P
->I tried virtually all of the items mentioned in the document and
-the only one which made a difference to me was the socket options. It
-turned out I was better off without any!!!!!</P
-><P
->In terms of overall speed of transfer, between various win95 clients
-and a DX2-66 20MB server with a crappy NE2000 compatible and old IDE
-drive (Kernel 2.0.30). The transfer rate was reasonable for 10 baseT.</P
-><P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
->The figures are: Put Get
-P166 client 3Com card: 420-440kB/s 500-520kB/s
-P100 client 3Com card: 390-410kB/s 490-510kB/s
-DX4-75 client NE2000: 370-380kB/s 330-350kB/s</PRE
-></P
-><P
->I based these test on transfer two files a 4.5MB text file and a 15MB
-textfile. The results arn't bad considering the hardware Samba is
-running on. It's a crap machine!!!!</P
-><P
->The updates mentioned in 1 and 2 brought up the transfer rates from
-just over 100kB/s in some clients.</P
-><P
->A new client is a P333 connected via a 100MB/s card and hub. The
-transfer rates from this were good: 450-500kB/s on put and 600+kB/s
-on get.</P
-><P
->Looking at standard FTP throughput, Samba is a bit slower (100kB/s
-upwards). I suppose there is more going on in the samba protocol, but
-if it could get up to the rate of FTP the perfomance would be quite
-staggering.</P
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="NAVFOOTER"
-><HR
-ALIGN="LEFT"
-WIDTH="100%"><TABLE
-SUMMARY="Footer navigation table"
-WIDTH="100%"
-BORDER="0"
-CELLPADDING="0"
-CELLSPACING="0"
-><TR
-><TD
-WIDTH="33%"
-ALIGN="left"
-VALIGN="top"
-><A
-HREF="groupmapping.html"
-ACCESSKEY="P"
->Prev</A
-></TD
-><TD
-WIDTH="34%"
-ALIGN="center"
-VALIGN="top"
-><A
-HREF="samba-howto-collection.html"
-ACCESSKEY="H"
->Home</A
-></TD
-><TD
-WIDTH="33%"
-ALIGN="right"
-VALIGN="top"
-><A
-HREF="appendixes.html"
-ACCESSKEY="N"
->Next</A
-></TD
-></TR
-><TR
-><TD
-WIDTH="33%"
-ALIGN="left"
-VALIGN="top"
->Group mapping HOWTO</TD
-><TD
-WIDTH="34%"
-ALIGN="center"
-VALIGN="top"
-><A
-HREF="optional.html"
-ACCESSKEY="U"
->Up</A
-></TD
-><TD
-WIDTH="33%"
-ALIGN="right"
-VALIGN="top"
->Appendixes</TD
-></TR
-></TABLE
-></DIV
-></BODY
-></HTML
-> \ No newline at end of file
+performance. Check the sections on the various clients in
+<a href="Other-Clients.html" title="Chapter 38. Samba and other CIFS clients">Samba and Other Clients</a>.
+</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id3018601"></a>Samba performance problem due changing kernel</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+Hi everyone. I am running Gentoo on my server and samba 2.2.8a. Recently
+I changed kernel version from linux-2.4.19-gentoo-r10 to
+linux-2.4.20-wolk4.0s. And now I have performance issue with samba. Ok
+many of you will probably say that move to vanilla sources...well I ried
+it too and it didn't work. I have 100mb LAN and two computers (linux +
+Windows2000). Linux server shares directory with DivX files, client
+(windows2000) plays them via LAN. Before when I was running 2.4.19 kernel
+everything was fine, but now movies freezes and stops...I tried moving
+files between server and Windows and it's trerribly slow.
+</p><p>
+Grab mii-tool and check the duplex settings on the NIC.
+My guess is that it is a link layer issue, not an application
+layer problem. Also run ifconfig and verify that the framing
+error, collisions, etc... look normal for ethernet.
+</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id3018632"></a>Corrupt tdb Files</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+Well today it happend, our first major problem using samba.
+Our samba PDC server has been hosting 3 TB of data to our 500+ users
+[Windows NT/XP] for the last 3 years using samba, no problem.
+But today all shares went SLOW; very slow. Also the main smbd kept
+spawning new processes so we had 1600+ running smbd's (normally we avg. 250).
+It crashed the SUN E3500 cluster twice. After alot of searching I
+decided to <b class="command">rm /var/locks/*.tbl</b>. Happy again.
+</p><p>
+Q1) Is there any method of keeping the *.tbl files in top condition or
+how to early detect corruption?
+</p><p>
+A1) Yes, run <b class="command">tdbbackup</b> each time after stoping nmbd and before starting nmbd.
+</p><p>
+Q2) What I also would like to mention is that the service latency seems
+alot lower then before the locks cleanup, any ideas on keeping it top notch?
+</p><p>
+A2) Yes! Samba answer as for Q1!
+</p></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="Other-Clients.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="Appendixes.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="DNSDHCP.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 38. Samba and other CIFS clients </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="index.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 40. DNS and DHCP Configuration Guide</td></tr></table></div></body></html>
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/swat.8.html b/docs/htmldocs/swat.8.html
index f101a7bc26..e0719dce3d 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/swat.8.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/swat.8.html
@@ -1,425 +1,87 @@
-<!DOCTYPE HTML PUBLIC "-//W3C//DTD HTML 4.01 Transitional//EN">
-<HTML
-><HEAD
-><TITLE
->swat</TITLE
-><META
-NAME="GENERATOR"
-CONTENT="Modular DocBook HTML Stylesheet Version 1.77"></HEAD
-><BODY
-CLASS="REFENTRY"
-BGCOLOR="#FFFFFF"
-TEXT="#000000"
-LINK="#0000FF"
-VLINK="#840084"
-ALINK="#0000FF"
-><H1
-><A
-NAME="SWAT"
-></A
->swat</H1
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFNAMEDIV"
-><A
-NAME="AEN5"
-></A
-><H2
->Name</H2
->swat&nbsp;--&nbsp;Samba Web Administration Tool</DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSYNOPSISDIV"
-><A
-NAME="AEN8"
-></A
-><H2
->Synopsis</H2
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->swat</B
-> [-s &lt;smb config file&gt;] [-a]</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN13"
-></A
-><H2
->DESCRIPTION</H2
-><P
->This tool is part of the <A
-HREF="samba.7.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-> Samba</A
-> suite.</P
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->swat</B
-> allows a Samba administrator to
- configure the complex <A
-HREF="smb.conf.5.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-><TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
-> smb.conf(5)</TT
-></A
-> file via a Web browser. In addition,
- a <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->swat</B
-> configuration page has help links
- to all the configurable options in the <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->smb.conf</TT
-> file allowing an
- administrator to easily look up the effects of any change. </P
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->swat</B
-> is run from <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->inetd</B
-> </P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN26"
-></A
-><H2
->OPTIONS</H2
-><P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
->-s smb configuration file</DT
-><DD
-><P
->The default configuration file path is
+<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>swat</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="swat.8"></a><div class="titlepage"><div></div><div></div></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>swat &#8212; Samba Web Administration Tool</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><tt class="command">swat</tt> [-s &lt;smb config file&gt;] [-a]</p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This tool is part of the <a href="Samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">Samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p><b class="command">swat</b> allows a Samba administrator to
+ configure the complex <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> file via a Web browser. In addition,
+ a <b class="command">swat</b> configuration page has help links
+ to all the configurable options in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file allowing an
+ administrator to easily look up the effects of any change. </p><p><b class="command">swat</b> is run from <b class="command">inetd</b> </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">-s smb configuration file</span></dt><dd><p>The default configuration file path is
determined at compile time. The file specified contains
- the configuration details required by the <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbd
- </B
-> server. This is the file that <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->swat</B
-> will modify.
+ the configuration details required by the <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> server. This is the file
+ that <b class="command">swat</b> will modify.
The information in this file includes server-specific
information such as what printcap file to use, as well as
descriptions of all the services that the server is to provide.
- See <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->smb.conf</TT
-> for more information.
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-a</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This option disables authentication and puts
- <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->swat</B
-> in demo mode. In that mode anyone will be able to modify
- the <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->smb.conf</TT
-> file. </P
-><P
-><SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->WARNING: Do NOT enable this option on a production
- server. </I
-></SPAN
-></P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN44"
-></A
-><H2
->INSTALLATION</H2
-><P
->After you compile SWAT you need to run <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->make install
- </B
-> to install the <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->swat</B
-> binary
+ See <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> for more information.
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-a</span></dt><dd><p>This option disables authentication and puts
+ <b class="command">swat</b> in demo mode. In that mode anyone will be able to modify
+ the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file. </p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>WARNING: Do NOT enable this option on a production
+ server. </em></span></p></dd><dt><span class="term">-V</span></dt><dd><p>Prints the version number for
+<b class="command">smbd</b>.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-s &lt;configuration file&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>The file specified contains the
+configuration details required by the server. The
+information in this file includes server-specific
+information such as what printcap file to use, as well
+as descriptions of all the services that the server is
+to provide. See <a href="smb.conf.5.html" target="_top"><tt class="filename">
+smb.conf(5)</tt></a> for more information.
+The default configuration file name is determined at
+compile time.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-d|--debug=debuglevel</span></dt><dd><p><i class="replaceable"><tt>debuglevel</tt></i> is an integer
+from 0 to 10. The default value if this parameter is
+not specified is zero.</p><p>The higher this value, the more detail will be
+logged to the log files about the activities of the
+server. At level 0, only critical errors and serious
+warnings will be logged. Level 1 is a reasonable level for
+day to day running - it generates a small amount of
+information about operations carried out.</p><p>Levels above 1 will generate considerable
+amounts of log data, and should only be used when
+investigating a problem. Levels above 3 are designed for
+use only by developers and generate HUGE amounts of log
+data, most of which is extremely cryptic.</p><p>Note that specifying this parameter here will
+override the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#loglevel" target="_top">log
+level</a> parameter in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html" target="_top">
+<tt class="filename">smb.conf(5)</tt></a> file.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-l|--logfile=logbasename</span></dt><dd><p>File name for log/debug files. The extension
+<tt class="constant">&quot;.client&quot;</tt> will be appended. The log file is
+never removed by the client.
+</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-h|--help</span></dt><dd><p>Print a summary of command line options.
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>INSTALLATION</h2><p>Swat is included as binary package with most distributions. The
+ package manager in this case takes care of the installation and
+ configuration. This section is only for those who have compiled
+ swat from scratch.
+ </p><p>After you compile SWAT you need to run <b class="command">make install
+ </b> to install the <b class="command">swat</b> binary
and the various help files and images. A default install would put
- these in: </P
-><P
-></P
-><UL
-><LI
-><P
->/usr/local/samba/bin/swat</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->/usr/local/samba/swat/images/*</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->/usr/local/samba/swat/help/*</P
-></LI
-></UL
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN56"
-></A
-><H3
->Inetd Installation</H3
-><P
->You need to edit your <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/inetd.conf
- </TT
-> and <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/services</TT
->
- to enable SWAT to be launched via <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->inetd</B
->.</P
-><P
->In <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/services</TT
-> you need to
- add a line like this: </P
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->swat 901/tcp</B
-></P
-><P
->Note for NIS/YP users - you may need to rebuild the
- NIS service maps rather than alter your local <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
-> /etc/services</TT
-> file. </P
-><P
->the choice of port number isn't really important
+ these in: </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>/usr/local/samba/bin/swat</p></li><li><p>/usr/local/samba/swat/images/*</p></li><li><p>/usr/local/samba/swat/help/*</p></li></ul></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><h3>Inetd Installation</h3><p>You need to edit your <tt class="filename">/etc/inetd.conf
+ </tt> and <tt class="filename">/etc/services</tt>
+ to enable SWAT to be launched via <b class="command">inetd</b>.</p><p>In <tt class="filename">/etc/services</tt> you need to
+ add a line like this: </p><p><b class="command">swat 901/tcp</b></p><p>Note for NIS/YP and LDAP users - you may need to rebuild the
+ NIS service maps rather than alter your local <tt class="filename">
+ /etc/services</tt> file. </p><p>the choice of port number isn't really important
except that it should be less than 1024 and not currently
used (using a number above 1024 presents an obscure security
hole depending on the implementation details of your
- <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->inetd</B
-> daemon). </P
-><P
->In <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/inetd.conf</TT
-> you should
- add a line like this: </P
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->swat stream tcp nowait.400 root
- /usr/local/samba/bin/swat swat</B
-></P
-><P
->One you have edited <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/services</TT
->
- and <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/inetd.conf</TT
-> you need to send a
- HUP signal to inetd. To do this use <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->kill -1 PID
- </B
-> where PID is the process ID of the inetd daemon. </P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN78"
-></A
-><H3
->Launching</H3
-><P
->To launch SWAT just run your favorite web browser and
- point it at "http://localhost:901/".</P
-><P
->Note that you can attach to SWAT from any IP connected
- machine but connecting from a remote machine leaves your
- connection open to password sniffing as passwords will be sent
- in the clear over the wire. </P
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN82"
-></A
-><H2
->FILES</H2
-><P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
-><TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/inetd.conf</TT
-></DT
-><DD
-><P
->This file must contain suitable startup
- information for the meta-daemon.</P
-></DD
-><DT
-><TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/services</TT
-></DT
-><DD
-><P
->This file must contain a mapping of service name
+ <b class="command">inetd</b> daemon). </p><p>In <tt class="filename">/etc/inetd.conf</tt> you should
+ add a line like this: </p><p><b class="command">swat stream tcp nowait.400 root
+ /usr/local/samba/bin/swat swat</b></p><p>One you have edited <tt class="filename">/etc/services</tt>
+ and <tt class="filename">/etc/inetd.conf</tt> you need to send a
+ HUP signal to inetd. To do this use <b class="command">kill -1 PID
+ </b> where PID is the process ID of the inetd daemon. </p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>LAUNCHING</h2><p>To launch SWAT just run your favorite web browser and
+ point it at &quot;http://localhost:901/&quot;.</p><p>Note that you can attach to SWAT from any IP connected
+ machine but connecting from a remote machine leaves your
+ connection open to password sniffing as passwords will be sent
+ in the clear over the wire. </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>FILES</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term"><tt class="filename">/etc/inetd.conf</tt></span></dt><dd><p>This file must contain suitable startup
+ information for the meta-daemon.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><tt class="filename">/etc/services</tt></span></dt><dd><p>This file must contain a mapping of service name
(e.g., swat) to service port (e.g., 901) and protocol type
- (e.g., tcp). </P
-></DD
-><DT
-><TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/usr/local/samba/lib/smb.conf</TT
-></DT
-><DD
-><P
->This is the default location of the <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->smb.conf(5)
- </TT
-> server configuration file that swat edits. Other
- common places that systems install this file are <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
-> /usr/samba/lib/smb.conf</TT
-> and <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/smb.conf
- </TT
->. This file describes all the services the server
- is to make available to clients. </P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN103"
-></A
-><H2
->WARNINGS</H2
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->swat</B
-> will rewrite your <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->smb.conf
- </TT
-> file. It will rearrange the entries and delete all
- comments, <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->include=</I
-></TT
-> and <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->copy=
- </I
-></TT
-> options. If you have a carefully crafted <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
-> smb.conf</TT
-> then back it up or don't use swat! </P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN111"
-></A
-><H2
->VERSION</H2
-><P
->This man page is correct for version 2.2 of
- the Samba suite.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN114"
-></A
-><H2
->SEE ALSO</H2
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->inetd(5)</B
->,
- <A
-HREF="smbd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbd(8)</B
-></A
->,
- <A
-HREF="smb.conf.5.html"
-TARGET="_top"
->smb.conf(5)</A
->
- </P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN121"
-></A
-><H2
->AUTHOR</H2
-><P
->The original Samba software and related utilities
+ (e.g., tcp). </p></dd><dt><span class="term"><tt class="filename">/usr/local/samba/lib/smb.conf</tt></span></dt><dd><p>This is the default location of the <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> server configuration file that swat edits. Other
+ common places that systems install this file are <tt class="filename">
+ /usr/samba/lib/smb.conf</tt> and <tt class="filename">/etc/smb.conf
+ </tt>. This file describes all the services the server
+ is to make available to clients. </p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>WARNINGS</h2><p><b class="command">swat</b> will rewrite your <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> file. It will rearrange the entries and delete all
+ comments, <i class="parameter"><tt>include=</tt></i> and <i class="parameter"><tt>copy=
+ </tt></i> options. If you have a carefully crafted <tt class="filename">
+ smb.conf</tt> then back it up or don't use swat! </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3.0 of the Samba suite.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>SEE ALSO</h2><p><b class="command">inetd(5)</b>, <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a>, <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a></p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
- to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</P
-><P
->The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer.
+ to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</p><p>The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer.
The man page sources were converted to YODL format (another
- excellent piece of Open Source software, available at
- <A
-HREF="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/"
-TARGET="_top"
-> ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/</A
->) and updated for the Samba 2.0
+ excellent piece of Open Source software, available at <a href="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/" target="_top">
+ ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/</a>) and updated for the Samba 2.0
release by Jeremy Allison. The conversion to DocBook for
- Samba 2.2 was done by Gerald Carter</P
-></DIV
-></BODY
-></HTML
-> \ No newline at end of file
+ Samba 2.2 was done by Gerald Carter. The conversion to DocBook XML 4.2 for
+ Samba 3.0 was done by Alexander Bokovoy.</p></div></div></body></html>
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/testparm.1.html b/docs/htmldocs/testparm.1.html
index baf11bacac..3732b53f4c 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/testparm.1.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/testparm.1.html
@@ -1,316 +1,51 @@
-<!DOCTYPE HTML PUBLIC "-//W3C//DTD HTML 4.01//EN">
-<HTML
-><HEAD
-><TITLE
->testparm</TITLE
-><META
-NAME="GENERATOR"
-CONTENT="Modular DocBook HTML Stylesheet Version 1.76b+
-"></HEAD
-><BODY
-CLASS="REFENTRY"
-BGCOLOR="#FFFFFF"
-TEXT="#000000"
-LINK="#0000FF"
-VLINK="#840084"
-ALINK="#0000FF"
-><H1
-><A
-NAME="TESTPARM">testparm</H1
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFNAMEDIV"
-><A
-NAME="AEN5"
-></A
-><H2
->Name</H2
->testparm&nbsp;--&nbsp;check an smb.conf configuration file for
- internal correctness</DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSYNOPSISDIV"
-><A
-NAME="AEN8"><H2
->Synopsis</H2
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->testparm</B
-> [-s] [-h] [-v] [-L &#60;servername&#62;] [-t &#60;encoding&#62;] {config filename} [hostname hostIP]</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN18"
-></A
-><H2
->DESCRIPTION</H2
-><P
->This tool is part of the <A
-HREF="samba.7.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-> Samba</A
-> suite.</P
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->testparm</B
-> is a very simple test program
- to check an <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbd</B
-> configuration file for
+<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>testparm</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="testparm.1"></a><div class="titlepage"><div></div><div></div></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>testparm &#8212; check an smb.conf configuration file for
+ internal correctness</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><tt class="command">testparm</tt> [-s] [-h] [-v] [-L &lt;servername&gt;] [-t &lt;encoding&gt;] {config filename} [hostname hostIP]</p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This tool is part of the <a href="Samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">Samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p><b class="command">testparm</b> is a very simple test program
+ to check an <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> configuration file for
internal correctness. If this program reports no problems, you
- can use the configuration file with confidence that <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbd
- </B
-> will successfully load the configuration file.</P
-><P
->Note that this is <I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->NOT</I
-> a guarantee that
+ can use the configuration file with confidence that <b class="command">smbd
+ </b> will successfully load the configuration file.</p><p>Note that this is <span class="emphasis"><em>NOT</em></span> a guarantee that
the services specified in the configuration file will be
- available or will operate as expected. </P
-><P
->If the optional host name and host IP address are
+ available or will operate as expected. </p><p>If the optional host name and host IP address are
specified on the command line, this test program will run through
the service entries reporting whether the specified host
- has access to each service. </P
-><P
->If <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->testparm</B
-> finds an error in the <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
-> smb.conf</TT
-> file it returns an exit code of 1 to the calling
+ has access to each service. </p><p>If <b class="command">testparm</b> finds an error in the <tt class="filename">
+ smb.conf</tt> file it returns an exit code of 1 to the calling
program, else it returns an exit code of 0. This allows shell scripts
- to test the output from <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->testparm</B
->.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN33"
-></A
-><H2
->OPTIONS</H2
-><P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
->-s</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Without this option, <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->testparm</B
->
+ to test the output from <b class="command">testparm</b>.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">-s</span></dt><dd><p>Without this option, <b class="command">testparm</b>
will prompt for a carriage return after printing the service
- names and before dumping the service definitions.</P
-></DD
-><DT
->-h</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Print usage message </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-L servername</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Sets the value of the %L macro to <TT
-CLASS="REPLACEABLE"
-><I
->servername</I
-></TT
->.
+ names and before dumping the service definitions.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-h|--help</span></dt><dd><p>Print a summary of command line options.
+</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-V</span></dt><dd><p>Prints the version number for
+<b class="command">smbd</b>.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-L servername</span></dt><dd><p>Sets the value of the %L macro to <i class="replaceable"><tt>servername</tt></i>.
This is useful for testing include files specified with the
- %L macro. </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-v</DT
-><DD
-><P
->If this option is specified, testparm
- will also output all options that were not used in
- <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->smb.conf</TT
-> and are thus set to
- their defaults.</P
-></DD
-><DT
->-t encoding</DT
-><DD
-><P
-> Output data in specified encoding.
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
->configfilename</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This is the name of the configuration file
+ %L macro. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-v</span></dt><dd><p>If this option is specified, testparm
+ will also output all options that were not used in <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> and are thus set to their defaults.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-t encoding</span></dt><dd><p>
+ Output data in specified encoding.
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term">configfilename</span></dt><dd><p>This is the name of the configuration file
to check. If this parameter is not present then the
- default <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->smb.conf</TT
-> file will be checked.
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
->hostname</DT
-><DD
-><P
->If this parameter and the following are
- specified, then <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->testparm</B
-> will examine the <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->hosts
- allow</I
-></TT
-> and <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->hosts deny</I
-></TT
->
- parameters in the <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->smb.conf</TT
-> file to
+ default <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> file will be checked.
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term">hostname</span></dt><dd><p>If this parameter and the following are
+ specified, then <b class="command">testparm</b> will examine the <i class="parameter"><tt>hosts
+ allow</tt></i> and <i class="parameter"><tt>hosts deny</tt></i>
+ parameters in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> file to
determine if the hostname with this IP address would be
- allowed access to the <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbd</B
-> server. If
+ allowed access to the <b class="command">smbd</b> server. If
this parameter is supplied, the hostIP parameter must also
- be supplied.</P
-></DD
-><DT
->hostIP</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This is the IP address of the host specified
+ be supplied.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">hostIP</span></dt><dd><p>This is the IP address of the host specified
in the previous parameter. This address must be supplied
- if the hostname parameter is supplied. </P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN77"
-></A
-><H2
->FILES</H2
-><P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
-><TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->smb.conf</TT
-></DT
-><DD
-><P
->This is usually the name of the configuration
- file used by <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbd</B
->.
- </P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN86"
-></A
-><H2
->DIAGNOSTICS</H2
-><P
->The program will issue a message saying whether the
+ if the hostname parameter is supplied. </p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>FILES</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term"><a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a></span></dt><dd><p>This is usually the name of the configuration
+ file used by <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a>.
+ </p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>DIAGNOSTICS</h2><p>The program will issue a message saying whether the
configuration file loaded OK or not. This message may be preceded by
errors and warnings if the file did not load. If the file was
loaded OK, the program then dumps all known service details
- to stdout. </P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN89"
-></A
-><H2
->VERSION</H2
-><P
->This man page is correct for version 3.0 of
- the Samba suite.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN92"
-></A
-><H2
->SEE ALSO</H2
-><P
-><A
-HREF="smb.conf.5.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-><TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->smb.conf(5)</TT
-></A
->,
- <A
-HREF="smbd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbd(8)</B
-></A
->
- </P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN99"
-></A
-><H2
->AUTHOR</H2
-><P
->The original Samba software and related utilities
+ to stdout. </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3.0 of
+ the Samba suite.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>SEE ALSO</h2><p><a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a>, <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a></p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
- to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</P
-><P
->The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer.
+ to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</p><p>The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer.
The man page sources were converted to YODL format (another
- excellent piece of Open Source software, available at
- <A
-HREF="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/"
-TARGET="_top"
-> ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/</A
->) and updated for the Samba 2.0
+ excellent piece of Open Source software, available at <a href="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/" target="_top">
+ ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/</a>) and updated for the Samba 2.0
release by Jeremy Allison. The conversion to DocBook for
- Samba 2.2 was done by Gerald Carter</P
-></DIV
-></BODY
-></HTML
-> \ No newline at end of file
+ Samba 2.2 was done by Gerald Carter. The conversion to DocBook XML 4.2
+ for Samba 3.0 was done by Alexander Bokovoy.</p></div></div></body></html>
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/testprns.1.html b/docs/htmldocs/testprns.1.html
index 0225aad9d5..ff7d4efd33 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/testprns.1.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/testprns.1.html
@@ -1,253 +1,38 @@
-<!DOCTYPE HTML PUBLIC "-//W3C//DTD HTML 4.01 Transitional//EN">
-<HTML
-><HEAD
-><TITLE
->testprns</TITLE
-><META
-NAME="GENERATOR"
-CONTENT="Modular DocBook HTML Stylesheet Version 1.77"></HEAD
-><BODY
-CLASS="REFENTRY"
-BGCOLOR="#FFFFFF"
-TEXT="#000000"
-LINK="#0000FF"
-VLINK="#840084"
-ALINK="#0000FF"
-><H1
-><A
-NAME="TESTPRNS"
-></A
->testprns</H1
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFNAMEDIV"
-><A
-NAME="AEN5"
-></A
-><H2
->Name</H2
->testprns&nbsp;--&nbsp;check printer name for validity with smbd</DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSYNOPSISDIV"
-><A
-NAME="AEN8"
-></A
-><H2
->Synopsis</H2
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->testprns</B
-> {printername} [printcapname]</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN13"
-></A
-><H2
->DESCRIPTION</H2
-><P
->This tool is part of the <A
-HREF="samba.7.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-> Samba</A
-> suite.</P
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->testprns</B
-> is a very simple test program
+<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>testprns</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="testprns.1"></a><div class="titlepage"><div></div><div></div></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>testprns &#8212; check printer name for validity with smbd</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><tt class="command">testprns</tt> {printername} [printcapname]</p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This tool is part of the <a href="Samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">Samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p><b class="command">testprns</b> is a very simple test program
to determine whether a given printer name is valid for use in
- a service to be provided by <A
-HREF="smbd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
-> smbd(8)</B
-></A
->. </P
-><P
->"Valid" in this context means "can be found in the
- printcap specified". This program is very stupid - so stupid in
+ a service to be provided by <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a>.</p><p>&quot;Valid&quot; in this context means &quot;can be found in the
+ printcap specified&quot;. This program is very stupid - so stupid in
fact that it would be wisest to always specify the printcap file
- to use. </P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN22"
-></A
-><H2
->OPTIONS</H2
-><P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
->printername</DT
-><DD
-><P
->The printer name to validate.</P
-><P
->Printer names are taken from the first field in each
+ to use. </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">printername</span></dt><dd><p>The printer name to validate.</p><p>Printer names are taken from the first field in each
record in the printcap file, single printer names and sets
- of aliases separated by vertical bars ("|") are recognized.
+ of aliases separated by vertical bars (&quot;|&quot;) are recognized.
Note that no validation or checking of the printcap syntax is
done beyond that required to extract the printer name. It may
be that the print spooling system is more forgiving or less
- forgiving than <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->testprns</B
->. However, if
- <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->testprns</B
-> finds the printer then
- <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbd</B
-> should do so as well. </P
-></DD
-><DT
->printcapname</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This is the name of the printcap file within
- which to search for the given printer name. </P
-><P
->If no printcap name is specified <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->testprns
- </B
-> will attempt to scan the printcap file name
- specified at compile time. </P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN39"
-></A
-><H2
->FILES</H2
-><P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
-><TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/printcap</TT
-></DT
-><DD
-><P
->This is usually the default printcap
- file to scan. See <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->printcap (5)</TT
->.
- </P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN48"
-></A
-><H2
->DIAGNOSTICS</H2
-><P
->If a printer is found to be valid, the message
- "Printer name &lt;printername&gt; is valid" will be
- displayed. </P
-><P
->If a printer is found to be invalid, the message
- "Printer name &lt;printername&gt; is not valid" will be
- displayed. </P
-><P
->All messages that would normally be logged during
+ forgiving than <b class="command">testprns</b>. However, if
+ <b class="command">testprns</b> finds the printer then <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> should do so as well. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">printcapname</span></dt><dd><p>This is the name of the printcap file within
+ which to search for the given printer name. </p><p>If no printcap name is specified <b class="command">testprns
+ </b> will attempt to scan the printcap file name
+ specified at compile time. </p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>FILES</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term"><tt class="filename">/etc/printcap</tt></span></dt><dd><p>This is usually the default printcap
+ file to scan. See <tt class="filename">printcap (5)</tt>.
+ </p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>DIAGNOSTICS</h2><p>If a printer is found to be valid, the message
+ &quot;Printer name &lt;printername&gt; is valid&quot; will be
+ displayed. </p><p>If a printer is found to be invalid, the message
+ &quot;Printer name &lt;printername&gt; is not valid&quot; will be
+ displayed. </p><p>All messages that would normally be logged during
operation of the Samba daemons are logged by this program to the
- file <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->test.log</TT
-> in the current directory. The
+ file <tt class="filename">test.log</tt> in the current directory. The
program runs at debuglevel 3, so quite extensive logging
information is written. The log should be checked carefully
- for errors and warnings. </P
-><P
->Other messages are self-explanatory. </P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN55"
-></A
-><H2
->VERSION</H2
-><P
->This man page is correct for version 2.2 of
- the Samba suite.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN58"
-></A
-><H2
->SEE ALSO</H2
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->printcap(5)</TT
->,
- <A
-HREF="smbd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbd(8)</B
-></A
->,
- <A
-HREF="smbclient.1.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbclient(1)</B
-></A
->
- </P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN66"
-></A
-><H2
->AUTHOR</H2
-><P
->The original Samba software and related utilities
+ for errors and warnings. </p><p>Other messages are self-explanatory. </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3.0 of
+ the Samba suite.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>SEE ALSO</h2><p><tt class="filename">printcap(5)</tt>,
+ <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a>, <a href="smbclient.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbclient</span>(1)</span></a></p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
- to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</P
-><P
->The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer.
+ to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</p><p>The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer.
The man page sources were converted to YODL format (another
- excellent piece of Open Source software, available at
- <A
-HREF="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/"
-TARGET="_top"
-> ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/</A
->) and updated for the Samba 2.0
+ excellent piece of Open Source software, available at <a href="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/" target="_top">
+ ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/</a>) and updated for the Samba 2.0
release by Jeremy Allison. The conversion to DocBook for
- Samba 2.2 was done by Gerald Carter</P
-></DIV
-></BODY
-></HTML
-> \ No newline at end of file
+ Samba 2.2 was done by Gerald Carter. The conversion to DocBook XML 4.2
+ for Samba 3.0 was done by Alexander Bokovoy.</p></div></div></body></html>
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/type.html b/docs/htmldocs/type.html
index e3f09acc18..0e0f6b7d2a 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/type.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/type.html
@@ -1,389 +1,9 @@
-<!DOCTYPE HTML PUBLIC "-//W3C//DTD HTML 4.01 Transitional//EN">
-<HTML
-><HEAD
-><TITLE
->Type of installation</TITLE
-><META
-NAME="GENERATOR"
-CONTENT="Modular DocBook HTML Stylesheet Version 1.76b+
-"><LINK
-REL="HOME"
-TITLE="SAMBA Project Documentation"
-HREF="samba-howto-collection.html"><LINK
-REL="PREVIOUS"
-TITLE="LanMan and NT Password Encryption in Samba"
-HREF="pwencrypt.html"><LINK
-REL="NEXT"
-TITLE="User and Share security level (for servers not in a domain)"
-HREF="securitylevels.html"></HEAD
-><BODY
-CLASS="PART"
-BGCOLOR="#FFFFFF"
-TEXT="#000000"
-LINK="#0000FF"
-VLINK="#840084"
-ALINK="#0000FF"
-><DIV
-CLASS="NAVHEADER"
-><TABLE
-SUMMARY="Header navigation table"
-WIDTH="100%"
-BORDER="0"
-CELLPADDING="0"
-CELLSPACING="0"
-><TR
-><TH
-COLSPAN="3"
-ALIGN="center"
->SAMBA Project Documentation</TH
-></TR
-><TR
-><TD
-WIDTH="10%"
-ALIGN="left"
-VALIGN="bottom"
-><A
-HREF="pwencrypt.html"
-ACCESSKEY="P"
->Prev</A
-></TD
-><TD
-WIDTH="80%"
-ALIGN="center"
-VALIGN="bottom"
-></TD
-><TD
-WIDTH="10%"
-ALIGN="right"
-VALIGN="bottom"
-><A
-HREF="securitylevels.html"
-ACCESSKEY="N"
->Next</A
-></TD
-></TR
-></TABLE
-><HR
-ALIGN="LEFT"
-WIDTH="100%"></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="PART"
-><A
-NAME="TYPE"><DIV
-CLASS="TITLEPAGE"
-><H1
-CLASS="TITLE"
->II. Type of installation</H1
-><DIV
-CLASS="PARTINTRO"
-><A
-NAME="AEN531"><H1
->Introduction</H1
-><P
->Samba can operate in various SMB networks. This part contains information on configuring samba
-for various environments.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="TOC"
-><DL
-><DT
-><B
->Table of Contents</B
-></DT
-><DT
->5. <A
-HREF="securitylevels.html"
->User and Share security level (for servers not in a domain)</A
-></DT
-><DT
->6. <A
-HREF="samba-pdc.html"
->How to Configure Samba as a NT4 Primary Domain Controller</A
-></DT
-><DD
-><DL
-><DT
->6.1. <A
-HREF="samba-pdc.html#AEN575"
->Prerequisite Reading</A
-></DT
-><DT
->6.2. <A
-HREF="samba-pdc.html#AEN581"
->Background</A
-></DT
-><DT
->6.3. <A
-HREF="samba-pdc.html#AEN620"
->Configuring the Samba Domain Controller</A
-></DT
-><DT
->6.4. <A
-HREF="samba-pdc.html#AEN663"
->Creating Machine Trust Accounts and Joining Clients to the
-Domain</A
-></DT
-><DD
-><DL
-><DT
->6.4.1. <A
-HREF="samba-pdc.html#AEN682"
->Manual Creation of Machine Trust Accounts</A
-></DT
-><DT
->6.4.2. <A
-HREF="samba-pdc.html#AEN723"
->"On-the-Fly" Creation of Machine Trust Accounts</A
-></DT
-><DT
->6.4.3. <A
-HREF="samba-pdc.html#AEN732"
->Joining the Client to the Domain</A
-></DT
-></DL
-></DD
-><DT
->6.5. <A
-HREF="samba-pdc.html#AEN747"
->Common Problems and Errors</A
-></DT
-><DT
->6.6. <A
-HREF="samba-pdc.html#AEN795"
->System Policies and Profiles</A
-></DT
-><DT
->6.7. <A
-HREF="samba-pdc.html#AEN839"
->What other help can I get?</A
-></DT
-><DT
->6.8. <A
-HREF="samba-pdc.html#AEN953"
->Domain Control for Windows 9x/ME</A
-></DT
-><DD
-><DL
-><DT
->6.8.1. <A
-HREF="samba-pdc.html#AEN979"
->Configuration Instructions: Network Logons</A
-></DT
-><DT
->6.8.2. <A
-HREF="samba-pdc.html#AEN998"
->Configuration Instructions: Setting up Roaming User Profiles</A
-></DT
-></DL
-></DD
-><DT
->6.9. <A
-HREF="samba-pdc.html#AEN1091"
->DOMAIN_CONTROL.txt : Windows NT Domain Control &#38; Samba</A
-></DT
-></DL
-></DD
-><DT
->7. <A
-HREF="samba-bdc.html"
->How to Act as a Backup Domain Controller in a Purely Samba Controlled Domain</A
-></DT
-><DD
-><DL
-><DT
->7.1. <A
-HREF="samba-bdc.html#AEN1127"
->Prerequisite Reading</A
-></DT
-><DT
->7.2. <A
-HREF="samba-bdc.html#AEN1131"
->Background</A
-></DT
-><DT
->7.3. <A
-HREF="samba-bdc.html#AEN1139"
->What qualifies a Domain Controller on the network?</A
-></DT
-><DD
-><DL
-><DT
->7.3.1. <A
-HREF="samba-bdc.html#AEN1142"
->How does a Workstation find its domain controller?</A
-></DT
-><DT
->7.3.2. <A
-HREF="samba-bdc.html#AEN1145"
->When is the PDC needed?</A
-></DT
-></DL
-></DD
-><DT
->7.4. <A
-HREF="samba-bdc.html#AEN1148"
->Can Samba be a Backup Domain Controller?</A
-></DT
-><DT
->7.5. <A
-HREF="samba-bdc.html#AEN1152"
->How do I set up a Samba BDC?</A
-></DT
-><DD
-><DL
-><DT
->7.5.1. <A
-HREF="samba-bdc.html#AEN1169"
->How do I replicate the smbpasswd file?</A
-></DT
-></DL
-></DD
-></DL
-></DD
-><DT
->8. <A
-HREF="ads.html"
->Samba as a ADS domain member</A
-></DT
-><DD
-><DL
-><DT
->8.1. <A
-HREF="ads.html#AEN1187"
->Installing the required packages for Debian</A
-></DT
-><DT
->8.2. <A
-HREF="ads.html#AEN1193"
->Installing the required packages for RedHat</A
-></DT
-><DT
->8.3. <A
-HREF="ads.html#AEN1202"
->Compile Samba</A
-></DT
-><DT
->8.4. <A
-HREF="ads.html#AEN1217"
->Setup your /etc/krb5.conf</A
-></DT
-><DT
->8.5. <A
-HREF="ads.html#AEN1227"
->Create the computer account</A
-></DT
-><DD
-><DL
-><DT
->8.5.1. <A
-HREF="ads.html#AEN1231"
->Possible errors</A
-></DT
-></DL
-></DD
-><DT
->8.6. <A
-HREF="ads.html#AEN1243"
->Test your server setup</A
-></DT
-><DT
->8.7. <A
-HREF="ads.html#AEN1248"
->Testing with smbclient</A
-></DT
-><DT
->8.8. <A
-HREF="ads.html#AEN1251"
->Notes</A
-></DT
-></DL
-></DD
-><DT
->9. <A
-HREF="domain-security.html"
->Samba as a NT4 domain member</A
-></DT
-><DD
-><DL
-><DT
->9.1. <A
-HREF="domain-security.html#AEN1273"
->Joining an NT Domain with Samba 2.2</A
-></DT
-><DT
->9.2. <A
-HREF="domain-security.html#AEN1337"
->Samba and Windows 2000 Domains</A
-></DT
-><DT
->9.3. <A
-HREF="domain-security.html#AEN1342"
->Why is this better than security = server?</A
-></DT
-></DL
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="NAVFOOTER"
-><HR
-ALIGN="LEFT"
-WIDTH="100%"><TABLE
-SUMMARY="Footer navigation table"
-WIDTH="100%"
-BORDER="0"
-CELLPADDING="0"
-CELLSPACING="0"
-><TR
-><TD
-WIDTH="33%"
-ALIGN="left"
-VALIGN="top"
-><A
-HREF="pwencrypt.html"
-ACCESSKEY="P"
->Prev</A
-></TD
-><TD
-WIDTH="34%"
-ALIGN="center"
-VALIGN="top"
-><A
-HREF="samba-howto-collection.html"
-ACCESSKEY="H"
->Home</A
-></TD
-><TD
-WIDTH="33%"
-ALIGN="right"
-VALIGN="top"
-><A
-HREF="securitylevels.html"
-ACCESSKEY="N"
->Next</A
-></TD
-></TR
-><TR
-><TD
-WIDTH="33%"
-ALIGN="left"
-VALIGN="top"
->LanMan and NT Password Encryption in Samba</TD
-><TD
-WIDTH="34%"
-ALIGN="center"
-VALIGN="top"
->&nbsp;</TD
-><TD
-WIDTH="33%"
-ALIGN="right"
-VALIGN="top"
->User and Share security level (for servers not in a domain)</TD
-></TR
-></TABLE
-></DIV
-></BODY
-></HTML
-> \ No newline at end of file
+<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Part II. Server Configuration Basics</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="previous" href="FastStart.html" title="Chapter 3. FastStart for the Impatient"><link rel="next" href="ServerType.html" title="Chapter 4. Server Types and Security Modes"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Part II. Server Configuration Basics</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="FastStart.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center"> </th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="ServerType.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="part" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h1 class="title"><a name="type"></a>Server Configuration Basics</h1></div></div><div></div></div><div class="partintro" lang="en"><div><div><div><h1 class="title"><a name="id2886752"></a>First Steps in Server Configuration</h1></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+Samba can operate in various modes within SMB networks. This HOWTO section contains information on
+configuring samba to function as the type of server your network requires. Please read this
+section carefully.
+</p><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt>4. <a href="ServerType.html">Server Types and Security Modes</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2888708">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2888804">Server Types</a></dt><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2888887">Samba Security Modes</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2889003">User Level Security</a></dt><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2889136">Share Level Security</a></dt><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2889257">Domain Security Mode (User Level Security)</a></dt><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2889510">ADS Security Mode (User Level Security)</a></dt><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2889596">Server Security (User Level Security)</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2889820">Seamless Windows Network Integration</a></dt><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2889997">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2890025">What makes Samba a SERVER?</a></dt><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2890058">What makes Samba a Domain Controller?</a></dt><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2890086">What makes Samba a Domain Member?</a></dt><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2890120">Constantly Losing Connections to Password Server</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>5. <a href="samba-pdc.html">Domain Control</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2891927">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2892230">Basics of Domain Control</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2892246">Domain Controller Types</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2892458">Preparing for Domain Control</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2892778">Domain Control - Example Configuration</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2893076">Samba ADS Domain Control</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2893098">Domain and Network Logon Configuration</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2893113">Domain Network Logon Service</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2893441">Security Mode and Master Browsers</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2893548">Common Problems and Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2893555">I cannot include a '$' in a machine name</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2893594">I get told &quot;You already have a connection to the Domain....&quot;
+or &quot;Cannot join domain, the credentials supplied conflict with an
+existing set..&quot; when creating a machine trust account.</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2893643">The system can not log you on (C000019B)....</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2893714">The machine trust account for this computer either does not
+exist or is not accessible.</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2893771">When I attempt to login to a Samba Domain from a NT4/W2K workstation,
+I get a message about my account being disabled.</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2893798">Until a few minutes after Samba has started, clients get the error &quot;Domain Controller Unavailable&quot;</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>6. <a href="samba-bdc.html">Backup Domain Control</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2895956">Features And Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2896128">Essential Background Information</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2896156">MS Windows NT4 Style Domain Control</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2896368">Active Directory Domain Control</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2896390">What qualifies a Domain Controller on the network?</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2896416">How does a Workstation find its domain controller?</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2896462">Backup Domain Controller Configuration</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2896532">Example Configuration</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2896591">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2896605">Machine Accounts keep expiring, what can I do?</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2896630">Can Samba be a Backup Domain Controller to an NT4 PDC?</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2896663">How do I replicate the smbpasswd file?</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2896692">Can I do this all with LDAP?</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>7. <a href="domain-member.html">Domain Membership</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2897692">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2897816">MS Windows Workstation/Server Machine Trust Accounts</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2897991">Manual Creation of Machine Trust Accounts</a></dt><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2898243">Using NT4 Server Manager to Add Machine Accounts to the Domain</a></dt><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2898440">&quot;On-the-Fly&quot; Creation of Machine Trust Accounts</a></dt><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2898502">Making an MS Windows Workstation or Server a Domain Member</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2898648">Domain Member Server</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2898697">Joining an NT4 type Domain with Samba-3</a></dt><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2899075">Why is this better than security = server?</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="domain-member.html#ads-member">Samba ADS Domain Membership</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2899216">Setup your smb.conf</a></dt><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2899298">Setup your /etc/krb5.conf</a></dt><dt><a href="domain-member.html#ads-create-machine-account">Create the computer account</a></dt><dt><a href="domain-member.html#ads-test-server">Test your server setup</a></dt><dt><a href="domain-member.html#ads-test-smbclient">Testing with smbclient</a></dt><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2899656">Notes</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2899678">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2899712">Can Not Add Machine Back to Domain</a></dt><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2899742">Adding Machine to Domain Fails</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>8. <a href="StandAloneServer.html">Stand-Alone Servers</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="StandAloneServer.html#id2902078">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="StandAloneServer.html#id2902275">Background</a></dt><dt><a href="StandAloneServer.html#id2902347">Example Configuration</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="StandAloneServer.html#id2902362">Reference Documentation Server</a></dt><dt><a href="StandAloneServer.html#id2902411">Central Print Serving</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="StandAloneServer.html#id2902618">Common Errors</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>9. <a href="ClientConfig.html">MS Windows Network Configuration Guide</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="ClientConfig.html#id2901732">Note</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="FastStart.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="index.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="ServerType.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 3. FastStart for the Impatient </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="index.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 4. Server Types and Security Modes</td></tr></table></div></body></html>
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/vfstest.1.html b/docs/htmldocs/vfstest.1.html
index 1fd7880805..7b124c070f 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/vfstest.1.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/vfstest.1.html
@@ -1,487 +1,43 @@
-<!DOCTYPE HTML PUBLIC "-//W3C//DTD HTML 4.01//EN">
-<HTML
-><HEAD
-><TITLE
->vfstest</TITLE
-><META
-NAME="GENERATOR"
-CONTENT="Modular DocBook HTML Stylesheet Version 1.76b+
-"></HEAD
-><BODY
-CLASS="REFENTRY"
-BGCOLOR="#FFFFFF"
-TEXT="#000000"
-LINK="#0000FF"
-VLINK="#840084"
-ALINK="#0000FF"
-><H1
-><A
-NAME="VFSTEST">vfstest</H1
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFNAMEDIV"
-><A
-NAME="AEN5"
-></A
-><H2
->Name</H2
->vfstest&nbsp;--&nbsp;tool for testing samba VFS modules </DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSYNOPSISDIV"
-><A
-NAME="AEN8"><H2
->Synopsis</H2
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->vfstest</B
-> [-d debuglevel] [-c command] [-l logfile] [-h]</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN15"
-></A
-><H2
->DESCRIPTION</H2
-><P
->This tool is part of the <A
-HREF="samba.7.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-> Samba</A
-> suite.</P
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->vfstest</B
-> is a small command line
+<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>vfstest</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="vfstest.1"></a><div class="titlepage"><div></div><div></div></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>vfstest &#8212; tool for testing samba VFS modules </p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><tt class="command">vfstest</tt> [-d debuglevel] [-c command] [-l logfile] [-h]</p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This tool is part of the <a href="Samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">Samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p><b class="command">vfstest</b> is a small command line
utility that has the ability to test dso samba VFS modules. It gives the
user the ability to call the various VFS functions manually and
supports cascaded VFS modules.
- </P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN21"
-></A
-><H2
->OPTIONS</H2
-><P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
->-c|--command=command</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Execute the specified (colon-separated) commands.
+ </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">-c|--command=command</span></dt><dd><p>Execute the specified (colon-separated) commands.
See below for the commands that are available.
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-d|--debug=debuglevel</DT
-><DD
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="REPLACEABLE"
-><I
->debuglevel</I
-></TT
-> is an integer
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-h|--help</span></dt><dd><p>Print a summary of command line options.
+</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-l|--logfile=logbasename</span></dt><dd><p>File name for log/debug files. The extension
+ <tt class="constant">'.client'</tt> will be appended. The log file is never removed
+ by the client.
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-V</span></dt><dd><p>Prints the version number for
+<b class="command">smbd</b>.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-s &lt;configuration file&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>The file specified contains the
+configuration details required by the server. The
+information in this file includes server-specific
+information such as what printcap file to use, as well
+as descriptions of all the services that the server is
+to provide. See <a href="smb.conf.5.html" target="_top"><tt class="filename">
+smb.conf(5)</tt></a> for more information.
+The default configuration file name is determined at
+compile time.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-d|--debug=debuglevel</span></dt><dd><p><i class="replaceable"><tt>debuglevel</tt></i> is an integer
from 0 to 10. The default value if this parameter is
-not specified is zero.</P
-><P
->The higher this value, the more detail will be
+not specified is zero.</p><p>The higher this value, the more detail will be
logged to the log files about the activities of the
server. At level 0, only critical errors and serious
warnings will be logged. Level 1 is a reasonable level for
day to day running - it generates a small amount of
-information about operations carried out.</P
-><P
->Levels above 1 will generate considerable
+information about operations carried out.</p><p>Levels above 1 will generate considerable
amounts of log data, and should only be used when
investigating a problem. Levels above 3 are designed for
use only by developers and generate HUGE amounts of log
-data, most of which is extremely cryptic.</P
-><P
->Note that specifying this parameter here will
-override the <A
-HREF="smb.conf.5.html#loglevel"
-TARGET="_top"
->log
-level</A
-> parameter in the <A
-HREF="smb.conf.5.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-><TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->smb.conf(5)</TT
-></A
-> file.</P
-></DD
-><DT
->-h|--help</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Print a summary of command line options.</P
-></DD
-><DT
->-l|--logfile=logbasename</DT
-><DD
-><P
->File name for log/debug files. The extension
- <TT
-CLASS="CONSTANT"
->'.client'</TT
-> will be appended. The log file is never removed
- by the client.
- </P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN48"
-></A
-><H2
->COMMANDS</H2
-><P
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->VFS COMMANDS</I
-></P
-><P
-></P
-><UL
-><LI
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->load &#60;module.so&#62;</B
-> - Load specified VFS module </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->populate &#60;char&#62; &#60;size&#62;</B
-> - Populate a data buffer with the specified data
- </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->showdata [&#60;offset&#62; &#60;len&#62;]</B
-> - Show data currently in data buffer
- </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->connect</B
-> - VFS connect()</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->disconnect</B
-> - VFS disconnect()</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->disk_free</B
-> - VFS disk_free()</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->opendir</B
-> - VFS opendir()</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->readdir</B
-> - VFS readdir()</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->mkdir</B
-> - VFS mkdir()</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->rmdir</B
-> - VFS rmdir()</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->closedir</B
-> - VFS closedir()</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->open</B
-> - VFS open()</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->close</B
-> - VFS close()</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->read</B
-> - VFS read()</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->write</B
-> - VFS write()</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->lseek</B
-> - VFS lseek()</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->rename</B
-> - VFS rename()</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->fsync</B
-> - VFS fsync()</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->stat</B
-> - VFS stat()</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->fstat</B
-> - VFS fstat()</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->lstat</B
-> - VFS lstat()</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->unlink</B
-> - VFS unlink()</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->chmod</B
-> - VFS chmod()</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->fchmod</B
-> - VFS fchmod()</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->chown</B
-> - VFS chown()</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->fchown</B
-> - VFS fchown()</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->chdir</B
-> - VFS chdir()</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->getwd</B
-> - VFS getwd()</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->utime</B
-> - VFS utime()</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->ftruncate</B
-> - VFS ftruncate()</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->lock</B
-> - VFS lock()</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->symlink</B
-> - VFS symlink()</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->readlink</B
-> - VFS readlink()</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->link</B
-> - VFS link()</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->mknod</B
-> - VFS mknod()</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->realpath</B
-> - VFS realpath()</P
-></LI
-></UL
-><P
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->GENERAL COMMANDS</I
-></P
-><P
-></P
-><UL
-><LI
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->conf &#60;smb.conf&#62;</B
-> - Load a different configuration file</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->help [&#60;command&#62;]</B
-> - Get list of commands or info about specified command</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->debuglevel &#60;level&#62;</B
-> - Set debug level</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->freemem</B
-> - Free memory currently in use</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->exit</B
-> - Exit vfstest</P
-></LI
-></UL
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN179"
-></A
-><H2
->VERSION</H2
-><P
->This man page is correct for version 3.0 of the Samba
- suite.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN182"
-></A
-><H2
->AUTHOR</H2
-><P
->The original Samba software and related utilities
+data, most of which is extremely cryptic.</p><p>Note that specifying this parameter here will
+override the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#loglevel" target="_top">log
+level</a> parameter in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html" target="_top">
+<tt class="filename">smb.conf(5)</tt></a> file.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-l|--logfile=logbasename</span></dt><dd><p>File name for log/debug files. The extension
+<tt class="constant">&quot;.client&quot;</tt> will be appended. The log file is
+never removed by the client.
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>COMMANDS</h2><p><span class="emphasis"><em>VFS COMMANDS</em></span></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><b class="command">load &lt;module.so&gt;</b> - Load specified VFS module </p></li><li><p><b class="command">populate &lt;char&gt; &lt;size&gt;</b> - Populate a data buffer with the specified data
+ </p></li><li><p><b class="command">showdata [&lt;offset&gt; &lt;len&gt;]</b> - Show data currently in data buffer
+ </p></li><li><p><b class="command">connect</b> - VFS connect()</p></li><li><p><b class="command">disconnect</b> - VFS disconnect()</p></li><li><p><b class="command">disk_free</b> - VFS disk_free()</p></li><li><p><b class="command">opendir</b> - VFS opendir()</p></li><li><p><b class="command">readdir</b> - VFS readdir()</p></li><li><p><b class="command">mkdir</b> - VFS mkdir()</p></li><li><p><b class="command">rmdir</b> - VFS rmdir()</p></li><li><p><b class="command">closedir</b> - VFS closedir()</p></li><li><p><b class="command">open</b> - VFS open()</p></li><li><p><b class="command">close</b> - VFS close()</p></li><li><p><b class="command">read</b> - VFS read()</p></li><li><p><b class="command">write</b> - VFS write()</p></li><li><p><b class="command">lseek</b> - VFS lseek()</p></li><li><p><b class="command">rename</b> - VFS rename()</p></li><li><p><b class="command">fsync</b> - VFS fsync()</p></li><li><p><b class="command">stat</b> - VFS stat()</p></li><li><p><b class="command">fstat</b> - VFS fstat()</p></li><li><p><b class="command">lstat</b> - VFS lstat()</p></li><li><p><b class="command">unlink</b> - VFS unlink()</p></li><li><p><b class="command">chmod</b> - VFS chmod()</p></li><li><p><b class="command">fchmod</b> - VFS fchmod()</p></li><li><p><b class="command">chown</b> - VFS chown()</p></li><li><p><b class="command">fchown</b> - VFS fchown()</p></li><li><p><b class="command">chdir</b> - VFS chdir()</p></li><li><p><b class="command">getwd</b> - VFS getwd()</p></li><li><p><b class="command">utime</b> - VFS utime()</p></li><li><p><b class="command">ftruncate</b> - VFS ftruncate()</p></li><li><p><b class="command">lock</b> - VFS lock()</p></li><li><p><b class="command">symlink</b> - VFS symlink()</p></li><li><p><b class="command">readlink</b> - VFS readlink()</p></li><li><p><b class="command">link</b> - VFS link()</p></li><li><p><b class="command">mknod</b> - VFS mknod()</p></li><li><p><b class="command">realpath</b> - VFS realpath()</p></li></ul></div><p><span class="emphasis"><em>GENERAL COMMANDS</em></span></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><b class="command">conf &lt;smb.conf&gt;</b> - Load a different configuration file</p></li><li><p><b class="command">help [&lt;command&gt;]</b> - Get list of commands or info about specified command</p></li><li><p><b class="command">debuglevel &lt;level&gt;</b> - Set debug level</p></li><li><p><b class="command">freemem</b> - Free memory currently in use</p></li><li><p><b class="command">exit</b> - Exit vfstest</p></li></ul></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3.0 of the Samba
+ suite.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
- to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</P
-><P
->The vfstest man page was written by Jelmer Vernooij.</P
-></DIV
-></BODY
-></HTML
-> \ No newline at end of file
+ to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</p><p>The vfstest man page was written by Jelmer Vernooij.</p></div></div></body></html>
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/wbinfo.1.html b/docs/htmldocs/wbinfo.1.html
index a8aa065eed..13967b3e61 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/wbinfo.1.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/wbinfo.1.html
@@ -1,383 +1,71 @@
-<!DOCTYPE HTML PUBLIC "-//W3C//DTD HTML 4.01 Transitional//EN">
-<HTML
-><HEAD
-><TITLE
->wbinfo</TITLE
-><META
-NAME="GENERATOR"
-CONTENT="Modular DocBook HTML Stylesheet Version 1.77"></HEAD
-><BODY
-CLASS="REFENTRY"
-BGCOLOR="#FFFFFF"
-TEXT="#000000"
-LINK="#0000FF"
-VLINK="#840084"
-ALINK="#0000FF"
-><H1
-><A
-NAME="WBINFO"
-></A
->wbinfo</H1
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFNAMEDIV"
-><A
-NAME="AEN5"
-></A
-><H2
->Name</H2
->wbinfo&nbsp;--&nbsp;Query information from winbind daemon</DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSYNOPSISDIV"
-><A
-NAME="AEN8"
-></A
-><H2
->Synopsis</H2
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->wbinfo</B
-> [-u] [-g] [-i ip] [-N netbios-name] [-n name] [-s sid] [-U uid] [-G gid] [-S sid] [-Y sid] [-t] [-m] [-r user] [-a user%password] [-A user%password] [-p]</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN27"
-></A
-><H2
->DESCRIPTION</H2
-><P
->This tool is part of the <A
-HREF="samba.7.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-> Samba</A
-> suite.</P
-><P
->The <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->wbinfo</B
-> program queries and returns information
- created and used by the <A
-HREF="winbindd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
-> winbindd(8)</B
-></A
-> daemon. </P
-><P
->The <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->winbindd(8)</B
-> daemon must be configured
- and running for the <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->wbinfo</B
-> program to be able
- to return information.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN38"
-></A
-><H2
->OPTIONS</H2
-><P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
->-u</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This option will list all users available
- in the Windows NT domain for which the <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->winbindd(8)
- </B
-> daemon is operating in. Users in all trusted domains
+<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>wbinfo</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="wbinfo.1"></a><div class="titlepage"><div></div><div></div></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>wbinfo &#8212; Query information from winbind daemon</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><tt class="command">wbinfo</tt> [-u] [-g] [-N netbios-name] [-I ip] [-n name] [-s sid] [-U uid] [-G gid] [-S sid] [-Y sid] [-t] [-m] [--sequence] [-r user] [-a user%password] [-A user%password] [--get-auth-user] [-p]</p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This tool is part of the <a href="Samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">Samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p>The <b class="command">wbinfo</b> program queries and returns information
+ created and used by the <a href="winbindd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">winbindd</span>(8)</span></a> daemon. </p><p>The <a href="winbindd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">winbindd</span>(8)</span></a> daemon must be configured
+ and running for the <b class="command">wbinfo</b> program to be able
+ to return information.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">-u</span></dt><dd><p>This option will list all users available
+ in the Windows NT domain for which the <a href="winbindd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">winbindd</span>(8)</span></a> daemon is operating in. Users in all trusted domains
will also be listed. Note that this operation does not assign
- user ids to any users that have not already been seen by
- <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->winbindd(8)</B
->.</P
-></DD
-><DT
->-g</DT
-><DD
-><P
->This option will list all groups available
- in the Windows NT domain for which the <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->winbindd(8)
- </B
-> daemon is operating in. Groups in all trusted domains
+ user ids to any users that have not already been seen by <a href="winbindd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">winbindd</span>(8)</span></a>
+ .</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-g</span></dt><dd><p>This option will list all groups available
+ in the Windows NT domain for which the <a href="Samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">Samba</span>(7)</span></a> daemon is operating in. Groups in all trusted domains
will also be listed. Note that this operation does not assign
- group ids to any groups that have not already been seen by
- <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->winbindd(8)</B
->. </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-N name</DT
-><DD
-><P
->The <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->-N</I
-></TT
-> option
- queries <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->winbindd(8)</B
-> to query the WINS
+ group ids to any groups that have not already been
+ seen by <a href="winbindd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">winbindd</span>(8)</span></a>. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-N name</span></dt><dd><p>The <i class="parameter"><tt>-N</tt></i> option
+ queries <a href="winbindd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">winbindd</span>(8)</span></a> to query the WINS
server for the IP address associated with the NetBIOS name
- specified by the <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->name</I
-></TT
-> parameter.
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-I ip</DT
-><DD
-><P
->The <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->-I</I
-></TT
-> option
- queries <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->winbindd(8)</B
-> to send a node status
+ specified by the <i class="parameter"><tt>name</tt></i> parameter.
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-I ip</span></dt><dd><p>The <i class="parameter"><tt>-I</tt></i> option
+ queries <a href="winbindd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">winbindd</span>(8)</span></a> to send a node status
request to get the NetBIOS name associated with the IP address
- specified by the <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->ip</I
-></TT
-> parameter.
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-n name</DT
-><DD
-><P
->The <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->-n</I
-></TT
-> option
- queries <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->winbindd(8)</B
-> for the SID
+ specified by the <i class="parameter"><tt>ip</tt></i> parameter.
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-n name</span></dt><dd><p>The <i class="parameter"><tt>-n</tt></i> option
+ queries <a href="winbindd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">winbindd</span>(8)</span></a> for the SID
associated with the name specified. Domain names can be specified
before the user name by using the winbind separator character.
For example CWDOM1/Administrator refers to the Administrator
user in the domain CWDOM1. If no domain is specified then the
- domain used is the one specified in the <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->smb.conf</TT
->
- <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->workgroup</I
-></TT
-> parameter. </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-s sid</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Use <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->-s</I
-></TT
-> to resolve
- a SID to a name. This is the inverse of the <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->-n
- </I
-></TT
-> option above. SIDs must be specified as ASCII strings
+ domain used is the one specified in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> <i class="parameter"><tt>workgroup
+ </tt></i> parameter. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-s sid</span></dt><dd><p>Use <i class="parameter"><tt>-s</tt></i> to resolve
+ a SID to a name. This is the inverse of the <i class="parameter"><tt>-n
+ </tt></i> option above. SIDs must be specified as ASCII strings
in the traditional Microsoft format. For example,
- S-1-5-21-1455342024-3071081365-2475485837-500. </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-U uid</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Try to convert a UNIX user id to a Windows NT
+ S-1-5-21-1455342024-3071081365-2475485837-500. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-U uid</span></dt><dd><p>Try to convert a UNIX user id to a Windows NT
SID. If the uid specified does not refer to one within
- the winbind uid range then the operation will fail. </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-G gid</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Try to convert a UNIX group id to a Windows
+ the winbind uid range then the operation will fail. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-G gid</span></dt><dd><p>Try to convert a UNIX group id to a Windows
NT SID. If the gid specified does not refer to one within
- the winbind gid range then the operation will fail. </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-S sid</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Convert a SID to a UNIX user id. If the SID
- does not correspond to a UNIX user mapped by <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
-> winbindd(8)</B
-> then the operation will fail. </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-Y sid</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Convert a SID to a UNIX group id. If the SID
- does not correspond to a UNIX group mapped by <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
-> winbindd(8)</B
-> then the operation will fail. </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-t</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Verify that the workstation trust account
+ the winbind gid range then the operation will fail. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-S sid</span></dt><dd><p>Convert a SID to a UNIX user id. If the SID
+ does not correspond to a UNIX user mapped by <a href="winbindd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">winbindd</span>(8)</span></a> then the operation will fail. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-Y sid</span></dt><dd><p>Convert a SID to a UNIX group id. If the SID
+ does not correspond to a UNIX group mapped by <a href="winbindd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">winbindd</span>(8)</span></a> then
+ the operation will fail. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-t</span></dt><dd><p>Verify that the workstation trust account
created when the Samba server is added to the Windows NT
- domain is working. </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-m</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Produce a list of domains trusted by the
- Windows NT server <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->winbindd(8)</B
-> contacts
+ domain is working. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-m</span></dt><dd><p>Produce a list of domains trusted by the
+ Windows NT server <a href="winbindd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">winbindd</span>(8)</span></a> contacts
when resolving names. This list does not include the Windows
NT domain the server is a Primary Domain Controller for.
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-r username</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Try to obtain the list of UNIX group ids
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term">--sequence</span></dt><dd><p>Show sequence numbers of
+ all known domains</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-r username</span></dt><dd><p>Try to obtain the list of UNIX group ids
to which the user belongs. This only works for users
defined on a Domain Controller.
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-a username%password</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Attempt to authenticate a user via winbindd.
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-a username%password</span></dt><dd><p>Attempt to authenticate a user via winbindd.
This checks both authenticaion methods and reports its results.
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-A username%password</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Store username and password used by winbindd
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-A username%password</span></dt><dd><p>Store username and password used by winbindd
during session setup to a domain controller. This enables
winbindd to operate in a Windows 2000 domain with Restrict
Anonymous turned on (a.k.a. Permissions compatiable with
Windows 2000 servers only).
- </P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN120"
-></A
-><H2
->EXIT STATUS</H2
-><P
->The wbinfo program returns 0 if the operation
- succeeded, or 1 if the operation failed. If the <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->winbindd(8)
- </B
-> daemon is not working <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->wbinfo</B
-> will always return
- failure. </P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN125"
-></A
-><H2
->VERSION</H2
-><P
->This man page is correct for version 3.0 of
- the Samba suite.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN128"
-></A
-><H2
->SEE ALSO</H2
-><P
-><A
-HREF="winbindd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->winbindd(8)</B
->
- </A
-></P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN133"
-></A
-><H2
->AUTHOR</H2
-><P
->The original Samba software and related utilities
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term">--get-auth-user</span></dt><dd><p>Print username and password used by winbindd
+ during session setup to a domain controller. Username
+ and password can be set using '-A'. Only available for
+ root.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-p</span></dt><dd><p>Check whether winbindd is still alive.
+ Prints out either 'succeeded' or 'failed'.
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-V</span></dt><dd><p>Prints the version number for
+<b class="command">smbd</b>.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-h|--help</span></dt><dd><p>Print a summary of command line options.
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>EXIT STATUS</h2><p>The wbinfo program returns 0 if the operation
+ succeeded, or 1 if the operation failed. If the <a href="winbindd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">winbindd</span>(8)</span></a> daemon is not working <b class="command">wbinfo</b> will always return
+ failure. </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3.0 of
+ the Samba suite.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>SEE ALSO</h2><p><a href="winbindd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">winbindd</span>(8)</span></a></p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
- to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</P
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->wbinfo</B
-> and <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->winbindd</B
->
- were written by Tim Potter.</P
-><P
->The conversion to DocBook for Samba 2.2 was done
- by Gerald Carter</P
-></DIV
-></BODY
-></HTML
-> \ No newline at end of file
+ to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</p><p><b class="command">wbinfo</b> and <b class="command">winbindd</b>
+ were written by Tim Potter.</p><p>The conversion to DocBook for Samba 2.2 was done
+ by Gerald Carter. The conversion to DocBook XML 4.2 for Samba
+ 3.0 was done by Alexander Bokovoy.</p></div></div></body></html>
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/winbind.html b/docs/htmldocs/winbind.html
index 1558512a61..8ba0047742 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/winbind.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/winbind.html
@@ -1,244 +1,74 @@
-<!DOCTYPE HTML PUBLIC "-//W3C//DTD HTML 4.01 Transitional//EN">
-<HTML
-><HEAD
-><TITLE
->Unified Logons between Windows NT and UNIX using Winbind</TITLE
-><META
-NAME="GENERATOR"
-CONTENT="Modular DocBook HTML Stylesheet Version 1.76b+
-"><LINK
-REL="HOME"
-TITLE="SAMBA Project Documentation"
-HREF="samba-howto-collection.html"><LINK
-REL="UP"
-TITLE="Optional configuration"
-HREF="optional.html"><LINK
-REL="PREVIOUS"
-TITLE="Printing Support"
-HREF="printing.html"><LINK
-REL="NEXT"
-TITLE="Passdb MySQL plugin"
-HREF="pdb-mysql.html"></HEAD
-><BODY
-CLASS="CHAPTER"
-BGCOLOR="#FFFFFF"
-TEXT="#000000"
-LINK="#0000FF"
-VLINK="#840084"
-ALINK="#0000FF"
-><DIV
-CLASS="NAVHEADER"
-><TABLE
-SUMMARY="Header navigation table"
-WIDTH="100%"
-BORDER="0"
-CELLPADDING="0"
-CELLSPACING="0"
-><TR
-><TH
-COLSPAN="3"
-ALIGN="center"
->SAMBA Project Documentation</TH
-></TR
-><TR
-><TD
-WIDTH="10%"
-ALIGN="left"
-VALIGN="bottom"
-><A
-HREF="printing.html"
-ACCESSKEY="P"
->Prev</A
-></TD
-><TD
-WIDTH="80%"
-ALIGN="center"
-VALIGN="bottom"
-></TD
-><TD
-WIDTH="10%"
-ALIGN="right"
-VALIGN="bottom"
-><A
-HREF="pdb-mysql.html"
-ACCESSKEY="N"
->Next</A
-></TD
-></TR
-></TABLE
-><HR
-ALIGN="LEFT"
-WIDTH="100%"></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="CHAPTER"
-><H1
-><A
-NAME="WINBIND">Chapter 15. Unified Logons between Windows NT and UNIX using Winbind</H1
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><H1
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN2225">15.1. Abstract</H1
-><P
->Integration of UNIX and Microsoft Windows NT through
- a unified logon has been considered a "holy grail" in heterogeneous
+<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 21. Integrated Logon Support using Winbind</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="optional.html" title="Part III. Advanced Configuration"><link rel="previous" href="VFS.html" title="Chapter 20. Stackable VFS modules"><link rel="next" href="AdvancedNetworkManagement.html" title="Chapter 22. Advanced Network Manangement"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 21. Integrated Logon Support using Winbind</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="VFS.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part III. Advanced Configuration</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="AdvancedNetworkManagement.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="winbind"></a>Chapter 21. Integrated Logon Support using Winbind</h2></div><div><div class="authorgroup"><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Tim</span> <span class="surname">Potter</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email">&lt;<a href="mailto:tpot@linuxcare.com.au">tpot@linuxcare.com.au</a>&gt;</tt></p></div></div></div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Andrew</span> <span class="surname">Tridgell</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email">&lt;<a href="mailto:tridge@samba.org">tridge@samba.org</a>&gt;</tt></p></div></div></div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Naag</span> <span class="surname">Mummaneni</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><div class="address"><p><tt class="email">&lt;<a href="mailto:getnag@rediffmail.com">getnag@rediffmail.com</a>&gt;</tt></p></div></div></div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="othername">R.</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">The Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email">&lt;<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</a>&gt;</tt></p></div></div></div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email">&lt;<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>&gt;</tt></p></div></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">27 June 2002</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2979118">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2979146">Introduction</a></dt><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2979218">What Winbind Provides</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2979278">Target Uses</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2979309">How Winbind Works</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2979337">Microsoft Remote Procedure Calls</a></dt><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2979371">Microsoft Active Directory Services</a></dt><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2979394">Name Service Switch</a></dt><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2979530">Pluggable Authentication Modules</a></dt><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2979602">User and Group ID Allocation</a></dt><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2979637">Result Caching</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2979664">Installation and Configuration</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2979692">Introduction</a></dt><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2979768">Requirements</a></dt><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2979861">Testing Things Out</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2981479">Conclusion</a></dt><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2981498">Common Errors</a></dt></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2979118"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>Integration of UNIX and Microsoft Windows NT through
+ a unified logon has been considered a &quot;holy grail&quot; in heterogeneous
computing environments for a long time. We present
- <SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->winbind</I
-></SPAN
->, a component of the Samba suite
+ <span class="emphasis"><em>winbind</em></span>, a component of the Samba suite
of programs as a solution to the unified logon problem. Winbind
uses a UNIX implementation
of Microsoft RPC calls, Pluggable Authentication Modules, and the Name
Service Switch to allow Windows NT domain users to appear and operate
as UNIX users on a UNIX machine. This paper describes the winbind
system, explaining the functionality it provides, how it is configured,
- and how it works internally.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><H1
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN2229">15.2. Introduction</H1
-><P
->It is well known that UNIX and Microsoft Windows NT have
+ and how it works internally.</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2979146"></a>Introduction</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>It is well known that UNIX and Microsoft Windows NT have
different models for representing user and group information and
use different technologies for implementing them. This fact has
made it difficult to integrate the two systems in a satisfactory
- manner.</P
-><P
->One common solution in use today has been to create
+ manner.</p><p>One common solution in use today has been to create
identically named user accounts on both the UNIX and Windows systems
and use the Samba suite of programs to provide file and print services
between the two. This solution is far from perfect however, as
adding and deleting users on both sets of machines becomes a chore
and two sets of passwords are required both of which
can lead to synchronization problems between the UNIX and Windows
- systems and confusion for users.</P
-><P
->We divide the unified logon problem for UNIX machines into
- three smaller problems:</P
-><P
-></P
-><UL
-><LI
-><P
->Obtaining Windows NT user and group information
- </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->Authenticating Windows NT users
- </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->Password changing for Windows NT users
- </P
-></LI
-></UL
-><P
->Ideally, a prospective solution to the unified logon problem
+ systems and confusion for users.</p><p>We divide the unified logon problem for UNIX machines into
+ three smaller problems:</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Obtaining Windows NT user and group information
+ </p></li><li><p>Authenticating Windows NT users
+ </p></li><li><p>Password changing for Windows NT users
+ </p></li></ul></div><p>Ideally, a prospective solution to the unified logon problem
would satisfy all the above components without duplication of
information on the UNIX machines and without creating additional
tasks for the system administrator when maintaining users and
groups on either system. The winbind system provides a simple
and elegant solution to all three components of the unified logon
- problem.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><H1
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN2242">15.3. What Winbind Provides</H1
-><P
->Winbind unifies UNIX and Windows NT account management by
+ problem.</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2979218"></a>What Winbind Provides</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>Winbind unifies UNIX and Windows NT account management by
allowing a UNIX box to become a full member of a NT domain. Once
this is done the UNIX box will see NT users and groups as if
they were native UNIX users and groups, allowing the NT domain
to be used in much the same manner that NIS+ is used within
- UNIX-only environments.</P
-><P
->The end result is that whenever any
+ UNIX-only environments.</p><p>The end result is that whenever any
program on the UNIX machine asks the operating system to lookup
a user or group name, the query will be resolved by asking the
NT domain controller for the specified domain to do the lookup.
Because Winbind hooks into the operating system at a low level
(via the NSS name resolution modules in the C library) this
redirection to the NT domain controller is completely
- transparent.</P
-><P
->Users on the UNIX machine can then use NT user and group
- names as they would use "native" UNIX names. They can chown files
+ transparent.</p><p>Users on the UNIX machine can then use NT user and group
+ names as they would use &quot;native&quot; UNIX names. They can chown files
so that they are owned by NT domain users or even login to the
- UNIX machine and run a UNIX X-Window session as a domain user.</P
-><P
->The only obvious indication that Winbind is being used is
+ UNIX machine and run a UNIX X-Window session as a domain user.</p><p>The only obvious indication that Winbind is being used is
that user and group names take the form DOMAIN\user and
DOMAIN\group. This is necessary as it allows Winbind to determine
that redirection to a domain controller is wanted for a particular
- lookup and which trusted domain is being referenced.</P
-><P
->Additionally, Winbind provides an authentication service
+ lookup and which trusted domain is being referenced.</p><p>Additionally, Winbind provides an authentication service
that hooks into the Pluggable Authentication Modules (PAM) system
to provide authentication via a NT domain to any PAM enabled
applications. This capability solves the problem of synchronizing
passwords between systems since all passwords are stored in a single
- location (on the domain controller).</P
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><H2
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN2249">15.3.1. Target Uses</H2
-><P
->Winbind is targeted at organizations that have an
+ location (on the domain controller).</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2979278"></a>Target Uses</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>Winbind is targeted at organizations that have an
existing NT based domain infrastructure into which they wish
to put UNIX workstations or servers. Winbind will allow these
organizations to deploy UNIX workstations without having to
maintain a separate account infrastructure. This greatly
simplifies the administrative overhead of deploying UNIX
- workstations into a NT based organization.</P
-><P
->Another interesting way in which we expect Winbind to
+ workstations into a NT based organization.</p><p>Another interesting way in which we expect Winbind to
be used is as a central part of UNIX based appliances. Appliances
that provide file and print services to Microsoft based networks
will be able to use Winbind to provide seamless integration of
- the appliance into the domain.</P
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><H1
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN2253">15.4. How Winbind Works</H1
-><P
->The winbind system is designed around a client/server
- architecture. A long running <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->winbindd</B
-> daemon
+ the appliance into the domain.</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2979309"></a>How Winbind Works</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>The winbind system is designed around a client/server
+ architecture. A long running <b class="command">winbindd</b> daemon
listens on a UNIX domain socket waiting for requests
to arrive. These requests are generated by the NSS and PAM
- clients and processed sequentially.</P
-><P
->The technologies used to implement winbind are described
- in detail below.</P
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><H2
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN2258">15.4.1. Microsoft Remote Procedure Calls</H2
-><P
->Over the last two years, efforts have been underway
+ clients and processed sequentially.</p><p>The technologies used to implement winbind are described
+ in detail below.</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2979337"></a>Microsoft Remote Procedure Calls</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>Over the last few years, efforts have been underway
by various Samba Team members to decode various aspects of
the Microsoft Remote Procedure Call (MSRPC) system. This
system is used for most network related operations between
@@ -246,23 +76,21 @@ NAME="AEN2258">15.4.1. Microsoft Remote Procedure Calls</H2
and print spooling. Although initially this work was done
to aid the implementation of Primary Domain Controller (PDC)
functionality in Samba, it has also yielded a body of code which
- can be used for other purposes.</P
-><P
->Winbind uses various MSRPC calls to enumerate domain users
+ can be used for other purposes.</p><p>Winbind uses various MSRPC calls to enumerate domain users
and groups and to obtain detailed information about individual
users or groups. Other MSRPC calls can be used to authenticate
NT domain users and to change user passwords. By directly querying
a Windows PDC for user and group information, winbind maps the
- NT account information onto UNIX user and group names.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><H2
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN2262">15.4.2. Name Service Switch</H2
-><P
->The Name Service Switch, or NSS, is a feature that is
+ NT account information onto UNIX user and group names.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2979371"></a>Microsoft Active Directory Services</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+ Since late 2001, Samba has gained the ability to
+ interact with Microsoft Windows 2000 using its 'Native
+ Mode' protocols, rather than the NT4 RPC services.
+ Using LDAP and Kerberos, a domain member running
+ winbind can enumerate users and groups in exactly the
+ same way as a Win2k client would, and in so doing
+ provide a much more efficient and
+ effective winbind implementation.
+ </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2979394"></a>Name Service Switch</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>The Name Service Switch, or NSS, is a feature that is
present in many UNIX operating systems. It allows system
information such as hostnames, mail aliases and user information
to be resolved from different sources. For example, a standalone
@@ -270,9 +98,7 @@ NAME="AEN2262">15.4.2. Name Service Switch</H2
flat files stored on the local filesystem. A networked workstation
may first attempt to resolve system information from local files,
and then consult a NIS database for user information or a DNS server
- for hostname information.</P
-><P
->The NSS application programming interface allows winbind
+ for hostname information.</p><p>The NSS application programming interface allows winbind
to present itself as a source of system information when
resolving UNIX usernames and groups. Winbind uses this interface,
and information obtained from a Windows NT server using MSRPC
@@ -280,67 +106,28 @@ NAME="AEN2262">15.4.2. Name Service Switch</H2
UNIX library calls, one can enumerate the users and groups on
a UNIX machine running winbind and see all users and groups in
a NT domain plus any trusted domain as though they were local
- users and groups.</P
-><P
->The primary control file for NSS is
- <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/nsswitch.conf</TT
->.
+ users and groups.</p><p>The primary control file for NSS is
+ <tt class="filename">/etc/nsswitch.conf</tt>.
When a UNIX application makes a request to do a lookup
- the C library looks in <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/nsswitch.conf</TT
->
+ the C library looks in <tt class="filename">/etc/nsswitch.conf</tt>
for a line which matches the service type being requested, for
- example the "passwd" service type is used when user or group names
+ example the &quot;passwd&quot; service type is used when user or group names
are looked up. This config line species which implementations
of that service should be tried and in what order. If the passwd
- config line is:</P
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->passwd: files example</B
-></P
-><P
->then the C library will first load a module called
- <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/lib/libnss_files.so</TT
-> followed by
- the module <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/lib/libnss_example.so</TT
->. The
+ config line is:</p><pre class="programlisting">
+passwd: files example
+ </pre><p>then the C library will first load a module called
+ <tt class="filename">/lib/libnss_files.so</tt> followed by
+ the module <tt class="filename">/lib/libnss_example.so</tt>. The
C library will dynamically load each of these modules in turn
and call resolver functions within the modules to try to resolve
the request. Once the request is resolved the C library returns the
- result to the application.</P
-><P
->This NSS interface provides a very easy way for Winbind
+ result to the application.</p><p>This NSS interface provides a very easy way for Winbind
to hook into the operating system. All that needs to be done
- is to put <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->libnss_winbind.so</TT
-> in <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/lib/</TT
->
- then add "winbind" into <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/nsswitch.conf</TT
-> at
+ is to put <tt class="filename">libnss_winbind.so</tt> in <tt class="filename">/lib/</tt>
+ then add &quot;winbind&quot; into <tt class="filename">/etc/nsswitch.conf</tt> at
the appropriate place. The C library will then call Winbind to
- resolve user and group names.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><H2
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN2278">15.4.3. Pluggable Authentication Modules</H2
-><P
->Pluggable Authentication Modules, also known as PAM,
+ resolve user and group names.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2979530"></a>Pluggable Authentication Modules</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>Pluggable Authentication Modules, also known as PAM,
is a system for abstracting authentication and authorization
technologies. With a PAM module it is possible to specify different
authentication methods for different system applications without
@@ -348,46 +135,24 @@ NAME="AEN2278">15.4.3. Pluggable Authentication Modules</H2
for implementing a particular policy for authorization. For example,
a system administrator may only allow console logins from users
stored in the local password file but only allow users resolved from
- a NIS database to log in over the network.</P
-><P
->Winbind uses the authentication management and password
+ a NIS database to log in over the network.</p><p>Winbind uses the authentication management and password
management PAM interface to integrate Windows NT users into a
UNIX system. This allows Windows NT users to log in to a UNIX
machine and be authenticated against a suitable Primary Domain
Controller. These users can also change their passwords and have
this change take effect directly on the Primary Domain Controller.
- </P
-><P
->PAM is configured by providing control files in the directory
- <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/pam.d/</TT
-> for each of the services that
+ </p><p>PAM is configured by providing control files in the directory
+ <tt class="filename">/etc/pam.d/</tt> for each of the services that
require authentication. When an authentication request is made
by an application the PAM code in the C library looks up this
control file to determine what modules to load to do the
authentication check and in what order. This interface makes adding
a new authentication service for Winbind very easy, all that needs
- to be done is that the <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->pam_winbind.so</TT
-> module
- is copied to <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/lib/security/</TT
-> and the PAM
+ to be done is that the <tt class="filename">pam_winbind.so</tt> module
+ is copied to <tt class="filename">/lib/security/</tt> and the PAM
control files for relevant services are updated to allow
authentication via winbind. See the PAM documentation
- for more details.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><H2
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN2286">15.4.4. User and Group ID Allocation</H2
-><P
->When a user or group is created under Windows NT
+ for more details.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2979602"></a>User and Group ID Allocation</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>When a user or group is created under Windows NT
is it allocated a numerical relative identifier (RID). This is
slightly different to UNIX which has a range of numbers that are
used to identify users, and the same range in which to identify
@@ -398,20 +163,9 @@ NAME="AEN2286">15.4.4. User and Group ID Allocation</H2
resolved for the first time, it is allocated the next UNIX id from
the range. The same process applies for Windows NT groups. Over
time, winbind will have mapped all Windows NT users and groups
- to UNIX user ids and group ids.</P
-><P
->The results of this mapping are stored persistently in
+ to UNIX user ids and group ids.</p><p>The results of this mapping are stored persistently in
an ID mapping database held in a tdb database). This ensures that
- RIDs are mapped to UNIX IDs in a consistent way.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><H2
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN2290">15.4.5. Result Caching</H2
-><P
->An active system can generate a lot of user and group
+ RIDs are mapped to UNIX IDs in a consistent way.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2979637"></a>Result Caching</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>An active system can generate a lot of user and group
name lookups. To reduce the network cost of these lookups winbind
uses a caching scheme based on the SAM sequence number supplied
by NT domain controllers. User or group information returned
@@ -422,1182 +176,557 @@ NAME="AEN2290">15.4.5. Result Caching</H2
the PDC and compared against the sequence number of the cached entry.
If the sequence numbers do not match, then the cached information
is discarded and up to date information is requested directly
- from the PDC.</P
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><H1
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN2293">15.5. Installation and Configuration</H1
-><P
->Many thanks to John Trostel <A
-HREF="mailto:jtrostel@snapserver.com"
-TARGET="_top"
->jtrostel@snapserver.com</A
->
-for providing the HOWTO for this section.</P
-><P
->This HOWTO describes how to get winbind services up and running
+ from the PDC.</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2979664"></a>Installation and Configuration</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+Many thanks to John Trostel <a href="mailto:jtrostel@snapserver.com" target="_top">jtrostel@snapserver.com</a>
+for providing the HOWTO for this section.
+</p><p>
+This HOWTO describes how to get winbind services up and running
to control access and authenticate users on your Linux box using
-the winbind services which come with SAMBA 2.2.2.</P
-><P
->There is also some Solaris specific information in
-<TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->docs/textdocs/Solaris-Winbind-HOWTO.txt</TT
->.
-Future revisions of this document will incorporate that
-information.</P
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><H2
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN2300">15.5.1. Introduction</H2
-><P
->This HOWTO describes the procedures used to get winbind up and
-running on my RedHat 7.1 system. Winbind is capable of providing access
+the winbind services which come with SAMBA 3.0.
+</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2979692"></a>Introduction</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+This section describes the procedures used to get winbind up and
+running on a RedHat 7.1 system. Winbind is capable of providing access
and authentication control for Windows Domain users through an NT
or Win2K PDC for 'regular' services, such as telnet a nd ftp, as
-well for SAMBA services.</P
-><P
->This HOWTO has been written from a 'RedHat-centric' perspective, so if
+well for SAMBA services.
+</p><p>
+This HOWTO has been written from a 'RedHat-centric' perspective, so if
you are using another distribution, you may have to modify the instructions
-somewhat to fit the way your distribution works.</P
-><P
-></P
-><UL
-><LI
-><P
-> <SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->Why should I to this?</I
-></SPAN
->
- </P
-><P
->This allows the SAMBA administrator to rely on the
+somewhat to fit the way your distribution works.
+</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>
+ <span class="emphasis"><em>Why should I to this?</em></span>
+ </p><p>This allows the SAMBA administrator to rely on the
authentication mechanisms on the NT/Win2K PDC for the authentication
of domain members. NT/Win2K users no longer need to have separate
accounts on the SAMBA server.
- </P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-> <SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->Who should be reading this document?</I
-></SPAN
->
- </P
-><P
-> This HOWTO is designed for system administrators. If you are
+ </p></li><li><p>
+ <span class="emphasis"><em>Who should be reading this document?</em></span>
+ </p><p>
+ This HOWTO is designed for system administrators. If you are
implementing SAMBA on a file server and wish to (fairly easily)
integrate existing NT/Win2K users from your PDC onto the
SAMBA server, this HOWTO is for you. That said, I am no NT or PAM
expert, so you may find a better or easier way to accomplish
these tasks.
- </P
-></LI
-></UL
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><H2
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN2313">15.5.2. Requirements</H2
-><P
->If you have a samba configuration file that you are currently
-using... <SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->BACK IT UP!</I
-></SPAN
-> If your system already uses PAM,
-<SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->back up the <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/pam.d</TT
-> directory
-contents!</I
-></SPAN
-> If you haven't already made a boot disk,
-<SPAN
-CLASS="emphasis"
-><I
-CLASS="EMPHASIS"
->MAKE ONE NOW!</I
-></SPAN
-></P
-><P
->Messing with the pam configuration files can make it nearly impossible
+ </p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2979768"></a>Requirements</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+If you have a samba configuration file that you are currently
+using... <span class="emphasis"><em>BACK IT UP!</em></span> If your system already uses PAM,
+<span class="emphasis"><em>back up the <tt class="filename">/etc/pam.d</tt> directory
+contents!</em></span> If you haven't already made a boot disk,
+<span class="emphasis"><em>MAKE ONE NOW!</em></span>
+</p><p>
+Messing with the pam configuration files can make it nearly impossible
to log in to yourmachine. That's why you want to be able to boot back
into your machine in single user mode and restore your
-<TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/pam.d</TT
-> back to the original state they were in if
-you get frustrated with the way things are going. ;-)</P
-><P
->The latest version of SAMBA (version 3.0 as of this writing), now
+<tt class="filename">/etc/pam.d</tt> back to the original state they were in if
+you get frustrated with the way things are going. ;-)
+</p><p>
+The latest version of SAMBA (version 3.0 as of this writing), now
includes a functioning winbindd daemon. Please refer to the
-<A
-HREF="http://samba.org/"
-TARGET="_top"
->main SAMBA web page</A
-> or,
+<a href="http://samba.org/" target="_top">main SAMBA web page</a> or,
better yet, your closest SAMBA mirror site for instructions on
-downloading the source code.</P
-><P
->To allow Domain users the ability to access SAMBA shares and
+downloading the source code.
+</p><p>
+To allow Domain users the ability to access SAMBA shares and
files, as well as potentially other services provided by your
SAMBA machine, PAM (pluggable authentication modules) must
be setup properly on your machine. In order to compile the
winbind modules, you should have at least the pam libraries resident
on your system. For recent RedHat systems (7.1, for instance), that
-means <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->pam-0.74-22</TT
->. For best results, it is helpful to also
-install the development packages in <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->pam-devel-0.74-22</TT
->.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><H2
-CLASS="SECT2"
-><A
-NAME="AEN2327">15.5.3. Testing Things Out</H2
-><P
->Before starting, it is probably best to kill off all the SAMBA
-related daemons running on your server. Kill off all <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbd</B
->,
-<B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->nmbd</B
->, and <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->winbindd</B
-> processes that may
+means <tt class="filename">pam-0.74-22</tt>. For best results, it is helpful to also
+install the development packages in <tt class="filename">pam-devel-0.74-22</tt>.
+</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2979861"></a>Testing Things Out</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+Before starting, it is probably best to kill off all the SAMBA
+related daemons running on your server. Kill off all <span class="application">smbd</span>,
+<span class="application">nmbd</span>, and <span class="application">winbindd</span> processes that may
be running. To use PAM, you will want to make sure that you have the
-standard PAM package (for RedHat) which supplies the <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/pam.d</TT
->
+standard PAM package (for RedHat) which supplies the <tt class="filename">/etc/pam.d</tt>
directory structure, including the pam modules are used by pam-aware
-services, several pam libraries, and the <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/usr/doc</TT
->
-and <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/usr/man</TT
-> entries for pam. Winbind built better
+services, several pam libraries, and the <tt class="filename">/usr/doc</tt>
+and <tt class="filename">/usr/man</tt> entries for pam. Winbind built better
in SAMBA if the pam-devel package was also installed. This package includes
-the header files needed to compile pam-aware applications. For instance,
-my RedHat system has both <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->pam-0.74-22</TT
-> and
-<TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->pam-devel-0.74-22</TT
-> RPMs installed.</P
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><H3
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><A
-NAME="AEN2338">15.5.3.1. Configure and compile SAMBA</H3
-><P
->The configuration and compilation of SAMBA is pretty straightforward.
+the header files needed to compile pam-aware applications.
+</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2979923"></a>Configure and compile SAMBA</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+The configuration and compilation of SAMBA is pretty straightforward.
The first three steps may not be necessary depending upon
-whether or not you have previously built the Samba binaries.</P
-><P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
-><TT
-CLASS="PROMPT"
->root#</TT
-> <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->autoconf</B
->
-<TT
-CLASS="PROMPT"
->root#</TT
-> <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->make clean</B
->
-<TT
-CLASS="PROMPT"
->root#</TT
-> <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->rm config.cache</B
->
-<TT
-CLASS="PROMPT"
->root#</TT
-> <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->./configure --with-winbind</B
->
-<TT
-CLASS="PROMPT"
->root#</TT
-> <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->make</B
->
-<TT
-CLASS="PROMPT"
->root#</TT
-> <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->make install</B
-></PRE
-></P
-><P
->This will, by default, install SAMBA in <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/usr/local/samba</TT
->.
+whether or not you have previously built the Samba binaries.
+</p><pre class="screen">
+<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="command">autoconf</b>
+<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="command">make clean</b>
+<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="command">rm config.cache</b>
+<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="command">./configure</b>
+<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="command">make</b>
+<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="command">make install</b>
+</pre><p>
+This will, by default, install SAMBA in <tt class="filename">/usr/local/samba</tt>.
See the main SAMBA documentation if you want to install SAMBA somewhere else.
-It will also build the winbindd executable and libraries. </P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><H3
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><A
-NAME="AEN2357">15.5.3.2. Configure <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->nsswitch.conf</TT
-> and the
-winbind libraries</H3
-><P
->The libraries needed to run the <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->winbindd</B
-> daemon
-through nsswitch need to be copied to their proper locations, so</P
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="PROMPT"
->root#</TT
-> <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->cp ../samba/source/nsswitch/libnss_winbind.so /lib</B
-></P
-><P
->I also found it necessary to make the following symbolic link:</P
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="PROMPT"
->root#</TT
-> <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->ln -s /lib/libnss_winbind.so /lib/libnss_winbind.so.2</B
-></P
-><P
->And, in the case of Sun solaris:</P
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="PROMPT"
->root#</TT
-> <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->ln -s /usr/lib/libnss_winbind.so /usr/lib/libnss_winbind.so.1</B
->
-<TT
-CLASS="PROMPT"
->root#</TT
-> <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->ln -s /usr/lib/libnss_winbind.so /usr/lib/nss_winbind.so.1</B
->
-<TT
-CLASS="PROMPT"
->root#</TT
-> <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->ln -s /usr/lib/libnss_winbind.so /usr/lib/nss_winbind.so.2</B
-></P
-><P
->Now, as root you need to edit <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/nsswitch.conf</TT
-> to
-allow user and group entries to be visible from the <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->winbindd</B
->
-daemon. My <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/nsswitch.conf</TT
-> file look like
-this after editing:</P
-><P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
-> passwd: files winbind
+It will also build the winbindd executable and libraries.
+</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2980035"></a>Configure <tt class="filename">nsswitch.conf</tt> and the
+winbind libraries on Linux and Solaris</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+The libraries needed to run the <span class="application">winbindd</span> daemon
+through nsswitch need to be copied to their proper locations, so
+</p><p>
+</p><pre class="screen">
+<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>cp ../samba/source/nsswitch/libnss_winbind.so /lib</tt></b>
+</pre><p>
+</p><p>
+I also found it necessary to make the following symbolic link:
+</p><p>
+<tt class="prompt">root# </tt> <b class="userinput"><tt>ln -s /lib/libnss_winbind.so /lib/libnss_winbind.so.2</tt></b>
+</p><p>And, in the case of Sun solaris:</p><pre class="screen">
+<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>ln -s /usr/lib/libnss_winbind.so /usr/lib/libnss_winbind.so.1</tt></b>
+<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>ln -s /usr/lib/libnss_winbind.so /usr/lib/nss_winbind.so.1</tt></b>
+<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>ln -s /usr/lib/libnss_winbind.so /usr/lib/nss_winbind.so.2</tt></b>
+</pre><p>
+Now, as root you need to edit <tt class="filename">/etc/nsswitch.conf</tt> to
+allow user and group entries to be visible from the <span class="application">winbindd</span>
+daemon. My <tt class="filename">/etc/nsswitch.conf</tt> file look like
+this after editing:
+</p><pre class="programlisting">
+ passwd: files winbind
shadow: files
- group: files winbind</PRE
-></P
-><P
->
+ group: files winbind
+</pre><p>
The libraries needed by the winbind daemon will be automatically
-entered into the <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->ldconfig</B
-> cache the next time
+entered into the <b class="command">ldconfig</b> cache the next time
your system reboots, but it
-is faster (and you don't need to reboot) if you do it manually:</P
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="PROMPT"
->root#</TT
-> <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->/sbin/ldconfig -v | grep winbind</B
-></P
-><P
->This makes <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->libnss_winbind</TT
-> available to winbindd
-and echos back a check to you.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><H3
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><A
-NAME="AEN2390">15.5.3.3. Configure smb.conf</H3
-><P
->Several parameters are needed in the smb.conf file to control
-the behavior of <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->winbindd</B
->. Configure
-<TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->smb.conf</TT
-> These are described in more detail in
-the <A
-HREF="winbindd.8.html"
-TARGET="_top"
->winbindd(8)</A
-> man page. My
-<TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->smb.conf</TT
-> file was modified to
-include the following entries in the [global] section:</P
-><P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
->[global]
- &#60;...&#62;
+is faster (and you don't need to reboot) if you do it manually:
+</p><p>
+<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>/sbin/ldconfig -v | grep winbind</tt></b>
+</p><p>
+This makes <tt class="filename">libnss_winbind</tt> available to winbindd
+and echos back a check to you.
+</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2980242"></a>NSS Winbind on AIX</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p>(This section is only for those running AIX)</p><p>
+The winbind AIX identification module gets built as libnss_winbind.so in the
+nsswitch directory of the samba source. This file can be copied to
+/usr/lib/security, and the AIX naming convention would indicate that it
+should be named WINBIND. A stanza like the following:
+</p><pre class="programlisting">
+WINBIND:
+ program = /usr/lib/security/WINBIND
+ options = authonly
+</pre><p>can then be added to
+<tt class="filename">/usr/lib/security/methods.cfg</tt>. This module only
+supports identification, but there have been success reports using the
+standard winbind pam module for authentication. Use caution configuring
+loadable authentication modules as it is possible to make it impossible
+to logon to the system. More information about the AIX authentication
+module API can be found at &quot;Kernel Extensions and Device Support
+Programming Concepts for AIX&quot;: <a href="http://publibn.boulder.ibm.com/doc_link/en_US/a_doc_lib/aixprggd/kernextc/sec_load_mod.htm" target="_top">
+Chapter 18. Loadable Authentication Module Programming Interface</a>
+and more information on administering the modules at <a href="http://publibn.boulder.ibm.com/doc_link/en_US/a_doc_lib/aixbman/baseadmn/iandaadmin.htm" target="_top">
+&quot;System Management Guide: Operating System and Devices&quot;</a>.
+</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2980323"></a>Configure smb.conf</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+Several parameters are needed in the smb.conf file to control
+the behavior of <span class="application">winbindd</span>. Configure
+<tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> These are described in more detail in
+the <a href="winbindd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">winbindd</span>(8)</span></a> man page. My
+<tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file was modified to
+include the following entries in the [global] section:
+</p><pre class="programlisting">
+[global]
+ &lt;...&gt;
# separate domain and username with '+', like DOMAIN+username
- <A
-HREF="winbindd.8.html#WINBINDSEPARATOR"
-TARGET="_top"
->winbind separator</A
-> = +
+ <a href="winbindd.8.html#WINBINDSEPARATOR" target="_top">winbind separator</a> = +
# use uids from 10000 to 20000 for domain users
- <A
-HREF="winbindd.8.html#WINBINDUID"
-TARGET="_top"
->winbind uid</A
-> = 10000-20000
+ <a href="winbindd.8.html#WINBINDUID" target="_top">winbind uid</a> = 10000-20000
# use gids from 10000 to 20000 for domain groups
- <A
-HREF="winbindd.8.html#WINBINDGID"
-TARGET="_top"
->winbind gid</A
-> = 10000-20000
+ <a href="winbindd.8.html#WINBINDGID" target="_top">winbind gid</a> = 10000-20000
# allow enumeration of winbind users and groups
- <A
-HREF="winbindd.8.html#WINBINDENUMUSERS"
-TARGET="_top"
->winbind enum users</A
-> = yes
- <A
-HREF="winbindd.8.html#WINBINDENUMGROUP"
-TARGET="_top"
->winbind enum groups</A
-> = yes
+ <a href="winbindd.8.html#WINBINDENUMUSERS" target="_top">winbind enum users</a> = yes
+ <a href="winbindd.8.html#WINBINDENUMGROUP" target="_top">winbind enum groups</a> = yes
# give winbind users a real shell (only needed if they have telnet access)
- <A
-HREF="winbindd.8.html#TEMPLATEHOMEDIR"
-TARGET="_top"
->template homedir</A
-> = /home/winnt/%D/%U
- <A
-HREF="winbindd.8.html#TEMPLATESHELL"
-TARGET="_top"
->template shell</A
-> = /bin/bash</PRE
-></P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><H3
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><A
-NAME="AEN2406">15.5.3.4. Join the SAMBA server to the PDC domain</H3
-><P
->Enter the following command to make the SAMBA server join the
-PDC domain, where <TT
-CLASS="REPLACEABLE"
-><I
->DOMAIN</I
-></TT
-> is the name of
-your Windows domain and <TT
-CLASS="REPLACEABLE"
-><I
->Administrator</I
-></TT
-> is
-a domain user who has administrative privileges in the domain.</P
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="PROMPT"
->root#</TT
-> <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->/usr/local/samba/bin/net rpc join -S PDC -U Administrator</B
-></P
-><P
->The proper response to the command should be: "Joined the domain
-<TT
-CLASS="REPLACEABLE"
-><I
->DOMAIN</I
-></TT
->" where <TT
-CLASS="REPLACEABLE"
-><I
->DOMAIN</I
-></TT
->
-is your DOMAIN name.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><H3
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><A
-NAME="AEN2417">15.5.3.5. Start up the winbindd daemon and test it!</H3
-><P
->Eventually, you will want to modify your smb startup script to
+ <a href="winbindd.8.html#TEMPLATEHOMEDIR" target="_top">template homedir</a> = /home/winnt/%D/%U
+ <a href="winbindd.8.html#TEMPLATESHELL" target="_top">template shell</a> = /bin/bash
+</pre></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2980439"></a>Join the SAMBA server to the PDC domain</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+Enter the following command to make the SAMBA server join the
+PDC domain, where <i class="replaceable"><tt>DOMAIN</tt></i> is the name of
+your Windows domain and <i class="replaceable"><tt>Administrator</tt></i> is
+a domain user who has administrative privileges in the domain.
+</p><p>
+<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>/usr/local/samba/bin/net join -S PDC -U Administrator</tt></b>
+</p><p>
+The proper response to the command should be: &quot;Joined the domain
+<i class="replaceable"><tt>DOMAIN</tt></i>&quot; where <i class="replaceable"><tt>DOMAIN</tt></i>
+is your DOMAIN name.
+</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2980493"></a>Start up the winbindd daemon and test it!</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+Eventually, you will want to modify your smb startup script to
automatically invoke the winbindd daemon when the other parts of
SAMBA start, but it is possible to test out just the winbind
portion first. To start up winbind services, enter the following
-command as root:</P
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="PROMPT"
->root#</TT
-> <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->/usr/local/samba/bin/winbindd</B
-></P
-><P
->I'm always paranoid and like to make sure the daemon
-is really running...</P
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="PROMPT"
->root#</TT
-> <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->ps -ae | grep winbindd</B
-></P
-><P
->This command should produce output like this, if the daemon is running</P
-><P
->3025 ? 00:00:00 winbindd</P
-><P
->Now... for the real test, try to get some information about the
-users on your PDC</P
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="PROMPT"
->root#</TT
-> <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->/usr/local/samba/bin/wbinfo -u</B
-></P
-><P
->
+command as root:
+</p><p>
+<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>/usr/local/samba/bin/winbindd</tt></b>
+</p><p>
+Winbindd can now also run in 'dual daemon mode'. This will make it
+run as 2 processes. The first will answer all requests from the cache,
+thus making responses to clients faster. The other will
+update the cache for the query that the first has just responded.
+Advantage of this is that responses stay accurate and are faster.
+You can enable dual daemon mode by adding <tt class="option">-B</tt> to the commandline:
+</p><p>
+<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>/usr/local/samba/bin/winbindd -B</tt></b>
+</p><p>
+I'm always paranoid and like to make sure the daemon
+is really running...
+</p><p>
+<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>ps -ae | grep winbindd</tt></b>
+</p><p>
+This command should produce output like this, if the daemon is running
+</p><pre class="screen">
+3025 ? 00:00:00 winbindd
+</pre><p>
+Now... for the real test, try to get some information about the
+users on your PDC
+</p><p>
+<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>/usr/local/samba/bin/wbinfo -u</tt></b>
+</p><p>
This should echo back a list of users on your Windows users on
-your PDC. For example, I get the following response:</P
-><P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
->CEO+Administrator
-CEO+burdell
-CEO+Guest
-CEO+jt-ad
-CEO+krbtgt
-CEO+TsInternetUser</PRE
-></P
-><P
->Obviously, I have named my domain 'CEO' and my <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->winbind
-separator</I
-></TT
-> is '+'.</P
-><P
->You can do the same sort of thing to get group information from
-the PDC:</P
-><P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
-><TT
-CLASS="PROMPT"
->root#</TT
-> <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->/usr/local/samba/bin/wbinfo -g</B
->
-CEO+Domain Admins
-CEO+Domain Users
-CEO+Domain Guests
-CEO+Domain Computers
-CEO+Domain Controllers
-CEO+Cert Publishers
-CEO+Schema Admins
-CEO+Enterprise Admins
-CEO+Group Policy Creator Owners</PRE
-></P
-><P
->The function 'getent' can now be used to get unified
+your PDC. For example, I get the following response:
+</p><pre class="screen">
+ CEO+Administrator
+ CEO+burdell
+ CEO+Guest
+ CEO+jt-ad
+ CEO+krbtgt
+ CEO+TsInternetUser
+</pre><p>
+Obviously, I have named my domain 'CEO' and my <i class="parameter"><tt>winbind
+separator</tt></i> is '+'.
+</p><p>
+You can do the same sort of thing to get group information from
+the PDC:
+</p><pre class="screen">
+<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>/usr/local/samba/bin/wbinfo -g</tt></b>
+ CEO+Domain Admins
+ CEO+Domain Users
+ CEO+Domain Guests
+ CEO+Domain Computers
+ CEO+Domain Controllers
+ CEO+Cert Publishers
+ CEO+Schema Admins
+ CEO+Enterprise Admins
+ CEO+Group Policy Creator Owners
+</pre><p>
+The function 'getent' can now be used to get unified
lists of both local and PDC users and groups.
-Try the following command:</P
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="PROMPT"
->root#</TT
-> <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->getent passwd</B
-></P
-><P
->You should get a list that looks like your <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/passwd</TT
->
+Try the following command:
+</p><p>
+<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>getent passwd</tt></b>
+</p><p>
+You should get a list that looks like your <tt class="filename">/etc/passwd</tt>
list followed by the domain users with their new uids, gids, home
-directories and default shells.</P
-><P
->The same thing can be done for groups with the command</P
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="PROMPT"
->root#</TT
-> <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->getent group</B
-></P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><H3
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><A
-NAME="AEN2453">15.5.3.6. Fix the init.d startup scripts</H3
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT4"
-><H4
-CLASS="SECT4"
-><A
-NAME="AEN2455">15.5.3.6.1. Linux</H4
-><P
->The <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->winbindd</B
-> daemon needs to start up after the
-<B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbd</B
-> and <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->nmbd</B
-> daemons are running.
-To accomplish this task, you need to modify the startup scripts of your system. They are located at <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/init.d/smb</TT
-> in RedHat and
-<TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/init.d/samba</TT
-> in Debian.
+directories and default shells.
+</p><p>
+The same thing can be done for groups with the command
+</p><p>
+<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>getent group</tt></b>
+</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2980734"></a>Fix the init.d startup scripts</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect4" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h5 class="title"><a name="id2980741"></a>Linux</h5></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+The <span class="application">winbindd</span> daemon needs to start up after the
+<span class="application">smbd</span> and <span class="application">nmbd</span> daemons are running.
+To accomplish this task, you need to modify the startup scripts of your system.
+They are located at <tt class="filename">/etc/init.d/smb</tt> in RedHat and
+<tt class="filename">/etc/init.d/samba</tt> in Debian.
script to add commands to invoke this daemon in the proper sequence. My
-startup script starts up <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbd</B
->,
-<B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->nmbd</B
->, and <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->winbindd</B
-> from the
-<TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/usr/local/samba/bin</TT
-> directory directly. The 'start'
-function in the script looks like this:</P
-><P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
->start() {
- KIND="SMB"
- echo -n $"Starting $KIND services: "
+startup script starts up <span class="application">smbd</span>, <span class="application">nmbd</span>, and <span class="application">winbindd</span> from the
+<tt class="filename">/usr/local/samba/bin</tt> directory directly. The 'start'
+function in the script looks like this:
+</p><pre class="programlisting">
+start() {
+ KIND=&quot;SMB&quot;
+ echo -n $&quot;Starting $KIND services: &quot;
daemon /usr/local/samba/bin/smbd $SMBDOPTIONS
RETVAL=$?
echo
- KIND="NMB"
- echo -n $"Starting $KIND services: "
+ KIND=&quot;NMB&quot;
+ echo -n $&quot;Starting $KIND services: &quot;
daemon /usr/local/samba/bin/nmbd $NMBDOPTIONS
RETVAL2=$?
echo
- KIND="Winbind"
- echo -n $"Starting $KIND services: "
+ KIND=&quot;Winbind&quot;
+ echo -n $&quot;Starting $KIND services: &quot;
daemon /usr/local/samba/bin/winbindd
RETVAL3=$?
echo
- [ $RETVAL -eq 0 -a $RETVAL2 -eq 0 -a $RETVAL3 -eq 0 ] &#38;&#38; touch /var/lock/subsys/smb || \
- RETVAL=1
+ [ $RETVAL -eq 0 -a $RETVAL2 -eq 0 -a $RETVAL3 -eq 0 ] &amp;&amp; \
+ touch /var/lock/subsys/smb || RETVAL=1
return $RETVAL
-}</PRE
-></P
-><P
->The 'stop' function has a corresponding entry to shut down the
-services and look s like this:</P
-><P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
->stop() {
- KIND="SMB"
- echo -n $"Shutting down $KIND services: "
+}
+</pre><p>If you would like to run winbindd in dual daemon mode, replace
+the line
+</p><pre class="programlisting">
+ daemon /usr/local/samba/bin/winbindd
+</pre><p>
+
+in the example above with:
+
+</p><pre class="programlisting">
+ daemon /usr/local/samba/bin/winbindd -B
+</pre><p>.
+</p><p>
+The 'stop' function has a corresponding entry to shut down the
+services and looks like this:
+</p><pre class="programlisting">
+stop() {
+ KIND=&quot;SMB&quot;
+ echo -n $&quot;Shutting down $KIND services: &quot;
killproc smbd
RETVAL=$?
echo
- KIND="NMB"
- echo -n $"Shutting down $KIND services: "
+ KIND=&quot;NMB&quot;
+ echo -n $&quot;Shutting down $KIND services: &quot;
killproc nmbd
RETVAL2=$?
echo
- KIND="Winbind"
- echo -n $"Shutting down $KIND services: "
+ KIND=&quot;Winbind&quot;
+ echo -n $&quot;Shutting down $KIND services: &quot;
killproc winbindd
RETVAL3=$?
- [ $RETVAL -eq 0 -a $RETVAL2 -eq 0 -a $RETVAL3 -eq 0 ] &#38;&#38; rm -f /var/lock/subsys/smb
- echo ""
+ [ $RETVAL -eq 0 -a $RETVAL2 -eq 0 -a $RETVAL3 -eq 0 ] &amp;&amp; \
+ rm -f /var/lock/subsys/smb
+ echo &quot;&quot;
return $RETVAL
-}</PRE
-></P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT4"
-><H4
-CLASS="SECT4"
-><A
-NAME="AEN2472">15.5.3.6.2. Solaris</H4
-><P
->On solaris, you need to modify the
-<TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/init.d/samba.server</TT
-> startup script. It usually
+}
+</pre></div><div class="sect4" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h5 class="title"><a name="id2980903"></a>Solaris</h5></div></div><div></div></div><p>Winbind doesn't work on solaris 9, see the <a href="Portability.html#winbind-solaris9" title="Winbind on Solaris 9">Portability</a> chapter for details.</p><p>On solaris, you need to modify the
+<tt class="filename">/etc/init.d/samba.server</tt> startup script. It usually
only starts smbd and nmbd but should now start winbindd too. If you
-have samba installed in <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/usr/local/samba/bin</TT
->,
-the file could contains something like this:</P
-><P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
->##
-## samba.server
-##
+have samba installed in <tt class="filename">/usr/local/samba/bin</tt>,
+the file could contains something like this:
+</p><pre class="programlisting">
+ ##
+ ## samba.server
+ ##
-if [ ! -d /usr/bin ]
-then # /usr not mounted
- exit
-fi
+ if [ ! -d /usr/bin ]
+ then # /usr not mounted
+ exit
+ fi
-killproc() { # kill the named process(es)
- pid=`/usr/bin/ps -e |
- /usr/bin/grep -w $1 |
- /usr/bin/sed -e 's/^ *//' -e 's/ .*//'`
- [ "$pid" != "" ] &#38;&#38; kill $pid
-}
-
-# Start/stop processes required for samba server
+ killproc() { # kill the named process(es)
+ pid=`/usr/bin/ps -e |
+ /usr/bin/grep -w $1 |
+ /usr/bin/sed -e 's/^ *//' -e 's/ .*//'`
+ [ &quot;$pid&quot; != &quot;&quot; ] &amp;&amp; kill $pid
+ }
+
+ # Start/stop processes required for samba server
+
+ case &quot;$1&quot; in
+
+ 'start')
+ #
+ # Edit these lines to suit your installation (paths, workgroup, host)
+ #
+ echo Starting SMBD
+ /usr/local/samba/bin/smbd -D -s \
+ /usr/local/samba/smb.conf
-case "$1" in
+ echo Starting NMBD
+ /usr/local/samba/bin/nmbd -D -l \
+ /usr/local/samba/var/log -s /usr/local/samba/smb.conf
-'start')
-#
-# Edit these lines to suit your installation (paths, workgroup, host)
-#
-echo Starting SMBD
- /usr/local/samba/bin/smbd -D -s \
- /usr/local/samba/smb.conf
+ echo Starting Winbind Daemon
+ /usr/local/samba/bin/winbindd
+ ;;
-echo Starting NMBD
- /usr/local/samba/bin/nmbd -D -l \
- /usr/local/samba/var/log -s /usr/local/samba/smb.conf
+ 'stop')
+ killproc nmbd
+ killproc smbd
+ killproc winbindd
+ ;;
-echo Starting Winbind Daemon
- /usr/local/samba/bin/winbindd
- ;;
+ *)
+ echo &quot;Usage: /etc/init.d/samba.server { start | stop }&quot;
+ ;;
+ esac
+</pre><p>
+Again, if you would like to run samba in dual daemon mode, replace
+</p><pre class="programlisting">
+ /usr/local/samba/bin/winbindd
+</pre><p>
-'stop')
- killproc nmbd
- killproc smbd
- killproc winbindd
- ;;
+in the script above with:
-*)
- echo "Usage: /etc/init.d/samba.server { start | stop }"
- ;;
-esac</PRE
-></P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT4"
-><H4
-CLASS="SECT4"
-><A
-NAME="AEN2479">15.5.3.6.3. Restarting</H4
-><P
->If you restart the <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbd</B
->, <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->nmbd</B
->,
-and <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->winbindd</B
-> daemons at this point, you
+</p><pre class="programlisting">
+ /usr/local/samba/bin/winbindd -B
+</pre><p>
+</p></div><div class="sect4" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h5 class="title"><a name="id2981021"></a>Restarting</h5></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+If you restart the <span class="application">smbd</span>, <span class="application">nmbd</span>, and <span class="application">winbindd</span> daemons at this point, you
should be able to connect to the samba server as a domain member just as
-if you were a local user.</P
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><H3
-CLASS="SECT3"
-><A
-NAME="AEN2485">15.5.3.7. Configure Winbind and PAM</H3
-><P
->If you have made it this far, you know that winbindd and samba are working
+if you were a local user.
+</p></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2981058"></a>Configure Winbind and PAM</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+If you have made it this far, you know that winbindd and samba are working
together. If you want to use winbind to provide authentication for other
services, keep reading. The pam configuration files need to be altered in
this step. (Did you remember to make backups of your original
-<TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/pam.d</TT
-> files? If not, do it now.)</P
-><P
->You will need a pam module to use winbindd with these other services. This
-module will be compiled in the <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->../source/nsswitch</TT
-> directory
-by invoking the command</P
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="PROMPT"
->root#</TT
-> <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->make nsswitch/pam_winbind.so</B
-></P
-><P
->from the <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->../source</TT
-> directory. The
-<TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->pam_winbind.so</TT
-> file should be copied to the location of
+<tt class="filename">/etc/pam.d</tt> files? If not, do it now.)
+</p><p>
+You will need a pam module to use winbindd with these other services. This
+module will be compiled in the <tt class="filename">../source/nsswitch</tt> directory
+by invoking the command
+</p><p>
+<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>make nsswitch/pam_winbind.so</tt></b>
+</p><p>
+from the <tt class="filename">../source</tt> directory. The
+<tt class="filename">pam_winbind.so</tt> file should be copied to the location of
your other pam security modules. On my RedHat system, this was the
-<TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/lib/security</TT
-> directory. On Solaris, the pam security
-modules reside in <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/usr/lib/security</TT
->.</P
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="PROMPT"
->root#</TT
-> <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->cp ../samba/source/nsswitch/pam_winbind.so /lib/security</B
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT4"
-><H4
-CLASS="SECT4"
-><A
-NAME="AEN2502">15.5.3.7.1. Linux/FreeBSD-specific PAM configuration</H4
-><P
->The <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/pam.d/samba</TT
-> file does not need to be changed. I
-just left this fileas it was:</P
-><P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
->auth required /lib/security/pam_stack.so service=system-auth
-account required /lib/security/pam_stack.so service=system-auth</PRE
-></P
-><P
->The other services that I modified to allow the use of winbind
+<tt class="filename">/lib/security</tt> directory. On Solaris, the pam security
+modules reside in <tt class="filename">/usr/lib/security</tt>.
+</p><p>
+<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>cp ../samba/source/nsswitch/pam_winbind.so /lib/security</tt></b>
+</p><div class="sect4" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h5 class="title"><a name="id2981164"></a>Linux/FreeBSD-specific PAM configuration</h5></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+The <tt class="filename">/etc/pam.d/samba</tt> file does not need to be changed. I
+just left this fileas it was:
+</p><pre class="programlisting">
+ auth required /lib/security/pam_stack.so service=system-auth
+ account required /lib/security/pam_stack.so service=system-auth
+</pre><p>
+The other services that I modified to allow the use of winbind
as an authentication service were the normal login on the console (or a terminal
session), telnet logins, and ftp service. In order to enable these
services, you may first need to change the entries in
-<TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/xinetd.d</TT
-> (or <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/inetd.conf</TT
->).
+<tt class="filename">/etc/xinetd.d</tt> (or <tt class="filename">/etc/inetd.conf</tt>).
RedHat 7.1 uses the new xinetd.d structure, in this case you need
-to change the lines in <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/xinetd.d/telnet</TT
->
-and <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/xinetd.d/wu-ftp</TT
-> from </P
-><P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
->enable = no</PRE
-></P
-><P
->to</P
-><P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
->enable = yes</PRE
-></P
-><P
->
+to change the lines in <tt class="filename">/etc/xinetd.d/telnet</tt>
+and <tt class="filename">/etc/xinetd.d/wu-ftp</tt> from
+</p><pre class="programlisting">
+ enable = no
+</pre><p>
+to
+</p><pre class="programlisting">
+ enable = yes
+</pre><p>
For ftp services to work properly, you will also need to either
have individual directories for the domain users already present on
the server, or change the home directory template to a general
directory for all domain users. These can be easily set using
-the <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->smb.conf</TT
-> global entry
-<B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->template homedir</B
->.</P
-><P
->The <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/pam.d/ftp</TT
-> file can be changed
+the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> global entry
+<i class="parameter"><tt>template homedir</tt></i>.
+</p><p>
+The <tt class="filename">/etc/pam.d/ftp</tt> file can be changed
to allow winbind ftp access in a manner similar to the
-samba file. My <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/pam.d/ftp</TT
-> file was
-changed to look like this:</P
-><P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
->auth required /lib/security/pam_listfile.so item=user sense=deny file=/etc/ftpusers onerr=succeed
-auth sufficient /lib/security/pam_winbind.so
-auth required /lib/security/pam_stack.so service=system-auth
-auth required /lib/security/pam_shells.so
-account sufficient /lib/security/pam_winbind.so
-account required /lib/security/pam_stack.so service=system-auth
-session required /lib/security/pam_stack.so service=system-auth</PRE
-></P
-><P
->The <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/pam.d/login</TT
-> file can be changed nearly the
-same way. It now looks like this:</P
-><P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
->auth required /lib/security/pam_securetty.so
-auth sufficient /lib/security/pam_winbind.so
-auth sufficient /lib/security/pam_unix.so use_first_pass
-auth required /lib/security/pam_stack.so service=system-auth
-auth required /lib/security/pam_nologin.so
-account sufficient /lib/security/pam_winbind.so
-account required /lib/security/pam_stack.so service=system-auth
-password required /lib/security/pam_stack.so service=system-auth
-session required /lib/security/pam_stack.so service=system-auth
-session optional /lib/security/pam_console.so</PRE
-></P
-><P
->In this case, I added the <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->auth sufficient /lib/security/pam_winbind.so</B
->
-lines as before, but also added the <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->required pam_securetty.so</B
->
+samba file. My <tt class="filename">/etc/pam.d/ftp</tt> file was
+changed to look like this:
+</p><pre class="programlisting">
+ auth required /lib/security/pam_listfile.so item=user sense=deny \
+ file=/etc/ftpusers onerr=succeed
+ auth sufficient /lib/security/pam_winbind.so
+ auth required /lib/security/pam_stack.so service=system-auth
+ auth required /lib/security/pam_shells.so
+ account sufficient /lib/security/pam_winbind.so
+ account required /lib/security/pam_stack.so service=system-auth
+ session required /lib/security/pam_stack.so service=system-auth
+</pre><p>
+The <tt class="filename">/etc/pam.d/login</tt> file can be changed nearly the
+same way. It now looks like this:
+</p><pre class="programlisting">
+ auth required /lib/security/pam_securetty.so
+ auth sufficient /lib/security/pam_winbind.so
+ auth sufficient /lib/security/pam_unix.so use_first_pass
+ auth required /lib/security/pam_stack.so service=system-auth
+ auth required /lib/security/pam_nologin.so
+ account sufficient /lib/security/pam_winbind.so
+ account required /lib/security/pam_stack.so service=system-auth
+ password required /lib/security/pam_stack.so service=system-auth
+ session required /lib/security/pam_stack.so service=system-auth
+ session optional /lib/security/pam_console.so
+</pre><p>
+In this case, I added the </p><pre class="programlisting">auth sufficient /lib/security/pam_winbind.so</pre><p>
+lines as before, but also added the </p><pre class="programlisting">required pam_securetty.so</pre><p>
above it, to disallow root logins over the network. I also added a
-<B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->sufficient /lib/security/pam_unix.so use_first_pass</B
->
-line after the <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->winbind.so</B
-> line to get rid of annoying
-double prompts for passwords.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT4"
-><H4
-CLASS="SECT4"
-><A
-NAME="AEN2535">15.5.3.7.2. Solaris-specific configuration</H4
-><P
->The /etc/pam.conf needs to be changed. I changed this file so that my Domain
+<b class="command">sufficient /lib/security/pam_unix.so use_first_pass</b>
+line after the <b class="command">winbind.so</b> line to get rid of annoying
+double prompts for passwords.
+</p></div><div class="sect4" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h5 class="title"><a name="id2981388"></a>Solaris-specific configuration</h5></div></div><div></div></div><p>
+The /etc/pam.conf needs to be changed. I changed this file so that my Domain
users can logon both locally as well as telnet.The following are the changes
that I made.You can customize the pam.conf file as per your requirements,but
be sure of those changes because in the worst case it will leave your system
-nearly impossible to boot.</P
-><P
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
->#
-#ident "@(#)pam.conf 1.14 99/09/16 SMI"
-#
-# Copyright (c) 1996-1999, Sun Microsystems, Inc.
-# All Rights Reserved.
-#
-# PAM configuration
-#
-# Authentication management
-#
-login auth required /usr/lib/security/pam_winbind.so
-login auth required /usr/lib/security/$ISA/pam_unix.so.1 try_first_pass
-login auth required /usr/lib/security/$ISA/pam_dial_auth.so.1 try_first_pass
-#
-rlogin auth sufficient /usr/lib/security/pam_winbind.so
-rlogin auth sufficient /usr/lib/security/$ISA/pam_rhosts_auth.so.1
-rlogin auth required /usr/lib/security/$ISA/pam_unix.so.1 try_first_pass
-#
-dtlogin auth sufficient /usr/lib/security/pam_winbind.so
-dtlogin auth required /usr/lib/security/$ISA/pam_unix.so.1 try_first_pass
-#
-rsh auth required /usr/lib/security/$ISA/pam_rhosts_auth.so.1
-other auth sufficient /usr/lib/security/pam_winbind.so
-other auth required /usr/lib/security/$ISA/pam_unix.so.1 try_first_pass
-#
-# Account management
-#
-login account sufficient /usr/lib/security/pam_winbind.so
-login account requisite /usr/lib/security/$ISA/pam_roles.so.1
-login account required /usr/lib/security/$ISA/pam_unix.so.1
-#
-dtlogin account sufficient /usr/lib/security/pam_winbind.so
-dtlogin account requisite /usr/lib/security/$ISA/pam_roles.so.1
-dtlogin account required /usr/lib/security/$ISA/pam_unix.so.1
-#
-other account sufficient /usr/lib/security/pam_winbind.so
-other account requisite /usr/lib/security/$ISA/pam_roles.so.1
-other account required /usr/lib/security/$ISA/pam_unix.so.1
-#
-# Session management
-#
-other session required /usr/lib/security/$ISA/pam_unix.so.1
-#
-# Password management
-#
-#other password sufficient /usr/lib/security/pam_winbind.so
-other password required /usr/lib/security/$ISA/pam_unix.so.1
-dtsession auth required /usr/lib/security/$ISA/pam_unix.so.1
-#
-# Support for Kerberos V5 authentication (uncomment to use Kerberos)
-#
-#rlogin auth optional /usr/lib/security/$ISA/pam_krb5.so.1 try_first_pass
-#login auth optional /usr/lib/security/$ISA/pam_krb5.so.1 try_first_pass
-#dtlogin auth optional /usr/lib/security/$ISA/pam_krb5.so.1 try_first_pass
-#other auth optional /usr/lib/security/$ISA/pam_krb5.so.1 try_first_pass
-#dtlogin account optional /usr/lib/security/$ISA/pam_krb5.so.1
-#other account optional /usr/lib/security/$ISA/pam_krb5.so.1
-#other session optional /usr/lib/security/$ISA/pam_krb5.so.1
-#other password optional /usr/lib/security/$ISA/pam_krb5.so.1 try_first_pass</PRE
-></P
-><P
->I also added a try_first_pass line after the winbind.so line to get rid of
-annoying double prompts for passwords.</P
-><P
->Now restart your Samba &#38; try connecting through your application that you
-configured in the pam.conf.</P
-></DIV
-></DIV
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><H1
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN2542">15.6. Limitations</H1
-><P
->Winbind has a number of limitations in its current
+nearly impossible to boot.
+</p><pre class="programlisting">
+ #
+ #ident &quot;@(#)pam.conf 1.14 99/09/16 SMI&quot;
+ #
+ # Copyright (c) 1996-1999, Sun Microsystems, Inc.
+ # All Rights Reserved.
+ #
+ # PAM configuration
+ #
+ # Authentication management
+ #
+ login auth required /usr/lib/security/pam_winbind.so
+ login auth required /usr/lib/security/$ISA/pam_unix.so.1 try_first_pass
+ login auth required /usr/lib/security/$ISA/pam_dial_auth.so.1 try_first_pass
+ #
+ rlogin auth sufficient /usr/lib/security/pam_winbind.so
+ rlogin auth sufficient /usr/lib/security/$ISA/pam_rhosts_auth.so.1
+ rlogin auth required /usr/lib/security/$ISA/pam_unix.so.1 try_first_pass
+ #
+ dtlogin auth sufficient /usr/lib/security/pam_winbind.so
+ dtlogin auth required /usr/lib/security/$ISA/pam_unix.so.1 try_first_pass
+ #
+ rsh auth required /usr/lib/security/$ISA/pam_rhosts_auth.so.1
+ other auth sufficient /usr/lib/security/pam_winbind.so
+ other auth required /usr/lib/security/$ISA/pam_unix.so.1 try_first_pass
+ #
+ # Account management
+ #
+ login account sufficient /usr/lib/security/pam_winbind.so
+ login account requisite /usr/lib/security/$ISA/pam_roles.so.1
+ login account required /usr/lib/security/$ISA/pam_unix.so.1
+ #
+ dtlogin account sufficient /usr/lib/security/pam_winbind.so
+ dtlogin account requisite /usr/lib/security/$ISA/pam_roles.so.1
+ dtlogin account required /usr/lib/security/$ISA/pam_unix.so.1
+ #
+ other account sufficient /usr/lib/security/pam_winbind.so
+ other account requisite /usr/lib/security/$ISA/pam_roles.so.1
+ other account required /usr/lib/security/$ISA/pam_unix.so.1
+ #
+ # Session management
+ #
+ other session required /usr/lib/security/$ISA/pam_unix.so.1
+ #
+ # Password management
+ #
+ #other password sufficient /usr/lib/security/pam_winbind.so
+ other password required /usr/lib/security/$ISA/pam_unix.so.1
+ dtsession auth required /usr/lib/security/$ISA/pam_unix.so.1
+ #
+ # Support for Kerberos V5 authentication (uncomment to use Kerberos)
+ #
+ #rlogin auth optional /usr/lib/security/$ISA/pam_krb5.so.1 try_first_pass
+ #login auth optional /usr/lib/security/$ISA/pam_krb5.so.1 try_first_pass
+ #dtlogin auth optional /usr/lib/security/$ISA/pam_krb5.so.1 try_first_pass
+ #other auth optional /usr/lib/security/$ISA/pam_krb5.so.1 try_first_pass
+ #dtlogin account optional /usr/lib/security/$ISA/pam_krb5.so.1
+ #other account optional /usr/lib/security/$ISA/pam_krb5.so.1
+ #other session optional /usr/lib/security/$ISA/pam_krb5.so.1
+ #other password optional /usr/lib/security/$ISA/pam_krb5.so.1 try_first_pass
+</pre><p>
+I also added a try_first_pass line after the winbind.so line to get rid of
+annoying double prompts for passwords.
+</p><p>
+Now restart your Samba and try connecting through your application that you
+configured in the pam.conf.
+</p></div></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2981479"></a>Conclusion</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>The winbind system, through the use of the Name Service
+ Switch, Pluggable Authentication Modules, and appropriate
+ Microsoft RPC calls have allowed us to provide seamless
+ integration of Microsoft Windows NT domain users on a
+ UNIX system. The result is a great reduction in the administrative
+ cost of running a mixed UNIX and NT network.</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2981498"></a>Common Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>Winbind has a number of limitations in its current
released version that we hope to overcome in future
- releases:</P
-><P
-></P
-><UL
-><LI
-><P
->Winbind is currently only available for
- the Linux operating system, although ports to other operating
+ releases:</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Winbind is currently only available for
+ the Linux, Solaris and IRIX operating systems, although ports to other operating
systems are certainly possible. For such ports to be feasible,
we require the C library of the target operating system to
support the Name Service Switch and Pluggable Authentication
Modules systems. This is becoming more common as NSS and
- PAM gain support among UNIX vendors.</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->The mappings of Windows NT RIDs to UNIX ids
+ PAM gain support among UNIX vendors.</p></li><li><p>The mappings of Windows NT RIDs to UNIX ids
is not made algorithmically and depends on the order in which
unmapped users or groups are seen by winbind. It may be difficult
to recover the mappings of rid to UNIX id mapping if the file
- containing this information is corrupted or destroyed.</P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
->Currently the winbind PAM module does not take
+ containing this information is corrupted or destroyed.</p></li><li><p>Currently the winbind PAM module does not take
into account possible workstation and logon time restrictions
- that may be been set for Windows NT users.</P
-></LI
-></UL
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><H1
-CLASS="SECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN2552">15.7. Conclusion</H1
-><P
->The winbind system, through the use of the Name Service
- Switch, Pluggable Authentication Modules, and appropriate
- Microsoft RPC calls have allowed us to provide seamless
- integration of Microsoft Windows NT domain users on a
- UNIX system. The result is a great reduction in the administrative
- cost of running a mixed UNIX and NT network.</P
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="NAVFOOTER"
-><HR
-ALIGN="LEFT"
-WIDTH="100%"><TABLE
-SUMMARY="Footer navigation table"
-WIDTH="100%"
-BORDER="0"
-CELLPADDING="0"
-CELLSPACING="0"
-><TR
-><TD
-WIDTH="33%"
-ALIGN="left"
-VALIGN="top"
-><A
-HREF="printing.html"
-ACCESSKEY="P"
->Prev</A
-></TD
-><TD
-WIDTH="34%"
-ALIGN="center"
-VALIGN="top"
-><A
-HREF="samba-howto-collection.html"
-ACCESSKEY="H"
->Home</A
-></TD
-><TD
-WIDTH="33%"
-ALIGN="right"
-VALIGN="top"
-><A
-HREF="pdb-mysql.html"
-ACCESSKEY="N"
->Next</A
-></TD
-></TR
-><TR
-><TD
-WIDTH="33%"
-ALIGN="left"
-VALIGN="top"
->Printing Support</TD
-><TD
-WIDTH="34%"
-ALIGN="center"
-VALIGN="top"
-><A
-HREF="optional.html"
-ACCESSKEY="U"
->Up</A
-></TD
-><TD
-WIDTH="33%"
-ALIGN="right"
-VALIGN="top"
->Passdb MySQL plugin</TD
-></TR
-></TABLE
-></DIV
-></BODY
-></HTML
-> \ No newline at end of file
+ that may be been set for Windows NT users, this is
+ instead up to the PDC to enforce.</p></li></ul></div></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="VFS.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="optional.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="AdvancedNetworkManagement.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 20. Stackable VFS modules </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="index.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 22. Advanced Network Manangement</td></tr></table></div></body></html>
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/winbindd.8.html b/docs/htmldocs/winbindd.8.html
index fb8c9c0458..c1a64d6a00 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/winbindd.8.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/winbindd.8.html
@@ -1,644 +1,153 @@
-<!DOCTYPE HTML PUBLIC "-//W3C//DTD HTML 4.01//EN">
-<HTML
-><HEAD
-><TITLE
->winbindd</TITLE
-><META
-NAME="GENERATOR"
-CONTENT="Modular DocBook HTML Stylesheet Version 1.76b+
-"></HEAD
-><BODY
-CLASS="REFENTRY"
-BGCOLOR="#FFFFFF"
-TEXT="#000000"
-LINK="#0000FF"
-VLINK="#840084"
-ALINK="#0000FF"
-><H1
-><A
-NAME="WINBINDD">winbindd</H1
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFNAMEDIV"
-><A
-NAME="AEN5"
-></A
-><H2
->Name</H2
->winbindd&nbsp;--&nbsp;Name Service Switch daemon for resolving names
- from NT servers</DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSYNOPSISDIV"
-><A
-NAME="AEN8"><H2
->Synopsis</H2
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->winbindd</B
-> [-F] [-S] [-i] [-B] [-d &#60;debug level&#62;] [-s &#60;smb config file&#62;] [-n]</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN18"
-></A
-><H2
->DESCRIPTION</H2
-><P
->This program is part of the <A
-HREF="samba.7.html"
-TARGET="_top"
-> Samba</A
-> suite.</P
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->winbindd</B
-> is a daemon that provides
+<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>winbindd</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="winbindd.8"></a><div class="titlepage"><div></div><div></div></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>winbindd &#8212; Name Service Switch daemon for resolving names
+ from NT servers</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><tt class="command">winbindd</tt> [-F] [-S] [-i] [-B] [-d &lt;debug level&gt;] [-s &lt;smb config file&gt;] [-n]</p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This program is part of the <a href="Samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">Samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p><b class="command">winbindd</b> is a daemon that provides
a service for the Name Service Switch capability that is present
in most modern C libraries. The Name Service Switch allows user
and system information to be obtained from different databases
services such as NIS or DNS. The exact behaviour can be configured
- throught the <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/nsswitch.conf</TT
-> file.
+ throught the <tt class="filename">/etc/nsswitch.conf</tt> file.
Users and groups are allocated as they are resolved to a range
of user and group ids specified by the administrator of the
- Samba system.</P
-><P
->The service provided by <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->winbindd</B
-> is called `winbind' and
+ Samba system.</p><p>The service provided by <b class="command">winbindd</b> is called `winbind' and
can be used to resolve user and group information from a
Windows NT server. The service can also provide authentication
- services via an associated PAM module. </P
-><P
-> The <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->pam_winbind</TT
-> module in the 2.2.2 release only
- supports the <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->auth</I
-></TT
-> and <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->account</I
-></TT
->
+ services via an associated PAM module. </p><p>
+ The <tt class="filename">pam_winbind</tt> module in the 2.2.2 release only
+ supports the <i class="parameter"><tt>auth</tt></i> and <i class="parameter"><tt>account</tt></i>
module-types. The latter simply
performs a getpwnam() to verify that the system can obtain a uid for the
- user. If the <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->libnss_winbind</TT
-> library has been correctly
+ user. If the <tt class="filename">libnss_winbind</tt> library has been correctly
installed, this should always succeed.
- </P
-><P
->The following nsswitch databases are implemented by
- the winbindd service: </P
-><P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
->hosts</DT
-><DD
-><P
->User information traditionally stored in
- the <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->hosts(5)</TT
-> file and used by
- <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->gethostbyname(3)</B
-> functions. Names are
+ </p><p>The following nsswitch databases are implemented by
+ the winbindd service: </p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">hosts</span></dt><dd><p>User information traditionally stored in
+ the <tt class="filename">hosts(5)</tt> file and used by
+ <b class="command">gethostbyname(3)</b> functions. Names are
resolved through the WINS server or by broadcast.
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
->passwd</DT
-><DD
-><P
->User information traditionally stored in
- the <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->passwd(5)</TT
-> file and used by
- <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->getpwent(3)</B
-> functions. </P
-></DD
-><DT
->group</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Group information traditionally stored in
- the <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->group(5)</TT
-> file and used by
- <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->getgrent(3)</B
-> functions. </P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-><P
->For example, the following simple configuration in the
- <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/nsswitch.conf</TT
-> file can be used to initially
- resolve user and group information from <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/passwd
- </TT
-> and <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/group</TT
-> and then from the
- Windows NT server. </P
-><P
-><TABLE
-BORDER="0"
-BGCOLOR="#E0E0E0"
-WIDTH="100%"
-><TR
-><TD
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
->passwd: files winbind
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term">passwd</span></dt><dd><p>User information traditionally stored in
+ the <tt class="filename">passwd(5)</tt> file and used by
+ <b class="command">getpwent(3)</b> functions. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">group</span></dt><dd><p>Group information traditionally stored in
+ the <tt class="filename">group(5)</tt> file and used by
+ <b class="command">getgrent(3)</b> functions. </p></dd></dl></div><p>For example, the following simple configuration in the
+ <tt class="filename">/etc/nsswitch.conf</tt> file can be used to initially
+ resolve user and group information from <tt class="filename">/etc/passwd
+ </tt> and <tt class="filename">/etc/group</tt> and then from the
+ Windows NT server.
+</p><pre class="programlisting">
+passwd: files winbind
group: files winbind
- </PRE
-></TD
-></TR
-></TABLE
-></P
-><P
->The following simple configuration in the
- <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/nsswitch.conf</TT
-> file can be used to initially
- resolve hostnames from <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/hosts</TT
-> and then from the
- WINS server.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN61"
-></A
-><H2
->OPTIONS</H2
-><P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
->-F</DT
-><DD
-><P
->If specified, this parameter causes
- the main <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->winbindd</B
-> process to not daemonize,
+</pre><p>The following simple configuration in the
+ <tt class="filename">/etc/nsswitch.conf</tt> file can be used to initially
+ resolve hostnames from <tt class="filename">/etc/hosts</tt> and then from the
+ WINS server.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">-F</span></dt><dd><p>If specified, this parameter causes
+ the main <b class="command">winbindd</b> process to not daemonize,
i.e. double-fork and disassociate with the terminal.
Child processes are still created as normal to service
each connection request, but the main process does not
exit. This operation mode is suitable for running
- <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->winbindd</B
-> under process supervisors such
- as <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->supervise</B
-> and <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->svscan</B
->
- from Daniel J. Bernstein's <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->daemontools</B
->
+ <b class="command">winbindd</b> under process supervisors such
+ as <b class="command">supervise</b> and <b class="command">svscan</b>
+ from Daniel J. Bernstein's <b class="command">daemontools</b>
package, or the AIX process monitor.
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-S</DT
-><DD
-><P
->If specified, this parameter causes
- <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->winbindd</B
-> to log to standard output rather
- than a file.</P
-></DD
-><DT
->-d debuglevel</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Sets the debuglevel to an integer between
- 0 and 100. 0 is for no debugging and 100 is for reams and
- reams. To submit a bug report to the Samba Team, use debug
- level 100 (see BUGS.txt). </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-i</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Tells <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->winbindd</B
-> to not
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-S</span></dt><dd><p>If specified, this parameter causes
+ <b class="command">winbindd</b> to log to standard output rather
+ than a file.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-V</span></dt><dd><p>Prints the version number for
+<b class="command">smbd</b>.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-s &lt;configuration file&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>The file specified contains the
+configuration details required by the server. The
+information in this file includes server-specific
+information such as what printcap file to use, as well
+as descriptions of all the services that the server is
+to provide. See <a href="smb.conf.5.html" target="_top"><tt class="filename">
+smb.conf(5)</tt></a> for more information.
+The default configuration file name is determined at
+compile time.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-d|--debug=debuglevel</span></dt><dd><p><i class="replaceable"><tt>debuglevel</tt></i> is an integer
+from 0 to 10. The default value if this parameter is
+not specified is zero.</p><p>The higher this value, the more detail will be
+logged to the log files about the activities of the
+server. At level 0, only critical errors and serious
+warnings will be logged. Level 1 is a reasonable level for
+day to day running - it generates a small amount of
+information about operations carried out.</p><p>Levels above 1 will generate considerable
+amounts of log data, and should only be used when
+investigating a problem. Levels above 3 are designed for
+use only by developers and generate HUGE amounts of log
+data, most of which is extremely cryptic.</p><p>Note that specifying this parameter here will
+override the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#loglevel" target="_top">log
+level</a> parameter in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html" target="_top">
+<tt class="filename">smb.conf(5)</tt></a> file.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-l|--logfile=logbasename</span></dt><dd><p>File name for log/debug files. The extension
+<tt class="constant">&quot;.client&quot;</tt> will be appended. The log file is
+never removed by the client.
+</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-h|--help</span></dt><dd><p>Print a summary of command line options.
+</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-i</span></dt><dd><p>Tells <b class="command">winbindd</b> to not
become a daemon and detach from the current terminal. This
option is used by developers when interactive debugging
- of <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->winbindd</B
-> is required.
- <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->winbindd</B
-> also logs to standard output,
- as if the <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->-S</B
-> parameter had been given.
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-n</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Disable caching. This means winbindd will
+ of <b class="command">winbindd</b> is required.
+ <b class="command">winbindd</b> also logs to standard output,
+ as if the <b class="command">-S</b> parameter had been given.
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-n</span></dt><dd><p>Disable caching. This means winbindd will
always have to wait for a response from the domain controller
before it can respond to a client and this thus makes things
slower. The results will however be more accurate, since
results from the cache might not be up-to-date. This
might also temporarily hang winbindd if the DC doesn't respond.
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-B</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Dual daemon mode. This means winbindd will run
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-B</span></dt><dd><p>Dual daemon mode. This means winbindd will run
as 2 threads. The first will answer all requests from the cache,
thus making responses to clients faster. The other will
update the cache for the query that the first has just responded.
- Advantage of this is that responses are accurate and fast.
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
->-s|--conf=smb.conf</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Specifies the location of the all-important
- <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->smb.conf</TT
-> file. </P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN103"
-></A
-><H2
->NAME AND ID RESOLUTION</H2
-><P
->Users and groups on a Windows NT server are assigned
+ Advantage of this is that responses stay accurate and are faster.
+ </p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>NAME AND ID RESOLUTION</h2><p>Users and groups on a Windows NT server are assigned
a relative id (rid) which is unique for the domain when the
user or group is created. To convert the Windows NT user or group
into a unix user or group, a mapping between rids and unix user
- and group ids is required. This is one of the jobs that <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
-> winbindd</B
-> performs. </P
-><P
->As winbindd users and groups are resolved from a server, user
+ and group ids is required. This is one of the jobs that <b class="command">
+ winbindd</b> performs. </p><p>As winbindd users and groups are resolved from a server, user
and group ids are allocated from a specified range. This
is done on a first come, first served basis, although all existing
users and groups will be mapped as soon as a client performs a user
or group enumeration command. The allocated unix ids are stored
in a database file under the Samba lock directory and will be
- remembered. </P
-><P
->WARNING: The rid to unix id database is the only location
+ remembered. </p><p>WARNING: The rid to unix id database is the only location
where the user and group mappings are stored by winbindd. If this
file is deleted or corrupted, there is no way for winbindd to
determine which user and group ids correspond to Windows NT user
- and group rids. </P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN109"
-></A
-><H2
->CONFIGURATION</H2
-><P
->Configuration of the <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->winbindd</B
-> daemon
- is done through configuration parameters in the <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->smb.conf(5)
- </TT
-> file. All parameters should be specified in the
- [global] section of smb.conf. </P
-><P
-></P
-><UL
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="smb.conf.5.html#WINBINDSEPARATOR"
-TARGET="_top"
-> <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->winbind separator</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="smb.conf.5.html#WINBINDUID"
-TARGET="_top"
-> <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->winbind uid</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="smb.conf.5.html#WINBINDGID"
-TARGET="_top"
-> <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->winbind gid</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="smb.conf.5.html#WINBINDCACHETIME"
-TARGET="_top"
-> <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->winbind cache time</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="smb.conf.5.html#WINBINDENUMUSERS"
-TARGET="_top"
-> <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->winbind enum users</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="smb.conf.5.html#WINBINDENUMGROUPS"
-TARGET="_top"
-> <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->winbind enum groups</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="smb.conf.5.html#TEMPLATEHOMEDIR"
-TARGET="_top"
-> <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->template homedir</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="smb.conf.5.html#TEMPLATESHELL"
-TARGET="_top"
-> <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->template shell</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-><LI
-><P
-><A
-HREF="smb.conf.5.html#WINBINDUSEDEFAULTDOMAIN"
-TARGET="_top"
-> <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->winbind use default domain</I
-></TT
-></A
-></P
-></LI
-></UL
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN151"
-></A
-><H2
->EXAMPLE SETUP</H2
-><P
->To setup winbindd for user and group lookups plus
+ and group rids. </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>CONFIGURATION</h2><p>Configuration of the <b class="command">winbindd</b> daemon
+ is done through configuration parameters in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> file. All parameters should be specified in the
+ [global] section of smb.conf. </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><a href="smb.conf.5.html#WINBINDSEPARATOR" target="_top">
+ <i class="parameter"><tt>winbind separator</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="smb.conf.5.html#WINBINDUID" target="_top">
+ <i class="parameter"><tt>winbind uid</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="smb.conf.5.html#WINBINDGID" target="_top">
+ <i class="parameter"><tt>winbind gid</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="smb.conf.5.html#WINBINDCACHETIME" target="_top">
+ <i class="parameter"><tt>winbind cache time</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="smb.conf.5.html#WINBINDENUMUSERS" target="_top">
+ <i class="parameter"><tt>winbind enum users</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="smb.conf.5.html#WINBINDENUMGROUPS" target="_top">
+ <i class="parameter"><tt>winbind enum groups</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="smb.conf.5.html#TEMPLATEHOMEDIR" target="_top">
+ <i class="parameter"><tt>template homedir</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="smb.conf.5.html#TEMPLATESHELL" target="_top">
+ <i class="parameter"><tt>template shell</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="smb.conf.5.html#WINBINDUSEDEFAULTDOMAIN" target="_top">
+ <i class="parameter"><tt>winbind use default domain</tt></i></a></p></li></ul></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>EXAMPLE SETUP</h2><p>To setup winbindd for user and group lookups plus
authentication from a domain controller use something like the
- following setup. This was tested on a RedHat 6.2 Linux box. </P
-><P
->In <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/nsswitch.conf</TT
-> put the
- following:</P
-><P
-><TABLE
-BORDER="0"
-BGCOLOR="#E0E0E0"
-WIDTH="100%"
-><TR
-><TD
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
->passwd: files winbind
+ following setup. This was tested on a RedHat 6.2 Linux box. </p><p>In <tt class="filename">/etc/nsswitch.conf</tt> put the
+ following:
+</p><pre class="programlisting">
+passwd: files winbind
group: files winbind
- </PRE
-></TD
-></TR
-></TABLE
-></P
-><P
->In <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/pam.d/*</TT
-> replace the
- <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->auth</I
-></TT
-> lines with something like this: </P
-><P
-><TABLE
-BORDER="0"
-BGCOLOR="#E0E0E0"
-WIDTH="100%"
-><TR
-><TD
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
->auth required /lib/security/pam_securetty.so
+</pre><p>In <tt class="filename">/etc/pam.d/*</tt> replace the <i class="parameter"><tt>
+ auth</tt></i> lines with something like this:
+</p><pre class="programlisting">
+auth required /lib/security/pam_securetty.so
auth required /lib/security/pam_nologin.so
auth sufficient /lib/security/pam_winbind.so
auth required /lib/security/pam_pwdb.so use_first_pass shadow nullok
- </PRE
-></TD
-></TR
-></TABLE
-></P
-><P
->Note in particular the use of the <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->sufficient</I
-></TT
->
- keyword and the <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->use_first_pass</I
-></TT
-> keyword. </P
-><P
->Now replace the account lines with this: </P
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->account required /lib/security/pam_winbind.so
- </B
-></P
-><P
->The next step is to join the domain. To do that use the
- <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbpasswd</B
-> program like this: </P
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->smbpasswd -j DOMAIN -r PDC -U
- Administrator</B
-></P
-><P
->The username after the <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->-U</I
-></TT
-> can be any
+</pre><p>Note in particular the use of the <i class="parameter"><tt>sufficient
+ </tt></i> keyword and the <i class="parameter"><tt>use_first_pass</tt></i> keyword. </p><p>Now replace the account lines with this: </p><p><b class="command">account required /lib/security/pam_winbind.so
+ </b></p><p>The next step is to join the domain. To do that use the
+ <b class="command">net</b> program like this: </p><p><b class="command">net join -S PDC -U Administrator</b></p><p>The username after the <i class="parameter"><tt>-U</tt></i> can be any
Domain user that has administrator privileges on the machine.
- Substitute your domain name for "DOMAIN" and the name of your PDC
- for "PDC".</P
-><P
->Next copy <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->libnss_winbind.so</TT
-> to
- <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/lib</TT
-> and <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->pam_winbind.so</TT
->
- to <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/lib/security</TT
->. A symbolic link needs to be
- made from <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/lib/libnss_winbind.so</TT
-> to
- <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/lib/libnss_winbind.so.2</TT
->. If you are using an
+ Substitute the name or IP of your PDC for &quot;PDC&quot;.</p><p>Next copy <tt class="filename">libnss_winbind.so</tt> to
+ <tt class="filename">/lib</tt> and <tt class="filename">pam_winbind.so
+ </tt> to <tt class="filename">/lib/security</tt>. A symbolic link needs to be
+ made from <tt class="filename">/lib/libnss_winbind.so</tt> to
+ <tt class="filename">/lib/libnss_winbind.so.2</tt>. If you are using an
older version of glibc then the target of the link should be
- <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/lib/libnss_winbind.so.1</TT
->.</P
-><P
->Finally, setup a <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->smb.conf</TT
-> containing directives like the
- following: </P
-><P
-><TABLE
-BORDER="0"
-BGCOLOR="#E0E0E0"
-WIDTH="100%"
-><TR
-><TD
-><PRE
-CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
->[global]
+ <tt class="filename">/lib/libnss_winbind.so.1</tt>.</p><p>Finally, setup a <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> containing directives like the
+ following:
+</p><pre class="programlisting">
+[global]
winbind separator = +
winbind cache time = 10
template shell = /bin/bash
@@ -648,274 +157,58 @@ CLASS="PROGRAMLISTING"
workgroup = DOMAIN
security = domain
password server = *
- </PRE
-></TD
-></TR
-></TABLE
-></P
-><P
->Now start winbindd and you should find that your user and
+</pre><p>Now start winbindd and you should find that your user and
group database is expanded to include your NT users and groups,
and that you can login to your unix box as a domain user, using
the DOMAIN+user syntax for the username. You may wish to use the
- commands <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->getent passwd</B
-> and <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->getent group
- </B
-> to confirm the correct operation of winbindd.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN190"
-></A
-><H2
->NOTES</H2
-><P
->The following notes are useful when configuring and
- running <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->winbindd</B
->: </P
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->nmbd</B
-> must be running on the local machine
- for <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->winbindd</B
-> to work. <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->winbindd</B
->
- queries the list of trusted domains for the Windows NT server
- on startup and when a SIGHUP is received. Thus, for a running <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
-> winbindd</B
-> to become aware of new trust relationships between
- servers, it must be sent a SIGHUP signal. </P
-><P
->Client processes resolving names through the <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->winbindd</B
->
- nsswitch module read an environment variable named <TT
-CLASS="ENVAR"
-> $WINBINDD_DOMAIN</TT
->. If this variable contains a comma separated
- list of Windows NT domain names, then winbindd will only resolve users
- and groups within those Windows NT domains. </P
-><P
->PAM is really easy to misconfigure. Make sure you know what
+ commands <b class="command">getent passwd</b> and <b class="command">getent group
+ </b> to confirm the correct operation of winbindd.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>NOTES</h2><p>The following notes are useful when configuring and
+ running <b class="command">winbindd</b>: </p><p><a href="nmbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">nmbd</span>(8)</span></a> must be running on the local machine
+ for <b class="command">winbindd</b> to work. <b class="command">winbindd</b> queries
+ the list of trusted domains for the Windows NT server
+ on startup and when a SIGHUP is received. Thus, for a running <b class="command">
+ winbindd</b> to become aware of new trust relationships between
+ servers, it must be sent a SIGHUP signal. </p><p>PAM is really easy to misconfigure. Make sure you know what
you are doing when modifying PAM configuration files. It is possible
- to set up PAM such that you can no longer log into your system. </P
-><P
->If more than one UNIX machine is running <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->winbindd</B
->,
+ to set up PAM such that you can no longer log into your system. </p><p>If more than one UNIX machine is running <b class="command">winbindd</b>,
then in general the user and groups ids allocated by winbindd will not
be the same. The user and group ids will only be valid for the local
- machine.</P
-><P
->If the the Windows NT RID to UNIX user and group id mapping
- file is damaged or destroyed then the mappings will be lost. </P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN206"
-></A
-><H2
->SIGNALS</H2
-><P
->The following signals can be used to manipulate the
- <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->winbindd</B
-> daemon. </P
-><P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
->SIGHUP</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Reload the <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->smb.conf(5)</TT
->
- file and apply any parameter changes to the running
+ machine.</p><p>If the the Windows NT RID to UNIX user and group id mapping
+ file is damaged or destroyed then the mappings will be lost. </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>SIGNALS</h2><p>The following signals can be used to manipulate the
+ <b class="command">winbindd</b> daemon. </p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">SIGHUP</span></dt><dd><p>Reload the <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> file and
+ apply any parameter changes to the running
version of winbindd. This signal also clears any cached
user and group information. The list of other domains trusted
- by winbindd is also reloaded. </P
-></DD
-><DT
->SIGUSR1</DT
-><DD
-><P
->The SIGUSR1 signal will cause <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
-> winbindd</B
-> to write status information to the winbind
+ by winbindd is also reloaded. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">SIGUSR1</span></dt><dd><p>The SIGUSR1 signal will cause <b class="command">
+ winbindd</b> to write status information to the winbind
log file including information about the number of user and
- group ids allocated by <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->winbindd</B
->.</P
-><P
->Log files are stored in the filename specified by the
- log file parameter.</P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN223"
-></A
-><H2
->FILES</H2
-><P
-></P
-><DIV
-CLASS="VARIABLELIST"
-><DL
-><DT
-><TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/etc/nsswitch.conf(5)</TT
-></DT
-><DD
-><P
->Name service switch configuration file.</P
-></DD
-><DT
->/tmp/.winbindd/pipe</DT
-><DD
-><P
->The UNIX pipe over which clients communicate with
- the <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->winbindd</B
-> program. For security reasons, the
+ group ids allocated by <b class="command">winbindd</b>.</p><p>Log files are stored in the filename specified by the
+ log file parameter.</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>FILES</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term"><tt class="filename">/etc/nsswitch.conf(5)</tt></span></dt><dd><p>Name service switch configuration file.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">/tmp/.winbindd/pipe</span></dt><dd><p>The UNIX pipe over which clients communicate with
+ the <b class="command">winbindd</b> program. For security reasons, the
winbind client will only attempt to connect to the winbindd daemon
- if both the <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/tmp/.winbindd</TT
-> directory
- and <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/tmp/.winbindd/pipe</TT
-> file are owned by
- root. </P
-></DD
-><DT
->/lib/libnss_winbind.so.X</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Implementation of name service switch library.
- </P
-></DD
-><DT
->$LOCKDIR/winbindd_idmap.tdb</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Storage for the Windows NT rid to UNIX user/group
+ if both the <tt class="filename">/tmp/.winbindd</tt> directory
+ and <tt class="filename">/tmp/.winbindd/pipe</tt> file are owned by
+ root. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">$LOCKDIR/winbindd_privilaged/pipe</span></dt><dd><p>The UNIX pipe over which 'privilaged' clients
+ communicate with the <b class="command">winbindd</b> program. For security
+ reasons, access to some winbindd functions - like those needed by
+ the <b class="command">ntlm_auth</b> utility - is restricted. By default,
+ only users in the 'root' group will get this access, however the administrator
+ may change the group permissions on $LOCKDIR/winbindd_privilaged to allow
+ programs like 'squid' to use ntlm_auth.
+ Note that the winbind client will only attempt to connect to the winbindd daemon
+ if both the <tt class="filename">$LOCKDIR/winbindd_privilaged</tt> directory
+ and <tt class="filename">$LOCKDIR/winbindd_privilaged/pipe</tt> file are owned by
+ root. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">/lib/libnss_winbind.so.X</span></dt><dd><p>Implementation of name service switch library.
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term">$LOCKDIR/winbindd_idmap.tdb</span></dt><dd><p>Storage for the Windows NT rid to UNIX user/group
id mapping. The lock directory is specified when Samba is initially
- compiled using the <TT
-CLASS="PARAMETER"
-><I
->--with-lockdir</I
-></TT
-> option.
- This directory is by default <TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->/usr/local/samba/var/locks
- </TT
->. </P
-></DD
-><DT
->$LOCKDIR/winbindd_cache.tdb</DT
-><DD
-><P
->Storage for cached user and group information.
- </P
-></DD
-></DL
-></DIV
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN252"
-></A
-><H2
->VERSION</H2
-><P
->This man page is correct for version 3.0 of
- the Samba suite.</P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN255"
-></A
-><H2
->SEE ALSO</H2
-><P
-><TT
-CLASS="FILENAME"
->nsswitch.conf(5)</TT
->,
- <A
-HREF="samba.7.html"
-TARGET="_top"
->samba(7)</A
->,
- <A
-HREF="wbinfo.1.html"
-TARGET="_top"
->wbinfo(1)</A
->,
- <A
-HREF="smb.conf.5.html"
-TARGET="_top"
->smb.conf(5)</A
-></P
-></DIV
-><DIV
-CLASS="REFSECT1"
-><A
-NAME="AEN262"
-></A
-><H2
->AUTHOR</H2
-><P
->The original Samba software and related utilities
+ compiled using the <i class="parameter"><tt>--with-lockdir</tt></i> option.
+ This directory is by default <tt class="filename">/usr/local/samba/var/locks
+ </tt>. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">$LOCKDIR/winbindd_cache.tdb</span></dt><dd><p>Storage for cached user and group information.
+ </p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3.0 of
+ the Samba suite.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>SEE ALSO</h2><p><tt class="filename">nsswitch.conf(5)</tt>, <a href="Samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">Samba</span>(7)</span></a>, <a href="wbinfo.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">wbinfo</span>(8)</span></a>, <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a></p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
- to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</P
-><P
-><B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->wbinfo</B
-> and <B
-CLASS="COMMAND"
->winbindd</B
->
- were written by Tim Potter.</P
-><P
->The conversion to DocBook for Samba 2.2 was done
- by Gerald Carter</P
-></DIV
-></BODY
-></HTML
-> \ No newline at end of file
+ to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</p><p><b class="command">wbinfo</b> and <b class="command">winbindd</b> were
+ written by Tim Potter.</p><p>The conversion to DocBook for Samba 2.2 was done
+ by Gerald Carter. The conversion to DocBook XML 4.2 for
+ Samba 3.0 was done by Alexander Bokovoy.</p></div></div></body></html>